Konica Minolta Documentation - Guides - Manuels Utilisateur - Konica Minolta
Konica Minolta Documentation - Guides - Manuels Utilisateur - Konica Minolta
Revenir à l'accueil Voir une liste d'imprimantes Vous souhaitez un imprimante ou un photocopieur Konica, contactez nous
ou juste avant la balise de fermeture -->
Suchergebnisse: 1 - 50 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
1060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Benutzerhandbuch: Inbetrieb nahme
n.a.
1997-01-25
1060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
1060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS 1060E Print System Getting Started
n.a.
1997-01-25
1060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
1060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 1060 : Manuel de Référence
n.a.
1997-09-10
1060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 1060 Print System Reference Guide
n.a.
1997-09-10
1060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide de l’Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 1060: Mise en Service
n.a.
1997-01-25
1060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Sistem a de Impresión QMS 1060 Guía del Usuario: Los Primeros Pasos
n.a.
1997-01-25
1060 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
1060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
1060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS 1060 Print System Getting Started
n.a.
1997-01-25
1060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 1060E Print System Reference Guide
n.a.
1997-09-10
1060 Print System
Service-Handbuch
Französisch
Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d'Impression QMS 1060: Instructions de Service
n.a.
1997-09-10
1060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 1060 Print System Operation
n.a.
1997-09-10
1060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Working with and Printing Status Pages.
n.a.
2002-03-19
1060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 1060E Print System Operation
n.a.
1997-09-10
1660 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
1660 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
1660 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 1660E: Print System Reference
n.a.
1996-01-01
1660 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 1660: Print System Reference
B
1996-01-01
1660 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Guide de l’Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 1660: Manuel de Référence
n.a.
1997-09-10
1660 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 1660E: Print System Operation
n.a.
1996-01-01
1660 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 1660: Mise en Service
n.a.
1997-09-10
1660 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 1660: Print System Operation
B
1996-01-01
1660 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
1660 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
1660 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS 1660: Getting Started
b
1996-01-01
1660 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS 1660E: Getting Started
n.a.
1996-01-01
1660 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Working with and Printing Status Pages.
n.a.
2002-03-19
1660 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Sistem a de Impresión QMS 1660 Guía del Usuario: Los Primeros Pasos
n.a.
1996-01-01
1725 E Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
1725 E Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Operation
B
1996-01-01
1725 E Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Reference
B
1996-01-01
1725 E Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Getting Started
b
1996-01-01
1725 EX Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
1725 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
1725 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
1725 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
1725 SLS Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2025 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2025 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Users Guide
n.a.
1996-01-01
2025 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Administrators Guide
n.a.
1996-01-01
2025 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2025 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X.
n.a.
2002-02-14
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher
n.a.
2002-09-26
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher
n.a.
2003-11-27
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Overlay / Background printing
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 2060: Mise en Service
n.a.
1997-09-10
Suchergebnisse: 1 - 50 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 51 - 100 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Printer specification
1.1.0
2002-04-08
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS Document Option Commands
J
2001-02-07
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Guia do software
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
LPR printing from Macintosh.
n.a.
2002-03-15
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Accounting.
n.a.
2003-07-21
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Booklet printing
n.a.
2001-12-27
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation.
n.a.
2003-05-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files.
n.a.
2002-03-19
2060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Operation
B
1998-09-18
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Drucksystem QMS 2060 Inbetriebnahme
n.a.
1997-09-10
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Benutzerhandbuch: Inbetrieb nahme
n.a.
1997-01-25
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3. x Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2001-11-19
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS UNIX Host Software
E
1998-02-07
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing envelops on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
2060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Reference
B
1998-09-18
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Use the Unix Host Software on Linux.
n.a.
2001-12-28
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress.
n.a.
2002-03-04
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS VMS Host Software
E
1998-02-07
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de software
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Consumable specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk.
n.a.
2002-03-18
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida software
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Software Handbuch
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Option specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Umlauts do not print from PageMaker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, LPR installation.
n.a.
2002-02-28
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Duplexing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98/ME driver installation.
n.a.
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Slowenisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
PodrÍcznik oprogramowania
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change resolution.
n.a.
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Installation Guide
B
2003-08-29
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR.
n.a.
2002-03-18
Suchergebnisse: 51 - 100 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 101 - 150 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
2060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace Toner cartridge.
n.a.
2003-07-18
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Working with and Printing Status Pages.
n.a.
2002-03-19
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Number Up printing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2003-02-10
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4. x NDS Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver
n.a.
2003-11-17
2060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide Logiciels
A
2001-12-10
2060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Reset Consumable Status.
n.a.
2003-07-21
2060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x.
n.a.
2002-03-18
2060 WX
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User Guide
n.a.
1997-09-10
2060 WX
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Getting Started
n.a.
1997-09-10
2060 WX
Sonstiges
Englisch
What is "LEF" A4?
n.a.
1997-09-10
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X.
n.a.
2002-02-14
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher
n.a.
2002-09-26
2425 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 2425 Operation Guide
n.a.
1997-08-09
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher
n.a.
2003-11-27
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Overlay / Background printing
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 2425: Mise en Service
n.a.
1997-09-10
2425 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Deutsch
QMS 2425 Benutzerhandbuch
n.a.
1997-08-09
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS Document Option Commands
J
2001-02-07
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Guia do software
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS 2425 Stacking and Stapling Information
n.a.
1997-09-05
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS 2425: Options Installation Guide.
n.a.
1997-09-05
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
LPR printing from Macintosh.
n.a.
2002-03-15
2425 Print System
Service-Handbuch
Französisch
Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d'Impression QMS 2425: Instructions de Service
n.a.
1997-09-10
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Accounting.
n.a.
2003-07-21
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Booklet printing
n.a.
2001-12-27
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation.
n.a.
2003-05-13
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace Toner cartridge.
n.a.
2003-07-18
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3. x Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 2425 Reference Guide
n.a.
1997-08-09
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2001-11-19
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS UNIX Host Software
E
1998-02-07
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress.
n.a.
2002-03-04
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS VMS Host Software
E
1998-02-07
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de software
A
2001-12-10
Suchergebnisse: 101 - 150 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 151 - 200 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk.
n.a.
2002-03-18
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida software
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS 2425: Getting Started
n.a.
1997-01-25
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Software Handbuch
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Umlauts do not print from PageMaker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, LPR installation.
n.a.
2002-02-28
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Benutzerhandbuch: Inbetrieb nahme
n.a.
1997-01-25
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98/ME driver installation.
n.a.
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Slowenisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
PodrÍcznik oprogramowania
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change resolution.
n.a.
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR.
n.a.
2002-03-18
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4. x NDS Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver
n.a.
2003-11-17
2425 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide Logiciels
A
2001-12-10
2425 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Reset Consumable Status.
n.a.
2003-07-21
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Overlay / Background printing
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS Document Option Commands
J
2001-02-07
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Guia do software
A
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
LPR printing from Macintosh.
n.a.
2002-03-15
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Booklet printing
n.a.
2001-12-27
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation.
n.a.
2003-05-13
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3. x Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS UNIX Host Software
E
1998-02-07
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress.
n.a.
2002-03-04
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS VMS Host Software
E
1998-02-07
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de software
A
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida software
A
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Software Handbuch
A
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Umlauts do not print from PageMaker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98/ME driver installation.
n.a.
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Slowenisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
Suchergebnisse: 151 - 200 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 201 - 250 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
PodrÍcznik oprogramowania
A
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change resolution.
n.a.
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
2425 Turbo
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4. x NDS Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
2425 Turbo
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide Logiciels
A
2001-12-10
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95 / 98 installation
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Reload Staples.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign IP Address via Control Panel or via MAP Utililty.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Setup Conserve Toner.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Setup TCP/IP port on Windows 95/98.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change / Set output resolution in the driver.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Restore driver to defaults.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Setup IPX connection.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Installing or Replacing the Toner Cartridge
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3.xx and lower Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Input tray selection.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Uninstall printer driver on PC.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT installation
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
CrownView setup.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4.xx NDS Installation
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4.xx Bindery Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Service-Handbuch
Englisch
Load Paper.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 installation
n.a.
2003-01-28
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Setup Collation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
2560 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Installation on Unix.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3225 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
3225 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Users Guide
n.a.
1996-01-01
3225 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Administrators Guide
n.a.
1996-01-01
3225 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3225 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X.
n.a.
2002-02-14
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher
n.a.
2002-09-26
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher
n.a.
2003-11-27
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Overlay / Background printing
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS Document Option Commands
J
2001-02-07
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, NDPS installation, Add Printer.
n.a.
2001-12-28
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Guia do software
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Option specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Operation
B
1999-02-02
3260 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Reference
B
2000-01-31
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
LPR printing from Macintosh.
n.a.
2002-03-15
3260 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replacing the Staple Cartridge
n.a.
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Accounting.
n.a.
2003-07-21
Suchergebnisse: 201 - 250 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 251 - 300 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Booklet printing
n.a.
2001-12-27
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation.
n.a.
2003-05-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files.
n.a.
2002-03-19
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, NDPS installation using the MQ NDPS Utility.
n.a.
2001-12-28
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3. x Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2001-11-19
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS UNIX Host Software
E
1998-02-07
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing envelops on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Use the Unix Host Software on Linux.
n.a.
2001-12-28
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress.
n.a.
2002-03-04
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS VMS Host Software
E
1998-02-07
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de software
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk.
n.a.
2002-03-18
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida software
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Software Handbuch
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace Toner Cartridge
n.a.
2003-07-18
3260 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Printer specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Umlauts do not print from PageMaker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, LPR installation.
n.a.
2002-02-28
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Duplexing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98/ME driver installation.
n.a.
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Slowenisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Consumable specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
PodrÍcznik oprogramowania
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change resolution.
n.a.
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR.
n.a.
2002-03-18
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
CrownView.
n.a.
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Working with and Printing Status Pages.
n.a.
2002-03-19
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Number Up printing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2003-02-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4. x NDS Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver
n.a.
2003-11-17
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide Logiciels
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Reset Consumable Status.
n.a.
2003-07-21
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x.
n.a.
2002-03-18
3260 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers.
n.a.
2001-12-10
Suchergebnisse: 251 - 300 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 251 - 300 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Booklet printing
n.a.
2001-12-27
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation.
n.a.
2003-05-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files.
n.a.
2002-03-19
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, NDPS installation using the MQ NDPS Utility.
n.a.
2001-12-28
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3. x Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2001-11-19
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS UNIX Host Software
E
1998-02-07
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing envelops on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Use the Unix Host Software on Linux.
n.a.
2001-12-28
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress.
n.a.
2002-03-04
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS VMS Host Software
E
1998-02-07
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de software
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk.
n.a.
2002-03-18
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida software
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Software Handbuch
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace Toner Cartridge
n.a.
2003-07-18
3260 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Printer specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Umlauts do not print from PageMaker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, LPR installation.
n.a.
2002-02-28
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Duplexing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98/ME driver installation.
n.a.
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Slowenisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Consumable specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
PodrÍcznik oprogramowania
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change resolution.
n.a.
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR.
n.a.
2002-03-18
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
CrownView.
n.a.
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Working with and Printing Status Pages.
n.a.
2002-03-19
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Number Up printing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2003-02-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4. x NDS Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver
n.a.
2003-11-17
3260 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide Logiciels
A
2001-12-10
3260 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Reset Consumable Status.
n.a.
2003-07-21
3260 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x.
n.a.
2002-03-18
3260 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers.
n.a.
2001-12-10
Suchergebnisse: 251 - 300 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 301 - 350 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
3825 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
3825 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3825 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Users Guide
n.a.
1996-01-01
3825 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Administrators Guide
n.a.
1996-01-01
3825 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
3825 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X.
n.a.
2002-02-14
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher
n.a.
2002-09-26
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher
n.a.
2003-11-27
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Overlay / Background printing
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS Document Option Commands
J
2001-02-07
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, NDPS installation, Add Printer.
n.a.
2001-12-28
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Guia do software
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Option specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Operation
B
1999-02-02
4032 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Reference
B
2000-01-31
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
LPR printing from Macintosh.
n.a.
2002-03-15
4032 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replacing the Staple Cartridge
n.a.
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Accounting.
n.a.
2003-07-21
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Booklet printing
n.a.
2001-12-27
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation.
n.a.
2003-05-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files.
n.a.
2002-03-19
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, NDPS installation using the MQ NDPS Utility.
n.a.
2001-12-28
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3. x Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2001-11-19
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS UNIX Host Software
E
1998-02-07
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing envelops on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Use the Unix Host Software on Linux.
n.a.
2001-12-28
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress.
n.a.
2002-03-04
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS VMS Host Software
E
1998-02-07
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de software
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk.
n.a.
2002-03-18
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida software
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Software Handbuch
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace Toner Cartridge
n.a.
2003-07-18
4032 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Printer specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Umlauts do not print from PageMaker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
Suchergebnisse: 301 - 350 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 351 - 400 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, LPR installation.
n.a.
2002-02-28
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Duplexing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98/ME driver installation.
n.a.
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Slowenisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Consumable specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
PodrÍcznik oprogramowania
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change resolution.
n.a.
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR.
n.a.
2002-03-18
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
CrownView.
n.a.
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Working with and Printing Status Pages.
n.a.
2002-03-19
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Number Up printing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2003-02-10
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4. x NDS Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver
n.a.
2003-11-17
4032 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide Logiciels
A
2001-12-10
4032 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Reset Consumable Status.
n.a.
2003-07-21
4032 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x.
n.a.
2002-03-18
4032 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers.
n.a.
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X.
n.a.
2002-02-14
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher
n.a.
2002-09-26
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher
n.a.
2003-11-27
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Overlay / Background printing
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Getting Started
n.a.
1997-01-25
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS Document Option Commands
J
2001-02-07
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Guia do software
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Options Installation Guide
n.a.
1997-09-05
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
LPR printing from Macintosh.
n.a.
2002-03-15
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Accounting.
n.a.
2003-07-21
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Booklet printing
n.a.
2001-12-27
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation.
n.a.
2003-05-13
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files.
n.a.
2002-03-19
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3. x Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2001-11-19
Suchergebnisse: 351 - 400 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 401 - 450 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS UNIX Host Software
E
1998-02-07
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing envelops on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Use the Unix Host Software on Linux.
n.a.
2001-12-28
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress.
n.a.
2002-03-04
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Benutzerhandbuch: Inbetrieb nahme
n.a.
1997-01-25
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS VMS Host Software
E
1998-02-07
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de software
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk.
n.a.
2002-03-18
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida software
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Software Handbuch
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace Toner.
n.a.
2003-07-18
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Umlauts do not print from PageMaker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Duplexing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98/ME driver installation.
n.a.
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Technische Daten
Englisch
Media Specification
1.1.0
2001-12-27
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Slowenisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
PodrÍcznik oprogramowania
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change resolution.
n.a.
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Operation
n.a.
1997-01-31
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR.
n.a.
2002-03-18
4060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Reference
n.a.
1997-01-31
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Working with and Printing Status Pages.
n.a.
2002-03-19
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Number Up printing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2003-02-10
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4. x NDS Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide Logiciels
A
2001-12-10
4060 Print System
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Reset Consumable Status.
n.a.
2003-07-21
4060 Print System
Sonstiges
Englisch
Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x.
n.a.
2002-03-18
4060 Q-Doc
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Q-Doc User Manual
1.1.0
2006-03-29
bizhub C10P
Konformitätserklärung
Englisch
Declaration of Conformity for Konica Minolta bizhub C10P, mc2500W, mc2530DL, mc2550
CEM-2006-T018A
2007-04-30
bizhub C20P
Konformitätserklärung
Englisch
Declaration of Conformity for Konica Minolta bizhub C20P, mc4650DN, mc4650EN
CEM-2007-T019B
2007-12-18
bizhub C30P
Konformitätserklärung
Englisch
Declaration of Conformity for Konica Minolta bizhub C30P, mc5550, mc5570
CEM-2006-T017C
2007-10-02
bizhub C31P
Konformitätserklärung
Englisch
Declaration of Conformity for Konica Minolta bizhub C31P, mc5650, mc5670
CEM-2008-T001A
2008-04-09
Color PagePro
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign IP Address
n.a.
2002-03-21
Color PagePro
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
Color PagePro
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Page Pro Printer on Windows 95/98 via TCP/IP.
n.a.
2002-03-21
Color PagePro Ex
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User Manual
1.1.0
2004-06-18
Color PagePro Ex
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
Color PagePro Ex
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Usermanual Network Card
1.1.0
2005-01-04
Color PagePro L
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User's Guide
1.1.0
2002-05-08
Color PagePro L
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
Color PagePro Plus
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User Guide
1.1.0
2004-06-18
Suchergebnisse: 401 - 450 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 451 - 500 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
Color PagePro Plus
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
Color PagePro Plus
Sonstiges
Englisch
Network Setup Guide
1.1.0
2001-09-30
Color PagePro PS
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
Color PagePro PS Plus
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User Guide
1.1.0
2004-06-18
Color PagePro PS Plus
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
Color PagePro PS Plus
Sonstiges
Englisch
Network Setup Guide
1.1.0
2001-09-30
Color PageWorks L
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User's Guide
1.1.0
2002-05-08
ColorScript 310
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
ColorScript 310/330 Guide de l’utilisateur
n.a.
1997-08-09
ColorScript 310
Benutzerhandbuch
Deutsch
ColorScript 310/330 Benutzerhandbuch
n.a.
1997-08-09
ColorScript 310
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
ColorScript 310/330 Users Guide
n.a.
1997-08-09
ColorScript 330
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
ColorScript 310/330 Guide de l’utilisateur
n.a.
1997-08-09
ColorScript 330
Benutzerhandbuch
Deutsch
ColorScript 310/330 Benutzerhandbuch
n.a.
1997-08-09
ColorScript 330
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
ColorScript 310/330 Users Guide
n.a.
1997-08-09
DeskLaser 1400 P
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign a TCP/IP Address.
n.a.
2002-04-13
DeskLaser 1400 P
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell, NDS installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
DeskLaser 1400 P
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell, Bindery installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
DeskLaser 1600 P
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User manual
n.a.
2002-04-05
DeskLaser 1600 P
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4, NDS installation.
n.a.
2001-12-27
DeskLaser 1600 P
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Network Interface - User manual
n.a.
2002-04-05
DeskLaser 1600 P
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Duplexer - User manual
n.a.
2002-04-05
DeskLaser 1600 P
Sonstiges
Englisch
Macintosh Installation.
n.a.
2001-12-27
DeskLaser 1600 P
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign TCP/IP Address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
DeskLaser 2000
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User Guide
n.a.
1997-09-10
DeskLaser 2000
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Getting Started
n.a.
1997-09-10
DeskLaser 2000
Sonstiges
Englisch
What is "LEF" A4?
n.a.
1997-09-10
magicolor 1600W
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Black
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1600W
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Cyan
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1600W
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
OPC Drum
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1600W
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Magenta
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1600W
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Yellow
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
User's guide
03
2008-11-21
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Norwegisch
User's guide
03
2008-11-21
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Niederländisch
User's guide
03
2008-11-21
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Griechisch
User's guide
03
2008-11-21
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Spanisch
User's guide
03
2008-11-21
magicolor 1650EN
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Black
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1650EN
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Cyan
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1650EN
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
OPC Drum
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1650EN
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Magenta
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Türkisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Schwedisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Spanisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Slovakisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Russisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Portugiesisch (Brasilien)
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Polnisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Norwegisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Koreanisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Japanisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Italienisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
Suchergebnisse: 451 - 500 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 501 - 550 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Ungarisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Griechisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Deutsch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Finnisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Niederländisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Dänisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Tschechisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Benutzerhandbuch
Arabisch
Safety information guide
02
2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Yellow
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Schwedisch
User's guide
01
2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Quick guide
00
2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Koreanisch
Quick guide
00
2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Griechisch
Quick guide
00
2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Tschechisch
Quick guide
00
2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Black
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Schwedisch
Quick guide
00
2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Dänisch
User's guide
01
2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Deutsch
User's guide
01
2008-12-01
magicolor 1680MF
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Cyan
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Tschechisch
User's guide
01
2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Ungarisch
User's guide
01
2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
User's guide
01
2008-12-01
magicolor 1680MF
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
OPC Drum
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1680MF
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Magenta
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1680MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Italienisch
User's guide
01
2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Yellow
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Russisch
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Russisch
Facsimile User's Guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Schwedisch
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Schwedisch
Facsimile User's Guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Facsimile User's Guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Türkisch
Facsimile User's Guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Italienisch
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Black
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Koreanisch
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Finnisch
Facsimile User's Guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Dänisch
Facsimile User's Guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Cyan
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Polnisch
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Tschechisch
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Ungarisch
Facsimile User's Guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Portugiesisch (Brasilien)
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Spanisch
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
OPC Drum
1.1.0
2008-12-18
Suchergebnisse: 501 - 550 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 551 - 600 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
magicolor 1690MF
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Magenta
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Norwegisch
User's guide
01
2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Türkisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Schwedisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Spanisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Slovakisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Russisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Portugiesisch (Brasilien)
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Polnisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Norwegisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Italienisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Ungarisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Griechisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Deutsch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Finnisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Niederländisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Dänisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Tschechisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Benutzerhandbuch
Arabisch
Installation guide
00
2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Toner, Yellow
1.1.0
2008-12-18
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X.
n.a.
2002-02-14
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Deutsch
ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, MacOS
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner K
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
TSCA Decalartion
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher
n.a.
2002-09-26
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher
n.a.
2003-11-27
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Overlay / Background printing
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Print System Options
B
1999-06-16
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Reference
B
1999-06-16
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Deutsch
ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, Windows.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Using Pantone Color Palettes for Crown Color Printers
1.1.0
2002-05-07
magicolor 2
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Fuser Oil
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS Document Option Commands
J
2001-02-07
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner M
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Guia do software
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
How to setup your printer for printing on different media’s.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Color Density Adjustment
A
1998-11-17
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
LPR printing from Macintosh.
n.a.
2002-03-15
magicolor 2
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Operation
B
1999-06-16
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Booklet printing
n.a.
2001-12-27
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Windows
1.1.0
2002-05-07
magicolor 2
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner C
1.1.0
1999-12-08
Suchergebnisse: 551 - 600 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 601 - 650 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation.
n.a.
2003-05-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files.
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Französisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3. x Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2001-11-19
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS UNIX Host Software
E
1998-02-07
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing envelops on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Use the Unix Host Software on Linux.
n.a.
2001-12-28
magicolor 2
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, OPC
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Macintosh
1.1.0
2002-05-07
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress.
n.a.
2002-03-04
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS VMS Host Software
E
1998-02-07
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de software
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk.
n.a.
2002-03-18
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida software
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Software Handbuch
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Italienisch
Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, MacOS.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Umlauts do not print from PageMaker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Italienisch
Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, Windows.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Pantone Color Setup.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98/ME driver installation.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner Y
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Slowenisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
PodrÍcznik oprogramowania
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Service-Handbuch
Deutsch
User Maintenance Guide
n/a.
2001-01-25
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change resolution.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR.
n.a.
2002-03-18
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
CrownView.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Working with and Printing Status Pages.
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4. x NDS Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Französisch
Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, MacOS.
1.1.1
2002-11-28
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Französisch
Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, Windows.
1.1.1
2002-11-28
magicolor 2
Technische Daten
Spanisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Technische Daten
Italienisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Technische Daten
Deutsch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Technische Daten
Französisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2
Technische Daten
Englisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
Suchergebnisse: 601 - 650 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 651 - 700 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver
n.a.
2003-11-17
magicolor 2
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide Logiciels
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2
Sonstiges
Englisch
Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x.
n.a.
2002-03-18
magicolor 2
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X.
n.a.
2002-02-14
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Deutsch
ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, MacOS
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2 +
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner K
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2 +
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
TSCA Decalartion
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher
n.a.
2002-09-26
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher
n.a.
2003-11-27
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Overlay / Background printing
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Deutsch
ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, Windows.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Using Pantone Color Palettes for Crown Color Printers
1.1.0
2002-05-07
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Installation Guide
A
1999-09-01
magicolor 2 +
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Fuser Oil
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS Document Option Commands
J
2001-02-07
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, NDPS installation, Add Printer.
n.a.
2001-12-28
magicolor 2 +
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner M
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Guia do software
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Technische Daten
Englisch
Option specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
How to setup your printer for printing on different media’s.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
LPR printing from Macintosh.
n.a.
2002-03-15
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Accounting.
n.a.
2003-07-21
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Booklet printing
n.a.
2001-12-27
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Windows
1.1.0
2002-05-07
magicolor 2 +
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner C
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation.
n.a.
2003-05-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files.
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, NDPS installation using the MQ NDPS Utility.
n.a.
2001-12-28
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Französisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3. x Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2001-11-19
magicolor 2 +
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Color Book - Booklet Maker - BM-2 - User Manual
1.1.0
2006-03-29
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS UNIX Host Software
E
1998-02-07
magicolor 2 +
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Operation manual
A
1999-09-01
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing envelops on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Use the Unix Host Software on Linux.
n.a.
2001-12-28
magicolor 2 +
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, OPC
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Macintosh
1.1.0
2002-05-07
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress.
n.a.
2002-03-04
Suchergebnisse: 651 - 700 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 701 - 750 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS VMS Host Software
E
1998-02-07
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Technische Daten
Englisch
Consumable specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de software
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk.
n.a.
2002-03-18
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida software
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Software Handbuch
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Italienisch
Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, MacOS.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Umlauts do not print from PageMaker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, LPR installation.
n.a.
2002-02-28
magicolor 2 +
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Print System Reference manual
A
1999-09-01
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Italienisch
Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, Windows.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Duplexing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Pantone Color Setup.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Technische Daten
Englisch
Printer specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98/ME driver installation.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner Y
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Slowenisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
PodrÍcznik oprogramowania
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change resolution.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR.
n.a.
2002-03-18
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
CrownView.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Working with and Printing Status Pages.
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Number Up printing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2003-02-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4. x NDS Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Französisch
Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, MacOS.
1.1.1
2002-11-28
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Französisch
Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, Windows.
1.1.1
2002-11-28
magicolor 2 +
Technische Daten
Spanisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Technische Daten
Italienisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Technische Daten
Deutsch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Technische Daten
Französisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Technische Daten
Englisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 +
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Statistics page on Crown Printers.
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver
n.a.
2003-11-17
magicolor 2 +
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide Logiciels
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 +
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Reset Consumable Status.
n.a.
2003-07-21
magicolor 2 +
Sonstiges
Englisch
Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x.
n.a.
2002-03-18
magicolor 2 +
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner K
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
TSCA Decalartion
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Italienisch
Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMSDesklaser.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Desklaser printers
1.1.0
2002-05-07
Suchergebnisse: 701 - 750 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 751 - 800 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Installation Guide
A
1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Fuser Oil
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Installation Guide
A
1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Black and White printing.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner M
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User's Guide
C
1999-06-26
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Setup Guide
C
1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Installation Guide
A
1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Installationsanleitung
A
1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Deutsch
-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Desklaser-Farbdrucker.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner C
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Englisch
Option specification
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Englisch
Consumable specifications
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Color Book - Booklet Maker - BM-2 - User Manual
1.1.0
2006-03-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, OPC
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Englisch
Printer specification
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Installation Guide
A
1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Französisch
Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes couleur Desklaser Minolta-QMS.
1.1.1
2002-11-28
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner Y
1.1.0
1999-12-08
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing Multiple Copies of a File using collation on the magicolor 2 DeskLaser
n.a.
2002-05-28
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Spanisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Italienisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Deutsch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Französisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Englisch
OPC belt lifetime
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Waste Toner Pack.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X.
n.a.
2002-02-14
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Installationsanleitung
1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Deutsch
ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, MacOS
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher
n.a.
2002-09-26
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Transfer Roller
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher
n.a.
2003-11-27
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Overlay / Background printing
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Deutsch
Benutzerhandbuch
B
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Repacking instructions
A
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Deutsch
ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, Windows.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Using Pantone Color Palettes for Crown Color Printers
1.1.0
2002-05-07
magicolor 2200
Technische Daten
Englisch
Consumable specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS Document Option Commands
J
2001-02-07
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide d'installation
1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, NDPS installation, Add Printer.
n.a.
2001-12-28
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Guia do software
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
How to setup your printer for printing on different media’s.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
Suchergebnisse: 751 - 800 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 801 - 850 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
LPR printing from Macintosh.
n.a.
2002-03-15
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Guide d’utilisation
B
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Accounting.
n.a.
2003-07-21
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Technische Daten
Englisch
Printer specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Booklet printing
n.a.
2001-12-27
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the OPC drum.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-K
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Windows
1.1.0
2002-05-07
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation.
n.a.
2003-05-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files.
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Loading the MPT tray on the magicolor 2200 Series.
n.a.
2003-03-10
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, NDPS installation using the MQ NDPS Utility.
n.a.
2001-12-28
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Technische Daten
Englisch
Option specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Französisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 2000 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Französisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Telnet to a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 3. x Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Englisch
How to remove paper jams near to the fuser unit?
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2001-11-19
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida di installazione
A
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS UNIX Host Software
E
1998-02-07
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing envelops on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Installation Guide
B
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Use the Unix Host Software on Linux.
n.a.
2001-12-28
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Italienisch
Guida Utenete
B
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Macintosh
1.1.0
2002-05-07
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress.
n.a.
2002-03-04
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Transfer Belt.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS VMS Host Software
E
1998-02-07
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98 driver installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Laser Lens Cover.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User Guide
B
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Fuser Oil
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de software
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-Y
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk.
n.a.
2002-03-18
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida software
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Software Handbuch
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Englisch
Clearing Media Jams Near the Sensor
n.a.
2002-09-18
magicolor 2200
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-M
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Italienisch
Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, MacOS.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Umlauts do not print from PageMaker.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, LPR installation.
n.a.
2002-02-28
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Spanisch
Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo
n.a.
2003-07-11
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Italienisch
Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo
n.a.
2003-07-11
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Deutsch
Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo
n.a.
2003-07-11
Suchergebnisse: 801 - 850 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 851 - 900 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo
n.a.
2003-07-11
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo
n.a.
2003-07-11
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Fuser Unit.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Italienisch
Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, Windows.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Duplexing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2002-03-25
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Pantone Color Setup.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Spanisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Italienisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Deutsch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Französisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Englisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Niederländisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Dänisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Service-Handbuch
Tschechisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign an IP address.
n.a.
2001-12-27
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows 95/98/ME driver installation.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Removing the Transfer Belt Fixture Unit on the magicolor 2200 Series
n.a.
2003-08-18
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Slowenisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Fuser Oil Roller.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
PodrÍcznik oprogramowania
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Change resolution.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR.
n.a.
2002-03-18
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
CrownView.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Französisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP.
n.a.
2002-04-12
magicolor 2200
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-C
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Working with and Printing Status Pages.
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Toner Cartridges.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Number Up printing on a Crown Printer.
n.a.
2003-02-10
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 4. x NDS Installation.
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Französisch
Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, MacOS.
1.1.1
2002-11-28
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Französisch
Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, Windows.
1.1.1
2002-11-28
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Statistics page on Crown Printers.
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver
n.a.
2003-11-17
magicolor 2200
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide Logiciels
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Reset Consumable Status.
n.a.
2003-07-21
magicolor 2200
Sonstiges
Englisch
Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x.
n.a.
2002-03-18
magicolor 2200
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Waste Toner Pack.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Installationsanleitung
C
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Italienisch
Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMSDesklaser.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Transfer Roller
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Using the Printer's Web Page
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Ungarisch
Installation Guide
C
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Desklaser printers
1.1.0
2002-05-07
Suchergebnisse: 851 - 900 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 901 - 950 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Repacking instructions
A
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Italienisch
Sostituzione di materiali di consumo
n.a.
2002-08-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Englisch
Consumable specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (vereinfacht)
Installation Guide
C
2002-01-12
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Black and White printing.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Setup duplexing
n,a,
2002-05-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Französisch
Assign IP Address.
n.a.
2001-12-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Assign IP Address.
n.a.
2001-12-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Deutsch
Benutzerhandbuch
B
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Französisch
Driver Options, using the printer driver.
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Driver Options, using the printer driver.
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Slovakisch
User Guide .
B
2002-01-12
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Disabling Color Matching Setting.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing Multiple Copies of a File using collation on the magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
n.a.
2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Thailändisch
Installation Guide
C
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Setting the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser to Switch Bins When One Bin is Empty
n.a.
2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
Installation Guide
C
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the OPC drum.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-K
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Französisch
Setting up a TCP/IP Network on Windows 2000
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Setting up a TCP/IP Network on Windows 2000
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Deutsch
-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Desklaser-Farbdrucker.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Loading the MPT tray on the magicolor 2200 Series.
n.a.
2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Tschechisch
Installation Guide
C
2002-02-23
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Tschechisch
User Guide
B
2002-02-23
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Uninstall the printer driver.
n.a.
2002-05-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Selecting Input/Output Trays on the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser
n.a.
2002-05-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Englisch
How to remove paper jams near to the fuser unit?
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Installation Guide
C
2002-01-12
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
Installation Guide
C
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Uninstalling the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser Driver
n.a.
2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Transfer Belt.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Disabling Composite Black Setting.
n.a.
2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Deutsch
Austausch von Verbrauchsmaterial.
n.a.
2002-08-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
User Guide
B
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Guide d’utilisation
B
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Laser Lens Cover.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Fuser Oil
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Englisch
Option specification
1.1.0
2002-04-29
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Englisch
Printer specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-Y
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Clear Care Procedure / Clear messages.
n.a.
2002-08-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Selecting Media Types and envelops on the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser
n.a.
2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Englisch
Clearing Media Jams Near the Sensor
n.a.
2002-09-18
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-M
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Printing Multiple Copies of a File using collation on the magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
n.a.
2002-05-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Installing the Printer Driver for the magicolor 2200 DeskLaser in Windows 95/98/NT4/2000/XP
n.a.
2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Technische Daten
Englisch
Consumable specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Selecting Media Types and envelops on the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser
n,a,
2002-05-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Spanisch
Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo
n.a.
2003-07-11
Suchergebnisse: 901 - 950 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 951 - 1000 von über 1000
Produkt
Unterkat.
Sprache
Titel
Version
Freigabe
Download
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Italienisch
Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo
n.a.
2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Deutsch
Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo
n.a.
2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Französisch
Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo
n.a.
2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo
n.a.
2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Vietnamesisch
Installation Guide
C
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Fuser Unit.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Slovakisch
Installation Guide
C
2002-01-12
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Guide d'installation
C
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Französisch
Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes couleur Desklaser Minolta-QMS.
1.1.1
2002-11-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Spanisch
Guía de instalación
C
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Spanisch
Guía de usuario
B
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Spanisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Italienisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Deutsch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Französisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Englisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Niederländisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Dänisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Service-Handbuch
Tschechisch
Maintenance Guide
D
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Removing the Transfer Belt Fixture Unit on the magicolor 2200 Series
n.a.
2003-08-18
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Fuser Oil Roller.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Installationsanleitung
Italienisch
Guida di installazione
C
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Selecting Input/Output Trays on the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser
n.a.
2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Italienisch
Guida Utente
B
2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Englisch
Menu options.
n.a.
2002-05-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sicherheitsdatenblatt
Englisch
Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-C
1.1.0
1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Toner Cartridges.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Sonstiges
Französisch
Remplacement des consommables
n.a.
2002-08-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Reset Consumable Status.
n.a.
2003-07-21
magicolor 2210
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Waste Toner Pack.
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2210
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X.
n.a.
2002-02-14
magicolor 2210
Sonstiges
Deutsch
ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, MacOS
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2210
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher
n.a.
2002-09-26
magicolor 2210
Benutzerhandbuch
Englisch
Replace the Transfer Roller
n.a.
2003-07-28
magicolor 2210
Installationsanleitung
Polnisch
Installation Guide
C
2002-01-17
magicolor 2210
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Software Guide
A
2001-12-10
magicolor 2210
Installationsanleitung
Französisch
Installation Guide Magicolor 2210, French
A
2001-11-15
magicolor 2210
Sonstiges
Englisch
Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher
n.a.
2003-11-27
magicolor 2210
Sonstiges
Englisch
Overlay / Background printing
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2210
Installationsanleitung
Slovakisch
Installation Guide
C
2002-01-17
magicolor 2210
Installationsanleitung
Deutsch
Installationsanleitung
C
2002-01-17
magicolor 2210
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x).
n.a.
2002-04-13
magicolor 2210
Sonstiges
Deutsch
ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, Windows.
1.1.1
2002-05-07
magicolor 2210
Sonstiges
Englisch
Using Pantone Color Palettes for Crown Color Printers
1.1.0
2002-05-07
magicolor 2210
Technische Daten
Englisch
Consumable specification
1.1.0
2002-04-13
magicolor 2210
Installationsanleitung
Chinesisch (traditionell)
Installation Guide
C
2002-01-17
magicolor 2210
Installationsanleitung
Englisch
QMS Document Option Commands
J
2001-02-07
magicolor 2210
Installationsanleitung
Portugiesisch (Portugal)
Guia de Instalação
C
2002-01-17
magicolor 2210
Sonstiges
Englisch
Novell 5.x, NDPS installation, Add Printer.
n.a.
2001-12-28
Suchergebnisse: 951 - 1000 von über 1000
Autre documentation Konica Minolta :
Konica-Minolta-Documentation-2-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Bizhub-40P-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Bizhub-C450-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Bizhub-C250-2-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Bizhub-601-3-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-IC-408-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-362-282-222-Francais-Manuel
Konica-Minolta-Bizhub-601-2-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Bizhub-D191F-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Bizhub-Ineo-7000-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C552-Francais-Manuel
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C250-Francais-Manuel
Konica-Minolta-Ineo-951-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Bizhub-Ineo-1052-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Ineo-25-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-ineo-163-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-ineo-253-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Bizhub-282-Francais-documentation-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-documentation-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Di2510-Di3010-Di3510-Advanced-Information-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C550-bizhub-C451-bizhub-C203-bizhub-C253-bizhub-C353-bizhub-C650-Advanced-Function-Operations-i-Option-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Bizhub-C203-Advanced-Function-Operations-i-Option2-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-3730DN-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-PageScope-Account-Manager-Ver.2.1-User-s-Guide-EFIGS-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C554-C454-C364-C284-C224-User-Guides-part-1-2-French-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-162-210-copier-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-552-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-130f-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-PRO-PRESS-C6000-C7000_ug_Expert-Guide-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-2400W-User-Documentation-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-User-Manual-bizhub-C252-Phase3-complete-set-Documentation-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C200-Phase2-User-Manuals-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C200-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C10-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-163-211-User-Manual-Copier-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-1600f-User-Manual-Copier-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-131f-190f-User-Manual-Manuels
Konica-bizhub-131f-190f-Advanced-Information-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-190f-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C253-Advanced-Function-Operations-i-Option-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C253-Advanced-Function-Operations-i-Option2-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C250-Francais-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-1690MF-Manuel
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-362-282-222-Français-Manuel
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C552-Français-Manuel
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C250-Français-Manuel
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C220-Anglais-English-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-36-Anglais-English-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-363-Anglais-English-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-363-Anglais-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-363-Pays-Bas-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-283-Russe-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-222-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C552-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C203-C253-C353-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-601-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C452-bizhub-C552-bizhub-C652DS-bizhub-C652-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C554-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-652-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C224-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C652DS-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub_c652-c652ds-c552-c452-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Photocopieur-Multifonctions-Couleur-bizhub-C10P-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Photocopieur-Multifonctions-Couleur-bizhub-C10-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-Photocopieur-Multifonctions-Couleur-7823-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C20-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C25-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-bizhub-C250-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-2490MF-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-1600W-Manuel
Konica-Minolta-7823-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-5670EN-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-5650EN-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-7823-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-7450II-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-8650DN-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-7450-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-7300-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-4750EN-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-2490MF-Imprimante-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-4750DN-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-4690MF-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-4695MF-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-4650EN-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-4650DN-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-2500W-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-3730DN-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-5570-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-5550-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-5450-Couleur-Manuels
Konica-Minolta-magicolor-5440DL-Couleur-Manuels
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=25461&productName=magicolor%202490MF
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=24593&productName=magicolor%202500W
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=45226&productName=magicolor%203730DN
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=31144&productName=magicolor%204650DN
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=31144&productName=magicolor%204650EN
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=48849&productName=magicolor%204690MF
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=48858&productName=magicolor%204695MF
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=41338&productName=magicolor%204750DN
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=25354&productName=magicolor%205450
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=29872&productName=bizhub%20C10
http://csesftp.konicaminolta.eu/NETUpload/download.aspx?brand=Frankreich&docId=DLEU0719195EN00&name=user.pdf
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/products/copier-print-systems/multifunctional-systems-black-and-white/bizhub-652/downloads/download-details.html?packageId=48057&productName=bizhub%20652
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/solutions-dentreprise/support/centre-de-telechargement/download-details.html?packageId=25408&productName=bizhub%20C250
http://csesftp.konicaminolta.eu/NETUpload/download.aspx?brand=Frankreich&docId=DLEU0618780EN00&name=bizhub_c250_um_scanner-operations_fr_1-1-1_phase3.pdf
http://csesftp.konicaminolta.eu/NETUpload/download.aspx?brand=Frankreich&docId=DLEU0618780EN00&name=bizhub_c250_um_box-operations_fr_1-1-1_phase3.pdfhttp://csesftp.konicaminolta.eu/NETUpload/download.aspx?brand=Frankreich&docId=DLEU0618780EN00&name=bizhub_c250_um_enlarge-operations_fr_1-1-1_phase3.pdf
http://csesftp.konicaminolta.eu/NETUpload/download.aspx?brand=Frankreich&docId=DLEU0618780EN00&name=bizhub_c250_um_print-operations_fr_1-1-1_phase3.pdf
http://csesftp.konicaminolta.eu/NETUpload/download.aspx?brand=Frankreich&docId=DLEU0618780EN00&name=bizhub_c250_um_copy-operations_fr_1-1-1_phase3.pdf
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=49761&productName=bizhub%20C25
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/solutions-dentreprise/support/centre-de-telechargement/download-details.html?packageId=47425&productName=magicolor%201600W
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=22632&productName=bizhub%20C252
http://csesftp.konicaminolta.eu/NETUpload/download.aspx?brand=Frankreich&docId=DLEU0610809EN00&name=bizhub_c252_um_scanner-operations_fr_1-1-1_phase3.pdf
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/business-solutions/support/download-center/download-details.html?packageId=26947&productName=Konica%20Minolta%20190f
http://www.konicaminolta.fr/solutions-dentreprise/support/centre-de-telechargement/download-details.html?packageId=21374&productName=bizhub%20210
http://csesftp.konicaminolta.eu/NETUpload/download.aspx?brand=Frankreich&docId=DLEU0514130EN00&name=bizhub_162_210_UM_FR_1.1.1.pdf
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/business-solutions.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/business-solutions/meta/about-konica-minolta.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/business-solutions/meta/imprint.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/business-solutions/meta/sitemap.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/business-solutions/meta/terms-of-use.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/meta/conditions-dutilisation.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/meta/identite.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/meta/information-groupe.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/meta/sitemap.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/info-photo.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/cartouche-toner.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/copieur-couleur.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/copieurs-couleur.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/copieurs.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fax-copieur.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fax-imprimante-copieur.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fileadmin/content/fr/rss/flux.xml
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/business-solutions.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/business-solutions/meta/about-konica-minolta.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/business-solutions/meta/imprint.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/business-solutions/meta/sitemap.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/business-solutions/meta/terms-of-use.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/accueil.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/developpement-durable.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/developpement-durable/certificats-et-labels.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/developpement-durable/cycle-de-vie-eco-responsable.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/developpement-durable/eco-fonctionnalites.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/developpement-durable/eco-technologies.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/developpement-durable/historique.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/developpement-durable/ops-green.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/developpement-durable/politique-environnementale.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/carrieres-et-emplois.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/contacts.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/espace-presse.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/espace-presse/communiques-de-presse.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/espace-presse/communiques-de-presse/presse/article/jamais-deux-sans-trois-konica-minolta-est-elu-gamme-de-lannee-par-bli-pour-la-troisieme-ann.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/espace-presse/communiques-de-presse/presse/article/konica-minolta-parraine-la-9eme-edition-de-la-nuit-des-trophees-de-limprimerie-francaise.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/espace-presse/communiques-de-presse/presse/article/konica-minolta-stand-c05-profitera-du-salon-it-partners-qui-se-tiendra-les-5-et-6-fevrier-procha.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/espace-presse/communiques-de-presse/presse/article/la-4eme-edition-des-journees-du-bureau-eco-responsable-par-konica-minolta-business-solutions-fr.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/espace-presse/communiques-de-presse/presse/article/temoignage-copy-top-retour-sur-un-investissement-reussi.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/informations-sur-lentreprise.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/entreprise/responsabilite-societale.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/meta/conditions-dutilisation.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/meta/gartner-magic-quadrant-2012.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/meta/identite.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/meta/information-groupe.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/meta/sitemap.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/produits-et-applications.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/produits-et-applications/applications.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/produits-et-applications/presses-numeriques.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/produits-et-applications/securite.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/produits-et-applications/systemes-dimpression-office.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/services-solutions-informatiques.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/services-solutions-informatiques/itraining.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/services-solutions-informatiques/marches-verticaux.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/services-solutions-informatiques/ops.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/services-solutions-informatiques/ops.html/solutions-dentreprise/produits/conseils-et-services/la-prestation-de-consulting-idoc/audit-idoc.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/services-solutions-informatiques/programme-dsp.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/services-solutions-informatiques/services-informatiques.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/support.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/support/acces-reserve.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/support/centre-de-telechargement.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/support/cleanplanet.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/fr/solutions-dentreprise/support/service-et-garantie.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/imprimante-multifonction.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/imprimante-photocopieur.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/imprimantes-copieur.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/imprimantes-laser-couleur.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/imprimantes-multifonction.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/imprimantes-photocopieuse.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/info-photo.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/photocopieurs-konica-minolta.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/photocopieurs.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/presse-numerique.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.fr/toner-photocopieur.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/csr/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/investors/fr/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/investors/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/2013/0111_01_01.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/2013/0117_01_01.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/2013/0204_01_01.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/research/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/africa1/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/africa2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/africa3/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/americas/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/americas2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/asiapacific1/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/asiapacific2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/asiapacific3/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/com_message/project/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/contact/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/me/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/mideast1/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/mideast2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/news/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/business.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/inkjethead.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/instruments.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/material.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/medical.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/oled.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/optical.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/planetarium.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/textileprinters.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/siteinfo/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/siteinfo/sitemap.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/tech_info/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-cn/corporate/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/corporate/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-fr/corporate/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/contact/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/document_download.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/domain.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/history.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/management.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/message.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/outline.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/symbol_logo.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/vision.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/csr/csr/governance/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/csr/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/investors/fr/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/investors/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/2013/0111_01_01.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/2013/0117_01_01.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/2013/0204_01_01.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/research/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/africa1/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/africa2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/africa3/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/americas/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/americas2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/asiapacific1/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/asiapacific2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/asiapacific3/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/com_message/project/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/contact/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/me/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/mideast1/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/mideast2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/news/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/business.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/inkjethead.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/instruments.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/material.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/medical.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/oled.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/optical.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/planetarium.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/textileprinters.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/siteinfo/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/siteinfo/sitemap.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/tech_info/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-cn/corporate/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/corporate/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/corporate/domain.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/corporate/history.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/corporate/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/corporate/message.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/corporate/outline.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/corporate/vision.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/csr/csr/governance/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/csr/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-de/siteinfo/sitemap.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about-fr/corporate/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/contact/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/document_download.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/domain.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/history.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/management.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/message.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/outline.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/symbol_logo.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/corporate/vision.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/csr/csr/governance/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/csr/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/investors/fr/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/investors/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/2013/0111_01_01.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/2013/0117_01_01.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/2013/0204_01_01.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/releases/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/about/research/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/africa1/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/africa2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/africa3/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/americas/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/americas2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/asiapacific1/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/asiapacific2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/asiapacific3/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/com_message/project/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/contact/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/me/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/mideast1/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/mideast2/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/news/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/business.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/inkjethead.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/instruments.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/material.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/medical.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/oled.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/optical.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/planetarium.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/selector/textileprinters.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/siteinfo/index.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/siteinfo/sitemap.html
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/tech_info/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/tech_info/01/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/tech_info/02/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/tech_info/03/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/tech_info/04/
[+] http://www.konicaminolta.com/tech_info/index.html
Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
User`s Guide Dutch IC-206 for ineo 163/213 2.1.1 2007-06-07
Parts Guide Manual Italian ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-04-30
User`s Guide Hungarian ineo 163/213 - User Manual Copy Operations 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Portuguese (Portugal) fk-506 for ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide English ineo 163/213 - User Manual Copy Operations 1.1.0 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Russian ineo 163/213 - User Manual TWAIN driver 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide French ineo 163/213 - User Manual GDI-driver 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Russian ineo 163/213 - User Manual Copy Operations 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Spanish ineo 163/213 - User Manual GDI-driver 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide German ineo 163/213 - User Manual Copy Operations 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Italian IC-206 for ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Greek ineo 163/213 - User Manual Copy Operations 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Italian IC-206 for ineo 163/213 2.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Dutch ineo 163/213 - User Manual TWAIN driver 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Dutch IC-206 for ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Dutch ineo 163/213 - User Manual Copy Operations 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Portuguese (Portugal) ineo 163/213 - User Manual GDI-driver 1.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Spanish NC-503 for ineo 163/213 2.1.1 2007-06-07
User`s Guide Dutch fk-506 for ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-06-07
Declaration of Conformity English Declaration of Conformity for ineo 163,213 i5 2010-01-08
User`s Guide German ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-04-30
User`s Guide French ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-04-30
User`s Guide Spanish ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-04-30
User`s Guide Italian ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-04-30
Declaration of Conformity - Not Related - Declaration of Conformity for ineo 163,213 i6 2011-09-15
Produit Sous-catégorie Langue Titre Version Date de sortie Lien
7013 Guide d’utilisation Italien Konica 7013 Bedienungsanleitung 1.1.1 2004-03-09
7013 Guide d’utilisation Anglais K7013 RS-232C User Manual 1.1.0 2004-09-08
7013 Guide d’utilisation Français Konica 7013 User Manual 1.1.1 2004-09-08
7013 Guide d’utilisation Allemand Konica 7013 Druckerkarte Bedienungsanleitung 1.1.1 2004-03-09
7013 Guide d’utilisation Anglais Konica 7013 Print Server Card Owner's Manual 1.1.0 2004-10-05
7013 Guide d’utilisation Allemand Konica 7013 Bedienungsanleitung 1.1.1 2004-03-09
7013 Guide d’utilisation Français K7013 Printer User Manual 1.1.1 2004-09-08
7013 Guide d’utilisation Anglais Konica 7013 User Manual 1.1.0 2004-09-08
7013 Guide d’utilisation Allemand RS232C Schnittstelle Bedienungsanleitung 1.1.1 2004-03-09
7013 Guide d’utilisation Anglais Konica 7013 Printer User Manual 1.1.0 2004-09-08
7013 Guide d’utilisation Français K7013 RS-232C 1.1.1 2004-09-08
7013 Abrégé d'utilisation Anglais Konica 7013 Quick Reference 1.1.0 2004-10-05
7020 Guide d’utilisation Danois Konica 7022/7130 User Manual 1.1.1 2004-03-17
7020 Guide d’utilisation Anglais IP-421 Instruction manual 1.1.0 2004-09-08
7020 Guide d’utilisation Anglais Konica 7020/7025/7030/7035 Instruction Manual 1.1.0 2004-03-31
7020 Guide d’utilisation Anglais IP-011 User's Guide 1.1.0 2004-10-05
7020 Guide d’utilisation Anglais FK-101 User Manual 1.1.0 2004-11-02
7020 Guide d’utilisation Allemand Konica 7020 Bedienungsanleitung 1.1.1 2004-03-09
7020 Guide d’utilisation Allemand IP-011 Bedienerhandbuch 1.1.1 2004-10-13
7020 Guide d’utilisation Allemand IP-421 Bedienerhandbuch 1.1.1 2004-10-13
7022 Guide d’utilisation Portugais Konica 7022 User Manual 1.1.1 2004-03-17
7022 Guide d’utilisation Anglais IP-423 User Manual 1.1.0 2004-09-08
7022 Guide d’utilisation Français Konica 7022/7130 User Manual 1.1.1 2004-03-16
7022 Guide d’utilisation Français URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.1 2004-09-07
7022 Guide d’utilisation Italien Konica 7022/7130 Manuale Instruzioni 1.1.1 2004-03-09
7022 Guide d’utilisation Hollandais Konica 7022/7130 User Manual 1.1.1 2004-03-17
7022 Guide d’utilisation Allemand Konica 7022/7130/7135 Bedienungsanleitung 1.1.1 2004-03-09
7022 Guide d’utilisation Anglais Konica IP-422 Print Controller User Manual 1.1.0 2004-03-10
7022 Guide d’utilisation Portugais URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.1 2004-09-07
7022 Guide d’utilisation Anglais Konica 7022/7130 Instruction Manual 1.1.0 2004-03-31
7022 Guide d’utilisation Allemand IP-422/IP-423 Printcontroller/PS-343/PS-345 PostScript3 Zubehör Bedienerhandbuch 1.1.1 2004-10-13
7022 Guide d’utilisation Espagnol URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.1 2004-09-07
7022 Guide d’utilisation Allemand IP-422 Printcontroller, PS-343 PostScript3 Zubehör Bedienerhandbuch 1.1.1 2004-10-13
7022 Guide d’utilisation Espagnol Konica 7022/7130 User Manual 1.1.1 2004-03-16
7022 Guide d’utilisation Allemand URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.1 2004-09-07
7022 Guide d’utilisation Italien URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.1 2004-09-07
7022 Guide d’utilisation Anglais URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.0 2004-09-07
7022/7122 Guide d’utilisation Anglais IP-423 User Manual 1.1.0 2004-09-08
7022/7122 Guide d’utilisation Français URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.1 2004-09-07
7022/7122 Guide d’utilisation Anglais Konica IP-422 Print Controller User Manual 1.1.0 2004-03-10
7022/7122 Guide d’utilisation Portugais URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.1 2004-09-07
7022/7122 Guide d’utilisation Allemand IP-422/IP-423 Printcontroller/PS-343/PS-345 PostScript3 Zubehör Bedienerhandbuch 1.1.1 2004-10-13
7022/7122 Guide d’utilisation Espagnol URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.1 2004-09-07
7022/7122 Guide d’utilisation Allemand IP-422 Printcontroller, PS-343 PostScript3 Zubehör Bedienerhandbuch 1.1.1 2004-10-13
7022/7122 Guide d’utilisation Allemand URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.1 2004-09-07
7022/7122 Guide d’utilisation Italien URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.1 2004-09-07
7022/7122 Guide d’utilisation Anglais URG FK-102 for Konica 7022/7130/7135 CORRECTED VERSION 1.1.0 2004-09-07
7024 Guide d’utilisation Allemand Konica 7024 Bedienungsanleitung 1.1.1 2004-03-09
7025 Guide d’utilisation Anglais IP-421 Instruction manual 1.1.0 2004-09-08
7025 Guide d’utilisation Anglais Konica 7020/7025/7030/7035 Instruction Manual 1.1.0 2004-03-31
Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
User`s Guide Spanish d131f_d191f - pcl Manual 1.1.1 2007-09-12
User`s Guide Spanish D131F/191F Advanced Information 1.1.1 2007-09-11
User`s Guide Italian D131F/191F Advanced Information 1.1.1 2007-09-11
User`s Guide Dutch D131F/191F User Manual 1.1.1 2007-09-11
User`s Guide German MB-190 Manual 1.0.0 2007-09-12
User`s Guide French D131F/191F User Manual 1.1.1 2007-09-11
User`s Guide Danish D131F/191F User Manual 1.1.1 2007-09-11
Search Results: 1 - 44 of 44
Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
User`s Guide English ineo+ 6000/7000 User's Guides 1 2010-10-05
User`s Guide German ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-06
User`s Guide English ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-0 2010-10-06
User`s Guide Czech ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Danish ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Greek ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Spanish ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Finnish ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide French ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Italian ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Norwegian ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Polish ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Russian ineo+ 6000/7000 Expert Guide 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Czech ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Danish ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide German ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Greek ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Spanish ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide French ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Italian ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Dutch ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Norwegian ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Polish ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Portuguese ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Russian ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-28
User`s Guide Turkish ineo+ 6000/7000 ORU-M Manuals 1-1-1 2010-10-29
Declaration of Conformity English Declaration of Conformity of ineo+ 6000, ineo+ 7000 i2 2011-03-14
User`s Guide Czech ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Danish ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide German ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Greek ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Spanish ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Finnish ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide French ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Italian ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Dutch ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Norwegian ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Polish ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Portuguese ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Russian ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Swedish ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide Turkish ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-1 2011-11-15
User`s Guide English ineo+ 6000L/6000/7000 - User`s Guides 2-1-0 2011-11-15
Declaration of Conformity English Declaration of Conformity of ineo+ 6000, ineo+ 7000 i1n 2012-11-14
Search Results: 1 - 44 of 44
Search Results: 1 - 6 of 6
Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
User`s Guide German ineo 1052 / 1250: User Guides 1-1-1 2012-07-27
User`s Guide Spanish ineo 1052 / 1250: User Guides 1-1-1 2012-07-27
User`s Guide French ineo 1052 / 1250: User Guides 1-1-1 2012-07-27
User`s Guide Italian ineo 1052 / 1250: User Guides 1-1-1 2012-07-27
User`s Guide English ineo 1052 / 1250: User Guides 1-1-0 2012-07-27
Declaration of Conformity English Declaration of Conformity for ineo 1052, ineo 1250 i1n 2012-11-14
Search Results: 1 - 6 of 6
Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
Quick Guide Swedish ineo +25 Quick Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-1 2012-01-12
Quick Guide Turkish ineo +25 Quick Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-1 2012-01-12
User`s Guide English ineo +25 Reference Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide English ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide German ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide French ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Italian ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Portuguese ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Spanish ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Czech ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Danish ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Dutch ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Finnish ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Greek ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Hungarian ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Norwegian ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Polish ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Russian ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Slovakian ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Swedish ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Turkish ineo +25 Safety Information Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide English ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide German ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide French ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Italian ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Portuguese ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Spanish ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Czech ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Danish ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Dutch ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Finnish ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Greek ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Hungarian ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Norwegian ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Polish ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Russian ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Slovakian ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Swedish ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
Install Manual/Guide Turkish ineo +25 Installation Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide German ineo +25 User Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-1 2012-01-12
User`s Guide English ineo +25 User Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-0 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Spanish ineo +25 User Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-1 2012-01-12
User`s Guide French ineo +25 User Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-1 2012-01-12
User`s Guide Italian ineo +25 User Guide (A2YF121 systems only) 2-1-1 2012-01-12
Declaration of Conformity English Declaration of Conformity for ineo+ 25 i1n 2012-11-14
Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
User`s Guide English ineo 223/283/363/423 User's Guides 1-1-0 2010-06-16
User`s Guide German ineo 223/283/363/423 User's Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
User`s Guide Spanish ineo 223/283/363/423 User's Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
User`s Guide French ineo 223/283/363/423 User's Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
User`s Guide Italian ineo 223/283/363/423 User's Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
User`s Guide Dutch ineo 223/283/363/423 User's Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide English ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-0 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Czech ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Danish ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide German ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Greek ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Spanish ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides Spanish 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide French ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Hungarian ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Italian ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Dutch ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Norwegian ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Polish ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Portuguese ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Russian ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Slovakian ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Quick Guide Turkish ineo 223/283/363/423 Quick Guides 1-1-1 2010-06-16
Declaration of Conformity English Declaration of Conformity for ineo 223, 283, 363, 423 i3 2011-09-15
Declaration of Conformity English Declaration of Conformity for ineo 223, 283, 363, 423 i1n 2012-11-14
Search Results: 101 - 135 of 135
Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
User`s Guide Hungarian bizhub C250 Phase3 User Manuals (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-11-01
User`s Guide Finnish bizhub C250 User Manuals 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-08-26
User`s Guide Polish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Portuguese (Portugal) bizhub C250 Phase2 User Manuals (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-08-26
User`s Guide Russian bizhub C250 Phase2 User Manuals (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-08-26
User`s Guide Swedish bizhub C250 Phase2 User Manuals (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-08-26
User`s Guide Finnish bizhub C250 Phase2 User Manuals (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-08-26
User`s Guide Turkish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Danish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Swedish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Czech bizhub C250 User Manuals 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-08-26
User`s Guide Spanish bizhub C250 Phase2 User Manuals (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-08-26
User`s Guide English User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.0 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Slovakian bizhub C250 User Manuals 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-08-26
User`s Guide Polish bizhub C250 Phase3 User Manuals (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-11-01
User`s Guide Swedish bizhub C250 User Manuals 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-08-26
Blue Angel German Blauer Engel Urkunde für Multifunktionsgerät bizhub C250 (RAL-UZ 114) i1 2006-06-26
Blue Angel German Blauer Engel Vertrag für Multifunktions- gerät bizhub C250 (RAL-UZ 114) 17011 2005-12-29
Declaration of Conformity English Declaration of Conformity for Konica Minolta bizhub C250, C250P, C252, C252P CEM 2006 - T012B 2006-10-17
ISO Certificate English ISO 14001:2004 certificate for production - Copy Machines, Laser Beam Printers, Shilong Factory, P.R. China 1526-2000-AE-RGC-RvA 2009-03-05
Special Certificates English Konica Minolta Information Security Management System according to ISO/IEC 27001 JQA-IM0473 2011-03-15
User`s Guide English TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide German TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide French TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Italian TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Spanish TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Traditional Chinese TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Korean TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide English HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide German HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide French HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Italian HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Spanish HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Traditional Chinese HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Korean HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
Search Results: 101 - 135 of 135
Alkategória Nyelv Megnevezés Verzió Megjelenés dátuma Link
Felhasználói segédlet Czech bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet Multilingual bizhub 40P Installation and Safety Guide 1.1.1 2009-03-11
Felhasználói segédlet English bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet Portugál Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Portuguese (Portugal) bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet English Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Danish bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet Polish Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Italian bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet Spanish bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet Italian Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Slovakian Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Dutch bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet Greek Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet German bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet Russian Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Russian bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet German Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Swedish Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Danish Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Polish bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet Spanish Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Hungarian Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Dutch Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Swedish bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet Norwegian Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Turkish Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet French bizhub 40P User Manual 1.1.1 2008-01-21
Felhasználói segédlet Finnish Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Felhasználói segédlet Czech Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
ISO tanúsítvány English ISO 14001:2004 certificate for production - Copy Machines, Laser Beam Printers, Shilong Factory, P.R. China 1526-2000-AE-RGC-RvA 2009-03-05
Felhasználói segédlet English bizhub 40P Reference Guide 1.1.0 2009-03-11
Felhasználói segédlet French Installation notes Windows 7 / Server 2008 R2 T1 R06 2009-11-05
Különleges tanúsítványok English Konica Minolta Information Security Management System according to ISO/IEC 27001 JQA-IM0473 2011-03-15
Megfelelőségi nyilatkozat - Not Related - Declaration of Conformity for Konica Minolta bizhub 40P CEM-2007-T018G 2011-09-16
Gyors segédlet Romanian poster bizhub 40P
Search Results: 1 - 50 of 126
Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
User`s Guide Dutch User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Italian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Hungarian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide French User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Hungarian User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Danish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide English User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C352/C250 and bizhub 750/600/bizhub 500/420) 1.1.0 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Spanish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide German User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Portuguese (Portugal) User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Portuguese (Portugal) User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Turkish User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide German User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Greek User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Turkish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Finnish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Portuguese (Portugal) User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide German User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Spanish User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Slovakian User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide English User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C352/C351/C250) 1.0.0 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Greek User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide French User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide English User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.0 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide French User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Greek User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Dutch User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Portuguese (Portugal) User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide German Bedienungsanleitungen (komplett) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Danish User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Hungarian User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide English FK-502 Phase 2.5 for bizhub C250/C300/C351/C352/C450 1.0.0 (Phase2.5) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Italian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Swedish User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Danish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Turkish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Dutch User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Norwegian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Czech User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Spanish User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Dutch User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Italian User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Greek User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide French User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Polish User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Greek User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Polish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Czech User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Finnish User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Czech User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
Search Results: 1 - 50 of 126
Search Results: 51 - 100 of 126
Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
User`s Guide Czech User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Polish User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Turkish User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Spanish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Norwegian User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Hungarian User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Swedish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Polish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Slovakian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Slovakian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Hungarian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Slovakian User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Czech User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Russian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Polish User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Norwegian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Slovakian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide English User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.0 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide English User Manual bizhub C450 Phase 2.5 (complete set) 1.0.0 (Phase 2.5) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide English Network Fax Operations 1.1.0 2006-08-22
User`s Guide Spanish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Hungarian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Italian User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Finnish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C252/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Greek User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Turkish User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Dutch User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Portuguese (Portugal) User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide English User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.0 (Phase 1.8) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Norwegian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide English User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.0 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Slovakian User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Swedish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide German Bedienungsanleitungen (komplett) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Italian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Finnish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Italian User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Swedish User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Russian User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Norwegian User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Spanish User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Portuguese (Portugal) User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Finnish User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Polish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide German User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Czech User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Dutch User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Norwegian User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Danish User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide Turkish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.1 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
Search Results: 51 - 100 of 126
Search Results: 101 - 126 of 126
Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
User`s Guide Danish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide Swedish User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250) 1.1.1 (Phase1) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide French User Manual bizhub C450 Phase3 (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase3) 2006-04-28
User`s Guide Finnish User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 2) 2004-12-01
User`s Guide English User Manual FK-502 (Fax Option for bizhub C450/C351/C250/C300/C352) 1.1.0 (Phase2) 2005-04-13
User`s Guide French User’s Guide (complete set) 1.1.1 (Phase 1) 2004-12-01
Blue Angel German Blauer Engel Vertrag für Kopierer bizhub C450 (RAL-UZ 114) 16721 2005-07-07
Declaration of Conformity English Declaration of Conformity for C450, C450P +Print Controller IC-402 +Fax CEM-2005 -T001C 2006-09-01
Declaration of Conformity English Declaration of Conformity for bizhub C451, bizhub C550, bizhub C650 CEM-2007-T015A 2007-09-07
Blue Angel German Blauer Engel Urkunde für Multifunktionsgerät bizhub C450 (RAL-UZ 114) i1 2006-06-26
ISO Certificate English ISO 14001:2004 certificate for production - Copy Machines, Laser Beam Printers, Shilong Factory, P.R. China 1526-2000-AE-RGC-RvA 2009-03-05
Special Certificates English Konica Minolta Information Security Management System according to ISO/IEC 27001 JQA-IM0473 2011-03-15
User`s Guide English TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide German TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide French TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Italian TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Spanish TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Traditional Chinese TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Korean TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide English HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide German HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide French HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Italian HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Spanish HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Traditional Chinese HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
User`s Guide Korean HDD TWAIN Driver Ver.4.0 User's Guide (EFIGSTK) 09,08 2012-01-05
Product Sub Category Language Title Version Release Date Link
IC-202 User`s Guide French IC-202 for ineo 750/600, Phase 2 - User Manual 1.1.1 2007-01-17
IC-204 User`s Guide Czech IC-204 for ineo 500/420, Phase 2 111 2007-01-10
IC-204 User`s Guide Russian IC-204 for ineo 500/420, Phase 2 111 2007-01-10
IC-204 User`s Guide Danish IC-204 for ineo 500/420/360 3 2008-01-16
IC-204 User`s Guide Italian IC-204 for ineo 500/420/360 3 2008-01-16
IC-204 User`s Guide Hungarian IC-204 for ineo 500/420/360 3 2008-01-16
IC-204 User`s Guide German IC-204 for ineo 500/420, Phase 2 111 2007-01-10
IC-204 User`s Guide English IC-204 for ineo 500/420, Phase 2 111 2007-01-10
IC-204 User`s Guide English IC-204 for ineo 500/420/360 3 2008-01-16
IC-204 User`s Guide Spanish IC-204 for ineo 500/420, Phase 2 111 2007-01-10
IC-204 User`s Guide Danish IC-204 for ineo 500/420, Phase 2 111 2007-01-10
IC-204_ineo User`s Guide Danish IC-204 for ineo 500/420/360 3 2008-01-16
IC-204_ineo User`s Guide Italian IC-204 for ineo 500/420/360 3 2008-01-16
IC-204_ineo User`s Guide Hungarian IC-204 for ineo 500/420/360 3 2008-01-16
IC-204_ineo User`s Guide English IC-204 for ineo 500/420/360 3 2008-01-16
IC-206 User`s Guide Dutch IC-206 for ineo 163/213 2.1.1 2007-06-07
IC-206 Parts Guide Manual Italian ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-04-30
IC-206 User`s Guide Italian IC-206 for ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-06-07
IC-206 User`s Guide Italian IC-206 for ineo 163/213 2.1.1 2007-06-07
IC-206 User`s Guide Dutch IC-206 for ineo 163/213 1.1.1 2007-06-07
IC-207_generic User`s Guide Spanish IC-207 1-1-1 2008-06-24
IC-207_generic User`s Guide French IC-207 1-1-1 2008-06-24
IC-207_generic User`s Guide Dutch IC-207 1-1-1 2008-06-24
IC-207_generic User`s Guide English IC-207 1-1-0 2008-06-24
IC-208_generic User`s Guide Hungarian ineo 751/601 1.1.1 2008-11-27
IC-208_generic User`s Guide French ineo 751/601 1.1.1 2008-11-27
Suchergebnisse: 1 - 50 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
1060 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Benutzerhandbuch: Inbetrieb nahme n.a. 1997-01-25
1060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
1060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS 1060E Print System Getting Started n.a. 1997-01-25
1060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
1060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 1060 : Manuel de Référence n.a. 1997-09-10
1060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 1060 Print System Reference Guide n.a. 1997-09-10
1060 Print System Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide de l’Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 1060: Mise en Service n.a. 1997-01-25
1060 Print System Installationsanleitung Spanisch Sistem a de Impresión QMS 1060 Guía del Usuario: Los Primeros Pasos n.a. 1997-01-25
1060 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
1060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
1060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS 1060 Print System Getting Started n.a. 1997-01-25
1060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 1060E Print System Reference Guide n.a. 1997-09-10
1060 Print System Service-Handbuch Französisch Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d'Impression QMS 1060: Instructions de Service n.a. 1997-09-10
1060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 1060 Print System Operation n.a. 1997-09-10
1060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Working with and Printing Status Pages. n.a. 2002-03-19
1060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 1060E Print System Operation n.a. 1997-09-10
1660 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
1660 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
1660 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 1660E: Print System Reference n.a. 1996-01-01
1660 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 1660: Print System Reference B 1996-01-01
1660 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Guide de l’Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 1660: Manuel de Référence n.a. 1997-09-10
1660 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 1660E: Print System Operation n.a. 1996-01-01
1660 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 1660: Mise en Service n.a. 1997-09-10
1660 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 1660: Print System Operation B 1996-01-01
1660 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
1660 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
1660 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS 1660: Getting Started b 1996-01-01
1660 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS 1660E: Getting Started n.a. 1996-01-01
1660 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Working with and Printing Status Pages. n.a. 2002-03-19
1660 Print System Installationsanleitung Spanisch Sistem a de Impresión QMS 1660 Guía del Usuario: Los Primeros Pasos n.a. 1996-01-01
1725 E Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
1725 E Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Operation B 1996-01-01
1725 E Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Reference B 1996-01-01
1725 E Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch Getting Started b 1996-01-01
1725 EX Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
1725 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
1725 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
1725 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
1725 SLS Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2025 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
2025 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Users Guide n.a. 1996-01-01
2025 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Administrators Guide n.a. 1996-01-01
2025 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
2025 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X. n.a. 2002-02-14
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher n.a. 2002-09-26
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher n.a. 2003-11-27
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Overlay / Background printing n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 2060: Mise en Service n.a. 1997-09-10
Suchergebnisse: 1 - 50 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 51 - 100 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Printer specification 1.1.0 2002-04-08
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS Document Option Commands J 2001-02-07
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Portugiesisch (Portugal) Guia do software A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch LPR printing from Macintosh. n.a. 2002-03-15
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Accounting. n.a. 2003-07-21
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Booklet printing n.a. 2001-12-27
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation. n.a. 2003-05-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files. n.a. 2002-03-19
2060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Operation B 1998-09-18
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Drucksystem QMS 2060 Inbetriebnahme n.a. 1997-09-10
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Benutzerhandbuch: Inbetrieb nahme n.a. 1997-01-25
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3. x Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2001-11-19
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS UNIX Host Software E 1998-02-07
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Printing envelops on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
2060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Reference B 1998-09-18
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Use the Unix Host Software on Linux. n.a. 2001-12-28
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress. n.a. 2002-03-04
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS VMS Host Software E 1998-02-07
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de software A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Consumable specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk. n.a. 2002-03-18
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida software A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Software Handbuch A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Option specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Umlauts do not print from PageMaker. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, LPR installation. n.a. 2002-02-28
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Duplexing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
2060 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98/ME driver installation. n.a. 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Slowenisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Polnisch PodrÍcznik oprogramowania A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Change resolution. n.a. 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch Installation Guide B 2003-08-29
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR. n.a. 2002-03-18
Suchergebnisse: 51 - 100 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 101 - 150 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
2060 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
2060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace Toner cartridge. n.a. 2003-07-18
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Working with and Printing Status Pages. n.a. 2002-03-19
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Number Up printing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2003-02-10
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4. x NDS Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver n.a. 2003-11-17
2060 Print System Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide Logiciels A 2001-12-10
2060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Reset Consumable Status. n.a. 2003-07-21
2060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x. n.a. 2002-03-18
2060 WX Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User Guide n.a. 1997-09-10
2060 WX Installationsanleitung Englisch Getting Started n.a. 1997-09-10
2060 WX Sonstiges Englisch What is "LEF" A4? n.a. 1997-09-10
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X. n.a. 2002-02-14
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher n.a. 2002-09-26
2425 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 2425 Operation Guide n.a. 1997-08-09
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher n.a. 2003-11-27
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Overlay / Background printing n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d’Impression QMS 2425: Mise en Service n.a. 1997-09-10
2425 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Deutsch QMS 2425 Benutzerhandbuch n.a. 1997-08-09
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS Document Option Commands J 2001-02-07
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Portugiesisch (Portugal) Guia do software A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS 2425 Stacking and Stapling Information n.a. 1997-09-05
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS 2425: Options Installation Guide. n.a. 1997-09-05
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch LPR printing from Macintosh. n.a. 2002-03-15
2425 Print System Service-Handbuch Französisch Guide de l'Utilisateur du Système d'Impression QMS 2425: Instructions de Service n.a. 1997-09-10
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Accounting. n.a. 2003-07-21
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Booklet printing n.a. 2001-12-27
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation. n.a. 2003-05-13
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace Toner cartridge. n.a. 2003-07-18
2425 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3. x Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 2425 Reference Guide n.a. 1997-08-09
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2001-11-19
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS UNIX Host Software E 1998-02-07
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress. n.a. 2002-03-04
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS VMS Host Software E 1998-02-07
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de software A 2001-12-10
Suchergebnisse: 101 - 150 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 151 - 200 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk. n.a. 2002-03-18
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida software A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS 2425: Getting Started n.a. 1997-01-25
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Software Handbuch A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Umlauts do not print from PageMaker. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, LPR installation. n.a. 2002-02-28
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Benutzerhandbuch: Inbetrieb nahme n.a. 1997-01-25
2425 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98/ME driver installation. n.a. 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Slowenisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Polnisch PodrÍcznik oprogramowania A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Change resolution. n.a. 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR. n.a. 2002-03-18
2425 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4. x NDS Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver n.a. 2003-11-17
2425 Print System Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide Logiciels A 2001-12-10
2425 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Reset Consumable Status. n.a. 2003-07-21
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Overlay / Background printing n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS Document Option Commands J 2001-02-07
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Portugiesisch (Portugal) Guia do software A 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch LPR printing from Macintosh. n.a. 2002-03-15
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Booklet printing n.a. 2001-12-27
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation. n.a. 2003-05-13
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3. x Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS UNIX Host Software E 1998-02-07
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress. n.a. 2002-03-04
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS VMS Host Software E 1998-02-07
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de software A 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida software A 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Deutsch Software Handbuch A 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Umlauts do not print from PageMaker. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Französisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98/ME driver installation. n.a. 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Slowenisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
Suchergebnisse: 151 - 200 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 201 - 250 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Polnisch PodrÍcznik oprogramowania A 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Change resolution. n.a. 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
2425 Turbo Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4. x NDS Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Englisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
2425 Turbo Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide Logiciels A 2001-12-10
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95 / 98 installation n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Reload Staples. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Assign IP Address via Control Panel or via MAP Utililty. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Setup Conserve Toner. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Setup TCP/IP port on Windows 95/98. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Change / Set output resolution in the driver. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Restore driver to defaults. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Setup IPX connection. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Installing or Replacing the Toner Cartridge n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3.xx and lower Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Input tray selection. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Uninstall printer driver on PC. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT installation n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch CrownView setup. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4.xx NDS Installation n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4.xx Bindery Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Service-Handbuch Englisch Load Paper. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 installation n.a. 2003-01-28
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Setup Collation. n.a. 2002-04-13
2560 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Installation on Unix. n.a. 2002-04-13
3225 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
3225 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Users Guide n.a. 1996-01-01
3225 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Administrators Guide n.a. 1996-01-01
3225 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
3225 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X. n.a. 2002-02-14
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher n.a. 2002-09-26
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher n.a. 2003-11-27
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Overlay / Background printing n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS Document Option Commands J 2001-02-07
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, NDPS installation, Add Printer. n.a. 2001-12-28
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Portugiesisch (Portugal) Guia do software A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Option specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Operation B 1999-02-02
3260 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Reference B 2000-01-31
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch LPR printing from Macintosh. n.a. 2002-03-15
3260 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replacing the Staple Cartridge n.a. 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Accounting. n.a. 2003-07-21
Suchergebnisse: 201 - 250 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 251 - 300 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Booklet printing n.a. 2001-12-27
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation. n.a. 2003-05-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files. n.a. 2002-03-19
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, NDPS installation using the MQ NDPS Utility. n.a. 2001-12-28
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3. x Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2001-11-19
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS UNIX Host Software E 1998-02-07
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Printing envelops on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Use the Unix Host Software on Linux. n.a. 2001-12-28
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress. n.a. 2002-03-04
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS VMS Host Software E 1998-02-07
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de software A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk. n.a. 2002-03-18
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida software A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Software Handbuch A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace Toner Cartridge n.a. 2003-07-18
3260 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Printer specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Umlauts do not print from PageMaker. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, LPR installation. n.a. 2002-02-28
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Duplexing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
3260 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98/ME driver installation. n.a. 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Slowenisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Consumable specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Polnisch PodrÍcznik oprogramowania A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Change resolution. n.a. 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR. n.a. 2002-03-18
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch CrownView. n.a. 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Working with and Printing Status Pages. n.a. 2002-03-19
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Number Up printing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2003-02-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4. x NDS Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver n.a. 2003-11-17
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide Logiciels A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Reset Consumable Status. n.a. 2003-07-21
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x. n.a. 2002-03-18
3260 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers. n.a. 2001-12-10
Suchergebnisse: 251 - 300 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 251 - 300 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Booklet printing n.a. 2001-12-27
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation. n.a. 2003-05-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files. n.a. 2002-03-19
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, NDPS installation using the MQ NDPS Utility. n.a. 2001-12-28
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3. x Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2001-11-19
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS UNIX Host Software E 1998-02-07
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Printing envelops on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Use the Unix Host Software on Linux. n.a. 2001-12-28
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress. n.a. 2002-03-04
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS VMS Host Software E 1998-02-07
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de software A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk. n.a. 2002-03-18
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida software A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Software Handbuch A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace Toner Cartridge n.a. 2003-07-18
3260 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Printer specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Umlauts do not print from PageMaker. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, LPR installation. n.a. 2002-02-28
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Duplexing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
3260 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98/ME driver installation. n.a. 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Slowenisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Consumable specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Polnisch PodrÍcznik oprogramowania A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Change resolution. n.a. 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR. n.a. 2002-03-18
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch CrownView. n.a. 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Working with and Printing Status Pages. n.a. 2002-03-19
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Number Up printing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2003-02-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4. x NDS Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver n.a. 2003-11-17
3260 Print System Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide Logiciels A 2001-12-10
3260 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Reset Consumable Status. n.a. 2003-07-21
3260 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x. n.a. 2002-03-18
3260 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers. n.a. 2001-12-10
Suchergebnisse: 251 - 300 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 301 - 350 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
3825 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
3825 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
3825 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Users Guide n.a. 1996-01-01
3825 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch QMS 3825/3225/2025 Print System Administrators Guide n.a. 1996-01-01
3825 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
3825 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X. n.a. 2002-02-14
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher n.a. 2002-09-26
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher n.a. 2003-11-27
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Overlay / Background printing n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS Document Option Commands J 2001-02-07
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, NDPS installation, Add Printer. n.a. 2001-12-28
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Portugiesisch (Portugal) Guia do software A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Option specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Operation B 1999-02-02
4032 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Reference B 2000-01-31
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch LPR printing from Macintosh. n.a. 2002-03-15
4032 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replacing the Staple Cartridge n.a. 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Accounting. n.a. 2003-07-21
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker. n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Booklet printing n.a. 2001-12-27
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation. n.a. 2003-05-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files. n.a. 2002-03-19
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, NDPS installation using the MQ NDPS Utility. n.a. 2001-12-28
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3. x Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2001-11-19
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS UNIX Host Software E 1998-02-07
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Printing envelops on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Use the Unix Host Software on Linux. n.a. 2001-12-28
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress. n.a. 2002-03-04
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS VMS Host Software E 1998-02-07
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de software A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk. n.a. 2002-03-18
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida software A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Software Handbuch A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace Toner Cartridge n.a. 2003-07-18
4032 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Printer specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Umlauts do not print from PageMaker. n.a. 2002-04-13
Suchergebnisse: 301 - 350 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 351 - 400 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, LPR installation. n.a. 2002-02-28
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Duplexing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
4032 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98/ME driver installation. n.a. 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Slowenisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Consumable specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Polnisch PodrÍcznik oprogramowania A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Change resolution. n.a. 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR. n.a. 2002-03-18
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch CrownView. n.a. 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Working with and Printing Status Pages. n.a. 2002-03-19
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Number Up printing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2003-02-10
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4. x NDS Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver n.a. 2003-11-17
4032 Print System Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide Logiciels A 2001-12-10
4032 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Reset Consumable Status. n.a. 2003-07-21
4032 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x. n.a. 2002-03-18
4032 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers. n.a. 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X. n.a. 2002-02-14
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher n.a. 2002-09-26
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher n.a. 2003-11-27
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Overlay / Background printing n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch Getting Started n.a. 1997-01-25
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS Document Option Commands J 2001-02-07
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Portugiesisch (Portugal) Guia do software A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch Options Installation Guide n.a. 1997-09-05
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch LPR printing from Macintosh. n.a. 2002-03-15
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Accounting. n.a. 2003-07-21
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker. n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Booklet printing n.a. 2001-12-27
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation. n.a. 2003-05-13
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files. n.a. 2002-03-19
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3. x Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2001-11-19
Suchergebnisse: 351 - 400 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 401 - 450 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS UNIX Host Software E 1998-02-07
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Printing envelops on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Use the Unix Host Software on Linux. n.a. 2001-12-28
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress. n.a. 2002-03-04
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Benutzerhandbuch: Inbetrieb nahme n.a. 1997-01-25
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS VMS Host Software E 1998-02-07
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de software A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk. n.a. 2002-03-18
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida software A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Deutsch Software Handbuch A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace Toner. n.a. 2003-07-18
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Umlauts do not print from PageMaker. n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Duplexing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
4060 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98/ME driver installation. n.a. 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Technische Daten Englisch Media Specification 1.1.0 2001-12-27
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Slowenisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Polnisch PodrÍcznik oprogramowania A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Change resolution. n.a. 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Operation n.a. 1997-01-31
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR. n.a. 2002-03-18
4060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Reference n.a. 1997-01-31
4060 Print System Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Working with and Printing Status Pages. n.a. 2002-03-19
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Number Up printing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2003-02-10
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4. x NDS Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Englisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide Logiciels A 2001-12-10
4060 Print System Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Reset Consumable Status. n.a. 2003-07-21
4060 Print System Sonstiges Englisch Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x. n.a. 2002-03-18
4060 Q-Doc Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Q-Doc User Manual 1.1.0 2006-03-29
bizhub C10P Konformitätserklärung Englisch Declaration of Conformity for Konica Minolta bizhub C10P, mc2500W, mc2530DL, mc2550 CEM-2006-T018A 2007-04-30
bizhub C20P Konformitätserklärung Englisch Declaration of Conformity for Konica Minolta bizhub C20P, mc4650DN, mc4650EN CEM-2007-T019B 2007-12-18
bizhub C30P Konformitätserklärung Englisch Declaration of Conformity for Konica Minolta bizhub C30P, mc5550, mc5570 CEM-2006-T017C 2007-10-02
bizhub C31P Konformitätserklärung Englisch Declaration of Conformity for Konica Minolta bizhub C31P, mc5650, mc5670 CEM-2008-T001A 2008-04-09
Color PagePro Sonstiges Englisch Assign IP Address n.a. 2002-03-21
Color PagePro Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
Color PagePro Sonstiges Englisch Install a Page Pro Printer on Windows 95/98 via TCP/IP. n.a. 2002-03-21
Color PagePro Ex Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User Manual 1.1.0 2004-06-18
Color PagePro Ex Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
Color PagePro Ex Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Usermanual Network Card 1.1.0 2005-01-04
Color PagePro L Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User's Guide 1.1.0 2002-05-08
Color PagePro L Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
Color PagePro Plus Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User Guide 1.1.0 2004-06-18
Suchergebnisse: 401 - 450 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 451 - 500 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
Color PagePro Plus Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
Color PagePro Plus Sonstiges Englisch Network Setup Guide 1.1.0 2001-09-30
Color PagePro PS Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
Color PagePro PS Plus Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User Guide 1.1.0 2004-06-18
Color PagePro PS Plus Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
Color PagePro PS Plus Sonstiges Englisch Network Setup Guide 1.1.0 2001-09-30
Color PageWorks L Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User's Guide 1.1.0 2002-05-08
ColorScript 310 Benutzerhandbuch Französisch ColorScript 310/330 Guide de l’utilisateur n.a. 1997-08-09
ColorScript 310 Benutzerhandbuch Deutsch ColorScript 310/330 Benutzerhandbuch n.a. 1997-08-09
ColorScript 310 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch ColorScript 310/330 Users Guide n.a. 1997-08-09
ColorScript 330 Benutzerhandbuch Französisch ColorScript 310/330 Guide de l’utilisateur n.a. 1997-08-09
ColorScript 330 Benutzerhandbuch Deutsch ColorScript 310/330 Benutzerhandbuch n.a. 1997-08-09
ColorScript 330 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch ColorScript 310/330 Users Guide n.a. 1997-08-09
DeskLaser 1400 P Sonstiges Englisch Assign a TCP/IP Address. n.a. 2002-04-13
DeskLaser 1400 P Sonstiges Englisch Novell, NDS installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
DeskLaser 1400 P Sonstiges Englisch Novell, Bindery installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
DeskLaser 1600 P Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User manual n.a. 2002-04-05
DeskLaser 1600 P Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4, NDS installation. n.a. 2001-12-27
DeskLaser 1600 P Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Network Interface - User manual n.a. 2002-04-05
DeskLaser 1600 P Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Duplexer - User manual n.a. 2002-04-05
DeskLaser 1600 P Sonstiges Englisch Macintosh Installation. n.a. 2001-12-27
DeskLaser 1600 P Sonstiges Englisch Assign TCP/IP Address. n.a. 2001-12-27
DeskLaser 2000 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User Guide n.a. 1997-09-10
DeskLaser 2000 Installationsanleitung Englisch Getting Started n.a. 1997-09-10
DeskLaser 2000 Sonstiges Englisch What is "LEF" A4? n.a. 1997-09-10
magicolor 1600W Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Black 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1600W Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Cyan 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1600W Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch OPC Drum 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1600W Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Magenta 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1600W Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Yellow 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Französisch User's guide 03 2008-11-21
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Norwegisch User's guide 03 2008-11-21
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Niederländisch User's guide 03 2008-11-21
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Griechisch User's guide 03 2008-11-21
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Spanisch User's guide 03 2008-11-21
magicolor 1650EN Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Black 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1650EN Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Cyan 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1650EN Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch OPC Drum 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1650EN Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Magenta 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Türkisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Schwedisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Spanisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Slovakisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Russisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Portugiesisch (Brasilien) Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Polnisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Norwegisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Koreanisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Japanisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Italienisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
Suchergebnisse: 451 - 500 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 501 - 550 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Ungarisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Griechisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Deutsch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Finnisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Niederländisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Dänisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Tschechisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Chinesisch (traditionell) Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Benutzerhandbuch Arabisch Safety information guide 02 2008-12-04
magicolor 1650EN Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Yellow 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Schwedisch User's guide 01 2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Quick guide 00 2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Koreanisch Quick guide 00 2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Griechisch Quick guide 00 2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Tschechisch Quick guide 00 2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Black 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Schwedisch Quick guide 00 2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Dänisch User's guide 01 2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Deutsch User's guide 01 2008-12-01
magicolor 1680MF Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Cyan 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Tschechisch User's guide 01 2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Ungarisch User's guide 01 2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Französisch User's guide 01 2008-12-01
magicolor 1680MF Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch OPC Drum 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1680MF Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Magenta 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1680MF Benutzerhandbuch Italienisch User's guide 01 2008-12-03
magicolor 1680MF Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Yellow 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Russisch User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Russisch Facsimile User's Guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Französisch User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Schwedisch User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Schwedisch Facsimile User's Guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Chinesisch (traditionell) Facsimile User's Guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Türkisch Facsimile User's Guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Italienisch User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Black 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Koreanisch User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Finnisch Facsimile User's Guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Dänisch Facsimile User's Guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Cyan 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Polnisch User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Tschechisch User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Ungarisch Facsimile User's Guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Portugiesisch (Brasilien) User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Spanisch User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch OPC Drum 1.1.0 2008-12-18
Suchergebnisse: 501 - 550 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 551 - 600 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
magicolor 1690MF Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Magenta 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Norwegisch User's guide 01 2008-11-21
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Türkisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Schwedisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Spanisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Slovakisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Russisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Portugiesisch (Brasilien) Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Polnisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Norwegisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Italienisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Ungarisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Griechisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Deutsch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Finnisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Niederländisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Dänisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Tschechisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Benutzerhandbuch Arabisch Installation guide 00 2008-12-04
magicolor 1690MF Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Toner, Yellow 1.1.0 2008-12-18
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X. n.a. 2002-02-14
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Deutsch ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, MacOS 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner K 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch TSCA Decalartion 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher n.a. 2002-09-26
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher n.a. 2003-11-27
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Overlay / Background printing n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Englisch Print System Options B 1999-06-16
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Reference B 1999-06-16
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Deutsch ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, Windows. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Using Pantone Color Palettes for Crown Color Printers 1.1.0 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Fuser Oil 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS Document Option Commands J 2001-02-07
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner M 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Portugiesisch (Portugal) Guia do software A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch How to setup your printer for printing on different media’s. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Color Density Adjustment A 1998-11-17
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch LPR printing from Macintosh. n.a. 2002-03-15
magicolor 2 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Operation B 1999-06-16
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Booklet printing n.a. 2001-12-27
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Windows 1.1.0 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner C 1.1.0 1999-12-08
Suchergebnisse: 551 - 600 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 601 - 650 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation. n.a. 2003-05-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files. n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Französisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3. x Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2001-11-19
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS UNIX Host Software E 1998-02-07
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Printing envelops on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Use the Unix Host Software on Linux. n.a. 2001-12-28
magicolor 2 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, OPC 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Macintosh 1.1.0 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress. n.a. 2002-03-04
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS VMS Host Software E 1998-02-07
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de software A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk. n.a. 2002-03-18
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida software A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Deutsch Software Handbuch A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Italienisch Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, MacOS. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Umlauts do not print from PageMaker. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Italienisch Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, Windows. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Pantone Color Setup. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Französisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98/ME driver installation. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner Y 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Slowenisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Polnisch PodrÍcznik oprogramowania A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Service-Handbuch Deutsch User Maintenance Guide n/a. 2001-01-25
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Change resolution. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR. n.a. 2002-03-18
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch CrownView. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Working with and Printing Status Pages. n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4. x NDS Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Englisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Französisch Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, MacOS. 1.1.1 2002-11-28
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Französisch Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, Windows. 1.1.1 2002-11-28
magicolor 2 Technische Daten Spanisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Technische Daten Italienisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Technische Daten Deutsch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Technische Daten Französisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 Technische Daten Englisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
Suchergebnisse: 601 - 650 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 651 - 700 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver n.a. 2003-11-17
magicolor 2 Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide Logiciels A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 Sonstiges Englisch Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x. n.a. 2002-03-18
magicolor 2 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X. n.a. 2002-02-14
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Deutsch ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, MacOS 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 + Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner K 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 + Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch TSCA Decalartion 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher n.a. 2002-09-26
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher n.a. 2003-11-27
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Overlay / Background printing n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Deutsch ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, Windows. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Using Pantone Color Palettes for Crown Color Printers 1.1.0 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Englisch Installation Guide A 1999-09-01
magicolor 2 + Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Fuser Oil 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS Document Option Commands J 2001-02-07
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 3.5.1 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, NDPS installation, Add Printer. n.a. 2001-12-28
magicolor 2 + Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner M 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Portugiesisch (Portugal) Guia do software A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Technische Daten Englisch Option specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch How to setup your printer for printing on different media’s. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch LPR printing from Macintosh. n.a. 2002-03-15
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Accounting. n.a. 2003-07-21
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Booklet printing n.a. 2001-12-27
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Windows 1.1.0 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 + Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner C 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation. n.a. 2003-05-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files. n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, NDPS installation using the MQ NDPS Utility. n.a. 2001-12-28
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Französisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3. x Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2001-11-19
magicolor 2 + Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Color Book - Booklet Maker - BM-2 - User Manual 1.1.0 2006-03-29
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS UNIX Host Software E 1998-02-07
magicolor 2 + Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Operation manual A 1999-09-01
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Printing envelops on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Use the Unix Host Software on Linux. n.a. 2001-12-28
magicolor 2 + Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, OPC 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Macintosh 1.1.0 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress. n.a. 2002-03-04
Suchergebnisse: 651 - 700 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 701 - 750 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS VMS Host Software E 1998-02-07
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Technische Daten Englisch Consumable specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de software A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk. n.a. 2002-03-18
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida software A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Deutsch Software Handbuch A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Italienisch Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, MacOS. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Umlauts do not print from PageMaker. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, LPR installation. n.a. 2002-02-28
magicolor 2 + Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Print System Reference manual A 1999-09-01
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Italienisch Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, Windows. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Duplexing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Pantone Color Setup. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Technische Daten Englisch Printer specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Französisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98/ME driver installation. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner Y 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Slowenisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Polnisch PodrÍcznik oprogramowania A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Change resolution. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR. n.a. 2002-03-18
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch CrownView. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Working with and Printing Status Pages. n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Number Up printing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2003-02-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4. x NDS Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Englisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Französisch Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, MacOS. 1.1.1 2002-11-28
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Französisch Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, Windows. 1.1.1 2002-11-28
magicolor 2 + Technische Daten Spanisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Technische Daten Italienisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Technische Daten Deutsch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Technische Daten Französisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Technische Daten Englisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 + Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Statistics page on Crown Printers. n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver n.a. 2003-11-17
magicolor 2 + Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide Logiciels A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 + Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Reset Consumable Status. n.a. 2003-07-21
magicolor 2 + Sonstiges Englisch Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x. n.a. 2002-03-18
magicolor 2 + Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner K 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch TSCA Decalartion 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sonstiges Italienisch Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMSDesklaser. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Desklaser printers 1.1.0 2002-05-07
Suchergebnisse: 701 - 750 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 751 - 800 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Englisch Installation Guide A 1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Fuser Oil 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Französisch Installation Guide A 1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Black and White printing. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner M 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User's Guide C 1999-06-26
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Englisch Setup Guide C 1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Spanisch Installation Guide A 1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Deutsch Installationsanleitung A 1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sonstiges Deutsch -Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Desklaser-Farbdrucker. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner C 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Technische Daten Englisch Option specification n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Technische Daten Englisch Consumable specifications 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Color Book - Booklet Maker - BM-2 - User Manual 1.1.0 2006-03-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, OPC 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Technische Daten Englisch Printer specification n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Italienisch Installation Guide A 1999-06-29
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sonstiges Französisch Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes couleur Desklaser Minolta-QMS. 1.1.1 2002-11-28
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner Y 1.1.0 1999-12-08
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Printing Multiple Copies of a File using collation on the magicolor 2 DeskLaser n.a. 2002-05-28
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Technische Daten Spanisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Technische Daten Italienisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Technische Daten Deutsch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Technische Daten Französisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2 DeskLaser Technische Daten Englisch OPC belt lifetime 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Waste Toner Pack. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X. n.a. 2002-02-14
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Deutsch Installationsanleitung 1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Deutsch ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, MacOS 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher n.a. 2002-09-26
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Transfer Roller n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher n.a. 2003-11-27
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Overlay / Background printing n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Deutsch Benutzerhandbuch B 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Repacking instructions A 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Deutsch ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, Windows. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Using Pantone Color Palettes for Crown Color Printers 1.1.0 2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 Technische Daten Englisch Consumable specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Explorer driver version 2.1.1b or lower). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS Document Option Commands J 2001-02-07
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide d'installation 1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, NDPS installation, Add Printer. n.a. 2001-12-28
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Portugiesisch (Portugal) Guia do software A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch How to setup your printer for printing on different media’s. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 3.x till 5.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
Suchergebnisse: 751 - 800 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 801 - 850 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch LPR printing from Macintosh. n.a. 2002-03-15
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Guide d’utilisation B 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Accounting. n.a. 2003-07-21
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and Page Maker. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Technische Daten Englisch Printer specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Booklet printing n.a. 2001-12-27
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the OPC drum. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-K 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Windows 1.1.0 2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 6. x, Basic NDS Installation. n.a. 2003-05-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT4, advanced printer features using separator files. n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Loading the MPT tray on the magicolor 2200 Series. n.a. 2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, NDPS installation using the MQ NDPS Utility. n.a. 2001-12-28
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Technische Daten Englisch Option specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Französisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Windows 2000 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Französisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Telnet to a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 3. x Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Englisch How to remove paper jams near to the fuser unit? n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Driver sharing: Windows 2000 to Windows NT (driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2001-11-19
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida di installazione A 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS UNIX Host Software E 1998-02-07
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Printing envelops on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Englisch Installation Guide B 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Use the Unix Host Software on Linux. n.a. 2001-12-28
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Italienisch Guida Utenete B 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Crown printers, Macintosh 1.1.0 2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Install and usage of a Crown Printer and QuarkXpress. n.a. 2002-03-04
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Transfer Belt. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS VMS Host Software E 1998-02-07
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98 driver installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Laser Lens Cover. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User Guide B 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Fuser Oil 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de software A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-Y 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via Ethertalk. n.a. 2002-03-18
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida software A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Deutsch Software Handbuch A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Englisch Clearing Media Jams Near the Sensor n.a. 2002-09-18
magicolor 2200 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-M 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Italienisch Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, MacOS. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Umlauts do not print from PageMaker. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, LPR installation. n.a. 2002-02-28
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Spanisch Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo n.a. 2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Italienisch Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo n.a. 2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Deutsch Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo n.a. 2003-07-11
Suchergebnisse: 801 - 850 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 851 - 900 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo n.a. 2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo n.a. 2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Fuser Unit. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Italienisch Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMS Crown, Windows. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Duplexing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2002-03-25
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Pantone Color Setup. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Spanisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Portugiesisch (Portugal) Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Italienisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Deutsch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Französisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Englisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Niederländisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Dänisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Service-Handbuch Tschechisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Französisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Assign an IP address. n.a. 2001-12-27
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Windows 95/98/ME driver installation. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Removing the Transfer Belt Fixture Unit on the magicolor 2200 Series n.a. 2003-08-18
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Slowenisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Fuser Oil Roller. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Polnisch PodrÍcznik oprogramowania A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Windows NT 4.0 driver installation (Sylvester driver version 2.0.6.3 or higher). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Change resolution. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Crown Printer on Mac OS 7.x, 8.x and 9.x via LPR. n.a. 2002-03-18
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch CrownView. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Französisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Install the Minolta-QMS Port Monitor using DHCP. n.a. 2002-04-12
magicolor 2200 Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-C 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Working with and Printing Status Pages. n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Toner Cartridges. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Number Up printing on a Crown Printer. n.a. 2003-02-10
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 4. x NDS Installation. n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Englisch Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Französisch Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, MacOS. 1.1.1 2002-11-28
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Französisch Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes Crown Minolta-QMS, Windows. 1.1.1 2002-11-28
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Statistics page on Crown Printers. n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Installing Minolta-QMS Crown printers in Windows NT4SP6 or lower environments using the v1.0.7 driver n.a. 2003-11-17
magicolor 2200 Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide Logiciels A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Reset Consumable Status. n.a. 2003-07-21
magicolor 2200 Sonstiges Englisch Adjusting output resolution in QuarkXpress 4.0x. n.a. 2002-03-18
magicolor 2200 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Checking the Status of Consumables Crown Printers. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Waste Toner Pack. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Deutsch Installationsanleitung C 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Italienisch Corrispondenza colore ICC per stampanti a colori Minolta-QMSDesklaser. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Transfer Roller n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Using the Printer's Web Page n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Ungarisch Installation Guide C 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Host based ICC ColorMagagement Minolta-QMS Desklaser printers 1.1.0 2002-05-07
Suchergebnisse: 851 - 900 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 901 - 950 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Repacking instructions A 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Italienisch Sostituzione di materiali di consumo n.a. 2002-08-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Technische Daten Englisch Consumable specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (vereinfacht) Installation Guide C 2002-01-12
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Black and White printing. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Setup duplexing n,a, 2002-05-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Französisch Assign IP Address. n.a. 2001-12-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Assign IP Address. n.a. 2001-12-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Deutsch Benutzerhandbuch B 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Französisch Driver Options, using the printer driver. n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Driver Options, using the printer driver. n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Slovakisch User Guide . B 2002-01-12
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Disabling Color Matching Setting. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Printing Multiple Copies of a File using collation on the magicolor 2200 DeskLaser n.a. 2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Thailändisch Installation Guide C 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Setting the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser to Switch Bins When One Bin is Empty n.a. 2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Polnisch Installation Guide C 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the OPC drum. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-K 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Französisch Setting up a TCP/IP Network on Windows 2000 n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Setting up a TCP/IP Network on Windows 2000 n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Deutsch -Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Desklaser-Farbdrucker. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Loading the MPT tray on the magicolor 2200 Series. n.a. 2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Tschechisch Installation Guide C 2002-02-23
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Tschechisch User Guide B 2002-02-23
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Uninstall the printer driver. n.a. 2002-05-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Selecting Input/Output Trays on the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser n.a. 2002-05-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Englisch How to remove paper jams near to the fuser unit? n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Installation Guide C 2002-01-12
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Englisch Installation Guide C 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Uninstalling the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser Driver n.a. 2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Transfer Belt. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Disabling Composite Black Setting. n.a. 2001-12-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Deutsch Austausch von Verbrauchsmaterial. n.a. 2002-08-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch User Guide B 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Guide d’utilisation B 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Laser Lens Cover. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Fuser Oil 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Technische Daten Englisch Option specification 1.1.0 2002-04-29
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Technische Daten Englisch Printer specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-Y 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Clear Care Procedure / Clear messages. n.a. 2002-08-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Selecting Media Types and envelops on the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser n.a. 2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Englisch Clearing Media Jams Near the Sensor n.a. 2002-09-18
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-M 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Printing Multiple Copies of a File using collation on the magicolor 2200 DeskLaser n.a. 2002-05-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Installing the Printer Driver for the magicolor 2200 DeskLaser in Windows 95/98/NT4/2000/XP n.a. 2002-03-19
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Technische Daten Englisch Consumable specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Selecting Media Types and envelops on the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser n,a, 2002-05-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Spanisch Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo n.a. 2003-07-11
Suchergebnisse: 901 - 950 von über 1000
Suchergebnisse: 951 - 1000 von über 1000
Produkt Unterkat. Sprache Titel Version Freigabe Download
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Italienisch Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo n.a. 2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Deutsch Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo n.a. 2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Französisch Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo n.a. 2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Consumables Specifications Spécifications des consommables Verbrauchsmaterialspezifikationen Specifiche sui materiali di consumo Especificaciones de materiales de consumo n.a. 2003-07-11
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Vietnamesisch Installation Guide C 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Fuser Unit. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Slovakisch Installation Guide C 2002-01-12
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Französisch Guide d'installation C 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Französisch Correspondance couleurs ICC pour imprimantes couleur Desklaser Minolta-QMS. 1.1.1 2002-11-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Spanisch Guía de instalación C 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Spanisch Guía de usuario B 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Spanisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Portugiesisch (Portugal) Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Italienisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Deutsch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Französisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Englisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Niederländisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Dänisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Service-Handbuch Tschechisch Maintenance Guide D 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Removing the Transfer Belt Fixture Unit on the magicolor 2200 Series n.a. 2003-08-18
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Fuser Oil Roller. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Installationsanleitung Italienisch Guida di installazione C 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Selecting Input/Output Trays on the magicolor 2200/6100 DeskLaser n.a. 2003-03-10
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Italienisch Guida Utente B 2002-04-13
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Englisch Menu options. n.a. 2002-05-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sicherheitsdatenblatt Englisch Material Safety Data Sheet, Toner-C 1.1.0 1999-12-27
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Toner Cartridges. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Sonstiges Französisch Remplacement des consommables n.a. 2002-08-08
magicolor 2200 DeskLaser Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Reset Consumable Status. n.a. 2003-07-21
magicolor 2210 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Waste Toner Pack. n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2210 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X. n.a. 2002-02-14
magicolor 2210 Sonstiges Deutsch ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, MacOS 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2210 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Mniolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.2 and higher n.a. 2002-09-26
magicolor 2210 Benutzerhandbuch Englisch Replace the Transfer Roller n.a. 2003-07-28
magicolor 2210 Installationsanleitung Polnisch Installation Guide C 2002-01-17
magicolor 2210 Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Software Guide A 2001-12-10
magicolor 2210 Installationsanleitung Französisch Installation Guide Magicolor 2210, French A 2001-11-15
magicolor 2210 Sonstiges Englisch Install a Konica Minolta PS/PCL Printer on Mac OS X, v10.3 and higher n.a. 2003-11-27
magicolor 2210 Sonstiges Englisch Overlay / Background printing n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2210 Installationsanleitung Slovakisch Installation Guide C 2002-01-17
magicolor 2210 Installationsanleitung Deutsch Installationsanleitung C 2002-01-17
magicolor 2210 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5. x, Basic NDS Installation (CrownNet 6.x). n.a. 2002-04-13
magicolor 2210 Sonstiges Deutsch ICC-Farbabstimmung für Minolta-QMS Crown-Farbdrucker, Windows. 1.1.1 2002-05-07
magicolor 2210 Sonstiges Englisch Using Pantone Color Palettes for Crown Color Printers 1.1.0 2002-05-07
magicolor 2210 Technische Daten Englisch Consumable specification 1.1.0 2002-04-13
magicolor 2210 Installationsanleitung Chinesisch (traditionell) Installation Guide C 2002-01-17
magicolor 2210 Installationsanleitung Englisch QMS Document Option Commands J 2001-02-07
magicolor 2210 Installationsanleitung Portugiesisch (Portugal) Guia de Instalação C 2002-01-17
magicolor 2210 Sonstiges Englisch Novell 5.x, NDPS installation, Add Printer. n.a. 2001-12-28
Suchergebnisse: 951 - 1000 von über 1000
User’s Guide [Printer/Copier/Scanner]x-1
Thank You
Thank you for purchasing a bizhub C35. You have made an excellent choice. Your
bizhub C35 is specially designed for optimal performance in Windows, Macintosh
and Linux environments.
Trademarks
Acrobat and the Acrobat logo are registered trademarks or trademarks of Adobe
Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries.
Adobe, the Adobe logo and Photoshop are registered trademarks or trademarks of
Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other countries.
Apple and the Apple logo are registered trademarks or trademarks of Apple, Inc. in
the United States and/or other countries.
DIC and the DIC logo are registered trademarks or trademarks of DIC Corporation in
the United States and/or other countries.
Ethernet is a registered trademark or trademark of Xerox Corporation in the United
States and/or other countries.
IEEE and the IEEE logo are registered trademarks or trademarks of The Institute of
Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc. in the United States and/or other countries.
Mac and Mac OS are registered trademarks or trademarks of Apple, Inc. in the
United States and/or other countries.
NETWARE is a registered trademark or trademark of Novell, Inc. in the United States
and/or other countries.
Pentium is registered trademark or trademark of Intel Corporation in the United
States and/or other countries.
TOYO is a registered trademark of TOYO INK MFG. CO., LTD. in the United States
and/or other countries.
Microsoft, Windows and Windows Vista are registered trademarks or trademarks of
Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.
KONICA MINOLTA and the KONICA MINOLTA logo are trademarks or registered
trademarks of KONICA MINOLTA HOLDINGS, INC.
bizhub and PageScope are trademarks or registered trademarks of KONICA
MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
All other trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective
owners.x-2
Copyright Notice
Copyright © 2009 KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC., Marunouchi Center Building, 1-6-1 Marunouchi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo, 100-0005, Japan. All
Rights Reserved. This document may not be copied, in whole or part, nor transferred
to any other media or language, without written permission of KONICA MINOLTA
BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
Notice
KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC. reserves the right to make
changes to this guide and to the equipment described herein without notice. Considerable effort has been made to ensure that this guide is free of inaccuracies and
omissions. However, KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC. makes
no warranty of any kind including, but not limited to, any implied warranties of merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose with regard to this guide.
KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC. assumes no responsibility
for, or liability for, errors contained in this guide or for incidental, special, or consequential damages arising out of the furnishing of this guide, or the use of this guide in
operating the equipment, or in connection with the performance of the equipment
when so operated.x-3
SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT
This package contains the following materials provided by KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS
TECHNOLOGIES, INC. (KMBT): software included as part of the printing system (“Printing
Software”), the digitally-encoded machine-readable outline data encoded in the special format
and in the encrypted form (“Font Programs”), other software which runs on a computer system
for use in conjunction with the Printing Software (“Host Software”), and related explanatory written materials (“Documentation”). The term “Software” shall be used to describe Printing Software, Font Programs and/or Host Software and also include any upgrades, modified versions,
additions, and copies of the Software.
The Software is being licensed to you under the terms of this Agreement.
KMBT grants to you a non-exclusive sublicense to use the Software and Documentation, provided that you agree to the following:
1. You may use the Software and accompanying Font Programs for imaging to the licensed
output device(s), solely for your own internal business purposes.
2. In addition to the license for Font Programs set forth in Section 1 above, you may use
Roman Font Programs to reproduce weights, styles, and versions of letters, numerals,
characters and symbols (“Typefaces”) on the display or monitor for your own internal business purposes.
3. You may make one backup copy of the Host Software, provided your backup copy is not
installed or used on any computer. Notwithstanding the above restrictions, you may install
the Host Software on any number of computers solely for use with one or more printing systems running the Printing Software.
4. You may assign its rights under this Agreement to an assignee of all of Licensee’s right and
interest to such Software and Documentation (“Assignee”) provided you transfer to
Assignee all copies of such Software and Documentation Assignee agrees to be bound by
all of the terms and conditions of this Agreement.
5. You agree not to modify, adapt or translate the Software and Documentation.
6. You agree that you will not attempt to alter, disassemble, decrypt, reverse engineer or
decompile the Software.
7. Title to and ownership of the Software and Documentation and any reproductions thereof
shall remain with KMBT and its licensor.
8. Trademarks shall be used in accordance with accepted trademark practice, including identification of the trademark owner’s name. Trademarks can only be used to identify printed
output produced by the Software. Such use of any trademark does not give you any rights
of ownership in that trademark.
9. You may not rent, lease, sublicense, lend or transfer versions or copies of the Software Licensee does not use, or Software contained on any unused media, except as part of the permanent transfer of all Software and Documentation as described above.
10. IN NO EVENT WILL KMBT OR ITS LICENSOR BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL, INCIDENTAL INDIRECT, PUNITIVE OR SPECIAL DAMAGES, INCLUDING
ANY LOST PROFITS OR LOST SAVING, EVEN IF KMBT HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES, OR FOR ANY CLAIM BY ANY THIRD PARTY. KMBT
OR ITS LICENSOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THE SOFTWARE, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE
AND NON-INFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. SOME STATES OR JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL OR SPECIAL DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATIONS MAY NOT APPLY
TO YOU.x-4
11. Notice to Government End Users: The Software is a “commercial item,” as that term is
defined at 48 C.F.R.2.101, consisting of “commercial computer software” and “commercial
computer software documentation,” as such terms are used in 48 C.F.R. 12.212. Consistent with 48 C.F.R. 12.212 and 48 C.F.R. 227.7202-1 through 227.7202-4, all U.S. Government End Users acquire the Software with only those rights set forth herein.
12. You agree that you will not export the Software in any form in violation of any applicable
laws and regulations regarding export control of any countries.x-5
Legal Restrictions on Copying
Certain types of documents must never be copied with the purpose or intent to pass
copies of such documents off as the originals.
The following is not a complete list, but is meant to be used as a guide to responsible
copying.
Financial Instruments
z Personal checks
z Traveler’s checks
z Money orders
z Certificates of deposit
z Bonds or other certificates of indebtedness
z Stock certificates
Legal Documents
z Food stamps
z Postage stamps (canceled or uncanceled)
z Checks or drafts drawn by government agencies
z Internal revenue stamps (canceled or uncanceled)
z Passports
z Immigration papers
z Motor vehicle licenses and titles
z House and property titles and deeds
General
z Identification cards, badges, or insignias
z Copyrighted works without permission of the copyright owner
In addition, it is prohibited under any circumstances to copy domestic or foreign currencies, or works of art without permission of the copyright owner.
When in doubt about the nature of a document, consult with legal counsel.
" This machine provides the forgery prevention function in order to prevent
financial instruments from being copied illegally.
We appreciate your understanding that printed images may infrequently have
some noise or image data may not be stored under certain circumstances
due to this forgery prevention function.x-6
For EU member states only
This symbol means: Do not dispose of this product
together with your household waste!
Please contact the Local Authority for appropriate disposal instructions. In the case of a new device being
purchased, the used one can also be given to our dealer
for appropriate disposal. Recycling of this product will
help to conserve natural resources and prevent potential
negative consequences for the environment and human
health caused by inappropriate waste handling.
This product complies with RoHS (2002/95/EC) directive.Contents
Contents x-7
1 Introduction .................................................................................................... 1-1
Getting Acquainted with Your Machine ....................................................... 1-2
Space Requirements................................................................................... 1-2
Part Names ................................................................................................. 1-4
Front View............................................................................................. 1-4
Rear View ............................................................................................. 1-6
Front View with Options ........................................................................ 1-6
Adjusting the angle of the control panel...................................................... 1-7
Drivers CD/DVD.......................................................................................... 1-8
Printer Drivers (PostScript Drivers)....................................................... 1-8
Printer Drivers (PCL Drivers) ................................................................ 1-8
Printer Drivers (XPS Drivers) ................................................................ 1-8
Printer Drivers (PPD Files).................................................................... 1-9
Scanner Drivers .................................................................................... 1-9
PC Fax Drivers...................................................................................... 1-9
Applications CD/DVD................................................................................ 1-10
Applications......................................................................................... 1-10
Documentation CD/DVD ........................................................................... 1-12
Documentation.................................................................................... 1-12
System Requirements............................................................................... 1-13x-8 Contents
2 Control panel and touch panel screens ...................................................... 2-1
About the Control Panel ................................................................................ 2-2
Touch panel screens ..................................................................................... 2-5
Home screen............................................................................................... 2-5
Initial Copy mode screen............................................................................. 2-7
Initial Scan to Folder mode screen.............................................................. 2-8
Initial Scan to E-mail mode screen.............................................................. 2-9
Initial Fax mode screen............................................................................... 2-9
Job screen................................................................................................. 2-10
Status screen ............................................................................................ 2-11
USB/HDD screen ...................................................................................... 2-12
Keys and icons that appear in the screens ............................................... 2-13
User authentication and account track ..................................................... 2-15
With user authentication............................................................................ 2-15
Device authentication.......................................................................... 2-15
External server authentication ............................................................ 2-15
Logging in using the authentication device ......................................... 2-16
With account track..................................................................................... 2-16
3 Utility Settings ................................................................................................ 3-1
[Accessibility] ................................................................................................ 3-2
[Meter Count] ................................................................................................. 3-7
[Address Registration] .................................................................................. 3-8
[User Settings] ............................................................................................. 3-10
[Machine Settings]..................................................................................... 3-13
[Copy Settings].......................................................................................... 3-15
[Scan Settings].......................................................................................... 3-16
[Print Settings]........................................................................................... 3-17
[Fax Settings] ............................................................................................ 3-20
[Select Default Start App].......................................................................... 3-20
[Admin Settings] .......................................................................................... 3-21
[Machine Settings]..................................................................................... 3-41
[Administrator Registration]....................................................................... 3-43
[Address Registration]............................................................................... 3-43
[Authentication Setting] ............................................................................. 3-44
[Ethernet]................................................................................................... 3-45
[External Memory Print]............................................................................. 3-48
[Job Timeout] ............................................................................................ 3-48
[Copy Settings].......................................................................................... 3-48
[Print Settings]........................................................................................... 3-49
[Fax Settings] ............................................................................................ 3-63
[Maintenance Menu].................................................................................. 3-63
[Folder Settings]........................................................................................ 3-69
[Security Settings] ..................................................................................... 3-70
Changing the administrator password ................................................ 3-74
Limitations of the password rules........................................................ 3-74Contents x-9
Passwords regulated by the password rules............................................. 3-74
Conditions of the password rules.............................................................. 3-75
Enhanced security settings ................................................................. 3-75
Required settings ...................................................................................... 3-75
Changed settings ...................................................................................... 3-76
[Restore Defaults] ..................................................................................... 3-77
[HDD Format]............................................................................................ 3-77
[Paper Empty] ........................................................................................... 3-78
[Restriction Code Settings]........................................................................ 3-78
[Erase Job Log]......................................................................................... 3-78
4 Media Handling .............................................................................................. 4-1
Print Media ..................................................................................................... 4-2
Specifications.............................................................................................. 4-2
Types .......................................................................................................... 4-4
Plain Paper (Recycled Paper)............................................................... 4-4
Thick Stock ........................................................................................... 4-5
Envelope ............................................................................................... 4-6
Label ..................................................................................................... 4-7
Letterhead............................................................................................. 4-8
Postcard................................................................................................ 4-8
Glossy Media ........................................................................................ 4-9
Single Side Only........................................................................................ 4-10
Special Paper............................................................................................ 4-11
Printable Area ........................................................................................... 4-12
Envelopes ................................................................................................. 4-13
Page Margins............................................................................................ 4-13
Loading Media .............................................................................................. 4-14
How do I load media? ............................................................................... 4-14
Tray 1 (Manual Feed Tray) ....................................................................... 4-14
Loading Plain Paper, Single Side Only and Special Paper................. 4-14
Other Media ........................................................................................ 4-16
Loading Envelopes ............................................................................. 4-17
Loading Label Sheets/Letterhead/Postcards/Thick Stock and
Glossy Media ...................................................................................... 4-19
Tray 2........................................................................................................ 4-21
Loading Plain Paper, Single Side Only and Special Paper................. 4-21
Loading Label Sheets/Letterhead/Postcards/Thick Stock and
Glossy Media ...................................................................................... 4-24
Tray 3/4 (Optional Lower Feeder Unit)...................................................... 4-27
Loading Plain Paper, Single Side Only and Special Paper................. 4-27
About Duplex Printing ................................................................................. 4-30
How do I autoduplex? ............................................................................... 4-30
Output Tray .................................................................................................. 4-32
Media Storage .............................................................................................. 4-33x-10 Contents
Original Media .............................................................................................. 4-34
Specifications............................................................................................ 4-34
Documents that can be placed on the original glass .......................... 4-34
Documents that can be loaded into the ADF ...................................... 4-34
Loading a Document ................................................................................... 4-36
Placing a document on the original glass.................................................. 4-36
Loading a document into the ADF............................................................. 4-37
5 Using the Printer Driver ................................................................................ 5-1
Selecting Driver Options/Defaults (for Windows) ....................................... 5-2
Windows Server 2008 R2/7/Vista/Server 2008/XP/Server 2003/
2000...................................................................................................... 5-2
Uninstalling the Printer Driver (for Windows) ............................................. 5-4
Windows Server 2008 R2/7/Vista/Server 2008/XP/Server 2003/
2000...................................................................................................... 5-4
Displaying Printer Driver Settings (for Windows) ...................................... 5-5
Windows 7/Server 2008 R2 .................................................................. 5-5
Windows Vista/Server 2008.................................................................. 5-5
Windows XP/Server 2003 ..................................................................... 5-5
Windows 2000 ...................................................................................... 5-5
Using the Postscript, PCL and XPS Printer Driver ..................................... 5-6
Common Buttons ........................................................................................ 5-6
[OK]....................................................................................................... 5-6
[Cancel]................................................................................................. 5-6
[Apply] ................................................................................................... 5-6
[Help]..................................................................................................... 5-6
[Favorite Setting]................................................................................... 5-6
[Printer View]......................................................................................... 5-7
[Paper View].......................................................................................... 5-7
[Quality View] ........................................................................................ 5-7
[Printer Information] .............................................................................. 5-7
[Default]................................................................................................. 5-7
[Advanced] Tab (PostScript Printer Driver Only)......................................... 5-7
[My Tab] ...................................................................................................... 5-8
[Basic] Tab .................................................................................................. 5-8
[Layout] Tab ................................................................................................ 5-9
[Cover Mode] Tab ....................................................................................... 5-9
[Stamp/Composition] Tab............................................................................ 5-9
[Quality] Tab.............................................................................................. 5-10
[Other] Tab................................................................................................ 5-11
Limitations on printer driver functions installed with Point and Print ......... 5-11
6 Proof Print, External memory and ID & Print functions ............................. 6-1
Proof Print ...................................................................................................... 6-2
Printing a job saved on the hard disk.......................................................... 6-2
Deleting a job saved on the hard disk......................................................... 6-2Contents x-11
External Memory ............................................................................................ 6-3
Printing from a connected USB memory device ......................................... 6-3
Selecting the type of files to be displayed................................................... 6-4
ID & Print ........................................................................................................ 6-4
Printing simultaneously with log-in........................................................ 6-4
Specifying a job to print......................................................................... 6-4
Deleting a job........................................................................................ 6-5
7 Performing Copy mode operations .............................................................. 7-1
Basic copy operation .................................................................................... 7-2
[Original Size] ................................................................................................. 7-4
Documents of mixed page sizes ................................................................. 7-4
[Paper] ............................................................................................................ 7-5
[Zoom] ............................................................................................................. 7-6
[Duplex/Combine] .......................................................................................... 7-7
[Density] ......................................................................................................... 7-8
[Original Type] ............................................................................................... 7-9
[Color Mode] ................................................................................................... 7-9
[Finishing] .................................................................................................... 7-10
[Proof Copy] ................................................................................................. 7-10
Proof Copy operation ................................................................................ 7-10
[Separate Scan] ............................................................................................ 7-11
Scanning the document in separate batches............................................ 7-12
[ID Copy] ....................................................................................................... 7-13
[Paper Margin] .............................................................................................. 7-14
[Image Quality] ............................................................................................. 7-15
8 Additional copy operations .......................................................................... 8-1
Interrupting a copy job .................................................................................. 8-2
Copy programs .............................................................................................. 8-3
Storing a copy program............................................................................... 8-3
Deleting a copy program............................................................................. 8-3
Copying using stored settings (copy programs).......................................... 8-4
9 Scanning From a Computer Application ..................................................... 9-1
Basic Scanning Operation ............................................................................ 9-2
Windows TWAIN Driver Settings .................................................................. 9-3
Mode settings.............................................................................................. 9-3
When [Basic Mode] is selected................................................................... 9-3
When [Advanced Mode] is selected............................................................ 9-4
Windows WIA Driver Settings ...................................................................... 9-7
Macintosh TWAIN Driver Settings ................................................................ 9-8
Mode settings.............................................................................................. 9-8
When [Basic Mode] is selected................................................................... 9-8
When [Advanced Mode] is selected............................................................ 9-9x-12 Contents
Using a Web Service ................................................................................... 9-12
Settings required to use a Web Service.................................................... 9-12
Installing this machine on the computer.................................................... 9-12
Confirmation before installation .......................................................... 9-12
Installation procedure.......................................................................... 9-12
Specifying the scan command from a computer (Web Service) ............... 9-13
Specifying the scan command from a computer................................. 9-13
10 Scanning with the machine ........................................................................ 10-1
Initial settings ............................................................................................... 10-2
Useful functions ........................................................................................... 10-2
Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations ............................................ 10-3
Basic Scan to E-mail operation................................................................. 10-3
Specifying document settings ................................................................... 10-4
[Simplex/Duplex] ................................................................................. 10-4
[Original Size]...................................................................................... 10-5
[Original Settings] - [Separate Scan]................................................... 10-5
[Original Settings] - [Original Direction]............................................... 10-6
[Original Settings] - [Orig. Binding Position]........................................ 10-6
[Color Mode] ....................................................................................... 10-7
[Original Type]..................................................................................... 10-7
Specifying scan settings............................................................................ 10-8
[Background/Density].......................................................................... 10-8
[Resolution] ......................................................................................... 10-8
[File Settings] - [File Type] .................................................................. 10-9
[File Settings] - [Scan Setting]............................................................. 10-9
[File Settings] - [PDF Encrypt]........................................................... 10-10
Specifying communication settings......................................................... 10-12
[Binary Division] ................................................................................ 10-12
[E-mail Encryption]............................................................................ 10-12
[Send Use Signature]........................................................................ 10-12
[E-mail].............................................................................................. 10-13
Specifying destinations ............................................................................ 10-14
Selecting from registered destinations.................................................... 10-14
Selecting from the Favorites list........................................................ 10-14
Selecting with an index search ......................................................... 10-15
Selecting by searching for a destination type or name ..................... 10-15
Directly typing in the address.................................................................. 10-16
Selecting from the log ............................................................................. 10-16
Selecting a program destination.............................................................. 10-17
Performing Scan to Folder mode operations .......................................... 10-18
Basic Scan to Folder operation............................................................... 10-18
Specifying document settings ................................................................. 10-20
[Simplex/Duplex] ............................................................................... 10-20
[Original Size].................................................................................... 10-20
[Original Settings] - [Separate Scan]................................................. 10-21Contents x-13
[Original Settings] - [Original Direction]............................................. 10-21
[Original Settings] - [Orig. Binding Position]...................................... 10-22
[Color Mode] ..................................................................................... 10-22
[Original Type]................................................................................... 10-23
Specifying scan settings.......................................................................... 10-23
[Background/Density]........................................................................ 10-23
[Resolution] ....................................................................................... 10-24
[File Settings] - [File Type] ................................................................ 10-24
[File Settings] - [Scan Setting]........................................................... 10-25
[File Settings] - [PDF Encrypt]........................................................... 10-25
Specifying the document name............................................................... 10-26
Specifying communication settings......................................................... 10-27
[URL Notification] .............................................................................. 10-27
[URL Notification Destination] ........................................................... 10-27
Specifying destinations ............................................................................ 10-27
Selecting from registered destinations.................................................... 10-27
Selecting from the Favorites list........................................................ 10-28
Selecting with an index search ......................................................... 10-28
Selecting by searching for a destination type or name ..................... 10-28
Directly typing in the address.................................................................. 10-29
With [FTP] ......................................................................................... 10-29
With [PC(SMB)]................................................................................. 10-29
With [WebDAV] ................................................................................. 10-30
With [USB Memory] .......................................................................... 10-30
With [HDD] ........................................................................................ 10-31
With [Web Service Settings] ............................................................. 10-32
Selecting from the log ............................................................................. 10-32
Selecting a program destination.............................................................. 10-33
Registering destinations ........................................................................... 10-34
Destination registration ........................................................................... 10-34
Address Book.................................................................................... 10-34
Group ................................................................................................ 10-34
Program ............................................................................................ 10-34
Registering an address book destination................................................ 10-35
Registering an address book destination (E-mail transmission) ....... 10-35
Registering Address Book (SMB transmission) ...................................... 10-36
Registering a program destination .......................................................... 10-37
11 Replacing Consumables ............................................................................. 11-1
Replacing Consumables ............................................................................. 11-2
About Toner Cartridges............................................................................. 11-2
Replacing a Toner Cartridge..................................................................... 11-4
Replacing a Imaging Unit.......................................................................... 11-9
Replacing the Waste Toner Bottle .......................................................... 11-17
Replacing the Transfer Roller ................................................................. 11-20
Replacing the Transfer Belt Unit ............................................................. 11-22x-14 Contents
Replacing the Backup Battery................................................................. 11-30
Replacing the Fuser Unit......................................................................... 11-33
Antistatic Protection .................................................................................. 11-38
12 Maintenance ................................................................................................. 12-1
Maintaining the machine ............................................................................. 12-2
Cleaning the machine .................................................................................. 12-4
Exterior...................................................................................................... 12-4
Media Rollers ............................................................................................ 12-5
Cleaning the Media Feed Rollers (Manual Feed Tray) ....................... 12-5
Cleaning the Media Feed Rollers for Tray 2/3/4 ................................. 12-7
Cleaning the Media Transfer Rollers for Tray 3/4 ............................... 12-8
Cleaning the Media Feed Rollers for the ADF .................................... 12-9
Cleaning the Laser Lens ......................................................................... 12-10
13 Troubleshooting .......................................................................................... 13-1
Introduction .................................................................................................. 13-2
Printing a configuration page ..................................................................... 13-2
Unlocking the Scanner ................................................................................ 13-3
Preventing Media Misfeeds ......................................................................... 13-4
Understanding the Media Path ................................................................... 13-5
Clearing Media Misfeeds ............................................................................. 13-6
Media misfeed indications......................................................................... 13-6
Clearing a Media Misfeed in Tray 2 .................................................... 13-7
Clearing a Media Misfeed in Tray 3/4 ............................................... 13-11
Clearing a Media Misfeed from the ADF........................................... 13-13
Clearing a Media Misfeed from the Duplex....................................... 13-15
Clearing a Media Misfeed from the Fuser Unit ................................. 13-16
Clearing a Media Misfeed from Tray 1 (Manual Feed Tray) and
Transfer Roller .................................................................................. 13-20
Solving Problems with Media Misfeeds ................................................... 13-23
Solving Other Problems ............................................................................ 13-26
Solving Problems with Printing Quality .................................................. 13-31
Status, error and service messages ........................................................ 13-38
Status messages..................................................................................... 13-38
Error messages....................................................................................... 13-39
Warning messages ........................................................................... 13-39
Operator messages .......................................................................... 13-41
Service messages................................................................................... 13-47
14 Installing Accessories ................................................................................. 14-1
Introduction .................................................................................................. 14-2
Lower Feeder Unit PF-P08 .......................................................................... 14-3
Kit Contents............................................................................................... 14-3
Installing a Lower Feeder Unit PF-P08 ..................................................... 14-4Contents x-15
Working Table WT-P01 ................................................................................ 14-6
Kit Contents............................................................................................... 14-6
Installing a Working Table WT-P01........................................................... 14-7
15 Authentication device (IC card type) ......................................................... 15-1
Using authentication device (IC card type) ............................................... 15-2
Configuring this machine ........................................................................... 15-2
Registering a user ....................................................................................... 15-4
Registering a user using Data Administrator............................................. 15-4
Checking the version of the installed Data Administrator.......................... 15-4
Setup......................................................................................................... 15-5
User registration...................................................................................... 15-10
Associating the user with card using authentication device.................... 15-15
Logging in to this machine ....................................................................... 15-15
When [Card Authentication] is enabled................................................... 15-16
When [Card Authentication + Password] is enabled............................... 15-16
A Appendix ........................................................................................................A-1
Technical specifications ...............................................................................A-2
Consumable Life Expectancy Chart............................................................A-6
User-Replaceable .................................................................................A-6
Service-Replaceable.............................................................................A-7
Text input ........................................................................................................A-8
Entering text................................................................................................A-8
Our Concern for Environmental Protection ................................................A-9
What is an ENERGY STAR product? ...................................................A-9x-16 Contents1Introduction1-2 Getting Acquainted with Your Machine
Getting Acquainted with Your Machine
Space Requirements
To ensure easy operation, consumable replacement and maintenance,
adhere to the recommended space requirements detailed below.
Side View
Front View
1068 mm (42.0")
100 mm
(3.9")
150 mm
(5.9") 530 mm (20.9")
288 mm
(11.3")
937 mm (36.9")
70 mm
(2.8")
508 mm (20.0")
776 mm (30.6")
359 mm
(14.1")
226 mm
(8.9") 550 mm (21.7")Getting Acquainted with Your Machine 1-3
" The option appears shaded in the above illustrations.
Side View with Options
954 mm (37.6")
70 mm
(2.8")
508 mm (20.0")
1009 mm (39.7")
359 mm
(14.1")
226 mm
(8.9")
550 mm (21.7")
376 mm (14.8")
233 mm
(9.2")1-4 Getting Acquainted with Your Machine
Part Names
The following drawings illustrate the parts of your machine referred to
throughout this guide, so please take some time to become familiar with
them.
Front View
1—Control panel
2—Automatic Document
Feeder (ADF)
2-a: ADF feed cover
2-b: Document guide
2-c: Document feed tray
2-d: Document output tray
2-e: Document stopper
" Lower the document
stopper when scanning
Legal-size paper with
the ADF.
3—USB HOST port
" A USB hub can be connected to the USB
HOST port. In addition,
a USB memory device
and an authentication
device (IC card type)
can be connected to
the USB hub at the
same time.
4—Tray 1 (Manual feed tray)
5—Tray 2
6—Output tray
7—Scanner lock lever
8—Original glass
9—Original cover pad
10—Scanner unit
10
9
6
7
8
4
3
2-e
2
2-c
2-d
5
1
2-a
2-bGetting Acquainted with Your Machine 1-5
11—Fuser unit
12—Right door
13—Transfer roller
14—Transfer belt unit
15—Imaging unit(s)
16—Front cover
17—Waste toner bottle
18—Toner cartridge(s)
11
12
15 14 13
16
17
18
18
17
13
14
151-6 Getting Acquainted with Your Machine
Rear View
1—Power switch
2—Rear cover
3—Power connection
4—LINE (telephone line) jack
5—TEL (telephone) jack
6—10Base-T/100Base-TX/
1000Base-T Ethernet Interface port
7—USB port
Front View with Options
1—Lower feeder unit PF-P08
(Tray 3)
2—Lower feeder unit PF-P08
(Tray 4)
3—Working Table WT-P01
1
3 2
4
6 5
7
2
1
3Getting Acquainted with Your Machine 1-7
Adjusting the angle of the control panel
The control panel can be adjusted to any of three angles. Adjust the control
panel to the angle that allows for easy operation.
1 Grab the sides of the control
panel, and then tilt it up.
" Before moving the control
panel to a lower angle, tilt it
up first, and then slowly tilt
it down.
" When tilting the control
panel, do not press on the
touch panel.1-8 Getting Acquainted with Your Machine
Drivers CD/DVD
Printer Drivers (PostScript Drivers)
" A specific PPD file has been prepared for applications (such as Page
Maker and Corel Draw) that require that a PPD file be specified when
printing.
When specifying a PPD file while printing on Windows Server 2008
R2, Windows 7, Vista, Server 2008, XP, Server 2003 and 2000, use
the specific PPD file provided on the Drivers CD/DVD.
Printer Drivers (PCL Drivers)
Printer Drivers (XPS Drivers)
Operating System Use/Benefit
Windows 7/Vista/Server 2008/XP/
Server 2003/2000
These drivers give you access to all of
the printer features, including finishing
and advanced layout. For details,
refer to “Displaying Printer Driver Settings (for Windows)” on page 5-5.
Windows Server 2008 R2/7/Vista/
Server 2008/XP/Server 2003 for
64bit
Operating System Use/Benefit
Windows 7/Vista/Server 2008/XP/
Server 2003/2000
These drivers give you access to all of
the printer features, including finishing
and advanced layout. For details,
refer to “Displaying Printer Driver Settings (for Windows)” on page 5-5.
Windows Server 2008 R2/7/ Vista/
Server 2008/XP/Server 2003 for
64bit
Operating System Use/Benefit
Windows 7/Vista/Server 2008 These drivers give you access to all of
the printer features, including finishing
and advanced layout.
For details on the installation method
and functions, refer to the [Reference
Guide] on the Documentation CD/
DVD.
Windows Server 2008 R2/7/ Vista/
Server 2008 for 64bitGetting Acquainted with Your Machine 1-9
Printer Drivers (PPD Files)
Scanner Drivers
PC Fax Drivers
" For details on the installation of the drivers, refer to the [Installation
Guide] on the Documentation CD/DVD.
Operating System Use/Benefit
Mac OS X (10.2.8/10.3/10.4/10.5/
10.6)
These files are required in order to
use the printer driver for each operating system.
For details of the Macintosh and
Linux printer driver, refer to the [Reference Guide] on the Documentation
CD/DVD.
Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 Desktop
SUSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10
Operating System Use/Benefit
TWAIN Driver for Windows 7/Vista/
Server 2008/XP/Server 2003/2000
These drivers enable you to set scanning functions, such as the color setting and size adjustments.
For details, refer to “Windows WIA
Driver Settings” on page 9-7.
TWAIN Driver for Mac OS X (10.3.9/
10.4/10.5/10.6)
WIA Driver for Windows 7/Vista/
Server 2008/XP
This driver enables you to set scanning functions, such as the color setting and size adjustments.
For details, refer to “Windows WIA
Driver Settings” on page 9-7.
WIA Driver for Windows 7/Vista/
Server 2008/XP for 64bit
Operating System Use/Benefit
Windows 7/Vista/Server 2008/XP/
Server 2003/2000
These drivers enable you to specify
fax settings, such as the paper settings for sending faxes and the settings for editing the address book. For
details, refer to the [Facsimile User’s
Guide] on the Documentation CD/
DVD.
Windows Server 2008 R2/7/Vista/
Server 2008/XP/Server 2003 for 64
bit1-10 Getting Acquainted with Your Machine
" For details of the Macintosh and Linux drivers, refer to the Reference
Guide on the Documentation CD/DVD.
" Windows TWAIN driver does not correspond to 64-bit applications
though it corresponds to 32-bit applications on 64-bit OS.
Applications CD/DVD
Applications
Applications Use/Benefit
Download Manager
(Windows Server 2008 R2/7/Vista/
Server 2008/XP/Server 2003/2000,
Mac OS 10.2.8/10.3/10.4/10.5/10.6)
This utility enables fonts and overlay
data to be downloaded to the hard
disk.
For details, refer to the online help for
all functions of Download Manager.
PageScope Net Care Device Manager
Printer management functions such
as status monitoring and network settings can be accessed.
For details, refer to the PageScope
Net Care Device Manager User’s
Guide on the Applications CD/DVD.
PageScope Data Administrator PageScope Data Administrator is an
administration tool with which authentication data and addresses registered
with the control panel of supported
devices (multifunctional OA equipment) can be changed from other
computers on the network.
For details, refer to the PageScope
Data Administrator User Manual on
the Applications CD/DVD.
Print Status Notifier This application notifies the user as to
whether a print job has completed
successfully or has encountered an
error.
For details, refer to the Print Status
Notifier User’s Guide on the Applications CD/DVD.Getting Acquainted with Your Machine 1-11
PageScope Direct Print This application provides functions for
sending PDF and TIFF files directly to
a printer to be printed.
For details, refer to the PageScope
Direct Print User’s Guide on the Applications CD/DVD.
PageScope Enterprise Suite Plug-In This plug-in provides the additional
functions of PageScope Enterprise
Suite, which enables centralized management of devices and permission
management.1-12 Getting Acquainted with Your Machine
Documentation CD/DVD
Documentation
Documentation Use/Benefit
Installation Guide This manual provides installation
details that must be performed in
order to use this machine, such as
setting up the machine and installing
the drivers.
Printer/Copier/Scanner User’s Guide
(this manual)
This manual provides details on general daily operations, such as using
the drivers and control panel and
replacing consumables.
Facsimile User’s Guide This manual provides details on general fax operations, such as sending
and receiving faxes and using the
control panel.
Reference Guide This manual provides details on
installing the Macintosh and Linux
drivers and on specifying settings for
the network.
Quick Guide This manual provides an introduction
to, and illustrations for, basic machine
operations and frequently used functions.Getting Acquainted with Your Machine 1-13
System Requirements
Personal computer
– Pentium 3: 400MHz or higher (Windows Vista: 1GHz or higher)
– PowerPC G3 or later (G4 or later is recommended)
– Macintosh equipped with an Intel processor
Operating System
– Microsoft Windows 7 Home Basic/Home Premium/Professional/Enterprise/Ultimate, Windows 7 Home Premium/Professional/Enterprise/
Ultimate, Windows Server 2008 R2 Standard/Enterprise, Windows
Server 2008 Standard/Enterprise, Windows Server 2008 Standard/
Enterprise x64 Edition, Windows Vista Home Basic/Home Premium/
Ultimate/Business/Enterprise, Windows Vista Home Basic/Home Premium /Ultimate/Business /Enterprise x64 Edition, Windows XP Home
Edition/Professional (Service Pack 2 or later), Windows XP Professional x64 Edition, Windows Server 2003, Windows Server 2003 x64
Edition, Windows 2000 (Service Pack 4 or later)
– Mac OS X (10.2.8/10.3/10.4/10.5/10.6; We recommend installing the
most recent patch.)
– Red Hat Enterprise Linux 5 Desktop, SUSE Linux Enterprise Desktop
10
Free hard disk space
256 MB or more
RAM
512 MB or more
CD/DVD drive
I/O interface
– 10Base-T/100Base-TX/1000Base-T Ethernet interface port
– USB 2.0 High-Speed compliant port
" The Ethernet cable and USB cable are not included with the machine.
" For details of the Macintosh and Linux drivers, refer to the [Reference
Guide] on the Documentation CD/DVD.1-14 Getting Acquainted with Your Machine2Control panel
and touch panel
screens2-2 About the Control Panel
About the Control Panel
No. Name Function
1 Touch panel Displays various screens and messages. Specify the
various settings by directly touching the panel.
2 [Power Save]
key/indicator
Press to enter Power Save mode. While the
machine is in Power Save mode, the indicator on the
[Power Save] key lights up in green and the touch
panel goes off. To cancel Power Save mode, press
the [Power Save] key again.
3 [Fax] key/indicator
Press to enter Fax mode. While the machine is in
Fax mode, the indicator on the [Fax] key lights up in
green.
4 [E-mail] key/indicator
Press to enter Scan to E-mail mode. While the
machine is in Scan to E-mail mode, the indicator on
the [E-mail] key lights up in green.
5 [Folder] key/indicator
Press to enter Scan to Folder mode. While the
machine is in Scan to Folder mode, the indicator on
the [Folder] key lights up in green.
6 [Copy] key/indicator
Press to enter Copy mode. While the machine is in
Copy mode, the indicator on the [Copy] key lights up
in green.
7 [Reset] key Press to clear the settings (except programmed settings) of all displayed functions.
Press to delete a job stopped during the scan operation.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8
9
191817 16 14 15 13 121110About the Control Panel 2-3
8 [Interrupt] key/
indicator
Press to enter Interrupt mode. While the machine is
in Interrupt mode, the indicator on the [Interrupt] key
lights up in green. To cancel Interrupt mode, press
the [Interrupt] key again.
9 [Stop] key Pressing the [Stop] key while copying, scanning or
printing temporarily stops the operation.
10 [Start (Color) ]
key
Press to start color copying, scanning or faxing.
Press to continue interrupted printing.
11 [Start] indicator Lights up in blue when copying, scanning or faxing
can be performed.
Lights up in orange when copying, scanning or faxing cannot be performed.
12 [Start (B&W) ]
key
Press to start black-and-white copying, scanning or
faxing.
Press to continue interrupted printing.
13 Keypad Use to enter the number of copies, a fax number, an
E-mail address or a name.
Use to type in the various settings.
14 [C] (clear) key Press to erase numbers or text.
Press to delete a job stopped during the scan operation.
15 [Error] indicator Flashes in orange if an error occurred.
Lights up in orange when the service representative
is being called.
16 [Data] indicator Flashes in blue while a print job is being received.
Lights up in blue while printing or when a print job is
queued.
17 [Utility/Counter]
key
Press to display the [Utility Settings] screen.
From the [Utility Settings] screen, settings can be
specified for the parameters in the [Accessibility],
[Meter Count], [Address Registration], [User Settings] and [Admin Settings] screens.
No. Name Function2-4 About the Control Panel
18 [Mode Memory]
key
Press to store the desired settings for copy, fax or
scan operations. In addition, stored settings can be
recalled.
19 [Access] key If user authentication or account track settings have
been applied, press the [Access] key after entering
the user name and password (for user authentication) or the account name and password (for account
track) in order to log on to this machine.
While logged on, press the [Access] key to log off.
No. Name FunctionTouch panel screens 2-5
Touch panel screens
Home screen
No. Indication Description
1 Status Displays messages about the current operating status.
2 [Fax] Press to enter Fax mode.
For details, refer to the [Facsimile User’s Guide].
3 [Scan to E-mail] Press to enter Scan to E-mail mode.
For details on the Scan to E-mail mode operations,
refer to “Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations” on page 10-3.
4 [Scan to Folder] Press to enter Scan to Folder mode.
For details on the Scan to Folder mode operations,
refer to “Performing Scan to Folder mode operations” on page 10-18.
5 [Copy] Press to enter Copy mode.
For details on the Copy mode operations, refer to
“Performing Copy mode operations” on page 7-1.
6 Date/time Shows the current date and time.
1
10 6 9 7 8
2 3 4 52-6 Touch panel screens
7 [USB/HDD] Press to print files on a USB memory device.
Press to print a print job saved on hard disk.
8 [Status] Press to view information on consumables and
devices.
9 [Job] Press to check a print, transmission, reception or
stored data job.
10 Toner supply
indicators
Shows the amount of toner remaining for yellow (Y),
magenta (M), cyan (C) and black (K).
No. Indication DescriptionTouch panel screens 2-7
Initial Copy mode screen
No. Indication Description
1 Number of copies
Indicates the specified number of copies.
2 Copy mode
operations
Press to display the corresponding screen for specifying various settings.
3 [Mode Check] Press to check the currently specified copy settings.
4 Press to return to the home screen.
1
3
2
42-8 Touch panel screens
Initial Scan to Folder mode screen
No. Indication Description
1 [Favorites] Press to display frequently used destinations.
2 [Direct Input] Press to directly enter an address of the selected
destination type.
3 [Log] Press to specify a destination from the log.
4 [Mode Check] Press to check the currently specified Scan to Folder
mode settings.
5 [Settings] Press to specify settings such as the document
scanning method.
6 Press to return to the home screen.
5 4
1 2 3
6Touch panel screens 2-9
Initial Scan to E-mail mode screen
Initial Fax mode screen
For details on the initial Fax mode screen, refer to the [Facsimile User’s
Guide].
No. Indication Description
1 [Favorites] Press to display frequently used destinations.
2 [Direct Input] Press to directly enter a destination address.
3 [Log] Press to specify a destination from the log.
4 [Mode Check] Press to check the currently specified Scan to E-mail
mode settings.
5 [Settings] Press to specify settings such as the document
scanning method.
6 Press to return to the home screen.
5 4
1 2 3
62-10 Touch panel screens
Job screen
No. Indication Description
1 [Print] Press to display a screen listing the print jobs.
2 [Send] Press to display a screen listing the transmission
jobs.
3 [Receive] Press to display a screen listing the reception jobs.
4 [Active]/[Log] Press to display screens listing the jobs currently
being performed or the job log.
5 Job list Displays the list of jobs.
The job number, user name and job status can be
checked.
6 [Delete] Press to delete the selected job. Next, press [Yes],
then [OK].
"When the job log is displayed, [Details]
appears. To view job details, press [Details].
7 Press to return to the home screen.
1 4 2 3
6
5
7Touch panel screens 2-11
Status screen
No. Indication Description
1 [Consumables] Press to display a screen showing the status of consumables.
"The percentages remaining for the
consumables may be different from the actual
amounts and should be used only as
reference.
2 [Device info.] Press to display a screen showing the information of
devices.
3 Press to return to the home screen.
2
3
12-12 Touch panel screens
USB/HDD screen
" For details on the Proof Print function, refer to “Proof Print” on
page 6-2.
" For details on the External Memory Print function, refer to “External
Memory” on page 6-3.
" For details on the ID & Print function, refer to “ID & Print” on page 6-4.
No. Indication Description
1 [Proof Print] Press to print a print job saved on hard disk.
[User Name] Select a user.
2 [External Memory]
Press to print files on a USB memory device.
[File List] Select the file to be printed. In addition, print settings
can be specified.
[File Type] Select the type of files to be displayed.
3 [ID & Print] Press to print a print job sent as a registered user or
public user.
[Login User] Press to display and print a job of the user who is
currently logged in.
[Public User] Press to display and print a job of a public user.
4 Press to return to the home screen.
1 2
3 4Touch panel screens 2-13
Keys and icons that appear in the screens
Icon Description
If the screen has multiple pages, press [ ] or [ ] to select a different page.
If values appear between [ ] and [ ], the current page number/total number of pages is indicated.
If there are tabs that are not displayed, press [ ] or [ ] to
select a different tab.
Press to adjust the image quality during a copy, scan or fax
operation.
Press [+] or [-] to change the entered value.
Press to view the error message when an error occurs.
Press to display descriptions of the various functions.
A description of the current screen will be displayed.
Press to display the address book. From this screen, you can
select single destinations and group destinations registered in
the address book.
Press to return to the home screen.
Appears while scanning and printing when making copies.
Appears while scanning with fax transmission and scanning
operations.2-14 Touch panel screens
Appears while printing with PC printing, received fax printing
and report printing.
Appears when using a G3 fax connection.
Appears when there are documents queued for a timer transmission.
Appears when there are fax documents received with memory
reception or PC faxing.
Appears when data or documents are being sent from this unit.
Appears when this unit is receiving data or documents.
Appears when enhanced security settings have been applied.
Appears when a USB memory device is connected.
Icon DescriptionUser authentication and account track 2-15
User authentication and account track
If user authentication or account track settings have been specified on the
machine, the user name or account name and the password must be entered
in the Login screen in order to log on.
The following procedures describe how to log on when user authentication or
account track settings have been specified.
" User authentication and account track settings are specified from PageScope Web Connection. For details, refer to the [Reference Guide].
With user authentication
Device authentication
1 Specify a name and password for [User Name] and [Password].
– For [User Name], the name can be specified either by directly typing it
in or selecting from a list.
2 Press [Login].
If authentication was successful, the functions of this machine can be
used.
External server authentication
1 Specify a name and password for [User Name] and [Password].
– For [User Name], the name can be specified either by directly typing it
in or selecting from a list.
2 Specify a server for [Server].
3 Press [Login].
If authentication was successful, the functions of this machine can be
used.
" If account track settings have been applied, account track will be performed after [Login] is pressed. However, if the machine has been set
to synchronize user authentication and account track and an account
had been specified for the user who is logging on, account track will
not be performed. For details, refer to the [Reference Guide].2-16 User authentication and account track
Logging in using the authentication device
The following describes how to log in to this machine with IC card authentication.
To perform IC card authentication, register the information recorded in
the IC card in advance.
If an authentication failure recurs, the problem may be due to incorrect
registration of IC card information. Register IC card information again.
Press [Device Authentication] to log in by specifying the user name
and password for [User Name] and [Password], without using the
authentication device.
1 Press [Card Authentication].
2 Press [Access Basic Screen].
– For ID & Print jobs, press [Begin Printing] to authenticate the user and
start printing.
3 Place the IC card on the authentication device.
" For details on how to register an IC card for the user, refer to “Authentication device (IC card type)” on page 15-1.
With account track
1 Specify an account and password for [Account] and [Password].
2 Press [Login].
If authentication was successful, the functions of this machine can be
used.3Utility Settings3-2 [Accessibility]
[Accessibility]
From the [Accessibility] screen, various settings can be specified for the displayed screens and the operation of control panel keys.
Invalid Input
Sound
Input Confirmation Sound
Key Repeat/
Interval
Sound Set- Set All
tings
Accessibility Time to Start
Enable
Enable
Key Interval
Volume
Operation
Confirmation
Volume
Enable
Volume
Enable
Volume
Operation
Completion
Successful Enable
Completion
Volume
Transmission
Completion
Enable
Volume
Basic Sound[Accessibility] 3-3
Low Caution
Sound (Level 2)
Low Caution
Sound (Level 1)
Completion
Preparation
Touch Panel
Adujstment
Message
Display Time
Enable
Enable
Volume
Caution
Sound
Volume
Enable
Volume
Enable
Volume
Severe
Caution
Sound
Enable
Volume
Low Caution
Sound (Level 3)
LCD
Brightness3-4 [Accessibility]
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Accessibility].
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
Item Description
[Key Repeat /Interval] The length of time until the value begins to change
after a button is held down and the length of time for
the value to change can be specified.
[Time to Start] Settings 0.1 to 3.0 seconds (Default:0.8)
Specify the length of time until a value begins to
change after a button is held down.
[Key Interval] Settings 0.1 to 3.0 seconds (Default:0.3)
Specify the length of time for the value to change.
[Sound Settings] Settings can be specified for the various sounds produced with key operations.
[Set all] Settings Enable: [ON] / [OFF]
Volume: [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
To specify that sounds be produced, press [Enable],
and then press [ON]. To adjust the volume, press
[Volume], and then press [Low], [Medium] or [High].
To specify that sounds not be produced, press
[Enable], and then press [OFF].
[Operation Confirmation]
Select if confirmation sounds are to be produced with
key operations.
[Input Confirmation
Sound]
Settings Enable : [ON] / [OFF]
Volume : [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select whether sounds are produced when keys are
pressed to enter data.
[Invalid Input Sound] Settings Enable : [ON] / [OFF]
Volume : [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select whether sounds are produced when keys are
pressed to enter invalid data.
[Basic Sound] Settings Enable : [ON] / [OFF]
Volume : [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select whether sounds are produced when the
default setting is selected while scrolling through the
settings.[Accessibility] 3-5
[Successful Completion] Select if sounds are to be produced when an operation or communication is completed successfully.
[Operation Completion]
Settings Enable : [ON] / [OFF]
Volume : [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select whether sounds are produced when an operation is completed successfully.
[Transmission Completion]
Settings Enable : [ON] / [OFF]
Volume : [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select whether sounds are produced when a communication is completed successfully.
[Completion Preparation]
Settings Enable : [ON] / [OFF]
Volume : [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select if sounds are to be produced when machine
preparations are finished.
[Caution Sound] Select if sounds are to be produced when cautions
occur.
[Low Caution Sound
(Level 1)]
Settings Enable : [ON] / [OFF]
Volume : [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select whether sounds are produced when a message appears in the touch panel, warning that it is
almost time to replace consumables or a replaceable
part.
[Low Caution Sound
(Level 2)]
Settings Enable : [ON] / [OFF]
Volume : [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select whether sounds are produced when the user
performs an incorrect operation.
[Low Caution Sound
(Level 3)]
Settings Enable : [ON] / [OFF]
Volume : [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select whether sounds are produced when an error
occurs that can be corrected by the user by referring
to the message that appeared or the User’s Guide.
[Severe Caution
Sound]
Settings Enable : [ON] / [OFF]
Volume : [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select whether sounds are produced when an error
occurs that cannot be corrected by the user or
requires a service representative.3-6 [Accessibility]
[Touch Panel Adujstment] If the touch panel buttons do not respond correctly,
the position of buttons in the touch panel may not be
correctly aligned with the position of the actual touch
sensor and may need to be adjusted.
Press the four check points ([+]) in the touch
panel adjustment screen, making sure that a
sound is produced with each, and then press
the [Start] key.
The check points ([+]) can be pressed in any
order.
To reset the adjustment, press the [C] key, and
then press the four check points ([+]) again.
To cancel the touch panel adjustment, press the
[Stop] key.
If the touch panel cannot be adjusted, contact
the service representative.
[Message Display Time] Settings [3 sec.] / [5 sec.]
Specify the length of time for displaying warning messages, which appear, for example, when an incorrect
operation is performed.
[LCD Brightness] Settings -3 to 3 (Default: 0)
Adjust the contrast of the touch panel.[Meter Count] 3-7
[Meter Count]
From the [Meter Count] screen, the page count for each function and the total
page count can be viewed.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Meter Count].
3 Press [ ], [ ], [ ] or [ ] to display the desired information.
Item Description
[Total] Displays the total page count for each operation mode.
[Copy] Displays the page count for copy operations.
[Print] Displays the page count for print operations.
[Scan] Displays the page count for scan operations.
[Fax] Displays the page count for fax operations.
Scan
Total
Print
Copy
Meter Count
Fax3-8 [Address Registration]
[Address Registration]
From the [Address Registration] screen, E-mail and fax destinations can be
registered and viewed.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Address Registration].
" [Address Registration] does not appear if only account track settings
have been specified and no user is logged on with an account.
Item Description
[E-mail] Destinations for E-mail transmissions can be registered and viewed.
For details on registering, refer to “Registering an
address book destination” on page 10-35.
[Mode Check] Press to view the details for the selected destination.
[New] Press to register a new destination.
Specify settings for [No.], [Name], [E-mail], [Favorites] and [Index].
Fax
Address
Registration
E-mail Mode Check
New
Mode Check
New
SMB Mode Check
New[Address Registration] 3-9
[Fax] Fax destinations can be registered and viewed.
For details on registering, refer to the [Facsimile
User’s Guide].
[Mode Check] Press to view the details for the selected destination.
[New] Press to register a new destination.
Specify settings for [No.], [Name], [Fax number],
[Favorites], [Index] and [Line Settings].
[SMB] Destinations for SMB transmissions can be registered and viewed.
For details on registering, refer to “Registering an
address book destination” on page 10-35.
[Mode Check] Press to view the details for the selected destination.
[New] Press to register a new destination.
Specify settings for [No.], [Name], [Connection]
([Host Name], [File Path], [User ID], [Password]),
[Favorites] and [Index].
Item Description3-10 [User Settings]
[User Settings]
From the [User Settings] screen, various settings are available to be changed
by the user.
Machine
Settings
Paper Tray
Settings
Copy
Settings
User Settings Language
Auto Tray
Switch
Tray 1
Measurement
Unit Setting
Enable ATS/
APS
ACS Level
Tray 2
Tray 3
Default
Copy
Settings
Auto Zoom
for Combine
Separate
Scan Output
Method
Tray 4
Scan to
E-mail
Default Tab
Fax
Default Tab
Scan to
Folder
Default Tab[User Settings] 3-11
Scan
Settings
Default
Scan
Settings
Print
Settings
JPEG
Compression
Level
Paper Tray
Settings
Paper Size
Black
Compression
Level
Default Tray
Custom Size
Paper
Settings
Tray 1
Tray 2
Duplex
Tray 3
Copies
Collate
Auto Tray
Switching
Paper Type
Paper Size
Custom Size
Paper Type
Paper Size
Paper Type
Tray 4 Paper Size
Paper Type3-12 [User Settings]
Tray Mapping
Mode
Logical
Tray 0
Logical
Tray 3
Logical
Tray 4
Tray Mapping
Logical
Tray 1
Logical
Tray 2
Logical
Tray 5
Logical
Tray 6
Logical
Tray 7
Logical
Tray 8
Logical
Tray 9
Print Reports
Statistics
Page
PS
Font List
PCL
Configuration Page
HDD Directory List
Counter List
Print[User Settings] 3-13
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [User Settings].
" [User Settings] is not displayed when the job log is full.
[Machine Settings]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
Item Description
[Language] Settings [English] / [French] / [Italian] /
[German] / [Spanish] / [Portuguese]
/ [Hangul] / [Simplified Chinese] /
[Traditional Chinese] / [Czech] /
[Hungarian] / [Polish] / [Slovak] /
[Russian] / [Dutch] / [Danish] / [Norwegian] / [Swedish] / [Finnish] /
[Greek] / [Turkish] / [Catalan] / [Japanese]
Specify the language for the screens that
appear in the touch panel.
[Measurement Unit Setting] Settings [Inch] / [mm]
Select the measurement units for the values
that appear in the touch panel screens.
"The default setting is [Inch] for 120V
model, and [mm] for other models.
Fax Settings
Default Fax
Settings
Remote RX
Enabled
Remote RX
No.
Display Fax
Activity
Fax RX
Fax TX3-14 [User Settings]
[Paper Tray Settings] Specify paper tray settings.
[Auto Tray Switch] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a paper tray loaded with
paper of the same size is selected automatically when a paper tray that was selected manually becomes empty while printing copies.
[Enable ATS/APS] Specify the paper trays that are selected when
the paper tray is automatically changed.
"[Tray 3] and [Tray 4] do not appear if the
optional lower feeder units have not
been installed.
[Tray 1] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not [Tray 1] can be selected
with the automatic tray-switching feature.
[Tray 2] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not [Tray 2] can be selected
with the automatic tray-switching feature.
[Tray 3] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not [Tray 3] can be selected
with the automatic tray-switching feature.
[Tray 4] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not [Tray 4] can be selected
with the automatic tray-switching feature.
[ACS Level] Settings 0 to 4 (Default: 2)
Adjust the level for detecting whether a document is in color or in black and white when the
[Auto] Color setting is selected.Set to [0] or [1]
for a tendency toward black and white, or set to
[3] or [4] for a tendency toward color.
[Scan to E-mail
Default Tab]
Settings [Favorites] / [Direct Input] / [Log]
Specify the initial screen when changing to the
E-mail transmission screen.
[Fax
Default Tab]
Settings [Favorites] / [Direct Input] / [Others]
Specify the initial screen when changing to the
fax transmission screen.[User Settings] 3-15
[Copy Settings]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
[Scan to Folder
Default Tab]
Settings [Favorites] / [Direct Input] / [Log]
Specify the initial screen when changing to the
folder transmission screen.
Item Description
[Auto Zoom for Combine] Settings [Yes] / [No]
Select whether or not the zoom ratio is automatically adjusted when the [Auto] Paper setting and a Combine setting are selected.
[Default Copy Settings] Settings [Factory Default] / [Current Setting]
Select the default copy settings that are
selected when the machine is turned on or the
[Reset] key is pressed.
[Factory Default]: The manufacturer’s default
settings are used as the default settings.
[Current Setting]: The currently specified settings are used as the default settings.
[Separate Scan Output
Method]
Settings [Batch Print] / [Page Print]
Select whether or not printing begins after all
document pages have been scanned when the
document is divided and the batches are separately loaded into the ADF or when the original
glass is being used to scan a document containing multiple pages.
[Batch Print]: Printing begins after all pages of
the document have been scanned.
[Page Print]: Printing of pages that can be
printed begins while the document is being
scanned.3-16 [User Settings]
[Scan Settings]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
Item Description
[JPEG Compression Level] Settings [High Quality] / [Standard] / [High
Compression]
Select the compression method for saving an
image in full color.
[High Quality]: The data size will become large,
but the image quality will be high.
[Standard]: Both the data size and image quality will be between those of [High Quality] and
[High Compression].
[High Compression]: The data size will become
small, but the image quality will be low.
[Black Compression Level] Settings [MH] / [MMR]
Select this machine’s transmission quality
when sending data with the TIFF file format
selected.
[MH]: The data size will become large.
[MMR]: The data size will become small.
[Default Scan Settings] Settings [Factory Default] / [Current Setting]
Select the default scan settings that are
selected when the machine is turned on or the
[Reset] key is pressed.
[Factory Default]: The manufacturer’s default
settings are used as the default settings.
[Current Setting]: The currently specified settings are used as the default settings.[User Settings] 3-17
[Print Settings]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
Item Description
[Paper Settings] Specify settings for the paper and paper trays.
[Paper Tray Settings] Specify settings for the paper trays.
[Default Tray] Settings [Tray 1] / [Tray 2] / [Tray 3] /
[Tray 4]
Select the paper tray that is given priority.
"[Tray 3] and [Tray 4] do not appear if the
optional lower feeder units have not
been installed.
[Tray 1]-[Tray 4] Specify the default settings for [Tray 1] through
[Tray 4].
"[Tray 3] and [Tray 4] do not appear if the
optional lower feeder units have not
been installed.3-18 [User Settings]
[Paper Size] Settings [Any] / [Letter] / [Legal] / [Executive] / [A4] / [A5] / [A6] / [B5 (JIS)] /
[B6] / [Govt Letter] / [Statement] /
[Folio] / [SP Folio] / [UK Quarto] /
[Foolscap] / [Govt Legal] / [16K] /
[4×6] / [Kai 16] / [Kai 32] / [Env C6] /
[Env DL] / [Env Monarch] / [Env
Chou#3] / [Env Chou#4] / [B5
(ISO)] / [Env #10] / [J Postcard] / [J
Postcard-D] / [8 1/8×13 1/4] / [8 1/
2×13 1/2] / [Custom Size]
Select the size of paper loaded in the selected
tray.
"The default setting is [Letter] for 120V
model, and [A4] for other models.
"Depending on the setting selected for
[User Settings] - [Machine Settings] -
[Measurement Unit Setting], 4 × 6 may
change to 10 × 15 cm.
"With [Tray 2], [Env C6], [Env DL], [Env
Monarch], [Env Chou#3], [Env Chou#4],
[B5 (ISO)], [Env #10] do not appear.
"With [Tray 3] and [Tray 4], only [Letter],
[Legal], [Govt Legal], [Executive], [A4]
and [B5 (JIS)] appear.
[Custom Size] Press [Width] and [Length], and then type in
the paper size.
"These settings can be specified if [Paper
Size] is set to [Custom].
"Settings for [Custom Size] cannot be
specified for [Tray 3] and [Tray 4].[User Settings] 3-19
[Paper Type] Settings [Any] / [Plain Paper] / [Recycled] /
[Thick 1] / [Thick 2] / [Label] / [Envelope] / [Postcard] / [Letterhead] /
[Glossy 1] / [Glossy 2] / [1 Side
Only] / [Special Paper]
Select the type of paper loaded in the selected
tray.
"[Envelope] appears only with [Tray 1].
"With [Tray 3] and [Tray 4], only [Any],
[Plain Paper], [Recycled], [1 Side Only]
and [Special Paper] appear.
[Duplex] Settings [OFF] / [Long Edge] / [Short Edge]
Select whether pages are printed
double-sided.
If [Long Edge] is selected, the pages will be
printed on both sides of the paper for
long-edge binding.
If [Short Edge] is selected, the pages will be
printed on both sides of the paper for
short-edge binding.
[Copies] Settings 1 to 9999 (Default: 1)
Specify the number of copies to be printed.
[Collate] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to enable collated (sort)
printing.
[Auto Tray Switching] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
If [ON] is selected and the specified tray runs
out of paper during printing, a tray loaded with
paper of the same size is automatically
selected so printing can continue.
If [OFF] is selected and the specified tray runs
out of paper, printing stops.3-20 [User Settings]
[Fax Settings]
Specify the fax settings. For details on specifying the fax settings, refer to the
[Facsimile User’s Guide].
[Select Default Start App]
This screen appears when an available application is registered while
Enhanced Server Authentication is enabled.
[Tray Mapping] Specify the Tray Mapping settings.
[Tray Mapping
Mode]
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the Tray Mapping function is used.
[Logical Tray 0]-
[Logical Tray 9]
Settings [Physical Tray 1] / [Physical Tray
2] / [Physical Tray 3]
"For [Logical Tray 1], the default value is
[Physical Tray 1].
Select the tray that is used for printing when a
print job is received from another manufacturer’s printer driver.
[Print Reports] Specify settings for printing the various reports.
[Configuration Page] Prints information and status of this machine.
[Statistics Page] Prints the statistics page.
[Font List] Prints the font list.
[PS] Prints the PostScript font list.
[PCL] Prints the PCL font list.
[HDD Directory List] Prints the directory list for the hard disk.
[Counter List Print] Prints the list of counters.[Admin Settings] 3-21
[Admin Settings]
From the Admin Settings screen, various settings are available to be changed
by the machine administrator. In order to display the Admin Settings screen,
the user must log on using the administrator password.
Administrator
Registration
Administrator
Registration
Extension
No.
E-mail
Address
Auto Reset
Settings
Enable
Auto Reset
Priority Mode
Machine
Settings
Date & Time
Settings
Admin
Settings
Date
(XX.XX.XX)
Sleep Time
Setting
Time
Daylight
Saving Time
List/Counter
Report
Input Tray
Time Zone
Enable
Job Settings
List
Name
Offset3-22 [Admin Settings]
Address
Registration
Address
Book
Address
Book
Fax
E-mail
List Output
Number of
Addresses
List Output
FTP Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
WebDAV Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
Start Number
Number of
Addresses
Start Number
SMB Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
Machine
Settings
Device Name
Address[Admin Settings] 3-23
Program Fax
E-mail
FTP
Group Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
Internet Fax Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output3-24 [Admin Settings]
WebDAV Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
SMB
Address
Book
Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
Group
Address
Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output
Internet Fax Start Number
Number of
Addresses
List Output[Admin Settings] 3-25
Ethernet TCP/IP Enable
BOOTP
ARP/PING
HTTP
FTP
IP Address
Subnet Mask
Gateway
DHCP
Telnet
Bonjour
Dynamic
DNS
RAW Port Enable
Bidirectional
IPP
Authentication Setting
Logout
Confirmation
Display
User List Display Setting
Card Authentication3-26 [Admin Settings]
SNMP
IPv6
WSD Print
IPSec
IP Address
Filter
Netware
AppleTalk
Network
Speed
Binary
Division
IEEE802. 1X
Permit
Access
Deny Access
Enable
Auto Setting
Link Local
Global
Address
Gateway
Address
SLP
SMTP[Admin Settings] 3-27
Encryption
Method
Auto. Obtain
Certificates
S/MIME
Enabled
Digital
Signature
S/MIME
Comm.Setting
Print S/MIME
Information
Copy Settings Specify Tray
When APS
OFF
Paper Priority
Job Timeout
External
Memory Print
Print Settings Startup Page
Setting
Auto
Continue
Paper Default
Paper
Paper Size
Custom Size
Paper Type
Measurement
Unit Setting
Width
Length3-28 [Admin Settings]
Hold Job
Timeout
Edge
Enhancement
Color Mode
Brightness
Halftone
Edge
Strength
Economy
Print
PCL Settings
Text Printing
Image
Printing
Text Printing
Graphics
Printing
Image
Printing
Text Printing
Graphics
Printing
Image
Printing
Quality
Settings
Contrast
RGB Source
RGB Intent
RGB Gray
RGB Source
RGB Intent
RGB Gray[Admin Settings] 3-29
Graphics
Printing
RGB Source
RGB Intent
RGB Gray
PS Settings
Graphics
Printing
Text Printing
Image
Printing
RGB Source
RGB Intent
RGB Gray
RGB Source
RGB Intent
RGB Gray
Simulation Simulation
Profile
Sim. Intent
CMYK Gray
RGB Source
RGB Intent
RGB Gray
Destination
Profile
Destination
Profile
Destination
Profile3-30 [Admin Settings]
Gradation
Adjustment
Tone
Calibration
Cyan
Magenta
Yellow
Black
AIDC
Process
CMYK
Density
Highlight
Middle
Shadow
Highlight
Middle
Shadow
Highlight
Middle
Shadow
Highlight
Middle
Shadow[Admin Settings] 3-31
Emulation
PCL
Default
Emulation
CR/LF
Mapping
Line/Page
Wait Timeout
Print PS
Errors
PS Protocol
Auto
Trapping
Color
Separation
PS
Black
Overprint
Font Setting Font Number
Pitch Size
Symbol Set
XPS Digital
Signature
Print XPS
Errors
Fax Settings Sender
Settings
Sender
Sender Fax
No.3-32 [Admin Settings]
Header/
Footer
Settings
Header
Position
Fax TX
Header
Name
Footer
Position
Comm.
Settings
PB/DP
RX Mode
Number of
RX Call
Rings
Redial
Redial
Interval
Line Monitor
Line Monitor
Volume
Ring Pattern
Manual RX
V.34 OFF[Admin Settings] 3-33
Fax Function
Settings
Function
Settings
Inch Paper
Priority
Paper Priority
Print Paper
Size
Tray
Selection for
RX Print
Min.
Reduction for
RX Print
Print
Separate Fax
Pages
Duplex
Print(RX)
F-Code TX
Dest. Check
Display Func.
Confirm Addr
(TX)
Confirm Addr
(Register)
Restrict Fax
TX
Restrict Fax
RX
Restrict
PC-Fax TX
Memory RX Memory RX
Password
Restrict
Internet Fax
RX
Restrict
Internet Fax
TX3-34 [Admin Settings]
Closed Network RX
Password
Enable
Password
Forward TX
Settings
Forward TX
Setting
Forwarding
Address
Forward &
Print
Remote RX
Settings
Remote RX
Enabled
Remote RX
No.
PC-Fax RX
Settings
PC-Fax RX
Setting
PC-Fax RX
Print
PBX
Connection
Settings
PBX
Function
PBX Number
Nighttime RX
Settings
Night Fax RX
Print
Night RX
Start Time
Night RX End
Time
Fax Report Activity
Report
TX Result
Report
TX Result
Report Image
Output
Settings
Output Time
Setting
Output Limit
Setting[Admin Settings] 3-35
List Print Fax Setup Pg
Broadcast
Result
Report
TX Result
Report
Screen
PC-Fax TX
Error Report
Broadcast
Report
TX Reserve
Fax Target
Fax Factory
Default
Fax Image
initialized
Maintenance
Menu
Event Log
Halftone 64 Cyan 64
Magenta 64
Yellow 64
Black 64
Halftone 128 Cyan 128
Magenta 128
Yellow 128
Black 128
I-Fax RX
Error Report
Print Menu3-36 [Admin Settings]
Halftone 256 Cyan 256
Magenta 256
Yellow 256
Black 256
Gradation
Activity
Report
Scan Send
Report Print
Scan Event
Log
Printer
Adjustment
Leading
Edge
Adjustment
Plain Paper
Thick 1
Thick 2
Envelope
Side Edge
Adjustment
Tray 1
Tray 2
Tray 3
Tray 4[Admin Settings] 3-37
Left ADJ
Duplex
Tray 1
Tray 2
Tray 3
Tray 4
2nd Image
Transfer
Current
Simplex Pass Plain Paper
Thick 1
Thick 2
Postcard
Envelope
Label
Glossy 1
Glossy 2
Manual
Duplex
Plain Paper
Thick 1
Thick 2
Postcard
Envelope
Label3-38 [Admin Settings]
Thick Paper
Image
Density
Cyan
Magenta
Yellow
Black
Monochrome
Density Adj.
Engine
DipSW 1
Engine
DipSW 2
Engine
DipSW 3
Engine
DipSW 26
Glossy 1
Glossy 2
Fine Line
ADJ
AIDC Mode
Thick Mode
Engine
DipSW
Engine
DipSW 27
Engine
DipSW 28
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~[Admin Settings] 3-39
Yellow
Magenta
Main Scan
Page
Scan Adjust
Value
Main Scan
Adjust
Cyan
Folder
Settings
Auto Del
Interval
Auto
Document
Delete Time
Security
Settings
Administrator
Password
Security
Details
Password
Rules
Tranfer Belt
Unit
Transfer
Roller Unit
Consumables
Replace
Supplies
Fusing Unit
Document
Hold Setting
Registering
and Changing Addr.
Manual Destination lnput
Hide Personal
Data
Disable Job
History
Display
Restrict Scan
to USB3-40 [Admin Settings]
Restore
Defaults
Restore
NetWork
Restore
System
Mode
Check HDD
Capacity
HDD Settings
Execute
Restore All
Enhanced
Security
Mode
Overwrite All
Data
SSD
Low-level
Format
HDD Format User Area
(Print)
User Area
(Scan)
All
Paper Empty Tray 1
Tray 2
Tray 3
Tray 4
Restriction
Code Settings
Erase Job Log[Admin Settings] 3-41
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Admin Settings].
3 Type in the administrator password (default:12345678).
" If the administrator password (default:12345678) is incorrectly
entered three times, machine operations are locked. If this occurs,
turn the machine off, then on again.
4 Press [OK].
[Machine Settings]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
Item Description
[Sleep Time Setting] Settings [5 min.] / [6 min.] / [7 min.] / [8 min.]
/ [9 min.] / [10 min.] / [11 min.] / [12
min.] / [13 min.] / [14 min.] / [15
min.] / [30 min.] / [1 Hour] / [3
Hours]
Specify the length of time until the machine
enters Power Save mode.
[Date & Time Settings] Specify the date, time and time zone.
[Date (XX.XX.XX)] Specify the current date.
"The default setting is set in the order
month, day, then year (MM.DD.YY) for
120V model, month, then year
(DD.MM.YY) for 220V model (Europe),
and year, month, then day (YY.MM.DD)
for 220V model (Asia and China).
[Time] Specify the current time.
[Time Zone] Settings -12:00 to +13:00 (Default: 00:00)
The time zone can be set between -12:00 and
+13:00 (in 30-minute increments).3-42 [Admin Settings]
[Daylight Saving Time] Specify settings for daylight saving time.
[Enable] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the machine’s internal
clock observes daylight saving time.
If [ON] is selected, the specified time offset
from the current time appears.
[Offset] Settings 1 to 150 (Default: 60)
Specify the length of time applied for daylight
saving time between 1 and 150 minutes (in
1-minute increments).
[List/Counter] The machine settings can be printed.
[Job Settings List] Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
Prints the list of machine settings.
[Report Input Tray] Settings [Tray 1] / [Tray 2] / [Tray 3] / [Tray
4]
Select the paper tray loaded with the paper
used to print reports.
[Auto Reset Settings] Specify settings to automatically reset copy
settings after the specified time period has
lapsed.
[Enable] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to reset after the specified time period has lapsed.
[Auto Reset] Settings 1 to 9 (Default: 1)
Specify the time required to reset.
[Priority Mode] Settings [Home] / [Copy] / [E-mail] / [Folder]
/ [Fax]
Select the function to be displayed on the
screen after resetting.[Admin Settings] 3-43
[Administrator Registration]
[Address Registration]
Item Description
[Administrator Registration] Specify administrator information.
[Name] Specify the name of the administrator.
[Extension No.] Specify the extension number for the administrator.
[E-mail Address] Specify the E-mail address for the administrator.
"This is the From address for E-mail
messages sent from this machine and
the address where machine status
notifications will be sent.
[Machine Settings] Specify machine information.
[Device Name] Specify the name of the machine.
The name specified for [Device Name] will be
used as the file name for scan data.
[Address] Specify the E-mail address for the machine.
Item Description
[Address Book] The destination lists for [Address Book],
[Group] and [Program] can be printed or
viewed.
[Address Book] Specify settings for printing the list of address
book destinations.
[Fax]/[E-mail]/[FTP]/
[WebDAV]/[SMB]/
[Internet Fax]
[Start Number]: Specify the starting address
book destination number.
[Number of Addresses]: Specify the number of
address book destinations.
[List Output]: Prints the list of address book
destinations.3-44 [Admin Settings]
[Authentication Setting]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
[Group] Specify settings for printing the list of group
destinations.
[Start Number]: Specify the starting group destination number.
[Number of Addresses]: Specify the number of
group destinations.
[List Output]: Prints the list of group destinations.
[Program] Specify settings for printing the list of program
destinations.
[Fax]/[E-mail]/[FTP]/
[WebDAV]/[SMB]/
[Internet Fax]/
[Address Book]/
[Group Address]
[Start Number]: Specify the starting program
destination number.
[Number of Addresses]: Specify the number of
program destinations.
[List Output]: Prints the list of program destinations.
Item Description
[User List Display Setting] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to display a user list.
[Logout Confirmation
Display]
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a logoff confirmation
message appears after the [Access] key is
pressed.
[Card Authentication] Displayed only when the authentication device
is connected, and used to register IC card
information for the user.
For details, refer to “Authentication device (IC
card type)” on page 15-1.[Admin Settings] 3-45
[Ethernet]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
Item Description
[TCP/IP] Specify network settings for the machine.
[Enable] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select the setting for connecting to this
machine through a network.
"If [OFF] is selected, the TCP/IP
parameters do not appear.
[IP Address] Settings [0.0.0.0]
Specify the IP address used by this machine on
the network.
[Subnet Mask] Settings [0.0.0.0]
Specify the subnet mask.
[Gateway] Settings [0.0.0.0]
Specify the gateway address.
[DHCP] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
If there is a DHCP server on the network, specify whether the IP address and other network
information are automatically assigned by the
DHCP server.
[BOOTP] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
If there is a BOOTP server on the network,
specify whether the IP address and other network information are automatically assigned by
the BOOTP server.
[ARP/PING] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the ARP/PING command
is used when the IP address is assigned.
[HTTP] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable HTTP.
[FTP] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable the FTP server.3-46 [Admin Settings]
[Telnet] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable Telnet transmissions.
[Bonjour] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable Bonjour.
[Dynamic DNS] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable Dynamic DNS.
[IPP] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable IPP.
[RAW Port] Specify the RAW port settings.
[Enable] Settings [Yes] / [No]
Select whether or not to enable the RAW port.
[Bidirectional] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to enable RAW port bidirectional communication.
[SLP] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable SLP.
[SMTP] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable E-mail transmission operations for this machine.
[SNMP] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable SNMP.
[WSD Print] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable WSD printing.
[IPSec] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable IPsec.
[IP Address Filter] Specify IP address filtering settings.
[Permit Access] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Specify access permissions for IP address filtering.
[Deny Access] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Specify access blocking for IP address filtering.[Admin Settings] 3-47
[IPv6] Specify IPv6 settings.
[Enable] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to enable IPv6.
[Auto Setting] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable the IPv6 auto
setting.
[Link Local] Displays the link-local address.
[Global Address] Displays the global address.
[Gateway Address] Displays the gateway address.
[Netware] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable NetWare.
[AppleTalk] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable AppleTalk.
[Network Speed] Settings [Auto] / [10 Mbps Full Duplex] / [10
Mbps Half Duplex] / [100 Mbps Full
Duplex] / [100 Mbps Half Duplex] /
[1 Gbps Full Duplex]
Specifies the transmission speed for the network and the transmission method for bidirectional transmission.
[IEEE802.1X] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable IEEE802.1X.
[Binary Division] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not transmission data is
divided.
[S/MIME Comm.Setting] Specify S/MIME communication settings.
[S/MIME Enabled] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable S/MIME.
[Digital Signature] Settings [Always add signature] / [Do not
add signature] / [Select when
sending]
Select the setting for digital signatures.
[Encryption Method] Settings [RC2-40] / [RC2-64] / [RC2-128] /
[DES] / [3DES] / [AES-128] /
[AES-192] / [AES-256]
Select the encryption method for the body of
E-mail messages.3-48 [Admin Settings]
[External Memory Print]
[Job Timeout]
[Copy Settings]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
[Auto. Obtain Certificates]
Settings [Yes] / [No]
Select whether or not to automatically obtain
certificates.
[Print S/MIME Information]
Settings [Yes] / [No]
Select whether or not to print S/MIME information.
Description
Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable the External Memory Print
function.
Description
Settings 5 to 300(Default:15)
Specify the length of time until a job timeout occurs.
Item Description
[Specify Tray When APS
OFF]
Settings [Tray Before APS ON] / [Default
Tray]
Select which paper tray is selected when the
automatic tray-switching feature (APS) is disabled.
[Paper Priority] Settings [Tray 1] / [Tray 2] / [Tray 3] / [Tray
4]
Specify the paper tray that is normally used.
"[Tray3] and [Tray4] do not appear if the
optional lower feeder units have not
been installed.[Admin Settings] 3-49
[Print Settings]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
Item Description
[Startup Page Setting] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a startup page is printed
when the machine is turned on.
[Auto Continue] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not printing continues when
a size error occurs during printing.3-50 [Admin Settings]
[Paper] Specify settings for the paper used for printing.
[Default Paper] Specify settings for the paper that is normally
used.
[Paper Size] Settings [Letter] / [Legal] / [Executive] / [A4]
/ [A5] / [A6] / [B5 (JIS)] / [B6] / [Govt
Letter] / [Statement] / [Folio] / [SP
Folio] / [UK Quarto] / [Foolscap] /
[Govt Legal] / [16K] / [4×6] / [Kai 16]
/ [Kai 32] / [Env C6] / [Env DL] /
[Env Monarch] / [Env Chou#3] /
[Env Chou#4] / [B5 (ISO)] /
[Env#10] / [J Postcard] / [J Postcard-D] / [8 1/8×13 1/4] / [8 1/2×13
1/2] / [Custom Size]
Select the paper size.
"The default setting is [Letter] for USA
and Canada, and [A4] for other
countries.
"Depending on the setting selected for
[User Settings] - [Machine Settings] -
[Measurement Unit Setting], 4 × 6 may
change to 10 × 15 cm.
[Custom Size] Press [Width] and [Length], and then type in
the paper size.
Setting range for Width
For inches: 3.63 to 8.50 inches
For millimeters: 92 to 216 mm
Setting range for Length
For inches: 5.83 to 14.00 inches
For millimeters: 148 to 256 mm
"These settings can be specified if [Paper
Size] is set to [Custom Size].
[Paper Type] Settings [Plain Paper] / [Recycled] / [Thick
1] / [Thick 2] / [Label] / [Envelope] /
[Postcard] / [Letterhead] / [Glossy
1] / [Glossy 2] / [1 Side Only] / [Special Paper]
Select the paper type.[Admin Settings] 3-51
[Measurement Unit Setting]
Settings [Inch] / [mm]
Select the measurement units.
[Hold Job Timeout] Settings [Disable] / [1 Hour] / [4 Hours] / [1
Day] / [1 Week]
Specify the length of time until print jobs saved
on the hard disk are deleted. If [Disable] is
selected, print jobs are not deleted at a specific
time.
[Quality Settings] Specify settings for the print quality.
[Color Mode] Settings [Color Mode] / [Gray Scale]
[Color Mode]: The pages are printed in full
color.
[Gray Scale]: The pages are printed in black
and white.
[Brightness] Settings -15 to 15% (Default: 0%)
The brightness of the printed image can be
adjusted.
[Halftone] Select how halftones in images, text and
graphics are reproduced.
[Image Printing] Settings [Line Art] / [Detail] / [Smooth]
Select how halftones in images are reproduced.
[Line Art]: Halftones are reproduced with high
precision.
[Detail]: Halftones are reproduced with detail.
[Smooth]: Halftones are reproduced with
smoothness.
[Text Printing] Settings [Line Art] / [Detail] / [Smooth]
Select how halftones in text are reproduced.
[Line Art]: Halftones are reproduced with high
precision.
[Detail]: Halftones are reproduced with detail.
[Smooth]: Halftones are reproduced with
smoothness.3-52 [Admin Settings]
[Graphics Printing] Settings [Line Art] / [Detail] / [Smooth]
Select how halftones in graphics are reproduced.
[Line Art]: Halftones are reproduced with high
precision.
[Detail]: Halftones are reproduced with detail.
[Smooth]: Halftones are reproduced with
smoothness.
[Edge Enhancement] Select how edges in images, text and graphics
are emphasized.
[Image Printing] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether image edges are emphasized.
[ON]: The edges are emphasized.
[OFF]: The edges are not emphasized.
[Text Printing] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether text edges are emphasized.
[ON]: The edges are emphasized.
[OFF]: The edges are not emphasized.
[Graphics Printing] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether graphics edges are emphasized.
[ON]: The edges are emphasized.
[OFF]: The edges are not emphasized.
[Edge Strength] Settings [OFF] / [Low] / [Middle] / [High]
Select the desired amount that edges are
emphasized.
[OFF]: The edges are not emphasized.
[Low]: The edges are slightly emphasized.
[Middle]: The edges are emphasized by an
average amount.
[High]: The edges are highly emphasized.[Admin Settings] 3-53
[Economy Print] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether to print graphics with a reduced
density by reducing the amount of toner that is
used.
[ON]: The amount of toner used is reduced
when printing.
[OFF]: The amount of toner used is not
reduced when printing.
[PCL Settings] Specify settings for PCL printing.
[Contrast] Settings -15 to 15%(Default: 0%)
The contrast of the image can be adjusted.
[Image Printing] Specify settings for RGB image data.
[RGB Source] Settings [Device Color] / [sRGB]
Select the color space for RGB image data.
If [Device Color] is selected, no color space is
specified.
RGB source profiles downloaded with Download Manager or PageScope Web Connection
are available as RGB Source.
[RGB Intent] Settings [Vivid] / [Photographic]
Select the characteristic applied when converting RGB image data to CMYK data.
[Vivid]: A vivid output is produced.
[Photographic]: A brighter output is produced.
[RGB Gray] Settings [Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK] / [Bk=K
Gray=K] / [Bk=K Gray=CMYK]
Select how black and grays are reproduced in
RGB image data.
[Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced
using the CMYK colors.
[Bk=K Gray=K]: Black and gray are reproduced
using black only.
[Bk=K Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced using
only black.3-54 [Admin Settings]
[Text Printing] Specify settings for RGB text data.
[RGB Source] Settings [Device Color] / [sRGB]
Select the color space for RGB text data.
If [Device Color] is selected, no color space is
specified.
RGB source profiles downloaded with Download Manager or PageScope Web Connection
are available as RGB Source.
[RGB Intent] Settings [Vivid] / [Photographic]
Select the characteristic applied when converting RGB text data to CMYK data.
[Vivid]: A vivid output is produced.
[Photographic]: A brighter output is produced.
[RGB Gray] Settings [Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK] / [Bk=K
Gray=K] / [Bk=K Gray=CMYK]
Select how black and grays are reproduced in
RGB text data.
[Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced
using the CMYK colors.
[Bk=K Gray=K]: Black and gray are reproduced
using black only.
[Bk=K Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced using
only black.
[Graphics Printing] Specify settings for RGB graphics data.
[RGB Source] Settings [Device Color] / [sRGB]
Select the color space for RGB graphics data.
If [Device Color] is selected, no color space is
specified.
RGB source profiles downloaded with Download Manager or PageScope Web Connection
are available as RGB Source.
[RGB Intent] Settings [Vivid] / [Photographic]
Select the characteristic applied when converting RGB graphics data to CMYK data.
[Vivid]: A vivid output is produced.
[Photographic]: A brighter output is produced.[Admin Settings] 3-55
[RGB Gray] Settings [Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK] / [Bk=K
Gray=K] / [Bk=K Gray=CMYK]
Select how black and grays are reproduced in
RGB graphics data.
[Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced
using the CMYK colors.
[Bk=K Gray=K]: Black and gray are reproduced
using black only.
[Bk=K Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced using
only black.
[PS Settings] Specify settings for PostScript printing.
[Image Printing] Specify settings for RGB image data.
[RGB Source] Settings [Device Color] / [sRGB] /
[AppleRGB] / [AdobeRGB1998] /
[ColorMatchRGB] / [BlueAdjustRGB]
Select the color space for RGB image data.
If [Device Color] is selected, no color space is
specified.
RGB source profiles downloaded with Download Manager or PageScope Web Connection
are available as RGB Source.
[RGB Intent] Settings [Vivid] / [Photographic] / [Relative
Color] / [Absolute Color]
Select the characteristic applied when converting RGB image data to CMYK data.
[Vivid]: A vivid output is produced.
[Photographic]: A brighter output is produced.
[Relative Color]: Relative color is applied to the
RGB source profile.
[Absolute Color]: Absolute color is applied to
the RGB source profile.3-56 [Admin Settings]
[RGB Gray] Settings [Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK] / [Bk=K
Gray=K] / [Bk=K Gray=CMYK]
Select how black and grays are reproduced in
RGB image data.
[Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced
using the CMYK colors.
[Bk=K Gray=K]: Black and gray are reproduced
using black only.
[Bk=K Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced using
only black.
[Destination Profile]
Settings [Auto]
Select the destination profile.
[Auto]: A destination profile that the machine
automatically adapts is selected based on a
combination of the specified color matching,
halftones and other profiles.
Destination profiles downloaded with Download Manager or PageScope Web Connection
are available as Destination Profile.
[Text Printing] Specify settings for RGB text data.
[RGB Source] Settings [Device Color] / [sRGB] /
[AppleRGB] / [AdobeRGB1998] /
[ColorMatchRGB] / [BlueAdjustRGB]
Select the color space for RGB text data.
If [Device Color] is selected, no color space is
specified.
RGB source profiles downloaded with Download Manager or PageScope Web Connection
are available as RGB Source.[Admin Settings] 3-57
[RGB Intent] Settings [Vivid] / [Photographic] / [Relative
Color] / [Absolute Color]
Select the characteristic applied when converting RGB text data to CMYK data.
[Vivid]: A vivid output is produced.
[Photographic]: A brighter output is produced.
[Relative Color]: Relative color is applied to the
RGB source profile.
[Absolute Color]: Absolute color is applied to
the RGB source profile.
[RGB Gray] Settings [Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK] / [Bk=K
Gray=K] / [Bk=K Gray=CMYK]
Select how black and grays are reproduced in
RGB text data.
[Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced
using the CMYK colors.
[Bk=K Gray=K]: Black and gray are reproduced
using black only.
[Bk=K Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced using
only black.
[Destination Profile]
Settings [Auto]
Select the destination profile.
[Auto]: A destination profile that the machine
automatically adapts is selected based on a
combination of the specified color matching,
halftones and other profiles.
Destination profiles downloaded with Download Manager or PageScope Web Connection
are available as Destination Profile.3-58 [Admin Settings]
[Graphics Printing] Specify settings for RGB graphics data.
[RGB Source] Settings [Device Color] / [sRGB] /
[AppleRGB] / [AdobeRGB1998] /
[ColorMatchRGB] / [BlueAdjustRGB]
Select the color space for RGB graphics data.
If [Device Color] is selected, no color space is
specified.
RGB source profiles downloaded with Download Manager or PageScope Web Connection
are available as RGB Source.
[RGB Intent] Settings [Vivid] / [Photographic] / [Relative
Color] / [Absolute Color]
Select the characteristic applied when converting RGB graphics data to CMYK data.
[Vivid]: A vivid output is produced.
[Photographic]: A brighter output is produced.
[Relative Color]: Relative color is applied to the
RGB source profile.
[Absolute Color]: Absolute color is applied to
the RGB source profile.
[RGB Gray] Settings [Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK] / [Bk=K
Gray=K] / [Bk=K Gray=CMYK]
Select how black and grays are reproduced in
RGB graphics data.
[Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced
using the CMYK colors.
[Bk=K Gray=K]: Black and gray are reproduced
using black only.
[Bk=K Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced using
only black.[Admin Settings] 3-59
[Destination Profile]
Settings [Auto]
Select the destination profile.
[Auto]: A destination profile that the machine
automatically adapts is selected based on a
combination of the specified color matching,
halftones and other profiles.
Destination profiles downloaded with Download Manager or PageScope Web Connection
are available as Destination Profile.
[Simulation] Specify settings for the simulation profile.
[Simulation Profile]
Settings [NONE] / [SWOP] / [Euroscale] /
[CommercialPress] / [JapanColor] /
[TOYO] / [DIC]
Select the simulation profile.
If [NONE] is selected, no simulation profile is
specified.
Simulation profiles downloaded with Download
Manager or PageScope Web Connection are
available as Simulation Profile.
[Sim. Intent] Settings [Relative Color] / [Absolute Color]
Select the characteristic applied to the simulation profile.
[Relative Color]: Relative color is applied to the
simulation profile.
[Absolute Color]: Absolute color is applied to
the simulation profile.
[CMYK Gray] Settings [Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK] / [Bk=K
Gray=K] / [Bk=K Gray=CMYK]
Select how black and grays are reproduced
using the four CMYK colors.
[Bk=CMYK Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced
using the CMYK colors.
[Bk=K Gray=K]: Black and gray are reproduced
using black only.
[Bk=K Gray=CMYK]: Black is reproduced using
only black.3-60 [Admin Settings]
[Gradation Adjustment] Specify settings for gradation level adjustments.
[Tone Calibration] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
[ON]: Image adjustments are applied.
[OFF]: Image adjustments are not applied.
[AIDC Process] Settings [Execute] / [Cancel]
[Execute]: Image adjustments are performed
immediately.
[Cancel]: Image adjustments are not performed.
"AIDC processing consumes toner.
[CMYK Density] Specify fine adjustment settings for cyan,
magenta, yellow and black.
[Cyan]/
[Magenta]/
[Yellow]/
[Black]
Settings -3 to 3 (Default: 0)
[Highlight]: The density of the highlight color in
images can be adjusted.
[Middle]: The density of the middle color in
images can be adjusted.
[Shadow]: The density of the shadow color in
images can be adjusted.
[Color Separation] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
[ON]: Color separation is performed. The contents of a color page is separated into the color
pages for yellow, magenta, cyan and black,
and each is printed with black gradations as
individual pages. The printing order is yellow,
magenta, cyan, then black.
[OFF]: Color separation is not performed. A
normal color separation is performed.
[Emulation] Specify the processing method for data
received by this machine.
[Default Emulation] Settings [Auto] / [PS] / [PCL]
Select the machine emulation language.
If [Auto] is selected, the machine automatically
selects the machine emulation language from
the data stream.[Admin Settings] 3-61
[PS] Specify settings for PostScript errors and data
transmissions.
[Wait Timeout] Settings 0 to 300 (Default: 0)
Specify the time until an error is determined to
be a PostScript error.
If [0] is selected, no timeout is performed.
[Print PS Errors] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not an error page is printed
when a Postscript error occurs.
[PS Protocol] Settings [Auto] / [Normal] / [Binary]
Select the protocol for data transmissions with
a PostScript data stream.
If [Auto] is selected, the machine automatically
selects an applicable protocol from the data
stream.
[Auto Trapping] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not neighboring colors are
printed superimposed in order to prevent white
space around images.
[Black Overprint] Settings [Text/Graphic] / [Text] / [OFF]
Specify whether black objects are printed
(superimposed) on a neighboring color in order
to prevent white space around black characters
or figures.
If [Text/Graphic] is selected, superimposed
printing is applied to text and graphics.
If [Text] is selected, superimposed printing is
applied to text.
[PCL] Specify settings for the PCL language.
[CR/LF Mapping] Settings [CR = CR LF = LF] / [CR = CRLF
LF = LF] / [CR = CR LF = LFCR] /
[CR = CRLF LF = LFCR]
Select the definitions of the CR/LF codes in the
PCL language.
[Line/Page] Settings 5 to 128 (Default: 60)
Specify the number of lines per page in the
PCL language.3-62 [Admin Settings]
[Font Setting] Specify font settings for the PCL language.
[Font Number] Settings 0 to 102 (Default: 000)
Specify the default font in the PCL language.
The font numbers that appear correspond to
the PCL font list.
For details on printing the font list, refer to
“[Print Settings]” on page 3-17.
[Pitch Size] Settings 0.44 to 99.99 (Default: 10.00)
Specify the font size in the PCL language.
If the setting selected for [Font Number] is for a
bitmap font, [Pitch Size] appears. If the setting
selected for [Font Number] is for an outline
font, [Point Size] appears.
[Symbol Set] Settings [PC8] / [Desktop] / [IOS4] / [ISO6] /
[ISO11] / [ISO15] / [ISO17] /
[ISO21] / [ISO60] / [ISO69] /
[ISOL1] / [ISOL2] / [ISOL5] /
[ISOL6] / [ISOL9] / [Legal] / [Math8]
/ [MCText] / [MSPUBL] / [PC775] /
[PC850] / [PC852] / [PC858] /
[PC8DN] / [PC8TK] / [PC1004] / [Pi
Font] / [PS math] / [PS Text] /
[Roman 8] / [WIN30] / [WIN Balt] /
[WINL1] / [WINL2] / [WINL5] /
[ARABIC8] / [HPWARA] /
[PC864ARA] / [HEBREW7] /
[HEBREW8] / [ISOHEB] /
[PC862HEB] / [ISOCYR] /
[PC866CYR] / [WINCYR] /
[PC866UKR] / [Greek 8] / [WINGRK] / [PC851GRK] / [PC8GRK] /
[ISOGRK]
Specify the symbol set used with the PCL language.[Admin Settings] 3-63
[Fax Settings]
Specify the fax settings. For details on specifying the fax settings, refer to the
[Facsimile User’s Guide].
[Maintenance Menu]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
[XPS] Specify XPS settings.
[Digital Signature] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not to enable XPS digital signatures.
[Enable]: XPS digital signatures are enabled.
[Disable]: XPS digital signatures are disabled.
[Print XPS Errors] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not an error report is printed
after an XPS error has occurred.
[ON]: The error report is printed.
[OFF]: The error report is not printed.
Item Description
[Print Menu] Specify settings for printing event logs and gradations.
[Event Log] Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
Prints the event log.
[Halftone 64] Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
Prints the halftone pattern using a 25% density
for each CMYK color.
[Cyan 64]/
[Magenta 64]/
[Yellow 64]/
[Black 64]
[Halftone 128] Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
Prints the halftone pattern using a 50% density
for each CMYK color.
[Cyan 128]/
[Magenta 128]/
[Yellow 128]/
[Black 128]3-64 [Admin Settings]
[Halftone 256] Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
Prints the halftone pattern using a 100% density for each CMYK color.
[Cyan 256]/
[Magenta 256]/
[Yellow 256]/
[Black 256]
[Gradation] Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
Prints the gradation pattern.
[Activity Report] Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
Prints the communications activity report.
[Scan Send Report
Print]
Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
Prints the scanning operations activity report.
[Scan Event Log] Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
Prints the scanning event log.
[Printer Adjustment] Specify various machine adjustments.
[Leading Edge Adjustment]
Adjust the top margin for various types of
media.
[Plain Paper] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the top margin of plain paper for simplex
(single-sided) printing.
[Thick 1] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the top margin of thick paper for simplex
(single-sided) printing.
[Thick 2] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the top margin of Thick 2 paper for simplex (single-sided) printing.
[Envelope] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the top margin of envelopes for simplex
(single-sided) printing.
[Side Edge Adjustment] Adjust the left margin for media fed from each
paper tray.
[Tray1] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the left margin of media fed from Tray 1
for simplex (single-sided) printing.[Admin Settings] 3-65
[Tray2] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the left margin of media fed from Tray 2
for simplex (single-sided) printing.
[Tray3] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the left margin of media fed from Tray 3
for simplex (single-sided) printing.
[Tray4] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the left margin of media fed from Tray 4
for simplex (single-sided) printing.
[Left ADJ Duplex] Adjust the left margin for media fed from each
paper tray with duplex (double-sided) printing.
[Tray1] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the left margin of media fed from Tray 1
for duplex (double-sided) printing.
[Tray2] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the left margin of media fed from Tray 2
for duplex (double-sided) printing.
[Tray3] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the left margin of media fed from Tray 3
for duplex (double-sided) printing.
[Tray4] Settings -15 to 15
Adjust the left margin of media fed from Tray 4
for duplex (double-sided) printing.
[2nd Image Transfer
Current]
Adjust the 2nd image transfer current.
[Simplex Pass] Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for simplex (single-sided) printing.
[Plain Paper] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for simplex (single-sided) printing of plain
paper.
[Thick 1] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for simplex (single-sided) printing of Thick 1
paper.3-66 [Admin Settings]
[Thick 2] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for simplex (single-sided) printing of Thick 2
paper.
[Postcard] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for simplex (single-sided) printing of postcards.
[Envelope] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for simplex (single-sided) printing of envelopes.
[Label] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for simplex (single-sided) printing of labels.
[Glossy 1] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for simplex (single-sided) printing of Glossy 1
media.
[Glossy 2] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for simplex (single-sided) printing of Glossy 2
media.
[Manual Duplex] Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for duplex (double-sided) printing.
[Plain Paper] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for printing on the back side of plain paper that
has already been printed on.
[Thick 1] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for printing on the back side of Thick 1 paper
that has already been printed on.
[Thick 2] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for printing on the back side of Thick 2 paper
that has already been printed on.[Admin Settings] 3-67
[Postcard] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for printing on the back side of postcards that
has already been printed on.
[Envelope] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for printing on the back side of envelopes that
has already been printed on.
[Label] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for printing on the back side of labels that has
already been printed on.
[Glossy 1] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for printing on the back side of Glossy 1 media
that has already been printed on.
[Glossy 2] Settings -8 to 7
Adjust the 2nd image transfer output (ATVC)
for printing on the back side of Glossy 2 media
that has already been printed on.
[Thick Paper Image
Density]
Adjust the density of images printed on thick
paper.
[Cyan] Settings -5 to 5 (Default: 0)
Finely adjust the density of cyan for images
printed on thick paper.
[Magenta] Settings -5 to 5 (Default: 0)
Finely adjust the density of magenta for images
printed on thick paper.
[Yellow] Settings -5 to 5 (Default: 0)
Finely adjust the density of yellow for images
printed on thick paper.
[Black] Settings -5 to 5 (Default: 0)
Finely adjust the density of black for images
printed on thick paper.
[Monochrome Density
Adj.]
Settings -2 to 2 (Default: 0)
Finely adjust the density of printed images with
grayscale printing.3-68 [Admin Settings]
[Fine Line ADJ] Settings -3 to 2 (Default: 0)
Adjust how fine lines are reproduced by changing the applied voltage (VC) to the electrostatic
roller.
[AIDC Mode] Settings [Mode 1] / [Mode 2]
Select the AIDC operation mode.
[Mode 1]: Standard mode
[Mode 2]: Low mode
[Thick Mode] Settings [Quality Mode] / [Speed Mode]
In order to prevent toner from clogging within
the developer unit as a result of it being driven
at half-speed, select the timing for driving the
developer unit at full speed for a fixed length of
time when thick paper is being fed.
[Quality Mode]: While printing on thick paper,
printing is periodically paused, and the developer unit is driven at full speed for a fixed
length of time. Since printing is paused, the
quality is not affected; however, a standby time
of approximately 70 seconds occurs every 400
seconds or so of half-speed operation.
[Speed Mode]: While printing on thick paper,
only the drive of the developer unit periodically
switches to full speed for a fixed length of time.
Since printing continues during full-speed
drive, the print quality is slightly affected, however the standby time is short.
[Engine DipSW] Change the DIP switches to control machine
operation.
[Engine DipSW 1] -
[Engine DipSW 28]
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Use to change engine settings.
"Normally, there is no need to change the
settings. If it becomes necessary to
change the settings, do so according to
the instructions from the service
representative.[Admin Settings] 3-69
[Folder Settings]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
[Main Scan Adjust] Adjust the scanning settings.
[Main Scan Page] Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
Print the test pattern for fine adjustment of the
color ratios in the main scanning direction.
[Scan Adjust Value] Specify color adjustments for yellow, magenta
and cyan.
[Yellow] Settings -42 to 42 (Default: 0)
Finely adjust the ratio of yellow in the main
scanning direction.
[Magenta] Settings -42 to 42 (Default: 0)
Finely adjust the ratio of magenta in the main
scanning direction.
[Cyan] Settings -42 to 42 (Default: 0)
Finely adjust the ratio of cyan in the main scanning direction.
[Supplies] Reset the service life counters for various consumables.
[Consumables Replace]
[Transfer Belt Unit] Settings [Yes] / [No]
Reset the transfer belt counter.
[Transfer Roller
Unit]
Settings [Yes] / [No]
Reset the transfer roller counter.
[Fusing Unit] Settings [Yes] / [No]
Reset the fuser unit counter.
Item Description
[Auto Del Interval] Settings [Erase Disabled] / [12 Hours] / [1
Day] / [2 Days] / [3 Days] / [7 Days]
/ [30 Days]
Select the length of time until files saved on the
hard disk are automatically deleted.3-70 [Admin Settings]
[Security Settings]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
[Auto Document Delete
Time]
Settings [Erase Disabled] / [12 Hours] / [1
Day] / [2 Days] / [3 Days] / [7 Days]
/ [30 Days]
Select the length of time that files are saved on
the hard disk.
[Document Hold Setting] Settings [Enable] / [Disable]
Select whether or not a file is deleted after it is
retrieved.
Item Description
[Administrator Password] Settings [12345678]
Change the administrator password.
Specify the administrator password as a 0 to 8
digit number.
"If password rules have been applied, an
8-digit password must be specified.
"If the administrator password is
incorrectly entered three times, machine
operations are locked. If this occurs, turn
the machine off, then on again.
[Password] (top): Type in the current password.
[Password] (bottom): Type in the new password.
[Security Details] Specify detailed security settings to limit
machine functions. Security can be enhanced if
machine functions are limited.
[Password Rules] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not password rules are
applied.
[Registering and
Changing Addr.]
Settings [Allow] / [Restrict]
Select whether or not to prohibit editing of the
address book. If [Restrict] is selected, the
address book cannot be edited.[Admin Settings] 3-71
[Manual Destination
Input]
Settings [Allow] / [Restrict]
Select whether or not to prohibit manual input
of a destination. If [Restrict] is selected, destinations for fax and scan operations cannot be
entered directly.
[Hide Personal Data] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to display transmission
destinations in the job log. If [ON] is selected,
transmission destinations are not displayed.
[Disable Job History
Display]
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to display the communication log. If [ON] is selected, the communication log is not displayed.
[Restrict Scan to USB] Settings [Allow] / [Restrict]
Select whether or not to prohibit the Scan to
USB function. If [Restrict] is selected, the Scan
to USB function cannot be used.
[Enhanced Security Mode] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to apply enhanced security settings. If [ON] is selected, the enhanced
security settings are applied.
[HDD Settings] Check the capacity of the hard disk or delete
data by overwriting.
[Check HDD Capacity] Check the total capacity of the hard disk, the
amount of space used and the amount of
space available.
[Overwrite All Data] Delete all data on the hard disk by overwriting
it.3-72 [Admin Settings]
[Mode] Settings [Mode 1] / [Mode 2] / [Mode 3] /
[Mode 4] / [Mode 5] / [Mode 6] /
[Mode 7] / [Mode 8]
Select the method for overwriting the data on
the hard disk.
[Mode 1]: Overwritten with 0x00
[Mode 2]: Overwritten with 1-byte random numbers Overwritten with 1-byte random numbers Overwritten with 0x00
[Mode 3]: Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten
with 0xff Overwritten with 1-byte random
numbers Verified
[Mode 4]: Overwritten with 1-byte random numbers Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten
with 0xff
[Mode 5]: Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten
with 0xff Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten with 0xff
[Mode 6]: Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten
with 0xff Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten with 0xff Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten with 0xff Overwritten with specified
512-byte data
[Mode 7]: Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten
with 0xff Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten with 0xff Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten with 0xff Overwritten with 0xaa
[Mode 8]: Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten
with 0xff Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten with 0xff Overwritten with 0x00 Overwritten with 0xff Overwritten with 0xaa
Verified[Admin Settings] 3-73
[Execute] Press to delete all data on the hard disk by
overwriting it, and then press [OK].
"Perform this operation when disposing
of this machine.
"While the data is being deleted by being
overwritten, do not use the power switch
to turn the machine off and on.
"After the machine is restarted, all data is
deleted by being overwritten.
The following data is deleted.
– Registered user and account data
– Registered information for secured printing and saved files
– Image files
[SSD Low-level Format] Press to delete all data on the SSD by overwriting it, and then press [OK].
"Perform this operation when disposing
of this machine.
"While the data is being deleted by being
overwritten, do not use the power switch
to turn the machine off and on.
"After the machine is restarted, all data is
deleted by being overwritten.
The following data is deleted.
– Sent and received fax data
– Address book (E-mail address and telephone number destination data)
– S/MIME certificates
– Image files3-74 [Admin Settings]
Changing the administrator password
The following procedure describes how to change the administrator password.
1 Press [Administrator Password].
2 Press [Password] (top).
3 Type in the current administrator password, and then press [OK].
4 Press [Password] (bottom).
5 Type in the new administrator password, and then press [OK].
6 Press [OK].
Limitations of the password rules
If password rules have been applied, limitations are placed on certain passwords. Specified passwords must be changed to meet the conditions.
Passwords regulated by the password rules
– Administrator password
– User passwords
– Account passwords
– Passwords for secure documents[Admin Settings] 3-75
Conditions of the password rules
– Specify a password of 8 or more digits.
– Uppercase and lowercase letters are differentiated.
– Half-width symbols are used. The use of symbols such as the quotation mark ("), plus sign (+) and spaces are limited with some settings.
– A password that consists of a repetition of the same character cannot
be specified.
– When changing the password, the same password as that before it is
changed cannot be specified.
Enhanced security settings
If settings have been specified that are incompatible with the enhanced security settings, the enhanced security settings cannot be applied.
The settings that must be specified or are forcibly set cannot be changed
after the enhanced security settings have been applied.
Required settings
The following settings must first be specified in order to apply the enhanced
security settings.
Administrator mode parameters Required settings
[Security Settings] - [Administrator
Password]
Specify a password that meets the
conditions of the password rules.
[Security] tab in PageScope Web
Connection - [Authentication Setting]
- [General Settings] - [User Authentication]
Select [Device] or [External Server].
[Security] tab in PageScope Web
Connection - [PKI Settings] - [Device
Certificate]
Register a self-signed certificate in
order to perform SSL communications.
[Network] tab in PageScope Web
Connection - [SNMP Settings] -
[SNMP v3 Settings] - [auth-password]
Specify passwords for [auth-password] and [priv-password] that meet
the conditions of the password rules.
[SSL] in PageScope Web Connection Select [AES-256] or [AES-256,
3DES-168].
[S/MIME] in PageScope Web Connection
Select [3DES], [AES-128], [AES-192]
or [AES-256].3-76 [Admin Settings]
Changed settings
For increased security, the following settings are set when enhanced security
settings are applied.
" A changed setting cannot be changed when [Enhanced Security
Mode] is set to [OFF].
" If password rules have been applied, a password that does not meet
the conditions of the password rules is considered a failed attempt
during authentication.
*1
Set to [AES/3DES] when [Enhanced Security Mode] is set to [OFF].
Administrator mode parameters Changed settings
[Security Settings] - [Security Details]
- [Password Rules]
Set to [ON].
[Security] tab in PageScope Web
Connection - [Authentication Setting]
- [General Settings] - [Public Access]
Set to [Restrict].
[Security] tab in PageScope Web
Connection - [PKI Settings] - [SSL/
TLS Settings] - [SSL/TLS]
Set to [Enable].
[Security] tab in PageScope Web
Connection - [PKI Settings] - [SSL/
TLS Settings] - [Encryption Strength]
Set to [AES-256] or [AES-256,
3DES-168].
*1
[Network] tab in PageScope Web
Connection - [E-mail Settings] -
[S/MIME] - [E-mail Text Encryption
Method]
Set to [3DES], [AES-128], [AES-192]
or [AES-256].
*1
[Network] tab in PageScope Web
Connection - [FTP Settings] - [FTP
Server Settings] - [FTP Server]
Set to [Disable].
[Network] tab in PageScope Web
Connection - [SNMP Settings] -
[SNMP v1/v2c Settings] - [Write]
Set to [Disable].
[Network] tab in PageScope Web
Connection - [SNMP Settings] -
[SNMP v3 Settings] - [Write User
Name] - [Security Level], [auth-password] and [priv-password]
Set to [Auth-password/Priv-password].
[Security Settings] - [Security Details]
- [Registering and Changing Addr.]
Set to [Restrict].[Admin Settings] 3-77
[Restore Defaults]
[HDD Format]
Item Description
[Restore Network] Resets the network settings to their defaults.
After this is pressed, the printer is automatically
restarted.
[Restore System] Resets the system settings to their defaults.
After this is pressed, the printer is automatically
restarted.
[Restore All] Resets all settings to their defaults. After this is
pressed, the printer is automatically restarted.
Item Description
[User Area (Print)] Initializes the user area (printing) of the hard
disk.
After the reformatting operation is finished, turn
the machine off, then on again.
[User Area (Scan)] Initializes the user area (scanning) of the hard
disk.
After the reformatting operation is finished, turn
the machine off, then on again.
[All] Initializes the hard disk.
After the reformatting operation is finished, turn
the machine off, then on again.3-78 [Admin Settings]
[Paper Empty]
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
[Restriction Code Settings]
[Erase Job Log]
Item Description
[Tray 1] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a message appears
when Tray 1 has run out of paper.
[Tray 2] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a message appears
when Tray 2 has run out of paper.
[Tray 3] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a message appears
when Tray 3 has run out of paper.
[Tray 4] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a message appears
when Tray 4 has run out of paper.
Item Description
Restriction Code Settings Displays the list of inhibited codes of the
OpenAPI connection applications.
[New]: Registers new inhibited codes for the
Index Code, Vendor Code, and Application
Code.
Item Description
Erase Job Log If [OK] is selected, Accounting Log, Counting
Log and Audit Log are deleted.4Media Handling4-2 Print Media
Print Media
Specifications
Media Media Size Tray* Duplex Copy Scan FAX
Inch Millimeter
Letter 8.5 × 11.0 215.9 × 279.4 1/2/3/4 Yes Yes Yes Yes
Letter Plus 8.5 ×
12.69
215.9 × 322.3 1/2 Yes Yes Yes No
Government
letter
8.0 × 10.5 203.2 × 266.7 1/2 Yes Yes Yes No
Legal 8.5 × 14.0 215.9 × 355.6 1/2/3/4 Yes Yes Yes Yes
Executive 7.25 ×
10.5
184.2 × 266.7 1/2/3/4 Yes Yes Yes No
Statement 5.5 × 8.5 139.7 × 215.9 1/2 No Yes Yes No
16 K 7.7 × 10.6 195.0 × 270.0 1/2 Yes Yes Yes No
UK Quarto 8.0 × 10.0 203.2 × 254.0 1/2 Yes Yes Yes No
Foolscap 8.0 × 13.0 203.2 × 330.2 1/2 Yes Yes Yes No
Government Legal 8.5 × 13.0 215.9 × 330.2 1/2/3/4 Yes Yes Yes No
Folio 8.25 ×
13.0
210.0 × 330.0 1/2 Yes Yes Yes No
8 1/2 × 13 1/2 8.5 × 13.5 215.9 × 342.9 1/2 Yes Yes Yes Yes
8 1/8 × 13 1/4 8.125 ×
13.25
206.4 × 336.6 1/2 Yes Yes Yes No
A4 8.2 × 11.7 210.0 × 297.0 1/2/3/4 Yes Yes Yes Yes
A5 5.9 × 8.3 148.0 × 210.0 1/2 No Yes Yes No
B5 (JIS) 7.2 × 10.1 182.0 × 257.0 1/2/3/4 Yes Yes Yes No
A6 4.1 × 5.8 105.0 × 148.0 1/2 No Yes** Yes** No
B6 5.0 × 7.2 128.0 × 182.0 1/2 No Yes** Yes** No
Photo size 4 × 6" 4.0 × 6.0 101.6 × 152.4 1/2 No Yes** Yes** No
Photo size 10 × 15 4.0 × 6.0 101.6 × 152.4 1/2 No Yes** Yes** No
Photo size E size 3.2 × 4.6 82.5 × 117.0 - No Yes** Yes** No
Photo size L size 3.5 × 5.0 89.0 × 127.0 - No Yes** Yes** No
Photo size 9 × 13 3.5 × 5.1 90.0 × 130.0 - No Yes** Yes** No
Photo size 13 × 18 5.1 × 7.1 130.0 × 180.0 - No Yes** Yes** No
Photo size 3 × 5" 3.0 × 5.0 76.2 × 127.0 - No Yes** Yes** No
Photo size
2 1/4 × 3 1/4"
2.25 ×
3.29
57.1 × 82.5 - No Yes** Yes** No
J-Postcard 3.9 × 5.8 100.0 × 148.0 1/2 No Yes** Yes** No
Double Postcard 5.8 × 7.9 148.0 × 200.0 1/2 No Yes Yes No
B5 (ISO) 6.9 × 9.8 176.0 × 250.0 1 No Yes Yes No
Envelope Com10 4.125 ×
9.5
104.8 × 241.3 1 No No No No
Envelope Monarch 7.5 ×
3.875
190.5 × 98.4 1 No No No NoPrint Media 4-3
Envelope You #6 7.5 ×
3.875
190.5 × 98.4 1 No No No No
Envelope DL 8.7 × 4.3 220.0 × 110.0 1 No No No No
Envelope C6 6.4 × 4.5 162.0 × 114.0 1 No No No No
Envelope You #2 6.4 × 4.5 162.0 × 114.0 1 No No No No
Envelope Chou #3 4.7 × 9.2 120.0 × 235.0 1 No No No No
Envelope Chou #4 3.5 × 8.1 90.0 × 205.0 1 No No No No
Kai 16 7.3 × 10.2 185.0 × 260.0 1/2 Yes Yes Yes No
Kai 32 5.1 × 7.3 130.0 × 185.0 1/2 No Yes** Yes** No
Custom,
Minimum
3.6 - 8.5 ×
5.8 - 14.0
92.0 - 216.0 ×
148.0 - 356.0
1/2*** Yes**** Yes Yes Yes
Custom,
Maximum
7.2 - 8.5 ×
10.0 - 14.0
182.0 - 216.0
× 254.0 -
356.0
1/2 Yes No No No
Notes: *Tray 1 = Multipurpose
Tray 3/4 = Plain paper only
**Original glass only
***Numerical value input
****Only a size within the range 182.0 - 216.0 × 254.0 - 356.0 is allowed.
Media Media Size Tray* Duplex Copy Scan FAX
Inch Millimeter4-4 Print Media
Types
" Keep media on a flat, level surface in its original wrapper until it is time
to load it.
" Before printing a large number of copies on special paper (other than
plain paper), perform a trial print to check the quality of the print result.
Plain Paper (Recycled Paper)
Use plain paper that is
Suitable for plain paper printers and copiers, such as standard or recycled
office paper.
DO NOT use media that is
Coated with a processed surface (such as carbon paper and colored
paper that has been treated)
Unapproved iron-on transfer media (such as heat-pressure paper, and
heat-press transfer paper)
Cold-water-transfer paper
Pressure sensitive
Designed specifically for inkjet printers (such as superfine paper, glossy
film, and postcards)
Already been printed on by another printer, copier, or fax machine
Dusty
Wet (or damp)
Capacity Tray 1 Up to 100 sheets, depending on the media
weight
Tray 2 Up to 250 sheets, depending on the media
weight
Tray 3/4 Up to 500 sheets, depending on the media
weight
Orientation Tray 1 Face down
Tray 2/3/4 Face up
Driver
Media Type
Plain Paper (Recycled)
Weight 60 to 90 g/m²
Duplexing Refer to “Specifications” on page 4-2.Print Media 4-5
" Keep media between 15% and 85% relative humidity. Toner does
not adhere well to moist or wet media.
Layered
Adhesive
Folded, creased, curled, embossed, warped, or wrinkled
Perforated, three-hole punched, or torn
Too slick, too coarse, or too textured
Different in texture (roughness) on the front and back
Too thin or too thick
Stuck together with static electricity
Composed of foil or gilt; too luminous
Heat sensitive or cannot withstand the fusing temperature (180°C
[356°F])
Irregularly shaped (not rectangular or not cut at right angles)
Attached with glue, tape, paper clips, staples, ribbons, hooks, or buttons
Acidic
Any other media that is not approved
Thick Stock
Paper thicker than 90 g/m2
(24 lb bond) is referred to as thick stock.
You can print continuously with thick stock. However, this could affect the
media feed, depending on the media quality and printing environment. If
problems occur, stop the continuous printing and print one sheet at a time.
Capacity Tray 1/2 Up to 20 sheets, depending on their thickness
Tray 3/4 Not supported
Orientation Tray 1 Face down
Tray 2 Face up
Driver
Media Type
Thick 1 (91–150 g/m²)
Thick 2 (151–210 g/m²)
Weight 91 to 210 g/m²
Duplexing Refer to “Specifications” on page 4-2.4-6 Print Media
Envelope
Print on the front (address) side only. Some parts of the envelope consist of
three layers of paper—the front, back, and flap. Anything printed in these layered regions may be lost or faded.
You can print continuously with envelope. However, this could affect the
media feed, depending on the media quality and printing environment. If
problems occur, stop the continuous printing and print one sheet at a time.
Use envelopes that are
Common office envelopes approved for laser printing with diagonal joints,
sharp folds and edges, and ordinary gummed flaps
" Because the envelopes pass through heated rollers, the gummed
area on the flaps may seal. Using envelopes with emulsion-based
glue avoids this problem.
Approved for laser printing
Dry
DO NOT use envelopes that have
Sticky flaps
Tape seals, metal clasps, paper clips, fasteners, or peel-off strips for sealing
Transparent windows
Too rough of a surface
Material that will melt, vaporize, offset, discolor, or emit dangerous fumes
Been presealed
Capacity Tray 1 Up to 10 sheets, depending on their thickness
Tray 2/3/4 Not supported
Orientation Face down
Driver
Media Type
Envelope
Duplexing Not supportedPrint Media 4-7
Label
A sheet of labels consists of a face sheet (the printing surface), adhesive, and
a carrier sheet:
The face sheet must follow the plain paper specification.
The face sheet surface must cover the entire carrier sheet, and no adhesive should come through on the surface.
You can print continuously with label sheets. However, this could affect the
media feed, depending on the media quality and printing environment. If
problems occur, stop the continuous printing and print one sheet at a time.
Check your application documentation for more information on printing labels.
Use label sheets that are
Recommended for laser printing
DO NOT use label sheets that
Have labels that easily peel off or have parts of the label already removed
Have backing sheets that have peeled away or have exposed adhesive
" Labels may stick to the fuser, causing them to peel off and media
misfeeds to occur.
Capacity Tray 1/2 Up to 20 sheets, depending on their thickness
Tray 3/4 Not supported
Orientation Tray 1 Face down
Tray 2 Face up
Driver
Media Type
Label
Duplexing Not supported4-8 Print Media
Are precut or perforated
Letterhead
You can print continuously with letterhead. However, this could affect the
media feed, depending on the media quality and printing environment. If
problems occur, stop the continuous printing and print one sheet at a time.
Check your application documentation for more information on printing
letterhead.
Postcard
You can print continuously with postcard. However, this could affect the
media feed, depending on the media quality and printing environment. If
problems occur, stop the continuous printing and print one sheet at a time.
Check your application documentation for more information on printing postcards.
Capacity Tray 1/2 Up to 20 sheets, depending on their size and
thickness
Tray 3/4 Not supported
Orientation Tray 1 Face down
Tray 2 Face up
Driver
Media Type
Letterhead
Duplexing Not supported
Capacity Tray 1/2 Up to 20 sheets, depending on their thickness
Tray 3/4 Not supported
Do not use OK to use
Shiny backed paper Full-page labels
(uncut)Print Media 4-9
Use postcards that are
Approved for laser printing
DO NOT use postcards that are
Coated
Designed for inkjet printers
Precut or perforated
Preprinted or multicolored
" If the postcard is warped, press on the warped
area before putting it in the tray 1/2.
Folded or wrinkled
Glossy Media
You can print continuously with glossy media. However, this could affect the
media feed, depending on the media quality and printing environment. If
problems occur, stop the continuous printing and print one sheet at a time.
Check your application documentation for more information on printing
glossy media.
Orientation Tray 1 Face down
Tray 2 Face up
Driver
Media Type
Postcard
Duplexing Not supported
Capacity Tray 1/2 Up to 20 sheets, depending on their thickness
Tray 3/4 Not supported4-10 Print Media
Single Side Only
Print on the single side only.
You can print continuously with single side only paper. However, this could
affect the media feed, depending on the media quality and printing environment. If problems occur, stop the continuous printing and print one sheet at a
time.
Select this setting when paper that should not be used with double sided
copying (for example, when on side has already been printed on) is loaded as
plain paper with a weight of 60–90 g/m².
Use single side only paper that is
Suitable for plain paper laser printers, such as standard or recycled office
paper
Plain paper that has been printed on with same printer
DO NOT use single side only paper that is
Not approved for use as plain paper
Orientation Tray 1 Face down
Tray 2 Face up
Driver
Media Type
Glossy 1 (100–128 g/m2
)
Glossy 2 (129–158 g/m2
)
Weight 100 to 158 g/m2
Duplexing Not supported
Capacity Tray 1 Up to 100 sheets, depending on the paper
weight.
Tray 2 Up to 250 sheets, depending on the paper
weight.
Tray 3/4 Up to 500 sheets, depending on the paper
weight.
Orientation Tray 1 Face down
Tray 2/3/4 Face up
Driver
Media Type
Single Side Only (60–90 g/m²)
Weight 60–90 g/m²
Duplexing Not supportedPrint Media 4-11
Special Paper
You can print continuously with special paper. However, this could affect the
media feed, depending on the media quality and printing environment. If
problems occur, stop the continuous printing and print one sheet at a time.
Select this setting when special paper, for example, color high-quality paper
(color paper), is loaded as plain paper with a weight of 60–90 g/m².
Use special paper that is
Approved for laser printers
DO NOT use special paper that is
Not approved for use as plain paper
Capacity Tray 1 Up to 100 sheets, depending on the paper
weight.
Tray 2 Up to 250 sheets, depending on the paper
weight.
Tray 3/4 Up to 500 sheets, depending on the paper
weight.
Orientation Tray 1 Face down
Tray 2/3/4 Face up
Driver
Media Type
Special Paper (60–90 g/m2
)
Weight 60–90 g/m²
Duplexing Refer to “Specifications” on page 4-2.4-12 Print Media
Printable Area
The printable area on all media sizes is
up to 4.2 mm (0.165") from the edges
of the media.
Each media size has a specific imageable area, the maximum area on which
the printer can print clearly and without
distortion.
This area is subject to both hardware
limits (the physical media size and the
margins required by the printer) and
software constraints (the amount of
memory available for the full-page frame buffer). The guaranteed imageable
(printable) area for all media sizes is the page size minus 4.2 mm (0.165")
from all edges of the media.
" When printing in color on legal-size media, the following limitations
apply.
z The printable area is 347.2 (13.7") mm from the leading edge of
the paper. (However, there is a non-printable area up to 4.2 mm
(0.165") from the leading edge.)
z The bottom margin is 14.2 mm (0.56").
a a
a
a
Printable
Area
a = 4.2 mm (0.165")Print Media 4-13
Envelopes
Envelopes can only be printed on their front sides (side where the recipient’s
address is written). In addition, printing on the front side in the area overlapping the back flap cannot be guaranteed. The location of this area differs
depending on the envelope type.
" The envelope print orientation is determined by your application.
Page Margins
Margins are set through your application. Some applications allow you to set
custom page sizes and margins while others have only standard page sizes
and margins from which to choose. If you choose a standard format, you may
lose part of your image (due to imageable area constraints). If you can custom-size your page in your application, use those sizes given for the imageable area for optimum results.
a=4.2 mm (0.165")
Non-printable area
Non-guaranteed printable area
Guaranteed printable area
Front side
(can be printed)
Back side
(cannot be printed)
a a
a
a4-14 Loading Media
Loading Media
How do I load media?
Note
Do not mix media of different types and sizes, as this will cause media
misfeeds or machine trouble.
Note
Paper edges are sharp and may cause injuries.
When refilling media, first remove any media remaining in the tray. Stack it
with the new media, even the edges, then reload it.
Tray 1 (Manual Feed Tray)
For details on the types and sizes of media that can be printed from Tray 1,
refer to “Specifications” on page 4-2.
Loading Plain Paper, Single Side Only and Special Paper
1 Open Tray 1.Loading Media 4-15
2 Slide the media guides to provide more space between them.
3 Press down on the center of the
paper-lifting plate until the left
and right locking tabs (white)
lock into place.
4 Load the paper face down in the
tray.4-16 Loading Media
" Do not load so much
paper that the top of the
stack is higher than the
maximum limit guide. Up
to 100 sheets (80 g/m2
) of
plain paper can be
loaded into the tray at
one time.
5 Slide the media guides against
the edges of the paper.
6 Select [Copy]/[Paper]/[Tray 1]/[Change Tray Set]/[Paper Size] and [Paper
Type] in the configuration menu, and then select the setting for the size
and type of paper that are loaded. See also “[Paper]” on page 7-5.
Other Media
When loading media other than plain paper, set the media mode (Envelope,
Label, Letterhead, Thick 1, Thick 2, Glossy 1, Glossy 2, or Postcards) in the
driver for optimum print quality.Loading Media 4-17
Loading Envelopes
1 Open Tray 1.
2 Slide the media guides to provide more space between them.
3 Press down on the center of the
paper-lifting plate until the left
and right locking tabs (white)
lock into place.4-18 Loading Media
4 Load the envelopes flap side up
in the tray.
" Before loading envelopes, press them down
to make sure that all air is
removed, and make sure
that the folds of the flaps
are firmly pressed; otherwise the envelopes may
become wrinkled or a
media misfeed may
occur.
" Up to 10 envelopes can be loaded into the tray at one time.
" For envelopes with the
flap along the long edge
(Envelope C6, Envelope
Monarch, Envelope You
#6, Envelope You #2,
and Envelope DL), load
the envelopes with the
flap side up.
5 Slide the media guides against
the edges of the envelopes.Loading Media 4-19
6 Select [Copy]/[Paper]/[Tray 1]/[Change Tray Set]/[Paper Size] and [Paper
Type] in the configuration menu, and then select the setting for the size
and type of paper that are loaded. See also.
Loading Label Sheets/Letterhead/Postcards/Thick Stock
and Glossy Media
1 Open Tray 1.
2 Slide the media guides to provide more space between them.4-20 Loading Media
3 Press down on the center of the
paper-lifting plate until the left
and right locking tabs (white)
lock into place.
4 Load the media face down in the
tray.
" Up to 20 sheets can be
loaded into the tray at
one time.
5 Slide the media guides against
the edges of the media.
6 Select [Copy]/[Paper]/[Tray 1]/[Change Tray Set]/[Paper Size] and [Paper
Type] in the configuration menu, and then select the setting for the size
and type of paper that are loaded. See also “[Paper]” on page 7-5.Loading Media 4-21
Tray 2
Loading Plain Paper, Single Side Only and Special Paper
1 Pull out Tray 2.
2 Press down the media pressure
plate to lock it into place.
3 Slide the media guides to provide more space between them.4-22 Loading Media
4 Turn the paper selection dial to
select the size of paper to be
loaded.
5 Load the paper face up in the
tray.
" Do not load above the ▼
mark. Up to 250 sheets
(80 g/m2
) of plain paper
can be loaded into the
tray at one time.Loading Media 4-23
6 Slide the media guides against
the edges of the paper.
7 Close Tray 2.
8 Select [Copy]/[Paper]/[Tray 2]/[Change Tray Set]/[Paper Size] and [Paper
Type] in the configuration menu, and then select the setting for the size
and type of paper that are loaded. See also “[Paper]” on page 7-5.4-24 Loading Media
Loading Label Sheets/Letterhead/Postcards/Thick Stock
and Glossy Media
1 Pull out Tray 2.
2 Press down the media pressure
plate to lock it into place.
3 Slide the media guides to provide more space between them.Loading Media 4-25
4 Turn the paper selection dial to
select the size of paper to be
loaded.
5 Load the paper face up in the
tray.
" Up to 20 sheets can be
loaded into the tray at
one time.4-26 Loading Media
6 Slide the media guides against
the edges of the paper.
7 Close Tray 2.
8 Select [Copy]/[Paper]/[Tray 2]/[Change Tray Set]/[Paper Size] and [Paper
Type] in the configuration menu, and then select the setting for the size
and type of paper that are loaded. See also “[Paper]” on page 7-5.Loading Media 4-27
Tray 3/4 (Optional Lower Feeder Unit)
Loading Plain Paper, Single Side Only and Special Paper
1 Pull out Tray 3 or Tray 4.
2 Press down the media pressure
plate to lock it into place.
3 Slide the media guides to provide more space between them.4-28 Loading Media
4 Load the paper face up in the
tray.
" Do not load above the ▼
mark. Up to 500 sheets
(80 g/m2
) of plain paper
can be loaded into the
tray at one time.
5 Slide the media guides against
the edges of the paper.Loading Media 4-29
6 Close Tray 3 or Tray 4.
7 Select [Copy]/[Paper]/[Tray 3]/[Change Tray Set]/[Paper Size] and [Paper
Type] in the configuration menu, and then select the setting for the size
and type of paper that are loaded. See also “[Paper]” on page 7-5.4-30 About Duplex Printing
About Duplex Printing
Duplex (double-sided) printing can be done with this printer, which has the
duplex unit built in as a standard. If the paper has low opacity (high translucency), then the printed data from one side of the page will show through to
the other side. Check your application for margin information. For best
results, print a small quantity to make sure the opacity is acceptable.
Note
Only plain paper, special paper and thick stock, 60–210 g/m2
can be
autoduplexed. See “Types” on page 4-4.
Duplexing envelopes, labels, letterheads, postcards, glossy media or
single side only papers is not supported.
How do I autoduplex?
Check your application to determine how to set your margins for duplex
(double-sided) printing.
The following Binding Position settings are available.
If [Long Edge (Left)] is selected, the pages will be laid out to
flip at the left.
If [Long Edge (Right)] is selected, the pages will be laid out
to flip at the right.
If [Short Edge (Top)] is selected, the pages will be laid out
to flip at the top.
1
1
1
2
3
1
1
1
2
3
1
3
1
2
1About Duplex Printing 4-31
In addition, if [Booklet] is selected, autoduplex printing is performed.
The following Order settings are available when [Booklet] is selected.
1 Load paper into the tray.
2 From the printer driver, specify duplex (double-sided) printing (Layout tab
in Windows).
3 Click [OK].
" With autoduplexing, the back side is printed first, and then the front
side is printed.
If [Long Edge (Bottom)] is selected, the pages will be laid
out to flip at the bottom.
If [Left Binding] is selected, the pages can be folded as a
left-bound booklet.
If [Right Binding] is selected, the pages can be folded as a
right-bound booklet.
1
3
1
2
1
1
1
2
3
3
3
1
1
24-32 Output Tray
Output Tray
All media is fed out facing down into the output tray of the machine. This tray
has a capacity of approximately 250 sheets (A4/Letter) of 80 g/m2
paper.
" If the media is stacked too high in the output tray, your machine may
experience media misfeeds, excessive media curl, or static buildup. Media Storage 4-33
Media Storage
Keep media on a flat, level surface in its original wrapper until it is time to
load it.
Media that has been stored for a long time out of its packaging may dry up
too much and cause misfeeding.
If media has been removed from its wrapper, place it in its original packaging and store in a cool, dark place on a level surface.
Avoid moisture, excessive humidity, direct sunlight, excessive heat, and
dust
Store paper in a location with a temperature between 0 °C and 30 °C and
humidity between 30% and 85%.
Avoid leaning against other objects or placing it in an upright position.
Before using stored media, do a trial print and check print quality. 4-34 Original Media
Original Media
Specifications
Documents that can be placed on the original glass
The following types of documents can be placed on the original glass.
Observe the following precautions when placing a document on the original
glass.
Do not place objects weighing more than 3 kg on the original glass; otherwise the glass may be damaged.
Do not press down extremely hard on a book spread on the original glass;
otherwise the original glass may be damaged.
Documents that can be loaded into the ADF
The following types of documents can be loaded into the ADF.
Document type Sheets, books, three-dimensional object
Document size Maximum size : Legal
Copy and Scan : 30–216 × 30–356 mm
Fax : 140–216 × 148–356 mm
Weight Maximum weight : 3 kg
Document media type /
Weight
Plain paper / 50 to 128 g/m²
Document size Maximum size : Legal
Mixed document sizes : Legal, Letter
Copy and Scan : 140–216 × 148–356 mm
(Single-sided/Double-sided)
Fax : 140–216 × 148–1000 mm
(Single-sided)
140–216 × 148–356 mm
(Double-sided)
Media capacity 50 sheets (media weight: 80 g/m2
)Original Media 4-35
Do not load the following types of documents into the ADF.
Documents containing pages of different sizes
Wrinkled, folded, curled, or torn documents
Highly translucent or transparent documents, such as overhead transparencies or diazo photosensitive paper
Coated documents such as carbon-backed paper
Documents printed on paper thicker than 128 g/m²
Documents with pages bound together with paper clips or staples
Documents that are bound in a book or booklet
Documents with pages bound together with glue
Documents with pages that have had cutouts removed or are cutouts
Label sheets
Offset printing masters
Documents with binder holes4-36 Loading a Document
Loading a Document
Placing a document on the original glass
1 Lift to open the ADF cover.
2 Position the document on the
original glass.
" Align the document with
the arrow on the left side
toward the rear of the
machine.
DocumentLoading a Document 4-37
3 Gently close the ADF cover.
Loading a document into the ADF
1 Put the document into the ADF
document feed tray face up.
" Before loading a document into the ADF, check
that no document pages
remain on the original
glass.
" Load the document
pages so that the top of
the document is toward
the back or the right side
of the machine.
2 Adjust the document guides to
the document size.
" For details on copying the loaded document, refer to “Performing
Copy mode operations” on page 7-1. For details on scanning, refer
to “Scanning From a Computer Application” on page 9-1.
Document4-38 Loading a Document5Using the Printer
Driver5-2 Selecting Driver Options/Defaults (for Windows)
Selecting Driver Options/Defaults
(for Windows)
Before you start working with your printer, you are advised to verify/change
the default driver settings. Also, in case you have options installed, you
should “declare” the options in the driver.
Windows Server 2008 R2/7/Vista/Server 2008/XP/Server
2003/2000
1 Choose the driver’s properties as follows:
– (Windows 7/Server 2008 R2)
From the [Start] menu, choose [Devices and Printers] to display the
[Devices and Printers] directory. Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA
bizhub C35 PCL6, KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 PS or KONICA
MINOLTA bizhub C35 XPS printer icon, and then click [Printer Properties].
– (Windows Vista/Server 2008)
From the [Start] menu, click [Control Panel], then [Hardware and
Sound], and then click [Printers] to open the Printers directory.
Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 PCL6, KONICA
MINOLTA bizhub C35 PS or KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 XPS
printer icon, and then click [Properties].
– (Windows XP/Server 2003)
From the [Start] menu, choose [Printers and Faxes] to display the
[Printers and Faxes] directory. Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA
bizhub C35 PCL6 or KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 PS printer icon
and choose [Properties].
– (Windows 2000)
From the [Start] menu, choose [Settings] and then [Printers] to display
the [Printers] directory. Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35
PCL6 or KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 PS printer icon and choose
[Properties].
2 If you have installed options, proceed with the next step. Otherwise, skip
to step 9.
3 Select the [Configure] tab.
4 Check that the installed options are correctly listed. If not, proceed with
the next step. Otherwise, continue with step 8.
5 Click the [Acquire Device Information] to automatically configure installed
options.Selecting Driver Options/Defaults (for Windows) 5-3
" The [Acquire Device Information] is available only if bi-directional
communication is available with the printer; otherwise it is grayed
out.
If Windows Server 2008 R2/7/Vista/Server 2008 is being used,
[Acquire Device Information] can also be clicked when the
machine is connected via USB.
6 From the [Device Option] list, select an option, one at a time, and then
select [Installed] or [None] from the [Setting] menu.
7 Click [Apply].
" Depending on the version of the operating system, [Apply] may not
appear. If this is the case, continue with the next step.
8 Select the [General] tab.
9 Click [Printing Preferences].
Printing Preference dialog box appears.
10 Select the default settings for your printer, such as the default media format you use, in the appropriate tabs.
11 Click [Apply].
12 Click [OK] to exit from the Print preference dialog box.
13 Click [OK] to exit from the Properties dialog box.5-4 Uninstalling the Printer Driver (for Windows)
Uninstalling the Printer Driver
(for Windows)
This section describes how to uninstall the printer driver if necessary.
Windows Server 2008 R2/7/Vista/Server 2008/XP/Server
2003/2000
1 Close all applications.
2 Choose the Uninstall Program as follows:
– (Windows Server 2008 R2/7/Vista/Server 2008/XP/Server 2003)
From the [Start] menu, choose [All programs], [KONICA MINOLTA],
[bizhub C35], and then [Uninstall Printer Driver].
– (Windows 2000)
From the [Start] menu, choose [Programs], [KONICA MINOLTA],
[bizhub C35], and then [Uninstall Printer Driver].
3 When the Uninstall dialog box appears, select the name of the driver to be
deleted, and then click the [Uninstall] button.
4 Click [Uninstall].
5 Click [OK], and restart your computer.
6 The printer driver will be uninstalled from your computer.Displaying Printer Driver Settings (for Windows) 5-5
Displaying Printer Driver Settings
(for Windows)
Windows 7/Server 2008 R2
1 From the [Start] menu, choose [Devices and Printers] to display the
[Devices and Printers] directory.
2 Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 PCL6, KONICA MINOLTA
bizhub C35 PS or KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 XPS printer icon, and
then click [Printing Preferences].
Windows Vista/Server 2008
1 From the [Start] menu, click [Control Panel], then [Hardware and Sound],
and then click [Printers] to open the Printers directory.
2 Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 PCL6, KONICA MINOLTA
bizhub C35 PS or KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 XPS printer icon, and
then click [Printing Preferences].
Windows XP/Server 2003
1 From the [Start] menu, choose [Printers and Faxes] to display the [Printers and Faxes] directory.
2 Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 PCL6 or KONICA
MINOLTA bizhub C35 PS printer icon and choose [Printing Preferences].
Windows 2000
1 From the [Start] menu, point to [Settings], and then click [Printers] to display the [Printers] directory.
2 Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA bizhub C35 PCL6 or KONICA
MINOLTA bizhub C35 PS printer icon and choose [Printing Preferences].5-6 Using the Postscript, PCL and XPS Printer Driver
Using the Postscript, PCL and XPS Printer
Driver
Common Buttons
The buttons described below appear on each tab.
[OK]
Click to exit the Properties dialog box, saving any changes made.
[Cancel]
Click to exit the Properties dialog box without saving any changes made.
[Apply]
Click to save all changes without exiting the Properties dialog box.
[Help]
Click to view the help.
[Favorite Setting]
This allows the current settings to be saved. To save the current settings,
specify the desired settings, and then click [Add]. Specify the settings
described below, and then click [OK].
[Name]: Type in the name of the settings to be saved.
[Icon]: Select an icon from the icon list to easily identify the settings.
The selected icon appears in the drop-down list.
[Sharing]: Specify whether or not the settings to be saved can be used by
other users logged onto the computer.
[Comment]: Add a simple comment to the settings to be saved.
Afterward, the saved settings can be selected from the drop-down list. To
change the registered setting, click [Edit].
In addition, predefined settings can be selected.
The predefined settings are those for [2 in 1], [Photo] and [Gray Scale].
Select [Default Setting] from the drop-down list to reset the functions in all
tabs to their default values.Using the Postscript, PCL and XPS Printer Driver 5-7
[Printer View]
Click the button to display an image of the printer in the figure area.
When this button is clicked, it changes to the [Paper View] button (when a tab
other than the [Quality] tab is selected) or the [Quality View] button (when the
[Quality] tab is selected).
" This button does not appear on the [Advanced] tab.
[Paper View]
Click the button to display a sample of the page layout in the figure area.
When this button is clicked, it changes to the [Printer View] button.
" This button does not appear on the [Quality] tab.
[Quality View]
Click the button to display a sample of the settings selected in the [Quality] tab.
When this button is clicked, it changes to the [Printer View] button.
" This button appears only when the [Quality] tab is selected.
[Printer Information]
Click this button to start up PageScope Web Connection.
" This button is available only if a network connection has been established.
[Default]
Click the button to reset the settings to their defaults.
" This button does not appear on the [Advanced] tab.
" When this button is clicked, the settings in the displayed dialog box
are reset to their defaults. The settings on other tabs are not changed.
[Advanced] Tab (PostScript Printer Driver Only)
The [Advanced] Tab allows you to
Select whether to enable or disable the settings for advanced printing
functions (such as booklet printing)5-8 Using the Postscript, PCL and XPS Printer Driver
Specify the PostScript output method
Specify whether or not the error messages of a print job are printed
Print a mirror image
Specify whether or not the application can directly output PostScript data
[My Tab]
[My Tab] allows you to
Display the most frequently used functions (from each tab) whose settings
are often changed
Add or remove displayed functions by clicking [Edit My Tab]. In addition,
functions can be added to [My Tab] by right-clicking them on their original
tabs.
[Basic] Tab
The [Basic] Tab allows you to
Specify the orientation of the media
Specify the size of the original document
Select the output media size
Zoom (expand/reduce) documents
Specify the paper tray
Specify the type of media
Specify the number of copies
Turn on/off job collation
Save a print job on the printer and print it later (Job Retention)
Save a confidential job on the printer and protect it with a password
Print a single copy for proofing
Specify user authentication and account track settings
Print on the back side of paper that has already been printed on
" Use paper that has been printed on with this printer.
In addition, the page printed with this setting is not guaranteed.
" Do not use the following types of paper.
- Paper that has been printed on with an inkjet printer
- Paper that has been printed on with a monochrome/color laser
printer/copier
- Paper that has been printed on with any other printer or fax machineUsing the Postscript, PCL and XPS Printer Driver 5-9
" To display a list of jobs saved with a [Job Retention] setting, press
[USB/HDD] in the home screen, and then press [Proof Print]. Print the
document by selecting the job in the list.
The password must be entered if one has been specified for the job.
[Layout] Tab
The [Layout] Tab allows you to
Print several pages of a document on the same page (N in 1 printing)
Print a single copy for enlargement and print several pages (PCL printer
driver only)
Rotate the print image 180 degrees
Specify whether or not blank pages are printed (PCL and XPS printer
driver only)
Specify duplex (double-sided) printing
Specify booklet printing
Specify binding position
Adjust the binding margin
Specify the position on the paper where the document is to be printed
(PCL printer driver only)
[Cover Mode] Tab
The [Cover Mode] Tab allows you to
Print front and back cover pages and separator pages
Specify the tray that contains the paper for the front and back cover pages
and separator pages
[Stamp/Composition] Tab
" Be sure to use overlays with print jobs with a paper size and orientation that matches the overlay form.
In addition, if settings have been specified for [N in 1] or [Booklet] in
the printer driver, the overlay form cannot be adjusted to match the
specified settings.
The settings in the Watermark function of the [Stamp/Composition] tab allows
you to
Select the watermark to be used
Create, edit or delete watermarks
Adjust the watermark position5-10 Using the Postscript, PCL and XPS Printer Driver
Print a frame around watermarks
Print transparent (shaded) watermarks
Print the watermark on only the first page
Print the watermark repeatedly throughout the all pages
The [Copy Protect] function prevents unauthorized copying.
The document is printed with the specified text or pattern in the background. The background pattern is normally inconspicuous, but becomes
visible when the document is copied. (PCL printer driver only)
The settings in the Overlay function of the [Stamp/Composition] tab allows
you to
Select the form to use
Add or delete overlay files
Launch Download Manager to download a form (PostScript printer driver
only)
" Download Manager Application should be installed earlier.
Create a form (PCL and XPS printer driver only)
Specify that the document and form are printed overlapping (PCL and
XPS printer driver only)
Display the form information (PCL and XPS printer driver only)
Print the form on [All Pages], [1st Page Only], [Even Page] and [Odd
Page]
Place the form in back of the document or in front on the printed document (PCL and XPS printer driver only)
[Quality] Tab
The [Quality] Tab allows you to
Switch between color and grayscale printing
Control the darkness of an image (Brightness)
Specify the printer color settings
Perform color separation
Select whether or not economy printing is used
Set the edge strength to [Low], [Middle] or [High]
Specify the amount of details in graphic patterns (PCL and XPS printer
driver only)
Specify the format of fonts that are to be downloaded (PCL and Postscript
printer driver only)Using the Postscript, PCL and XPS Printer Driver 5-11
Print using the printer’s fonts (PCL and Postscript printer driver only)
Control the tones of an image (Contrast) (PCL printer driver only)
Specify the image compression method (PCL printer driver only)
Select whether or not Auto Trapping function is used (Postscript printer
driver only)
Specify the Black Over Print function (Postscript printer driver only)
[Other] Tab
The [Other] Tab allows you to
Select that Microsoft Excel sheets are not to be divided when printing
(32bit printer driver only)
Select that the white background of Microsoft PowerPoint data does not
hide overlay files (32bit PCL and XPS printer driver only)
Send a notification by E-mail when printing is finished
Shows the version information for the printer driver
Prevent loss when printing fine lines (PCL printer driver only)
Limitations on printer driver functions installed with
Point and Print
If Point and Print is performed with the following server and client combinations, there are limitations on some printer driver functions.
Server and client combinations
Server: Windows Server 2008 R2/Server 2008/Server 2003
Client: Windows 7/Vista/XP/2000
Functions with limitations applied
Booklet, Skip Blank Pages, Front Cover, Back Cover, Separator Page,
Create Overlay File, Print in Overlay, Watermark
*JOBNAME, USERNAME, and HOSTNAME output of PJL5-12 Using the Postscript, PCL and XPS Printer Driver6Proof Print,
External memory
and ID & Print
functions6-2 Proof Print
Proof Print
Print jobs saved on hard disk can be printed or deleted.
" If [Store Job], [Print and Hold], [Secured Job], [Secured Job(Encryption)] or [Proof then Print] was selected for [Job Retention] in the
printer driver, the job file is saved on the hard disk.
Printing a job saved on the hard disk
1 In the home screen, press [USB/HDD].
2 Press [Proof Print].
3 Select a user.
4 Press [OK].
5 Select the job to be printed.
6 Press [Print].
" If the job was saved with the [Secured Job] or [Secured Job(Encryption)] setting, type in the password.
7 Type in the number of copies to be printed, and then press [OK].
Deleting a job saved on the hard disk
1 In the home screen, press [USB/HDD].
2 Press [Proof Print].
3 Select a user.
4 Press [OK].
5 Select the job to be deleted.
6 Press [Delete].
" If the job was saved with the [Secured Job] or [Secured Job(Encryption)] setting, type in the password.
7 Press [Yes], and then press [OK].External Memory 6-3
External Memory
PDF, XPS, JPEG and TIFF files saved on USB memory devices can be
printed by plugging the USB memory device into the machine.
Printing from a connected USB memory device
1 Plug the USB memory device into
the USB HOST port. appears
at the bottom of the screen.
2 In the home screen, press [USB/
HDD].
3 Press [External Memory].
4 Press [File List].
5 Select the file to be printed.
If the file to be printed is in a folder, select the folder, and then press
[Open]. To return to the folder containing the one that is currently displayed, press [Up].
" At each folder level, a maximum of 99 folders and files can be displayed.
" The names of folders are displayed given priority over the names of
files.
" A maximum of eight folder levels can be displayed.
" If JPEG and TIFF files are not displayed, select the file type with [File
Type].
6 Press [OK].
7 Specify the print settings.
8 Press [Print].
" Do not unplug the USB memory device from the USB HOST port during printing.6-4 ID & Print
Selecting the type of files to be displayed
1 In the home screen, press [USB/HDD].
2 Press [External Memory].
3 Press [File Type].
4 Select the type of files to be displayed.
5 Press [OK].
ID & Print
If a job is printed on this machine with user authentication through the printer
driver using the registered user or public user privilege, it is saved as an ID &
Print job on the hard disk of this machine.
" When using batch printing for an ID & Print job, the copying cannot be
interrupted.
Printing simultaneously with log-in
1 Specify a name and password for [User Name] and [Password].
– For [User Name], the name can be specified either by directly typing it
in or selecting from a list.
2 Press [Begin Printing].
3 Press [Login].
The user is authenticated and printing starts.
Specifying a job to print
1 Specify a name and password for [User Name] and [Password].
– For [User Name], the name can be specified either by directly typing it
in or selecting from a list.
2 Press [Access Basic Screen].
3 Press [Login].
This authenticates the user and returns to the home screen.
4 In the home screen, press [USB/HDD].
5 Press [ID & Print].
6 Select [Login User] or [Public User] as the user who sends a job.
7 Select the job to be printed.
8 Press [Print].ID & Print 6-5
Deleting a job
1 Specify a name and password for [User Name] and [Password].
– For [User Name], the name can be specified either by directly typing it
in or selecting from a list.
2 Press [Access Basic Screen].
3 Press [Login].
This authenticates the user and returns to the home screen.
4 In the home screen, press [USB/HDD].
5 Press [ID & Print].
6 Select [Login User] or [Public User] as the user who sends a job.
7 Select the job to be deleted.
8 Press [Delete].
9 Press [Yes], and then press [OK].6-6 ID & Print7Performing
Copy mode
operations7-2 Basic copy operation
Basic copy operation
The general procedure for making copies is described below.
1 Place the document on the original glass or load it into the ADF.
" For details on positioning the
document, refer to “Placing a
document on the original
glass” on page 4-36 and
“Loading a document into the
ADF” on page 4-37.
2 In the home screen, press [Copy].
" When the [Start (Color)] or [Start (B&W)] key is pressed in the home
screen, the job can be copied with the defaults.
3 Specify the desired copy settings.
" For details on specifying document size settings, refer to “[Original
Size]” on page 7-4.
For details on specifying paper size settings, refer to “[Paper]” on
page 7-5.
For details on specifying zoom ratio settings, refer to “[Zoom]” on
page 7-6.
For details on specifying double-sided copy settings, refer to “[Duplex/
Combine]” on page 7-7.
For details on specifying density settings, refer to “[Density]” on
page 7-8.
For details on specifying document type settings, refer to “[Original Basic copy operation 7-3
Type]” on page 7-9.
For details on specifying color settings, refer to “[Color Mode]” on
page 7-9.
For details on specifying Finishing settings, refer to “[Finishing]” on
page 7-10.
For details on performing the Proof Copy operation, refer to “[Proof
Copy]” on page 7-10.
For details on performing the Separate Scan operation, refer to “[Separate Scan]” on page 7-11.
For details on performing the ID Copy operation, refer to “[ID Copy]”
on page 7-13.
For details on specifying a binding margin, refer to “[Paper Margin]” on
page 7-14.
For details on adjusting the image quality, refer to “[Image Quality]” on
page 7-15.
4 Using the keypad, type in the desired number of copies.
" If the number of copies was incorrectly entered, press the [C] key, and
then type in the correct number of copies.
5 To make a color copy, press the [Start (Color)] key.
To make a black-and-white copy, press the [Start (B&W)] key.
" This machine cannot automatically detect the size of an original document that will be scanned. Before scanning the document, specify its
size. If the size of the original document is not correctly specified,
some parts of the image may be lost. For details on specifying the size
of an original document, refer to “[Original Size]” on page 7-4.
" When sorting or making double-sided or combined copies using the
original glass, press [Finish] after all pages of the document have
been scanned.
" A screen showing the scanned document appears after the [Start
(Color)] key or the [Start (B&W)] key is pressed. Check that the document was scanned as desired.
[Number Of Originals]: Number of scanned document pages
[Number Of Sets]: Number of scanned copies/specified number of
copies
[Printed/TTL Pgs]: Number of copy pages printed/total number of
pages to be printed (Does not appear during a Separate Scan operation.)
" For details on interrupted printing (Interrupt Mode), refer to “Interrupting a copy job” on page 8-2.7-4 [Original Size]
" For details on copying using stored settings, refer to “Copy programs”
on page 8-3.
" A document containing pages of different sizes can be loaded into the
ADF. For details on copying documents with pages of different sizes,
refer to “[Original Size]” on page 7-4.
[Original Size]
The document size can be specified.
Documents of mixed page sizes
A document containing pages of different sizes (Letter and Legal) can be
loaded into the ADF. Each document page will be copied onto paper of the
same size as the original.
" Load all document pages so that they are aligned on the left side of
the ADF.
Item Description
[Standard Size] Select the size of the document.
Select [Letter/Legal] to copy a document containing different page sizes.
[Custom Size] Specify the size of the document if it is a non-standard
size.
Press [X] and [Y], and then type in the document size. [X]
can be set between 30 mm and 356 mm (1.18 inches and
14.00 inches); [Y] can be set between 30 mm and 216
mm (1.18 inches and 8.50 inches).[Paper] 7-5
[Paper]
The size and type of the paper to be printed on can be selected, and the size
and type settings for the paper loaded into each paper tray can be changed.
The paper size can be selected automatically according to the document size
or it can be specified manually.
" For details on the paper types and sizes, refer to “Print Media” on
page 4-2.
" When paper is loaded in the bypass tray, the [Paper] screen appears
while the bypass tray (tray 1) is selected automatically.
Item Description
[1]-[4] Manually select the paper tray.
[3] and [4] are available if the optional lower feeder
units have been installed.
[Auto] The paper is selected automatically according to the
size of the original document.
[Change Tray Set] Specify the type and size of the paper loaded in the
selected paper tray.
[Paper Size] Specify the paper size.
[Standard Size] Select the paper size.
[Custom Size] Enter the size of the paper.
[Paper Type] Select the paper type.7-6 [Zoom]
[Zoom]
The image size for the document can be enlarged or reduced.
Item Description
[+]/[-] Specify the zoom ratio of the copy (25.0% to
400.0%).
With documents loaded into the ADF, the zoom
ratio can be set between 25% and 200%.
[Set Zoom] The various preset zoom ratios and the zoom ratio
for the [Minimal] setting can be changed.
The zoom ratios can be set between 25.0% and
200.0%.
Zoom settings Select a preset zoom ratio or a programmed zoom
ratio.
[Auto]: Select this setting for the most appropriate
zoom ratio to be automatically selected based on
the size of the loaded document and the specified
paper size.
[Full Size]: Select this setting to produce a copy
that is the same size as the document (100.0%).
[Manual]: Press [+] or [-] to enter a custom zoom
ratio.
[Minimal]: Select this setting to print a copy of the
document image so that it is slightly smaller than
the original document size.[Duplex/Combine] 7-7
[Duplex/Combine]
Whether the scanned document and the printed copy are printed on just one
side or both sides can be specified. In addition, document images of multiple
pages (2 or 4 pages) can be combined and printed on a single page.
Item Description
[Duplex] Select whether simplex (single-sided) or duplex
(double-sided) copies are to be printed.
[1 > 1]: Select this setting to produce single-sided
copies from single-sided documents.
[1>2]: Select this setting to produce one double-sided copy from two single-sided documents.
[2>1]: Select this setting to produce two single-sided copies from one double-sided document.
[2 > 2]: Select this setting to produce double-sided copies from double-sided documents.
[Combine] Select whether to make combined copies.
[No]: Select this setting to not produce combined
copies.
[2 in 1]: Select this setting to copy two document
pages onto one page.
[4 in 1 Horizontal]: Select this setting to copy four
document pages onto one page. The document
images will be arranged horizontally.
[4 in 1 Vertical]: Select this setting to copy four
document pages onto one page. The document
images will be arranged vertically.7-8 [Density]
[Density]
Specify the copy density.
[Binding Position] Specify the binding positions for the document
and the copies.
[Orig. Binding Position]
Select [Left Bind], [Right Bind], [Top Bind] or
[Auto] as the binding position for the document.
If the binding position for the document is set to
[Auto], the binding position is set at the left or at
the top.
[Output Binding
Position]
Select [Left Bind], [Right Bind], [Top Bind] or
[Auto] as the binding position for the copies.
If the binding position for the copy is set to [Auto],
the binding position is set at the left or at the top.
[Original Direction] Select [Top], [Bottom], [Left] or [Right] as the orientation of the document loaded into the ADF or
placed on the original glass.
Item Description
[+]/[-] Adjust the copy density to one of nine levels.
[Standard] Select this setting to return the copy density to the
standard setting.
Item Description[Original Type] 7-9
[Original Type]
Select the document quality (text or image documents).
[Color Mode]
Specify the printing color used for copies.
Copies will be printed with the specified Color setting when the [Start (Color)]
key is pressed.
Item Description
[Text] Select this setting when copying documents containing only text.
[Text/Photo] Select this setting when copying documents containing both text and photos.
Black text, color text and shading are automatically
recognized, and the most appropriate image processing is performed.
In addition, processing appropriate for printed
photo documents will be applied to any photos.
[Photo] Select this setting when copying documents containing printed photos.
Item Description
[Auto] Select this setting to detect whether the scanned
document is in color or in black and white, then
automatically print copies in either color or black
and white.
[Full Color] Select this setting to print the copy in full color,
regardless of whether the scanned document is in
color or in black and white.7-10 [Finishing]
[Finishing]
Specify any settings for finishing outputted copies.
[Proof Copy]
Before printing a large number of copies, a single finished proof copy can be
printed in order to be checked. Select whether or not to print a proof copy.
Proof Copy operation
" When printing a proof copy, specify multiple copies.
1 In the home screen, press [Copy].
2 Place the document on the original glass or load it into the ADF.
" For details on positioning the document, refer to “Placing a document
on the original glass” on page 4-36 and “Loading a document into the
ADF” on page 4-37.
3 Specify the copy settings.
4 Press [Proof Copy].
Item Description
[Sort] Select this setting when making multiple copies of
documents containing multiple pages so that they
will be automatically separated into sets of the full
document.
[Group] Select this setting when making multiple copies of
documents containing multiple pages so that they
will be automatically separated into sets of each
page.
[Auto] Select this option to automatically switch between
[Sort] and [Group] depending on the number of
printable sheets per copy.
[Group] is set when printing a single sheet in the
1-sided or 2-sided mode, and [Sort] is set when
printing multiple sheets.
Item Description
[ON] Select this setting to print a proof copy.
[OFF] Select this setting to not print a proof copy.[Separate Scan] 7-11
5 Press [ON].
6 Press [OK].
7 Press the [Start (Color)] key or the [Start (B&W)] key.
A single proof copy is printed.
8 Check the proof copy.
If the proof copy was printed as desired, continue with step 9.
" Using the keypad, the number of copies can be changed.
" To print another proof copy, press [Proof Copy].
" To change the settings, press [Cancel], and then perform steps 2
through 8.
9 Press [Print].
The remaining number of copies is printed.
[Separate Scan]
The scan operation can be divided into several sessions, for example, when
all pages of a document cannot be loaded into the ADF, and then the scanned
pages can be treated as a single copy job. In addition, the scanning location
can be switched between the original glass and the ADF during the scanning
operation.
Item Description
[ON] Select this setting to perform a Separate Scan
operation.
[OFF] Select this setting to not perform a Separate Scan
operation.7-12 [Separate Scan]
Scanning the document in separate batches
" Do not load more pages into the ADF than the maximum number of
pages allowed, otherwise a document misfeed or damage to the document may occur.
" When sorting or making double-sided or combined copies using the
original glass, instead of using the Separate Scan operation, the document can be scanned as a multiple-page document.
1 In the home screen, press [Copy].
2 Place the document on the original glass or load it into the ADF.
" For details on positioning the document, refer to “Placing a document
on the original glass” on page 4-36 and “Loading a document into the
ADF” on page 4-37.
3 Specify the copy settings.
4 Press [Separate Scan].
5 Press [ON].
6 Press [OK].
7 Press the [Start (Color)] key or the [Start (B&W)] key.
Scanning of the document begins.
" To change the scanning settings, press [Change Settings].
8 Position the next document page or pages, and then press the [Start
(Color)] key or the [Start (B&W)] key.
Scanning of the document begins.
9 Repeat step 7 until all document pages have been scanned.
10 After all document pages have been scanned, press [Finish].[ID Copy] 7-13
[ID Copy]
The back and front of a card, such as an insurance card, driver’s license or
business card, can be scanned separately and printed together on a single
page.
" With the ID Copy operation, the zoom ratio is set to 100%.
" The paper sizes that are available for copying are Letter, Legal and
A4.
" The card can only be placed on the original glass. Position the card to
be scanned aligned at the upper-left corner of the original glass. Since
the image is printed 4 mm from the top and left side, reposition the
card as necessary
1 In the home screen, press [Copy].
2 Place the card, front side down, on the original glass.
" For details on positioning the document, refer to “Placing a document
on the original glass” on page 4-36.
3 Specify the copy settings.
4 Press [ID Copy].
5 Press the [Start (Color)] key or the [Start (B&W)] key.
Scanning of the front side begins.
6 Position the card, back side down, at the same location on the original
glass.
" To copy only the front side, press [Print].
7 Press the [Start (Color)] key or the [Start (B&W)] key.
Scanning of the back side begins.
The copy is fed out.
A
B7-14 [Paper Margin]
[Paper Margin]
Copies can be printed with a binding margin so they can easily be stored in
filing binders.
" If part of the image is lost due to the binding margin setting, reduce the
zoom ratio before printing copies.
Item Description
[+]/[-] Specify the width of the binding margin between
0.1 mm and 20.0 mm (0.001 inches and 0.787
inches).
[None] Select this setting to leave no binding margin.[Image Quality] 7-15
[Image Quality]
The quality can be adjusted for the document to be scanned.
Item Description
[Background removal] Adjust the background density when copying documents with a colored background (such as newspapers or recycled paper) or thin documents where
the back side is visible from the front side.
Adjust the background density to one of nine levels. Select a setting in the + direction to darken the
background, or select a setting in the - direction to
lighten the background. Press [Standard] to return
the density to the standard setting.
[Contrast] The image can be adjusted to make it softer or
sharper.
Adjust the contrast to one of nine levels. Select a
setting in the + direction to make the image
sharper, or select a setting in the - direction to
make the image softer. Press [Std.] to return the
contrast to the standard setting.
[Sharpness] The sharpness of text and image outlines can be
adjusted.
Adjust the sharpness to one of seven levels. Select
a setting in the + direction to increase the sharpness, or select a setting in the - direction to
decrease the sharpness. Press [Std.] to return the
sharpness to the standard setting.7-16 [Image Quality]8Additional copy
operations8-2 Interrupting a copy job
Interrupting a copy job
The current jobs can be temporarily interrupted so a document can be copied
with different copy settings.
This is convenient for quickly making a copy.
" The [Interrupt] key cannot be pressed while a document is being
scanned.
" When the [Interrupt] key is pressed, the copy settings return to their
defaults.
1 In the home screen, press [Copy].
2 Place the document on the original glass or load it into the ADF.
" For details on positioning the document, refer to “Placing a document
on the original glass” on page 4-36 and “Loading a document into the
ADF” on page 4-37.
3 Press the [Interrupt] key.
The indicator on the [Interrupt] key lights up in green, and printing of the
current job stops.
4 Specify the copy settings.
5 To make a color copy, press the [Start (Color)] key.
To make a black-and-white copy, press the [Start (B&W)] key.
6 After the interrupting job has finished printing, press the [Interrupt] key.
The indicator on the [Interrupt] key goes off, and Interrupt mode is canceled.
Printing of the job that was interrupted continues.Copy programs 8-3
Copy programs
Frequently used copy settings can be stored together as a program to easily
be recalled later.
Storing a copy program
" A maximum of 15 copy programs can be stored.
1 In the home screen, press [Copy].
2 Specify the copy settings.
3 Press the [Mode Memory] key.
The copy programs screen appear.
4 Press [Register].
5 Press [Name].
6 Type in the name of the copy program, and then press [OK].
" For details on entering text, refer to “Entering text” on page A-8.
7 Press [OK].
8 Press [Cancel].
The initial Copy mode screen appears again.
Deleting a copy program
1 In the home screen, press [Copy].
2 Press the [Mode Memory] key.
The copy programs screen appear.
3 Select the copy program to be deleted.
4 Press [Delete].
5 Press [Yes].
6 Press [OK].
7 Press [Cancel].
The initial Copy mode screen appears again.8-4 Copy programs
Copying using stored settings (copy programs)
1 In the home screen, press [Copy].
2 Place the document on the original glass or load it into the ADF.
" For details on positioning the document, refer to “Placing a document
on the original glass” on page 4-36 and “Loading a document into the
ADF” on page 4-37.
3 Press the [Mode Memory] key.
The copy programs screen appear.
4 Select the copy program to be recalled.
5 Press [Detail].
The settings screen appears.
6 Check the copy settings stored with the selected copy program.
7 Press [Close].
8 Press [OK].
The initial Copy mode screen appears again.
9 Press the [Start (Color)] key or the [Start (B&W)] key.9Scanning From a
Computer
Application9-2 Basic Scanning Operation
Basic Scanning Operation
Documents can be scanned from a computer connected to this machine via a
network. Scanning settings can be specified and the scanning operation can
be performed from TWAIN- or WIA-compatible applications. From the scanner driver, a preview can be displayed and various adjustments, such as the
size of the scan area, can be specified.
" For details on the installation of the scanner driver or network TWAIN
settings, refer to the Installation Guide on the Documentation CD/
DVD.
1 Position the document to be
scanned.
" For details on positioning
the document, refer to
“Placing a document on
the original glass” on
page 4-36 and “Loading
a document into the ADF”
on page 4-37.
2 Start the application to be used for scanning.
3 Start the scanner driver according to the application settings.
4 Specify the necessary scanner driver settings.
5 Click the [Scan] button in the scanner driver.Windows TWAIN Driver Settings 9-3
Windows TWAIN Driver Settings
Mode settings
[Mode Settings]
Select [Basic Mode] for specifying basic settings, or select [Advanced Mode]
for specifying detailed settings.
The settings that can be specified differ for each mode.
When [Basic Mode] is selected
The following parameters can be set when [Basic Mode] is selected.
[Help] icon
Click to display Help information.
[About] icon
Click to display the software version information.
[Scan Objective]
Specify the document type.
[Scan Type]
Specify the scan type.
[Resolution]
Specify the resolution.
[Auto Color Adjustment]
Specify the auto color adjustment settings.
[Auto Deskew]
Specify settings for correcting the skew of the image.
[Paper source]
Specify the paper source.
When scanning documents from the ADF, select whether to scan only the
front side or both sides of the document.
[Original Size]
Specify the original size.
[Rotation]
Select the orientation of the image to be scanned.9-4 Windows TWAIN Driver Settings
" If the [Rotate back side] check box is selected, the back side of the
image is rotated 180° and scanned. (Applies only if [ADF (2-sided)] is
selected.)
[Image size]
Shows the data size of the scan image.
[Close]
Click to close the TWAIN driver window.
[Prescan]
Click to begin scanning a preview image.
[Scan]
Click to begin scanning.
[Clear] icon
Click to erase the preview image.
When [Advanced Mode] is selected
The following parameters can be set when [Advanced Mode] is selected.
[Load]
Specify a saved settings file (dat file) for scanning.
[Save]
Save the current settings as a settings file (dat file).
[Default]
Return all settings to their defaults.
[Help icon]
Click to display the Help.
[About icon]
Click to display the software version information.
[Paper source]
Specify the paper source.
With scanning documents from the ADF, select whether to scan only the front
side or both sides of the document.
[Original Size]
Specify the original size.
[Scan Type]
Specify the scan type.Windows TWAIN Driver Settings 9-5
[Resolution]
Specify the resolution.
[Scale]
Specify the enlargement or reduction ratio for the selected area.
" If the resolution is set at 1200 × 1200dpi or higher, a setting larger
than 100% cannot be specified.
Scanning Mode
Select [Auto] or [Manual]. When [Manual] is selected, a tab appears so that
detailed settings can be specified, for example, for [Brightness/Contrast], [Filter], [Curves], [Levels], [Color Balance], and [Hue/Saturation].
" The parameters that can be set differ depending on the scanning
mode that is selected.
" The detailed settings that appear differ depending on the setting
selected for [Scan Type].
" If [Auto] is selected as the scanning mode, scanning from the original
glass is performed after a prescan is performed so that a preview
image can be checked.
[Image size]
Shows the data size of the scan image.
[Rotation]
Select the orientation of the image to be scanned.
" If the [Rotate back side] check box is selected, the back side of the
image is rotated 180° and scanned. (Applies only if [ADF (2-sided)] is
selected)
[Auto Deskew]
Specify settings for correcting the skew of the image.
[Close]
Click to close the TWAIN driver window.
[Prescan]
Click to begin scanning a preview image.
[Scan]
Click to begin scanning.
[AutoCrop] icon
Click to automatically detect the scanning position based on the preview
image.9-6 Windows TWAIN Driver Settings
[Zoom Prescan] icon
Click to rescan the area selected in the preview window and enlarge it to fit
the window.
[Mirror] icon
Click to display a mirror image of the preview image.
[Tone Reversal] icon
Click to reverse the colors of the preview image.
[Clear] icon
Click to erase the preview image.
[Preview] window
Displays a preview image. Drag the rectangle over the image to select an
area.
[Before (RGB)]/[After]
Move the pointer in the preview window to display the color tones at the
pointer’s position before and after adjustments.
[Width]/[Height]
Displays the width and height for the selected area in the selected measurement units.Windows WIA Driver Settings 9-7
Windows WIA Driver Settings
[Paper source]
Select the paper source.
[Color picture]
Select this setting when scanning in color.
[Grayscale picture]
Select this setting when scanning in grayscale.
[Black and white picture or text]
Select this setting when scanning in black and white.
[Custom Settings]
Select this setting when scanning with [Adjust the quality of the scanned picture] settings applied.
" If settings have been specified with [Adjust the quality of the canned
picture], [Custom Settings] is automatically selected.
[Adjust the quality of the scanned picture]
Click this message to display the Advanced Properties dialog box. In the
Advanced Properties dialog box, settings can be specified for [Brightness],
[Contrast], [Resolution(DPI)], and [Picture type] (select from color, grayscale
or black and white).
" These settings are applied when [Custom Settings] is selected.
[Page size]
Specify the paper size when [Page source] is set to [Document Feeder].
Preview window
Displays a preview image. Drag the rectangle over the image to select an
area.
[Preview]
Click to begin scanning a preview image.
[Scan]
Click to begin scanning.
[Cancel]
Click to close the WIA driver window.9-8 Macintosh TWAIN Driver Settings
Macintosh TWAIN Driver Settings
Mode settings
[Mode Settings]
Select [Basic Mode] for specifying basic settings, or select [Advanced Mode]
for specifying detailed settings.
The settings that can be specified differ for each mode.
When [Basic Mode] is selected
The following parameters can be set when [Basic Mode] is selected.
[Help] icon
Click to display Help information.
[About] icon
Click to display the software version information.
[Scan Objective]
Specify the document type.
[Scan Type]
Specify the scan type.
[Resolution]
Specify the resolution.
[Auto Color Adjustment]
Specify the auto color adjustment settings.
[Auto Deskew]
Specify settings for correcting the skew of the image.
[Paper source]
Specify the paper source.
When scanning documents from the ADF, select whether to scan only the
front side or both sides of the document.
[Original Size]
Specify the original size.
[Rotation]
Select the orientation of the image to be scanned.Macintosh TWAIN Driver Settings 9-9
" If the [Rotate back side] check box is selected, the back side of the
image is rotated 180° and scanned. (Applies only if [ADF (2-sided)] is
selected.)
[Image size]
Shows the data size of the scan image.
[Close]
Click to close the TWAIN driver window.
[Prescan]
Click to begin scanning a preview image.
[Scan]
Click to begin scanning.
[Clear] icon
Click to erase the preview image.
When [Advanced Mode] is selected
The following parameters can be set when [Advances Mode] is selected.
[Load]
Specify a saved settings file (dat file) for scanning.
[Save]
Save the current settings as a settings file (dat file).
[Default]
Return all settings to their defaults.
Help icon
Click to display the Help.
About icon
Click to display the software version information.
[Paper source]
Specify the paper source.
With scanning documents from the ADF, select whether to scan only the front
side or both sides of the document.
[Original Size]
Specify the original size.
[Scan Type]
Specify the scan type.9-10 Macintosh TWAIN Driver Settings
[Resolution]
Specify the resolution.
[Scale]
Specify the enlargement or reduction ratio for the selected area.
" If the resolution is set at 1200 × 1200dpi or higher, a setting larger
than 100% cannot be specified.
[Scanning Mode]
Select [Auto] or [Manual]. When [Manual] is selected, a tab appears so that
detailed settings can be specified, for example, for [Brightness/Contrast], [Filter], [Curves], [Levels], [Color Balance], and [Hue/Saturation].
" The parameters that can be set differ depending on the scanning
mode that is selected.
" The detailed settings that appear differ depending on the setting
selected for [Scan Type].
" If [Auto] is selected as the scanning mode, scanning from the original
glass is performed after a prescan is performed so that a preview
image can be checked.
[Image size]
Shows the data size of the scan image.
[Rotation]
Select the orientation of the image to be scanned.
" If the [Rotate back side] check box is selected, the back side of the
image is rotated 180° and scanned. (Applies only if [ADF (2-sided)] is
selected)
[Auto Deskew]
Specify settings for correcting the skew of the image.
[Close]
Click to close the TWAIN driver window.
[Prescan]
Click to begin scanning a preview image.
[Scan]
Click to begin scanning.
[AutoCrop] icon
Click to automatically detect the scanning position based on the preview
image.Macintosh TWAIN Driver Settings 9-11
[Zoom Prescan] icon
Click to rescan the area selected in the preview window and enlarge it to fit
the window.
[Mirror] icon
Click to display a mirror image of the preview image.
[Tone Reversal] icon
Click to reverse the colors of the preview image.
[Clear] icon
Click to erase the preview image.
Preview window
Displays a preview image. Drag the rectangle over the image to select an
area.
[Before (RGB)]/[After]
Move the pointer in the preview window to display the color tones at the
pointer’s position before and after adjustments.
[Width]/[Height]
Displays the width and height for the selected area in the selected measurement units.9-12 Using a Web Service
Using a Web Service
The scan command can be sent from a computer (Windows 7/Vista/Server
2008) on the network or this machine can scan using a specified operation,
and the scan data can be sent to a computer. The settings that must be specified in advance on the computer are described below.
Settings required to use a Web Service
The following settings are required in order to use a Web Service.
Install this machine on the computer.
Specify settings on the machine for using a Web Service.
" Specify the Web Service settings on the machine from the Admin Settings screen. For details, refer to the [Reference Guide].
Installing this machine on the computer
Confirmation before installation
Before installation, make sure that “Network Discovery” (Network and Sharing Center in Control Panel) is enabled.
Installation procedure
1 In the Start button menu, click “Network”.
The devices connected to the network appear.
2 Right-click the scanner icon for this machine, and then click “Install”.
– Depending on the settings specified on the computer, a UAC (User
Account Control) message may appear. Check the information
described in the message, and then continue with the procedure.
– If both scanning and printing using a Web Service have been enabled
on this machine, this machine appears as a printer icon.
– The driver software is automatically installed. After a confirmation
message appears, click [Close].
3 From the control panel of the machine, select [Scan to Folder] - [Direct
Input] - [Web Service Settings], and then check that a destination
appears.Using a Web Service 9-13
Specifying the scan command from a computer (Web
Service)
A computer can send the scan command to this machine, then receive the
scan data.
As an example, the procedure for scanning from the Windows Photo Gallery
is described below.
" The scan command can also be sent from this machine, where the
data will be saved. For details, refer to “With [Web Service Settings]”
on page 10-32.
Specifying the scan command from a computer
1 Start up the application used for scanning.
2 In the “File” menu, click “From Scanner or Camera”.
3 From the “Select Device” list, select this machine, and then click [OK].
The New Scan window appears.
4 Position the document on this machine.
– Specify the scan settings, and then click [Scan].
Scanning begins, and the scan data is added to the list of image files.9-14 Using a Web Service10
1Scanning with
the machine10-2 Initial settings
Initial settings
This machine is equipped with scanning functions for saving data on this
machine’s hard disk or on a USB memory device, and with network scanning
functions for sending scanned image data through the network with E-mail
transmissions, FTP transmissions, SMB transmissions, WebDAV transmissions and Web Service transmissions.
In order to perform an FTP transmission, a connection to the network is
required, and parameters must be specified on the [TCP/IP] and [FTP]
screens.
In order to perform an SMB transmission, a connection to the network is
required, and parameters must be specified on the [TCP/IP] and [SMB]
screens.
In order to perform a WebDAV transmission, a connection to the network
is required, and parameters must be specified on the [TCP/IP] and [WebDAV] screens.
In order to perform a Web Service transmission, a connection to the network is required, and parameters must be specified on the [TCP/IP] and
[WSD Print] screens.
In order to perform an E-mail transmission, a connection to the network is
required, parameters must be specified on the [TCP/IP] and [SMTP]
screens, and an E-mail address must be registered for [Administrator
Registration].
For details on specifying network settings, refer to the [Reference Guide].
Useful functions
The destinations (recipients) for scan data can be registered as address
book destinations or group destinations.
The destination and scan settings can be registered together as a single
program. This is convenient for frequently scanning documents and sending data under the same conditions.Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations 10-3
Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations
Basic Scan to E-mail operation
The basic procedure for the Scan to E-mail operation, which sends scan data
with an E-mail transmission, is described below.
1 Press [Scan to E-mail] to display the initial Scan to E-mail mode screen.
2 Place the document in the ADF or on the original glass.
– For details on loading the original document, refer to “Loading a Document” on page 4-36.
" If the document contains more pages than can be loaded into the ADF,
set [Settings] - [Original Settings] - [Separate Scan] to [ON] so that the
document can be divided and scanned separately. For details, refer to
“[Original Settings] - [Separate Scan]” on page 10-5.
" To scan multiple document pages using the original glass and send
them as combined scan data, set [Settings] - [Original Settings] - [Separate Scan] to [ON]. For details on [Separate Scan], refer to “[Original
Settings] - [Separate Scan]” on page 10-5.
3 Specify the destination.
– For details on specifying destinations, refer to “Specifying destinations” on page 10-14.
– In the initial Scan to E-mail mode screen, press [Mode Check] to
check or change the specified destinations.
4 If necessary, specify settings for other parameters in the [Settings] screen.
– For details on the [Simplex/Duplex], [Original Size], [Original Settings],
[Color Mode] and [Original Type] parameters available from the [Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying document settings” on page 10-4.
– For details on the [Background/Density], [Resolution] and [File Settings] parameters available from the [Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying scan settings” on page 10-8.
– For details on the [Communication] parameters available from the
[Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying communication settings” on
page 10-12.10-4 Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations
5 Press the [Start] key.
– Press the [Start (Color)] key to scan in color, or press the [Start (B&W)]
key to scan in black and white.
" This machine cannot automatically detect the size of an original document that will be scanned. Before scanning the document, specify its
size. If the size of the original document is not correctly specified,
some parts of the image may be lost. For details on specifying the size
of an original document, refer to “[Original Size]” on page 10-5.
" If the memory becomes full while the document is being scanned,
scanning cannot continue. To send the document pages that have
already been scanned, press the [Start] key. To stop the transmission,
press the [Stop] key.
Specifying document settings
The [Simplex/Duplex], [Original Size], [Original Settings], [Color Mode] and
[Original Type] parameters available from the [Settings] screen can be used
to specify document settings.
[Simplex/Duplex]
Select whether double-sided documents are to be scanned when the ADF is
used.
Item Description
[1-sided] Select this setting when scanning a single-sided
document.
[2-sided] Select this setting when scanning a doublesided document.
[Cover + 2-sided] Select this setting when scanning a doublesided document with a cover page. Only the
front side of the cover page will be scanned, and
then both the front and back sides of the remaining pages will be scanned.Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations 10-5
[Original Size]
Specify the size of the document that is to be sent.
[Original Settings] - [Separate Scan]
A document can be divided and scanned separately.
The scan operation can be divided into several sessions, for example, when
the document contains more pages than can be loaded into the ADF or when
the original glass is being used to scan a document containing multiple
pages, and then all scanned pages can be sent as a single document.
1 Place the document in the ADF or on the original glass.
2 Press [Scan to E-mail] to display the initial Scan to E-mail mode screen.
3 With [Original Settings] in the [Settings] screen, set [Separate Scan] to
[ON].
4 Press the [Start] key.
The document is scanned.
5 Place the next document page on the original glass, and then press the
[Start] key.
– Repeat this step until all document pages have been scanned.
6 After all pages of the document have been scanned, press [Finish].
Item Description
[Standard Size] Select the size of the document.
Select [Letter/Legal] to scan a document containing different page sizes.
[Custom Size] Specify the size of the document if it is a
non-standard size.
Press [X] and [Y], and then type in the document
size. [X] can be set between 30 mm and 356
mm (1.18 inches and 14.00 inches); [Y] can be
set between 30 mm and 216 mm (1.18 inches
and 8.50 inches).10-6 Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations
[Original Settings] - [Original Direction]
Specify the orientation of the document.
[Original Settings] - [Orig. Binding Position]
Specify the binding position when scanning a double-sided document using
the ADF. The orientation of the back sides of the pages differs depending on
whether the double-sided document will be bound at the top or at the left.
Item Description
[Top] Select this setting when the document is loaded
with its top edge at the top.
[Bottom] Select this setting when the document is loaded
with its top edge at the bottom.
[Left] Select this setting when the document is loaded
with its top edge at the left (at the right when
placed on the original glass).
[Right] Select this setting when the document is loaded
with its top edge at the right (at the left when
placed on the original glass).
Item Description
[Left Bind] Select this setting to specify a binding position at
the left.
[Top Bind] Select this setting to specify a binding position at
the top.
[Auto] Select this setting to automatically specify the
binding position.
If the document length is 297 mm (11.69 inches)
or less, a binding position along the long side of
the paper is selected.
If the document length is more than 297 mm
(11.69 inches), a binding position along the short
side of the paper is selected.Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations 10-7
[Color Mode]
Select whether the document will be scanned in color or black and white.
" [Black] may not be available, depending on the setting selected for
[File Type].
[Original Type]
Select the appropriate image quality setting according to content of the document.
Item Description
[Color] [Auto] Select this setting to automatically detect
the color of the document and scan it with
the corresponding setting.
[Full Color] Select this setting to scan in full color.
[Monochrome] [Gray Scale] Select this setting for documents with
many halftones, such as in
black-and-white photos.
[Black] Select this setting for documents with distinct black and white areas, such as in line
drawings.
Item Description
[Text] Select this setting when scanning documents
containing only text.
[Text/Photo] Select this setting when scanning documents
containing a combination of text and photos.
[Photo] Select this setting when scanning documents
containing only photos.10-8 Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations
Specifying scan settings
The [Background/Density], [Resolution] and [File Settings] parameters available from the [Settings] screen can be used to specify scan settings.
[Background/Density]
Specify the appropriate image quality settings for the document.
[Resolution]
Select the resolution at which the document is to be scanned.
" A finer scan has more information to be sent, therefore, the transmission time increases.
" If [File Type] is set to [Compact PDF], [Resolution] can only be set to
[300×300dpi].
Item Description
[Background Removal] Select the density of the background color at
which documents with a background color are to
be scanned. Nine density levels are available for
the background color.
[Density] Select the density at which the document is to
be scanned. Nine density levels are available.
Select the appropriate density setting according
to your document.
[Sharpness] Select the strength of outlines, for example, on
characters and lines, for scanning the document. To scan characters and lines with greater
sharpness, select a setting in the + direction.
Seven sharpness levels are available.
Item Description
[150×150dpi] Select this setting to scan the document at 150
× 150 dpi.
[200×200dpi] Select this setting to scan the document at 200
× 200 dpi.
[300×300dpi] Select this setting to scan the document at 300
× 300 dpi.
[600×600dpi] Select this setting to scan the document at 600
× 600 dpi.Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations 10-9
[File Settings] - [File Type]
Select the file format for the scan data to be saved.
" The [File Type] parameter may not be available, depending on the settings selected for [Color Mode] and [Resolution].
" If [File Type] is set to [Compact PDF], [Resolution] can only be set to
[300×300dpi].
[File Settings] - [Scan Setting]
Select whether the data is divided into individual pages or multi-page data is
created when multiple pages are scanned.
Item Description
[PDF] Select this setting to save the data in the PDF
format.
[Compact PDF] Select this setting to save the data compressed
more than with the PDF format.
[TIFF] Select this setting to save data in the TIFF format.
[JPEG] Select this setting to save the data in the JPEG
format.
[XPS] Select this setting to save data in the XPS format.
Item Description
[Single Page] Select this setting to save the data divided into
individual pages.
[Multi Page] Select this setting to save the scan as
multi-page data.10-10 Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations
[File Settings] - [PDF Encrypt]
Specify the encryption settings when [PDF] or [Compact PDF] is selected.
Item Description
[Encryption
Level]
[Yes] Select this setting to enable encryption.
After selecting this setting, set the encryption level to [Low], [Middle] or [High].
[No] Select this setting to disable encryption.
[Password] Type in the password required to open
encrypted data. (up to 32 characters)
[Document Permissions] Type in the password required to change
the permissions for a document. (up to 32
characters)Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations 10-11
[Details] If encryption has been enabled, detailed
permission settings can be specified.
"This appears only if [Encryption
Level] is set to [Yes] and a
password has been specified for
[Document Permissions].
[Printing
Allowed]
Select whether to allow the data to be
printed ([Allow]), to prohibit printing
([Restrict]), or to allow printing only at a
low resolution ([Low Resolution]).
[Changes
Allowed]
Select whether to allow or prohibit document editing, such as signing, entering text
and annotating the data, and select the
permission level if it is allowed.
[Level 1]: Pages can be inserted, deleted
and rotated.
[Level 2]: Annotations can be created,
data can be entered in form fields, and signatures can be added to existing signature
fields.
[Level 3]: All operations, except page
extracting, can be performed.
[Level 4]: Data can be entered in form
fields, and signatures can be added to
existing signature fields.
[Level 5]: The page layout can be
changed, data can be entered in form
fields, and signatures can be added to
existing signature fields.
"Levels 1, 2, 3 and 5 appear only
when [Encryption Level] is set to
[Low]. Levels 1, 2, 3 and 4 appear
when [Encryption Level] is set to
[Middle] or [High].
[Enable Copying]
Select whether to allow text and images in
a document to be copied ([Allow]) or to
prohibit it ([Restrict]).
Item Description10-12 Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations
Specifying communication settings
The [Communication] parameters available from the [Settings] screen can be
used to specify settings for E-mail transmissions.
[Binary Division]
Select whether or not transmission data is divided.
[E-mail Encryption]
[Send Use Signature]
Item Description
[ON] Select this setting to divide transmission data.
[OFF] Select this setting to not divide transmission
data.
[Admin. Setting] The setting specified with [Admin Settings] -
[Ethernet] - [Binary Division] is given priority.
Description
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Specify settings for E-mail encryption.
Description
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a digital signature is applied to E-mail
messages.Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations 10-13
[E-mail]
Specify the subject and address of E-mail messages.
Item Description
[File Name] Type in the document name for the scan data.
[Subject] Type in the subject for E-mail messages.
[From] Specify the sender’s address.
Select [Administrator E-mail Addr.] or [User
Address], or type it in directly.
[Body] Type in the body text for the E-mail message.10-14 Specifying destinations
Specifying destinations
Use any of the following methods to specify destinations.
“Selecting from registered destinations” on page 10-27
“Directly typing in the address” on page 10-29
“Selecting from the log” on page 10-32
Selecting from registered destinations
An address book destination or group destination can be selected from those
previously registered on the machine.
" In order to select a registered destination, address book destinations
and group destinations must first be registered on the machine. For
details, refer to “Registering destinations” on page 10-34.
" In [User Settings] - [Machine Settings] - [Scan to E-mail Default Tab],
you can specify the default destination tab in the Scan to E-mail mode
screen. For details, refer to “[Machine Settings]” on page 3-13.
Selecting from the Favorites list
When destinations are registered, they can be specified as [Favorites].
As a default, the [Favorites] destination list appears when the initial Scan to
E-mail mode screen is displayed.
Select a destination from the list. To specify multiple destinations for a broadcast transmission, specify all destinations where the data is to be sent.
" The setting for the Favorites list can be specified for a destination
when it is registered. For details, refer to “Registering an address book
destination” on page 10-35.Specifying destinations 10-15
Selecting with an index search
Destinations can be selected by searching for the index characters specified
when each destination was registered.
1 In the initial Scan to E-mail mode screen, press .
2 Press the desired index tab to search for destinations.
– If the desired index tab is not displayed, press [ ] or [ ] until the
desired tab appears.
– To select a group destination, press [Group].
3 Select the destination, and then press [OK].
" To specify multiple destinations, specify all destinations where the
data is to be sent.
Selecting by searching for a destination type or name
Destinations can be selected by searching for their type or name.
1 In the initial Scan to E-mail mode screen, press .
2 Press [Search].
3 Select the method to search for destinations.
– [Type]: Select the destination type (“Fax”, “E-mail”, etc.).
– [Name]: Directly enter the name of the destination to be searched for.
Type in the name to be searched for, and then press [OK] to display a
list of the search results.
4 Select the destination, and then press [OK].
– To specify multiple destinations, select all destinations where the data
is to be sent.
5 Press [OK].10-16 Specifying destinations
Directly typing in the address
To specify a destination that is not registered with the machine, directly type
in the address.
1 In the initial Scan to E-mail mode screen, press [Direct Input].
2 Press [E-mail].
3 Type in the E-mail address.
4 Press [OK].
" To specify multiple destinations, specify all destinations where the
data is to be sent.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Manual
Destination Input] is set to [Restrict], an address cannot be directly
typed in. For details on [Manual Destination Input], refer to “[Security
Settings]” on page 3-70.
Selecting from the log
A destination can be selected from the log of the last five transmissions.
1 In the initial Scan to E-mail mode screen, press [Log].
2 Select the destination from the list, and then press the [Start] key.
" Only one destination can be selected from the log.
" The only destinations that appear in the log are those specified after
pressing [Direct Input].
In addition, destinations specified with broadcast transmissions do not
appear in the log.
" When the machine is turned off, the log is cleared.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Disable
Job History Display] is set to [ON], a destination cannot be selected
from the log.Specifying destinations 10-17
Selecting a program destination
Data can be sent with a program destination previously registered on the
machine.
Program destinations are registered with destinations where data is frequently sent together with scan settings allowing data to easily be sent without the trouble of specifying the various settings.
" In order to select a program destination, the program destination must
first be registered on the machine. For details, refer to “Registering a
program destination” on page 10-37.
1 Press [Scan to E-mail] to display the initial Scan to E-mail mode screen.
– For details on the initial Fax screen, refer to “Initial Scan to E-mail
mode screen” on page 2-9.
2 Position the document to be scanned.
– For details on loading the original document, refer to “Loading a Document” on page 4-36.
3 Press the [Mode Memory] key.
4 Select the desired program destination from the list, and then press [OK].
The settings and destination addresses are recalled.
" Only one program destination can be selected.
5 Press the [Start] key.
– Press the [Start (Color)] key to scan in color, or press the [Start (B&W)]
key to scan in black and white.10-18 Performing Scan to Folder mode operations
Performing Scan to Folder mode operations
Basic Scan to Folder operation
The basic procedure for the Scan to Folder operation, which sends scan data
to the machine’s hard disk, a USB memory device or to a folder on the network, is described below.
1 Press [Scan to Folder] to display the initial Scan to Folder mode screen.
2 Place the document in the ADF or on the original glass.
– For details on loading the original document, refer to “Loading a Document” on page 4-36.
" If the document contains more pages than can be loaded into the ADF,
set [Settings] - [Original Settings] - [Separate Scan] to [ON] so that the
document can be divided and scanned separately. For details, refer to
“[Original Settings] - [Separate Scan]” on page 10-21.
" To scan multiple document pages using the original glass and send
them as combined scan data, set [Settings] - [Original Settings] - [Separate Scan] to [ON]. For details on “Separate Scan”, refer to “[Original
Settings] - [Separate Scan]” on page 10-21.
3 Specify the destination.
– For details on specifying destinations, refer to “Specifying destinations” on page 10-27.
– In the initial Scan to Folder mode screen, press [Mode Check] to
check or change the specified destinations.
4 If necessary, specify settings for other parameters in the [Settings] screen.
– For details on the [Simplex/Duplex], [Original Size], [Original Settings],
[Color Mode] and [Original Type] parameters available from the [Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying document settings” on page 10-20.
– For details on the [Background/Density], [Resolution] and [File Settings] parameters available from the [Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying scan settings” on page 10-23.
– For details on the [File Name] parameter available from the [Settings]
screen, refer to “Specifying the document name” on page 10-26.
– For details on the [Communication] parameters available from the
[Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying communication settings” on
page 10-27.Performing Scan to Folder mode operations 10-19
5 Press the [Start] key.
– Press the [Start (Color)] key to scan in color, or press the [Start (B&W)]
key to scan in black and white.
" This machine cannot automatically detect the size of an original document that will be scanned. Before scanning the document, specify its
size. If the size of the original document is not correctly specified,
some parts of the image may be lost. For details on specifying the size
of an original document, refer to “[Original Size]” on page 10-20.
" If the memory becomes full while the document is being scanned,
scanning cannot continue. To send the document pages that have
already been scanned, press the [Start] key. To stop the transmission,
press the [Stop] key.
" To check a scan job, press [Job], and then press [Save] in the [Log]
screen.10-20 Performing Scan to Folder mode operations
Specifying document settings
The [Simplex/Duplex], [Original Size], [Original Settings], [Color Mode] and
[Original Type] parameters available from the [Settings] screen can be used
to specify document settings.
[Simplex/Duplex]
Select whether double-sided documents are to be scanned when the ADF is
used.
[Original Size]
Specify the size of the document that is to be sent.
Item Description
[1-sided] Select this setting when scanning a single-sided
document.
[2-sided] Select this setting when scanning a doublesided document.
[Cover + 2-sided] Select this setting when scanning a doublesided document with a cover page. Only the
front side of the cover page will be scanned, and
then both the front and back sides of the remaining pages will be scanned.
Item Description
[Standard Size] Select the size of the document.
Select [Letter/Legal] to scan a document containing different page sizes.
[Custom Size] Specify the size of the document if it is a
non-standard size.
Press [X] and [Y], and then type in the document
size. [X] can be set between 30 mm and 356
mm (1.18 inches and 14.00 inches); [Y] can be
set between 30 mm and 216 mm (1.18 inches
and 8.50 inches).Performing Scan to Folder mode operations 10-21
[Original Settings] - [Separate Scan]
A document can be divided and scanned separately.
The scan operation can be divided into several sessions, for example, when
the document contains more pages than can be loaded into the ADF or when
the original glass is being used to scan a document containing multiple
pages, and then all scanned pages can be sent as a single document.
1 Place the document in the ADF or on the original glass.
2 Press [Scan to Folder] to display the initial Scan to Folder mode screen.
3 With [Original Settings] in the [Settings] screen, set [Separate Scan] to
[Yes].
4 Press the [Start] key.
The document is scanned.
5 Place the next document page on the original glass, and then press the
[Start] key.
Repeat this step until all document pages have been scanned.
6 After all pages of the document have been scanned, press [Finish].
[Original Settings] - [Original Direction]
Specify the orientation of the document.
Item Description
[Top] Select this setting when the document is loaded
with its top edge at the top.
[Bottom] Select this setting when the document is loaded
with its top edge at the bottom.
[Left] Select this setting when the document is loaded
with its top edge at the left (at the right when
placed on the original glass).
[Right] Select this setting when the document is loaded
with its top edge at the right (at the left when
placed on the original glass).10-22 Performing Scan to Folder mode operations
[Original Settings] - [Orig. Binding Position]
Specify the binding position when scanning a double-sided document using
the ADF. The orientation of the back sides of the pages differs depending on
whether the double-sided document will be bound at the top or at the left.
[Color Mode]
Select whether the document will be scanned in color or black and white.
" [Black] may not be available, depending on the setting selected for
[File Type].
Item Description
[Left Bind] Select this setting to specify a binding position at
the left.
[Top Bind] Select this setting to specify a binding position at
the top.
[Auto] Select this setting to automatically specify the
binding position.
If the document length is 297 mm (11.69 inches)
or less, a binding position along the long side of
the paper is selected.
If the document length is more than 297 mm
(11.69 inches), a binding position along the short
side of the paper is selected.
Item Description
[Color] [Auto] Select this setting to automatically detect the
color of the document and scan it with the corresponding setting.
[Full Color] Select this setting to scan in full color.
[Monochrome]
[GrayScale] Select this setting for documents with many
halftones, such as in black-and-white photos.
[Black] Select this setting for documents with distinct
black and white areas, such as in line drawings.Performing Scan to Folder mode operations 10-23
[Original Type]
Select the appropriate image quality setting according to the content of the
document.
Specifying scan settings
The [Background/Density], [Resolution] and [File Settings] parameters available from the [Settings] screen can be used to specify scan settings.
[Background/Density]
Specify the appropriate image quality settings for the document.
Item Description
[Text] Select this setting when scanning documents
containing only text.
[Text/Photo] Select this setting when scanning documents
containing a combination of text and photos.
[Photo] Select this setting when scanning documents
containing only photos.
Item Description
[Background Removal] Select the density of the background color at
which documents with a background color are to
be scanned. Nine density levels are available for
the background color.
[Density] Select the density at which the document is to
be scanned. Nine density levels are available.
Select the appropriate density setting according
to your document.
[Sharpness] Select the strength of outlines, for example, on
characters and lines, for scanning the document. To scan characters and lines with greater
sharpness, select a setting in the + direction.
Seven sharpness levels are available.10-24 Performing Scan to Folder mode operations
[Resolution]
Select the resolution at which the document is to be scanned.
" A finer scan has more information to be sent, therefore, the transmission time increases.
" If [File Type] is set to [Compact PDF], [Resolution] can only be set to
[300×300dpi].
[File Settings] - [File Type]
Select the file format for the scan data to be saved.
" The [File Type] parameter may not be available, depending on the settings selected for [Color Mode] and [Resolution].
" If [File Type] is set to [Compact PDF], [Resolution] can only be set to
[300×300dpi].
Item Description
[150×150dpi] Select this setting to scan the document at 150
× 150 dpi.
[200×200dpi] Select this setting to scan the document at 200
× 200 dpi.
[300×300dpi] Select this setting to scan the document at 300
× 300 dpi.
[600×600dpi] Select this setting to scan the document at 600
× 600 dpi.
Item Description
[PDF] Select this setting to save the data in the PDF
format.
[Compact PDF] Select this setting to save the data compressed
more than with the PDF format.
[TIFF] Select this setting to save data in the TIFF format.
[JPEG] Select this setting to save the data in the JPEG
format.
[XPS] Select this setting to save data in the XPS format.Performing Scan to Folder mode operations 10-25
[File Settings] - [Scan Setting]
Select whether the data is divided into individual pages or multi-page data is
created when multiple pages are scanned.
[File Settings] - [PDF Encrypt]
Specify the encryption settings when [PDF] or [Compact PDF] is selected.
Item Description
[Single Page] Select this setting to save the data divided into
individual pages.
[Multi Page] Select this setting to save the scan as
multi-page data.
Item Description
[Encryption Level]
[Yes] Select this setting to enable encryption. After
selecting this setting, set the encryption level to
[Low], [Middle] or [High].
[No] Select this setting to disable encryption.
[Password] Type in the password required to open encrypted
data. (up to 32 characters)
[Document Permissions] Type in the password required to change the permissions for a document. (up to 32 characters)10-26 Performing Scan to Folder mode operations
Specifying the document name
Specify the document name for the scan data.
[Details] If encryption has been enabled, detailed permission settings can be specified.
"This appears only if [Encryption Level] is set
to [Yes] and a password has been specified
for [Document Permissions].
[Printing
Allowed]
Select whether to allow the data to be printed
([Allow]), to prohibit printing ([Restrict]), or to allow
printing only at a low resolution ([Low Resolution]).
[Changes
Allowed]
Select whether to allow or prohibit document editing, such as signing, entering text and annotating
the data, and select the permission level if it is
allowed.
[Level 1]: Pages can be inserted, deleted and
rotated.
[Level 2]: Annotations can be created, data can be
entered in form fields, and signatures can be
added to existing signature fields.
[Level 3]: All operations, except page extracting,
can be performed.
[Level 4]: Data can be entered in form fields, and
signatures can be added to existing signature
fields.
[Level 5]: The page layout can be changed, data
can be entered in form fields, and signatures can
be added to existing signature fields.
"Levels 1, 2, 3 and 5 appear only when
[Encryption Level] is set to [Low]. Levels 1,
2, 3 and 4 appear when [Encryption Level]
is set to [Middle] or [High].
[Enable
Copying]
Select whether to allow text and images in a document to be copied ([Allow]) or to prohibit it
([Restrict]).
Item Description
[File Name] Type in the document name for the scan data.Specifying destinations 10-27
Specifying communication settings
The [Communication] parameters available from the [Settings] screen can be
used to specify settings for sending job completion notifications by E-mail.
[URL Notification]
[URL Notification Destination]
Specifying destinations
Use any of the following methods to specify destinations.
“Selecting from registered destinations” on page 10-27
“Directly typing in the address” on page 10-29
“Selecting from the log” on page 10-32
Selecting from registered destinations
An address book destination or group destination can be selected from those
previously registered on the machine.
" In order to select a registered destination, address book destinations
and group destinations must first be registered on the machine. For
details, refer to “Registering destinations” on page 10-34.
" In [User Settings] - [Machine Settings] - [Scan to Folder Default Tab],
you can specify the default destination tab in the Scan to Folder mode
screen. For details, refer to “[Machine Settings]” on page 3-13.
Description
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Specify whether or not notifications of completion of a job are
to be sent by E-mail.
Description
Specify the E-mail address where notifications of completion of
a job are to be sent.10-28 Specifying destinations
Selecting from the Favorites list
When destinations are registered, they can be specified as [Favorites].
As a default, the [Favorites] destination list appears when the initial Scan to
Folder mode screen is displayed.
Select a destination from the list. To specify multiple destinations for a broadcast transmission, specify all destinations where the data is to be sent.
" The setting for the Favorites list can be specified for a destination
when it is registered. For details, refer to “Registering an address book
destination” on page 10-35.
Selecting with an index search
Destinations can be selected by searching for the index characters specified
when each destination was registered.
1 In the initial Scan to Folder mode screen, press .
2 Press the desired index tab to search for destinations.
– If the desired index tab is not displayed, press [ ] or [ ] until the
desired tab appears.
– To select a group destination, press [Group].
3 Select the destination, and then press [OK].
– To specify multiple destinations, specify all destinations where the
data is to be sent.
Selecting by searching for a destination type or name
Destinations can be selected by searching for their type or name.
1 In the initial Scan to Folder mode screen, press .
2 Press [Search].
3 Select the method to search for destinations.
– [Type]: Select the destination type (“FTP”, “SMB”, “WebDAV”, etc.).
– [Name]: Directly enter the name of the destination to be searched for.
Type in the name to be searched for, and then press [OK] to display a
list of the search results.
4 Select the destination, and then press [OK].
– To specify multiple destinations, select all destinations where the data
is to be sent.
5 Press [OK].Specifying destinations 10-29
Directly typing in the address
To specify a destination that is not registered with the machine, directly type
in the address.
With [FTP]
1 In the initial Scan to Folder mode screen, press [Direct Input].
2 Press [FTP].
3 Specify settings for [Host Name], [File Path], [User Name] and [Password]
for the destination computer.
4 If necessary, specify settings for other parameters in the [Details] screen.
– [Pasv]: Select whether or not the PASV mode is used.
– [Proxy]: Select whether or not a proxy server is used.
– [Port No.]: Type in the port number. (Range: 1 to 65535)
5 Press [OK].
" To specify multiple destinations, specify the various settings, press
[Next Dest.], and then specify the settings for the next FTP destination.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Manual
Destination Input] is set to [Restrict], an address cannot be directly
typed in. For details on [Manual Destination Input], refer to “[Security
Settings]” on page 3-70.
With [PC(SMB)]
1 In the initial Scan to Folder mode screen, press [Direct Input].
2 Press [PC(SMB)].
3 Specify settings for [Host Name], [File Path], [User Name] and [Password]
for the destination computer.
4 If necessary, press [Browse], and then browse to a shared folder to specify it.10-30 Specifying destinations
5 Press [OK].
" To specify multiple destinations, specify the various settings, press
[Next Dest.], and then specify the settings for the next SMB destination.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Manual
Destination Input] is set to [Restrict], an address cannot be directly
typed in. For details on [Manual Destination Input], refer to “[Security
Settings]” on page 3-70.
With [WebDAV]
1 In the initial Scan to Folder mode screen, press [Direct Input].
2 Press [WebDAV].
3 Specify settings for [Host Name], [File Path], [User Name] and [Password]
for the destination computer.
4 If necessary, specify settings for other parameters in the [Details] screen.
– [Port No.]: Type in the port number. (Range: 1 to 65535)
– [Proxy]: Select whether or not a proxy server is used.
– [SSL Setting]: Select whether or not SSL is used.
5 Press [OK].
" To specify multiple destinations, specify the various settings, press
[Next Dest.], and then specify the settings for the next WebDAV destination.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Manual
Destination Input] is set to [Restrict], an address cannot be directly
typed in. For details on [Manual Destination Input], refer to “[Security
Settings]” on page 3-70.
With [USB Memory]
1 Plug the USB memory device into the USB HOST port.
2 In the initial Scan to Folder mode screen, press [Direct Input].
3 Press [USB Memory].
" If a USB memory device has not already been plugged in, [USB Memory] is not available.
4 Specify a setting for [Document Name].Specifying destinations 10-31
5 Press [OK].
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Manual
Destination Input] is set to [Restrict], an address cannot be directly
typed in. For details on [Manual Destination Input], refer to “[Security
Settings]” on page 3-70.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Restrict
Scan to USB] is set to [Restrict], [USB Memory] is not available. For
details on [Restrict Scan to USB], refer to “[Security Settings]” on
page 3-70.
" With a USB Memory transmission, only one destination can be specified.
With [HDD]
1 In the initial Scan to Folder mode screen, press [Direct Input].
2 Press [HDD].
3 Press [Save Document].
4 If user authentication settings have been specified, select [Public] or [Private].
5 Specify a setting for [Document Name].
6 Press [OK].
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Manual
Destination Input] is set to [Restrict], an address cannot be directly
typed in. For details on [Manual Destination Input], refer to “[Security
Settings]” on page 3-70.
" With an HDD transmission, only one destination can be specified.
" Scan data saved on the hard disk can be saved to a computer by
copying it with PageScope Web Connection. For details, refer to the
[Reference Guide].10-32 Specifying destinations
With [Web Service Settings]
With a Web Service transmission, scan data can be sent to a previously registered network computer.
Network computers where this machine is registered as a Web Service scanner appear as destinations. Select a destination.
1 In the initial Scan to Folder mode screen, press [Direct Input].
2 Press [Web Service Settings].
3 Select the destination.
– If the desired destination is not displayed, press [Search], and then
type in the destination name to be searched for.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Manual
Destination Input] is set to [Restrict], an address cannot be directly
typed in. For details on [Manual Destination Input], refer to “[Security
Settings]” on page 3-70.
" With a Web Service transmission, only one destination can be specified.
" With WSD scanning on Windows Server 2008 R2/7/Vista/Server
2008, it may not be possible to specify a resolution or document size.
Selecting from the log
A destination can be selected from the log of the last five transmissions.
1 In the initial Scan to Folder mode screen, press [Log].
2 Select the destination from the list, and then press the [Start] key.
" Only one destination can be selected from the log.
" The only destinations that appear in the log are those specified after
pressing [Direct Input].
In addition, destinations specified with broadcast transmissions do not
appear in the log.
" When the machine is turned off, the log is cleared.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Disable
Job History Display] is set to [ON], a destination cannot be selected
from the log.Specifying destinations 10-33
Selecting a program destination
Data can be sent with a program destination previously registered on the
machine.
Program destinations are registered with destinations where data is frequently sent together with scan settings allowing data to easily be sent without the trouble of specifying the various settings.
" In order to select a program destination, the program destination must
first be registered on the machine. For details, refer to “Registering a
program destination” on page 10-37.
1 Press [Scan to Folder] to display the initial Scan to Folder mode screen.
2 Position the document to be scanned.
– For details on loading the original document, refer to “Loading a Document” on page 4-36.
3 Press the [Mode Memory] key.
4 Select the desired program destination from the list, and then press [OK].
The settings and destination addresses are recalled.
" Only one program destination can be selected.
5 Press the [Start] key.
– Press the [Start (Color)] key to scan in color, or press the [Start (B&W)]
key to scan in black and white.10-34 Registering destinations
Registering destinations
Destination registration
By registering destinations where scan data is frequently sent, recipients can
be recalled allowing a data to easily be sent. With this machine, address book
destinations, group destinations and program destinations can be registered.
Address Book
The information for destinations (E-mail addresses and computer folders,
etc.) where data is frequently sent can be registered. A destination can
selected from the address book when scanning. A maximum of 2,000
address book destinations can be registered.
E-mail and SMB address book destinations can be registered from the control
panel of this machine or from PageScope Web Connection. For details on
registering, refer to “Registering an address book destination” on page 10-35.
Computer folder FTP and WebDAV destinations are registered only from
PageScope Web Connection. For details, refer to the [Reference Guide].
Group
Multiple address book destinations can be registered together as a group.
This is useful when sending the same scan data to multiple destinations. A
maximum of 100 group destinations (with a maximum of 500 address book
destinations per group) can be registered.
Group destinations are registered from PageScope Web Connection. For
details on registering, refer to the [Reference Guide].
Program
Destinations where scan data is frequently sent can be registered together
with scan settings (scan settings, document settings, etc.). During scanning,
a program destination can be recalled by pressing the [Mode Memory] key in
the control panel. A maximum of 400 program destinations can be registered.
For details on registering, refer to “Registering a program destination” on
page 10-37.Registering destinations 10-35
Registering an address book destination
The procedure for registering an address book destination for scan data is
described below.
E-mail address book destinations can be registered from the control panel of
this machine or from PageScope Web Connection. The following procedure
describes how to register from the control panel of this machine.
" For details on registering from PageScope Web Connection, refer to
the [Reference Guide].
" FTP, SMB, and WebDAV destinations can be registered only from the
PageScope Web Connection. For details on registering from PageScope Web Connection, refer to the [Reference Guide].
" For details on specifying an address book destination to send scan
data, refer to “Selecting from registered destinations” on page 10-27.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Registering and Changing Addr.] is set to [Restrict], a destination cannot be
registered from the control panel.
Registering an address book destination (E-mail
transmission)
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Address Registration].
3 Press [E-mail].
4 Press [New].
– To view the information registered for a destination, select the registered destination, and then press [Mode Check]. To delete the destination, press [Delete] in the [Mode Check] screen.
5 Enter the information for the destination, and then press [OK].
Item Description
[Name] Type in the registration name for the address
book destination. (up to 72 bytes)
[E-mail address] Type in the E-mail address of the recipient. (up
to 320 characters)10-36 Registering destinations
6 Press [OK].
Registering Address Book (SMB transmission)
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Address Registration].
3 Press [SMB].
4 Press [New].
– To view the information registered for a destination, select the registered destination, and then press [Mode Check]. To delete the destination, press [Delete] in the [Mode Check] screen.
5 Enter the information for the destination, and then press [OK].
6 Press [OK].
[Favorites] For frequently used destinations, set to [ON].
This displays the destination in the [Favorites]
list, allowing it to be found more easily.
[Index] Select the index characters that will be used to
search for the destination.
Item Description
[Name] Type in the registration name for the address
book destination. (up to 72 bytes)
[Connection] Specify [Host Name], [File Path], [User Name]
and [Password] for the destination computer.
If necessary, use [Browse] to search for the
shared folder.
[Favorites] For frequently used destinations, set to [ON].
This displays the destination in the [Favorites]
list, allowing it to be found more easily.
[Index] Select the index characters that will be used to
search for the destination.Registering destinations 10-37
Registering a program destination
The procedure for registering a program destination for scan transmissions is
described below.
Program destinations can be registered from the control panel of this
machine or from PageScope Web Connection. The following procedure
describes how to register from the control panel of this machine.
" For details on registering from PageScope Web Connection, refer to
the [Reference Guide].
" For details on specifying a program destination to send scan data,
refer to “Selecting a program destination” on page 10-33.
1 Press [Scan to E-mail] or [Scan to Folder] to display the initial Scan to
E-mail or Scan to Folder mode screen.
2 Specify settings for the various parameters available from the [Settings]
screen.
– For details on the parameters available from the Settings screen, refer
to “Performing Scan to E-mail mode operations” on page 10-3 and
“Performing Scan to Folder mode operations” on page 10-18.
3 In the control panel, press the [Mode Memory] key.
The list of program destinations appears.
4 Press [Register].
5 Specify settings for [Name] and [Dest.] for the program destination, and
then press [OK].
– Press to display the address book screen. Select a registered
destination.
6 Press [OK].10-38 Registering destinations11 Replacing
Consumables11-2 Replacing Consumables
Replacing Consumables
Note
Failure to follow instructions as outlined in this manual could result in
voiding your warranty.
Note
If the toner has run out or the time to replace the transfer belt unit has been
reached, an error message appears. Refer to “Error messages” on
page 13-39.
When the time to replace the transfer belt unit has been reached, print a
configuration page, and then check the status of the consumables. For
details on printing the configuration page, refer to “Printing a configuration
page” on page 13-2.
About Toner Cartridges
Your machine uses four toner cartridges: black, yellow, magenta, and cyan.
Handle the toner cartridges carefully to avoid spilling toner inside the machine
or on yourself.
" When replacing the toner cartridges, install only new cartridges. If a
used toner cartridge is installed, the amount of remaining toner may
not appear correctly.
" Do not open the toner cartridge unnecessarily. If toner is spilled, avoid
inhaling it or allowing it to come in contact with your skin.
" If toner gets on your hands or clothes, immediately wash them with
soap and water.
" If toner was inhaled, move to an area with fresh air, and gargle thoroughly with a large quantity of water. If conditions such as coughing
appear, seek professional medical attention.
" If toner gets in your eyes, immediately flush them with water for at
least 15 minutes. If any irritation persists, seek professional medical
attention.
" If toner gets in your mouth, thoroughly rinse it, and then drink 1 to 2
cups of water. If necessary, seek professional medical attention.
" Store toner cartridges out of the reach of children.Replacing Consumables 11-3
" Refer to the following URL for recycling information.
US: http://kmbs.konicaminolta.us/content/environment/cleanplanetmcpp.html
Europe: http://cleanplanet.konicaminolta.eu/
Other regions: konicaminolta.com
Note
The use of non-genuine toner cartridges may result in unstable
performance. In addition, any damage caused by the use of
non-genuine toner cartridges is not covered by the warranty, even if it
occurs during the warranty period. (Although damage is not certain to
result from using non-genuine toner cartridges, we strongly
recommend that you use genuine toner cartridges.)
Keep toner cartridges:
In their packaging until you’re ready to install them.
In a cool, dry location away from sunlight (due to heat).
The maximum storage temperature is 35°C (95°F) and the maximum
storage humidity is 85% (noncondensing). If the toner cartridge is moved
from a cold place to a warm, humid place, condensation may occur,
degrading print quality. Allow the toner to adapt to the environment for
about one hour before use.
Level during handling and storage.
Do not turn cartridges upside down; the toner inside the cartridges may
become caked or unequally distributed.
Away from salty air and corrosive gases such as aerosols.11-4 Replacing Consumables
Replacing a Toner Cartridge
Note
Be careful not to spill toner while replacing a toner cartridge. If toner
spills, immediately wipe it off with a soft, dry cloth.
When the toner is empty, the message [Replace Toner (x)] appears in the
touch panel.
Follow the instructions below to replace the toner cartridge. As an example,
the procedure for replacing the yellow toner cartridge is described below.
1 Open the machine’s front cover.Replacing Consumables 11-5
2 Pull the front lever of the color
toner cartridge indicated to the
left.
The replacement procedure for
the toner cartridge is the same
for all colors (yellow: Y, magenta:
M, cyan: C, and black: K).
The following instructions show
the procedure to replace the
toner cartridge (Y).
3 Grab the handle of the toner cartridge to be replaced, and then
pull out the cartridge.
The following instructions show
the procedure to replace the
toner cartridge(Y).
Note
Dispose of the used toner cartridge according to your local regulations.
Do not burn the toner cartridge.
For details, refer to “About Toner Cartridges” on page 11-2.
4 Check the color of the new toner cartridge to be installed.
Y M C K11-6 Replacing Consumables
5 Remove the toner cartridge from
the bag.
6 Shake the cartridge to distribute
the toner.
7 Peel off the protective film from
the right side of the toner cartridge.
3 ×Replacing Consumables 11-7
8 Make sure that the toner cartridge is the same color as the
machine compartment, and then
insert the toner cartridge into the
machine.
" Fully insert the toner cartridge.
9 Pull the lever to the right to lock
it in place.
" The front lever should be
securely returned to its
original position; otherwise, the front cover of
the machine cannot be
closed.
" If it is difficult to operate
the lever, push it in.
10 Make sure that the toner cartridge is securely installed, and
then peel off the protective film.11-8 Replacing Consumables
11 Close the front cover.
" When closing the front
cover, press the area of
the cover with small projections.Replacing Consumables 11-9
Replacing a Imaging Unit
Note
Do not touch the OPC drum
surface. This could lower image
quality.
If the messages [Replace Imaging Unit] appear, replace the specified imaging
unit. As an example, the procedure for replacing the black imaging unit is
described below.
1 Check the message window to see which color imaging unit needs replacing.11-10 Replacing Consumables
2 Open the machine’s front cover.
3 Pull the front lever of the color
toner cartridge indicated to the
left.
The replacement procedure for
the imaging unit is the same for
all colors (yellow: Y, magenta: M,
cyan: C, and black: K).
The following instructions show
the procedure to replace the
toner cartridge (K).
Y M C KReplacing Consumables 11-11
4 Grab the handle of the toner cartridge to be removed, and then
pull out the cartridge.
" Do not tilt removed toner cartridge, otherwise toner may
spill.
5 Pull up the waste toner bottle to
unlock it.
6 Grab the left and right handles of
the waste toner bottle, and then
slowly pull out the bottle.
" Do not tilt removed waste
toner box, otherwise
waste toner may spill.11-12 Replacing Consumables
7 While pressing down the area
marked “Push” on the imaging
unit to be replaced, slide the unit
completely out of the machine.
The following instructions show
the procedure to replace the
imaging unit (K).
Note
Dispose of the used imaging unit according to your local regulations.
Do not burn the imaging unit.
8 Check the color of the new imaging unit to be installed.
" In order to prevent toner from spilling, leave the imaging unit in the
bag until step 7 is being performed.
9 Remove the imaging unit from
the bag.Replacing Consumables 11-13
10 Hold the imaging unit with both
hands, and then shake it twice
as shown in the illustration.
" Do not grab the bottom of
the bag; otherwise, the
imaging unit may be
damaged, resulting in
decreased print quality.
11 Remove the protective cover
from the imaging unit.
Remove all packing tape from
the imaging unit11-14 Replacing Consumables
12 Remove the paper from the
imaging unit.
Remove the protective cover
from the imaging unit.
13 Make sure that the new imaging
unit to be installed is the same
color as the machine compartment, and then install the imaging unit in the machine.
14 Press in on the waste toner bottle until it locks into place.Replacing Consumables 11-15
15 Make sure that the toner cartridge is the same color as the
machine compartment, and then
insert the toner cartridge into the
machine.
" Fully insert the toner cartridge.
16 Pull the lever to the right to lock
it in place.
" The front lever should be
securely returned to its
original position; otherwise, the front cover of
the machine cannot be
closed.
" If it is difficult to operate
the lever, push it in.11-16 Replacing Consumables
17 Close the front cover.
" When closing the front
cover, press the area of
the cover with small projections.Replacing Consumables 11-17
Replacing the Waste Toner Bottle
When the waste toner bottle becomes full, the message [Waste Toner Box
Full] appears in the message window. The machine stops and will not start
again until the waste toner bottle is replaced.
1 Open the machine’s front cover.
2 Pull up the waste toner bottle to
unlock it.11-18 Replacing Consumables
3 Grab the left and right handles of
the waste toner bottle, and then
slowly pull out the bottle.
" Do not tilt removed waste
toner box, otherwise
waste toner may spill.
4 Remove the new waste toner bottle from its packaging. Insert the used
waste toner bottle into the plastic bag included in the box, and then box it
up.
Note
Dispose of the used waste toner bottle according to your local
regulations. Do not burn the waste toner bottle.
5 Press in on the waste toner bottle until it locks into place.Replacing Consumables 11-19
6 Close the front cover.
" When closing the front
cover, press the area of
the cover with small projections.
" If the waste toner bottle is not fully inserted, the front cover cannot
be closed.11-20 Replacing Consumables
Replacing the Transfer Roller
When the time to replace the transfer roller is reached, the message [Replace
transfer roller unit.] appears. Printing can continue even after this message
appears; however, since the print quality is reduced, the transfer roller should
be replaced immediately.
1 Pull the lever, and then open the
right door.
" Before opening the right
door, fold up Tray 1.
2 While pushing the levers to the
inside, move the roller presser
toward you. Replacing Consumables 11-21
3 While continuing to press the
levers, remove the transfer
roller.
4 Prepare a new transfer roller.
5 While pressing the levers, insert
the shaft of the transfer roller
into the bearings.
6 Move the levers away from you
until it snaps into place.11-22 Replacing Consumables
7 Close the right door.
8 Reset the counter in the [Admin Settings]/[Maintenance Menu]/[Supplies]/
[Consumables Replace]/[Transfer Roller Unit] menu.
Replacing the Transfer Belt Unit
When the time to replace the transfer belt unit is reached, the message
[Replace image transfer belt.] appears. Printing can continue even after this
message appears; however, since the print quality is reduced, the transfer
belt unit should be replaced immediately.
1 Turn off the machine and disconnect the power cord and interface cover.Replacing Consumables 11-23
2 Open the machine’s front cover.
3 Remove the all toner cartridges,
all imaging units and waste toner
bottle.
" For details on removing
the toner cartridges,
imaging units or waste
toner bottle, refer to
“Replacing a Toner Cartridge” on page 11-4 or
“Replacing a Imaging
Unit” on page 11-9.
" Cover the removed imaging unit to protect it from direct sunlight.
" Do not tilt removed toner cartridge, otherwise toner may spill.
" Do not tilt removed waste toner box, otherwise waste toner may
spill.11-24 Replacing Consumables
4 Pull the lever, and then open the
right door.
" Before opening the right
door, fold up Tray 1.
5 Remove the top part of the right
door.
6 Insert the protective sheet into
the unit in the direction of the
arrow until it stops.Replacing Consumables 11-25
7 Push down the guides.
8 Hold the handles, and then carefully pull out the transfer belt
unit.
" Be sure to keep the
transfer belt level; otherwise, the transfer belt
may be scratched.
9 Prepare a new transfer belt unit.
" Be careful not to touch
the surface of the belt.
" Do not remove the blue
lever.11-26 Replacing Consumables
10 Remove the protective cover
from the new transfer belt unit.
11 Insert the new transfer belt unit
along the rails.
" Fully insert it until it locks
into place.
" Be sure to keep the
transfer belt level; otherwise, the transfer belt
may be scratched.
12 Push up the guides.Replacing Consumables 11-27
13 Pull out the protective sheet.
14 Install the top part of the right
door.
15 Close the right door.11-28 Replacing Consumables
16 Install the all toner cartridges, all
imaging units and waste toner
bottle.
" For details on installing
the toner cartridges,
imaging units or waste
toner bottle, refer to
“Replacing a Toner Cartridge” on page 11-4 or
“Replacing a Imaging
Unit” on page 11-9.
17 Close the front cover.
" When closing the front
cover, press the area of
the cover with small projections.Replacing Consumables 11-29
18 Reconnect the power cord, and
turn on the machine.
19 Reset the counter in the [Admin Settings]/[Maintenance Menu]/[Supplies]/
[Consumables Replace]/[Transfer Belt Unit] menu.11-30 Replacing Consumables
Replacing the Backup Battery
When the backup battery is at its end of life, the machine’s date and time cannot be retained. Follow the procedure described below to replace the backup
battery.
Note
Only use the coin-shaped 3V lithium battery CR2032. It’s very important
to protect the machine controller board and any associated circuit
boards from electrostatic damage. Before performing this procedure,
review the antistatic caution on page 11-38. In addition, always handle
circuit boards by the edges only.
1 Turn off the machine and disconnect the power cord and interface cables.
2 Remove the cover.Replacing Consumables 11-31
3 Using a coin, remove a screw.
4 Open the cover.
5 Remove the hook, and then
remove the backup battery.11-32 Replacing Consumables
6 Remove the hook, and then
insert a new backup battery.
" When inserting the new
backup battery, be sure
that the + side faces towerd the left.
" Risk of explosion if battery is replaced by an
incorrect type. Dispose of
used batteries according
to your local regulations.
Do not burn the backup
battery.
7 Reinstall the panel and tighten a screw.
8 Install the cover.
9 Reconnect all interface cables.
10 Reconnect the power cord, and
turn on the machine.
11 Use [Date(XX. XX. XX)] on the [Admin Settings]/[Machine Settings]/
[Date & Time Settings] menu to set the date, and use [Time] on the
[Admin Settings]/[Machine Settings]/[Date & Time Settings] menu to set
the time.Replacing Consumables 11-33
Replacing the Fuser Unit
When the time to replace the fuser unit is reached, the message [Replace
fusing unit.] appears. Printing can continue even after this message appears;
however, since the print quality is reduced, the fuser unit should be replaced
immediately
1 Turn off the machine.
Note
There are extremely hot parts within the machine. Before replacing the
fuser unit, wait about 20 minutes after turning off the machine, and then
check that the fusing section has reached room temperature, otherwise,
you may get burnt.
2 Pull the lever, and then open the
right door.
" Before opening the right
door, fold up Tray 1.
3 Open the fuser unit cover.11-34 Replacing Consumables
4 Pull down the 2 levers.
5 Remove the fuser unit.
6 Prepare a new fuser unit.
" Be careful not to touch the
surface of the fuser roller.Replacing Consumables 11-35
7 Lift up the 2 levers.
8 Remove the packing material.
9 Push down the 2 levers.11-36 Replacing Consumables
10 Pull down the 2 levers of a new
fuser unit.
11 Insert the fuser unit until it locks
into place.
12 Lift up the 2 levers.Replacing Consumables 11-37
13 Close the fuser unit cover.
14 Close the right door.
" If the door cannot be closed,
check that the fuser unit is
fully inserted.
15 Reset the counter in the [Admin Settings]/[Maintenance Menu]/[Supplies]/
[Consumables Replace]/[Fusing Unit] menu.11-38 Antistatic Protection
Antistatic Protection
Note
It’s very important to protect the printer controller board from
electrostatic damage while performing any task involving the controller
board.
Turn off all power switches first. If an antistatic wrist strap is provided in
your printer option kit, attach one end of it to your wrist and the other
end to the bare metal chassis on the back of your printer. Never attach
the wrist strap to any piece of equipment with an electrical current
present. Plastic, rubber, wood, painted metal surfaces, and telephones
are not acceptable grounding points.
If you don’t have an antistatic wrist strap, discharge your body’s static
electric charge by touching a grounded surface before you handle any
printer boards or components. Also avoid walking around after
grounding yourself.12 Maintenance12-2 Maintaining the machine
Maintaining the machine
CAUTION
Read all caution and warning labels carefully, making sure to follow any
instructions contained in them. These labels are located on the inside of
the machine’s covers and the interior of the machine body.
Handle the machine with care to preserve its life. Abuse handling may cause
damage and void your warranty. If dust and paper scraps remain on the
inside or outside of the machine, machine performance and print quality will
suffer, so the machine should be cleaned periodically. Keep the following
guidelines in mind.
WARNING!
Turn off the machine, unplug the power cord, and disconnect all
interface cables before cleaning. Do not spill water or detergent into the
machine; otherwise the machine will be damaged and an electric shock
may occur.
CAUTION
The fuser unit is hot. When the right door is opened, the fuser
unit temperature drops gradually (one hour wait time).
Be careful when cleaning the inside of the machine or removing media
misfeeds, as the fuser unit and other internal parts may be very hot.
Do not place anything on top of the machine.
Use a soft cloth to clean the machine.
Never spray cleaning solutions directly on the machine’s surface; the
spray could penetrate through the air vents of the machine and damage
the internal circuits.
Avoid using abrasive or corrosive solutions or solutions that contain solvents (such as alcohol and benzene) to clean the machine.
Always test any cleaning solution (such as mild detergent) on a small
inconspicuous area of your machine to check the solution’s performance.
Never use sharp or rough implements, such as wire or plastic cleaning
pads.
Always close the machine’s covers gently. Never subject the machine to
vibration.Maintaining the machine 12-3
Do not cover the machine immediately after using it. Turn it off and wait
until it cools down.
Do not leave the machine’s covers open for any length of time, especially
in well-lit places; light may damage the imaging units.
Do not open the machine during printing.
Do not tap media stacks on the machine.
Do not lubricate or disassemble the machine.
Do not tilt the machine.
Do not touch the electrical contacts, gears, or laser devices. Doing so may
damage the machine and cause the print quality to deteriorate.
Keep media in the output tray at a minimum level. If the media is stocked
too high, your machine may experience media misfeeds and excessive
media curl.
Make sure two people are available to lift the machine when
moving it.
Keep the machine level to avoid
toner spillage.
When lifting the machine, fold up
Tray 1, and then lift the machine
as shown in the illustration at the
right.
If the optional lower feeder unit
is installed, move it and the
machine separately. Do not
grasp the grip of Tray 3, or the
right side cover; otherwise, the
lower feeder unit may be damaged.
If you get toner on your skin, wash it off with cool water and a mild soap.
CAUTION
If you get toner in your eyes, wash it out immediately with cool water
and consult a doctor.
Make sure any parts removed during cleaning are replaced before you
plug in the machine.
39 kg
86 lbs12-4 Cleaning the machine
Cleaning the machine
CAUTION
Be sure to turn off the machine and unplug the power cord before
cleaning.
Exterior
Control Panel Ventilation Grill
Machine Exterior
Original Glass Original Cover PadCleaning the machine 12-5
Media Rollers
The accumulation of paper dust and other debris on the media rollers can
cause media-feeding problems.
Cleaning the Media Feed Rollers (Manual Feed Tray)
1 Open Tray 1.
2 Press down on the center of the
paper-lifting plate until the left
and right locking tabs (white)
lock into place.12-6 Cleaning the machine
3 Clean the media feed rollers by
wiping them with a soft, dry
cloth.
4 Close the tray.Cleaning the machine 12-7
Cleaning the Media Feed Rollers for Tray 2/3/4
1 Pull out the tray.
2 Clean the media feed rollers by
wiping them with a soft, dry
cloth.
3 Close the tray.12-8 Cleaning the machine
Cleaning the Media Transfer Rollers for Tray 3/4
1 Open the right side cover of
Tray 3 or Tray 4.
" Before opening the right
side cover of Tray 3 or
Tray 4, fold up Tray 1.
2 Clean the media transfer rollers
by wiping them with a soft, dry
cloth.
3 Close the right side cover of
Tray 3 or Tray 4.Cleaning the machine 12-9
Cleaning the Media Feed Rollers for the ADF
1 Open the ADF feed cover.
2 Clean the media feed rollers by
wiping them with a soft, dry
cloth.
3 Close the ADF feed cover.12-10 Cleaning the machine
Cleaning the Laser Lens
This machine is constructed with four laser lenses. Clean all lenses as
described below. The laser lens cleaning tool should be attached to the inside
of the tray 2.
1 Pull out the tray 2.
2 Remove the cover.
" Since the cover will be used
later, do not return it to its
original position.
3 Remove the cleaning tool from
the tray 2. Cleaning the machine 12-11
4 Close the tray 2.
5 Open the machine’s front cover.
6 Remove the waste toner bottle
and the toner cartridge and
imaging unit for the color of laser
lens to be cleaned.
" For details on removing the
toner cartridge, imaging unit
or waste toner bottle, refer to
“Replacing a Toner Cartridge” on page 11-4 or
“Replacing a Imaging Unit”
on page 11-9.
" Do not tilt removed toner cartridge, otherwise toner may
spill.
" Do not tilt removed waste toner box, otherwise waste toner may spill.
7 Attach the cover to the removed
imaging unit.12-12 Cleaning the machine
8 Insert the laser lens cleaning
tool into the imaging unit opening, pull it out, and then repeat
this back and forth movement 2
or 3 times.
9 Install the removed toner cartridge, imaging unit and waste
toner bottle.
" For details on installing the
toner cartridge, imaging unit
or waste toner bottle, refer to
“Replacing a Toner Cartridge” on page 11-4 or
“Replacing a Imaging Unit”
on page 11-9.
10 Close the front cover.
11 Pull out the tray 2.Cleaning the machine 12-13
12 Return the laser lens cleaning
tool to its holder on the inside of
the tray 2.
13 Close the cover.
14 Close the tray 2.
15 Clean between each of the laser lenses in the same way.
" The laser lens cleaning tool is included with the machine.
Safely store the laser lens cleaning tool so that it will not be lost.12-14 Cleaning the machine13 Troubleshooting13-2 Introduction
Introduction
This chapter provides information to aid you in resolving machine problems
you may encounter, or at least guide you to the proper sources for help.
Printing a configuration page
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [User Settings].
3 Press [Print Settings].
4 Press [Print Reports].
5 Press [Configuration Page].
6 Press [Print].
7 Press [OK].
Printing the configuration page page 13-2
Unlocking the Scanner page 13-3
Preventing media misfeeds page 13-4
Understanding the media path page 13-5
Clearing media misfeeds page 13-6
Solving problems with media misfeeds page 13-23
Solving other problems page 13-26
Solving problems with printing quality page 13-31
Status, error, and service messages page 13-38Unlocking the Scanner 13-3
Unlocking the Scanner
1 Lift open the ADF cover.
2 Move the scanner lock lever to
.
3 Close the ADF cover.
4 Turn off the machine, and then turn it on again.13-4 Preventing Media Misfeeds
Preventing Media Misfeeds
Make sure that...
Media matches the machine specifications.
Media is flat, especially on the leading edge.
The machine is on a hard, flat, level surface.
You store media in a dry location away from moisture and humidity.
You always adjust the media guides in the tray after inserting the media (a
guide that is not properly adjusted can cause poor print quality, media misfeeds, and machine damage).
You load the media printing-side up in the tray (many manufacturers place an
arrow on the end of the wrapper to indicate the printing side).
Avoid...
Media that is folded, wrinkled, or excessively curled.
Double feeding (remove the media and fan the sheets—they may be sticking
together).
Loading more than one type/size/weight of media in a tray at the same time.
Overfilling the trays.
Allowing the output tray to overfill (the output tray has a 250-sheet capacity—
misfeeding may occur if you allow more than 250 sheets of media to accumulate at one time).Understanding the Media Path 13-5
Understanding the Media Path
Understanding media path will help you locate media misfeeds
4 Fuser unit 10 Print head unit
5 Duplex 11 Imaging unit
6 Tray 1 (Manual feed tray) 12 Transfer belt unit
7 Tray 4 (optional lower feeder unit) 13 Toner cartridge
8 Tray 3 (optional lower feeder unit) 14 Output tray
9 Tray 2
4
11
12
13
14
6
5
10
9
8
7
3
1 2
1 ADF media feed rollers
2 Document feed tray
3 Document output tray13-6 Clearing Media Misfeeds
Clearing Media Misfeeds
To avoid damage, always remove misfed media gently, without tearing it. Any
piece of media left in the machine, whether large or small, can obstruct the
media path and cause further misfeeds. Do not reload media that has misfed.
Note
The image is not fixed on the media before the fusing process. If you
touch the printed surface, the toner may stick to your hands, so be
careful not to touch the printed face when removing the misfed media.
Make sure not to spill any toner inside the machine.
CAUTION
Unfused toner can dirty your hands, clothes, or anything else it gets on.
If you accidentally get toner on your clothes, lightly dust them off as
best as you can. If some toner remains on your clothes, use cool, not
hot water, to rinse the toner off. If toner gets on your skin, wash it off
with cool water and a mild soap.
CAUTION
If you get toner in your eyes, wash it out immediately with cool water
and consult a doctor.
If, after clearing the media misfeed, the misfeed message in the control panel
window persists, open and close the engine cover. This should clear the misfeed message.
Media misfeed indications
If a misfeed occurs during printing, the message “Misfeed detected” appears
and the location of the misfeed is indicated in the screen.
Media misfeed locations Page
reference
Media misfeed in Tray 2 page 13-7
Media misfeed in Tray 3/Tray 4 page 13-11
Media misfeed in the ADF page 13-13
Media misfeed in the duplex unit page 13-15
Media misfeed in the fuser unit page 13-16
Media misfeed in Tray 1 (manual feed tray) page 13-20Clearing Media Misfeeds 13-7
Clearing a Media Misfeed in Tray 2
1 Pull the lever, and then open the
right door.
" Before opening the right
door, fold up Tray 1.
2 Carefully pull out the misfed
media.13-8 Clearing Media Misfeeds
CAUTION
The area around the fuser unit is
extremely hot.
Touching anything other than the
indicated levers may result in
burns. If you get burned,
immediately cool the skin under
cold water, and then seek
professional medical attention.
Note
Decreased print quality may
result if the surface of the image
transfer belt or the transfer roller
is touched.
Be careful not to touch the
surface of the image transfer belt
or transfer roller. Clearing Media Misfeeds 13-9
3 Close the right side door.
4 Pull out Tray 2, and then remove
all media from the tray.
5 Fan the media you removed and
then align it well.13-10 Clearing Media Misfeeds
6 Load the media face up in Tray 2.
" Make sure that the media is flat.
" Do not load paper above the ▼ mark.
" Slide the media guides against the edges of the paper.
7 Close Tray 2.Clearing Media Misfeeds 13-11
Clearing a Media Misfeed in Tray 3/4
1 Open the right side cover of
Tray 3 or Tray 4.
" Before opening the right
side cover of Tray 3 or
Tray 4, fold up Tray 1.
2 Carefully pull out the misfed
media.
3 Close the right side cover of
Tray 3 or Tray 4.13-12 Clearing Media Misfeeds
4 Pull out Tray 3 or Tray 4, and
then remove all paper from the
tray.
5 Fan the paper you removed and
then align it well.
6 Load the paper face up in Tray 3 or Tray 4.
" Make sure that the paper is flat.
" Do not load paper above the ▼ mark.
" Slide the media guides against the edges of the paper.
7 Close Tray 3 or Tray 4.Clearing Media Misfeeds 13-13
Clearing a Media Misfeed from the ADF
1 Open the ADF feed cover.
2 Remove the document from the
ADF document feed tray.
3 Lift to open the ADF cover.13-14 Clearing Media Misfeeds
4 Remove any misfed media.
5 Close the ADF cover.
6 Close the ADF feed cover.Clearing Media Misfeeds 13-15
Clearing a Media Misfeed from the Duplex
1 Pull the lever, and then open the
right door.
" Before opening the right
door, fold up Tray 1.
2 Carefully pull out the misfed
media.
3 Close the right door.13-16 Clearing Media Misfeeds
Clearing a Media Misfeed from the Fuser Unit
1 Pull the lever, and then open the
right door.
" Before opening the right
door, fold up Tray 1.
2 Lift up the 2 levers.
3 Open the fuser unit cover.Clearing Media Misfeeds 13-17
4 Carefully pull out the misfed
media.
" If the misfed media cannot
be removed by pulling it
down, pull it from the top of
the fuser unit.13-18 Clearing Media Misfeeds
CAUTION
The area around the fuser unit is
extremely hot.
Touching anything other than the
indicated levers may result in
burns. If you get burned,
immediately cool the skin under
cold water, and then seek
professional medical attention.
Note
Decreased print quality may
result if the surface of the image
transfer belt or the transfer roller
is touched.
Be careful not to touch the
surface of the image transfer belt
or transfer roller. Clearing Media Misfeeds 13-19
5 Close the fuser unit cover.
6 Push down the 2 levers.
7 Close the right door.13-20 Clearing Media Misfeeds
Clearing a Media Misfeed from Tray 1 (Manual Feed Tray)
and Transfer Roller
1 Pull the lever, and then open the
right door.
" Before opening the right
door, fold up Tray 1.
2 Carefully pull out the misfed
media.Clearing Media Misfeeds 13-21
CAUTION
The area around the fuser unit is
extremely hot.
Touching anything other than the
indicated levers may result in
burns. If you get burned,
immediately cool the skin under
cold water, and then seek
professional medical attention.
Note
Decreased print quality may
result if the surface of the image
transfer belt or the transfer roller
is touched.
Be careful not to touch the
surface of the image transfer belt
or transfer roller. 13-22 Clearing Media Misfeeds
3 Close the right door.Solving Problems with Media Misfeeds 13-23
Solving Problems with Media Misfeeds
" Frequent misfeeds in any area indicate that area should be checked,
repaired, or cleaned. Repeated misfeeds may also happen if you’re
using unsupported print media or original media.
Symptom Cause Solution
Several
sheets go
through the
machine
together.
The front edges of
the media are not
even.
Remove the media and even up the
front edges, then reload it.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
Media misfeed message stays
on.
Front cover needs to
be opened and
closed again to reset
the machine.
Open and close the front cover again.
Some media remains
misfed in the
machine.
Check the media path again to make
sure that you have removed all of the
misfed media.
Duplex misfeeds.
Unsupported media
(wrong size, thickness, type, etc.) is
being used.
Use KONICA MINOLTA-approved
media. See “Special Paper” on
page 4-11.
Also, refer to
http://konicaminolta.com
for a complete list of currently
approved media.
Plain paper, recycled paper, special
paper, Thick 1 and Thick 2 can be
autoduplexed if the media type is set
properly in the driver. See “Specifications” on page 4-2.
Make sure that you have not mixed
media types in the tray.
Do not duplex, envelopes, labels, letter
head, postcards, glossy media, or single side only paper.
Media is still being
misfed.
Check the media path inside the
duplex again to make sure that you
have removed all of the misfed media.13-24 Solving Problems with Media Misfeeds
Media is misfed in the
ADF.
The loaded document
does not meet the
specifications.
Load the correct document. For details
on the documents that can be loaded,
refer to “Documents that can be loaded
into the ADF” on page 4-34.
The loaded document
exceeds the maximum capacity.
Load the document so that it does not
exceed the maximum capacity. For
details on the documents that can be
loaded, refer to “Documents that can
be loaded into the ADF” on page 4-34.
The document guides
were not slid against
the edges of the document.
Slide the document guides against the
edges of the document. For details on
loading the document, refer to “Loading a document into the ADF” on
page 4-37.
Media is misfeeding.
The media is not correctly positioned in
the tray.
Remove the misfed media and reposition the media properly in the tray.
The number of sheets
in the tray exceeds
the maximum
allowed.
Remove the excess media and reload
the correct number of sheets in the
tray.
The media guides are
not correctly adjusted
to the media size.
Adjust the media guides in the Tray 1
to match the size of the media.
Warped or wrinkled
media is loaded in the
tray.
Remove the media, smooth it out, and
reload it. If it still misfeeds, do not use
that media.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
Envelopes are loaded
in Tray 2, 3, 4.
Envelope must be loaded in Tray 1
only.
Labels, letterhead,
postcards, thick
stock, or glossy are
loaded in Tray 3, 4.
Labels, letterhead, postcards, thick
stock, or glossy must be loaded in Tray
1 or 2.
Custom-sized media
is loaded in Tray 3, 4.
Custom-sized media can be loaded in
Tray 1 or 2.
See “Print Media” on page 4-2.
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Problems with Media Misfeeds 13-25
The recommended
label sheet is facing
the wrong way in Tray
1.
Load the label sheets according to the
manufacturer’s instructions.
Envelopes are facing
the wrong way in Tray
1.
Load the envelopes in Tray 1 with the
flaps facing up.
If the flaps are on the long edge, load
the envelopes with the flap edge
toward the machine and the flap side
facing up.
Unsupported media
(wrong size, thickness, type, etc.) is
being used.
Use KONICA MINOLTA-approved
media.
See “Specifications” on page 4-2.
Also, refer to
http://konicaminolta.com
for a complete list of currently
approved media.
The media feed roller
is dirty.
Clean the media feed roller.
For more details, refer to “Media Rollers” on page 12-5.
Symptom Cause Solution13-26 Solving Other Problems
Solving Other Problems
Symptom Cause Solution
Machine
power is not
on.
The power cord is not
correctly plugged into
the outlet.
Turn off the machine, confirm that the
power cord is correctly plugged into
the outlet, and then turn on the
machine.
Something is wrong
with the outlet connected to the
machine.
Plug another electrical appliance into
the outlet and see whether it operates
properly.
The power switch is
not correctly turned
on (I position).
Turn the power switch off (O position),
then turn it back to the on (I position).
The machine is connected to an outlet
with a voltage or frequency that does not
match the machine
specifications.
Use a power source with the specifications listed in appendix A, “Technical
Specifications.”
The control
panel displays [Toner
is low.] much
sooner than
expected.
One of the toner cartridges may be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
Printed with heavy
toner coverage.
See specifications in Appendix A.
Cannot print
the machine
status list.
The tray is empty. Check that at least Tray 1 is loaded
with media, in place, and secure.
There is a media misfeed.
Clear the media misfeed.Solving Other Problems 13-27
Printing from
a USB memory device is
not possible.
[External Memory
Print] is set to [Disable].
Press the [Utility/Counter] key, and
then set [Admin Settings] - [External
Memory Print] to [Enable].
The file format (file
extension) is not one
that can be printed.
Only files with the format (extension)
for JPEG, TIFF, XPS or PDF can be
printed.
Press [USB/HDD], and then, with
[External Memory] - [File Type], select
the type of files to be displayed.
A public user is not
specified for user
authentication.
Contact the administrator of this unit.
Printing
takes too
much time.
The machine is set to
a slow printing mode
(for example, thick
stock).
It takes more time to print with special
media. When using regular paper,
make sure that the media type is set
properly in the driver.
The machine is set to
power saving mode.
It takes time for printing to start in
power saving mode.
The job is very complex.
Wait. No action needed.
A toner cartridge for a
different region or an
unapproved toner
cartridge is installed
([Incorrect toner cartridge]is displayed in
the message window).
Install a correct KONICA MINOLTA
toner cartridge approved for your specific machine.
If an error has been
detected during printing job transmission
in the Copy mode, it
takes a while to process the error and
resume the printing
operation.
Wait. No action needed.
Blank pages
are printed.
One or more of the
toner cartridges are
defective or empty.
Check the toner cartridges. The image
will not print correctly or not at all, if the
cartridges are empty.
The wrong media is
being used.
Check that the media type.
Symptom Cause Solution13-28 Solving Other Problems
Not all pages
print.
A different user accidentally canceled the
job.
Try printing the remaining pages.
The tray is empty. Check that the tray is loaded with
media, in place, and secure.
A document is printed
with an overlay file
which has been created by an unsuitable printer driver.
Print the overlay file using a suitable
printer driver.
Machine
resets or
turns off frequently.
The power cord is not
correctly plugged into
the outlet.
Turn off the machine, confirm that the
power cord is correctly plugged into
the outlet, and then turn on the
machine.
A system error
occurred.
Contact Technical Support with the
error information.
You are
experiencing duplex
problems.
Media or settings are
not correct.
Make sure that you are using correct
media.
See “Specifications” on page 4-2.
Also, refer to
http://konicaminolta.com
for a complete list of currently
approved media.
Do not duplex custom-sized media,
envelopes, labels, postcards, letterhead, or glossy media.
Make sure that you have not mixed
media types in the tray.
In the Windows printer driver ([Layout]/
[Print Type]), choose [2-Sided]."
Set duplex (Double-Sided) copying.
For details on setting duplex (Double-Sided) copying, refer to “About
Duplex Printing” on page 4-30.
For N-up on duplexed pages, choose
Collate only in the printer driver’s
[Basic] Tab. Do not set collation in the
application.
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Other Problems 13-29
With N-up on
multiple copies, the output is
incorrect.
Both the printer driver
and the application
have been set for collation.
For N-up on multiple copies, choose
Collate only in the printer driver’s Basic
Tab. Do not set collation in the application.
Booklet Left
and Right
Binding output is incorrect.
Both the printer driver
and the application
have been set for collation.
For Booklet Left Binding and Booklet
Right Binding, choose Collate only in
the printer driver’s Basic Tab. Do not
set collation in the application.
You hear
unusual
noises.
The machine is not
level.
Place the machine on a flat, hard, level
surface.
The tray is not
installed correctly.
Remove the tray that you are printing
from and reinsert it completely into the
machine.
There is a foreign
object stuck inside
the machine.
Turn off the machine and remove the
object. If you cannot remove it, contact
Technical Support.
Some areas
of the
scanned
image are
missing.
Acrobat 8 (Macintosh
version) is used for
scanning the image.
With the Acrobat Scan setting, turn off
the OCR and Filtering functions.
The
web-based
utility cannot
be accessed.
The PageScope Web
Connection Administrator’s password is
incorrect.
The PageScope Web Connection
Administrator password has a 0-character minimum and an 16-character
maximum. For details of the
PageScope Web Connection administrator password, refer to the [Reference Guide] on the Documentation
CD/DVD.
Media is
wrinkled.
The media is moist
from humidity or having water spilled on it.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
The media feed roller
or fuser unit is defective.
Check them for damage. If necessary,
contact Technical Support with the
error information.
Unsupported media
(wrong size, thickness, type, etc.) is
being used.
Use KONICA MINOLTA-approved
media. See “Specifications” on
page 4-2.
Symptom Cause Solution13-30 Solving Other Problems
Data was
sent to the
machine, but
it doesn’t
print.
An error message is
displayed in the message window.
Handle according to the message displayed.
A job may be cancelled if user authentication setting is
specified.
Click the User Authentication button in
the printer driver, and then type in the
necessary information before printing.
The hard
disk was
automatically formatted.
The hard disk was
full.
When the control panel displays [HDD
is low on disk space.], delete print jobs
and resources (fonts, forms, etc.)
which were saved on the hard disk
using Download Manager or PageScope Web Connection.
A network
connection
cannot be
established
with an IPv4
address.
Duplicate detection of
the IPv6 address
failed.
Set [Ethernet]/[TCP/IP]/[IPv6]/[Enable]
in [Admin Settings] menu to [No].
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Problems with Printing Quality 13-31
Solving Problems with Printing Quality
Symptom Cause Solution
Nothing is
printed, or
there are
blank spots
on the
printed page.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check if any is damaged.
One or more of the
imaging units may be
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Adjust the humidity for media storage.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
The media set in the
printer driver mismatches the media
loaded in the
machine.
Load the correct media in the machine.
Several sheets are
being fed at the same
time.
Remove the media from the tray and
check for static electricity. Fan plain
paper or other media, and replace it in
the tray.
Entire sheet
is printed in
black or
color.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
One or more of the
imaging units may be
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.13-32 Solving Problems with Printing Quality
Image is too
light; there is
low image
density.
Laser lens is dirty. Clean the laser lens.
The copy density is
set too light.
Select a darker copy density.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Remove the moist media and replace
with new, dry media.
There is not much
toner left in the cartridge.
Replace the toner cartridge.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
Media type is set
incorrectly.
When printing envelopes, labels, letter
head, postcards, thick stock, glossy
media, single side only paper or special paper, specify the appropriate
media type in the printer driver.
Image is too
dark.
The copy density is
set too dark.
Select a lighter copy density.
The document was
not pressed close
enough against the
original glass.
Position the document so that it is
pressed close enough against the original glass. For details on positioning
the document on the original glass,
refer to “Placing a document on the
original glass” on page 4-36.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
One or more of the
imaging units may be
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Problems with Printing Quality 13-33
Image is
blurred;
background
is lightly
stained;
there is
insufficient
gloss of the
printed
image.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
One or more of the
imaging units may be
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.
The original glass is
dirty.
Clean the original glass. For details,
refer to “Cleaning the machine” on
page 12-4.
The original cover
pad is dirty.
Clean the original cover pad. For
details, refer to “Cleaning the machine”
on page 12-4.
The print or
color density
is uneven.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective or low.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
One or more of the
imaging units is
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.
The machine is not
level.
Place the machine on a flat, hard, level
surface.
Symptom Cause Solution13-34 Solving Problems with Printing Quality
Irregular
print or mottled image
appears.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Adjust the humidity in the media storage area.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
Unsupported media
(wrong size, thickness, type, etc.) is
being used.
Use KONICA MINOLTA-approved
media. See “Specifications” on
page 4-2.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
One or more of the
imaging units is
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.
There is
insufficient
fusing or the
image
comes off
when
rubbed.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
Unsupported media
(wrong size, thickness, type, etc.) is
being used.
Use KONICA MINOLTA-approved
media. See “Specifications” on
page 4-2.
Media type is set
incorrectly.
When printing envelopes, labels, letter
head, postcards, thick stock, single
side only paper or special paper, specify the appropriate media type in the
printer driver.
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Problems with Printing Quality 13-35
There are
toner
smudges or
residual
images.
One or more of the
toner cartridges are
defective or installed
incorrectly.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
There are
toner
smudges on
the back side
of the page
(whether or
not it has
been
duplexed).
The media transfer
roller is dirty.
Clean the media transfer roller.
If you think the transfer roller should be
replaced, contact Technical Support
with the error information.
The media path is
dirty with toner.
Print several blank sheets and the
excess toner should disappear.
One or more of the
toner cartridges are
defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
One or more of the
imaging units is
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.
Abnormal
areas (white,
black, or
color) appear
in a regular
pattern.
The laser lens is dirty. Clean the laser lens.
A toner cartridge may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges with the
color causing the abnormal image.
Replace it with a new toner cartridge.
One or more of the
imaging units is
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.
Symptom Cause Solution13-36 Solving Problems with Printing Quality
Image
defects.
The laser lens is dirty. Clean the laser lens.
A toner cartridge may
be leaking.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
A toner cartridge may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridge with the
color causing the abnormal image.
Replace it with a new toner cartridge.
One or more of the
imaging units may be
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.
Lateral lines
or bands
appear on
image.
The machine is not
level.
Place the machine on a flat, hard, level
surface.
The media path is
dirty with toner.
Print several sheets and the excess
toner should disappear.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
One or more of the
imaging units is
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.
Colors look
drastically
wrong.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and verify
that the toner is distributed evenly on
each cartridge roller, and reinstall the
toner cartridges.
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Problems with Printing Quality 13-37
If the problem is not resolved, even after all of the above have been performed, contact Technical Support with the error information.
Colors are
not registering properly;
colors are
mixed or
have
page-to-pag
e variation.
Gradations are not
adjusted correctly.
Set [Print Settings]/[Quality Settings]/
[Gradation Adjustment]/[Tone Calibration] in the [Admin Settings] menu to
[ON], and then perform the AIDC color
calibration. For details, refer to “[Print
Settings]” on page 3-49.
The front cover is
opened during the
calibration.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
The color
has a poor
reproduction
or has poor
color density.
One or more of the
imaging units may be
defective.
Remove the imaging units and check
for damage. If it is damaged, replace it.
Symptom Cause Solution13-38 Status, error and service messages
Status, error and service messages
Various status, error and service messages appear in the touch panel of the
control panel. They provide information about the machine and help you
locate problems that may have occurred. Check the message that appears,
and then perform the necessary steps.
Status messages
Message Cause Solution
[Initializing] The machine was
turned on.
No action is required.
[Restarting] The machine is being
restarted.
[Enter Power Save mode] The machine is entering normal operation
mode from Power
Save mode.
[Calibrating] The image is being
adjusted.
[Warming up] The machine is warming up or AIDC is
being performed.
[Check setting. Tray x] The paper specified
from the touch panel
was loaded in the
paper tray.
[TWAIN/WSD connecting] Computer scanning is
being performed with
TWAIN or a Web
Service.Status, error and service messages 13-39
Error messages
Warning messages
Message Cause Solution
[Unable to collate.]
[Prints one set only.]
There is not enough
space available on the
hard disk for collated
printing.
After one copy is
printed, the error is canceled.
[HDD is low on disk
space.]
[Delete unneeded file.]
There is too little
space available on the
hard disk.
Delete downloaded
fonts. Otherwise, initialize the hard disk.
[Replace imaging unit.]
[Replace imaging unit.]
[x]
The time to replace
the imaging unit has
been reached.
Replace the indicated
imaging unit.
[Replace toner (x)]
[Toner empty. Replace
toner and close front door.
x]
The time to replace
the toner cartridge has
been reached.
Replace the indicated
toner cartridge.
[Replace image transfer
belt.]
[Replace transfer belt unit.]
The time to replace
the transfer belt unit
has been reached.
Replace the transfer
belt unit.
After replacing the
transfer belt unit, reset
its counter. For details,
refer to “[Maintenance
Menu]” on page 3-63.
[Replace fusing unit.]
[Replace fusing unit.]
The time to replace
the fuser unit has
been reached.
Replace the fuser unit.
After replacing the fuser
unit, reset its counter.
For details, refer to
“[Maintenance Menu]”
on page 3-63.
[Replace waste toner
box.]
[Prepare new waste toner
box.]
The time to replace
the waste toner bottle
is near.
Prepare the new waste
toner bottle.13-40 Status, error and service messages
[Toner is low.]
[Prepare new toner
cartridge.]
[x]
The time to replace
the toner cartridge is
near.
Prepare the new toner
cartridge.
[Replace imaging unit
soon.]
[Prepare new imaging unit.]
[x]
The time to replace
the imaging unit is
near.
Prepare the new imaging unit.
[Replenish paper]
[Replenish paper.]
[Trayx]
There is no paper in
the paper tray.
Appears when [Paper
Empty] ([Admin
Settings]) is set to
[ON]. For details, refer
to “[Paper Empty]” on
page 3-78.
Load paper into the
paper tray.
[Incorrect toner
cartridge]
[Install proper toner
cartridge.]
[x]
A toner cartridge
incompatible with the
machine has been
installed.
Replace the indicated
toner cartridge with a
correct one.
[Incorrect Imaging Unit]
[Install proper imaging
unit.]
[x]
An imaging unit
incompatible with the
machine has been
installed.
Replace the indicated
imaging unit with a correct one.
[Replace transfer roller
unit.]
[Replace transfer roller
unit.]
The time to replace
the transfer roller has
been reached.
Replace the transfer
roller.
After replacing the
transfer roller, reset its
counter. For details,
refer to “[Maintenance
Menu]” on page 3-63.
[USB hub is not
supported.]
[Disconnect USB hub.]
A USB hub is
connected to the USB
HOST port.
Disconnect the USB
hub from the USB
HOST port.
Message Cause SolutionStatus, error and service messages 13-41
Operator messages
[The USB device is
invalid.]
[Disconnect USB device.]
An incompatible USB
device is connected to
the USB HOST port.
Disconnect the USB
device from the USB
HOST port.
[IEEE802.1x Auth. failed]
[Please reboot.]
IEEE 802.1X port
authentication timed
out.
Turn the machine off,
then on again.
[IEEE802.1x
Authenticating]
[Please wait.]
IEEE 802.1X port
authentication is being
performed.
If authentication is successful, the message is
cleared.
If authentication times
out, turn the machine
off, then on again.
Message Cause Solution
[Configuration of Options
Changed]
[Configuration of Options
Changed]
[Power Off and ON.]
An optional lower
feeder unit was
installed or removed
while the machine is
on.
Turn the machine off,
wait a few seconds, and
then it on again.
[Cover Open]
[Cover is open.]
[Close all covers properly.]
The cover is open. Close the indicated
cover.
[Misfeed Detected]
[Misfeed was detected.]
[Remove the paper.]
A media misfeed
occurred.
Open the indicated
cover, and remove the
misfed media.
[Imaging Unit Missing]
[Install imaging unit and
close all doors.]
No imaging unit is
installed. Otherwise,
an imaging unit
incompatible with the
machine has been
installed.
Install the correct imaging unit.
Message Cause Solution13-42 Status, error and service messages
[Toner Cartridge Missing]
[install toner cartridge and
close all doors.]
No toner cartridge is
installed. Otherwise, a
toner cartridge
incompatible with the
machine has been
installed.
Install the correct toner
cartridge.
[Waste Toner Box Full]
[Replace waste toner box
by following the instruction.]
The waste toner bottle
is full.
Replace the waste
toner bottle.
[Replace Imaging Unit]
[Open front door and
replace imaging unit by
following the instruction.]
The time to replace
the imaging unit has
been reached.
Replace the appropriate imaging unit.
[Replace Toner (x)]
[Replace toner by following
the instruction and close
front door.]
The time to replace
the toner cartridge has
been reached.
Replace the appropriate toner cartridge.
[Paper Size Mismatch]
[Load xxx in Tray x or cancel job.]
The paper size specified from the touch
panel is different from
the size of paper
loaded in the paper
tray.
Load paper of the correct size into the indicated paper tray.
Otherwise, cancel the
job.
[Paper Setting for Manual
feed]
[Load xx xxxx in bypass
tray. Touch [Print].]
Tray 1 has been
selected for printing.
Press [Print]. Otherwise, cancel the job.
[Replenish paper]
[Replenish paper or select
other paper tray.]
No other paper tray
contains paper
matching the specified
type and size. (when
[Auto Tray Switching]
is set to [ON])
Load the specified
paper into a paper tray.
[Replenish paper]
[Load paper in bypass tray
or select other paper tray.]
There is no paper in
Tray 1 when printing
with Tray 1 selected.
(when [Auto Tray
Switching] is set to
[OFF])
Load paper into Tray 1.
Message Cause SolutionStatus, error and service messages 13-43
[Replenish paper]
[Replenish paper in Tray x
or select other paper tray.]
There is no paper in
the paper tray
selected for printing.
(when [Auto Tray
Switching] is set to
[OFF])
Load paper into the
specified paper tray.
[Paper Size/Type
Mismatch]
[Load the following paper in
tray x.]
[Paper : xxxxx xxxxx]
The type and size of
the paper loaded into
all of the paper trays
are different. (when
[Auto Tray Switching]
is set to [ON])
Load the specified
paper into a paper tray.
[Output Tray Full]
[Output tray full. Remove
paper from the tray.]
The output tray is full
of paper.
Remove the paper from
the output tray.
[Memory Full]
[Insufficient memory
Cancel the job.]
The print data sent
from the computer has
caused the memory to
become full.
Cancel the job.
[Stored Job Error]
[Stored job specification
not correct.]
[Tray x]
Tray 3/Tray 4 was
specified for printing a
stored job when Tray
3/Tray 4 is not
installed on the
machine.
When trying to print a
stored job, the
installed memory had
been changed since
the job was stored.
Install Tray 3/Tray 4, or
install the memory that
had been installed
when the job was
stored.
[Job Registration Limit
Over]
[Registered jobs reached
limit.]
[Wait for job registration to
complete.]
Copy, scan or fax
transmission
operations were
repeated while
printing or
transmissions could
not be performed.
Wait a while. The error
is canceled.
Message Cause Solution13-44 Status, error and service messages
[Check Scanner Lock
Lever]
[Unlock the scanner lock
lever.]
The scanner is locked. Cancel the job.
Unlock the scanner.
For details, refer to
“Unlocking the Scanner” on page 13-3.
[Place Original on Glass]
[Unable to scan from ADF
with this original size.]
The selected
document size cannot
be scanned from the
ADF.
Place the document on
the original glass if it
has a size that cannot
be scanned from the
ADF.
[Place Original on ADF]
[Place originals on the
Document Feeder.]
The document is not
loaded into the ADF
when scanning a
document containing
pages of different
sizes.
Load the document into
ADF.
[Matching Paper not
Available]
[Paper of matching size not
available.]
[xxxxx]
Paper of the same
size as the document
cannot be selected
with the [Auto] Paper
setting selected in
Copy mode.
Load the paper tray
with paper of the same
size as the document.
[Out of the Range of Auto
Zoom]
[Zoom ratio for paper size
is outlying.]
[Select other paper or
zoom ratio.]
An appropriate zoom
ratio cannot be
selected with the
“Auto” Zoom setting
selected.
Specify a zoom ratio
between 25% and
400%.
[Place Original on Glass]
[Unable to scan from ADF
with this zoom ratio.]
The selected zoom
ratio (200% or more)
cannot be used to
scan from the ADF.
Place the document on
the original glass.
[Duplex Copy Disabled]
[Duplex copy disabled.
Cancel it or select]
[:A5-Legal/Plain Paper/
Thick 1-2]
The selected paper
type and size cannot
be used with duplex
(double-sided)
printing.
Cancel duplex (double-sided) printing, or
change the paper type
and size settings.
Message Cause SolutionStatus, error and service messages 13-45
[Memory Full (Scan)]
[Insufficient memory.]
[The job is cancelled.]
The memory capacity
is insufficient.
Otherwise, the SSD
storage area is
insufficient.
Cancel the job.
[HDD Capacity Over]
[Insufficient HDD capacity.]
[Delete unnecessary file.]
[The job is cancelled.]
There is not enough
space available on the
hard disk.
Delete any unnecessary files.
Cancel the job.
[Document Registration
Limit Over]
[Saved documents in folder
reached limit.]
[The job is cancelled.]
The number of image
files on the hard disk
has reached the
maximum possible.
Cancel the job.
[Connection Failed]
[Check if the destination is
correct.]
[The job is cancelled.]
The machine failed to
connect to the FTP
server.
Wait a while. The error
is canceled.
[Error Occurred during
Writing]
[Check whether it is
write-protected or out of
space.]
The machine failed to
write data to the USB
memory device.
Cancel the job.
[Scan TX Failed]
[Scan TX failed.]
[Job is cancelled.]
The scan transmission
failed. (Does not
appear with a
broadcast
transmission.)
Wait a while. The error
is canceled.
[Counter reached its
limit.]
[The counter has reached
its maximum allowance.]
[Please delete the job.]
The counter has
reached the upper
limit.
Delete the job.
Message Cause Solution13-46 Status, error and service messages
[I-Fax RX failed]
[Failed to complete the job
due to an error while I-FAX
RX.]
[Check the log.]
The job did not end
normally because an
error occurred during
I-FAX RX.
Check the log.
[I-Fax TX failed]
[I-FAX TX failed due to
error.]
[Redial will be attempted
after predetermined time
progress.]
The job did not end
normally because an
error occurred during
I-FAX TX.
A document is sent
again after the specified
time period has lapsed.
Message Cause SolutionStatus, error and service messages 13-47
Service messages
These messages indicate a more serious problem that can only be corrected
by a service representative. If one of these messages appears, turn the
machine off, then on again. If the problem persists, contact your local vendor
or authorized service provider.
Message Cause Solution
[Service Call]
[Error occurred. Power
OFF and ON, or contact
Service with Trouble
Code;xxxx]
An error has been
detected with the item
indicated by “xxxx” in
the service message.
Restart the machine.
This often clears the
service message, and
machine operation can
resume.
If the problem persists,
contact the service representative.13-48 Status, error and service messages14
Installing
Accessories14-2 Introduction
Introduction
Note
Use of accessories not manufactured or supported by
KONICA MINOLTA will void your warranty.
" For details of accessories, visit our web site (http://konicaminolta.com)
Lower Feeder Unit
(Tray 3/Tray 4)
500-sheet tray included
Working Table
WT-P01
Provides an area to temporarily place an original or
install an authentication device.Lower Feeder Unit PF-P08 14-3
Lower Feeder Unit PF-P08
You can install up to one optional lower feeder unit PF-P08 (Tray 3/4). The
lower feeder unit PF-P08 increases your machine’s media feed capacity by
500 sheets.
Kit Contents
Lower feeder unit with a tray (500-sheet capacity)14-4 Lower Feeder Unit PF-P08
Installing a Lower Feeder Unit PF-P08
Note
Since consumables are installed in the machine, be sure to keep the
printer level when moving it in order to prevent accidental spills.
1 Turn off the machine and disconnect the power cord and interface cables.
2 Prepare the lower feeder unit.
" Be sure to place the lower feeder unit on a level surface.
3 Open the right side cover of the
lower feeder unit.
" The right side cover of the lower feeder must be opened before the
feeder can be installed onto the machine.Lower Feeder Unit PF-P08 14-5
4 With another person’s help,
place the machine on top of the
lower feeder unit, making sure
that the positioning pins on the
lower feeder unit correctly fit into
the holes on the bottom of the
machine.
WARNING!
This machine weighs approximately 39 kg (86 lbs) when it is fully
loaded with consumables. The machine must be lifted by two people.
5 Close the right side cover of the
lower feeder unit.
6 Reconnect all interface cables.
39 kg
86 lbs14-6 Working Table WT-P01
7 Reconnect the power cord, and
turn on the machine.
8 Declare Paper Source Unit 3/4 in the Windows printer driver [Properties]/
[Configure] tab.
Working Table WT-P01
Provides an area to temporarily place an original or other materials. This is
also used when the authentication device is installed.
Kit Contents
a—Working table
b—Mounting plateWorking Table WT-P01 14-7
c—Four screws
d—Two screws
e—Two clamps
" Use this part when installing the Authentication Device (IC card type).
Store the part in a safe place for future use.
Installing a Working Table WT-P01
1 Using a coin, turn the screws (c)
to install the mounting plate.
c
b14-8 Working Table WT-P01
2 Tighten the screws (c) temporarily.
3 Install the working table.
c
1
aWorking Table WT-P01 14-9
4 Using a coin, tighten the screws
(c).
5 Using a coin, tighten the screws
(d).
d14-10 Working Table WT-P0115 Authentication
device (IC card
type)15-2 Using authentication device (IC card type)
Using authentication device (IC card type)
The authentication device (IC card type) is an IC card authentication system
that reads the IC card to perform personal authentication. Using this system,
you can perform authentication with an IC card to log in to this machine or
execute a print job when User Authentication is enabled in this machine.
To use the authentication device, first register the card ID of the user in this
machine. The registered user, who is authenticated with the card ID, can log
in to this machine or execute a print job. This section explains how to configure the required settings in this machine, register users, and log in to this
machine with authentication.
" Do not disconnect the USB cable while using the authentication
device. Doing so may cause the system to become unstable.
" Do not leave the IC card within 40 mm of the card reader.
Configuring this machine
User authentication settings must be configured with MFP authentication on
this machine.
Configure the user authentication settings using PageScope Web Connection.
" For details on using PageScope Web Connection, refer to "Reference
Guide".
1 In Administrator mode of PageScope Web Connection, click [Security] tab
- [Authentication] - [General Settings].Configuring this machine 15-3
2 In [User Authentication], select [Device].
3 Click [Apply] to save the settings.
4 In the [General Settings] page of [Authentication Device Settings], select
[Authentication Type] and [IC Card Type].
– In [IC Card Type], specify the required IC card type.
– For [Authentication Type], specify how to log in to this machine after
registration.
[Card Authentication]: Allows the user to log in by simply placing the
IC card.
[Card Authentication + Password]: Allows the user to log in by placing
the IC card and entering the password.
– For details on how to log in to this machine, refer to “Logging in to this
machine” on page 15-15.15-4 Registering a user
5 Click [Apply] to save the settings
– If the card function setting page appears, specify the necessary settings.
6 Exit PageScope Web Connection.
Then, proceed with the user registration.
Registering a user
Register a user using Data Administrator. The following two methods can be
used.
Connect the authentication device to your computer, and use Data Administrator to register the target user and card at a time.
Connect the authentication device to this machine, and associate the
user, who has been registered using Data Administrator, with an IC card.
Registering a user using Data Administrator
To use Data Administrator, configure this machine, and set up Data Administrator. For setup, install the IC Card Driver (USB-Driver) of the authentication
device, and then install Data Administrator IC Card Plugin.
" Before setup, install Data Administrator V4.0 or later in your computer.
For the Data Administrator operating environment and installation procedure, refer to the Data Administrator User's Guide.
Checking the version of the installed Data Administrator
1 From the [Help] menu of Data Administrator, select [Version Information].
" This software cannot be used if the version is "3.x". Install "4.x".
If Data Administrator V3.x is installed, it is removed when V4.x is
installed.
2 Click [Plug-in version].Registering a user 15-5
3 In [Plug-in information list], confirm the plugin version of Data Administrator.
– This software is available if the plugin version is "4.x".
Setup
1 Turn the Main Power Switch of this machine off, and disconnect the
authentication device from this machine.
2 Install IC Card Driver (USB-Driver).
Connect the authentication device to the USB port of your computer.
The [Found New Hardware] dialog box appears.15-6 Registering a user
3 Select [Locate and install driver software (recommended)].
4 Insert the application CD-ROM provided with the authentication device
into the CD-ROM drive of the computer.
5 Click the [Browse my computer for driver software (advanced)].Registering a user 15-7
6 Check that the driver's search location is the application CD-ROM, and
then click [Next].
– When the driver's search location is not the application CD-ROM, click
[Browse]. Select the IC Card Driver (USB-Driver) folder in the
CD-ROM, and click [OK].15-8 Registering a user
– Installation starts.
7 Click [Close].
Installation of the IC Card Driver (USB-Driver) is completed.
8 Install Data Administrator IC Card Plugin.
Open the IC_Card_Plugin folder on the application CD-ROM, and then
click setup.exe.Registering a user 15-9
9 Select a language, and then click [OK].
The installation program starts.
10 Follow the on-screen instructions to proceed with the installation.
11 Click [Next].
12 Select [I accept the terms in the license agreement], and then click [Next].15-10 Registering a user
13 Click [Install].
14 Click [Finish].
Installation of the Data Administrator IC Card Plugin is completed, which
completes the setup.
User registration
To register a user with Data Administrator, the computer and this machine
must be connected via network.
Also, to proceed to register a card with Data Administrator, the authentication
device must be connected to the USB port of the computer.
When registering a user, you can only enter the card ID and associate the
user with card using the authentication device unit connected to this machine.
1 Turn the main power switch on.Registering a user 15-11
2 To register a user and card with Data Administrator at a time, connect the
authentication device to the USB port of the computer that contains Data
Administrator.
" Do not connect another USB device to the same port as for the
authentication device. Doing so reduces the USB power supply,
resulting in an operation failure.
" To use the USB hub, be sure to connect the self-power USB hub that
supplies 500 mA or more.
" Restart the procedure 5 or more seconds after connecting the authentication device.
3 Data Administrator starts, and device information of this machine is
imported.
The Device Information window appears.
– For details on how to import device information, refer to the Data
Administrator User's Guide.15-12 Registering a user
4 In Select Function, select [Authentication settings] - [User authentication
settings], and then click [Add].
5 Select the desired template, and then click [OK].
The User settings window appears.
6 Enter the user name and password, and select the [IC card authentication] tab.Registering a user 15-13
– Enter the E-mail address and other information as required.
7 Place the IC card on the authentication device, and click [Start reading].
– To skip the card registration with Data Administrator, but to associate
the card with user using the authentication device connected to this
machine, select [Input the card ID directly] and enter the card ID number corresponding to the registered user.
8 Click [OK].
– Repeat steps 4 to 7 to register all users.
9 Click [Export to the device]15-14 Registering a user
– Select the user name and click [Edit] to change the registered data.
10 Click [Write].
– Data Administrator provides the batch copy function that batch-configures the registered user data in multiple machines with the authentication device enabled.
The registered user data is configured in this machine.
11 Click [OK]Logging in to this machine 15-15
12 If the authentication device is already connected to the computer, remove
it, turn the main power of this machine off, and then connect the authentication device to this machine.
" To turn the power switch of this machine off and on, first turn the main
power switch off, and then turn it on after 10 or more seconds has
elapsed. Not doing so may result in an operation failure.
" When connecting or disconnecting the USB cable, hold the plug. Otherwise, the cable may be damaged.
If you only enter the card ID when registering a user, associate the user with
card using the authentication device connected to this machine.
Associating the user with card using authentication
device
When a user and card ID have been registered using Data Administrator, the
user must be associated with the card in the Administrator Settings of the
machine.
1 Press [Utility/Counter] key on the control panel of this machine to switch
to the [Admin Settings] screen.
2 Press [Authentication Setting].
3 Press [Card Authentication].
4 Select a user to be registered, and press [OK].
– Press [All] to display all users. Press [Search] to extract target users
with search characters.
5 Press [Edit].
– Press [Delete] to cancel the registration when IC card information is
already registered.
6 Place the IC card on the authentication device, and press [OK].
– This associates the user with the IC card and registers the IC card for
the user.
Logging in to this machine
The following explains how to log in to this machine with IC card authentication.
To perform IC card authentication, register the information recorded in the
IC card in advance.15-16 Logging in to this machine
If an authentication failure recurs, the problem may be due to incorrect
registration of IC card information. Register IC card information again.
When [Card Authentication] is specified for [Authentication Type], a registered user is authenticated by simply placing the IC card. When [Card
Authentication + Password] is specified, a registered user is authenticated
by placing the IC card and entering the password.
Press [User Name] and [Password] to log in by entering the user name
and the password, without using the authentication device.
IC card authentication cannot be performed while the machine is in Power
Save mode. After pressing the [Power Save] key to cancel Power Save
mode, place the IC card on the authentication device and complete the
authentication procedure.
When [Card Authentication] is enabled
1 Press [Card Authentication].
" When using the ID & Print function with IC card authentication, select
[Begin Printing] or [Access Basic Screen] as necessary. For details on
the ID & Print function, refer to “ID & Print” on page 6-4.
2 Place the IC card on the authentication device.
When [Card Authentication + Password] is enabled
1 Press [Card Authentication].
" When using the ID & Print function with IC card authentication, select
[Begin Printing] or [Access Basic Screen] as necessary. For details on
the ID & Print function, refer to “ID & Print” on page 6-4.
2 Place the IC card on the authentication device.
3 Press [Password] and enter the password.
4 Press [Login].AppendixA-2 Technical specifications
Technical specifications
Type Desktop integrated flatbed ADF printer
Document holder Stationary (unit scanning)
Photoconductor OPC
Luminous source CCFL Dual
Printing system Semiconductor laser beam scanning + dry-type
electrophotographic method
Developing system Dry mono-component SMT developing system
Fusing system Lower free belt fusing system
Resolution Scanning 600 dpi × 600 dpi (standard),
600 dpi × 1200 dpi (max.),
600 dpi × 300 dpi (when using ADF)
Printing 600 dpi×600 dpi
Document Type Sheets, books, and other three-dimensional objects
Size Maximum Legal
Weight Maximum 3 kg
First print Black and white/color: 12.9 seconds or less (with
plain A4 paper), 12.8 seconds or less (with plain
Letter paper)
First copy Black and
white
10.1 seconds or less (with plain Letter/
A4 paper)
Color 12 seconds or less (with plain Letter/A4
paper)
Print speed/copy speed Simples
(single-sided)
Plain
paper
A4: 30.0 pages/minute (black
and white/color)
Letter: 31.6 pages/minute
(black and white/color)
Thick
paper
A4: 15.0 pages/minute (black
and white/color)
Letter: 15.8 pages/minute
(black and white/color)
Duplex
(double-sided)
Plain
paper
A4: 30.0 sides/minute (black
and white/color)
Letter: 31.6 sides/minute
(black and white/color)Technical specifications A-3
Warm-up Time Time until the machine is ready to begin printing
after being turned on (at room temperature (23°C))
120 V: Avg. 45 seconds
220 V: Avg. 45 seconds
240 V: Avg. 45 seconds
Paper sizes Tray 1
(manual
feed tray)/
Tray 2
Paper width
*1
: 92 to 216 mm
Paper length: 148 to 356 mm
*1
Envelopes with a width of 220 mm
can be printed from Tray 1 (manual
feed tray).
Tray 3/
Tray4
(optional)
A4, B5, Executive, Letter, Government
Legal, Legal
Paper types Plain paper (60 to 90 g/m2
)
Recycled (60 to 90 g/m2
)
Envelopes
Letterhead
Label
Thick 1 (91 to 150 g/m2
)
Thick 2 (151 to 210 g/m2
)
Postcard
Glossy 1 (100 to 128 g/m2
)
Glossy 2 (129 to 158 g/m2
)
Single side only (60 to 90 g/m2
)
Special paper (60 to 90 g/m2
)A-4 Technical specifications
Paper capacity Tray 1
(manual
feed tray)
Plain/Recycled/Single side only/Special paper:
100 sheets
Envelope:
10 envelopes
Label/Postcard/Thick 1/Thick 2/Glossy
1/Glossy 2/Letterhead:
20 sheets
Tray 2 Plain/Recycled/Single side only/Special paper:
250 sheets
Label/Postcard/Thick 1/Thick 2/Glossy
1/Glossy 2/Letterhead:
20 sheets
Tray 3/
Tray 4
(optional)
Plain/Recycled/Single side only/Special paper:
500 sheets
Image loss width Printing Leading edge/trailing edge/right edge/
left edge: 4.2 mm or less
Copying Leading edge/trailing edge/right edge/
left edge: 4.0 mm or less
Output capacity 250 sheets
Operating temperature 10 to 30°C (50 to 86°F)
"Fluctuations of no more than 10°C (18°F)
within an hour.
Operating humidity 15 to 85%
"Fluctuations of no more than 10% within an
hour.
Power supply 120 V, 60 Hz
220 to 240 V, 50 to 60 Hz
Power consumption 120 V: 1200 W or less
220 to 240 V: 1300 W or less
Power Save mode: 34 W or less
Amperage 120 V: 10.9 A or less
220 to 240 V: 4.8 A or less
Acoustic Noise Printing: 55 dB or less
Copying: 57 dB or less
Standby: 39 dB or lessTechnical specifications A-5
External dimensions Height: 550 mm (21.7")
Width: 530 mm (20.9")
Depth: 508 mm (20")
"Excluding some protruding parts and the
manual feed tray.
Weight Approximately 34.6 kg (76.3 lb) (without consumables)
Approximately 39.0 kg (86.0 lb) (with consumables)
Interface USB 2.0 (High Speed) compliant, 10Base-T/
100Base-TX/1000Base-T Ethernet, Host USB (USB
device printing)
Standard memory 1536 MB
Hard disk 120 GB
Machine life Maximum 400,000 pages and no more than
5 yearsA-6 Technical specifications
Consumable Life Expectancy Chart
User-Replaceable
" The values shown above indicate the number of pages for simplex
printing using A4/Letter-size media with 5% coverage.
The actual life may differ (be shorter) depending on the printing conditions (coverage, paper size, etc.), differences in the printing method,
such as continuous printing or intermittent printing (when print jobs of
one page are often printed), or the type of paper used, for example,
thick paper. In addition, the life will be affected by the temperature and
humidity of the operating environment.
" Whether printing in color or black and white, color printers consume a
small amount of each toner during the initialization operation when the
machine is turned on or off and during automatic adjustments to maintain print quality. Even if an operating error occurred during black-and
white printing, color toner is consumed and may need to be replaced.
Item Average Life Expectancy
Toner cartridge Standard in-box Cartridge:
6,000 pages or more (continuous)
Replacement Cartridge (High-Capacity):
6,000 pages or more (continuous)
Declared yield value in accordance with ISO/
IEC 19798.
"The toner cartridge life will be shorter
when using intermittent printing.
Imaging unit 30,000 pages (continuous)
20,000 pages (2 pages per job)
Waste toner bottle 36,000 pages (monochrome) (continuous)
9,000 pages (full color) (continuous)
Declared yield value in accordance with ISO/
IEC 19798.
Transfer roller 100,000 pages
Transfer belt unit 100,000 pages (continuous)
Fuser unit 100,000 pages (continuous)Technical specifications A-7
Service-Replaceable
Item Average Life Expectancy
Media feed roller 300,000 pagesA-8 Text input
Text input
The procedure for using the keyboard screen is described below.
Entering text
In the keyboard screen, press the character that you want to enter.
To enter uppercase letters, press [ ].
To enter symbols, press [ ].
To enter special characters, such as accented characters, press [ ].
To delete the character to the right of the cursor, press [Delete].
To move the cursor, press [ ] or [ ].
" Numbers can also be typed in with the keypad in the control panel.
" To clear all entered text, press the [C] key.Our Concern for Environmental Protection A-9
Our Concern for Environmental Protection
As an ENERGY STAR
®
Partner, we have determined that this machine meets
the ENERGY STAR Guidelines for energy efficiency.
What is an ENERGY STAR product?
An ENERGY STAR product has a special feature that allows it to automatically switch to a “low-power mode” after a period of inactivity. An ENERGY
STAR product uses energy more efficiently, saves you money on utility bills
and helps protect the environment.A-10 Our Concern for Environmental ProtectionIndex
Index A-11
Numerics
10Base-T/100Base-TX/1000Base-T
Ethernet Interface port ..........1-4
A
Accessibility .................................3-2
Account track ....................2-15, 2-16
Address Book ...........................10-34
Address Registration ........3-8, 10-35
ADF ................................................1-4
ADF feed cover .............................1-4
Admin Settings ...........................3-21
Address Registration ................3-43
Administrator Registration .........3-43
Authentication Setting ...............3-44
Copy Settings ...........................3-48
Ethernet ....................................3-45
External Memory Print ..............3-48
Fax Settings ..............................3-63
Folder Settings ......................... 3-69
HDD Format ............................. 3-77
Job Timeout ............................. 3-48
Machine Settings ...................... 3-41
Maintenance Menu ................... 3-63
Paper Empty ............................ 3-78
Print Settings ............................ 3-49
Restore Defaults ...................... 3-77
Security Settings ...................... 3-70
Associating the user with card using
authentication device ....... 15-15
C
Configuring this machine ......... 15-2
Consumables
Backup Battery ....................... 11-30
Fuser Unit ............................... 11-33
Imaging Unit ............................. 11-9
Toner Cartridge ........................ 11-2
Transfer Belt Unit ................... 11-22A-12 Index
Transfer Roller ........................11-20
Waste Toner Bottle .................11-17
Control panel .........................1-4, 2-2
Copy mode ....................................7-2
Color Mode .................................7-9
Density ........................................7-8
Duplex/Combine .........................7-7
Finishing ...................................7-10
ID Copy .....................................7-13
Image Quality ............................7-15
Original Size ...............................7-4
Original Type ..............................7-9
Paper ..........................................7-5
Paper Margin ............................7-14
Proof Copy ................................7-10
Separate Scan ..........................7-11
Zoom ...........................................7-6
D
Document feed tray ......................1-4
Document guide ...........................1-4
Document output tray ..................1-4
Document stopper ........................1-4
E
External Memory ..........................6-3
F
Front cover ....................................1-4
Fuser unit ......................................1-4
G
Group .........................................10-34
I
Imaging unit ..................................1-4
Interrupt .........................................8-2
L
LINE (telephone line) jack ............1-4
Loading Media ............................4-14
Logging in to this machine ......15-15
Lower feeder unit ................ 1-4, 14-3
M
Maintenance ............................... 12-2
Media
Clearing misfeeds .................... 13-6
Loading .................................... 4-14
Path .......................................... 13-5
Preventing misfeeds ................. 13-4
Media Misfeed
ADF ........................................ 13-13
Duplex .................................... 13-15
Fuser Unit ............................... 13-16
Transfer Roller ....................... 13-20
Tray 1 ..................................... 13-20
Tray 2 ....................................... 13-7
Tray 3/4 .................................. 13-11
Media Path .................................. 13-5
Messages
Error messages ...................... 13-39
Operator messages ................ 13-41
Service messages .................. 13-47
Status messages .................... 13-38
Warning messages ................ 13-39
Meter Count .................................. 3-7
Misfeed problems .................... 13-23
Mode Memory ............................... 8-3
O
Original cover pad ....................... 1-4
Original glass ............................... 1-4
Original Media
Loading .................................... 4-36
Output tray .......................... 1-4, 4-32
P
Page Margins ............................. 4-13
Part Names ................................... 1-4
Power connection ........................ 1-4
Power switch ................................ 1-4
Print Media ................................... 4-2
Envelopes ................................ 4-13
Storage ..................................... 4-33Index A-13
Print media type
Envelope .....................................4-6
Glossy Media ..............................4-9
Label ...........................................4-7
Letterhead ...................................4-8
Plain Paper (Recycled Paper) .....4-4
Postcard ......................................4-8
Single Side Only .......................4-10
Special Paper ...........................4-11
Thick Stock .................................4-5
Print quality ...............................13-31
Print Setting
Copy Settings ...........................3-15
Fax Settings ..............................3-20
Machine Settings ......................3-13
Print Settings ............................3-17
Scan Settings ............................3-16
Printable Area .............................4-12
Printer driver
Advanced Tab .............................5-7
Basic Tab ....................................5-8
Cover Mode Tab .........................5-9
Displaying ...................................5-5
Layout Tab ..................................5-9
My Tab ........................................5-8
Other Tab ..................................5-11
Quality Tab ...............................5-10
Uninstalling .................................5-4
Watermark/Overlay Tab ..............5-9
Program .....................................10-34
Program Address .....................10-37
Proof Print .....................................6-2
R
Rear cover .....................................1-4
Registering a user ......................15-4
Right door .....................................1-4
S
Scan mode ....................................9-2
Scan to E-mail mode ..................10-3
Background/Density ..................10-8
Binary Division ........................10-12
Color Mode ...............................10-7
E-mail ......................................10-13
E-mail Encryption ................... 10-12
File Setting .................... 10-9, 10-10
Original Settings .............. 10-5, 10-6
Original Size ............................. 10-5
Original Type ............................ 10-7
Resolution ................................ 10-8
Send Use Signature ............... 10-12
Simplex/Duplex ........................ 10-4
Scan to Folder mode ............... 10-18
Background/Density ............... 10-23
Color Mode ............................. 10-22
File Setting .................. 10-24, 10-25
FTP ........................................ 10-29
HDD ....................................... 10-31
Original Settings .......... 10-21, 10-22
Original Size ........................... 10-20
Original Type .......................... 10-23
PC(SMB) ................................ 10-29
Resolution .............................. 10-24
Simplex/Duplex ...................... 10-20
URL Notification ..................... 10-27
URL Notification Destination
................................................ 10-27
USB Memory .......................... 10-30
Web Service Settings ............. 10-32
WebDAV ................................ 10-30
Scanner lock lever ....................... 1-4
Scanner unit ................................. 1-4
Service messages .................... 13-47
System Requirements ............... 1-13
T
TEL (telephone) jack .................... 1-4
Text input ...................................... A-8
Toner cartridge ............................ 1-4
Touch panel .................................. 2-5
Transfer belt unit ......................... 1-4
Transfer roller .............................. 1-4
Tray 1 (Manual feed tray) ............ 1-4
Tray 2 ............................................ 1-4
Tray 3 ............................................ 1-4
Tray 4 ............................................ 1-4
Troubleshooting ........................ 13-1
Media Misfeeds ...................... 13-23
Status, error and
service messages .................. 13-38A-14 Index
TWAIN Driver .........................9-3, 9-8
U
USB HOST port .............................1-4
USB port ........................................1-4
User authentication ....................2-15
Device authentication ...............2-15
External server authentication
...................................................2-15
User Settings ..............................3-10
Using authentication device
(IC card type) .......................15-2
Utility Setting ................................3-1
W
Waste toner bottle ........................1-4
When [Card Authentication +
Password] is enabled .......15-16
When [Card Authentication] is
enabled ...............................15-16
WIA Driver .....................................9-7
Working Table ......................1-4, 14-6Copyright
A121-9561-13A 2009 2011. 1
http://konicaminolta.com
User’s Guide [Facsimile]x-1
Thank You
Thank you for purchasing a bizhub C35. You have made an excellent choice.
This User’s Guide describes operating procedures and precautions for the
use of the Fax functions. Be sure to read this User’s Guide before starting
any machine operations.
In order to ensure correct use of the Fax functions, read this User’s Guide,
and then store it where it can immediately be referred to when necessary.
Trademarks
KONICA MINOLTA and the KONICA MINOLTA logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of KONICA MINOLTA HOLDINGS, INC.
bizhub and PageScope are trademarks or registered trademarks of
KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
Windows, Windows NT, Windows Server is a registered trademark or trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.
Ethernet is a registered trademark or trademark of Xerox Corporation in the
United States and/or other countries.
IEEE and the IEEE logo are registered trademarks or trademarks of The Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc. in the United States and/or
other countries.
All other trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their
respective owners.
Copyright Notice
Copyright © 2009 KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.,
Marunouchi Center Building, 1-6-1 Marunouchi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo, 100-
0005, Japan. All Rights Reserved. This document may not be copied, in
whole or part, nor transferred to any other media or language, without written
permission of KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.x-2
Manual Notice
KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC. reserves the right to
make changes to this guide and to the equipment described herein without
notice. Considerable effort has been made to ensure that this guide is free of
inaccuracies and omissions. However, KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS
TECHNOLOGIES, INC. makes no warranty of any kind including, but not limited to, any implied warranties of merchantability and fitness for a particular
purpose with regard to this guide. KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS
TECHNOLOGIES, INC. assumes no responsibility for, or liability for, errors
contained in this guide or for incidental, special, or consequential damages
arising out of the furnishing of this guide, or the use of this guide in operating
the equipment, or in connection with the performance of the equipment when
so operated.Contents
Contents x-3
1 Introduction .................................................................................................... 1-1
Machine Parts ................................................................................................ 1-2
Front View................................................................................................... 1-2
Rear View.................................................................................................... 1-2
About the Control Panel ................................................................................ 1-3
Touch panel .................................................................................................... 1-6
Home screen............................................................................................... 1-6
Initial Fax screen......................................................................................... 1-8
Keys and icons that appear in the screens ................................................. 1-9
User authentication and account track ..................................................... 1-11
With user authentication............................................................................ 1-11
Device authentication.......................................................................... 1-11
External server authentication ............................................................ 1-11
With account track..................................................................................... 1-12
Initial settings ............................................................................................... 1-13
G3 fax settings .......................................................................................... 1-13
[Date & Time Settings] ........................................................................ 1-13
[Fax Target]......................................................................................... 1-13
[Sender Settings] ................................................................................ 1-13
[Comm. Settings] ................................................................................ 1-13x-4 Contents
Internet fax settings................................................................................... 1-14
[TCP/IP Settings] ................................................................................ 1-14
[Network Fax Functions Settings] ....................................................... 1-14
[E-mail TX (SMTP)]............................................................................. 1-14
[E-mail RX (POP)]............................................................................... 1-14
[Subject] .............................................................................................. 1-14
[Text] ................................................................................................... 1-14
Useful functions ........................................................................................... 1-15
2 Fax Settings screen ....................................................................................... 2-1
[Fax Settings] (User Settings) ...................................................................... 2-2
Settings ....................................................................................................... 2-2
[Fax Settings] (Admin Settings) ................................................................... 2-4
Settings ....................................................................................................... 2-8
[Sender Settings]......................................................................................... 2-8
[Header/Footer Settings]............................................................................. 2-9
[Comm. Settings]....................................................................................... 2-10
[Function Settings] .................................................................................... 2-12
[Fax Function Settings] ............................................................................. 2-13
[Memory RX] ............................................................................................. 2-15
[Closed Network RX Password]................................................................ 2-15
[Forward TX Settings] ............................................................................... 2-15
[Remote RX Settings]................................................................................ 2-16
[PC-Fax RX Settings]................................................................................ 2-16
[Nighttime RX Settings]............................................................................. 2-17
[PBX Connection Settings]........................................................................ 2-17
[Fax Report] .............................................................................................. 2-18
[List Print] .................................................................................................. 2-19
[Fax Target]............................................................................................... 2-20
[Fax Factory Default]................................................................................. 2-20
[Fax Image Initialized] ............................................................................... 2-20
3 Sending faxes ................................................................................................ 3-1
General operation .......................................................................................... 3-2
Positioning the original document ............................................................... 3-4
Using the ADF............................................................................................. 3-4
Using the original glass............................................................................... 3-5
Specifying destinations ................................................................................ 3-7
Selecting from the registered destinations.................................................. 3-7
Selecting from the Favorites list............................................................ 3-7
Selecting with an index search ............................................................. 3-7
Selecting by searching for a destination type or name ......................... 3-8
Directly typing in the address...................................................................... 3-8
G3 fax ................................................................................................... 3-8
Internet fax ............................................................................................ 3-9
Selecting from the log ................................................................................. 3-9Contents x-5
Selecting with an LDAP search................................................................. 3-10
Specifying scan settings ............................................................................. 3-11
[Original Type]........................................................................................... 3-11
[Resolution] ............................................................................................... 3-11
[Separate Scan] ........................................................................................ 3-11
Procedure ........................................................................................... 3-12
[Density] .................................................................................................... 3-12
[Background Removal].............................................................................. 3-12
[Sharpness]............................................................................................... 3-12
Specifying communication settings (G3 fax) ............................................ 3-13
[ECM OFF]................................................................................................ 3-13
[V34 OFF].................................................................................................. 3-13
[Check Dest. & Send]................................................................................ 3-13
Useful transmission functions (G3 fax) ..................................................... 3-14
[Timer TX] ................................................................................................. 3-14
[Password TX]........................................................................................... 3-15
[F-Code TX]............................................................................................... 3-15
Specifying e-mail (Internet fax) settings .................................................... 3-17
Specifying document settings .................................................................... 3-18
[Original Size]............................................................................................ 3-18
[Long Original]........................................................................................... 3-18
[Simplex/Duplex] ....................................................................................... 3-18
[Binding Position] ...................................................................................... 3-19
Sending to multiple destinations (broadcast transmissions) ................. 3-20
Selecting a program destination ................................................................ 3-21
Faxing manually (G3 fax) ............................................................................ 3-22
If the fax cannot be sent (automatic redialing) (G3 fax) ........................... 3-23
Canceling a queued transmission ............................................................. 3-23
Adding the transmitting subscriber identification ................................... 3-24
G3 fax........................................................................................................ 3-24
Internet fax ................................................................................................ 3-24
4 Receiving faxes .............................................................................................. 4-1
Receiving G3 faxes ........................................................................................ 4-2
Automatic reception .................................................................................... 4-2
Manual reception......................................................................................... 4-3
With the control panel ........................................................................... 4-3
With an external telephone ................................................................... 4-3
DRPD.......................................................................................................... 4-4
[Ring Pattern] ........................................................................................ 4-4
Receiving Internet faxes ............................................................................... 4-5
Useful reception functions ........................................................................... 4-6
Polling reception (G3 fax)............................................................................ 4-6
Performing a polling reception .............................................................. 4-6
Memory reception (G3 fax/Internet fax) ...................................................... 4-7
Using received documents.................................................................... 4-7x-6 Contents
Closed network reception (G3 fax).............................................................. 4-7
Fax forwarding (G3 fax/Internet fax) ........................................................... 4-8
E-mail forwarding (G3 fax/Internet fax) ....................................................... 4-8
Remote reception (G3 fax).......................................................................... 4-9
Giving the reception command from an external telephone ................. 4-9
Night reception (G3 fax/Internet fax)......................................................... 4-10
Printing received faxes ............................................................................... 4-11
Determining the paper size ....................................................................... 4-11
Step 1: Determining the most suitable paper size .............................. 4-11
Step 2: Determining the actual paper size used for printing ............... 4-12
Reducing and splitting............................................................................... 4-12
When [Tray Selection for RX Print] is set to a specific drawer............ 4-12
When [Min. Reduction for RX Print] is set to [100%] .......................... 4-13
When [Print Separate Fax Pages] is set to [OFF]............................... 4-13
When [Print Separate Fax Pages] is set to [ON]................................. 4-13
Adding reception information .................................................................... 4-14
5 Sending/receiving a PC fax ........................................................................... 5-1
Sending a PC fax ........................................................................................... 5-2
Transmission operation............................................................................... 5-2
Selecting a recipient from the phone book.................................................. 5-3
Selecting a recipient from the address book............................................... 5-4
Specifying transmission conditions ............................................................. 5-4
Creating a fax cover sheet .......................................................................... 5-5
[FAX Cover Sheet Settings] dialog box................................................. 5-5
[Basic] tab ............................................................................................. 5-6
[Recipient] tab ....................................................................................... 5-6
[Sender] tab .......................................................................................... 5-7
[Image] tab ............................................................................................ 5-7
Fax driver settings ......................................................................................... 5-8
[Printing Preferences] dialog box ................................................................ 5-8
[Properties] dialog box ................................................................................ 5-8
Common Settings........................................................................................ 5-9
[FAX] tab ................................................................................................... 5-10
[Basic] tab ................................................................................................. 5-11
[Authentication/Account Track] dialog box.......................................... 5-12
[Layout] tab ............................................................................................... 5-12
[Configure] tab........................................................................................... 5-13
[Settings] tab ............................................................................................. 5-13
Saving fax driver settings.......................................................................... 5-14
Saving the settings.............................................................................. 5-14
Editing settings.................................................................................... 5-14
Using the phone book ................................................................................. 5-15
Adding recipients to a phone book............................................................ 5-15
Editing a phone book ................................................................................ 5-16
Changing personal information ........................................................... 5-16Contents x-7
Changing group membership.............................................................. 5-17
Changing a group name ..................................................................... 5-17
Creating a folder ................................................................................. 5-17
Searching for personal information ..................................................... 5-17
Receiving a PC fax ....................................................................................... 5-18
Using received documents........................................................................ 5-18
Uninstalling the fax driver ........................................................................... 5-19
6 Registering destinations ............................................................................... 6-1
Destination registration ................................................................................ 6-2
Address Book.............................................................................................. 6-2
Group .......................................................................................................... 6-2
Program ...................................................................................................... 6-2
Registering an address book destination ................................................... 6-3
G3 fax.......................................................................................................... 6-3
Settings ................................................................................................. 6-4
Internet fax .................................................................................................. 6-5
Registering a program destination .............................................................. 6-6
7 Communication management ...................................................................... 7-1
Checking a job ............................................................................................... 7-2
Checking jobs being performed .................................................................. 7-2
Transmission jobs ................................................................................. 7-2
Reception jobs ...................................................................................... 7-2
Checking the job log.................................................................................... 7-3
Transmission jobs ................................................................................. 7-3
Reception jobs ...................................................................................... 7-3
Printing reports/lists ...................................................................................... 7-4
Types of reports .......................................................................................... 7-4
Types of lists ............................................................................................... 7-5
Activity Report............................................................................................. 7-6
Items that are printed ............................................................................ 7-6
TX Result Report......................................................................................... 7-7
Items that are printed ............................................................................ 7-7
Reservation TX Report................................................................................ 7-8
Items that are printed ............................................................................ 7-8
Broadcast Result Report............................................................................. 7-9
Items that are printed ............................................................................ 7-9
Broadcast Reservation Report.................................................................. 7-10
Items that are printed .......................................................................... 7-10
PC-Fax TX Error Report............................................................................ 7-11
Items that are printed .......................................................................... 7-11
I-Fax RX Error Report ............................................................................... 7-11
Items that are printed .......................................................................... 7-11
Address Book List/Group List/Program List .............................................. 7-12
Fax Setup Information list ......................................................................... 7-12x-8 Contents
8 Troubleshooting ............................................................................................ 8-1
Problems when sending faxes ..................................................................... 8-2
G3 fax.......................................................................................................... 8-2
Internet fax .................................................................................................. 8-4
PC fax ......................................................................................................... 8-4
Problems when receiving faxes ................................................................... 8-6
G3 fax.......................................................................................................... 8-6
Internet fax .................................................................................................. 8-7
Other problems .............................................................................................. 8-8
Error messages .............................................................................................. 8-9
9 Appendix ........................................................................................................A-1
Technical specifications ...............................................................................A-2
G3 fax..........................................................................................................A-2
Internet fax ..................................................................................................A-2
PC fax (Fax driver)......................................................................................A-3
Text input ........................................................................................................A-4
Entering text................................................................................................A-4Introduction1-2 Machine Parts
Machine Parts
The parts of the machine referred to throughout this manual are illustrated
below. Please take some time to become familiar with them.
Front View
1: Control panel
2: Automatic Document Feeder
(ADF)
2-a: ADF feed cover
2-b: Document guide
2-c: Document feed tray
2-d: Document output tray
2-e: Document stopper
3: USB HOST port
4: Tray 1 (Manual feed tray)
5: Tray 2
6: Output tray
7: Scanner lock lever
8: Original glass
9: Original cover pad
10: Scanner unit
Rear View
1: Power switch
2: Rear cover
3: Power connection
4: LINE (telephone line) jack
5: TEL (telephone) jack
6: 10Base-T/100Base-TX/
1000Base-T (IEEE 802.3) Ethernet interface port
7: USB port
4
3
2-e
2
2-c
2-d
5
1
2-a
2-b
10
9
6
7
8
1
3 2
4
6 5
7About the Control Panel 1-3
About the Control Panel
No. Name Function
1 Touch panel Displays various screens and messages.
Specify the various settings by directly touching the panel.
2 [Power Save] key/
indicator
Press to enter Power Save mode. While the
machine is in Power Save mode, the indicator
on the [Power Save] key lights up in green and
the touch panel goes off. To cancel Power
Save mode, press the [Power Save] key again.
3 [Fax] key/indicator Press to enter Fax mode. While the machine is
in Fax mode, the indicator on the [Fax] key
lights up in green.
4 [E-mail] key/indicator Press to enter Scan to E-mail mode. While the
machine is in Scan to E-mail mode, the indicator on the [E-mail] key lights up in green.
5 [Folder] key/indicator Press to enter Scan to Folder mode. While the
machine is in Scan to Folder mode, the indicator on the [Folder] key lights up in green.
6 [Copy] key/indicator Press to enter Copy mode. While the machine
is in Copy mode, the indicator on the [Copy]
key lights up in green.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8
9
191817 16 14 15 13 1211101-4 About the Control Panel
7 [Reset] key Press to clear the settings (except programmed settings) of all displayed functions.
8 [Interrupt] key/indicator
Press to enter Interrupt mode. While the
machine is in Interrupt mode, the indicator on
the [Interrupt] key lights up in green. To cancel
Interrupt mode, press the [Interrupt] key again.
9 [Stop] key Pressing the [Stop] key while copying, scanning or printing temporarily stops the operation.
10 [Start (Color)] key Press to start color copying, scanning or faxing.
Press to continue interrupted printing.
11 [Start] indicator Lights up in blue when copying, scanning or
faxing can be performed.
Lights up in orange when copying, scanning or
faxing cannot be performed.
12 [Start (B&W)] key Press to start black-and-white copying, scanning or faxing.
Press to continue interrupted printing.
13 Keypad Use to enter the number of copies, a fax number, an e-mail address or a name.
Use to type in the various settings.
14 [C] (clear) key Press to erase numbers or text.
15 [Error] indicator Flashes in orange if an error occurred.
Lights up in orange when the service representative is being called.
16 [Data] indicator Flashes in blue while a print job is being
received.
Lights up in blue while printing or when a print
job is queued.
17 [Utility/Counter] key Press to display the [Utility Settings] screen.
In the [Utility Settings] screen, settings can be
specified for the parameters in the [Accessibility], [Meter Count], [Address Registration],
[User Settings] and [Admin Settings] screens.
No. Name FunctionAbout the Control Panel 1-5
18 [Mode Memory] key Press to store the desired settings for copy, fax
or scan operations. In addition, stored settings
can be recalled.
19 [Access] key If user authentication or account track settings
have been applied, press the [Access] key
after entering the user name and password (for
user authentication) or the account name and
password (for account track) in order to log on
to this machine.
While logged on, press the [Access] key to log
off.
No. Name Function1-6 Touch panel
Touch panel
Home screen
No. Indication Description
1 Status Displays messages about the current operating status.
2 [Fax] Press to enter Fax mode.
3 [Scan to E-mail] Press to enter Scan to E-mail mode.
For details, refer to the [Printer/Copier/Scanner
User’s Guide].
4 [Scan to Folder] Press to enter Scan to Folder mode.
For details, refer to the [Printer/Copier/Scanner
User’s Guide].
5 [Copy] Press to enter Copy mode.
For details, refer to the [Printer/Copier/Scanner
User’s Guide].
6 Date/time Shows the current date and time.
7 [USB/HDD] Press to print files on a USB memory device.
Press to print a print job saved on hard disk.
1
10 6 9 7 8
2 3 4 5Touch panel 1-7
8 [Status] Press to view information on consumables and
devices.
9 [Job] Press to check a print, transmission, reception
or storing job.
10 Toner supply indicators
Shows the amount of toner remaining for yellow (Y), magenta (M), cyan (C) and black (K).
No. Indication Description1-8 Touch panel
Initial Fax screen
No. Indication Description
1 [Favorites] Press to display frequently used destinations.
2 [Direct Input] Press to directly enter a destination address.
3 [Others] Press to select a destination from the log. Documents saved on the machine’s memory can
also be used.
4 [Off-Hook] Press to send or receive a fax manually.
5 [Mode Check] Press to check the currently specified destinations and settings. From this screen, specified
destinations can also be deleted.
6 [Settings] Press to specify fax settings.
7 Press to return to the home screen.
7 5 6
1 2 3 4Touch panel 1-9
Keys and icons that appear in the screens
Icon Description
If the screen has multiple pages, press [ ] or [ ] to
select a different page.
If values appear between [ ] and [ ], the current page
number/total number of pages is indicated.
If there are tabs that are not displayed, press [ ] or [ ] to
select a different tab.
Press to adjust the image quality during a copy, scan or fax
operation.
Press [+] or [-] to change the entered value.
Press when an error occurs to view the error message.
Press to display descriptions of the various functions.
A description of the current screen will be displayed.
Press to display the address book. From this screen, you
can select single destinations and group destinations registered in the address book.
Appears while scanning and printing when making copies.
Appears while scanning with fax transmission and scanning
operations.
Appears while printing with PC printing, received fax printing
and report printing.1-10 Touch panel
Appears when using a G3 fax connection.
Appears when there are documents queued for a timer
transmission.
Appears when there are fax documents received with memory reception or PC faxing.
Appears when data or documents are being sent from this
unit.
Appears when this unit is receiving data or documents.
Appears when enhanced security settings have been
applied.
Appears when a USB memory device is connected.
Icon DescriptionUser authentication and account track 1-11
User authentication and account track
If user authentication or account track settings have been specified on the
machine, the user name or account name and the password must be entered
in the Login screen in order to log on.
The following procedures describe how to log on when user authentication or
account track setting have been specified.
" User authentication and account track settings are specified from PageScope Web Connection. For details, refer to the [Reference Guide].
With user authentication
Device authentication
1 Specify a name and password for [User Name] and [Password].
– For [User Name], the name can be specified either by directly typing it
in or selecting from a list.
2 Press [Login].
If authentication was successful, the functions of this machine can be
used.
External server authentication
1 Specify a name and password for [User Name] and [Password].
– For [User Name], the name can be specified either by directly typing it
in or selecting from a list.
2 Specify a server for [Server].
3 Press [Login].
If authentication was successful, the functions of this machine can be
used.
" If account track settings have been applied, account track will be performed after [Login] is pressed. However, if the machine has been set
to synchronize user authentication and account track and an account
had been specified for the user who is logging on, account track will
not be performed. For details, refer to the [Reference Guide].1-12 User authentication and account track
With account track
1 Specify an account and password for [Account] and [Password].
2 Press [Login].
If authentication was successful, the functions of this machine can be
used.Initial settings 1-13
Initial settings
After installation, settings must be specified for the following in order to use
the fax functions. Be sure to specify these settings correctly, otherwise fax
transmissions cannot be performed.
G3 fax settings
[Date & Time Settings]
Specify the current date and time.
For details on the settings, refer to the [Printer/Copier/Scanner User’s Guide].
[Fax Target]
Select the country where this machine is installed.
For details on the settings, refer to “[Fax Target]” on page 2-20.
[Sender Settings]
Specify the name and fax number of the sender (this machine).
For details on the settings, refer to “[Sender Settings]” on page 2-8.
[Comm. Settings]
Specify settings for the fax operating environment, such as the dialing method
and reception mode.
For details on the settings, refer to “[Comm. Settings]” on page 2-10.1-14 Initial settings
Internet fax settings
" Settings for using Internet fax functions are specified from PageScope
Web Connection. For details on the settings, refer to the [Reference
Guide].
[TCP/IP Settings]
Specify the necessary settings in order to use this machine in a TCP/IP network environment.
[Network Fax Functions Settings]
Enable Internet fax functions.
[E-mail TX (SMTP)]
Enable the e-mail (Internet fax) transmission function. In addition, specify the
IP address of the SMTP server and the e-mail address of this machine.
" When sending Internet faxes, [Binary Division] is always set to [OFF].
[E-mail RX (POP)]
Enable the e-mail (Internet fax) reception function. In addition, specify the
address, login name and password for the POP server.
[Subject]
Register a subject for the e-mail (Internet fax).
The subject can also be specified from the control panel before an Internet
fax is sent. For details, refer to “Specifying e-mail (Internet fax) settings” on
page 3-17.
[Text]
Register the message text for the e-mail (Internet fax).
The message text can also be specified from the control panel before an
Internet fax is sent. For details, refer to “Specifying e-mail (Internet fax) settings” on page 3-17.Useful functions 1-15
Useful functions
By registering destinations where faxes are frequently sent, recipients can be
recalled allowing a fax to easily be sent.
Address Book
Register information of destinations (fax numbers and e-mail addresses,
etc.) where data is frequently sent.
Group
Register multiple address book destinations together in a group.
Program
Register destinations where faxes are frequently sent together with fax
settings ([Scan Settings], [Comm. Settings] and [Original Settings]
screens).
" For details on registering destinations, refer to “Registering destinations” on page 6-1.1-16 Useful functionsFax Settings
screen2-2 [Fax Settings] (User Settings)
[Fax Settings] (User Settings)
The parameters available on the [Fax Settings] screen ([User Settings]) are
described below.
Settings
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [User Settings].
3 Press [Fax Settings].
The Fax Settings screen appears.
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
Item Description
[Remote RX Enabled] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the remote reception function is
used.
[Remote RX No.] Type in the number (2 digits) for performing remote
reception.
Remote RX
Enabled
Remote RX No.
Print Settings
Machine Settings
Scan Settings
Copy Settings
User Settings
Default
Fax Settings
Fax Settings
Display Fax
Activity[Fax Settings] (User Settings) 2-3
[Default Fax Settings] Settings [Factory Default] / [Current Setting]
Select the default settings for the parameters on the
[Scan Settings], [Comm. Settings] and [Original Settings] screens that are selected when the machine is
turned on or the [Reset] key is pressed.
[Factory Default]: The default settings are the manufacturer’s default settings.
[Current Setting]: The default settings are the current
settings.
[Display Fax Activity] Select whether or not transmission/reception information is displayed in the control panel while sending/receiving G3 faxes.
[Fax TX] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the number of originals,
address, ID and number of destinations are displayed
while G3 faxes are being sent.
[Fax RX] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the number of originals and ID
are displayed while G3 faxes are being received.
Item Description2-4 [Fax Settings] (Admin Settings)
[Fax Settings] (Admin Settings)
The parameters available on the [Fax Settings] screen ([Admin Settings]) are
described below.
Machine
Settings
Sender Settings Sender
Administrator
Registration
Authentication
Setting
Admin Settings
Address
Registration
Ethernet
Sender Fax No.
External
Memory Print
Job Timeout
Copy Settings
Fax Settings
Security
Settings
Folder Settings
Restore
Defaults
Print Settings
Header/Footer
Settings
Header Position
Footer Position
Fax TX Header
Name
Maintenance
Menu[Fax Settings] (Admin Settings) 2-5
Paper Empty
HDD Format Comm. Settings PB/DP
Number of RX
Call Rings
RX Mode
Redial Interval
Redial
Line Monitor
Volume
Line Monitor
Manual RX V.34
OFF
Ring Pattern
Function
Settings
Inch Paper
Priority
Print Paper Size
Paper Priority
Min. Reduction
for RX Print
Tray Selection
for RX Print
Duplex Print
(RX)
Print Separate
Fax Pages
Restriction
Code Settings2-6 [Fax Settings] (Admin Settings)
Fax Function
Settings
F-Code TX
Confirm Addr
(TX)
Dest. Check
Display Func.
Restrict Fax TX
Confirm Addr
(Register)
Restrict PC-Fax
TX
Restrict Fax RX
Memory RX Memory RX
Password
Forward TX
Settings
Forward TX
Setting
Forward & Print
Forwarding
Address
Closed Network
RX Password
Enable
Password
Restrict Internet Fax TX
Restrict Internet Fax RX[Fax Settings] (Admin Settings) 2-7
Remote RX
Settings
Remote RX
Enabled
Remote RX No.
Nighttime RX
Settings
Night Fax RX
Print
Night RX End
Time
Night RX Start
Time
PC-Fax RX
Settings
PC-Fax RX
Setting
PC-Fax RX
Print
PBX Connection
Settings
PBX Function
PBX Number
Fax Report Activity Report
TX Result
Report Image
TX Result
Report
PC-Fax TX
Error Report
TX Reserve
Broadcast
Result Report
Broadcast
Report
TX Result
Report Screen2-8 [Fax Settings] (Admin Settings)
Settings
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Admin Settings].
3 Type in the administrator password (Default: 12345678), and then press
[OK].
The Admin Settings screen appears.
4 Press [Fax Settings].
The Fax Settings screen appears.
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
[Sender Settings]
Item Description
[Sender] Type in the sender’s (this machine’s) name. (up to 30
bytes)
The information specified here is printed as the transmitting subscriber identification in the header of sent
documents.
[Sender Fax No.] Type in the fax number of this machine. (up to 20
characters)
The information specified here is printed as the transmitting subscriber identification in the header of sent
documents.
List Print Fax Setup Pg
Fax Image
Initialized
Fax Factory
Default
Fax Target
I-Fax RX Error
Report[Fax Settings] (Admin Settings) 2-9
[Header/Footer Settings]
Item Description
[Header Position] Settings [Inside Body Text] / [Outside Body Text]
/ [OFF]
Select the position for the transmitting subscriber
identification added to documents sent from this
machine.
The added transmitting subscriber identification is
printed as a part of the image in the received document.
If [OFF] is selected, the transmitting subscriber information is not added. (For 120V model, [OFF] is not
available.)
"When transmitting subscriber identification is
added while sending Internet faxes, the
information is added inside the document
regardless of the selected setting.
[Fax TX Header
Name]
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select the information added as the transmitting subscriber identification.
[ON]: Adds the sender’s name, recipient’s fax number (To: xxxxx), date/time that transmission begins,
communication number and page number/total number of pages as the transmitting subscriber identification.
[OFF]: Adds the sender’s name, sender’s fax number, date/time that transmission begins, communication number and page number/total number of pages
as the transmitting subscriber identification.
"The recipient's address will not be added when
sending Internet faxes, even if [ON] is
selected.2-10 [Fax Settings] (Admin Settings)
[Comm. Settings]
[Footer Position] Settings [Inside Body Text] / [Outside Body Text] /
[RX Ft. OFF]
Select the position for the reception information
(reception time and reception number) printed in documents received by this machine.
If [RX Ft. OFF] is selected, the reception information
is not printed.
Item Description
[PB/DP] Settings [PB] / [10pps] / [20pps]
Select the dialing method according to the operating
environment being used.
"The default setting differs depending on the
setting selected for [Admin Settings] - [Fax
Settings] - [Fax Target]. If [Fax Target] is set to
a country that is not compatible with [20pps],
[20pps] does not appear.
[RX Mode] Settings [Auto RX] / [Manual RX] / [DRPD]
Select the reception method.
[Auto RX]: Automatic reception
[Manual RX]: Manual reception; Select this setting if
an external telephone is connected and the phone
line is often busy, or if remote reception is to be used.
[DRPD]: If the receiver rings with the pattern selected
from the four ring patterns available, the incoming call
is automatically received as a fax. If [DRPD] is
selected, select the ring pattern for faxing with [Ring
Pattern].
[Number of RX Call
Rings]
Settings [1] - [15] ([2])
Specify how many rings are produced until the
machine begins receiving the fax when it is set for
automatic reception.
"The available settings and the default setting
differ depending on the setting selected for
[Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Target].
Item Description[Fax Settings] (Admin Settings) 2-11
[Redial] Settings [0] - [10] ([1])
Specify the number of times this machine automatically redials when a fax could not be sent correctly,
for example, if the line is busy or a communication
error occurred.
"The available settings and the default setting
differ depending on the setting selected for
[Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Target].
[Redial Interval] Settings [2] - [15] ([2])
Select the length of the interval (in minutes) between
redial attempts when the machine automatically redials.
"The available settings and the default setting
differ depending on the setting selected for
[Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Target].
[Line Monitor] Settings [OFF] / [Until Connection Complete] /
[Until Transmission Complete]
Select whether the line monitoring tone is produced
during communication.
[OFF]: No line monitoring tone is produced.
[Until Connection Complete]: The line monitoring
tone is produced until the connection with the destination has been completed after dialing.
[Until Transmission Complete]: The line monitoring
tone is produced until the fax transmission has been
completed after dialing.
[Line Monitor Volume] Settings [Low] / [Medium] / [High]
Select the volume of the line monitoring tone.
[Ring Pattern] Settings [Normal Ring] / [Double] / [Triple 1] /
[Triple 2]
Select the ring pattern for faxing when [RX Mode] is
set to [DRPD].
"For details on the settings, refer to “[Ring
Pattern]” on page 4-4.
Item Description2-12 [Fax Settings] (Admin Settings)
[Function Settings]
[Manual RX V.34
OFF]
Settings [Yes] / [No]
Select whether or not V.34 is automatically turned off
during manual reception.
Item Description
[Inch Paper Priority] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not paper sizes in inches are given
priority when printing received documents.
"The default setting is [ON] for 120V model, and
[OFF] for other models.
[Paper Priority] Settings [Auto Select] / [Fixed Size] /
[Size Priority]
Specify the priority for the paper drawers when printing received documents.
[Auto Select]: Selects the paper automatically.
[Fixed Size]: Prints only on paper of the specified
size.
[Size Priority]: Prints on paper with the size given priority. If no paper size has been given priority, paper
with the closest size is used for printing.
[Print Paper Size] Settings [Letter] / [Legal] / [Oficio] / [A4]
Select the size of paper used for printing received
documents.
In order for this parameter to be available, [Tray
Selection for RX Print] must be set to [Auto].
"The default setting is [Letter] for 120V model,
and [A4] for other models.
Item Description[Fax Settings] (Admin Settings) 2-13
[Fax Function Settings]
[Tray Selection for
RX Print]
Settings [Auto] / [Tray 1] / [Tray 2] / [Tray 3] /
[Tray 4]
Select the paper drawer to be used when a specific
paper drawer is used for printing received documents.
"[Tray 3] and [Tray 4] do not appear if the
optional lower feeder units have not been
installed.
[Min. Reduction for
RX Print]
Settings [87%] - [96%] / [100%]
Specify the reduction ratio (%) used for printing
received documents.
[Print Separate Fax
Pages]
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not pages are split when the
received document is longer than the standard paper
size.
When [Duplex Print (RX)] is set to [ON], this parameter does not appear.
[Duplex Print (RX)] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not received documents are printed
on both sides of paper.
When [Print Separate Fax Pages] is set to [ON], this
parameter does not appear.
Item Description
[F-Code TX] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not F-code transmissions are used.
[Dest. Check Display
Func.]
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the list of specified destinations
is printed before the fax is sent.
Item Description2-14 [Fax Settings] (Admin Settings)
[Cofirm Addr (TX)] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the destination address must
be entered a second time for confirmation when
directly typing in the address.
Requiring that the address be entered twice reduces
misdirected faxes caused by the address being
mistyped.
[Cofirm Addr (Register)]
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the destination address must
be entered a second time for confirmation when registering destinations.
Requiring that the address be entered twice prevents
incorrect programming caused by the address being
mistyped.
[Restrict Fax TX] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to prohibit G3 fax transmissions.
[Restrict Fax RX] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to prohibit G3 fax receptions.
[Restrict PC-Fax TX] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to prohibit PC fax transmissions.
[Restrict Internet Fax
TX]
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to prohibit transmission of Internet faxes.
[Restrict Internet Fax
RX]
Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to prohibit reception of Internet
faxes.
Item Description[Fax Settings] (Admin Settings) 2-15
[Memory RX]
" The function specified from this screen cannot be used at the same
time as a function specified from the [PC-Fax RX Settings], [Forward
TX Settings] and [Nighttime RX Settings] screens.
[Closed Network RX Password]
[Forward TX Settings]
Item Description
[Memory RX] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the memory reception function
is used.
If [ON] is selected, received documents are saved in
the machine’s memory and are not automatically
printed.
[Password] Specify the password (up to 8 digits) for allowing documents saved in the memory to be used.
Item Description
[Enable] Settings [Yes] / [No]
Select whether or not the closed network reception
function is used.
[Password] Specify the password (4 digits) for allowing the
machine to be used with closed network receptions.
Item Description
[Forward TX Setting] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the memory reception function
is used.
[Forwarding Address] Type in the fax number of the forwarding destination.
Press to select a registered destination.
"A received document can also be forwarded to
an e-mail address. To forward documents to an
e-mail address, select the forwarding
destination from the address book.2-16 [Fax Settings] (Admin Settings)
" The function specified from this screen cannot be used at the same
time as a function specified from the [PC-Fax RX Settings], [Memory
RX] and [Nighttime RX Settings] screens.
[Remote RX Settings]
[PC-Fax RX Settings]
" The function specified from this screen cannot be used at the same
time as a function specified from the [Forward TX Settings], [Memory
RX] and [Nighttime RX Settings] screens.
[Forward & Print] Settings [Forward & Print] / [Forward & Print (If
TX Fails)]
Select whether or not this machine also prints the fax
when it is forwarded.
[Forward & Print]: Normally prints the fax at the same
time that is forwarded.
[Forward & Print (If TX Fails)]: Prints the fax if forwarding failed.
Item Description
[Remote RX Enabled] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the remote reception function is
used.
[Remote RX No.] Type in the remote reception number (2 digits) for
performing remote reception.
Item Description
[PC-Fax RX Setting] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not the PC fax reception function is
used.
[PC-Fax RX Print] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a PC fax is printed automatically after it is received.
However, if the fax is saved with the memory reception function, it is not automatically printed.
Item Description[Fax Settings] (Admin Settings) 2-17
[Nighttime RX Settings]
" The function specified from this screen cannot be used at the same
time as a function specified from the [Forward TX Settings], [Memory
RX] and [PC-Fax RX Settings] screens.
[PBX Connection Settings]
Item Description
[Night Fax RX Print] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to prohibit printing of documents received during the night.
[Night RX Start Time] Specify the start time for the night.
[Night RX End Time] Specify the end time for the night.
Item Description
[PBX Function] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a PBX line is connected.
[PBX Number] Specify the outside line access number.
The outside line access number specified here will be
dialed before the fax numbers registered with
address book destinations and program destinations.2-18 [Fax Settings] (Admin Settings)
[Fax Report]
Item Description
[Activity Report] Specify the settings for printing activity reports.
[Output Settings] Settings [Every 100 comm.] / [Every Day] /
[100/Daily] / [No]
Select the conditions for printing.
[Every 100 comm.]: Prints after every 100 communication jobs.
[Every Day]: Prints at the specified time every
day.
[100/Daily]: Prints at the specified time every
day and after every 100 communication jobs.
[No]: Is not printed.
[Output Time
Setting]
Specify the time for printing the report when
[Output Settings] is set to [Every day] or [100/
Daily].
[Activity Report] Settings [Journal 100] / [Within 24 Hours]
Select a setting when [Output Settings] is set to
[Every day] or [100/Daily].
[Journal 100]: Prints the information for the 100
most recent communication jobs.
[Within 24 Hours]: Prints the information for a
maximum 100 communication jobs within the
past 24 hours.
[TX Result Report] Settings [Always] / [If TX Fails] / [No]
Select the conditions for printing the transmission results report.
[TX Result Report Image] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not an image of the first page
of the document is printed in the transmission
results report.
[TX Reserve] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a report is printed with
timer transmissions.[Fax Settings] (Admin Settings) 2-19
[List Print]
[PC-Fax TX Error Report] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not an error report is printed
with PC fax transmissions.
[Broadcast Report] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not a results report is printed
with broadcast transmissions.
[Broadcast Result Report] Settings [All Dest.] / [Mode Once]
Select the conditions for printing the results
report for broadcast transmissions.
[All Dest.]: Prints the report if transmission to all
destinations was completed.
[Mode Once]: Prints a report for each destination if transmission could not be completed,
even after redialing.
[TX Result Report Screen] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to request confirmation
for printing a transmission results report before
beginning the transmission.
[I-Fax RX Error Report] Settings [ON] / [OFF]
Select whether or not to print a reception error
report when reception of an Internet fax fails.
Item Description
[Fax Setup Pg] Settings [Print] / [Cancel]
A list of fax-related settings will be printed.
To print, press [Print], and then press [OK].2-20 [Fax Settings] (Admin Settings)
[Fax Target]
[Fax Factory Default]
" The address book is not initialized.
[Fax Image Initialized]
" The address book is not initialized.
Description
Settings [U.S.A.] / [Canada] / [Mexico] / [Austria] / [Belgium] /
[Denmark] / [Finland] / [France] / [Germany] /
[Greece] / [Ireland] / [Italy] / [The Netherlands] / [Norway] / [Poland] / [Portugal] / [Spain] / [Sweden] / [Switzerland] / [The U.K.] / [Russia] / [Argentina] / [Brazil] /
[South Africa] / [Australia] / [New Zealand] / [China] /
[Hong Kong] / [Malaysia] / [Singapore] / [Korea] / [Taiwan] / [Israel] / [Japan] / [Saudi Arabia] / [Turkey] /
[Hungary] / [Slovakia] / [Vietnam] / [The Czech
Republic] / [The Philippines] / [Europe]
Select the country where this machine is installed. Select the setting when
installing the machine.
Description
Settings [Yes] / [No]
The fax settings are reset to those specified when the machine was shipped
from the manufacturer.
To return all settings to their factory default, press [Yes], and then press [OK].
Description
Settings [Yes] / [No]
All saved fax data (jobs) is initialized.
To initialize, press [Yes], and then press [OK]. The machine is automatically
restarted.Sending faxes3-2 General operation
General operation
The general procedure for sending G3 faxes and Internet faxes is described
below.
1 Press [Fax] or press the [Fax] key to display the initial Fax screen.
– For details on the initial Fax screen, refer to “Initial Fax screen” on
page 1-8.
2 Place the document in the ADF
or on the original glass.
– For details on loading the
original document, refer to
“Positioning the original document” on page 3-4.
3 Specify the destination.
– For details on specifying destinations, refer to “Specifying destinations” on page 3-7.
– In the initial Fax screen, press [Mode Check] to check or change the
specified destinations.
4 Press [Settings], and then select the appropriate settings on the [Scan
Settings], [Comm. Settings] and [Original Settings] screens.
– For details on the [Scan Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying scan
settings” on page 3-11.
– For details on the [Comm. Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying communication settings (G3 fax)” on page 3-13, “Useful transmission functions (G3 fax)” on page 3-14 and “Specifying e-mail (Internet fax)
settings” on page 3-17.General operation 3-3
– For details on the [Original Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying document settings” on page 3-18.
5 Press the [Start] key.
– The fax is sent in black and white regardless of whether the [Start
(Color)] key or the [Start (B&W)] key is pressed.
After all document pages have been scanned, the fax is sent.
" This machine cannot automatically detect the size of an original document that will be scanned. Before scanning the document, specify its
size. If the size of the original document is not correctly specified,
some parts of the image may be lost. For details on specifying the size
of an original document, refer to “[Original Size]” on page 3-18.
" If the G3 fax cannot be sent, for example, because the recipient’s line
is busy, the machine will redial the fax number and try again to send
the fax. For details on redialing, refer to “If the fax cannot be sent
(automatic redialing) (G3 fax)” on page 3-23.
" If the fax could not be sent, a transmission results report is printed (if
the machine has been set to print the transmission results report). For
details on the transmission results report, refer to “Printing reports/
lists” on page 7-4.
" To stop a queued G3 fax and Internet fax transmission or a G3 fax
transmission queued for redialing, delete the job from the Job screen.
For details, refer to “Canceling a queued transmission” on page 3-23.
" If the memory becomes full while the document is being scanned,
scanning cannot continue. To send the document pages that have
already been scanned, press the [Start] key. To stop the transmission,
press the [Stop] key.
" Internet fax documents will be scanned and sent with the following
attributes.
· File type: Monochrome (TIFF)
· Coding method: TIFF-S (MH) 3-4 Positioning the original document
Positioning the original document
With this machine, the document can be placed in the ADF or on the original
glass.
Using the ADF
If the ADF is used, documents containing multiple pages can be automatically
scanned and faxed. In addition, double-sided documents can also be faxed.
1 Place the document face up in
the ADF.
2 Slide the document guides
against the edges of the document.
" Lower the document stopper
when scanning Legal-size
paper with the ADF.
" If the document contains
more pages than can be
loaded into the ADF, the document can be divided and
scanned separately. For
details, refer to “[Separate
Scan]” on page 3-11.
" A document containing a combination of Letter- and Legal-size pages
can be scanned with the ADF. When scanning a document containing
a combination of Letter- and Legal-size pages, select “Legal” as the
size of the document to be scanned. For details on specifying the size
of an original document, refer to “[Original Size]” on page 3-18.
" Do not load original documents that are bound together, for example,
with paper clips or staples.Positioning the original document 3-5
" Do not load more than 50 sheets; otherwise an original document misfeed or damage to the document or machine may occur.
" If the original document is not loaded correctly, it may not be fed in
straight, or an original document misfeed or damage to the document
may occur.
" Do not open the ADF cover while documents loaded into the ADF are
being scanned.
Using the original glass
If the original glass is used, documents that cannot be loaded into the ADF
(thick documents, such as a book, or a document on thin paper) can be
scanned and faxed. With the original glass, only one document page at a time
can be scanned.
1 Lift open the ADF.
2 Place the document face down
on the original glass, aligning the
document with the document
scales.3-6 Positioning the original document
3 Carefully close the ADF.
" When using the original
glass to scan a document
containing multiple pages,
the document can be divided
and scanned separately. For
details, refer to “[Separate
Scan]” on page 3-11.Specifying destinations 3-7
Specifying destinations
Use any of the following methods to specify destinations.
“Selecting from the registered destinations” on page 3-7
“Directly typing in the address” on page 3-8
“Selecting from the log” on page 3-9
“Selecting with an LDAP search” on page 3-10
Selecting from the registered destinations
An address book destination or group destination can be selected from those
previously registered on the machine.
" In order to select a registered destination, address book destinations
and group destinations must first be registered on the machine. For
details, refer to “Registering destinations” on page 6-1.
Selecting from the Favorites list
When destinations are registered, they can be specified as [Favorites].
As a default, the [Favorites] destination list appears when the initial Fax
screen is displayed.
Select a destination from the list. To specify multiple destinations for a broadcast transmission, select all destinations where the fax is to be sent.
" The setting for the Favorites list can be specified for a destination
when it is registered. For details, refer to “Registering destinations” on
page 6-1.
Selecting with an index search
Destinations can be selected by searching for the index characters specified
when each destination was registered.
1 In the initial Fax screen, press .
2 Press the desired index tab to search the destinations.
– If the desired index tab is not displayed, press [ ] or [ ] until the
desired tab appears.
– To select a group destination, press [Group].3-8 Specifying destinations
3 Select the destination, and then press [OK].
– To specify multiple destinations for a broadcast transmission, select all
destinations where the fax is to be sent.
Selecting by searching for a destination type or name
Destinations can be selected by searching for their type or name.
1 In the initial Fax screen, press .
2 Press [Search].
3 Select the search method.
– [Type]: Select the destination type (Fax, E-mail, etc.).
– [Name]: Directly enter the name of the destination to be searched for.
Type in the name to be searched for, and then press [OK] to display a
list of the search results.
4 Select the destination, and then press [OK].
– To specify multiple destinations for a broadcast transmission, select all
destinations where the fax is to be sent.
5 Press [OK].
Directly typing in the address
To specify a destination that is not registered with the machine, directly type
in the address.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Direct
Input] is set to [Restrict], an address cannot be directly typed in.
G3 fax
1 In the initial Fax screen, press [Direct Input].
2 Press [Fax].
3 Type in the fax number.
– [Tone]: Press to send push-button tones when pulse dialing is being
used. [T] appears in the screen.
– [Pause]: Press to insert a pause when dialing. [P] appears in the
screen.
– [-]: Press to insert a dash as a separator symbol while dialing. This
has no effect on the dialing.Specifying destinations 3-9
4 Press [OK].
" If [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Function Settings] - [Cofirm
Addr (TX)] is set to [ON], the fax number must be entered again after
[OK] is pressed.
" To specify multiple destinations for a broadcast transmission, press
[Next Dest.] after the fax number was entered, and then type in the
next fax number.
" If the machine is being used with a PBX, press [Pause] after the outside line access number (for example, [0]) for reliable dialing when
transmitting from an inside line to an outside line.
Internet fax
1 In the initial Fax screen, press [Direct Input].
2 Press [Internet Fax].
3 Type in the E-mail address.
4 Press [OK].
" To specify multiple destinations, specify all destinations where the
data is to be sent.
Selecting from the log
A destination can be selected from the log of the last five transmissions.
1 In the initial Fax screen, press [Others].
2 Press [Log].
3 Select the destination, and then press [OK].
" Only addresses that have been directly typed in remain in the log.
" Selecting destinations from the log is possible only for jobs with a single destination.
" When the machine is turned off, the transmission log is cleared.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Function Settings] - [Cofirm
Addr (TX)] is set to [ON], a destination cannot be selected from the
log.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Disable
Job History Display] is set to [ON], a destination cannot be selected
from the log.3-10 Specifying destinations
" The following types of transmissions are not recorded in the log.
· PC faxing
· Fax forwarding and E-mail forwarding
· Transmissions recovered after the machine is turned off, then on
again
· Transmissions where the address is directly typed in while the
machine is off-hook
Selecting with an LDAP search
Destinations can be selected after searching an LDAP server. This can be
used if the network contains an LDAP server, for example, for user management.
" In order to perform an LDAP search, the LDAP server must be registered with the machine. For details, refer to the [Reference Guide].
" Internet faxing is not compatible with a destination search of an LDAP
server.
1 In the initial Fax screen, press .
2 Press [LDAP].
3 Select the search method, and then perform the search.
– [Search]: Type in the keyword to be searched for. Press [OK] to begin
searching.
– [Advanced Search]: Select the appropriate conditions, and then type
in the keyword to be searched for. Press [OK] to begin searching.
4 Select the destination, and then press [OK].
– To register an address in the address book, select the address from
the address list, and then press [Save].
– To view the details of an address, select the address from the address
list, and then press [Details].
– To specify multiple destinations for a broadcast transmission, select all
destinations where the fax is to be sent.Specifying scan settings 3-11
Specifying scan settings
From the [Scan Settings] screen, settings for scanning the document can be
specified.
[Original Type]
Select the appropriate image quality setting according to your document.
[Resolution]
Select the resolution at which the document is to be scanned.
" A finer scan has more information to be sent, therefore, the transmission time increases.
" Only [Standard] and [Fine] are available for sending Internet faxes. If
[Super Fine] was selected, the setting will change to [Fine] before the
Internet fax is sent.
[Separate Scan]
A document can be divided and scanned separately.
The scan operation can be divided into several sessions, for example, when
the document contains more pages than can be loaded into the ADF or when
the original glass is being used to scan a document containing multiple
pages, and then all scanned pages can be faxed as a single document.
Item Description
[Text] Select this setting when scanning documents containing only text.
[Text/Photo] Select this setting when scanning documents containing a combination of text and photos.
[Photo] Select this setting when scanning documents containing only photos.
Item Description
[Standard] The document will be scanned at 200 × 100 dpi.
[Fine] The document will be scanned at 200 × 200 dpi.
[Super Fine] (G3 fax
only)
The document will be scanned at 400 × 400 dpi.3-12 Specifying scan settings
Procedure
1 Press [Fax] or press the [Fax] key to display the initial Fax screen.
2 Place the document in the ADF or on the original glass.
3 Specify the destination.
4 Press [Settings].
5 Press [Scan Settings].
6 Set [Separate Scan] to [ON].
7 Press the [Start] key.
The document is scanned.
8 Load the next batch of document pages, and then press the [Start] key.
– Repeat this operation until all document pages have been scanned.
– Press [Change Settings] to change the scan settings.
9 After all pages of the document have been scanned, press [Finish].
[Density]
Select the density at which the document is to be scanned.
Nine density levels are available. Select the appropriate density setting
according to your document.
[Background Removal]
Select the density of the background color at which documents with a background color are to be scanned.
Nine density levels are available for the background color.
[Sharpness]
Select the strength of outlines, for example, on characters and lines, for scanning the document.
To scan characters and lines with greater sharpness, select a setting toward
“+”. Seven sharpness levels are available.Specifying communication settings (G3 fax) 3-13
Specifying communication settings (G3 fax)
With [Line Settings] in the [Comm. Settings] screen, settings for the transmission line can be specified.
[ECM OFF]
The error correction mode (ECM) is turned off when data is being sent.
ECM is an error correction mode defined by ITU-T (International Telecommunication Union - Telecommunication Standardization Sector). Fax machines
equipped with the ECM feature communicate with each other while confirming that the sent data is free of errors. Therefore, communication can be free
of disturbances caused by telephone line noise, etc. If noise frequently
occurs, it may take a slightly longer time to complete a communication, compared with when ECM is turned off. After the transmission has been completed, this machine automatically turns on ECM.
" This setting cannot be used together with polling reception.
" If [V34 OFF] is set to [No], [ECM OFF] cannot be set to [Yes].
[V34 OFF]
V.34 is a communication mode used with super G3 fax communication. When
the remote machine or this machine is connected to a telephone line through
a PBX, it may not be possible to establish communication in super G3 mode
due to the condition of the telephone line. In this case, it is recommended that
V.34 be turned off before sending data. After the transmission has been completed, this machine automatically turns on the V.34 mode.
" This setting cannot be used together with polling reception.
[Check Dest. & Send]
The specified fax number is compared with the remote fax number (CSI), and
the data is sent only if the fax numbers match. If they do not match, the communication will fail, resulting in a transmission error.
" In order to use this function, the recipient’s fax number must be specified on their fax machine.3-14 Useful transmission functions (G3 fax)
Useful transmission functions (G3 fax)
With [Comm. Method] in the [Comm. Settings] screen, useful transmission
functions can be specified.
" For details on [Polling RX], refer to “Polling reception (G3 fax)” on
page 4-6.
[Timer TX]
A timer transmission can be specified.
Timer transmission is the function for sending a fax at a specified time. Multiple destinations can be specified. A maximum of 16 timer transmissions
(including transmissions being redialed) can be queued.
To send a timer transmission, press [Yes], and then use the keypad to type in
the transmission time. The time can be set in hours and minutes. The day
cannot be specified.
" In order to send a timer transmission, the date and time must first be
specified on the machine. For details on the date and time settings,
refer to the [Printer/Copier/Scanner User’s Guide].
" This function cannot be used together with Internet fax transmissions
or polling reception.
" If information was incorrectly entered, press the [C] key to erase the
entered information.
" If the machine is off at the specified TX Start Time, the fax will be sent
the next time that the machine is turned on.
" For details on canceling a queued transmission job, refer to “Canceling a queued transmission” on page 3-23.Useful transmission functions (G3 fax) 3-15
[Password TX]
A password transmission can be specified.
Password transmission is the function for sending a fax with a password
applied. This function can be used if the recipient’s fax machine is compatible
with closed network receptions.
If the recipient’s fax machine is set for closed network receptions, this
machine must transmit with the same password as the closed network reception password specified on the recipient’s machine.
To send a password transmission, press [Yes], and then use the keypad to
type in the closed network reception password specified on the recipient’s fax
machine.
" If information was incorrectly entered, press the [C] key to erase the
entered information.
" This function cannot be used together with F-code transmissions or
polling reception.
[F-Code TX]
An F-code transmission can be specified.
F-code transmissions are the function for sending a fax to a specific recipient’s box with a specified Sub address and password.
To send an F-code transmission, press [Yes]. Press [Sub Address] or [Password], and then use the keypad to type in the corresponding settings. The following types of recipient boxes are available.
Confidential TX
The fax will be sent to a confidential box on the recipient’s machine. Type
in the box number for [Sub Address], and type in the communication
password for [Password].
Relay TX
The fax will be sent to a relay box if the recipient’s machine is equipped
with a relay transmission function. Type in the relay box number for [Sub
Address], and type in the relay password for [Password].
" This function can be used if the recipient’s fax machine is compatible
with F-codes.
" Confidential communication is the function for using a confidential box
to receive a document to be sent to a specific person. In order to send
a confidential transmission from this machine, a confidential box and
password must be specified on the recipient’s fax machine.3-16 Useful transmission functions (G3 fax)
" Relay transmission is the function for sending a document to a relay
station, which then broadcasts the document to the recipients. In order
to send a relay transmission, a relay box number, relay password and
destination group number must be specified on the recipient’s
machine used as a relay station. This machine cannot be used as a
relay station.
" This function cannot be used together with password transmissions or
polling reception.
" If information was incorrectly entered, press the [C] key to erase the
entered information.Specifying e-mail (Internet fax) settings 3-17
Specifying e-mail (Internet fax) settings
With [E-mail Settings] in the [Comm. Settings] screen, specify the file name,
subject, From address and body text for sending Internet fax (e-mail) messages.
" For details on registering information from PageScope Web Connection, refer to the [Reference Guide].
Item Description
[File Name] Type in the document name for the scan data.
[Subject] Type in the subject for e-mail messages.
Subject text registered with PageScope Web Connection can also be selected.
[From] Specify the sender's address.
Select [Administrator E-mail Addr.] or [User
Address], or type it in directly.
[Administrator E-mail Addr.] can be selected if the
administrator e-mail address has been registered.
[User Address] can be selected if an e-mail
address has been registered for the currently
authenticated user.
[Body] Type in the body text for the e-mail message.
Body text registered with PageScope Web Connection can also be selected.3-18 Specifying document settings
Specifying document settings
From the [Original Settings] screen, settings can be specified for the document to be faxed.
[Original Size]
Specify the size of the document that is to be faxed.
[Long Original]
Select whether or not a long original document is to be sent. A document with
a maximum length of 1,000 mm can be sent.
To send a long document, press [ON].
" Long documents can only be scanned using the ADF. Double-sided
long documents cannot be scanned.
[Simplex/Duplex]
Select whether double-sided documents are to be scanned when the ADF is
used.
Item Description
[Standard Size] When sending a document of a standard size,
press [Standard Size], and then select the document size.
[Custom Size] Specify the size of the document if it is a non-standard size.
Press [X] and [Y], and then type in the document
size. [X] can be set between 148 mm and 356 mm
(5.83 inches and 14.00 inches); [Y] can be set
between 140 mm and 216 mm (5.51 inches and
8.50 inches).
Item Description
[1-sided] Select this setting when scanning a single-sided
document.
[2-sided] Select this setting when scanning a double-sided
document.Specifying document settings 3-19
[Binding Position]
Specify the binding position when sending a double-sided document using
the ADF. The orientation of the back sides of the pages differs depending on
whether the double-sided document will be bound at the top or at the left.
[Cover + 2-sided] Select this setting when scanning a double-sided
document with a cover page. Only the front side of
the first page will be scanned, and then both the
front and back sides of the remaining pages will be
scanned.
Item Description
[Left Bind] Select this setting for binding at the left.
[Top Bind] Select this setting for binding at the top.
[Auto] Select this setting to automatically specify the
binding position.
If the document length is 297 mm (11.69 inches) or
less, a binding position along the long side of the
paper is selected.
If the document length is more than 297 mm (11.69
inches), a binding position along the short side of
the paper is selected.3-20 Sending to multiple destinations (broadcast transmissions)
Sending to multiple destinations (broadcast
transmissions)
The same document can be sent to multiple destinations with a single operation.
If all of the desired destinations are selected when sending the fax, the same
document will be sent to each of the specified destinations. A broadcast
transmission can be specified as a timer transmission.
Use any of the following methods to specify destinations for broadcast transmissions.
Selecting from registered destinations (up to 500 destinations) (page 3-7)
Directly typing in the address (up to 100 destinations, including the destinations with an LDAP search) (page 3-8)
Selecting with an LDAP search (up to 100 destinations, including the destinations with direct input) (page 3-10)
Selecting a group destination (page 3-7)
Selecting a program destination (page 3-21)
" For details on destination types and their registration procedures, refer
to “Registering destinations” on page 6-1.
" The results of the broadcast transmission can be viewed in the Broadcast Result Report. For details, refer to “Broadcast Result Report” on
page 7-9.
" When the broadcast transmission destinations include both G3 fax
and Internet fax destinations, the document cannot be sent with the
[Super Fine] Resolution setting (400 × 400 dpi).
" When the broadcast transmission destinations include both G3 fax
and Internet fax destinations, the timer transmission function cannot
be used.
" Internet faxing is not compatible with a destination search of an LDAP
server.Selecting a program destination 3-21
Selecting a program destination
A fax can be sent with a program destination registered on the machine.
Program destinations are registered with destinations where faxes are frequently sent together with fax settings ([Scan Settings], [Comm. Settings] and
[Original Settings] screens) allowing a fax to easily be sent without the trouble
of specifying the various settings.
1 Press [Fax] or press the [Fax] key to display the initial Fax screen.
– For details on the initial Fax screen, refer to “Initial Fax screen” on
page 1-8.
2 Position the document to be faxed.
– For details on loading the original document, refer to “Positioning the
original document” on page 3-4.
3 Press the [Mode Memory] key.
4 Select the desired program destination from the list, and then press [OK].
The settings and destination addresses are recalled.
5 Press the [Start] key.
The document is scanned and transmission begins.
" In order to select a program destination, the program destination must
first be registered on the machine. For details, refer to “Registering a
program destination” on page 6-6.
" When the broadcast transmission destinations include both G3 fax
and Internet fax destinations, the document cannot be sent with the
[Super Fine] Resolution setting (400 × 400 dpi).
" When the broadcast transmission destinations include both G3 fax
and Internet fax destinations, the timer transmission function cannot
be used.3-22 Faxing manually (G3 fax)
Faxing manually (G3 fax)
If a fax is sent manually, the status of the recipient can be confirmed before
the fax is sent.
In order to send a fax manually, the following requirements must be met.
The document cannot be divided and scanned separately. If the original
glass is being used, the document being sent can contain only one page.
F-code transmissions, timer transmissions, password transmissions and
polling reception are not being performed.
Automatic redialing cannot be used.
Multiple destinations cannot be specified.
The procedure for a manual transmission with [Off-Hook] pressed is
described below.
" If [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Function Settings] - [Cofirm
Addr (TX)] is set to [ON], [Off-Hook] cannot be used.
1 Press [Fax] or press the [Fax] key to display the initial Fax screen.
– For details on the initial Fax screen, refer to “Initial Fax screen” on
page 1-8.
2 Position the document to be faxed.
– For details on loading the original document, refer to “Positioning the
original document” on page 3-4.
3 Press [Settings], and then select the appropriate settings on the [Scan
Settings], [Comm. Settings] and [Original Settings] screens.
– For details on the [Scan Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying scan
settings” on page 3-11.
– For details on the [Comm. Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying communication settings (G3 fax)” on page 3-13 and “Useful transmission
functions (G3 fax)” on page 3-14.
– For details on the [Original Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying document settings” on page 3-18.
4 Press [Off-Hook].
5 Make sure that [Send] is selected.
6 Specify the destination.
– Press to select a registered destination.
– Press the [Mode Memory] key to select a program destination.
7 After the fax answer tone is heard, press [Start] or press the [Start] key.
The document is scanned and transmission begins.If the fax cannot be sent (automatic redialing) (G3 fax) 3-23
If the fax cannot be sent (automatic
redialing) (G3 fax)
If the fax could not be sent correctly, for example, if the line is busy or a communication error occurred, a message appears, informing that the number
will be redialed after a certain length of time. A fax that could not be sent
becomes a queued transmission, and the machine automatically redials the
number after a certain length of time has passed.
If necessary, the number of redial attempts and the interval between them
can be specified. For details, refer to “[Comm. Settings]” on page 2-10.
" Automatic redialing cannot be used if the fax is being sent manually.
" For details on canceling a transmission being redialed, refer to “Canceling a queued transmission” on page 3-23.
" For details on problems that may occur during transmission, refer to
“Problems when sending faxes” on page 8-2.
Canceling a queued transmission
To stop a queued G3 fax and Internet fax transmission or a G3 fax transmission queued for redialing, delete the job from the Job screen.
1 In the home screen, press [Job].
– For details on the home screen, refer to “Home screen” on page 1-6.
2 Press [Send].
A list of queued transmission jobs appears.
3 Select the job to be deleted, and then press [Delete].
4 Press [Yes], and then press [OK].
The job is deleted.
" For details on the Job screen, refer to the [Printer/Copier/Scanner
User’s Guide].3-24 Adding the transmitting subscriber identification
Adding the transmitting subscriber
identification
The transmitting subscriber identification can be added to documents sent
from this machine. This information is printed in the header of the received
document as a part of the image.
" For details on the settings for specifying where to print the transmitting
subscriber identification and for printing the recipient information in the
transmitting subscriber identification, refer to “[Header/Footer Settings]” on page 2-9.
G3 fax
The following information can be printed as the transmitting subscriber identification.
Sender’s name
Fax numbers of the sender or recipient
Date/time that transmission begins
Communication number
Page number/total number of pages
" For details on the registering the name and fax number of the sender
(this machine), refer to “[Sender Settings]” on page 2-8.
" During a manual transmission, the total number of pages is not printed
in the transmitting subscriber identification.
Internet fax
The following information can be printed as the transmitting subscriber identification.
From address of the Internet fax (E-mail)
Date/time that transmission begins
Communication number
Page number/total number of pages
" When sending Internet faxes, transmitting subscriber identification is
added inside the document.Receiving faxes4-2 Receiving G3 faxes
Receiving G3 faxes
The following reception modes are available with this machine. Select the
one that fits your environment.
“Automatic reception” on page 4-2
“Manual reception” on page 4-3
“DRPD” on page 4-4
" When the machine is turned off, faxes cannot be received. Therefore,
be sure to leave the machine turned on.
Automatic reception
Select this mode when using the telephone line as a dedicated fax line. When
the specified number of rings is detected, fax reception begins automatically.
In order to receive faxes automatically, the following settings in the [Fax Settings] screen ([Admin Settings]) must be specified.
Set [Comm. Settings] - [RX Mode] to [Auto RX].
With [Comm. Settings] - [Number of RX Call Rings] to specify how many
rings are produced before the machine begins receiving the fax.
" For details on the settings, refer to “[Comm. Settings]” on page 2-10.Receiving G3 faxes 4-3
Manual reception
Select this mode if an external telephone is connected and it is frequently
used to make phone calls.
Manual reception can be performed either with the control panel of this
machine or with an external telephone.
In order to receive faxes manually, the following settings in the [Fax Settings]
screen ([Admin Settings]) must be specified.
Set [Comm. Settings] - [RX Mode] to [Manual RX].
With [Comm. Settings] - [Manual RX V.34 OFF], specify that V.34 is automatically turned off during manual reception.
" For details on the settings, refer to “[Comm. Settings]” on page 2-10.
With the control panel
The procedure for manually receiving a fax from the control panel is
described below.
1 When the external telephone rings, press [Off-Hook] in the initial Fax
screen.
2 Press [Receive].
3 Press [Start] or press the [Start] key.
The machine starts receiving the fax.
With an external telephone
For details on the procedure using the external telephone, refer to “Remote
reception (G3 fax)” on page 4-9.4-4 Receiving G3 faxes
DRPD
Select this mode when using DRPD (Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection).
If the receiver rings with the pattern selected from the four ring patterns available, the incoming call is automatically received as a fax.
In order to use DRPD, the following settings in the [Fax Settings] screen
([Admin Settings]) must be specified.
Set [Comm. Settings] - [RX Mode] to [DRPD].
With [Comm. Settings] - [Ring Pattern], select the ring pattern for faxing.
" For details on the settings, refer to “[Comm. Settings]” on page 2-10.
[Ring Pattern]
Refer to the following table and select the ring pattern.
S-ON (Short-ON): On for 150 ms to 600 ms
L-ON (Long-ON): On for more than 600 ms
S-OFF (Short-OFF): Off for 100 ms to 1,200 ms
L-OFF (Long-OFF): Off for more than 1,200 ms
Settings Ring Pattern
[Normal Ring] L-ON + L-OFF
[Double] L-ON + S-OFF + L-ON + L-OFF
[Triple 1] S-ON + S-OFF + L-ON + S-OFF + S-ON + L-OFF
[Triple 2] S-ON + S-OFF + S-ON + S-OFF + L-ON + L-OFFReceiving Internet faxes 4-5
Receiving Internet faxes
Settings for receiving Internet faxes (e-mail) must first be specified from the
[E-mail RX (POP)] page of PageScope Web Connection. For details of the
settings on the [E-mail RX (POP)] page, refer to the [Reference Guide].
This machine connects to the POP server at a fixed interval to check if an
Internet fax has arrived. If an Internet fax has been received, the attached file
will automatically be printed.
" If data is received with a resolution not supported by this machine, a
reception error occurs. For the resolution of data that can be received
by this machine, refer to “Technical specifications” on page A-2.
" The subject and body text of received Internet faxes are not printed.
" If the memory reception or PC fax reception function is being used, the
data for a received Internet fax is saved in the memory. For details on
using data saved in the memory, refer to “Memory reception (G3 fax/
Internet fax)” on page 4-7 or “Receiving a PC fax” on page 5-18.
" Settings can be specified for printing a reception error report when
reception of an Internet fax fails. For details on the report, refer to
“Printing reports/lists” on page 7-4.4-6 Useful reception functions
Useful reception functions
The various useful reception functions available with this machine are
described below.
Polling reception (G3 fax)
Polling reception is the function where a document queued for polling transmission by the sender or a document saved on the sender’s bulletin board is
sent with a command from the recipient. This is useful when the recipient is to
incur the cost of the call.
Polling reception can be performed to receive a normal fax or to receive a fax
by specifying the sender’s bulletin board.
" This function cannot be used together with ECM OFF, V34 OFF, password transmissions, timer transmissions, F-code transmissions or
Internet fax transmissions.
" Multiple destinations cannot be specified.
Performing a polling reception
The procedure for using polling reception is described below.
1 Press [Fax] or press the [Fax] key to display the initial Fax screen.
2 Specify the destination.
3 Press [Settings].
4 Press [Comm. Settings].
5 Press [Comm. Method].
6 Press [Polling RX].
7 Press [Yes], and then select the reception method.
– To perform normal polling reception, press [Polling RX].
– To specify a sender’s bulletin board for polling reception, press [Bulletin], and then use the keypad to type in the sender’s bulletin board
number.
– If information was incorrectly entered, press the [C] key to erase the
entered information.
8 Press [OK].
9 Press the [Start] key.
Polling reception begins.Useful reception functions 4-7
Memory reception (G3 fax/Internet fax)
Memory reception is the function for saving received documents in the
machine’s memory. Documents saved in the memory can be printed or
retrieved.
In order to use memory reception, the following settings in the [Fax Settings]
screen ([Admin Settings]) must be specified.
Set [Memory RX] - [Memory RX] to [ON].
With [Memory RX] - [Password], specify the password for allowing documents saved in the memory to be used.
" For details on the settings, refer to “[Memory RX]” on page 2-15.
" This function cannot be used together with PC fax reception, fax forwarding, E-mail forwarding or night reception.
Using received documents
The procedure for using a document saved in the memory is described
below.
1 Press [Fax] or press the [Fax] key to display the initial Fax screen.
2 Press [Others].
3 Press [Memory RX].
4 Type in the password, and then press [OK].
The list of documents saved in the memory is displayed.
5 Select the document to be printed, and then press [Print].
– To delete the selected document, press [Delete].
The document is printed.
" Received documents can be retrieved by using PageScope Web Connection. For details, refer to the [Reference Guide].
Closed network reception (G3 fax)
Closed network reception is the function for accepting only transmissions
from sender’s machines with a matching password.
This function can only be used if the sender’s fax machine is equipped with a
password transmission function. If this machine is set for closed network
receptions, the sender’s fax machine must transmit with the same password
as the closed network reception password specified on this machine.
In order to use closed network reception, the following settings in the [Fax
Settings] screen ([Admin Settings]) must be specified.4-8 Useful reception functions
Set [Closed Network RX Password] - [Enable] to [Yes].
With [Closed Network RX Password] - [Password], specify the password
for allowing the machine to be used with closed network receptions.
" For details on the settings, refer to “[Closed Network RX Password]”
on page 2-15.
Fax forwarding (G3 fax/Internet fax)
Fax forwarding is the function for forwarding received documents to the previously specified destination.
In order to use fax forwarding, the following settings in the [Fax Settings]
screen ([Admin Settings]) must be specified.
Set [Forward TX Settings] - [Forward TX Setting] to [ON].
With [Forward TX Settings] - [Forwarding Address], specify the fax number of the forwarding destination.
With [Forward TX Settings] - [Forward & Print], select whether or not this
machine also prints the fax when it is forwarded.
" For details on the settings, refer to “[Forward TX Settings]” on
page 2-15.
" An Internet fax destination cannot be specified as the forwarding destination.
" If a document with a resolution of 300 × 300 dpi is received as an
Internet fax, this machine prints the document without forwarding it.
" This function cannot be used together with PC fax reception, memory
reception or night reception.
E-mail forwarding (G3 fax/Internet fax)
E-mail forwarding is the function for forwarding received documents to the
previously specified destination.
In order to use e-mail forwarding, the following settings in the [Fax Settings]
screen ([Admin Settings]) must be specified.
Set [Forward TX Settings] - [Forward TX Setting] to [ON].
With [Forward TX Settings] - [Forwarding Address], press , and
then specify the e-mail address of the forwarding destination.Useful reception functions 4-9
With [Forward TX Settings] - [Forward & Print], select whether or not this
machine also prints the fax when it is forwarded.
" For details on the settings, refer to “[Forward TX Settings]” on
page 2-15.
" This function cannot be used together with PC fax reception, memory
reception or night reception.
Remote reception (G3 fax)
Remote reception is the function for giving this machine the command to
receive a fax by entering a remote reception number from an external telephone.
In order to use remote reception, the following settings in the [Fax Settings]
screen ([Admin Settings]) must be specified.
Set [Comm. Settings] - [RX Mode] to [Manual RX].
Set [Remote RX Settings] - [Remote RX Enabled] to [Yes].
With [Remote RX Settings] - [Remote RX No.], specify the remote reception number for giving the command to receive a fax.
" For details on the parameters in the [Comm. Settings] screen, refer to
“[Comm. Settings]” on page 2-10.
" For details on the parameters in the [Remote RX Settings] screen,
refer to “[Remote RX Settings]” on page 2-16.
Giving the reception command from an external telephone
The procedure for using remote reception is described below.
1 When the external telephone rings, pick up the receiver, and then check
that a fax is being sent.
2 With the external telephone, type in the remote reception number (2 digits).
The machine starts receiving the fax.
3 Replace the telephone receiver.
" When using remote reception with pulse dialing, the telephone must
be switched to pulse dialing. For details on switching to pulse dialing,
refer to the instruction manual for the telephone.4-10 Useful reception functions
Night reception (G3 fax/Internet fax)
Night reception is the function for prohibiting printing of received documents
during the specified night times. Documents received during the time that
printing is prohibited are all printed when the machine is finally able to print.
In order to use night reception, the following settings in the [Fax Settings]
screen ([Admin Settings]) must be specified.
Set [Nighttime RX Settings] - [Night Fax RX Print] to [ON].
With [Nighttime RX Settings] - [Night RX Start Time], specify the start time
for the night.
With [Nighttime RX Settings] - [Night RX End Time], specify the end time
for the night.
" For details on the settings, refer to “[Nighttime RX Settings]” on
page 2-17.
" This function cannot be used together with PC fax reception, memory
reception, fax forwarding or E-mail forwarding.Printing received faxes 4-11
Printing received faxes
This section describes how received faxes are printed.
Determining the paper size
The following describes the guidelines for determining the most suitable
paper size and the size of paper that will be printed on.
" For details on the paper settings for printing received documents, refer
to “[Function Settings]” on page 2-12.
Step 1: Determining the most suitable paper size
Based on the following rules, the most suitable paper size is automatically
determined from the width and length of the received document.
Width of
received
document
(fixed at A4)
Inch Paper
Priority
Footer
Position
Length of
received
document
(mm)
Paper size
that was
determined
(most
suitable
paper size)
A4-width [OFF] [RX Ft. OFF]
or [Inside
Body Text]
1,000 or less A4
[Outside Body
Text]
1,000 or less A4
[ON] [RX Ft. OFF]
or [Inside
Body Text]
292 or less Letter
293 - 1000 Legal
[Outside Body
Text]
284 or less Letter
285 - 1000 Legal4-12 Printing received faxes
Step 2: Determining the actual paper size used for printing
The machine checks if paper of the most suitable size determined in step 1 is
loaded.
If paper of the most suitable size is loaded, printing begins.
If paper of the most suitable size is not loaded, or if the Auto Tray Switch
function is disabled, the machine checks for paper of the next most suitable size in the order listed in the following table, starting from the top.
" If no paper suitable for printing is loaded in a paper drawer, a message
appears, instructing that paper be loaded.
" For details on the Auto Tray Switch function, refer to the [Printer/
Copier/Scanner User’s Guide].
Reducing and splitting
The following four reducing and splitting operations are performed when a
received document is printed, depending on the selected settings.
" For details on the reducing and splitting settings for printing received
documents, refer to “[Function Settings]” on page 2-12.
When [Tray Selection for RX Print] is set to a specific
drawer
If the received document is the same size or is shorter than the paper
loaded in the drawer, the image is printed reduced by the specified reduction ratio (between 87% and 96%).
If the received document is longer than the paper loaded in the drawer,
the image is automatically reduced (between 75% and 96%) and printed.
If the received document still does not fit within the paper, even after being
reduced up to 75%, any part of the image that does not fit within the paper
will be lost.
The pages cannot be split.
Most suitable paper
size
A4 Letter Legal
Order for selecting
paper
(from top to bottom)
A4 Letter Legal
A4 Letter
Legal A4Printing received faxes 4-13
When [Min. Reduction for RX Print] is set to [100%]
The pages cannot be split.
The image is not reduced.
[Tray Selection for RX Print] is set to [Auto].
Received documents are printed at full size on paper that fits the length of
the received image minus 20 mm. As a result, up to 20 mm of the trailing
edge of the image may be cut off. If the length of the received image is
more than 20 mm longer than the paper size, the image is printed on the
next larger paper size (most suitable paper size).
When [Print Separate Fax Pages] is set to [OFF]
The received document is automatically reduced (between 75% and 96%)
and printed. If the received document still does not fit within a single page,
even after being reduced up to 75%, any part of the image that does not fit
within the paper will be lost.
The image is reduced in both the main scanning direction and the
sub-scanning direction while maintaining the original height-to-width ratio.
If the orientation of the paper to be printed on is different from the orientation of the paper that was automatically selected, the image will not be
automatically rotated 90°.
When [Print Separate Fax Pages] is set to [ON]
The received document is reduced by the specified reduction ratio
(between 87% and 96%). If the document does not fit within a single
page, the document is split and the remainder is printed on the next page.
There is no overlapping section on split pages.
" Pages are not split when the following settings have been specified,
even if [Print Separate Fax Pages] is set to [ON].
·When [Tray Selection for RX Print] is set to a specific drawer for printing
·When [Min. Reduction for RX Print] is set to [100%]
·When [Paper Priority] is set to [Fixed Size] or [Size Priority]
·When [Duplex Print] is set to [ON]4-14 Adding reception information
Adding reception information
Reception information can be added to documents received at this machine.
This information is printed in the footer of the received document.
The following information can be printed as the reception information.
Reception date/time
Communication number
Page number/total number of pages
" For details on the settings for specifying whether or not reception
information is printed and where to print the reception information,
refer to “[Header/Footer Settings]” on page 2-9.Sending/
receiving a PC
fax5-2 Sending a PC fax
Sending a PC fax
Using the fax driver, a G3 fax can be sent from this machine through operations performed on the computer without using any paper.
" In order to perform a PC-Fax operation, the fax driver must be
installed. For details on installing the driver, refer to the [Installation
Guide].
" The fax driver is not compatible with IPP (Internet Printing Protocol).
Transmission operation
The procedure for sending a PC fax is described below.
1 Using a computer application, create the data to be sent.
2 On the [File] menu, click [Print].
3 From the [Printer Name] box, select the installed printer (appears with a
name such as “xxxxxxx FAX”).
4 If necessary, click [Properties] (or [Preferences]), and then change the fax
driver settings.
– For details, refer to “Fax driver settings” on page 5-8.
5 Click [Print].
The [FAX Transmission Popup] dialog box appears.
6 In the [Name] and [FAX Number] boxes, type the appropriate information.
– Up to 80 characters can be entered in the [Name] box.
– Up to 38 characters, including numbers between 0 and 9, hyphens (-),
#, *, P, and T, can be entered in the [FAX Number] box. To send a fax
overseas, enter the country code at the beginning of the fax number.
– [ECM]: Select this check box to use ECM (error correction mode). If
the [V.34 Mode] check box is selected, this check box cannot be
cleared.
– [V.34 Mode]: Select this check box to use the super G3 fax transmission mode. Select this check box for ordinary operation; clear this
check box only when communication is not possible due to the mode
of the recipient’s machine.
– To specify a fax number registered in the address book of this
machine, click [Add from Address Book]. For details, refer to “Selecting a recipient from the address book” on page 5-4.
– To specify a fax number registered in the phone book, click [Add From
Phone Book]. For details, refer to “Selecting a recipient from the
phone book” on page 5-3.Sending a PC fax 5-3
– To add the entered name and fax number to the [Simple Entry] folder
of the phone book, click [Register To Phone Book].
7 Click [Add Recipients].
– To send a fax to multiple recipients, repeat steps 6 and 7. Up to 100
recipients can be registered.
– To remove a registered recipient, click [Delete From List].
8 To change the fax mode settings, click [Fax Mode Setting Details]. To
specify a fax cover sheet, select the [FAX Cover Sheet] check box.
– For details, refer to “Specifying transmission conditions” on page 5-4
and “Creating a fax cover sheet” on page 5-5.
9 Click [OK].
The fax data is sent via this machine.
Selecting a recipient from the phone book
By clicking [Add From Phone Book] in the [FAX Transmission Popup] dialog
box, the recipients of the PC fax can be selected from the phone book.
" Before using the phone book, register the name and fax number of the
recipient. For details, refer to “Using the phone book” on page 5-15.
1 When sending a fax, click [Add From Phone Book] in the [FAX Transmission Popup] dialog box.
2 Select [Personal List] or [Group] from the list on the left side of the phone
book to display the desired recipient under [Personal Information].
– To search for recipients by specifying conditions, click [Find].
3 Select a recipient name under [Personal Information], and then click [Add
Recipients].
– To send a fax to multiple recipients, continue adding them in the same
way. Up to 100 recipients can be registered.
– To delete a recipient added under [Recipient List], select the name of
the recipient to be deleted, and then click [Delete].
– If recipients have been registered as a group, select the name of the
group, and then click [Add Recipients]. All members of the group are
added under [Recipient List] (broadcast transmission).
4 Click [OK].
The [FAX Transmission Popup] dialog box appears again with the specified names added under [Recipient List].5-4 Sending a PC fax
Selecting a recipient from the address book
By clicking [Add from Address Book] in the [FAX Transmission Popup] dialog
box, the recipients of the PC fax can be selected from the address book destinations registered on this machine.
" In order to select recipients from the address book of this machine,
your computer must be connected to this machine and be able to communicate with it.
" Before a recipient can be selected from the address book of this
machine, the name and fax number of the recipient must be added to
the address book. For details, refer to “Registering destinations” on
page 6-1.
1 When sending a fax, click [Add from Address Book] in the [FAX Transmission Popup] dialog box.
2 Select [Address Book List] from the list on the left side of the dialog box to
display the desired recipient under [Address Book].
– To start communicating with this machine and read the information
from the address book, click [Get Addr. Info].
– To search for recipients by specifying conditions, click [Find].
3 Select the name of a recipient name under [Address Book], and then click
[Add Recipients].
– To send a fax to multiple recipients, continue adding them in the same
way. Up to 100 recipients can be registered.
– To delete a recipient added under [Recipient List], select the name of
the recipient to be deleted, and then click [Delete From List].
4 Click [OK].
The [FAX Transmission Popup] dialog box appears again with the specified names added under [Recipient List].
Specifying transmission conditions
By clicking [Fax Mode Setting Details] in the [FAX Transmission Popup] dialog box, the transmission conditions for the PC fax can be specified.
Item Description
[Print Recipient File] Select this check box to print the original document
after a fax is sent.
[Timer Send] Specify the transmission time. Click [Reflect Current Time] to add the current time set on the computer to the [Send Time] box.Sending a PC fax 5-5
" When faxing with a timer transmission, make sure that the time set on
the computer matches the time set on this machine. If the specified
transmission time is earlier than the current time set on this machine,
the fax will be sent on the following day.
Creating a fax cover sheet
By selecting the [FAX Cover Sheet] check box in the [FAX Transmission
Popup] dialog box, the PC fax can be sent with a cover sheet attached. In
addition, click [Settings] to display the [FAX Cover Sheet Settings] dialog box
in order to change the settings for cover sheets.
In the [FAX Cover Sheet Settings] dialog box, change the desired settings by
switching between the [Basic], [Recipient], [Sender] and [Image] tabs.
[FAX Cover Sheet Settings] dialog box
[SUB Address] If the fax is to be sent using F-codes, specify the
SUB address. (up to 20 digits)
[Sender ID] If the fax is to be sent using F-codes, specify the
sender ID. (up to 20 digits, including numbers, #
and *)
Item Description
[Cover Sheet Settings] Select a set of cover sheet settings.
To change the settings for the selected cover
sheet, click [Edit].
To save the selected cover sheet settings so they
can be recalled later, click [Add] after specifying
the new settings.
[Check] Click to display an enlarged image of the layout.
[Cover Size] Specify the size of the cover sheet.
[Basic] tab Specify settings such as the style and usage conditions.
[Recipient] tab Specify recipient information.
[Sender] tab Specify sender information.
[Image] tab Specify the file for the image added to the cover
sheet.
Item Description5-6 Sending a PC fax
[Basic] tab
[Recipient] tab
Item Description
[Style] Select the desired cover sheet design.
[Subject] Enter the subject of the fax to be sent. (up to 64
characters)
[Date] Specify the date. Select a specific format, or enter
the date as desired. (up to 20 characters)
[Pages] Specify the number of pages to be sent.
[Comment] Enter the text that will appear in the comment box.
(up to 640 characters)
A line break is counted as two characters.
Item Description
[Standard] Select this to use the preset text.
[Details] Select this to specify details under [Recipient Setting Details] at the bottom of the dialog box.
[Load with Joint
Name]
Select this to add the individual recipients in
a group destination. The contents of [Recipient List] in the [FAX Transmission Popup]
dialog box are added.
[Change Each
Recipient]
Select this to change the information for the
recipients. The information for the contents
of [Recipient List] in the [FAX Transmission
Popup] dialog box are changed.
[Load Set Information]
Select this to add the information entered in
the [Company], [Department], [Name] and
[FAX Number] boxes. (up to 80 characters)
Click [Read] to import the information for
the first recipient into the boxes.Sending a PC fax 5-7
[Sender] tab
[Image] tab
Item Description
[Sender Information Settings]
Enter the appropriate sender information in the
[Company], [Department], [Name], [Phone], [FAX
Number] and [E-mail] boxes. Select the check
boxes for the items to be added, and then type in
the text. (up to 80 characters)
Item Description
[Paste Image] To add an image to the cover sheet, select the
[Paste Image] check box, and then specify the
image file. Only files in the BMP format can be
selected.
[Zoom] Specify the zoom ratio for the added image.
[Position] In the [X:] and [Y:] boxes, specify the position of
the added image.5-8 Fax driver settings
Fax driver settings
This section describes the settings and buttons common to tabs of the [Printing Preferences] or [Properties] dialog box of the fax driver.
" For details on installing the driver, refer to the [Installation Guide].
[Printing Preferences] dialog box
Settings for machine-specific functions can be specified.
To display the [Printing Preferences] dialog box, click [Properties] (or [Preferences]) in the [Print] dialog box, or right-click the printer icon in the [Printers]
or [Printers and Faxes] window, then click [Printing Preferences].
[Properties] dialog box
Settings concerning the installed options and the default settings for displaying confirmation messages and authentication dialog boxes can be changed.
To display the [Properties] dialog box, right-click the printer icon in the [Printers] or [Printers and Faxes] window, and then click [Properties].
Item Description
[FAX] tab Specify the transmission conditions for PC faxes.
For details, refer to “[FAX] tab” on page 5-10.
[Basic] tab Specify settings for the paper and original document to be sent. If user authentication or account
track settings have been specified on the machine,
specify the user or account information.
For details, refer to “[Basic] tab” on page 5-11.
[Layout] tab Specify settings for the page layout.
For details, refer to “[Layout] tab” on page 5-12.
[Version Information] tab View the driver version information.
Item Description
[Configure] tab Specify settings concerning the installed options.
For details, refer to “[Configure] tab” on page 5-13.
[Settings] tab Change the default settings for displaying confirmation messages and authentication dialog boxes.
For details, refer to “[Settings] tab” on page 5-13.Fax driver settings 5-9
Common Settings
The buttons described below appear on all tabs.
Item Description
[OK] Click this button to apply changes to the settings
and close the dialog box.
[Cancel] Click this button to cancel changes to the settings
and close the dialog box.
[Help] Click this button to display the Help for the items in
the displayed dialog box.
[Add] (Favorite Setting) Click this button to save the current settings so
they can be recalled later.
For details, refer to “Saving fax driver settings” on
page 5-14.
[Edit] (Favorite Setting) Click this button to change the saved settings.
For details, refer to “Saving fax driver settings” on
page 5-14.
[Default] Click this button to return the settings to those
specified when the driver was installed.
View Displays a sample page layout based on the current settings so the transmission result image can
be checked.
Icons for the specified functions appear at the bottom.
[Printer Information] Click this button to start Web Connection and
check the printer information. This button is available only when your computer can communicate
with this machine.5-10 Fax driver settings
[FAX] tab
The settings available on the [FAX] tab are described below.
Item Description
[Resolution] Select a resolution for the fax. Selecting a higher
resolution may increase the communication time.
[Print Recipient File] Select this check box to print the original document
after a fax is sent. This function can also be specified as a transmission condition when sending a
fax.
For details, refer to “Specifying transmission conditions” on page 5-4.
[Timer Send] Specify the transmission time. Click [Reflect Current Time] to add the current time set on the computer to the [Send Time] box. This function can
also be specified as a transmission condition when
sending a fax.
For details, refer to “Specifying transmission conditions” on page 5-4.
[SUB Address] If the fax is to be sent using F-codes, specify the
SUB address. (up to 20 digits)
This function can also be specified as a transmission condition when sending a fax.
For details, refer to “Specifying transmission conditions” on page 5-4.
[Sender ID] If the fax is to be sent using F-codes, specify the
sender ID. (up to 20 digits, including numbers, #
and *)
This function can also be specified as a transmission condition when sending a fax.
For details, refer to “Specifying transmission conditions” on page 5-4.
[Cover Sheet] Select this check box to specify cover sheet settings. This can also be specified when sending a
fax.
For details, refer to “Creating a fax cover sheet” on
page 5-5.
[Phone Book Entry] Click this button to edit the phone book.
For details, refer to “Using the phone book” on
page 5-15.Fax driver settings 5-11
" When faxing with a timer transmission, make sure that the time set on
the computer matches the time set on this machine. If the specified
transmission time is earlier than the current time set on this machine,
the fax will be sent on the following day.
[Basic] tab
The settings available on the [Basic] tab are described below.
" To fax an original document of a custom size, select [Custom Size]
from the [Original Size] list. In the [Custom Size Settings] dialog box,
specify the length and width of the original document.
" If user authentication is not enabled in the [Configure] tab, user
authentication will not be performed. If user authentication is being
used, be sure to enable it in the [Device Option] list. For details, refer
to “[Configure] tab” on page 5-13.
Item Description
[Original Orientation] Select the orientation of the original document to
be sent.
[Original Size] Select the paper size of the original document to
be sent.
[Paper Size] Select the size of the paper to be sent. If it is different from the original document size, the output
image will be automatically enlarged or reduced.
[Zoom] Select an enlargement or reduction ratio.
[Authentication/Account
Track]
Click this button to specify the user name and
password when [User Authentication] has been
enabled on this machine, or the account name and
password when [Account Track] has been enabled
on this machine.5-12 Fax driver settings
[Authentication/Account Track] dialog box
" If a fax is sent using a user name and password or account name and
password that are not registered on the machine, or if a fax is sent
without the [User Authentication] or [Account Track] settings specified
in the driver, the fax is deleted without being authenticated by the
machine.
" Even if the user or account has been registered on the machine, the
PC fax may not be sent if use of the fax function is not permitted.
[Layout] tab
The settings available on the [Layout] tab are described below.
" Sending documents containing pages of different sizes or orientations
in one job may cause some images to be partially lost or to overlap.
Item Description
[User Authentication] If user authentication settings have been specified
on this machine, select [Recipient User], and then
specify in the [User Name] and [Password] boxes
the settings specified on the machine. (up to 64
characters)
If public user access is allowed on this machine,
the printer can be used when [Public User] is
selected.
Server settings must be specified if user authentication is performed with a server. Click [Server
Setting], and then select a server.
[Account Track] If account track settings have been specified on
this machine, specify in the [Department Name]
and [Password] boxes the settings specified on the
machine. (up to 8 characters)
Item Description
[Combination] Select this check box to combine the pages of a
multi-page document into a single sheet, or divide
a single document page into multiple sheets when
faxing. Click [Combination Details] to specify various details.Fax driver settings 5-13
[Configure] tab
The settings available on the [Configure] tab are described below.
" Click [Acquire Device Information] to communicate with this machine
and read the machine status. This feature is not available if the computer cannot establish a connection and communicate with this
machine.
[Settings] tab
The settings available on the [Settings] tab are described below.
Item Description
[Device Option] Specify the status of the options installed on this
machine and user authentication/account track
settings. Select the status of each item in the [Setting] box.
[Acquire Device Information]
Click this button to communicate with this machine
and read the status of the installed options.
[Acquire Settings] Click this button to specify the conditions, such as
the destination, that are acquired from the device
information.
Item Description
[Display Constraint Message]
Select this check box to display a message when
functions that cannot be used together have been
enabled from the driver.
[Verify Authentication
settings before printing]
Select this check box to verify authentication settings for this machine before printing, and display a
message if they do not match.
[Popup Authentication
Dialog when printing]
Select this check box to display the [User Authentication/Account Track] dialog box when printing so
that the user name and account name can be
entered.
[Reconfirm FAX number
entered directly]
Select this check box to display a dialog box for
entering the fax number again for confirmation
when [Add Recipients] is clicked after information
has been entered in the [FAX Number] box of the
[FAX Transmission Popup] dialog box.5-14 Fax driver settings
Saving fax driver settings
The settings specified in the [Printing Preferences] dialog box of the fax driver
can be saved as favorite settings.
Saved settings can be recalled at any time by selecting them from the [Favorite Setting] list in the [Printing Preferences] dialog box.
Saving the settings
After changing the fax driver settings, click [Add] in the [Favorite Setting] box.
Then, specify settings for the following.
" Up to 30 shared driver settings and up to 20 private driver settings can
be saved.
Editing settings
To edit saved favorite settings, click [Edit] in the [Favorite Setting] box. Select
the name of the favorite settings to be edited, and then edit the settings.
" To select the items to be recalled when favorite settings are selected,
click [Option]. Selected settings are applied to the current settings
when the favorite settings are recalled.
" The settings for fax driver functions cannot be changed.
" To save the favorite settings as a file, click [Export]. To import exported
favorite settings into the fax driver, click [Import]. This is useful when
using the same settings on a different computer.
Item Description
[Name] Enter a name for the settings. (up to 30 characters)
[Icon] Select an icon. Settings can be saved without an
icon selected.
[Sharing] Select this check box to share the setting file with
other users, or clear this check box to register it for
private use.
Only the administrator can select the [Sharing]
check box.
[Comment] Enter a detailed description of the setting file, if
necessary. (up to 255 characters)Using the phone book 5-15
Using the phone book
Adding frequently used recipients to a phone book allows you to recall them
when sending faxes. Use the [FAX] tab of the fax driver to add recipients to a
phone book.
Adding recipients to a phone book
The procedure for adding recipients to the phone book is described below.
1 In the [FAX] tab of the fax driver, click [Phone Book Entry].
The [Phone Book Entry] dialog box appears.
2 Select [Personal List] from the list on the left side of the phone book, and
then click [Add New].
The [Personal Information\\Personal List] dialog box appears.
3 In the [Name], [FAX Number], [Company] and [Department] boxes, type
the appropriate information.
– When the entered name is printed on the fax cover sheet, a title will
not be included. To provide the name with a title on the fax cover
sheet, enter the name with a title in the [Name] box.
– Up to 80 characters can be entered in the [Name], [Company] and
[Department] boxes.
– Up to 38 characters, including numbers between 0 and 9, hyphens (-),
spaces, #, *, P, and T, can be entered in the [FAX Number] box. To
send a fax overseas, enter the country code at the beginning of the fax
number.
– [ECM]: Select this check box to use ECM (error correction mode). If
the [V.34 Mode] check box is selected, this check box cannot be
cleared.
– [V.34 Mode]: Select this check box to use the super G3 fax transmission mode. Select this check box for ordinary operation; clear this
check box only when communication is not possible due to the mode
of the recipient’s machine.
4 To add the recipient to groups, select the check boxes for the groups.
– When a recipient is added to a group, a fax can be sent to the recipient by selecting the group as the destination (broadcast transmission).
If faxes will frequently be sent to certain destinations, it is useful to add
them to a group.
– The recipient can be added to multiple groups.5-16 Using the phone book
5 Click [OK].
The personal information is registered and displayed under [Personal
List]. If groups have been selected for the recipient, the recipient will
appear in the list for those groups.
6 Click [OK].
If recipients have already been added to the phone book, editing of the
phone book is finished. If this is the first time that a recipient is being
added to the phone book, a dialog box appears, requesting confirmation
to save the phone book.
7 Click [Yes].
The [Save As] dialog box appears.
8 Browse to the folder where the file is to be saved, type in the file name,
and then click [Save].
The phone book is saved as a new file.
" The [Save As] dialog box appears only the first time that a recipient is
being added to the phone book. When the phone book is subsequently edited, the [Save As] dialog box does not appear, and the
existing file is automatically overwritten.
" The saved phone book file automatically appears the next time that
the phone book is opened. To open a different phone book file, click
the [File] menu in the [Phone Book Entry] dialog box, and then click
[Open]. If multiple phone book files have been saved, you can switch
between these files to locate the desired one.
" To create a new phone book file, click the [File] menu in the [Phone
Book Entry] dialog box, and then click [New]. On the [File] menu, click
[Save As] to save the file with a different name.
" The phone book file is saved with the .csv extension.
Editing a phone book
Editing or organizing a phone book, for example, by changing the registered
personal information or group name, enhances its usability.
Changing personal information
Select the name of the recipient to be edited under [Personal List] on the left
side of the phone book, and then click [Edit]. The [Personal Information] dialog box appears, which is the same as that for adding a recipient, so that the
information can be changed.Using the phone book 5-17
To delete a recipient, select the name of the recipient under [Personal List] on
the left side of the phone book, and then click [Delete]. At the same time, that
recipient is deleted from all groups it belongs to.
" Names and fax numbers that have been added using [Register To
Phone Book] when sending faxes appear in the [Simple Entry] folder
of the phone book.
Changing group membership
Select the name of the recipient to be edited under [Personal List] on the left
side of the phone book, and then select or clear the check boxes in the group
list on the right.
Up to 100 recipients can be added to a single group.
Changing a group name
Select the group name to be changed under [Group] on the left side of the
phone book, click the [Edit] menu, and then click [Rename Group].
Creating a folder
Select [Personal List] on the left side of the phone book, and then click [Add
Folder] to create a folder. A folder can also be created by clicking [Add
Folder] in the [Edit] menu.
A recipient can be moved from the [Personal List] to the new folder by dragging the name to the folder.
To edit a folder, select the folder to be changed, and then click [Edit].
To delete a folder, select the folder to be deleted, and then click [Delete].
Searching for personal information
Clicking [Find] on the right side of the phone book displays the [Find] dialog
box, where various search conditions can be specified.5-18 Receiving a PC fax
Receiving a PC fax
When this machine receives a PC fax, the received document is saved in the
machine’s memory in the TIFF format. Documents saved in the memory can
be printed or retrieved.
In order to use PC fax reception, the following settings in the [Fax Settings]
screen ([Admin Settings]) must be specified.
Set [PC-Fax RX Settings] - [PC-Fax RX Setting] to [ON].
With [PC-Fax RX Settings] - [PC-Fax RX Print], select whether or not a
PC fax is printed automatically after it is received.
" For details, refer to “[PC-Fax RX Settings]” on page 2-16.
" This function cannot be used together with fax forwarding, E-mail forwarding, memory reception or night reception.
" If faxes are saved with the memory reception function, a PC fax is not
automatically printed after it is received.
Using received documents
The procedure for using a document saved in the memory is described
below.
1 Press [Fax] or press the [Fax] key to display the initial Fax screen.
2 Press [Others].
3 Press [Memory RX].
4 Type in the password, and then press [OK].
The list of documents saved in the memory is displayed.
5 Select the document to be printed, and then press [Print].
– To delete the selected document, press [Delete].
The document is printed.
" With [Memory RX], specify the password that allows documents saved
in the memory to be used. For details, refer to “[Memory RX]” on
page 2-15.
" Received PC fax documents can be retrieved by using PageScope
Web Connection. For details, refer to the [Reference Guide].Uninstalling the fax driver 5-19
Uninstalling the fax driver
If the fax driver must be removed, for example, when reinstallation of the
driver is necessary, remove the driver using the following procedure.
1 Click [Start], and then click [All Programs] (or [Programs]) - [KONICA
MINOLTA] - [xxxxx (model name)] - [Uninstall Printer Driver].
2 Select the components to be removed, and then click [Uninstall]. Continue
by following the instructions that appear.
3 If a dialog box appears, instructing you to restart the computer, click [OK].5-20 Uninstalling the fax driverRegistering
destinations6-2 Destination registration
Destination registration
By registering destinations where faxes are frequently sent, recipients can be
recalled allowing a fax to easily be sent. With this machine, address book
destinations (Address Book), group destinations (Group) and program destinations (Program) can be registered.
Address Book
The information for destinations where faxes are frequently sent can be registered. A destination can selected from the address book when a fax is being
sent. A maximum of 2,000 address book destinations can be registered.
For details on registering, refer to “Registering an address book destination”
on page 6-3.
Group
Multiple address book destinations can be registered together as a group.
This is useful when sending the same fax to multiple destinations in a broadcast transmission. A maximum of 100 group destinations (with a maximum of
500 address book destinations per group) can be registered.
Group destinations are registered from PageScope Web Connection. For
details on registering, refer to the [Reference Guide].
Program
Destinations where faxes are frequently sent can be registered together with
fax settings ([Scan Settings], [Comm. Settings] and [Original Settings]
screens). A registered program destination can be recalled by pressing the
[Mode Memory] key in the control panel. A maximum of 400 program destinations can be registered.
For details on registering, refer to “Registering a program destination” on
page 6-6.Registering an address book destination 6-3
Registering an address book destination
The procedure for registering an address book destination is described
below.
G3 fax
Address book destinations can be registered from the control panel of this
machine or from PageScope Web Connection. The following procedure
describes how to register from the control panel of this machine.
" For details on registering from PageScope Web Connection, refer to
the [Reference Guide].
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Manual
Destination Input] is set to [Restrict], a destination cannot be registered from the control panel and the user mode of PageScope Web
Connection.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Address Registration].
3 Press [Fax].
4 Press [New].
– To view the information registered for a destination, select the registered destination, and then press [Details]. To delete the destination,
press [Delete] in the Details screen.
5 Enter the information for the destination, and then press [OK].6-4 Registering an address book destination
Settings
Item Description
[Name] Type in the registration name for the address
book destination.
[Fax number] Type in the fax number of the recipient.
[Tone]: Press to send push-button tones
when pulse dialing is being used. [T]
appears in the screen.
[Pause]: Press to insert a pause when dialing. [P] appears in the screen.
[-]: Press to insert a dash as a separator
symbol while dialing. This has no effect on
the dialing.
If the machine is being used with a PBX,
press [Outside] when registering an outside
destination. [E] appears in the screen. At
the point indicated by [E], the outside line
access number specified on this machine is
automatically dialed. For details, refer to
“[PBX Connection Settings]” on page 2-17.
If [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax
Function Settings] - [Cofirm Addr (Register)] is set to [ON], the fax number must be
entered again after [OK] is pressed.
[Favorites] For frequently used destinations, set to [ON].
This allows the destination to be found more
easily, which is useful when destinations are
being selected.
[Index] Select the search characters that will be used
to search for the destination.Registering an address book destination 6-5
Internet fax
Internet fax destinations can be registered only from the PageScope Web
Connection.
For details on registering from PageScope Web Connection, refer to the [Reference Guide].
" If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] - [Manual
Destination Input] is set to [Restrict], a destination cannot be registered from the user mode of PageScope Web Connection.
[Line Settings] Configure the line used to send faxes.
[ECM OFF] The error correction mode (ECM) is turned off
to shorten the transmission time. ECM is an
error correction mode defined by ITU-T (International Telecommunication Union Telecommunication Standardization Sector). Fax
machines equipped with the ECM feature
communicate with each other while confirming
that the data sent is free of errors.
[V34 OFF] V.34 is a communication mode used with
super G3 fax communication. When the
remote machine or this machine is connected
to a telephone line through a PBX, it may not
be possible to establish communication in
super G3 mode due to the condition of the
telephone line. In this case, it is recommended
that V.34 be turned off before sending data.
After the transmission has been completed,
this machine automatically turns on the V.34
mode.
[Check Dest. &
Send]
The specified fax number is compared with
the remote fax number (CSI) and the data is
sent only if those fax numbers match. If they
do not match, the communication will fail,
resulting in a transmission error.
To verify the destination and send the fax, the
recipient’s fax number must be specified on
their fax machine.
Item Description6-6 Registering a program destination
Registering a program destination
The procedure for registering a program destination for fax transmission is
described below.
Program destinations can be registered from the control panel of this
machine or from PageScope Web Connection. The following procedure
describes how to register from the control panel of this machine.
" For details on registering from PageScope Web Connection, refer to
the [Reference Guide].
1 Press [Fax] or press the [Fax] key to display the initial Fax screen.
2 Press [Settings], and then select the appropriate settings on the [Scan
Settings], [Comm. Settings] and [Original Settings] screens.
– For details on the [Scan Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying scan
settings” on page 3-11.
– For details on the [Comm. Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying communication settings (G3 fax)” on page 3-13, “Useful transmission functions (G3 fax)” on page 3-14 and “Specifying e-mail (Internet fax)
settings” on page 3-17.
– For details on the [Original Settings] screen, refer to “Specifying document settings” on page 3-18.
3 Press the [Mode Memory] key.
4 Press [Register].
5 At [Name], enter the name.
6 At [Dest.], specify the destination.
– Press , select the address book or group destinations, and
then press [OK].
7 Press [OK].Communication
management7-2 Checking a job
Checking a job
From the Job screen, the status of transmission/reception jobs and results of
jobs can be viewed. In the home screen, press [Job] to display the Job
screen.
" For details on the Job screen, refer to the [Printer/Copier/Scanner
User’s Guide].
Checking jobs being performed
A list of jobs currently being performed appears when the initial Job screen is
displayed. If the job log is displayed, press [Active] to display the list of jobs
currently being performed.
Transmission jobs
Press [Send] to view the list of jobs queued for redialing and queued for
transmission.
To delete a job, select the job from the list, and then press [Delete].
Reception jobs
Press [Receive] to view the list of jobs being received and queued for reception.
To delete a job, select the job from the list, and then press [Delete].Checking a job 7-3
Checking the job log
Press [Log] in the Job screen to display the job log.
" If [Admin Settings] – [Security Settings] – [Security Details] – [Disable
Job History Display] is set to [ON], the job log cannot be displayed.
Transmission jobs
Press [Send] to view the log for transmission jobs.
To view job details, select the job from the list, and then press [Details].
" To view an address, select the job from the job log, and then press
[Details]. If [Admin Settings] - [Security Settings] - [Security Details] -
[Hide Personal Data] is set to [ON], the address is displayed as “****”.
Reception jobs
Press [Receive] to view the log for reception jobs.
To view job details, select the job from the list, and then press [Details].7-4 Printing reports/lists
Printing reports/lists
This section describes the fax-related reports and lists that can be printed by
this machine.
Types of reports
The following types of fax-related reports can be printed by this machine.
Report name Description
Activity Report This report provides a record of transmissions and
receptions. Results can be viewed of the last 100
transmissions/receptions. Transmission results
and reception results are printed separately.
If necessary, the conditions for printing can be
specified.
TX Result Report This report provides a record of the transmission
results. A reduced image of the sent document is
printed on the first page.
This report is automatically printed when a fax is
sent. If necessary, the conditions for printing can
be specified.
Reservation TX Report
(G3 fax only)
This report provides a detailed record of timer
transmissions.
This report is automatically printed when a timer
transmission is queued. If necessary, the machine
can be set so that this report is not printed.
Broadcast Result Report This report provides a record of the results of
broadcast transmissions.
If necessary, the conditions for printing can be
specified.
Broadcast Reservation
Report (G3 fax only)
This report provides a detailed record of broadcast
timer transmissions.
This report is automatically printed when a broadcast timer transmission is queued. If necessary,
the machine can be set so that this report is not
printed.
PC-Fax TX Error Report This report is printed if an error occurred, preventing a PC fax transmission from being completed
correctly.Printing reports/lists 7-5
Types of lists
The following types of fax-related lists can be printed by this machine.
I-Fax RX Error Report This report is printed if reception of an Internet fax
failed.
List name Description
Address Book List This list contains the information registered for
address book destinations.
Group List This list contains the information registered for
group destinations.
Program List This list contains the information registered for
program destinations.
Fax Setup Information
List
This list contains the fax-related settings that have
been specified.
Report name Description7-6 Printing reports/lists
Activity Report
This report provides a record of transmissions and receptions. Results can be
viewed of the last 100 transmissions/receptions. Transmission results and
reception results are printed separately.
The Activity Report is printed automatically.
" With [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Report] - [Activity Report],
the conditions for printing can be specified. For details, refer to “[Fax
Report]” on page 2-18.
Items that are printed
Item Description
[No.] Shows the communication number.
[Destination] Shows the registration name or address of the
destination.
[Start Time] Shows the time that communication began.
[Time] Shows the length of time required for communication.
[Prints] Shows the number of pages sent/received.
[Result] Shows the communication results.
For details, check the margin of the report.
[Note] Shows remarks regarding the communication.
For details, check the margin of the report.Printing reports/lists 7-7
TX Result Report
This report provides a record of the transmission results. If necessary, a
reduced image of the first page of the sent document can be printed in the
report.
The TX Result Report is printed automatically when transmission is completed.
" With [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Report] - [TX Result
Report], the conditions for printing can be specified. For details, refer
to “[Fax Report]” on page 2-18.
" With [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Report] - [TX Result
Report Image], whether or not to print a reduced image of the sent
document in the TX Result Report can be specified. For details, refer
to “[Fax Report]” on page 2-18.
" With [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Report] - [Confirm TX
Result Report], whether or not to print the transmission results report
before transmission can be specified. For details, refer to “[Fax
Report]” on page 2-18.
Items that are printed
Item Description
[Destination] Shows the registration name or address of the
destination.
[Start Time] Shows the time that transmission began.
[Time] Shows the length of time required for transmission.
[Prints] Shows the number of pages sent.
[Result] Shows the results of the transmission.
For details, check the margin of the report.
[Note] Shows remarks regarding the transmission.
For details, check the margin of the report.7-8 Printing reports/lists
Reservation TX Report
This report provides a detailed record of timer transmissions.
The Reservation TX Report is printed automatically when a timer transmission is queued.
" With [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Report] - [TX Reserve],
whether or not to print the Reservation TX Report can be specified.
For details, refer to “[Fax Report]” on page 2-18.
Items that are printed
Item Description
[Destination] Shows the registration name or address of the
destination.
[Create Time] Shows the time that the transmission was queued.
[Start Time] Shows the time that transmission will begin.
[Prints] Shows the number of pages that were scanned.
[Note] Shows remarks regarding the transmission.
For details, check the margin of the report.Printing reports/lists 7-9
Broadcast Result Report
This report provides a record of the results of broadcast transmissions.
The Broadcast Result Report is printed automatically when a broadcast
transmission is completed.
" With [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Report] - [Broadcast
Report], whether or not to print the Broadcast Result Report can be
specified. For details, refer to “[Fax Report]” on page 2-18.
" With [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Report] - [Broadcast
Result Report], the conditions for printing can be specified. For details,
refer to “[Fax Report]” on page 2-18.
Items that are printed
Item Description
[Destination] Shows the registration name or address of all destinations for the broadcast transmission.
[Start Time] Shows the time that transmission began.
[Time] Shows the length of time required for transmission.
[Prints] Shows the number of pages sent.
[Result] Shows the results of the transmission.
For details, check the margin of the report.
[Note] Shows remarks regarding the transmission.
For details, check the margin of the report.7-10 Printing reports/lists
Broadcast Reservation Report
This report provides a detailed record of broadcast timer transmissions.
The Broadcast Reservation Report is printed automatically when a broadcast
timer transmission is queued.
" With [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Report] - [TX Reserve],
whether or not to print the Broadcast Reservation Report can be specified. For details, refer to “[Fax Report]” on page 2-18.
Items that are printed
Item Description
[Destination] Shows the registration name or address of all destinations for the broadcast transmission.
[Create Time] Shows the time that the transmission was queued.
[Start Time] Shows the time that transmission will begin.
[Prints] Shows the number of pages that were scanned.
[Note] Shows remarks regarding the transmission.
For details, check the margin of the report.Printing reports/lists 7-11
PC-Fax TX Error Report
This report is printed if an error occurred, preventing a PC fax transmission
from being completed correctly.
" With [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Report] - [PC-Fax TX Error
Report], whether or not to print the PC fax transmission error report can
be specified. For details, refer to “[Fax Report]” on page 2-18.
Items that are printed
I-Fax RX Error Report
This report is printed if reception of an Internet fax failed.
" With [Admin Settings] - [Fax Settings] - [Fax Report] - [I-Fax RX Error
Report], whether or not to print the I-Fax RX error report can be specified. For details, refer to “[Fax Report]” on page 2-18.
Items that are printed
Item Description
[Destination] Shows the registration name or fax number of all
destinations for the broadcast transmission.
[Create Time] Shows the time that a PC fax was sent from the
computer.
[Start Time] Shows the time that transmission will begin.
[Cause] Shows the cause of the error.
For details, check the margin of the report.
[Name] Shows the user name.
Item Description
[From] Shows the e-mail address of the sender.
[Receiving time] Shows the time that reception began.
[Cause] Shows the cause of the reception error.
[Subject] Shows the subject text.7-12 Printing reports/lists
Address Book List/Group List/Program List
These lists contain the information registered for the various destinations.
The procedure for printing a destinations list is described below.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Admin Settings].
3 Type in the administrator password, and then press [OK].
4 Press [Address Registration].
5 Press [Address Book].
6 Select the list to be printed.
– To print [Address Book] list, continue with step 7.
– To print the [Group] list, continue with step 8.
– To print the [Program] list, continue with step 7.
7 Select the type of destinations to be printed on.
8 If necessary, specify settings for [Start Number] and [Number of
Addresses] to limit the number of destinations to be printed.
– With [Start Number], specify the registration number for the first destination to be printed.
– With [Number of Addresses], specify the number of destinations to be
printed. The specified number of destinations starting from the registration number specified with [Start Number] will be printed.
9 Press [List Output].
10 Press [Print], and then press [OK].
The destination list is printed.
Fax Setup Information list
This list contains the fax-related settings that have been specified.
For details on printing the settings list, refer to “[List Print]” on page 2-19.Troubleshooting8-2 Problems when sending faxes
Problems when sending faxes
" For details on the error messages, refer to “Error messages” on
page 8-9. For details on troubleshooting procedures for document
misfeeds, paper misfeeds, poor print quality, or empty toner, refer to
the [Printer/Copier/Scanner User’s Guide].
If the fax cannot be sent correctly, refer to the following table, and then perform the indicated operation. If the fax still cannot be sent correctly, even after
performing the described operations, contact your technical representative.
G3 fax
Symptom Cause Solution
The document is not
scanned.
The document is too
thick, too thin or too
small.
Use the original glass to
send the fax.
The document is
scanned at an angle.
The document guides
are not adjusted to the
width of the document.
Slide the document
guides to fit the width of
the document.
The fax received by the
recipient is blurry.
The document is incorrectly positioned.
Position the document
correctly.
The original glass is
dirty.
Clean the original glass.
The text in the document
is written too faint.
Adjust the density.
There may be a problem
with the telephone connection.
Check the telephone
line, and then try sending the fax again.
There may be a problem
with the recipient’s fax
machine.
Make a copy to check
that this machine is
operating correctly, and
then, if the copy was
printed correctly, have
the recipient check the
condition of their fax
machine.
The fax received by the
recipient is blank.
The document was sent
with the front side facing
down (when the ADF is
used).
Load the document to be
faxed facing up.Problems when sending faxes 8-3
Transmission is not possible.
The transmission procedure may have been
performed incorrectly.
Check the transmission
procedure, and then try
sending the fax again.
The fax number may be
wrong.
Check the fax number.
The address book destination, group destination
or program destination
may have been registered incorrectly.
Check that the destinations were correctly registered.
The telephone line may
be incorrectly connected.
Check the telephone line
connection. If it is disconnected, connect it.
There may be a problem
with the recipient’s fax
machine (such as, no
paper or turned off).
Contact the recipient.
An incorrect telephone
line setting may have
been selected.
Check that the dialing
method setting selected
from the [Comm. Settings] screen matches
the telephone line being
used.
An incorrect password
may have been specified when the transmission was sent with
[Password TX] set to
[Yes].
Check the password at
the receiving end, and
then try sending the fax
again with the correct
password.
An incorrect password
may have been specified when the transmission was sent with
[F-Code TX] set to [Yes].
Check the password at
the receiving end, and
then try sending the fax
again with the correct
password.
The recipient’s fax number may have been
incorrectly specified on
their fax machine when
the transmission was
sent with [TX Confirm
CSI] set to [Yes].
Have the recipient check
that their fax number is
correctly specified on
their machine.
Symptom Cause Solution8-4 Problems when sending faxes
Internet fax
PC fax
Symptom Cause Solution
Transmission is not possible.
The network settings are
not specified correctly.
Check that the settings
in “Initial settings” on
page 1-13 have been
correctly specified.
The e-mail address for
the destination is incorrect.
Check that the registered destination information is correct.
The cables are not connected correctly.
Check that the cables
are correctly connected.
Symptom Cause Solution
The message “Printer is
not connected” or “Print
Error” appears on the
computer screen.
The fax driver specified
when sending may not
be supported by the
printer controller.
Check the specified
printer name.
The network or USB
cable may be disconnected.
Check that the cable is
correctly connected.
An error may have
occurred on this
machine.
Check the control panel
of this machine.
Memory may be insufficient.
Check whether a test
page can be sent.Problems when sending faxes 8-5
Print processing on the
computer finished, but
transmission does not
start.
The fax driver specified
when sending may not
be supported by the
printer controller.
Check the specified
printer name.
The network or USB
cable may be disconnected.
Check that the cable is
correctly connected.
An error may have
occurred on this
machine.
Check the control panel
of this machine.
Unprocessed jobs may
remain queued on this
machine.
From the control panel of
this machine, check the
Job screen for the processing order for the job.
Account track settings
have been specified, but
an unregistered account
name or password has
been entered.
Enter the correct
account name and password.
User authentication settings have been specified, but an unregistered
user name or password
has been entered.
Enter the correct user
name and password.
The computer may have
insufficient memory.
Check whether a test
page can be sent.
A network connection
with the printer controller
is not established (when
connecting via the network).
Contact your administrator.
This machine may be in
enhanced security
mode.
Contact your administrator.
Symptom Cause Solution8-6 Problems when receiving faxes
Problems when receiving faxes
If the fax cannot be received correctly, refer to the following table, and then
perform the indicated operation. If the fax still cannot be received correctly,
even after performing the described operations, contact your technical representative.
G3 fax
Symptom Cause Solution
The received fax is
blank.
There may be a problem with the telephone
connection or with the
caller’s fax machine.
Check that the machine
can make clean copies.
If it can, have the caller
send the fax again.
The caller may have
loaded the pages backward.
Contact the caller.
Reception is not possible.
The machine is set to
receive faxes manually.
Set the machine to automatic reception. Otherwise, perform the
manual reception operation.
Memory is full. Load paper if it is empty,
and then print the faxes
stored in memory.
The telephone line is
incorrectly connected.
Check the telephone line
connection. If it is disconnected, connect it.
There may be a problem
with the caller’s fax
machine.
Make a copy to check
that this machine is
operating correctly, and
then, if the copy was
printed correctly, have
the recipient check the
condition of their fax
machine.
[Closed Network RX
Password] - [Enable]
may have been set to
[Yes].
If [Closed Network RX
Password] - [Enable] is
set to [Yes], faxes can
only be received from
specific senders. For
details, contact the
administrator.Problems when receiving faxes 8-7
Internet fax
Reception is not possible.
The fax may have been
sent with an incorrect
Sub address for the
specified F-code.
If an incorrect Sub
address is received, a
communication error
occurs and the fax cannot be received. Have
the sender check the
Sub address on their fax
machine.
Printing is not possible. [PC-Fax RX Settings] -
[PC-Fax RX Setting]
may have been set to
[ON].
Print the fax from the
machine’s memory.
[Memory RX] - [Memory
RX] may have been set
to [ON].
Print the fax from the
machine’s memory.
[Nighttime RX Settings] -
[Night Fax RX Print] may
have been set to [ON].
Printing is performed
when the specified night
time has ended.
Symptom Cause Solution
Reception is not possible.
The cables are not connected correctly.
Check that the cables
are correctly connected.
Memory is full. Load paper if it is empty,
and then print the faxes
stored in memory.
Printing is not possible. [PC-Fax RX Settings] -
[PC-Fax RX Setting]
may have been set to
[ON].
Print the fax from the
machine's memory.
[Memory RX] - [Memory
RX] may have been set
to [ON].
Print the fax from the
machine's memory.
Symptom Cause Solution8-8 Other problems
Other problems
Symptom Cause Solution
The number of document pages indicated in
the transmission results
report is different from
the number of pages in a
batch transmission.
Memory is full. During batch transmissions, the number of
document pages indicated in the transmission results report may
be different from the
number of pages in the
transmission if the memory is full.Error messages 8-9
Error messages
If a machine malfunction occurs, the error screen appears with one of the following error messages. Refer to the following table, and then perform the
indicated operation.
If fax transmissions/receptions still cannot be performed correctly, even after
performing the described operations, contact your technical representative.
Error message Cause Solution
[Off-Hook] The machine has been
left off-hook after a manual transmission.
Put the machine back
on-hook.
[Memory Full (Fax)] The memory is full. If a fax is being sent,
send the scanned document pages. Otherwise,
send the fax manually.
If a fax is being received,
print the received documents saved in the
memory.
[Fax TX Failed] An error occurred while
a G3 fax is being sent.
This error is automatically cleared.
[Fax RX Failed] An error occurred while
a G3 fax is being
received.
This error is automatically cleared.
[PC-Fax TX Error] An error occurred while
receiving PC-Fax TX
data.
This error is automatically cleared.
[Polling RX Error] Multiple destinations
were specified for polling
reception.
Multiple destinations
cannot be specified for
polling reception. Try
performing the operation again with only one
destination specified.
[PC-Fax Restricted] A PC fax transmission
was requested although
PC fax transmissions
are prohibited.
For details on specifying
PC fax transmission settings, refer to “[Fax
Function Settings]” on
page 2-13.
[I-Fax TX failed] An error occurred while
an Internet fax is being
sent.
This error is automatically cleared.8-10 Error messages
[I-Fax RX failed] An error occurred while
an Internet fax is being
received.
This error is automatically cleared.
Error message Cause SolutionAppendix
AA-2 Technical specifications
Technical specifications
G3 fax
Internet fax
Item Specifications
Compatible lines PSTN (Public Switched Telephone Network)
PBX (Private Branch eXchange)
Compatibility ECM/Super G3
Modem speed 2.4 kbps - 33.6 kbps
Fax transmission speed 3 sec/page (at A4, 33.6 kbps, JBIG, V.34)
Coding method MH, MR, MMR or JBIG
Fax memory 256 MB for G3 fax and Internet fax TX/RX
Maximum scanning size ADF: 216 mm × 1000 mm
Original glass: Legal
Maximum recording size Legal
(Pages with a maximum length of 1,000 mm
can be received or printed, depending on the
selected page splitting setting.)
Edge erase 4.0 mm (top, bottom, left and right)
Resolution Standard: 200 × 100 dpi (8 × 3.85 dot/mm)
Fine: 200 × 200 dpi (8 × 7.7 dot/mm)
Super Fine: 400 × 400 dpi (16 × 15.4 dot/mm)
Super Fine (Reception only): 200 × 400 dpi (8 ×
15.4 dot/mm)
Item Description
Protocol Internet fax (Simple mode), TCP/IP, SMTP,
POP3
Fax memory 256 MB for G3 fax and Internet fax TX/RX
File type Monochrome (TIFF)
Coding method
(Transmission)
TIFF-S (MH)
Coding method (Reception) TIFF-S (MH), TIFF-F (MH/MR/MMR)Technical specifications A-3
PC fax (Fax driver)
" For details on other specifications, refer to the [Printer/Copier/Scanner
User’s Guide].
Resolution (Transmission) Standard: 200 × 100 dpi
Fine: 200 × 200 dpi
Resolution (Reception) 200 × 100 dpi, 204 × 98 dpi (80 × 38.5 dot/cm)
200 × 200 dpi, 204 × 196 dpi (80 × 77 dot/cm)
300 × 300 dpi
200 × 400 dpi, 204 × 391 dpi (80 × 154 dot/cm)
400 × 400 dpi, 408 × 391 dpi (160 × 154 dot/cm)
Item Description
Operating system Windows 2000 Service Pack 4
Windows Server 2003 (32-bit/64-bit)
Windows XP (32-bit/64-bit)
Windows Vista (32-bit/64-bit)
Windows Server 2008 (32-bit/64-bit)
Windows Server 2008 R2
Windows 7 (32-bit/64-bit)
CPU Pentium 3: 400 MHz or higher (Windows Vista:
1 GHz or higher)
Memory 512 MB or more
Item DescriptionA-4 Text input
Text input
The procedure for using the keyboard screen is described below.
Entering text
In the keyboard screen, press the character that you want to enter.
To enter uppercase letters, press [ ].
To enter symbols, press [ ].
To enter special characters, such as accented characters, press [ ].
To delete the character to the right of the cursor, press [Delete].
To move the cursor, press [ ] or [ ].
" Numbers can also be typed in with the keypad in the control panel.
" To clear all entered text, press the [C] key.Index
Index A-5
A
Account track ....................1-11, 1-12
Address Book ...............................6-2
Address Registration ...................6-3
ADF ................................................3-4
C
Canceling ....................................3-23
Closed network reception ............4-7
Comm. Method ............................3-14
F-Code TX ................................3-15
Password TX ............................3-15
Timer TX ...................................3-14
Comm. Settings .................3-13, 3-14
Control Panel ................................1-3
D
DRPD .............................................4-4
Ring Pattern ................................4-4
E
E-mail forwarding ........................ 4-8
E-mail Settings ........................... 3-17
F
Fax driver ...................................... 5-8
Authentication/
Account Track .......................... 5-12
Basic ........................................ 5-11
Configure .................................. 5-13
Favorite Setting ........................ 5-14
FAX .......................................... 5-10
Layout ...................................... 5-12
Printing Preferences ................... 5-8
Properties ................................... 5-8
Settings .................................... 5-13
Uninstall ................................... 5-19
Fax forwarding ............................. 4-8
Fax screen .................................... 1-8A-6 Index
Fax Settings (Admin Settings) ....2-4
Closed Network
RX Password ............................2-15
Comm. Settngs .........................2-10
Fax Factory Default ..................2-20
Fax Function Settings ...............2-13
Fax Image Initialized .................2-20
Fax Report ................................2-18
Fax Target ................................2-20
Forward TX Settings .................2-15
Function Settings ......................2-12
Header/Footer Settings ...............2-9
List Print ....................................2-19
Memory RX ...............................2-15
Nighttime RX Settings ...............2-17
PBX Connection Settings .........2-17
PC-Fax RX Settings ..................2-16
Remote RX Settings .................2-16
Sender Settings ..........................2-8
Fax Settings (User Settings) ........2-2
Footer ..........................................4-14
G
Group .............................................6-2
Group Address List ....................7-12
H
Header .........................................3-24
Home screen .................................1-6
I
Icon ................................................1-9
J
Job .................................................7-2
Active ..........................................7-2
Log ..............................................7-3
L
Line Settings ...............................3-13
ECM OFF ..................................3-13
TX Confirm CSI .........................3-13
V34 OFF ...................................3-13
Lists .............................................. 7-5
Address Book List .................... 7-12
Fax Setup Information List ....... 7-12
M
Machine Parts .............................. 1-2
Memory reception ........................ 4-7
Mode Memory ............................. 3-21
N
Night reception .......................... 4-10
O
Off-Hook ..................................... 3-22
Original glass ............................... 3-5
Original Settings ........................ 3-18
Binding Position ....................... 3-19
Long Original ............................ 3-18
Original Size ............................. 3-18
Simplex/Duplex ........................ 3-18
P
Parts .............................................. 1-2
PC-Fax ................................. 5-2, 5-18
Address book ............................. 5-4
FAX Cover Sheet ....................... 5-5
Phone book ................................ 5-3
Transmission operation .............. 5-2
Phone book ................................ 5-15
Polling reception .......................... 4-6
Printing received faxes ............. 4-11
Program ........................................ 6-2
Program Address ......................... 6-6
Program Address List ............... 7-12
R
Receiving G3 faxes ...................... 4-2
Automatic reception ................... 4-2
DRPD ......................................... 4-4
Manual reception ........................ 4-3
Receiving Internet faxes ............. 4-5
Redial .......................................... 3-23
Remote reception ........................ 4-9Index A-7
Reports ..........................................7-4
Activity Report .............................7-6
Broadcast Reservation
Report .......................................7-10
Broadcast Result Report .............7-9
I-Fax RX Error Report ...............7-11
PC-Fax TX Error Report ...........7-11
Reservation TX Report ...............7-8
TX Result Report ........................7-7
S
Scan Settings ..............................3-11
Background Removal ...............3-12
Density ......................................3-12
Original Type ............................3-11
Resolution .................................3-11
Separate Scan ..........................3-11
Sharpness .................................3-12
Sending faxes ...............................3-1
General operation .......................3-2
Specifications .............................. A-2
Specifying destinations ...............3-7
Direct Input .................................3-8
Favorites .....................................3-7
LDAP ........................................3-10
Log ..............................................3-9
Search ........................................3-8
T
Text input ..................................... A-4
Touch panel ..................................1-6
Troubleshooting ...........................8-1
Error messages ..........................8-9
U
User authentication ....................1-11
Device authentication ...............1-11
External server
authentication ...........................1-11A-8 IndexCopyright
A121-9562-13A 2009 2011. 1
http://konicaminolta.com
User’s Guide [Box Operations]Introduction
C550 x-1
Introduction
Thank you for choosing this machine.
This User’s Guide contains details on the operations required to use the User
Box functions of the bizhub C550, precautions on their use, and basic troubleshooting procedures. In order to ensure that this machine is used correctly and efficiently, carefully read this User’s Guide before using the machine.
If software (such as PageScope Job Spooler, HDDTWAIN or PageScope Box
Operator) other than that described in this User’s Guide has been installed,
data saved in a user box can be used from a computer on the network. Since
the operation differs for each software, refer to the manual for the corresponding software for details.
In addition, for details on the operation of PageScope Web Connection,
which can be used to operate this machine over a network, refer to the User’s Guide [PageScope Web Connection Operations].
Views of the actual equipment may be slightly different from the illustrations
used in this manual.Introduction
C550 x-2
Trademarks and registered trademarks
KONICA MINOLTA, KONICA MINOLTA Logo, and The essentials of imaging
are registered trademarks or trademarks of KONICA MINOLTA HOLDINGS,
INC.
PageScope and bizhub are registered trademarks or trademarks of KONICA
MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
Netscape is a registered trade mark of Netscape Communications Corporation in the United States and other countries.
This machine and PageScope Box Operator are based in part on the work of
the Independent JPEG Group.
Compact-VJE
Copyright 1986-2003 VACS Corp.
RC4®
is a registered trademark or trademark of RSA Security Inc. in the United States and/or other countries.
RSA
®
is a registered trademark or trademark of RSA Security Inc. RSA
BSAFE
®
is a registered trademark or trademark of RSA Security Inc. in the
United States and/or other countries.
License information
This product includes RSA BSAFE Cryptographic software
from RSA Security Inc.
OpenSSL statement
OpenSSL license
Copyright © 1998-2005 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must
display the following acknowledgment:
“This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for
use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/)”Introduction
C550 x-3
4. The names “OpenSSL Toolkit” and “OpenSSL Project” must not be used
to endorse or promote products derived from this software without prior
written permission. For written permission, please contact
opensslcore@openssl.org.
5. Products derived from this software may not be called “OpenSSL” nor
may “OpenSSL” appear in their names without prior written permission
of the OpenSSL Project.
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowledgment:
“This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for
use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)”
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT “AS IS” AND
ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY
WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com). This product includes software written by Tim Hudson
(tjh@cryptsoft.com).
Original SSLeay license
Copyright © 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) All rights reserved.
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com).
The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL.
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the following conditions are aheared to. The following conditions apply to all code
found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, Ihash, DES, etc., code; not just
the SSL code.
The SSL documentation included with this distribution is covered by the
same copyright terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com).
Copyright remains Eric Young’s, and as such any Copyright notices in the
code are not to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric Young
should be given attribution as the author of the parts of the library used. This
can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in documentation (online or textual) provided with the package.Introduction
C550 x-4
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list
of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must
display the following acknowledgement:
“This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com)”
The word ‘cryptographic’ can be left out if the rouines from the library being used are not cryptographic related.
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from
the apps directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement:
“This product includes software written by Tin Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com)”
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put under another distribution licence [including the GNU Public
Licence.]
NetSNMP License
Part 1: CMU/UCD copyright notice: (BSD like)
Copyright 1989, 1991, 1992 by Carnegie Mellon University Derivative Work -
1996, 1998-2000
Copyright 1996, 1998-2000 The Regents of the University of California All
Rights ReservedIntroduction
C550 x-5
Permission to use, copy, modify and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided that
the above copyright notice appears in all copies and that both that copyright
notice and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation, and
that the name of CMU and The Regents of the University of California not be
used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software without specific written permission.
CMU AND THE REGENTS OF THE UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA DISCLAIM
ALLWARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL
IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO
EVENT SHALL CMU OR THE REGENTS OF THE UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM THE LOSS
OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
Part 2: Networks Associates Technology, Inc copyright notice (BSD)
Copyright © 2001-2003, Networks Associates Technology, Inc
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
- Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
- Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
- Neither the name of the Networks Associates Technology, Inc nor the
names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products
derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.Introduction
C550 x-6
Part 3: Cambridge Broadband Ltd. copyright notice (BSD)
Portions of this code are copyright © 2001-2003, Cambridge Broadband Ltd.
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
- Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
- Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
- The name of Cambridge Broadband Ltd. may not be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER “AS IS”
AND ANYEXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THEIMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;
OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Part 4: Sun Microsystems, Inc. copyright notice (BSD)
Copyright © 2003 Sun Microsystems, Inc., 4150 Network Circle, Santa Clara,
California 95054, U.S.A. All rights reserved.
Use is subject to license terms below.
This distribution may include materials developed by third parties.
Sun, Sun Microsystems, the Sun logo and Solaris are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun Microsystems, Inc. in the U.S. and other countries.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
- Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
- Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.Introduction
C550 x-7
- Neither the name of the Sun Microsystems, Inc. nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this
software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
Part 5: Sparta, Inc copyright notice (BSD)
Copyright © 2003-2004, Sparta, Inc All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
- Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
- Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
- Neither the name of Sparta, Inc nor the names of its contributors may be
used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
Part 6: Cisco/BUPTNIC copyright notice (BSD)Introduction
C550 x-8
Copyright © 2004, Cisco, Inc and Information Network Center of Beijing University of Posts and Telecommunications. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
- Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
- Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
- Neither the name of Cisco, Inc, Beijing University of Posts and Telecommunications, nor the names of their contributors may be used to endorse
or promote products derived from this software without specific prior
written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
All other product names mentioned are trademarks or registered trademarks
of their respective companies
Kerberos
Copyright © 1985-2005 by the Massachusetts Institute of Technology. All
rights reserved.
permission notice
WITHIN THAT CONSTRAINT, permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose and without fee is
hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies
and that both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation, and that the name of M.I.T. not be used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software without specific,
written prior permission. Furthermore if you modify this software you must label your software as modified software and not distribute it in such a fashion
that it might be confused with the original MIT software.Introduction
C550 x-9
M.I.T. makes no representations about the suitability of this software for any
purpose. It is provided “as is” without express or implied warranty.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS” AND WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE.
THIS SOFTWARE IS NOT ORIGINAL MIT SOFTWARE, MODIFIED BY KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
Mersenne Twister
A C-program for MT19937, with initialization improved 2002/1/26.
Coded by Takuji Nishimura and Makoto Matsumoto.
Before using, initialize the state by using init_genrand(seed) or
init_by_array(init_key, key_length).
Copyright © 1997-2002, Makoto Matsumoto and Takuji Nishimura, All rights
reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. The names of its contributors may not be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.Introduction
C550 x-10
Any feedback is very welcome.
http://www.math.sci.hiroshima-u.ac.jp/~m-mat/MT/emt.html
email: m-mat @ math.sci.hiroshima-u.ac.jp (remove space)Introduction
C550 x-11
Contents
Introduction
Trademarks and registered trademarks .........................................x-2
OpenSSL statement ....................................................................... x-2
NetSNMP License .......................................................................... x-4
Kerberos ......................................................................................... x-8
Mersenne Twister ........................................................................... x-9
Contents ...........................................................................................x-11
About this manual ...........................................................................x-17
Structure of the manual ................................................................ x-17
Notation ........................................................................................ x-17
Explanation of manual conventions ..............................................x-18
User’s Guides ..................................................................................x-20
Printed manuals ............................................................................ x-20
User’s Guide CD manuals ............................................................ x-20
1 Overview of the User Box functions
1.1 Available User Box functions ...........................................................1-2
Saving documents ..........................................................................1-2
Using document data .....................................................................1-3
Organizing document data .............................................................1-5
1.2 Set-up for User Box functions .........................................................1-7
User box registration ......................................................................1-7
1.3 Control panel .....................................................................................1-8
1.4 Touch panel .....................................................................................1-11
Screen layout ................................................................................1-11
Icons on the touch panel ..............................................................1-12
1.5 About External Memory ..................................................................1-13
Available External Memory ...........................................................1-13
Connecting an external memory ..................................................1-13
2 Saving documents
2.1 Information on saving documents ...................................................2-2
User authentication ........................................................................2-2
Registering user boxes ...................................................................2-4
Naming documents ........................................................................2-4Introduction
C550 x-12
2.2 Authentication and user boxes that can be accessed ..................2-6
When user authentication and account track settings are not
specified .........................................................................................2-6
When only user authentication settings are specified ....................2-7
When only account track settings are specified .............................2-8
When user authentication and account track settings are
specified and synchronized ............................................................2-8
When user authentication and account track settings are
specified, but not synchronized ...................................................2-10
2.3 Saving copies in user boxes ..........................................................2-12
Settings that can be saved and changed .....................................2-12
Saving copy documents ...............................................................2-13
2.4 Saving scans in user boxes ............................................................2-17
Previewing ....................................................................................2-17
Preview - View Pages - Change Setting .......................................2-19
Preview - View Status ...................................................................2-20
Saving after previewing ................................................................2-20
Using a user box destination ........................................................2-22
Entering destinations directly .......................................................2-24
Saving in User Box mode .............................................................2-27
Saving on external memory from User Box mode .......................2-29
2.5 Saving printouts in user boxes ......................................................2-32
Saving data in a user box .............................................................2-33
Saving data in the Secure Print User Box ....................................2-36
Saving data in the Encrypted PDF User Box ................................2-38
2.6 Specifying scan settings ................................................................2-39
Settings that can be specified ......................................................2-39
Original Type ................................................................................2-40
Simplex/Duplex ............................................................................2-42
Resolution .....................................................................................2-43
File Type .......................................................................................2-44
Density ..........................................................................................2-49
Separate Scan ..............................................................................2-50
Color (Quality Adjustment) ............................................................2-50
Background Adjustment (Quality Adjustment) .............................2-52
Sharpness (Quality Adjustment) ...................................................2-54
Frame Erase (Erase) ......................................................................2-56
Book Copy (Book Scan) ...............................................................2-58
Scan Size (Application) .................................................................2-60
Original Settings ...........................................................................2-64Introduction
C550 x-13
2.7 Display and operation of the left panel .........................................2-67
Job List .........................................................................................2-67
Job List - Delete ...........................................................................2-68
Job List - Job Details ....................................................................2-68
Settings when saving documents ................................................2-73
Detail - Check Scan Settings .......................................................2-74
Detail - Check Original Settings ...................................................2-75
Settings when using documents ..................................................2-75
Detail .............................................................................................2-76
Check Job Settings ......................................................................2-76
Check Job Settings - Destination Settings ..................................2-77
Check Job Settings - E-Mail Settings ..........................................2-77
Preview .........................................................................................2-78
Preview - Detail ............................................................................2-79
Preview - Detail (Print/Combine) ..................................................2-79
Preview - Detail (Send/Bind TX) ...................................................2-80
3 Organizing user box documents
3.1 Overview of document organizing ...................................................3-2
Available operations in the File Document screen .........................3-2
Checking documents saved in user boxes ....................................3-3
Description of File Document screen .............................................3-5
Searching for a user box name ......................................................3-6
3.2 Deleting a document .........................................................................3-8
3.3 Changing the document name .......................................................3-10
3.4 Moving a document ........................................................................3-12
3.5 Duplicating a document .................................................................3-14
3.6 Checking document details ...........................................................3-16
Check the details ..........................................................................3-17
Preview screen operations ...........................................................3-19
4 Printing a user box document
4.1 Overview of document printing .......................................................4-2
Available operations in the Use Document screen .........................4-2
Checking documents saved in user boxes ....................................4-3
Description of Use Document screen ............................................4-5
Searching for a user box name ......................................................4-5
4.2 Printing ...............................................................................................4-6
Available print settings ...................................................................4-6
To print a document .......................................................................4-7
Changing the number of copies .....................................................4-8
Specifying single-sided/double-sided printing ...............................4-8Introduction
C550 x-14
Specifying Finishing settings ..........................................................4-9
Adding a binding margin ..............................................................4-16
Adding cover pages (Cover Sheet) ...............................................4-19
Adding insertions (Insert Sheet) ....................................................4-24
Inserting chapter title pages (Chapters) .......................................4-29
Printing the date/time (Date/Time) ................................................4-33
Printing page numbers (Page Number) ........................................4-36
Adding preset text or images (Stamp) ..........................................4-41
Adding text and images to prevent copying (Copy Protect) ........4-44
Adding repeated preset text or images (Stamp Repeat) ..............4-53
Inserting a header/footer (Header/Footer) ....................................4-61
4.3 Combined printing ..........................................................................4-66
Available combined printing parameters ......................................4-66
To print a document .....................................................................4-67
5 Sending a user box document
5.1 Overview of document transmissions .............................................5-2
Available document transmission operations .................................5-2
Transmission methods ...................................................................5-2
Checking documents saved in user boxes ....................................5-3
Description of Use Document screen ............................................5-5
Searching for a user box name ......................................................5-5
To send a document .......................................................................5-6
5.2 Specifying the destination ................................................................5-8
Selecting from the address book ...................................................5-8
Selecting from a group destination ................................................5-9
Searching for a destination ...........................................................5-11
Directly specifying an e-mail destination ......................................5-13
Directly specifying an SMB destination ........................................5-15
Directly specifying an FTP destination .........................................5-16
Directly specifying a WebDAV destination ...................................5-19
Selecting a destination with an Address search ..........................5-21
5.3 Specifying the transmission settings ............................................5-24
Settings that can be specified ......................................................5-24
File Type .......................................................................................5-25
E-Mail Settings (Communication Settings) ...................................5-29
URL Notification Setting (Communication Settings) ....................5-30
E-Mail Encryption (Communication Settings) ...............................5-31
Digital Signature (Communication Settings) .................................5-32
Date/Time (Application) ................................................................5-33
Page Number (Application) ...........................................................5-37
Stamp (Application) ......................................................................5-41
Header/Footer (Application) .........................................................5-44
Send & Print (Application) .............................................................5-49Introduction
C550 x-15
5.4 Bind TX .............................................................................................5-52
Available combined sending parameters .....................................5-52
To perform a combined transmission ...........................................5-52
5.5 Checking settings before sending .................................................5-56
Deleting unnecessary destinations ...............................................5-57
6 Printing/sending a system user box document
6.1 Overview of system user boxes .......................................................6-2
6.2 Secure Print User Box ......................................................................6-3
Available printing parameters .........................................................6-3
To print a document (Mode 1) ........................................................6-4
To print a document (Mode 2) ........................................................6-7
6.3 Annotation User Box .......................................................................6-10
Available printing parameters .......................................................6-10
To print a document .....................................................................6-11
Available transmission parameters ...............................................6-13
To send a document .....................................................................6-15
Changing the text .........................................................................6-17
6.4 Encrypted PDF User Box ................................................................6-21
Printing .........................................................................................6-21
Deleting .........................................................................................6-23
6.5 ID & Print User Box .........................................................................6-26
Printing .........................................................................................6-27
Deleting .........................................................................................6-28
6.6 External Memory .............................................................................6-30
Available printing parameters .......................................................6-30
File types that can be printed .......................................................6-30
Document Details .........................................................................6-31
To print a document .....................................................................6-31
To print an encrypted PDF file ......................................................6-33
7 Specifying Utility mode parameters
7.1 Settings that can be specified from Utility mode ...........................7-2
Utility mode parameters .................................................................7-2
PageScope Web Connection .........................................................7-2
7.2 User box permissions .......................................................................7-3
Types of users ................................................................................7-3
Public user boxes and personal/group user boxes ........................7-3
7.3 Displaying settings screens .............................................................7-4
Displaying the Administrator Settings screen ................................7-4Introduction
C550 x-16
7.4 Registering user boxes .....................................................................7-6
Registering user boxes ...................................................................7-7
Registering annotation user boxes ...............................................7-11
7.5 Maximum Number of User Boxes ..................................................7-18
7.6 User Box Settings ...........................................................................7-20
Displaying the User Box Settings screen .....................................7-20
Delete Unused User Box ..............................................................7-21
Delete Secure Print Documents ...................................................7-22
Auto Delete Secure Document .....................................................7-23
Encrypted PDF Delete Time .........................................................7-24
ID & Print Delete Time ..................................................................7-25
Document Hold Setting ................................................................7-26
External Memory Function Settings .............................................7-27
7.7 ID & Print Settings ...........................................................................7-29
7.8 User Box Administrator Setting .....................................................7-31
7.9 HDD Setting .....................................................................................7-34
Check HDD Capacity ...................................................................7-35
Overwrite Temporary Data ...........................................................7-36
Overwrite All Data .........................................................................7-39
HDD Lock Password ....................................................................7-41
HDD Encryption Setting ...............................................................7-44
Format HDD ..................................................................................7-46
8 Appendix
8.1 Error message list .............................................................................8-2
8.2 Entering text ......................................................................................8-3
Enlarging the keyboard ...................................................................8-5
To type text .....................................................................................8-6
List of Available Characters ............................................................8-6
8.3 Glossary .............................................................................................8-7
9 Index
9.1 Index ...................................................................................................9-2Introduction
C550 x-17
About this manual
This User’s Guide covers the bizhub C550 box functions.
This section introduces the structure of the manual and notations used for
product names, etc.
This manual is intended for users who understand the basic operations of
computers and the machine. For the operating procedures of Windows or
Macintosh operating system and application programs, refer to the respective manuals.
In addition, software, such as HDDTWAIN and PageScope Box Operator,
which are used with the Box functions of this machine, are also available. Users of these software should refer to the corresponding manuals on the CDROM.
Structure of the manual
This manual consists of the following chapters.
Chapter 1 Overview of the User Box functions
Chapter 2 Saving documents
Chapter 3 Organizing user box documents
Chapter 4 Printing a user box document
Chapter 5 Sending a user box document
Chapter 6 Printing/sending a system user box document
Chapter 7 Specifying Utility mode parameters
Chapter 8 Appendix
Chapter 9 Index
Notation
Product name Notation in the manual
bizhub C550 This machine, C550
Microsoft Windows NT 4.0 Windows NT 4.0
Microsoft Windows 2000 Windows 2000
Microsoft Windows XP Windows XP
Microsoft Windows Vista Windows Vista
When the operating systems above are written
together
Windows NT 4.0/2000/XP/VistaIntroduction
C550 x-18
Explanation of manual conventionsIntroduction
C550 x-19Introduction
C550 x-20
User’s Guides
This machine is provided with printed manuals and PDF manuals on the User’s Guide CD.
Printed manuals
Quick Guide [Copy/Print/Fax/Scan/Box Operations]
This manual contains operating procedures and descriptions of the most frequently used functions, allowing the machine to immediately be used.
In addition, this manual contains notes and precautions that should be followed for safe use of the machine.
Be sure to read this manual before using the machine.
User’s Guide [Enlarge Display Operations]
This manual contains details on operating procedures in Enlarge Display
mode.
Refer to this manual for details on using copy, network scanner and fax functions in Enlarge Display mode.
User’s Guide CD manuals
User’s Guide [Copy Operations]
This manual contains descriptions of the Copy mode operations and machine maintenance. Refer to this manual for details on the paper and documents, copy procedures using convenient Application functions, replacing
consumables, and troubleshooting operations such as clearing paper misfeeds.
User’s Guide [Print Operations]
This manual contains details of the printing functions that can be specified
with the standard built-in printer controller. Refer to this manual for operating
procedures on using the printing functions.
User’s Guide [Box Operations] (this manual)
This manual contains operating procedures for using the user boxes on the
hard disk. Refer to this manual for details on saving data in user boxes, retrieving data from user boxes and transferring data.
User’s Guide [Network Scanner Operations]
This manual contains descriptions on specifying network settings for standard equipment and operating procedures for scanning functions. Refer to
this User’s Guide for details on using network functions and the Scan to EMail, Scan to FTP and Scan to SMB operations.Introduction
C550 x-21
User’s Guide [PageScope Web Connection Operations]
This manual contains descriptions on the machine settings that can be specified remotely with PageScope Web Connection from a Web browser on a
computer. Refer to this manual for details on operating procedures for using
PageScope Web Connection.
User’s Guide [Fax Operations]
This manual contains descriptions of the G3 fax operations. Refer to this
manual for details on using the G3 fax operations when the optional fax kit is
installed.
In order to use the fax functions, the optional fax kit must be purchased separately.
User’s Guide [Network Fax Operations]
This manual contains details on the network fax functions. Refer to this manual for operating procedures on Internet faxing and IP address faxing.
User’s Guide [Fax Driver Operations]
This manual contains details of the fax driver functions that can be used to
send a fax directly from a computer.
Refer to this manual for operating procedures on using the PC-FAX functions.
In order to use the fax functions, the optional fax kit must be purchased separately.
User’s Guide [Advanced Function Operations]
This User’s Guide describes overview and usage of functions that become
available by registering the optional license kit and enabling its function, and
functions that become available by connecting the MFP with applications.
In order to use the functions effectively, please read this User’s Guide.
The following models support the advanced function.
bizhub C650/C550/C451/C353/C253/C2031 Overview of the User Box
functionsOverview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-2
1 Overview of the User Box functions
1.1 Available User Box functions
The User Box functions allow document data to be saved on the internal hard
disk of the machine and later printed. Documents that can be saved are data
scanned for copying and saved scan data. To save data to a box, create the
box, and then save the data to the specified box.
The saved data can be printed, sent by e-mail, forwarded to an FTP site, or
sent to a computer. By using the User Box functions, documents can easily
be scanned repeatedly and the separate data can be saved on a computer.
Saving documents
Data can be saved to the following box:
*1
To connect an external memory, an optional local interface kit is required.
User box Description Reference
Public/personal/group
user boxes
Document data that has been copied or scanned on this
machine can be saved in the user boxes.
Document data, which is printed from a computer on the
network, can be saved.
Based on user authentication or account track settings,
access to some boxes, such as personal and group user
boxes, can be limited to particular users.
p. 2-2
Annotation user box Document data saved in Scan mode and to be printed or
transmitted with an image of the date/time or an annotation number can be saved.
p. 2-2
External memory
*1
Appears if an external memory is installed. Scanned data
can be directly saved in the external memory connected
to the machine.
p. 2-29Overview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-3
Using document data
The document saved in boxes can be used as follows:
Original Computers Fax
External memory
FTP server
etc.
User box Description Reference
Public/personal/group
user boxes
Saved documents can be printed or sent. Multiple documents can be selected for printing/transmission.
Depending on user authentication and account track settings, use of some boxes, such as personal and group
user boxes, can be limited to a particular user.
p. 6-2
Bulletin board user box
*1
This box appears when the optional fax kit is installed.
Saved documents in the bulletin board user box can be
printed.
-
Polling TX user box
*1
This box appears when the optional fax kit is installed.
Documents sent using polling can be printed.
-
Secure print user box Saved documents can be printed. To print the data, enter
an ID and password.
p. 6-3
Memory RX user box
*1
This box appears when the optional fax kit is installed.
The fax document received though the memory RX setting can be confirmed and printed.
-
Annotation user box Document data saved can be printed or transmitted with
an image of the date/time or an annotation number.
p. 6-10Overview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-4
*1
For details on bulletin board, Polling TX, Polling RX, Memory RX and File
Re-TX, refer to the User's Guide [Fax Operations].
*2
For print instruction of an encrypted PDF, see PageScope Direct Print
manual or the manual of PageScope Web Connection.
*3
To connect an external memory, an optional local interface kit is required.
Fax retransmit user box
*1
This box appears when the optional fax kit is installed.
Saved documents can be retransmitted or printed for
confirmation.
-
Encrypted PDF user
box
*2
Saved documents can be printed. Encrypted PDF files
saved in an external memory and sent for print jobs are
also saved in this box. To print documents, the preset
password is necessary.
p. 6-21
ID & Print user box
*3
This user box appears if user authentication is applied.
Documents being sent for print jobs by the printer driver
after logging on as a user can be printed.
p. 6-26
External memory
*3
Appears if an external memory is installed. Document
data in the external memory connected to the machine
can be printed.
p. 6-30
User box Description ReferenceOverview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-5
Organizing document data
Documents can be organized by renaming the saved document name,
changing the box where they are saved, or duplicating or deleting them.
Fax Computers
External memory
FTP server etc.
E-mail etc.
Printouts
User box Delete Change
name
Move Copy Details
Public/personal/group user
boxes
o o o o o
Bulletin board user box o × × × ×
Polling TX user box o × × × ×
Secure print user box o o × × o
Memory RX user box o o × × o
Annotation user box o o × × o
Fax retransmit user box o × × × ×
Encrypted PDF user box × × × × ×
ID & Print User Box × × × × ×Overview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-6
External memory × × × × ×
User box Delete Change
name
Move Copy DetailsOverview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-7
1.2 Set-up for User Box functions
Before using the User Box functions, the following settings should be specified.
User box registration
Create and save the user boxes where documents will be saved. Boxes can
be registered by using the machine’s touch panel or by using PageScope
Web Connection from a computer on the network. The following boxes can
be created:
- Public/personal/group user boxes (p. 7-6)
- Annotation user box (p. 7-11)Overview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-8
1.3 Control panel
Use the control panel for User Box mode operation. The following keys and
switches are provided on the control panel.
1
2
4
5
3
6
7
8
14 13 12 9
15
16
17
18
11 10
19
20
21
22
No. Part name Description
1 Touch panel Displays various screens and messages. Specify
the various settings by directly touching the panel.
2 Main Power indicator Lights up in green when the machine is turned on
with the main power switch.
3 Sub power switch Press to turn on/off machine operations, for example, for copying, printing or scanning. When turned
off, the machine enters a state where it conserves
energy.
4 [Mode Memory] key Press to register (store) the desired copy/scan settings as a program or to recall a registered copy/
scan program.Overview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-9
5 [Utility/Counter] key Press to display the Utility screen and the Meter
Count screen.
6 [Reset] key Press to clear all settings (except programmed settings) entered in the control panel and touch panel.
7 [Interrupt] key Press to enter Interrupt mode. While the machine
is in Interrupt mode, the indicator on the [Interrupt]
key lights up in green and the message “Now in Interrupt mode.” appears on the touch panel. To
cancel Interrupt mode, press the [Interrupt] key
again.
8 [Stop] key Pressing the [Stop] key during scanning temporarily stops the scan operation.
9 [Proof Copy] key Press to print a single proof copy to be checked
before printing a large number of copies.
Press the [Proof Copy] key before scanning or copying, the result can be viewed on the touch panel.
!
Detail
This key cannot be used if the [User Box]
key was pressed to save a document.
To preview a document being saved in a
user box, press the [Fax/Scan] key. For
details on previewing, refer to the User’s
Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
10 [Start] key Press to start scanning. When this machine is
ready to begin to scan, the indicator on the [Start]
key lights up in blue. If the indicator on the [Start]
key lights up in orange, the operation cannot be
started.
Press to restart a stopped job.
11 Data indicator Flashes in blue while a print job is being received.
Lights up in blue when data is being printed.
12 [C] (clear) key Press to erase a value (such as the number of copies, a zoom ratio, or a size) entered using the keypad.
13 Keypad Use to type in the number of sets to be copied.
Use to type in the zoom ratio.
Use to type in the various settings.
14 [Help] key Press to display the Help screen. From this screen,
descriptions of the various functions and details of
operations can be displayed.
15 [Enlarge Display] key Press to enter Enlarge Display mode. If authentication is performed with PageScope Authentication
Manager, it does not enter Enlarge Display mode.
16 [Accessibility] key Press to display the screen for specifying settings
for user accessibility functions.
No. Part name DescriptionOverview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-10
7 CAUTION
Do not apply extreme pressure to the touch panel, otherwise it may be
scratched or damaged.
% Never push down on the touch panel with force, and never use a hard
or pointed object to make a selection in the touch panel.
17 [Power Save] key Press to enter Power Save mode. While the machine is in Power Save mode, the indicator on the
[Power Save] key lights up in green and the touch
panel goes off. To cancel Power Save mode, press
the [Power Save] key again.
18 [Access] key In order to use this machine when user authentication or account track settings have been applied,
enter the user name and password (for user authentication) or the account name and password
(for account track), and then press this key. Also
press this key to log off.
19 [Brightness] dial Use to adjust the brightness of the touch panel.
20 [User Box] key Press to enter User Box mode.
While the machine is in User Box mode, the indicator on the [User Box] key lights up in green.
21 [Fax/Scan] key Press to enter Fax/Scan mode.
While the machine is in Fax/Scan mode, the indicator on the [Fax/Scan] key lights up in green. For details on the scan operation, refer to the User’s
Guide [Network Scanner Operations]. For details
on the fax operation, refer to the User’s Guide [Fax
Operations].
22 [Copy] key Press to enter Copy mode. (As a default, the machine is in Copy mode.)
While the machine is in Copy mode, the indicator
on the [Copy] key lights up in green. For details, refer to the User’s Guide [Copy Operations].
No. Part name DescriptionOverview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-11
1.4 Touch panel
Screen layout
1
4
5 3
2
No. Part Name Description
1 Message display area The status of the machine and details on
operations are displayed.
2 Functions/settings display area Softkeys to select functions are displayed.
This area is for specifying the settings of
various functions. Touch softkeys to display the corresponding screen for specifying the settings.
3 Icon display area Icons indicating the status of jobs and the
machine are displayed.
4 Left panel The softkeys, such as [Job List] showing
the jobs being processed or to be processed, and [Mode Check] showing the result of the specified settings, appear in this
area.
For details on the left panel, refer to “Display and operation of the left panel” on
page 2-67.
5 Toner supply indicators These indicators show the amount of toner
remaining for yellow (Y), magenta (M), cyan
(C), and black (K).Overview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-12
Icons on the touch panel
The status of the machine may appear in the icon display area. The followings are the icons appear on the touch panel.
Icon Description
Indicates that data is being sent from the machine, regardless of
the current mode.
Indicates that data is being received by the machine, regardless of
the current mode.
Indicates that an error occurred during an image stabilization operation, a print operation or a scan operation.
Touch this icon to view a screen containing a warning code.
If the warning screen was closed when a warning occurred, touch
this button to display the warning screen again.
Appears when there is a message indicating that consumables
must be replaced or the machine requires maintenance. Touch this
icon to display the message, and then perform the replacement or
maintenance procedure.
Appears when an error occurs with the connection to the POP
server.
Indicates that paper is not loaded in the paper tray.
Indicates that very little paper remains in the paper tray.
If the optional image controller is installed, touch this icon to display the setting screen for the image controller.
Indicates that Enhanced Security mode is set to ON.
Indicates that an external memory is installed.Overview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-13
1.5 About External Memory
If the optional local interface kit is installed on this machine, a USB flash
memory can be connected for saving or printing data.
Available External Memory
The conditions of external memories available on this machine are as follows.
- USB flash memory supporting the USB (1.1/2.0) Interface
- FAT32 formatted.
Connecting an external memory
Connect an external memory to the USB connector on the side of this machine.Overview of the User Box functions
1
C550 1-14
When the external memory is connected, an icon appears on the bottom of
the screen and the following screen appears.Check it, and then touch [OK].
2
Reminder
This machine is equipped with two USB connectors on the side. As one
is for optional connection, two sets of external memories cannot be connected at a time.
Do not pull out the external memory while a document is being saved to
the external memory or being printed.
Do not use any USB device other than the USB flash memory (such as
hard disk or USB hub). However, the optional products connectable to
the USB connector of this machine are exceptions.2 Saving documentsSaving documents
2
C550 2-2
2 Saving documents
2.1 Information on saving documents
Keep in mind the following information before saving documents.
User authentication
This machine can be set so that an account or user name and a password
must be entered in order to use the machine. Contact the administrator for
details on the account or user name for using the machine.
With user authentication (machine authentication)
Type in the user name and password, and then touch [Login] or press the
[Access] key.
With user authentication (external server authentication)
Specify the user name, password and authenticating server, and then touch
[Login] or press the [Access] key.Saving documents
2
C550 2-3
With account track
Type in the account name and password, and then touch [Login] or press the
[Access] key.
2
Note
With user authentication, the only boxes that are displayed are those that
can be accessed by the user that is logged on. For details, refer to “Authentication and user boxes that can be accessed” on page 2-6.
If “Prohibited Functions When Authentication Error” in Administrator
mode is set to “Mode 2” and a user enters an incorrect password the
specified number of times, that user is locked out and can no longer use
the machine. Contact the administrator to cancel operation restrictions.
If authentication is performed with PageScope Authentication Manager,
contact your server administrator for log on.Saving documents
2
C550 2-4
For details on logging on when using optional authentication unit (biometric type) AU-101 for authentication, refer to the User’s Guide [Copy
Operations].
Registering user boxes
Before document data can be saved, a user box must be created for saving
the data.
Up to 1,000 user boxes can be created.
Up to 200 documents can be saved in a single user box.
A total of 10,000 pages can be saved in all user boxes.
A total of 3,000 documents can be saved in all user boxes.
There are public user boxes (which can be used by more than one person),
personal user boxes (which can be used only by a single person), and group
user boxes (which can be used by users belonging to the account that has
been logged on when account track settings have been specified). For details on registering user boxes, refer to “Registering user boxes” on
page 7-6.
Naming documents
Document data that is saved can be given a name.
The names can contain a maximum of 30 characters.
The names can also be changed after they are saved.
The names can be specified when the data is saved; however, if the data is
saved without a name specified, a preset name is applied.
Names are created by combining the following elements. As an example, the
document name “CKMBT_C55008102315230” is described.
Element Description
C This letter indicates the mode when the document was saved.
C: Copy
S: Fax/Scan
P: Print
KMBT_C550 This represents the name of the device that scanned the data. The
factory default is “KMBT_C550”. This name can be changed with the
“Input Machine Address” parameter on the Administrator/Machine
Setting screen in Administrator mode. A name of up to 10 characters
can be specified.
08102315230 This indicates the year (last two digits), month, day, hour and minutes when the data was scanned. The last digit is a serial number if
the document is part of a series of scans.Saving documents
2
C550 2-5
2
Note
“S” appears for documents saved from the Fax/Scan mode screen or the
User Box mode screen.
_0001 This indicates the page when multi-page data is scanned. This numeral does not appear beside “Document Name”; however, it is
added automatically as part of the name when the file is transmitted.
Add this part to the name according to the naming conditions of the
server receiving the files, for example, when data is sent by FTP.
.TIF This is the extension for the specified data format. These characters
do not appear beside “Document Name”; however, they are added
automatically as part of the name when the file is transmitted.
Element DescriptionSaving documents
2
C550 2-6
2.2 Authentication and user boxes that can be accessed
When user authentication and account track settings have been applied, the
user boxes that can be accessed and the permissions change as shown below. Specify the user authentication and account track settings according to
the desired functions.
When user authentication and account track settings are not specified
Users can access all public user boxes.
User boxes created by users and the administrator are public user boxes.
Create and access
Public user boxSaving documents
2
C550 2-7
When only user authentication settings are specified
Users can access all public user boxes and only personal user boxes that the
user has created.
Personal user boxes cannot be accessed by other users.
A user box administrator can be specified.
A user box administrator can access all public user boxes and all personal
user boxes.
If authentication data is erased by canceling the user authentication settings
or changing the authentication method, all personal user boxes become
public user boxes.
User 1
User 2
Accessible
Public user box
Personal user
box for user 1
Personal user
box for user 2
Box
administratorSaving documents
2
C550 2-8
When only account track settings are specified
Users can access all public user boxes and only group user boxes for the account that the user belongs to.
If authentication data is erased by canceling the account track settings or
changing the authentication method, all group user boxes become public
user boxes.
When user authentication and account track settings are specified and
synchronized
Account A
Account B
Accessible
Public user box
Group user box
for account A
Group user box
for account B
Account A
User 1
Account B
User 2Saving documents
2
C550 2-9
If the account for the user was previously registered, group user boxes for
accounts that the user does not belong to cannot be accessed.
Users can access all public user boxes, only group user boxes for the account that the user belongs to, and only personal user boxes that the user
has created.
Personal user boxes cannot be accessed by other users.
A user box administrator can be specified.
A user box administrator can access all public user boxes, all personal user
boxes and all group user boxes.
If authentication data is erased by canceling the user authentication settings
or changing the authentication method, all personal user boxes and group
user boxes become public user boxes.
Account A
Account B
User 1
User 2
Accessible
Public user box
Personal user
box for user 1
Box
administrator
Group user box
for account A
Group user box
for account B
Personal user
box for user 2Saving documents
2
C550 2-10
When user authentication and account track settings are specified, but
not synchronized
If the account for the user was not previously registered, the user logs on
with the account name and password. The group user box for the account
can be accessed by a member of an account different from the one that is
logged on.
Account A
User 1
Account BSaving documents
2
C550 2-11
Users can access all public user boxes, and only personal user boxes that
the user has created.
Personal user boxes cannot be accessed by other users.
If a user enters an account name and password when logging on, the group
user box for that account can be accessed.
A user box administrator can be specified.
A user box administrator can access all public user boxes, all personal user
boxes and all group user boxes.
If authentication data is erased by canceling the user authentication settings
or changing the authentication method, all personal user boxes and group
user boxes become public user boxes.
User 1
Accessible
Public user box
Personal user
box for user 1
Box
administrator
Accessible by entering the account name and password
Group user box
for account A
Group user box
for account BSaving documents
2
C550 2-12
2.3 Saving copies in user boxes
Settings that can be saved and changed
Within the various functions that can be specified before making copies,
there are functions whose settings can be saved and there are functions that
cannot be saved but can be set when printing. The functions whose settings
can be saved and those that can be changed are listed below.
!
Detail
The Fold/Bind settings are available only if optional finisher FS-608 is installed.
The Punch settings are available only if optional finisher FS-517 and the
punch kit are installed.
Function type Function Can be saved Can be set when
printing
Number of copies × o
Paper tray selection o ×
Output tray selection o ×
Basic screen settings Color o ×
Paper o ×
Zoom o ×
Original > Copy o o
Fold/Bind o o
Collate/Group o o
Punch o o
Staple o o
Original Settings Combine o ×
Quality/Density Original Type o ×
Density o ×
Background Adjustment o ×
Application Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert o o
Edit Color o ×
Page Margin o o
Stamp/Composition o oSaving documents
2
C550 2-13
Saving copy documents
Copy documents can be saved in user boxes. Specify the following information when saving copy documents.
!
Detail
The document can be saved in the following types of user boxes.
Public user boxes
Personal user boxes (when user authentication settings are specified)
Group user boxes (when account track settings are specified)
Annotation User Box
2
Note
To output the copy document after saving it to a user box and specifying
Z-Fold for it, specify a paper size that supports Z-Fold when saving the
copy document.
The sizes that support Z-Fold are 8-1/2 × 14 w, 11 × 17 w, A3 w, B4
w and 8K w.
1 Press the [Copy] key in the control panel.
2 Touch [Application].
Parameter Description
User Box Specify the user box where the data is to be saved.
Document Name Type in 30 characters or less for the name of the document to be
saved.
Save & Print To make copies of the document while saving it, touch [Yes].Saving documents
2
C550 2-14
3 Touch [Save in User Box].
The Save in User Box screen appears.
4 Select the user box where the data is to be saved. Touch [User Box].
5 Touch the tab for the desired user box, and then touch the button for
the user box to select it.
– To type in a user box number to specify the user box, touch [Enter
User Box No.].
– To save the document in the Annotation User Box, touch [System
User Box], and then touch [Annotation User Box] to select the user
box.Saving documents
2
C550 2-15
The button for the selected user box appears selected.
?
Is a password required when saving data?
% It is not necessary to enter the password when saving data, even if
a password has been specified for the user box.
6 Touch [OK].
7 Specify the name of the document to be saved. To change the automatically specified name, touch [Document Name].Saving documents
2
C550 2-16
8 After typing in the name, touch [OK].
– To change the name, touch [Delete] until the characters are deleted,
and then type in the new name.
– To erase all of the text, press the [C] (clear) key.
9 Select whether or not a copy will also be printed when the data is
saved. To print a copy, touch [Yes].
10 Touch [OK].
11 Specify the necessary copy settings.
– If a User Box function was set, [Save in User Box] appears selected.
12 Load the document into the ADF or place it on the original glass.
13 If desired, press the [Proof Copy] key to check a preview image.
– For details on using previews in Copy mode, refer to the User’s
Guide [Copy Operations].
14 Press the [Start] key in the control panel.
– If “Yes” was selected beside “Save & Print”, the scanned document
is copied and the document data is saved in the specified user box.
– If “No” was selected beside “Save & Print”, the scanned document
data is saved in the specified user box.
!
Detail
For details on the copy settings, refer to the User’s Guide [Copy Operations].
For details on printing the document saved in a user box, refer to “Printing a user box document” on page 4-2.Saving documents
2
C550 2-17
2.4 Saving scans in user boxes
From the Fax/Scan mode screen, scanned images can be saved in user boxes. User box destinations can be registered in the address book, or a user
box destination can be specified directly.
The following procedures describe how to select a user box destination, how
to specify a user box destination directly, and how to save from User Box
mode.
2
Note
Press the [Fax/Scan] key to display the Fax/Scan mode screen.
!
Detail
The document can be saved in the following types of user boxes.
Public user boxes
Personal user boxes (when user authentication settings are specified)
Group user boxes (when account track settings are specified)
Annotation User Box (only when entered directly)
Previewing
When saving scans in registered user box destinations, pressing the [Proof
Copy] key in the control panel after loading the document displays a preview
of the finished scan in the touch panel. In the Preview screen, the orientation
of the scanned document can be checked and the settings can be changed.
!
Detail
A preview cannot be displayed if the document is scanned with an encryption setting specified.
A preview cannot be displayed if the document is being saved by pressing the [User Box] key, then touching [Save Document].
The following operations can be performed from the Preview - View Pages
screen.Saving documents
2
C550 2-18
2
Note
By directly selecting a page, the image of the selected page is rotated by
180 degrees.
Item Description
[Prev. Page]/[Next Page] If the document being saved contains multiple pages, the various
pages can be displayed.
Zoom The document can be viewed at full size or at a size of 2, 4 or 8 times
the normal size. Select the display size, and then use the scroll bars
at the right side and at the bottom of the image to view the desired
section of the image.
Page Rotation [Rotate current page]: Touch this button to rotate the currently displayed page by 180 degrees.
[Select page(s) to rotate]: This key appears when the document being saved contains multiple pages. A list of scanned pages appears,
allowing you to select the pages to be rotated by 180 degrees. The
following operations are available in the list of scanned pages.
[Select Odd]: Touch this button to rotate the images of the odd-numbered pages by 180 degrees.
[Select Even]: Touch this button to rotate the images of the evennumbered pages by 180 degrees.
[Select All]: Touch this button to rotate the images of all pages by
180 degrees.
[View Finishing] The specified settings appear as icons and descriptions in the preview image. To remove the icons and descriptions and display only
the image, touch [View Finishing] to deselect it.
[Change Setting] Touch this button to change some of the settings specified before
the document is scanned. For details, refer to “Preview - View Pages
- Change Setting” on page 2-19.Saving documents
2
C550 2-19
Preview - View Pages - Change Setting
The following settings specified before scanning the original can be
changed.
The new settings are applied to the originals scanned after the change of setting.
Item Description
Basic - Document Select either 1-sided or 2-sided. If the “Cover + 2-Sided” is specified, [Cover + 2-Sided] also appears.
Basic - Binding Position This item can be selected when the destination of “E-Mail”, “User
Box”, “FTP”, “SMB” or “WebDAV” is specified and “Book Copy” is
not selected.
Basic - Original Size This item can be selected when “Mixed Original” is specified.
Application - Frame
Erase
Specify settings for the “Frame Erase” function. (p. 2-56)
Application - Center
Erase
When [Center Erase] appears and is able to be selected, Center
Erase can be specified.Saving documents
2
C550 2-20
Preview - View Status
Select whether or not to continue scanning.
Saving after previewing
The following procedure describes the operations performed after the document is positioned.
1 Position the document to be scanned.
2 Press the [Proof Copy] key.
3 Select the document orientation.
– When placed on the original glass
Item Description
[Finish] To continue scanning after the currently displayed original, make
sure that [Finish] is not selected.Saving documents
2
C550 2-21
– When loaded into the ADF
4 Press the [Start] key.
The document is scanned, and the Preview screen is displayed.
5 Check the preview image, and then rotate the image or change the settings, if necessary.Saving documents
2
C550 2-22
– To scan another document page, touch the View Status tab, touch
[Finish] to deselect it, and then position the other document page.
6 Press the [Start] key.
The transmission begins.
Using a user box destination
A destination where a user box has been registered is called a “user box destination”.
User box destinations are saved on the Address Book tab and are indicated
by “User Box” as the destination type. The following procedure describes
how to select a previously registered user box destination for saving data.
2
Note
If a user box destination is used, the document is automatically saved
with the default name.
1 Press the [Fax/Scan] key in the control panel.
The Fax/Scan mode screen appears.Saving documents
2
C550 2-23
2 Touch [Address Book].
The registered destinations are displayed.
3 Select the user box where the document is to be saved.
4 Specify the necessary scan settings and original settings.
– For details on the scan and document settings, refer to the User’s
Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
5 Load the document into the ADF or place it on the original glass.
6 If desired, press the [Proof Copy] key to check a preview image.
– For details, refer to “Saving after previewing” on page 2-20.
7 Press the [Start] key in the control panel.
The document is scanned and the data is saved.Saving documents
2
C550 2-24
Entering destinations directly
Using the control panel to directly type in the user box destination is called
“direct input”.
2
Note
If “Manual Destination Input” (displayed by touching [Security Settings]
on the Administrator Settings screen, then [Security Details]) is set to
“Restrict”, [Direct Input] does not appear.
1 Press the [Fax/Scan] key in the control panel.
The Fax/Scan mode screen appears.
2 Touch [Direct Input].
3 Touch [User Box].
The User Box screen appears.Saving documents
2
C550 2-25
4 Select the user box where the data is to be saved. Touch [User Box].
– To save the document in the Annotation User Box, touch [Scan Settings], then [Application], and then touch [Annotation] to select the
user box.
5 Touch the tab for the desired user box, and then select the user box.
– To type in a user box number to specify the user box, touch [Enter
User Box No.].
The button for the selected user box appears selected.Saving documents
2
C550 2-26
6 Check the name of the document to be saved. Touch [Document
Name].
– The default name appears beside “Document Name”. To change
the name, touch [Delete] until the characters are deleted, and then
type in the new name.
– To erase all of the text, press the [C] (clear) key.
7 Type in the document name, and then touch [OK].
8 Touch [OK].
The Direct Input tab appears again. The number of the specified user
box appears under “Broadcast Destinations”.
9 Specify the necessary scan settings and original settings.
– For details on the scan and document settings, refer to the User’s
Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
10 Load the document into the ADF or place it on the original glass.Saving documents
2
C550 2-27
11 If desired, press the [Proof Copy] key to check a preview image.
– For details, refer to “Saving after previewing” on page 2-20.
12 Press the [Start] key in the control panel.
2
Note
Only one user box destination can be specified with a single transmission, but multiple e-mail and fax destinations can be specified.
Saving in User Box mode
Press the [User Box] key in the control panel, and then directly type in the
user box destination. Documents to be saved can be used in the same way
as saved scan data.
1 Press the [User Box] key in the control panel.
The User Box Operations screen appears.
2 Touch [Save Document].Saving documents
2
C550 2-28
3 Touch the tab for the desired user box, and then select the user box.
– To save the document in the Annotation User Box, touch [System
User Box], and then touch [Annotation User Box] to select the user
box.
– To type in a user box number to specify the user box, touch [Enter
User Box No.].
The button for the selected user box appears selected.
4 Touch [OK].
The Save Document screen appears.
5 Check the name of the document to be saved. Touch [Document
Name].
– The default name appears beside “Document Name”. To change
the name, touch [Delete] until the characters are deleted, and then
type in the new name.
– To erase all of the text, press the [C] (clear) key.Saving documents
2
C550 2-29
6 Type in the document name, and then touch [OK].
7 Specify the necessary scan settings and original settings.
– For details on the scan and document settings, refer to “Specifying
scan settings” on page 2-39.
8 Load the document into the ADF or place it on the original glass.
9 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.
2
Note
Only one user box destination can be specified with a single transmission.
Saving on external memory from User Box mode
If the optional local interface kit is installed on this machine, external memory
can be connected for saving scanned documents.
!
Detail
The default setting for saving a document to external memory is “OFF”
(cannot be saved). In addition, the user setting is “OFF” (cannot be
saved), even if user authentication settings have been specified. To save
documents to external memory, change the settings in Administrator
mode so that documents can be saved. For details, refer to “External
Memory Function Settings” on page 7-27.
1 Press the [User Box] key in the control panel.
The User Box Operations screen appears.Saving documents
2
C550 2-30
2 Touch [Save Document].
3 Touch [System User Box], and then touch [External Memory].
4 Touch [OK].
5 Check the name of the document to be saved. Touch [Document
Name].Saving documents
2
C550 2-31
– The default name appears beside “Document Name”. To change
the name, touch [Delete] until the characters are deleted, and then
type in the new name.
– To erase all of the text, press the [C] (clear) key.
6 Type in the document name, and then touch [OK].
7 Specify the necessary scan and document settings.
– For details on the scan and document settings, refer to “Specifying
scan settings” on page 2-39.
8 Load the document into the ADF or place it on the original glass.
9 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.Saving documents
2
C550 2-32
2.5 Saving printouts in user boxes
If the printer driver for this machine is installed on a computer on the network,
the document can be saved in a user box with the same operation for printing
it.
!
Detail
The document can be saved in the following types of user boxes. The
user box number must be entered in order to save the document.
Public user boxes
Personal user boxes (when user authentication settings are specified)
Group user boxes (when account track settings are specified)
Annotation User Box
2
Note
To output the document after saving it to a user box and specifying ZFold for it, specify a paper size that supports Z-Fold when saving the
document.
The sizes that support Z-Fold are 8-1/2 × 14 w,11 × 17 w, A3 w, B4 w
and 8K w.Saving documents
2
C550 2-33
Saving data in a user box
1 In the application, click “Print” on the “File” menu.
2 Click the [Preferences] button beside the printer name.Saving documents
2
C550 2-34
3 From the “Output Method” list, select “Save in User Box” or “Save in
User Box/Print”.
4 In the User Settings dialog box, type the file name and box number,
and then click the [OK] button.Saving documents
2
C550 2-35
5 Click the [OK] button.
6 Click the [OK] button to start printing.
!
Detail
If user authentication and account track settings have been specified,
click the [Authentication/Account Track] button, and then type in the user
name for logging on and account information. For details, refer to the User’s Guide [Print Operations].Saving documents
2
C550 2-36
Saving data in the Secure Print User Box
1 In the application, click “Print” on the “File” menu.
2 Click the [Preferences] button beside the printer name.
3 From the “Output Method” list, select “Secure Print”.Saving documents
2
C550 2-37
4 In the User Settings dialog box, type the ID and password for the confidential document, and then click the [OK] button.
5 Click the [OK] button.
6 Click the [OK] button to start printing.Saving documents
2
C550 2-38
!
Detail
If user authentication and account track settings have been specified,
click the [Authentication/Account Track] button, and then type in the user
name for logging on and account information. For details, refer to the User’s Guide [Print Operations].
Saving data in the Encrypted PDF User Box
A command for saving a file in a user box cannot be specified from the printer’s Properties dialog box for a PDF file that requires a password to be entered in order for it to be opened. To print from this machine, the file must be
saved in the Encrypted PDF User Box.
The file can be saved in the Encrypted PDF User Box in either of the following
two ways.
- Saving from PageScope Direct Print
- Saving with direct printing from PageScope Web Connection
When printing an encrypted PDF file saved on external memory, select the
data in the External Memory screen, and then print it.
When printed, the encrypted PDF file on the external memory is saved in the
Encrypted PDF User Box on this machine. Access the Encrypted PDF User
Box on this machine, and then print the document.
!
Detail
For details on PageScope Direct Print, refer to the corresponding manual.
For details on printing a document saved in the Encrypted PDF User Box,
refer to “Encrypted PDF User Box” on page 6-21.Saving documents
2
C550 2-39
2.6 Specifying scan settings
The scan and document settings that can be specified when saving data in
User Box mode are described below.
Settings that can be specified
In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings] or [Original Settings] to
specify detailed settings for scanning and sending. Settings can be specified
for the following.
Scan Settings
Parameter Description Page reference
Original Type Select the quality of the document to be scanned. p. 2-40
Simplex/Duplex Select whether a single-sided or double-sided document is
to be scanned.
p. 2-42
Resolution Select the resolution for scanning. p. 2-43
File Type Select the file format for the scan data to be saved. p. 2-44
Density Select the density for scanning. p. 2-49
Separate Scan The scan operation can be divided into several sessions
when all pages of a document cannot be loaded into the
ADF or when placing the document on the original glass.
p. 2-50
Quality Adjustment Adjust the image quality, such as the background, color
and sharpness.
p. 2-50
Erase Specify settings for the “Erase” function. p. 2-56
Book Scan Set the “Book Copy” function. p. 2-58
Application Specify settings for the scan size. p. 2-60Saving documents
2
C550 2-40
Original Settings
Original Type
From the following five image quality settings, select the appropriate setting
according to the type of document being scanned.
If “Text/Photo” or “Photo” is selected, the photo type can also be selected.
Parameter Description Page reference
Mixed Original Select this setting when loading a document containing different page sizes.
p. 2-64
Z-Folded Original Select this setting when loading a zigzag-folded document. p. 2-64
Long Original Select this setting for documents that are longer than the
standard size.
p. 2-64
Original Direction Select the orientation of the loaded document. p. 2-64
Binding Position Select the binding position for the document. p. 2-64
Despeckle Select this setting to reduce the effect that dust on the left
partition glass has on images when the document is loaded
into the ADF.
p. 2-64
Setting Description
Text Select this setting for documents consisting only of text.
Text/Photo Select this setting for documents consisting of both text and photos (halftones).
Photo Select this setting for documents consisting of only photos (halftones).
Dot Matrix Original Select this setting for documents consisting of text that generally appears faint.
Copied Paper Select this setting for documents with an even density produced using a
copier or printer.Saving documents
2
C550 2-41
2
Note
The “Compact PDF” File Type setting and the “Text” or “Dot Matrix Original” Original Type settings cannot be selected at the same time.
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
2 Touch [Original Type].
3 Touch the button for the image quality.
Setting Description
Photo Paper Select this setting for photos printed on photo paper.
Printed Photo Select this setting for printed photos, such as in books or magazines.Saving documents
2
C550 2-42
4 If “Text/Photo”or “Photo” is selected, select the photo type, and then
touch [OK].
5 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.
Simplex/Duplex
Select whether a single-sided or double-sided document is to be scanned.
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
2 Touch [Simplex/Duplex].
Setting Description
1-Sided Select this setting to scan a single-sided document.
2-Sided Select this setting to scan a double-sided document.
Cover + 2-Sided Select this setting to scan the first page of the document as a singlesided cover page, then scan the remaining pages as double-sided.Saving documents
2
C550 2-43
3 Select the scanning type.
4 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.
Resolution
Select the resolution for scanning.
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
2 Touch [Resolution].Saving documents
2
C550 2-44
3 Select the resolution.
4 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.
File Type
Select the file format for saving the scan data. The following six file formats
are available.
File type
!
Detail
Even if the file type was selected when the document was saved in the
user box, it is necessary to specify the file type when the date is downloaded. For details, refer to the User’s Guide [PageScope Web Connection Operations].
If “JPEG” is selected, “Single Page” is automatically selected under
“Scan Setting”.
A compression method can be selected when saving a TIFF file in color.
For details, refer to the User’s Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
Setting Description
PDF Select this setting to save the data in the PDF format.
Compact PDF Select this setting to compress the data more than with the PDF format. This is used with full-color scan data.
TIFF Select this setting to save data in the TIFF format.
JPEG Select this setting to save the data in the JPEG format.
XPS Select this setting to save the data in the XPS format.
Compact XPS Select this setting to compress the data more than the XPS format
and save.Saving documents
2
C550 2-45
Some File Type settings may not be available, depending on the selected
Color setting. The possible combinations of the File Type and Color settings
are shown below.
If the “PDF” or “Compact PDF” File Type setting is selected, the encryption
level and stamp combination method can be specified.
Encryption settings
Detail Settings of Encryption
If document permissions are specified from the Encryption screen, detailed
permission settings can be specified.
In addition, the grouping of the saved data can be specified.
Scan Setting
Auto Color Full Color Gray Scale Black
PDF o o o o
Compact PDF o o o ×
TIFF o o o o
JPEG o o o ×
XPS o o o o
Compact XPS o o o ×
Parameter Description
Encryption Level Select the encryption level.
Password Enter the password necessary to open encrypted data. Type in a
password of 32 characters or less. For confirmation, type in the
password again.
Document Permissions Enter the password necessary to change document permissions.
Type in a password of 32 characters or less. For confirmation, type
in the password again.
Parameter Description
Printing Allowed Select whether or not to allow printing of the data. If “Encryption Level” is set to “High level”, “Low Resolution” appears.
Enable copying of text,
images and other content
Select whether or not to allow text and images to be extracted.
Change Allowed Select the permission level for document editing, such as signing,
entering text and annotating the data.Saving documents
2
C550 2-46
!
Detail
For details on specifying the Color setting, refer to “Color (Quality Adjustment)” on page 2-50.
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
2 Touch [File Type].
– Even if “Single Page” is selected when saving a document in a user
box, the document is saved in “Multi Page”. Pages can be specified
when downloading data to a computer.
– For details on downloading to a computer, refer to the User’s Guide
[PageScope Web Connection Operations].
3 Select the file format.
Setting Description
Single Page Select this setting to create a file in a format where the data for each
page can be saved when downloading.
Multi Page Select this setting to create a single file from the entire scanned document. This setting cannot be selected if the “JPEG” File Type setting is selected.Saving documents
2
C550 2-47
– When saving data in a user box, the file format must be specified,
even if the file format was selected before scanning.
4 If “PDF” or “Compact PDF” was selected, touch [Encryption], if necessary.
– The contents of a document saved with encryption cannot be previewed.Saving documents
2
C550 2-48
5 Specify the encryption settings.
6 Touch [OK].
7 Select the scan setting.
8 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Saving documents
2
C550 2-49
Density
Adjust the density for scanning.
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
2 Touch [Density].
3 Select the density.
– To adjust the density, touch [Light] or [Dark].
– To select the default setting, touch [Standard].
4 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Saving documents
2
C550 2-50
Separate Scan
The scan operation can be divided into several sessions for various types of
documents, for example, when all pages of a document cannot be loaded
into the ADF, when placing the document on the original glass, or when single-sided documents are combined with double-sided documents.
Touch [Separate Scan]. The setting is selected when the button appears selected.
Color (Quality Adjustment)
Select whether the document will be scanned in color or black and white.
The following four settings are available.
Some Color settings may not be available, depending on the selected File
Type setting. The possible combinations of the Color and File Type settings
are shown below.
Setting Description
Auto Color Select this setting to automatically detect the color of the document
and scan it with the corresponding setting.
Full Color Select this setting to scan in full color.
Gray Scale Select this setting for documents with many halftones, such as in
black-and-white photos.
Black Select this setting for documents with distinct black and white areas,
such as in line drawings.Saving documents
2
C550 2-51
!
Detail
For details on specifying the File Type setting, refer to “File Type” on
page 2-44.
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
2 Touch [Quality Adjustment].
Auto Color Full Color Gray Scale Black
PDF o o o o
Compact PDF o o o ×
TIFF o o o o
JPEG o o o ×
XPS o o o o
Compact XPS o o o ×Saving documents
2
C550 2-52
3 Select the color type.
4 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.
Background Adjustment (Quality Adjustment)
The scanning density of the document background can be adjusted. When
documents printed on colored paper are scanned in color, the background
may become black. In that case, the density of the background can be adjusted.
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
2 Touch [Quality Adjustment].Saving documents
2
C550 2-53
3 Touch [Background Removal].
4 Adjust the density of the background.
– To adjust the density automatically, touch [Auto].
– To adjust the density, touch [Light] or [Dark].
– To select the default setting, touch [Standard].
5 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Saving documents
2
C550 2-54
Sharpness (Quality Adjustment)
Contours, for example, the edges of text, can be emphasized when scanning.
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
2 Touch [Quality Adjustment].
3 Touch [Sharpness].Saving documents
2
C550 2-55
4 Adjust the sharpness.
5 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Saving documents
2
C550 2-56
Frame Erase (Erase)
An area around the edge of the document can be erased. Areas with a width
between 1/16 and 2 inches on the North American (inch) model (between 0.1
and 50.0 mm on the European (metric) model) can be specified separately for
the left and right sides and the top and bottom.
!
Detail
If a width to be erased around the document is specified with “Frame
Erase” with the “Book Copy” function, the same settings are also applied
on the Frame Erase screen (displayed from the Erase screen).
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
2 Touch [Erase].
3 Touch [Frame Erase].Saving documents
2
C550 2-57
4 Select the width of the area to be erased.
– To use frame erasing, touch [Yes].
– To erase the same width on all sides, touch [Frame], and then specify a value.
– To specify different widths for the top, left, right and bottom, touch
the button for the desired location, and then specify a value. To
cancel frame erasing, touch [None].
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
5 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next two screens that appear.Saving documents
2
C550 2-58
Book Copy (Book Scan)
Select the method for scanning page spreads. The following four scanning
methods are available. In addition, the binding position and erase settings
can be specified.
2
Note
Specify the size of the page spread as the scan size.
The document can be scanned while erasing the shadows typical for page
spreads.
2
Note
If a width to be erased around the document is specified with “Frame
Erase” with the “Book Copy” function, the same settings are also applied
on the Frame Erase screen (displayed from the Erase screen).
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
Setting Description
Book Spread Select this setting to scan a page spread as a single page.
Separation Select this setting to scan a page spread as two separate pages (left
and right).
Front Cover Select this setting to scan the first page as the front cover.
Front + Back Covers Select this setting to scan the first page as the front cover, the second page as the back cover, and the remaining pages as the body.
Parameter Description
Frame Erase An area around the edge of the document can be erased. Areas with
a width between 1/16 and 2 inches on the North American (inch)
model (between 0.1 and 50.0 mm on the European (metric) model)
can be specified separately for the left and right sides and the top
and bottom.
Center Erase An area along the center of the document can be erased. An area
with a width between 1/16 and 1-3/16 inches on the North American
(inch) model (between 0.1 and 30.0 mm on the European (metric)
model) can be specified.Saving documents
2
C550 2-59
2 Touch [Book Scan].
3 Touch [Book Copy].
4 Specify the settings for the “Book Copy” function.Saving documents
2
C550 2-60
– If “Separation”, “Front Cover” or “Front + Back Covers” was selected, touch [Binding Position], and then select the binding position.
5 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next two screens that appear.
Scan Size (Application)
Select the size of paper that is to be scanned.
The following Scan Size settings are available.
2
Note
If the “Book Copy” function was set, specify the size of the page spread.
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Scan Settings].
Setting Description
Auto Select this setting to detect the size of the first page in the loaded
document.
Standard sizes Select a preset paper size (such as A4 or B5) and orientation.
Custom Size Type in the dimensions of a custom size that is not available as a preset size. The size in the X direction can be set between 2 and 17
inches on the North American (inch) model (30.0 and 432.0 mm on
the European (metric) model), and the size in the Y direction can be
set between 2 and 17 inches on the North American (inch) model
(30.0 and 297.0 mm on the European (metric) model).
Photo Size On the North American (inch) model, 3 × 5 or 2-1/4 × 3-1/4 can be
selected.
On the European (metric) model, 13 × 18, 10 × 15 or 9 × 13 can be
selected.Saving documents
2
C550 2-61
2 Touch [Application].
3 Touch [Scan Size].
4 Select the desired size and orientation.
– On the North American (inch) model:Saving documents
2
C550 2-62
– On the European (metric) model:
– Select the orientation and size of the paper to be scanned.
– Touching [Custom Size] displays the Custom Size screen. Use the
keypad to type in the size, and then touch [OK].
– The values can be specified in 1/16-inch increments on the North
American (inch) model (in 0.1 mm increments on the European
(metric) model).
– On the North American (inch) model:Saving documents
2
C550 2-63
– On the European (metric) model:
– Touching [Photo Size] displays the Photo Size screen. Select the
orientation and size of the photo to be scanned, and then touch
[OK].
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
5 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next two screens that appear.Saving documents
2
C550 2-64
Original Settings
Specify the type of document that is loaded, for example, if it contains mixed
page sizes or is folded in a zigzag.
2
Note
The original settings and direction settings can be used together.
1 In the Save Document screen, touch [Original Settings].
2 Select settings for the Original Settings functions.
Parameter Description
Mixed Original Select this setting when documents of different sizes are loaded into
the ADF (optional). The scan speed is decreased since the size of
each page is detected before it is scanned.
Z-Folded Original Select this setting to detect the size of a zigzag-folded document by
the length fed through the ADF.
Long Original Select this setting for documents that are longer than the standard
size.
Original Direction Select the orientation of the document. After the document is
scanned, the data is processed so that it is correctly oriented.
Binding Position Select the binding position, such as when holes are punched in the
document or the document is stapled.
This adjusts the scan of double-sided documents so that the binding
position is not reversed.
Left Select this setting for a document with binding on the left side.
Top Select this setting for a document with binding at the top.
Auto: The binding is on the long side if the page is 297 mm or less,
or it is on the short side if the page is more than 297 mm.
Despeckle Select this setting to reduce the effect that dust on the left partition
glass has on images when the document is loaded into the ADF.Saving documents
2
C550 2-65
– Touching [Original Direction] displays the Original Direction screen.
Touch the button for the desired orientation, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Binding Position] displays the Binding Position screen.
Touch the button for the binding position, and then touch [OK].
– To apply the “Despeckle” setting, touch [Despeckle] to select it.
3 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Saving documents
2
C550 2-66
!
Detail
The scanning speed will be reduced if the “Despeckle” setting is selected.
Clean the left partition glass when it becomes extremely dirty. For details,
refer to the User’s Guide [Copy Operations].Saving documents
2
C550 2-67
2.7 Display and operation of the left panel
In the left panel of the touch panel, job status and settings can be displayed
using the keys. The followings are the keys appear in the left panal in User
Box mode.
Job List
Queued operation, such as saving document data to a user box and printing/
sending documents, is called a job. Touch [Job List] to display the jobs being
processed.
1
2
3
No. Part Name Description
1 [Job List] Jobs that are being processed and the job
history can be checked.
2 [Check Job] Information on the selected user box, scan,
printing and transmission settings of documents can be checked.
3 [Preview] Saved document image can be previewed.Saving documents
2
C550 2-68
Job List - Delete
Jobs being processed can be deleted from the list to cancel the job. Select
the job from the job list, and then touch [Delete]. Check the message that appears, and then delete the job.
!
Detail
With documents containing multiple pages, an image for each page can
be checked.
Job List - Job Details
Jobs that are being processed and the job history can be viewed from the
Job List screens. Jobs are classified into the following three categories:
Name Description
[Print] Lists print jobs for copying, computer printing, and received faxes.
[Send] Lists fax and scanner transmission jobs.
[Save] Lists jobs for saving documents in user boxes.Saving documents
2
C550 2-69
2
Note
If the optional fax kit has been installed, the Receive tab appears.
Current Jobs in Print page
!
Detail
If user authentication settings have been applied, the document name is
not accessible from other users.
Document names do not appear on the screen for secured documents.
If Change Job Priority in Administrator mode is set to “Restrict”, the print
job priority control is not available.
If Change Job Priority is set to ON, touching this softkey interrupts the
printing job for the given priority. The interrupted job is automatically
printed once the given priority job is finished.
Item Description
List items No.: Job identification number assigned when the job is queued.
User Name: User or account name who queued the job.
Status: Job status (Receiving, PrintWait, Printing, StopPrint, Print Err, Job Stored)
Document Name: File name to be printed.
Time Stored: Time when the job is queued.
Org.: The number of original pages.
Copies: The number of copies to be printed.
[↑] [↓] Touch them when there are more jobs than seven that can be displayed at one
time, to switch the pages.
[Delete] Deletes the selected job.
[Increase
Priority]
Allows to change printing job priority.
[Release
Held Jobs]
Allows to change settings of a stored job, or print or delete the job.
[Check Job
Set.]
Allows to view the settings of the selected job. To check, touch either [← Back] or
[Forward →].
[Detail] Displays the job status, user name, document name, output tray, queued time, the
number of original pages, and the number of copies to be printed. Touch [Delete]
to delete the job.Saving documents
2
C550 2-70
Job History in Print page
!
Detail
If user authentication settings have been applied, the document name is
not accessible from other users.
Document names do not appear on the screen for secured documents.
Current Jobs in Send page
Item Description
List items No.: Job identification number assigned when the job is queued.
User Name: User or account name who queued the job.
Document Name: File name to be printed.
Time Stored: Time when the job is queued.
Org.: The number of originals.
Copies: The number of copies to be printed.
Result: Result of a job (Job Complete, Deleted Due To Error, Deleted by User, Reset Modes).
[↑] [↓] Touch them when there are more jobs than seven that can be displayed at one
time, to switch the pages.
[Deleted
Jobs]/[Finished
Jobs]/[All
Jobs]
Touch the softkey to display each category of job.
[Detail] Displays the results of the job, error details, user name, document name, output
tray, queued time, completed time, the number of original pages, and the number
of copies to be printed.
Item Description
List items No.: Job identification number assigned when the job is queued.
Address Type: Type of the terminal receiving data (Fax, E-Mail, FTP, PC (SMB),
WebDAV, TWAIN, others).
Status: Job status (Transferring, Waiting, Dialing, Waiting To Redial)
Address: Fax number, E-mail address and user box name of the recipient.
Time Stored: Time when the job is queued.
Org.: The number of original pages.
[↑] [↓] Touch them when there are more jobs than seven that can be displayed at one
time, to switch the pages.
[Timer TX
Job]
Displays the status of the reserved transmission in the memory. Touch [Delete] to
delete the job.
[L1][L2] These softkeys appear if the optional fax multi line has been installed. Displays the
list of the selected line.
[Delete] Deletes the selected job.
[Redial] Select the job marked “Waiting To Redial” status for redialing.
[Check Job
Set.]
Allows to view the settings of the selected job. To check, touch either [← Back] or
[Forward →].Saving documents
2
C550 2-71
!
Detail
If user authentication settings have been applied, the document name is
not accessible from other users.
Document names do not appear on the screen for secured documents.
“TWAIN” is indicated for jobs sent by the Web service.
The external server information in [Detail] is available only if the external
server authentication is applied.
Job History in Send page
[Detail] Displays the job status, user name, document name, destination type, destination,
queued time, transmission time, the number of original pages, and external server
information. Touch [Delete] to delete the job.
Item Description
Item Description
List items No.: Job identification number assigned when the job is queued.
Address Type: Type of the terminal receiving data (Fax, E-Mail, FTP, PC (SMB),
WebDAV, TWAIN, others).
Address: Fax number, E-mail address and user box name of the recipient.
Time Stored: Time when the job is queued.
Org.: The number of original pages.
Result: Result of a job (Job Complete/Deleted Due To Error/Deleted by User).
[↑] [↓] Touch them when there are more jobs than seven that can be displayed at one
time, to switch the pages.
[Deleted
Jobs]/[Finished
Jobs]/[All
Jobs]
Touch the softkey to display each category of job.
[Comm.
List]
Displays the Scan list, Fax TX list, and Fax RX list. At each list screen, the activity
report, TX report, and RX report can be printed.
[Detail] Displays the job results, error details, user name, document name, destination
type, queued time, transmission time, the number of original pages, and external
server information.Saving documents
2
C550 2-72
!
Detail
If user authentication settings have been applied, the document name is
not accessible from other users.
Document names do not appear on the screen for secured documents.
“TWAIN” is indicated for jobs sent by the Web service.
The external server information in [Detail] is available only if the external
server authentication is applied.
Current Jobs in Receive page
The Receive tab appears only when the optional fax kit has been installed.
For details on the contents of the tab, refer to the User’s Guide [Fax Operations].
Job History in Receive page
The Receive tab appears only when the optional fax kit has been installed.
For details on the contents of the tab, refer to the User’s Guide [Fax Operations].
Current Jobs in Save page
!
Detail
If user authentication settings have been applied, the document name is
not accessible from other users.
Document names do not appear on the screen for secured documents.
Item Description
List items No.: Job identification number assigned when the job is queued.
User Name: User or account name who queued the job.
Status: Job status (Receiving, Saving to Memory).
Document Name: Displays the name of the saved document.
Time Stored: Time when the job is queued.
Org.: The number of original pages.
[↑] [↓] Touch them when there are more jobs than seven that can be displayed at one
time, to switch the pages.
[Delete] Deletes the selected job.
[Detail] Displays the job status, user name, document name, user box, queued time, and
the number of original pages. Touch [Delete] to delete the job.Saving documents
2
C550 2-73
Job History in Save page
!
Detail
If user authentication settings have been applied, the document name is
not accessible from other users.
Document names do not appear on the screen for secured documents.
Settings when saving documents
When [Save Document] is selected, the information of the user box where the
document is to be saved is displayed.
Item Description
List items No.: Job identification number assigned when the job is queued.
User Name: User or account name who queued the job.
Document Name: Displays the name of the saved document.
Time Stored: Time when the job is queued.
Org.: The number of originals.
Result: Result of a job (Job Complete/Deleted Due To Error/Deleted by User/Reset Modes).
[↑] [↓] Touch them when there are more jobs than seven that can be displayed at one
time, to switch the pages.
[Deleted
Jobs]/[Finished
Jobs]/[All
Jobs]
Touch the softkey to display each category of job.
[Comm.
List]
Displays the Scan list, Fax TX list, and Fax RX list. At each list screen, the activity
report, TX report, and RX report can be printed.
[Detail] Displays the job result, error details, user name, document name, user box,
queued time, and the number of original pages.Saving documents
2
C550 2-74
When saving a document, select “Scan Settings” or “Original Settings”. [Details] appears. Touch [Detail] to view scan settings and original settings.
Detail - Check Scan Settings
The basic scan setting, scan settings, and application settings can be
checked. To check, touch either [← Back] or [Forward →].Saving documents
2
C550 2-75
Detail - Check Original Settings
The original settings can be checked.
Settings when using documents
When [Use Document] is selected, information of the selected user box is
displayed.Saving documents
2
C550 2-76
Detail
Touch [Document Details] in the Use Document screen to view the Registerd
Time/User Name/Document Name/the No. of Pages/Job No. Touch [Preview] to view the preview image of the saved document.
When multiple documents are selected, switch the preview page by touching
[↑] [↓].
2
Note
For the procedure on viewing preview image, refer to “Preview” on
page 2-78.
Check Job Settings
When [Send] or [Bind TX] is selected on the Use Document screen, [Check
Job Settings] appears.
Touch [Check Job Settings] to check the following settings:
- Destination Settings
- E-Mail SettingsSaving documents
2
C550 2-77
Check Job Settings - Destination Settings
This screen displays the list of registered destinations.
- To add a destination to the address book, touch [Store Address].
- To view the details of the destination on the screen, select the destination
and touch [Details].
- To delete a destination, select the destination and touch [Delete].
!
Detail
For details on address book registration, refer to the User’s Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
Check Job Settings - E-Mail Settings
The document name, subject, From address and message body for sending
e-mail messages can be checked.Saving documents
2
C550 2-78
Preview
When Use Document or File Document is selected, the image of the saved
document can be previewed.
Touch [Preview] to display the thumbnail image of the top page in the left
panel.
!
Detail
With the documents containing multiple pages, only the image of the first
page can be checked.
The contents of a document saved with encryption cannot be previewed.Saving documents
2
C550 2-79
Preview - Detail
To enlarge the preview image, touch [Detail].
The document can be viewed at full size or at a size of 2, 4 or 8 times the
normal size. Select the display size, and use the scroll bars in the right end
and bottom end of the image to view the desired section of the image.
Preview - Detail (Print/Combine)
When [Print] or [Combine] is selected while using documents, by touching
[Detail], the page image of printing result can be previewed.
!
Detail
With documents containing multiple pages, an image for each page can
be checked.Saving documents
2
C550 2-80
2
Note
When selecting on the page directly, the image of the selected page is
rotated by 180 degrees.
Preview - Detail (Send/Bind TX)
If [Send] or [Bind TX] is selected when using documents, by touching [Detail],
the result of the page image to be sent can be previewed.
Item Description
[Prev. Page]/[Next Page] If stored document contains multiple pages, touch [Prev. Page]/
[Next Page] to move to the previous/next page on the preview
image.
Zoom The document can be viewed at full size or at a size of 2, 4 or 8 times
the normal size. Select the display size, and use the scroll bars in the
right end and bottom end of the image to view the desired section of
the image.
Page Rotation [Rotate current page]: Touch this key to rotate the page currently
displayed by 180 degrees.
[Select page(s) to rotate]: This key appears when the stored document contains multiple pages. List of scanned pages appears. Select the desired page to rotate by 180 degrees. The rotation options
in the list of scanned page are as follows:
[Select Odd]: Rotates the images for odd number of pages by 180
degrees.
[Select Even]: Rotates the images for even number of pages by 180
degrees.
[Select All]: Rotates the images for all of pages by 180 degrees.
[View Finishing] Touch this key to display the specified settings in the preview image
by icons and text. When [View Finishing] is cancelled, the only image
is displayed without icons or text.Saving documents
2
C550 2-81
2
Note
When selecting on the page directly, the image of the selected page is
rotated by 180 degrees.
Item Description
[Scan] This button appears if the optional fax kit has been installed. Touch
this key to display the preview for [E-mail TX], [PC (FTP)], [SMB], and
[WebDAV].
[Fax] This button appears if the optional fax kit has been installed. Touch
this key to display the preview for sending G3 fax/IP address fax/
Internet fax.
[Prev. Page]/[Next Page] If stored document contains multiple pages, touch [Prev. Page]/
[Next Page] to move to the previous/next page on the preview
image.
Zoom The document can be viewed at full size or at a size of 2, 4 or 8 times
the normal size. Select the display size, and use the scroll bars in the
right end and bottom end of the image to view the desired section of
the image.
Page Rotation [Rotate current page]: Touch this key to rotate the page currently
displayed by 180 degrees.
[Select page(s) to rotate]: This key appears when the stored
document contains multiple pages. List of scanned pages appears.
Select the desired page to rotate by 180 degrees. The rotation
options in the list of scanned page are as follows:
[Select Odd]: Rotates the images for odd number of pages by 180
degrees.
[Select Even]: Rotates the images for even number of pages by 180
degrees.
[Select All]: Rotates the images for all of pages by 180 degrees.
[View Finishing] Touch this key to display the specified settings in the preview image
by icons and text. When [View Finishing] is cancelled, the image only
is displayed without icons or text.3 Organizing user box
documentsOrganizing user box documents
3
C550 3-2
3 Organizing user box documents
3.1 Overview of document organizing
Available operations in the File Document screen
The following operations can be performed from the File Document screen.
From the File Document screen, documents in the following user boxes can
be organized. The operations that can be performed with some user boxes
may be limited. The limitations on the operations are shown below.
!
Detail
Documents can be moved or copied between public user boxes, personal user boxes and group user boxes.
When organizing documents in the Secure Print User Box, the ID and
password for the confidential document must be entered.
Operation Description Page reference
Delete Data that is no longer needed, for example, documents that
have already been printed or transmitted, can be deleted.
p. 3-8
Edit Name The name of a saved document can be changed. p. 3-10
Move Document data that is currently saved in a user box can be
moved to a different public user box/personal user box/
group user box.
p. 3-12
Copy Document data currently saved in a user box can be copied
to a different public user box/personal user box/group user
box.
p. 3-14
Document Details The date and time when the document was saved and a preview image can be checked.
p. 3-16
Public/personal/
group user boxes
Annotation User Box Secure Print User
Box
Delete o o o
Edit Name o o o
Move o × ×
Copy o × ×
Document Details o o oOrganizing user box documents
3
C550 3-3
Checking documents saved in user boxes
The following procedure describes how to check the list of documents saved
in a user box.
1 Press the [User Box] key
in the control panel.
2 Touch [File Document].
3 From the Public, Personal or Group tab, touch the button for the desired user box.
– The Personal tab displays only user boxes registered to the user
that is logged on with user authentication.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-4
– The Group tab displays only user boxes for the account that the
user belongs to when account track settings are specified.
4 Touch [OK].
5 If a password has been set for the user box, type in the password, and
then touch [OK].Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-5
The list of documents saved in the user box is displayed.
2
Note
If “Prohibited Functions When Authentication Error” in Administrator
mode is set to “Mode 2” and a user enters an incorrect bpx password the
specified number of times, that box is locked and can no longer be used.
Contact the administrator to cancel operation restrictions.
Description of File Document screen
As a default, thumbnails of the saved documents and the document names
are displayed. The following information is displayed.
To check various information, such as the date/time when the document was
stored and the document name, touch [Detail View].
A
thumbnail
of the first
page is
displayed.
The
document
name is
displayed.
The number of pages is displayed.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-6
Searching for a user box name
The desired user box can be searched for by its name.
1 From the screen containing a list of the user boxes, touch [Search User
Box].
The date/time when the document was stored is displayed.
Touch to switch between displaying the list in ascending or
descending order.
The name of the user who stored the
document and the mode when the
document was registered are displayed.
The
document
name is
displayed.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-7
2 The user boxes for each index character appear.
3 Touch the button for an index character to display the list of user boxes
registered with that index character.
!
Detail
A user box name can be searched for from the Save Document screen,
Use Document screen or File Document screen.
The personal user boxes and group user boxes that can be accessed
when a user is logged on are also displayed.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-8
3.2 Deleting a document
From the File Document screen, documents that are no longer needed, for
example, documents that have already been printed, can be deleted.
1 From the File Document screen, select the document to be deleted.
– Multiple documents can be selected.
– To select all documents, touch [Select All].
– To cancel the selection of all documents, touch [Reset].
2 Touch [Delete].Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-9
3 Check the document information that appeared, touch [Yes], and then
touch [OK] to delete the document.
The documents are deleted.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-10
3.3 Changing the document name
The name of a saved document can be changed.
1 From the File Document screen, select the document to be renamed.
– A name cannot be changed if multiple documents are selected.
2 Touch [Edit Name].Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-11
3 The current name appears. Type in the new name.
4 Touch [Start].
2
Note
The document name is the name of the file sent by e-mail or to an FTP,
SMB or WebDAV server. Specify a document name according to the conditions of the destination server when transmitting.
The document name can also be changed when the document is transmitted.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-12
3.4 Moving a document
Document data that is currently saved in a user box can be moved to a different public user box/personal user box/group user box.
2
Note
A document cannot be moved if multiple documents are selected.
1 From the File Document screen, select the document to be moved.
2 Touch [Move].Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-13
3 Specify the user box where the document is to be moved.
?
Is a password required for moving data to a different user box?
% It is not necessary to enter the password when moving data to a different user box, even if a password has been specified for the box.
4 Check the information, and then touch [Start].
The data is moved, and a message appears, indicating that the operation was completed.
5 Touch [OK].
2
Note
The date and time that the document was moved is recorded under
“Time Stored”.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-14
3.5 Duplicating a document
Document data that is currently saved in a user box can be copied to a different public user box/personal user box/group user box.
2
Note
A document cannot be copied if multiple documents are selected.
1 From the File Document screen, select the document to be copied.
2 Touch [Copy].Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-15
3 Specify the user box where the document is to be copied.
?
Is a password required for copying data to a different user box?
% It is not necessary to enter the password when copying data to a
different user box, even if a password has been specified for the
box.
4 Check the information, and then touch [Start].
The data is copied, and a message appears, indicating that the operation was completed.
5 Touch [OK].
2
Note
The date and time that the document was copied is recorded under
“Time Stored”.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-16
3.6 Checking document details
The details of saved documents can be checked from the touch panel.
The following information can be checked from the Document Details
screen.
!
Detail
The preview screen can be displayed by touching a button in the sub display area or by touching a button in the Document Details screen.
Item Description
Registered
Time
Displays the date and time that the document was stored.
User Name Displays the mode (Scan, Copy or Print) and name of the user who stored the
document.
Document
Name
Displays the name of the document.
No. of Pages Displays the number of pages in the document.
Job No. Displays the job number when the document was stored.
[Preview] button
Touch this button to display the Enlarged Thumbnail View screen. For details,
refer to “Preview screen operations” on page 3-19.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-17
Check the details
2
Note
Multiple documents can be selected.
1 From the File Document screen, select the document to be checked.
2 Touch [Document Details].
The Document Details screen appears.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-18
3 Check the details of the document.
– To select multiple documents, touch [↑] and [↓] to display different
screens.
– To display the preview, touch [Preview].
– To perform the operation from the sub display area, touch [Preview]
in the sub display area, and then touch [Detail].
4 After checking the document, touch [Close].Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-19
Preview screen operations
Touching [Enlarged Thumbnail View] in the Document Details screen displays the Enlarged Thumbnail View screen. The image can be viewed at full
size or at a size of 2, 4 or 8 times the normal size. The procedure for checking
the image at a size of 4 times the normal size is described below.
!
Detail
With documents containing multiple pages, only the image of the first
page can be checked.
The contents of a document saved with encryption cannot be previewed.
1 The image is displayed at full size in the Enlarged Thumbnail View
screen. Touch [ ] twice.
The image is displayed at a size 4 times the normal size.Organizing user box documents
3
C550 3-20
2 To select a different area to be enlarged, touch the scroll bar arrows on
the right side and at the bottom of the image.
– When the selection is moved to the right:
– When the selection is moved down:
3 After checking the image, touch [Close].4 Printing a user box
documentPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-2
4 Printing a user box document
4.1 Overview of document printing
Available operations in the Use Document screen
The following operations can be performed from the Use Document screen.
From the Use Document screen, documents in the following user boxes can
be printed and transmitted. The operations that can be performed with some
user boxes may be limited. The limitations on the operations are shown below.
Operation Description Page reference
Print Documents saved in user boxes in Copy mode,
Fax/Scan mode or Print mode can be printed. Finishing settings, such as the number of copies and
double-sided printing, can be added when the document is printed.
p. 4-6
Send Documents saved in user boxes in Fax/Scan mode
or Print mode can be sent by e-mail. Finishing and
transmission settings can be added when the document is transmitted.
p. 5-24
Combine Multiple documents within the same user box can
be combined and printed. Finishing settings, such
as the number of copies and double-sided printing,
can be added when the document is printed.
p. 4-66
Bind TX Multiple documents within the same user box can
be combined and transmitted. Finishing and transmission settings can be added when the document
is transmitted.
p. 5-52
Document Details The date and time when the document was saved
and a preview image can be checked.
p. 3-16
Public/personal/group user
boxes
Annotation
User Box
Secure Print
User Box
Encrypted PDF
User Box
Print o o o o
Send o o × ×
Combine o × × ×
Bind TX o × × ×
Document Details o o o oPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-3
Checking documents saved in user boxes
The following procedure describes how to check the list of documents saved
in a user box.
1 Press the [User Box] key
in the control panel.
2 Touch [Use Document].
3 From the Public, Personal or Group tab, touch the button for the desired user box.
– The Personal tab displays only user boxes registered to the user
that is logged on with user authentication.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-4
– The Group tab displays only user boxes for the account that the
user belongs to when account track settings are specified.
4 Touch [OK].
5 If a password has been set for the user box, type in the password, and
then touch [OK].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-5
The list of documents saved in the user box is displayed.
2
Note
If “Prohibited Functions When Authentication Error” in Administrator
mode is set to “Mode 2” and a user enters an incorrect box password the
specified number of times, that box is locked and can no longer be used.
Contact the administrator to cancel operation restrictions.
Description of Use Document screen
The documents are displayed on the Use Document screen in the same way
that they are displayed on the File Document screen. For details, refer to “Description of File Document screen” on page 3-5.
Searching for a user box name
For details on searching for a user box name, refer to “Searching for a user
box name” on page 3-6.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-6
4.2 Printing
Available print settings
Settings can be specified for the following when a document is printed.
!
Detail
The Fold/Bind settings are available only if optional finisher FS-608 is installed.
The Z-Fold setting is available only if the Z-folding unit is installed on the
optional finisher FS-608/FS-517/FS-518.
The Punch settings are available only if the punch kit is installed on the
optional finisher.
For details on combining multiple documents and printing, refer to “Combined printing” on page 4-66.
Available parameters Description Page reference
Copies Specify the number of copies to be printed. p. 4-8
Print Select whether a single-sided or double-sided
copy is to be printed.
p. 4-8
Finishing Specify settings for collating, grouping, stapling,
hole punching or folding/binding.
p. 4-9
Page Margin Print the document with a binding margin added. p. 4-16
Sheet/Cover/Chapter
Insert
Print the document with other paper added as cover sheets, insertions or chapter title pages.
p. 4-19
Stamp/Composition Print the document with the date/time, page
number or a stamp added.
p. 4-33Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-7
To print a document
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be printed.
2 Under “Action”, touch [Print].
3 Select the print settings.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-8
4 If desired, touch [Preview], then [Details] on the left side of the screen
to check a preview image.
– For details on the Preview screen, refer to “Preview - Detail (Print/
Combine)” on page 2-79.
5 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.
!
Detail
For details on changing the settings, refer to the descriptions starting with
page 4-8.
Changing the number of copies
Specify the number of copies to be printed.
% In the Print screen, use the keypad to type in the desired number of
copies.
– The number of copies can be set between 1 and 9,999.
– To reset the number of copies to “1”, press the [C] (clear) key.
Specifying single-sided/double-sided printing
Select whether a single-sided or double-sided copy of the document is to be
printed.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-9
% Touch [1-Sided] or [2-Sided].
Specifying Finishing settings
Specify settings for collating, grouping, stapling, hole punching or folding/
binding. Settings can be specified for the following.
Parameter Description
Sort Select this setting to feed out copies of the document by sets.
Group Select this setting to feed out copies of the document by page.
Offset Select this setting to separate the sets or pages of the copies.
If a finisher is installed, the printed pages are fed out with each set
shifted to separate it.
If no finisher is installed, the printed pages are fed out sorted in an
alternating crisscross pattern.
Staple Select one of these settings to bind copies with a staple in the corner
(upper left or upper right) or with two staples. The stapling position
can also be selected.
Punch Select a setting to punch holes in copies. The position of the
punched holes can also be selected.
Half-Fold (Fold/Bind): Select this setting to fold copies in half before feeding them out.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-10
Center Staple & Fold
(Fold/Bind):
Select this setting to staple copies at two places along the center,
then fold the copies in half before feeding them out.
Tri-fold (Fold/Bind): Select this setting to fold copies in three before feeding them out.
Z-Fold
(Fold/Bind: When FS-
608 is installed)
(Fold: When FS-517/FS-
518 is installed)
Select this setting to fold copies in half along the center, and additionally mountainfold one of the halves before feeding them out.
Parameter DescriptionPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-11
!
Detail
The feeding method when a finisher is installed can be changed from Administrator mode. For details on the Finishing settings, refer to the User’s
Guide [Copy Operations].
When a Fold/Bind setting is selected, “Sort” is automatically selected,
and the “Group”, Offset, Staple and Punch settings are canceled.
In order to carry out the Z-fold finishing process, the Z-folding unit must
be installed on the optional finisher FS-608/FS-517/FS-518.
The printouts are Z-folded only when the loaded size of the saved document supports Z-Fold (8-1/2 × 14 w,11 × 17 w, A3 w, B4 w or 8K w).
2
Reminder
In order to select a Fold/Bind setting, all of the following conditions must
be met.
The paper width must be between 7-3/16 and 12-1/4 inches on the North
American (inch) model (between 182 and 314 mm on the European (metric) model).
The paper length must be between 10-1/8 and 18 inches on the North
American (inch) model (between 257 and 458 mm on the European (metric) model).
In order to use a Fold/Bind setting, optional finisher FS-608 must be installed.
1 In the Print screen, touch [Finishing].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-12
2 Touch [Sort] or [Group]. To separate the copies, touch [Yes] under “Offset”.
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
3 Select the desired Staple and Punch settings.
– On the North American (inch) model:Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-13
– On the European (metric) model:
4 To specify the positions of the staples and punched holes, touch [Position Setting].
5 Touch the button for the desired position, and then touch [OK].
– When the “Corner” Staple setting is selected:Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-14
– When the “2 Position” Staple setting is selected:
– When a Punch setting is selected:
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
6 If finisher FS-608 is installed, touch [Fold/Bind]. If finisher FS-517/FS-
518 is installed, touch [Fold].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-15
7 Touch [Yes], and then select the desired folding method.
– If finisher FS-608 is installed
– If finisher FS-517/FS-518 is installed
8 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-16
Adding a binding margin
A binding margin can be added to the left or right side or to the top of the
printed pages. Settings can be specified for the following.
1 In the Print screen, touch [Page Margin].
2 Touch [Yes].
3 Select the desired position for the binding margin, and then use the
keypad to specify the width of the binding margin.
– The width of the binding margin can be specified in 1/16-inch increments on the North American (inch) model (in 0.1 mm increments
on the European (metric) model).
– To set the binding margin to 0 mm, touch [None].
Parameter Description
Margin Position Select the location where the binding margin is to be added. If “Auto” is selected, a binding margin along the long side of the paper is
selected if the document length is less than 11-11/16 inches on the
North American (inch) model (less than 297 mm on the European
(metric) model). If the document length is more than 11-11/16 inches
on the North American (inch) model (more than 297 mm on the European (metric) model), a binding margin along the short side of the
paper is selected.
Adjust Value An area with a width between 1/16 and 3/4 inches on the North
American (inch) model (between 0.1 and 20.0 mm on the European
(metric) model) can be specified. To specify a binding margin of 0
mm, touch [None].
Image Shift When a binding margin is created, the image can be shifted according to the position of the created binding margin. The image can be
shifted between 1/16 and 10 inches on the North American (inch)
model (between 0.1 and 250 mm on the European (metric) model)
left, right, up or down, depending on the position of the binding margin. If the document is to be printed double-sided, touch [Change
Back Shift] to also specify the shift on the back side of the pages.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-17
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
4 To move the image according to the binding margin, touch [Image
Shift].
The Image Shift screen appears.
– On the North American (inch) model:Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-18
– On the European (metric) model:
5 Touch [OK].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-19
Adding cover pages (Cover Sheet)
Documents can be printed with cover pages added to the front and back.
First, load the paper trays with the paper for the front cover page and the
back cover page.
Settings can be specified for the following.
Parameter Description
Front Cover None Select this setting to add no front cover.
Front (Copy) Select this setting to print the first page of the document onto the
front cover page.
If “2-Sided” is selected, the second page of the document is
printed on the back of the front cover page.
Front (Blank) Select this setting to add the front cover page in front of the first
page of the document.
Back Cover None Select this setting to add no back cover.
Back (Copy) Select this setting to print the last page of the document onto the
back cover page.
If “2-Sided” is selected, the last two pages of the document are
printed on the back cover page.
Back (Blank) Select this setting to add the back cover page after the last page
of the document.
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
4
4
3
3
2
2
2
2
1
1
REPORTPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-20
2
Note
If a setting for the “Cover Sheet” function is to be specified when printing
a copied document, either of the following conditions must be met when
saving the document in a user box.
A paper tray is specified.
A Cover Sheet setting is specified.
1 In the Print screen, touch [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert].
2 Touch [Cover Sheet].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-21
3 Select the desired cover page format.
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
– To select the post inserter tray, select “Front (Blank)” or “Back
(Blank)”.
4 Select the paper trays loaded with the paper for the front and back cover pages. Touch [Paper].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-22
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
5 Select the paper tray loaded with the paper for the front or back cover
page.
– On the North American (inch) model:Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-23
– On the European (metric) model:
6 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-24
Adding insertions (Insert Sheet)
The document can be printed with other paper, such as colored paper, inserted for the specified pages. There are settings (“Copy” and “Blank”) for
selecting whether or not the inserted pages are printed. When the settings
are combined with single-sided printing or double-sided printing, the document is printed as described below.
Example: When page 6 is specified
!
Detail
The specified paper can be inserted at a maximum of 30 locations within
a document of up to 999 pages.
Setting Description
Copy (with “1-Sided” selected)
The specified paper is inserted for the 6th page, and the 6th page of
the document is printed onto it.
Copy (with “2-Sided” selected)
The back side of the 3rd page is left blank, the specified paper is inserted for the 4th page, and a double-sided copy of the 6th and 7th
pages of the document are printed onto it.
Blank (with “1-Sided”
selected)
A specified paper is inserted after the 6th page.
Blank (with “2-Sided”
selected)
The specified paper is inserted for the 4th page of the printed document.
If an odd-numbered page is specified, the back side is left blank.
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT 4
3
4
2
3
2
1
1
REPORT
4
2
3
3
2
1
1
REPORTPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-25
1 In the Print screen, touch [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert].
2 Touch [Insert Sheet].
3 Touch [Yes], and then specify the locations where the paper is to be inserted.
– Touch a button, and then use the keypad to type in the page where
the paper is to be inserted.
– To arrange the entered page numbers in order, touch [Sort].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-26
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
4 Select the paper tray loaded with the paper for the insertions. Touch
[Insert Paper].
– On the North American (inch) model:Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-27
– On the European (metric) model:
5 Select the insertion method.
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
– To select the post inserter tray, select “Blank” under “Insert Type”.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-28
6 Select the paper tray loaded with the paper for the insertions, and then
touch [OK].
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
7 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-29
Inserting chapter title pages (Chapters)
Settings can be specified for the function when printing double-sided pages.
Pages, such as chapter title pages, that must be printed on the front side of
the paper can be specified.
!
Detail
Pages can be specified at a maximum of 30 locations within a document
of up to 999 pages.
1 In the Print screen, touch [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert].
3
7
7
8
6
2 6
4
4
5
3
3
3
7
7
8
5
5
6
3
3
4
8
8
7
7
6
6
5
5
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-30
2 Touch [Chapters].
3 Touch [Yes], and then specify the pages to be printed on the front side
of the paper.
– Touch a button, and then use the keypad to type in the desired
page number.
– To arrange the entered page numbers in order, touch [Sort].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-31
4 To print the front side of the page on different paper, touch [Copy Insert] under “Chapter Paper”.
– If “None” is selected, all pages of the document are printed on the
same paper.
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-32
5 Select the paper tray loaded with the paper to be inserted, and then
touch [OK].
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
– The post inserter tray cannot be selected in the Chapter Paper Settings screen.
6 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-33
Printing the date/time (Date/Time)
The printing date and time can be added to all pages of a document.
1 In the Print screen, touch [Stamp/Composition].
2 Touch [Date/Time].
Parameter Description
Date Format Select the format for the date.
Time Format Select the whether or not the time is added and select its format.
Pages Select the pages to be printed on (either all pages or only the front cover).
Text Color Select the printing color (black, red, blue, green, yellow, cyan and magenta).
Text Size Select the size (8pt, 10pt, 12pt or 14pt) in which text is printed.
Print Position Select the position within the page where the image is printed. After a position is selected, it can be finely adjusted.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-34
3 To insert the date and time, touch [Yes], and then specify the date and
time settings.
– Touching [Text Color] displays a screen for specifying the color.
Touch the button for the desired color, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Text Size] displays a screen for specifying the text size.
Touch the button for the desired size, and then touch [OK].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-35
– Touching [Print Position] displays a screen for specifying the printing position. Touch the button for the desired printing position, and
then make any fine adjustments, if necessary. After specifying the
settings, touch [OK].
– To make fine adjustments, touch [Adjust Position].
The position can be adjusted between 1/16 and 1-15/16 inches on
the North American (inch) model (between 0.1 and 50.0 mm on the
European (metric) model) in the left/right direction and the up/down
direction.
– On the North American (inch) model:Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-36
– On the European (metric) model:
4 Touch [OK].
5 Touch [Close].
Printing page numbers (Page Number)
Page numbers can be added to all pages of the document.
Settings can be specified for the following.
With “Insert Sheet Setting”, settings can be selected to specify whether or
not page numbers are printed on cover sheets and printed insertions.
Parameter Description
Starting Page Number Specify the starting page number.
Starting Chapter
Number
Specify the starting chapter number.
Page Number Type Select the format for the page number.
Insert Sheet Setting Select whether or not page numbers are printed on inserted paper.
Text Color Select the printing color (black, red, blue, green, yellow, cyan and
magenta).
Text Size Select the size (8pt, 10pt, 12pt or 14pt) in which text is printed.
Print Position Select the position within the page where the image is printed. After
a position is selected, it can be finely adjusted.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-37
1 In the Print screen, touch [Stamp/Composition].
Setting Description
Cover Sheet Print on Front
and Back Cover
Select this setting to print the page numbers on the
front and back cover pages also.
Print on Back
Cover Only
Select this setting to not print the page number on the
front cover page.
Do Not Print
Page Number
Select this setting to not print the page numbers on the
front and back cover pages.
Insert Sheet (Copy) Print Page # Select this setting to print the page number on printed
insertions also.
Do Not Print # Select this setting to not print the page number on
printed insertions.
Skip the
Page(s)
Select this setting to count printed insertions as pages,
but not print the page numbers on them.
Insert (Blank) Do Not Print # Select this setting to not print the page number on
blank insertions.
Skip the
Page(s)
Select this setting to count blank insertions as pages,
but not print the page numbers on them.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-38
2 Touch [Page Number].
3 To insert page numbers, touch [Yes], and then specify the page
number settings.
– Touching [Insert Sheet Setting] displays a screen for specifying settings. Touch the buttons for the desired settings, and then touch
[OK].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-39
– Touching [Text Color] displays a screen for specifying the color.
Touch the button for the desired color, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Text Size] displays a screen for specifying the text size.
Touch the button for the desired size, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Print Position] displays a screen for specifying the printing position. Touch the button for the desired printing position, and
then make any fine adjustments, if necessary. After specifying the
settings, touch [OK].
– To make fine adjustments, touch [Adjust Position].
The position can be adjusted between 1/16 and 1-15/16 inches on
the North American (inch) model (between 0.1 and 50.0 mm on the Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-40
European (metric) model) in the left/right direction and the up/down
direction.
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
4 Touch [OK].
5 Touch [Close].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-41
Adding preset text or images (Stamp)
Preset text, such as “URGENT”, can be added to all pages of a document.
Settings can be specified for the following.
1 In the Print screen, touch [Stamp/Composition].
2 Touch [Stamp].
Parameter Description
Stamp Type/Preset
Stamps
Select a stamp, such as “URGENT”, “DRAFT” or “DO NOT COPY”.
Pages Select the pages to be printed on (either all pages or only the front
cover).
Text Color Select the printing color (black, red, blue, green, yellow, cyan and
magenta).
Text Size Select the size (minimum or standard) in which text is printed.
Print Position Select the position within the page where the image is printed. After
a position is selected, it can be finely adjusted.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-42
3 To insert a stamp, touch [Yes], and then specify the stamp settings.
– Touching [Text Color] displays a screen for specifying the color.
Touch the button for the desired color, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Text Size] displays a screen for specifying the text size.
Touch the button for the desired size, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Print Position] displays a screen for specifying the printing position. Touch the button for the desired printing position, and Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-43
then make any fine adjustments, if necessary. After specifying the
settings, touch [OK].
– To make fine adjustments, touch [Adjust Position].
The position can be adjusted between 1/16 and 1-15/16 inches on
the North American (inch) model (between 0.1 and 50.0 mm on the
European (metric) model) in the left/right direction and the up/down
direction.
– On the North American (inch) model:Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-44
– On the European (metric) model:
4 Touch [OK].
5 Touch [Close].
Adding text and images to prevent copying (Copy Protect)
Print hidden text on all pages of a document in order to prevent unauthorized
copying. When a document printed with copy protection text is copied, the
hidden text appears clearly repeated throughout the pages of the copies so
that the reader knows that it is a copy.
The following information can be inserted as copy protection.
Type Description
Registered Stamp Insert stamp images previously registered with the utility.
Preset Stamp Insert preset text, such as “Invalid Copy”, “Copy” or “INTERNAL
USE ONLY”, as preset stamps.
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORTPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-45
!
Detail
The printed serial number is the serial number of the machine. For details
on specifying the serial number, contact your technical representative.
Use the Copy Protection Utility to register a registered stamp. For details,
refer to the manual for the utility.
The paper is divided into 8 blocks for copy protection, and the items within
that area can be increased.
The number of areas required for each item is listed below.
!
Detail
When text is arranged at a +45-degree angle (-45-degree angle), up to
four areas are needed.
To insert spaces, touch [Position].
To specify the following copy protection settings, touch [Detailed Settings].
Date/Time Insert the date and time that the document was registered.
Other Insert the job number assigned to the document, the serial number
or a distribution number.
Job Number: Select whether to print the job number.
Serial Number: Select whether to print the serial number of the machine.
Distribution Control Number: Select whether to print the entered distribution numbers.
Item Description Required number of areas
Registered Stamp One stamp 1
Preset Stamp One stamp 1
Date/Time Date Format 1
Time Format 1
Other Job Number 1
Serial Number 1
Distribution Control Number 1
Parameter Description
Text/Background Color Select the color (black, cyan or magenta) used to print the text and
background.
Type DescriptionPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-46
To perform the following operations, touch [Position].
- Changing the angle of text within the area (+45 degrees, 0 degrees (none)
or -45 degrees)
- Inserting spaces between copy protection
- Changing the printing order of copy protection
- Deleting copy protection or spaces
1 In the Print screen, touch [Stamp/Composition].
2 Touch [Copy Protect].
Density Select the printing density (light, std. or dark).
Copy Protect Pattern Select the pattern type and contrast when the document is copied.
Text Size Select the size (minimal, std. or large) in which text, such as the date/
time, is printed.
Pattern Overwrite Select whether the pattern is printed on top of or behind the document text.
Background Pattern Select the pattern to be printed in the background.
Parameter DescriptionPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-47
3 To apply copy protection, touch [Yes], and then specify the copy protection settings.
– Touching [Preset Stamp] displays a screen for specifying the preset
stamp settings. Touch the button for the desired stamp type, and
then touch [OK].
– Touching [Date/Time] displays a screen for specifying the date/time
settings. Select the information to be inserted, and then touch [OK].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-48
– Touching [Other] displays a screen for specifying other settings.
Select the information to be inserted, and then touch [OK].
4 To specify detailed copy protection settings, touch [Detailed Settings].
A screen for specifying settings appears. Specify the desired settings,
and then touch [OK].
– Text/Background ColorPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-49
– Density
– Copy Protect Pattern
– Text SizePrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-50
– Pattern Overwrite
– Background Pattern
5 After finishing changing the settings, touch [Close].
6 To change the arrangement of spaces, touch [Position].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-51
7 To arrange text at an angle, select the angle.
– When text is arranged at an angle, up to four areas are needed. If
five or more items are specified, delete an item before specifying
the angle.
8 To change the arrangement or delete an item, touch [Change Pos./Delete].
– The Change screen appears.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-52
– To change the arrangement, select the copy protection item to be
moved, and then touch either [Up] or [Down].
– To insert a space, move o to the right of the location where the
space is to be inserted, and then touch [Insert].
– To delete an item, select the item to be deleted.
9 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next two screens that appear.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-53
10 Touch [Close].
Adding repeated preset text or images (Stamp Repeat)
Text or images can be repeatedly printed throughout all pages.
The following information can be inserted as a repeating stamp.
!
Detail
The printed serial number is the serial number of the machine. For details
on specifying the serial number, contact your technical representative.
Use the Copy Protection Utility to register a registered stamp. For details,
refer to the manual for the utility.
The paper is divided into 8 blocks for repeating stamps, and the items within
that area can be increased.
The number of areas required for each item is listed below.
Type Description
Registered Stamp Insert stamp images previously registered with the utility.
Preset Stamp Insert preset text, such as “Invalid Copy”, “Copy” or “Private”, as
preset stamps.
Date/Time Insert the date and time that the document was registered.
Other Insert the job number assigned to the document, the serial number
or a distribution number.
Job Number: Select whether to print the job number.
Serial Number: Select whether to print the serial number of the machine.
Distribution Control Number: Select whether to print the entered distribution numbers.
Item Description Required number of areas
Registered Stamp One stamp 1
Preset Stamp One stamp 1
Date/Time Date Format 1
Time Format 1
Other Job Number 1
Serial Number 1
Distribution Control Number 1Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-54
!
Detail
When text is arranged at a +45-degree angle (-45-degree angle), up to
four areas are needed.
To insert spaces, touch [Position].
To specify the following stamp settings, touch [Detail Settings].
To perform the following operations, touch [Position].
- Changing the angle of text within the area (+45 degrees, 0 degrees (none)
or -45 degrees)
- Inserting spaces between stamps
- Changing the printing order of stamps
- Deleting stamps or spaces
1 In the Print screen, touch [Stamp/Composition].
Parameter Description
Text Color Select the color (black, cyan or magenta) used to print the text and
background.
Density Select the printing density (light, std. or dark).
Text Size Select the size (minimal, std. or large) in which text, such as the date/
time, is printed.
Pattern Overwrite Select “Front (Overwrite)”, “Transparent” or “Back” for printing the
pattern.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-55
2 Touch [Stamp Repeat].
3 To insert a repeating stamp, touch [Yes], and then specify the stamp
settings.
– Touching [Preset Stamp] displays a screen for specifying the preset
stamp settings. Touch the button for the desired stamp type, and
then touch [OK].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-56
– Touching [Date/Time] displays a screen for specifying the date/time
settings. Select the information to be inserted, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Other] displays a screen for specifying other settings.
Select the information to be inserted, and then touch [OK].
4 To specify detailed repeating stamp settings, touch [Detail Settings].
A screen for specifying settings appears. Specify the desired settings,
and then touch [OK].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-57
– Text Color
– Density
– Text SizePrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-58
– Pattern Overwrite
5 After finishing changing the settings, touch [Close].
6 To change the arrangement of spaces, touch [Position].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-59
7 To arrange text at an angle, select the angle.
– When text is arranged at an angle, up to four areas are needed. If
five or more items are specified, delete an item before specifying
the angle.
8 To change the arrangement or delete an item, touch [Change Pos./Delete].
The Change screen appears.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-60
– To change the arrangement, select the copy protection item to be
moved, and then touch either [Up] or [Down].
– To insert a space, move o to the right of the location where the
space is to be inserted, and then touch [Insert].
– To delete an item, select the item to be deleted.
9 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next two screens that appear.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-61
10 Touch [Close].
Inserting a header/footer (Header/Footer)
Headers or footers can be inserted on all pages. The contents of the header/
footer must be previously registered in Administrator mode.
!
Detail
For details on registering headers/footers, refer to the User’s Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
Headers/footers use registered information that is recalled; however, the
information can be checked or changed when printing. Settings can be
specified for the following.
1 In the Print screen, touch [Stamp/Composition].
Parameter Description
Header Settings Select whether or not to print a header. If a header is to be
printed, specify whether to print text, the date/time or other information (distribution number, job number or serial number).
Footer Settings Select whether or not to print a footer. If a footer is to be printed, specify whether to print text, the date/time or other information (distribution number, job number or serial number).
Pages Select the pages where the header/footer is to be printed (either all pages or 1st page only).
Text Color Select the printing color (black, red, blue, green, yellow, cyan
and magenta).
Text Size Select the size (8pt, 10pt, 12pt or 14pt) in which text is printed.Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-62
2 Touch [Header/Footer].
3 To print a header/footer, touch [Yes], and then select the type of header/footer to be recalled.
4 To check or temporarily change the selected settings, touch [Check/
Change Temporarily].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-63
The Check/Change Temporarily screen appears.
5 Under “Header Settings” or “Footer Settings”, touch [Print], and then
specify the header/footer settings.
– TextPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-64
– Date/Time
– Other
6 Specify the settings for the pages to be printed on, the text color and
the text size.
– Text ColorPrinting a user box document
4
C550 4-65
– Text Size
– To cancel the temporarily changed settings, touch [Reset].
7 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.
8 Touch [Close].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-66
4.3 Combined printing
Available combined printing parameters
Multiple documents can be printed together. Up to 10 documents can be selected to be printed together.
Additional settings, such as those for the number of copies, can be specified
for the selected document. Settings can be specified for the following.
2
Note
Documents saved in a box and having a front cover, back cover and
blank insertion in addition to Image Repeat and OHP Interleave settings
specified cannot be combined and printed.
“Sort”, “Group” and “Tri-fold” cannot be specified with combined printing.
!
Detail
The Fold/Bind settings are available only if optional finisher FS-608 is installed.
The Z-Fold setting is available only if the Z-folding unit is installed on the
optional finisher FS-608/FS-517/FS-518.
The Punch settings are available only if the punch kit is installed on the
optional finisher.
The printouts are Z-folded only when the loaded size of the saved document supports Z-Fold (8-1/2 × 14 w,11 × 17 w, A3 w, B4 w or 8K w).
Available parameters Description Page reference
Copies Specify the number of copies to be printed. p. 4-8
Print Select whether a single-sided or double-sided
copy is to be printed.
p. 4-8
Finishing Specify settings for offsetting, stapling, hole
punching or folding/binding.
p. 4-9
Page Margin Print the document with a binding margin added. p. 4-16
Stamp/Composition Print the document with the date/time, page
number or a stamp added.
p. 4-33Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-67
To print a document
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be printed.
2 Under “Action”, touch [Combine].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-68
3 Specify the combination order.
– Select the two documents whose order is to be switched.
– The documents are combined and printed in the order specified
here.
4 Touch [OK].Printing a user box document
4
C550 4-69
5 Select the print settings.
6 If desired, touch [Preview], then [Details] on the left side of the screen
to check a preview image.
– For details on the Preview screen, refer to “Preview - Detail (Print/
Combine)” on page 2-79.
7 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.
!
Detail
For details on changing the settings, refer to the descriptions starting with
page 4-8.5 Sending a user box
documentSending a user box document
5
C550 5-2
5 Sending a user box document
5.1 Overview of document transmissions
Available document transmission operations
Document data saved in a user box can be sent using four different methods.
The data can easily be routed simply by registering a destination with this
machine instead of by sending the data through different computers.
2
Note
Documents saved from Copy mode cannot be sent.
Transmission methods
Specify the destination using any of the following four methods depending
on the desired transmission purpose and use. Destinations can be specified
using any combination of these methods.
Method Description
E-mail Document data can be sent as an e-mail attachment.
PC (SMB) Document data is sent to a shared folder on the specified computer.
FTP Document data is uploaded to the specified FTP server.
WebDAV Document data is sent to the specified server on the network.
Method Description Page reference
Address book destination
Select different destinations from those registered
in the address book.
p. 5-8
Group destinations Multiple destinations can be registered together
with this method. This is convenient when documents are always sent to the same destinations.
p. 5-9
Direct input With this method, destinations for e-mail transmissions, FTP transmissions, SMB transmissions and
WebDAV transmissions are entered directly from
the control panel. This is used when sending data to
a destination that is not already registered.
p. 5-13
Address search Select this method when an LDAP server is used.
Addresses registered on the LDAP server can be
searched for the address that corresponds to the
specified conditions.
p. 5-21Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-3
!
Detail
Up to 500 destinations can be specified from the address book and with
an Address search.
Up to five destinations can be entered directly each with e-mail transmissions, SMB transmissions, FTP transmissions and WebDAV transmissions.
Checking documents saved in user boxes
The following procedure describes how to check the list of documents saved
in a user box.
1 Press the [User Box] key
in the control panel.
2 Touch [Use Document].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-4
3 From the Public, Personal or Group tab, touch the button for the desired user box.
– The Personal tab displays only user boxes registered to the user
that is logged on with user authentication.
– The Group tab displays only user boxes for the account that the
user belongs to when account track settings are specified.
4 Touch [OK].
5 If a password has been set for the user box, type in the password, and
then touch [OK].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-5
The list of documents saved in the user box is displayed.
2
Note
If “Prohibited Functions When Authentication Error” in Administrator
mode is set to “Mode 2” and a user enters an incorrect box password the
specified number of times, that box is locked and can no longer be used.
Contact the administrator to cancel operation restrictions.
Description of Use Document screen
The documents are displayed on the Use Document screen in the same way
that they are displayed on the File Document screen. For details, refer to “Description of File Document screen” on page 3-5.
Searching for a user box name
For details on searching for a user box name, refer to “Searching for a user
box name” on page 3-6.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-6
To send a document
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be sent.
2 Under “Action”, touch [Send].
3 Specify the destination and transmission settings.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-7
4 If desired, touch [Preview], then [Details] on the left side of the screen
to check a preview image.
– For details on the Preview screen, refer to “Preview - Detail (Send/
Bind TX)” on page 2-80.
5 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.
!
Detail
For details on specifying the destination and transmission settings, refer
to the descriptions starting with page 5-8.
2
Note
Transmission may not be possible if limitations have been placed on the
document name according to the destination server conditions. Since the
document name becomes the file name during transmission, consult
your network administrator when specifying the document name.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-8
5.2 Specifying the destination
Selecting from the address book
Follow the procedure described below to send data by selecting a recipient
from the already registered destinations.
For details on registering destinations, refer to the User’s Guide [Network
Scanner Operations].
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be sent, and
then touch [Send].
2 Touch [Address Book].
– The index appears if “Default Address Book” (displayed by touching [Custom Display Settings] on the User Settings screen, then
[Fax/Scan Settings]) is set to “Index”. If “Address Type” is selected,
the index of destination types is displayed.
A list of registered destinations appears.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-9
3 Touch a destination button to select the address.
– The corresponding address appears as the name of the registered
destination when an index button is touched.
– Multiple destinations can be specified at the same time.
– Additional destinations can be added by directly typing in the address.
The button appears selected, and the destination appears under
“Broadcast Destinations”.
!
Detail
The desired destination can be searched for. For details, refer to “Searching for a destination” on page 5-11.
Selecting from a group destination
“Group” refers to multiple destinations that are registered collectively. Follow
the procedure described below to send data by selecting a group that has
been registered in advance.
For details on registering group destinations, refer to the User’s Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
!
Detail
The description below describes the procedure for specifying the group
and sending the data, starting from the situation where “Address Book
default” has been set to “Address Type” in [Custom Display Settings] in
the User Settings screen.
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be sent, and
then touch [Send].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-10
2 Touch [Group].
The registered group destinations appear.
3 Touch the button for the group destination.
A list of destinations registered in the group appears.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-11
4 Select the destination where the data is to be sent, and then touch
[OK].
– To select all destinations, touch [Select All].
– To deselect all destinations, touch [Reset].
– Additional destinations can be added by directly typing in the address.
The button appears selected, and the destination appears under
“Broadcast Destinations”.
Searching for a destination
A search for the desired destination can be performed using any of the following methods. The following procedure describes how to perform a
search.
Method Description
Index This button appears if “Default Address Book” (displayed by touching
[Custom Display Settings] on the User Settings screen, then [Fax/Scan
Settings]) is set to “Address Type”. The index characters can be
searched based on the character that was specified when the destination was registered.
Address Type This button appears if “Default Address Book” (displayed by touching
[Custom Display Settings] on the User Settings screen, then [Fax/Scan
Settings]) is set to “Index”. The destination types can be searched
based on the type that was specified when the destination was registered.
Search Type in the destination name or part of the address to search for the
corresponding address.
Address search An LDAP search can be performed if an LDAP server is being used, for
example, for user management. Search the addresses registered on
the LDAP server for the address that corresponds to the conditions. A
basic search, where a keyword is entered, and an advanced search,
where multiple conditions are used to narrow down the search, are
available.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-12
!
Detail
In order to perform an Address search, settings for the Address server
must be specified from Administrator mode. For details, refer to “Enabling LDAP” in the User’s Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
For details on performing an Address search, refer to “Selecting a destination with an Address search” on page 5-21.
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be sent, and
then touch [Send].
2 Touch [Address Book], and then touch [Search].
3 Touch [Detail Search].
4 Touch [Name] or [Address] to select the search to be performed.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-13
5 Type in the text to be searched for, and then touch [OK].
The Detailed Search screen appears again, and the search results are
displayed.
6 Select the desired destination, and then touch [OK].
Directly specifying an e-mail destination
2
Note
If “Manual Destination Input” (displayed by touching [Security Settings]
on the Administrator Settings screen, then [Security Details]) is set to
“Restrict”, [Direct Input] does not appear.
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be sent, and
then touch [Send].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-14
2 Touch [E-Mail] on the Direct Input tab.
A screen appears, allowing you to type in the address of the destination.
3 Type in the address of the destination, and then touch [OK].
– To specify additional destinations, repeat steps 2 and 3.
The entered addresses appear under “Broadcast Destinations”.
2
Note
Frequently entered user names and domain names can be registered to
be recalled and used again. Prefixes and suffixes must first be registered
in Administrator mode.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-15
Directly specifying an SMB destination
Settings can be specified for the following.
2
Note
If “Manual Destination Input” (displayed by touching [Security Settings]
on the Administrator Settings screen, then [Security Details]) is set to
“Restrict”, [Direct Input] does not appear.
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be sent, and
then touch [Send].
2 Touch [PC (SMB)] on the Direct Input tab.
A screen appears, allowing you to type in the host name for the destination and the file path.
Parameter Description
Host Name Specify the host name (in uppercase letters) or IP address for the destination. Type using the keyboard that appears, and then touch [OK].
File Path Type the path to the destination folder in uppercase letters.
User Name Type in the user name used to log on, and then touch [OK].
Password Specify the password. Type using the keyboard that appears, and then
touch [OK].
Reference Check the structure of the folders on the destination computer. This
can be used to directly specify the destination folder.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-16
3 Enter the information for the destination, and then touch [OK].
– To check the contents of the shared folders, touch [Reference].
– To specify an additional address, touch [Next Destination], and
then enter the information.
The entered addresses appear under “Broadcast Destinations”.
2
Reminder
If more than the following number of computers or workgroups exist on
the network (subnet) that this machine belongs to, browsing over the network may not be performed correctly.
Workgroups: 128
Computers: 128
Directly specifying an FTP destination
Settings can be specified for the following.
Parameter Description
Host Name Specify the host name or IP address for the destination. Type using the
keyboard that appears, and then touch [OK].
File Path Specify the path to the destination folder. Type using the keyboard that
appears, and then touch [OK].
User Name Type in the user name used to log on, and then touch [OK].
Password Specify the password. Type using the keyboard that appears, and then
touch [OK].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-17
Detailed Settings
2
Note
If “Manual Destination Input” (displayed by touching [Security Settings]
on the Administrator Settings screen, then [Security Details]) is set to
“Restrict”, [Direct Input] does not appear.
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be sent, and
then touch [Send].
2 Touch [FTP] on the Direct Input tab.
A screen appears, allowing you to type in the host name for the destination and the file path.
Parameter Description
Port Number Type in the port number.
PASV Select whether or not the PASV (passive) mode is used. Touch [Yes] or
[No].
Proxy Select whether or not a proxy server is used. Touch [Yes] or [No].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-18
3 Type in the destination information.
– To specify an additional address, touch [Next Destination], and
then enter the information.
The entered addresses appear under “Broadcast Destinations”.
4 To specify advanced settings, touch [Detailed Settings], and then
specify the settings.
5 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-19
Directly specifying a WebDAV destination
Settings can be specified for the following.
Detailed Settings
2
Note
If “Manual Destination Input” (displayed by touching [Security Settings]
on the Administrator Settings screen, then [Security Details]) is set to
“Restrict”, [Direct Input] does not appear.
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be sent, and
then touch [Send].
2 Touch [WebDAV] on the Direct Input tab.
A screen appears, allowing you to type in the host name for the destination and the file path.
Parameter Description
Host Name Specify the host name or IP address for the destination. Type using the
keyboard that appears, and then touch [OK].
File Path Type (in uppercase letters) the path to the destination folder.
User Name Type in the user name used to log on, and then touch [OK].
Password Specify the password. Type using the keyboard that appears, and then
touch [OK].
Parameter Description
Port Number Type in the port number.
Proxy Select whether or not a proxy server is used.
SSL Settings Select whether or not SSL is used with transmissions.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-20
3 Type in the destination information.
– To specify an additional address, touch [Next Destination], and
then enter the information.
The entered addresses appear under “Broadcast Destinations”.
4 To specify advanced settings, touch [Detailed Settings], and then
specify the settings.
5 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-21
Selecting a destination with an Address search
If LDAP server settings are specified in Administrator mode, [Address
Search] appears in the screen.
!
Detail
For details on the LDAP server settings, refer to “Enabling LDAP” in the
User’s Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
If “Manual Destination Input” (displayed by touching [Security Settings]
on the Administrator Settings screen, then [Security Details]) is set to
“Restrict”, [Address Search] does not appear.
The position of [Address Search] can be changed from the User Settings
screen. For details, refer to “Address Book Default” in the User’s Guide
[Network Scanner Operations].
1 Touch [Address Search].
2 If multiple LDAP servers are specified, select the server to be searched,
and then touch [OK].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-22
3 Select the desired search type.
– When there is only one LDAP server
– When there are multiple LDAP servers
4 Specify the search conditions.
– If “Search” was selected, type in the keyword to be searched for,
and then touch [Start Search].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-23
– If “Advanced Search” was selected, select the search condition
types and type in the text to be searched for, and then touch [Start
Search].
5 Select the desired destination, and then touch [OK].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-24
5.3 Specifying the transmission settings
Settings that can be specified
In the screen for selecting a destination, touch [File Type], [Communication
Settings] or [Application] to specify detailed settings for sending. Settings
can be specified for the following.
File Type
Communication Settings
!
Detail
For details on the S/MIME communication settings, refer to the User’s
Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
The “Digital Signature” parameter may not be available or may be set to
normally sign, depending on the specified S/MIME communication settings.
Application
Parameter Description Page reference
File Type Select the file format for the scan data to be saved. p. 5-25
Parameter Description Page reference
E-Mail Settings Specify the document name, subject, From address
and message body for sending e-mail messages.
p. 5-29
URL Notification Setting
Specify the e-mail address where notifications of
completion of the job are to be sent.
p. 5-30
E-Mail Encryption This parameter appears when “S/MIME Communication Settings” is set to “ON”. Select whether or not
to encrypt e-mail messages that are sent.
p. 5-31
Digital Signature This parameter appears when “S/MIME Communication Settings” is set to “ON”. Select whether or not
to add a digital signature to e-mail messages that are
sent.
p. 5-32
Parameter Description Page reference
Stamp/Composition Print the document with the date/time, page number
or a stamp added.
p. 5-33
Send & Print Settings can be specified to print a document when
it is sent. In addition, various settings can be specified when printing.
p. 5-49Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-25
File Type
File Type
Select the file format for sending the data. The following six file formats are
available.
2
Note
The “JPEG” setting cannot be selected for a received fax saved in a user
box.
“JPEG” cannot be selected for Bind TX.
A compression method can be selected when saving a TIFF file in color.
For details, refer to the User’s Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
Encryption settings
If the “PDF” or “Compact PDF” File Type setting is selected, the encryption
level and stamp combination method can be specified.
Setting Description
PDF Select this setting to save the data in the PDF format.
Compact PDF Select this setting to compress the data more than with the PDF format.
This is used with full-color scan data.
TIFF Select this setting to save data in the TIFF format.
JPEG Select this setting to save the data in the JPEG format.
XPS Select this setting to save the data in the XPS format.
Compact XPS Select this setting to compress the data more than the XPS format and
save.
Parameter Description
Encryption Level Select the encryption level.
Password Enter the password necessary to open encrypted data. Type in a password of 32 characters or less. For confirmation, type in the password
again.
Document Permissions
Enter the password necessary to change document permissions. Type
in a password of 32 characters or less. For confirmation, type in the
password again.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-26
Detail Settings of Encryption
If document permissions are specified from the Encryption screen, detailed
permission settings can be specified.
Stamp Combine Method
2
Note
The date/time, page number and header/footer can be combined as text.
Stamps are combined as images.
In addition, the grouping of the data to be sent can be specified.
Scan Setting
2
Note
“Single Page” cannot be selected for Bind TX.
1 Touch [File Type] in a screen for selecting a destination.
Parameter Description
Printing Allowed Select whether or not to allow printing of the data. If “Encryption Level”
is set to “High level”, “Low Resolution” appears.
Enable copying of
text, images and other
content
Select whether or not to allow text and images to be extracted.
Change Allowed Select the permission level for document editing, such as signing, entering text and annotating the data.
Setting Description
Image Select this setting to insert the text as an image.
Text Select this setting to insert the text as text.
Setting Description
Single Page Select this setting to send a single file for each page of the document.
Multi Page Select this setting to send the entire document as a single file. This setting cannot be selected if the “JPEG” File Type setting is selected.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-27
2 Select the file format.
3 If “PDF” or “Compact PDF” was selected, touch [Encryption], if necessary.
– The contents of a document saved with encryption cannot be previewed.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-28
4 Specify the encryption settings.
5 To specify the stamp combination method, touch [Stamp Composition].
6 Select the desired stamp combination method.
7 Touch [OK].
8 Select the scan setting.
9 Touch [OK].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-29
E-Mail Settings (Communication Settings)
When data is sent, an e-mail message containing the document name can
be sent to the specified e-mail address.
Settings can be specified for the following.
2
Note
If “Change the “From” Address” (displayed by touching [System Settings]
on the Administrator Settings screen, then [Restrict User Access], then
[Restrict Access to Job Settings]) is set to “Restrict”, the From address
cannot be entered directly.
1 Touch [Communication Settings] in a screen for selecting a destination.
2 Touch [E-Mail Settings].
Parameter Description
Document Name The name of the file to be saved is displayed. The document name
specified later appears as the document name, even if the document
name was specified in the File Document screen. A maximum of 30
characters can be entered.
Subject The text specified from Utility mode is automatically displayed. Touch
[Direct Input] to change the text. A maximum of 64 characters can be
entered.
From The e-mail address specified from Utility mode is automatically displayed.
Body The text specified from Utility mode is displayed. Touch [Direct Input]
to change the text. A maximum of 256 characters can be entered.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-30
3 Specify the e-mail transmission settings.
4 Touch [Close], and then touch [Close] in the next screen that appears.
URL Notification Setting (Communication Settings)
Specify the e-mail address where notifications of completion of the job are
to be sent.
!
Detail
The destinations that can be specified for “URL Notification Setting” include FTP servers, SMB servers or WebDAV servers.
This feature does not function during e-mail transmissions, even if a setting is specified.
1 Touch [Communication Settings] in a screen for selecting a destination.
2 Touch [URL Notification Setting].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-31
3 Specify the e-mail address where notifications will be sent.
– Select a registered e-mail address.
– Touch [Direct Input], and then specify the e-mail address for the
destination of URL notifications.
4 Touch [OK].
5 Touch [Close].
E-Mail Encryption (Communication Settings)
A setting can be specified for this parameter when “S/MIME Communication
Settings” is set to “ON”. Select whether or not to encrypt e-mail messages
that are sent.
!
Detail
For details on the S/MIME communication settings, refer to the User’s
Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
1 Touch [Communication Settings] in a screen for selecting a destination.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-32
2 Touch [E-Mail Encryption].
3 Touch [Close], and then touch [Close] in the next screen that appears.
Digital Signature (Communication Settings)
This parameter appears when “S/MIME Communication Settings” is set to
“ON”. Select whether or not to add a digital signature to e-mail messages
that are sent.
!
Detail
For details on the S/MIME communication settings, refer to the User’s
Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
This parameter may not be available or may be set to normally sign, depending on the specified S/MIME communication settings.
1 Touch [Communication Settings] in a screen for selecting a destination.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-33
2 To add a digital signature, touch [Digital Signature], and then select the
digital signature.
3 Touch [Close], and then touch [Close] in the next screen that appears.
Date/Time (Application)
The scanning date and time can be added to all pages of a document.
Settings can be specified for the following.
1 Touch [Application] in a screen for selecting a destination.
Parameter Description
Date Format Select the format for the date.
Time Format Select the whether or not the time is added and select its format.
Pages Select the pages to be printed on (either all pages or only the front cover).
Text Color Select the printing color (black, red, blue, green, yellow, cyan and magenta).
Text Size Select the size (8pt, 10pt, 12pt or 14pt) in which text is printed.
Print Position Select the position within the page where the image is printed. After a
position is selected, it can be finely adjusted.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-34
2 Touch [Stamp/Composition].
3 Touch [Date/Time].
4 To add a date and time, touch [Yes], and then specify the date and time
settings.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-35
– Touching [Text Color] displays a screen for specifying the color.
Touch the button for the desired color, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Text Size] displays a screen for specifying the text size.
Touch the button for the desired size, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Print Position] displays a screen for specifying the printing position. Touch the button for the desired printing position, and
then make any fine adjustments, if necessary. After specifying the
settings, touch [OK].
– To make fine adjustments, touch [Adjust Position].
The position can be adjusted between 1/16 and 1-15/16 inches on
the North American (inch) model (between 0.1 and 50.0 mm on the Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-36
European (metric) model) in the left/right direction and the up/down
direction.
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
5 Touch [OK].
6 Touch [Close], and then touch [Close] in the next screen that appears.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-37
Page Number (Application)
Page numbers can be added to all pages of the document.
Settings can be specified for the following.
1 Touch [Application] in a screen for selecting a destination.
2 Touch [Stamp/Composition].
Parameter Description
Starting Page Number Specify the starting page number.
Starting Chapter
Number
Specify the starting chapter number.
Page Number Type Select the format for the page number.
Text Color Select the printing color (black, red, blue, green, yellow, cyan and magenta).
Text Size Select the size (8pt, 10pt, 12pt or 14pt) in which text is printed.
Print Position Select the position within the page where the image is printed. After a
position is selected, it can be finely adjusted.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-38
3 Touch [Page Number].
4 To add page numbers, touch [Yes], and then specify the page number
settings.
– Touching [Text Color] displays a screen for specifying the color.
Touch the button for the desired color, and then touch [OK].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-39
– Touching [Text Size] displays a screen for specifying the text size.
Touch the button for the desired size, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Print Position] displays a screen for specifying the printing position. Touch the button for the desired printing position, and
then make any fine adjustments, if necessary. After specifying the
settings, touch [OK].
– To make fine adjustments, touch [Adjust Position].
The position can be adjusted between 1/16 and 1-15/16 inches on
the North American (inch) model (between 0.1 and 50.0 mm on the
European (metric) model) in the left/right direction and the up/down
direction.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-40
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
5 Touch [OK].
6 Touch [Close], and then touch [Close] in the next screen that appears.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-41
Stamp (Application)
Preset text, such as “URGENT”, can be added to all pages of a document.
Settings can be specified for the following.
2
Note
If “File Type” is set to “PDF” or “Compact PDF”, the stamps are added
as images. They cannot be added as text.
1 Touch [Application] in a screen for selecting a destination.
2 Touch [Stamp/Composition].
Parameter Description
Stamp Type/Preset
Stamps
Select a stamp, such as “URGENT”, “CIRCULAR” or “DO NOT COPY”.
Pages Select the pages to be printed on (either all pages or only the front cover).
Text Color Select the printing color (black, red, blue, green, yellow, cyan and magenta).
Text Size Select the size (minimum or standard) in which text is printed.
Print Position Select the position within the page where the image is printed. After a
position is selected, it can be finely adjusted.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-42
3 Touch [Stamp].
4 To specify a stamp, touch [Yes], and then specify the stamp settings.
– Touching [Text Color] displays a screen for specifying the color.
Touch the button for the desired color, and then touch [OK].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-43
– Touching [Text Size] displays a screen for specifying the text size.
Touch the button for the desired size, and then touch [OK].
– Touching [Print Position] displays a screen for specifying the printing position. Touch the button for the desired printing position, and
then make any fine adjustments, if necessary. After specifying the
settings, touch [OK].
– To make fine adjustments, touch [Adjust Position].
The position can be adjusted between 1/16 and 1-15/16 inches on
the North American (inch) model (between 0.1 and 50.0 mm on the
European (metric) model) in the left/right direction and the up/down
direction.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-44
– On the North American (inch) model:
– On the European (metric) model:
5 Touch [OK].
6 Touch [Close], and then touch [Close] in the next screen that appears.
Header/Footer (Application)
Headers or footers can be inserted on all pages. The contents of the header/
footer must be previously registered in Administrator mode.
!
Detail
For details on registering headers/footers, refer to the User’s Guide [Network Scanner Operations].
Headers/footers use registered information that is recalled; however, the
information can be checked or changed when printing. Settings can be
specified for the following.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-45
1 In the Application screen, touch [Stamp/Composition].
2 Touch [Header/Footer].
Parameter Description
Header Settings Select whether or not to print a header. If a header is to be printed,
specify whether to print text, the date/time or other information (distribution number, job number or serial number).
Footer Settings Select whether or not to print a footer. If a footer is to be printed, specify
whether to print text, the date/time or other information (distribution
number, job number or serial number).
Pages Select the pages where the header/footer is to be printed (either all
pages or 1st page only).
Text Color Select the printing color (black, red, blue, green, yellow, cyan and magenta).
Text Size Select the size (8pt, 10pt, 12pt or 14pt) in which text is printed.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-46
3 To print a header/footer, touch [Yes], and then select the type of header/footer to be recalled.
4 To check or temporarily change the selected settings, touch [Check/
Change Temporarily].
– The Check/Change Temporarily screen appears.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-47
5 Under “Header Settings” or “Footer Settings”, touch [Print], and then
specify the header/footer settings.
– Text
– Date/TimeSending a user box document
5
C550 5-48
– Others
6 Specify the settings for the pages to be printed on, the text color and
the text size.
– Text Color
– Text Size
– To cancel the temporarily changed settings, touch [Reset].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-49
7 Touch [OK], and then touch [OK] in the next screen that appears.
8 Touch [Close].
Send & Print (Application)
Settings can be specified to print a document when it is scanned. In addition,
various settings can be specified when printing.
Settings can be specified for the following.
1 Touch [Application] in a screen for selecting a destination.
2 Touch [Send & Print].
Parameter Description
Copies Use the keypad to type in the number of copies to be printed. A number
between 1 and 999 can be specified.
Simplex/Duplex Select whether a single-sided or double-sided copy is to be printed.
Staple Select whether or not the prints will be stapled. If they will be stapled,
select the number of staples and the position.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-50
3 To print a document while sending it, touch [Yes], and then specify the
desired settings.
4 To select the staple position, touch [Corner] or [2 Position], and then
touch [Position Setting].
5 Touch the button for the desired position, and then touch [OK].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-51
6 Touch [OK].
7 Touch [Close].Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-52
5.4 Bind TX
Available combined sending parameters
Multiple documents can be sent together. Up to 10 documents can be selected to be sent together.
In the screen for selecting a destination, touch [File Type], [Communication
Settings] or [Application] to specify detailed settings for sending. Settings
can be specified for the following.
File Type
Communication Settings
Application
To perform a combined transmission
1 From the Use Document screen, select the document to be sent.
Parameter Description Page reference
File Type Select the file format for the scan data to be saved. p. 5-25
Parameter Description Page reference
E-Mail Settings Specify the document name, subject, From address
and message body for sending e-mail messages.
p. 5-29
URL Notification Setting
Specify the e-mail address where notifications of
completion of the job are to be sent.
p. 5-30
Parameter Description Page reference
Stamp/Composition Print the document with the date/time, page
number or a stamp added.
p. 5-33, p. 5-37,
p. 5-41Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-53
2 Under “Action”, touch [Bind TX].
3 Specify the combination order.
– Select the two documents whose order is to be switched.
– The documents are combined and transmitted in the order specified here.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-54
4 Touch [OK].
5 Specify the destination and transmission settings.
6 If desired, touch [Preview], then [Details] on the left side of the screen
to check a preview image.
– For details on the Preview screen, refer to “Preview - Detail (Send/
Bind TX)” on page 2-80.
7 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-55
!
Detail
For details on specifying the destination and transmission settings, refer
to the descriptions starting with page 5-24.
2
Note
Transmission may not be possible if limitations have been placed on the
document name according to the destination server conditions. Since the
document name becomes the file name during transmission, consult
your network administrator when specifying the document name.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-56
5.5 Checking settings before sending
Touch [Check Job] in the sub display area to display the list of destinations.
In this area, the selected settings can be checked. To change a destination,
select it in this area.
Settings can be checked and changed with the following.
1 Touch [Check Job] in the sub display area.
The Broadcast Destinations list appears.
2 Select the desired destination from the list of registered destinations.
Item Description
Destination Settings The list of destinations can be viewed or changed, and destinations can
be added. An address that was directly typed in can also be registered.
Check E-Mail Settings The e-mail settings can be checked.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-57
3 Touch [Check Job Settings].
The Check Job Detailed Settings screen appears.
4 Touch the button for the setting to be changed, and then check or
change the setting.
– If a setting is changed, the changed destination moves to the end
of the list.
5 After checking the settings, touch [Close].
Deleting unnecessary destinations
The selected destination can be deleted.
1 Touch [Check Job] in the sub display area.
The Broadcast Destinations list appears.Sending a user box document
5
C550 5-58
2 Select the destination to be deleted from the list of registered destinations.
3 Touch [Delete].
The destination is deleted.6 Printing/sending a
system user box
documentPrinting/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-2
6 Printing/sending a system user box document
6.1 Overview of system user boxes
The operations available after touching [Use Document] can be performed
with the system user boxes as shown below.
!
Detail
Documents saved in system user boxes can be deleted or the document
names can be changed. For details, refer to chapter 3, “Organizing user
box documents” on page 3-2.
Type Description Print documents
Send documents
Secure Print User
Box
This user box contains documents that were
saved from the printer driver with an ID and
password specified. The ID and password
must be entered in order to check the document contents.
o ×
Annotation User
Box
This user box contains documents saved from
Fax/Scan mode or Copy mode. Previously
specified text can be added to the documents
when they are printed or transmitted.
o o
Encrypted PDF
User Box
This user box contains encrypted PDF documents saved from PageScope Web Connection or PageScope Direct Print.
o ×
ID & Print User
Box
This user box appears when user authentication settings have been specified. A document
can be printed after the user has entered the
user name and password from a computer on
the network.
o ×
External Memory This user box appears when the optional local
interface kit is installed. A document saved on
external memory connected to the USB interface can be printed.
o ×Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-3
6.2 Secure Print User Box
Available printing parameters
Settings can be specified for the following when a document is printed.
!
Detail
The Fold/Bind settings are available only if optional Finisher FS-608 is installed.
The Z-Fold setting is available only if the Z-folding unit is installed on the
optional finisher FS-608/FS-517/FS-518.
The Punch settings are available only if the punch kit is installed on the
optional finisher.
The printouts are Z-folded only when the loaded size of the saved document supports Z-Fold (8-1/2 × 14 w,11 × 17 w, A3 w, B4 w or 8K w).
Available parameters Description Page reference
Copies Specify the number of copies to be printed. p. 4-8
Print Select whether a single-sided or double-sided
copy is to be printed.
p. 4-8
Finishing Specify settings for collating, grouping, stapling,
hole punching or folding/binding.
p. 4-9
Sheet/Cover/Chapter
Insert
Print the document with other paper added as cover sheets, insertions or chapter title pages.
p. 4-19
Stamp/Composition Print the document with the date/time, page
number or a stamp added.
p. 4-33Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-4
To print a document (Mode 1)
Follow the procedure described below when “Prohibited Functions When
Authentication Failed” (displayed by touching [Security Settings] on the Administrator Settings screen, then [Security Details]) is set to “Mode 1”.
1 Touch [Use Document].
2 Touch [System User Box].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-5
3 Touch [Secure Print User Box], and then touch [OK].
4 Type in the ID for the confidential document, and then touch [OK].
5 Type in the password for the confidential document, and then touch
[OK].
A list of the documents that can be printed is displayed.Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-6
6 Select the document to be printed.
7 Under “Action”, touch [Print].
8 Select the print settings.
9 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-7
!
Detail
For details on changing the settings, refer to the descriptions starting with
page 4-8.
To print a document (Mode 2)
Follow the procedure described below when “Prohibited Functions When
Authentication Error” (displayed by touching [Security Settings] on the Administrator Settings screen, then [Security Details]) is set to “Mode 2”.
1 Touch [Use Document].
2 Touch [System User Box].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-8
3 Touch [Secure Print User Box], and then touch [OK].
4 Type in the ID for the secured document, and then touch [OK].
A list of the documents that can be printed is displayed.
5 Select the document to be printed and then touch [Enter Password].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-9
6 Type in the password for the secured document, and then touch [OK].
7 Under “Action”, touch [Print].
8 Select the print settings.
9 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.
!
Detail
For details on changing the settings,refer to the descriptions starting with
page 4-5.Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-10
6.3 Annotation User Box
Available printing parameters
Settings can be specified for the following when a document is printed.
!
Detail
The Fold/Bind settings are available only if optional finisher FS-608 is installed.
The Z-Fold setting is available only if the Z-folding unit is installed on the
optional finisher FS-608/FS-517/FS-518.
The Punch settings are available only if the punch kit is installed on the
optional finisher.
The printouts are Z-folded only when the loaded size of the saved document supports Z-Fold (8-1/2 × 14 w,11 × 17 w, A3 w, B4 w or 8K w).
Available parameters Description Page reference
Copies Specify the number of copies to be printed. p. 4-8
Print Select whether a single-sided or double-sided
copy is to be printed.
p. 4-8
Finishing Specify settings for collating, grouping, stapling,
hole punching or folding/binding.
p. 4-9
Page Margin Print the document with a binding margin added. p. 4-16
Sheet/Cover/Chapter
Insert
Print the document with other paper added as cover sheets, insertions or chapter title pages.
p. 4-19
Stamp/Composition Print the document with the date/time, page
number or a stamp added.
p. 4-33Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-11
To print a document
1 Touch [Use Document].
2 Touch [System User Box].
3 Touch [Annotation User Box], and then touch [OK].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-12
4 Select the desired box, and then touch [OK].
A list of documents appears.
5 Select the document to be printed.
6 Under “Action”, touch [Print].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-13
7 Select the print settings.
8 If desired, touch [Preview], then [Details] on the left side of the screen
to check a preview image.
– For details on the Preview screen, refer to “Preview - Detail (Print/
Combine)” on page 2-79.
9 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.
!
Detail
For details on changing the settings, refer to the descriptions starting with
page 4-8.
Available transmission parameters
Document data saved in user boxes can be sent using four different methods.
Method Description
E-mail Document data can be sent as an e-mail attachment.
PC (SMB) Document data is sent to a shared folder on the specified computer.
FTP Document data is uploaded to the specified FTP server.
WebDAV Document data is sent to the specified server on the network.Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-14
2
Note
Documents saved from Copy mode cannot be sent.
Specify the destination using any of the following four methods depending
on the desired transmission purpose and use. Destinations can be specified
using any combination of these methods.
!
Detail
Up to 500 destinations can be specified from the address book and with
an Address search.
Up to five destinations can be entered directly each with e-mail transmissions, SMB transmissions, FTP transmissions and WebDAV transmissions.
In the screen for selecting a destination, touch [File Type], [Communication
Settings] or [Application] to specify detailed settings for sending. Settings
can be specified for the following.
File Type
Method Description Page reference
Address book destination
Select different destinations from those registered
in the address book.
p. 5-8
Group destinations Multiple destinations can be registered together
with this method. This is convenient when documents are always sent to the same destinations.
p. 5-9
Direct input With this method, destinations for e-mail transmissions, FTP transmissions, SMB transmissions and
WebDAV transmissions are entered directly from
the control panel. This is used when sending data
to a destination that is not already registered.
p. 5-13
Address search Select this method when an LDAP server is used.
Addresses registered on the LDAP server can be
searched for the address that corresponds to the
specified conditions.
p. 5-21
Parameter Description Page reference
File Type Select the file format for the scan data to be saved. p. 5-25Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-15
Communication Settings
Application
To send a document
1 In the Annotation User Box screen, select the document to be sent.
Parameter Description Page reference
E-Mail Settings Specify the document name, subject, From address and message body for sending e-mail messages.
p. 5-29
URL Notification Setting
Specify the e-mail address where notifications of
completion of the job are to be sent.
p. 5-30
Parameter Description Page reference
Stamp/Composition Print the document with the date/time, page
number or a stamp added.
p. 5-33
Send & Print Settings can be specified to print a document
when it is sent. In addition, various settings can be
specified when printing.
p. 5-49
Stamp Element The format of previously added text or distribution
numbers can be changed.
p. 6-17Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-16
2 Under “Action”, touch [Send].
3 Specify the destination and transmission settings.
4 If desired, touch [Preview], then [Details] on the left side of the screen
to check a preview image.
– For details on the Preview screen, refer to “Preview - Detail (Send/
Bind TX)” on page 2-80.
5 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.
!
Detail
For details on changing the settings,refer to the descriptions starting with
page 4-5.Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-17
2
Note
Transmission may not be possible if limitations have been placed on the
document name according to the destination server conditions. Since the
document name becomes the file name during transmission, consult
your network administrator when specifying the document name.
Changing the text
The format for text or distribution numbers is first specified for documents
saved in the Annotation User Box. This information can be changed when the
document is sent.
Settings can be specified for the following.
1 Touch [Application] in a screen for selecting a destination.
Parameter Description
Secondary Field Text can be added to the number that is printed. A maximum of 20
characters can be entered.
Date/Time Select the format for the date and time that is printed.
Density Select the density for the annotation numbers that are printed.
Number Type Select the output format (number of digits) for the annotation numbers that are printed.
Print Position Select the printing position.Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-18
2 Touch [Stamp Element].
The Change Text screen appears.
3 Touch the button for the setting to be changed, and then change the
setting.
– Touch [Secondary Field], type in the text to be added, and then
touch [OK].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-19
– Touch [Date/Time], select the format for the date and time to be
printed, and then touch [OK].
– Touch [Density], touch the button for the desired text density, and
then touch [OK].
– Touch [Number Type], select the format for the numbering, and
then touch [OK].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-20
– Touch [Print Position], select the printing position, and then touch
[OK].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-21
6.4 Encrypted PDF User Box
In order to print a document saved in the Encrypted PDF User Box, the password specified when the document was saved must be entered.
!
Detail
Documents are saved in the Encrypted PDF User Box by using PageScope Web Connection or PageScope Direct Print. For details on saving
documents, refer to the manual for the corresponding software.
2
Note
When printing an encrypted PDF file saved on external memory, select
the data in the External Memory screen, and then print it.
When printed, the encrypted PDF file on the external memory is saved in
the Encrypted PDF User Box on this machine. Access the Encrypted PDF
User Box on this machine, and then print the document.
Printing
1 Touch [Use Document].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-22
2 Touch [System User Box].
3 Touch [Encrypted PDF User Box], and then touch [OK].
A list of documents appears.
4 Select the document to be printed.Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-23
5 Under “Action”, touch [Print].
6 Type in the password, and then touch [OK].
Deleting
1 Touch [Use Document].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-24
2 Touch [System User Box].
3 Touch [Encrypted PDF User Box], and then touch [OK].
4 Select the document to be deleted.Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-25
5 Under “Action”, touch [Delete].
6 Check the message, touch [Yes] to delete the document, and then
touch [OK].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-26
6.5 ID & Print User Box
This user box appears if user authentication is applied. If an appropriate user
is logged on this machine, documents can be printed. Document data, which
is printed from a computer on the network by entering the user name and
password, is temporarily saved in the ID & Print User Box.
When documents are saved in ID & Print User Box, the following keys appear
on the login screen. Enter the user name and password, and then touch the
desired key.
2
Note
For details on saving document data sent for print jobs from a computer
to ID & Print User Box, refer to the User’s Guide [Print Operations].
!
Detail
Even if user authentication is not applied or for print jobs saved by a public user, print jobs can also be saved in ID & Print User Box. For details,
refer to “ID & Print Settings” on page 7-29.
When printing is completed, the data in ID & Print User Box is deleted.
Item Description
[Begin Printing] A document that is saved in ID & Print User Box can be printed without logging in.
[Print & Login] A document that is saved in ID & Print User Box can be printed when
a user is logged in.
[Login] Login only. After logging on, a document that is saved in ID & Print
User Box can be printed or deleted.Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-27
Printing
1 Touch [Use Document].
2 Touch [System User Box].
3 Touch [ID & Print User Box], and then touch [OK].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-28
4 Select the document to be printed.
5 Under “Action”, touch [Print].
Deleting
1 Touch [Use Document].
2 Touch [System User Box].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-29
3 Touch [ID & Print User Box], and then touch [OK].
4 Select the document to be deleted.
5 Under “Action”, touch [Delete].
6 Check the message, touch [Yes] to delete the document, and then
touch [OK].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-30
6.6 External Memory
If the optional local interface kit is installed, a document saved on external
memory can be printed from this machine.
Available printing parameters
Settings can be specified for the following when a document is printed.
File types that can be printed
- Only files with the format (extension) for PDF, JPEG, TIFF or XPS can be
printed.
- Files with the JPEG and XPS format cannot be printed double-sided and
cannot have holes punched or be stapled.
- PDF files up to version 1.6 can be printed with this machine.
Available parameters Description
Copies Use the keypad to type in the number of copies to be printed. A
number between 1 and 9999 can be specified.
Color Select whether printing is in full color or in black and white.
Print Select whether a single-sided or double-sided copy is to be printed.
Binding Position Select the binding margin position for double-sided printing. Select
a binding margin at the top, left or right side.
Finishing For details on the settings that can be specified, refer to“Specifying
Finishing settings” on page 4-9.
Paper Select the paper drawer containing the paper to be printed on.Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-31
Document Details
Select a file, and then touch [Document Details] to view information for the
selected document, such as its modification date and the document name.
To print a document
1 Press the [User Box] key in the control panel.
The User Box Operations screen appears.
2 Touch [Use Document].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-32
3 Touch [System User Box], and then touch [External Memory].
4 Touch [OK].
– Of the saved files, only the names of files with a format that can be
printed are displayed.
– A maximum of 255 printable files can be displayed in the folder with
the specified path. If there are more than 255 files in a single folder,
it may take some time to display the file list.
The configuration of the folders and files on the connected external
memory is displayed.
5 Select the document to be printed.
– The document to be printed can also be specified by typing in the
path to the folder containing it. Touch [File Path], and then type in
the path.
– To open the folder containing the currently selected item, touch
[Up].
– To view the contents of the folder, touch [Open].Printing/sending a system user box document
6
C550 6-33
– A maximum of 250 characters can be entered for the file path and
file name. If the number of characters exceeds this limit, the file list
cannot be displayed.
6 Touch [Print].
7 Specify the print settings.
8 Touch [Start], or press the [Start] key in the control panel.
To print an encrypted PDF file
When printing an encrypted PDF file saved on external memory, select the
data in the External Memory screen, and then print it.
When printed, the encrypted PDF file on the external memory is saved in the
Encrypted PDF User Box on this machine. Access the Encrypted PDF User
Box on this machine, and then print the document.7 Specifying Utility mode
parametersSpecifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-2
7 Specifying Utility mode parameters
7.1 Settings that can be specified from Utility mode
Various basic settings and advanced parameters for using this machine can
be set from the Utility mode. This chapter describes the procedures for setting the Utility mode parameters for the User Box functions.
Utility mode parameters
The following Utility mode parameters are described in this manual.
PageScope Web Connection
PageScope Web Connection is a device management utility supported by
the HTTP server integrated into the device. Using a Web browser on a computer connected to the network, machine settings can be specified from PageScope Web Connection.
Specifying settings with the utility is convenient since text can easily be
typed in from your computer instead of with the machine’s control panel.
Since some settings can only be specified with PageScope Web Connection,
refer to the PageScope Web Connection User’s Guide for details.
Parameter Description Page reference
One-Touch/User
Box Registration
Create new user boxes. “Registering user boxes” on
page 7-6
Administrator Settings
Specify various settings, for example, for
deleting documents from user boxes.
“User Box Settings” on
page 7-20
Specify limitations on the number of user
boxes that can be registered for each user.
“Maximum Number of User
Boxes” on page 7-18
Specify settings for the ID & Print User Box. “ID & Print Settings” on
page 7-29
Specify the password for the user box administrator.
“User Box Administrator
Setting” on page 7-31
Perform operations such as formatting the
hard disk and deleting data.
“HDD Setting” on page 7-34Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-3
7.2 User box permissions
Types of users
Users of various levels can use this machine. Other than machine administrators, user box administrators can use User Box functions. The following
types of users can access the various user boxes.
!
Detail
To log on as the user box administrator, type “boxadmin” as the user
name for user authentication and type the password specified in “User
Box Administrator Setting” on page 7-31.
Public user boxes and personal/group user boxes
The operations indicated below can be performed with public user boxes,
which can be accessed by all users, and with personal/group user boxes,
which can only be accessed by specific users.
*1 The operations can be performed only on user boxes created by the registered user.
*2 User box administrators and administrators can perform operations without entering the password, even if a password has been set for the user box.
Type Description
Public user This user has access when user authentication settings have not been applied.
Registered
user
These user are registered by the administrator when user authentication settings have been applied.
User box administrator
This user can log on as a box administrator when user authentication settings
have been applied. This user can access all user boxes, regardless of whether
a password has been specified.
Administrator This user can manage the machine. This user can create, change or delete any
user box, regardless of whether a password has been specified.
Operation Create boxes View/download/
delete documents
Change box
settings
Delete boxes
User box type Public Personal/
group
Public Personal/
group
Public Personal/
group
Public Personal/
group
Public user o × o × o × o ×
Registered user o o o o*1 o o*1 o o
User box administrator
o*2
o*2
o*2
o*2
o*2
o*2
o*2
o*2
Administrator o*2
× × × o*2
o*2
o*2
o*2Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-4
7.3 Displaying settings screens
Displaying the Administrator Settings screen
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Touch [3 Administrator Settings].
– An item can also be selected by pressing the key in the keypad for
the number beside the desired button. For [3 Administrator Settings], press the [3] key in the keypad.
3 Type in the password, and then touch [OK].
– For details on typing in text, refer to “Entering text” on page 8-3.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-5
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
The Administrator Settings screen appears.
!
Detail
If “Prohibited Functions When Authentication Error” is set to “Mode 2” an
incorrect administrator password is entered the specified number of
times, it is no longer possible to enter Administrator mode. For details on
the “Prohibited Functions When Authentication Error” parameter, refer to
the User’s Guide [Copy Operations].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-6
7.4 Registering user boxes
New user boxes can be registered. The following types of user boxes can be
registered.
!
Detail
If user authentication is canceled after personal user boxes are created,
the personal user boxes become public user boxes.
Bulletin board user boxes and relay user boxes can be created when optional fax kit FK-502 is installed. For details, refer to the User’s Guide [Fax
Operations].
If user authentication settings have been applied, be sure to type in the
ID and password, and touch [Login] or press [Access] key. If authentication settings have not been applied, personal user boxes cannot be created.
If optional fax kit FK-502 has been installed, confidential reception settings can be specified as advanced User Box functions.
Type Description
Public user boxes This shared user box can be accessed by everyone.
Personal user boxes This user box for an individual can only be accessed by users that have
logged on if user authentication settings have been applied.
Group user boxes This user box can only be accessed by users who belong to the account
and have logged on when account track settings have been specified.
Annotation user
boxes
This user box is used when an image of the date/time or an annotation
number is added to saved document data that is to be printed or transmitted. The type of text to be added can be specified when the document
is being used.
Annotation user boxes are registered in Administrator mode.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-7
Registering user boxes
Settings can be specified for the following when registering.
New screen 1/2
New screen 2/2
2
Reminder
If “Password Rules” is set to “Enable”, only a password with 8 digits can
be specified.
If a user box password containing less than 8 characters has already
been registered, change the password so that it contains 8 characters
before setting “Password Rules” to “Enable”. For details on the password rules, refer to the User’s Guide [Copy Operations].
Parameter Description
User Box No. The next available user box number is displayed. To specify a user box
number, touch [User Box No.], and then use the keypad to type in the
user box number (between 1 and 999999999).
User Box Name Touch [User Box Name], and then use the control panel keypad and the
keyboard that appears in the touch panel to type in the user box name
(20 characters or less). The same user box name can be specified for a
multiple number of user boxes if the boxes have been given different user
box numbers.
Password Specify a password to limit access to the user box. Touch [Password],
and then use the control panel keypad and the keyboard that appears in
the touch panel to type in the password (8 characters or less).
Index Select the index characters.
Type Depending on the user authentication and account track settings that
have been specified, select “Public”, “Personal” or “Group”.
If “Personal” was selected, specify the owner name. To change the owner, touch [Change Owner], and then select a different owner.
If “Group” was selected, specify the owner account. In the Change Owner screen, select a different owner account.
Parameter Description
Auto Document Delete Time
Select the time until the document is deleted after it is saved in the user
box.
Confidential RX This parameter appears when optional fax kit FK-502 is installed. Select
whether or not the confidential reception function is added to the user
box. If the confidential reception function is added, type in the confidential reception password.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-8
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Touch [1 One-Touch/User Box Registration].
3 Touch [2 Create User Box].
The Create User Box screen appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-9
4 Touch [1 Public/Personal User Box].
5 Touch [New].
New screen 1/2 appears.
6 Specify the desired settings.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-10
7 Touch [Forward→].
New screen 2/2 appears.
8 Specify the desired settings.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
9 Touch [OK].
The user box is registered.
!
Detail
In the screen showing the list of user boxes, registered user boxes can
be edited or deleted.
To change the settings, select the user box, and then touch [Edit].
To delete a user box, select the user box, and then touch [Delete].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-11
Registering annotation user boxes
Settings can be specified for the following when registering.
New screen 1/3
New screen 2/3
New screen 3/3
2
Reminder
If “Password Rules” is set to “Enable”, only a password with 8 digits can
be specified.
If a user box password containing less than 8 characters has already
been registered, change the password so that it contains 8 characters
Parameter Description
User Box No. The next available user box number is displayed. To specify a user box
number, touch [User Box No.], and then use the keypad to type in the user
box number (between 1 and 999999999).
User Box Name Touch [User Box Name], and then use the control panel keypad and the keyboard that appears in the touch panel to type in the user box name (20 characters or less). The same user box name can be specified for a multiple
number of user boxes if the boxes have been given different user box numbers.
Password Specify a password to limit access to the user box. Touch [Password], use
the control panel keypad and the keyboard that appears in the touch panel
to type in the password (8 characters or less).
Parameter Description
Count Up Select whether the count for the annotation number is formatted by jobs or
by pages.
Secondary Field Text can be added to the number that is printed. A maximum of 20 characters can be entered.
Date/Time Select the format for the date and time that is printed.
Density Select the density for the annotation numbers that are printed.
Number Type Select the output format (number of digits) for the annotation numbers that
are printed.
Print Position Select the printing position.
Primary Field Text can be added. A maximum of 40 characters can be entered.
Parameter Description
Auto Document
Delete Time
Select the time until the document is deleted after it is saved in the user box.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-12
before setting “Password Rules” to “Enable”. For details on the password rules, refer to the User’s Guide [Copy Operations].
1 Touch [3 One-Touch/User Box Registration] in the Administrator Settings screen.
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [2 Create User Box] in the One-Touch/User Box Registration
screen.
3 Touch [4 Annotation User Box].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-13
4 Touch [New].
New screen 1/3 appears.
5 Specify the desired settings.
6 Touch [Forward→].
New screen 2/3 appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-14
7 Specify the desired settings. The text can be specified in the corresponding screen.
– Secondary Field
– Date/TimeSpecifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-15
– Density
– Number Type
– Print PositionSpecifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-16
– Primary Field
8 Touch [Forward→].
New screen 3/3 appears.
9 Specify the desired settings.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
10 Touch [OK].
The user box is registered.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-17
!
Detail
In the screen showing the list of user boxes, registered user boxes can
be edited or deleted.
To change the settings, select the user box, and then touch [Edit].
To delete a user box, select the user box, and then touch [Delete].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-18
7.5 Maximum Number of User Boxes
Specify limitations on the number of user boxes that can be registered for
each user.
1 Touch [3 One-Touch/User Box Registration] in the Administrator Settings screen.
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [4 Maximum Number of User Boxes] in the One-Touch/User Box
Registration screen.
The Maximum Number of User Boxes screen appears.
3 Select a user type, and then select a user name.
The maximum number of user boxes can be specified for the selected
user.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-19
4 Specify the user box limitation settings.
– A maximum between 0 and 1,000 user boxes can be specified.
– If the maximum number of user boxes is set to “0”, new user boxes
cannot be registered.
– To specify no limit, touch [OFF] under “Max. No. of Use Boxes”.
– To specify a limit, touch [ON] under “Max. No. of Use Boxes”, use
the keypad to type in the maximum number of user boxes, and then
touch [Apply].
5 Touch [OK].
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-20
7.6 User Box Settings
Displaying the User Box Settings screen
1 Touch [1 System Settings] in the Administrator Settings screen.
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [0 User Box Settings] in the System Settings screen.
The User Box Settings screen appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-21
Delete Unused User Box
Boxes containing no saved documents can be deleted as unused boxes.
1 Touch [1 Delete Unused User Box] in the User Box Settings screen.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
2 To delete the user boxes, touch [Yes].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-22
Delete Secure Print Documents
All documents saved in the Secure Print User Box can be deleted.
1 Touch [2 Delete Secure Print Documents] in the User Box Settings
screen.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
2 To delete the documents, touch [Yes].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-23
Auto Delete Secure Document
Select the time until confidential documents are deleted after they are saved.
1 Touch [3 Auto Delete Secure Document] in the User Box Settings
screen.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
2 To specify the time setting, touch [Yes], and then select the time period.
– The time until documents are deleted can be set to 12 hours, 1 day,
2 days, 3 days, 7 days or 30 days.
– To not delete the documents, touch [No].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-24
Encrypted PDF Delete Time
Select the time until encrypted PDF files are deleted after they are saved.
1 Touch [4 Encrypted PDF Delete Time] in the User Box Settings screen.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
2 To specify the time setting, touch [Yes], and then select the time period.
– The time until documents are deleted can be set to 12 hours, 1 day,
2 days, 3 days, 7 days or 30 days.
– To not delete the documents, touch [No].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-25
ID & Print Delete Time
Specify the length of time until documents are deleted from the ID & Print
User Box after they are saved.
!
Detail
[ID & Print Delete Time] appears if user authentication settings have been
specified.
1 Touch [5 ID & Print Delete Time] in the User Box Settings screen.
2 To automatically delete the documents, touch [Yes], and then select
the time period.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-26
!
Detail
The time until documents are deleted can be set to 12 hours, 1 day, 2
days, 3 days, 7 days or 30 days.
2
Note
To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying the
changes to the settings.
To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/Counter]
key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in each screen
until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box mode appears.
Document Hold Setting
Select whether or not documents are automatically deleted when they are
transmitted or printed.
1 Touch [6 Document Hold Setting] in the User Box Settings screen.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
2 Specify the desired settings.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-27
– To not delete the document when it is printed or transmitted, touch
[ON].
– To delete the document when it is printed or transmitted, touch
[OFF].
External Memory Function Settings
Select whether or not external memory connected to the machine can be
used.
!
Detail
The default setting for saving a document to external memory is “OFF”
(cannot be saved). In addition, the user setting is “OFF” (cannot be
saved), even if user authentication settings have been specified. To save
documents to external memory, change the settings in Administrator
mode so that documents can be saved.
Settings can be specified for the following.
Parameter Description
Save Document Select whether or not a scanned document can be saved on external memory when [Save Document] is touched in User Box mode.
Print Document Select whether or not a document saved on external memory can
be printed or sent when [Use Document] is touched in User Box
mode.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-28
1 In the User Box Settings screen, touch [7 External Memory Function
Settings].
2 Specify the desired settings.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-29
7.7 ID & Print Settings
Settings concerning the ID & Print User Box can be specified. Settings can
be specified for the following.
2
Note
Public user jobs are printed or stored when printing by a public user is
permitted.
Jobs without authentication are printed or stored when “Print without Authentication” is permitted.
1 Touch [4 User Authentication/Account Track] in the Administrator Settings screen.
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [2 User Authentication Settings].
3 Touch [1 Administrative Settings].
Parameter Description
ID & Print “ON”: All the general print jobs and ID & Print jobs from the registered user are saved in the ID & Print User Box.
“OFF”: The ID & Print jobs from the registered user are saved in the
ID & Print User Box. General print jobs are output without being
saved in the ID & Print User Box.
Public User “Print Immediately”: Public user jobs or jobs without user authentication information are printed without being saved in the ID & Print
User Box.
“Save”: Public user jobs or jobs without user authentication information are saved in the ID & Print User Box.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-30
4 Touch [ID & Print Settings].
5 Specify the desired settings, and then touch [OK].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-31
7.8 User Box Administrator Setting
Select whether or not use by the box administrator is permitted. (The default
setting is “Allow”.)
When logging on as the box administrator, type “boxadmin” as the user
name in the user authentication screen, and then type in the password specified in step 5.
0 If both user authentication and account track settings are not applied, a
user box administrator cannot be specified.
1 Touch [Security Settings] in the Administrator Settings screen.
– For details on operations that can be performed by box administrators, refer to “User box permissions” on page 7-3.
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [2 User Box Administrator Setting] in the Security Setting
screen.
The User Box Administrator Setting screen appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-32
3 Select whether a user box administrator will be specified.
– To prohibit it, touch [Restrict], and then touch [OK].
– To allow it, touch [Allow], and then continue with step 4.
4 Type in the password for the user box administrator (up to 8 characters), and then touch [OK].
– For details on typing in text, refer to “Entering text” on page 8-3.
A screen for retyping the password appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-33
5 Type in the password again, and then touch [OK].
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
The password for the user box administrator is specified and use by the
user box administrator is permitted.
2
Reminder
If “Password Rules” is set to “Enable”, only a password with 8 digits can
be specified.
If a user box password containing less than 8 characters has already
been registered, change the password so that it contains 8 characters
before setting “Password Rules” to “Enable”. For details on the password rules, refer to the User’s Guide [Copy Operations].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-34
7.9 HDD Setting
Various hard disk operations are available, such as those for erasing data
from the hard disk and for checking the amount of free space on the hard
disk. Settings can be specified for the following.
!
Detail
The following data is erased when the hard disk is formatted.
Program destinations
Address book destinations
Authentication method settings
User authentication settings
Account track settings
User boxes
User box settings
Documents in user boxes
Secure print user box settings
Bulletin board user box settings
Parameter Description
Check HDD Capacity The amount of hard disk space that is used and that remains can
be checked.
Overwrite Temporary Data Select whether mode 1 or mode 2 is used as the method for overwriting data on the hard disk. When the security kit is installed, select whether encryption or overwriting is given priority.
Overwrite All Data All data can be overwritten.
HDD Lock Password Specify the hard disk locking password
HDD Encryption Setting Specify the setting for encrypting the data on the hard disk.
A setting is required only when the optional security kit is installed.
Format HDD Format the hard disk.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-35
Check HDD Capacity
The amount of space on the hard disk can be checked.
1 Touch [Security Settings] in the Administrator Settings screen.
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [6 HDD Setting] in the Security Setting screen.
3 Touch [1 Check HDD Capacity] in the HDD Setting screen.
The Check HDD Capacity screen appears.
4 Touch [Close].
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
The HDD Setting screen appears again.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-36
Overwrite Temporary Data
The setting for overwriting data on the hard disk can be specified. (The default setting is “Mode 1”.)
This machine destroys data by overwriting all data in the entire area where
an image was stored when that image data on the hard disk is considered
unnecessary. In addition, destroying the structure of data other than image
data prevents the disclosure of the data in case the hard disk is stolen.
2
Reminder
When the setting for giving priority to encryption or overwriting is
changed, the hard disk must be formatted.
1 Touch [Security Settings] in the Administrator Settings screen.
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [6 HDD Setting] in the Security Setting screen.
3 Touch [2 Overwrite Temporary Data] in the HDD Setting screen.
– Select “Encryption Priority” when performing high-level security encryption processing. However, data overwriting with encryption of
the hard disk differs depending on whether “Mode 1” or “Mode 2”
is selected. Normally, “Encryption Priority” is selected.
– If “Overwrite Priority” is selected, data overwriting with encryption
of the hard disk is performed depending on whether “Mode 1” or
“Mode 2” is selected. Select this setting when the format of the
data written to the hard disk is considered important.
Setting Description
Mode 1 Overwritten with 0x00
Mode 2 Overwritten with 0x00 → Overwritten with 0xff →
Overwritten with the letter “A” (0x61) → VerifiedSpecifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-37
– When the security kit is not installed:
– When the security kit is installed:
The Overwrite Temporary Data screen appears.
4 To overwrite the data, touch [Yes], and then select the overwriting
method.
– If the security kit is installed, touch [Encryption Priority] or [Overwrite Priority].
5 Touch [OK].
– If “Encryption Priority” and “Overwrite Priority” was changed, continue with step 6.
The mode for overwriting temporary data is specified.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-38
6 If a message appears, asking whether to reformat the hard disk, touch
[Yes].
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch [No].
7 Follow the instructions in the screen to restart the machine.
8 If an error message appears, indicating that the encryption key does
not match, the Administrator Settings screen appears. In this screen,
touch [Format HDD].
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-39
2
Reminder
When the machine is turned off, then on again with the main power
switch, wait at least 10 seconds to turn on the machine after turning it off;
otherwise, the machine may not function correctly.
In order to enable the setting specified in the Overwrite Temporary Data
screen, “Overwrite Temporary Data” must be set to “Yes”.
Overwrite All Data
The machine can be set to overwrite all data on the hard disk.
The methods for overwriting data are described below.
2
Reminder
Perform this operation before disposing of the machine. Before performing this operation, be sure to consult with your service representative.
2
Note
The operation for Mode 1 takes approximately 40 minutes.
1 Touch [Security Settings] in the Administrator Settings screen.
Setting Description
Mode 1 Overwritten with 0x00
Mode 2 Overwritten with random 1-byte numbers → Overwritten with random 1-
byte numbers → Overwritten with 0x00
Mode 3 Overwritten with 0x00 → Overwritten with 0xff → Overwritten with random
1-byte numbers → Verified
Mode 4 Overwritten with random 1-byte numbers → Overwritten with 0x00 → Overwritten with 0xff
Mode 5 Overwritten with 0x00 → Overwritten with 0xff → Overwritten with 0x00 →
Overwritten with 0xff
Mode 6 Overwritten with 0x00 → Overwritten with 0xff → Overwritten with 0x00 →
Overwritten with 0xff → Overwritten with 0x00 → Overwritten with 0xff →
Overwritten with random number
Mode 7 Overwritten with 0x00 → Overwritten with 0xff → Overwritten with 0x00 →
Overwritten with 0xff → Overwritten with 0x00 → Overwritten with 0xff →
Overwritten with 0xaa
Mode 8 Overwritten with 0x00 → Overwritten with 0xff → Overwritten with 0x00 →
Overwritten with 0xff → Overwritten with 0x00 → Overwritten with 0xff →
Overwritten with 0xaa → VerifiedSpecifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-40
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [6 HDD Setting] in the Security Setting screen.
3 Touch [3 Overwrite All Data] in the HDD Setting screen.
The Overwrite All Data screen appears.
4 Select the desired method for overwriting data on the hard disk, and
then touch [Overwrite].
A confirmation message appears, asking whether or not to overwrite
the data.
5 To overwrite the data, touch [Yes], and then touch [OK].
– To return to the Overwrite All Data screen without overwriting the
data, touch [No].Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-41
6 Follow the instructions in the screen to restart the machine.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
All data on the hard disk is overwritten.
2
Reminder
While the data is being overwritten, do not use the main power switch to
turn the machine off and on.
When the machine is turned off, then on again with the main power
switch, wait at least 10 seconds to turn on the machine after turning it off;
otherwise, the machine may not function correctly.
HDD Lock Password
The password for locking the hard disk can be specified.
The hard disk locking password is extremely important in order to protect the
data on the hard disk. Keep the password in a safe place so that it will not
be lost.
2
Reminder
Be sure to keep the password in a safe place so that it will not be lost. If
the password is lost, significant restoration operations will be required for
recovery.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-42
1 Touch [Security Settings] in the Administrator Settings screen.
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [6 HDD Setting] in the Security Setting screen.
3 Touch [4 HDD Lock Password] in the HDD Setting screen.
The HDD Lock Password screen appears. From this screen, the password can be changed or the hard disk locking password can be canceled.
4 Type in the password (20 characters long), and then touch [OK].
– Do not specify a password that is the same character repeated 20
times.
– For details on typing in text, refer to “Entering text” on page 8-3.
A screen for retyping the password appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-43
5 Type the password specified in step 4, and then touch [OK].
The message “Turn the main switch OFF and ON.” appears.
6 Follow the instructions in the screen to restart the machine.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
The hard disk locking password is set.
2
Reminder
Be sure to keep the specified password in a safe place so that it will not
be lost.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-44
HDD Encryption Setting
If the security kit is installed, the machine can be set to encrypt the hard disk.
!
Detail
[HDD Encryption Setting] appears when security kit SC-503 is installed.
If the encryption key is specified or changed, data saved on the hard disk
may no longer be available.
1 Touch [Security Settings] in the Administrator Settings screen.
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [6 HDD Setting] in the Security Setting screen.
3 Touch [HDD Encryption Setting] in the HDD Setting screen.
A message appears, requesting confirmation to specify the setting.
4 To encrypt the data, touch [Yes], and then touch [OK].
The HDD Encryption Setting screen appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-45
5 Using the control panel keypad or the keyboard that appears in the
touch panel, type in the new encryption key. To delete the entered encryption key, press the [C] (clear) key.
The HDD Encryption Setting screen appears again.
6 Follow the instructions in the screen to restart the machine.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-46
2
Note
The encryption key must be registered by the machine’s administrator.
The encryption key must contain 20 characters.
Do not specify an encryption key that contains the same character repeated 20 times.
Be sure to keep the specified encryption key in a safe place so that it will
not be lost.
2
Reminder
When the machine is turned off, then on again with the main power
switch, wait at least 10 seconds to turn on the machine after turning it off;
otherwise, the machine may not function correctly.
Format HDD
The hard disk can be formatted.
2
Note
When the hard disk is formatted, the data saved on the hard disk is
erased.
1 Touch [Security Settings] in the Administrator Settings screen.
– For details on displaying the Administrator Settings screen, refer to
“Displaying the Administrator Settings screen” on page 7-4.
2 Touch [6 HDD Setting] in the Security Setting screen.
3 Touch [Format HDD] in the HDD Setting screen.
A confirmation message appears, asking whether or not to format the
hard disk.Specifying Utility mode parameters
7
C550 7-47
4 To format the hard disk, touch [Yes], and then touch [OK].
– To return to the HDD Settings screen without formatting the hard
disk, touch [No].
The hard disk is formatted.
5 Follow the instructions in the screen to restart the machine.
– To cancel changes to the settings, touch the menu item name in the
Bookmark screen to return to the selected screen without applying
the changes to the settings.
– To finish specifying settings in the Utility mode, press the [Utility/
Counter] key. Otherwise, exit the Utility mode by touching [Close] in
each screen until the screen for the Copy, Fax/Scan or User Box
mode appears.
2
Reminder
When the machine is turned off, then on again with the main power
switch, wait at least 10 seconds to turn on the machine after turning it off;
otherwise, the machine may not function correctly.8 AppendixAppendix
8
C550 8-2
8 Appendix
8.1 Error message list
If any of the following error messages appear, perform the operations described below.
2
Note
For details on the network settings, refer to the User’s Guide [Network
Scanner Operations].
Message Cause and remedy
Cannot connect to the
network.
A connection to the network could not be established. Check if the
network cable is correctly connected. In addition, check that the Network Setting parameters on the Administrator mode have been correctly specified.
The destination cannot
be selected because the
number of destinations
has exceeded the max.
number of broadcasting
possible.
The number of destinations specified exceeds the number possible
for a broadcast transmission. Reduce the number of broadcast destinations, or send the transmission in multiple batches.
Image could not be
saved in the User Box
due to insufficient HDD
capacity check log.
The hard disk is full. Delete unnecessary data, and then try saving the
data again.
The number of User Boxes has reached its maximum.
The number of user boxes that can be registered has reached the
maximum number possible. Delete unnecessary user boxes, and
then try registering new boxes again.
This user box has
reached its maximum
number of documents
allowed.
The number of documents that can be saved in a user box has
reached the maximum number possible. Delete unnecessary documents, and then try saving the document again.
The number of programmed jobs has
reached the max. allowance.
Wait until a programmed
job is completed.
The number of jobs that can be programmed has reached the maximum number possible. Wait until a job has been completed, or delete a current job.Appendix
8
C550 8-3
8.2 Entering text
The following procedure describes how to use the keyboard that appears in
the touch panel for typing in the names of registered users and custom paper
sizes. The keypad can also be used to type in numbers.
Any of the following keyboards may appear.
Example
Password input screen:
Screen for entering the name of a custom paper size:
Touching [Shift] switches the keyboard display between lowercase letters
(numbers) and uppercase letters (symbols).Appendix
8
C550 8-4Appendix
8
C550 8-5
Enlarging the keyboard
The keyboard can be displayed larger so that it easier to read.
1 While the keyboard is displayed, touch [Enlarge ON].
The keyboard is displayed enlarged.
2 To cancel the enlarged display and return the keyboard to its normal
size, touch [Enlarge OFF] while the keyboard is displayed enlarged.
2
Note
The keyboard is used in the same way, even when it is displayed enlarged.Appendix
8
C550 8-6
To type text
% Touch the button for the desired character from the keyboard that appeared.
– To type in uppercase letters or symbols, touch [Shift].
– Numbers can also be typed in with the keypad.
The entered characters appear in the text box.
2
Note
To revert to the setting when the keyboard was displayed, touch [Cancel].
To clear all entered text, press the [C] (clear) key.
Some buttons may not appear, depending on the characters being entered.
!
Detail
To change a character in the entered text, touch [←] and [→] to move the
cursor to the character to be changed, touch [Delete], and then type in
the desired letter or number.
List of Available Characters
space
Alphanumeric
characters/
symbolsAppendix
8
C550 8-7
8.3 Glossary
Term Definition
10Base-T/100Base-TX/
1000Base-T
An Ethernet standard, which is a cable consisting of twisted copper
wire pairs. The transmission speed of 10Base-T is 10 Mbps, of
100Base-TX is 100 Mbps, and of 1000Base-T is 1000 Mbps.
Adobe®
Flash®
Software developed by Adobe Systems, Inc. (formaly developed by
Macromedia, Inc.), and used to create data combining vector-graphic animation and sound, and the format of this data file. The bidirectional content can be manipulated using a keyboard and a mouse.
The files can be kept relatively compact, and they can be accessed
with the Web browser plug-in.
anonymous FTP While normal FTP sites are protected by an account name and password, this type of FTP site can be used by anyone without a password by simply entering “anonymous” as the account name.
Auto IP A function for automatically acquiring the IP address. If acquisition
of the IP address failed with DHCP, an IP address is acquired from
the address space of 169.254.0.0.
bit Abbreviation for Binary Digit. The smallest unit of information (data
quantity) on a computer or printer. Displays data using 0 or 1.
Bit-mapped Font Fonts that are represented by a set of dots to form the character.
Dithering may occur if the character size is increased.
BMP Abbreviation for Bitmap. A file format for saving image data which
uses the .bmp extension. Commonly used on Windows platforms.
You can specify the color depth from monochrome (2 values) to full
color (16,777,216 colors). Images are not usually compressed when
saved.
Byte Unit of information (data quantity) on a computer or printer. Configured as 1 byte equals 8 bits.
Compact PDF Compression method for reducing the data amount using the PDF
format when converting color documents to data.
The highest compression efficiency is achieved by identifying the
text and image regions and using the resolution and compression
method most appropriate for each region.
The compact PDF format can be selected when converting documents to data using the scanning functions of this machine.
Contrast The difference in intensity between the light and dark parts of the image (light/dark variation). An image with little light/dark variation is
said to have a low contrast, and an image with large light/dark variation is said to have a high contrast.
Default The initial settings. The settings first selected when the machine is
turned on, or the settings first specified when the function is selected.
Default Gateway A device, such as a computer or router, used as a “gateway” to access computers not on the same LAN
Density An indication of the amount of darkness in the image
Density Adjustment The function that adjusts the color tones of an output device, such
as a printer or monitorAppendix
8
C550 8-8
DHCP Abbreviation for Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. A protocol in
which a client computer on a TCP/IP network automatically specifies
the network settings from the server. With collective management of
the IP address for DHCP clients on the DHCP server, you can avoid
duplication of an address and you can build a network easily.
Dither A method of using only black and white to create the illusion of different shades of gray. The process is simpler than with error diffusion; however, some irregularities may occur.
DNS Abbreviation for Domain Name System. A system that acquires the
supported IP addresses from host names in a network environment.
DNS allows the user to access other computers over a network by
specifying host names, instead of difficult to memorize and understand IP addresses.
DPI (dpi) Abbreviation for Dots Per Inch. A resolution unit used by printers and
scanners. Indicates how many dots per inch are represented in an
image. The higher the value, the higher the resolution.
Driver Software that works as a bridge between a computer and a peripheral device.
Ethernet LAN transmission line standard
File Extension The characters added to the file name in order to differentiate file formats. The file extension is added after a period, for example, “.bmp”
or “.jpg”.
FTP Abbreviation for File Transfer Protocol. A protocol for transferring
files over the Internet or an intranet on the TCP/IP network.
Gradation The light and dark levels of an image. As the number increases,
smoother brightness variations can be reproduced.
Grayscale Monochrome image expressive form using the gradation information
from black to white
Halftone The method of producing the light and dark parts of an image
through varying sizes of black and white dots
Hard Disk Large capacity storage device for storing data. The data can be
stored even if the power is turned off.
HTTP Abbreviation for HyperText Transfer Protocol. A protocol used to
send and receive data between a Web server and a client (Web
browser). Documents containing images, recordings, and video clips
can be exchanged with the expressive form information.
ID & Print Function that allows you to print the job sent from the printer driver
when performing user authentication.
Install To install hardware, operating systems, applications, printer drivers
on to a computer
IP Address A code (address) that is used to identify individual network devices
over the Internet. A maximum of three digits for four numbers are
displayed such as 192.168.1.10. IP addresses are assigned to devices, including computers, which are connected to the Internet.
JPEG Abbreviation for Joint Photographic Experts Group. One of the file
formats for saving image data. (The file extension is “.jpg”.) The compression ratio is roughly 1/10 to 1/100. This format uses an effective
method in the compression of continuous-tone images, such as
photographs.
Term DefinitionAppendix
8
C550 8-9
Kerberos A type of network authentication system used by Windows 2000 or
later. Used in Active Directory authentication. Users can be safely
and efficiently authenticated with a two-phase authentication (user
logon and network resource usage) on a dependable site set up on
the network.
LAN Abbreviation for Local Area Network. A network which connects
computers on the same floor, in the same building, or in neighboring
buildings.
LDAP Abbreviation for Lightweight Directory Access Protocol. On a TCP/
IP network, such as the Internet or an intranet, this protocol is used
to access a database for managing environment information and the
e-mail addresses of network users.
Memory Storage device for storing data temporally. When the power is
turned off the data may or may not be erased.
Multi-Page TIFF A single TIFF file that contains multiple pages
OS Abbreviation for Operating System. Basic software for controlling
the system of a computer.
PASV Abbreviation for PASsiVe. A mode for connecting to an FTP server
from within a firewall. If this mode is not specified, the firewall will be
considered inaccessible and the connection will be terminated, preventing the file from being sent.
PDF Abbreviation for Portable Document Format. An electronically formatted document which uses the .pdf extension. Based on the PostScript format, you can use the free Adobe Reader software to view
documents.
Pixel An image pixel. The smallest unit of an image.
Plug-and-play Ability to automatically find and use the appropriate driver when a
peripheral device is connected to a computer
Port Number The number that identifies the transmission port for each process
running on a computer on the network. The same port cannot be
used by multiple processes.
PPI Abbreviation for Pixels Per Inch. Measuring unit for resolution, particularly for monitors and scanners. This measurement indicates the
number of image pixels contained within 1 inch.
Preview A function that allows you to view an image before processing a print
or scan job
Print Job Print request transmitted from a computer to a printing device
Property Attribute information
When using a printer driver, various functions can be specified in the
file properties.
In the file properties, you can check the attribute information of the
file.
Protocol The rules that allow computers to communicate with other computers or peripheral devices
Proxy Server A server that is installed to act as an intermediary connection between each client and different servers to effectively ensure security
over the entire system for Internet connections
Term DefinitionAppendix
8
C550 8-10
Resolution Displays the ability to reproduce the details of images and print matter correctly
Scanning With the scanning operation of the scanner, an image is read while
the row of image sensors is gradually moved. The direction that the
image sensors are moved is called the main scanning direction, and
the direction in which the image sensors are arranged is called the
sub-scanning direction.
Screen Frequency Indicates the density of dots used to create the image
Single-Page TIFF A single TIFF file that contains only a single page
SMB Abbreviation for Server Message Block. A protocol that shares files
and printers over a network and which is mainly used by Microsoft
Windows.
SSL/TLS Abbreviation for Secure Socket Layer/Transport Layer Security. The
encoding method for safely transmitting data between the Web server and browser.
Subnet Mask The unit used to divide a TCP/IP network into small networks (subnetworks). It is used to identify the bits in a network address that are
higher than the IP address.
TCP/IP Abbreviation for Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol.
The de facto standard protocol used by the Internet that uses IP addresses to identify each network device.
Thumbnail A small image that shows the contents of the image or document file
(the image displayed when the file was opened)
TIFF Abbreviation for Tagged Image File Format. One of the file formats
for saving image data. (The file extension is “.tif”.) Depending on the
tag indicating the data type, information for various image formats
can be saved in a single image data.
TWAIN The interface standard for imaging devices, such as scanners and
digital cameras, and for applications, such as graphics software. In
order to use a TWAIN-compliant device, the TWAIN driver is required.
Uninstall To delete software installed on a computer
USB Abbreviation for Universal Serial Bus. A general interface standard
for connecting a mouse, printer, and other devices to a computer.
Web Browser Software such as Internet Explorer and Netscape Navigator for viewing Web pages
Term Definition9 IndexIndex
9
C550 9-2
9 Index
9.1 Index
Numerics
1-Sided/2-Sided ...............................4-8
A
Address search ..............................5-21
Administrator Settings screen ..........7-4
Annotation User Box ............6-10, 7-11
Auto Delete Secure Document .......7-23
B
Background Adjustment ................2-52
Bind TX ...........................................5-52
Book Copy .....................................2-58
C
Caution explanation .......................x-18
Changing document name .............3-10
Changing text .................................6-17
Chapters .........................................4-29
Check HDD Capacity .....................7-35
Check Job ......................................5-56
Check Job Settings ........................2-76
Check Job Settings - Destination
Settings ..........................................2-77
Check Job Settings - E-Mail
Settings ..........................................2-77
Color ...............................................2-50
Combined printing ..........................4-66
Control panel ....................................1-8
Copies ..............................................4-8
Copy protect ..................................4-44
Cover Sheet ...................................4-19
Creating user boxes .........................7-6
Current Jobs .................................. 2-69
D
Date/Time ............................ 4-33, 5-33
Delete Secure Print Documents .... 7-22
Delete Unused User Box ............... 7-21
Deleting documents ........................ 3-8
Density .......................................... 2-49
Detail ............................................. 2-76
Detail - Check Original Settings .... 2-75
Detail - Check Scan Settings ........ 2-74
Detail explanation ...........................x-18
Digital Signature ............................ 5-32
Direct input .................................... 2-24
Document Details .......................... 3-16
Document Hold Setting ................. 7-26
Document names ............................ 2-4
Duplicating documents ................. 3-14
E
E-Mail Encryption .......................... 5-31
E-Mail Settings .............................. 5-29
Encrypted PDF Delete Time .......... 7-24
Encrypted PDF User Box .... 2-38, 6-21
Entering text .................................... 8-3
Erase ............................................. 2-56
Error message list ............................ 8-2
F
File Document ................................. 3-2
File Type .............................. 2-44, 5-25
Finishing .......................................... 4-9
Format HDD .................................. 7-46Index
9
C550 9-3
G
Glossary ...........................................8-7
Group destinations ...........................5-9
H
HDD Encryption Setting .................7-44
HDD Lock Password ......................7-41
HDD Setting ...................................7-34
Header/Footer ......................4-61, 5-44
I
Icon ................................................1-12
ID & Print Delete Time ....................7-25
ID & Print Settings ..........................7-29
ID & Print User Box ........................6-26
Insert Sheet ....................................4-24
J
Job History .....................................2-70
Job List ...........................................2-67
Job List - Delete .............................2-68
Job List - Job Details .....................2-68
L
Left panel .......................................2-67
M
Maximum Number of User
Boxes .............................................7-18
Moving documents ........................3-12
N
Note explanation ............................x-18
O
Original Settings .............................2-64
Original Type ..................................2-40
Overwrite All Data ..........................7-39
Overwrite Temporary Data .............7-36
P
Page Margin .................................. 4-16
Page Number ...................... 4-36, 5-37
Preview .......................................... 2-78
Previewing ..................................... 3-19
Print settings ................................... 4-6
Printing and saving ........................ 2-32
R
Registered destinations ................... 5-8
Reminder explanation ....................x-18
Resolution ..................................... 2-43
S
Saving copy documents ................ 2-13
Saving in User Box mode .............. 2-27
Saving scanned data ..................... 2-17
Scan Settings ................................ 2-39
Scan Size ...................................... 2-60
Searching for a destination ........... 5-11
Searching for user box name .......... 3-6
Secure Print User Box ........... 2-36, 6-3
Send & Print .................................. 5-49
Sending documents ........................ 5-2
Separate Scan ............................... 2-50
Settings when using documents ... 2-75
Sharpness ..................................... 2-54
Simplex/Duplex ............................. 2-42
Stamp .................................. 4-41, 5-41
Stamp Repeat ............................... 4-53
System user boxes .......................... 6-2
T
Text entry ........................................ 8-3
Touch panel ................................... 1-11Index
9
C550 9-4
U
URL Notification Setting .................5-30
Use Document .................................4-2
User authentication ..........................2-2
User Box Administrator Setting .....7-31
User box destinations ....................2-22
User box permissions ......................7-3
User Box Settings ..........................7-20
User’s guide conventions ...............x-18
User’s guides .................................x-20
Utility mode ......................................7-2
W
Warning explanation ......................x-18Copyright
A00J-9644-44 2006 2008. 4
http://konicaminolta.com
User’s Guide [Advanced Function Operations]bizhub 423/363/283/223 contents-1
Table of contents
1 Introduction
1.1 Welcome .......................................................................................................................................... 1-2
1.1.1 User's guides ..................................................................................................................................... 1-2
1.1.2 User's Guide ...................................................................................................................................... 1-3
1.2 Use conditions................................................................................................................................. 1-4
1.3 Conventions used in this manual .................................................................................................. 1-5
1.3.1 Symbols used in this manual ............................................................................................................. 1-5
To use this machine safely................................................................................................................. 1-5
Procedural instruction........................................................................................................................ 1-5
Key symbols....................................................................................................................................... 1-6
1.3.2 Original and paper indications ........................................................................................................... 1-6
Original and paper sizes .................................................................................................................... 1-6
Original and paper indications ........................................................................................................... 1-6
2 Overview
2.1 Overview of each function ............................................................................................................. 2-2
2.1.1 Supported function table ................................................................................................................... 2-2
2.1.2 Key layout after the function is expanded ......................................................................................... 2-2
2.1.3 Functions available with expanded functions.................................................................................... 2-3
3 Assigning Application Keys
3.1 Overview .......................................................................................................................................... 3-2
3.1.1 Key layout after the function is expanded ......................................................................................... 3-2
3.1.2 [Application Menu] ............................................................................................................................. 3-3
3.2 Customizing the application keys 1 and 2.................................................................................... 3-4
3.2.1 [Application Key Settings].................................................................................................................. 3-4
4 Web Browser Function
4.1 Overview .......................................................................................................................................... 4-2
4.1.1 Available operations with the Web Browser function ........................................................................ 4-2
4.1.2 Specifications..................................................................................................................................... 4-2
Specifications for Web Browser ........................................................................................................ 4-2
Restrictions on Flash Player .............................................................................................................. 4-3
4.2 Displaying Web Browser ................................................................................................................ 4-4
4.3 Configuring settings to enable use of the Web browser............................................................. 4-5
4.3.1 Restricting the use of the Web browser in the MFP .......................................................................... 4-5
[Web Browser Setting] ....................................................................................................................... 4-5
4.3.2 Restricting the use of Web browser for each user ............................................................................ 4-6
[Function Permission]......................................................................................................................... 4-6
4.3.3 Restricting the use of local contents ................................................................................................. 4-7
[Web browser contents access]......................................................................................................... 4-7
4.4 Basic operation ............................................................................................................................... 4-8
4.4.1 Screen components........................................................................................................................... 4-8
4.4.2 Operating instructions........................................................................................................................ 4-9
Operation using the Touch Panel ...................................................................................................... 4-9
Operation using the Keypad .............................................................................................................. 4-9
4.4.3 How to enter text ............................................................................................................................. 4-10
Entering text..................................................................................................................................... 4-10
4.4.4 Screen display mode ....................................................................................................................... 4-10
[Normal]............................................................................................................................................ 4-10bizhub 423/363/283/223 contents-2
[Just-Fit Rendering].......................................................................................................................... 4-10
[Smart-Fit Rendering]....................................................................................................................... 4-10
4.4.5 Specifying speaker volume.............................................................................................................. 4-11
4.5 Toolbar........................................................................................................................................... 4-12
4.5.1 Description of the toolbar ................................................................................................................ 4-12
4.5.2 [Favorites] - [List].............................................................................................................................. 4-13
List of favorites................................................................................................................................. 4-13
4.5.3 [Favorites] - [Add]............................................................................................................................. 4-13
4.5.4 [Address] .......................................................................................................................................... 4-14
4.5.5 [History]............................................................................................................................................ 4-14
[Display History] ............................................................................................................................... 4-14
4.5.6 [Print]................................................................................................................................................ 4-15
4.5.7 [Menu] .............................................................................................................................................. 4-15
4.6 Configuring the Web Browser settings....................................................................................... 4-16
4.6.1 [Page Operation] .............................................................................................................................. 4-16
4.6.2 [Display]............................................................................................................................................ 4-16
4.6.3 [Manage windows] ........................................................................................................................... 4-17
4.6.4 [Settings] .......................................................................................................................................... 4-17
4.7 Printing, displaying, or saving a document file .......................................................................... 4-18
4.7.1 Printing a document file ................................................................................................................... 4-18
4.7.2 Displaying a document file............................................................................................................... 4-19
4.7.3 Saving a document file .................................................................................................................... 4-20
4.8 Uploading a document file ........................................................................................................... 4-21
4.8.1 Restrictions ...................................................................................................................................... 4-21
4.8.2 Uploading a scanned document file ................................................................................................ 4-21
4.8.3 Uploading a document file in a User Box ........................................................................................ 4-22
5 PageScope Web Connection (Web Browser Function)
5.1 Using PageScope Web Connection .............................................................................................. 5-2
5.1.1 Prior check......................................................................................................................................... 5-2
5.1.2 How to access ................................................................................................................................... 5-2
5.2 Screen components........................................................................................................................ 5-3
5.3 Logging in and logging out ............................................................................................................ 5-4
5.3.1 Login .................................................................................................................................................. 5-4
5.3.2 Logout................................................................................................................................................ 5-4
5.4 Using the User Box function .......................................................................................................... 5-5
5.4.1 Open User Box .................................................................................................................................. 5-5
[Open User Box]................................................................................................................................. 5-5
[File List]............................................................................................................................................. 5-6
5.4.2 Document operations ........................................................................................................................ 5-7
Printing a document........................................................................................................................... 5-7
Deleting a document.......................................................................................................................... 5-9
6 Image Panel
6.1 Overview .......................................................................................................................................... 6-2
Features ............................................................................................................................................. 6-2
6.2 Displaying the Image Panel............................................................................................................ 6-3
6.3 Operating Image Panel................................................................................................................... 6-4
6.3.1 Screen components........................................................................................................................... 6-4
6.3.2 General operation .............................................................................................................................. 6-5
6.3.3 Reading a document.......................................................................................................................... 6-7
Scanning a document........................................................................................................................ 6-7
Retrieving from User Box................................................................................................................... 6-8
Retrieving a document from an external memory.............................................................................. 6-9
Using data saved in a cellular phone or PDA .................................................................................. 6-10bizhub 423/363/283/223 contents-3
6.3.4 Editing the document....................................................................................................................... 6-11
[Preview]........................................................................................................................................... 6-11
[Document/Page] - [Edit Document] ................................................................................................ 6-11
[Document/Page] - [Combine Documents]...................................................................................... 6-12
[Document/Page] - [Document Settings] ......................................................................................... 6-13
[Return to Scan Dest.]...................................................................................................................... 6-13
6.3.5 Specifying a destination................................................................................................................... 6-14
Printing............................................................................................................................................. 6-14
Specifying destinations.................................................................................................................... 6-15
Saving a document in an external memory ..................................................................................... 6-15
6.3.6 Checking the send tray .................................................................................................................... 6-16
Send Tray......................................................................................................................................... 6-16
[Check TX Tray]................................................................................................................................ 6-16
6.3.7 Sending data from a cellular phone or PDA .................................................................................... 6-17
6.4 Registering a photo in the address book ................................................................................... 6-18
6.4.1 Specifications of photo data............................................................................................................ 6-18
6.4.2 Registering photo data .................................................................................................................... 6-19
6.5 Customizing Image Panel ............................................................................................................ 6-21
6.5.1 Customizing the Read Data area ..................................................................................................... 6-21
6.5.2 Customizing the Document Destination area .................................................................................. 6-22
6.5.3 Deleting a registered shortcut icon.................................................................................................. 6-23
7 PDF Processing Function
7.1 Overview .......................................................................................................................................... 7-2
Available operations with the PDF processing function .................................................................... 7-2
7.2 PDF document properties .............................................................................................................. 7-3
7.3 Encrypting PDF document and adding digital signature ............................................................ 7-4
7.3.1 Password-based encryption.............................................................................................................. 7-4
7.3.2 Digital ID-based encryption ............................................................................................................... 7-5
7.4 Direct Print....................................................................................................................................... 7-7
8 Searchable PDF function
8.1 Overview .......................................................................................................................................... 8-2
Precautions when creating searchable PDF files .............................................................................. 8-2
Recognizable character size.............................................................................................................. 8-2
8.2 Configuring the OCR operation setting ........................................................................................ 8-3
[OCR Operation Setting] .................................................................................................................... 8-3
8.3 Configuring the searchable PDF setting....................................................................................... 8-4
9 My Panel Function
9.1 Overview .......................................................................................................................................... 9-2
9.1.1 Available operations with My Panel ................................................................................................... 9-2
Customizable items ........................................................................................................................... 9-2
Functions available by linking to the Web browser ........................................................................... 9-2
Functions available with Image Panel................................................................................................ 9-3
9.1.2 My Panel acquisition procedure ........................................................................................................ 9-3
9.1.3 Restrictions on using the My Panel function ..................................................................................... 9-3
9.2 Displaying My Panel........................................................................................................................ 9-4
9.2.1 Main Menu ......................................................................................................................................... 9-4
9.2.2 Displaying Main Menu........................................................................................................................ 9-4
9.3 Customizing My Panel.................................................................................................................... 9-5
9.3.1 [My Panel Settings] ............................................................................................................................ 9-5
9.3.2 Displaying [My Panel Settings]........................................................................................................... 9-5
9.3.3 [Language Setting]............................................................................................................................. 9-6
9.3.4 [Measurement Unit Settings].............................................................................................................. 9-6
9.3.5 [Copier Settings] ................................................................................................................................ 9-7bizhub 423/363/283/223 contents-4
[Default Tab]....................................................................................................................................... 9-7
[Shortcut Key 1] - [Shortcut Key 2] .................................................................................................... 9-7
[Quick Settings 1] - [Quick Settings 4] ............................................................................................... 9-8
[Default Tab Density Settings]............................................................................................................ 9-8
9.3.6 [Scan/Fax Settings]............................................................................................................................ 9-9
[Default Tab]....................................................................................................................................... 9-9
[Address Book Index Default] ............................................................................................................ 9-9
[Shortcut Key 1] - [Shortcut Key 2] .................................................................................................. 9-10
[Default Address Book] .................................................................................................................... 9-10
[Default Address Type]..................................................................................................................... 9-10
9.3.7 [User Box Settings] .......................................................................................................................... 9-11
[Default Tab]..................................................................................................................................... 9-11
[Shortcut Key 1] - [Shortcut Key 2] .................................................................................................. 9-11
9.3.8 [Color Selection Settings] ................................................................................................................ 9-12
9.3.9 [Main Menu Settings] ....................................................................................................................... 9-12
Main menu button............................................................................................................................ 9-12
Registering a main menu button...................................................................................................... 9-12
9.3.10 [Initial Screen Settings] .................................................................................................................... 9-13
10 My Address function
10.1 Overview ........................................................................................................................................ 10-2
10.1.1 Classification of address books....................................................................................................... 10-2
Public address book ........................................................................................................................ 10-2
My Address Book ............................................................................................................................ 10-2
10.1.2 My Address Book acquisition procedure......................................................................................... 10-3
10.1.3 Restrictions on using the My Address function ............................................................................... 10-3
10.2 Registering and editing a destination ......................................................................................... 10-4
10.2.1 Address Book .................................................................................................................................. 10-4
10.2.2 Group ............................................................................................................................................... 10-5
10.3 Copying destinations between address books.......................................................................... 10-7
10.3.1 Copying destinations from the public address book to My Address Book..................................... 10-7
10.3.2 Copying destinations from My Address Book to the public address book..................................... 10-8
10.4 Using My Address Book when sending a document................................................................. 10-9
10.4.1 Specifying destinations.................................................................................................................... 10-9
10.4.2 Searching for destinations ............................................................................................................... 10-9
11 Index
11.1 Index by item ................................................................................................................................. 11-2
11.2 Index by button.............................................................................................................................. 11-31 Introductionbizhub 423/363/283/223 1-2
1.1 Welcome
1
1 Introduction
1.1 Welcome
Thank you for purchasing this machine.
This User's Guide describes the overview and usage of functions available by registering an optional license
kit to this machine, and functions available by connecting it to an application. To use each function effectively,
please read this User's Guide.
1.1.1 User's guides
Printed manual Overview
[Quick Guide Copy/Print/Fax/Scan/Box Operations]
This manual describes operating procedures and the
functions that are most frequently used in order to enable you to begin using this machine immediately.
This manual contains notes and precautions that should
be followed to ensure safe usage of this machine.
Please be sure to read this manual before using this machine.
User's guide CD manuals Overview
[User's Guide Copy Operations] This manual describes details on copy mode operations
and the settings of this machine.
• Specifications of originals and copy paper
• Copy function
• Maintaining this machine
• Troubleshooting
[User's Guide Enlarge Display Operations] This manual describes details on operating procedures
of the enlarge display mode.
• Copy function
• Scanning function
• G3 fax function
• Network fax function
[User's Guide Print Operations] This manual describes details on printer functions.
• Printer function
• Setting the printer driver
[User's Guide Box Operations] This manual describes details on user box functions.
• Saving data in user boxes
• Retrieving data from user boxes
• Transferring and printing data from user boxes
[User's Guide Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax
Operations]
This manual describes details on transmitting scanned
data.
• E-mail TX, FTP TX, SMB TX, Save in User Box, WebDAV TX, Web Services
• G3 fax
• IP Address Fax, Internet Fax
[User's Guide Fax Driver Operations] This manual describes details on the fax driver function
that transmits faxes directly from a computer.
• PC-FAX
[User's Guide Network Administrator] This manual describes details on setting methods for
each function using the network connection.
• Network settings
• Settings using PageScope Web Connectionbizhub 423/363/283/223 1-3
1.1 Welcome
1
1.1.2 User's Guide
This User's Guide is intended for users ranging from those using this machine for the first time to administrators.
It describes basic operations, functions that enable more convenient operations, simple troubleshooting operations, and various setting methods of this machine.
Note that basic technical knowledge about the product is required to enable users to perform troubleshooting
operation. Limit your troubleshooting operations to the areas explained in this manual.
Should you experience any problems, please contact our service representative.
[User's Guide Advanced Function Operations] This manual describes details on functions that become
available by registering the optional license kit and by
connecting to an application.
• Web browser function
• Image panel
• PDF Processing Function
• Searchable PDF
• My panel and My address functions
[Trademarks/Copyrights] This manual describes details on trademarks and copyrights.
• Trademarks and copyrights
User's guide CD manuals Overviewbizhub 423/363/283/223 1-4
1.2 Use conditions
1
1.2 Use conditions
Enabling i-Option LK-101 v2 or i-Option LK-103 v2 allows you to access the Internet from the Control Panel of the MFP.
Users will bear a responsibility for contents accessed, downloaded, and uploaded using Web Browser in the
MFP, and other communicated contents. Users shall conform to the company rules and laws of the country
where this machine is used.
Konica Minolta Business Technologies, Inc. and its group businesses will not bear any responsibility for use
of the Internet by users.
i-Option LK-103 v2 may not be available depending on the area. For details, contact your service representative.bizhub 423/363/283/223 1-5
1.3 Conventions used in this manual
1
1.3 Conventions used in this manual
1.3.1 Symbols used in this manual
Symbols are used in this manual to express various types of information.
The following describes each symbol related to correct and safe usage of this machine.
To use this machine safely
7 WARNING
- This symbol indicates that a failure to heed the instructions may lead to death or serious injury.
7 CAUTION
- This symbol indicates that negligence of the instructions may lead to mishandling that may cause injury
or property damage.
NOTICE
This symbol indicates a risk that may result in damage to this machine or documents.
Follow the instructions to avoid property damage.
Procedural instruction
0 This check mark indicates an option that is required in order to use conditions or functions that are prerequisite for a procedure.
1 This format number "1" represents the first step.
2 This format number represents the order of serial steps.
% This symbol indicates a supplementary explanation of a procedural instruction.
% This symbol indicates transition of the Control Panel to access a desired menu item.
This symbol indicates a desired page.
The operation procedures are described using
illustrations.bizhub 423/363/283/223 1-6
1.3 Conventions used in this manual
1
d Reference
This symbol indicates a reference.
View the reference as required.
Key symbols
[ ]
Key names on the touch panel or computer screen, or a name of user's guide are indicated by these brackets.
Bold text
This presents a key name, part name, product name or option name on the control panel.
1.3.2 Original and paper indications
Original and paper sizes
The following explains the indication for originals and paper described
in this manual.
When indicating the original or paper size, the Y side represents the
width and the X side the length.
Original and paper indications
w indicates the paper size with the length (X) being longer than the
width (Y).
v indicates the paper size with the length (X) being shorter than the
width (Y).2 Overviewbizhub 423/363/283/223 2-2
2.1 Overview of each function
2
2 Overview
2.1 Overview of each function
The following describes the overview of each function.
Reference
- To use the advanced function, an optional Upgrade Kit UK-203 is required.
- A Hard Disk must be installed in the MFP in order to use the advanced function.
- For details on the license kit registration and enabling functions on MFPs, refer to the [Quick Guide
Copy/Print/Fax/Scan/Box Operations].
- To connect the function to the application, enable it at the application side. For details on enabling the
function, refer to the manual for the corresponding application.
2.1.1 Supported function table
The following table shows the supported functions for the license kits and applications.
2.1.2 Key layout after the function is expanded
Adding the Web Browser function, Image Panel function or My Panel function changes the usage of the User
Box, Fax/Scan, and Copy keys on the Control Panel.
- The User Box key functions as an Application Menu, and the Fax/Scan and Copy keys function as
application keys.
- Press Application Menu to display the [Application Menu], which allows you to switch to the added
function.
- To fit the use status, the function to be assigned to the application key can be changed.
For details, refer to page 3-2.
Web Browser Image panel PDF processing
Searchable
PDF
i-Option LK-101 v2 o o − −
i-Option LK-102 − − o −
i-Option LK-103 v2 o o o −
i-Option LK-105 − − − o
My Panel My Address
PageScope My Panel Manager o obizhub 423/363/283/223 2-3
2.1 Overview of each function
2
2.1.3 Functions available with expanded functions
The following describes the overview of each function. For details, refer to the reference described below.
Reference
- When the accounting management device is installed in the MFP, Image Panel cannot be used.
Function Overview Reference
Web Browser This function can be used by registering i-Option LK-101 v2 or i-Option
LK-103 v2 in the MFP.
By using the Control Panel of the MFP connected to the network, you
can access to the Internet or intranet and display or print the contents.
Also, through a Web browser, you can operate PageScope Web Connection of the MFP connected to the network and use documents saved
in User Boxes.
p. 4-2
p. 5-2
Image Panel This function can be used by registering i-Option LK-101 v2 or i-Option
LK-103 v2 in the MFP.
Image Panel is a new intuitive and easy-to-understand panel interface.
This panel helps you easily image the entire operation flow from loading
to sending a document.
You can add photo data to the one-touch destinations using PageScope Web Connection. The registered photo data is applied to the address list of Image Panel.
p. 6-2
PDF processing This function can be used by registering i-Option LK-102 or i-Option
LK-103 v2 in the MFP.
Performs password- or digital ID-based encryption of PDF, adds a digital
signature, and configures property settings when distributing documents in the PDF format using the scan or User Box function.
p. 7-2
Searchable PDF This function is available when i-Option LK-105 is registered with the
MFP.
You can create a text searchable PDF file by pasting transparent text
data on the area of a document in which characters are recognized
through an OCR process.
You can create a searchable PDF file when saving or sending an original
in the PDF format using the scan or User Box functions.
p. 8-2
My Panel This function is used in connection with the PageScope My Panel Manager.
Available by centrally managing the environment of the Control Panel
customized by the user depending on the application (My Panel), and
then obtaining My Panel on the MFP selected by the user.
p. 9-2
My Address This function is used in connection with the PageScope My Panel Manager.
Available by centrally managing the personal address book (My Address
Book) by the server, and then obtaining My Address Book on the MFP
selected by the user.
p. 10-23 Assigning Application Keysbizhub 423/363/283/223 3-2
3.1 Overview
3
3 Assigning Application Keys
3.1 Overview
The following describes the key layout and [Application Menu] of the Control Panel.
3.1.1 Key layout after the function is expanded
Adding the Web Browser function, Image Panel function or My Panel function allows User Box to function
as Application Menu, and Fax/Scan and Copy as application keys.
Reference
- The Web Browser and Image Panel functions can be used by registering i-Option LK-101 v2 or i-Option LK-103 v2 in the MFP.
- The My Panel function is used in connection with the PageScope My Panel Manager.
No. Name Description
1 Application menu Press this key to display the [Application Menu]. You cannot assign a different function to this key.
If a function is added, attach a Application Menu sticker (included in the
Upgrade Kit UK-203) to change the key name on the Control Panel.
For details, refer to page 3-3.
2 Application key 1 The fax/scan function is assigned by default. The administrator can assign
a different function to this key.
If the function assigned to the key is changed, attach a sticker describing
the new function (included in the Upgrade Kit UK-203) to change the key
name on the Control Panel.
For details on assigning a function, refer to page 3-4.
1 2 3bizhub 423/363/283/223 3-3
3.1 Overview
3
3.1.2 [Application Menu]
Press Application Menu to display the [Application Menu].
To use a function not assigned to the application key 1 or 2, you can switch functions to a desired one from
the [Application Menu].
3 Application key 2 The copy function is assigned by default. The administrator can assign a
different function to this key.
If the function assigned to the key is changed, attach a sticker describing
the new function (included in the Upgrade Kit UK-203) to change the key
name on the Control Panel.
For details on assigning a function, refer to page 3-4.
No. Name Descriptionbizhub 423/363/283/223 3-4
3.2 Customizing the application keys 1 and 2
3
3.2 Customizing the application keys 1 and 2
To fit the use status, the function to be assigned to the application keys 1 and 2 can be changed.
3.2.1 [Application Key Settings]
To assign a function to the application keys 1 and 2, use [Application Key Settings].
1 Press Utility/Counter to display [Utility].
2 Press [Administrator Settings].
3 Enter the administrator password, and then press [OK].
4 Press [System Settings].
5 In [System Settings] (2/2), press [Application Key Settings].
6 Select an application key ([Key 1] or [Key 2]) to which you assign a function.bizhub 423/363/283/223 3-5
3.2 Customizing the application keys 1 and 2
3
7 Select a function to be assigned.
8 Press [OK].
The function is assigned to the application key.4Web Browser Functionbizhub 423/363/283/223 4-2
4.1 Overview
4
4 Web Browser Function
4.1 Overview
The Web Browser function prints, displays, and saves contents on the Internet or intranet by accessing them
from the Control Panel of the MFP connected to the network.
Reference
- This function can be used on the MFP with i-Option LK-101 v2 or i-Option LK-103 v2 registered.
4.1.1 Available operations with the Web Browser function
The Web Browser function allows you to perform the following operations.
- Displaying and printing Web contents on the Internet or intranet.
- Displaying, printing, and saving a document file on the Internet or intranet.
- Uploading a scanned document file or a document file saved in a User Box to a server on the Internet
or intranet.
- Sharing documents in the User Box of MFPs on the network using PageScope Web Connection.
- When the My Panel function is available, you can personalize the user operation environment of the
Web browser by linking the Web browser with My Panel.
d Reference
For details on using PageScope Web Connection from the Control Panel, refer to page 5-2.
For details on My Panel, refer to page 9-2.
4.1.2 Specifications
Specifications for Web Browser
The following shows the major specifications of the Web Browser installed in the MFP.
Item Specifications
Browser engine NetFront
Supported protocols HTTP (HTTP/0.9, 1.0, 1.1), HTTPS, TCP/IP
Supported markup
language
HTML 4.01, XHTML 1.1/Basic
Supported style sheet Part of CSS1 and 2
Supported script language
Part of JavaScript 1.5, ECMAScript 3rd Edition, Ajax (limited to the scope supported by JavaScript)
Supported DOM Part of Level 1 and 2
Supported format JPEG, BMP, PNG, GIF, animation GIF, PDF, Flash 7.0 and earlier
Supported SSL/TLS
versions
SSL 2.0, SSL 3.0, TLS 1.0
Supported character
codes
Japanese (Shift_JIS), Japanese (ISO-2022-JP), Japanese (EUC-JP), Chinese
Simplified (GB2312), Chinese Traditional (Big5), Western European (ISO-8859-
1), Unicode (UTF-8)
Display mode Normal, Just-Fit Rendering, Smart-Fit Rendering
PDF viewer Adobe®
Reader
®
LE
Flash player Adobe®
Flash®
Player 7bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-3
4.1 Overview
4
Restrictions on Flash Player
There are following restrictions on the Flash Player installed in Web Browser.
- The function to generate an event by key operations is not supported.
- The functions to paste or obtain data such as character strings from the clipboard are not supported.
- The context menu is not supported.
- The print function of Flash is not supported.
- The functions to execute JavaScript from Flash or operate Flash from JavaScript are not supported.
- The screen without a window (pop-up) is not supported.
- The favorite function of Flash is not supported.
- The function to communicate data in real time using the Flash Media Server is not supported.
- The XMLSocket-based communication function is not supported.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-4
4.2 Displaying Web Browser
4
4.2 Displaying Web Browser
In [Application Menu], press [Web Browser]. The page specified as the home is displayed.
Reference
- If a login user is using the Web browser linked to My Panel and the user presses [Web Browser], the
Web browser setting and information related to the user is downloaded to the MFP from the server. If
the user has specified a personal home page, that page is displayed.
- When the Web browser starts, you can specify whether to display the home page or the last page that
was visited. For details, refer to page 4-17.
d Reference
For details on the [Application Menu], refer to page 3-3.
For details on My Panel, refer to page 9-2.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-5
4.3 Configuring settings to enable use of the Web browser
4
4.3 Configuring settings to enable use of the Web browser
If you do not want to allow use of the Web browser in the MFP, you can restrict its use without disabling the
license kit. Also, you can restrict use of the Web browser for each user.
4.3.1 Restricting the use of the Web browser in the MFP
If you do not want to allow use of the Web browser, you can restrict its use without disabling the license kit.
[Web Browser Setting]
1 Press Utility/Counter to display [Utility].
2 Press [Administrator Settings].
3 Enter the administrator password, and then press [OK].
4 Press [Network Settings].
5 In [Network Settings] (2/2), press [Web Browser Setting].
6 Select [Invalid], and then press [OK].
Reference
- If [Web Browser Setting] is set to [Invalid], [Web Browser] is hidden in the [Application Menu].bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-6
4.3 Configuring settings to enable use of the Web browser
4
4.3.2 Restricting the use of Web browser for each user
If user management is performed in the MFP, you can restrict use of the Web browser for each user.
[Function Permission]
1 Press Utility/Counter to display [Utility].
2 Press [Administrator Settings].
3 Enter the administrator password, and then press [OK].
4 Press [User Authentication/ Account Track].
5 In [User Authentication Settings], press [User Registration].
6 Select the user you want to restrict use of the Web browser, and press [Edit].
% If you want to restrict public users to use the Web browser, press [ ] and select [Public].
7 Press [Function Permission].
8 In [Function Permission] (3/3), specify [Web Browser] to [Restrict], and press [OK].
Reference
- This setting is not available if [Invalid] is specified in [Administrator Settings]ö[Network Settings]ö[Web Browser Setting].
- Configuring the function permission of the public user is available when public user access is allowed
in [Administrator Settings]ö[User Authentication/ Account Track]ö[General Settings]ö[Public User
Access].
- If users are managed in the external server, you can configure the default settings for function permissions to users who log in to the MFP using external server authentication for the first time. To configure
it, select [Administrator Settings]ö[User Authentication/ Account Track]ö[User Authentication Settings]ö[Administrative Settings]ö[Default Function Permission]ö[Web Browser]. For details on [Default Function Permission], refer to the [User's Guide Network Administrator].bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-7
4.3 Configuring settings to enable use of the Web browser
4
4.3.3 Restricting the use of local contents
If the Web browser is used through the use of an application that interacts with the Web browser, you can
access the files (pre-installed contents, image files, help files, etc.) saved in the HDD of the MFP from the
Web browser.
The administrator can restrict the use of files saved in the HDD of the MFP from the Web browser as required.
Reference
- For details on the application that interacts with the Web browser, contact your service representative.
[Web browser contents access]
1 Press Utility/Counter to display [Utility].
2 Press [Administrator Settings].
3 Enter the administrator password, and then press [OK].
4 Press [Security Settings].
5 Press [Security Details].
6 In [Security Details] (4/4), specify [Web browser contents access] to [Restrict], and press [OK].bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-8
4.4 Basic operation
4
4.4 Basic operation
4.4.1 Screen components
The Web browser screen has the following components.
Reference
- When the optional local connection kit is installed in the MFP, sound from Web pages or Flash contents
can be output through the speaker in the local connection kit. The speaker volume can be adjustable
using the speaker icon. For details, refer to page 4-11.
No. Name Description
1 Toolbar Operates Web Browser or configure the Web Browser settings. It is always
displayed on the Web Browser screen.
For details, refer to page 4-12.
2 Scroll bar Appears on the right of the screen when all display contents are not displayed vertically in one screen.
Appears at the bottom of the screen when all display contents are not displayed horizontally in one screen.
3 Window When multiple windows are displayed, you can switch the window using
the tab located at the bottom of the screen.
Press [e] in the active tab to close the window.
4 Icon The icon that represents the connection status appears when loading contents.
If the optional local connection kit is installed in the MFP, the speaker icon
is displayed.
1
4 3
2bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-9
4.4 Basic operation
4
4.4.2 Operating instructions
Operate Web Browser mainly on the Touch Panel. You can perform some of the operations from the Keypad
of the Control Panel.
Reference
- Using the Stylus Pen to operate the Touch Panel provides operating comfort.
Operation using the Touch Panel
Operate Web Browser mainly on the Touch Panel.
- To select an item, press a desired item.
- If a link is provided in the contents, press the link to jump to it.
- If you need to enter characters, press the entry form in the dialog box or contents. The keyboard screen
appears. To enter characters, use the keyboard screen.
- To scroll the screen, press [ ], [ ], [ ], or [ ] on the scroll bar.
Operation using the Keypad
You can use the Keypad in the Control Panel to enter numeric values or select items in the list.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-10
4.4 Basic operation
4
4.4.3 How to enter text
If you need to enter characters, press the entry form in the dialog box or contents. The keyboard screen appears.
Entering text
Press the character you want to enter in the keyboard screen.
- To enter uppercase letters or symbols, press [Shift].
- You can also enter numbers using the Keypad.
Reference
- To change a character in the entered text, press [ ] or [ ] to move the cursor to the character to be
changed, press [Delete], and then enter the desired letter or number.
- To delete all characters entered, press C (clear) in the Control Panel.
- To revert to the setting when the keyboard was displayed, press [Undo].
- Some buttons may not appear, depending on the characters being entered.
- When entering character codes on multiple lines is allowed, the linefeed button appears.
4.4.4 Screen display mode
There are three types of display modes for the Web Browser screen.
[Normal]
This is the display mode same as that for the normal Web Browser. Content is not adjusted to the screen
size. Scroll the screen horizontally and vertically when browsing it.
(The default is set to [Normal]. )
[Just-Fit Rendering]
The content layout is maintained and a page is displayed by reducing its width to fit the screen. Scroll the
screen horizontally and vertically when browsing it.
[Smart-Fit Rendering]
The table is divided and laid out vertically to fit the width of the screen. Scroll the screen horizontally and vertically when browsing it. The layout may be changed depending on the page to be displayed.
d Reference
For details on changing the display mode, refer to page 4-16.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-11
4.4 Basic operation
4
4.4.5 Specifying speaker volume
When the optional local connection kit is installed in the MFP, sound from Web pages or Flash contents can
be output through the speaker in the local connection kit.
If a speaker is connected to the MFP, the speaker icon is displayed at the bottom left of the Web browser.
Press the speaker icon to display the Volume screen where you can control the speaker volume.
- To increase the volume one level, press [Higher], or the # key on the Control Panel.
- To reduce the volume one level, press [Lower], or the * key on the Control Panel.
- Pressing [Mute] outputs no sound. In addition, the speaker icon changes to the speaker mute icon.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-12
4.5 Toolbar
4
4.5 Toolbar
The toolbar on the top of the Web Browser screen allows you to perform various operations and configure
various settings.
4.5.1 Description of the toolbar
The following shows the functions of the buttons on the toolbar.
Icon Name Description
Back Brings you back to the previous page.
Next Brings you to the next page.
Reload/Abort Reloads the currently displayed page to update the contents.
If you press this button while loading a page, the loading stops.
Home Displays the page registered as the home.
By default, "http://www.konicaminolta.com/" is registered.
For details on changing the home page, refer to page 4-16.
[Favorites] -
[List]
Displays the list of registered favorites.
For details, refer to page 4-13.
[Favorites] -
[Add]
Adds the URL of the currently displayed page to the favorites. Adding a URL to the favorites requires the administrator authority.
For details, refer to page 4-13.
[Address] Brings you to the screen to enter a URL.
For details, refer to page 4-14.
[History] Displays the list of pages displayed up till then.
For details, refer to page 4-14.
[Print] Prints the currently displayed contents.
For details, refer to page 4-15.
[Menu] Configure the Web browser settings. There are two types of menus;
one for the user and one for the administrator.
For details, refer to page 4-15.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-13
4.5 Toolbar
4
4.5.2 [Favorites] - [List]
Press [List] to display the list of the registered favorites using the thumbnails. Selecting a favorite allows you
to access the corresponding URL.
Reference
- If the user is using the Web browser linked to My Panel, the list of favorites for the user who is managed
in the server is displayed.
List of favorites
Press to display the list of operations available for the item. From this list, select the desired operation.
The following shows the available operations.
4.5.3 [Favorites] - [Add]
(Adding a URL to the favorites requires the administrator authority. )
Pressing [Add] prompts you to enter the administrator password. Enter the administrator password and press
[OK]. The registration screen appears. Check the contents and press [OK]. The URL of the displayed page is
added to the favorites. The MFP can hold up to 100 favorites.
- To register the thumbnail images of the page to be added to the favorites, select the [Register Thumbnail] check box on the registration screen.
- It is registered with the title previously given to the contents. To change the title, press the entry form
for the title on the registration screen, and then change the title.
Reference
- For users using the Web browser by linking to My Panel, administrator authority is not required. My Panel can hold up to 20 favorites for each user.
Item Description
[List View]/[Thumbnail
View]
Switches the favorites display between the list display and thumbnail view.
[Address View]/[Title
View]
Switches the display of favorites between the address view and title view.
[Delete All] Deletes all registered favorites.
Deleting the favorites requires the administrator authority.
[Close] Closes the list of favorites.
Item Description
[Open New Window] Opens the selected favorite with a new window.
[Edit] Edits the title and address of the selected favorite.
Editing the favorites requires the administrator authority.
[Up] Brings you above the selected favorite.
Use this button when the list of favorites is displayed in the list view.
[Down] Brings you below the selected favorite.
Use this button when the list of favorites is displayed in the list view.
[Delete] Deletes the selected favorite.
Deleting the favorites requires the administrator authority.
[Close] Closes this screen.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-14
4.5 Toolbar
4
4.5.4 [Address]
Press [Address] to display the screen for entering the address.
Press the entry form to display the keyboard screen. Enter the URL of the page to be displayed, and press
[OK] or [Open New Window].
Press [Input History] to display the list of input history. You can reference the past inputs. The MFP can hold
up to 100 input history records.
Reference
- If you display the screen for entering the address, you see the URL of the page being displayed. To
delete the URL currently shown, display the keyboard screen and press [Delete]. Press C (clear) in the
Control Panel to delete all data entries.
- If the user is using the Web browser linked to My Panel, the list of input history records for the user who
is managed in the server is displayed. My Panel can hold up to 20 input history records for each user.
4.5.5 [History]
Press [History] to display the display history screen. From the list of display history, select a page to be displayed again. The MFP can hold up to 100 display history records.
Reference
- If the user is using the Web browser linked to My Panel, the list of display history records for the user
who is managed in the server is displayed. My Panel can hold up to 20 display history records for each
user.
[Display History]
Press to display the list of operations available for the item. From this list, select the desired operation.
The following shows the available operations.
Item Description
[Address View]/[Title
View]
Switches the display history between the address view and title view.
[Delete All] Deletes all registered entries in the display history.
Deleting the display history requires the administrator authority.
[Close] Closes the list of display history.
Item Description
[Open New Window] Loads the selected display history with a new window.
[Delete] Deletes the selected display history.
Deleting the display history requires the administrator authority.
[Close] Closes this screen.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-15
4.5 Toolbar
4
4.5.6 [Print]
Press [Print] to display the Print screen.
Configure the print settings, and then press [Start] or the Start key on the control panel. The displayed contents are printed.
Reference
- If you attempt to print a Web page or JPEG or other image that takes up a large amount of memory, a
scan error may occur and printing will be disabled.
- The setting value of [Finishing] varies depending on which options are installed.
– The Staple settings are available only if the optional finisher is installed.
– The Punch settings are available only if the punch kit is installed on the optional finisher.
– The Fold and Center Staple & Fold functions can be used when a saddle stitcher is installed on the optional finisher.
4.5.7 [Menu]
Press [Menu] to configure the Web Browser settings. There are two types of menus; one for the user and one
for the administrator.
For details, refer to page 4-16.
Item Description
[Paper] Select the size of paper for printing.
[Simplex/Duplex] Select whether to print in 2-sided mode.
[Stamp Settings] Specify whether to print the [Title], [URL], [Date/Time], and [Page Number].
[Finishing] Configure settings for collating, grouping, offsetting. stapling, hole punching,
folding, or binding.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-16
4.6 Configuring the Web Browser settings
4
4.6 Configuring the Web Browser settings
Pressing [Menu] in the tool bar displays the menu for the user. Users can only view the Web browser operation settings and information.
The administrator of the MFP can configure the operating environment and security settings in addition to the
Web browser operation settings. To display the administrator menu, press [Administrator] in the menu
screen, and enter the administrator password.
4.6.1 [Page Operation]
In the [Page Operation] tab, configure the settings for page operation.
Reference
- Items with
*
are displayed only for the administrator menu.
- [Use for Home Page] is displayed for users using the Web browser by linking to My Panel.
4.6.2 [Display]
In the [Display] tab, configure settings for displaying contents. The administrator of the MFP can configure
the settings to hide or display images and animations, enable or disable JavaScript, and make detailed setting related to the contents display.
Item Description
[Use for Home Page]
*
Registers the displayed page as the home page.
[Page Memo] Displays the page saved as a page memo. Selecting the page memo from the
list displays the corresponding page.
Press to display the list of operations available for the item. From this list,
select the desired operation.
[Save as Page Memo] Saves the displayed page as it is.
[Zoom Display] Press [Zoom Display] to display the key to enlarge or reduce the page display
size. Press the key to adjust the page display size.
Item Description
[Display Mode] Select the display mode for Web Browser from [Normal], [Just-Fit Rendering],
and [Smart-Fit Rendering].
For details, refer to page 4-10.
[Encoding] Specify the encode type to be used when displaying contents.
[Detail Settings] Configure settings for displaying contents.
• [Image]: Select this check box to display images.
• [Animation]: Select this check box to display animation GIF.
• [Table]: Select this check box to recognize the table in HTML and adjust
the layout.
• [JavaScript]: Select this check box to enable JavaScript in contents.
• [CSS]: Select this check box to enable CSS in contents.
• [Ward Wrap]: Select this check box to enable the word wrap in contents.
• [Line Boundary Char. Check]: Select this check box to enable the line
boundary character check in contents.
• [Rapid-Render]: Select this check box to enable the Rapid-Render function.
• [Pop-Up Window]: Select this check box to allow displaying the pop-up
window.
• [Offline Permission]: Select this check box to allow the use of the contents
off-line.
• [Auto Flash Playback]: Select this check box to automatically play a Flash
content.
• [Enable Offline Display]: Select this check box to enable viewing of the contents off-line. Displayed when [Offline Permission] is allowed by the administrator.
[Color Selection Setting]
Select a color for the selected item ([Green], [Blue], [Yellow], or [Orange]).bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-17
4.6 Configuring the Web Browser settings
4
4.6.3 [Manage windows]
In the [Manage windows] tab, operate the window. Up to five windows can be opened.
4.6.4 [Settings]
The [Settings] tab allows you to check and reset the Web browser information. The administrator of the MFP
can configure the operating environment and security settings of the Web browser.
Reference
- Items with
*
are displayed only for the administrator menu.
- The following settings are available for users using the Web browser by linking to My Panel.
– [Startup Settings]
– Setting for deleting [Cookies]
– Setting for deleting [Authentication Information]
- My Panel can hold up to 20 items of cookies and authentication information for each user.
Item Description
[Create new window] Displays the contents of the URL registered as the home page with a new window.
[Open in new window] Displays the link destination page with a new window.
[Close active window] Closes the active window.
[Close other windows] Closes all windows.
This is not selectable when only one window is open.
Item Description
[Startup Settings]
*
Specify whether to display the page registered as the home page or the last
page being displayed when you exited Web Browser previously, at the startup
of Web Browser.
[Security]
*
Configure SSL or TLS setting, or display a root certificate or CA certificate.
[Cookies]
*
Configure settings to receive and delete cookies. This menu is also used to delete all cookies saved in the MFP.
[Cache]
*
Configure settings to use and delete caches. This menu is also used to delete
all caches saved in the MFP.
[Proxy]
*
Configure the settings for use of proxy.
To use the proxy, register the address and port for the proxy server. If proxy
authentication is required, register the ID and password for use in proxy authentication.
[Authentication Information]
*
Specify the timing to delete the authentication information you have entered in
the contents. This menu is also used to delete all authentication information
saved in the MFP.
[Access Log]
*
Check for access history of all users.
You can check the [ID], [User Name], [URL] and [Access].
[Web Browser Information]
Displays Web Browser information.
[Reset] Restart the Web browser.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-18
4.7 Printing, displaying, or saving a document file
4
4.7 Printing, displaying, or saving a document file
If a link to a document file is provided in the displayed contents, you can print, display, or save the document
file.
- The PDF and XPS formats are supported for the document files.
- You cannot display an XPS file.
Press the link to the document file in the contents to display the top screen of the document file.
4.7.1 Printing a document file
Press [Print] to display the Print screen.
Configure the print settings, and then press [Start] or the Start key on the control panel. The document file is
downloaded and printed.
Reference
- If you attempt to print a document file that takes up a large amount of memory, a scan error may occur
and printing will be disabled.
- If the downloaded PDF is encrypted, it is saved in the Encryption PDF User Box without being printed.
- The setting value of [Finishing] varies depending on which options are installed.
– The Staple settings are available only if the optional finisher is installed.
– The Punch settings are available only if the punch kit is installed on the optional finisher.
Item Description
[Paper] Select the size of paper for printing.
[Simplex/Duplex] Select whether to print in 2-sided mode.
[Stamp Settings] Press this button to specify whether to print a [Date/Time] and [Page Number].
[Finishing] Configure settings for collating, grouping, offsetting. stapling, hole punching,
folding, or binding.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-19
4.7 Printing, displaying, or saving a document file
4
– The Fold and Center Staple & Fold functions can be used when a saddle stitcher is installed on the optional finisher.
4.7.2 Displaying a document file
Press [View] to display the link destination PDF file.
The toolbar on the top of the screen allows you to enlarge, reduce, print, or save the PDF file.
Key Description
Brings you back to the top page.
Brings you back to the previous page.
Brings you to the next page.
Brings you to the last page.
Rotates the display 90 degrees clockwise.
Increases the zoom ratio.
Reduces the zoom ratio.
Displays according to the width of the display area.
Displays the entire page.
Select the User Box to save the document file.
Configure the print settings, and print the document file.
Displays the splash window (displayed momentarily when the software activates).
Closes the screen.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-20
4.7 Printing, displaying, or saving a document file
4
4.7.3 Saving a document file
Press [Save]. The User Box selection screen is displayed.
Select the User Box to save the file, press [OK], and then [Start] or Start. Then the document file is saved in
the User Box.
Reference
- To save a document file to a User Box, you must register the User Box in the MFP in advance. For details, refer to the [User's Guide Box Operations].
- When printing a document file (full color) that was saved in a User Box from the Web browser, you cannot specify [Zoom] or [Combine].bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-21
4.8 Uploading a document file
4
4.8 Uploading a document file
If document files are shared on the server, you can upload a scanned document file or a document file in a
User Box to the server using a Web Browser.
This section explains how to upload a document file, using the following upload site as an example.
Example
4.8.1 Restrictions
Note that there are following restrictions to use this function.
- PDF, TIFF, or XPS is the type of a document file that can be uploaded. A document cannot be divided
to upload.
- Multiple document files cannot be uploaded at the same time.
- The user cannot manually edit the file name text box.
- If you perform one of the following operations after selecting a document file to be uploaded, the job is
deleted together with the selected document file.
– The System Auto Reset function has been started.
– The Web browser has been closed.
– The upload site has been updated by operating the toolbar of the Web browser.
– The Web browser has been restarted.
– The user has logged out during login processing.
– The sub power switch has been turned off.
– Reset has been pressed to reset the panel.
4.8.2 Uploading a scanned document file
The following explains the procedure to upload a scanned document file.
Reference
- This procedure is not available for users who are disabled from scanning data.
- The file format cannot be set to JPEG when scanning an original to be uploaded.
1 Display the upload site using the Web browser of the MFP.
2 Press the button to select a document file to be uploaded.
% In this example, press [Browse].
Item Description
[Browse...] Press this button to select a document file to be uploaded.
"type" is set to "file" in the Input tag of HTML.
[OK] Press this button to upload a document file.
"type" is set to "submit" in the Input tag of HTML.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-22
4.8 Uploading a document file
4
3 Press [Scan].
4 Place the original to be uploaded on the MFP.
5 Configure the scan settings, and press [Start] or the Start key.
% If Proof Copy is selected, you can check finishing.
After scanning is completed, the file name is displayed in the text box.
6 Press the button to start uploading.
% In this example, press [OK].
Uploading of a document file then starts.
4.8.3 Uploading a document file in a User Box
The following explains the procedure to upload a document file retrieved from a User Box.
Reference
- This procedure is not available for users who are disabled from accessing the saved documents.
- Before uploading a document file in a User Box, create a User Box to save the document file in.
- Only the Public User Box and Personal User Box can be selected.
- The file format cannot be set to JPEG when selecting a document file to be uploaded from a User Box.
When selecting a JPEG document file saved in a User Box, the file format is changed to PDF. If necessary, specify the appropriate file format before uploading a document file.
- When uploading a document file saved in a User Box while Page Separation is enabled, Page Separation is canceled and changed to Multi Page.
1 Display the upload site using the Web browser of the MFP.bizhub 423/363/283/223 4-23
4.8 Uploading a document file
4
2 Press the button to select a document file to be uploaded.
% In this example, press [Browse].
3 Press the [User Box] key.
4 Select a desired User Box, and press [Use Document].
5 Select a document file to be uploaded, and press [File Settings].
% Select multiple document files and press [Combine]; they can be combined as one file. The combination order can be changed as required.
% Select a document file and press [Document Details] to check the date and time the document file
was saved and to preview the image.
6 Configure the file setting, and press [Start] or the Start key.
% Press [Application] to configure the stamp or page number print setting.
The file name appears in the text box.
7 Press the button to start uploading.
% In this example, press [OK].
Uploading of a document file then starts.5 PageScope Web Connection
(Web Browser Function)bizhub 423/363/283/223 5-2
5.1 Using PageScope Web Connection
5
5 PageScope Web Connection (Web Browser Function)
5.1 Using PageScope Web Connection
PageScope Web Connection is a device management utility that is supported by the HTTP server built in
this machine. To use this utility, directly access the MFP connected to the network using Web Browser.
To use this utility using Web Browser installed in the MFP, only the User Box function is available.
This chapter describes how to use documents in the User Box of the MFP on the network by operating PageScope Web Connection using the Web Browser installed in the MFP.
Reference
- This function can be used on the MFP with i-Option LK-101 v2 or i-Option LK-103 v2 registered.
- i-Option LK-101 v2 or i-Option LK-103 v2 must be registered also in the MFP access destination.
- For details on using the Web Browser installed in the MFP, refer to page 4-2.
- To operate PageScope Web Connection from a Web browser of your computer, you can use various
functions such as the status check, setting change, and network setting functions of the MFP. For details, refer to the [User's Guide Network Administrator].
5.1.1 Prior check
The most recent information may not appear in PageScope Web Connection screens because older versions of pages are saved in the cache for the Web browser. In addition, problems may occur when the cache
is used.
When using PageScope Web Connection, disable the cache for the Web browser.
Reference
- Changing the cache settings requires the administrator authority.
1 Press [Menu] on the toolbar of the Web browser.
2 Press [Administrator].
3 Enter the administrator password, and then press [OK].
4 Press the [Settings] tab, and then select [Cache].
5 Clear the [Use cache] check box, and then press [OK].
5.1.2 How to access
Start the Web browser, and then specify the IP address of the MFP to be accessed.
1 Press [Address] on the toolbar of the Web browser.
2 Press the entry form to display the keyboard screen.
3 Enter the IP address of the MFP to be accessed, and then press [OK].
4 Press [OK] or [Open New Window].
The PageScope Web Connection screen appears.
Reference
- If you have specified to not receive cookies for Web browser settings, PageScope Web Connection
screen does not appear. For details on configuring cookie settings, refer to page 4-17.
- If you display the screen for entering the address, you see the URL of the page being displayed. To
delete the URL currently shown, display the keyboard screen and press [Delete]. Press C (clear) in the
Control Panel to delete all URL entries.bizhub 423/363/283/223 5-3
5.2 Screen components
5
5.2 Screen components
The PageScope Web Connection screen is constructed as shown below.
No. Name Description
1 KONICA MINOLTA
logo
Press the logo to go to the KONICA MINOLTA Web site (http://www.konicaminolta.com/).
2 PageScope Web
Connection logo
Press the logo to display the version information for PageScope Web
Connection.
3 Login user name Displays the icon of the current mode and the name of the user who is
logged on (public, registered user, or account).
4 [Logout] Press this button to log out from the current mode.
5 Contents display Displays the contents of PageScope Web Connection.
3 4
5
1
2bizhub 423/363/283/223 5-4
5.3 Logging in and logging out
5
5.3 Logging in and logging out
If you have specified to perform User Authentication or Account Track on the MFP, the login screen appears
after displaying PageScope Web Connection.
Reference
- If you have not specified to perform User Authentication or Account Track, the screen displayed when
you logged in as a public user appears.
- To use PageScope Web Connection using the Web Browser installed in the MFP, its administrator
mode is not available.
5.3.1 Login
Select whether to log in as a public user or registered user. If External Server Authentication is selected, select
an external authentication server.
Enter the required information, and press [Login]. Select a display language if necessary.
Reference
- The User Boxes that can be accessed vary depending on the logged in user or account track.
5.3.2 Logout
Press [Logout] on the upper right of the screen to display a logout confirmation screen. Press [OK]. The login
screen appears again.bizhub 423/363/283/223 5-5
5.4 Using the User Box function
5
5.4 Using the User Box function
To use PageScope Web Connection using the Web Browser installed in the MFP, the following operations
are available as the User Box function.
- Operating documents in the User Box on the MFP being used or a different MFP connected to the network.
- Using the Public, Personal, and Group User Boxes as User Box Types.
- Displaying, printing, and deleting a document in the User Box.
5.4.1 Open User Box
Logging in using PageScope Web Connection displays the list of User Boxes (Public, Personal, and Group
User Boxes) registered in the accessed MFP.
[Open User Box]
Select a desired User Box name ([User Box Name]) at User Box List. Alternatively, directly enter a User Box
number ([User Box Number]) and User Box password ([User Box Password]), and then press [OK].
Reference
- When you select a User Box name ([User Box Name]) with a password specified in [User Box List], a
screen for entering the password appears.
[Open User Box]
[User Box List]
Item Description
[User Box Number] Enter the User Box number to be opened.
[User Box Password] If a password is set to the target User Box, enter the password.
Item Description
[Search from Index] Switch the index display according to the indexes selected when creating a
User Box.
[Page (Display by 50
cases)]
When this machine contains 50 or more User Boxes, specify the desired page
to change the display.
User Box List Displays the [User Box Number], [User Box Name], [Type] and [Time Stored].
A key icon appears beside User Boxes where a password has been specified.bizhub 423/363/283/223 5-6
5.4 Using the User Box function
5
[File List]
Select a User Box in [Open User Box]. The basic information of the User Box is displayed with a list of the
documents saved in the User Box.
Item Description
[Thumbnail View] Specify whether to view the thumbnail images of the document.
Set to [OFF] for list display.
[Specify operation] Select an operation.
For details, refer to page 5-7.
[Changes the display] Press this button to display the [Select] check box beside all documents with
which the selected operation can be performed.
[Select] Displays a check box beside all documents with which the selected operation
can be performed.
[Thumbnail] Displays thumbnail images of the document.
[Document Name] Displays the name of the document.
[Number of Originals] Displays the number of originals in a document.
[Edit Name] Press this button to change the document name.bizhub 423/363/283/223 5-7
5.4 Using the User Box function
5
5.4.2 Document operations
A selected document can be printed or deleted.
Printing a document
1 Select [Print] from [Specify operation], and then press [Changes the display].
A check box appears beside all printable documents.
2 Select the check box for the document to be printed, and then press [Print Setting].bizhub 423/363/283/223 5-8
5.4 Using the User Box function
5
3 Configure necessary settings, and then press [OK].
% In [Page Range], select whether to print all pages of the selected document or to print by specifying
a page range.
% In [Change order], you can change the print order when printing multiple documents.
4 Press [Open File].
5 Press [Print].
% If [View] is pressed, a PDF file appears. To print the displayed PDF file, press .
6 Configure print settings, and then press [Start] or the Start key on the control panel.
Reference
- If the [Function Version] of the destination MFP is not [Version 3], press [Open File] in Step 4 to display
the PDF file on the panel. To print the displayed PDF file, press . To check the function version of
the MFP, select [Device Information] in [Utility].bizhub 423/363/283/223 5-9
5.4 Using the User Box function
5
Deleting a document
1 Select [Delete] from [Specify operation], and then press [Changes the display].
A check box appears beside the documents that can be deleted.
2 Select the check box for the document to be deleted, and then press [Delete].
% Select the [Check/Uncheck (applied to all the documents)] check box to select all documents.bizhub 423/363/283/223 5-10
5.4 Using the User Box function
5
3 Check the document name to be deleted, and then press [OK].
The document is deleted.6 Image Panelbizhub 423/363/283/223 6-2
6.1 Overview
6
6 Image Panel
6.1 Overview
Image Panel is a new intuitive and easy-to-understand panel interface.
Reference
- This function can be used on the MFP with i-Option LK-101 v2 or i-Option LK-103 v2 registered.
- If [User Authentication/ Account Track] ö [Scan to Authorized Folder Settings] is set to [Limit] in [Administrator Settings], Image Panel cannot be used.
Features
Image Panel divides the operation workflow into three processes, "reading a document", "editing a document", and "specifying a destination", which can be operated on one screen. This allows you to easily understand the entire operation workflow and operation in progress.
Image Panel focuses on operability. Therefore, the functions available in Image Panel are limited compared
with the conventional panel.
When the My Panel and My Address function are available, you can customize the Image Panel screen as a
user-specific screen.
d Reference
For details on the My Panel function, refer to page 9-2.
For details on the My Address function, refer to page 10-2.bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-3
6.2 Displaying the Image Panel
6
6.2 Displaying the Image Panel
In [Application Menu], press [Image Panel] to display the Image Panel top screen.
d Reference
For details on the [Application Menu], refer to page 3-3.bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-4
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6.3.1 Screen components
The Image Panel screen consists of the following.
No. Name Description
1 Login Information
area
Displays the user name and icon of the user who is currently logged in.
2 Read Data area Scan a document, retrieve a document from a User Box or external memory, and send data from a cellular phone or PDA.
3 Desktop area Documents read in the Read Data area are displayed in a thumbnail view
or list view.
4 List Display/Thumbnail View switching
Switches the desktop area display between the list display and thumbnail
view.
5 Message area Displays an auxiliary message such as operating instructions.
6 Status area Displays the date and current time.
If an alert occurs, an alert icon appears.
7 Edit tool area Edit the page, combine and change settings of the document after it is
scanned.
8 Send Tray/Edit Tool
display switching
Switches the display between the send tray and edit tool display.
For details on the send tray, refer to page 6-16.
9 Document Destination area
Specify a destination of the read document from [Print] or [Destination
List].
1 3 4 5 6
9
8 7
2bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-5
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
6.3.2 General operation
The following describes the operation flow from document reading processing to sending processing by
showing operations of Image Panel in order of "reading a document", "editing a document", and "specifying
a destination".
Reference
- You can specify a destination first, and then read a document.
In the Read Data area, read or retrieve a document.
• To scan a document, place the document, and then press [Scan]. Configure the scan settings as needed, and then start to read the document. For details, refer to page 6-7.
• To use a document saved in a User Box, select the User Box from [Document Source List], and select
the document you want to retrieve. For details, refer to page 6-8.
• To use a document saved in an external memory, select [External Memory] from [Document Source
List], and select the document you want to retrieve. For details, refer to page 6-9.
• To use data saved in a cellular phone or PDA, select [Mobile] from [Document Source List]. For details,
refer to page 6-10.
Select [Scan] Select [Document Source List].
In the Edit Tool area, edit the read document. For details, refer to page 6-11.
In the Document Destination area, specify a destination of the read document.
• To print, press [Print]. For details, refer to page 6-14.
• To send the document, select a destination from [Destination List]. For details, refer to page 6-15.
• To save data in an external memory, press [External Memory] in the Destination List screen. For details, refer to page 6-15.
Select [Print]. Select [Destination List]bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-6
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
If you specify an address, the send tray appears. For details, refer to page 6-16.
Press Start to send the document.
• To send data from a cellular phone or PDA, press
Start to display a PIN code. Enter the PIN code in
the cellular phone or PDA to send data to the MFP.
Data is sent to the specified destination. For details, refer to page 6-17.bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-7
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
6.3.3 Reading a document
Scan a document, retrieve a document from a User Box or external memory, and send data from a cellular
phone or PDA.
Scanning a document
Press [Scan] to display the Scan Settings screen. Configure the scan settings as needed, and then press
[Scan].
Reference
- Only one document can be scanned.
Item Description
[Original Type] Select the image quality from [Text], [Text/Photo], [Photo], [Dot Matrix Original]
and [Copied Paper] according to the contents of the original to be scanned.
[Simplex/Duplex] Select either to scan a 1-sided original or 2-sided original.
[Resolution] Select the scan resolution from [200 e 100dpi (Standard)], [200 e 200dpi
(Fine)], [300 e 300dpi], [400 e 400dpi (Super Fine)] and [600 e 600dpi (Ultra
Fine)].
[File Type] Select a file type from [PDF], [Compact PDF], [TIFF], [JPEG], [XPS] and [Compact XPS].
Select whether to save the whole scanned pages as one file, or to divide a file
in specified number of pages in order to save data. You cannot select [Multi
Page] if [JPEG] is selected for file type.
To send divided files by attaching them to an E-mail, specify [E-mail Attachment Method]. Select [All Files Sent as one (1) E-mail] to attach all divided files
to one E-mail message. Select [One (1) File per E-Mail] to send E-mail messages for each divided file.
Selecting [Compact PDF] for file type allows you to specify [Outline PDF].
If either i-Option LK-102 or i-Option LK-103 v2 is registered in the MFP, selecting [PDF] or [Compact PDF] for file type allows you to specify [Encryption]
and [PDF Document Properties]. For details on the function, refer to page 7-2.
If i-Option LK-105 is registered in the MFP, selecting [PDF] or [Compact PDF]
for the file type allows you to specify [Searchable PDF]. For details on the function, refer to page 8-2.
[Density] Adjust the density for scanning.
[Color] Select the scan color from [Auto Color], [Full Color], [Gray Scale] and [Black].
[Document Name] Specify the document name.
[Separate Scan] Press this button to divide scanning of the document into several times. It is
useful for the following cases.
• When the number of pages of a document is too many, and it cannot be
loaded into the ADF
• When placing the originals on the original glass
• When 1-sided originals and 2-sided originals are mixedbizhub 423/363/283/223 6-8
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
Retrieving from User Box
Select a User Box from [Document Source List] to display the Use Document screen. Select a document to
be retrieved, and then press [OK].
Reference
- If a password has been specified for the selected User Box, the password input screen appears. Enter
the password.
- Only one User Box can be selected.
- Up to 10 documents can be retrieved from a User Box at one time.
- If a User Box is specified as a destination, you cannot retrieve more than one document.
- You cannot specify the User Box, from which you retrieved the document, as the destination.
Item Description
[Edit Name] Press this button to change the name of the selected document.
[Document Details] Press this button to check the detailed information or preview image of the selected document.bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-9
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
Retrieving a document from an external memory
Select [External Memory] from [Document Source List] to display the list of documents saved in the external
memory. Select a document to be retrieved, and then press [OK].
Reference
- To retrieve a document from an external memory, you must configure the following settings in the MFP
depending on the purpose of the document to be used.
– To print a retrieved document, in [Administrator Settings]ö[System Settings]ö[User Box Settings]ö[External Memory Function Settings], set [Print Document] to [ON]. To additionally perform user
authentication, in [Administrator Settings]ö[User Authentication/ Account Track]ö[User Authentication Settings]ö[User Registration], set [Function Permission]ö[Print] to [Allow] for each user.
– To save a retrieved document in a User Box, in [Administrator Settings]ö[System Settings]ö[User Box
Settings]ö[External Memory Function Settings], set [External Memory Document Scan] to [ON]. To additionally perform user authentication, in [Administrator Settings]ö[User Authentication/ Account
Track]ö[User Authentication Settings]ö[User Registration], set [Function Permission]ö[External
Memory Document Scan] to [Allow] for each user.
- The available file formats are PDF, TIFF, JPEG, and XPS.
- Up to 200 documents can be retrieved from an external memory.
- To open a folder, select the one you want to open, and then press [Open].
- You cannot specify a JPEG document together with any other format at the same time.
- If a document has been retrieved from an external memory, you cannot read the document using [Scan]
or [Document Source List].
- You can only specify either [Print] or a User Box as a destination of a document retrieved from an external memory. Also, you can specify only one User Box as a destination. To save a document in a User
Box, you must create a User Box and register the User Box in the address book in advance.
- If other than User Box is specified as a destination, you cannot select [External Memory].bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-10
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
Using data saved in a cellular phone or PDA
Select [Mobile] from [Document Source List]. Selecting [Mobile/PDA] and pressing [OK] displays the cellular
phone icon on the desktop area.
Reference
- To connect the MFP to a cellular phone or PDA, install the optional Local Interface Kit EK-605 in the
MFP. Additionally, configure the following settings in the MFP.
– Set [Administrator Settings]ö[Network Settings]ö[Bluetooth Setting] to [Enable]. Also, set [Administrator Settings]ö[System Connection]ö[Cellular Phone/PDA Setting] to [Allow].
– To perform user authentication, in [Administrator Settings]ö[User Authentication/ Account
Track]ö[User Authentication Settings]ö[User Registration], set [Function Permission]ö[Cellular
Phone/PDA] to [Allow] for each user.
- If [Mobile/PDA] is selected, you cannot read a document using [Scan] or [Document Source List].
- You can only specify either [Print] or a User Box as a destination for sending data from a cellular phone
or PDA. Also, you can specify only one User Box as a destination. To save a document in a User Box,
you must create a User Box and register the User Box in the address book in advance.
- If other than [Print] or a User Box is specified as a destination, you cannot select [Mobile].
- This machine supports RepliGo version 2.1.0.8.
- To print an XHTML file, since a linked file is retrieved using the WebDAV client function, you must configure the following settings in the MFP in advance.
– Set [Administrator Settings]ö[Network Settings]ö[WebDAV Settings]ö[WebDAV Client Settings] to
[ON].
– To connect via a proxy, register a proxy server in [Proxy Server Address] of [WebDAV Client Settings].
Additionally, set [User Settings]ö[Cellular Phone/PDA Setting]ö[Proxy Server Use] to [Yes].
– In [User Settings]ö[Cellular Phone/PDA Setting]ö[Link File Error Notification], specify the operation for
the machine to execute when it is unable to retrieve the linked file.
d Reference
For details on how to send data from a cellular phone or PDA, refer to page 6-17.
The function to connect the MFP to a cellular phone or PDA is available even if the license kit is not registered.
For details, refer to the [User's Guide Box Operations] and [User's Guide Print Operations].
Item Specifications
Communication protocol
Bluetooth Ver. 2.0 + EDR
Supporting profile OPP/BPP/SPP
Supporting file type PDF/CPDF/XPS/CXPS/TIFF/JPEG/XHTML/RepliGo
Supporting XHTML file Character code: UTF-8, Shift-JIS, ISO-8859
Extension of link file: JPEG, JPG, PNGbizhub 423/363/283/223 6-11
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
6.3.4 Editing the document
Edit the read document.
Reference
- When using data saved in a cellular phone or PDA, you cannot check the preview image or edit the data.
[Preview]
Press this button to check the detailed information or preview image of the selected document.
Reference
- For a document retrieved from an external memory, the [Preview] function is not available.
- For a combined document, the preview function is available only for the first document.
[Document/Page] - [Edit Document]
Edit the pages of a selected document.
You can rotate the page that has been scanned in the wrong direction, or delete an unnecessary page. For
a document consisting of multiple pages, you can move pages to change the page order. Also, you can preview the pages to check the page content.
Reference
- If you have selected multiple documents, the edit page function is not available.
- If you have selected a combined document, the edit page function is not available.
Item Description
[Odd Page] Press this button to select the odd page.
[Even Page] Press this button to select the even page.
[Preview /Set Range] Press this button to preview the page.
[Delete Page] Press this button to delete the selected page.bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-12
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
[Document/Page] - [Combine Documents]
Combine selected multiple documents. You can use [Move] to change the combination order.
Reference
- You can only select either [Print] or [Destination List] as a destination of a combined document.
- Up to 10 documents can be combined at one time.
- You cannot combine a scanned document with a document retrieved from a User Box.
[Rotate Page] Press this button to rotate the selected page.
The allowable rotation angles are left 90 degrees, right 90 degrees, and 180
degrees.
[Move Page] Press this button to change the order by moving the selected page.
While checking the thumbnail images, you can select the moving position.
Item Descriptionbizhub 423/363/283/223 6-13
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
[Document/Page] - [Document Settings]
Configure settings for sending the selected document.
You can change the resolution of the document, file type, and color setting.
Reference
- If you have selected multiple documents, the document setting function is not available.
- If you have selected a document retrieved from an external memory, the document setting function is
not available.
[Return to Scan Dest.]
Press [Return to Scan Dest.] to restore the selected document to the source location.
- The scanned document is deleted from the MFP.
- The document retrieved from a User Box is restored to the source User Box.
Item Description
[Resolution] Select the scan resolution from [Settings when saving], [200 e 100dpi (Standard)], [200 e 200dpi (Fine)], [300 e 300dpi], [400 e 400dpi (Super Fine)] and [600
e 600dpi (Ultra Fine)].
[File Type] Select the file format for sending data from [PDF], [Compact PDF], [TIFF],
[JPEG], [XPS] and [Compact XPS].
Select whether to save the whole scanned pages as one file, or to divide a file
in specified number of pages in order to save data. You cannot select [Multi
Page] if [JPEG] is selected for file type.
To send divided files by attaching them to an E-mail, specify [E-mail Attachment Method]. Select [All Files Sent as one (1) E-mail] to attach all divided files
to one E-mail message. Select [One (1) File per E-Mail] to send E-mail messages for each divided file.
Selecting [Compact PDF] for file type allows you to specify [Outline PDF].
If either i-Option LK-102 or i-Option LK-103 v2 is registered in the MFP, selecting [PDF] or [Compact PDF] for file type allows you to specify [Encryption]
and [PDF Document Properties]. For details on the function, refer to page 7-2.
If i-Option LK-105 is registered in the MFP, selecting [PDF] or [Compact PDF]
for the file type allows you to specify [Searchable PDF]. For details on the function, refer to page 8-2.
[Color] Select the scan color for sending data from [Use Existing Color Setting], [Full
Color], [Gray Scale] and [Black].bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-14
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
6.3.5 Specifying a destination
Specify a destination of the read document.
Printing
Press [Print] to print data directly from the MFP. Configure the print settings, and then press [OK].
Reference
- If you have scanned multiple documents, the print setting function will not be available.
- When you print a combined document, [Combine] and [Zoom] are not available.
- When printing a document with an embedded password using the password copy function, you cannot
specify [Combine] or [Zoom]. For details on the password copy function, refer to the [User's Guide Copy
Operations].
- When you print a document that has been retrieved from an external memory, [Combine] and [Zoom]
are not available.
- When you print a document of JPEG, XPS, or Compact XPS format that has been retrieved from an
external memory, [2-Sided] is not available. Also, Staple and Punch are not available for the [Finishing]
setting.
- When printing data saved in a cellular phone or PDA, you can only check the print settings. To change
print settings, select [User Settings]ö[Cellular Phone/PDA Setting]ö[Print].
Reference
- The setting value of [Finishing] varies depending on which option is installed.
– The Staple settings are available only if the optional finisher is installed.
– The Punch settings are available only if the punch kit is installed on the optional finisher.
- [Continuous Print] is displayed when multiple documents are combined using the editing tool, and then
[Print] is selected as a destination.
Item Description
[Copies:] Specify the number of copies to be printed using the Keypad.
[Print] Select whether to print in 2-sided mode.
[Finishing] Press this button to configure settings for collating, grouping, stapling, or hole
punching.
[Combine] Press this button to specify whether to combine pages.
Multiple pages of a document can be combined and printed on a single page.
[Zoom] Press this button to specify a zoom ratio for the document.
[Continuous Print] This function is available when printing combined documents in the 2-sided
print mode.
Multiple document are printed continuously when they are combined. When
printing in 2-Sided mode, and the document ends on the front side of a sheet
of paper, select whether to start printing of the next document on the back side
of the sheet or on the front side of a new sheet.bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-15
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
Specifying destinations
From [Destination List], select an address to which you want to send a document.
Press the [Search] tab to reference one-touch destinations registered in the main unit. Press the [Group] tab
to reference the group list registered in the main unit.
Reference
- If you have read multiple documents, the User Box function will not be available.
- If My address function is available, pressing [My Address] allows you to view My Address Book. For
details on the My Address function, refer to page 10-2.
- If you have specified an address, you can check the send tray by pressing [Verify Address Tray/ Remote
Address Setting].
- E-mail addresses for which a certificate is registered are displayed with a key icon.
- You can only specify User Boxes as an address book destination of a document retrieved from an external memory or a document saved in a cellular phone or PDA.
Saving a document in an external memory
Select [External Memory] from [Destination List], and press [OK].
Reference
- To save data in an external memory, in [Administrator Settings]ö[System Settings]ö[User Box Settings]ö[External Memory Function Settings], set [Save Document] to [ON]. To additionally perform user
authentication, in [Administrator Settings]ö[User Authentication/ Account Track]ö[User Authentication Settings]ö[User Registration], set [Function Permission]ö[Save to External Memory] to [Allow] for
each user.
- If [Print] or a destination is specified as a destination, you cannot select [External Memory].bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-16
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
6.3.6 Checking the send tray
Send Tray
If you specify an address, the send tray appears. The send tray displays the icon for the destination you have
specified.
[Check TX Tray]
Press the icon of the send tray to display the Check Send To screen, where you can check the list of specified
destinations.
If an E-mail address is specified as a destination, you can specify settings for the E-mail encryption and digital
signature attachment.
No. Name Description
1 Dest. Settings icon Press the Dest. Settings icon to display the Check Send To screen, where
you can check the list of specified destinations.
2 Destination icon Displays the icons for destinations.
Press the icon for the desired destination to display the Check Send To
screen, where you can check the detail information of the destination.
1 2
Item Description
[Remote Address Settings]
Press this button to configure settings for E-mail encryption based on S/MIME
and digital signature attachment.
This setting is available when [ON] is selected for [S/MIME Communication
Settings] of [Administrator Settings], and E-mail is selected.
[Detail] Press this button to check the detailed information of the address.bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-17
6.3 Operating Image Panel
6
Reference
- To encrypt an E-mail message and attach a digital signature using S/MIME, set [Administrator Settings]ö[Network Settings]ö[E-Mail Settings]ö[S/MIME Communication Settings] to [ON].
- To encrypt an E-mail, a certificate must be registered in the E-mail address.
- To attach a digital signature to an E-mail message, the device certificate must be registered in the MFP.
Also, set [Administrator Settings]ö[Network Settings]ö[E-Mail Settings]ö[S/MIME Communication
Settings]ö[Digital Signature] to [Always add signature] or [Select when sending]. For details, refer to
the [User's Guide Network Administrator].
6.3.7 Sending data from a cellular phone or PDA
Selecting a destination and pressing Start displays the PIN code on the Control Panel.
Specify the data you want to use and the MFP to send data in the cellular phone or PDA. Then enter the PIN
code to send data to the MFP.
Reference
- You can only specify either [Print] or a User Box as a destination for sending data from a cellular phone
or PDA. Also, you can specify only one User Box as a destination. To save a document in a User Box,
you must create a User Box and register the User Box in the address book in advance.
– For details on how to create a User Box, refer to the [User's Guide Box Operations].
– For details on how to register a destination to the address book, refer to the [User's Guide Network
Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations].
- For the operation of a cellular phone or PDA, refer to the operation manual of the cellular phone or PDA.
- The communication speed may be reduced or communication may be interrupted by obstacles, signal
quality, magnetic field or static electricity.
- Documents and image data may not be sent correctly depending on the security setting of the cellular
phone or PDA.
[Delete] Press this button to delete the selected address.
Item Descriptionbizhub 423/363/283/223 6-18
6.4 Registering a photo in the address book
6
6.4 Registering a photo in the address book
From the Web browser on your computer, you can use PageScope Web Connection to add photo data to
registered one-touch destinations.
The registered photo data is applied to the [Destination List] of Image Panel.
d Reference
For details on PageScope Web Connection, refer to the [User's Guide Network Administrator].
6.4.1 Specifications of photo data
The specifications for registerable photo data are as shown below.
Reference
- Photo data is not enlarged or reduced during photo data registration process.
Item Specifications
File Type BMP format, 24-bit color, uncompressed
Image size 48 e 48 pixels
Data size 6,966 bytesbizhub 423/363/283/223 6-19
6.4 Registering a photo in the address book
6
6.4.2 Registering photo data
Register photo data by operating PageScope Web Connection from the Web browser on your computer.
Reference
- To add photo data to the address book, you must register one-touch destinations in advance.
- When the My Address function is available, you can add photo data to one-touch destinations in My
Address Book.
- Photo data can be registered in My Address Book only when you log in as a registered user.
1 Log in to the user mode or administrator mode.
2 Select [Store Address].
3 Select [Photo/Icon].
4 Select the one-touch destination to which you want to add photo data, and then click [Edit].
% When the photo data is registered, [Photo/Icon] is displayed in [Photo].bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-20
6.4 Registering a photo in the address book
6
5 Select [Register Photo].
6 Click [Browse], and then specify the folder where the photo data you want to add is saved.
7 Press [OK].
The photo data is added to the one-touch destination.bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-21
6.5 Customizing Image Panel
6
6.5 Customizing Image Panel
When the My Panel and My Address function are available, you can customize the Image Panel screen as a
user-specific screen.
To customize the Image Panel screen, the following conditions are required.
- The My Panel and My Address functions are available on the MFP.
- Perform user authentication, and then log in as a registered user.
d Reference
For details on the My Panel function, refer to page 9-2.
For details on the My Address function, refer to page 10-2.
6.5.1 Customizing the Read Data area
Shortcut icons for frequently used User Boxes can be registered in the Read Data area.
1 In [Data Source], press [Document Source List].
2 Press [Customize Basic Screen].
3 Select the User Box you want to register in the basic screen, and select the location in the Read Data
area.
% If you have selected a location that is already registered in the basic screen, the data is overwritten.
% You cannot register a User Box that is already registered in the basic screen to another location in
the basic screen.bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-22
6.5 Customizing Image Panel
6
4 Press [OK].
A shortcut icon is registered.
6.5.2 Customizing the Document Destination area
Shortcut icons for frequently used destinations can be registered in the Document Destination area.
1 Press [Destination List] in the [Data Destination] area.
2 Press [Customize Basic Screen].
3 Select the destination you want to register in the basic screen, and select the location in the Document
Destination area.
% If you have selected a location that is already registered in the basic screen, the data is overwritten.
% You cannot register a destination that is already registered in the basic screen to another location
in the basic screen.bizhub 423/363/283/223 6-23
6.5 Customizing Image Panel
6
4 Press [OK].
A shortcut icon is registered.
6.5.3 Deleting a registered shortcut icon
1 Press [Customize Basic Screen].
2 Select an icon you want to delete.
3 Press [Delete].
4 Press [OK].
The shortcut icon is deleted.7 PDF Processing Functionbizhub 423/363/283/223 7-2
7.1 Overview
7
7 PDF Processing Function
7.1 Overview
The PDF processing function allows you to specify the security level for distributing a scanned document and
a document saved in a User Box, such as by encrypting a document or adding a digital signature as required.
Reference
- This function can be used on the MFP with i-Option LK-102 or i-Option LK-103 v2 registered.
Available operations with the PDF processing function
The PDF processing function allows you to perform the following operations.
- Configuring the PDF document property settings when distributing it with the scan or User Box function
(p. 7-3).
- Encrypting a PDF document using a password or digital ID (public key) when distributing it with the scan
or User Box function (p. 7-4).
- Adding a digital signature when distributing an encrypted PDF document (p. 7-4).
- An AES-encrypted PDF document can be printed using the direct print mode (p. 7-7).
d Reference
For details on the scan function, refer to the [User's Guide Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations].
For details on User Box functions, refer to the [User's Guide Box Operations].bizhub 423/363/283/223 7-3
7.2 PDF document properties
7
7.2 PDF document properties
Selecting [PDF] or [Compact PDF] as a file type when distributing a scanned document or document saved
in a User Box allows you to configure the PDF document property settings.
Reference
- When saving a document in a User Box using [Save Document] of the User Box function, you cannot
configure the PDF document property settings.
- When sending a document in a User Box in the PDF format to other device using PageScope Web
Connection, you can configure the PDF document property settings.
Item Description
[Title] If [No] is selected for [Apply file name.], specify the title of the PDF document
(up to 64 characters).
[Apply file name.] Specify whether to apply the file name as the name of the PDF document.
[Author] Enter the author of the PDF document (up to 64 characters).
When user authentication is performed, the login name is entered as the author name.
[Subject] Enter the sub-title of the PDF document (up to 64 characters).
[Keywords] Enter the keywords of the PDF document (up to 64 characters).bizhub 423/363/283/223 7-4
7.3 Encrypting PDF document and adding digital signature
7
7.3 Encrypting PDF document and adding digital signature
Selecting [PDF] or [Compact PDF] as a file type when distributing a scanned document or document saved
in a User Box allows you to enhance security for the PDF document by encrypting it using a password or the
digital ID of a user (public key).
When a device certificate is registered in the MFP, a PDF document can be distributed with a digital signature
added. Adding a digital signature certifies the author (MFP) of the sent document and guarantees that the
document has not been modified after being signed.
Reference
- Using PageScope Web Connection, you can encrypt and add a digital signature to send a document
in a User Box to another device in the PDF format.
- To add a digital signature, it is necessary to encrypt the PDF document using a password or digital ID.
7.3.1 Password-based encryption
To encrypt a document using a password, configure the following settings.
Item Description
[Encryption Target] Select an encryption target.
Selecting [Other than Metadata] excludes the item specified in [PDF Document
Properties] from the encryption target.
Selecting [Other than Metadata] does not allow you to select [Low Level] for
Encryption Level.
[Encryption Type] Select [Password].
[Signature] When a device certificate has been registered in the MFP, specify whether to
add a digital signature.
For details on registering a device certificate in the MFP, refer to the [User's
Guide Network Administrator].
[Encryption Level] Select an encryption level.
• [Low Level]: RC4 encoding method (40-bit key length), supported by Acrobat 3.0 or later
• [High Level 1]: RC4 encoding method (128-bit key length), supported by
Acrobat 5.0 or later
• [High Level 2]: AES encoding method (128-bit key length), supported by
Acrobat 7.0 or later
[Password] Enter the password required to open a PDF document.
Enter the password twice for confirmation.
[Document Permissions]
Enter the password required to change the document permissions. Enter the
password twice for confirmation. You cannot use the same password as that
specified in [Password].
After you have configured document permissions, press [Detail Settings] to
configure the detailed permission settings. The set values vary depending on
the encryption level.bizhub 423/363/283/223 7-5
7.3 Encrypting PDF document and adding digital signature
7
[Detail Settings]
7.3.2 Digital ID-based encryption
To encrypt a document using the digital ID of a user, configure the following settings.
Item Description
[Printing Allowed] Specify whether to permit printing of a PDF document.
[Low Resolution] is selectable when [High Level 1] or [High Level 2] is selected
for Encryption Level.
[Enable copying of
text, images and other
content]
Specify whether to enable copying of text, images and other content.
[Changes Allowed] Specify the permission level related to making changes to a PDF document.
• Select [Inserting, deleting and rotating pages] to insert, delete or rotate the
page. Configure this setting for encryption at a higher security level.
• Select [Filling in form fields and signing.] to enter information in the form
and add a digital signature. Configure this setting for encryption at a higher
security level.
• Select [Commenting, filling in form fields and signing] to add comments,
enter information in the form and add a digital signature.
• Select [Page layout, filling in form fields and signing.] to insert, delete or rotate the page, enter information in the form and add a digital signature.
Configure this setting for encryption at a lower security level.
• Select [Any except extracting pages] to edit a document, create the form
field and enter information to it, add comments, and add a digital signature.
Item Description
[Encryption Target] Select an encryption target.
Selecting [Other than Metadata] excludes the item specified in [PDF Document
Properties] from the encryption target.
[Encryption Type] Select [Digital ID].
Select [Digital ID] to display the screen for selecting destinations. The screen
for selecting an address displays a list of E-mail addresses with registered digital IDs for S/MIME sending. Specify a digital ID to be used for encryption by
selecting an E-mail address.
Selecting [Same as destination] uses the digital ID of the address; you do not
need to specify a digital ID on this screen.
Specification of the digital ID is independent of specification of an address;
therefore, you need to specify an address separately.
[Signature] When a device certificate has been registered in the MFP, specify whether to
add a digital signature.
For details on registering a device certificate in the MFP, refer to the [User's
Guide Network Administrator].bizhub 423/363/283/223 7-6
7.3 Encrypting PDF document and adding digital signature
7
[Detail Settings]
Reference
- Digital ID-based encryption requires registering the certificate of a user in an E-mail address in advance.
For details on registering the certificate of a user in an E-mail address, refer to the [User's Guide Network Administrator].
- You can specify up to 100 digital IDs.
- The specifiable digital ID depends on the apply level of a user.
- When saving a PDF document in a User Box, you cannot encrypt it using a digital ID.
- When encrypting a PDF document and creating a searchable PDF document at the same time, the following settings are not available if [Adjust Rotation] is set to [Adjust] in the searchable PDF setting. [Adjust Rotation] is set to [Adjust] by default. Change the setting as necessary.
– [Encryption Type]: [Digital ID]
– [Encryption Level]: [High Level 2]
– [Encryption Target]: [Other than Metadata]
– [Signature]: [Yes]
- For details on the searchable PDF function, refer to page 8-2.
[Encryption Level] Select an encryption level. To encrypt a document using a digital ID, you cannot select [Low Level] for Encryption Level.
• [High Level 1]: RC4 encoding method (128-bit key length), supported by
Acrobat 5.0 or later
• [High Level 2]: AES encoding method (128-bit key length), supported by
Acrobat 7.0 or later
Item Description
[Printing Allowed] Specify whether to permit printing of a PDF document.
[Enable copying of
text, images and other
content]
Specify whether to enable copying of text, images and other content.
[Changes Allowed] Specify the permission level related to making changes to a PDF document.
• Select [Inserting, deleting and rotating pages] to insert, delete or rotate the
page. Configure this setting for encryption at a higher security level.
• Select [Filling in form fields and signing.] to enter information in the form
and add a digital signature. Configure this setting for encryption at a higher
security level.
• Select [Commenting, filling in form fields and signing] to add comments,
enter information in the form and add a digital signature.
• Select [Any except extracting pages] to edit a document, create the form
field and enter information to it, add comments, and add a digital signature.
Item Descriptionbizhub 423/363/283/223 7-7
7.4 Direct Print
7
7.4 Direct Print
An AES-encrypted PDF document can be printed in the direct print mode.
User PageScope Web Connection to print documents in the direct print mode. Log in as a public user or
registered user, and then select [Direct Print].
Click [Browse] to locate the file, and then click [OK].
d Reference
For details on PageScope Web Connection, refer to the [User's Guide Print Operations].8 Searchable PDF functionbizhub 423/363/283/223 8-2
8.1 Overview
8
8 Searchable PDF function
8.1 Overview
Searchable PDF refers to a function that creates a text searchable PDF file by pasting transparent text data
on the area of a document in which characters are recognized through an OCR process.
You can create a searchable PDF file when saving or sending an original in the PDF or compact PDF format
using the scan or User Box function. The searchable PDF function supports multiple languages. When creating a searchable PDF file, select an appropriate language according to the original for correct OCR
processing. Also, you can improve the accuracy of OCR processing by automatically correcting the page direction.
If you want to manage paper-based documents in electronic format, it will be convenient to use the searchable PDF function to convert documents into a text-searchable PDF file.
Reference
- This function is available when i-Option LK-105 is registered with the MFP.
- For details on the scan function, refer to the [User's Guide Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations].
- For details on User Box functions, refer to the [User's Guide Box Operations].
Precautions when creating searchable PDF files
Depending on the original condition, there may be some problems recognizing the text, the text may become
garbled, or other problems may arise.
Example
- The characters that the MFP does not support will not be correctly recognized.
- If any language different from that used in the original is selected when creating a searchable PDF file,
text will not be correctly recognized.
- If the page direction is not set to be corrected automatically, and the direction of the specified original
does not match the direction of the text, text will not be correctly recognized.
d Reference
For details on the setting to automatically correct the page direction, refer to page 8-4.
Recognizable character size
Reference
- When creating a searchable PDF file, a resolution over 300 dpi cannot be specified for scanning.
Japanese European language Asian language
Resolution
200 dpi 12 pt to 142 pt 9 pt to 142 pt 20 pt to 142 pt
300 dpi 8 pt to 96 pt 6 pt to 96 pt 12 pt to 96 ptbizhub 423/363/283/223 8-3
8.2 Configuring the OCR operation setting
8
8.2 Configuring the OCR operation setting
Before creating a searchable PDF file, you can specify whether to give priority to accuracy or speed for OCR
processing.
[OCR Operation Setting]
1 Press Utility/Counter.
2 Press [User Settings].
3 Press [Scan/Fax Settings].
4 In [Scan/Fax Settings] (2/2), press [OCR Operation Setting].
5 Select the OCR operation, and press [OK].
% [Prioritize Quality]: Give priority to recognition accuracy of an original text. Also, inclination of the
original is adjusted automatically.
% [Prioritize Speed]: Give priority to OCR processing speed. Inclination of the original is not adjusted.bizhub 423/363/283/223 8-4
8.3 Configuring the searchable PDF setting
8
8.3 Configuring the searchable PDF setting
You can create a searchable PDF file by selecting [PDF] or [Compact PDF] for file type when saving or sending an original in the PDF format using the Scan and User Box functions.
d Reference
For details on how to specify the file type when using the Scan function, refer to the [User's Guide Network
Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations].
For details on how to specify the file type when using the User Box function, refer to the [User's Guide Box
Operations].
Reference
- If [Compact PDF] is selected for [File Type] to create a searchable PDF file, the OCR processing speed
may be faster than when [PDF] is selected.
- When creating a searchable PDF file, [Resolution] cannot be set to [400 e 400dpi (Super Fine)] or [600
e 600dpi (Ultra Fine)].
- To create a searchable PDF file and encrypt a PDF file at the same time, if any of the following settings
are specified, [Adjust Rotation] cannot be set to [Adjust] in the PDF encryption setting.
– [Encryption Type]: [Digital ID]
– [Encryption Level]: [High Level 2]
– [Encryption Target]: [Other than Metadata]
– [Signature]: [Yes]
- For details on how to encrypt a PDF file, refer to page 7-4.
- For [Japanese], [Chinese], [Korean] and [Taiwanese], the text direction (vertical or horizontal writing) is
recognized automatically. However, for [Chinese], [Korean] and [Taiwanese], if both vertical and horizontal text directions are used on the same page, the original is processed based on one or the other.
- Downloading or sending a document configured as a searchable PDF file and saved in a User Box using
PageScope Web Connection causes the searchable PDF setting to be canceled and a text search to
be disabled.
Item Description
[Language Selection] Select a language to use to create a searchable PDF file.
Text will not be correctly recognized unless an appropriate language is selected according to the original.
[Adjust Rotation] Specify whether to automatically rotate each page to correct it according to
the text direction detected through an OCR process.
If the page direction is not corrected automatically, and the direction of the
specified original does not match the direction of the text, text will not be correctly recognized.9 My Panel Functionbizhub 423/363/283/223 9-2
9.1 Overview
9
9 My Panel Function
9.1 Overview
The My Panel function allows the user to centrally manage the environment of the Control Panel customized
by the user according to the application (My Panel), and to obtain My Panel on the MFP selected by the user.
Using My Panel provides the same operationality on multiple MFPs in network environment.
d Reference
This function is used in connection with the PageScope My Panel Manager. For details on enabling the
function, refer to the PageScope My Panel Manager manual.
You can also configure My Panel settings using the PageScope My Panel Manager. For details, refer to the
PageScope My Panel Manager manual.
9.1.1 Available operations with My Panel
My Panel allows you to personalize the Control Panel so that frequently-used functions are preferentially displayed.
Also, if the Web browser or Image Panel is available, by linking it with PageScope My Panel Manager, you
can manage the Web browser settings and information for each user, and personalize the Image Panel
screen.
Customizable items
My Panel allows you to customize the following items.
- Specification of a language displayed on the Control Panel
- Specification of a measurement unit to be displayed when entering numbers
- Initial display settings for the basic screen of the Copy function and registration of short-cut keys and
setting value keys to be arranged in the basic screen
- Initial display settings for the basic screen of the fax/scan function and registration of shortcut keys
- Initial display settings for the basic screen of the User Box function and registration of shortcut keys
- Specification of the color of selected buttons of the Control Panel
- Display of the My Panel main menu
- Display of the initial screen of the Control Panel
Functions available by linking to the Web browser
You can personalize the operation environment of the Web browser by linking the Web browser with My Panel. My Panel allows you to manage the following settings and information for each user.
- Home page
- Favorites
- Display history of contents
- URL input history
- Cookie
- Authentication information
d Reference
Register a home page and favorites using the Web browser. Display history, input history, cookies, authentication information are automatically stored in the server as the user uses the Web browser. For details on
how to use the Web browser, refer to page 4-2.
You can edit the registration information of a home page and favorites using PageScope My Panel Manager. For details, refer to the PageScope My Panel Manager manual.bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-3
9.1 Overview
9
Functions available with Image Panel
By linking the Image Panel with My Panel or My Address Book, you can register shortcuts for the document
source and destination in the basic screen of Image Panel to personalize the operation environment of Image
Panel. Also, you can refer to My Address Book to specify a destination to send data to.
d Reference
For details on customizing the Image Panel screen, refer to page 6-21.
For details on the My Address function, refer to page 10-2.
9.1.2 My Panel acquisition procedure
Perform user authentication on the selected MFP. If the user authentication is succeeded, the MFP automatically accesses the server to obtain My Panel of the user who is logged in.
The user can use My Panel while logged in to the MFP. My Panel is not available after the user logs out.
9.1.3 Restrictions on using the My Panel function
The following are restrictions on the use of My Panel.
- Registering, editing and deleting My Panel are available only for the user who owns the My Panel. The
administrator of the MFP cannot operate My Panel.
- When you access My Panel for the first time, the language, measurement unit and color selection settings comply with the settings in the MFP.
- When you access My Panel for the first time, the main menu of My Panel is displayed in the initial
screen.
- Only the setting memory (copy program and fax/scan program) registered on the MFP you use is available.
- Depending on the functions or option installation status of the MFP on which My Panel is used, the operating environment specified as My Panel may not be available.
- When registering, editing, or deleting My panel, an error may occur depending on the connection status
to the server. If an error occurs, check the network connection.
My Panel is available
My Panel is available
Server
(manages My Panel)
(3) Obtain My Panel (2) Access the server
(1) Perform authentication
My Panel is not available
• Authentication failed
• Log out
• Failed to obtain My Panel, etc.bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-4
9.2 Displaying My Panel
9
9.2 Displaying My Panel
9.2.1 Main Menu
Main Menu appears first when displaying My Panel.
In Main Menu, you can freely lay out frequently used functions and shortcut keys to the setting memory. In
Main Menu, 12 types of shortcut keys can be registered.
For details on configuring settings for Main Menu, refer to page 9-12.
9.2.2 Displaying Main Menu
When using the My Panel function, you can change the initial screen to be displayed after user authentication
is succeeded. To display Main Menu for My Panel from a different initial screen, use the [Application Menu].
In [Application Menu], press [My Panel] to display Main Menu of My Panel.
d Reference
The initial screen displayed after user authentication is succeeded can be changed in [My Panel Settings] Settings. For details, refer to page 9-13.
For details on the [Application Menu], refer to page 3-3.bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-5
9.3 Customizing My Panel
9
9.3 Customizing My Panel
Customize My Panel in [My Panel Settings] of [Utility].
9.3.1 [My Panel Settings]
Customizable items are as follows.
9.3.2 Displaying [My Panel Settings]
When the My Panel function is available, [My Panel Settings] appears in [Utility].
1 Log in as a registered user.
2 Press Utility/Counter.
3 Press [My Panel Settings].
Item Description
[Language Setting] Select a language to be used on My Panel.
For details, refer to page 9-6.
[Measurement Unit
Settings]
Select a measurement unit to be used when displaying values on My Panel.
For details, refer to page 9-6.
[Copier Settings] Specify the initial display settings for the basic screen of the Copy function and
register short-cut keys and setting value keys to be arranged in the basic
screen.
For details, refer to page 9-7.
[Scan/Fax Settings] Initial display settings for the basic screen of the fax/scan function and registration of shortcut keys
For details, refer to page 9-9.
[User Box Settings] Configure initial display settings for the basic screen of the User Box function
and register shortcut keys.
For details, refer to page 9-11.
[Color Selection Settings]
Select a color for the selected buttons on My Panel.
For details, refer to page 9-12.
[Main Menu Settings] Register the main menu buttons on the Main Menu screen of My Panel.
For details, refer to page 9-12.
[Initial Screen Settings] Specify the initial screen to be displayed after user authentication is succeeded.
For details, refer to page 9-13.bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-6
9.3 Customizing My Panel
9
The My Panel Settings screen appears.
9.3.3 [Language Setting]
Select a language to be used on My Panel from the languages available on the MFP.
9.3.4 [Measurement Unit Settings]
Select a length unit to be used on My Panel.bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-7
9.3 Customizing My Panel
9
9.3.5 [Copier Settings]
Specify the initial display settings for the basic screen of the Copy function and register short-cut keys and
setting value keys to be arranged in the basic screen.
[Default Tab]
Configure the default display settings for the basic screen in the copy mode.
[Basic] displays normal basic display.
[Quick Copy] displays the setting items of basic settings screen in a single screen. It can be used to specify
multiple setting at one time.
[Shortcut Key 1] - [Shortcut Key 2]
Lay out shortcut keys for frequently used copy application functions on the basic screen.
Up to two shortcut keys can be laid out.
Even if you log in to another model and register a function in [Shortcut Key 1] and/or [Shortcut Key 2], [OFF]
is displayed for this machine when that function is not available with this machine. (Example: [Density], [Background Removal])
In addition, displaying a page with which to register a function in [Shortcut Key 1] and/or [Shortcut Key 2]
when that function is not available causes [OFF] to be selected. If [OK] is selected, [OFF] is set for [Shortcut
Key 1] and [Shortcut Key 2].
As a result, shortcut keys are not displayed even if you log in to another model.bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-8
9.3 Customizing My Panel
9
[Quick Settings 1] - [Quick Settings 4]
Arrange the setting values of the Copy function and copy program keys in the basic screen.
By arranging the frequently-used setting values and copy program keys in the basic screen, you can configure the copy settings easily only by pressing the key. You can arrange up to four keys.
Even if you log in to another model and register a function in [Quick Settings 1] - [Quick Settings 4], [OFF] is
displayed for this machine when that function is not available with this machine. (Example: [Color])
Displaying a page with which to register a function in [Quick Settings 1] - [Quick Settings 4] when that function
is not available causes [OFF] to be selected. If [OK] is selected, [OFF] is set for [Quick Settings 1] and [Quick
Settings 4].
As a result, quick setting keys are not displayed even if you log in to another model.
d Reference
To arrange a copy program in the basic screen, you must register the copy program in advance. For details
on how to register a copy program, refer to the [User's Guide Copy Operations].
[Default Tab Density Settings]
Place the key to adjust the copy density on the basic screen.
Reference
- When placing the density adjustment key on the basic screen, [Quick Settings 3] and [Quick Settings
4] are not available.bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-9
9.3 Customizing My Panel
9
9.3.6 [Scan/Fax Settings]
Configure initial display settings for the basic screen of the fax/scan function and register shortcut keys.
[Default Tab]
Configure initial display settings for the basic screen in the fax/scan function.
[Address Book Index Default]
To use the public address book, specify the type of an index to be displayed initially in [Address Book].
By default, [My Address Book] is selected.
d Reference
For details on the My Address function, refer to page 10-2.bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-10
9.3 Customizing My Panel
9
[Shortcut Key 1] - [Shortcut Key 2]
Lay out shortcut keys for frequently used fax/scan application functions on the basic screen. Up to two shortcut keys can be laid out.
[Default Address Book]
Configure settings for the default screen of [Address Book].
[Default Address Type]
When displaying an address book by address type, specify an address type to be displayed by default.bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-11
9.3 Customizing My Panel
9
9.3.7 [User Box Settings]
Configure initial display settings for the basic screen of the User Box function and register shortcut keys.
[Default Tab]
Configure the default display settings for the basic screen (after User Box is pressed on the Control Panel)
in the User Box mode.
[Shortcut Key 1] - [Shortcut Key 2]
Lay out shortcut keys for User Boxes frequently used when using a User Box document on the basic screen.
Up to two shortcut keys can be laid out.bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-12
9.3 Customizing My Panel
9
9.3.8 [Color Selection Settings]
Select a color for the selected buttons on My Panel.
9.3.9 [Main Menu Settings]
Customize the main menu of My Panel.
You can freely lay out frequently used functions and shortcut keys to the setting memory (copy programs and
fax/scan programs) in Main Menu.
Main menu button
The shortcut key displayed in Main Menu is called the main menu button, and up to 12 types can be registered.
To register the set memory (copy programs and fax/scan programs) as main menu buttons, press [Icon] to
select icons for the setting memory to be displayed on Main Menu.
Registering a main menu button
[Function], [Copy Function Settings], [Scan/Fax Function Settings], [Copy Program Settings], and [Scan/Fax
Program Settings] can be assigned as main menu buttons.
Item Description
[Function] Registers a shortcut key to each of [Copy], [Scan/Fax], [User Box], [Image Panel], and [Web Browser] functions.
Shortcut key for the Web Browser or Image Panel functions can be registered
in Main Menu only when its function is enabled.
[Copy Function Settings]
Register shortcut keys in Copy Function Settings for each of [Paper Setting],
[Zoom], [Duplex/Combine], and [Finishing].bizhub 423/363/283/223 9-13
9.3 Customizing My Panel
9
9.3.10 [Initial Screen Settings]
Specify the initial screen to be displayed after user authentication is succeeded. By default, the My Panel
main menu is displayed as the initial screen.
Reference
- Shortcut key for the Web Browser or Image Panel functions can be registered in the initial screen only
when its function is enabled.
[Scan/Fax Function
Settings]
Register shortcut keys in Scan/Fax Function Settings for each of [Scan Settings], [Original Settings] and [Comm. Settings].
[Copy Program Settings]
Register a shortcut key to the copier setting memory (copy program) registered in the MFP.
Press [Icon] in the Main Menu Settings screen. You can select setting memory
icons to be displayed on Main Menu.
The shortcut key for the setting memory is available only on the MFP with the
setting memory registered.
For details on registering the copier setting memory (copy program), refer to
the [User's Guide Copy Operations].
[Scan/Fax Program
Settings]
Register a shortcut key to the fax/scan setting memory (fax/scan program)
registered in the MFP.
Press [Icon] in the Main Menu Settings screen. You can select setting memory
icons to be displayed on Main Menu.
The shortcut key for the setting memory is available only on the MFP with the
setting memory registered.
For details on registering the fax/scan setting memory (fax/scan program), refer to the [User's Guide Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations].
Item Description10 My Address functionbizhub 423/363/283/223 10-2
10.1 Overview
10
10 My Address function
10.1 Overview
The My Address function allows the user to centrally manage the personal address book (My Address Book)
on the server, and to obtain My Address Book on the MFP selected by the user.
Using My Address Book allows you to use the same address book on multiple MFPs in your network environment without registering addresses individually on each MFP.
d Reference
This function is used in connection with the PageScope My Panel Manager. For details on enabling the
function, refer to the PageScope My Panel Manager manual.
You can also add entries to My Address Book using PageScope My Panel Manager. For details, refer to the
PageScope My Panel Manager manual.
10.1.1 Classification of address books
When the My Address function is available, you can use the following two kinds of address books.
Public address book
Public address book refers to an address book accessible to anyone registered in the main unit of the MFP
selected by the user.
The public address book is provided with the following features.
- In the public address book. one-touch destinations, groups, and programs can be registered.
- Since the public address book is registered in the main unit of the MFP, available destinations depend
on the selected MFP.
- The user or administrator can register, edit, or delete the public address book.
- If registration and editing of destinations by a user is restricted by the administrator, registration or editing of the public address book is not possible.
My Address Book
My Address Book refers to a server-managed address book accessible only to the user.
My Address Book is provided with the following features.
- In My Address Book, one-touch destinations and groups can be registered.
- Since the My Address function is obtained from the server on the MFP selected by the user, it is available on any MFP in which the My Address function is available.
- Only the specified user can register, edit or delete My Panel.bizhub 423/363/283/223 10-3
10.1 Overview
10
10.1.2 My Address Book acquisition procedure
Perform user authentication on the selected MFP. If the user authentication is succeeded, the MFP automatically accesses the server to obtain My Address Book of the user who is logged in.
The user can use My Address Book while logged in to the MFP. My Address Book is not available after the
user logs out.
10.1.3 Restrictions on using the My Address function
There are following restrictions on My Address Book.
- Only the user who owns My Address Book can register, edit or delete My Address Book. The administrator of the MFP cannot operate My Address Book.
- My Address Book can contain up to 100 one-touch destinations and up to 10 groups (up to 100 onetouch destinations per group).
- If the number of registered destinations in My Address Book exceeds the maximum value, a new destination cannot be registered.
- Program cannot be registered in My Address Book.
- Destination search by index is not possible in My Address Book.
- User Box is available only on the MFPs with registered destinations.
- Depending on the MFP settings or options installed in the MFP on which My Address Book is used,
sending that has been specified in the address book may not be performed.
- When registering, editing, or deleting My address book, an error may occur depending on the connection status to the server. If an error occurs, check the network connection.
My Address Book is available
My Address Book is
available
Server
(manages My Address Book)
(3) Obtain My
Address Book
(2) Access the server
(1) Perform authentication
My Address Book is not available
• Authentication failed
• Log out
• Failed to obtain My Panel, etc.bizhub 423/363/283/223 10-4
10.2 Registering and editing a destination
10
10.2 Registering and editing a destination
Register frequently used personal addresses in My Address Book. Addresses can be registered using any of
the following methods.
- Using the Control Panel of the MFP
- Using PageScope Web Connection from a computer on the network
- Using the PageScope My Panel Manager
In My Address Book, one-touch destinations and groups can be registered. This section describes how to
register addresses from the Control Panel of the MFP.
10.2.1 Address Book
Frequently used fax numbers and E-mail addresses, and registered User Boxes can be registered as onetouch destinations. Up to 100 one-touch destinations can be registered in My Address Book.
1 Log in as a registered user.
2 Press Utility/Counter.
3 Press [One-Touch/User Box Registration].
4 Press [Create One-Touch Destination].
5 Press [Address Book (Personal)].
% To add one-touch destinations to the shared address book, press [Address Book (Public)].
A list of personal one-touch destinations appears.
6 Press [New].
% To edit a registered destination, select the destination, and then press [Edit].
% To delete a registered address, select the destination, and then press [Delete].
% To check a registered address, select the address, and then press [Check Job Set.].bizhub 423/363/283/223 10-5
10.2 Registering and editing a destination
10
7 Select the type of address to be registered, and then configure settings for required items.
d Reference
For details of the address book entries, refer to the [User's Guide Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations].
10.2.2 Group
Multiple one-touch destinations in My Address Book can be grouped, and registered as a group. In My Address Book, up to 10 groups (up to 100 one-touch destinations per group) can be registered.
1 Log in as a registered user.
2 Press Utility/Counter.
3 Press [One-Touch/User Box Registration].
4 Press [Create One-Touch Destination].
5 Press [Group].
A list of groups appears.
6 Press [Personal], and then press [New].
% To edit a registered group, select the group, and then press [Edit].
% To delete a registered group, select the group, and then press [Delete].
% To check a registered group, select the group, and then press [Check Job Set.].
% Press [Public] to display the public groups.bizhub 423/363/283/223 10-6
10.2 Registering and editing a destination
10
7 Check that a personal group is selected as a registration destination, and then configure settings for
required items.
% Select [Select Group]. The addresses registered in My Address Book are displayed. Select onetouch destination to be grouped.
d Reference
For details on registration contents of the group, refer to the [User's Guide Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax
Operations].bizhub 423/363/283/223 10-7
10.3 Copying destinations between address books
10
10.3 Copying destinations between address books
Registered one-touch destinations can be copied between the public address book and My Address Book.
Reference
- Groups cannot be copied between the public address book and My Address Book.
10.3.1 Copying destinations from the public address book to My Address Book
Addresses registered in the public address book can be copied to My Address Book.
1 Display [Create One-Touch Destination].
2 Press [Address Book (Public)].
3 Select the type of address to be copied.
A list of registered address books of the selected address type appears.
4 Select an address to be copied, and then press [Copy to Personal Addr.].
5 Select [Yes] on the confirmation screen, and then press [OK].
The selected address is copied.bizhub 423/363/283/223 10-8
10.3 Copying destinations between address books
10
10.3.2 Copying destinations from My Address Book to the public address book
Destinations registered in My Address Book can be copied to the public address book.
1 Display [Create One-Touch Destination].
2 Press [Address Book (Personal)].
A list of personal one-touch destinations appears.
3 Select an address to be copied, and then press [Copy to Shared Addr.].
4 Select [Yes] on the confirmation screen, and then press [OK].
The selected address is copied.bizhub 423/363/283/223 10-9
10.4 Using My Address Book when sending a document
10
10.4 Using My Address Book when sending a document
Use My Address Book to specify a destination when sending a document using the Scan/Fax functions, or
sending a document in a User Box.
10.4.1 Specifying destinations
When the My Address function is available, the following screen appears when specifying an address.
Addresses registered in My Address Book appears by address type. Select the desired destination.
To select an address registered in the public address book, press [Public].
10.4.2 Searching for destinations
If a desired address is not found, you can search for it. In the screen for specifying a destination, press
[Search].
To search for destinations based on the registered address type, press [Address Type].
To search for destinations based on the name and a part of registration contents, press [Detail Search].11 Indexbizhub 423/363/283/223 11-2
11.1 Index by item
11
11 Index
11.1 Index by item
A
Accessing ....................................................................5-2
Acquiring my panel ......................................................9-3
Address book ............................................................10-4
Application key ....................................................3-2, 3-4
Application menu ........................................................3-3
C
Cache ..........................................................................5-2
Cellular phone/PDA .........................................6-10, 6-17
Customizing ..............................................3-4, 6-21, 9-5
D
Deleting .......................................................................5-9
Display mode of web browser ...................................4-10
Displaying ..................................................................4-19
E
Entering text in web browser ....................................4-10
External memory .......................................................6-15
F
Flash player .................................................................4-3
G
Group ........................................................................10-5
I
Image panel ...................................... 2-3, 6-2, 6-3, 6-21
Image panel operation ................................................6-5
J
Just-fit rendering .......................................................4-10
L
Logging in ....................................................................5-4
Logging out .................................................................5-4
M
Main menu ...................................................................9-4
My address ........................................................2-3, 10-2
My address book ............................................10-2, 10-9
My address book acquisition ....................................10-3
My panel ......................................................2-3, 9-2, 9-4
My panel settings ........................................................9-5
O
OCR .............................................................................8-3
Opening user boxes ....................................................5-5
Operating web browser ...............................................4-9
P
PageScope Web Connection ......................................5-2
PDF processing .................................................. 2-3, 7-2
Photo .........................................................................6-18
PIN code ....................................................................6-17
Print ...........................................................................6-14
Printing ............................................................. 4-18, 5-7
Public address book ..................................................10-2
R
Restriction of web browser .........................................4-5
Restrictions on my address .......................................10-3
Restrictions on my panel .............................................9-3
S
Saving ........................................................................4-20
Scanning ......................................................................6-7
Screen components of image panel ...........................6-4
Screen components of
PageScope Web Connection ......................................5-3
Screen components of web browser ..........................4-8
Searchable PDF .......................................... 2-3, 8-2, 8-4
Send tray ...................................................................6-16
Smart-fit rendering ....................................................4-10
Speaker .....................................................................4-11
Specifications ................................................... 4-2, 6-18
Specifications for web browser ...................................4-2
T
Toolbar ......................................................................4-12
U
Upload .......................................................................4-21
User box ............................................................. 5-5, 6-8
W
Web browser .............................................. 2-3, 4-2, 4-4
Web browser information ..........................................4-17
Web browser settings ................................................4-16bizhub 423/363/283/223 11-3
11.2 Index by button
11
11.2 Index by button
A
Access log .................................................................4-17
Access to the Web browser contents .........................4-7
Address Book (Personal) ...........................................10-4
Address Book Index Default .......................................9-9
Application key 1 .........................................................3-2
Application key 2 .........................................................3-3
Application Key Settings .............................................3-4
Application menu ........................................................3-3
Application menu key ..................................................3-2
Authentication information ........................................4-17
C
Cache ........................................................................4-17
Cellular Phone ...........................................................6-10
Color Selection Settings ............................................9-12
Combine Documents ................................................6-12
Cookie .......................................................................4-17
Copier Settings ............................................................9-7
Copy to Personal Addr ..............................................10-7
Copy to Shared Addr ................................................10-8
D
Default Address Book ...............................................9-10
Default Address Type ................................................9-10
Default Tab ................................................9-7, 9-9, 9-11
Default Tab Density Settings .......................................9-8
Destination List ..........................................................6-15
Digital ID ......................................................................7-5
Direct Print ..................................................................7-7
Document Settings ....................................................6-13
Document Source List .................................................6-8
Document/Page ....................................6-11, 6-12, 6-13
E
Easy Setting ................................................................9-8
Edit Document ...........................................................6-11
Encryption ...................................................................7-4
External memory ...............................................6-9, 6-15
F
Favorites (Add) ..........................................................4-13
Favorites (View) .........................................................4-13
Function Permission ....................................................4-6
G
Group ........................................................................10-5
H
History .......................................................................4-14
I
Initial Screen Settings ................................................9-13
Input Address ............................................................4-14
L
Language Setting ........................................................9-6
M
Main Menu Settings ...................................................9-12
Manage windows ......................................................4-17
Measurement Unit Settings .........................................9-6
Menu ..........................................................................4-16
My Panel Settings ........................................................9-5
O
OCR operation setting .................................................8-3
P
Page Operation .........................................................4-16
Password .....................................................................7-4
PDF Document Properties ...........................................7-3
Photo/Icon .................................................................6-19
Preview ......................................................................6-11
Print ...........................................................................4-15
Print Settings .............................................................6-14
Proxy .........................................................................4-17
R
Return to Scan Dest ..................................................6-13
S
Scan ............................................................................6-7
Scan/Fax Settings .......................................................9-9
Security ......................................................................4-17
Settings .....................................................................4-17
Shortcut key ........................................... 9-7, 9-10, 9-11
U
User Box Settings ......................................................9-11
V
View ...........................................................................4-16
W
Web browser setting ...................................................4-5Copyright
A1UD-9586AF-00 2010 2010. 1
http://konicaminolta.com
magicolor 1650EN
User’s Guide
A034-9571-03Ax-1
Thank You
Thank you for purchasing a magicolor 1650EN. You have made an excellent choice.
Your magicolor 1650EN is specially designed for optimal performance in Windows,
Macintosh and Linux environments.
Trademarks
KONICA MINOLTA and the KONICA MINOLTA logo are trademarks or registered
trademarks of KONICA MINOLTA HOLDINGS, INC.
magicolor and PageScope are trademarks or registered trademarks of KONICA
MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
All other trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective
owners.
Copyright Notice
Copyright © 2008 KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC., Marunouchi Center Building, 1-6-1 Marunouchi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo, 100-0005, Japan. All
Rights Reserved. This document may not be copied, in whole or part, nor transferred
to any other media or language, without written permission of KONICA MINOLTA
BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
Notice
KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC. reserves the right to make
changes to this guide and to the equipment described herein without notice. Considerable effort has been made to ensure that this guide is free of inaccuracies and
omissions. However, KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC. makes
no warranty of any kind including, but not limited to, any implied warranties of merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose with regard to this guide.
KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC. assumes no responsibility
for, or liability for, errors contained in this guide or for incidental, special, or consequential damages arising out of the furnishing of this guide, or the use of this guide in
operating the equipment, or in connection with the performance of the equipment
when so operated.x-2
SOFTWARE LICENSE AGREEMENT
This package contains the following materials provided by KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS
TECHNOLOGIES, INC. (KMBT): software included as part of the printing system (“Printing
Software”), the digitally-encoded machine-readable outline data encoded in the special format
and in the encrypted form (“Font Programs”), other software which runs on a computer system
for use in conjunction with the Printing Software (“Host Software”), and related explanatory written materials (“Documentation”). The term “Software” shall be used to describe Printing Software, Font Programs and/or Host Software and also include any upgrades, modified versions,
additions, and copies of the Software.
The Software is being licensed to you under the terms of this Agreement.
KMBT grants to you a non-exclusive sublicense to use the Software and Documentation, provided that you agree to the following:
1. You may use the Software and accompanying Font Programs for imaging to the licensed
output device(s), solely for your own internal business purposes.
2. In addition to the license for Font Programs set forth in Section 1 above, you may use
Roman Font Programs to reproduce weights, styles, and versions of letters, numerals,
characters and symbols (“Typefaces”) on the display or monitor for your own internal business purposes.
3. You may make one backup copy of the Host Software, provided your backup copy is not
installed or used on any computer. Notwithstanding the above restrictions, you may install
the Host Software on any number of computers solely for use with one or more printing systems running the Printing Software.
4. You may assign its rights under this Agreement to an assignee of all of Licensee’s right and
interest to such Software and Documentation (“Assignee”) provided you transfer to
Assignee all copies of such Software and Documentation Assignee agrees to be bound by
all of the terms and conditions of this Agreement.
5. You agree not to modify, adapt or translate the Software and Documentation.
6. You agree that you will not attempt to alter, disassemble, decrypt, reverse engineer or
decompile the Software.
7. Title to and ownership of the Software and Documentation and any reproductions thereof
shall remain with KMBT and its licensor.
8. Trademarks shall be used in accordance with accepted trademark practice, including identification of the trademark owner’s name. Trademarks can only be used to identify printed
output produced by the Software. Such use of any trademark does not give you any rights
of ownership in that trademark.
9. You may not rent, lease, sublicense, lend or transfer versions or copies of the Software Licensee does not use, or Software contained on any unused media, except as part of the permanent transfer of all Software and Documentation as described above.
10. IN NO EVENT WILL KMBT OR ITS LICENSOR BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL, INCIDENTAL INDIRECT, PUNITIVE OR SPECIAL DAMAGES, INCLUDING
ANY LOST PROFITS OR LOST SAVING, EVEN IF KMBT HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES, OR FOR ANY CLAIM BY ANY THIRD PARTY. KMBT
OR ITS LICENSOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THE SOFTWARE, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE
AND NON-INFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. SOME STATES OR JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL OR SPECIAL DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATIONS MAY NOT APPLY
TO YOU.x-3
11. Notice to Government End Users: The Software is a “commercial item,” as that term is
defined at 48 C.F.R.2.101, consisting of “commercial computer software” and “commercial
computer software documentation,” as such terms are used in 48 C.F.R. 12.212. Consistent with 48 C.F.R. 12.212 and 48 C.F.R. 227.7202-1 through 227.7202-4, all U.S. Government End Users acquire the Software with only those rights set forth herein.
12. You agree that you will not export the Software in any form in violation of any applicable
laws and regulations regarding export control of any countries.
About Adobe Color Profile
ADOBE SYSTEMS INCORPORATED
COLOR PROFILE LICENSE AGREEMENT
NOTICE TO USER: PLEASE READ THIS CONTRACT CAREFULLY. BY USING ALL OR ANY
PORTION OF THE SOFTWARE YOU ACCEPT ALL THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF
THIS SOFTWARE YOU ACCEPT ALL THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF THIS AGREEMENT. IF YOU DO NOT AGREE WITH THE TERMS OF THIS AGREEMENT, DO NOT USE
THE SOFTWARE.
1. DEFINITIONS In this Agreement, “Adobe” means Adobe Systems Incorporated, a Delaware corporation, located at 345 Park Avenue, San Jose, California 95110. “Software”
means the software and related items with which this Agreement is provided.
2. LICENSE Subject to the terms of this Agreement, Adobe hereby grants you the worldwide,
non-exclusive, nontransferable, royalty-free license to use, reproduce and publicly display
the Software. Adobe also grants you the rights to distribute the Software only (a) as embedded within digital image files and (b) on a standalone basis. No other distribution of the
Software is allowed; including, without limitation, distribution of the Software when incorporated into or bundled with any application software. All individual profiles must be referenced by their ICC Profile description string. You may not modify the Software. Adobe is
under no obligation to provide any support under this Agreement, including upgrades or
future versions of the Software or other items. No title to the intellectual property in the Software is transferred to you under the terms of this Agreement. You do not acquire any rights
to the Software except as expressly set forth in this Agreement.
3. DISTRIBUTION If you choose to distribute the Software, you do so with the understanding
that you agree to defend, indemnify and hold harmless Adobe against any losses, damages or costs arising from any claims, lawsuits or other legal actions arising out of such distribution, including without limitation, your failure to comply with this Section 3. If you
distribute the Software on a standalone basis, you will do so under the terms of this Agreement or your own license agreement which (a) complies with the terms and conditions of
this Agreement; (b) effectively disclaims all warranties and conditions, express or implied,
on behalf of Adobe; (c) effectively excludes all liability for damages on behalf of Adobe; (d)
states that any provisions that differ from this Agreement are offered by you alone and not
Adobe and (e) states that the Software is available from you or Adobe and informs licensees how to obtain it in a reasonable manner on or through a medium customarily used for
software exchange. Any distributed Software will include the Adobe copyright notices as
included in the Software provided to you by Adobe.x-4
4. DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY Adobe licenses the Software to you on an “AS IS” basis.
Adobe makes no representation as to the adequacy of the Software for any particular purpose or to produce any particular result. Adobe shall not be liable for loss or damage arising out of this Agreement or from the distribution or use of the Software or any other
materials. ADOBE AND ITS SUPPLIERS DO NOT AND CANNOT WARRANT THE PERFORMANCE OR RESULTS YOU MAY OBTAIN BY USING THE SOFTWARE, EXCEPT
FOR ANY WARRANTY, CONDITION, REPRESENTATION OR TERM TO THE EXTENT
TO WHICH THE SAME CANNOT OR MAY NOT BE EXCLUDED OR LIMITED BY LAW
APPLICABLE TO YOU IN YOUR JURISDICTION, ADOBE AND ITS SUPPLIERS MAKE
NO WARRANTIES, CONDITIONS, REPRESENTATIONS OR TERMS, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, WHETHER BY STATUTE, COMMON LAW, CUSTOM, USAGE OR OTHERWISE AS TO ANY OTHER MATTERS, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS, INTEGRATION, SATISFACTORY QUALITY
OR FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE. YOU MAY HAVE ADDITIONAL
RIGHTS WHICH VARY FROM JURISDICTION TO JURISDICTION. The provisions of Sections 4, 5 and 6 shall survive the termination of this Agreement, howsoever caused, but this
shall not imply or create any continued right to use the Software after termination of this
Agreement.
5. LIMITATION OF LIABILITY IN NO EVENT WILL ADOBE OR ITS SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE
TO YOU FOR ANY DAMAGES, CLAIMS OR COSTS WHATSOEVER OR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, OR ANY LOST PROFITS OR LOST
SAVINGS, EVEN IF AN ADOBE REPRESENTATIVE HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH LOSS, DAMAGES, CLAIMS OR COSTS OR FOR ANY CLAIM BY
ANY THIRD PARTY. THE FOREGOING LIMITATIONS AND EXCLUSIONS APPLY TO
THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW IN YOUR JURISDICTION. ADOBE’S
AGGREGATE LIABILITY AND THAT OF ITS SUPPLIERS UNDER OR IN CONNECTION
WITH THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE LIMITED TO THE AMOUNT PAID FOR THE SOFTWARE. Nothing contained in this Agreement limits Adobe’s liability to you in the event of
death or personal injury resulting from Adobe’s negligence or for the tort of deceit (fraud).
Adobe is acting on behalf of its suppliers for the purpose of disclaiming, excluding and/or
limiting obligations, warranties and liability as provided in this Agreement, but in no other
respects and for no other purpose.
6. TRADEMARKS Adobe and the Adobe logo are the registered trademarks or trademarks of
Adobe in the United States and other countries. With the exception of referential use, you
will not use such trademarks or any other Adobe trademark or logo without separate prior
written permission granted by Adobe.
7. TERM This Agreement is effective until terminated. Adobe has the right to terminate this
Agreement immediately if you fail to comply with any term hereof. Upon any such termination, you must return to Adobe all full and partial copies of the Software in your possession
or control.
8. GOVERNMENT REGULATIONS If any part of the Software is identified as an export controlled item under the United States Export Administration Act or any other export law,
restriction or regulation (the “Export Laws”), you represent and warrant that you are not a
citizen, or otherwise located within, an embargoed nation (including without limitation Iran,
Iraq, Syria, Sudan, Libya, Cuba, North Korea, and Serbia) and that you are not otherwise
prohibited under the Export Laws from receiving the Software. All rights to use the Software
are granted on condition that such rights are forfeited if you fail to comply with the terms of
this Agreement.x-5
9. GOVERNING LAW This Agreement will be governed by and construed in accordance with
the substantive laws in force in the State of California as such laws are applied to agreements entered into and to be performed entirely within California between California residents. This Agreement will not be governed by the conflict of law rules of any jurisdiction or
the United Nations Convention on Contracts for the International Sale of Goods, the application of which is expressly excluded. All disputes arising out of, under or related to this
Agreement will be brought exclusively in the state Santa Clara County, California, USA.
10. GENERAL You may not assign your rights or obligations granted under this Agreement
without the prior written consent of Adobe. None of the provisions of this Agreement shall
be deemed to have been waived by any act or acquiescence on the part of Adobe, its
agents, or employees, but only by an instrument in writing signed by an authorized signatory of Adobe. When conflicting language exists between this Agreement and any other
agreement included in the Software, the terms of such included agreement shall apply. If
either you or Adobe employs attorneys to enforce any rights arising out of or relating to this
Agreement, the prevailing party shall be entitled to recover reasonable attorneys’ fees. You
acknowledge that you have read this Agreement, understand it, and that it is the complete
and exclusive statement of your agreement with Adobe which supersedes any prior agreement, oral or written, between Adobe and you with respect to the licensing to you of the
Software. No variation of the terms of this Agreement will be enforceable against Adobe
unless Adobe gives its express consent, in writing, signed by an authorized signatory of
Adobe.
ICC Profile for TOYO INK Standard Color on Coated paper
(TOYO Offset Coated 2.1)
This ICC Profile (TOYO Offset Coated 2.1) characterizes Japanese offset press on Coated
paper and is fully compatible with ICC profile format.
About “TOYO INK Standard Color on Coated paper”
This is the standard for color reproduction of sheet-fed offset press on Coated paper made by
TOYO INK MFG.CO., LTD. (“TOYO INK”).
This standard is made from printing test with using TOYO INK’s sheet-fed offset printing inks
and TOYO INK’s own printing conditions.
“TOYO INK Standard Color on Coated paper” is compatible with “JAPAN COLOR”.
Agreement
1. The reproduction of images on a printer or a monitor using this ICC Profile do not completely match the TOYO INK Standard Color on Coated paper.
2. Any and all copyrights of this ICC Profile shall remain in TOYO INK; therefore you shall not
transfer, provide, rent, distribute, disclose, or grant any rights in this ICC Profile to any third
party without the prior written consent of TOYO INK.
3. In no event will TOYO INK its directors, officers, employees or agents be liable to you for
any consequential or incidential, either direct or indirect, damages(including damages for
loss of business profits, business interruption, loss of business information, and the like)
arising out of the use or inability to use this ICC Profile.
4. TOYO INK shall not be responsible for answering any question related to this ICC Profile.x-6
5. All company names and product names used in this document is the trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective holder.
This ICC Profile made by GretagMacbeth ProfileMaker and granted TOYO INK certain license
to distribute by GretagMacbeth AG.
TOYO Offset Coated 2.1 © TOYO INK MFG. CO., LTD. 2004
DIC STANDARD COLOR PROFILE LICENSE AGREEMENT
IMPORTANT: PLEASE READ THIS STANDARD COLOR PROFILE LICENSE AGREEMENT
("LICENSE AGREEMENT") CAREFULLY BEFORE USING THE DIC STANDARD COLOR
PROFILE, INCLUDING THE DIC STANDARD SFC_AM2.0, DIC STANDARD SFM_AM2.0,
DIC STANDARD SFU_AM2.0, DIC STANDARD SFC_FM2.0, DIC WAKIMIZU SFC_AM2.0,
DIC WAKIMIZU SFC_FM2.0, DIC ABILIO SFC_AM1.0, DIC HY-BRYTE SFC_AM1.0, DIC
STANDARD WEBC_AM2.1, DIC STANDARD WEBC_FM2.1, DIC NEWSCOLOR_AM1.0, DIC
NEWSCOLOR_FM1.0, PROVIDED BY DIC HEREWITH, AND ANY CORRESPONDIMG
ONLINE OR ELECTRONC DOCUMENTATION AND ALL UPDATES OR UPGRADES OF THE
ABOVE THAT ARE PROVIDED TO YOU (COLLECTIVELY, THE "PROFILE").
THIS LICENSE AGREEMENT IS A LEGAL AGREEMENT BETWEEN YOU (EITHER AN INDIVIDUAL OR, IF ACQUIRED BY OR FOR AN ENTITY, AN ENTITY) AND DIC CORPORATION,
A JAPANESE COMPANY ("DIC"). THIS LICENSE AGREEMENT PROVIDES A LICENSE TO
USE THE PROFILE AND CONTAINS WARRANTY INFORMATION AND LIABILITY DISCLAIMERS. IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO BE BOUND BY ALL OF THESE TERMS, YOU MAY
NOT USE THE PROFILE.
1. License Grant
DIC grants you a gratis non-exclusive and non-transferable license to use the Profile and to
allow your employees and authorized agents, if any, to use the Profile, solely in connection
with their work for you, subject to all of the limitations and restrictions in this License Agreement.
2. Ownership
The foregoing license gives you limited license to use the Profile. You will own the rights in
the media containing the recorded Profile, but DIC retains all right, title and interest, including all copyright and intellectual property rights, in and to, the Profile and all copies thereof.
All rights not specifically granted in this License Agreement, including all copyrights, are
reserved by DIC.
3. Term
a. This License Agreement is effective until terminated.
b. You may terminate this License Agreement by notifying DIC in writing of your intention to
terminate this License Agreement and by destroying, all copies of the Profile in your possession or control.
c. DIC may terminate this License Agreement without prior notice to you if you fail to comply with any of the terms and conditions of this License Agreement (either directly or
through your employees or agents), retroactive to the time of such failure to comply. In
such event, you must immediately stop using the Profile and destroy all copies of the Profile in your possession or control.
d. All provisions in this License Agreement relating to warranty disclaimers (Section 5) and
the limitation of liability (Section 6) shall survive any termination of this License Agreement.x-7
4. License Method and Restrictions
a. You may install and use the Profile on a single desktop computer; provided, however,
that, notwithstanding anything contrary contained herein, you may not use the Profile on
any network system or share, install or use the Profile concurrently on different computers,
or electronically transfer the Profile from one computer to another or over a network.
b. You may not make or distribute copies, fix, alter, merge, modify, adapt, sublicense, transfer, sell, rent, lease, gift or distribute all or a portion of the Profile, or modify the Profile or
create derivative works based upon the Profile.
c. You acknowledge that the Profile is not intended for any usage which may cause death
or physical injury or environmental damage and agree not to use the Profile for such usage.
d. You shall not use the Profile to develop any software or other technology having the
same primary function as the Profile, including but not limited to using the Profile in any
development or test procedure that seeks to develop like software or other technology, or to
determine if such software or other technology performs in a similar manner as the Profile.
e. DIC and other trademarks contained in the Profile are trademarks or registered trademarks of DIC in Japan and/or other countries. You may not remove or alter any trademark,
trade names, product names, logo, copyright or other proprietary notices, legends, symbols
or labels in the Profile. This License Agreement does not authorize you to use DIC’s or its
licensors’ names or any of their respective trademarks.
5. WARRANTY DISCLAIMER
a. THE PROFILE IS PROVIDED TO YOU FREE OF CHARGE, AND ON AN "AS-IS"
BASIS, IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE TERMS AND COONDITIONS OF THIS LICENSE
AGREEMENT. DIC PROVIDES NO TECHNICAL SUPPORT, WARRANTIES OR REMEDIES FOR THE PROFILE.
b. DIC DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES AND REPRESENTATIONS, WHETHER
EXPRESS, IMPLIED, OR OTHERWISE, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, NONINFRINGEMENT, TITLE AND QUIET ENJOYMENT. YOU SHALL ASSUME AND BE
FULLY LIABLE AND RESPONSIBLE FOR ALL RISKS IN CONNECTION WITH YOUR
USE OF THE PROFILE. DIC DOES NOT WARRANT THAT THE PROFILE IS FREE OF
DEFECTS OR FLAWS OR WILL OPERATE WITHOUT INTERRUPTION, AND IS NOT
RESPONSIBLE FORCORRECTING OR REPAIRING ANY DEFECTS OR FLAWS, FOR
FEE OR GRATIS. NO RIGHTS OR REMEDIES WILL BE CONFERRED ON YOU
UNLESS EXPRESSLY GRANTED HEREIN.
6. LIMITATION OF LIABILITY
DIC SHALL NOT BE LIABLE TO YOU OR ANY THIRD PARTY FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, PUNITIVE, COVER OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, DAMAGES FOR THE INABILITY TO USE EQUIPMENT OR ACCESS DATA, LOSS OF BUSINESS, LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION OR THE LIKE), ARISING OUT OF THE USE OF, OR INABILITY TO
USE, THE PROFILE AND BASED ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY INCLUDING
BREACH OF CONTRACT, BREACH OF WARRANTY, TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), PRODUCT LIABILITY OR OTHERWISE, EVEN IF DIC OR ITS REPRESENTATIVES HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
THE FOREGOING LIMITATIONS ON LIABILITY SHALL APPLY TO ALL ASPECTS OF
THIS LICENSE AGREEMENT.
7. General
a. This License Agreement shall be governed and construed in accordance with the laws of
Japan, without giving effect to principles of conflict of laws. If any provision of this License
Agreement shall be held by a court of competent jurisdiction to be contrary to law, that provision will be enforced to the maximum extent permissible, and the remaining provisions of x-8
this License Agreement will remain in full force and effect. You hereby consent to the
exclusive jurisdiction and venue of Tokyo District Court to resolve any disputes arising
under this License Agreement.
b. This License Agreement contains the complete agreement between the parties with
respect to the subject matter hereof, and supersedes all prior or contemporaneous agreements or understandings, whether oral or written. You agree that any varying or additional
terms contained in any written notification or document issued by you in relation to the Profile licensed hereunder shall be of no effect.
c. The failure or delay of DIC to exercise any of its rights under this License Agreement or
upon any breach of this License Agreement shall not be deemed a waiver of those rights or
of the breach.
For EU member states only
This symbol means: Do not dispose of this product
together with your household waste!
Please contact the Local Authority for appropriate disposal instructions. In the case of a new device being
purchased, the used one can also be given to our dealer
for appropriate disposal. Recycling of this product will
help to conserve natural resources and prevent potential
negative consequences for the environment and human
health caused by inappropriate waste handling.
This product complies with RoHS (2002/95/EC) directive.Contents
Contents x-9
1 Introduction .................................................................................................... 1-1
Getting Acquainted with Your Printer .......................................................... 1-2
Space Requirements................................................................................... 1-2
Printer Parts ................................................................................................ 1-4
Front View............................................................................................. 1-4
Rear View ............................................................................................. 1-5
Front View with Options ........................................................................ 1-6
Rear View with Options......................................................................... 1-7
Printer Driver CD/DVD ................................................................................... 1-8
PostScript Drivers ....................................................................................... 1-8
PCL Drivers................................................................................................. 1-8
PPD Files .................................................................................................... 1-8
Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD .......................................................... 1-9
Utilities......................................................................................................... 1-9
Documentation.................................................................................... 1-10
System Requirements ................................................................................. 1-11x-10 Contents
2 Using the Printer Driver ................................................................................ 2-1
Selecting Driver Options/Defaults (for Windows) ....................................... 2-2
Windows Server 2008/Vista/XP/Server 2003/2000
(KONICA MINOLTA mc1650 PCL6, KONICA MINOLTA
mc1650 PS) .......................................................................................... 2-2
Uninstalling the Printer Driver (for Windows) ............................................. 2-4
Windows Server 2008/Vista/XP/Server 2003/2000
(KONICA MINOLTA mc1650 PCL6, KONICA MINOLTA
mc1650 PS) .......................................................................................... 2-4
Displaying Printer Driver Settings (for Windows) ...................................... 2-5
Windows Server 2008/Vista.................................................................. 2-5
Windows XP/Server 2003 ..................................................................... 2-5
Windows 2000 ...................................................................................... 2-5
Using the Postscript and PCL Printer Driver .............................................. 2-6
Common Buttons ........................................................................................ 2-6
OK......................................................................................................... 2-6
Cancel................................................................................................... 2-6
Apply ..................................................................................................... 2-6
Help....................................................................................................... 2-6
Favorite Setting..................................................................................... 2-6
Advanced Tab (PostScript Printer Driver Only)........................................... 2-7
Basic Tab .................................................................................................... 2-8
Layout Tab .................................................................................................. 2-8
Cover Page Tab.......................................................................................... 2-8
Watermark/Overlay Tab.............................................................................. 2-8
Quality Tab.................................................................................................. 2-9
Other Tab.................................................................................................... 2-9
Limitations on printer driver functions installed with Point and Print ......... 2-10
3 Using the Status Monitor (Windows Only) .................................................. 3-1
Working with the Status Monitor .................................................................. 3-2
Introduction ................................................................................................. 3-2
Operating Environment ............................................................................... 3-2
Opening the Status Monitor ........................................................................ 3-2
Using the Status Monitor............................................................................. 3-2
Recognizing Status Monitor Alerts .............................................................. 3-3
Recovering from a Status Monitor Alert ...................................................... 3-3
Closing the Status Monitor ........................................................................... 3-3
4 Printer Control Panel and Configuration Menu .......................................... 4-1
About the Control Panel ................................................................................ 4-2
Control Panel Indicators and Keys.............................................................. 4-2
Toner Supply Indicators .............................................................................. 4-4
Configuration Menu Overview ...................................................................... 4-5
Menu ........................................................................................................... 4-5
MAIN MENU................................................................................................ 4-6Contents x-11
PRINT MENU........................................................................................ 4-6
PAPER MENU ...................................................................................... 4-8
QUALITY MENU ................................................................................. 4-13
INTERFACE MENU ............................................................................ 4-17
SYSTEM DEFAULT............................................................................ 4-22
SERVICE MENU................................................................................. 4-26
LANGUAGE MENU................................................................................... 4-27
5 Media Handling .............................................................................................. 5-1
Print Media ..................................................................................................... 5-2
Media Types ................................................................................................... 5-3
Plain Paper.................................................................................................. 5-3
Thick Stock.................................................................................................. 5-4
Envelopes ................................................................................................... 5-5
Labels.......................................................................................................... 5-6
Letterhead................................................................................................... 5-7
Postcards .................................................................................................... 5-7
Printable Area ................................................................................................ 5-8
Envelopes ................................................................................................... 5-9
Page Margins.............................................................................................. 5-9
Loading Media .............................................................................................. 5-10
Tray 1 (Multipurpose Tray)........................................................................ 5-10
Loading Plain Paper............................................................................ 5-10
Other Media ........................................................................................ 5-13
Loading Envelopes ............................................................................. 5-13
Loading Labels/Postcard/Thick Stock and Letterhead........................ 5-16
Tray 2........................................................................................................ 5-18
Loading Plain Paper............................................................................ 5-18
Duplexing ..................................................................................................... 5-21
Output Tray .................................................................................................. 5-22
Media Storage .............................................................................................. 5-23
6 Replacing Consumables ............................................................................... 6-1
Replacing Consumables ............................................................................... 6-2
About Toner Cartridges............................................................................... 6-2
Replacing a Toner Cartridge................................................................. 6-5
Removing All Toner Cartridges........................................................... 6-12
Replacing the Imaging Cartridge............................................................... 6-16
Replacing the Fuser Unit........................................................................... 6-19
7 Maintaining the Printer .................................................................................. 7-1
Maintaining the Printer .................................................................................. 7-2
Cleaning the Printer ....................................................................................... 7-4
Exterior........................................................................................................ 7-4
Interior......................................................................................................... 7-5
Cleaning the Media Feed Roller ........................................................... 7-5x-12 Contents
Cleaning the Print Head Window .......................................................... 7-9
Cleaning the Media Feed Rollers for Tray 2 ....................................... 7-18
Cleaning the Media Feed Rollers for the attachment.......................... 7-20
Cleaning the Duplex Feed Rollers ...................................................... 7-22
8 Troubleshooting ............................................................................................ 8-1
Introduction .................................................................................................... 8-2
Printing a Configuration Page ...................................................................... 8-2
Preventing Media Misfeeds ........................................................................... 8-4
Understanding the Media Path ..................................................................... 8-5
Clearing Media Misfeeds .............................................................................. 8-5
Media Misfeed Messages and Clearing Procedures................................... 8-6
Clearing a Media Misfeed in the Printer................................................ 8-7
Clearing a Media Misfeed From Tray 1............................................... 8-13
Clearing a Media Misfeed From Tray 2............................................... 8-14
Clearing a Media Misfeed from the Duplex Option ............................. 8-17
Solving Problems with Media Misfeeds ..................................................... 8-19
Solving Other Problems .............................................................................. 8-21
Solving Problems with Printing Quality .................................................... 8-25
Status, Error, and Service Messages ......................................................... 8-31
Standard Status Messages....................................................................... 8-31
Error Messages (Warning)........................................................................ 8-32
Error Messages (Operator Call)................................................................ 8-34
Service Messages..................................................................................... 8-36
9 Installing Accessories ................................................................................... 9-1
Introduction .................................................................................................... 9-2
Tray 2 .............................................................................................................. 9-3
Installing Tray 2........................................................................................... 9-3
Duplex Option ................................................................................................ 9-6
Installing Attachment................................................................................... 9-6
Installing the Duplex Option ........................................................................ 9-8
A Appendix ........................................................................................................A-1
Technical Specifications ...............................................................................A-2
Printer..........................................................................................................A-2
Consumable Life Expectancy Chart............................................................A-5
Our Concern for Environmental Protection ................................................A-6
What is an ENERGY STAR product? ...................................................A-6Introduction1-2 Getting Acquainted with Your Printer
Getting Acquainted with Your Printer
Space Requirements
To ensure easy operation, consumable replacement and maintenance,
adhere to the recommended space requirements detailed below.
Front View
496 mm (19.5")
100 mm
(3.9")
396 mm (15.6")
707 mm (27.8")
100 mm
(3.9")
380 mm (14.9")
520 mm (20.5")
127 mm
(5.0")
245 mm
(9.6")
275 mm (10.8")
100 mm
(3.9")
Side ViewGetting Acquainted with Your Printer 1-3
" The option appears shaded in the above illustrations.
" The option appears shaded in the above illustrations.
Side View with Options
922 mm (36.3")
100 mm
(3.9")
435 mm (17.1")
637 mm (25.0")
157 mm
(6.2")
130 mm
(5.1")
245 mm
(9.6")
392 mm (15.4")
(when Tray 2 and the duplex option are installed)
100 mm
(3.9")
Side View with Options
919 mm (36.2")
100 mm
(3.9")
435 mm (17.1")
582 mm (22.9")
157 mm
(6.2")
127 mm
(5.0")
245 mm
(9.6")
337 mm (13.3")
(when the attachment and duplex option are installed)
100 mm
(3.9")1-4 Getting Acquainted with Your Printer
Printer Parts
The following drawings illustrate the parts of your printer referred to throughout this guide, so please take some time to become familiar with them.
Front View
1—Output tray
2—Control panel
3—Front cover
4—Dust cover
5—Tray 1 (Multipurpose tray)
6—Top cover
7—Fuser unit
8—Fuser separator levers
9—Fuser cover lever
10—Imaging cartridge
11—Toner cartridge
1
2
3
4
6
5
8
8
7
10
11
9
7
11
10Getting Acquainted with Your Printer 1-5
Rear View
1—Power switch
2—Power connection
3—USB port
4—10Base-T/100Base-TX
Ethernet Interface port
3
4
2
11-6 Getting Acquainted with Your Printer
Front View with Options
(when Tray 2 is installed)
1—Lower feeder unit (Tray 2)
(when Tray 2 and duplex option are
installed)
1—Duplex option
2—Lower feeder unit (Tray 2)
(when the attachment and duplex
option are installed)
1—Duplex option
2—Attachment
1
1
2
1
2Getting Acquainted with Your Printer 1-7
Rear View with Options
(when Tray 2 and duplex option are
installed)
1—Duplex option
2—Lower feeder unit (Tray 2)
(when the attachment and duplex
option are installed)
1—Duplex option
2—Attachment
1
2
1
21-8 Printer Driver CD/DVD
Printer Driver CD/DVD
PostScript Drivers
PCL Drivers
PPD Files
" For details on the installation of the Windows printer drivers, refer to
the Installation Guide.
Operating System Use/Benefit
Windows Server 2008/Vista/XP/
Server 2003/2000
These drivers give you access to all of
the printer features. See also “Displaying Printer Driver Settings (for Windows)” on page 2-5.
Windows Server 2008/Vista/XP/
Server 2003 for 64bit
Operating System Use/Benefit
Windows Server 2008/Vista/XP/
Server 2003/2000
These drivers give you access to all of
the printer features. See also “Displaying Printer Driver Settings (for Windows)” on page 2-5.
Windows Server 2008/Vista/XP/
Server 2003 for 64bit
Operating System Use/Benefit
Macintosh OS X (10.2.8/10.3/10.4/
10.5)
These files are required in order to
use the printer driver for each operating system.
For details of the Macintosh and Linux
printer drivers, refer to the Reference
Guide on the Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD.
Macintosh OS X Server (10.2/10.3/
10.4/10.5)
Red Hat Linux 9.0, SuSE Linux 8.2Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD 1-9
Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD
Utilities
Utility Use/Benefit
Status Monitor (Windows only) The current status of the printer in
addition to the status of consumables
and error information can be viewed.
For details, refer to chapter 3 “Using
the Status Monitor (Windows Only)” .
PageScope Net Care Device Manager
Printer management functions such as
status monitoring and network settings
can be accessed.
For details, refer to the PageScope
Net Care Device Manager User’s
Guide on the Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD.
PageScope Network Setup Using the TCP/IP and IPX protocols,
basic network printer settings can be
specified.
For details, refer to the PageScope
Network Setup User Manual on the
Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD.
PageScope Plug and Print This utility automatically detects a new
printer connected to the network and
creates a print object on the Windows
print server.
For details, refer to the PageScope
Plug and Print Quick Guide on the
Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD.
PageScope NDPS Gateway This network utility enables printers
and KONICA MINOLTA multifunctional
products to be used in an NDPS environment.
For details, refer to the PageScope
NDPS Gateway User Manual on the
Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD.
PageScope Direct Print This application provides functions for
sending PDF and TIFF files directly to
a printer to be printed.
For details, refer to the PageScope
Direct Print User’s Guide on the Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD.1-10 Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD
Documentation
Documentation Use/Benefit
Installation Guide This manual provides details on the
initial operations that must be performed in order to use this printer,
such as setting up the printer and
installing the drivers.
User’s Guide (this manual) This manual provides details on general daily operations, such as using
the drivers and control panel and
replacing consumables.
Reference Guide This manual provides details on
installing the Macintosh and Linux
drivers and on specifying settings for
the network, and the printer management utility.
Service & Support Guide The Need Assistance sheet provides
information on product support and
servicing.System Requirements 1-11
System Requirements
Personal computer
– Pentium 2: 400 MHz (Pentium 3: 500 MHz or higher is recommended)
– PowerPC G3 or later (G4 or later is recommended)
– Macintosh equipped with an Intel processor
Operating System
– Microsoft Windows
Windows Server 2008 Standard/Enterprise, Windows Server 2008
Standard/Enterprise x64 Edition,
Windows Vista Home Basic/Home Premium/Ultimate/Business/Enterprise,
Windows Vista Home Basic /Home Premium /Ultimate/Business /
Enterprise x64 Edition,
Windows XP Home Edition/Professional (Service Pack 1 or later; Service Pack 2 or later is recommended),
Windows XP Professional x64 Edition,
Windows Server 2003,
Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition,
Windows 2000 (Service Pack 4 or later)
– Mac OS X (10.2.8 or later; We recommend installing the newest
patch), Mac OS X Server (10.2 or later)
– Red Hat Linux 9.0, SuSE Linux 8.2
Free hard disk space
– Approximately 20 MB of free hard disk space for printer driver and Status Monitor
– Approximately 128 MB of free hard disk space for image processing
RAM
128 MB or more
CD/DVD-ROM drive
I/O interface
– 10Base-T/100Base-TX Ethernet interface port
– USB 2.0 High-Speed compliant port
" For details on the Macintosh and Linux printer drivers, refer to the Reference Guide on the Utilities and Documentation CD/DVD.1-12 System RequirementsUsing the Printer
Driver2-2 Selecting Driver Options/Defaults (for Windows)
Selecting Driver Options/Defaults
(for Windows)
Before you start working with your printer, you are advised to verify/change
the default driver settings. Also, in case you have options installed, you
should “declare” the options in the driver.
Windows Server 2008/Vista/XP/Server 2003/2000 (KONICA
MINOLTA mc1650 PCL6, KONICA MINOLTA mc1650 PS)
1 Choose the driver’s properties as follows:
– (Windows Server 2008/Vista)
From the Start menu, click Control Panel, then Hardware and
Sound, and then click Printers to open the Printers directory.
Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA mc1650 PCL6 or KONICA
MINOLTA mc1650 PS printer icon, and then click Properties.
– (Windows XP/Server 2003)
From the Start menu, choose Printers and Faxes to display the
Printers and Faxes directory. Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA
mc1650 PCL6 or KONICA MINOLTA mc1650 PS printer icon and
choose Properties.
– (Windows 2000)
From the Start menu, choose Settings and then Printers to display
the Printers directory. Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA mc1650
PCL6 or KONICA MINOLTA mc1650 PS printer icon and choose
Properties.
2 If you have installed options, proceed with the next step. Otherwise, skip
to step 9.
3 Select the Configure tab.
4 Check that the installed options are correctly listed. If not, proceed with
the next step. Otherwise, continue with step 8.
5 Click the Refresh to automatically configure installed options.
" The Refresh is available only if bi-directional communication is
available with the printer; otherwise it is grayed out.
6 From the Device Options list, select an option, one at a time, and then
select Enable or Disable from the Settings menu.
7 Click Apply.
8 Select the General tab.
9 Click Printing Preferences.
The Printing Preference dialog box appears.Selecting Driver Options/Defaults (for Windows) 2-3
10 Select the default settings for your printer, such as the default media format you use, on the appropriate tabs.
11 Click Apply.
12 Click OK to exit from the Print preference dialog box.
13 Click OK to exit from the Properties dialog box.2-4 Uninstalling the Printer Driver (for Windows)
Uninstalling the Printer Driver
(for Windows)
This section describes how to uninstall the printer driver if necessary.
" You must have administrator privileges in order to uninstall the printer
driver.
" If the User Account Control window appears when uninstalling on Windows Server 2008/Vista, click the Allow button or the Continue button.
Windows Server 2008/Vista/XP/Server 2003/2000 (KONICA
MINOLTA mc1650 PCL6, KONICA MINOLTA mc1650 PS)
1 Close all applications.
2 Choose the Uninstall Program as follows:
– (Windows Server 2008/Vista/XP/Server 2003)
From the Start menu, choose All programs, KONICA MINOLTA,
magicolor 1650, and then Uninstall Printer Driver.
– (Windows 2000)
From the Start menu, choose Programs, KONICA MINOLTA, magicolor 1650, and then Uninstall Printer Driver.
3 When the Uninstall dialog box appears, select the name of the driver to be
deleted, and then click the Uninstall button.
4 Click Uninstall.
5 Click OK, and restart your computer.
6 The printer driver will be uninstalled from your computer.Displaying Printer Driver Settings (for Windows) 2-5
Displaying Printer Driver Settings
(for Windows)
Windows Server 2008/Vista
1 From the Start menu, click Control Panel, then Hardware and Sound,
and then click Printers to open the Printers directory.
2 Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA mc1650 PCL6, or KONICA MINOLTA
mc1650 PS printer icon, and then click Printing Preferences.
Windows XP/Server 2003
1 From the Start menu, choose Printers and Faxes to display the Printers
and Faxes directory.
2 Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA mc1650 PCL6 or KONICA MINOLTA
mc1650 PS printer icon and choose Printing Preferences.
Windows 2000
1 From the Start menu, point to Settings, and then click Printers to display
the Printers directory.
2 Right-click the KONICA MINOLTA mc1650 PCL6 or KONICA MINOLTA
mc1650 PS printer icon and choose Printing Preferences.2-6 Using the Postscript and PCL Printer Driver
Using the Postscript and PCL Printer Driver
Common Buttons
The buttons described below appear on each tab.
OK
Click to exit the Properties dialog box, saving any changes made.
Cancel
Click to exit the Properties dialog box without saving any changes made.
Apply
Click to save all changes without exiting the Properties dialog box.
Help
Click to view the help.
Favorite Setting
This allows the current settings to be saved. To save the current settings,
specify the desired settings, and then click Add. Specify the settings
described below, and then click OK.
Name: Type in the name of the settings to be saved.
Icon: Select an icon from the icon list to easily identify the settings.
The selected icon appears in the drop-down list.
Sharing: Specify whether or not the settings to be saved can be used by
other users logged onto the computer.
Comment: Add a simple comment to the settings to be saved.
Afterward, the saved settings can be selected from the drop-down list. To
change the registered setting, click Edit.
In addition, predefined settings can be selected.
The predefined settings are those for "2-up", "Photo" and "Grayscale".
Select Defaults from the drop-down list to reset the functions in all tabs to
their default values.Using the Postscript and PCL Printer Driver 2-7
Printer View
Click the button to display an image of the printer in the figure area.
When this button is clicked, it changes to the Paper View button (when a tab
other than the Quality tab is selected) or the Quality View button (when the
Quality tab is selected).
" This button does not appear on the Advanced tab.
Paper View
Click the button to display a sample of the page layout in the figure area.
When this button is clicked, it changes to the Printer View button.
" This button does not appear on the Quality tab.
Quality View
Click the button to display a sample of the settings selected in the Quality tab.
When this button is clicked, it changes to the Printer View button.
" This button appears only when the Quality tab is selected.
Default
Click the button to reset the settings to their defaults.
" This button does not appear on the Advanced tab.
" When this button is clicked, the settings in the displayed dialog box
are reset to their defaults. The settings on other tabs are not changed.
Advanced Tab (PostScript Printer Driver Only)
The Advanced Tab allows you to
Select whether to enable or disable the settings for advanced printing
functions (such as booklet printing)
Specify the PostScript output method
Specify whether or not the error messages of a print job are printed
Print a mirror image
Specify whether or not the application can directly output PostScript data2-8 Using the Postscript and PCL Printer Driver
Basic Tab
The Basic Tab allows you to
Specify the orientation of the media
Specify the size of the original document
Select the output media size
Zoom (expand/reduce) documents
Specify the paper source
Specify the type of media
Specify the number of copies
Layout Tab
The Layout Tab allows you to
Print several pages of a document on the same page (N-up printing)
Print a single copy for enlargement and print several pages (PCL printer
driver only)
Specify booklet printing (when the duplex option is installed)
Rotate the print image 180 degrees
Specify whether or not blank pages are printed (PCL printer driver only)
Specify duplex (double-sided) printing (when the duplex option is
installed)
Adjust the binding margin
Adjust the printing position (PCL printer driver only)
Cover Page Tab
The Cover Page Tab allows you to
Print front and back cover pages and separator pages
Specify the paper tray that contains the paper for the front and back cover
pages and separator pages
Watermark/Overlay Tab
" Be sure to use overlays with print jobs with a paper size and orientation that matches the overlay form.
In addition, if settings have been specified for “N-up” or “Booklet” in
the printer driver, the overlay form cannot be adjusted to match the
specified settings.Using the Postscript and PCL Printer Driver 2-9
The settings in the "Watermark" function of the Watermark/Overlay tab allows
you to
Select the watermark to be used
Create, edit or delete watermarks
Print a frame around watermarks
Print transparent (shaded) watermarks
Print the watermark on only the first page
Print the watermark repeatedly throughout the all pages
The settings in the "Overlay" function of the Watermark/Overlay tab allows
you to
Select the form to use
Add or delete overlay files
Create a form (PCL printer driver only)
Specify that the document and form are printed overlapping (PCL printer
driver only)
Display the form information (PCL printer driver only)
Print the form on All Pages, First Page, Even Pages and Odd Pages
Place the form in back of the document or in front on the printed document (PCL printer driver only)
Quality Tab
The Quality Tab allows you to
Switch between color and grayscale printing
Specify the printer color settings (Quick Color)
Specify the resolution for the printout
Specify the amount of details in graphic patterns (PCL printer driver only)
Specify the image compression method (PCL printer driver only)
Select whether or not economy printing is used
Specify the format of fonts that are to be downloaded
Print using the printer's fonts
Other Tab
The Other Tab allows you to
Select that Microsoft Excel sheets are not to be divided when printing2-10 Using the Postscript and PCL Printer Driver
Select that the white background of Microsoft PowerPoint data does not
hide overlay files (PCL printer driver only)
Send a notification by e-mail when printing is finished
Shows the version information for the printer driver
Limitations on printer driver functions installed with
Point and Print
If Point and Print is performed with the following server and client combinations, there are limitations on some printer driver functions.
Server and client combinations
Server: Windows Server 2008/Server 2003/XP/2000/Vista
Client: Windows Server 2008/Server 2003/XP/2000/Vista
Functions with limitations applied
Booklet, Skip Blank Pages, Front Cover Page, Back Cover Page, Separator Page, Create Overlay, Print Overlay, WatermarkUsing the Status
Monitor
(Windows Only)3-2 Working with the Status Monitor
Working with the Status Monitor
Introduction
The Status Monitor shows information about the current status of the printer.
The Status Monitor can be installed from the Utilities and Documentation CD/
DVD.
For details on the installation, refer to the Reference Guide on the Utilities
and Documentation CD/DVD.
Operating Environment
The Status Monitor can be used on computers running Windows Vista/XP/
Server 2003/2000 connected to the printer using the Ethernet connection.
Opening the Status Monitor
Use one of the following steps to open the Status Monitor:
Windows Vista/XP/Server 2003—From the Start menu, choose All Programs, KONICA MINOLTA, and then Status Monitor. Double-click the
Status Monitor icon displayed in the taskbar.
Windows 2000—From the Start menu, choose Programs, KONICA
MINOLTA, and then Status Monitor. Double-click the Status Monitor icon
displayed in the task bar.
Using the Status Monitor
Status Tab
Select Printer—Selects the printer whose status is displayed. In addition,
the messages that appear in the message window of the selected printer
are displayed.
Graphic—Normally, the Konica Minolta logo is displayed. When a printer
error is detected, a graphic representation of the printer is shown, and the
location of the problem is indicated. When the background of the printer
graphic is red or yellow, there is an error and the job has been interrupted.
Advanced Options—Click Advanced Options to display the Advanced
Options dialog box. From the Advanced Options dialog box, select
whether the Status Monitor automatically starts when the operating system is started and whether error notifications are sent by e-mail.
Order Supplies—Click Order Supplies to automatically access the order
page for supplies. The address of the page that is accessed can be specified from the Advanced Options dialog box.Recognizing Status Monitor Alerts 3-3
Printer Alerts—Displays text messages that alert you of conditions such
as low toner.
Recovery Instructions—Provides you with explanations of what you
need to do in order to correct problems and recover from error conditions.
Consumables Tab
Displays the usage status (approximate percentage remaining) of each toner
consumables.
Order Supplies—Click Order Supplies to automatically access the order
page for supplies. The address of the page that is accessed can be specified from the Advanced Options dialog box.
Refresh—Rechecks the supplies and displays their status.
" Click Help to display windows containing explanations of the Status
Monitor functions. Refer to this help for detailed information.
" The percentages remaining for the consumables displayed using the
Status Monitor may be different from the actual amounts and should
be used only as reference.
Recognizing Status Monitor Alerts
When the Status Monitor detects a printing problem, the icon on the Windows
task bar changes from green (normal) to yellow (warning), orange or red
(error), depending on the severity of the printer problem.
Recovering from a Status Monitor Alert
When the Status Monitor notifies you of a printing problem, double-click its
icon on the Windows task bar to open the Status Monitor. The Status Monitor
identifies what type of error has occurred.
Closing the Status Monitor
Click Close to close the Status Monitor window. To exit Status Monitor,
right-click the Status Monitor icon in the taskbar, and then click Exit.3-4 Closing the Status MonitorPrinter Control
Panel and
Configuration
Menu4-2 About the Control Panel
About the Control Panel
The control panel, located on the top of the printer, allows you to direct the
printer’s operation. In addition, it displays the current status of the printer,
including any condition that needs your attention.
Control Panel Indicators and Keys
No. Indicator Off On
1 The printer is not ready
to accept data.
The printer is ready to
accept data.
2 No problem. The printer requires
operator attention
(usually accompanied by
a status message in the
message window.)
Ready
Error
Cancel
8
MESSAGE
WINDOW
3
1
2
6 5 4
7
Ready
ErrorAbout the Control Panel 4-3
No. Indicator Function
3 Moves up in the menu structure
Within a menu choice that is changeable character by character, scrolls upward through the
available characters
4 Moves right in the menu structure
Moves right through the available menu choices
5 Moves down in the menu structure.
Within a menu choice that is changeable character by character, scrolls downward through
the available characters
6 Moves left in the menu structure
Moves left through the available menu choices
7 Cancels the currently displayed menu choice
Allows you to cancel one or all print jobs that
are currently being printed or processed:
1. Press the Cancel key.
2. Press the ) or * keys to select either CANCEL
JOB/CURRENT or CANCEL JOB/ALL
3. Press the Menu Select key.
The print job(s) is (are) cancelled.
8 Enters the menu system
Moves down in the menu structure
Selects the displayed menu choice
Cancel4-4 About the Control Panel
Toner Supply Indicators
The indicators shown below will appear, indicating the amount of toner that
remains in the yellow (Y), magenta (M), cyan (C), and black (K) toner cartridges.
I D L EConfiguration Menu Overview 4-5
Configuration Menu Overview
The configuration menu accessible from the control panel is structured as
shown below.
Menu
" If MAIN MENU/SYSTEM DEFAULT/SECURITY/CONFIG/
ENABLE is set to ON, the user password or administrator password
must be entered to display the main menu. The displayed menu is different according to the authority of the entered password.
For details on the default passwords, refer to “SYSTEM DEFAULT” on
page 4-22.
PRINT MENU
PAPER MENU
INTERFACE MENU
SYSTEM DEFAULT
SERVICE MENU
QUALITY MENU
IDLE
LANGUAGE
MAIN MENU4-6 Configuration Menu Overview
MAIN MENU
PRINT MENU
With this menu, printer information, such as the configuration page and the
demo page, can be printed.
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
MENU MAP Settings YES/NO
Prints the menu map.
CONFIGURATION
Settings YES/NO
Prints the configuration page.
STATISTICS
PAGE
Settings YES/NO
Prints the statistics page such as the number of pages
printed.
POSTSCRIPT
PCL
MENU MAP
DIRECTORY LIST
CONFIGURATION
FONT LIST
DEMO
STATISTICS PAGE
PRINT MENUConfiguration Menu Overview 4-7
" The amounts remaining for the supplies status and coverage information displayed using the statistics page may be different from the
actual amounts and should be used only as reference.
FONT LIST POST
SCRIPT
Settings YES/NO
Prints the PostScript font list.
PCL Settings YES/NO
Prints the PCL font list.
DIRECTORY
LIST
Settings YES/NO
Prints the directory list of the flash.
DEMO Settings YES/NO
Prints the demo page.4-8 Configuration Menu Overview
PAPER MENU
With this menu, the media used for printing can be managed.
" * This menu item appears only if the duplex option is installed.
** These menu items appear only if an optional lower feeder unit is
installed.
TRAY 1 MODE
TRAY1 MEDIA SIZE
MEDIA TYPE
TRAY2
**
MEDIA SIZE
CUSTOM SIZE
AUTO CONTINUE
INPUT TRAY
PAGE RECOVERY
DUPLEX
*
ORIENTATION
LENGTH (xx)
WIDTH (xx)
PAPER MENU
TRAY CHAINING
**
MAP
**
LOGICAL TRAY 0
MODE
LOGICAL TRAY 9
~Configuration Menu Overview 4-9
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
INPUT
TRAY
TRAY 1
MODE
Settings AUTO/CASSETTE
When printing from Tray 1, select whether the paper
size and paper type set from the printer driver or the
MEDIA SIZE and MEDIA TYPE settings set by
selecting MAIN MENU/PAPER MENU/INPUT
TRAY/TRAY 1 in the control panel have priority.
If AUTO is selected, the printer driver settings have
priority during printing.
If CASSETTE is selected, printing is performed
when the printer driver settings and the control
panel settings are all the same.
TRAY1 MEDIA
SIZE
Settings LETTER/LEGAL/
EXECUTIVE/A4/A5/B5/
B5(ISO)/G LETTER/
STATEMENT/FOLIO/UK
QUARTO/FOOLSCAP/G
LEGAL/C6/DL/
J-POSTCARD/KAI 16/
KAI 32/16K/SP FOLIO/
OFICIO/CUSTOM
Select the setting for the size of paper
loaded into Tray 1.
"The default setting for North
America is LETTER. The default
setting for all other regions is A4.
MEDIA
TYPE
Settings PLAIN PAPER/LABELS/
LETTERHEAD/ENVELOPE/
POSTCARD/THICK1/
THICK2
Select the setting for the type of paper
loaded into Tray 1.
TRAY2 MEDIA
SIZE
Settings LETTER/A4
Select the setting for the size of paper
loaded into Tray 2.
"The default setting for North
America is LETTER. The default
setting for all other regions is A4.4-10 Configuration Menu Overview
CUSTOM
SIZE
WIDTH
(xx)
Settings 92-216 mm
(3.63-8.50 inch)*
* With inch measurements, the
decimal point does not appear
in the message window.
For example, 3.63 inches
appears as 363.
Specify the width of the custom-sized
paper loaded into Tray 1.
"On the model for North America,
the settings appear in inches and
the menu item appears as
WIDTH(IN). On the models for
all other regions, the settings
appear in millimeters and the
menu item appears as
WIDTH(MM).
LENGTH
(xx)
Settings With plain paper
195-356 mm
(7.69-14.01 inch)*
With thick stock
184-297 mm
(7.24-11.70 inch)*
* With inch measurements, the
decimal point does not appear
in the message window.
For example, 7.69 inches
appears as 769.
Specify the length of the custom-sized
paper loaded into Tray 1.
"On the model for North America,
the settings appear in inches and
the menu item appears as
LENGTH(IN). On the models for
all other regions, the settings
appear in millimeters and the
menu item appears as
LENGTH(MM).Configuration Menu Overview 4-11
AUTO
CONTINUE
Settings ON/OFF
If OFF is selected, an error occurs if the size of
paper being printed on is different from the size of
paper specified in the printer driver.
If ON is selected, no error occurs if the size of paper
being printed on is different from the size of paper
specified in the printer driver.
TRAY
CHAINING
Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected and the specified paper tray runs
out of paper during printing, a paper tray loaded with
paper of the same size is automatically selected so
printing can continue.
If NO is selected and the specified paper tray runs
out of paper, printing stops.
MAP MODE Settings ON/OFF
Select whether or not the Tray Mapping
function is used.
LOGICAL
TRAY
0-9
Settings PHYSICAL TRAY 1/
PHYSICAL TRAY 2
Specify whether jobs received from
another manufacturer’s printer driver are
printed using Tray 1 or Tray 2.
PHYSICAL TRAY 2 is the default only
for LOGICAL TRAY 2. The default for
all other logical trays is PHYSICAL
TRAY 1.
DUPLEX Settings OFF/SHORTEDGE/LONGEDGE
If LONGEDGE is selected, the pages will be printed on both sides
of the paper for long-edge binding.
If SHORTEDGE is selected, the pages will be printed on both
sides of the paper for short-edge binding.
ORIENTATION
Settings PORTRAIT/LANDSCAPE
Specify the orientation of the media.4-12 Configuration Menu Overview
PAGE
RECOVERY
Settings ON/OFF
Select whether or not the page is printed again after recovering
from a paper misfeed.
If ON is selected, the page that was misfed is printed again.
If OFF is selected, printing continues with the next page without
printing the misfed page.Configuration Menu Overview 4-13
QUALITY MENU
With this menu, settings for the print quality can be specified.
BLACK
CYAN
MAGENTA
TONER OUT ACTION
REPLACE TONER
AIDC REQUEST AIDC
QUALITY MENU
YELLOW
P/H CLEAN UP
MODE
REMOVE ALL
IMAGE REFRESH
ECONOMY PRINT
DUPLEX SPEED4-14 Configuration Menu Overview
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
REPLACE
TONER
BLACK Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, the carousel rotates to the black
toner cartridge, so that it can be replaced.
For details on replacing the toner cartridge, refer to
“Replacing a Toner Cartridge” on page 6-5.
CYAN Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, the carousel rotates to the cyan
toner cartridge, so that it can be replaced.
For details on replacing the toner cartridge, refer to
“Replacing a Toner Cartridge” on page 6-5.
MAGENTA Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, the carousel rotates to the
magenta toner cartridge, so that it can be replaced.
For details on replacing the toner cartridge, refer to
“Replacing a Toner Cartridge” on page 6-5.
YELLOW Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, the carousel rotates to the yellow
toner cartridge, so that it can be replaced.
For details on replacing the toner cartridge, refer to
“Replacing a Toner Cartridge” on page 6-5.
REMOVE
ALL
Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, the printer enters REMOVE ALL
mode.
This mode is used when removing all toner cartridges.
For details on removing all toner cartridges, refer to
“Removing All Toner Cartridges” on page 6-12.
TONER
OUT
ACTION
Settings STOP/CONTINUE
If STOP is selected, printing stops when the toner cartridge is
empty.
If CONTINUE is selected, printing continues even if the toner
cartridge is empty. However, the printing result are not
guaranteed. If printing is continued, the message "X TONER
LIFE END" appears and printing stops.Configuration Menu Overview 4-15
AIDC REQUEST
AIDC
Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, image adjustments are
performed.
"The AIDC function consumes toner.
MODE Settings ON/OFF
If ON is selected, the image adjustments are
applied.
If OFF is selected, image adjustments are not
applied.
P/H
CLEAN
UP
Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, the printer enters P/H CLEAN UP mode.
P/H CLEAN UP mode is a mode that allows the user to clean the
print head window more easily. The print head window is not
cleaned automatically.
For details on cleaning the print head window, refer to “Cleaning
the Print Head Window” on page 7-9.
IMAGE
REFRESH
Settings YES/NO
Use when thin white horizontal lines appear at intervals on
images.
"The IMAGE REFRESH function consumes toner.
ECONOMY
PRINT
Settings ON/OFF
Select whether to print graphics with a reduced density by
reducing the amount of toner that is used.
If ON is selected, the amount of toner used is reduced when
printing.
If OFF is selected, the amount of toner used is not reduced when
printing.4-16 Configuration Menu Overview
DUPLEX
SPEED
Settings AUTOMATIC/SPEED/QUALITY
Select the print speed for double-sided printing.
If AUTOMATIC is selected, the print speed is automatically
selected.
If SPEED is selected, the print speed has priority; however, the
print quality may decrease.
If QUALITY is selected, the print quality has priority; therefore,
the print speed will decrease while the print quality may increase.Configuration Menu Overview 4-17
INTERFACE MENU
With this menu, interface settings can be specified.
The printer must be rebooted after any setting in the ETHERNET menu (for
example, the TCP/IP address) is changed.
Therefore, the following message appears when the configuration menu is
exited (the + key is repeatedly pressed) after a setting has been changed.
Select YES, and then press the Menu Select key to reboot the printer.
Otherwise, turn off the printer, and then turn the printer on again after a few
seconds.
ETHERNET
*
INTERFACE MENU
TCP/IP ENABLE
IPV4 DHCP/BOOTP
IPV4 ADDRESS
DEFAULT ROUTER
SUBNET MASK
ENABLE AUTO IP
IPV6 ENABLE
IP SERVICES ENABLE HTTP IDENTIFIER4-18 Configuration Menu Overview
" * If MAIN MENU/SYSTEM DEFAULT/SECURITY/CONFIG/
ENABLE is set to ON, the administrator password must be entered to
display this menu.
For details on the default administrator password, refer to “SYSTEM
DEFAULT” on page 4-22.
IPX/SPX FRAME TYPE
ETHERNET SPEED
DISABLE 802.1X
PS PROTOCOL
ENABLE
JOB TIMEOUT
USB
ENABLE AUTO
GLOBAL PREFIX
DISABLE FILTERS
DISABLE IPSECConfiguration Menu Overview 4-19
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
ETHERNET
TCP/IP ENABLE Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, TCP/IP is enabled.
If NO is selected, TCP/IP is disabled.
IPV4 DHCP/
BOOTP
Settings YES/NO
Select whether or not the IP
address is automatically
acquired.
If YES is selected, the IP address
is automatically acquired.
If NO is selected, the IP address
is not automatically acquired.
IPV4
ADDRESS
Settings 192.168.001.002
Set the IPv4 address for this
printer on the network.
Use the +, ,, *, and ) keys to
specify the value.
If the IP address is manually
specified, DHCP/BOOTP is
automatically set to NO.
DEFAULT
ROUTER
Settings 000.000.000.000
Specify the IPv4 address of the
router if one is on the network.
Use the +, ,, *, and ) keys to
specify the value.
SUBNET
MASK
Settings 000.000.000.000
Specify the subnet mask for the
network.
Use the +, ,, *, and ) keys to
specify the value.4-20 Configuration Menu Overview
ENABLE
AUTO IP
Settings YES/NO
Select whether or not the IPv4
address is automatically acquired
when DHCP/BOOTP and PING,
ARP are not functioning or when
there is no response.
If YES is selected, the IP address
is automatically acquired.
If NO is selected, the IP address
is not automatically acquired.
IPV6 ENABLE Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, IPv6 is
enabled.
If NO is selected, IPv6 is disabled.
IDENTIFIER
Displays the Link-Local address.
ENABLE
AUTO
Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, auto
configuration of IPv6 is enabled.
If NO is selected, auto
configuration of IPv6 is disabled.
GLOBAL
PREFIX
Displays the global address.
IP SERVICES
ENABLE
HTTP
Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, HTTP is enabled.
If NO is selected, HTTP is disabled.
DISABLE
FILTERS
Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, filter is disabled.
DISABLE
IPSEC
Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, IPsec is disabled.Configuration Menu Overview 4-21
IPX/SPX FRAME
TYPE
Settings AUTO/802.2/802.3/ETHER
II/SNAP
Specify the protocol used with NetWare.
ETHERNET
SPEED
Settings AUTO/100 FULL DUPLEX/100 HALF
DUPLEX/10 FULL DUPLEX/10 HALF
DUPLEX
Specify the transmission speed for the network and the
transmission method for bi-directional transmission.
DISABLE
802.1X
Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, IEEE802.1x function is disabled.
PS PROTOCOL
Settings BINARY/QUOTED BINARY
Select whether PostScript jobs are received in the binary
format or the quoted format.
USB ENABLE Settings YES/NO
If YES is selected, USB is enabled.
If NO is selected, USB is disabled.
JOB
TIMEOUT
Settings 0-60-999
Specify the length of time (in seconds) until the print job
being received is timed out when USB is being used.4-22 Configuration Menu Overview
SYSTEM DEFAULT
With this menu, settings can be specified to adjust the operation of the printer,
such as the time until the machine enters Energy Saver mode.
" If MAIN MENU/SYSTEM DEFAULT/SECURITY/CONFIG/
ENABLE is set to ON, the administrator password must be entered to
display this menu.
PRINT QUALITY
EMULATIONS DEFAULT
AUTO DEFAULT
ERROR PAGE
PCL LINE TERMINATION
FONT PITCH SIZE
FONT NUMBER
POINT SIZE
SYMBOL SET
STARTUP OPTIONS START PAGE
DATE & TIME
ENERGY SAVER
SYSTEM DEFAULT
COLOR MODE
POSTSCRIPTConfiguration Menu Overview 4-23
" All factory default values are shown in bold.
PRINT
QUALITY
Settings HIGH/STANDARD
Select the image quality for prints.
COLOR
MODE
Settings COLOR/GRAYSCALE
Specify whether printing is in full color or grayscale.
"The color mode setting specified from the printer driver
has priority over the setting specified for this menu item.
FORMAT ERASE FLASH
RESTORE/SAVE RESTORE FACTORY
SAVE CUSTOM
RESTORE CUSTOM
SECURITY CONFIG ENABLE
SET ADMIN PASSWD
SET USER PASSWD4-24 Configuration Menu Overview
EMULATIONS
DEFAULT Settings AUTOMATIC/POSTSCRIPT/PCL5/
PCL XL/HEX DUMP
Specify the printer control language.
If AUTOMATIC is selected, the printer automatically
selects the printer control language from the data
stream.
AUTO
DEFAULT
Settings PCL5/POSTSCRIPT
Select the printer description language when it
cannot be identified from the data.
POSTSCRIPT
ERROR
PAGE
Settings ON/OFF
Select whether or not an error page is
printed when a PostScript error occurs.
PCL LINE
TERMINATION
Settings CR=CR LF=CRLF/
CR=CR LF=LF/
CR=CRLF LF=LF/
CR=CRLF LF=CRLF
Select the definitions of the CR/LF codes
in the PCL language.
FONT PITCH
SIZE
Settings 44-1000-9999
Specify the bitmap font size in
the PCL language.
FONT
NUMBER
Settings 0-32767
Specify the font used with the
PCL language.
The font numbers that appear
correspond to the PCL font
list. For details on printing the
font list, refer to “PRINT
MENU” on page 4-6.
POINT
SIZE
Settings 400-1200-
99975
Specify the outline font size in
the PCL language.
SYMBOL
SET
Specify the symbol set used
with the PCL language.
The default setting is PC8.Configuration Menu Overview 4-25
STARTUP
OPTIONS
START
PAGE
Settings YES/NO
Select whether or not a startup page is printed when
the printer is turned on.
If YES is selected, the startup page is printed when
the printer is turned on.
If NO is selected, the startup page is not printed.
DATE &
TIME
Settings yyyymmdd:hhmmss
Set the date and time on the time-of-day (TOD) clock.
The settings appear in the following order: year, month, day:hour,
minutes, seconds.
ENERGY
SAVER
Settings 15 MINUTES/30 MINUTES/1 HOUR/
2 HOURS
Specify the length of time until the machine enters Energy Saver
mode.
"2 HOURS is displayed only on 120 V units.
SECURITY
CONFIG ENABLE Settings ON/OFF
Select whether or not the menus are
protected with a password.
If ON is selected, all menus are protected
with a password.
SET
USER
PASSWD
Settings: 1
Specify the user password for displaying
the user menus. The specified password
is applied only if MAIN MENU/SYSTEM DEFAULT/SECRITY/CONFIG/
ENABLE is set to ON.
The password can contain a maximum of
16 characters.
"Empty passwords are not allowed.4-26 Configuration Menu Overview
SERVICE MENU
With this menu, the service representative can adjust the printer and perform
maintenance operations. This menu cannot be used by the user.
SET
ADMIN
PASSWD
Settings: the last four digits of the printer
serial number
Specify the administrator password for
displaying the administrator menus. The
specified password is applied only if
MAIN MENU/SYSTEM DEFAULT/
SECRITY/CONFIG/ENABLE is set to
ON.
The password can contain a maximum of
16 characters.
"Empty passwords are not allowed.
FORMAT ERASE
FLASH
Settings YES/NO
Select whether or not to initialize the flash RAM.
If YES is selected, the flash RAM is initialized.
RESTORE
/SAVE
RESTORE
FACTORY
Settings YES/NO
Select whether or not all menu items are reset to
their initial settings.
If YES is selected, all menu items are reset to their
initial settings.
SAVE
CUSTOM
Settings YES/NO
Select whether or not all changed menu settings are
saved.
If YES is selected, all changes are saved.
RESTORE
CUSTOM
Settings YES/NO
Select whether or not menu items are reverted to
the previously saved settings.
If YES is selected, the menu items revert to the
previously saved settings.Configuration Menu Overview 4-27
LANGUAGE MENU
ENGLISH/FRENCH/
GERMAN/SPANISH/
ITALIAN/PORTUGUESE/DUTCH/CZECH/
JAPANESE/POLISH
The display language of the message window
can be changed to the required language.
The default setting is English.
The language selections appear in the message window in the corresponding language.
For example, GERMAN appears as DEUTSCH.4-28 Configuration Menu OverviewMedia Handling5-2 Print Media
Print Media
Specifications
" For custom sizes, use the printer driver to specify the settings within
the ranges shown in the above table.
Media Media Size Tray* Duplex
Inch Millimeter
Letter 8.5 x 11.0 215.9 x 279.4 1/2 Yes
Legal 8.5 x 14.0 215.9 x 355.6 1 No
Statement 5.5 x 8.5 140.0 x 216.0 1 No
Executive 7.25 x 10.5 184.0 x 267.0 1 No
A4 8.2 x 11.7 210.0 x 297.0 1/2 Yes
A5 5.9 x 8.3 148.0 x 210.0 1 No
B5 (JIS) 7.2 x 10.1 182.0 x 257.0 1 No
B5 (ISO) 6.9 x 9.8 176.0 x 250.0 1 No
Folio 8.3 x 13.0 210.0 x 330.0 1 No
SP Folio 8.5 x 12.69 215.9 x 322.3 1 No
Foolscap 8.0 x 13.0 203.2 x 330.2 1 No
UK Quarto 8.0 x 10.0 203.2 x 254.0 1 No
Government Letter 8.0 x 10.5 203.2 x 266.7 1 No
Government Legal 8.5 x 13.0 216.0 x 330.0 1 No
Envelope DL 4.3 x 8.7 110.0 x 220.0 1 No
Envelope C6 4.5 x 6.4 114.0 x 162.0 1 No
Japanese Postcard 3.9 x 5.8 100.0 x 148.0 1 No
16K 7.7 x 10.6 195.0 x 270.0 1 No
Kai 16 7.3 x 10.2 185.0 x 260.0 1 No
Kai 32 5.1 x 7.3 130.0 x 185.0 1 No
Oficio Mexico 8.5 x 13.5 215.9 x 342.9 1 No
Custom Size, Minimum** 3.6 x 7.7 92.0 x 195.0 1 No
Custom Size, Maximum** 8.5 x 14.0 216.0 x 356.0 1 No
Notes: * Tray 1 = Multipurpose
Tray 2 = Plain paper only
** With thick stock
The minimum size is 3.6 x 7.25 inch (92.0 x 184.0 mm).
The maximum size is 8.5 x 11.7 inch (216.0 x 297.0 mm).Media Types 5-3
Media Types
Before purchasing a large quantity of special media, do a trial print with the
same media and check the print quality.
Keep media on a flat, level surface in its original wrapper until it is time to
load it. For a list of approved media, refer to printer.konicaminolta.com.
Plain Paper
Use plain paper that is
Suitable for plain paper laser printers, such as standard or recycled office
paper.
Note
Do not use the media types listed below. These could cause poor print
quality, media misfeeds, or damage to the printer.
DO NOT use media that is
Coated with a processed surface (such as carbon paper, digitally gloss-
coated media, and colored paper that has been treated)
Carbon backed
Unapproved iron-on transfer media (such as heat-sensitive paper,
heat-pressure paper, and heat-press transfer paper)
Cold-water-transfer paper
Pressure sensitive
Designed specifically for inkjet printers (such as superfine paper, glossy
film, and postcards)
Already been printed on by another printer, copier, or fax machine
Dusty
Wet (or damp)
Capacity Tray 1 Up to 200 sheets, depending on the paper
weight
Tray 2 Up to 500 sheets, depending on the paper
weight
Orientation Face up
Driver
Media Type
Plain paper
Weight 60 to 90 g/m² (16 to 24 lb bond)
Duplexing Only Letter/A4 plain paper can be autoduplexed.5-4 Media Types
" Keep media between 15% and 85% relative humidity. Toner does
not adhere well to moist or wet paper.
Layered
Adhesive
Folded, creased, curled, embossed, warped, or wrinkled
Perforated, three-hole punched, or torn
Too slick, too coarse, or too textured
Different in texture (roughness) on the front and back
Too thin or too thick
Stuck together with static electricity
Composed of foil or gilt; too luminous
Heat sensitive or cannot withstand the fusing temperature (180°C
[356°F])
Irregularly shaped (not rectangular or not cut at right angles)
Attached with glue, tape, paper clips, staples, ribbons, hooks, or buttons
Acidic
Any other media that is not approved
Thick Stock
Paper thicker than 90 g/m2
(24 lb bond) is referred to as thick stock. Test all
thick stock to ensure acceptable performance and to ensure that the image
does not shift.
Capacity Tray 1 Up to 50 thick stock sheets, depending on
their thickness
Tray 2 Not supported
Orientation Face up
Driver
Media Type
Thick 1 (91 to163 g/m2
)
Thick 2 (164 to 209 g/m2
)
Weight 91 to 209 g/m² (25 to 55.9 lb)
Duplexing Not supportedMedia Types 5-5
DO NOT use thick stock that is
Mixed with any other media in Tray 1 (as this will cause printer misfeeding)
Envelopes
Print on the front (address) side only. Some parts of the envelope consist of
three layers of paper—the front, back, and flap. Anything printed in these layered regions may be lost or faded.
Use envelopes that are
Envelope C6 or Envelope DL
(Other envelope sizes are not supported.)
Common office envelopes approved for laser printing with diagonal joints,
sharp folds and edges, and ordinary gummed flaps
" Because the envelopes pass through heated rollers, the gummed
area on the flaps may seal. Using envelopes with emulsion-based
glue avoids this problem.
Approved for laser printing
Dry
DO NOT use envelopes that have
Sticky flaps
Tape seals, metal clasps, paper clips, fasteners, or peel-off strips for sealing
Transparent windows
Too rough of a surface
Material that will melt, vaporize, offset, discolor, or emit dangerous fumes
Been presealed
Capacity Tray 1 Up to 10 envelopes, depending on their
thickness
Tray 2 Not supported
Orientation Face up
Driver
Media Type
Envelope
Duplexing Not supported5-6 Media Types
Labels
A sheet of labels consists of a face sheet (the printing surface), adhesive, and
a carrier sheet:
The face sheet must follow the plain paper specification.
The face sheet surface must cover the entire carrier sheet, and no adhesive should come through on the surface.
You can print continuously with label sheets. However, this could affect the
media feed, depending on the media quality and printing environment. If
problems occur, stop the continuous printing and print one sheet at a time.
Try printing your data on a sheet of plain paper first to check placement.
Check your application documentation for more information on printing labels.
Use label sheets that are
Recommended for laser printers
DO NOT use label sheets that
Have labels that easily peel off or have parts of the label already removed
Have backing sheets that have peeled away or have exposed adhesive
" Labels may stick to the fuser, causing them to peel off and media
misfeeds to occur.
Are precut or perforated
Capacity Tray 1 Up to 50 label sheets, depending on their
thickness
Tray 2 Not supported
Orientation Face up
Driver
Media Type
Labels
Duplexing Not supported
Full-page labels
(uncut)
Do not use OK to use
Shiny backed paperMedia Types 5-7
Letterhead
Try printing your data on a sheet of plain paper first to check placement.
Postcards
Try printing your data on a sheet of plain paper first to check placement.
Capacity Tray 1 Up to 50 sheets, depending on their size and
thickness
Tray 2 Not supported
Orientation Face up
Driver
Media Type
Letterhead
Duplexing Not supported
Capacity Tray 1 Up to 50 postcards, depending on their
thickness
Tray 2 Not supported
Orientation Face up
Driver
Media Type
Postcard
Duplexing Not supported5-8 Printable Area
Use postcards that are
Approved for laser printers
DO NOT use postcards that are
Coated
Designed for inkjet printers
Precut or perforated
Preprinted or multicolored
Folded or wrinkled
" If the postcard is warped, press on the warped
area before putting it in Tray 1.
Printable Area
The printable area on all media sizes is
up to 4.2 mm (0.165") from the edges
of the media.
Each media size has a specific printable area (the maximum area on which
the machine can print clearly and without distortion).
This area is subject to both hardware
limits (the physical media size and the
margins required by the machine) and
software constraints (the amount of
memory available for the full-page
frame buffer). The printable area for all media sizes is the page size minus
4.2 mm (0.165") from all edges of the media.
" When printing in color on legal-size media, the following limitations
apply.
z The printable area is 339.6 (13.4") mm from the leading edge of
the paper. (However, there is a non-printable area up to 4.2 mm
(0.165") from the leading edge.)
z The bottom margin is 16.0 mm (0.63").
a a
a
a
Printable
Area
a=4.2 mm (0.165")Printable Area 5-9
Envelopes
Envelopes can only be printed on their front sides (side where the recipient’s
address is written). In addition, printing on the front side in the area overlapping the back flap cannot be guaranteed. The location of this area differs
depending on the envelope type.
" The envelope print orientation is determined by your application.
" With the Envelope DL size (long edge feeding), the nonprintable areas
on the left and right sides are 6 mm.
Page Margins
Margins are set through your application. Some applications allow you to set
custom page sizes and margins while others have only standard page sizes
and margins from which to choose. If you choose a standard format, you may
lose part of your image (due to printable area constraints). If you can custom-size your page in your application, use those sizes given for the printable
area for optimum results.
a=4.2 mm (0.165")
Non-printable area
Non-guaranteed printable area
Guaranteed printable area
Front side
(can be printed)
Back side
(cannot be printed)
a a
a
a5-10 Loading Media
Loading Media
How do I load media?
Take off the top and bottom sheets of a
ream of paper. Holding a stack of approximately 200 sheets at a time, fan the
stack to prevent static buildup before
inserting it in a tray.
Note
Although this printer was designed for printing on a wide range of
media types, it is not intended to print exclusively on a single media
type except plain paper. Continuous printing on media other than plain
paper (such as envelopes, labels, or thick stock) may adversely affect
print quality or reduce engine life.
When refilling media, first remove any media remaining in the tray. Stack it
with the new media, even the edges, then reload it.
Do not mix media of different types and sizes, as this will cause media misfeeds.
Tray 1 (Multipurpose Tray)
For details on the types and sizes of media that can be printed from Tray 1,
refer to “Print Media” on page 5-2.
Loading Plain Paper
1 Remove the dust cover from
Tray 1.Loading Media 5-11
2 Slide the media guides to provide more space between them.
3 Load the paper face up in the
tray.
" Do not load paper above
the ▼ mark. Up to 200
sheets (80 g/m2
[21 lb]) of
plain paper can be
loaded into the tray at
one time.5-12 Loading Media
4 Slide the media guides against
the edges of the paper.
5 Reattach the dust cover.
6 Select MAIN MENU/PAPER MENU/INPUT TRAY/TRAY1/MEDIA
SIZE and MEDIA TYPE in the configuration menu, and then select the
settings for the size and type of paper that are loaded. See also “PAPER
MENU” on page 4-8.Loading Media 5-13
Other Media
When loading media other than plain paper, set the media mode (for example, Envelope, Label, or Thick Stock) in the driver for optimum print quality.
Loading Envelopes
1 Remove the dust cover from
Tray 1.
2 Remove any media from the tray.
3 Slide the media guides to provide more space between them.5-14 Loading Media
4 Load the envelopes flap side
down in the tray.
" Before loading envelopes, press them down
to make sure that all air is
removed, and make sure
that the folds of the flaps
are firmly pressed; otherwise the envelopes may
become wrinkled or a
media misfeed may
occur.
" Up to 10 envelopes can be loaded into the tray at one time.
" For envelopes with the flap (Envelope C6 or Envelope DL), load
the envelopes with the flap side inserted first.
5 Slide the media guides against
the edges of the envelopes.
6 Reattach the dust cover.Loading Media 5-15
7 Select MAIN MENU/PAPER MENU/INPUT TRAY/TRAY1/MEDIA
SIZE and MEDIA TYPE in the configuration menu, and then select the
settings for the size and type of paper that are loaded. See also “PAPER
MENU” on page 4-8.5-16 Loading Media
Loading Labels/Postcard/Thick Stock and Letterhead
1 Remove the dust cover from
Tray 1.
2 Remove any media from the
tray.
3 Slide the media guides to provide more space between them.
4 Load the media face up in the
tray.
" Up to 50 sheets can be
loaded into the tray at
one time.Loading Media 5-17
5 Slide the media guides against
the edges of the media.
6 Reattach the dust cover.
7 Select MAIN MENU/PAPER MENU/INPUT TRAY/TRAY1/MEDIA
SIZE and MEDIA TYPE in the configuration menu, and then select the
settings for the size and type of paper that are loaded. See also “PAPER
MENU” on page 4-8.5-18 Loading Media
Tray 2
Only Letter/A4 plain paper can be loaded in Tray 2.
Loading Plain Paper
1 Pull out Tray 2 as far as possible.
2 Lift up Tray 2 to remove it.
3 Remove the lid from Tray 2.Loading Media 5-19
4 Press down the media pressure
plate to lock it into place.
5 Load the paper face up in the
tray.
" Do not load above the
100% line. Up to 500
sheets (80 g/m2
[21 lb]) of
plain paper can be
loaded into the tray at
one time.
6 Reattach the lid to Tray 2.
100%
75
505-20 Loading Media
7 Reinsert Tray 2 into the printer.Duplexing 5-21
Duplexing
Select paper with high opacity for duplex (double sided) printing. Opacity
refers to how effectively paper blocks out what is written on the opposite side
of the page. If the paper has low opacity (high translucency), then the printed
data from one side of the page will show through to the other side. Check
your application for margin information. For best results, print a small quantity
to make sure the opacity is acceptable.
Duplex (Double sided) printing can be done automatically with the duplex
option installed and selected.
Note
Only Letter/A4 plain paper, 60–90 g/m2
(16–24 lb bond) can be
autoduplexed. See “Print Media” on page 5-2.
Duplexing envelopes, labels, postcards, thick stock, or letterhead is not
supported.
How do I autoduplex?
You should verify that the duplex option is physically installed on the printer to
successfully duplex the job.
Check your application to determine how to set your margins for duplex
printing.
The following Binding Position settings are available.
If “Short Edge” is selected, the pages will be laid out to flip
at the top.
If “Long Edge” is selected, the pages will be laid out to flip
at the sides.
1
3
1
2
1
1
1
1
2
35-22 Output Tray
In addition, if “N-up” has been set to “Booklet”, autoduplex printing is performed.
The following Order settings are available when “Booklet” is selected.
1 Load plain paper into the tray.
2 From the printer driver, specify the layout for duplex printing.
3 Click OK.
" With autoduplexing, the back side is printed first, and then the front
side is printed.
Output Tray
All printed media is output to the face-down output tray on top of the printer.
This tray has a capacity of approximately 100 sheets (A4/Letter) of 80 g/m2
(21 lb) paper.
" If the media is stacked too high in the output tray, your printer may
experience media misfeeds, excessive media curl, or static buildup.
If “Left Binding” is selected, the pages can be folded as a
left-bound booklet.
If “Right Binding” is selected, the pages can be folded as a
right-bound booklet.
1
1
2
3
3
3
1
1
2Media Storage 5-23
Media Storage
How do I store media?
Keep media on a flat, level surface in its original wrapper until it is time to
load it.
Media that has been stored for a long time out of its packaging may dry up
too much and cause misfeeding.
If media has been removed from its wrapper, place it in its original packaging and store in a cool, dark place on a level surface.
Avoid moisture, excessive humidity, direct sunlight, excessive heat (above
35°C [95°F]), and dust.
Avoid media leaning against other objects or placing it in an upright position.
Before using stored media, do a trial print and check print quality. 5-24 Media StorageReplacing
Consumables6-2 Replacing Consumables
Replacing Consumables
Note
Failure to follow instructions as outlined in this manual could result in
voiding your warranty.
About Toner Cartridges
Your printer uses four toner cartridges: black, yellow, magenta, and cyan.
Handle the toner cartridges carefully to avoid spilling toner inside the printer
or on yourself.
" Install only new toner cartridges in your printer. If a used toner cartridge is installed, then toner remaining amount may not be accurate.
" The toner is nontoxic. If you get toner on your skin, wash it off with
cool water and a mild soap. If you get toner on your clothes, lightly
dust them off as best as you can. If some toner remains on your
clothes, use cool, not hot water, to rinse the toner off.
CAUTION
If you get toner in your eyes, wash it out immediately with cool water
and consult a doctor.
" Refer to the following URL for recycling information.
US: printer.konicaminolta.com/products/recycle/index.asp
Europe: www.konicaminolta.eu/printing-solutions/more-information/
clean-planet.html
Other regions: printer.konicaminolta.com
Note
Do not use refilled toner cartridges or unapproved toner cartridges. Any
damage to the printer or quality problems caused by a refilled toner
cartridge or unapproved toner cartridge will void your warranty. No
technical support is provided to recover from these problems.Replacing Consumables 6-3
When replacing a toner cartridge, refer to the following table. For optimum
print quality and performance, use only approved KONICA MINOLTA toner
cartridges for your specific printer type, as listed in the table below. You can
find your machine type and the toner cartridge part numbers on the consumables reorder label inside the top cover your machine.
" For optimum print quality and performance, use only the corresponded TYPE genuine KONICA MINOLTA toner cartridges.
Printer
Type
Printer Part
Number
Toner Cartridge Type Toner Cartridge
Part Number
AM A034 012
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Yellow (Y) A0V3 05F
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Magenta (M) A0V3 0AF
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Cyan (C) A0V3 0GF
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Black (K) A0V3 01F
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Yellow (Y) A0V3 06F
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Magenta (M) A0V3 0CF
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Cyan (C) A0V3 0HF
EU A034 022
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Yellow (Y) A0V3 05H
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Magenta (M) A0V3 0AH
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Cyan (C) A0V3 0GH
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Black (K) A0V3 01H
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Yellow (Y) A0V3 06H
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Magenta (M) A0V3 0CH
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Cyan (C) A0V3 0HH
AP A034 042
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Yellow (Y) A0V3 05K
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Magenta (M) A0V3 0AK
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Cyan (C) A0V3 0GK
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Black (K) A0V3 01K
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Yellow (Y) A0V3 06K
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Magenta (M) A0V3 0CK
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Cyan (C) A0V3 0HK
GC A034 082
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Yellow (Y) A0V3 05N
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Magenta (M) A0V3 0AN
Standard-Capacity Toner Cartridge -Cyan (C) A0V3 0GN
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Black (K) A0V3 01N
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Yellow (Y) A0V3 06N
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Magenta (M) A0V3 0CN
High-Capacity Toner Cartridge - Cyan (C) A0V3 0HN6-4 Replacing Consumables
Keep toner cartridges:
In their packaging until you’re ready to install them.
In a cool, dry location away from sunlight (due to heat).
The maximum storage temperature is 35° C (95° F) and the maximum
storage humidity is 85% (noncondensing). If the toner cartridge is moved
from a cold place to a warm, humid place, condensation may occur,
degrading print quality. Allow the toner to adapt to the environment for
about one hour before use.
Level during handling and storage.
Do not hold, stand or store
cartridges on their ends or turn
them upside down; the toner
inside the cartridges may
become caked or unequally
distributed.
Away from salty air and corrosive gases such as aerosols.Replacing Consumables 6-5
Replacing a Toner Cartridge
Note
Be careful not to spill toner while replacing a toner cartridge. If toner
spills, immediately wipe it off with a soft, dry cloth.
If TONER OUT ACTION on the MAIN MENU/QUALITY MENU/TONER
OUT ACTION menu is set to STOP, the message X TONER OUT/
REPLACE XXXX (where “X” and “XXXX” represent the color of the toner)
appears when a toner cartridge becomes empty. Follow the steps below to
replace the toner cartridge.
" If TONER OUT ACTION on the MAIN MENU/QUALITY MENU/
TONER OUT ACTION menu is set to CONTINUE, the printing can
continue even after the message "X TONER OUT" has appeared;
however, the printing quality cannot be guaranteed. If printing is continued and the toner becomes empty, the message "X TONER LIFE
END" appears and printing stops. For details on the setting, refer to
“QUALITY MENU” on page 4-13.
1 Check the message window to see which color toner cartridge needs
replacing.
" If the machine detects that a toner cartridge is empty (X TONER OUT
or X TONER LIFE END appears), the empty toner cartridge is automatically moved so that it can be replaced.
If you wish to change the toner cartridge, use ether operation described
below to switch the printer to REPLACE TONER.
Press Key Until Display Reads
X TONER OUT
REPLACE XXXX or
X TONER LIFE END
MENU
MAIN MANU
MAIN MENU
PRINT MENU6-6 Replacing Consumables
× 2 MAIN MENU
QUALITY MENU
QUALITY MENU
REPLACE TONER
REPLACE TONER
BLACK
Press until appropriate
color (X) is displayed.
REPLACE TONER
X
X
*YES
*YES IS SELECTED
Then, it displays
OPEN DOOR AND
REPLACE X TONER
Press Key Until Display ReadsReplacing Consumables 6-7
2 Open the front cover.
" Before opening the front
cover, open Tray 1 if it is
not already open.
3 Check that the toner cartridge to be replaced has been moved to the front.
" You can identify the toner cartridge by the color of the handle.
4 Pull down the handle on the
toner cartridge until the toner
cartridge is unlocked and moves
out slightly toward you.
Remove the toner cartridge.
" Do not manually rotate
the toner cartridge carousel. In addition, do not
rotate the carousel with
force, otherwise it may be
damaged.6-8 Replacing Consumables
Note
Do not touch the contact
indicated in the illustration.
Note
Dispose of the empty toner cartridge according to your local
regulations. Do not burn the toner cartridge.
For details, refer to “About Toner Cartridges” on page 6-2.
5 Prepare a new toner cartridge.
6 Shake the cartridge a few times
to distribute the toner.
" Make sure that the toner
roller cover is securely
attached before shaking
the toner cartridge.Replacing Consumables 6-9
7 Remove the cover from the
toner roller.
" Do not touch or scratch
the toner roller.
8 Align the shaft on each end of
the toner cartridge with its holders, and then insert the cartridge.
" Before inserting the toner
cartridge, make sure that
the color of the toner cartridge to be installed is
the same as the label on
the toner cartridge carousel.6-10 Replacing Consumables
Note
Do not touch the contact
indicated in the illustration.
9 Press in the toner cartridge until
it locks into place.
10 Close the front cover.Replacing Consumables 6-11
" The printer must complete a calibration cycle after the toner cartridge has been replaced. If you open the top or front cover before
the message IDLE appears, the printer stops and repeats the calibration cycle.6-12 Replacing Consumables
Removing All Toner Cartridges
Note
Be careful not to spill toner while removing a toner cartridge. If toner
spills, immediately wipe it off with a soft, dry cloth.
By using the REMOVE ALL mode, all toner cartridges can be removed.
Follow the procedure described below to use the REMOVE ALL mode.
1 Perform the operation described below to switch the printer to the
REMOVE ALL mode.
Press Key Until Display Reads
IDLE
MANU
MAIN MANU
MAIN MENU
PRINT MENU
× 2 MAIN MENU
QUALITY MENU
QUALITY MENU
REPLACE TONER
REPLACE TONER
BLACK
REPLACE TONER
REMOVE ALLReplacing Consumables 6-13
" It is not possible to exit REMOVE ALL mode before the operation is
finished (even if the Cancel key is pressed).
If the printer has incorrectly been switched to REMOVE ALL mode,
open, then close the front cover four times to exit REMOVE ALL
mode.
2 Open the front cover.
" Before opening the front
cover, open Tray 1 if it is
not already open.
REMOVE ALL
*NO
REMOVE ALL
YES
*YES
IS SELECTED
Then, it displays
OPEN DOOR AND
REMOVE M TONER
Press Key Until Display Reads6-14 Replacing Consumables
3 Pull down the handle on the
toner cartridge until the toner
cartridge is unlocked and moves
out slightly toward you.
Remove the toner cartridge.
" Do not manually rotate
the toner cartridge carousel. In addition, do not
rotate the carousel with
force, otherwise it may be
damaged.
Note
Do not touch the contact
indicated in the illustration.Replacing Consumables 6-15
4 Close the front cover.
5 Follow the same procedure to remove the cartridges for the cyan, black,
then yellow toners.6-16 Replacing Consumables
Replacing the Imaging Cartridge
When replacing an imaging cartridge, refer to the following table. For optimum print quality and performance, use only approved KONICA MINOLTA
imaging cartridge for your specific printer type, as listed in the table below.
You can find your machine type and the imaging cartridge part numbers on
the consumables reorder label inside the top cover your machine.
" For optimum print quality and performance, use only the corresponded TYPE genuine KONICA MINOLTA imaging cartridge.
1 Open the top cover.
" If there is paper in the
output tray, remove it,
and then fold up the output tray before opening
the top cover.
2 Grab the handle and lift it up
slightly to the back, and then
slowly pull the imaging cartridge
out vertically.
Printer
Type
Printer Part
Number
Part Name Imaging Cartridge
Part Number
AM A034 012 Imaging Cartridge A0VU 011
EU A034 022 A0VU 0Y1
AP A034 042 A0VU 0Y1
GC A034 082 A0VU 0Y1Replacing Consumables 6-17
Note
Dispose of the used imaging cartridge according to your local
regulations. Do not burn the imaging cartridge.
3 Prepare the new imaging cartridge.
Note
Do not touch the PC drum and the transfer belt on the imaging
cartridge.
4 Slowly insert the new imaging
cartridge vertically, and then
push it slightly down toward you
to finish installing the imaging
cartridge.6-18 Replacing Consumables
5 Carefully close the top cover.
" The printer must complete a calibration cycle after the imaging cartridge has been replaced. If you open the top cover before the
message IDLE appears, the printer stops and repeats the calibration cycle.Replacing Consumables 6-19
Replacing the Fuser Unit
For optimum print quality and performance, use only approved KONICA
MINOLTA fuser unit for your specific printer type.
1 Turn off the printer and disconnect the power cord.
Note
There are extremely hot parts within the printer. Before replacing the
fuser unit, wait about 20 minutes after turning off the printer, and
then check that the fusing section has reached room temperature,
otherwise, you may get burnt.
2 Open the top cover.
" If there is paper in the
output tray, remove it,
and then fold up the output tray before opening
the top cover.6-20 Replacing Consumables
3 Push the blue handles back as
far as possible.
4 Grab the blue handles and lift
the fuser unit to remove it.
Note
Do not touch the matching
connectors of the fuser unit and
the machine.Replacing Consumables 6-21
5 Prepare a new fuser unit.
6 Pull the fuser separator levers
forward as far as possible.6-22 Replacing Consumables
7 Remove the fuser separator
material, and then return the
fuser separator levers to their
original positions.
Note
Be careful not to touch the paper exit sensor and the surface of the
fuser roller in the fuser unit.
8 While lifting the fuser unit with
the blue handles (one on each
side), vertically insert the fuser
unit.Replacing Consumables 6-23
Note
Do not touch the paper exit
sensor on the fuser unit.
Note
Do not touch the matching
connectors of the fuser unit
and the machine.
M6-24 Replacing Consumables
9 After the fuser unit is firmly
installed, flip the blue handles
down toward you.
10 Carefully close the top cover.
11 Reconnect the power cord, and
turn on the printer.Maintaining the
Printer7-2 Maintaining the Printer
Maintaining the Printer
CAUTION
Read all caution and warning labels carefully, making sure to follow any
instructions contained in them. These labels are located on the inside of
the printer’s covers and the interior of the printer body.
Handle the printer with care to preserve its life. Abuse handling may cause
damage and void your warranty. If dust and paper scraps remain on the
inside or outside of the printer, printer performance and print quality will suffer,
so the printer should be cleaned periodically. Keep the following guidelines in
mind.
WARNING!
Turn off the printer, unplug the power cord, and disconnect all interface
cables before cleaning. Do not spill water or detergent into the printer;
otherwise the printer will be damaged and an electric shock may occur.
CAUTION
The fuser unit is hot. When the top cover is opened, the fuser
unit temperature drops gradually (one hour wait time).
Be careful when cleaning the inside of the printer or removing media misfeeds, as the fuser unit and other internal parts may be very hot.
Do not place anything on top of the printer.
Use a soft cloth to clean the printer.
Never spray cleaning solutions directly on the printer’s surface; the spray
could penetrate through the air vents of the printer and damage the internal circuits.
Avoid using abrasive or corrosive solutions or solutions that contain solvents (such as alcohol and benzene) to clean the printer.
Always test any cleaning solution (such as mild detergent) on a small
inconspicuous area of your printer to check the solution’s performance.
Never use sharp or rough implements, such as wire or plastic cleaning
pads.
Always close the printer’s covers gently. Never subject the printer to vibration.
Do not cover the printer immediately after using it. Turn it off and wait until
it cools down.Maintaining the Printer 7-3
Do not leave the printer’s covers open for any length of time, especially in
well-lit places; light may damage the imaging cartridge.
Do not open the printer during printing.
Do not tap media stacks on the printer.
Do not lubricate or disassemble the printer.
Do not tilt the printer.
Do not touch the electrical contacts, gears, or laser devices. Doing so may
damage the printer and cause the print quality to deteriorate.
Keep media in the output tray at a minimum level. If the media is stocked
too high, your printer may experience media misfeeds and excessive
media curl.
Keep the printer level to avoid
toner spillage.
When lifting the printer, grasp
the areas shown in the figure.
Before moving the printer,
remove the dust cover, and fold
up Tray 1.
If the optional lower feeder unit,
attachment and duplex option
are installed, remove them and
move them separately.
If you get toner on your skin, wash it off with cool water and a mild soap.
CAUTION
If you get toner in your eyes, wash it out immediately with cool water
and consult a doctor.
Make sure any parts removed during cleaning are replaced before you
plug in the printer.
15.1 kg
33.3 lbs7-4 Cleaning the Printer
Cleaning the Printer
CAUTION
Be sure to turn off the printer and unplug the power cord before
cleaning. However, be sure to turn on the printer when cleaning the
print head window.
Exterior
Ready
Error
Cancel
Control Panel Ventilation Grill
Printer ExteriorCleaning the Printer 7-5
Interior
Cleaning the Media Feed Roller
1 Open the top cover.
" If there is paper in the
output tray, remove it,
and then fold up the output tray before opening
the top cover.
2 Grab the handle and lift it up
slightly to the back, and then
slowly pull the imaging cartridge
out vertically.7-6 Cleaning the Printer
Note
Do not touch the PC drum and the transfer belt on the imaging
cartridge.
Position the removed imaging
cartridge horizontally as shown in
the illustration at the right.
Be sure to keep the imaging
cartridge horizontal and place it
where it will not become dirty.
Do not leave the imaging
cartridge removed for more than
15 minutes, and do not place the
removed imaging cartridge in a
location where it would be
exposed to direct light (such as
sunlight).
3 Clean the media feed rollers by
wiping them with a soft, dry
cloth.
BOTTOM
VIEWCleaning the Printer 7-7
CAUTION
The area around the fuser unit is
extremely hot.
Touching anything other than the
indicated levers may result in
burns. If you get burned,
immediately cool the skin under
cold water, and then seek
professional medical attention.
Note
Decreased print quality may
result if the surface of the
transfer roller is touched.
Be careful not to touch the
surface of the transfer roller.7-8 Cleaning the Printer
4 Slowly insert the imaging cartridge vertically, and then push it
slightly down toward you to finish reinstalling the imaging cartridge.
5 Carefully close the top cover.Cleaning the Printer 7-9
Cleaning the Print Head Window
1 Perform the operation described below to switch the printer to the P/H
CLEAN UP mode.
Press Key Until Display Reads
IDLE
MENU
MAIN MANU
MAIN MENU
PRINT MENU
× 2 MAIN MENU
QUALITY MENU
QUALITY MENU
REPLACE TONER
× 3 QUALITY MENU
P/H CLEAN UP
P/H CLEAN UP
*YES
*YES
IS SELECTED
Then, it displays
OPEN DOOR
REMOVE TONER7-10 Cleaning the Printer
" To exit P/H CLEAN UP mode, press the Cancel key.
2 Open the front cover.
" Before opening the front
cover, open Tray 1 if it is
not already open.
3 The magenta toner cartridge has
been moved to the position from
where it can be replaced.
Pull down the handle on the
toner cartridge until the toner
cartridge is unlocked and moves
out slightly toward you.
Remove the toner cartridge.
" When the magenta toner
cartridge is removed, a
gap is created within the
printer so that the print
head window can easily
be cleaned.Cleaning the Printer 7-11
Note
Do not touch the contact
indicated in the illustration.
4 Close the front cover.
" The toner cartridge rotate
within the printer.
5 After the toner cartridges have
finished rotating, open the top
cover.7-12 Cleaning the Printer
6 Grab the handle and lift it up
slightly to the back, and then
slowly pull the imaging cartridge
out vertically.
Note
Do not touch the PC drum and the transfer belt on the imaging
cartridge.
Position the removed imaging
cartridge horizontally as shown in
the illustration at the right.
Be sure to keep the imaging
cartridge horizontal and place it
where it will not become dirty.
Do not leave the imaging
cartridge removed for more than
15 minutes, and do not place the
removed imaging cartridge in a
location where it would be
exposed to direct light (such as
sunlight).Cleaning the Printer 7-13
7 Clean the print head window by
wiping it with a soft, dry cloth.
CAUTION
The area around the fuser unit is
extremely hot.
Touching anything other than the
indicated levers may result in
burns. If you get burned,
immediately cool the skin under
cold water, and then seek
professional medical attention.
BOTTOM
VIEW7-14 Cleaning the Printer
Note
Decreased print quality may
result if the surface of the
transfer roller is touched.
Be careful not to touch the
surface of the transfer roller.
8 Slowly insert the imaging cartridge vertically, and then push it
slightly down toward you to finish reinstalling the imaging cartridge.Cleaning the Printer 7-15
9 Close the top cover.
10 After the toner cartridges have
finished rotating, open the front
cover.7-16 Cleaning the Printer
11 Align the shaft on each end of
the toner cartridge with its holders, and then insert the cartridge.
Note
Do not touch the contact
indicated in the illustration.Cleaning the Printer 7-17
12 Press in the magenta toner cartridge until it locks into place.
13 Close the front cover.7-18 Cleaning the Printer
Cleaning the Media Feed Rollers for Tray 2
Be sure to remove the duplex option before cleaning the media feed rollers
for Tray 2.
1 If the duplex option is installed, remove it.
2 Remove the dust cover from Tray 1.
Close Tray 1 and the output tray.
3 Lift the printer off of Tray 2 and
temporarily place it on a sturdy
flat surface.
4 Clean the media feed rollers by
wiping them with a soft, dry
cloth.Cleaning the Printer 7-19
5 Lift the printer and reinstall it on
top of Tray 2.
6 Open Tray 1 and reattach the dust cover.
7 If you removed the duplex option in step 1, reinstall it.7-20 Cleaning the Printer
Cleaning the Media Feed Rollers for the attachment
Be sure to remove the duplex option before cleaning the media feed rollers
for the attachment.
1 If the duplex option is installed, remove it.
2 Remove the dust cover from Tray 1.
Close Tray 1 and the output tray.
3 Lift the printer off of the attachment and temporarily place it on
a sturdy flat surface.
4 Clean the media feed rollers by
wiping them with a soft, dry
cloth.Cleaning the Printer 7-21
5 Lift the printer and reinstall it on
top of the attachment.
6 Open Tray 1 and reattach the dust cover.
7 If you removed the duplex option in step 1, reinstall it.7-22 Cleaning the Printer
Cleaning the Duplex Feed Rollers
1 Open the duplex cover.
2 Clean the feed rollers by wiping
them with a soft, dry cloth.
3 Carefully close the duplex cover.Troubleshooting8-2 Introduction
Introduction
This chapter provides information to aid you in resolving printer problems you
may encounter, or at least guide you to the proper sources for help.
Printing a Configuration Page
Print a configuration page to verify the printer is configured correctly.
Printing the configuration page page 8-2
Preventing media misfeeds page 8-4
Understanding the media path page 8-5
Clearing media misfeeds page 8-5
Solving problems with media misfeeds page 8-19
Solving other problems page 8-21
Solving problems with printing quality page 8-25
Status, error, and service messages page 8-31
Press Key Until Display Reads
IDLE
MENU
MAIN MENU
MAIN MENU
PRINT MENU
PRINT MENU
MENU MAP
PRINT MENU
CONFIGURATIONPrinting a Configuration Page 8-3
CONFIGURATION
YES
The configuration page prints and the
printer goes back to IDLE.
Press Key Until Display Reads8-4 Preventing Media Misfeeds
Preventing Media Misfeeds
Make sure that...
Media matches the printer specifications.
Media is flat, especially on the leading edge.
The printer is on a hard, flat, level surface.
You store media in a dry location away from moisture and humidity.
You always adjust the media guides in Tray 1 after inserting the media (a
guide that is not properly adjusted can cause poor print quality, media misfeeds, and printer damage).
You load the media printing-side up in the tray (many manufacturers place an
arrow on the end of the wrapper to indicate the printing side).
Avoid...
Media that is folded, wrinkled, or excessively curled.
Double feeding (remove the media and fan the sheets—they may be sticking
together).
Loading more than one type/size/weight of media in a tray at the same time.
Overfilling the trays.
Allowing the output tray to overfill (the output tray has a 100-sheet capacity—
misfeeding may occur if you allow more than 100 sheets of media to accumulate at one time).Understanding the Media Path 8-5
Understanding the Media Path
Understanding the printer’s media path will help you locate media misfeeds.
1 Output tray
2 Imaging cartridge
3 Toner cartridge carousel
4 Tray 1
5 Tray 2 (optional)
6 Fuser unit
7 Duplex option
Clearing Media Misfeeds
To avoid damage, always remove misfed media gently, without tearing it. Any
piece of media left in the printer, whether large or small, can obstruct the
media path and cause further misfeeds. Do not reload media that has misfed.
Note
The image is not fixed on the media before the fusing process. If you
touch the printed surface, the toner may stick to your hands, so be
careful not to touch the printed face when removing the misfed media.
Make sure not to spill any toner inside the printer.
CAUTION
Unfused toner can dirty your hands, clothes, or anything else it gets on.
If you accidentally get toner on your clothes, lightly dust them off as
best as you can. If some toner remains on your clothes, use cool, not
hot water, to rinse the toner off. If toner gets on your skin, wash it off
with cool water and a mild soap.
CAUTION
If you get toner in your eyes, wash it out immediately with cool water
and consult a doctor.
If, after clearing the media misfeed, the misfeed message in the control panel
window persists, open and close the printer’s top cover. This should clear the
misfeed message.
1
6
7
2
3
4
58-6 Clearing Media Misfeeds
Media Misfeed Messages and Clearing Procedures
Media Misfeed Message Page Reference
CHECK TRAY1
PAPER
(Displaying alternately)
PRESS
MENU/SELECT
This message appears in the following cases.
z When no media is loaded in Tray 1
z When a misfeed has occurred in Tray 1
With the first case, load media into the tray, and
then press the Menu Select key.
With the second case, refer to page 8-13.
PAPER JAM
FUSER
page 8-7
PAPER JAM
EXIT
page 8-7
PAPER JAM
TRANSFER
page 8-7
PAPER JAM TRAY2
OPEN TOP COVER
page 8-14
PAPER JAM
DUPLEX
page 8-17Clearing Media Misfeeds 8-7
Clearing a Media Misfeed in the Printer
1 Open the top cover.
" If there is paper in the
output tray, remove it,
and then fold up the output tray before opening
the top cover.
2 Grab the handle and lift it up
slightly to the back, and then
slowly pull the imaging cartridge
out vertically.8-8 Clearing Media Misfeeds
Note
Do not touch the PC drum and the transfer belt on the imaging
cartridge.
Position the removed imaging
cartridge as shown in the
illustration at the right.
Be sure to keep the imaging
cartridge horizontally horizontal
and place it where it will not
become dirty.
Do not leave the imaging
cartridge removed for more than
15 minutes, and do not place the
removed imaging cartridge in a
location where it would be
exposed to direct light (such as
sunlight).Clearing Media Misfeeds 8-9
3 Push the fuser separator levers
back as far as possible.
CAUTION
The area around the fuser unit is
extremely hot.
Touching anything other than the
indicated levers may result in
burns. If you get burned,
immediately cool the skin under
cold water, and then seek
professional medical attention.8-10 Clearing Media Misfeeds
4 Remove any misfed media.
" If a media misfeed occurs
near the fuser unit, pull
out the media from below
the fuser unit, as shown
in the illustration at the
right.
" If the media cannot
be removed from
below the fuser unit,
raise the fuser unit
cover, and then
remove the media
from above the fuser
unit.
" Remove the dust
cover from Tray 1 and
remove the media.
M
MClearing Media Misfeeds 8-11
Note
Do not touch the paper exit
sensor on the fuser unit.
Note
Decreased print quality may
result if the surface of the
transfer roller is touched.
Be careful not to touch the
surface of the transfer roller.
M8-12 Clearing Media Misfeeds
5 Return the fuser separator
levers to their original positions.
6 Slowly insert the imaging cartridge vertically, and then push it
slightly down toward you to finish reinstalling the imaging cartridge.
7 Carefully close the top cover.
MClearing Media Misfeeds 8-13
Clearing a Media Misfeed From Tray 1
1 Remove the dust cover from
Tray 1.
2 Carefully pull out the misfed
media.
" If the media cannot be
removed, instead of pulling it with extreme force,
clear the media misfeed
according to the procedure described in “Clearing a Media Misfeed in
the Printer” on page 8-7.
3 Reattach the dust cover.
4 Press the Menu Select key.8-14 Clearing Media Misfeeds
Clearing a Media Misfeed From Tray 2
1 Pull out Tray 2 as far as possible.
2 Lift up Tray 2 to remove it.
3 Remove any misfed paper.
" If necessary, remove the
dust cover from Tray 1
and close the tray.Clearing Media Misfeeds 8-15
4 Remove the lid from Tray 2, and
then remove all paper from the
tray.
5 Fan the paper, and align its
edges.
6 Press down the media pressure
plate to lock it into place.
7 Load the media in Tray 2, and
attach the lid.8-16 Clearing Media Misfeeds
8 Reinsert Tray 2.
9 Open and close the top cover to
clear the misfeed message.Clearing Media Misfeeds 8-17
Clearing a Media Misfeed from the Duplex Option
1 Open the duplex cover.
2 Carefully pull out the misfed
media.
" Always remove the misfed media in the feed
direction as shown only.
" If the media misfeed
occurs at the bottom feed
slot and the media does
not stick out enough to be
removed, turn the dial at
the right in the direction
of the arrow until the
media can be pulled out.8-18 Clearing Media Misfeeds
3 Close the duplex cover.Solving Problems with Media Misfeeds 8-19
Solving Problems with Media Misfeeds
" Frequent misfeeds in any area indicate that area should be checked,
repaired, or cleaned. Repeated misfeeds may also happen if you’re
using unsupported print media.
Symptom Cause Solution
Several
sheets go
through the
printer
together.
The front edges of
the media are not
even.
Remove the media and even up the
front edges, then reload it.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
Media misfeed message stays
on.
Top cover needs to
be opened and
closed again to reset
the printer.
Open and close the top cover again.
Some media remains
misfed in the printer.
Recheck the media path and make
sure that you have removed all of the
misfed media.
Duplex
option misfeeds.
Unsupported media
(wrong size, thickness, type, etc.) is
being used.
Use KONICA MINOLTA-approved
media. See “Print Media” on page 5-2.
Also, refer to http://printer. konicaminolta.com for a complete list of currently approved media.
Only Letter/A4 plain paper and recycled paper can be autoduplexed if the
duplex option is installed and the
media type is set properly in the driver.
Make sure that you have not mixed
media types in Tray 1.
Do not duplex envelopes, labels, thick
stock, postcard, or letterheads.
Media is still being
misfed.
Recheck the media path inside the
duplex option and make sure that you
have removed all of the misfed media.8-20 Solving Problems with Media Misfeeds
Media is
misfeeding.
The media is not correctly positioned in
the tray.
Remove the misfed media and reposition the media properly in the tray.
The number of sheets
in the tray exceeds
the maximum
allowed.
Remove the excess media and reload
the correct number of sheets in the
tray.
The media guides are
not correctly adjusted
to the media size.
Adjust the media guides in the Tray 1
to match the size of the media.
Warped or wrinkled
media is loaded in the
tray.
Remove the media, smooth it out, and
reload it. If it still misfeeds, do not use
that media.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
Custom-sized media,
envelopes, labels,
postcards, thick
stock, or letterheads
are loaded in Tray 2.
Special media must be loaded in Tray
1 only.
The recommended
label sheet is facing
the wrong way in Tray
1.
Load the label sheets according to the
manufacturer’s instructions.
Envelopes are facing
the wrong way in Tray
1.
Load the envelopes in Tray 1 with the
flaps facing down.
If the flaps are on the long edge (Envelope C6 and Envelope DL), load the
envelopes with the flap edge toward
the printer and the flap side facing
down.
Unsupported media
(wrong size, thickness, type, etc.) is
being used.
Use KONICA MINOLTA-approved
media. See “Print Media” on page 5-2.
Also, refer to http://printer. konicaminolta.com for a complete list of currently approved media.
The media feed roller
is dirty.
Clean the media feed roller.
For more details, refer to “Cleaning the
Media Feed Roller” on page 7-5.
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Other Problems 8-21
Solving Other Problems
" To order KONICA MINOLTA consumables, go to www.q-shop.com.
Symptom Cause Solution
Printer
power is not
on.
The power cord is not
correctly plugged into
the outlet.
Turn off the printer, confirm that the
power cord is correctly plugged into the
outlet, and then turn on the printer.
Something is wrong
with the outlet connected to the printer.
Plug another electrical appliance into
the outlet and see whether it operates
properly.
The power switch is
not correctly turned
on (I position).
Turn the power switch off (O position),
then turn it back to the on (I position).
The printer is connected to an outlet
with a voltage or frequency that does not
match the printer
specifications.
Use a power source with the specifications listed in appendix A, “Technical
Specifications”.
The control
panel displays X
TONER
LOW much
sooner than
expected.
One of the toner cartridges may be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and check
each for damage. If one or more is
damaged, replace it.
You printed with
heavy toner coverage.
See specifications in appendix A,
“Technical Specifications”.
You can’t
print the configuration
page.
The tray is empty. Check that at least Tray 1 is loaded
with media, in place, and secure.
There is a media
misfeed.
Clear the media misfeed.8-22 Solving Other Problems
Printing
takes too
much time.
The printer is set to a
slow printing mode
(for example, thick
stock).
It takes more time to print with special
media. When using regular paper,
make sure that the media type is set
properly in the driver.
The printer is set to
power saving mode.
It takes time for printing to start in
power saving mode.
The job is very complex.
Wait. No action needed.
A toner cartridge for a
different region is
installed (X INCORRECT is displayed in
the message window).
Install a correct KONICA MINOLTA
toner cartridge approved for your specific printer.
Blank pages
are printed.
One or more of the
toner cartridges are
defective or empty.
Check the toner cartridges. The image
will not print correctly or not at all, if a
cartridge is empty.
The wrong media is
being used.
Check that the media type set in the
driver matches the media loaded in the
printer.
Printer
returned to
IDLE before
the configuration menu
was
changed.
The printer was in the
configuration menu
structure without a
selection being made
within two minutes.
When in the configuration menu structure, select your choice within 2 minutes.
Not all pages
print.
The Cancel key was
pressed.
Make sure no one pressed the Cancel
key while your job was printing.
The tray is empty. Check that the tray is loaded with
media, in place, and secure.
A document is printed
with an overlay file
which has been created by a non-suitable driver.
Print the overlay file using a suitable
driver.
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Other Problems 8-23
Printer
resets or
turns off frequently.
The power cord is not
correctly plugged into
the outlet.
Turn off the printer, confirm that the
power cord is correctly plugged into the
outlet, and then turn on the printer.
A system error
occurred.
Contact Technical Support with the
error information.
You are
experiencing duplex
problems.
Media or settings are
not correct.
For autoduplexing, make sure that you
have a duplex option installed.
Make sure that you are using correct
media.
Only Letter/A4 plain paper can be
autoduplexed.
Do not duplex envelopes, labels,
postcards, thick stock, letterheads,
or plain paper with a size other than
Letter/A4.
Make sure that you have not mixed
media types in Tray 1.
Make sure the duplex option is installed
and declared in the Windows printer
driver (Properties/Configure tab).
In the printer driver (Layout tab),
choose “Double-sided”.
You hear
unusual
noises.
The printer is not
level.
Place the printer on a flat, hard, level
surface.
The tray is not
installed correctly.
Remove the tray that you are printing
from and reinsert it completely into the
printer.
There is a foreign
object stuck inside
the printer.
Turn off the printer and remove the
object. If you cannot remove it, contact
Technical Support.
The
web-based
utility cannot
be accessed.
The PageScope Web
Connection Administrator’s password is
incorrect.
The PageScope Web Connection
Administrator password has a 1-character minimum and a 16-character
maximum. For details of the PageScope Web Connection administrator
password, refer to the Reference Guide
on the Utilities and Documentation CD/
DVD.
Symptom Cause Solution8-24 Solving Other Problems
Media is
wrinkled.
The media is moist
from humidity or having water spilled on it.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
The media feed roller
or fuser unit is defective.
Check them for damage. If necessary,
contact Technical Support with the
error information.
Unsupported media
(wrong size, thickness, type, etc.) is
being used.
Use KONICA MINOLTA-approved
media. See “Print Media” on page 5-2.
Also, refer to http://printer. konicaminolta.com for a complete list of currently approved media.
The date and
time is not
correctly
maintained
on the
printer.
The backup battery
has reached the end
of its service life.
Contact Technical Support.
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Problems with Printing Quality 8-25
Solving Problems with Printing Quality
Symptom Cause Solution
Nothing is
printed, or
there are
blank spots
on the
printed page.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check if any is damaged.
The imaging cartridge
may be defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Adjust the humidity for media storage.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
The media set in the
printer driver mismatches the media
loaded in the printer.
Load the correct media in the printer.
The power source
does not match the
printer specifications.
Use a power source with the proper
specifications.
Several sheets are
being fed at the same
time.
Remove the media from the tray and
check for static electricity. Fan plain
paper or other media, and replace it in
the tray.
Media is not set properly in the tray(s).
Remove the media, tap it to straighten
it out, return it into the tray, and realign
the media guides.
Entire sheet
is printed in
black or
color.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check each for damage. If one or more
is damaged, replace it.
The imaging cartridge
may be defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.8-26 Solving Problems with Printing Quality
Image is too
light; there is
low image
density.
The print head window is dirty.
Clean the print head window.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Remove the moist media and replace
with new, dry media.
There is not much
toner left in the cartridge.
Replace the toner cartridge.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check each for damage. If one or more
is damaged, replace it.
Media type is set
incorrectly.
When printing envelopes, labels, postcards, thick stock, or letterheads, specify the appropriate media type in the
printer driver.
Image is too
dark.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check each for damage. If one or more
is damaged, replace it.
The imaging cartridge
may be defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
Image is
blurred;
background
is lightly
stained;
there is
insufficient
gloss of the
printed
image.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check each for damage. If one or more
is damaged, replace it.
The imaging cartridge
may be defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Problems with Printing Quality 8-27
The print or
color density
is uneven.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective or low.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
The imaging cartridge
is defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
The printer is not
level.
Place the printer on a flat, hard, level
surface.
Irregular
print or mottled image
appears.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Adjust the humidity in the media storage area.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
Unsupported media
(wrong size, thickness, type, etc.) is
being used.
Use KONICA MINOLTA-approved
media. See “Print Media” on page 5-2.
Also, refer to http://printer. konicaminolta.com for a complete list of currently approved media.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and check
each for damage. If one or more is damaged, replace it.
The imaging cartridge
is defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
There is
insufficient
fusing or the
image
comes off
when
rubbed.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
Unsupported media
(wrong size, thickness, type, etc.) is
being used.
Use KONICA MINOLTA-approved
media. See “Print Media” on page 5-2.
Also, refer to http://printer. konicaminolta.com for a complete list of currently approved media.
Media type is set
incorrectly.
When printing envelopes, labels, postcards, thick stock, or letterheads, specify the appropriate media type in the
printer driver.
Symptom Cause Solution8-28 Solving Problems with Printing Quality
There are
toner
smudges or
residual
images.
One or more of the
toner cartridges are
defective or installed
incorrectly.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check each for damage. If one or more
is damaged, replace it.
There are
toner
smudges on
the back side
of the page
(whether or
not it has
been
duplexed).
The media path is
dirty with toner.
Print several blank sheets and the
excess toner should disappear.
One or more of the
toner cartridges are
defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check each for damage. If one or more
is damaged, replace it.
The imaging cartridge
is defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
Abnormal
areas (white,
black, or
color) appear
in a regular
pattern.
The print head window is dirty.
Clean the print head window.
A toner cartridge may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridge with the
color causing the abnormal image.
Replace it with a new toner cartridge.
The imaging cartridge
is defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
Symptom Cause SolutionSolving Problems with Printing Quality 8-29
Image
defects.
The print head window is dirty.
Clean the print head window.
A toner cartridge may
be leaking.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
A toner cartridge may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridge with the
color causing the abnormal image.
Replace it with a new toner cartridge.
The imaging cartridge
may be defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
Lateral lines
or bands
appear on
image.
The printer is not
level.
Place the printer on a flat, hard, level
surface.
The media path is
dirty with toner.
Print several sheets and the excess
toner should disappear.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check each for damage. If one or more
is damaged, replace it.
The imaging cartridge
is defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
Thin white
horizontal
lines appear
at intervals
on images.
Toner is not evenly
adhering to the
media.
Perform IMAGE REFRESH. (On the
control panel menu, go to MAIN
MENU/QUALITY MENU/IMAGE
REFRESH, then select YES.)
If the problem persists, contact your
vendor or authorized service provider.
Colors look
drastically
wrong.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and verify
that the toner is distributed evenly on
each cartridge roller, and reinstall the
toner cartridges.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be low or empty.
Check the control panel for an X
TONER LOW or X TONER OUT message. If necessary, replace the specified toner cartridge.
Symptom Cause Solution8-30 Solving Problems with Printing Quality
If the problem is not resolved, even after all of the above have been performed, contact Technical Support with the error information.
For contact information, refer to the Need Assistance Sheet.
Colors are
not registering properly;
colors are
mixed or
have pageto-page variation.
The imaging cartridge
is not correctly
seated.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
reinstall it.
One or more of the
toner cartridges may
be defective.
Remove the toner cartridges and
check each for damage. If one or more
is damaged, replace it.
The media is moist
from humidity.
Remove the moist media and replace it
with new, dry media.
The color
has a poor
reproduction
or has poor
color density.
The imaging cartridge
may be defective.
Remove the imaging cartridge and
check for damage. If it is damaged,
replace it.
Perform AIDC. (On the control panel
menu, go to MAIN MENU/QUALITY MENU/AIDC/REQUEST
AIDC, then select YES.)
Symptom Cause SolutionStatus, Error, and Service Messages 8-31
Status, Error, and Service Messages
Status, error, and service messages are displayed in the control panel message window. They provide information about your printer and help you locate
many problems. When the condition associated with a displayed message
has changed, the message is cleared from the window.
Standard Status Messages
This message... means... do this...
CALIBRATING Whenever you replace a
toner cartridge or reboot the
printer after making environmental changes, the printer
automatically pauses to do
an Auto-Image Density Control (AIDC) cycle. This process is provided to make
reliable printer operation
with optimum output quality
possible.
No action needed.
CANCELLING JOB The job is being cancelled.
ENERGY SAVER The printer is in Energy
Saver mode to reduce
power consumption during
periods of inactivity.
In addition, the machine will
return to its normal operating
condition when any key on
the control panel is pressed.
IDLE The printer is on and ready
to receive data.
INITIALIZING The printer is being initialized.
PRINTING The printer is printing.8-32 Status, Error, and Service Messages
Error Messages (Warning)
PROCESSING The printer is processing
data.
No action needed.
magicolor 1650
STARTING PRINTER
The printer is being started
up.
PORT AUTH ACTIVE The IEEE802.1x port is
being authorized.
WARMING UP The printer is warming up.
REFRESHING The printer is adjusting the
toner distribution.
This message... means... do this...
CHECK TRAY1
PAPER
(Displaying alternately)
PRESS
MENU/SELECT
Tray 1 is empty. Load the media into
Tray 1, and then press
the Menu Select key.
Media has misfed in
Tray 1.
Remove the misfed
media.
I/C END The imaging cartridge
has reached the end
of its life.
Replace the imaging
cartridge.
"Printing can
continue,
however, the
printing result are
not guaranteed.
If printing is
continued, the
message "I/C
LIFE END"
appears and
printing stops.
I/C LOW The imaging cartridge
is near the end of its
life.
Prepare a new imaging
cartridge.
TRAY 2 IS EMPTY Tray 2 is empty. Load the media into
Tray 2.
This message... means... do this...Status, Error, and Service Messages 8-33
TRAY 2 OPEN Tray 2 cassette is not
installed or is not fully
closed.
Close Tray 2 or print
from another tray.
VIDEO I/F ERROR A video interface
error occurred in the
printer.
Turn off the printer. After
a few seconds, turn on
the printer.
X INCORRECT The X toner cartridge
is an unapproved
type.
Install a
KONICA MINOLTA
toner cartridge of the
appropriate type (AM,
EU, AP or GC). See
page 6-3.
X MEMORY ERROR A memory error
occurred in the toner
cartridge.
Re-install the specified
toner cartridge.
X TONER LOW The X toner cartridge
is nearly empty.
Prepare the specified
color toner cartridge.
X TONER OUT
(Ready Indicator: On. Error
Indicator: Off)
The X toner cartridge
is empty.
(If the MAIN MENU/
QUALITY MENU/
TONER OUT ACTION
menu is set to
CONTINUE.)
Replace the toner cartridge.
"Printing can
continue,
however, the
printing results
are not
guaranteed.
If printing is
continued, the
message "X
TONER LIFE
END" appears
and printing
stops.
This message... means... do this...8-34 Status, Error, and Service Messages
Error Messages (Operator Call)
This
message...
means... do this...
AUTH
TIMEOUT
The user is automatically
logged off due to IEEE802.1x
port authorization.
Reauthorize the IEEE802.1x
port, and then log on.
AIDC
ERROR
AIDC sensor error. Open and close front cover
to automatically clean AIDC
parts.
BELT
ERROR
The printer detected incorrect
image position on the image
transfer belt.
Check the cyan and black
toner cartridges and replace
them if they have run out.
If the error has not been
recovered by this procedure, please call Technical
Support.
DUPLEX
UNIT
PANEL
OPEN
Duplex cover is open. Close the duplex cover.
DOWNLOAD
IMAGE
INVALID
While updating code, an error
has occurred.
The user should attempt the
upgrade process again.
I/C LIFE
END
The imaging cartridge is
reached the end of its life.
Replace the imaging cartridge.
PAPER JAM
DUPLEX
Media has misfed in the
duplex option.
Locate and remove the misfeed.
PAPER JAM
EXIT
Media has misfed in the fuser
area.
PAPER JAM
FUSER
PAPER JAM
TRANSFER
Media has misfed in the transfer roller area. This type of
misfeed means that the media
did not make it to the paper
exit area.
PAPER JAM
TRAY 2
Media has misfed while being
pulled from Tray 2.
Locate and remove the misfeed.Status, Error, and Service Messages 8-35
PUT
"SIZE"
"TYPE"
IN TRAY 1
The size of paper being
printed on is different from the
size of paper specified in the
printer driver.
Load the correct paper on
Tray1, and press the Menu
Select key, then specify the
size and type of the paper.
PUT
“SIZE”
“TYPE”
IN TRAY 2
The paper size set from the
printer driver is different from
the size of paper loaded into
Tray 2.
Open Tray 2 and keep
correct paper size. Then
close Tray 2.
Specify the correct paper
size in the MAIN MENU/
PAPER MENU/INPUT
TRAY/TRAY2/MEDIA
SIZE menu.
TOP COVER
OPEN
The printer’s top cover is
open.
Close the top cover.
The imaging cartridge is not
installed.
Install the imaging cartridge.
A imaging cartridge incompatible with the machine is
installed.
Replace the imaging cartridge with a correct one.
X TONER
LIFE END
The X toner cartridge has
reached the end of its life.
Replace the toner cartridge.
"If the MAIN MENU/
QUALITY MENU/
TONER OUT
ACTION menu is set
to CONTINUE.
X TONER
MISSING
The X toner cartridge is not
installed.
Install a X toner cartridge.
X TONER
OUT
REPLACE
XXXX
(Ready Indicator: Off. Error
Indicator: On)
The X toner cartridge is empty.
(If the MAIN MENU/
QUALITY MENU/TONER OUT
ACTION menu is set to STOP.)
Replace the toner cartridge.
"If the MAIN MENU/
QUALITY MENU/
TONER OUT
ACTION menu is set
to CONTINUE,
printing can continue.
However, the printing
results are not
guaranteed.
This
message...
means... do this...8-36 Status, Error, and Service Messages
Service Messages
These messages indicate a more serious error that can only be corrected by
a customer service engineer. If one of these messages appears, turn the
printer off, then turn it on again. If the problem persists, contact your local
vendor or authorized service provider.
This service
message...
means... do this...
SERVICE
CALL XXXX
An error has been detected
with the item indicated “XXXX”
in the service message.
Reboot the printer. This often
clears the service message,
and printer operation can
resume.
If the problem persists, contact Technical Support.Installing
Accessories9-2 Introduction
Introduction
Note
Use of accessories not manufactured or supported by
KONICA MINOLTA will void your warranty.
This chapter provides information about the following accessories.
Note
Installing accessories always requires that the printer and accessories
are turned off and unplugged during installation.
" For details on the available options, refer to
printer.konicaminolta.com.
Tray 2 500-sheet tray
Duplex Option Auto duplexing
"In order for the duplex option to be installed,
Tray 2 must be installed on the printer.
Duplex Option and
Attachment
Auto duplexing
"The attachment is an interface unit for
installing the duplex option on the machine.
"During installation, install the attachment
before installing the duplex option.Tray 2 9-3
Tray 2
If Tray 2 is installed, up to 500 additional sheets of A4/Letter-size paper can
be loaded.
Installing Tray 2
Note
Since consumables are installed in the printer, be sure to keep the
printer level when moving it in order to prevent accidental spills.
1 Turn off the printer and disconnect the power cord and interface cables.9-4 Tray 2
2 Remove the dust cover from Tray 1.
Close Tray 1 and the output tray.
3 Prepare Tray 2.
" Be sure to place Tray 2 on a level surface.
4 Lift the printer and place it on top
of Tray 2, making sure that the
positioning pins on Tray 2 correctly fit into the holes in the bottom of the printer.
5 Open Tray 1 and reattach the dust cover.
6 Load paper into Tray 2.
For details on loading paper, refer to “Tray 2” in “Loading Plain Paper” on
page 5-18.
7 Insert Tray 2 into the printer.
8 Reconnect all interface cables.Tray 2 9-5
9 Reconnect the power cord, and
turn on the printer.
10 Declare the Tray 2 in the Windows printer driver (Properties/Configure
tab, see page 2-2).9-6 Duplex Option
Duplex Option
Duplex (Double Sided) printing can be performed automatically with the
duplex option installed.
See “Duplexing” on page 5-21.
In order for the duplex option to be installed, either of the following must be
installed on the printer.
z Tray 2
z Attachment
" If Tray 2 is installed, it is not necessary to install the attachment. In this
case, skip “Installing the Attachment”, and continue with “Installing the
Duplex Option” on page 9-8.
Installing Attachment
If the attachment is installed, the duplex option can be installed.
(The attachment cannot be used by itself; it must be used together with the
duplex option.)
Note
Since consumables are installed in the printer, be sure to keep the
printer level when moving it in order to prevent accidental spills.
Duplex option AttachmentDuplex Option 9-7
1 Turn off the printer and disconnect the power cord and interface cables.
2 Remove the dust cover from
Tray 1.
Close Tray 1 and the output tray.
3 Prepare the attachment.
" Be sure to place the attachment on a level surface.
4 Lift the printer and place it on top
the attachment, making sure that
the positioning pins on the
attachment correctly fit into the
holes on the bottom of the
printer.
5 Open Tray 1 and reattach the dust cover.
Next, install the duplex option.9-8 Duplex Option
Installing the Duplex Option
" The illustrations in the following installation procedure show the printer
with Tray 2 installed; however, the installation procedure would be the
same if the attachment was installed.
1 Turn off the printer and disconnect the power cord and interface cables.
2 Remove the tape affixed to the
rear cover.
3 Prepare the duplex option.Duplex Option 9-9
4 Install the duplex option.
Align the duplex option with its
installation position, and then
push down on the bottom of the
duplex option until it locks into
place.
Note
When attaching the duplex option, attach the bottom of the option first.
If the duplex option is attached incorrectly, it may be damaged.
5 Open the duplex cover.
While holding the duplex option
against the printer, tighten the
screws inside the cover to complete the installation of the
duplex option.9-10 Duplex Option
6 Reconnect all interface cables.
7 Reconnect the power cord, and
turn on the printer.
8 Declare the duplex in the Windows printer driver (Properties/Configure
tab, see page 2-2).AppendixA-2 Technical Specifications
Technical Specifications
Printer
Type Desktop full color laser beam printer
Printing system Dual laser diode with polygon mirror
Developing system Mono component development system
Fusing system Heat roller system
Resolution 600 dpi × 600 dpi × 4 bits or
600 dpi × 600 dpi × 1 bit
First print Simplex
Monochrome:
13.0 seconds for A4, Letter (plain paper)
Full color:
22.0 seconds for A4, Letter (plain paper)
Duplex
Monochrome:
26.0 seconds for A4, Letter (plain paper)
Full color:
35.0 seconds for A4, Letter (plain paper)
Print speed Simplex
Monochrome:
20.0 pages per minute for A4, Letter (plain
paper)
Full color:
5.0 pages per minute for A4, Letter (plain
paper)
Duplex
Monochrome:
Tray 1: 8.0 pages per minute for A4, Letter
(plain paper)
Tray 2: 13.2 pages per minute for A4, Letter (plain paper)
Full color:
5.0 pages per minute for A4, Letter (plain
paper)
Warm-up time Avg. 45 secondsTechnical Specifications A-3
Media sizes Tray 1
Paper width:92 to 216 mm (3.6 to 8.5")
Paper length:
Plain paper:
195 to 356 mm (7.7 to 14.0")
Thick stock 1/2:
184 to 297 mm (7.25 to 11.7")
Tray 2 (Optional)
A4/Letter
Paper/Media Plain paper (60 to 90 g/m2
; 16 to 24 lb bond)
Envelope
Thick stock 1 (91 to 163 g/m2
)
Thick stock 2 (164 to 209 g/m2
)
Postcard
Letterhead
Label sheet
Input capacity Tray 1
Plain paper: 200 sheets
Envelope: 10 envelopes
Label/Letterhead/Postcard/Thick Stock:
50 sheets
Tray 2 (Optional)
Plain paper: 500 sheets
Output capacity Output tray: 100 sheets (A4, Letter)
Operating temperature 10 to 35°C (50 to 95°F)
Operating humidity 15 to 85%
Power supply 120 V, 60 Hz
220 to 240 V, 50 to 60 Hz
Power consumption 120 V: 1000 W or less
220 to 240 V: 1060 W or less
Energy Saver Mode: 18.5 W or less
Amperage 120 V: 8.4 A or less
220 to 240 V: 4.4 A or less A-4 Technical Specifications
Acoustic Noise Printing: 50 dB or less (monochrome)
49 dB or less (color)
Standby: 29 dB or less
External dimensions Height: 275 mm (10.8")
Width: 396 mm (15.6")
Depth: 380 mm (14.9")
Weights 11.9 kg (without consumables)
15.1 kg (with consumables)
Interface USB 2.0 High-Speed compliant, 10Base-T/
100Base-TX Ethernet
Standard memory 256 MBTechnical Specifications A-5
Consumable Life Expectancy Chart
User-Replaceable
Service-Replaceable
" The values listed in the above table indicate the number of pages for
simplex printing using A4/Letter-size media with 5% coverage.
The actual life may differ (be shorter) depending on the printing conditions (coverage, paper size, etc.), differences in the printing method,
such as continuous printing or intermittent printing (when print jobs of
one page are often printed), or the type of paper used, for example,
thick paper. In addition, the life will be affected by the temperature and
humidity of the operating environment.
Item Average Life Expectancy (in Simplex Pages)
Toner cartridge Starter Cartridge =
500 pages (Y, M, C)
1,000 pages (K)
Replacement Cartridge =
Standard-capacity: 1,500 pages (Y, M, C)
High-capacity: 2,500 pages (Y, M, C, K)
Imaging cartridge Monochrome:
45,000 pages (Continuous)
10,000 pages (1 page per job)
Full color:
11,250 pages (Continuous)
7,500 pages (1 page per job)
Fuser unit 50,000 pages
Item Average Life Expectancy
Transfer roller 50,000 pagesA-6 Our Concern for Environmental Protection
Our Concern for Environmental Protection
As an ENERGY STAR
®
Partner, we have determined that this machine meets
the ENERGY STAR Guidelines for energy efficiency.
What is an ENERGY STAR product?
An ENERGY STAR product has a special feature that allows it to automatically switch to a “low-power mode” after a period of inactivity. An ENERGY
STAR product uses energy more efficiently, saves you money on utility bills
and helps protect the environment.Index
Index A-7
A
Accessories
Duplex option ..............................9-6
Tray 2 ..........................................9-3
C
Configuration menu .....................4-5
Consumables
Fuser Unit .................................6-19
Imaging Cartridge .....................6-16
Toner cartridge ...........................6-2
Control panel ................................4-2
D
Duplexing ....................................5-21
Duplex option ..............................9-6
E
Envelope ....................................... 5-5
Error messages .......................... 8-32
L
Labels ........................................... 5-6
Letterhead .................................... 5-7
Loading media ........................... 5-10
M
Maintenance ................................. 7-2
Media
Clearing misfeeds ...................... 8-5
Loading .................................... 5-10
Path ............................................ 8-5
Preventing misfeeds ................... 8-4
Printable area ............................. 5-8
Media misfeed
Duplex option ........................... 8-17A-8 Index
Interior .........................................8-5
Tray 2 ........................................8-14
Media path .....................................8-5
Media storage .............................5-23
Media type
Envelope .....................................5-5
Labels .........................................5-6
Letterhead ...................................5-7
Plain paper ..................................5-3
Postcard ......................................5-7
Thick stock ..................................5-4
Message window ..........................4-2
Messages ....................................8-31
Misfeed problems .......................8-19
Clearing ......................................8-5
Media path ..................................8-5
Preventing ...................................8-4
O
Output tray ..................................5-22
P
Page margins ................................5-9
Plain paper ....................................5-3
Postcard ........................................5-7
Preventing media misfeeds .........8-4
Print quality .................................8-25
Printable Area ...............................5-8
Printer
Parts ...........................................1-4
Printer driver .................................2-6
Advanced tab ..............................2-7
Basic tab .....................................2-8
Cover page tab ...........................2-8
Displaying ...................................2-5
Layout tab ...................................2-8
Other Tab ....................................2-9
Quality Tab .................................2-9
Uninstalling .................................2-4
Watermark/Overlay Tab ..............2-8
S
Service messages ......................8-36
Status Monitor ..............................3-2
Closing ....................................... 3-3
Opening ...................................... 3-2
Using .......................................... 3-2
T
Thick stock ................................... 5-4
Tray 2 ............................................ 9-3
Troubleshooting .......................... 8-1
User’s Guide [Copy Operations]bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 Contents-1
Table of contents
1 Introduction
1.1 Welcome .......................................................................................................................................... 1-2
1.1.1 User's guides ..................................................................................................................................... 1-2
1.1.2 User's Guide ...................................................................................................................................... 1-3
1.2 Conventions used in this manual .................................................................................................. 1-4
1.2.1 Symbols used in this manual ............................................................................................................. 1-4
To use this machine safely................................................................................................................. 1-4
Procedural instruction........................................................................................................................ 1-4
Key symbols....................................................................................................................................... 1-5
1.2.2 Original and paper indications ........................................................................................................... 1-5
Original and paper sizes .................................................................................................................... 1-5
Original and paper indications ........................................................................................................... 1-5
2 Part names and their functions
2.1 Options............................................................................................................................................. 2-2
2.1.1 bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS................................................................................................ 2-2
2.1.2 bizhub C452....................................................................................................................................... 2-5
2.2 Main Body........................................................................................................................................ 2-7
2.2.1 Outside of the main body (front) ........................................................................................................ 2-7
2.2.2 Outside of the main body (rear) ......................................................................................................... 2-9
2.2.3 Main bodyInside............................................................................................................................... 2-11
bizhub C652/C552/C452 ................................................................................................................. 2-11
bizhub C652DS/C552DS ................................................................................................................. 2-13
2.2.4 Control panel.................................................................................................................................... 2-14
Adjusting the angle of the control panel .......................................................................................... 2-15
2.2.5 Touch panel ..................................................................................................................................... 2-16
2.3 Option............................................................................................................................................. 2-18
2.3.1 Finisher FS-526/Saddle stitcher SD-508/Punch kit PK-516............................................................ 2-18
2.3.2 Job separator JS-602 ...................................................................................................................... 2-20
2.3.3 Z Folding Unit ZU-606 ..................................................................................................................... 2-21
2.3.4 Post Inserter PI-505 ......................................................................................................................... 2-22
2.3.5 Finisher FS-527/ Saddle Stitcher SD-509/ Punch Kit PK-517/ Job Separator JS-603................... 2-23
2.3.6 Job Separator JS-504...................................................................................................................... 2-25
2.3.7 Large capacity unit LU-301/LU-204 ................................................................................................ 2-26
3 Using this machine
3.1 Turning on or off the machine ....................................................................................................... 3-2
3.2 Basic copy operations.................................................................................................................... 3-4
3.2.1 Placing originals................................................................................................................................. 3-4
Loading the original into the ADF ...................................................................................................... 3-4
Placing the original on the original glass ........................................................................................... 3-5
3.2.2 Basic copy operations ....................................................................................................................... 3-5
3.2.3 Copy operations using multiple functions ......................................................................................... 3-6
Functions that cannot be combined .................................................................................................. 3-8
4 Control Panel Keys
Control panel and functions............................................................................................................... 4-2
4.1 About the [Start] key, the [Stop] key, and the [Interrupt] key..................................................... 4-4
The [Start] key .................................................................................................................................... 4-4
The [Stop] key .................................................................................................................................... 4-4bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 Contents-2
The [Interrupt] key .............................................................................................................................. 4-4
The [Reset] key .................................................................................................................................. 4-4
4.2 About the [Copy] key, the [Fax/Scan] key, and the [User Box] key ........................................... 4-5
The [Copy] key ................................................................................................................................... 4-5
The [Fax/Scan] key ............................................................................................................................ 4-5
The [User Box] key............................................................................................................................. 4-5
4.3 The [Utility/Counter] key ................................................................................................................ 4-6
4.4 The [Mode Memory] key................................................................................................................. 4-7
4.5 The [Access] key............................................................................................................................. 4-8
Controlling access to the machine by user/account (user authentication/account track)................. 4-8
Using the machine during non-scheduled hours............................................................................. 4-10
4.6 The [Power Save] key ................................................................................................................... 4-11
4.7 The [Accessibility] key.................................................................................................................. 4-12
4.8 The [Enlarge Display] key............................................................................................................. 4-14
4.9 The [Guidance] key ....................................................................................................................... 4-15
4.10 The [C] (Clear) key ........................................................................................................................ 4-17
4.11 The [Proof Copy] key .................................................................................................................... 4-18
Printing one set to check the copy result (Proof Copy) ................................................................... 4-18
Using a preview image to check the copy result (Advanced Preview) ............................................ 4-19
5 Copy Function
5.1 Basic................................................................................................................................................. 5-3
5.1.1 Color .................................................................................................................................................. 5-4
5.1.2 Paper.................................................................................................................................................. 5-5
Configuring a custom size ................................................................................................................. 5-6
Configuring wide paper...................................................................................................................... 5-6
5.1.3 Zoom.................................................................................................................................................. 5-7
5.1.4 Duplex/Combine ................................................................................................................................ 5-8
5.1.5 Finishing........................................................................................................................................... 5-10
5.1.6 Post Inserter..................................................................................................................................... 5-12
Keys on control panel ...................................................................................................................... 5-12
Finishing using Post Inserter............................................................................................................ 5-13
5.1.7 Separate Scan ................................................................................................................................. 5-13
5.1.8 Auto Rotate OFF .............................................................................................................................. 5-14
5.2 Original Setting.............................................................................................................................. 5-15
Copying mixed originals .................................................................................................................. 5-16
Copying Z-folded originals............................................................................................................... 5-17
5.3 Quality/Density .............................................................................................................................. 5-18
5.4 Application..................................................................................................................................... 5-20
5.4.1 Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert............................................................................................................. 5-21
OHP Interleave................................................................................................................................. 5-21
Cover Sheet ..................................................................................................................................... 5-22
Insert Sheet...................................................................................................................................... 5-23
Insert Image ..................................................................................................................................... 5-24
Chapters .......................................................................................................................................... 5-26
Program Jobs .................................................................................................................................. 5-27
5.4.2 Edit Color ......................................................................................................................................... 5-29
Neg./Pos. Reverse ........................................................................................................................... 5-29
Mirror Image..................................................................................................................................... 5-30
Background Color............................................................................................................................ 5-31
Color Adjustment ............................................................................................................................. 5-31
5.4.3 Book Copy/Repeat .......................................................................................................................... 5-33
Book Copy ....................................................................................................................................... 5-33
Image Repeat................................................................................................................................... 5-34
Poster Mode .................................................................................................................................... 5-35
Booklet Original................................................................................................................................ 5-36
5.4.4 Page Margin..................................................................................................................................... 5-37
5.4.5 Image Adjust .................................................................................................................................... 5-39bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 Contents-3
5.4.6 Booklet............................................................................................................................................. 5-40
5.4.7 Erase ................................................................................................................................................ 5-41
Frame Erase..................................................................................................................................... 5-41
Non-Image Area Erase..................................................................................................................... 5-42
5.4.8 Stamp/Composition......................................................................................................................... 5-43
Date/Time......................................................................................................................................... 5-44
Page Number................................................................................................................................... 5-45
Stamp............................................................................................................................................... 5-47
Copy Protect.................................................................................................................................... 5-48
Copy Guard...................................................................................................................................... 5-49
Password Copy................................................................................................................................ 5-50
Stamp Repeat .................................................................................................................................. 5-51
Header/Footer.................................................................................................................................. 5-53
Watermark........................................................................................................................................ 5-54
Overlay............................................................................................................................................. 5-55
Registered Overlay........................................................................................................................... 5-56
5.4.9 Card Copy........................................................................................................................................ 5-59
5.4.10 Save in User Box ............................................................................................................................. 5-60
5.5 Left panel display .......................................................................................................................... 5-61
5.5.1 Job List ............................................................................................................................................ 5-62
5.5.2 Check Job........................................................................................................................................ 5-64
6 User Settings
6.1 System Settings .............................................................................................................................. 6-3
6.2 Custom Display Settings ................................................................................................................ 6-6
6.3 Copier Settings................................................................................................................................ 6-8
6.4 Fax/Scan Settings......................................................................................................................... 6-11
6.5 Printer Settings ............................................................................................................................. 6-12
6.6 Change Password......................................................................................................................... 6-13
6.7 Change E-Mail Address................................................................................................................ 6-14
6.8 Change Icon .................................................................................................................................. 6-15
6.9 Register Authentication Information........................................................................................... 6-16
6.10 Cellular Phone/PDA Setting ......................................................................................................... 6-18
7 Administrator Settings
7.1 System Settings .............................................................................................................................. 7-3
7.1.1 Power Save Settings.......................................................................................................................... 7-3
7.1.2 Output Settings.................................................................................................................................. 7-4
7.1.3 Date/Time Settings ............................................................................................................................ 7-5
7.1.4 Daylight Saving Time ......................................................................................................................... 7-6
7.1.5 Weekly Timer Setting ......................................................................................................................... 7-7
7.1.6 Restrict User Access.......................................................................................................................... 7-8
7.1.7 Expert Adjustment ............................................................................................................................. 7-9
Leading Edge Adjustment................................................................................................................ 7-13
Centering.......................................................................................................................................... 7-13
Media Adjustment............................................................................................................................ 7-14
Center Staple Position ..................................................................................................................... 7-14
Half-Fold Position ............................................................................................................................ 7-15
Tri-Fold Position Adjustment ........................................................................................................... 7-15
Punch Vertical Position Adjustment................................................................................................. 7-16
Punch Horizontal Position Adjustment ............................................................................................ 7-16
Punch Regist Loop Size Adjustment ............................................................................................... 7-17
Punch Edge Sensor Adjustment...................................................................................................... 7-17
Vertical Punch (Z-Fold) Position Adjustment ................................................................................... 7-17
Horizontal Punch (Z-Fold) Position Adjustment............................................................................... 7-18
1st Z-Fold Position Adjustment ....................................................................................................... 7-18
2nd Z-Fold Position Adjustment ...................................................................................................... 7-19
Punch Unit Size Detect Sensor........................................................................................................ 7-19bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 Contents-4
Color Registration Adjust................................................................................................................. 7-20
Gradation Adjustment...................................................................................................................... 7-21
7.1.8 List/Counter ..................................................................................................................................... 7-22
7.1.9 Reset Settings.................................................................................................................................. 7-23
7.1.10 User Box Settings ............................................................................................................................ 7-24
7.1.11 Standard Size Setting ...................................................................................................................... 7-24
7.1.12 Stamp Settings ................................................................................................................................ 7-25
7.1.13 Blank Page Print Settings ................................................................................................................ 7-26
7.1.14 Skip Job Operation Settings............................................................................................................ 7-26
7.1.15 Default Bypass Paper Type Setting ................................................................................................. 7-27
7.1.16 Advanced Preview Setting............................................................................................................... 7-27
7.1.17 Page Number Print Position............................................................................................................. 7-28
7.2 Administrator/Machine Settings.................................................................................................. 7-29
7.3 One-Touch/User Box Registration.............................................................................................. 7-30
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track............................................................................................ 7-31
7.4.1 General Settings .............................................................................................................................. 7-32
7.4.2 User Authentication Settings ........................................................................................................... 7-34
7.4.3 Account Track Settings.................................................................................................................... 7-37
7.4.4 Print without Authentication............................................................................................................. 7-38
7.4.5 Print Counter List ............................................................................................................................. 7-38
7.4.6 External Server Settings................................................................................................................... 7-39
7.4.7 Limiting Access to Destinations....................................................................................................... 7-39
7.4.8 Authentication Device Settings........................................................................................................ 7-40
7.4.9 User/Account Common Setting....................................................................................................... 7-41
7.4.10 Scan to Home Settings.................................................................................................................... 7-41
7.4.11 Scan to Authorized Folder Settings ................................................................................................. 7-41
7.5 Network Settings .......................................................................................................................... 7-42
7.6 Copier Settings.............................................................................................................................. 7-43
7.7 Printer Settings ............................................................................................................................. 7-45
7.8 Fax Settings................................................................................................................................... 7-46
7.9 System Connection....................................................................................................................... 7-47
7.10 Security Settings ........................................................................................................................... 7-49
7.10.1 Administrator Password................................................................................................................... 7-49
7.10.2 User Box Administrator Setting ....................................................................................................... 7-49
7.10.3 Administrator Security Levels .......................................................................................................... 7-50
7.10.4 Security Details ................................................................................................................................ 7-51
7.10.5 Enhanced Security Mode................................................................................................................. 7-54
Required settings............................................................................................................................. 7-54
Settings to forcibly changed ............................................................................................................ 7-54
7.10.6 HDD Settings ................................................................................................................................... 7-55
7.10.7 Function Management Settings....................................................................................................... 7-56
7.10.8 Stamp Settings ................................................................................................................................ 7-57
7.10.9 Driver Password Encryption Setting ................................................................................................ 7-57
7.11 License Settings............................................................................................................................ 7-58
7.12 OpenAPI Authentication Management Settings ........................................................................ 7-59
8 Maintenance
8.1 Paper ................................................................................................................................................ 8-2
8.1.1 Checking the paper............................................................................................................................ 8-2
Replenishment message.................................................................................................................... 8-2
Precautions regarding the use of paper ............................................................................................ 8-2
Paper storage..................................................................................................................................... 8-2
8.1.2 Loading paper.................................................................................................................................... 8-3
Loading paper into trays 1 and 2....................................................................................................... 8-3
Loading paper into trays 3 and 4....................................................................................................... 8-4bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 Contents-5
Loading paper into the bypass tray ................................................................................................... 8-5
Loading paper into the LCT ............................................................................................................... 8-7
8.2 Consumables................................................................................................................................... 8-8
8.2.1 Checking comsumables .................................................................................................................... 8-8
Replacement message ...................................................................................................................... 8-8
Checking consumables status......................................................................................................... 8-10
Viewing counters.............................................................................................................................. 8-10
Checking the total number of pages printed ................................................................................... 8-11
8.3 Cleaning procedure ...................................................................................................................... 8-12
Slit glass (bizhub C652/C552/C452)................................................................................................ 8-12
Slit glass (front) (bizhub C652DS/C552DS)...................................................................................... 8-12
Slit glass (back) (bizhub C652DS/C552DS) ..................................................................................... 8-13
Original glass, control panel, paper take-up roller........................................................................... 8-13
Housing, document pad .................................................................................................................. 8-14
9 Troubleshooting
9.1 When the message "Trouble" appears (call a service representative)...................................... 9-2
Problems that cannot be corrected by the user ................................................................................ 9-2
9.2 Troubleshooting table..................................................................................................................... 9-4
Simple troubleshooting...................................................................................................................... 9-4
Main messages and their remedies ................................................................................................... 9-8
Icons that appear in the touch-panel screen ................................................................................... 9-10
9.3 If print quality is deteriorated....................................................................................................... 9-12
Cleaning the electrostatic charger wire ........................................................................................... 9-12
Cleaning the print head.................................................................................................................... 9-13
10 Authentication unit (biometric type)
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type) ............................................................................ 10-2
10.1.1 Configuring this machine ................................................................................................................. 10-3
10.1.2 Registering a user ............................................................................................................................ 10-5
Registering a user using the control panel of this machine............................................................. 10-5
Registering a user using Data Administrator ................................................................................... 10-6
Checking the version of the installed Data Administrator................................................................ 10-7
Setup................................................................................................................................................ 10-7
User registration............................................................................................................................. 10-11
10.1.3 Logging in to this machine............................................................................................................. 10-17
When 1-to-many authentication has been specified ..................................................................... 10-17
When 1-to-1 authentication has been specified............................................................................ 10-18
11 Authentication unit (IC card type)
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type) ..................................................................................... 11-2
11.1.1 Configuring this machine ................................................................................................................. 11-2
11.1.2 Registering a user ............................................................................................................................ 11-4
Registering a user using the control panel of this machine............................................................. 11-4
Registering a user using Data Administrator ................................................................................... 11-6
Checking the version of the installed Data Administrator................................................................ 11-6
Setup................................................................................................................................................ 11-7
User registration............................................................................................................................. 11-11
11.1.3 Logging in to this machine............................................................................................................. 11-15
When IC card authentication is enabled........................................................................................ 11-15
When IC card authentication + password authentication is enabled ............................................ 11-16
12 Specifications
12.1 Paper .............................................................................................................................................. 12-2
Paper types and paper capacities ................................................................................................... 12-2
12.2 Machine specifications................................................................................................................. 12-4
bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452.................................................................................... 12-4bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 Contents-6
Automatic duplex unit...................................................................................................................... 12-7
Reverse automatic document feeder (bizhub C652/C552/C452).................................................... 12-7
Reverse automatic document feeder (bizhub C652DS/C552DS).................................................... 12-7
12.3 Options........................................................................................................................................... 12-8
Large capacity unit LU-301.............................................................................................................. 12-8
Large capacity unit LU-204.............................................................................................................. 12-8
Finisher FS-526................................................................................................................................ 12-9
Saddle stitcher SD-508.................................................................................................................. 12-10
Punch kit PK-516........................................................................................................................... 12-11
Job Separator JS-602.................................................................................................................... 12-12
Z-Folding Unit ZU-606................................................................................................................... 12-12
Post Inserter PI-505 ....................................................................................................................... 12-13
Finisher FS-527.............................................................................................................................. 12-13
Saddle stitcher SD-509.................................................................................................................. 12-14
Punch Kit PK-517 .......................................................................................................................... 12-15
Job Separator JS-504.................................................................................................................... 12-15
Job Separator JS-603.................................................................................................................... 12-16
Authentication unit (biometric type) AU-101.................................................................................. 12-16
Authentication unit (biometric type) AU-102.................................................................................. 12-17
Authentication unit (IC card type) AU-201 ..................................................................................... 12-17
13 Appendix
13.1 Colors............................................................................................................................................. 13-2
Hue, brightness, and saturation....................................................................................................... 13-2
Red, green, and blue........................................................................................................................ 13-4
13.2 Image quality ................................................................................................................................. 13-5
Contrast, copy density, and sharpness ........................................................................................... 13-5
Color balance (CMYK) ..................................................................................................................... 13-6
13.3 Glossary ......................................................................................................................................... 13-7
14 Index
14.1 Index by item ................................................................................................................................. 14-2
14.2 Index by button.............................................................................................................................. 14-61 Introductionbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 1-2
1.1 Welcome
1
1 Introduction
1.1 Welcome
Thank you for purchasing this machine.
This User's Guide describes the functions, operating instructions, precautions for correct operation, and
simple troubleshooting guidelines of this machine. In order to obtain maximum performance from this
product and use it effectively, please read this User's Guide as necessary.
1.1.1 User's guides
Printed manual Overview
Quick Guide [Copy/Print/Fax/Scan/Box Operations]
This manual describes operating procedures and the
functions that are most frequently used in order to enable you to begin using this machine immediately.
This manual also contains notes and precautions that
should be followed to ensure safe usage of this machine.
Please be sure to read this manual before using this
machine.
User's guide CD manuals Overview
Copy Operations This manual describes details on copy mode operations and the settings of this machine.
• Specifications of originals and copy paper
• Copy function
• Maintaining this machine
• Troubleshooting
Enlarge Display Operations This manual describes details on operating procedures of enlarge display mode.
• Copy function
• Scanning function
• G3 fax function
• Network fax function
Print Operations This manual describes details on printer functions.
• Printer function
• Configuring the printer driver
Box Operations This manual describes details on the boxed functions
using the hard disk.
• Saving data in User Boxes
• Retrieving data from User Boxes
• Printing and transferring data from User Boxes
Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations This manual describes details on transmitting
scanned data.
• Scan to E-Mail, FTP TX, SMB TX, Save in User
Box, WebDAV and Web Service
• G3 fax
• IP Address Fax, Internet Fax
Fax Driver Operations This manual describes details on the fax driver function that transmits faxes directly from a computer.
• PC-FAX
Network Administrator This manual describes details on setting methods for
each function using the network connection.
• Network settings
• Settings using PageScope Web Connectionbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 1-3
1.1 Welcome
1
1.1.2 User's Guide
This User's Guide is intended for a wide range of users ranging from those using this machine for the first
time to administrators.
It describes basic operations, functions that enable more convenient operations, maintenance procedures,
simple troubleshooting operations, and various setting methods of this machine.
Note that basic technical knowledge about the product is required to enable users to perform maintenance
work or troubleshooting operations. Limit your maintenance and troubleshooting operations to the areas
explained in this manual.
Should you experience any problems, please contact our service representative.
Advanced Function Operations This manual describes details on functions that become available by registering the optional license kit
and by connecting to an application.
• Web browser function
• Image Panel
• PDF Processing Function
• Searchable PDF
• My panel and My address function
Trademarks/Copyrights This manual describes details on trademarks and
copyrights.
• Trademarks and copyrights
User's guide CD manuals Overviewbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 1-4
1.2 Conventions used in this manual
1
1.2 Conventions used in this manual
1.2.1 Symbols used in this manual
Symbols are used in this manual to express various types of information.
The following describes each symbol related to correct and safe usage of this machine.
To use this machine safely
7 WARNING
- This symbol indicates that a failure to heed the instructions may lead to death or serious injury.
7 CAUTION
- This symbol indicates that negligence of the instructions may lead to mishandling that may cause injury
or property damage.
NOTICE
This symbol indicates a risk that may result in damage to this machine or originals.
Follow the instructions to avoid property damage.
Procedural instruction
0 This check mark indicates an option that is required in order to use conditions or functions that are
prerequisite for a procedure.
1 This format number "1" represents the first step.
2 This format number represents the order of serial steps.
% This symbol indicates a supplementary explanation of a
procedural instruction.
% This symbol indicates transition of the control panel to access a desired menu item.
This symbol indicates a desired page.
dReference
This symbol indicates a reference.
A procedural operation
is illustrated.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 1-5
1.2 Conventions used in this manual
1
View the reference as required.
Key symbols
[ ]
This symbol represents a key name on the control panel, touch panel or the computer screen, power switch,
etc.
1.2.2 Original and paper indications
Original and paper sizes
The following explains the indication for originals and paper described
in this manual.
When indicating the original or paper size, the Y side represents the
width and the X side the length.
Original and paper indications
w indicates the paper size with the length (X) being longer than the
width (Y).
v indicates the paper size with the length (X) being shorter than the
width (Y).2 Part names and their
functionsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-2
2.1 Options
2
2 Part names and their functions
2.1 Options
2.1.1 bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS
No. Name Description
1 Main unit The original is scanned by the scanner section, and the
scanned image is printed by the printer section.
Referred to as the "machine", the "main unit", or the
"C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS" throughout the manual.
2 Authentication unit (biometric type)
AU-101
Performs user authentication by scanning vein patterns in the finger.
Working table WT-506 is required to install the authentication unit.
3 Authentication unit (biometric type)
AU-102
4 Authentication unit (IC card type)
AU-201
Performs user authentication by scanning information
recorded on the IC card.
Working table WT-506 is required to install the authentication unit.
5 Working table WT-506 Provides an area to temporarily place an original or
other materials. This is also used when the authentication unit is installed.
5
6
2 3
1
4
10
8
9
7
15
16
18 19 20
17
12
11
13 14bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-3
2.1 Options
2
6 Keyboard holder KH-101 Mount this kit to use a compact keyboard.
For details on compact keyboards, contact your service representative.
7 Output Tray OT-503 Collects printed pages.
8 Mount kit MK-715 Used for banner printing.
• This option may not be available depending on the
sales area.
9 Image controller IC-412 v1.1 Allows you to use this machine as a network-enabled
color printer.
10 Large capacity unit LU-301 Can be loaded with up to 3,000 sheets of 8-1/2 e 11-
size (A4 -size) paper.
Referred to as the LCT throughout the manual.
11 Large capacity unit LU-204 Can be loaded with up to 2,500 sheets of 12 e 18-size
(A3-size) paper.
To change the paper size, contact your service representative.
Referred to as the LCT throughout the manual.
12 Saddle Stitcher SD-509 Install this unit onto the Finisher to allow Fold/Bind.
This unit is hereinafter referred to as the Saddle Stitcher through the manual.
13 Finisher FS-527 Sorts, groups and staples printed paper before feeding
out.
14 Punch Kit PK-517 Install this unit onto the Finisher to allow punching
holes.
15 Job Separator JS-603 Install this unit onto the Finisher.
Collects printed pages.
16 Z Folding Unit ZU-606 Installed onto the finisher to allow Z folding or punching.
17 Saddle stitcher SD-508 Installed onto the finisher to allow Fold/Bind.
Referred to as the saddle stitcher throughout the manual.
18 Finisher FS-526 Sorts, groups and staples printed paper before feeding
out.
19 Punch kit PK-516 Installed onto the finisher to punch holes.
20 Post Inserter PI-505 Installed onto the finisher to enable insertion of a cover
sheet into copied sheets. This unit also allows you to
manually operate the finisher (only the lower tray is
available).
21 Job Separator JS-602 Install this unit onto the Finisher.
Collects printed pages.
No illustration is provided as the options are built into the main body.
22 Fax kit FK-502 Allows this machine to function as a fax machine. Alternatively, it allows more telephone lines to be connected.
23 Stamp unit SP-501 Applies a stamp to originals that have been scanned.
24 Spare TX Maker stamp 2 A replacement stamp for the stamp unit.
25 Mount kit MK-720 Attach this kit to install an optional fax kit.
26 Local interface kit EK-604 Install this kit when using the compact keyboard. This
kit contains a speaker.
For details on compact keyboards, contact your service representative.
27 Local Interface Kit EK-605 Install this kit when using the connection function with
a Bluetooth-compatible cellular phone or PDA. This kit
contains a speaker and a receiving device for Bluetooth communication.
For details on compact keyboards, contact your service representative.
No. Name Descriptionbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-4
2.1 Options
2
28 Video interface kit VI-505 Required for installing the image controller onto this
machine.
29 Security Kit SC-507 Allows you to use Copy Guard or Password Copy.
This kit is used to prevent unauthorized copying.
30 i-Option LK-101 v2 Enables a Web browser and the Image Panel function
to be used on the control panel.
31 i-Option LK-102 Enables PDF document encryption with a digital ID, attachment of a digital signature, and property settings
when distributing a PDF document using the scan or
User Box function.
32 i-Option LK-103 v2 Provides both i-Option LK-101 v2 and LK-102 functions.
• This option may not be available depending on the
sales area.
33 i-Option LK-105 Provides the searchable PDF function.
34 Upgrade kit UK-203 Required when using Web browser, image panel, PDF
processing, searchable PDF, My panel, or My address
function. If necessary, you can increase up to nine languages, which can be displayed in the control panel of
this machine.
No. Name Descriptionbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-5
2.1 Options
2
2.1.2 bizhub C452
No. Name Description
1 Main unit The original is scanned by the scanner section, and the
scanned image is printed by the printer section.
Referred to as the "machine", the "main unit", or the
"C452" throughout the manual.
2 Authentication unit (biometric type)
AU-101
Performs user authentication by scanning vein patterns
in the finger.
Working table WT-506 is required to install the authentication unit.
3 Authentication unit (biometric type)
AU-102
4 Authentication unit (IC card type)
AU-201
Performs user authentication by scanning information recorded on the IC card.
Working table WT-506 is required to install the authentication unit.
5 Working table WT-506 Provides an area to temporarily place an original or other
materials. This is also used when the authentication unit
is installed.
6 Keyboard holder KH-101 Mount this kit to use a compact keyboard.
For details on compact keyboards, contact your service
representative.
7 Output Tray OT-503 Collects printed pages.
8 Mount kit MK-715 Used for banner printing.
• This option may not be available depending on the
sales area.
9 Image controller IC-412 v1.1 Allows you to use this machine as a network-enabled
color printer.
10 Large capacity unit LU-301 Can be loaded with up to 3,000 sheets of 8-1/2 e 11-size
(A4 -size) paper.
Referred to as the LCT throughout the manual.
2 3
1
4
16
11
9
10
8
13
12
14 15
5
6
7bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-6
2.1 Options
2
11 Large capacity unit LU-204 Can be loaded with up to 2,500 sheets of 12 e 18-size
(A3-size) paper.
To change the paper size, contact your service representative.
Referred to as the LCT throughout the manual.
12 Saddle Stitcher SD-509 Install this unit onto the Finisher to allow Fold/Bind.
This unit is hereinafter referred to as the Saddle Stitcher
through the manual.
13 Finisher FS-527 Sorts, groups and staples printed paper before feeding
out.
14 Punch Kit PK-517 Install this unit onto the Finisher to allow punching holes.
15 Job Separator JS-603 Install this unit onto the Finisher.
Collects printed pages.
16 Job Separator JS-504 Install this unit onto the Output Tray of the main unit to
offset the printed papers. This unit is hereinafter referred
to as the Job Separator through the manual.
No illustration is provided as the options are built into the main body.
17 Fax kit FK-502 Allows this machine to function as a fax machine. Alternatively, it allows more telephone lines to be connected.
18 Stamp unit SP-501 Applies a stamp to originals that have been scanned.
19 Spare TX Maker stamp 2 A replacement stamp for the stamp unit.
20 Mount kit MK-720 Attach this kit to install an optional fax kit.
21 Local interface kit EK-604 Install this kit when using the compact keyboard. This kit
contains a speaker.
For details on compact keyboards, contact your service
representative.
22 Local Interface Kit EK-605 Install this kit when using the connection function with a
Bluetooth-compatible cellular phone or PDA. This kit
contains a speaker and a receiving device for Bluetooth
communication.
For details on compact keyboards, contact your service
representative.
23 Video interface kit VI-505 Required for installing the image controller onto this machine.
24 Security Kit SC-507 Allows you to use Copy Guard or Password Copy.
This kit is used to prevent unauthorized copying.
25 i-Option LK-101 v2 Enables a Web browser and the Image Panel function to
be used on the control panel.
26 i-Option LK-102 Enables PDF document encryption with a digital ID, attachment of a digital signature, and property settings
when distributing a PDF document using the scan or
User Box function.
27 i-Option LK-103 v2 Provides both i-Option LK-101 v2 and LK-102 functions.
• This option may not be available depending on the
sales area.
28 i-Option LK-105 Provides the searchable PDF function.
29 Upgrade kit UK-203 Required when using Web browser, image panel, PDF
processing, searchable PDF, My panel, or My address
function. If necessary, you can increase up to nine languages, which can be displayed in the control panel of
this machine.
30 Heater HT-508 Install this unit into the tray to dehumidify the paper. Dehumidifying prevents paper in the tray from absorbing
moisture.
• This option may not be available depending on the
sales area.
No. Name Descriptionbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-7
2.2 Main Body
2
2.2 Main Body
2.2.1 Outside of the main body (front)
No. Name
1 Control panel
2 Left-side cover release lever
3 Left-side cover
4 Lateral guide
5 ADF
6 Original tray
7 Original output tray
8 Sub power switch
9 USB port (type A) USB 2.0/1.1
10 USB port (type A) USB 2.0/1.1 (For compact keyboard)
11 Automatic duplex unit release lever
12 Automatic duplex unit
5
9
10
16
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
1 4 6
7
8
11
14
13
12
15
17
18
19
22 20 21
30
2
3bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-8
2.2 Main Body
2
13 Upper right-side door
14 Upper right-side door release lever
15 Bypass tray door
16 Bypass Tray
17 Bypass tray door release lever
18 Lower right-side door
19 Lower right-side door release lever
20 Paper-empty indicator
21 Total counter
22 Main power switch
23 Tray 4
24 Tray 3
25 Tray 2
26 Tray 1
27 Lower front door
28 Upper front door
29 Output tray
30 Status indicator
No. Namebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-9
2.2 Main Body
2
2.2.2 Outside of the main body (rear)
The illustration above shows the main unit with an optional video interface kit, fax kit, and mount kit.
No. Name
1 Finisher connector
2 Filter
3 Power cord
4 Power switch for dehumidifying heater
5 Jack for connecting a telephone (TEL PORT2)
6 Telephone jack 2 (LINE PORT2)
1
2
13
10
11
12
9
8
4 3
7
5
6bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-10
2.2 Main Body
2
7 Jack for connecting a telephone (TEL PORT1)
8 Telephone jack 1 (LINE PORT1)
9 USB port (type A) USB 2.0/1.1
10 RS-232C port
11 USB port (type B) USB 2.0/1.1
12 Network connector (10Base-T/100Base-TX/1000Base-T)
13 Ozone filter
No. Namebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-11
2.2 Main Body
2
2.2.3 Main bodyInside
bizhub C652/C552/C452
No. Name
1 Original glass
2 Fusing unit
3 Fusing unit cover lever
4 Print head glass cleaning tool
1
8
2
3
4
5
9
7
10
11
12 13
6bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-12
2.2 Main Body
2
5 Waste toner box
6 Imaging unit
7 Charger-cleaning tool
8 Imaging unit release lever
9 Toner cartridges
10 Slit glass
11 Original scales
12 Jam removal dial
13 Slit glass cleaner
No. Namebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-13
2.2 Main Body
2
bizhub C652DS/C552DS
No. Name
1 Original glass
2 Fusing unit
3 Fusing unit cover lever
4 Print head glass cleaning tool
1
8
2
3
4
5
9
7
10
11
12 13
14
6bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-14
2.2 Main Body
2
2.2.4 Control panel
5 Waste toner box
6 Imaging unit
7 Charger-cleaning tool
8 Imaging unit release lever
9 Toner cartridges
10 Slit glass (front)
11 Original scales
12 Opening and closing guide
13 Slit glass cleaner
14 Slit glass (back)
No. Name
No. Name
1 Stylus pen
2 Touch panel
3 Main power indicator
4 Sub power switch
5 Function key
6 Data indicator
1 2
3
5
4
8
7 6bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-15
2.2 Main Body
2
Adjusting the angle of the control panel
You can adjust the angle of the control panel of this machine among three levels. You can also tilt the control
panel to the left. Use the control panel at an angle convenient to use.
NOTICE
When tilting the control panel, do not grab the touch panel.
1 Pull the control panel release lever toward you, and then pull the
control panel up or down.
You can tilt the angle of the control panel to one of the three
positions.
2 To tilt the control panel to the left or right, hold the bottom of the
control panel, and then tilt the panel to the left or right.
7 Keypad
8 Brightness adjustment dial
No. Namebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-16
2.2 Main Body
2
2.2.5 Touch panel
When the machine has been turned on and is ready to begin the copy operation, the basic settings screen
appears. To activate a function or to select a setting, lightly press the desired button appearing in the screen.
The basic settings screen can be switched between the Basic tab and Quick Copy tab. The arrangement of
the buttons and screens differ with the Basic tab and Quick Copy tab; however, the functions that can be set
are the same. This manual describes procedures for configuring settings from the Basic tab. The Quick Copy
tab displays the setting items of the Basic tab on one screen, which is useful for configuring multiple settings.
NOTICE
Do not apply excessive pressure on the touch panel. Such impact may leave a flaw on the panel, inviting
damage to the touch panel. When operating in the touch panel, never press down on the touch panel with
force or with a pointed object such as a mechanical pencil.
Basic tab
Quick Copy tab
No. Name
1 Message display area
2 Functions/settings display area
3 Icon/shortcut key display area
4 Toner supply indicators
5 Left panel
6 Check Job
7 Job List
8 Copier setting button (arrow)
3
2
5
7
6
4
1
3
2
5
7
8
4
1
9bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-17
2.2 Main Body
2
dReference
To switch the basic settings screen:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Custom Display Settings] ö [Copier Settings] ö [Default
Tab].
To configure color selection settings for buttons and tabs:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Custom Display Settings] ö [Color Selection Settings] .
9 Color settings
No. Namebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-18
2.3 Option
2
2.3 Option
2.3.1 Finisher FS-526/Saddle stitcher SD-508/Punch kit PK-516
No. Name
1 Output tray 2
2 Output tray 1
3 Front door
1
26
20
19
18
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10
21
22
23
11
12
13
14
16
15
17
25 24bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-19
2.3 Option
2
* Press the output tray switch to move folded and center stapled paper to the end of the folding output tray.
4 Horizontal transport unit cover
5 Jam removal dial [FN8]
6 Guide lever [FN7]
7 Guide lever [FN9]
8 Jam removal dial [FN6]
9 Jam removal dial [FN5]
10 Guide lever [FN3]
11 Guide lever [FN4]
12 Punch kit
13 Punch scrap box
14 Guide lever [FN10]
15 Recessed pull
16 Jam removal dial [FN11]
17 Saddle stitcher
18 Output belt
19 Output tray switch
*
20 Folding output tray
21 Jam removal dial [FN2]
22 Guide lever [FN1]
23 Staple replacement door
24 Guide lever [FN13]
25 Guide lever [FN14]
26 Exit cover
No. Namebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-20
2.3 Option
2
2.3.2 Job separator JS-602
No. Name
1 Finishing tray
2 Job separator cover
1 2bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-21
2.3 Option
2
2.3.3 Z Folding Unit ZU-606
No. Name
1 Z folding/conveyance unit
2 Guide lever [FN1]
3 Punch scrap box
4 Front door
5 Guide lever [FN6]
6 Guide lever [FN7]
7 Guide lever [FN8]
8 Recessed pull [FN2]
9 Jam removal dial [FN5]
1
2
4 3
5 8 9
7 11 10
6bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-22
2.3 Option
2
2.3.4 Post Inserter PI-505
10 Guide lever [FN3]
11 Jam removal dial [FN4]
No. Name
No. Name
1 Post inserter control panel
2 Lower tray paper guide
3 Lower Tray
4 Upper Tray
5 Upper Tray paper guide
6 Upper unit release lever
6
1
3
4
5
2bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-23
2.3 Option
2
2.3.5 Finisher FS-527/ Saddle Stitcher SD-509/ Punch Kit PK-517/ Job Separator
JS-603
1
2
3 4 5 6 7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-24
2.3 Option
2
No, Name
1 Output tray 2
2 Output tray 1
3 Front door
4 Horizontal transport unit cover
5 Stapler
6 Guide lever [FN3]
7 Jam removal dial [FN2]
8 Guide lever [FN1]
9 Guide lever [FN4]
10 Staple holder
11 Punch scrap box
12 Saddle stitcher
20
17
18
19
15 16bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-25
2.3 Option
2
2.3.6 Job Separator JS-504
13 Jam removal dial [FN6]
14 Recessed pull [FN5]
15 Transport unit
16 Punch kit
17 Job separator
18 Staple cartridge
19 Recessed pull [FN7]
20 Folding output tray
No, Name
No. Name
1 Jam removal dial
2 Eject assist lever
3 Output tray 2
4 Tray extension
5 Output tray 1
1
2
3
4
5bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 2-26
2.3 Option
2
2.3.7 Large capacity unit LU-301/LU-204
No. Name
1 Jam removal cover
2 Upper door
3 Paper take-up roller
4 Paper-empty indicator
5 Release lever
1 3
2
5
4
1
3
2
5
43 Using this machinebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 3-2
3.1 Turning on or off the machine
3
3 Using this machine
3.1 Turning on or off the machine
This machine has two power controls: the [main power switch] and [sub power switch].
The [main power switch] turns on or off all functions of the machine. Normally, keep the [main power switch]
on.
The [sub power switch] turns on and off machine operations, for example, for copying, printing or scanning.
Turning [sub power switch] off causes the machine to enter power-saving mode.
0 When the [sub power switch] is turned on, the indicator on the [Start] key lights up in orange, and a
screen appears to indicate that the machine is starting up. After a few seconds, the message "Warming
up. Ready to scan." appears in the touch panel, and the indicator on the [Start] key lights up in blue,
indicating that a job can now be queued.
0 A job can also be queued while the machine is warming up after the [sub power switch] is turned on.
After the machine has finished warming up, the scanned image will be printed.
0 The default settings are the settings that are selected immediately after the machine is turned on and
before any settings are configured from the control panel or touch panel, and those that are selected
when the [Reset] key is pressed to cancel all settings configured from the control panel or touch panel.
The default settings can be changed.
0 Do not turn off the [main power switch] while a queued job or stored data is waiting to be printed. The
jobs yet to be printed will be deleted.
0 Settings that have not been registered and jobs in the printing queue are cleared when the [main power
switch] and [sub power switch] are turned off.
0 To turn the [main power switch] on immediately after turning it off, wait for 10 or more seconds before
turning it on again. Not doing so may result in an operation failure.
0 Do not turn off the [main power switch] or [sub power switch] while images are being scanned,
transmitted, or received. Data being scanned or communicated will be deleted.
0 Do not turn off the [main power switch] or [sub power switch] during the copying or printing process. If
you turn it off, a paper jam may occur.
0 Do not connect or disconnect the USB cable of the compact keyboard while this machine is turned on.
Do not also connect another medium to the USB port for the compact keyboard.
1 To turn the power on, open the main power switch cover, and then
press n on the [main power switch].
2 Close the main power switch cover.
3 Press the [sub power switch].
Check that the touch panel is turned on.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 3-3
3.1 Turning on or off the machine
3
4 To turn the power off, press the [sub power switch], then the [main power switch].
dReference
To change the default settings for Copy:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Copier Settings] ö [Default Copy Settings].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 3-4
3.2 Basic copy operations
3
3.2 Basic copy operations
The following procedures describe how to set the original and the basic copy operations.
3.2.1 Placing originals
Place the original in the ADF or on the original glass. Select the optimal position for setting the original
according to the type of the original to be copied.
- Using the ADF, a multi-page original can be fed and scanned automatically, one page at a time from
the top. The ADF can also be used to automatically scan 2-sided originals.
- When using the original glass, place the original directly on the original glass for scanning. This method
is suited for originals in the form of a book and the like that cannot be fed through the ADF.
Load the original, and configure settings for relevant functions as needed.
Loading the original into the ADF
The following types of originals should not be loaded into the ADF. If loaded, paper may be jammed or the
original may be damaged.
- Wrinkled, folded, curled, or torn originals
- Highly translucent or transparent originals , such as OHP transparencies or diazo photosensitive paper
- Coated originals such as carbon-backed paper
- Originals printed on paper thicker than 55-7/8 lb (210 g/m2
)
- Originals printed on paper thicker than 34-1/16 lb (128 g/m2
) for 2-sided printing
- Originals that are bound, for example, with staples or paper clips
- Originals that are bound in a book or booklet form
- Originals with pages bound together with glue
- Originals with pages that have had cutouts removed or are cutouts
- Label sheets
- Offset printing masters
- Originals with binder holes
- Originals that have just been printed with this machine
1 Slide the lateral guides to fit the size of the original.
2 Load the original face up in the original tray and arrange according
to the scanning order. Load the original pages so that the top of
the original is toward the back side of the machine.
% Do not load more than 100 sheets or up to the point where the
top of the stack is higher than the , mark. Such an action may
cause an original paper jam or damage to the original. It may
also invite machine failure. However, an original that exceeds
100 pages can be scanned in separate batches.
% If the original is not loaded correctly, it may not be fed in
straight, causing it to jam or become damaged.
% If the document is loaded in any orientation other than with the
top of the document toward the back of the machine, be sure
to select the document orientation.
3 Slide the adjustable lateral guides against the edges of the original.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 3-5
3.2 Basic copy operations
3
Placing the original on the original glass
0 When placing the original on the original glass, be sure to lift open the ADF at least 15°. If the original
is placed on the original glass without the ADF being lifted at least 15°, the correct document size may
not be detected.
0 Do not place an original weighing more than 4-7/16 lb (2 kg) on the original glass. Furthermore, do not
use a strong force to press down on a book or any other form of original that must be spread on the
original glass. Otherwise, the machine may be damaged or a failure may occur.
0 For thick books or large objects, perform scanning without closing the ADF. When a document is being
scanned with the ADF open, do not look directly at the original glass surface where light may be emitted
through. Note, however, that the light coming through the original glass is not a laser beam, and will not
expose the user to the related hazards.
0 When Non-Image Area Erase is selected, you do not have to close the ADF to copy the original. Place
the original anywhere on the original glass. The area surrounding the original text will be excluded from
the copy. For details, refer to page 5-42.
1 Lift open the ADF.
2 Place the original face down on the original glass.
% Load the original by placing it so that its top side faces the
back side of the machine.
3 Align the original with the mark in the back-left corner of the
original scales.
% For transparent or translucent originals, place a blank sheet of
paper of the same size as the original over the original.
% For bound originals spread over two facing pages, such as a
book or a magazine, position the top of the original toward the back of this machine and align the
original with the mark in the back-left corner of the original scales.
% When Non-Image Area Erase is selected, the original can be placed anywhere on the original glass.
4 Close the ADF.
3.2.2 Basic copy operations
The following procedure describes the basic copy operations.
1 Arrange originals in the order you want them to be scanned and
load them face up in the ADF.
% The original should be placed face down on the original glass.
2 Using the keypad, enter a value for the number of copies you desire.
% If you have entered incorrect number of copies, press the [C] (clear) key on the keypad, and then reenter the correct number.
3 Press the [Start] key.
The original is scanned and copied.
% To interrupt the copy operation being performed, press the [Stop] key.
% A "Ready to accept another job" message that appears during the current printing job indicates that
the next original can be scanned.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 3-6
3.2 Basic copy operations
3
% If an original with copy guard patterns embedded is scanned, the copy operation is stopped and
the job is discarded.
% If an original with a password embedded by the password copy function is scanned, the copy
operation starts after you enter the password.
% If multiple originals with different passwords are scanned at the same time, you will need to enter a
password for each original.
3.2.3 Copy operations using multiple functions
This section describes copy operations using combination of functions.
1 Load the original.
2 Press [Original Setting].
% For details on original setting, refer to page 5-15.
3 Press [Basic] ö [Duplex/Combine].
% For details on the Duplex/Combine settings, refer to page 5-8.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 3-7
3.2 Basic copy operations
3
4 Press [Basic] and then configure settings for respective functions.
% For details on color setting, refer to page 5-4.
% For details on paper size setting, refer to page 5-5.
% For details on magnification setting, refer to page 5-7.
% For details on image quality of originals, refer to page 5-18.
% For details on copy density setting, refer to page 5-18.
% For details on the setting not to rotate images, refer to page 5-14.
5 Press [Application] and then configure settings for respective functions.
% For setting for the application functions, refer to page 5-20.
6 Press [Basic] ö [Finishing].
% For details on copy finishing and folding/binding, refer to page 5-10.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 3-8
3.2 Basic copy operations
3
7 Press [Check Job] ö [Check Details].
% For details on checking job settings, refer to page 5-64.
8 Using the keypad, enter a value for the number of copies you desire.
% If you have entered incorrect number of copies, press the [C] (clear) key on the keypad, and then reenter the correct number.
9 Press the [Start] key.
The original is scanned and copied.
% To interrupt the copy operation being performed, press the [Stop] key.
% A "Ready to accept another job" message that appears during the current printing job indicates that
the next original can be scanned.
Functions that cannot be combined
Some settings cannot be combined with each other. If they are combined improperly, the settings will be
given priorities in either of the two ways described below.
- The setting configured last is given priority. (The setting specified first is canceled.)
- The setting configured first is given priority. (A warning message appears.)4 Control Panel Keysbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-2
4
4 Control Panel Keys
This section describes the functions of the keys on the operation panel.
Control panel and functions
Press the keys on the operation panel to use the Copy, Fax/Scan, User Box or other functions.
No. Name Description Page
1 Touch panel Displays various screens and messages. You can
configure various settings by directly touching the
touch panel.
-
2 Power indicator Lights up in blue when the machine is turned on with
the [main power switch].
-
3 [Sub power switch] Turns on or off machine operations. When turned off,
the machine is in the power-saving mode.
-
4 [Power Save] Enters Power Save mode. While the machine is in
Power Save mode, the indicator on the [Power Save]
key lights up in green and the touch panel goes off.
To exit from Power Save mode, press the [Power
Save] key again.
p. 4-11
5 [Mode Memory] Allows you to register (store) the desired
copy/fax/scan settings as a program or to recall a
registered program.
p. 4-7
6 [Utility/Counter] Switches to the Utility screen or the Meter Count
screen.
p. 4-6
7 [Reset] Resets all settings (except programmed settings)
entered using the control panel or touch panel.
p. 4-4
1
2
5
4
6
3
7
8
9
1413 10
15
16
17
18
12 11
19
20
21
22bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-3
4
8 [Interrupt] Switches to Interrupt mode. While the machine is in
Interrupt mode, the indicator on the [Interrupt] key
lights up in green and the message "Now in Interrupt
mode" appears in the touch panel. To cancel Interrupt mode, press the [Interrupt] key again.
p. 4-4
9 [Stop] Temporarily stops the operation while copying,
scanning or printing.
p. 4-4
10 [Proof Copy] Allows you to print a single proof copy to be checked
before printing a large number of copies. You can
also display a finishing image using the current settings in the touch panel.
p. 4-18
11 [Start] Starts the copy, scan or fax operation. p. 4-4
12 Data indicator Flashes in blue while a print job is being received.
Lights up in blue when a print job is queued to be
printed or while it is being printed. Lights up in blue
when there is saved fax data or unprinted fax data.
-
13 [C] (Clear) Clears a value (such as the number of copies, a
zoom ratio and size) entered using the keypad.
p. 4-17
14 Keypad Allows you to enter the number of copies to be produced, the zoom ratio, and various other setting values.
-
15 [Guidance] Switches to the Guidance screen. You can display
descriptions of the functions and operating procedures.
p. 4-15
16 [Enlarge Display] Enters Enlarge Display mode. If you are using PageScope Authentication Manager for authentication,
the Enlarge Display screen will not be available.
p. 4-14
17 [Accessibility] Switches to the screen for configuring settings for
user accessibility functions.
p. 4-12
18 [Access] If user authentication or account track settings have
been applied, press the [Access] key after entering
the user name and password (for user authentication) or the account name and password (for account track) in order to use this machine.
p. 4-8
19 [Brightness] dial Allows you to adjust the brightness of the touch panel.
-
20 [User Box] Enters User Box mode. While the machine is in User
Box mode, the indicator on the [User Box] key lights
up in green.
For details on User Box functions, refer to the "User's Guide [Box Operations]".
p. 4-5
21 [Fax/Scan] Enters Fax/Scan mode. While the machine is in
Fax/Scan mode, the indicator on the [Fax/Scan] key
lights up in green.
For details on the fax/scan function, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
p. 4-5
22 [Copy] Enters Copy mode. (As a default, the machine is in
Copy mode. ) While the machine is copying, the indicator on the [Copy] key lights up in green.
p. 4-5
No. Name Description Pagebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-4
4.1 About the [Start] key, the [Stop] key, and the [Interrupt] key
4
4.1 About the [Start] key, the [Stop] key, and the [Interrupt] key
The [Start] key
% Start the copy, scan or fax operation.
Press this key again to restart a suspended job.
% When this machine is ready to begin the operation, the indicator on the [Start] key lights up in blue.
If the indicator on the [Start] key lights up in orange, the copy operation cannot begin. (Check that
no warning or message is displayed in the touch panel.)
The [Stop] key
% Press the [Stop] key while copying to temporarily stop the scanning or printing operation.
% To resume a temporarily stopped job, press the [Start] key.
% To delete a temporarily stopped job, select a job in the suspended job list in the screen, and press
the [Delete] key.
The [Interrupt] key
Press this key to start a new copy job with different copy settings by suspending the current job in process.
This is convenient when you need to make copies urgently.
0 The [Interrupt] key cannot be operated while an original is being scanned.
0 Pressing the [Interrupt] key restores the default settings.
1 Load the original.
2 Press the [Interrupt] key.
The indicator on the Interrupt key lights up in green and printing of the current job is suspended.
3 Configure the copy settings.
4 Press the [Start] key.
5 After the interrupting job has finished printing, press the [Interrupt] key.
The Interrupt indicator goes off and the interrupting copy settings are canceled.
The copy settings return to those specified before the interrupting copying job.
The [Reset] key
Resets all settings (except programmed settings) entered using the control panel or touch panel.
% Press the [Reset] key.
The basic settings screen appears.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-5
4.2 About the [Copy] key, the [Fax/Scan] key, and the [User Box] key
4
4.2 About the [Copy] key, the [Fax/Scan] key, and the [User Box] key
This machine operates in Copy, Fax/Scan and User Box modes, from which the user can select a desired
function. The indicator on the selected key lights up in green.
The [Copy] key
% Enters Copy mode.
The basic settings screen appears.
The [Fax/Scan] key
% Press this key to enter Fax/Scan mode.
For details on the fax/scan function, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax
Operations]".
The [User Box] key
% Enters User Box mode.
For details on User Box functions, refer to the "User's Guide [Box Operations]".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-6
4.3 The [Utility/Counter] key
4
4.3 The [Utility/Counter] key
Press the [Utility/Counter] key to display the Utility screen. You can configure the machine settings and check
its use status in the Utility menu screen.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
Settings
One-Touch/User Box Registration
Allows you to register items related to the fax/scanner and User Boxes operations.
For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]" and "User's Guide [Box Operations]".
User Settings Provides setting items that can be operated by the user.
Administrator Settings Provides setting items that can only be operated by the administrator of the
machine.
Check Consumable Life Allows you to check the status (usage level) of consumables.
Banner Printing Allows you to select whether to enable or disable printing on long sheets
of paper.
This menu item appears when the optional finisher is not installed.
For details on long paper print, refer to the "User's Guide [Print Operations]".
Device Information Displays information about this machine.
Function Version: Allows you to check the function version of the currently
installed firmware. Check the function version of this machine and of the
printer driver. Ensure that they match before using this machine.
IPv4 Address: Allows you to check the currently specified IPv4 address.
IPv6 Address: Allows you to check the currently specified IPv6 address.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-7
4.4 The [Mode Memory] key
4
4.4 The [Mode Memory] key
Combine frequently used copy settings into programs and register them with this machine. These programs
can easily be recalled as programs.
0 Up to 30 programs can be registered.
0 To register a program, configure the copy settings to be registered before pressing the [Mode Memory]
key.
% Press the [Mode Memory] key.
dReference
To prohibit modification and deletion of copy programs:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Restrict User Access] ö
[Copy Program Lock Settings].
To delete a copy program:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Restrict User Access] ö
[Delete Saved Copy Program].
Settings
Recall Copy Program Select the button for the copy program registered with the copy settings to
be recalled.
Register Program • From the copy program buttons displayed in the screen, press the button you want to register copy settings with, and then press [Register
Program].
• Enter the registration name, and then press [OK].
Check Program settings Press this button to check the copy settings registered with the selected
copy program button.
Edit Name Press this button to rename the registration name of the selected copy program button.
After enabling Copy Program Lock, [Edit Name] will not be displayed.
Delete Press this button to delete the selected program button.
After enabling Copy Program Lock, [Delete] will not be displayed.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-8
4.5 The [Access] key
4
4.5 The [Access] key
If the administrator has configured user authentication settings/account track settings, only the users who
have been registered or the users whose accounts have been registered can use this machine.
If the administrator has configured a usage schedule, a user can use the machine by entering a password for
non-business hours.
Controlling access to the machine by user/account (user
authentication/account track)
0 With the user authentication/account track functions enabled, only the users who enter passwords for
users or for accounts can use this machine.
0 Thus, the number of copies among others can be managed by user/account.
0 Contact the administrator for information on the user name, account name, password and server name.
0 The login page that appears may vary depending on the user authentication/account track settings.
0 The user authentication settings can be used together with the account track settings. If the User
Authentication/Account Track is set to [Do Not Synchronize], complete user authentication, and then
log in by using the Account Track screen.
0 If MFP authentication or external server authentication has been set, a total of 1,000 users and accounts
can be registered.
0 After copying is completed, press the [Access] key to log out from the machine.
0 To get permission to use the machine, you can use an authentication unit (biometrics type/IC card type)
for authentication.
0 The account, which sets the use of this machine to suspend in Account Track Settings, cannot log in
to this machine. The users, who belong to the suspended account, cannot also log in to this machine.
0 If authentication is performed with PageScope Authentication Manager, check with your server
administrator for information on the login procedure.
% Press the [Access] key.
Screen for user authentication
Screen for account trackbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-9
4.5 The [Access] key
4
dReference
To configure user authentication/account track:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track].
Settings
User Authentication Performs the user authentication procedure to use this machine.
Public User Access Allows users who have no access to the user
name or password to use this machine.
This item is not displayed when [Public User Access] is set to [Restrict] in the General Settings of
Administrator Settings.
If enhanced security mode has been enabled,
[Public User Access] is not displayed.
User Name Enter the user name.
User Name List Select a user name from a displayed list.
• If enhanced security mode has been enabled,
[User Name List] is not displayed.
• The user, who has set the use of this machine
to suspend in User Authentication Settings, is
not displayed in the [User Name List].
Password Enter the password.
Server Name Indicates the name of the default server. Press
[Server Name] to display the names of the registered servers. Select the desired server.
Login Displays the basic settings screen, enabling you
to use this machine.
Account Track Performs the account track procedure to use this machine.
Account Name Enter the account name.
Password Enter the password.
When the account track input method is set to
[Password Only] in Administrator Settings, the
login screen displays only [Password]. The user
can directly enter the password in the login
screen from the keypad. For an all-number password, the user can log in without displaying the
keyboard screen, simply by pressing [Login], or
the [Access] key.
• For a password containing alphabets, numbers and/or symbol characters, press [Password] and then enter the password.
• After entering numbers from the keypad,
press [Password] to enter alphabets and symbols in succession.
Login Displays the basic settings screen, enabling you
to use this machine.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-10
4.5 The [Access] key
4
Using the machine during non-scheduled hours
The machine can be set to automatically enter Sleep mode according to a usage schedule determined by the
administrator so the use of the machine can be limited. This is referred to as Weekly Timer. Follow the
procedure described below to use the machine while the Weekly Timer is being used.
0 From the [Password for Non-Business Hours] screen (displayed from Administrator Settings mode), the
machine can be set so that the screen for entering the password for non-business hours is not
displayed.
1 Press the [Power Save] key.
2 Enter the password for non-business hours.
3 Press [OK].
4 Using the keypad, enter the length of time to elapse before the machine enters Sleep mode again.
5 Press [OK].
The basic settings screen appears.
dReference
To configure Weekly Timer:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Weekly Timer Settings].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-11
4.6 The [Power Save] key
4
4.6 The [Power Save] key
If no operation is performed for a specified length of time, the touch panel goes off and the machine
automatically enters a mode where it conserves energy. This is referred to as Low Power or Sleep mode.
The following describes the procedure for returning from Low Power or Sleep mode.
0 Although the machine conserves more energy in Sleep mode than in Low Power mode, the warm-up
process for returning to ready-for-copy state from Sleep mode is more time-consuming.
0 As the factory default, Low Power mode is set to restart after 15 minutes and Sleep mode after 30
minutes. In other words, the machine enters Low Power mode if no operation is performed for 15
minutes. Likewise, it enters Sleep mode after 30 minutes has elapsed.
0 The machine can receive jobs even while it is in Low Power mode.
% Press the [Power Save] key.
The machine returns from Low Power mode when any other key on the control panel or the touch panel
surface is pressed.
dReference
To enable Low Power mode:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Power Save Settings].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-12
4.7 The [Accessibility] key
4
4.7 The [Accessibility] key
This section describes the procedures for configuring settings for the control panel and adjusting the touch
panel.
0 To return to the basic settings screen from the Accessibility Setting screen, press the [Accessibility] key,
the [Reset] key or [Close].
0 In the Enlarge Display screen, [Default Enlarge Display Settings] appears, enabling you to configure
default settings for use in the Enlarge Display mode using the copy or fax/scan functions.
% Press the [Accessibility] key.
Page 1/2
Page 2/2
Settings
Touch Panel Adjustment Adjust the position of touch panel buttons when they do not respond correctly because they may not be correctly aligned with the position of the
actual touch sensor.
• The touch sensors are not aligned in the touch panel if pressing [Touch
Panel Adjustment] does not activate any action. Press the [1] key on the
keypad.
• Press the four check point buttons ([+]) on the touch panel adjustment
screen while listening on a buzzer sound each time. When the checking
by pressing the check point buttons is completed successfully, the indicator on the [Start] key lights up in blue. Press the [Start] key.
• The check point buttons ([+]) can be pressed in any order.
• To perform adjustment again, press the [C] (Clear) key, and then press
the four check point buttons ([+]) again.
• To cancel the touch panel adjustment process, press the [Stop] or [Reset] key.
• If the touch panel cannot be adjusted, contact your service representative.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-13
4.7 The [Accessibility] key
4
Key Repeat Start/Interval
Time
Specify the length of time until the value begins to change after a touch
panel button is held down, and also specify the length of time for the value
to change to the next number.
The settings specified for Key Repeat Start/Interval Time are only applied
in Enlarge Display mode.
System Auto Reset Confirmation
Specify whether to display a message when the system auto reset operation is performed in Enlarge Display mode, allowing the user to choose either to continue operating without exiting Enlarge Display mode or to exit
Enlarge Display mode and return to the basic settings screen.
Also specify the duration of time for displaying the confirmation screen.
Auto Reset Confirmation Specify whether to display a message when the automatic panel reset operation is performed in Enlarge Display mode, allowing the user to choose
either to continue operating without resetting the current settings or to reset the settings.
Also specify the duration of time for displaying the confirmation screen.
Enlarge Display Mode
Confirmation
Specify whether to display a message when the [Enlarge Display] key is
pressed to change the display of the screen, requesting confirmation to
cancel the settings that cannot be specified in Enlarge Display mode.
Message Display Time Specify the duration of time for displaying warning messages, which appear, for example, when an incorrect operation is performed.
Sound Setting Configure the settings for sounding associated with key operations. The
following sound setting functions are available. To produce a sound, press
[Yes], and then select the volume from [Low], [Medium] and [High]. To not
produce a sound, press [No].
[Operation Confirmation Sound]
• [Input Confirmation Sound]: A sound produced when a key in the control panel or a button in the touch panel is pressed for an entry
• [Invalid Input Sound]: A sound produced for invalid button operation in
the control panel or the touch panel
• [Basic Sound]: A sound produced when the default value item is selected for an option subject to rotational switching
[Successful Completion Sound]
• [Completed Operation Sound]: A sound produced when the operation
has completed normally
• [Completed Transmission Sound]: A sound produced when a communications-related operation is completed normally
[Completed Preparation Sound]: A sound produced when a device is ready
[Caution Sound]
• [Simple Caution Sound (Level 1)]: A sound produced when the replacement time is nearing for supplies or a replaceable part and a message
appears in the touch panel
• [Simple Caution Sound (Level 2)]: A sound produced for a user error
• [Simple Caution Sound (Level 3)]: A sound produced when an error occurs that can be corrected by the user by referring to the message that
appears or the User's Guide
• [Severe Caution Sound]: A sound produced when an error occurs that
cannot be corrected by the user or requires action by a service representative
Default Enlarge Display
Settings
For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Enlarge Display Operations]".
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-14
4.8 The [Enlarge Display] key
4
4.8 The [Enlarge Display] key
Press this key to enter Enlarge Display mode and enable machine operation using a screen with a layout with
larger-size characters.
For details on the Enlarge Display screen, refer to the "User's Guide [Enlarge Display Operations]".
0 Press the [Enlarge Display] key to return to normal display.
0 If PageScope Authentication Manager is used for authentication, the login screen cannot be switched
to the enlarged display mode.
% Press the [Enlarge Display] key.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-15
4.9 The [Guidance] key
4
4.9 The [Guidance] key
Press this key to view and check descriptions of various functions and operating procedures. When the
[Guidance] key is pressed, the Guidance screen for the displayed screen appears.
0 From the Help main menu screen, you can find the target Guidance screen based on the function or
purpose.
0 Refer to the left panel of the Guidance screen to check the position of the displayed Guidance screen
in the menu structure.
0 Press [Close] in the Guidance screen to move up one level in the menu structure. Press [Exit] to exit
Guidance mode and return to the screen that was displayed before the [Guidance] key was pressed.
Press [To Menu] to display the Help main menu.
0 In the Main Menu and Guidance Menu screens, select items by pressing the button or by pressing the
key in the keypad.
0 The Guidance screens cannot be displayed when the following operations are being performed:
Scanning, printing a proof copy, preview of a finished copy, operating in Enlarge Display mode, or
operating in Accessibility mode
0 While the Guidance screen is displayed, the following keys on the operation panel are disabled:
[Start], [C], [Interrupt], [Proof Copy], [Access], [Mode Memory], and [Enlarge Display]
% Press the [Guidance] key.
Settings
Function Check descriptions by selecting a Guidance menu grouped by function
type and name.
Search by Operation Check descriptions by selecting a Guidance menu grouped by operation
type.
• With [Go to function] displayed, the function for the selected operation
can be set. However, when the fax/scan function is used, for example,
[Go to function] displayed on a Guidance screen for the copy function,
for example, cannot be selected as it is a different function from the one
in use.
• Select [Copy] and press [Scan special original]; instructions and animation guidance are displayed to enable the user to view the procedure
for placing an original. However, Start Guidance is not displayed in the
animation guidance for placing an original.
Function Map Check descriptions from a navigation destination of the current screen or
the menu structure it belongs to.
Other Functions Check descriptions by selecting a Guidance menu grouped by useful function.
Name and Function of
Parts
Check the description of the main unit and its options.
Service/Admin. Information
Check the name, extension number and E-mail address of the administrator.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-16
4.9 The [Guidance] key
4
Consumables Replace/
Processing Procedure
Check procedures for replacing the toner cartridge, imaging unit or waste
toner box, adding staples or discarding punch-hole scraps by viewing animations. Press the target button, and then press [Start Guidance].
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-17
4.10 The [C] (Clear) key
4
4.10 The [C] (Clear) key
Clears a value (such as the number of copies, a zoom ratio and size) entered using the keypad.
% Press the [C] key.
The value is deleted. Enter the correct value.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-18
4.11 The [Proof Copy] key
4
4.11 The [Proof Copy] key
Printing one set to check the copy result (Proof Copy)
Print a single proof copy for checking before printing a large number of copies. This prevents copy errors
from occurring.
0 When printing a proof copy, specify multiple copies.
1 Load the original.
2 Select the desired copy settings.
3 Press the [Proof Copy] key.
4 Press [Print] and then select the original direction.
5 Press the [Start] key.
This prints one copy when the original has been loaded in the ADF.
6 When it has been loaded on the original glass, press the [Finish], then the [Start] key.
A single proof copy is printed.
7 Check the proof copy.
% If the proof copy is found all right, go to Step 10.
To change the copy settings, go to Step 8.
8 Press [Change Setting] in the proof copy screen.
After changing the copy settings in the Change Settings screen, press [OK]
% "Number of Sets" in the proof copy screen indicates "the number of sets printed in the proof copy
mode/the number of sets specified to be printed", and "Total # of Pages Printed" indicates "the
number of sheets printed in the proof copy mode/the total number of sheets to be printed".
% To stop copying while the screen for changing the settings is displayed, select the proof copy job
to be stopped from the list of jobs in the left panel, and then press [Delete].
% If no operation is performed for the specified length of time while this screen is displayed, the copy
job for which proof copy has been completed is registered as a stored job and the basic settings
screen appears again.
Stored job registration is performed when the System Auto Reset function is activated or one minute
after (if System Auto Reset is set to "OFF").
9 Press the [Proof Copy] key to repeat proof copy.
10 Press [Print].
The number of copies yet to be printed is registered as a copy job.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-19
4.11 The [Proof Copy] key
4
Using a preview image to check the copy result (Advanced Preview)
Check the finishing image of a copy in the touch panel before printing. This prevents copy errors from
occurring.
0 When you scan the original using the Program Jobs function, scan all originals, press [Finish], and then
preview the finishing state.
0 When you attempt to scan the original with an insert page specified, the machine scans the original first,
and then the insert original. When this process is complete, you can preview the finishing state.
0 To use the Book Copy or Booklet function, no preview is available. Check the finishing state after
printing.
0 The Punch settings are available only if the Punch Kit PK-516 or Z Folding Unit is installed on the
Finisher FS-526 or the Punch Kit PK-517 is installed on the Finisher FS-527.
0 Fold and Center Staple & Fold is available only if the Saddle Stitcher is installed on the optional Finisher.
0 The Z-fold settings are available only if the Z Folding Unit is installed on the optional Finisher FS-526.
1 Load the original.
2 Select the desired copy settings.
3 Press the [Proof Copy] key.
4 Press [Preview on Screen] for the proof copy method and then select the original direction.
5 Press the [Start] key.
The Preview (View Status) screen appears.
6 Check the preview image.
% To change the settings, press [View Pages]. Go to Step 7.
% To start printing, press the [Start] key.
% To scan another original, press [Finish], load the original, and then press the [Start] key.
7 Change the settings, and then press [View Status].
Settings
Prev. Page/
Next Page
Switch from the current screen to either the previous or the next screen.
Zoom Enlarge the preview image and check the details. Press [+] and [-] to
change the zoom ratio from full size to 2, 4 or 8 times the normal size. To
select a different area to be enlarged, touch the scroll bar arrows on the
right and at the bottom side of the image.
The finishing state cannot be displayed if you change the display size.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 4-20
4.11 The [Proof Copy] key
4
8 Press the [Start] key.
Select this menu to start printing.
Rotate Image Rotate the preview image 180 degrees in order to correct the orientation of
the original if necessary.
Pressing rotates the currently displayed page.
Pressing [Rotate Pages] displays the Scanned Page List. Select the page
to be rotated. Up to six scanned pages can be displayed. Press [ ] or [ ]
to change the selection.
View Finishing View the finishing settings using icons or in text on the preview screen, and
check the finishing state.
Change Setting Change the settings for the next original to be scanned.
View Pages/View Status Switch between the View Status and View Pages tab in the Preview screen.
Perform image rotation and setting changes on [View Pages] and stop
scanning on [View Status].
Settings5 Copy Functionbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-2
5
5 Copy Function
You can configure the settings for multiple copy features by pressing buttons on the operation or touch panel.
This chapter describes the functions that can be configured by pressing the buttons in the touch panel.
Item
Basic Configure the basic settings for making copies. p. 5-3
Original Setting Configure the type and size of the original. p. 5-15
Quality/Density Configure the quality or density for the original to optimize copy
quality.
p. 5-18
Application Configure the application settings for making copies. p. 5-20
Left panel Job List Check jobs currently being performed
and jobs waiting to be performed.
p. 5-62
Check Job Check the current settings and the result
of the settings.
p. 5-64bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-3
5.1 Basic
5
5.1 Basic
Configure the basic settings for making copies.
Item
Color Specify the print color for making copies. p. 5-4
Paper Select the paper type to be printed on and paper tray. p. 5-5
Zoom Select the zoom ratio of the image to be copied. p. 5-7
Duplex/Combine Configure the 2-sided copy and combined copy settings. p. 5-8
Finishing program
button
Configure frequently used offset and finishing settings in advance.
You can activate preferred finishing functions by simply pressing
this button.
p. 6-8
Finishing Press this button to select the settings for offsetting and finishing
copies.
p. 5-10
Separate Scan Select this item to divide a large original and scan it in a number of
batches.
p. 5-13
Auto Rotate OFF Select this item to copy the original according to the paper orientation without rotating the image.
p. 5-14
Language Selection Display the Language Selection screen to specify the language to
be displayed on the touch panel. This item is not displayed when
two shortcut keys are configured.
-
Shortcut Key Allows you to arrange shortcut keys for the frequently used Application functions on the Basic screen.
-bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-4
5.1 Basic
5
5.1.1 Color
Select the print color for making copies.
For the print color, you can select one from [Auto Color], [Full Color], [2 Color], [Black] and [Single Color].
% Press [Basic] ö [Color].
Settings
Auto Color Automatically detects whether the scanned original is in color or in black
and white, and selects the appropriate color setting (full color or black).
Full Color Makes copies in full color, regardless of whether the scanned original is in
color or in black and white.
2 Color Prints all areas of the scanned original determined to be in color with the
specified color, and prints all areas determined to be black in black.
Black Prints the copy in black and white, regardless of whether the scanned original is in color or in black and white.
Single Color Prints the copy in the specified single color, regardless of the color of the
scanned original.
When you specify a single color, the original is copied by converting the
color differences (apparent color densities) and the gradation levels into
density differences of the single color.
Average Density Copies the original by only converting the gradation levels into density differences of the single
color, regardless of the color differences in the
original, bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-5
5.1 Basic
5
5.1.2 Paper
Select the paper type and size to be printed, or to change the paper size and paper type settings specified
for each paper tray.
The paper size can be selected automatically according to the original size or it can be specified manually.
0 If you select [Transparency], specify [Black] for [Color] in advance.
0 The auto zoom setting and the auto paper setting cannot be selected at the same time.
0 If a setting for special paper is selected for a paper tray, that tray is not selected automatically with the
Auto Paper setting. (However, a paper tray set to Single Side Only is given priority to be selected with
1-sided printing.) When setting special paper in the paper tray, be sure to set the paper type. For details
on special paper, refer to page 12-2.
% Press [Basic] ö [Paper].
Settings
Auto Automatically selects the paper size according to the original size.
1-4 Trays Allows you to specify the paper manually.
# (Bypass Tray)
L Large capacity unit
(Optional)
Change Tray Settings Specify the paper type and paper size for the selected paper tray.
Paper Type Specify the paper type for the selected paper tray.
Paper Size Specify the paper size for the selected paper tray.
[Auto Detect]:
Automatically detects the paper size.
[12-1/4 e 18 w] (Only for Tray 1 and Tray 2):
Enables 12-1/4 e 18 w to be selected.
[Standard Size] (only for Bypass Tray):
Specify a paper size to use the bypass tray as a
paper tray dedicated to the paper size.
[Custom Size] (only for Bypass Tray):
Enter the paper size.
[Wide Paper]:
Select a paper size larger than the original.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-6
5.1 Basic
5
Configuring a custom size
% [Basic] ö [Paper] ö [Bypass Tray] ö [Change Tray Settings] ö [Custom Size].
Configuring wide paper
% [Basic] ö [Paper] ö [Bypass Tray] ö [Change Tray Settings] ö [Wide Paper].
Settings
X/Y • North American model (inch): Configure the length [X] and width [Y] with
pressing [+] or [-].
• European model (cm): Enter the length [X] and width [Y] of the paper.
Store Register custom paper sizes.
memory 1 to 5 Select the memory button where the paper size is
to be stored.
Change Custom Size
Name
Rename memory button names.
Settings
Wide Paper Select the size of the paper to be loaded.
Change Size X/Y Enter the length [X] and width [Y] of the paper.
Preset Paper Sizes Enables 12 e 18 w to be selected.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-7
5.1 Basic
5
5.1.3 Zoom
The original image size in the original can be enlarged or reduced.
0 The auto zoom setting and the auto paper setting cannot be selected at the same time.
0 If the auto zoom setting is selected and an enlargement is to be copied on paper larger than the original,
load the original with the same orientation as the paper.
% Press [Basic] ö [Zoom].
dReference
To set image rotation:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Copier Settings] ö [Enlargement Rotation].
Settings
Auto Automatically selects the most appropriate zoom ratio based on the size of
the loaded original and the specified paper size.
Full Size Copies the original image in the size identical to the original (100%).
Manual • Enter the zoom ratio (25.0% - 400.0%) of the copy.
• Under "Set Individual Zoom", you can enter different zoom ratios for
the X and Y directions.
Set Zoom Enter the desired zoom and select the button to
register the value with.
"User Preset Zoom" indicates the registered
zoom.
Minimal Copies an original image slightly smaller than the original size or the specified size. The image in the original is centered on the paper without any
cutoff.
Select this setting when you want to copy the entire scope of the original
within the paper used.
-/+ Configure the zoom ratio (25.0% - 400.0%) of the copy without changing
the aspect ratio.
Fixed Zoom Select a preset zoom when copying from a fixed size original onto a fixed
size paper.
User Preset Zoom Select a registered copy zoom value. To change the registered zoom values, use [Set Zoom].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-8
5.1 Basic
5
5.1.4 Duplex/Combine
Configure whether to scan one side or both sides of the originals and whether to print on one side or both
sides of the paper. Multiple (2, 4 or 8) pages of original images can be reduced in size and printed on a single
page.
Using the Duplex/Combine function, you can save paper sheets for copying.
% Press [Basic] ö [Duplex/Combine].
Settings
1-Sided > 1-Sided
2-Sided > 1-Sided
1-Sided > 2-Sided
2-Sided > 2-Sided
Binding Position Configure the binding position of the original and copies to be output.
Without setting the Binding Position, the resulting copy may not be what
you intended.
When [1- Sided > 1- Sided] is selected, the binding position cannot be set.
Original Binding
Position
Select the original binding position from [LeftBind], [Right-Bind], [Top] and [Auto].
• If the binding position for the original is set to
[Auto], the position of the binding margin is
automatically selected. A binding margin
along the long side of the paper is selected if
the original length is 11-11/16 inch (297 mm)
or less. If the original length is more than 11-
11/16 inch (297 mm), a binding margin along
the short side of the paper is selected.
• If [Auto] is selected for the original binding position, the binding margin is set at the top or
on the left.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-9
5.1 Basic
5
Binding Position Output Binding Position
Select the output binding position from [Left
Bind], [Right Bind], [Top] and [Auto].
• If the binding position for the copy is set to
[Auto], the binding position is automatically
determined according to the orientation of the
loaded original. If the original length is 11-
11/16 inch (297 mm) or less, a binding position along the long side of the paper is selected. If the original length is more than 11-11/16
inch (297 mm), a binding position along the
short side of the paper is selected.
• If Output Binding Position is set to [Auto], the
binding position is set at the top or on the left.
Original Direction Select the orientation of the original loaded into the ADF or placed on the
original glass.
Without setting original direction, the resulting copy may not be what you
intended.
No Disables combined copy.
2in1 Copies images on two original pages on one sheet of paper.
Portrait original pages
Landscape original pages
4in1/8in1 4in1 Copies images of four original pages on one
sheet of paper.
8in1 Copies images of eight original pages on one
sheet of paper.
Horizontal Specify the combine order of the original (Numbering Direction setting).
Vertical
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-10
5.1 Basic
5
5.1.5 Finishing
Various settings can be selected for sorting and finishing copies fed into the copy output tray.
0 The Staple settings are available only if the optional finisher is installed.
0 The Punch settings are available only if the Punch Kit PK-516 or Z Folding Unit is installed on the
Finisher FS-526 or the Punch Kit PK-517 is installed on the Finisher FS-527.
0 The Fold/Bind is available only if the Saddle Stitcher is installed on the optional Finisher.
0 The Z-fold settings are available only if the Z Folding Unit is installed on the optional Finisher FS-526.
0 "Staple" cannot be used together with "Offset".
0 The Half-Fold, Center Staple & Fold or Tri-Fold function cannot be used together with any of "Offset",
"Staple" or "Punch".
% Press [Basic] ö [Finishing].
Settings
Sort Prints the copied sets separately when a multi-page original is copied.
Group Makes multiple copies of each page when you make multiple copies of a multipage original.
1
1
1
4
3
2
1
4
3
2
1
1
1
1bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-11
5.1 Basic
5
Offset Yes/No Specify whether to separate each set of copies from another set in the output
tray when copying multiple sets of multi-page originals.
When the Finisher or Job Separator JS-504 is not installed:
If the following conditions are met, printed copies are fed out and sorted in an
alternating crisscross pattern.
• 8-1/2 e 11, A4 or B5 paper is used
• Paper of the same size and type is loaded with the w orientation in one paper tray and with the v orientation in another tray
• Auto paper selection is specified for the paper size setting
When the Finisher or Job Separator JS-504 is installed:
The copies are fed out and stacked on top of each other with each set shifted
to separate it.
Fold/Bind When the Saddle Stitcher SD-508 is installed on the Finisher FS-526:
Half Fold Center Staple & Fold Tri-Fold
Z-Fold
To configure the Z folding setting, install the Z Folding Unit ZU-606.
When the Saddle Stitcher SD-509 is installed on the Finisher FS-527:
Half Fold Center Staple & Fold
Staple Staples copies in corner or at two points before they are output.
Punch Punches holes in copies before they are output.
Settings
1bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-12
5.1 Basic
5
5.1.6 Post Inserter
When the Post Inserter PI-505 is installed on the Finisher FS-526, you can manually operate the Finisher
FS-526 using the post inserter control panel.
Reference
- Only the lower tray can be used as the output tray. The upper tray is not available.
Keys on control panel
Position Setting Configure desired staple or hole-punch positions.
Select Auto, and the machine automatically judges the staple or punch positions for the paper relative to the original direction loaded.
• A staple or hole-punch position is set along the long side of the paper if the
original length is 11-11/16 inch (297 mm) or less.
• Staple or hole-punch positions are set along the short side of the paper if
the original length is more than 11-11/16 inch (297 mm).
• Staple or punching positions are set on the upper or left-side end.
• Be sure to load the original so that its top side is placed in the back.
• If desired, press [Original Direction], and then select the original direction.
Settings
No. Name
1 Corner staple lamp
2 Center staple & fold lamp
3 [Finishing] key
4 2-hole lamp
5 3-hole lamp
6 [Select punch] key
7 [Start/stop] key
8 4-hole lamp
9 Tri-fold lamp
10 2 position staple lamp
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
10 9 8bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-13
5.1 Basic
5
Finishing using Post Inserter
1 Place paper in the lower tray of the Post Inserter, and align the lateral guide to the paper size.
% Set the paper by placing it so that its top side faces the back of the machine.
% To use the corner staple or 2-staple option, load the paper face up.
% To perform Punch, load the paper face up.
% To perform Bind, load the front side of the bound paper face down.
% To perform Tri-Fold, load the outside of the tri-folded paper face down.
2 Press [Finishing] key and [Select punch] key, and select the desired finishing.
% To configure Finishing settings, press [Finishing] key to turn the LED on. To configure punch
settings, press [Select punch] key to turn the LED on.
% Punch settings are available together with the corner staple or 2-staple option.
3 Press the [Start/stop] key.
% If [Start/stop] key is pressed during operation, the operation will be stopped.
5.1.7 Separate Scan
When the original contains pages exceeding the capacity of the ADF, you can divide the original into several
batches to handle each lot as a single copy job. You can also use the copy function by switching between
the ADF and the original glass for scanning the originals.
0 Do not load original sheets beyond the upper limit for the ADF. It would cause jamming and/or spoiling
of the original or failure of the machine.
0 When making 2-sided or combined copies using the original glass, the machine can scan a number of
original pages without enabling Separate Scan.
1 Load the original.
2 In the Basic tab, press [Separate Scan].
ABC
Front
Cover Front
Cover
ABC ABC ABCbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-14
5.1 Basic
5
3 Press the [Start] key.
The original is scanned.
4 Load the next batch of the original, and then press the [Start] key.
% To change the scanning settings, press [Change Setting].
5 Repeat Step 4 until all pages of the original are scanned.
6 After all original pages have been scanned, press [Finish].
7 Press the [Start] key.
dReference
To set the Separate Scan output method:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Copier Settings] ö [Separate Scan Output Method].
5.1.8 Auto Rotate OFF
Select this setting to copy the original according to the paper orientation without rotating the image.
0 For some paper sizes or zoom values, part of the image may be cut off.
% Press [Basic] ö [Auto Rotate OFF].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-15
5.2 Original Setting
5
5.2 Original Setting
Configure the original status or original direction for outputting desired copies.
% Press [Original Setting].
Settings
Mixed Original Loads originals of different sizes into the ADF and scan them at a time.
Z-Folded Original Correctly detects the original size when folded originals are loaded into the
ADF and copied.
Original Size Select [Auto] to detect the size of the original automatically.
If the size of the original is not automatically detected, select the original
size.
Custom Size Enter the original size.
Photo Size Select the photo size.
Binding Position Specify the original binding position (page margin) to prevent the copy
from being printed upside-down when scanning a 2-sided original,
Auto Automatically configures the binding position of
the original.
• A binding margin along the long side of the
paper is selected if the original length is 11-
11/16 inch (297 mm) or less.
• If the original length is more than 11-11/16
inch (297 mm), a binding margin along the
short side of the paper is selected.
Original Direction Specify the original direction to load into the ADF or place on the original
glass when copying 2-sided originals or making 2-sided or combined copies.
Despeckle Reduces the influence of a dirt of the slit glass upon a copy output when
loading an original in the ADF.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-16
5.2 Original Setting
5
Copying mixed originals
Loads originals of different sizes into the ADF and scan them at a time.
To copy onto paper of the same size as the original, select [Full Size] in the Zoom tab and select [Auto] on
the Paper tab. To copy all original pages on paper of the same size, select [Auto] in the Zoom tab and select
the desired paper size on the Paper tab.
0 When [1-Sided > 2-Sided] is selected together with Auto Paper, the back side becomes blank if its
paper size is different from that of the front side. For example, if a single-sided original is copied in the
order of 11 × 17 (A3) and 8-1/2 × 11 (A4), it results in copying of the front side (11 × 17 (A3)) / back side
(blank) and of the front side (8-1/2 × 11 (A4)) / back side (blank).
NOTICE
Load all of the original pages into the ADF so that the top of the pages is toward the back or the left side of
the machine.
1 Slide the adjustable lateral guides of the ADF to fit the size of the
largest original page.
2 Arrange originals in the order you want them to be scanned and
load them face up in the ADF.
3 In the basic settings screen, press [Original Setting].
4 Press [Mixed Original].
% To cancel the setting, press [Mixed Original] again to deselect
it.
The following chart shows the possible combinations of standard-sized paper that can be used for the Mixed
Original setting.
Original Size
Maximum Original Width
11 e 17
w (A3
w)
8-1/2 e
11 v
(A4 v)
8-1/2 e
14 w
(B4 w)
8-1/2 e
11 w
(A4 w)
5-1/2 e
8-1/2 v
(A5 v)
5-1/2 e
8-1/2
w (A5
w)
(B5 v) (B5 w)
11 e 17 w (A3
w)
o o - - - - - -
8-1/2 e 11 v
(A4 v)
o o - - - - - -
8-1/2 e 14 w
(B4 w)
o o o - - - o -
8-1/2 e 11 w
(A4 w)
o o o o o - o -
5-1/2 e 8-1/2
v (A5 v)
- - o o o - o -
5-1/2 e 8-1/2
w (A5 w)
- - - - - o - o
(B5 v) o o o - - - o -
(B5 w) - - o o o - o o
o Possible to combine
- Not possible to combinebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-17
5.2 Original Setting
5
Copying Z-folded originals
Correctly detects the original size when folded originals are loaded into the ADF and copied.
The length of the first page of the original is detected, and the subsequent pages are scanned as pages of
the same size.
NOTICE
Unfold folded originals before loading them into the ADF. If the original is copied without being unfolded, a
paper jam may occur.
1 Load the original into the ADF.
2 In the basic settings screen, press [Original Setting].
3 Press [Z-Folded Original].
% To cancel the setting, press [Z-Folded Original] again to
deselect it.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-18
5.3 Quality/Density
5
5.3 Quality/Density
Select the setting for the image type of the original to better adjust the copy quality/density.
% Press [Quality/Density].
Settings
Original Type Select the original type (text and image type) to obtain better copy quality.
Text Copies originals containing only text. The edges of
copied text are reproduced with sharpness, providing an image that is easy to read.
Text/Photo [Photo Paper]:
Select this setting to print photos from originals
containing both text and images onto photographic paper. A smooth copy image is produced.
[Printed Photo]:
Select this setting to copy printed originals containing both text and images, such as pamphlets or
catalogs.
Photo [Photo Paper]:
Select this setting when the original photos are
printed on photographic paper. Halftone original
images (photographs, etc.) that cannot be reproduced with the usual settings will be reproduced in
as nearly an original state as possible. A smooth
copy image is produced.
[Printed Photo]:
Select this setting to copy printed originals, such
as pamphlets or catalogs. Halftone original images
(photographs, etc.) that cannot be reproduced with
the usual settings will be reproduced in as nearly
an original state as possible.
Map Select this setting to copy originals with a background color, originals containing pencil markings
or fine colored lines such as maps. A sharp copy
image is produced.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-19
5.3 Quality/Density
5
Original Type Dot Matrix Original Select this setting to copy originals containing only
text that appears faint (such as that written with a
pencil). The copied text is reproduced so that it is
darker, making it easier to read.
Copied Paper Select this setting to copy images (originals) printed using this machine.
Density Adjust copy density.
Background Removal Adjust the density of the background area for originals with colored background (newsprints, recycle paper, etc.) or originals on thin paper showing
text or images from the back.
Select [Auto] for "Background Removal Level" to enable automatic background density adjustment for copying with the optimal background density.
For "Background Removal", normally [Bleed Removal] is selected. However,
when copying an original with colored background, select [Paper Discoloration Adj] to make adjustment for background removal for copying.
Text Enhancement Adjust the text reproduction level for an original with a photo overlapping the
text (background text) to clarify the text on the background.
To emphasize the text on the background, press [Daker Text] to adjust the
setting toward +.
To emphasize the background image, press [Lighter Text] to adjust the setting toward -.
[Text Enhancement] can be configured when an item other than [Photo] is
selected.
Glossy Makes copies with a glossy finish.
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-20
5.4 Application
5
5.4 Application
Configure the application settings for making copies.
Item
Sheet/Cover/Chapter
Insert
Inserts another sheet of paper or adds a cover page to the paper
for copying. You can also scan multiple copies of the original with
different settings.
p. 5-21
Edit Color Inverts the contrast or gradation of the original or prints the original
in the mirror image. It also adds a color in the background or adjust
the quality of a color image.
p. 5-29
Book Copy/Repeat Configure the settings for a book or catalog. An image on a single
sheet of original can be repeatedly copied or divided and enlarged
in parts to produce copies of the respective parts.
p. 5-33
Page Margin Select the binding margin (blank area) of the paper used for copying.
p. 5-37
Image Adjust Configure the layout for the image when the paper is larger than the
original.
p. 5-39
Booklet Automatically arranges the page order of the scanned original and
makes 2-sided 2 in 1 copies to produce a page layout for a centerbound book, such as a magazine.
p. 5-40
Erase Erases unnecessary outside portion of the original body text or
erases the area outside the original placed on the original glass.
p. 5-41
Stamp/Composition Prints the date/time, page number or a stamp printed on copies.
This function also allows you to embed information for preventing
unauthorized copying in a document.
p. 5-43
Card Copy Copies the contents of the front and back sides of a card-size original, for example, insurance card, driver's license, or business card,
on one sheet.
p. 5-59
Save in User Box Saves the scanned original data in a User Box. p. 5-60bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-21
5.4 Application
5
5.4.1 Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert
OHP Interleave
Prevent copies printed onto OHP transparencies from sticking together because of the heat produced during
copying by having paper (interleaves) inserted between the transparencies.
0 Printing on OHP transparencies is possible only in black.
0 Use interleaf paper with the same size as the OHP transparencies.
0 The number of copies is fixed to one. You cannot change.
0 The finishing function cannot be changed.
0 Load transparencies into the bypass tray.
0 Do not use a transparency that has been through the machine even once. It may lead to reduced print
quality, a paper jam or a damage to the machine. (Even if a transparency has been discharged without
printing, it cannot be reused.)
1 Load the original.
2 Press [Basic] ö [Color] ö [Black].
3 Load transparencies into the bypass tray. Load the interleave paper into the desired paper tray.
4 Set the paper type of the bypass tray to [Transparency] and press [OK].
5 Press [Application] ö [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert] ö [OHP Interleave].
dReference
Setting Black for Color Settings:
Press [Basic] ö [Color] ö [Black].
Settings
Interleave Paper Select the paper tray loaded with paper with a transparency interleaf.
Transparency Indicates the paper size of the loaded transparency.
EFGH
EFGH
EFGH
EFGH
EFGH
EFGHbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-22
5.4 Application
5
Cover Sheet
Copies the front and back cover sheets onto separate paper when copying an original with a front/back cover
sheet. When the original to copy does not have a front and back cover, you can insert blank sheets of paper
as the front and back covers.
0 Use paper of the same size for the body text and cover sheets, and ensure the same orientation of
paper for both purposes.
% Press [Application] ö [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert] ö [Cover Sheet].
dReference
To configure the 2-sided copy mode:
Press [Basic] ö [Duplex/Combine].
Settings
None Disables copying of the front/back cover and blank sheet insertion.
Front (Copy) For 1-sided copy:
Copies the first page of the original onto paper for the front cover sheet.
For 2-sided copy:
Copies the second page of the original onto the back of the paper for the
front cover sheet.
Front (Blank) Adds paper for the front cover sheet as the first page of the copy.
Back (Copy) For 1-sided copy:
Copies the last page of the original onto the back cover page.
For 2-sided copy:
Copies the last two pages of the original the 2-sided copy mode onto both
sides of the paper for the back cover when copying an original with an even
number of pages.
Back (Blank) Add paper for the back cover sheet to the last page of the copy.
Paper Select the paper tray loaded with the paper for the front/back cover page or
blank cover pages.
You can select the paper tray of the Post Inserter when [Front(Blank)] or
[Back(Blank)] is selected while the optional Post Inserter is installed.
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
4
4
3
3
2
2
2
2
1
1
REPORTbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-23
5.4 Application
5
Insert Sheet
A different sheet of paper (such as colored paper) can be inserted as specified pages in the copies. You can
select from two options: [Copy] and [Blank] to enable or disable copying to the inserted sheet.
0 You can specify up to 30 positions for insert sheets.
0 Use paper of the same size for the sheets to be inserted and for the original copies, and ensure the
same orientation of paper for both.
% Press [Application] ö [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert] ö [Insert Sheet].
Settings
P --- Specify where to insert sheets of a different paper type.
Sort Sorts specified pages in the ascending order.
Insert Paper Select the paper tray loaded with the paper to be inserted. You can select the
paper tray of the Post Inserter when [Blank] is selected while the optional Post
Inserter is installed.
Copy Copies the original with the specified paper inserted for the specified pages.
When setting the specified page to "2"
For 1-sided copy:
Inserts the specified paper as the second page of the copies, and copies the
second page of the original onto it.
For 2-sided copy:
Leaves the back side of the first page of the copy blank, inserts the specified
paper for the second page of the copy, and makes a 2-sided copy of the second and third pages of the original onto the inserted sheet.
6
6
4
4
5
2
2
3
6
6
5
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
6
6
5
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
1
1
REPORTbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-24
5.4 Application
5
dReference
To configure the 2-sided copy mode:
Press [Basic] ö [Duplex/Combine].
Insert Image
A multi-page original scanned on the original glass can be inserted at the pre-set location in an original first
scanned with the ADF.
0 With the Insert Image function, the inserted original is added after the specified page.
0 You can specify up to 30 positions for the original to be inserted.
0 If the document scanned on the original glass has more pages than the number of pages specified in
the Insert Image screen, the remaining pages of the inserted original are printed at the end of the
original.
0 The original on the original glass is scanned with the same settings as for the original scanned in the
ADF.
0 If the original scanned on the original glass has fewer pages than the number of pages specified in the
Insert Image screen, the missing insertion pages will not be printed.
0 If the same page number is specified twice, two insertion original pages are added at the specified
location.
0 If the specified page number is greater than the total number of pages in the main original, the
corresponding insertion original page is added at the end of the copy.
1 Load the original into the ADF.
Blank Select this option to insert the specified paper sheet after the page you have
specified.
When setting the specified page to "3"
For 1-sided copy:
Inserts the specified paper as the fourth page of the copy.
For 2-sided copy:
Leaves the back side of the second page of the copy blank, and inserts the
specified paper for the third page of the copy.
Settings
6
6
4
4
5
6
6
5
5
4
4
3
3
6
6
5
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
1
1
2
REPORT
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
A B
4
3
B
2
1 A
1
REPORTbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-25
5.4 Application
5
2 Press [Application] ö [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert] ö [Insert Image].
3 Press the [Start] key.
4 Place the original to be inserted on the original glass.
5 Press the [Start] key.
% To insert a multi-page original, repeat steps 4 and 5 until all pages of the insertion original are
scanned in the order that they are to be inserted.
6 Press [Finish].
7 Press the [Start] key.
Copying begins.
Settings
P --- Specify the position to insert the page scanned through the original
glass.
Sort Sorts specified pages in the ascending order.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-26
5.4 Application
5
Chapters
When making 2-sided copies, the pages specified as the first page of a chapter can be printed on the front
side of the paper. If the document was arranged so that the specified page would be printed on the back side
of a page, the page is left blank and the specified page is printed on the front side of the next page.
0 You can set up to 30 positions for the first page of chapters.
0 Enable the Chapters function to set [1-Sided > 2-Sided]. For a 2-sided original, select [2-Sided >2-
Sided].
0 Make sure that the paper loaded for the first page of the chapter and for text copies have the same size
and orientation.
% Press [Application] ö [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert] ö [Chapters].
dReference
To configure the 2-sided copy mode:
Press [Basic] ö [Duplex/Combine].
Settings
P --- Specify the first page of the chapters.
Sort Sorts specified pages in the ascending order.
Chapter Paper Specify the paper tray for paper to be inserted for the first page of the chapter.
Copy Insert Makes copies of the first pages of the chapters on paper of a different type
from that for the text pages.
None Copies all pages with the same type of paper.
3
7
7
8
6
2 6
4
4
5
3
3
3
7
7
8
5
5
6
3
3
4
8
8
7
7
6
6
5
5
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-27
5.4 Application
5
Program Jobs
When the originals to be copied include different types of materials such as a 1-sided original for full size
copying and a 2-sided original for enlarged copying among other things, you can use this setting for scanning
various originals with different settings and then copy them all in a single copying job.
Different Zoom or Paper settings can be specified for a part of the original or Finishing settings or a numbering
function can be set after the entire original is scanned, and then all copies can be printed together.
0 Up to 100 types of originals can be scanned.
0 When configuring a program job, the [Group] setting cannot be selected in the Finishing screen.
Instead, select [Sort].
1 Press [Application] ö [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert] ö [Program Jobs].
2 Select the desired copy settings, and then press the [Start] key.
3 Press [Fix].
% Press [Retry] to delete the scanned job. Press [Change Setting] to configure the copy settings.
% When the original has been loaded on the original glass, press [Finish].
4 Load the next original and press [Change Setting].
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
4
2
3
3
2
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
1
1
0001
REPORTbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-28
5.4 Application
5
5 Select the desired copy settings, and then press the [Start] key.
% Repeat Steps 3 to 5 until all originals have been scanned.
6 After all original pages have been scanned, press [Finish].
7 Press [Yes].
8 Specify finish settings as needed.
9 Press [Start] or the [Start] key.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-29
5.4 Application
5
5.4.2 Edit Color
Neg./Pos. Reverse
Use this function to enable the original to be copied with the density and gradations of the image inversed.
The images in the original are copied and output reversed like negative film of photographs.
0 If a single color is selected, the images are reversed relative to the selected color.
0 If a background color is selected, colors are reversed relative to the selected base color and the color
of the images.
% Press [Application] ö [Edit Color] ö [Neg./Pos. Reverse].
% To cancel the Neg./Pos. Reverse function, press [Neg./Pos. Reverse] again.
dReference
To set Single Color:
Press [Basic] ö [Color] ö [Single Color].
To Set Background Color:
Press [Application] ö [Edit Color] ö [Background Color]. bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-30
5.4 Application
5
Mirror Image
Copy originals as mirror images.
% Press [Application] ö [Edit Color] ö [Mirror Image].
Settings
Original Size Select [Auto] to detect the size of the original automatically.
If the size of the original is not automatically detected, select the original
size.
Custom Size Enter the original size.
Photo Size Select the photo size.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-31
5.4 Application
5
Background Color
Color the blank area of the original with a specified background color.
% Press [Application] ö [Edit Color] ö [Background Color].
Color Adjustment
Adjust the image quality to fit an image based on the color-copied original.
1 Press [Application] ö [Edit Color] ö [Color Adjust].
Settings
Select Color Select a background color.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-32
5.4 Application
5
2 Configure respective functions.
% Press [Sample Copy] to see how it will appear with the currently specified color quality adjustment
settings.
Settings
Brightness Adjust the brightness of the copied image.
Contrast Adjust the copy density balance.
Saturation Adjust how vivid colors should be for full color copies.
Red Adjust how vivid red colors should be for full color copies.
Green Adjust how vivid green colors should be for full color copies.
Blue Adjust how vivid blue colors should be for full color copies.
Hue Adjust the hue for full color copies.
The hue refers to a color trend relative to discrete colors such as red,
blue and yellow. By adjusting the hue, the image can attain more reddish or bluish tone, for example.
Copy Density Adjust copy density (lighter or darker).
Sharpness Adjust the sharpness to emphasize the edges of text so that copied
text can be read more easily. You can make an overly sharp original
image softer or a blurry image clearer.
Color Balance Adjust the individual concentrations of yellow (Y), magenta (M), cyan
(C), and black (K) for full-color copies.
Full-color copy reproduces colors of the original by mixing toners of
four colors: yellow, magenta, cyan, and black.
By changing the amount of each of the four toners, adjust the tints in
the copy.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-33
5.4 Application
5
5.4.3 Book Copy/Repeat
Book Copy
Divides or does not divide page spreads (such as a book or catalog) into left and right pages to copy data.
This function enables copying with the ADF open by placing the original on the Original Glass. If necessary,
you can place an original image at the center of the paper to copy.
0 Place the original on the original glass.
0 If [Book Copy] is selected, [Image Adjust] is set to [Centering] and [Erase] is set to [Non-Image Area
Erase] automatically. For details on [Centering], refer to page 5-39. For details on [Non-Image Area
Erase], refer to page 5-41. The automatically set [Centering] or [Non-Image Area Erase] can be
cancelled.
0 When [Book Spread] or [Separation] is selected, pressing the [Start] key starts printing.
0 When [Front and Back Cover] is selected, the scanning operation starts with the front cover followed
by scanning of the back cover, and ends with scanning of all two-page spreads of the body text in the
order of the page numbers.
0 When [Front Cover] is selected, all two-page spreads are scanned in order after the front cover.
0 When [Front and Back Cover] or [Front Cover] is selected, wait until all pages in the original are scanned
and then press [Finish] and then the [Start] key to start printing.
% Press [Application] ö [Book Copy/Repeat] ö [Book Copy].
Settings
Book Spread Copies both pages of a two-page spread original as a one page original.
Separation Copies the right and left pages of two-page spreads separately in the order
of the page numbers.
Front Cover Copies the front cover, the right and left pages of two-page spreads separately in the order of the page numbers, and the back cover in this order.
Front and Back Cover Copies the front cover, separate copies of each page in the page spreads
and the back cover in the original page order.
SURVEYOR’S
REPORT
SURVEYOR’S
REPORTbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-34
5.4 Application
5
Image Repeat
An original image can be repeatedly printed on a single sheet of paper. Specify the original and paper sizes
or the zoom to automatically calculate the number of images to be copied accordingly. Alternatively, specify
the desired number of repetitions.
% Press [Application] ö [Book Copy/Repeat] ö [Image Repeat].
Frame Erase Erases projection of the dark shadow around the book.
Frame Configure the width of the area around the entire
frame to be erased.
Top, Right, Bottom,
Left
Configure the width of the top, right side, bottom
and left side of the frame to be erased.
None Select this settings to not erase the frame.
Center Erase Erases projection of the dark shadow at the center of the book.
Binding Position Select the binding position of the original.
To indicate it, select [Separation], [Front Cover], and [Front and Back Cover].
Settings
With Margin Repeats copying of the scanned area of the original so that the copy area of
the sheet is filled with the copied image. If the entire image does not fit into
the copy area, the extra range is not copied.
Without Margin Repeats copying of the scanned area of the original so that the sheet is filled
with the copied image. However, some parts of the image may be lost.
Auto Detect Automatically detects the area to be scanned.
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-35
5.4 Application
5
Poster Mode
This function enables enlarged copy of the original image to a size exceeding the paper size that can be
loaded in the machine, such as the 34 e 44 (A0) or 24 e 36 (B0) size. Specify the original size and the output
size (enlarged copy size) to output enlarged copies of divided sections of the original onto separate sheets
of paper respectively. Create an enlarged copy of the specified finished size by joining those copies of
sections.
To create an 34 e 44-size (A0-size) poster, create copies of sections on eight 11 e 17-size (A3-size) sheets
and join them together.
0 Place the original on the original glass.
0 In Poster Mode, the number of copies is set to 1.
% Press [Application] ö [Book Copy/Repeat] ö [Poster Mode].
Set Range Select [Auto] to detect the size of the original automatically.
If the size of the original is not automatically detected, or the reading range
must be specified, select the original size.
Custom Size Enter the original size.
Photo Size Select the photo size.
2/4/8 Repeat 2 Repeat
4 Repeat
8 Repeat
Repeats copying of the scanned area of the original
as many times as specified. Note, however, that an
image that does not fit within the size of the paper
used is copied with partial cutoff.
[Repeat Interval Settings] can be configured only
for [2 Repeat].
Repeat Interval Settings
Specify the clearance between copied images.
Settings
Image Size Select the finished image size.
Custom Size Enter the finished image size.
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-36
5.4 Application
5
Booklet Original
A catalog with its staples removed can be copied and bound with staples at the center to create copies of
the original catalog.
0 This function is available if a saddle stitcher is installed in the optional finisher.
NOTICE
Load a catalog with the staples removed.
1 Load the original.
% To use the original glass, position the pages in order, starting with the side that includes the first
page, then the side that includes the second page, then the side that includes the third page.
Paper Size • North American model(inch):
Configure the width of the binding margin (1/16 inch to 3/4 inch) with
pressing [+] and [-]. When [None] is selected, the binding margin width is
set to 0 inch.
• European model(cm):
Enter the width of the binding margin (0.1 mm - 20.0 mm). When [None]
is selected, the binding margin width is set to 0 mm.
Zoom Enter the zoom to output a copy of the finished size.
Original Size Select [Auto] to detect the size of the original automatically.
If the size of the original is not automatically detected, select the original
size.
Custom Size Enter the original size.
Photo Size Select the photo size.
Settings
7
2
2
1
8
2
2
7
7
5
4
4
3
6
5
4
4
3
6
Staples
+
2 7 8 1
4 5 6 3bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-37
5.4 Application
5
% To use the ADF, load the pages with the side that includes the first page on top.
2 Press [Application] ö [Book Copy/Repeat] ö [Booklet Original].
3 Press the [Start] key.
4 After all original pages have been scanned, press [Finish] and the [Start] key.
5.4.4 Page Margin
Copies can be printed with a binding margin so that the pages can easily be filed. When scanning a 2-sided
original, you can specify the paper binding position (binding margin for the paper) to prevent the copy from
being printed upside-down.
Left
Top
Right
0 You can specify the binding position without creating a binding margin.
0 For 2-sided copy, you need to set the paper binding position and the original direction. Otherwise, the
original image may be copied up-side-down.
0 If the positions of the staples or punched holes are different from the binding position, the positions of
the staples or punched holes are given priority.
0 If part of the image is lost when copied with the specified binding margin settings, reduce the zoom and
perform copying.
% Press [Application] ö [Page Margin].
3
3
4
6
6
5
1
1
2
8
8
7
4
4
ABC
DEF
GHI
3
3
ABC
DEF
GHI
2
2
ABC
DEF
1
1
ABC
DEF
GHI
3
3
ABC
DEF
GHI
1
2
AB
DE
GH
4
4
ABC
DEF
GHI
2
2
ABC
DEF
GHI
2
2
ABC
DEF
1
1
ABC
DEF
GHI
4
4
ABC
DEF
GHI
2
2
ABC
DEF
GHI
2
2
ABC
DEF
1
1
ABC
DEF
GHI
4
4
ABC
DEF
GHI
3
3
ABC
DEF
GHI
2
2
ABC
DEF
1
1
ABC
DEF
GHI
3
3
ABC
DEF
GHI
ABC
DEF
2 1
ABC
DEF
4 4
ABC
DEF
GHI
ABC
DEF
GHI
2 2
ABC
DEF
1
1
ABC
DEF
GHI 3
3
ABC
DEF
GHI
1
2
BC
EF
HI
4
4
ABC
DEF
GHI
2
2
ABC
DEF
GHI
2
2
ABC
DEF
1
1
ABC
DEF
GHIbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-38
5.4 Application
5
dReference
To set the zoom:
Press [Basic] ö [Zoom].
Settings
Margin Position Select an option from [Auto], [Left], [Top] and [Right].
When Auto is selected, the binding position is automatically set.
• This function automatically determines the binding position according to
the orientation of the loaded original. If the original length is 11-11/16
inch (297 mm) or less, a binding position along the long side of the paper
is selected. If the original length is more than 11-11/16 inch (297 mm), a
binding position along the short side of the paper is selected.
• The binding position is set on the upper or left-side end.
• Be sure to load the original so that its top side is placed in the back. If
the document is loaded in any other orientation, this setting fails.
Image Shift Adjust the image position according to the binding margin.
Change Back Shift Adjust the image position on the back side of the
paper in the 2-sided copy mode.
Adjust Value • North American model (inch): Configure the width of the binding margin
(1/16 inch to 3/4 inch) with pressing [+] and [-]. When [None] is selected,
the binding margin width is set to 0 inch.
• European model (cm): Enter the width of the binding margin (0.1 mm -
20.0 mm). When [None] is selected, the binding margin width is set to 0
mm.
Original Direction Select the orientation of the original loaded into the ADF or placed on the
original glass.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-39
5.4 Application
5
5.4.5 Image Adjust
If the paper is larger than the original, you can enlarge the original and copy it into the center of the paper.
Full Size
Center Zoom
Centering
% Press [Application] ö [Image Adjust].
Settings
Full Size Enlarges the image up to the largest possible paper size that can contain the
entire original, and copies the image at the center of the paper.
Place the original on the original glass.
Center Zoom Enlarges the image up to the largest possible paper size that can contain the
entire original, and copies the image at the center of the paper. However,
some parts of the image may be lost.
Place the original on the original glass.
Centering Copies the original image at the center of the paper without enlarging it.
Original Size Select [Auto] to detect the size of the original automatically.
If the size of the original is not automatically detected, select the original
size.
Custom Size Enter the original size.
Photo Size Select the photo size.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-40
5.4 Application
5
5.4.6 Booklet
The page order of the scanned original is automatically arranged to produce 2-sided 2 in 1 copies in a page
layout for center binding, such as for a magazine.
0 Center Staple & Fold or Half-Fold is available if the Saddle Stitcher is installed in the optional Finisher.
0 Generally, a multiple of 4 pages is required with a 1-sided original, and a multiple of 2 pages is required
with a 2-sided original. If there are not enough pages, blank pages are automatically added at the end.
0 If a booklet is selected with the Auto Paper Select enabled, the zoom is automatically set at 64.7%
(70.7%).
% Press [Application] ö [Booklet].
Settings
Left Bind/Right Bind Select the output binding position for copies to be output.
Center Staple & Fold Staples copies at two places along the center, then folds the copies in half
before feeding them out.
Half-Fold Feeds out a copied sheet by folding it in two.
No This setting feeds out a copied sheet without Center Staple & Fold or HalfFold.
Paper Select the paper tray loaded with the desired paper.
Cover Sheet Copies the front and back cover sheets onto separate paper when copying
an original with a front/back cover sheet. When the original to copy does not
have a front and back cover, you can insert blank sheets of paper as the
front and back covers.
8
8
7
7
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
6 3
6 3
5
4
8 1
8 1
7
REPORT
2
8
8
7
7
3
3
2
2
1
1
REPORT
3 6
6 6
4
5
1 8
1 8
2
REPORT
7
Right binding
Left bindingbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-41
5.4 Application
5
dReference
To set to an appropriate zoom:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Copier Settings] ö [Auto Zoom for Combine/Booklet].
5.4.7 Erase
Frame Erase
Copies can be produced by erasing shadows of punched holes, unnecessary areas around the original text,
such as the transmission information on received faxes and the shadows of punched holes. All four sides
around the original can be erased in the same width or in a different width for each side.
% Press [Application] ö [Erase] ö [Frame Erase].
Settings
Frame Erases the four sides of the original in the same width.
Top Right Bottom Left Erases each frame side in a different width.
+/- • North American model (inch): Press [+], [-] to set the erasing width between 1/16 inch and 2 inch.
• European model (cm): Press [+], [-] to set the erasing width between 0.1
mm and 50.0 mm. The erasing width can also be entered using the keypad.
None Sets the erasing width to 0 inch (0 mm).
A
A:1/16 inch to 2 inch (0.1 mm to 50.0 mm)
Abizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-42
5.4 Application
5
Non-Image Area Erase
This function enables copying with the ADF open while having an original that cannot be loaded in the ADF
placed at a desired position on the original glass.
The original is automatically detected and the area outside the original text is erased.
Erase methods include "Bevel" and "Rectangular". "Bevel" is used when the background of the original is
thin and "Rectangular" is used when it is dark.
You can place the original on any position without opening or closing the ADF so that you can make copies
promptly. In addition, toner consumption will be reduced as the area outside the original text is erased.
0 If erasing is not performed as desired, set "Erase Operation" under "Erase Adjustment" in Administrator
Settings.
0 The size of the original automatically detected is 3/8 inch e 3/8 inch (10 mm e 10 mm) or larger.
If the detection fails, a blank sheet of paper is output.
0 You cannot make copies with the ADF closed.
0 The original image may be defected at its top or end.
% Press [Application] ö [Erase] ö [Non-Image Area Erase].
dReference
To set Erase Operation:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment] ö
[Erase Adjustment].
Rectangular erasing
Bevel erasingbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-43
5.4 Application
5
5.4.8 Stamp/Composition
Add date and time, page number, stamp, image, or header or footer to make copies.
Item
Date/Time Adds date and time to copies.
Page Number Adds page numbers or chapter numbers to copies.
Stamp Adds preset or registered stamps to copies.
Copy Security Adds a hidden text for preventing unauthorized copying in a document when
copying. This function also allows you to copy a text with copy inhibit information or password embedded. Using this function, you can prevent original
information from being leaked.
Stamp Repeat Repeats copying of a stamp or the date and time onto the paper.
Header/Footer Adds date and time to the top or bottom of the paper to print copies.
Watermark Adds a watermark (watery text) to the center of the copied pages.
Overlay Makes copies with the image of the first scanned original page overlapping
the subsequent original images.
Registered Overlay Saves an image of the scanned original as a registered overlay in the hard
disk and later overlay the registered image on the copy of another original.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-44
5.4 Application
5
Date/Time
You can select the print position and notation format to print the date and time. Specify whether to print on
all pages or only on the first page.
0 The date/time stamp cannot be printed on blank pages inserted using the Cover Sheet, Insert Sheet
and Chapters functions. Change the setting for printing on blank pages in Administrator Settings to
enable blank page printing.
0 The date/time as of scanning the original is stamped on the paper.
% Press [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition] ö [Date/Time].
dReference
To enable printing on blank pages:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Blank Page Print Settings].
Settings
Date Format Select the type (format) of date and time notation.
Time Format Select the type (format) of date and time notation. When [None] is selected,
the time is not printed.
Pages Select to print the date/time on all pages or only on the first page.
Print Position Select a position from the nine print position options.
Adjust Position Adjust horizontal and vertical positions between
1/16 inch (0.1 mm) and 1-15/16 inch (50.0 mm).
Text Details Set the text color, size and type.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-45
5.4 Application
5
Page Number
You can select the print position and notation format to print page numbers and chapter numbers. Page and
chapter numbers are printed on all pages.
0 Page numbers cannot be printed on blank pages inserted using the Cover Sheet, Insert Sheet and
Chapters functions. Change the setting for printing on blank pages in Administrator Settings to enable
blank page printing.
% Press [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition] ö [Page Number].
Settings
Starting Page Number • Set [Page Number] between -99999 and 99999, and set [Chapter] between -100 and 100.
• Press [*] to switch over the signs (+ and -) of the setting.
• If a negative value is specified, the numbers are not printed until the numbering reaches 1. For example, if "-1" was specified, the numbers are
printed starting with "1" on the third copied page.
• The entered chapter number is printed if [1-1, 1-2...] is selected under
"Page Number Type".
Starting Chapter Number
Page Number Type Select the type (format) of the page.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-46
5.4 Application
5
dReference
To configure the settings for the Cover Sheet, Insert Sheet and Chapters functions:
Press [Application] ö [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert].
To configure the settings for the Chapters function:
Press [Application] ö [Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert] ö [Chapters].
To enable printing on blank pages:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Blank Page Print Settings].
Insert Sheet Setting Set this parameter when using the Cover Sheet, Insert Sheet and Chapters
functions together.
Cover Sheet Print on Front and Back Cover:
Prints on the front and back covers.
Print on Back Cover Only:
Prints a page number on the back cover but not on
the front cover. Page number printing starts with
"2" for 1-sided copy and with "3" for 2-sided copy.
Do not print Page Number:
Disables printing on the front or back cover. Page
number printing starts with "2" for 1-sided copy
and with "3" for 2-sided copy.
Insert Sheet (Copy) Print page #:
Prints on inserted pages.
Do Not Print #:
Counts but not prints on inserted pages.
Skip the Page(s):
Disables counting and printing on inserted pages.
Insert (Blank) Do Not Print #:
Counts but not prints on inserted pages.
Skip the Page(s):
Disables counting and printing on inserted pages.
Print Position Select a position from the nine print position options.
Adjust Position Adjust horizontal and vertical positions between
1/16 inch (0.1 mm) and 1-15/16 inch (50.0 mm).
Text Details Set the text color, size and type.
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-47
5.4 Application
5
Stamp
You can select the print position and notation format to print the stamp. Select printing on all pages or only
on the first page.
0 A stamp refers to text with printing contents fixed and preset. You can also select a stamp registered
with the Copy Protection Utility.
0 Stamps cannot be printed on blank pages inserted using the Cover Sheet, Insert Sheet and Chapters
functions. Change the setting for printing on blank pages in Administrator Settings to enable blank page
printing.
% Press [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition] ö [Stamp].
dReference
To enable printing on blank pages:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Blank Page Print Settings].
Settings
Stamp Type/Preset
Stamps
Select a stamp to be printed from the eight types available.
Pages Select to print the stamp on all pages or only on the first page.
Text Size Select the character size used for the stamp.
Text Color Select the text color for the stamp.
Print Position Select a position from the nine print position options.
Adjust Position Adjust horizontal and vertical positions between
1/16 inch (0.1 mm) and 1-15/16 inch (50.0 mm).bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-48
5.4 Application
5
Copy Protect
This function allows you to print a hidden text for preventing unauthorized copying, for example, a preset
stamp such as Private or date, in the background without particular distinction. If you copy a document with
Copy Protect printed, a text is highlighted on the entire sheet of paper to be printed, enabling you to know
that the copy is not authorized.
0 The copy protection text is printed on all pages. The page to start with cannot be specified.
0 The selected copy protection text formats appear in the order they are placed, and can be used in
combination for up to eight text lines.
0 Use the PageScope Web Connection or Copy Protection Utility to register a registered stamp.
0 Multiple registered stamps or preset stamps cannot be selected.
% Press [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition] ö [Copy Security]ö [Copy Protect].
Settings
Registered Stamp Select one from registered stamps.
Preset Stamp Select a stamp to be printed from the eight types available.
Date/Time Select the type of date and time notation. When [None] is selected for Time
Format, the time is not printed.
The date/time as of scanning the original is stamped on the paper.
Other Job Number Select Yes to print the copy job number.
Serial Number Select Yes to print the serial number of this machine.
For details on setting for the serial number, contact
your service representative.
Distribution Control
Number
Prints the distribution control number.
Specify the distribution control number using a value between 1 and 99999999.
Detail Settings Configure the settings for Text/Background Color, Density, Copy Protect
Text, Text Size, Pattern Overwrite and Background Pattern.
ABCD
Draft Draft Draft
Draf aft
Draft
Draft Draft raft
Draft Draft
ABCD
Draft Draft Draft
Draf aft
Draft
Draft Draft raft
Draft Draft
ABCDbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-49
5.4 Application
5
dReference
To delete a registered stamp:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Stamp Settings] ö
[Delete Registered Stamp].
Copy Guard
This function prints a document, embedding a Copy Guard pattern in a copy protect text, for example, a
preset stamp such as Private or date.
If an attempt is made to copy copy-guarded sheets, the machine that supports this function scans a Copy
Guard pattern, stops copying, and discards the currently running job.
0 For a text, specify the pre-registered preset stamps.
0 The Copy Guard text is printed on all pages. The page to start with cannot be specified.
0 The selected Copy Guards appear in the order they are placed, and can be used in combination for up
to six text lines.
0 You can select the preset stamp, date/time, and the other items together.
0 Multiple preset stamps cannot be selected.
0 A Copy Guard cannot be printed on a colored paper, envelope, or transparency film.
% [Application] ö [Stamp/Compositon] ö [Copy Security] ö [Copy Guard]
Position Change the angle. The angle can be changed when there are no more than
four lines in the selected copy protection text.
Change Pos./Delete Change the arrangement order. Select the target
copy protection text and press [Up] or [Down].
To add a space to the copy protection text, press
[Insert Space]. Press either [Up] or [Down] to move
o that appears beside the specified copy protection text type, and then press [Insert].
To delete the copy protection text, press [Delete],
and then press the button for the copy protection
text to be deleted.
Settings
ABCD
Draft Draft Draft
Draf aft
Draft
Draft Draft raft
Draft Draft
ABCD
NGbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-50
5.4 Application
5
dReference
To specify and detect a Copy Guard:
Select Utility/Counter ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Security Details] ö [Copy Guard].
Password Copy
This function prints a document, embedding a copy protect text, for example, a preset stamp such as Private
or date, and a password for Password Copy.
If an attempt is made to copy password-copied sheets, the machine that supports this function scans a
Password Copy pattern and prompts you to enter the password. When the correct password is entered,
copying will start.
0 For a text, specify the pre-registered preset stamps.
0 A Password Copy is printed on all pages. The page to start with cannot be specified.
0 The selected Password Copy texts appear in the order they are placed, and can be used in combination
for up to six text lines.
0 You can select the preset stamp, date/time, and the other items together.
0 Multiple preset stamps cannot be selected.
0 A Password Copy cannot be printed on a colored paper, envelope, or transparency film.
0 If you fail to enter a password three times, the currently processed copy job will be erased.
0 If a password is detected on copies with Zoom, 2 Color, Grayscale, Color Adjust, Colored Paper,
Envelope, or Transparency specified, the currently processed copy job will be erased.
0 If multiple originals with different passwords are scanned, you will need to enter a password for each
original.
Settings
Copy Guard Type Preset Stamp Select a stamp to be printed from the eight types
available.
Date/Time Specify the type of the date or time to be printed on
paper. The date/time as of scanning the original is
stamped on the paper.
Other Specify Job Number, Serial Number, and Distribution Control Number to be printed on paper. Serial
Number is assigned at the time of shipment of this
machine. For details on settings, contact your service representative.
Detail Settings Specify Text/Background Color, Copy Guard Pattern, Text Size, and Background Pattern to be printed on paper.
ABCD
1234
1234
1234
Draft Draft Draft
Draf aft
Draft
Draft Draft raft
Draft Draft
ABCD
NG
Draft Draft Draft
Draf aft
Draft
Draft Draft raft
Draft Draft
ABCD
12bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-51
5.4 Application
5
% Select [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition] ö [Copy Security] ö [Password Copy].
dReference
To specify and detect a Password Copy:
Select [Utility/Counter] ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Security Details] ö [Password
Copy].
Stamp Repeat
You can print a stamp, the date and time, or other specified items on all pages of the copy.
0 The printing contents of the Stamp Repeat function are printed on all pages.
0 The selected Stamp appear in the order they are placed, and can be used in combination for up to eight
text lines.
0 Use the PageScope Web Connection or Copy Protection Utility to register a registered stamp.
0 Multiple registered stamps or preset stamps cannot be selected.
Settings
Password Enter the password to be embedded in paper.
Stamp Type Preset Stamp Select a stamp to be printed from the eight types
available.
Date/Time Specify the type of the date or time to be printed on
paper. The date/time as of scanning the original is
stamped on the paper.
Other Specify Job Number, Serial Number, and Distribution Control Number to be printed on paper. Serial
Number is assigned at the time of shipment of this
machine. For details on settings, contact your service representative.
Detail Settings Specify Text/Background Color, Password Copy
Pattern, Text Size, and Background Pattern to be
printed on paper.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-52
5.4 Application
5
% Press [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition] ö [Stamp Repeat].
dReference
To delete a registered stamp:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Stamp Settings] ö
[Delete Registered Stamp].
Settings
Registered Stamp Select one from registered stamps.
Preset Stamp Select a stamp to be printed from the eight types available.
Date/Time Select the type of date and time notation. When [None] is selected for Time
Format, the time is not printed.
The date/time as of scanning the original is stamped on the paper.
Other Job Number Select Yes to print the copy job number.
Serial Number Select Yes to print the serial number of this machine.
For details on setting for the serial number, contact
your service representative.
Distribution Control
Number
Prints the distribution control number.
Specify the distribution control number using a value between 1 and 99999999.
Detail Settings Select the Text Color, Density, Text Size and Pattern Overwrite.
Position Change the angle as required when there are no more than four lines in the
selected repeating stamp.
Change Pos./Delete Change the arrangement order. Select the target
Stamp Repeat and press [Up] or [Down].
To add a space to repeated stamps, press [Insert
Space]. Press either [Up] or [Down] to move o that
appears beside the specified Stamp Repeat, and
then press [Insert].
To delete the Stamp Repeat text, press [Delete],
and then press the button for the Stamp Repeat
text to be deleted.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-53
5.4 Application
5
Header/Footer
This setting enables printing the date/time and text at the top or the bottom of the paper. The date/time or a
distribution number can be printed on each page. The header and footer can contain predetermined
contents, but you can also temporarily change the contents.
0 In order to use the Header/Footer function, a header/footer must be registered in advance in
Administrator Settings. If no header/footer is registered in Administrator Settings, the [Header/Footer]
menu does not appear.
% Press [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition] ö [Header/Footer].
dReference
To register a header/footer:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Stamp Settings] ö
[Header/Footer Settings].
Settings
Recall Header/Footer Select a header/footer to be used.
Check/Change Temporarily
Check or temporarily change the contents of the registered header/footer.
Header Settings Select to enable or disable printing of a header/footer. To print a header/footer, configure the
following settings:
Text:
Enter the text for the header/footer.
Date/Time:
Select the type of date and time notation.
Other:
Select to print or not to print the distribution control
number, job number, or serial number.
Footer Settings
Pages Select to print the header/footer on all pages or
only on the first page.
Text Details Select the Text Color, Text Size and Text Type.
Reset Reset the settings to the initial contents.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-54
5.4 Application
5
Watermark
You can print a watermark (light text) at the center of the paper. Select fixed preset text to be printed such
as "Invalid Copy" and "Private".
Copying with a watermark enables explicit indication of the use of the copied paper. It also helps prevent
unauthorized copy from the copied paper.
0 The watermark is printed on all pages at an angle of 45 degrees. It is printed once per page.
0 In case other settings affect the watermark printing to cause partial loss, the Watermark function is
canceled upon copying.
% Press [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition] ö [Watermark].
Settings
Watermark Type Select a watermark from the eight types available.
The watermark selected is printed over the original image.
Text Color Select the watermark color from [Black], [Magenta] and [Cyan].
The watermark is printed in the selected color.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-55
5.4 Application
5
Overlay
Makes copies with the image of the first scanned original page overlapping the subsequent original images.
For example, if you set Overlay to copy three original pages, two pages are output, including "a merged
image of the first and second pages" and "a merged images of the first and the third pages".
The Overlay function is useful for overlay of text, pictures or figures not prepared in other Stamp/Composition
functions on the original.
% Press [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition] ö [Overlay].
Settings
Pages Select to print the overlay image on all pages or only on the first page. Selecting [1st Page Only] prints only on the second page of the original.
Original Size Select [Auto] to detect the size of the original automatically.
If the size of the original is not automatically detected, select the original
size.
Custom Size Enter the original size.
Photo Size Select the photo size.
Density Use the keypad to enter the density of an overlay image (using a value between 20 to 100%).
Color Select the color of overlay image from [full color], [black], [red], [blue],
[green], [yellow], [cyan], or [magenta].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-56
5.4 Application
5
Registered Overlay
This function enables storing of an image from the scanned original as a registered overlay on the hard disk
for later use in copying another original. It is useful to register frequently used overlay images.
% Press [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition] ö [Registered Overlay].
Composition Transparent Composes overlay image to be superimposed and
increases the brightness of the image. This setting
prevents an original from being hidden by the composed overlay image.
Background Composition (Original)
Composes the original as the background. The
overlay image is superimposed on the original
when they are printed.
Back Composes the overlay image as the background.
The original is superimposed on the overlay image
when they are printed.
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-57
5.4 Application
5
Settings
Recall Overlay Image Specify whether to print a registered overlay image on the front or back side.
Press an item to select an overlay image and configures its setting.
• You cannot select an overlay image when no overlay has been registered.
Thumbnail View
Display Name
In the screen view, you can check overlay images.
In the Display Name mode, you can check overlay
images using their file names. Select the desired
overlay image.
Detail Settings Density:
Use the keypad to enter the density of an overlay
image (using a value between 20 to 100%).
Color:
Select the color of overlay image from [full color],
[black], [red], [blue], [green], [yellow], [cyan], or [magenta].
Composition:
Transparent
Composes overlay image to be superimposed and
increases the brightness of the image. This setting
prevents an original from being hidden by the composed overlay image.
Background Composition(Original)
Composes the original as the background. The
overlay image is superimposed on the original
when they are printed.
Back
Composes the overlay image as the background.
The original is superimposed on the overlay image
when they are printed.
Image Details Check the "Name", "Registered Date", "Image
Size" and "Color" of the overlay image.
To confirm the enlarged overlay image, press [Preview].
Register Overlay Image New Enter the name of the overlay image to be registered.
Load the overlay image original on the original
glass and press the [Start] key to have the overlay
image registered.
Overwrite Select an overlay image to use for overwrite and
press [Overwrite].
Load the overlay image original on the original
glass and press the [Start] key to have the overlay
image overwritten.
Delete Select an overlay image to be deleted and press
[Delete].
Detail Settings Density:
Specify the density of an overlay to be registered
between 20% and 100%.
Color:
Select the color for the overlay image to be registered from [Auto Color], [Full Color] and [Black].
Pages Select to print the overlay image on all pages or only on the first page.
Original Size Select [Auto] to detect the size of the original automatically.
If the size of the original is not automatically detected, select the original
size.
Custom Size Enter the original size.
Photo Size Select the photo size.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-58
5.4 Application
5
dReference
To prohibit changing the overlay registration:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Restrict User Access] ö
[Restrict Access to Job Settings] ö [Change Registered Overly].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-59
5.4 Application
5
5.4.9 Card Copy
Separately scans the contents of the front and back sides of a card, for example, insurance card, driver's
license, or business card, and copies them together on one sheet. You can copy a card with the full size or
enlarge an image to fit paper. Using the card copy function, you can save the number of sheets to be used.
0 A card must be placed in the erect mode on the original glass.
0 The card copy function and the auto paper function cannot be selected at the same time.
0 For some zoom values, part of the image may be cut off.
% Select [Application] ö [Card Copy].
dReference
To specify the default of Card Copy:
Select [Utility/Counter] ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Copier Settings] ö [Card Copy].
Settings
Original Size Press [X] and [Y], and enter the size of the card to be copied. Also select the
pre-specified size from [size1] to [size4].
Layout Specify where to place the front and back sides of a card.
Zoom You can copy a card with the full size or enlarge an image to fit paper.
A A
B
Bbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-60
5.4 Application
5
5.4.10 Save in User Box
This function enables saving of data from the scanned originals on the hard disk (in the User Box) built in the
machine. Documents saved in User Boxes can be printed when necessary.
For details on using documents saved in User Boxes, refer to the "User's Guide [Box Operations]".
% Press [Application] ö [Save in User Box].
Settings
User Box Select the destination User Box.
Document Name Specify a document name for the read original.
A name automatically assigned to the document appears. You can change
the file name.
Save & Print [Yes]:
Select to copy the scanned original and save it in the specified User Box.
[No]:
Select to save the data of the scanned original in the specified User Box.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-61
5.5 Left panel display
5
5.5 Left panel display
In the left panel of the basic settings screen, you can view the job list and the job status information.
You can also view the result of the settings being configured.
dReference
To configure settings displayed as the default in the left panel:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Custom Display Settings] ö [Left Panel Display Default].
To prohibit other users from deleting jobs or to give permission to do so:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Restrict User Access] ö
[Restrict Access to Job Settings] ö [Delete Other User Jobs].
To prohibit or permit change if the print priority of jobs:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Restrict User Access] ö
[Restrict Access to Job Settings] ö [Changing Job Priority].
To hide the file name and destination in the job log:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Security Details] ö [Hide
Personal Information].
To delete all job logs:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Security Details] ö
[Initialize] ö [Job History].
Job List Check Job
Settings
Job List Lists jobs currently being performed or waiting to be performed.
If the Left Panel Display Default is set to "Status Display" in User Settings,
the job status is displayed.
Delete To delete a job, select the job from the job list, and
then press [Delete].
Job Details Opens the Job List screen.
Check Job Displays the result of the settings being configured.
Check Details Check or change the current copy settings.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-62
5.5 Left panel display
5
5.5.1 Job List
From the Job List screen, lists of jobs being performed by this machine and the jobs that have been
performed in addition to the job details can be viewed, and the job settings can be changed.
0 If user authentication settings have been applied and the machine is set so that jobs cannot be deleted
by other users, the job is not deleted.
0 If an Administrator Settings parameter was set so that the output priority of jobs cannot be changed,
[Increase Priority] does not appear and the output priority of the jobs cannot be specified.
0 When there is a job being printed, another job can be registered. Up to 251 jobs can be registered in
total.
0 If the authentication method is changed in Administrator Settings and all management data is cleared,
the jobs in the [Job History] are deleted.
% Press [Job List] ö [Job Details] ö [Print].
Settings
Print Opens the screen for checking print jobs.
Send Opens the screen for checking fax and scan transmission jobs. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Receive Opens the screen for checking fax reception jobs. For details, refer to
the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Save Opens the screen for saving jobs. For details, refer to the "User's
Guide [Box Operations]".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-63
5.5 Left panel display
5
Current Jobs Lists the jobs currently processed. Check the current status.
Delete Deletes a job.
Increase Priority
(Displayed for the list
of print jobs in process)
The currently processed print job is interrupted and printing of the job given priority begins. Printing of the interrupted job is
automatically restarted once printing for the
job given priority is finished.
If the currently processed print job cannot be
interrupted because it contains Fold or Staple, the job given priority is executed after the
currently processed print job has been completed.
Release Held Job
(Displayed for the list
of print jobs in process)
Select to switch to the held job list and
change the settings of, print, or delete a held
job.
The held job list contains jobs that could not
be printed because, for example, system
auto reset was activated during the proof
copy.
• If desired, press [Change Settings] to
change the copy settings.
• For confirmation, press the [Proof Copy]
key to print a copy from a stored job.
Check Job Set. Check job settings for stored jobs, jobs being
printed, jobs queued to be printed, and held
jobs.
Current Jobs Detail Check the status, results, error details, user
name, queued time, completed time, number
of original pages and number of copies for
jobs in process.
To delete the job, press [Delete] in the Detail
screen.
Job History Lists completed jobs.
• This list includes jobs that failed because of an error.
• You can check the job logs and results.
• [Scanned Image] in the left panel displays the first page of the selected job with a thumbnail. To display thumbnails in [Scanned Image], set [Job History Thumbnail Display] in Administrator Settings
to [ON]. For details, refer to page 7-51.
Deleted Jobs Displays only jobs that were deleted before
they were finished.
Finished Jobs Displays only jobs that were completed normally.
All Jobs Displays all jobs.
Detail Check the status, results, error details, user
name, queued time, completed time, number
of original pages and number of copies for
jobs in the Job History list.
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 5-64
5.5 Left panel display
5
5.5.2 Check Job
From the Check Job Settings screens, the current copy settings can be checked and changed if desired.
1 Press [Check Job] ö [Check Details].
2 Check the copy settings. To change the copy settings, press the relevant button.
3 After checking the settings, press [Close].6 User Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-2
6
6 User Settings
User Settings are for setting items that a user can adjust as appropriate.
The contents of these setting items depend upon how the Administrator settings are configured. User
Settings cannot be initialized all at once. To initialize all settings, either manually reset them one by one or
contact your service representative.
Settings
System Settings Configure the basic functions of this machine.
Custom Display Settings Change the touch panel display to the convenience of the user.
Copier Settings Configure the settings for copy functions to be used in copy operations.
Scan/Fax Settings Configure setting for fax and scan operations.
Printer Settings Configure setting is for the printer operations.
Change Password Change the password for the user who is currently logged in.
Change E-Mail Address Change the E-mail addresses specified for registered users.
Change Icon Change the icons specified for registered users.
Register Authentication Information
Register or delete the biometric authentication information or IC card authentication information of the current login user.
Cellular Phone/PDA Setting
Configure settings to print data from a cellular phone or PDA.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-3
6.1 System Settings
6
6.1 System Settings
Configure the basic functions of this machine.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [System Settings].
Settings
Language Selection Select the language for display in the touch panel.
Measurement Unit Settings Select the units for the values displayed in the touch panel.
Paper Tray Settings Auto Tray Selection
Settings
Select the trays to be selected automatically
when the Auto Paper Select function is enabled.
Also configure the priority for the auto tray switch
operation to switch paper trays when it is enabled.
• Configure "Auto Paper Selection Setting" to
use paper types other than plain paper as
plain paper in a regular auto paper selection
mode.
Auto Tray Switch
ON/OFF
Select whether a paper tray loaded with paper of
the same size is selected automatically when a
paper tray that was selected manually becomes
empty while printing copies.
No Matching Paper in
Tray Setting
Specify the action to be taken when the matching
paper is not loaded into the specified paper tray.
• [Stop Printing (Tray Fixed)]
Printing stops.
• [Switch Trays (Tray Priority)]
Whether the matching paper is loaded into the
specified paper tray is determined first. And if
not, another tray that has the matching paper
loaded (if any) is selected.
Print Lists Select the paper tray used for printing lists, such
as the sales counter and consumables indicators.
Also select whether to print lists in 1-Sided or 2-
Sided mode.
Post Inserter Settings Specify the paper tray, paper type, or paper size
when using the Post Inserter. This button appears
only when the Post Inserter is installed.
Auto Color Level Adjust. Adjust the reference level for detecting a color or black-and-white original
when the Auto Color setting is selected.
Power Save Settings Refer to page 7-3. Appears when user access is permitted under
Administrator settings.
Output Settings Refer to page 7-4.
AE Level Adjustment Refer to page 7-9.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-4
6.1 System Settings
6
Auto Paper Select for Small
Original
Specify the paper size to be used for a case where the document placed
on the original glass is too small to be detected in Auto Paper mode.
Copy on Small Size Prints on 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 (A5) paper.
• If 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 (A5) paper is not loaded in the
tray, a message that instructs you to load 5-
1/2 e 8-1/2 (A5) paper in the bypass tray appears.
Copy on Letter (Copy
on A4)
Prints on 8-1/2 e 11 (A4) paper.
Prohibit Copy Starts printing when a paper tray is selected manually and the [Start] key is pressed.
Blank Page Print Settings Appears when user access is permitted under Administrator settings. For
details, refer to page 7-26.
Page Number Print Position
Specify a page number print position when printing page numbers after
configuring 2-sided print or booklet settings. Select whether to print the
page numbers on a same position on all pages or on positions symmetric
with respect to the stapling position.
Select Keyboard Select the keyboard type displayed by default in the touch panel.
Factory default
Language Selection English
Measurement Unit Settings This value varies depending on the area.
Auto Tray Selection Settings
Tray Priority
Tray 1 ö Tray 2 ö Tray 3 ö Tray 4 ö LCT
LCT is displayed when the optional LCT is installed.
Auto Tray Switch ON/OFF Restrict
No Matching Paper in Tray
Setting
Stop Printing (Tray Fixed)
Print Lists • Tray 1
• 1-Sided
Post Inserter Settings Paper Tray: F1
Paper Type: Plain Paper
Paper size: Auto Detect
Paper Type Plain paper
Paper Size Auto Detect
Auto Color Level Adjust. Standard (3)
Low Power Mode Settings 15 min.
Sleep Mode Settings 30 min.
Print/Fax Output Settings Print: Page Print
Fax: Batch Print
Output Tray Settings • Copy: Tray 2
• Print: Tray 2
• Print Reports: Tray 1
• Fax: Tray 1
[Output Tray] is displayed when the Finisher FS-526, Finisher FS-527, or
Job Separator JS-504 is installed.
[Tray 3] is displayed if the Job Separator JS-603 is installed in the Finisher
FS-527.
AE Level Adjustment Standard (2)
Auto Paper Select for Small
Original
Prohibit Copy
Blank Page Print Settings Do Not Print
Page Number Print Position
Left & Right Bind: All the Same
Top & Bottom Bind: All the Same
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-5
6.1 System Settings
6
dReference
To enable Auto Paper:
Press [Basic] ö [Paper] ö [Auto Paper].
To enable Auto Color:
Press [Basic] ö [Color] ö [Auto Color].
To configure Background Removal to Auto:
Press [Quality/Density] ö [Background Removal] ö [Auto].
Select Keyboard Local Keyboard
Factory defaultbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-6
6.2 Custom Display Settings
6
6.2 Custom Display Settings
Change the touch panel display to the convenience of the user.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Custom Display Settings].
Settings
Copier Settings Default Tab Select either the standard Basic tab or the Quick
Copy tab as the basic settings screen in Copy
mode.
Shortcut Key 1 Allocate shortcut keys for frequently used Application functions to be added to the basic settings
screen. Pressing a shortcut key displays the desired setting screen.
• When the optional image controller is installed, only one shortcut key can be enabled.
Shortcut Key 2
Quick Settings 1 Allows you to register setting conditions for frequently used copy functions and place them on
the basic settings screen. The registered setting
condition can be invoked by only pressing the
corresponding easy setting key.
Quick Settings 2
Quick Settings 3
Quick Settings 4
Default Tab Density
Settings
Specify whether to display the copy density setting in the basic settings screen. If [ON] is selected, you can press [Dark] or [Light] in the basic
settings screen to adjust the copy density.
• If [ON] is selected, [Quick Settings 3] and
[Quick Settings 4] cannot be specified.
Scan/Fax Settings This setting is for the network scan, fax, and network fax operations. For
details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
User Box Settings Configure settings for the User Box operations. For details, refer to the
"User's Guide [Box Operations]".
Copy Screen Configure whether to display the [Next Box Job], [Next Scan/Fax Job], or
[Next Copy Job] button or messages when you program the next job during the printing operation.
FAX Active Screen This setting is for the fax and network fax operations. For details, refer to
the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Color Selection Settings Select the color used for indicating that the button is selected.
Left Pane Display Default Left Panel Display
Default
Configure whether to display a list of jobs in process and in queue or to display the contents of the
current Copy settings as the default display of the
left panel.
Job Display Setting Configure whether to display a list of jobs in process and in queue or to display the progress of the
current job in process, when the default display of
the left panel set to "Job List".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-7
6.2 Custom Display Settings
6
Search Option Settings This setting is for the network scan, fax, and network fax operations. For
details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Factory default
Default Tab Basic
Shortcut Key 1/Shortcut
Key 2/Quick settings
1/Quick settings 2/Quick
settings 3/Quick settings 4
OFF
Default Tab Density Settings
OFF
Default Tab (Fax/Scan Settings)
Address Book
Program Default
(Fax/Scan Settings)
PAGE1
Address Book Index Default
(Fax/Scan Settings)
Favorites
Shortcut Key 1/Shortcut
Key 2
(Fax/Scan Settings)
OFF
Default Address Book
(Fax/Scan Settings)
Index
Default Address Type
(Fax/Scan Settings)
Group
Default Tab (User Box Settings)
Public
Shortcut Key 1/Shortcut
Key 2 (User Box Settings)
OFF
Copy Operating Screen No
Color Selection Settings Green
Left Panel Display Default Job List
Job Display Setting List Display
Uppercase and lowercase
letters
Differentiate
Search Option Screen OFF
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-8
6.3 Copier Settings
6
6.3 Copier Settings
Configure the settings used by the copy functions.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Copier Settings].
Settings
Auto Booklet ON when
Fold & Staple
Configure whether to automatically specify Booklet when Center Staple
and Fold is selected.
This item is displayed if the saddle stitcher is installed in the finisher.
Auto Zoom for Combine/Booklet
Configure whether the preset zoom ratios are automatically selected when
Combine or Booklet is selected in Auto Paper mode.
• Select the recommended zoom ratios for the following zoom settings:
2 in 1, Booklet: 64.7% (70.7%)
4 in 1: 50.0%
8 in 1: 32.3% (35.3%)
Auto Sort/Group Selection Configure whether to output the copied pages automatically in Sort mode
when copying multiple-page original using the ADF.
Default Copy Settings Configure the initial values for the Copy function to be displayed when the
power in turned on or the [Reset] key is pressed.
Current Setting The current settings are used as the default settings.
Factory Default The factory settings are used as the default settings.
Default Enlarge Display
Settings
This setting is for the enlarged display screen operations. For details, refer
to the "User's Guide [Enlarge Display Operations]".
When AMS Direction is Incorrect
Configure whether to print or discard the job when the original orientation
does not match that of paper in Auto Zoom mode.
Separate Scan Output
Method
Configure the output for divided original loaded in the ADF or for multiple
pages of the original scanned on the original glass.
Page Print Printing of copies that can be printed begins while
the original is being scanned.
Batch Print Printing begins after all pages of the original have
been scanned.
Enlargement Rotation Configure whether to rotate and print a large-size original image when the
original orientation does not match that of paper.
Auto Zoom (Platen) Appears when user access is permitted under Administrator settings. For
details, refer to page 7-43.
Auto Zoom (ADF)
Specify Default Tray when
APS Off
Select Tray for Insert Sheet
Tri-Fold Print Side This item is displayed when user access is allowed in Administrator settings while the Finisher FS-526 is installed. For details, refer to page 7-43.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-9
6.3 Copier Settings
6
Half-Fold/Tri-Fold Specification
Specify whether to apply Half-Fold/Tri-Fold for all pages together or for
specific pages when handling a job containing multiple pages.
When Booklet is selected simultaneously with Half-Fold, all pages are halffolded together even if [One Sheet at a Time] is selected.
If the number of original pages exceeds the folding capacity of this machine, the "Fold" function setting is cancelled automatically, and the sheets
are printed without being folded.
This item is displayed if the Saddle Stitcher SD-508 is installed in the Finisher FS-526.
To change the folding capacity, contact your service representative.
Half-folding capacity setting: 1-3 (default:3)
Tri-folding capacity setting: 1-3 (default:1)
Half-Fold Specification Specify whether to apply Half-Fold together for all pages or for each page
when handling a job containing multiple pages.
When Booklet is selected simultaneously with Half-Fold, all pages are halffolded together even if [One Sheet at a Time] is selected.
If the number of original pages exceeds the folding capacity of this machine, the "Fold" function setting is cancelled automatically, and the sheets
are printed without being folded.
This item is displayed if the Saddle Stitcher SD-509 is installed in the Finisher FS-527.
To change the folding capacity, contact your service representative.
Half-folding capacity setting: 1-3 (default:3)
Print Jobs During Copy
Operation
Appears when user access is permitted under Administrator settings. For
details, refer to page 7-43.
Automatic Image Rotation
Finishing Program Configure whether to display the Finishing Program button in the basic settings screen. To display the button, register the contents of the finishing
program.
Register frequently used finishing functions so that you can set them at
once by using the button that appears in the basic settings screen.
This item is set if the finisher is installed.
Card Shot Settings Appears when user access is permitted under Administrator settings. For
details, refer to page 7-43.
Factory default
Auto Booklet ON when
Fold & Staple
Auto Select Booklet
Auto Zoom for Combine/Booklet
Auto Display Zoom Ratio
Auto Sort/Group Selection Yes
Default Copy Settings Factory Default
When AMS Direction is Incorrect
Print
Separate Scan Output
Method
Page Print
Enlargement Rotation Allow
Auto Zoom (Platen) OFF
Auto Zoom (ADF) ON
Specify Default Tray when
APS Off
Tray Before APS ON
Select Tray for Insert Sheet Tray 2
Tri-Fold Print Side Inside
Half-Fold/Tri-Fold Specification
Multiple Sheets
Half-Fold Specification Multiple Sheets
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-10
6.3 Copier Settings
6
Print Jobs During Copy
Operation
Accept
Automatic Image Rotation When Auto Paper/Auto Zoom Is Set
Finishing Program ON
Card Shot Layout: Top/Bottom
Zoom: Full Size
Store Original Size: X: 3-1/2 inch (89.0 mm) Y: 21 inch (51.0 mm)
Factory defaultbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-11
6.4 Fax/Scan Settings
6
6.4 Fax/Scan Settings
This setting is for the network scan, fax, and network fax operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide
[Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-12
6.5 Printer Settings
6
6.5 Printer Settings
This setting is for the printer operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Print Operations]".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-13
6.6 Change Password
6
6.6 Change Password
Change the password for the user who is currently logged in.
0 A public user cannot use this function.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Change Password].
2 Enter the previous password, and then press [OK].
3 Enter a new password.
4 Press [Password Confirmation], and then enter the new password again.
5 Press [OK].
The new password is registered.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-14
6.7 Change E-Mail Address
6
6.7 Change E-Mail Address
Change the E-mail addresses specified as registered user information.
0 When logged in as a registered user, you can change the E-mail address.
0 Appears when user access is permitted under Administrator settings. For details, refer to page 7-50.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Change E-Mail Address].
2 Press [E-mail Address].
3 Change the E-mail address.
4 Press [OK].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-15
6.8 Change Icon
6
6.8 Change Icon
Change the icon specified as registered user information.
0 When logged in as a registered user, you can change the E-mail address.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [User Settings] ö [Change Icon].
2 Select the icon and press [OK].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-16
6.9 Register Authentication Information
6
6.9 Register Authentication Information
Register or delete the biometric authentication information or IC card authentication information about the
registered users.
You can register or delete authentication information when performing the following operations.
0 Select [Utility/Counter] ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Restrict User Access] ö
[Restrict Access to Job Settings] ö [Biometric/IC Card Info. Registration] ö [Allow].
0 Select [Utility/Counter] ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö [User
Authentication Settings] ö [User Registration] ö [Function Permission] ö [Biometric/IC Card Info.
Registration] ö [Allow].
0 Log in as a registered user.
1 Select Utility/Counter ö [User Settings] ö [Register Authentication Settings].
2 Press [Edit].
To delete authentication information, press [Delete].
For biometric authentication
For IC card authenticationbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-17
6.9 Register Authentication Information
6
3 Register authentication information.
For biometric authentication, place your finger on the Authentication Unit to scan the finger vein pattern.
Scan the finger vein pattern three times; reset the same finger each time and then press [Scan] for each
scanning.
After scanning the finger vein patterns, place the same finger on the authentication unit, and press
[Authentication Test].
If your finger vein patterns have been authenticated in the authentication test, press [Register]. If
authentication has failed, retry scanning the finger.
For IC card authentication, place your IC card on the Authentication Unit, and press [OK].
4 Press [Close].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 6-18
6.10 Cellular Phone/PDA Setting
6
6.10 Cellular Phone/PDA Setting
Configure settings to print data in a cellular phone or PDA through this machine. For details, refer to the
"User's Guide Box Operations" and "User's Guide Print Operations".7 Administrator Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-2
7
7 Administrator Settings
Administrator Settings are used only by the administrator to adjust the settings. Logging on to Administrator
Settings requires the administrator password.
Settings
System Settings Configure the basic functions of this machine.
Administrator/Machine
Settings
Register administrator information and E-mail address of this machine.
One-Touch/User Box Registration
Configure settings for the User Box, network scan, fax, and network fax
operations.
User Authentication/Account Track
Configure the authentication settings to restrict the functions of this machine.
Network Settings Configure settings for the software, cellular phone, or PDA that can be accessed with this machine.
Copier Settings Configure the settings for copy functions to be used in copy operations.
Printer Settings Configure settings for the print operations.
Fax Settings Configure settings for the fax and network fax operations.
System Connection Configure network settings.
Security Settings Configure settings to restrict the functions of this machine for processing
secret data.
License Settings Enable an optional i-Option function.
OpenAPI Authentication
Management Settings
Configure settings to prevent our deprecated OpenAPI connection application from being registered in this machine.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-3
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1 System Settings
Configure the basic functions of this machine.
7.1.1 Power Save Settings
Configure the settings for the power-saving mode.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Power Save
Settings].
Settings
Low Power Mode Settings Enter a time period before switching to the lower power mode when this
machine is not being operated.
Sleep Mode Settings Enter a time period before switching to the sleep mode when this machine
is not being operated.
Power Save Key Configure the type of the power save function to be started when you press
the [Power Save] key.
Low Power Provides power-saving effect higher than normal.
Sleep Although this machine conserves more energy in
the sleep mode than in the power save mode, the
machine must warm-up when the sleep mode is
canceled, therefore taking more preparation time
than the power save mode.
Enter Power Save Mode Configure settings for switching to the power save mode after printing documents from computers or receiving faxes.
Normal Enters the power save mode when the time specified in Low Power Mode Settings has elapsed.
Immediately Enters the power save mode in a short time.
Factory default
Low Power Mode Settings 15 minutes
Sleep Mode Settings 30 minutes
Power Save Key Lower
Enter Power Save Mode Immediatelybizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-4
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.2 Output Settings
Configure the settings for the output functions.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Output Settings].
Settings
Print/Fax Output Settings This setting is for the print and fax operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]" and " User's
Guide [Print Operations]".
Output Tray Settings Configure an output tray given priority for outputting by function.
This item is displayed when the Finisher or Job Separator JS-504 is installed.
Shift Output Each Job Select whether to shift the output paper for each job.
This item is displayed when the Finisher or Job Separator JS-504 is installed.
Factory default
Print/Fax Output Settings Print: Page Print
Fax: Batch Print
Output Tray Settings • Copy: Tray 2
• Print: Tray 2
• Print Reports: Tray 1
• Fax: Tray 1
[Tray 3] is displayed when the Job Separator JS-603 is installed in the Finisher FS-527.
Shift Output Each Job Yesbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-5
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.3 Date/Time Settings
Configure the current date and time and the time zone.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Date/Time Settings].
dReference
To cancel the current settings:
Press the [C] key.
Settings
Year Configure the current date and time.
Monthly
Daily
Hour
Minute
Time Zone Configure the UTC (Coordinate Universal Time) related time zone.
Factory default
Time Zone +00:00bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-6
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.4 Daylight Saving Time
Configure daylight saving time settings.
0 This function is available when this machine is connected to the network where UTC (Coordinate
Universal Time) is specified. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Administrator]".
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Daylight Saving
Time].
Settings
Configure whether to use daylight saving time and the time difference from UTC (Coordinate Universal
Time).
Factory default
Daylight Saving Time Nobizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-7
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.5 Weekly Timer Setting
Configure the weekly timer in order to allow you to turn on and off this machine at the specified date and time.
0 An exact date/time setting must be performed in advance.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Weekly Timer
Settings].
Settings
Weekly Timer ON/OFF Settings
Configure whether to use the weekly timer function.
Time Settings Configure the time of each day of the week to turn on and off this machine.
Set All The setting for the selected day of the week is applied to the same day of the week in other weeks.
Delete Cancels the selected input value.
Date Settings Configure the days when timer operation is activated individually. To cancel the setting, press the same day again.
Daily Setting Configure the days of the week when the timer
operation is activated.
Select Time for Power
Save
Configure the time to turn this machine off and on if you want to turn it off
at a specific time, for example, during a lunch break.
Password for Non- Business Hours
Configure whether to require a user to enter the password if the user uses
this machine outside the specified time.
• To make the user to enter the password, you need to specify the password.
Factory default
Weekly Timer ON/OFF Settings
OFF
Select Time for Power
Save
No
Password for Non-Business Hours
Nobizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-8
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.6 Restrict User Access
Restrict the machine operation, or change or delete the copy programs by the user.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Restrict User
Access].
Settings
Copy Program Lock Settings
Configure the registered copy programs that are prevented from being
changed or deleted.
Delete Saved Copy Program
Delete the registered copy programs.
Restrict Access to Job Settings
Configure whether to allow users to configure the following settings.
Changing Job Priority Configure whether to allow users to change the
print priority of jobs.
Delete Other User
Jobs
Configure whether to allow other users to delete
jobs when the user authentication settings have
been specified.
Registering and
Changing Addresses
This setting is for the network scan, fax, and network fax operations.
For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network
Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Changing Zoom Ratio
Configure whether to allow users to change registered zoom ratios.
Changing the "From"
Address
This setting is for the network scan operations.
For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network
Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Change Registered
Overlay
Configure whether to allow users to change registered image overlays.
Biometric/IC Card Info. Registration
Configure whether to allow a registered user to
register or delete biometric authentication information or IC card authentication information of
the user.
Restrict Operation Restrict Broadcasting
This setting is for the network scan, fax, and network fax operations.
For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network
Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Factory default
Changing Job Priority Allow
Delete Other User Jobs Restrict
Registering and Changing
Addresses
Allow
Changing Zoom Ratio Allowbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-9
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.7 Expert Adjustment
Make adjustments so that output quality is increased.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment].
Changing the "From" Address
Restrict
Change Registered Overlay
Allow
Biometric/IC card Information Registration
Restrict
Restrict Broadcasting OFF
Factory default
Settings
AE Level Adjustment Configure the initial value for AE (auto exposure). The higher the setting,
the more that the original background is emphasized.
Printer Adjustment Adjust the starting print position and defective print images caused by paper type features.
dReference
The starting print position is factory-adjusted. Normally, you
are not required to change the set values.
Leading Edge Adjustment p. 7-13
Centering p. 7-13
Leading Edge Adjustment (Duplex Side 2)
p. 7-13
Centering (Duplex 2nd Side) p. 7-13
Erase Leading Edge Adjust leading edge erase width.
For details on displaying this item,
contact your service representative.
Vertical Adjustment Adjust the feed direction zoom ratio of
paper types.
For details on displaying this item,
contact your service representative.
Media Adjustment p. 7-14bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-10
7.1 System Settings
7
Finisher Adjustment Adjust the staple, folding, and punch position of the finisher.
This button appears only when the finisher is installed.
dReference
Create a sample in advance, and then adjust them while
checking the sample.
Center Staple Position p. 7-14
Half-Fold Position p. 7-15
Tri-Fold Position Adjustment p. 7-15
(This item is displayed when the Finisher FS-526 and Saddle Stitcher SD-
508 are installed.)
Punch Vertical Position Adjustment
p. 7-16
(This item is displayed when the Finisher FS-526 and Punch Kit PK-516
are installed.)
Punch Horizontal Position Adjustment
p. 7-16
Punch Regist Loop Size Adjustment
p. 7-17
Punch Edge Sensor Adjustment p. 7-17
(This item is displayed when the Finisher FS-526 and Punch Kit PK-516
are installed.)
Vertical Punch (Z-Fold) Position
Adjustment
p. 7-17
(This item is displayed when Z Folding
Unit is installed.)
Horizontal Punch (Z-Fold) Position Adjustment
p. 7-18
(This item is displayed when Z Folding
Unit is installed.)
1st Z-Fold Position Adjustment p. 7-18
(This item is displayed when Z Folding
Unit is installed.)
2nd Z-Fold Position Adjustment p. 7-19
(This item is displayed when Z Folding
Unit is installed.)
Punch Unit Size Detect Sensor p. 7-19
(This item is displayed when Z Folding
Unit is installed.)
Post Inserter Tray Size Adjustment
Adjust the paper size to be used in the
Post Inserter. You can specify different paper sizes for the upper and lower trays. This button appears when the
Post Inserter PI-505 is installed.
Density Adjustment Correct the toner amount to be used by color depending on the paper
type.
• To correct the toner amount to be used in the black print mode, press
[Black Image Density].
Image Stabilization Image Stabilization Only Press the [Start] key to stabilize images.
Pressing the [Image Stabilization Only]
button executes normal image stabilization.
If a good result was not achieved after
the [Image Stabilization Only] button
was pressed, execute [Initialize + Image Stabilization].
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-11
7.1 System Settings
7
Image Stabilization Setting Specify the type and opportunity of
image stabilization. If [Standard] is selected, normal stabilization is performed during warm-up processing
when a change in the absolute humidity has been detected during warm-up
processing.
If [Color Priority] is selected, color stabilization is performed when the power has been turned on.
Selecting [Black & White Priority] executes monochrome stabilization during warm-up when absolute humidity
change is detected during the warmup, and then stabilizes color before
performing color print.
Paper Separation Adjustment
Adjust the paper position where the two sides are separated for 2-sided
print.
Color Registration Adjust Correct color shifts if they are detected in the print result.
For details, refer to page 7-20.
Gradation Adjustment Adjust irregular gradation levels of print images.
For details, refer to page 7-21.
Image Stabilization Only Stabilize the image by pressing the
[Start] key before performing gradation adjustment.
Print Adjust the gradation when the color
gradation has been changed in a print
image. This function performs adjustment, emphasizing the gradation expression of an image and the
reproducibility of texts or lines.
Copy Adjust the gradation when the color
gradation has been changed in a print
image. This function performs adjustment to save as many images as possible in memory.
Scanner Area Adjust the scan range of the scanner.
For details on displaying this item, contact your service representative.
ADF Adjustment Make adjustments for scanning images in the ADF.
For details on displaying this item, contact your service representative.
Line Detection Prior Detection Setting
(bizhub C652/C552/C452)
Configure whether to issue an alert
when the slit glass is dirty.
• Select an alert display format and
contamination detection level.
Prior Detection Setting (front)
(bizhub C652DS/C552DS)
Configure whether to issue an alert
when the slit glass (front) is dirty.
• Select an alert display format and
contamination detection level.
Prior Detection Setting (back)
(bizhub C652DS/C552DS)
Configure whether to issue an alert
when the slit glass (back) is dirty.
• Select an alert display format, contamination detection level and display timing.
Feed Cleaning Settings Configure whether to remove a dirt on
the slit glass each time one sheet of
paper passes through the ADF when
scanning an original using the ADF.
Trail Edge Adjust Correct a shift if it is detected at the trailing edge of the print result.
Place, 11 e 17 w, 8-1/2 e 11 v, A3 w, or A4 v on the bypass tray, and
then press the [Start] key to print a test pattern.
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-12
7.1 System Settings
7
User Paper Settings Configure special paper settings for User Paper 1 through 6. Settings to
configure include Basic Weight and Media Adjustment.
For details on displaying this item, contact your service representative.
Erase Adjustment Non-Image Area Erase Operation Settings
Configure Non-Image Area operation
settings.
[Auto]:
Automatically detects the background
density of the original, and selects either "Bevel" or "Rectangular" accordingly.
[Specify]:
Allows you to manually specify an
erase method and original density. As
an erase method, select "Bevel" or
"Rectangular". Specify an original
density from five levels.
Factory default
AE Level Adjustment Standard (2)
Leading Edge Adjustment 0.0 mm
Centering 0.0 mm
Leading Edge Adjustment
(Duplex Side 2)
0.0 mm
Centering (Duplex 2nd
Side)
0.0 mm
Media Adjustment Auto
Center Staple Position 0.0 mm
Half-Fold Position 0.0 mm
Tri-Fold Position Adjustment
0.0 mm
Punch Vertical Position Adjustment
0.0 mm
Punch Horizontal Position
Adjustment
0.0 mm
Punch Regist Loop Size
Adjustment
For Finisher FS-526
Finisher: 0.0 mm
Finisher (for Z folding): 0.0 mm
Post inserter feeder (Upper tray): 0.0 mm
Post inserter feeder (Lower tray): 0.0 mm
For Finisher FS-527: 0
Vertical Punch (Z-Fold) Position Adjustment
0.0 mm
Horizontal Punch (Z-Fold)
Position Adjustment
0.0 mm
1st Z-Fold Position Adjustment
0.0 mm
2nd Z-Fold Position Adjustment
0.0 mm
Post Inserter Tray Size Adjustment
Auto Detect
Density Adjustment 0
Image Stabilization Only Image Stabilization Only
Image Stabilization Setting Standard
Paper Separation Adjustment
0.0 mm
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-13
7.1 System Settings
7
Leading Edge Adjustment
Adjust the starting print position at the leading edge of each type of paper (with respect to the paper feed
direction).
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Printer Adjustment] ö [Leading Edge Adjustment].
% To adjust the starting print position at the leading edge of the second side for 2-sided printing (with
respect to the paper feed direction), press [Leading Edge Adjustment (Duplex Side 2)].
2 Select a paper type to be adjusted.
3 Load the paper into the bypass tray.
4 Press the [Start] key.
A test pattern is printed.
5 Check that the distance from the starting print position of the test
pattern to the edge of the paper (a) is 4.2 mm.
% Press [+] or [-] to adjust the width.
Press the [Start] key to print a test pattern.
6 Press [OK].
Centering
Adjust the starting print position at the left edge of each paper tray (with respect to the paper feed direction).
0 Only 8-1/2 e 11 v (A4 v) paper can be used to adjust the bypass tray.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Printer Adjustment] ö [Centering].
% To adjust the starting print position at the left edge of the second side for 2-sided printing (with
respect to the paper feed direction), press [Centering (Duplex 2nd Side)].
2 Select a paper tray to be adjusted.
3 Press the [Start] kay.
A test pattern is printed.
Color Registration Adjust 0 dot
Prior Detection Setting Yes
Warning Display: TYPE1
Detection Level: Std.
Prior Detection Setting
(front)
Yes
Warning Display: TYPE1
Detection Level: Std.
Prior Detection Setting
(back)
Feed Cleaning Settings Remove
Non-Image Area Erase Operation Settings
Erase Operation: Specify
Erase Method: Rectangular
Original Density: 3
Factory default
a
a:4.2mmbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-14
7.1 System Settings
7
4 Check that the distance from the starting print position of the test
pattern to the left edge of the paper (b) is 3.0 mm (+/-0.5 mm).
% Press [+] or [-] to adjust the width.
Press the [Start] key to print a test pattern.
5 Press [OK].
Media Adjustment
Adjust defective print images caused by paper type features.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Printer Adjustment] ö [Media Adjustment].
2 Select a paper type to be adjusted.
% If defective images exist on the back side of 2-sided copy paper, select [2nd Side].
3 Press [+] or [-] to specify an adjusted value.
% If missing parts or white spots exist in print images, press [-]. If the surface of the print image is
rough, press [+].
4 Press [OK] ö [Close].
5 Copy, and then check the print image.
Center Staple Position
Adjust the stapling position for each paper size when printing with the center staple function.
0 Adjust the half-fold position before adjusting the center stapling position.
0 Before making any adjustments, create a sample using the center staple function. Adjust the center
staple position while checking the created sample.
0 It can be adjusted only when the saddle sticher is installed.
0 When stapling in parallel with the left edge of paper, contact your service representative.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Finisher Adjustment] ö [Center Staple Position].
2 Select the size of paper of which the center staple position is adjusted.
3 Press [+] or [-] to adjust the staple position while checking the sample.
4 Press [OK].
5 Create a sample, and check the print result.
b
b:3.0mm±0.5mmbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-15
7.1 System Settings
7
dReference
To adjust the half-fold position:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment] ö
[Finisher Adjustment] ö [Half-Fold Position].
Half-Fold Position
Adjust the center staple & fold and half-fold positions.
0 Before making any adjustments, create a sample using the half-fold function. Adjust the half-fold
position while checking the created sample.
0 It can be adjusted only when the saddle sticher is installed.
0 When adjusting the half-fold position in parallel with the left edge of paper, contact your service
representative.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Finisher Adjustment] ö [Half-Fold Position].
2 Select the size of paper of which half-fold position is adjusted.
3 Press [+] or [-] to adjust the punched hole position while checking the sample.
4 Press [OK].
5 Create a sample, and check the print result.
Tri-Fold Position Adjustment
Adjust the folding position for each paper size when printing with the tri-fold function. The folding width
depends on the paper size, which cannot be changed.
0 Before making any adjustments, create a sample using the tri-fold function. Adjust the tri-fold position
while checking the created sample.
0 It can be adjusted when the Finisher FS-526 and Saddle Stitcher SD-508 are installed.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Finisher Adjustment] ö [Tri-Fold Position Adjustment].
2 Select the size of paper of which tri-fold position is adjusted.
3 Press [+] or [-] to adjust the tri-fold position while checking the sample.
4 Press [OK].
5 Create a sample, and check the print result.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-16
7.1 System Settings
7
Punch Vertical Position Adjustment
Adjust the vertical position of the punched holes for each paper size.
0 Before making any adjustments, create a sample using the punch settings. Adjust the punched hole
position while checking the created sample.
0 This adjustment is available if the Finisher FS-526 and Punch Kit PK-516 are installed.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Finisher Adjustment] ö [Punch Vertical Position Adjustment].
2 Select the paper size to adjust the vertical punch position.
3 Press [+] or [-] to adjust the punched hole position while checking the sample.
4 Press [OK].
5 Create a sample, and check the print result.
Punch Horizontal Position Adjustment
Adjust the horizontal position of the punched holes. Adjust the horizontal position of the punched holes as
appropriate for each installed option or paper type.
0 Before making any adjustments, create a sample using the punch settings. Adjust the punched hole
position while checking the created sample.
0 The horizontal position of the punched holes can be adjusted as appropriate for each installed option
if the finisher FS-526, punch kit PK-516, and post inserter are installed.
0 This adjustment is available for each paper type if the Finisher FS-527 and Punch Kit PK-517 are
installed.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Finisher Adjustment] ö [Punch Horizontal Position Adjustment].
% Select an option to adjust the horizontal position of the punched holes if the post inserter is installed.
% First, select the paper type if the finisher FS-527 and punch kit PK-517 are installed.
2 Press [+] or [-] to adjust the punched hole position while checking the sample.
3 Press [OK].
4 Create a sample, and check the print result.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-17
7.1 System Settings
7
Punch Regist Loop Size Adjustment
Correct the orientation of the paper and adjust the punched hole position to be parallel with the left edge of
the paper. The punched hole array is corrected by adjusting the resistance applied to the paper for each
paper type.
0 This adjustment is available if the punch kit is installed.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Finisher Adjustment] ö [Punch Regist Loop Size Adjustment].
First select the option to adjust the inclination of punch holes when the Finisher FS-526 and Post
Inserter PI-505 or Z Folding Unit ZU-606 are installed.
2 Select a paper type for which the punch hole angle is adjusted.
3 Press [+] or [-] to adjust the punched hole position.
4 Press [OK].
5 Create a sample, and check the print result.
Punch Edge Sensor Adjustment
If the punch position is displaced depending on the paper tray, the punch kit is automatically adjusted.
0 This adjustment is available if the Finisher FS-526 and the Punch Kit PK-516 are installed.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Finisher Adjustment] ö [Punch Edge Sensor Adjustment].
2 Press the [Start] key.
The punch edge sensor is automatically adjusted.
The adjusted result appears.
Vertical Punch (Z-Fold) Position Adjustment
Adjust the vertical position of the punched holes for each paper size.
0 Before making any adjustments, create a sample using the punch settings. Adjust the center staple
position while checking the created sample.
0 This adjustment is available if the Z Folding Unit is installed.
1 Select [Utility/Counter] ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment] ö
[Finisher Adjustment] ö [Vertical Punch (Z-Fold) Position Adjustment].
2 Select the size of paper of which the vertical punched hole position is adjusted.
3 Press [+] or [-] to adjust the punched hole position while checking the sample.
4 Press [OK].
5 Create a sample, and check the print result.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-18
7.1 System Settings
7
Horizontal Punch (Z-Fold) Position Adjustment
Adjust the horizontal position of the punched holes for each paper size.
0 Before making any adjustments, create a sample using the punch settings. Adjust the center staple
position while checking the created sample.
0 This adjustment is available if the Z Folding Unit is installed.
1 Select [Utility/Counter] ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment] ö
[Finisher Adjustment] ö [Horizontal Punch (Z-Fold) Position Adjustment].
2 Press [+] or [-] to adjust the punched hole position while checking the sample.
3 Press [OK].
4 Create a sample, and check the print result.
1st Z-Fold Position Adjustment
Adjust the first paper folding position for each paper size when using the Z-fold function.
0 Before making any adjustments, create a sample using the Z-fold function. Adjust the center staple
position while checking the created sample.
0 This adjustment is available if the Z Folding Unit is installed.
1 Select [Utility/Counter] ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment] ö
[Finisher Adjustment] ö [1st Z-Fold Position Adjustment].
2 While checking the sample, press [+] or [-] to adjust the first folding position.
3 Press [OK].
4 Create a sample, and check the print result.
1st Z-Fold Positionbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-19
7.1 System Settings
7
2nd Z-Fold Position Adjustment
Adjust the second paper folding position for each paper size when using the Z-fold function.
0 Before making any adjustments, create a sample using the Z-fold function. Adjust the center staple
position while checking the created sample.
0 This adjustment is available if the Z Folding Unit is installed.
1 Select [Utility/Counter] ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment] ö
[Finisher Adjustment] ö [2nd Z-Fold Position Adjustment].
2 While checking the sample, press [+] or [-] to adjust the second folding position.
% The distance between the left end of paper and the second Z-fold position must be 2 mm or more.
3 Press [OK].
4 Create a sample, and check the print result.
Punch Unit Size Detect Sensor
If the punch position is displaced depending on the paper tray, the punch unit is automatically adjusted.
0 This adjustment is available if the Z Folding Unit or Punch Kit PK-516 is installed.
1 Select [Utility/Counter] ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment] ö
[Finisher Adjustment] ö [Punch Unit Size Detect Sensor].
2 Press [Start].
% The punch unit edge sensor is automatically adjusted.
% The adjusted result appears.
2nd Z-Fold Position
2 mm or morebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-20
7.1 System Settings
7
Color Registration Adjust
If color shifts are detected in the print result, adjust the each color print position for each paper type.
0 The procedure for adjusting the color registration is the same for yellow, magenta and cyan.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Color Registration Adjust].
2 Select a color to be corrected.
3 Select a paper type for which color registration is adjusted.
4 Load the paper into the bypass tray.
% The loadable paper size is 11 e 17w, 8-1/2 e 11v, A3 w, or A4 v.
5 Press the [Start] key.
A test pattern is printed.
6 Check that the black line aligns with the color line to be adjusted
at the X and Y positions of the test pattern.
% Press [+] or [-] to adjust the color line to be corrected while checking the sample.
The color registration is adjusted.
7 Press the [Start] key to print a test pattern, and then check the print result.
8 Press [OK].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-21
7.1 System Settings
7
Gradation Adjustment
Adjust irregular gradation levels of print images.
0 Adjust each correction item three times.
1 Turn off the main power switch of this machine.
2 Wait at least 10 seconds, and then turn it on again.
3 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Expert Adjustment]
ö [Gradation Adjustment].
4 Press the [Start] key.
The image stabilization operation starts.
The correction items on the right of the touch panel become enabled.
5 Select an item to be corrected.
6 Select paper used to output a test pattern.
% As a paper size, select 11 e 17w, 8-1/2 e 11v, A3w or A4 v. By default, 11 e 17 w (A3 w) is
selected.
% Paper in the bypass tray cannot be selected.
7 Press the [Start] key.
A test pattern is printed.
% Selecting 11 e 17w or A3w outputs one sheets, and selecting 8-1/2 e 11v or A4v outputs two
sheets.
8 Place the printed test pattern on the original glass in orientation displayed in the touch panel.
% For the test patterns of 8-1/2 e 11v or A4v, place the output two sheets side by side.
9 Place 10 or more sheets of blank paper on top of the test pattern to prevent it from becoming
transparent.
10 Close the ADF.
11 Press the [Start] key.
The test pattern is scanned.
The gradation level is automatically adjusted.
12 Repeat steps 5 through 11 two more times.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-22
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.8 List/Counter
Configure the job settings list print settings and paper count settings for this machine.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [List/Counter].
Settings
Management List Job Settings List Configure paper tray settings for printing the job
settings list and specify a print side.
Paper Size/Type Counter Register a combination of paper size and paper type for a counter. Every
time the counter is changed, the count is reset to 0.
Counter Clear Resets the count to 0.
Paper Size Select the paper size of the counter.
Paper Type Select the paper type of the counter.
Factory default
Job Settings List • 1-Sided
• Tray 1bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-23
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.9 Reset Settings
Configure auto reset settings.
0 All settings performed in the following tabs during operation using the copy function are automatically
reset to the initial settings after the specified time has elapsed.
Basic tab, Original Setting tab, Quality/Density tab, Application tab
0 Even if [OFF] is selected for System Auto Reset Time, the system auto reset function operates when
this machine is not used for one minute during user authentication/account track operations.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Reset Settings].
Settings
System Auto Reset Priority Mode Configure a mode to be displayed in the system
auto reset mode.
System Auto Reset
Time
Configure whether to perform system auto reset.
Specify a time until the initial screen appears if
this machine is not operated. The specified time
is not canceled.
dReference
If user authentication or enhanced security mode is enabled, the administrator settings mode or user
authentication mode is logged off according to the setting for System Auto
Reset Time.
In the enlarge display mode, the system auto reset mode is disabled.
Auto Reset Configure whether to perform auto reset in the selected mode.
Specify a time until the basic settings screen appears and the settings are
reset to the initial values if this machine is not operated.
Job Reset When Account is
changed
Configure whether to reset the settings when you
log off if the user authentication or account track
settings have been configured.
When original is set
on ADF
Configure whether to reset the settings when an
original is loaded in the ADF.
Next Job Configure whether to reset the following settings
when the next job is selected.
• Staple Setting
• Original Set/Bind Direction
• Reset Data After Job
The destination of data is always reset.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-24
7.1 System Settings
7
dReference
To configure user authentication/account track:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö [General
Settings].
7.1.10 User Box Settings
This setting is for the User Box functions. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Box Operations]".
7.1.11 Standard Size Setting
Configure settings relating to the capability for detecting original size and the foolscap paper sizes.
For details on displaying this item, contact your service representative.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Standard Size
Setting].
Factory default
Priority Mode Copy
System Auto Reset Time 1 minute
Auto Reset • Copy: 1 Minute
• Scan/Fax: 1 Minute
• User Box: 1 Minute
When Account is changed Reset
When original is set on ADF Do Not Reset
Next Job • Staple Setting: OFF
• Original Set/Bind Direction: OFF
• Reset Data After Job: Reset All
Settings
Original Glass Original Size
Detect
Configure the capability for detecting original sizes.
8-1/2 e 14/Foolscap Size
Detection
European model (cm) only
Specify whether to detect a size of 8-1/2 e 14 or a foolscap size.
• This item may not be displayed on product sales areas.
Foolscap Size Setting Select the size that you want to use when the paper size is close to 13 inches. bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-25
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.12 Stamp Settings
Configure header and footer settings to be printed.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Stamp Settings].
Factory default
Original Glass Original Size
Detect
Table 1
8-1/2 e 14 Foolscap Size
Detection
8-1/2 e 14
Foolscap Size Setting 8 e 13 w
Settings
Header/Footer Settings Register or change a header and footer.
To use the header/footer function in Application Setting, a header and
footer must be registered in advance.
New Enter a registration name, and then configure detailed header and footer settings.
Configure whether to print a header and footer,
and then configure print contents.
• Text: Enter text.
• Date/Time: Select a format to display the date
and time.
• Other: Specify the distribution control
number. Select whether to include the Job
Number, Serial Number, and Account/User
Name.
Configure pages and text details.
• Pages: Select whether to print the header and
footer on all pages or only on the first page.
• Text Details: Select the color, size, and type of
the text for the header and footer to be printed.
Delete Deletes the selected header or footer.
Check/Edit Change the selected header or footer.
Fax TX Settings This setting is for the fax and network fax operations.
For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Factory default
FAX TX Settings Cancelbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-26
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.13 Blank Page Print Settings
Configure whether to print stamps or overlay on blank pages.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Blank Page Print
Settings].
7.1.14 Skip Job Operation Settings
Configure whether to start processing for the next job when the current job stops due to running out of paper
in the paper tray. Selecting "Yes" provides no print queue time due to job stopping.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Skip Job Operation
Settings].
Settings
Configure whether to print stamp/composition on blank pages.
Factory default
Blank Page Print Settings Do Not Print
Settings
Fax Configure whether to skip a job in the fax mode.
Other than Fax Configure whether to skip a job in a mode other than the fax mode.
Factory default
Skip Job Operation Settings
Fax: Yes
Other than Fax: Yesbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-27
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.15 Default Bypass Paper Type Setting
Configure the initial settings for the paper type to be used for the bypass tray. The initial setting for the paper
type is applied after the job finishes or the tray runs out of paper.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Default Bypass
Paper Type Setting].
7.1.16 Advanced Preview Setting
Configure settings to fax or scan a document. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network
Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Settings
Configure whether to specify the initial setting for paper type for the bypass tray. When you specified this,
select a paper type.
Factory default
Default Bypass Paper Type
Setting
Yes
Paper Type: Plain Paperbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-28
7.1 System Settings
7
7.1.17 Page Number Print Position
Specify a page number print position when printing page numbers after configuring 2-sided print or booklet
settings. Select whether to print the page numbers on a same position on all pages or on positions symmetric
with respect to the stapling position.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Settings] ö [Page Number Print
Position].
Settings
Left & Right Bind: All the
Same
Top & Bottom Bind: All the
Same
Select a desired print position.
Left & Right Bind: Symmetrical
Top & Bottom Bind: All the
Same
Left & Right Bind: Symmetrical
Top & Bottom Bind: Symmetrical
Factory default
Page Number Print Position
Left & Right Bind: All the Same
Top & Bottom Bind: All the Samebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-29
7.2 Administrator/Machine Settings
7
7.2 Administrator/Machine Settings
Register administrator information and E-mail address of this machine.
0 The device name entered under the Input Machine Address may not be supported by your operating
system.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Administrator/Machine Setting].
Settings
Administrator Registration Register administrator information displayed on the Service/Admin. Information screen of the Guidance screen and the From address for sending
E-mail from this machine.
Input Machine Address Register the device name and E-mail address of this machine. The device
name is used as a part of the name of the file created on this machine. The
E-mail address can be used for Internet fax.
Factory default
Device Name The default abbreviation is input for the product name. If necessary, it can
be changed freely.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-30
7.3 One-Touch/User Box Registration
7
7.3 One-Touch/User Box Registration
This setting is for the User Box, network scan, fax, and network fax operations. For details, refer to the "User's
Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]" and "User's Guide [Box Operations]".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-31
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
Configure the authentication settings to control the use of this machine.
Type and functions of authentication
- User Authentication
Appropriate for controlling users. To allow unregistered users to use this machine, public user settings
are required.
– Restricts accessible functions.
– Counts the number of outputting and scanning by user.
– Limits on using color or black printing and on the number of copies that can be set by user.
– Operates a Personal User Box for each user and group box.
– Controls the access allowed level of the destination.
– Prohibits jobs of other users from being deleted.
- Account Track
Appropriate for controlling groups or multiple users.
– Counts the number of outputting and scanning by account.
– Limits on using color or black printing and on the number of copies that can be set by account.
– Operates the group box.
Reference
- Either user authentication or account track settings can be configured, or user authentication can be
synchronized with account track. Settings can be configured for the both and used without being
synchronized.
- A total of 1,000 users and accounts can be registered.
- To register more than 1,000, use PageScope Authentication Manager. You can register up to 30,000
users and accounts.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-32
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
7.4.1 General Settings
Configure the settings for enabling the authentication functions.
0 Before registering a user, select an authentication method. If all management data is cleared after the
authentication method was selected, the histories of the registered users, print, send, receive, and save
jobs are deleted.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö
[General Settings].
Settings
User Authentication Configure whether to use user authentication.
OFF Disables user authentication.
ON (External Server) Restricts users who can access this machine using the external authentication server. This setting
is available when external authentication server
settings are configured.
ON (MFP) Restricts users who can access this machine using this machine.
Public User Access Allows public user accesses when the enhanced security mode is disabled.
Restrict Prohibits unregistered users from using this machine.
ON (With Login) A public user can use this machine after pressing
[Public user] in the Login screen to log in to this
machine.
ON (Without Login) A public user can use this machine without logging in to this machine in the Login screen.
Account Track ON/OFF Configure whether to use the account track function.
Account Track Input Method
Select an authentication method when configuring account track settings.
Account Name &
Password
Enter the account name and password to log in.
Password Only Enter only the password to log in.
• You cannot configure this when user authentication settings are configured.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-33
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
dReference
To configure external server settings:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö [External
Server Settings].
For details on enhanced security settings, contact your service representative.
Synchronize User Authentication & Account Track
Configure the authentication operation settings when both user authentication and account track settings are configured. Configure whether to automatically select the account assigned to the user during logging in.
Synchronize Allows the user to log in to one account assigned
to the user.
The user who succeeded in user authentication
can log in without account track authentication.
dReference
This function is appropriate for managing each user by account.
Do Not Synchronize Allows the user to log in to some accounts.
The user who succeeded in user authentication
performs account track authentication to log in.
When # of Jobs Reach
Maximum
Configure the action of this machine that is taken when the output count of
the job reaches the limit specified for the user or account.
Skip Job Stops the running job, and then automatically
starts the next job.
Stop Job Stops all jobs.
Number of User Counters
Assigned
Configure how many of a total of 1,000 users and account registrations
should be allowed for user registration at maximum. The remaining registration number is for accounts.
When user authentication and account track settings are configured, the
number of counters assigned for users can be specified.
Ticket Hold Time Setting Enter a time to hold the Kerberos authentication tickets. The external server authentication settings are configured, and applied when Active Directory is selected as the authentication server type.
Factory default
User Authentication OFF
Public User Access Restrict
Account Track OFF
Account Track Input Method
Account Name & Password
Synchronize User Authentication & Account Track
Synchronize
When # of Jobs Reach
Maximum
Skip Job
Number of User Counters
Assigned
500
Ticket Hold Time Setting 60 min.
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-34
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
7.4.2 User Authentication Settings
Configure the user and user counter management settings.
0 When only user authentication settings are configured, User Authentication Setting are enabled.
0 If only user authentication settings are configured, up to 1,000 users can be registered. If user
authentication and account track settings are configured, up to 500 users can be registered as initial
settings.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö
[User Authentication Settings].
Settings
Administrative Settings User Name List Configure whether to display a key to display a list
of registered users in the Login screen.
This item is enabled when the enhanced security
settings are disabled.
Default Function Permission
Configure an initial value for function permission
to users who are authenticated on the external
server.
ID & Print Settings Configure whether to use the ID & print function.
Also configure whether to immediately print unauthenticated jobs or public user job or save it in
the ID & Print User Box.
ID & Print Operation
Settings
Configure whether to print all jobs using one authentication or print jobs one by one if multiple ID
& print jobs are accumulated.
Default Operation
Selection
In the Login screen for user authentication where
ID and print jobs are stored, specify the default
values for the operation to be carried out after authentication has been completed.
When using this machine while the ID & print
function is disabled, the user can select [Access]
to log in to this machine without specifying the
operation to be carried out after authentication.
User Registration Register users who can access this machine. Select a desired registration
number, and then press [Edit]. Settings for registered users can be
changed.
• Selecting a user and pressing [Delete] delete the selected user.
• If public user access is allowed, functions available to public users can
be restricted. To change the setting for public users, select the registration number "000".
User Name Enter a user name.
• Once a user name is registered, it cannot be
changed.
• A user name that has already been registered
cannot be used again.
Password Enter the password.
E-Mail Address Enter an E-mail address.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-35
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
Account Name Specify the account track of the registered user
when account track settings are configured,
Before you select an account name, you must
registered it.
Output Permission Apply the following restrictions to the selected
user or all users.
• Print
Configure whether to allow the user to copy
and print in color and black, respectively.
If black copy or print is restricted, print in
black and white cannot be output.
• Send
Configure whether to allow the user to send
fax and E-mail in color.
dReference
Single color and 2 color output settings can be changed by the administrator. For details, refer to page 7-41.
Max. Allowance Set Configure the max. allowance for the selected
user or all users. When not specifying it, select
[No Limit].
• Total Allowance
Specify the number of copies that can be output by the user.
• Individual Allowance
Specify the number of black copies and color
copies that can be output by the user.
Auth.-info.registrieren
Press [Edit], and then register authentication information.
This setting is available when the optional authentication unit is installed.
Function Permission Restrict functions available to the selected user or
all users. Specify whether to allow the following
functions:
• Copy
• Scan
• Fax
• Print
• User Box
• Print Scan/Fax TX
• Save to External Memory
• External Memory Document Scan
• Manual Destination Input (If [Allow] is selected, specify either to allow Manual Destination
Input or manage the destination manually.)
• Limited Color Print (Public user only)
• Biometric/IC Card Regist. Info.
• Mobile/PDA
Pause Suspends the use of this machine for the selected
user. [Stop Job] is selected, the specified user
cannot log in to this machine.
It is convenient to set suspend for users who do
not use this machine temporarily or who have lost
an IC card, instead of deleting them.
• If [All Users] is selected, you can suspend the
use of this machine for all the registered users.
• If suspend is selected for a specific account,
it is also suspended for users who belong to
that account even if [Continue Job] is selected
for this setting.
Icon Select an icon.
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-36
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
dReference
To specify the maximum number of registrations for the user:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö [General
Settings] ö [Number of User Counters Assigned].
User Counter Reset All Counters Resets all counters for all users.
Counter Details Shows the use status for the selected user.
Press [Clear Counter] to reset the counter.
• The public user counter is specified for the
last page.
Factory default
User Name List OFF
Default Function Permission
Save to External Memory/External Memory Document Scan: Restrict
Other items: Allow
ID & Print Settings ID & Print: OFF (when the authentication unit is not installed)
ON (when the authentication unit is installed)
Public User: Print Immediately
ID & Print Operation Settings
Print All Jobs
Default Operation Selection
Begin Printing
Output Permission All Items: Allow
Max. Allowance Set Individual Allowance: Color No Limit/Black No Limit
Total Allowance: No Limit
Function Permission Copy: Allow
Scan: Allow
Fax: Allow
Print: Allow
User Box: Allow
Print Scan/Fax TX: Allow
External Memory Document Scan: Restrict
Save to External Memory: Restrict
Manual Destination Input: Allow/Allow All
Limited Color Print: Restrict
Biometric/IC Card Regist. Info.: Restrict
Mobile/PDA: Allow
Pause Continue Job
Icon
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-37
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
7.4.3 Account Track Settings
Configure the account and account counter management settings.
0 When only account track settings are configured, Account Track Settings is enabled.
0 If only account track settings are configured, up to 1,000 accounts can be registered. If user
authentication and account track settings are configured, up to 500 accounts can be registered as initial
settings.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö
[Account Track Settings].
Settings
Account Track Registration • Select a desired registration number, press [Edit], and then register or
change the account.
• Select an account to be deleted, and the press [Delete].
Account name Specify the account name.
• An account name that has already been registered cannot be used again.
Password Enter the password.
Output Permission Apply the following restrictions to the selected
account or all accounts.
• Print
Specify whether to allow color or black copy
or print output to the user of the account.
If black copy or print is restricted, print in
black and white cannot be output.
• Send
Specify whether to allow the account members to send fax or E-mail in color.
dReference
Single color and 2 color output settings can be changed by the administrator. For details, refer to page 7-41.
Max. Allowance Set Configure the max. allowance for the selected account or all accounts. When not specifying it, select [No Limit].
• Total Allowance
Configure the number of copies that can be
output by a member of the account.
• Individual Allowance
Configure the number of black copies and
color copies that can be output by a member
of the account.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-38
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
dReference
To specify the maximum number of registrations for the account:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö [General
Settings] ö [Number of User Counters Assigned].
7.4.4 Print without Authentication
This setting is for the print operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Print Operations]".
7.4.5 Print Counter List
Select the paper tray and print format to be used for printing the counter list.
0 This function is enabled when user authentication or account track settings are configured.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö
[Print Counter List].
Pause Suspends the use of this machine for the selected
account. If [Stop Job] is selected, the specified
user cannot log in to this machine.
It is convenient to set suspend for accounts that
do not use this machine temporarily, instead of
deleting them.
• If [All Accounts] is selected, you can suspend
the use of this machine for all registered accounts.
• If [Stop Job] is selected, it is also suspended
for users who are belong to the accounts.
Account Track Counter Reset All Counters Resets all counters for all accounts.
Counter Details Shows the use status for the selected account.
Press [Clear Counter] to reset the counter.
Factory default
Output Permission All Items: Allow
Max. Allowance Set Individual Allowance: Color No Limit/Black No Limit
Total Allowance: No Limit
Settings
Settings
Paper Tray Select the desired paper tray.
Simplex/Duplex Select Print (1-Sided) or Print (2-Sided).
Print Item Configure whether to print all data or printing data only.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-39
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
7.4.6 External Server Settings
Configure the external server that performs user authentication.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö
[External Server Settings].
dReference
For details on configuring external server settings, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Administrator]".
7.4.7 Limiting Access to Destinations
This setting is for the network scan, fax, and network fax operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide
[Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]", "User's Guide [Network Administrator]".
Factory default
Print Counter List • Paper Tray: Tray 1
• Simplex/Duplex:1-Sided
• Print Item: All Data
Settings
Select a number for the desired external server. You can also change the settings for the registered servers.
New/Edit Server Name Enter the name of the external server.
Server Type Configure an external server type, and then configure the settings for required items.
Delete Delete the selected external server.
Set as Default Configure an external server specified as the initial value. Select a desired
server, and then press the [Set as Default] button.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-40
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
7.4.8 Authentication Device Settings
Configure the authentication operations when the optional authentication unit is installed.
0 This setting is available when the optional authentication unit is installed.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö
[Authentication Device Settings].
Settings
General Settings Card Authentication Displayed when the Authentication Unit (IC card
type) AU-201 is installed.
• IC Card Type
Select the type of the IC card to be used in this
machine. The FeliCa card ([FeliCa], [SSFC],
[FCF], or [FCF (Campus)]) or Type A card
([Type A]) can be selected. If [FeliCa+Type A],
[SSFC+Type A], [FCF+Type A], or [FCF (Campus)+ Type A] is selected, both the FeliCa and
Type A cards can be used in this machine at
the same time. If [SSFC] or [SSFC+Type A] is
selected, specify [Company Code] or [Company Identification Code].
• Operation Settings
Specify how to log in to this machine. [IC Card
Authentication] allows the user to log in by
simply placing the IC card. [Card Authentication + Password] allows the user to log in by
placing the IC card and entering the password.
Bio Authentication Displayed when Authentication Unit (biometric
type) AU-101 or Authentication Unit (biometric
type) AU-102 is installed.
• Beep Sound
Specify whether to output a beep when reading the finger vein pattern.
• Operation Settings
Specify how to log in to this machine. [1-tomany authentication] allows the user to log in
by simply placing his or her finger on the authentication unit. [1-to-1 authentication] allows the user to log in by entering the user
name and placing his or her finger on the authentication unit.
Logoff Settings Configure whether to log out when scanning of
the original finishes.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-41
7.4 User Authentication/Account Track
7
7.4.9 User/Account Common Setting
Configure the settings for the logout confirmation screen and settings for single color and 2 color output
management if authentication settings have been configured.
0 This function is enabled if authentication function settings have been configured.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [User Authentication/Account Track] ö
[User/Account Common Setting].
7.4.10 Scan to Home Settings
This setting is for the network scan operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network
Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]""User's Guide [Network Administrator]".
7.4.11 Scan to Authorized Folder Settings
This setting is for the network scan, fax, and network fax operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide
[Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]", "User's Guide [Network Administrator]".
Settings
Logout Confirmation
Screen Display Setting
Configure whether to display the logout confirmation screen when you
press the [Access] key to log out.
Single Color > 2 Color Output Management
Configure whether to manage the output of single color or 2 color as color
print or black print.
When managing it as black print, even a user who is restricted from performing color print can perform single color or 2 color output.
dReference
For details on output permission for users, refer to page 7-34 or
page 7-37.
Factory default
Logout Confirmation
Screen Display Setting
ON
Single Color > 2 Color Output Management
Colorbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-42
7.5 Network Settings
7
7.5 Network Settings
This setting is for the network operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Administrator]".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-43
7.6 Copier Settings
7
7.6 Copier Settings
Configure the settings used by the copy functions.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Copier Settings].
Settings
Auto Zoom (Platen) Configure whether Auto Select is automatically selected when a paper tray
is selected manually while an original is placed on the original glass.
Auto Zoom (ADF) Configure whether Auto Select is automatically selected when a paper tray
is selected manually while an original is placed in the ADF.
Specify Default Tray when
APS Off
Configure which paper tray to be selected when the APS (Auto Paper) setting is canceled.
Tray Before APS ON Uses the paper tray specified before the APS was
selected.
Default Tray Uses Tray 1.
Select Tray for Insert Sheet Configure the default paper tray loaded with paper for the cover pages
(front cover), inserted sheets and the chapter title pages.
Print Jobs During Copy
Operation
Configure whether to accept print data or fax data while a copy operation
is being performed.
Accept Accepts print data or fax data to print.
Receive Only Prints print data or fax data after the copy operation is finished.
Tri-Fold Print Side Configure whether the printed side is on the inside or the outside when the
page is folded in three.
This function is enabled when the finisher FS-526 and Saddle Sticher SD-
508 are installed.
Automatic Image Rotation When the original orientation is different from paper orientation, the image
is rotated depending on the setting. Configure when the image is automatically rotated.
Copy Card Settings Register card copy setting.
If [Card Copy] is selected in [Application], the function can be invoked with
the registered setting.
Layout Specify where to place the front and back sides
of a card.
Zoom Specify to copy a card with the full size or enlarge
an image to fit paper.
Store Original Size Change and register the pre-specified original
size or [Original Name].
Factory default
Auto Zoom (Platen) OFF
Auto Zoom (ADF) ONbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-44
7.6 Copier Settings
7
Specify Default Tray when
APS Off
Tray Before APS ON
Select Tray for Insert Sheet Tray 2
Print Jobs During Copy
Operation
Accept
Tri-Fold Print Side Inside
Automatic Image Rotation When Auto Paper/Auto Zoom is Set
Card Shot Settings Layout: Top/Bottom
Zoom: Full Size
Factory defaultbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-45
7.7 Printer Settings
7
7.7 Printer Settings
This setting is for the print operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Print Operations]".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-46
7.8 Fax Settings
7
7.8 Fax Settings
This setting is for the fax and network fax operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network
Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-47
7.9 System Connection
7
7.9 System Connection
Configure settings for software, cellular phone, or PDA that can be accessed with this machine.
% [Utility/Counter] ö [Administrator Settings] ö [System Connection]
Settings
OpenAPI Settings Access Setting Specify whether to allow the user to access this
machine from other system that is using OpenAPI.
SSL/Port Settings SSL Setting To use SSL encryption,
select [SSL Only] or
[SSL/Non-SSL].
• If Enhanced Security Mode is enabled,
[SSL Only] is enabled.
Port No. Enter a port number.
Port No. (SSL) Enter the port number
to be used for SSL
communication.
Client Certificate Request
Specify whether to enable a client certificate
request. If you authenticate the client by requesting for its
certificate (verification
of client certificate), select [Enable].
Certificate Verification
Level Settings
To verify a certificate,
configure settings to
verify the certificate.
[Validity Period]:
Select whether to
check that the target
certificate is within the
validity period.
[Key Usage]:
Select whether to
check that the certificate key is being used
properly.[Chain]: Select whether to check
that the certificate
chain (certification
path) is correct.
[Expiration Date Confirmation]:
Select whether to
check the target certificate for validation.
[CN]:
Select whether to
check that the CN of
the certificate matches
the server address.
Authentication Specify whether to authenticate an access from
other system that is using OpenAPI.
• To authenticate, enter the login name and
password in [Login Name] and [Password]
• When user authentication is performed or when
acquiring the device information with the PageScope Authentication Manager, set the Authentication setting of the OpenAPI Setting
screen of the machine to [OFF].
Automatic Prefix/Suffix
Setting
Select whether to automatically add prefix and suffix to a destination number.
If [Automatic Prefix/Suffix Setting] is set to [ON], the other settings will be restricted. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Administrator]".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-48
7.9 System Connection
7
Printer Information Specify [Printer Name], [Printer Location], [Printer Information], and [Printer
URI].
The [Printer Information] setting is linked to [Printer Information] in [HTTP Server Settings].
Cellular Phone/PDA
Setting
Specify whether to allow the user to print data in a cellular phone or PDA or
save such data in a User Box.
Factory default
Access Setting Possible to combine
SSL Setting Non-SSL Only
Client Certificates Disable
Validity Period Confirm
Key Usage Do Not Confirm
Chain Do Not Confirm
Expiration Date Confirmation
Do Not Confirm
CN Do Not Confirm
Authenticate OFF
Automatic Prefix/Suffix
Setting
OFF
Cellular Phone/PDA Setting
Restrict
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-49
7.10 Security Settings
7
7.10 Security Settings
Configure the settings for the restricting the functions of this machine for processing secret data.
7.10.1 Administrator Password
Change the administrator password.
0 The administrator password can be entered using 0 through 8 digits.
0 If password rules are specified, an 8-digit password must be entered.
0 If you enter an incorrect administrator password a configured number of times, you are prohibited from
using this machine. In this case, contact your service representative.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Administrator
Password].
2 Enter the administrator password, and then press [OK].
3 Enter a new administrator password.
4 Press [Password Confirmation], enter the administrator password again, and then press [OK].
5 Press [OK].
The password is changed.
dReference
To configure password rule settings:
Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Security Details] ö
[Password Rules].
7.10.2 User Box Administrator Setting
Configure settings for the User Box operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Box Operations]".
Factory default
Administrator Password 12345678bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-50
7.10 Security Settings
7
7.10.3 Administrator Security Levels
Configure settings so that the user can change some of the settings accessible only to the administrator.
Settings allowed to the user appear in User Settings.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Administrator
Security Levels].
Settings
Level 1 Allows the user to change the following settings.
• Power Save Settings
• Auto Zoom (Platen)
• Auto Zoom (ADF)
• Specify Default Tray when APS Off
• Select Tray for Insert Sheet
• Automatic Image Rotation
• Card Shot Settings
Level 2 Allows the user to change the following settings.
• All settings allowed in Level 1
• Output Settings
• AE Level Adjustment
• Blank Page Print Settings
• Change E-Mail Address
• Print Jobs During Copy Operation
Prohibit Does not allow the user to change the settings allowed in Level 1 and Level
2.
Factory default
Administrator Security Levels
Prohibitbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-51
7.10 Security Settings
7
7.10.4 Security Details
Configure security detail settings to restrict the functions of this machine. You can restrict the functions to
enhance security.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Security Details].
Settings
Password Rules Configure whether to enable the password rules.
When enabled, the restrictions are applied to the following passwords. The
set passwords must be changed to ones that meet the conditions.
• Administrator password
• User password
• Account password
• User Box password
• Security document password
• Specify a password in 8 or more digits.
• Uppercase and lowercase letters are differentiated.
• Only half-width symbols can be used. For some of the passwords,
specification of """, "+", and "space" is restricted.
• A password that consists of a repetition of the same character cannot
be specified.
• The same password as one before being changed cannot be registered.
Prohibited Functions When
Authentication Error
Configure restrictions on operation when you enter one of the following
passwords incorrectly.
• User password
• Account password
• User Box password
• Security document password
• Administrator password
Mode 1 Disables operations for a specified time if authentication fails.
Mode 2 Disables operations of the control panel if authentication fails.
Specify the max. allowance for authentication operation frequency.
Release Releases the prohibited operations due to failure
in authentication, enabling the operations.
Release Time Settings
Configure the length of time until prohibited operations are automatically released.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-52
7.10 Security Settings
7
Confidential Document Access Method
Synchronizes with the settings for "Prohibited Functions When Authentication Error", automatically changes it.
• Mode 1
Requires entering security document ID and password before selecting
a security document from a User Box.
• Mode 2
Performs authentication based on the password after you enter the security document ID and select a security document from a User Box.
Manual Destination Input This setting is for the network scan, fax, and network fax operations. For
details, refer to the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Print Data Capture This setting is for the print operations. For details, refer to the "User's
Guide [Print Operations]".
Job Log Settings Configure job log settings to be obtained when power is turned off and on.
Specify the type of obtain log and whether to permit overwriting.
Pressing [Erase Job Log] erases the job log.
Restrict Fax TX This setting is for the fax and network fax operations. For details, refer to
the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Hide Personal Information
Hide Personal Information
(MIB)
Specify whether to display the file name, address, or User Box number as
MIB information in Job List.
Display Activity Log This setting is for the fax and network fax operations. For details, refer to
the "User's Guide [Network Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Initialize Initializes Job History, Network Settings, Copy Program, or Store Address.
Job History Thumbnail Display
Configure whether to perform thumbnail display when displaying the job
history.
Secure Print Only This setting is for the print operations. For details, refer to the "User's
Guide [Print Operations]".
Copy Guard Specify whether to use the Copy Guard function.
If [Copy Guard] is selected in [Application], you can embed copy inhibit information on paper. You can also detect copy inhibit information embedded on paper.
• Displayed when the optional Security Kit is installed.
Password Copy Specify whether to use the Password Copy function.
If [Password Copy] is selected in [Application], you can embed a password
on paper. You can also detect a password embedded on paper.
• Displayed when the optional Security Kit is installed.
Factory default
Password Rules Invalid
Prohibited Functions When
Authentication Error
• Mode 1
• Release Time Settings: 5 min.
Confidential Document Access Method
Mode 1
Manual Destination Input Allow All
Print Data Capture Allow
Job Log Settings No
Restrict Fax TX OFF
Hide Personal Information OFF
Hide Personal Information
(MIB)
ON
Display Activity Log ON
Job History Thumbnail Display
OFF
Secure Print Only No
Settingsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-53
7.10 Security Settings
7
Copy Guard No
Password Copy No
Factory defaultbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-54
7.10 Security Settings
7
7.10.5 Enhanced Security Mode
The enhanced security mode cannot be enabled when any of the current functional settings conflict with the
enhanced security mode.
When the enhanced security mode is enabled, the settings required for the mode or the settings that have
been forcibly switched when entering the mode cannot be changed.
Required settings
To enable the enhanced security mode, the following settings must have been configured.
Settings to forcibly changed
When the enhanced security is enabled, the following settings are forced.
- The changed settings will not revert when the enhanced security mode is turned off.
- After the password rules have been changed, any passwords that do not comply with the changed rules
will not be authenticated. For details on the password rules, refer to page 7-51.
- For details on the network settings to be forcibly changed, refer to the "User's Guide [Network
Scan/Fax/Network Fax Operations]".
Administrator Settings Required settings
User Authentication/Account Track / General Settings / User Authentication
Select either [ON (External Server)] or [ON (MFP)].
• When you enable account track, select [Account Name & Password] for the account track
input method.
Security Settings / Administrator Password Set a password complying with password rules.
Security Settings / HDD Settings / HDD Lock Password
Set an HDD lock password.
[Security] in PageScope Web Connection / PKI
Settings / SSL Setting
• Set [Mode using SSL/TLS] to [Administrator
mode] and [User mode].
• Set [Encryption Strength] to [AES-256] or
[3DES-168].
• Image controller setting
• Management function setting
• CE password
• CE authentication function
• HDD installation setting
All the settings above must be configured by your
service representative.
These items must be configured by your service
representative. For details, contact your service
representative.
Administrator Settings Settings to forcibly changed
System Settings / Restrict User Access / Restrict
Access to Job Settings / Registering and Changing
Addresses
Set to [Restrict].
User Authentication/Account Track / General Settings / Pubic User Access
Set to [Restrict].
User Authentication/Account Track / User Authentication Settings / Administrative Settings / User
Name List
Set to [OFF].
User Authentication/Account Track / Print without
Authentication
Set to [Restrict].
Network Settings / FTP Setting / [FTP Server Settings]
[FTP Server Settings] is not displayed.
Network Settings / SNMP Setting / SNMP v1/v2c
Settings
[Write Setting] is set to [Disable].
Network Settings / SNMP Setting / SNMP v3 Settings
In [Write User], [Security Level] cannot be set to
[OFF].
Network Settings / TCPSocket Settings [Use SSL/TLS] is set to [ON].
Network Settings / WebDAV Settings / WebDAV
Server Settings / SSL Settings
Set to [SSL Only].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-55
7.10 Security Settings
7
If [Enhanced Security settings] is enabled, various security functions are configured to allow you to ensure
the higher-level security of data management. For details, contact your service representative. To enable the
enhanced security mode, the following settings must first be configured. Different screens appear depending
on the current settings.
7.10.6 HDD Settings
This setting is for the hard disk operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Box Operations]".
System Connection / OpenAPI Setting Set to [SSL Only].
Security Settings / User Box Administrator Setting Set to [Restrict].
Security Settings / Security Details / Password
Rules
Set to [Enable].
Security Settings / Security Details / Prohibited
Functions When Authentication Error
Set to [Mode 2], and the number of tries is set to 3.
• The number of tries can be changed to 1, 2, or
3.
Security Settings / Security Details / Prohibited
Functions When Authentication Error / Release
Time Settings
The allowable setting range is limited to 5 or more
minutes. This value cannot be less than 5 minutes.
Security Settings / Security Details / Confidential
Document Access Method
Set to [Mode 2].
Security Settings/Security Details/Print Data Capture
Set to [Restrict].
Security Settings/Security Details/Hide Personal
Information (MIB)
Set to [ON].
Security Settings / Security Details / Initialize / Network Settings
[Network Settings] is not displayed.
Security Settings/Security Details/Job History
Thumbnail Display
Set to [OFF].
Security Settings / Image Log TX Setting Set to [OFF].
Review Secure Print User Box Only the list is displayed before the password authentication is performed.
[Network] in PageScope Web Connection / E-Mail
Setting / S/MIME
[Automatically Obtain Certificates] is set to [No].
[E-Mail Text Encryption Method] is set to [3DES].
[Maintenance] in PageScope Web Connection /
Reset / Network Setting Clear
[Network Setting Clear] is not displayed.
[Security Administrator] in PageScope Web Connection / Password Setting
[Administrator Password Setting] is not displayed.
CS Remote Care Restricts the device setting in the remote mode
based on CS Remote Care.
Administrator Settings Settings to forcibly changedbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-56
7.10 Security Settings
7
7.10.7 Function Management Settings
Configure the settings for the network functions that are difficult to count.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Function
Management Settings] .
Settings
Network Function Usage
Settings
ON Configure the settings for the network management that are difficult to count when managing
operations.
OFF The following functions cannot be used if "Network Function Usage Settings" is set to "OFF".
• PC-FAX transmission
• Using the HDD TWAIN driver to view and retrieve documents in User Boxes
• Using PageScope Box Operator to view and
retrieve documents in User Boxes
• Using PageScope Scan Direct to retrieve documents in User Boxes
• Box operations using PageScope Web Connection (The User Box tab does not appear.)
Factory default
Network Function Usage
Settings
ONbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-57
7.10 Security Settings
7
7.10.8 Stamp Settings
Manage the stamp.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [Security Settings] ö [Stamp Settings].
dReference
To configure copy protect and stamp repeat settings:
Press [Application] ö [Stamp/Composition].
7.10.9 Driver Password Encryption Setting
This setting is for the print operations. For details, refer to the "User's Guide [Print Operations]".
Settings
Stamp Settings Apply Stamps Configure whether to add a stamp when printing
or sending.
To add a stamp, configure stamp contents settings.
dReference
If a stamp is added, print settings cannot be configured in "Stamp/Composition" of "Application".
Delete Registered
Stamp
• Stamp
Deletes all registered stamps.
• Copy Protect/Stamp Repeat
Deletes all stamps registered in Copy Protect
and the stamp repeat function.
Factory default
Apply Stamps Printing: Do Not Apply
Sending: Do Not Applybizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-58
7.11 License Settings
7
7.11 License Settings
Enable the functions of an optional component i-Option LK-101, LK-102, LK-103 or LK-105. For details on
the enabling procedure, refer to the "Quick Guide [Copy/Print/Fax/Scan/Box Operations]".
0 An optional component i-Option LK-101, LK-102, LK-103 or LK-105 must be purchased. For details,
contact your service representative.
% Press the [Utility/Counter] key ö [Administrator Settings] ö [License Settings] .
Reference
- When the functions of an optional component i-Option LK-101, LK-102, LK-103 or LK-105 are enabled,
the enabled functions can be checked with [List of Enabled Functions].
Settings
Get Request Code Issue a request code for this machine to be registered in the license management server (LMS).
Install License Enter the function code and license code obtained from the license management server (LMS).bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 7-59
7.12 OpenAPI Authentication Management Settings
7
7.12 OpenAPI Authentication Management Settings
Configure settings to prevent our deprecated OpenAPI connection application from being registered in this
machine. For details, contact your service representative.8 Maintenancebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-2
8.1 Paper
8
8 Maintenance
8.1 Paper
8.1.1 Checking the paper
Replenishment message
If a tray has run out of paper during printing, load paper or change the paper tray. Load paper in the paper
tray that is highlighted in color.
Precautions regarding the use of paper
Do not use the following types of paper. Not observing these precautions may lead to reduced print quality,
a paper jam or a damage to the machine.
- OHP transparencies that have already been fed through the machine (even if they are still blank)
- Paper that has been printed on with a heat-transfer printer or an inkjet printer
- Folded, curled, wrinkled, or torn paper
- Paper that has been left unwrapped for a long period of time
- Damp paper, perforated paper, or paper with punched holes
- Extremely smooth or extremely rough paper, or paper with an uneven surface
- Paper that has been treated, such as carbon-backed, heat-sensitive or pressure-sensitive paper
- Paper that has been decorated with foil or embossing
- Paper of a non-standard shape (paper that is not rectangular)
- Paper that is bound with glue, staples or paper clips
- Paper with labels attached
- Paper with ribbons, hooks, buttons, etc., attached
Paper storage
Store paper in a cool, dark location with little humidity. If the paper becomes damp, a paper jam may occur.
Store the paper flat, not on its edge. Curled paper may cause a paper jam.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-3
8.1 Paper
8
8.1.2 Loading paper
This section describes how to load paper into each tray.
If printing stops due to the tray being empty, load paper into the tray. Printing restarts automatically.
For the types of paper to be used, refer to page 12-2.
Loading paper into trays 1 and 2
The same procedures can be used to load paper into trays 1 and 2.
The following procedure describes how to load paper into tray 1.
0 When "Auto Detect" is selected on the "Paper" tab, the size of loaded paper is automatically detected.
1 Pull out tray 1.
NOTICE
Be careful not to touch the film.
2 Slide the lateral guides to fit the size of paper being loaded.
% If the lateral guides are not positioned correctly for the loaded
paper, the paper size will not be correctly detected.
3 Load the paper into the tray so that the side of the paper to be
printed on (the side facing up when the package was unwrapped)
faces up.
% Do not load so many sheets of paper that the top of the stack
is higher than the mark.
% If paper is curled, flatten it before loading it.
% If special paper is loaded, the paper type must be specified.
% Load letterhead paper so that the side to be printed on faces
down.
4 Close tray 1.
dReference
To configure paper settings:
Press [Basic] ö [Paper].
Filmbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-4
8.1 Paper
8
Loading paper into trays 3 and 4
The same procedures can be used to load paper into trays 3 and 4.
The following procedure describes how to load paper into tray 3.
1 Pull out tray 3.
NOTICE
Be careful not to touch the surface of the paper take-up roller with
your hand.
2 Lift up the paper take-up roller, and then load the paper into the
tray.
% Load the paper into the tray so that the side of the paper to be
printed on (the side facing up when the package was
unwrapped) faces up.
% Do not load so many sheets of paper that the top of the stack
is higher than the mark.
% Do not load tray 3 with paper of a size other than that
previously specified.
% If paper is curled, flatten it before loading it.
% If special paper is loaded, the paper type must be specified.
% Load letterhead paper so that the side to be printed on faces down.
% To change the paper size for tray 3, contact your service representative.
3 Lower the paper take-up roller, and then close tray 3.
dReference
To configure paper settings:
Press [Basic] ö [Paper].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-5
8.1 Paper
8
Loading paper into the bypass tray
1 Open the bypass tray.
% To load large-sized paper, pull out the tray extension.
NOTICE
Be careful not to touch the surface of the paper take-up roller with
your hand.
2 With the side to be printed on facing down, insert the paper as far as possible into the feed slot.
% The image will be printed on the surface of the paper facing down when the paper is loaded into the
bypass tray.
% Do not load so many sheets of paper that the top of the stack is higher than the mark.
% If paper is curled, flatten it before loading it.
% Push the paper guides firmly up against the edges of the paper.
% Load letterhead paper so that the side to be printed on faces up.
% When loading postcards:
Load them in the w orientation, as shown in the illustration.
To use postcards other than 4 e 6-size (A6-size), check the
size of postcards to be used, and then select the size on the
Custom Size screen before using them.
% When using envelopes:
Expel air from the envelopes, and then load them while holding
the folds of the envelopes.
Load them with the flap side up, as shown in the illustration.
The flap side of envelopes cannot be printed on.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-6
8.1 Paper
8
% To load label sheets:
Load them in the w orientation, as shown in the illustration.
A label sheet consists of the printing surface, sticking layer,
and pasteboard. Peel off the pasteboard, then you can stick
the label to other objects.
3 Slide the lateral guides to fit the size of paper being loaded.
4 Select the paper type.
% To use label sheets, select [Thick 1].
% OHP transparencies can be printed only in black. Before selecting OHP transparencies, select
[Black] in the Color tab.
% If you select [4 e 6 w (A6 Card w)], the paper type is automatically set to [Thick 3].
dReference
To configure paper settings:
Press [Basic] ö [Paper].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-7
8.1 Paper
8
Loading paper into the LCT
The same procedures can be used to load paper into the Large capacity unit LU-301 and LU-204.
The following procedure describes how to load paper into Large capacity unit LU-301.
0 To change the paper size, contact your service representative.
1 Open the upper door.
NOTICE
Be careful not to touch the surface of the paper take-up roller with
your hand.
2 Lift up the paper take-up roller, and then load the paper into the
tray.
% Load the paper into the tray so that the side of the paper to be
printed on (the side facing up when the package was
unwrapped) faces down.
% Do not load so many sheets of paper that the top of the stack
is higher than the mark.
% Do not load the LCT with paper of a size other than that
previously specified.
% If paper is curled, flatten it before loading it.
% If special paper is loaded, the paper type must be specified.
% Load letterhead paper so that the side to be printed on faces
up.
dReference
To configure paper settings:
Press [Basic] ö [Paper].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-8
8.2 Consumables
8
8.2 Consumables
8.2.1 Checking comsumables
Replacement message
When it is time to replace the Toner Cartridge or Imaging Unit, an advanced warning message appears at the
top of the screen.
For the replacement procedure, refer to the guidance or the [Quick Guide Copy/Print/Fax/Scan/Box
Operations].
For details on using the guidance, refer to the [Quick Guide Copy/Print/Fax/Scan/Box Operations].
When the message appears, make a preparation and replace the Toner Cartridge or Imaging Unit according
to the guidance contained in your maintenance agreement.
When it is almost time to replace the Toner Cartridge, an advanced warning message similar to the one
shown below appears.
When the message appears, prepare to replace the Toner Cartridge according to the guidance contained in
your maintenance agreement.
When it is time to replace the Toner Cartridge or Imaging Unit, an advanced warning message similar to the
one shown below appears. Replace them according to the guidance contained in your maintenance
agreement.
- Do not replace any color other than the one indicated in the message in the touch panel.
- For the Toner Cartridge, the machine stops operating after the message appears.
Toner Cartridgebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-9
8.2 Consumables
8
Imaging Unit
NOTICE
Do not replace the Imaging Unit until a "Please replace following unit(s)." message appears.
If you continue to use the drum unit while an advanced warning message is displayed, the following
replacement message appears. Replace the drum unit according to the guidance contained in your
maintenance agreement.
Toner Cartridge
Imaging Unit
If a Toner Cartridge other than for black or the Imaging Unit is empty, printing can continue using black. Press
[Continue], and then select the job to be printed.
Replacement by user Replacement by service representative
Replacement by user Replacement by service representativebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-10
8.2 Consumables
8
Checking consumables status
In the Check Consumable Life screen, you can check the status (usage level) of consumables.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Check Consumable Life].
% To print the list of usage levels, press [Print List], then [Start] or the [Start] key.
Viewing counters
In the Meter Count screen, you can check the total number of prints since counting started. In the Coverage
Rate screen, the consumed amount of toner can be viewed.
1 Press the [Utility/Counter] key.
2 Press [Meter Count] ö [Check Details].
% To print the counter list, press [Print List], select paper, and then press the [Start] key.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-11
8.2 Consumables
8
% To display the Coverage Rate screen, press [Coverage Rate].
Checking the total number of pages printed
Pressing Total Counter displays the total number of pages printed to
date.
Total Counterbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-12
8.3 Cleaning procedure
8
8.3 Cleaning procedure
Slit glass (bizhub C652/C552/C452)
NOTICE
Do not touch the slit glass.
1 Open the ADF, and then remove the slit glass cleaner.
2 Wipe stains off the slit glass using the slit glass cleaner.
% Wipe off stains from the back side to the front side along the
guide.
Slit glass (front) (bizhub C652DS/C552DS)
NOTICE
Do not touch the slit glass (front).
1 Open the ADF, and then remove the slit glass cleaner.
2 Wipe stains off the slit glass using the slit glass (front) cleaner.
% Wipe off stains from the back side to the front side along the
guide. bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-13
8.3 Cleaning procedure
8
Slit glass (back) (bizhub C652DS/C552DS)
NOTICE
Do not touch the slit glass (back).
1 Open the ADF, and then remove the slit glass cleaner.
2 Open the opening and closing guide.
3 Wipe stains off the slit glass using the slit glass (back) cleaner.
% Wipe off stains from the back side to the front side along the
guide.
Original glass, control panel, paper take-up roller
NOTICE
Do not press the control panel hard, or the keys and touch panel may be damaged.
% Wipe the surface using a soft, dry cloth.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 8-14
8.3 Cleaning procedure
8
Housing, document pad
NOTICE
Never use solvents, such as benzene or thinner, to clean the document pad.
% Wipe the surface using a soft cloth moistened with a mild household detergent.9 Troubleshootingbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-2
9.1 When the message "Trouble" appears (call a service representative)
9
9 Troubleshooting
This chapter describes troubleshooting.
9.1 When the message "Trouble" appears (call a service
representative)
If this message appears, perform the operation described in the message. If the problem is not resolved,
perform the following operations, and then contact your service representative.
Normally, the phone number and fax number of your service representative appear in the center of the
screen.
If a defective part can be separated in order to be able to continue operations after a problem has been
detected, [Continue] or [Recover Data] is displayed. To continue operations, select any key. However, the
problem has not been resolved, so contact your service representative immediately.
Problems that cannot be corrected by the user
1 Write down the malfunction code in the Service Call screen.
2 Turn off the [sub power switch].
3 Turn off the [main power switch].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-3
9.1 When the message "Trouble" appears (call a service representative)
9
4 Unplug the machine.
5 Contact your service representative and inform them of the written down malfunction code.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-4
9.2 Troubleshooting table
9
9.2 Troubleshooting table
Simple troubleshooting
The following explains simple troubleshooting procedures. If the problem is not corrected after the described
operation is performed, contact your service representative.
Description of problem Check points Remedy
The machine does not start up
when the [main power switch] is
turned on
Is power being supplied from the
electrical outlet?
Correctly insert the power supply
plug into the electrical outlet.
Has the [sub power switch] been
turned on?
Turn on the [sub power switch].
Copying does not start Is the upper right-side door of
the machine open?
Securely close the upper rightside door of the machine.
Is there any paper that matches
the original?
Load paper of the appropriate
size into the paper tray.
The printed output is too light Is the copy density set to [Light]? Press [Dark] in the Density
screen to copy at the desired
copy density. (p. 5-18)
Is the paper damp? Replace with new paper. (p. 8-3)
The printed output is too dark Is the copy density set to [Dark]? Press [Light] in the Density
screen to copy at the desired
copy density. (p. 5-18)
Was the original not pressed
close enough against the original
glass?
Position the original so that it is
pressed closely against the original glass. (p. 3-5)
The printed image is blurry Is the paper damp? Replace with new paper. (p. 8-3)
Was the original not pressed
close enough against the original
glass?
Position the original so that it is
pressed closely against the original glass. (p. 3-5)
There are dark specks or spots
throughout the printed output
There are streaks in the printed
output
Is the original glass dirty? Wipe the glass with a soft, dry
cloth. (p. 8-13)
Is the slit glass dirty? Clean the slit glass with the slit
glass cleaner. (p. 8-12)
Is the document pad dirty? Clean the document pad with a
soft cloth dampened with a mild
detergent. (p. 8-14)
Was the original printed on highly
translucent material, such as diazo photosensitive paper or OHP
transparencies?
Place a blank sheet of paper on
top of the original. (p. 3-5)
Is a 2-sided original being copied?
If a thin 2-sided original is being
copied, the print on the back side
may be reproduced on the front
side of the copy. In the Background Removal screen, select a
lighter background density.
(p. 5-18)
Is the electrostatic charger wire
dirty?
Use the charger-cleaning tool to
clean the electrostatic charger.
(p. 9-12)bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-5
9.2 Troubleshooting table
9
The image is printed at an angle Is the original positioned correctly?
Correctly position the original
against the document scales.
(p. 3-5)
Load the original into the ADF,
and slide the adjustable lateral
guides to fit the size of the original. (p. 3-4)
Is the original incorrectly positioned in the ADF?
If the original cannot be fed correctly through the ADF, make
copies by positioning the original
on the original glass. (p. 3-5)
Is the slit glass dirty (while using
the ADF)?
Clean the slit glass with the slit
glass cleaner. (p. 8-12)
Are the adjustable lateral guides
incorrectly positioned against
the edges of the paper?
Slide the adjustable lateral
guides against the edges of the
paper.
Was curled paper loaded into the
paper tray?
Flatten the paper before loading
it.
The printed page is curled Was paper that curls easily (as
with recycled paper) used?
Remove the paper from the paper tray, turn it over, and then
load it again.
Replace with new dry paper.
(p. 8-3)
The edge of the printed image is
dirty
Is the document pad dirty? Clean the document pad with a
soft cloth dampened with a mild
detergent. (p. 8-14)
Was the selected paper size larger than the original?
(With a Zoom setting of "Full
Size" (100.0%))
Select a paper size that is the
same size as the original.
Otherwise, select Auto to enlarge
the copy to the selected paper
size. (p. 5-7)
Is the size or orientation of the
original different from that of the
paper?
(With a Zoom setting of "Full
Size" (100.0%))
Select a paper size that is the
same size as the original. Otherwise, select a paper orientation
that is the same as that of the
original.
Was the copy reduced to a size
smaller than the paper (with a reduced zoom ratio specified)?
Select a zoom ratio that adjusts
the original size to the selected
paper size.
Otherwise, select Auto to enlarge
the copy to the selected paper
size. (p. 5-7)
Even though a paper jam was
cleared, copies cannot be produced
Is paper jammed at other locations?
Remove any jammed paper from
other locations.
Printing with the "2-Sided >
1-Sided" or "2-Sided > 2-Sided"
settings are not available
Have settings been selected that
cannot be combined?
Check the combinations of the
selected settings.
Copying is not possible even
though the password is entered
on a machine with account track
settings configured
Did the message "Your account
has reached its maximum allowance." appear?
Contact your administrator.
The original is not fed Is the ADF slightly open? Securely close the ADF.
Is the original one that does not
meet the specifications?
Check that the original is one
that can be loaded into the ADF.
(p. 12-7)
Is the original correctly loaded? Position the original correctly.
(p. 3-4)
The Finisher or Job Separator
JS-504 does not run.
Is any power being supplied to
the connector?
Check that the cord is correctly
inserted into the connector.
Description of problem Check points Remedybizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-6
9.2 Troubleshooting table
9
The staple is incorrectly positioned by 90°
Has the staple position been correctly specified?
Specify the desired position for
stapling. (p. 5-10)
The pages that were fed out
were not uniformly loaded and
the punched holes or staples
are incorrectly positioned
Is the paper curled? Remove the paper from the paper tray, turn it over, and then
load it again.
Is there a gap between the lateral
guides in the paper tray and the
sides of the paper?
Slide the lateral guides in the paper tray against the sides of the
paper so that there is no gap.
Is the paper type configured correctly?
Configure the paper type of the
selected tray correctly.
Though the authentication unit
is connected with this machine
sing a USB cable, the status indicator LED does not light in
green
A malfunction of the USB port of
this machine is suspected.
Turn off the main power of this
machine, disconnect the USB
cable from this machine or authentication unit, and then connect it again. Wait at least 10
seconds, and then turn on the
main power of this machine.
Though the authentication unit
is connected with the computer
using a USB cable, the status indicator LED does not light in
green
MA malfunction of the USB port
of your computer is suspected.
Restart your computer.
Has the authentication unit driver
being installed correctly?
Check that your computer is installed to the computer correctly.
(p. 10-2) (p. 11-2)
No notice sound is given when
scanning is started or authentication is finished on this machine
Has the notice sound being set
to OFF on this machine?
Set the notice sound to ON.
(p. 10-2)
When the "Failed to register"
message appears on this machine where registration fails
The scanning time on the authentication unit is limited per
scanning. If scanning does not
finish within the limited time, the
corresponding message appears.
For details on the scanning time,
contact your service representative.
To finish scanning within the limited time, confirm how to perform
authentication and how to place
your finger when scanning.
(p. 10-2)
During scanning, place the
scanned part on the scanning
section correctly, and do not
move it until results have been
obtained.
If the scanned part is dusty or
rough and dry when performing
authentication, a correct image
will not be able to be obtained,
and scanning may not finish.
Clean your finger, and then scan
it again, or improve the rough
and dry condition of your finger.
If the scanned part is too thick or
thin (when the finger width is outside the range from 3/8 to 1 inch
(10 to 25 mm)), a correct image
cannot be obtained, and scanning may not finish. Try "stretching your finger", "placing your
finger deeply", or "placing your
finger shallowly" on the scanning
section.
When the "Failed to authenticate." message appears on this
machine where login fails
When the "Failed to read data.
Place your finger once again
and click the [Start reading] button." message appears on the
computer where registration has
failed
The scanning time on the authentication unit is limited to five
seconds per scan. If scanning
does not finish within five seconds, the corresponding message appears.
Description of problem Check points Remedybizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-7
9.2 Troubleshooting table
9
Scanning does not start Have you placed your finger correctly on the authentication unit?
Confirm how to perform authentication and how to place your
finger when scanning. (p. 10-2)
During scanning, place the
scanned part on the scanning
section correctly, and do not
move it until results have been
obtained.
If the scanned part is dusty or
rough and dry when performing
authentication, a correct image
will not be able to be obtained,
and scanning may not finish.
Clean your finger, and then scan
it again, or improve the rough
and dry condition of your finger.
If the scanned part is too thick or
thin (when the finger width is outside the range from 3/8 to 1 inch
(10 to 25 mm)), a correct image
cannot be obtained, and scanning may not finish. Try "stretching your finger", "placing your
finger deeply", or "placing your
finger shallowly" on the scanning
section.
Did you restart this machine after
connecting the authentication
unit to this machine?
Turn off the main power of this
machine, disconnect the USB
cable from this machine or authentication unit, and then connect it again. Wait at least 10
seconds, and then turn on the
main power of this machine.
Connecting the authentication
unit to the computer starts the
hardware uninstall wizard
Is the USB port to which the authentication unit is connected the
same as the one used when installing the driver?
If you connect the authentication
unit to a different USB port from
the one used when installing the
driver, the hardware uninstall
wizard may start. Use the same
USB port as the one used when
installing the driver.
When the "Failed to register"
message appears on this machine where registration fails
The scanning time of the authentication unit is limited to 10 seconds. If scanning does not finish
within the limited time, the corresponding message appears.
To finish scanning within the limited time, confirm how to place
the IC card. (p. 11-2)
When a message appears on
the computer where registration
fails
When the "Failed to authenticate." message appears on this
machine where login fails
When IC card authentication +
password authentication is enabled
Did you enter the correct password?
Check the password, and then
enter the correct one if not.
Scanning does not start Did you restart this machine after
connecting the authentication
unit to this machine?
Turn off the main power of this
machine, disconnect the USB
cable from this machine or authentication unit, and then connect it again. Wait at least 10
seconds, and then turn on the
main power of this machine.
Description of problem Check points Remedybizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-8
9.2 Troubleshooting table
9
Main messages and their remedies
If any message other than those listed below appears, perform the operation described in the message.
Message Cause Remedy
Originals left on original glass. The original has been left on the
original glass.
Remove the original from the
original glass.
Paper of matching size is not
available.
Select the paper size.
Paper of a suitable size is not
loaded in a paper tray.
Either select paper of a different
size or load paper of a suitable
size.
Place paper in Bypass Tray. Paper of a suitable size is not
loaded in the bypass tray.
Load paper of the appropriate
size into the bypass tray.
The original size cannot be detected
Select the paper size.
(1) The original is not positioned
correctly.
(2) An original with a nonstandard
size or with a size too small to be
detected is loaded.
(1) Position the original correctly.
(2) Select the correct paper size.
The image will not fit in the selected paper size.
Change the direction of the original
The image does not fit in the paper.
Turn the original 90° and load it.
Cannot be set with XXX. Functions that cannot be used
together are selected.
Make copies using only one of
the functions.
The output tray has reached its
capacity.
Remove paper from the tray indicated by .
Copy cannot be performed because the paper loading capacity
of the output tray of the displayed Finisher or Job Separator
reached the maximum.
Remove all paper from the indicated tray.
Enter the login user name and
password and then touch
[Login] or press the [Access]
key.
User authentication settings
have been configured. Copies
cannot be made unless a user
name and correct password are
entered.
Enter the correct user name and
password. (p. 4-8)
Enter Account Name and password, and then touch [Login] or
press the [Access] key.
Account track settings have
been configured. Copies cannot
be made unless an account
name and correct password are
entered.
Enter the correct account name
and password. (p. 4-8)
Your account has reached its
maximum allowance.
The limit on the number of pages
that can be printed has been
reached.
Contact the administrator of the
machine.
The part indicated by is
open.
Ensure that it is properly closed.
Since a machine door or cover is
open or an option is not installed
correctly, the machine is unable
to make copies.
Make sure that all doors and
covers of this machine and options are closed securely.
Check covers. The exit cover of the finisher is
open.
Securely close the exit cover of
the finisher.
Install the Imaging Unit and
close all doors
The indicated Imaging Unit is not
installed correctly.
Reinstall each consumable and
replaceable part. Or contact your
service representative.
[Install a toner cartridge.] The indicated toner cartridge is
not installed correctly.
Reinstall each consumable and
replaceable part. Or contact your
service representative.
[Set the toner cartridge, and
close all doors.]
The indicated toner cartridge is
not installed correctly.
Reinstall each consumable and
replaceable part. Or contact your
service representative.
Install the waste toner box and
close all doors.
The waste toner box is not installed correctly.
Reinstall each consumable and
replaceable part. Or contact your
service representative.
Incorrect Imaging Unit is installed. Install the correct Imaging Unit and close all doors.
The correct Imaging Unit is not
set.
Reinstall each consumable and
replaceable part. Or contact your
service representative.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-9
9.2 Troubleshooting table
9
Replenish paper. The indicated tray has run out of
paper.
Add paper. (p. 8-3)
Toner (X) is low. Please when indicate.
The toner for the indicated color
is about to run out.
Prepare to replace the toner cartridge following the guidance
contained in your maintenance
agreement.
Install toner cartridge (X) The toner is about to run out. Replace the toner cartridge following the guidance contained in
your maintenance agreement.
Toner is depleted
Replace the toner cartridge following the guidance (explanation).
Press the [Continue] button to
continue the operations.
Toner is depleted Replace the toner cartridge following the guidance contained in
your maintenance agreement.
No more staples.
Replace the staple cartridge, or
cancel stapling
The staples have run out. Replace the staple cartridge.
Misfeed detected. Remove paper according to the instructions.
Since a paper jam occurred, the
machine is unable to make copies.
Clear the jammed paper.
Empty hole-punch scrap box
To continue the job, disable
punching.
(1) The punch scrap box is full.
(2) The punch scrap box is not installed.
(1) Throw punch scraps away
from the punch scrap box.
(2) Install the punch scrap box.
Reset the following number of
originals.
XX
After clearing a paper jam, it is
necessary to reload certain pages of the original that have already been fed through the ADF.
Load the indicated original pages
into the ADF.
An internal error occurred. Open
and then close the front door. If
the trouble code appears again,
contact your Service Rep.
The machine malfunctioned and
is unable to make copies.
Take a remedy according to the
message displayed in the
screen. If the problem is not resolved or released, inform your
service representative of the
malfunction code displayed in
the screen.
An internal error occurred. Turn
the main switch OFF and ON. If
the trouble code appears again,
contact your Service Rep.
Malfunction detected.
Inform the service representative of the error code.
The machine malfunctioned and
is unable to make copies.
Inform your service representative of the code displayed in the
screen.
Clean the slit scan glass on the
far left with a glass cleaner.
Continuing using the machine in
this condition may cause lines to
appear in the output.
The slit glass is dirty. User the slit glass cleaner to
clean it.
Clean the slit glass on the left
side of the machine with the
glass cleaner. Continuing using
the machine in this condition
may cause lines to appear in the
output.
The slit glass (front) is dirty. User the slit glass cleaner to
clean it.
Clean the slit glass on the left
side of the ADF with the glass
cleaner. Continuing using the
machine in this condition may
cause lines to appear in the output.
The slit glass (back) is dirty. User the slit glass cleaner to
clean it.
Message Cause Remedybizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-10
9.2 Troubleshooting table
9
Icons that appear in the touch-panel screen
Now Downloading Program
Data from the Firmware server.
(1) CS Remote Care was activated by your service representative.
(2) Internet ISW is being downloaded.
Do not turn off the sub power
switch while this message is displayed.
After turning off the sub power
switch, turn off the main power
switch, and then contact your
service representative.
Authentication information entered is invalid, due to failed access attempts.
Contact the administrator.
The authentication information
has become invalid since the authentication attempts have failed
the specified number of times.
Contact the administrator of the
machine.
Due to failed access attempts,
the current administrator password is invalid.
The administrator password has
become invalid since the authentication attempts have failed the
specified number of times.
Turn the machine off, then on
again.
Turn off the main power switch,
and then wait at least 10 seconds before turning it on again.
The job log has reached the
maximum allowed.
Contact the administrator.
The write area of the job log has
reached the maximum allowed.
Obtain the job log using PageScope Web Connection.
No Animation Guide data available. Contact your administrator.
Animation guide data is not installed.
For details on installing animation guide data, contact your
service representative.
Verify that external keyboard is
properly connected. It may not
be connected or multiple keyboards may be connected.
The compact keyboard is not
connected to this machine.
Turn off the main power of this
machine, connect the compact
keyboard to this machine. Wait
at least 10 seconds, and then
turn on the main power of this
machine.
Message Cause Remedy
Icon Description
Indicates that data is being sent from the machine, regardless of the current mode.
Indicates that the machine is receiving data, regardless of the current
mode.
Indicates that an error occurred during an image stabilization operation, a
print operation or a scan operation.
Press this icon to view a screen containing a warning code.
If the warning screen was closed when a warning occurred, press this button to display the warning screen again.
Appears when there is a message indicating that consumables must be replaced or the machine requires maintenance. Press this button to display
the message, and then carry out the replacement or maintenance procedure.
Appears when an error occurs with the connection to the POP server.
Indicates that paper is not loaded in the paper tray.
Indicates that very little paper remains in the paper tray.
If the optional image controller is installed, press this icon to display the
setting screen for the image controller.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-11
9.2 Troubleshooting table
9
Indicates that "Enhanced Security Mode" is set to "ON".
Appears when the external memory (USB memory) is not connected.
Indicates that a nonstandard external memory has been connected to this
machine, therefore, USB connection is not enabled.
Indicates that the job is in the waiting-for-redial status because, for example, the recipient's line is busy when sending with the G3 Fax or IP Address
Fax function.
Icon Descriptionbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-12
9.3 If print quality is deteriorated
9
9.3 If print quality is deteriorated
Cleaning the electrostatic charger wire
If the electrostatic charger wire is dirty, streaks will appear though the printed images. If this occurs, follow
the procedure described below to clean the electrostatic charger wire.
0 When replacing the waste toner box, follow the "Quick Guide" to clean the electrostatic charger wire.
1 Open the machine's lower front door.
2 Slowly pull out the charger-cleaning tool as far as possible. Next,
slowly push in the charger-cleaning tool as far as possible.
Repeat the above operations three times.
3 Securely insert the charger-cleaning tool, and then close the front door.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-13
9.3 If print quality is deteriorated
9
Cleaning the print head
If the print head becomes dirty, print quality may be reduced. If this occurs, clean the print head according
to the following procedure.
1 Pull out tray 1.
2 Remove the print head glass cleaning tool from tray 1.
3 Open the machine's lower front door.
4 Release the securing levers for the waste toner box, and then
remove the waste toner box.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 9-14
9.3 If print quality is deteriorated
9
5 Insert the print head glass cleaning tool into the print head
cleaning opening, pull it out, and then repeat this back-and-forth
movement two or three times.
6 Install the waste toner box.
7 Place back the print head glass cleaning tool to tray 1.
8 Close tray 1.10 Authentication unit (biometric
type)bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-2
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
10 Authentication unit (biometric type)
This chapter describes the authentication unit (biometric type).
1. Authentication unit (biometric type) AU-101
2. Authentication unit (biometric type) AU-102
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
The authentication unit (biometric type) is a "biometrics (biometric authentication)" system that scans a finger
vein pattern to perform personal authentication. Using the biometric authentication, you can log in to this
machine where user authentication settings are configured in order to execute a print job.
Place your forefinger straight so that your forefinger cushion slightly touches the hollow and protuberance
part of the scanning section. Secure your middle finger and thumb on the both sides of the authentication
unit to prevent your forefinger to be used for authentication from rotating.
For details on how to place your forefinger on the authentication unit, refer to page 10-17.
NOTICE
If you change the authentication unit from AU-101 to AU-102, the users you registered with AU-101 cannot
use AU-102. Connect AU-102 to this machine, and then register the users again.
Do not place anything other than your finger on the scanning section during scanning operation. Doing so
may cause a malfunction.
Do not disconnect the USB cable from the authentication unit or computer during a scanning operation.
Doing so may cause the system to become unstable.
The status indicator LED and notice sound indicate the status of the authentication unit.
*1
For authentication unit (biometric type) AU-101
*2
For authentication unit (biometric type) AU-102
1
2
Status indicator LEDs Status
Lit in green Ready state or authentication is completed
Flash in green During authentication or scanning operation
Lit in red Authentication failed or scanning failed
Unlit The authentication unit is not recognized
Notice sound Status
One short blip sound Scanning starts
One short blip sound During a retry after authentication failed
One short blip sound
*1
/two short blip sounds
*2
Authentication completed
Two short blip sounds
*1
/
one short blip and one long beep sounds
*2
Authentication failed
One long beep sound
*2
Scanning canceledbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-3
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
To use the authentication unit, first register the finger vein pattern of the user in this machine. The registered
user, who is authenticated with the finger vein pattern, can log in to this machine or execute a print job. This
section explains how to configure the required settings in this machine, register users, and log in with
authentication.
10.1.1 Configuring this machine
NOTICE
User authentication settings must be configured with MFP authentication on this machine.
This device does not support external server authentication. To combine account track settings with user
authentication settings, set Synchronize User Authentication & Account Track to "Synchronize".
1 Use the control panel of this machine to display the Administrator Settings screen. Press [4 User
Authentication/Account Track], then [1 General Settings].
2 Set [User Authentication] to "ON (MFP)", and then press [OK].
3 Press [Yes], and then [OK].
4 Press [8 Authentication Device Settings].
5 Press [1 General Settings].
6 Press [Bio Authentication].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-4
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
7 Configure "Beep Sound" and "Operation Settings".
% For "Beep Sound", specify whether to give a "blip" sound when the finger vein pattern is scanned
successfully.
% For "Operation Settings", specify how to log in to this machine after registration.
1-to-many authentication: Allows the user to log in by simply placing his or her finger.
1-to-1 authentication: Allows the user to log in by entering the user name and placing his or her
finger.
For details on how to log in to this machine, refer to page 10-17.
8 Press [OK] twice.
9 Press [2 Logoff Settings].
10 Specify whether to log out the user when scanning the original has finished after the user logged in with
the authentication unit.
11 Press [OK].
12 Press [Close] twice.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-5
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
10.1.2 Registering a user
The following two methods can be used to register a user.
- Connect the authentication unit to this machine, and directly register the target user in this machine
- Connect the authentication unit to your computer, and use Data Administrator to register the target user
NOTICE
The registered user data is saved in the HDD of this machine. Changing the user authentication type of this
machine or formatting the HDD will erase the registered user data.
Registering a user using the control panel of this machine
1 Use the control panel of this machine to display the Administrator Settings screen. Press [4 User
Authentication/Account Track], and then [2 User Authentication Settings].
NOTICE
[2 User Authentication Settings] is disabled when User Authentication is set to [OFF] in General
Settings.
2 Press [2 User Registration].
3 Select a desired registration number, and then press [Edit].
4 Press [Register Auth. Info.].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-6
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
5 Press [Edit].
6 Place your finger on the authentication unit to scan the finger vein pattern.
% Scan the finger vein pattern three times; reset the same finger each time and then press [Scan] for
each scanning.
% After scanning the finger vein pattern, place the same finger on the authentication unit, and press
[Authentication Test].
% If your finger vein patterns have been authenticated in the authentication test, press [New]. If
authentication has failed, retry scanning the finger.
7 Press [Close] twice.
8 Enter the user name and password.
9 Configure function permission settings as required.
10 Press [OK].
11 Press [Close].
Registering a user using Data Administrator
To use Data Administrator, configure this machine, and set up Data Administrator. For setup, install the
BioDriver (USB-Driver) of the authentication unit, and then install Data Administrator Bio Plugin.
NOTICE
Before setup, install Data Administrator V4.0 or later in your computer. For the Data Administrator operating
environment and installation procedure, refer to the Data Administrator User's Guide.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-7
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
Checking the version of the installed Data Administrator
1 From the "Help" menu of Data Administrator, select "Version Information".
NOTICE
This software cannot be used if the version is "3.x". Install "4.x".
If Data Administrator V3.x is installed, it is removed when V4.x is installed.
2 Click the [Plug-in version].
3 In "Plug-in information list:", confirm the plugin version of Data Administrator.
% This software is available if the plugin version is "4.x".
Setup
1 Turn the main power of this machine off, and disconnect the authentication unit from this machine.
2 Install BioDriver (USB-Driver).
Connect the authentication unit to the USB port of your computer.
The "Found New Hardware" dialog box appears.
3 Select "Locate and install driver software (recommended)".
4 Insert the application CD-ROM provided with the authentication unit into the CD-ROM drive of the
computer.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-8
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
5 Click the "Browse my computer for driver software (advanced)".
6 Check that the driver's search location is the application CD-ROM, and then click the [Next].
% When the driver's search location is not the application CD-ROM, click the [Browse]. Select the
BioDriver (USB-Driver) folder on the CD-ROM, and then click the [OK].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-9
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
% Installation starts.
7 Click the [Close].
Installation of BioDriver (USB-Driver) is completed.
8 Install Data Administrator Bio Plugin.
Open the DA_Bio_Plugin folder on the application CD-ROM, and then click setup.exe.
9 Select a language, and then click the [OK].
The installation program starts.
10 Follow the on-screen instructions to proceed with the installation.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-10
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
11 Click the [Next].
12 Select "I accept the terms in the license agreement", and then click the [Next].
13 Click the [Install].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-11
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
14 Click the [Finish].
Installation of the Data Administrator Bio Plugin is completed, which completes the setup.
User registration
To register a user with Data Administrator, connect the authentication unit to the USB port of the computer,
and also connect the computer to this machine via network.
1 If the authentication unit is already connected to this machine, turn the main power switch of this
machine off, and then disconnect the authentication unit.
% When the authentication unit is already connected to the computer, go to step 4.
NOTICE
To turn the main power switch off and on, first turn the main power switch off, and then turn it on after
10 or more seconds has elapsed. Not doing so may result in an operation failure.
When connecting or disconnecting the USB cable, hold the plug. Otherwise, the cable may be
damaged.
2 Turn the main power on.
3 Connect the authentication unit to the USB port of the computer that contains Data Administrator.
NOTICE
Do not connect another USB device to the same port as for the authentication unit. Doing so reduces
the USB power supply, resulting in an operation failure.
To use the USB hub, be sure to connect the self-power USB hub that supplies 500 mA or more.
Restart the procedure 5 or more seconds after connecting the authentication unit.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-12
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
4 Data Administrator starts, and device information of this machine is imported.
The Device Information window appears.
% For details on how to import device information, refer to the Data Administrator User's Guide.
5 In Select Function, select "Authentication Settings" - "User Setting", and then click the [Add].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-13
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
6 Select the desired template, and then click the [OK].
The User Registration window appears.
7 Enter the user name and password, select the "AU-101" or "AU-102" tab, and then click the [Register
Auth. Info].
% Enter the E-mail address and other information as required.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-14
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
8 Register finger vein pattern.
% Scan the finger vein patterns three times; reset the same finger and then press [Start Reading] for
each scanning.
% After scanning the finger vein patterns, place the same finger, and click [Authentication Test].
% If the authentication test has succeeded, press [Register].
% If the authentication test has failed, place your finger on the authentication unit again, and click
[Authentication Test].
% If the authentication has failed, click [Reset] to repeat the scanning process.
For authentication unit AU-101
For authentication unit AU-102
9 Click the [Registration].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-15
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
10 Click the [OK].
% Repeat steps 5 to 10 to register all users.
11 Click the [Export to the device].
% Select the user name and click the [Edit] to change the registered data.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-16
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
12 Click the [Write].
% Data Administrator provides the batch copy function that batch-configures the registered user data
in multiple machines with the authentication unit enabled.
The registered user data is configured in this machine.
13 Click the [OK].
14 Disconnect the authentication unit from the USB port of the computer.
15 Turn the main power switch of this machine off, connect the authentication unit to this machine, and
turn the main power of this machine on.
NOTICE
To turn the main power switch off and on, first turn the main power switch off, and then turn it on after
10 or more seconds has elapsed. Not doing so may result in an operation failure.
When connecting or disconnecting the USB cable, hold the plug. Otherwise, the cable may be
damaged.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-17
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
10.1.3 Logging in to this machine
This section explains how to log in to this machine with the finger vein pattern authentication.
- To use authentication unit (biometric type), register the finger vein pattern in advance.
- If authentication fails frequently, finger vein pattern may not be registered correctly. Register the finger
vein pattern again.
- Authentication is carried out when you simply place your finger on the 1-to-many authentication.
Authentication is carried out when you enter the user name and place your finger on the 1-to-1
authentication.
- Press [ID & PW] to log in by entering the user name and the password, without using the authentication
unit.
When 1-to-many authentication has been specified
% Place your finger on the authentication unit.
The basic settings screen appears.
Authentication unit (biometric type) AU-101 Authentication unit (biometric type) AU-102bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 10-18
10.1 Using an authentication unit (biometric type)
10
When 1-to-1 authentication has been specified
1 Select [User Name], and enter the user name.
2 Place your finger on the authentication unit.
The basic settings screen appears.
Authentication unit (biometric type) AU-101 Authentication unit (biometric type) AU-10211 Authentication unit (IC card
type)bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-2
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
11 Authentication unit (IC card type)
This chapter describes the authentication unit (IC card type).
1. Authentication unit (IC card type) AU-201
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
The authentication unit (IC card type) is an "IC card authentication " system that reads the IC card to perform
personal authentication. Using this system, you can perform authentication with an IC card to log in to this
machine or execute a print job when User Authentication is enabled in this machine.
To use the authentication unit, first register the card ID of the user in this machine. The registered user, who
is authenticated with the card ID, can log in to this machine or execute a print job. This section explains how
to configure the required settings in this machine, register users, and log in with authentication.
For details on how to place the IC card in the authentication unit, refer to the "Quick Guide
[Copy/Print/Fax/Scan/Box Operations]".
NOTICE
Authentication unit (IC card type) AU-201 must be installed inside the working table WT-506.
Do not disconnect the USB cable while using the authentication unit. Doing so may cause the system to
become unstable.
Do not leave the IC card within 1-9/16 inch (40 mm) of the card reader.
11.1.1 Configuring this machine
NOTICE
User authentication settings must be configured with MFP authentication on this machine.
This device does not support external server authentication. For the [Public User] or [Account Track] settings,
refer to page 7-31. To combine account track settings with user authentication settings, set Synchronize
User Authentication & Account Track to "Synchronize".
1 Use the control panel of this machine to display the Administrator Settings screen. Press [4 User
Authentication/Account Track], then [General Settings].
1bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-3
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
2 Set [User Authentication] to "ON (MFP)", and then press [OK].
3 Press [Yes], and then [OK].
4 Press [8 Authentication Device Settings].
5 Press [1 General Settings].
6 Press [Card Authentication].
7 Configure "IC Card Type" and "Operation Settings".
% In "IC Card Type", specify the required IC card type.
% For "Operation Settings", specify how to log in to this machine after registration.
Card Authentication: Allows the user to log in by simply placing the IC card.
Card Authentication + Password: Allows the user to log in by placing the IC card and entering the
password.
For details on how to log in to this machine, refer to page 11-15.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-4
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
8 Press [OK] twice.
9 Press [2 Logoff Settings].
10 Specify whether to log out the user when scanning the original has finished after the user logged in with
the authentication unit.
11 Press [OK].
12 Press [Close] twice.
11.1.2 Registering a user
The following two methods can be used to register a user.
- Connect the authentication unit to this machine, and directly register the target user in this machine
- Connect the authentication unit to your computer, and use Data Administrator to register the target user
NOTICE
The registered user data is saved in the HDD of this machine. Changing the user authentication type of this
machine or formatting the HDD will erase the registered user data.
Registering a user using the control panel of this machine
1 Use the control panel of this machine to display the Administrator Settings screen. Press [4 User
Authentication/Account Track], and then [2 User Authentication Settings].
2 Press [2 User Registration].
3 Select a desired registration number, and then press [Edit].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-5
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
4 Press [Register Auth. Info.].
5 Press [Edit].
6 Place the IC card on the authentication unit, and press [OK].
7 When message [Registration complete] appears, press [Close] twice.
8 Enter the user name and password.
9 Configure function permission settings as required.
10 Press [OK].
11 Press [Close].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-6
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
Registering a user using Data Administrator
To use Data Administrator, configure this machine, and set up Data Administrator. For setup, install the IC
Card Driver (USB-Driver) of the authentication unit, and then install Data Administrator IC Card Plugin.
NOTICE
Before setup, install Data Administrator V4.0 or later in your computer. For the Data Administrator operating
environment and installation procedure, refer to the Data Administrator User's Guide.
Checking the version of the installed Data Administrator
1 From the "Help" menu of Data Administrator, select "Version Information".
NOTICE
This software cannot be used if the version is "3.x". Install "4.x".
If Data Administrator V3.x is installed, it is removed when V4.x is installed.
2 Click the [Plug-in version].
3 In "Plug-in information list", confirm the plugin version of Data Administrator.
% This software is available if the plugin version is "4.x".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-7
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
Setup
1 Turn the main power of this machine off, and disconnect the authentication unit from this machine.
2 Install IC Card Driver (USB-Driver).
Connect the authentication unit to the USB port of your computer.
The "Found New Hardware" dialog box appears.
3 Select "Locate and install driver software (recommended)".
4 Insert the application CD-ROM provided with the authentication unit into the CD-ROM drive of the
computer.
5 Click the "Browse my computer for driver software (advanced)".bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-8
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
6 Check that the driver's search location is the application CD-ROM, and then click the [Next].
% When the driver's search location is not the application CD-ROM, click the [Browse]. Select the IC
Card Driver (USB-Driver) folder in the CD-ROM, and click the [OK].
% Installation starts.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-9
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
7 Click the [Close].
Installation of the IC Card Driver (USB-Driver) is completed.
8 Install Data Administrator IC Card Plugin.
Open the IC_Card_Plugin folder on the application CD-ROM, and then click setup.exe.
9 Select a language, and then click the [OK].
The installation program starts.
10 Follow the on-screen instructions to proceed with the installation.
11 Click the [Next].bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-10
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
12 Select "I accept the terms in the license agreement", and then click the [Next].
13 Click the [Install].
14 Click the [Finish].
Installation of the Data Administrator IC Card Plugin is completed, which completes the setup.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-11
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
User registration
To register a user with Data Administrator, connect the authentication unit to the USB port of the computer,
and also connect the computer to this machine via network.
1 If the authentication unit is already connected to this machine, turn the main power switch of this
machine off, and then disconnect the authentication unit.
% When the authentication unit is already connected to the computer, go to step 4.
NOTICE
To turn the main power switch off and on, first turn the main power switch off, and then turn it on after
10 or more seconds has elapsed. Not doing so may result in an operation failure.
When connecting or disconnecting the USB cable, hold the plug. Otherwise, the cable may be
damaged.
2 Turn the main power on.
3 Connect the authentication unit to the USB port of the computer that contains Data Administrator.
NOTICE
Do not connect another USB device to the same port as for the authentication unit. Doing so reduces
the USB power supply, resulting in an operation failure.
To use the USB hub, be sure to connect the self-power USB hub that supplies 500 mA or more.
Restart the procedure 5 or more seconds after connecting the authentication unit.
4 Data Administrator starts, and device information of this machine is imported.
The Device Information window appears.
% For details on how to import device information, refer to the Data Administrator User 's Guide.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-12
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
5 In Select Function, select "Authentication Settings" - "User Setting", and then click the [Add].
6 Select the desired template, and then click the [OK].
The User Registration window appears.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-13
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
7 Enter the user name and password, and select the "IC card authentication" tab.
% Enter the E-mail address and other information as required.
8 Place the IC card on the authentication unit, and click the [Start reading].
% If necessary, click [Card ID Input] to register the card ID.
9 Click the [OK].
% Repeat steps 5 to 12 to register all users.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-14
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
10 Click [Export to the device].
% Select the user name and click the [Edit] to change the registered data.
11 Click the [Write].
% Data Administrator provides the batch copy function that batch-configures the registered user data
in multiple machines with the authentication unit enabled.
The registered user data is configured in this machine.
12 Click the [OK].
13 Disconnect the authentication unit from the USB port of the computer.
14 Turn the main power switch of this machine off, connect the authentication unit to this machine, and
turn the main power switch of this machine on.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-15
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
NOTICE
To turn the main power switch off and on, first turn the main power switch off, and then turn it on after
10 or more seconds has elapsed. Not doing so may result in an operation failure.
When connecting or disconnecting the USB cable, hold the plug. Otherwise, the cable may be
damaged.
11.1.3 Logging in to this machine
This section explains how to log in to this machine with IC card authentication.
- To use authentication unit (IC card type), register the information recorded in the IC card in advance.
- If authentication fails frequently, IC card information may not be registered properly. Register IC card
information again.
- When the IC Card authentication is enabled, a registered user is authenticated by simply placing the IC
card. Authentication is carried out when you place the IC card and enter the password when both IC
cards and passwords are used for authentication.
- Press [ID & PW] to log in by entering the user name and the password, without using the authentication
unit.
When IC card authentication is enabled
% Place the IC card on the working table.
The basic settings screen appears.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 11-16
11.1 Using authentication unit (IC card type)
11
When IC card authentication + password authentication is enabled
1 Place the IC card on the working table.
2 Press [Password], and then enter the password.
3 Press either [Login] or the [Access] key.
The basic settings screen appears.12 Specificationsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-2
12.1 Paper
12
12 Specifications
This chapter describes the specifications of the paper, machine, and options.
This product specification is subject to change without notice toward the improvement.
12.1 Paper
Paper types and paper capacities
*1
Paper where you do not print on both sides (for example, when something is already printed on the front
side).
*2
Fine and other special paper.
*3
Paper where company names, preset text, and others are already printed.
*4
Colored paper.
*5
Paper that is registered as one of frequently used paper types.
For paper weight and media adjustment settings, contact your service representative.
Paper type Paper weight Paper capacity
Plain paper
Single Side Only
*1
Special Paper
*2
Letterhead
*3
Colored Paper
*4
User Paper 1
*5
User Paper 2
*5
17 lb to 23-15/16 lb
(64 to 90 g/m2
)
Bypass tray: 150 sheets, Tray 1/2: 500 sheets
Tray 3: 1,500 sheets, Tray 4: 1,000 sheets
Large capacity unit LU-301: 3,000 sheets
Large capacity unit LU-204: 2,500 sheets
Thick 1
User Paper 3
*5
24-3/16 lb to
31-15/16 lb
(91 to 120 g/m2
)
Bypass tray: 100 sheets, Tray 1/2: 400 sheets
Tray 3: 1,150 sheets, Tray 4: 750 sheets
Large capacity unit LU-301: 2,500 sheets
Large capacity unit LU-204: 2,000 sheets
Thick 1+
User Paper 4
*5
32-3/16 lb to
41-3/4 lb
(121 to 157 g/m2
)
Bypass tray: 80 sheets, Tray 1/2: 280 sheets
Tray 3: 800 sheets, Tray 4: 500 sheets
Large capacity unit LU-301: 1,750 sheets
Large capacity unit LU-204: 1,450 sheets
Thick 2
User Paper 5
*5
42 lb to 55-5/8 lb
(158 to 209 g/m2
)
Bypass tray: 70 sheets, Tray 1/2: 250 sheets
Tray 3: 700 sheets, Tray 4: 450 sheets
Large capacity unit LU-301: 1,550 sheets
Large capacity unit LU-204: 1,250 sheets
Thick 3
User Paper 6
*5
55-7/8 lb to 68-1/8 lb
(210 to 256 g/m2
)
Bypass tray: 60 sheets, Tray 1/2: 200 sheets
Tray 3: 600 sheets, Tray 4: 400 sheets
Large capacity unit LU-301: 1,300 sheets
Large capacity unit LU-204: 1,000 sheets
Thick 4 68-3/8 lb to
79-13/16 lb
(257 to 300 g/m2
)
Bypass tray: 50 sheets
Transparency - Bypass tray: 20 sheets
Postcards - Bypass tray: 50 sheets
Tray 3: 200 sheets
*
, Tray 4: 200 sheets
*
*
Ask the service representative to change the setting.
Envelope - Bypass tray: 10 sheets
Label sheets - Bypass tray: 50 sheetsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-3
12.1 Paper
12
NOTICE
Paper other than plain paper, such as OHP transparencies and colored paper, is called special paper. Be sure
to select a special paper setting for paper trays loaded with media such as OHP transparencies and colored
paper.
If the paper size and paper type have not been correctly specified, a paper jam may occur or poor image
quality may result.
When you select Plain Paper, Thick 1, Thick 1+, Thick 2, Thick 3, or Thick 4 for the bypass tray, you can select
Duplex 2nd Side. Select Duplex 2nd Side when you load paper where something is printed on one side.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-4
12.2 Machine specifications
12
12.2 Machine specifications
bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452
Specification
Type Scanner, printer, desktop, or stand-alone
Document holder Stationary (mirror scanning)
Photo conductor OPC
Light source White rare-gas fluorescent
Copy system Laser electrostatic copying
Developing system Dry 2-component HMT developing system
Fusing system Belt fusing
Resolution Scanning 600 dpi e 600 dpi
Output 1,800 dpi e 600 dpi
Originals Type Sheets, books (two-page spread), three-dimensional objects
Size Max. 11 e17 (A3)
Weight 4-7/16 lb (2 kg) (three-dimensional objects)
Copying paper type Plain paper (17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64 to 90 g/m2
)), Thick1 (24-3/16 lb to 31-
15/16 lb (91 to 120 g/m2
)), Thick1+ (32-3/16 lb to 41-3/4 lb (121 to 157
g/m2
)), Thick2 (42 lb to 55-5/8 lb (158 to 209 g/m2
)), Thick3 (55-7/8 lb to
68-1/8 lb (210 to 256 g/m2
)), Thick4 (68-3/8 lb to 79-13/16 lb (257 to 300
g/m2
))
*
,
Letterhead, colored paper, transparency
*
, postcard
**
, envelope
*
, label
sheet
*
, banner paper (33-13/16 lb to 55-7/8 lb (127 to 210 g/m2
))
*
2 Sided: Plain paper (17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64 to 90 g/m2
)), Thick1/1+/2/3
(24-3/16 lb to 68-1/8 lb (91 to 256 g/m2
))
*
Available for bypass tray.
**
Available for bypass tray or tray 3/4. (When using tray 3/4, ask the service
representative to change the setting.)
Copy paper size
12-1/4 e 18 w, 12 e 18 w to 8-1/2 e 11 v, A3 w to A5 w, 8 e 13 w*1
,
16K v, 8K w
8-1/2 e 11 v, 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 v
*
, A4 v to A5 v, 16K v
*2
12-1/4 e 18 w, 12 e 18 w to 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w/v, A3 w to B6 w, A6 w,
4 e 6 w, 8 e 13 w*1
, A6 card w, 16K w/v, 8K w
Width: 3-9/16 to 12-1/4 (90 mm to 311.1 mm), length: 5-1/2 to 47-1/4
(139.7 mm to 1,200 mm)
*1
There are six types of foolcaps: 8-1/2 e 13-1/2 w, 220 e 330 mmw,
8-1/2 e 13 w, 8-1/4 e 13 w, 8-1/8 e 13-1/4 w, and 8 e 13 w. Any one of
these sizes is selectable. For details, contact your service representative.
*2
Banner Paper
Width: 8-1/4 to 11-11/16 (210 to 297 mm)
Length: 18 to 47-1/4 (457 to 1,200 mm)
Number of sheets loaded in
output tray
Plain paper 250 sheets
Thick 10 sheets
Transparency 1 sheetbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-5
12.2 Machine specifications
12
Number of loadable sheets
(8-1/2 e 11 (A4))
Tray 1 or 2 Plain paper: 500 sheets (21-1/4 lb (80 g/m2
))/550
sheets (17 lb (64 g/m2
)), Thick 1: 400 sheets,
Thick 1+: 280 sheets, Thick 2: 250 sheets, Thick
3: 200 sheets
Tray 3 Plain paper: 1,500 sheets (21-1/4 lb (80
g/m2
))/1,650 sheets (17 lb (64 g/m2
)), Thick 1:
1,150 sheets, Thick 1+: 800 sheets, Thick 2: 700
sheets, Thick 3: 600 sheets, Postcard: 200 sheets
Tray 4 Plain paper: 1,000 sheets (21-1/4 lb (80
g/m2
))/1,100 sheets (17 lb (64 g/m2
)), Thick 1: 750
sheets, Thick 1+: 500 sheets, Thick 2: 450 sheets,
Thick 3: 400 sheets, Postcard: 200 sheets
Bypass tray Plain paper: 150 sheets (21-1/4 lb (80 g/m2
)),
Thick 1: 100 sheets, Thick 1+: 80 sheets, Thick 2:
70 sheets, Thick 3: 60 sheets, Thick 4: 50 sheets,
Transparency: 20 sheets, Postcard or label sheet:
50 sheets, Envelope: 10 sheets
Warm-up time Period from the time the [main power switch] was turned on to the time
[sub power switch] was turned on to get ready for printing (room temperature is 73.4 °F (23 °C))
C652/C652DS: 30 sec. or less
C552/C552DS: 60 sec. or less
C452: 60 sec. or less (Black: 30 sec. or less)
Period from the time [main power switch] was turned on to the time this
machine is ready for printing (room temperature is 73.4 °F (23 °C))
C652/C652DS: 39 sec. or less
C552/C552DS: 39 sec. or less
C452: 60 sec. or less (Black: 45 sec. or less)
Warm-up time may vary depending on the operating environment and usage.
Image chipping width Top edge 3/16 (4.2 mm)
Bottom edge 1/8 (3.0 mm)
Right edge 1/8 (3.0 mm)
Left edge 1/8 (3.0 mm)
First copy
(When 8-1/2 e 11 v (A4 v)
printing)
C652/C652DS
Full color: 5.5 sec. or less
Black: 3.8 sec. or less
C552/C552DS
Full color: 6.0 sec. or less
Black: 4.3 sec. or less
C452
Full color: 6.0 sec. or less
Black: 4.8 sec. or less
Specificationbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-6
12.2 Machine specifications
12
Copy speed (When 8-1/2 e
11 (A4) printing)
Full Color
(Simplex/Duplex)
C652/C652DS
Plain paper: 50 sheets/min., Thick1 or 1+: 32
sheets/min., Thick2, 3 or 4, Special paper, Glossy
mode: 25 sheets/min.
C552/C552DS
Plain paper: 45 sheets/min., Thick1 or 1+: 28
sheets/min., Thick 2, 3 or 4, Special paper,
Glossy mode: 23 sheets/min.
C452
Plain paper: 45 sheets/min., Thick1 or 1+: 28
sheets/min., Thick2, 3 or 4, Special paper, Glossy
mode: 23 sheets/min.
Black
(Simplex/Duplex)
C652/C652DS
Plain paper: 65 sheets/min., Thick1 or 1+: 32
sheets/min., Thick2, 3 or 4, Special paper, Glossy
mode: 25 sheets/min.
C552/C552DS
Plain paper: 55 sheets/min., Thick1 or 1+: 28
sheets/min., Thick2, 3 or 4, Special paper, Glossy
mode: 23 sheets/min.
C452
Plain paper: 45 sheets/min., Thick1 or 1+: 28
sheets/min., Thick2, 3 or 4, Special paper, Glossy
mode: 23 sheets/min.
Copy magnification Full size: 100.0% ± 0.5%
Enlarge: 121.4%, 129.4%, 154.5%, or 200.0% (115.4%, 122.4%, 141.4%,
or 200.0%)
Reduce: 78.5%, 73.3%, 64.7%, or 50.0% (86.6%, 81.6%, 70.7%, or
50.0%)
Manual: 25.0 to 400.0% (in 0.1% steps)
Number of continuous
copies
1 to 9999 sheets
Density adjustment Copy density Manual density adjustment (9 levels)
Background density Manual or automatic density adjustment (9 levels)
Power supply North American model (inch): AC 120 V, 16 A, 60 Hz
European model (cm): AC 220 - 240 V, 10 A, 50/60 Hz
Max. power consumption C652/C652DS: 2,100W
C552/C552DS: 2,000 W
C452: 2,000 W
Size Width 25-9/16 e Depth 30-9/16 (excluding panel)/34-5/8 (including
panel) e Height 45-1/2 (including ADF)
(Width 650 mme Depth 777 mm (excluding panel)/879 mm (including
panel) e Height 1,155 mm (including ADF))
Machine occupation dimensions
C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS:
Width 100-9/16 e Depth 60-1/16 e Height 64-15/16
(Width 2,554 mm e Depth 1,525 mm e Height 1,650 mm)
The dimensions above are measured when the finisher (FS-526) tray extension, paper trays and LCU (LU-204) are pulled out, and the ADF is open.
C452:
Width 84-9/16 e Depth 60-1/16 e Height 64-15/16
(Width 2,148mm e Depth 1,525mm e Height1,650mm)
The dimensions above are measured when the finisher (FS-527) tray extension and paper trays and LCU (LU-204) are pulled out, and the ADF is
open.
Memory size (hard disk capacity)
2,048 MB (250 GB)
Weight bizhub C652/C552/C452 :Approx. 487-13/16 lb (Approx. 221 kg)
bizhub C652DS/C552DS :Approx. 223 kg
Specificationbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-7
12.2 Machine specifications
12
Automatic duplex unit
Reverse automatic document feeder (bizhub C652/C552/C452)
Reverse automatic document feeder (bizhub C652DS/C552DS)
Specification
Paper type Plain paper (17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64 to 90 g/m2
)), Thick1 (24-3/16 lb to 31-
15/16 lb (91 to 120 g/m2
)), Thick1+ (32-3/16 lb to 41-3/4 lb (121 to 157
g/m2
)), Thick2 (42 lb to 55-5/8 lb (158 to 209 g/m2
)), Thick3 (55-7/8 lb to
68-1/8 lb (210 to 256 g/m2
))
Paper size 12-1/4 e 18 w, 12 e 18 w to 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w, A3 w to B6 w, A6 w, 8 e 13
w*1
, 16K w/v, 8K w, 4 e 6 w
Width: 3-15/16 to 12-1/4 (100 to 311.1 mm), Length: 5-13/16 to 18 (148 to
457.2 mm)
*1
There are six types of foolcaps: 8-1/2 e 13-1/2 w, 220 e 330 mmw,
8-1/2 e 13 w, 8-1/4 e 13 w, 8-1/8 e 13-1/4 w, and 8 e 13 w. Any one of
these sizes is selectable. For details, contact your service representative.
Power supply Supply from machine
Specification
Original feed function 1-sided original, 2-sided original, mixed original
Original types 1-sided Plain paper (9-5/16 lb to 55-7/8 lb (35 to 210
g/m2
))
2-sided, mixed original
Plain paper (13-5/16 lb to 34-1/16 lb (50 to 128
g/m2
))
Original Size 1-Sided/2-Sided Originals: 11 e 17 w to 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w/v, A3 w to B6 w,
A6 w, 8 e 13 w
For details on handling mixed originals, refer to p. 5-16.
Original loading capacity 1- or 2-sided original: Max. 100 sheets (21-1/4 lb (80 g/m2
))
Power supply Supply from machine
Max. power consumption 60 W or less
Size Width 24-5/16 e Depth 22-5/8 e Height 5-1/8
(Width 618 mm e Depth 575 mm e Height 130 mm)
Weight Approx. 35-1/4 lb (Approx. 16 kg)
Specification
Original feed function 1-sided original, 2-sided original, mixed original
Original types 1-sided, 2-sided Plain paper (9-5/16 lb to 55-7/8 lb (35 to 210
g/m2
))
mixed original Plain paper (13-5/16 lb to 34-1/16 lb (50 to 128
g/m2
))
Original Size 1-Sided/2-Sided Originals: 11 e 17 w, 8-1/2 e 11 w/v, A3 w to B6 w, A6
w, 8 e 13 w
For details on handling mixed originals, refer to p. 5-16.
Original loading capacity 1- or 2-sided original: Max. 100 sheets (21-1/4 lb (80 g/m2
))
Power supply Supply from machine
Max. power consumption 80 W or less
Size Width 24-5/16 e Depth 22-5/8 e Height 5-1/8
(Width 618 mm e Depth 575 mm e Height 129 mm)
Weight Approx. 39-11/16 lb (Approx. 18 kg)bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-8
12.3 Options
12
12.3 Options
Large capacity unit LU-301
Large capacity unit LU-204
*
The maximum number of loadable sheets for each paper size is 2,500 sheets (for 21-1/4 lb (80 g/m2
)) or
2,750 sheets (for 17 lb (64 g/m2
)).
Specification
Paper type Plain paper (17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64 to 90 g/m2
)), Thick 1 (24-3/16 lb to 31-
15/16 lb (91 to 120 g/m2
)), Thick 1+ (32-3/16 lb to 41-3/4 lb (121 to 157
g/m2
)), Thick 2 (42 lb to 55-5/8 lb (158 to 209 g/m2
)), Thick 3 (55-7/8 lb to
68-1/8 (210 to 256 g/m2
))
Paper size 8-1/2 e 11 v, A4 v
Number of loadable sheets Plain paper: 3,000 sheets (21-1/4 lb (80 g/m2
))/3,300 sheets (17 lb (64
g/m2
)), Thick 1: 2,500 sheets, Thick 1+: 1,750 sheets, Thick 2: 1,550
sheets, Thick 3: 1,300 sheets
Power supply Supply from machine
Max. power consumption 22W or less
Size Width 14-7/16e Depth 20-13/16e Height 15-15/16
(Width 367 mm e Depth 528 mm e Height 405 mm)
Weight Approx. 39-11/16 lb (Approx. 18 kg)
Specification
Paper type Plain paper (17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64 to 90 g/m2
)), Thick 1 (24-3/16 lb to 31-
15/16 lb (91 to 120 g/m2
)), Thick 1+ (32-3/16 lb to 41-3/4 lb (121 to 157
g/m2
)), Thick 2 (42 lb to 55-5/8 lb (158 to 209 g/m2
)), Thick 3 (55-7/8 lb to
68-1/8 lb (210 to 256 g/m2
))
Paper size
*
12 e 18 w, 11 e 17 w to 8-1/2 e 11 w/v, A3w, B4 w, A4 w/v
Number of loadable sheets Plain paper: 2,500 sheets (21-1/4 lb (80 g/m2
))/2,750 sheets (17 lb (64
g/m2
)), Thick 1: 2,000 sheets, Thick 1+: 1,450 sheets, Thick 2: 1,250
sheets, Thick 3: 1,000 sheets
Power supply Supply from machine
Max. power consumption 22W or less
Size Width 24-3/4e Depth 21-7/8e Height 15-15/16
(Width 629 mm e Depth 556 mm e Height 405 mm)
Weight Approx. 55-1/8 lb (Approx. 25 kg)bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-9
12.3 Options
12
Finisher FS-526
Specification
Output tray Output tray 1, output tray 2
Feeding function Group, Sort, Offset Group
*
, Offset Sort
*
, Staple
*
*
Fed into output tray 2
Paper type Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 to 90 g/m2
))
Thick (24-3/16 lb to 79-13/16 lb (91 to 300 g/m2
)), transparency, postcard, envelope, label sheet, letterhead paper, colored paper
Staple: Plain paper (17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64 to 90 g/m2
))
Thick (24-3/16 lb to 55-5/8 lb (91 to 209 g/m2
))
*
*
Can be used only as a cover page
Paper size (Main Tray)
12 e 18 w to 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w/v, A3 w to A6 w/v, 8 e 13 w*1
, 16K w/v, 8K w
Width: 3-15/16 to 13 (100 to 330.2 mm), length: 5-1/2 to 19-1/4 (139 to 488 mm)
Staple: 11 e 17 w to 8-1/2 e 11 w/v, A3 w to B5 w/v, A5 v, 8 e 13 w*1
,
5-1/2 e 8-1/2 v, 16K w/v, 8K w,
Width: 7-3/16 to 13 (182 to 330 mm), length: 5-1/2 to 19-1/4 (139 to 488 mm)
(Sub Tray)
13 e 19 w to 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w/v, A3 w to A5 w/v, B6 w, A6 w, 8 e 13 w*1
, 11 e 17
w, 16K w/v, 8K w
Width: 3-15/16 to 13-1/16 (100 to 331 mm), length: 5-1/2 to 19-1/4 (139 to 488
mm)
*1
There are six types of foolcaps: 8-1/2 e 13-1/2 w, 220 e 330 mmw,
8-1/2 e 13 w, 8-1/4 e 13 w, 8-1/8 e 13-1/4 w, and 8 e 13 w. Any one of these sizes is selectable. For details, contact your service representative.
Paper loading capacity
< Output tray 2>
Group/Sort 3,000 sheets
*1
(11 e 8-1/2 w/v, 7-1/4 e 10-1/2 w/v, A4
w/v, B5 w/v, 16K w/v)
1,500 sheets (12 e 18 w*2
, 8-1/2 e 14 w, A3 w, B4 w,
8 e 13 w*3
, 8K w)
500 sheets (5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w/v, A5 w/v, B6 w, A6 w)
*1
2,500 sheets when saddle stitcher SD-508 is installed.
*2
12 e 18 is 304.8 e 457.2 mm that is one-size larger
than A3.
*3
There are six types of foolcaps: 8-1/2 e 13-1/2 w, 220
e 330 mm w, 8-1/2 e 13 w, 8-1/4 e 13 w, 8-1/8 e 13-
1/4 w, 8 e 13 w. Any one of these sizes is selectable.
For details, contact your service representative.
Offset Group/Offset
Sort
When the length
of paper is 5-
15/16 to 12-5/8
(150 mm to 320
mm)
300 sets
When the length
of paper is other
than 5-15/16 to
12-5/8
(150 mm to 320
mm)
150 setsbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-10
12.3 Options
12
Saddle stitcher SD-508
Staple 11 e 17 w, A3 w 2 sheets-9
sheets
50 sets
10 sheets-20
sheets
50 sets
21 sheets-30
sheets
30 sets
31 sheets-40
sheets
25 sets
41 sheets-50
sheets
20 sets
Other than 11 e 17
w, A3 w
2 sheets-9
sheets
100 sets
10 sheets-20
sheets
50 sets
21 sheets-30
sheets
30 sets
31 sheets-40
sheets
25 sets
41 sheets-50
sheets
20 sets
51 sheets-60
sheets
15 sets
61 sheets-100
sheets
10 sets
Paper loading capacity
< Output tray 1>
100 sheets
Maximum number of
stapled sheets
Plain paper (17 to
23-15/16 lb (64 to 90
g/m2
))
100 sheets
Shift amount 1-3/16 (30 mm)
Power supply Supply from machine
Max. power consumption
105 W or less (when all applicable options are installed)
Size Width 28-1/2 (Main tray is pulled output: 33-7/16, Sub tray is pulled output: 34-
11/16) e Depth 27-15/16 e Height 40-3/8
(Width 723.8 (Main tray is pulled output: 848.8 mm, Sub tray is pulled output:
881.2 mm) mm e Depth 709.5 e Height 1,025 mm)
Weight Approx. 132-1/4 lb (Approx. 60 kg)
Consumables Staples MS-10A
For EH-1028 (Product No. 1002 manufactured by MAX) (5,000 staples included)
e 1 unit
Specification
Specification
Feeding function Center Staple and Fold, Half-Fold, Tri-Fold
(Belt conveyer feeding)
Paper type Center Staple and Fold: Plain paper (17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64 to 90 g/m2
))
Half-Fold or Tri-Fold: Plain paper (17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64 to 90 g/m2
))bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-11
12.3 Options
12
*
Not applicable to multi-function jobs (jobs with multiple functions combined).
Punch kit PK-516
Paper size Center Staple and Fold, Half-Fold: 12 e 18 w to 8-1/2 e 11 w, A3w, B4w,
A4w, 8K w
Width: 8-1/4 to 12-3/8 (210 mm to 314 mm), length: 11 to 18-1/16 (279 mm
to 458 mm)
Tri-Fold: 8-1/2 e 11 w, A4w, 16K w
Maximum number of
sheets that can be centerstapled
20 sheets, 19 sheets (21-1/4 lb (80 g/m2
)) or 16 sheets (23-15/16 (90 g/m2
))
+ Thick (55-5/8 lb (209 g/m2
)) 1 sheet
Maximum number of folded sheets
Half-Fold: 3 sheets
Tri-Fold: 3 sheets
Number of sheets that can
be loaded into the folding
output tray
Plain paper (21-1/4 lb (80
g/m2
))
*
When the length of paper is 13
(330 mm) or more
One sheet folded 20 sets
Two sheets stapled
and folded
18 sets
Three sheets stapled
and folded
15 sets
Four sheets stapled 12 sets
Five sheets stapled 8 sets
Six to 15 sheets stapled
5 sets
16 to 20 sheets stapled
5 sets
Tri-Fold -
When the length of paper is 13
(330 mm) than less
One sheet folded 10 sheets
Two sheets stapled
and folded
10 sets
Three sheets stapled
and folded
10 sets
Four sheets stapled 5 sets
Five sheets stapled 5 sets
Six to 15 sheets stapled
5 sets
16 to 20 sheets stapled
4 sets
Tri-Fold 20 sets
Size Width 11-1/16e Depth 23-1/4e Height 20-7/8
(Width 281.3 mm e Depth 596.4 mm e Height 529.8 mm)
Weight Approx. 49-13/16 lb (Approx. 22.6 kg), Approx. 8-3/8 lb (Approx. 3.8 kg)
(Output tray)
Consumables Staple MS-5C
For EH-554 (Product No. 500 manufactured by MAX) (5,000 staples included) e 1 unit
Power supply Supply from finisher
Specification
Specification
Number of punch holes 2 holes, 3 holes or 4 holes
Paper type Plain paper (17-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
)),
Thick (24-3/16 lb to 79-13/16 lb (91 g/m2
to 300 g/m2
))bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-12
12.3 Options
12
Job Separator JS-602
Z-Folding Unit ZU-606
Paper size "2-Hole" Punch setting:
11 e 17 w to 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w, A3w to A5w/v, 8 e 13 w*
, 16K w/v, 8K w,
7-1/4 e 10-1/2 w/v
"3-Hole"/"4-Hole" Punch settings:
A3 w, B4 w, A4 v, B5 v, 11 e 17 w, 8-1/2 e 11 v, 7-1/4 e 10-1/2 v, 8K w,
16K v
*
There are four types of foolcaps:
8-1/2 e 13 w, 8-1/4 e 13 w, 8-1/8 e 13-1/4 w, 8 e 13 w. Any one of these
sizes is selectable. For details, contact your service representative.
Power supply Supply from finisher
Size Width 5-3/4 e Depth 25-3/16e Height 9-3/16
(Width 146.2 mm e Depth 639.2 mm e Height 233.8 mm)
Weight Approx. 9-15/16 lb (4.5 kg)
Specification
Specification
Output tray Output tray 3
Feeding function Group, Sort
Paper type Plain paper (17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
))
Paper size 11 e 17 w - 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w, 8 e 13 w*
, A3 w to A5 w
*
There are five types of foolcaps:
8-1/2 e 13-1/2 w, 8-1/2 e 13 w, 8-1/4 e 13 w, 8-1/8 e 13-1/4 w, 8 e 13 w.
Any one of these sizes is selectable. For details, contact your service representative.
Paper loading capacity Plain paper (80 g/m2
) 8-1/2 × 11 w, A4 w 100 sheets
Other than 8-1/2 × 11
w, A4 w
50 sheets
Size Width 13-7/16 e Depth 21-1/8 e Height 5-7/8
(Width 341 mm e Depth 537 mm e Height 149 mm)
Weight Approx. 3-7/8 lb (Approx. 1.75 kg)
Specification
Number of punch holes 2 holes, 3 holes, 4 holes
Paper type when hole
punching is selected
Plain paper 17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64g/m2
- 90g/m2
)
Paper size when hole
punching is selected
11 e 17 w - 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w/v, 8 × 13 w*
, A3 w to A5 w/v
*
There are four types of foolcaps:
8-1/2 e 13 w, 8-1/4 e 13 w, 8-1/8 e 13-1/4 w, 8 e 13 w. Any one of these
sizes is selectable. For details, contact your service representative.
Fold type Z-Fold
Paper type when Z-folding
is selected
Plain paper (64g/m2
- 90g/m2
)
Paper size when Z-folding
is selected
11 e 17 w, 8-1/2 e 14 w, A3 w, B4 w
Power supply Supply from electrical outlet
Size Width 6-11/16 e Depth 26 e Height 40-7/16
(Width 169.7 mm e Depth 660 mm e Height 1027.5 mm)
Weight Approx. 99-3/16 lb (Approx. 45 kg)bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-13
12.3 Options
12
Post Inserter PI-505
Finisher FS-527
Specification
Configuration 2 trays (upper and lower)
Cover paper type Plain paper 17 lb to 23-15/16 lb (64-90g/m2
), Thick 24-1/4 lb to 55-5/8 lb
(91 g/m2
-209 g/m2
)
Cover paper size
8-1/2 e 11 w/v, 7-1/4 e 10-1/2 w/v, 5-1/2 e 8-1/2/v, A4 w/v to A5 v, 16K
w/v
Width: 7-3/16 to 12-1/4 (182 mm to 311.1 mm)
Length: 5-1/2 to 11-11/16 (139 mm to 297 mm)
12 e 18 w, 11 e 17 w, 8-1/2 e 14 w, 8-1/2 e 11 w/v, 7-1/4 e 10-1/2 w/v,
5-1/2 e 8-1/2 v, 8 e 13 w*1
, A3 w to 5 v, 16K w/v, 8K w, SRA4 w
Width: 7-3/16 to 12-1/4 (182 mm to 311.1 mm)
Length: 5-1/2 to 11-11/16 (139 mm to 457.2 mm)
*1
There are four types of foolcaps: 8-1/2 e 13-1/2 w, 220 e 330 mm w, 8-
1/2 e 13 w, 8-1/4 e 13 w.
Any one of these sizes is selectable. For details, contact your service representative.
Paper loading capacity Plain paper 21-1/4 lb (80 g/m2
) 200 sheets for each tray
Power supply Supply from finisher
Size Width 20-1/8 e Depth 25 e 8-11/16
(Width 511 mm e Depth 635 mm e Height 220 mm)
Weight Approx. 23-1/8 lb (Approx. 10.5 kg)
Specification
Output tray Output tray 1, Output tray 2
Feeding function Group, Sort, Offset Group*, Offset Sort*, Staple*
* Fed into Output tray 2
Paper type Group/Sort: Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
)),
Thick (24-3/16 lb to 79-13/16 lb (91 g/m2
to 300 g/m2
)), Transparency,
Postcards, Envelope, Label sheets, letterhead paper, banner paper
Offset Group/ Offset Sort: Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
)), Thick (24-3/16 lb to 79-13/16 lb (91 g/m2
to 300 g/m2
))
Staple: Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
)), Thick
(24-3/16 lb to 82-7/16 lb (91 g/m2
to 310 g/m2
))*
* There is a limit on the number of sheets.
Paper size < Output tray 1 >
12-1/4 e 18 w, 11 e 17 w to 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w/v, A3 w to B6 w, A6 w
Width: 3-9/16 to 12/1/4 (90 mm to 311.15 mm), Length: 5-1/2 to 47-1/4
(139.7 mm to 1200 mm)
< Output tray 2 >
Group/Sort:
12-1/4 e 18 w, 11 e 17 w to 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w/v, A3 w to B6 w, A6 w
Width: 3-15/16 to 12-1/4 (100 mm to 311.15 mm), Length: 5-1/2 to 18
(139.7 mm to 457.2 mm)
Offset Group / Offset Sort:
12-1/4 e 18 w, 11 e 17 w, 8-1/2 e 14 w, 8-1/2 e 11 w/v, A3 w to A5 w
Width: 7-3/16 to 12-1/4 (182 mm to 311.15 mm), Length: 5-7/8 to 18 (148.5
mm to 457.2 mm)
Staple:
11 e 17 w, 8-1/2 e 11 w/v, A3 w to A5 v
Width: 7-3/16 to 11-1/4 (182 mm to 297 mm), Length: 5-7/8 to 17(148.5
mm to 431.8 mm)bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-14
12.3 Options
12
Saddle stitcher SD-509
Paper loading capacity
< Output tray 1>
Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90
g/m2
))
200 sheets
Thick (24-3/16 lb to 79-13/16 lb (91 g/m2
to 300 g/m2
)),
Transparency, Postcards, Envelope, Label sheets, letterhead paper
20 sheets
Paper loading height: 1-3/8 (35 mm)
Paper loading capacity
< Output tray 2>
Group/Sort Plain paper (15-
15/16 lb to 23-
15/16 lb (60
g/m2
to 90
g/m2
))
8-1/2 × 11 w,
A4 w or less
3000 sheets
8-1/2 × 14 w,
B4 w or more
1500 sheets
5-1/2 × 8-1/2
w, A5 w or less
500 sheets
Thick (24-3/16 lb to 79-13/16 lb (91
g/m2
to 300 g/m2
)), Transparency,
Postcards, Envelope, Label sheets,
letterhead paper
20 sheets
Offset Group /
Offset Sort
Plain paper (15-
15/16 lb to 23-
15/16 lb (60
g/m2
to 90
g/m2
))
8-1/2 × 11 w,
A4 w or less
3000 sheets
8-1/2 × 14 w,
B4 w or more
1500 sheets
5-1/2 × 8-1/2
w, A5 w or less
500 sheets
Staple Plain paper (15-
15/16 lb to 23-
15/16 lb (60
g/m2
to 90
g/m2
))
2 sheets-9 sheets: 100 sets *
* 8-1/2 × 14 w, B4 w or more: 50
sets
10 sheets-20 sheets: 50 sets
21 sheets-30 sheets: 30 sets
31 sheets-40 sheets: 25 sets
41 sheets-50 sheets: 20 sets
Paper loading height: 14-3/4 (375 mm) (8-1/2 × 11 w, A4 w or less)/7-3/8
(187.5 mm) (8-1/2 × 14 w, B4 w or more)
Maximum number of folded sheets
Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
)): 50 sheets
Thick (24-3/16 lb to 31-15/16 lb (91g/m2
to 120 g/m2
)): 30 sheets
Thick (32-3/16 lb to 55-5/8 lb (121 g/m2
to 209 g/m2
)): 15 sheets
Example number of stapled sheets: Thick (55-5/8 lb (209 g/m2
)) 2 sheets +
Plain paper 23-15/16 lb (90 g/m2
) 48 sheets
Shift amount 1-/16 (30 mm)
Power supply Supply from machine
Max. power consumption 56 W or less
Size Width 20-13/16 (25-7/8) e Depth 25-1/4 e Height 48-3/8
(Width 528 (658) mm e Depth 641 mm e Height 1025 (1087) mm)
The numbers enclosed in parentheses ( ) indicate the values applied when
the tray is pulled output
Weight Approx. 92-5/8 lb (Approx. 42 kg)
Consumables Staples SK-602
For EH-590 (Product No.505 manufactured by MAX) (5,000 staples included) e 1 unit
Specification
Specification
Feeding function Center Staple and Fold, Half-Foldbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-15
12.3 Options
12
Punch Kit PK-517
Job Separator JS-504
Paper type Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
)) Thick 24-3/16
lb to 55-5/8 lb (91 g/m2
- 209 g/m2
)*
* Can be used only as a cover page
Paper size 12-1/4 × 18 w, 11 × 17 w, 8-1/2 × 14 w, 8-1/2 × 11 w, A3 w, B4 w, A4 w
Width: 8-1/4 to 12-14 (210 mm to 311.15 mm), Length: 11 to 18 (279.4 mm
to 457.2 mm)
Maximum number of
sheets that can be centerstapled
15 sheets, 14 sheets (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
))+ 1
sheets 15-15/16 lb to 55-5/8 lb (60 g/m2
to 209 g/m2
)
Maximum number of folded sheets
3 sheets
Number of sheets that can
be loaded into the folding
output tray
Number of stapled
and folded sheets
1 sheets - 3 sheets 20 sets
4 sheets- 10 sheets 10 sets
11 sheets- 15 sheets 5 sets
Size Width 9-7/16 e Depth 22-13/16 e Height 21
(Width 239 mm e Depth 579 mm e Height 534 mm)
Weight Approx. 52-15/16 lb (Approx. 24 kg)
Consumables Staples SK-602
For EH-280 (Product No.505 manufactured by MAX) (5,000 staples included) e 2 unit
Power supply Supply from finisher FS-527
Specification
Specification
Number of punch holes 2 holes, 3 holes or 4 holes
Paper type Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
)), Thick 24-3/16
lb to 68-1/8 lb (91 g/m2
to 256 g/m2
)
Paper size "2-Hole"/"3-Hole" Punch settings
11 × 17 w to 8-1/2 × 11 w/v, A3 w to B5 w/v, 16K w/v, 8K w
A3 w, B4 w, A4 v, B5 v, 11 e 17 w, 8-1/2 e 11 v, 7-1/4 e 10-1/2 v, 8K w,
16K v
Power supply Supply from finisher FS-527
Size Widht 2-5/16 e Depth 18-1/2 e Height 5-5/16 inch
(Width 58 mm e Depth 470 mm e Height 135 mm)
Weight Approx. 3-15/16 lb (Approx. 1.8 kg)
Specification
Output tray Output tray 1, Output tray 2
Feeding function Group, Sort, Offset Group, Offset Sort
Paper type Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90
g/m2
))
Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90
g/m2
)), Thick 24-3/16 lb to 72-1/16 lb (91 g/m2
- 271 g/m2
), Transparency,
Postcards, Label sheets, Envelope, Banner paper
Paper size 12-1/4 e 18 w, Postcards, Banner Paper, 11 e 17 w - 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w/v,
A3 w to B6 w, A6 wbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-16
12.3 Options
12
Job Separator JS-603
Authentication unit (biometric type) AU-101
Paper loading capacity Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90
g/m2
)): 50 sheets
Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90
g/m2
)): 150 sheets, Thick 24-3/16 lb to 72-1/16 lb (91 g/m2
- 271 g/m2
),
Transparency, Postcards, Label sheets: 20 sheets
Envelope: 10 sheets
Banner Paper: 1 sheets
Power supply Supply from machine
Max. power consumption 40 W or less
Shift amount 1-3/16 (30 mm)
Offset function Plain paper, Thick 11 e 17 w to 8-1/2 e 11 w/v, A3 w to
B5 w
Size Width 16-1/4 (413 mm)/21-8/5 (550 mm) (when tray extension is pulled out)
e Depth 18-3/4 (477 mm) e Height 5-1/16 (129 mm)
Weight Approx. 11-1/4 lb (Approx. 5 kg)
Specification
Specification
Output tray Output tray 3
Feeding function Group, Sort
Paper type Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
)), Thick 24-3/16
lb to 68-1/8 lb (91 g/m2
-256 g/m2
), Transparency, Envelope, Label sheets,
Letterhead Paper
Paper size 12-1/4 e 18 w, 11 e 17 w to 5-1/2 e 8-1/2 w, A3 w to A5 w
Paper loading capacity Plain paper (15-15/16 lb to 23-15/16 lb (60 g/m2
to 90 g/m2
)): 100 sheets,
Thick (24-3/16 lb to 79-13/16 lb (91 g/m2
to 300 g/m2
)), Transparency, Envelope, Label sheets, Letterhead Paper: 10 sheets
Paper loading height: 7/8 (22 mm)
Size Width 14-7/16 e Depth 20-13/16 e Height 15-15/16 inch
(Width 165 mm e Depth 389 mm e Height 63 mm)
Weight Approx. 2-3/16 lb (Approx. 1 kg)
Specification
Name AU-101
Applied finger width 3/8 to 1 (10 to 25 mm)
Interface USB 2.0
Dimensions Approx. 3-1/16 (W) e 3-3/4 (D) e 2-3/16 (H)
(Approx. 78 mm (W) e 95 mm (D) e 55 mm (H))
Weight Approx. 5/16 lb (Approx. 150 g) (excluding USB
cable)
Max. power consumption (mA) DC 5 V 500 mA
System conditions (during
operation)
Ambient temperature 50 ºF to 95 ºF (10 ºC to 35 ºC)
Humidity 10% to 80% (No dew condensation)
System conditions (during
non-operation)
Ambient temperature 14 ºF to 140 ºF (-10 ºC to 60 ºC)
Humidity 10% to 80% (No dew condensation)bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-17
12.3 Options
12
Authentication unit (biometric type) AU-102
Authentication unit (IC card type) AU-201
Compatible computer CPU PC/AT compatible, 1 GHz or more
Memory 128 MB or more
HDD Free space: 100 MB or more
Monitor 800 e 600 pixels, 16-bit color or more
Network TCP/IP
Application Microsoft Internet Explorer 6.0 (SP1) or later
Microsoft .NET Framework (SP1) or later
Interface USB 1.1 or later
Supported Operating Systems Windows 2000 Professional (SP4)
Windows XP Professional Edition (SP2)
Windows Vista Business/Enterprise
Specification
Specification
Name AU-102
Biometric sensor system Transmission-type optical system
Verification time Approx. 1 sec. or less
Interface USB 2.0
Dimensions Approx. 2-5/16 (W) e 3-1/4 (D) e 2-15/16 (H)
(Approx. 59 mm (W) e 82 mm (D) e 74 mm (H))
Weight Approx. 3/16 (96 g) (excluding USB cable)
Max. power consumption (mA) DC 5 V 500 mA
System conditions (during
operation)
Ambient temperature 41 ºF to 95 ºF (5 ºC to 35 ºC)
Humidity 20% to 80% (No dew condensation)
System conditions (during
non-operation)
Ambient temperature 32 ºF to 122 ºF (0 ºC to 50 ºC)
Humidity 20% to 80% (No dew condensation)
Compatible computer CPU PC/AT compatible, 1 GHz or more
Memory 128 MB or more
HDD Free space: 100 MB or more
Monitor 800 e 600 pixels, 16-bit color or more
Network TCP/IP
Application Microsoft Internet Explorer 6.0 (SP1) or later
Microsoft .NET Framework (SP1) or later
Interface USB 1.1 or later
Supported Operating Systems Windows 2000 Professional (SP4)
Windows XP Professional Edition (SP2)
Windows Vista Business/Enterprise
Specification
Name AU-201
Dimensions Approx. 3-5/8 (W) e 2-1/2 (D) e 5/8 (H)
(Approx. 92 mm (W) e 64 mm (D) e 16 mm (H))
Weight Approx. 1/4 lb (Approx. 120 g)
Power supply Power received from USB portbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 12-18
12.3 Options
12
System conditions (during
operation)
Ambient temperature 32 ºF to 104 ºF (0 ºC to 40 ºC)
Humidity 20% to 85% (No dew condensation)
System conditions (during
non-operation)
Ambient temperature -4 ºF to 122 ºF (-20 ºC to 50 ºC)
Humidity 20% to 85% (No dew condensation)
Radio law division Self-guided read-write communication facility
Applicable card ISO 14443 TypeA, FeliCa-based noncontact IC
card, HID iClass
Acquired standard VCCI class B
Compatible computer CPU PC/AT compatible, 1 GHz or more
Memory 128 MB or more
HDD Free space: 100 MB or more
Monitor 800e 600 pixels, 16-bit color or more
Network TCP/IP
Application Microsoft Internet Explorer 6.0 (SP1) or later
Microsoft .NET Framework (SP1) or later
Interface USB 1.1 or later
Supported Operating Systems Windows 2000 Professional (SP4)
Windows XP Professional Edition (SP2)
Windows Vista Business/Enterprise
Specification13 Appendixbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 13-2
13.1 Colors
13
13 Appendix
13.1 Colors
Hue, brightness, and saturation
Color has three elements: hue, brightness, and saturation. These are referred to as three attributes of colors
and all colors are created by combinations these elements.
You can adjust the hue, brightness, and saturation in 19 levels.
What is hue?
Everybody has an idea of what "hue" an object has, for example, an apple is red, a lemon is yellow, and the
sky is blue. "Hue" is the tint by which the color of an object is classified as red, yellow, blue, etc.
What is brightness?
"Brightness" is the degree of lightness in a color, as compared with another color, which makes it a light color
or a dark color. For example, when comparing the yellow of a lemon and the yellow of a grapefruit, it is
obvious that the yellow of the lemon is brighter. But what about when comparing the yellow of a lemon and
the red of a bean? Obviously, the yellow of the lemon is brighter. "Brightness" is this degree of lightness that
enables comparison regardless of the hue.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 13-3
13.1 Colors
13
What is saturation?
What makes the difference between the yellow of a lemon and the yellow of a pear? By saying that the lemon
is a more vivid yellow and the pear is a duller yellow, the difference between the two colors is stated in terms
of "saturation", as opposed to "brightness". As opposed to hue and brightness, "saturation" is the
characteristic that indicates the degree of vividness.
Hue
Brightness
Saturationbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 13-4
13.1 Colors
13
Red, green, and blue
This machine allows you to adjust red, green, and blue in 19 levels.
Red
Green
Bulebizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 13-5
13.2 Image quality
13
13.2 Image quality
Contrast, copy density, and sharpness
Contrast:
You can finely adjust an image in between soft/smooth and crisp.
Copy density:
You can finely adjust the shading of an image.
Sharpness:
You can adjust the amount of contours in text and images.
You can adjust the contrast and copy density in 19 levels and the sharpness in 7 levels.
Contrast
Copy Density
Sharpnessbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 13-6
13.2 Image quality
13
Color balance (CMYK)
Full-color copy reproduces colors of the original by mixing toners of four colors: yellow, magenta, cyan, and
black. By changing the amount of each of the four toners, adjust the tints in the copy.
You can adjust the color balance in 19 levels.
Yellow
Bule
Magenta
Red Green
Cyan
Blackbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 13-7
13.3 Glossary
13
13.3 Glossary
The following describes the terms used in Copy mode.
Term Description
ADF The acronym for automatic 2-sided document feeder, which automatically scans
originals. (ADF = Automatic document feeder)
AE Level Adjustment Function that adjusts the background of the original. The higher the setting, the
more that the document background is emphasized. (AE = Auto Exposure)
APS The acronym for Auto Paper Select. (APS = Auto Paper Select)
ATS Function that automatically switches trays. (ATS=Auto Tray Switch)
Auto Paper Function that detects the size of the original placed on the original glass or loaded into the ADF, and automatically selects paper of the same size if it is set to
Full Size or selects the paper size appropriate to the specified zoom ratio.
Auto Zoom Function that automatically selects the appropriate zoom ratio when you place
an original in the ADF or on the original glass, and selects the paper size.
Background Color Function that copies the original using one of the 18 colors available for the
background color (blank areas).
Background Removal
Function that adjusts the background density of the original with a colored background. Select a background removal method and level to copy the original.
Binding Position Function that allows you to specify the position of the page margin in one side
of the loaded original. Selecting the appropriate setting prevents the copy from
being printed upside-down when making a 2-sided copy from a 1-sided original
or when making a 1-sided copy from a 2-sided original.
Blue Function that adjusts the level of blue in the image, for example, if you wish to
emphasize the blue of water or the sky.
Brightness Function that makes the image either lighter or darker.
Center Staple & Fold Function that folds the copies in half and staples them together in the center.
Change Tray Settings Function that copies the original with a paper size not specified in the paper tray
or copies it on paper other than plain paper.
Color Function that copies the original in specified colors. Using the 2 Color function,
you can copy in two colors: specified color and black.
Color Adjust Function that adjusts the color copy image quality to match the original image.
Color Balance Function that adjusts the balance in the concentration for each of cyan (C), magenta (M), yellow (Y) and black (K). You can finely adjust the individual color balance in 19 levels between -3 and +3.
Combine Originals Function that arranges reduced copies of multiple original pages on a single
copy page. You can select , "2in1", "4in1", or "8in1" depending on the number
of pages to be combined.
Contrast Function that adjusts the contrast between light and dark.
Copy Density Function that allows you to finely adjust the copy density in 19 levels between -
3 and +3.
Copy Protect Function that prints hidden text to prevent unauthorized copying. Copying a
copy-protected document repeatedly prints hidden text in all pages more clearly
than the original to prove the user that it is a copied document.
Cover Sheet Function that attaches a sheet in the specified paper tray as a cover page.
Density Function that adjusts the density of the print image in nine levels.
Duplex 2nd Side Function to use when copying on paper that has already been printed on one
side.
Duplex/Combine Function to specify the scanning side of the original and the printing side of the
paper to be 1-sided or 2-sided.
Edit Color Function that configures the image according to the objectives of copy editing.
Finishing Allows you to select how to sort or finish copies when feeding them into the output tray.bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 13-8
13.3 Glossary
13
Finishing Preview Function that allows you to check the finishing status with a preview image before printing.
Finishing Program Allows you to select a preset offset or finishing method.
Glossy Function that improves the glossy level of an image.
Green Function that adjusts the level of green in the image, for example, if you wish to
emphasize the green of forests and trees.
Group (Access permission)
Function that limits the addresses that can be accessed by each user in order to
assure security.
Group (Copy or Finishing)
Function that prints copies in pages. This function first prints the specified
number of copies of the first page, and then prints the second page in the same
way.
Half-Fold Function that folds printed paper in half.
Hue Function that adjusts the hue level to make the image either more reddish or
more bluish.
Manual Function that enlarges or reduces the loaded original with the zoom ratio specified using the keypad, and copies it on paper.
Minimal This setting slightly reduces the image of the original and copies it at the center
of the paper.
Mirror Image Function that produces a copy in the mirror image of the original.
Mixed Original Function that detects the size of each original page and prints a copy on paper
of the appropriate size when loading originals in different page sizes into the
ADF.
Neg./Pos. Reverse Function that copies the original with the light- and dark-colored areas or the
colors (gradations) of the image reversed.
Offset Function that sorts copies.
Original Direction Function that allows you to configure the orientation of the original that was
placed in the ADF or on the original glass.
Original Type Function that allows you to select the desired functions according to the original
text or image type and adjust it to obtain better image quality.
Paper Allows you to configure the type and the size of the paper to be printed on.
Proof Copy Function that prints a sample copy and stops printing temporarily before printing
a large number of copies. This prevents copy errors from occurring in a large
number of copies.
Punch Function that punches copies for filing.
Red Function that adjusts the level of red in the image, for example, if you wish to redden skin tones.
Saturation That adjusts the degree of vividness of the colors in the image.
Save in User BOX Function that temporarily saves the job on the hard disk so that it can be recalled
later and used again.
Separate Scan Function that divides the original into multiple parts for scanning when the
number of original pages exceeds the maximum (100 pages) that can be loaded
into the ADF. You can scan the original and batch-copies it as one copy job. You
can also load the original on the original glass or switch to the ADF during scanning.
Sharpness Function that emphasizes the edges of text so that it can be read more easily.
This function also enables you to adjust the original image.
Sheet/Cover/Chapter Insert
Allows you to configure editing functions according to your copying requirement.
Sort Function that prints a document in sets of copies. The second copy set is printed
after all of the first copy set is finished.
Staple Function that staples copies.
Text Enhancement Function that allows you to configure the reproduction quality of the text when
copying originals consisting of text that overlaps images such as illustrations or
graphs (text with a background).
Term Descriptionbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 13-9
13.3 Glossary
13
Transparency Interleave
Function that inserts a blank sheet between transparency films each time a
transparency film is copied. This function prevents transparency films from sticking together.
Tri-Fold Function that tri-folds printed paper.
Zoom Function that changes the zoom ratio of the copy.
Term Description14 Indexbizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 14-2
14.1 Index by item
14
14 Index
14.1 Index by item
Numerics
1st Z-Fold Position Adjustment .................................7-18
2nd Z-Fold Position Adjustment ...............................7-19
A
Access .........................................................................4-8
Accessibility ..............................................................4-12
Account track ..............................................................4-8
Account track settings ..............................................7-37
ADF ..............................................................................2-7
Adjusting gradation ...................................................7-21
Adjusting the center staple position ..........................7-14
Adjusting the half-fold position .................................7-15
Adjusting the punch edge sensor .............................7-17
Adjusting the punch horizontal position ....................7-16
Adjusting the punch resistance loop .........................7-17
Adjusting the punch vertical position ........................7-16
Adjusting the tri-fold positions ..................................7-15
Administrator password ............................................7-49
Administrator security levels .....................................7-50
Administrator settings .................................................7-2
Administrator/machine settings ................................7-29
Advanced preview .....................................................4-19
Application settings ...................................................5-20
Authentication device settings ..................................7-40
Authentication method ..............................................7-40
Authentication unit ..............................................2-2, 2-5
Authentication unit (biometric type)
............................................................10-2, 12-16, 12-17
Authentication unit (IC card type) ..................11-2, 12-17
Automatic duplex unit .......................................2-7, 12-7
B
Background color ......................................................5-31
Basic tab ...................................................................2-16
Biometric type ...........................................................10-2
Blank page print settings ..........................................7-26
Blue ...........................................................................13-4
Book copy .................................................................5-33
Book copy/repeat ......................................................5-33
Booklet ......................................................................5-40
Booklet original .........................................................5-36
Brightness .................................................................13-2
Brightness adjustment dial ........................................2-14
Bypass tray .................................................................2-7
Bypass tray door .........................................................2-7
C
C ................................................................................4-17
Centering ...................................................................7-13
Centering (duplex 2nd side) ......................................7-13
Changing E-mail addresses ......................................6-14
Changing icons ..........................................................6-15
Changing passwords .................................................6-13
Charger-cleaning tool ................................................2-11
Checking comsumables ..............................................8-8
Checking job settings ................................................2-16
Checking job settings. ...............................................5-64
Checking the total number of pages printed .............8-11
Cleaning procedure ...................................................8-12
CMYK ........................................................................13-6
Color ............................................................................5-4
Color adjustment .......................................................5-31
Color balance ............................................................13-6
Color registration adjustment ....................................7-20
Colors ........................................................................13-2
Configuring the basic settings .....................................5-3
Contrast .....................................................................13-5
Control panel .................................. 2-7, 2-14, 4-2, 8-13
Copier settings ................................................. 6-8, 7-43
Copy density .............................................................13-5
Copy function ..............................................................5-2
Copy protection .........................................................5-48
Copying .......................................................................4-5
Copying mixed originals ............................................5-16
Cover sheet ...............................................................5-22
Coverage rate ............................................................8-10
Custom display settings ..............................................6-6
Custom size .................................................................5-6
D
Data indicator ............................................................2-14
Date/time ...................................................................5-44
Date/time settings .......................................................7-5
Daylight saving time ....................................................7-6
Default bypass paper type setting ............................7-27
Document pad ...........................................................8-14
Driver password encryption setting ...........................7-57
Duplex/Combine ..........................................................5-8
E
Editing colors .............................................................5-29
Editing pages .............................................................5-21
Eject assist lever ........................................................2-25
Electrostatic charger wire ..........................................9-12
Enhanced security mode ...........................................7-54
Enlarge Display ..........................................................4-14
Erasing .......................................................................5-41
Erasing frames ...........................................................5-41bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 14-3
14.1 Index by item
14
Erasing non-image areas ..........................................5-42
Expert adjustment .......................................................7-9
External server settings .............................................7-39
F
Fax kit ..................................................................2-2, 2-6
Fax multi line ...............................................................2-2
Fax settings ...............................................................7-46
Fax/Scan .....................................................................4-5
Fax/scan settings ......................................................6-11
Filter .............................................................................2-9
Finisher ......................... 2-2, 2-3, 2-6, 2-18, 2-23, 12-9
Finisher connector .......................................................2-9
Finishing ....................................................................5-10
Folding and binding ...................................................5-10
Front door ..............................................2-18, 2-21, 2-24
Function keys ............................................................2-14
Function management settings .................................7-56
Functions/settings display area ................................2-16
Fusing unit .................................................................2-11
Fusing unit cover lever ..............................................2-11
G
General settings ........................................................7-32
Green .........................................................................13-4
Grouping ...................................................................5-10
Guidance ...................................................................4-15
Guide lever ............................................2-18, 2-21, 2-24
H
HDD settings .............................................................7-55
Header/footer ............................................................5-53
Hide Personal Information (MIB) ...............................7-52
Horizontal transport unit cover ........................2-18, 2-24
Housing .....................................................................8-14
Hue ............................................................................13-2
I
IC card type ...............................................................11-2
Icon/shortcut key display area ..................................2-16
Icons ..........................................................................9-10
Image adjustment ......................................................5-39
Image controller ..................................................2-2, 2-5
Image quality .............................................................13-5
Image Repeat ............................................................5-34
Imaging unit ...............................................................2-11
Imaging unit release lever .........................................2-11
Inserting images ........................................................5-24
Inserting sheets .........................................................5-23
Inside of the main body .............................................2-11
Interleaving OHP transparencies ...............................5-21
Internal controller port .................................................2-9
Interrupt .......................................................................4-4
J
Jack for connecting a telephone (TEL PORT1) ...........2-9
Jack for connecting a telephone (TEL PORT2) ...........2-9
Jam removal cover ....................................................2-26
Jam removal dial ............................................ 2-11, 2-18
Job list .......................................................................2-16
Job Separator ................. 2-3, 2-6, 12-12, 12-15, 12-16
Job separator cover ..................................................2-20
Job Separator JS-504 ...............................................2-25
Job separator JS-602 ................................................2-20
Job Separator JS-603 ...............................................2-23
K
Keypad ......................................................................2-14
L
Large capacity unit ......................... 2-2, 2-5, 2-26, 12-8
Lateral guide ................................................................2-7
Leading edge adjustment ..........................................7-13
Leading edge adjustment (duplex side 2) .................7-13
Left panel ........................................................ 2-16, 5-61
Left-side cover .............................................................2-7
Left-side cover release levert ......................................2-7
License settings .........................................................7-58
Limiting access to destinations .................................7-39
List/counter ...............................................................7-22
Listing jobs ................................................................5-62
Loading paper .............................................................8-3
Loading paper into the bypass tray .............................8-5
Loading paper into the LCT .........................................8-7
Loading paper into trays 1 and 2 ................................8-3
Loading paper into trays 3 and 4 ................................8-4
Local interface kit ............................................... 2-2, 2-6
Lower front door ..........................................................2-7
Lower right-side door ..................................................2-7
Lower right-side door release lever .............................2-8
Lower Tray .................................................................2-22
Lower tray paper guide .............................................2-22
M
Machine specifications ..............................................12-4
Main power indicator .................................................2-14
Main power switch ......................................................2-7
Maintenance ................................................................8-2
Media adjustment ......................................................7-14
Message display area ................................................2-16
Meter count ...............................................................8-10
Mirror image ..............................................................5-30
Mode Memory .............................................................4-7
Mount kit ............................................................. 2-2, 2-5
N
Negative-positive reversal .........................................5-29
Network connector
(10Base-T/100BaseTX/1000Base-T) ...........................2-9
Network settings .......................................................7-42
O
Offsetting ...................................................................5-10
OpenAPI Authentication Management Settings ........7-59
Options ............................................................. 2-2, 12-8
Original glass ........................................ 2-11, 8-12, 8-13bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 14-4
14.1 Index by item
14
Original glass cleaner ................................................2-11
Original output tray ......................................................2-7
Original scales ...........................................................2-11
Original setting ..........................................................5-15
Original tray .................................................................2-7
Output belt ................................................................2-18
Output settings ............................................................7-4
Output tray ....................................... 2-2, 2-5, 2-7, 2-18
Output tray 1 .........................................2-18, 2-24, 2-25
Output tray 2 .........................................2-18, 2-24, 2-25
Output tray switch .....................................................2-18
Outside of the main body (front) .................................2-7
Outside of the main body (rear) ...................................2-9
Overlay ......................................................................5-55
Overlaying registered images ....................................5-56
Ozone filter ..................................................................2-9
P
Page margin ..............................................................5-37
Page number .............................................................5-45
Page number print position settings .........................7-28
Paper .........................................................5-5, 8-2, 12-2
Paper capacities ........................................................12-2
Paper types ...............................................................12-2
Paper-empty indicator ......................................2-7, 2-26
Password Copy .........................................................5-50
Placing originals ..........................................................3-4
Post Inserter ............................... 2-3, 2-22, 5-12, 12-13
Post inserter control panel ..............................2-22, 5-12
Poster mode ..............................................................5-35
Power cord ..................................................................2-9
Power Save ...............................................................4-11
Power save settings ....................................................7-3
Power switch for dehumidifying heater .......................2-9
Print head ..................................................................9-13
Print head glass cleaning tool ...................................2-11
Print without authentication ......................................7-38
Printer settings ................................................6-12, 7-45
Printing counter list ...................................................7-38
Program jobs .............................................................5-27
Proof copy .................................................................4-18
Punch kit .................................... 2-2, 2-18, 2-23, 12-11
Punch kit PK-516 ......................................................2-18
Punch Kit PK-517 ......................................................2-23
Punch scrap box ...................................2-19, 2-21, 2-24
Punch Unit Size Detect Sensor .................................7-19
Punching ...................................................................5-10
Q
Quality/density ..........................................................5-18
Quick Copy tab .........................................................2-16
R
Red ............................................................................13-4
Register Authentication Information ..........................6-16
Registering one-touch destinations or
User Boxes ................................................................7-30
Release lever .............................................................2-26
Replacement message ................................................8-8
Replenishment message .............................................8-2
Reset ...........................................................................4-4
Reset settings ............................................................7-23
Restricting user accesses ...........................................7-8
Reverse automatic document feeder ........................12-7
RS-232C port ..............................................................2-9
S
Saddle stitcher ..................... 2-2, 2-3, 2-6, 2-18, 12-10
Saddle stitcher SD-508 .............................................2-18
Saddle Stitcher SD-509 .............................................2-23
Saturation ..................................................................13-2
Saving in User Boxes ................................................5-60
Scan to authorized folder settings ............................7-41
Scan to home settings ...............................................7-41
Security details ..........................................................7-51
Security kit .......................................................... 2-2, 2-6
Security settings ........................................................7-49
Separate scan ...........................................................5-13
Separating chapters ..................................................5-26
Service call ..................................................................9-2
Settings common to user and account track
authentication ............................................................7-41
Sharpness ..................................................................13-5
Skip job operation settings ........................................7-26
Sorting .......................................................................5-10
Specifications ............................................................12-2
Stamp ........................................................................5-47
Stamp repetition ........................................................5-51
Stamp settings ............................................... 7-25, 7-57
Stamp unit .......................................................... 2-3, 2-6
Stamp/composition ...................................................5-43
Staple cartridge .........................................................2-25
Staple holder .............................................................2-24
Staple replacement door ...........................................2-18
Stapler .......................................................................2-24
Stapling .....................................................................5-10
Start .............................................................................4-4
Status indicator ...........................................................2-7
Stop .............................................................................4-4
Stylus pen ..................................................................2-14
Sub power switch ............................................. 2-7, 2-14
System connection ....................................................7-47
System settings .................................................. 6-3, 7-3
T
Take-up roller ............................................................8-13
Telephone jack 1 (LINE PORT1) ..................................2-9
Telephone jack 2 (LINE PORT2) ..................................2-9
Toner cartridges ........................................................2-11
Toner supply indicators .............................................2-16
Total counter ...............................................................2-7
Touch panel .................................................... 2-14, 2-16
Touch pen ..................................................................2-14
Tray 1 ...........................................................................2-7bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 14-5
14.1 Index by item
14
Tray 2 ..........................................................................2-7
Tray 3 ..........................................................................2-7
Tray 4 ..........................................................................2-7
Tray extension ...........................................................2-25
Troubleshooting ..........................................................9-2
Troubleshooting table .................................................9-4
Turning off automatic rotation ...................................5-14
U
Upper door ................................................................2-26
Upper front door ..........................................................2-7
Upper right-side door ..................................................2-7
Upper right-side door release lever .............................2-8
Upper Tray ................................................................2-22
Upper Tray paper guide ............................................2-22
Upper unit release lever ............................................2-22
USB port (type A) USB 2.0/1.1 ............................2-7, 2-9
USB port (type B) USB 2.0/1.1 ....................................2-9
User authentication .....................................................4-8
User authentication settings .....................................7-34
User authentication/account track ............................7-31
User Box ......................................................................4-5
User Box administrator setting .................................7-49
User Box settings ......................................................7-24
User settings ...............................................................6-2
Utility/Counter .............................................................4-6
V
Video interface kit ........................................................2-2
W
Waste toner box ........................................................2-11
Watermark .................................................................5-54
Weekly timer setting ....................................................7-7
Wide paper ..................................................................5-6
Working table ......................................................2-2, 2-5
Z
Z folding unit .................................................2-21, 12-12
Z-folded original ........................................................5-17
Zoom .................................................................5-7, 5-59bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 14-6
14.2 Index by button
14
14.2 Index by button
Numerics
1-Sided > 1-Sided .......................................................5-8
1-Sided > 2-Sided .......................................................5-8
1st Z-Fold Position Adjustment .................................7-18
2 Color .........................................................................5-4
2/4/8 Repeat ..............................................................5-35
2in1 ..............................................................................5-9
2nd Z-Fold Position Adjustment ...............................7-19
2-Sided > 1-Sided .......................................................5-8
2-Sided > 2-Sided .......................................................5-8
4in1/8in1 ......................................................................5-9
A
Access .........................................................................4-8
Accessibility ..............................................................4-12
Account Name ...................................................4-9, 7-35
Account Track ...........................................................7-32
Account Track Counter .............................................7-38
Account Track Input Method ....................................7-32
Account Track Registration .......................................7-37
Account Track Settings .............................................7-37
Administrative Settings .............................................7-34
Administrator Password ............................................7-49
Administrator Registration .........................................7-29
Administrator Security Levels ...................................7-50
Administrator Settings .........................................4-6, 7-2
Administrator/Machine Settings ................................7-29
AE Level Adjustment ...........................................6-3, 7-9
All Jobs ......................................................................5-63
Application ................................................................5-20
Apply Stamps ............................................................7-57
Auth.-info.registrieren ................................................7-35
Authentication Device Settings .................................7-40
Auto .............................................................................5-7
Auto Booklet ON when Fold & Staple .........................6-8
Auto Color ...................................................................5-4
Auto Color Level Adjust. ..............................................6-3
Auto Detect ...............................................................5-34
Auto Paper Select for Small Original ...........................6-4
Auto Prefix/Suffix setting ...........................................7-47
Auto Reset .................................................................7-23
Auto Reset Confirmation ...........................................4-13
Auto Rotate OFF .......................................................5-14
Auto Sort/Group Selection ..........................................6-8
Auto Tray Selection Settings .......................................6-3
Auto Tray Switch ON/OFF ...........................................6-3
Auto Zoom (ADF) ...............................................6-8, 7-43
Auto Zoom (Platen) ............................................6-8, 7-43
Auto Zoom for Combine/Booklet ................................6-8
Automatic Image Rotation .................................6-9, 7-43
B
Back (Blank) ..............................................................5-22
Back (Copy) ...............................................................5-22
Background Color .....................................................5-31
Background Removal ................................................5-19
Banner Printing ............................................................4-6
Basic ............................................................................5-3
Binding Position ..................................... 5-8, 5-15, 5-34
Bio Authentication .....................................................7-40
Black ............................................................................5-4
Blank ..........................................................................5-24
Blank Page Print Settings ................................. 6-4, 7-26
Blue ...........................................................................5-32
Book Copy .................................................................5-33
Book Copy/Repeat ....................................................5-33
Book Spread ..............................................................5-33
Booklet ......................................................................5-40
Booklet Original .........................................................5-36
Bottom .......................................................................5-41
Brightness .................................................................5-32
Bypass Tray .................................................................5-5
C
C ................................................................................4-17
Card Authentication ...................................................7-40
Card Copy .................................................................5-59
Card Shot Settings ......................................................6-9
Cellular Phone/PDA Setting ......................................7-48
Center Erase ..............................................................5-34
Center Staple & Fold .................................................5-40
Center Staple Position ...............................................7-14
Center Zoom .............................................................5-39
Centering ........................................................ 5-39, 7-13
Centering (Duplex 2nd Side) ......................................7-13
Change E-Mail Address .............................................6-14
Change Icon ..............................................................6-15
Change Password .....................................................6-13
Change Setting ..........................................................4-20
Change Size ................................................................5-6
Change Tray Settings ..................................................5-5
Chapter Paper ...........................................................5-26
Chapters ....................................................................5-26
Check Consumable Life ..............................................4-6
Check Details ............................................................5-61
Check Job ...................................................... 5-61, 5-64
Check Job Set. ..........................................................5-63
Check Program Settings .............................................4-7
Check/Change Temporarily .......................................5-53
Color ................................................................. 5-4, 5-55
Color Adjustment .......................................................5-31
Color Balance ............................................................5-32
Color Registration Adjust ............................... 7-11, 7-20
Color Selection Settings ..............................................6-6
Composition ..............................................................5-56
Confidential Document Access Method ....................7-52
Consumables Replace/Processing Procedure ..........4-16
Contrast .....................................................................5-32bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 14-7
14.2 Index by button
14
Copied Paper ............................................................5-19
Copier Settings ..........................................6-6, 6-8, 7-43
Copy ..................................................................4-5, 5-23
Copy Card Settings ...................................................7-43
Copy Density .............................................................5-32
Copy Guard ...............................................................5-49
Copy Insert ................................................................5-26
Copy Program Lock Settings ......................................7-8
Copy Protect .............................................................5-48
Copy Screen ................................................................6-6
Counter Details ................................................7-36, 7-38
Cover Sheet .....................................................5-22, 5-40
Coverage Rate ..........................................................8-10
Current Jobs ..............................................................5-63
Custom Display Settings .............................................6-6
Custom Size ................................................................5-6
D
Date Format ..............................................................5-44
Date Settings ...............................................................7-7
Date/Time ......................... 5-44, 5-48, 5-50, 5-51, 5-52
Date/Time Settings ......................................................7-5
Daylight Saving Time ...................................................7-6
Default Bypass Paper Type Setting ..........................7-27
Default Copy Settings .................................................6-8
Default Enlarge Display Settings .................................6-8
Default Function Permission .....................................7-34
Default Operation Selection ......................................7-34
Default Tab ..................................................................6-6
Default Tab Density Settings .......................................6-6
Delete ..............................................................5-61, 5-63
Delete Registered Stamp ..........................................7-57
Delete Saved Copy Program .......................................7-8
Deleted Jobs .............................................................5-63
Density ............................................................5-19, 5-55
Density Adjustment ...................................................7-10
Despeckle ..................................................................5-15
Detail .........................................................................5-63
Detail Settings ............................ 5-48, 5-50, 5-51, 5-52
Detection While Feeding Setting ...............................7-11
Device Information ......................................................4-6
Display Activity Log ...................................................7-52
Document Name .......................................................5-60
Dot Matrix Original ....................................................5-19
Driver Password Encryption Setting .........................7-57
Duplex/Combine .........................................................5-8
E
Edit Color ..................................................................5-29
Edit Name ....................................................................4-7
E-Mail Address ..........................................................7-34
Enhanced Security Mode ..........................................7-54
Enlarge Display ..........................................................4-14
Enlarge Display Mode Confirmation ..........................4-13
Enlargement Rotation ..................................................6-8
Enter Power Save Mode .............................................7-3
Erase ..........................................................................5-41
Erase Adjustment ......................................................7-12
Expert Adjustment .......................................................7-9
External Server Settings ............................................7-39
F
FAX Active Screen .......................................................6-6
Fax Settings ...............................................................7-46
Fax TX Settings .........................................................7-25
Fax/Scan .....................................................................4-5
Fax/Scan Settings .....................................................6-11
Finished Jobs ............................................................5-63
Finisher Adjustment ...................................................7-10
Finishing ....................................................................5-10
Finishing Program .......................................................6-9
Fixed Zoom .................................................................5-7
Fold/Bind ...................................................................5-11
Frame ........................................................................5-41
Frame Erase ................................................... 5-34, 5-41
Front (Blank) ..............................................................5-22
Front (Copy) ...............................................................5-22
Front and Back Cover ...............................................5-33
Front Cover ................................................................5-33
Full Color .....................................................................5-4
Full Size ............................................................ 5-7, 5-39
Function .....................................................................4-15
Function Management Settings ................................7-56
Function Map ............................................................4-15
Function Permission ..................................................7-35
G
General Settings ............................................. 7-32, 7-40
Get Request Code .....................................................7-58
Glossy ........................................................................5-19
Gradation Adjustment .................................... 7-11, 7-21
Green .........................................................................5-32
Group .........................................................................5-10
Guidance ...................................................................4-15
H
Half-Fold ....................................................................5-40
Half-Fold Position ......................................................7-15
Half-Fold Specification ................................................6-9
Half-Fold/Tri-Fold Specification ..................................6-9
HDD Settings .............................................................7-55
Header/Footer ...........................................................5-53
Header/Footer Settings .............................................7-25
Hide Personal Information .........................................7-52
Hide Personal Information (MIB) ...............................7-52
Hue ............................................................................5-32
I
Icon ............................................................................7-35
ID & Print Operation Settings ....................................7-34
ID & Print Settings .....................................................7-34
Image Adjust ..............................................................5-39
Image Repeat ............................................................5-34bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 14-8
14.2 Index by button
14
Image Shift ................................................................5-38
Image Size .................................................................5-35
Image Stabilization ....................................................7-10
Image Stabilization Only ............................................7-10
Image Stabilization Setting ........................................7-11
Increase Priority ........................................................5-63
Initialize ......................................................................7-52
Input Machine Address .............................................7-29
Insert Image ...............................................................5-24
Insert Paper ...............................................................5-23
Insert Sheet ...............................................................5-23
Insert Sheet Setting ...................................................5-46
Install License ............................................................7-58
Interleave Paper ........................................................5-21
Interrupt .......................................................................4-4
J
Job Details ................................................................5-61
Job History ................................................................5-63
Job History Thumbnail Display .................................7-52
Job List ............................................................5-61, 5-62
Job Log Settings .......................................................7-52
Job Reset ..................................................................7-23
K
Key Repeat Start/Interval Time .................................4-13
L
Language Selection .....................................................6-3
Layout ........................................................................5-59
LCT ..............................................................................5-5
Leading Edge Adjustment .........................................7-13
Leading Edge Adjustment (Duplex Side 2) ................7-13
Left ............................................................................5-41
Left Bind ....................................................................5-40
Left Panel Display Default ...........................................6-6
License Settings ........................................................7-58
Limiting Access to Destinations ................................7-39
Line Detection ...........................................................7-11
List/Counter ...............................................................7-22
Login ............................................................................4-9
Logout Confirmation Screen Display Setting ............7-41
Low Power ..................................................................7-3
Low Power Mode Settings ..........................................7-3
M
Management List .......................................................7-22
Manual .........................................................................5-7
Manual Destination Input ..........................................7-52
Map ...........................................................................5-18
Margin Position .........................................................5-38
Max. Allowance Set .........................................7-35, 7-37
Measurement Unit Settings .........................................6-3
Media Adjustment .....................................................7-14
Message Display Time ..............................................4-13
Meter Count ..............................................................8-10
Minimal ........................................................................5-7
Mirror Image ..............................................................5-30
Mixed Original ...........................................................5-15
Mode Memory .............................................................4-7
N
Name and Function of Parts ......................................4-15
Neg./Pos. Reverse .....................................................5-29
Network Function Usage Settings .............................7-56
Network Settings .......................................................7-42
No Matching Paper in Tray Setting .............................6-3
None ..........................................................................5-41
Non-Image Area Erase ..............................................5-42
Non-Image Area Erase Operation Settings ...............7-12
Number of User Counters Assigned .........................7-33
O
Offset .........................................................................5-11
OHP Interleave ..........................................................5-21
ON (External Server) ..................................................7-32
ON (MFP) ...................................................................7-32
One-Touch/User Box Registration ................... 4-6, 7-30
OpenAPI Authentication Management Settings ........7-59
OpenAPI settings .......................................................7-47
Original Setting ..........................................................5-15
Original Type .............................................................5-18
Other ............................................................... 5-48, 5-52
Other Functions .........................................................4-15
Output Permission .......................................... 7-35, 7-37
Output Settings .................................................. 6-3, 7-4
Output Tray Settings ...................................................7-4
Overlay ......................................................................5-55
P
P --- ...................................................... 5-23, 5-25, 5-26
Page Margin ..............................................................5-37
Page Number ............................................................5-45
Page Number Print Position ............................. 6-4, 7-28
Page Number Type ....................................................5-45
Pages .......................................... 5-44, 5-47, 5-55, 5-57
Paper ................................................................ 5-5, 5-22
Paper Separation Adjustment ...................................7-11
Paper Size .................................................................5-36
Paper Size/Type Counter ..........................................7-22
Paper Tray Settings .....................................................6-3
Password .......................................................... 4-9, 7-34
Password Copy .........................................................5-50
Password for Non- Business Hours ............................7-7
Password Rules .........................................................7-51
Pause .............................................................. 7-35, 7-38
Photo .........................................................................5-18
Position ........................................................... 5-49, 5-52
Position Setting .........................................................5-12
Post Inserter ..................................................... 2-3, 5-12
Post inserter control panel ........................................5-12
Poster Mode ..............................................................5-35
Power Save ...............................................................4-11
Power Save Key ..........................................................7-3bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 14-9
14.2 Index by button
14
Power Save Settings ...........................................6-3, 7-3
Preset Stamp ...................................................5-48, 5-52
Print ...........................................................................5-62
Print Counter List ......................................................7-38
Print Data Capture .....................................................7-52
Print Jobs During Copy Operation ....................6-9, 7-43
Print Lists ....................................................................6-3
Print Position .........................................5-44, 5-46, 5-47
Print without Authentication ......................................7-38
Print/Fax Output Settings ............................................7-4
Printer Adjustment .......................................................7-9
Printer Information .....................................................7-48
Printer Settings ........................................6-12, 7-2, 7-45
Prior Detection Setting ..............................................7-11
Program Jobs ............................................................5-27
Prohibited Functions When Authentication Error ......7-51
Proof Copy ................................................................4-18
Public User Access ...........................................4-9, 7-32
Punch ........................................................................5-11
Punch Edge Sensor Adjustment ...............................7-17
Punch Horizontal Position Adjustment ......................7-16
Punch Regist Loop Size Adjustment .........................7-17
Punch Vertical Position Adjustment ..........................7-16
Q
Quality/Density ..........................................................5-18
Quick Settings 1 ..........................................................6-6
Quick Settings 2 ..........................................................6-6
Quick Settings 3 ..........................................................6-6
Quick Settings 4 ..........................................................6-6
R
Recall Header/Footer ................................................5-53
Recall Overlay Image ................................................5-57
Receive ......................................................................5-62
Red ............................................................................5-32
Register Authentication Information ..........................6-16
Register Overlay Image .............................................5-57
Register Program ........................................................4-7
Registered Overlay ....................................................5-56
Registered Stamp ...........................................5-48, 5-52
Release Held Job ......................................................5-63
Reset .................................................................4-4, 5-53
Reset All Counters ...........................................7-36, 7-38
Reset Settings ...........................................................7-23
Restrict Access to Job Settings ..................................7-8
Restrict Fax TX ..........................................................7-52
Restrict Operation .......................................................7-8
Restrict User Access ...................................................7-8
Right ..........................................................................5-41
Right Bind ..................................................................5-40
Rotate Image .............................................................4-20
S
Saturation ..................................................................5-32
Save ..........................................................................5-62
Save & Print ...............................................................5-60
Save in User Box .......................................................5-60
Scan to Authorized Folder Settings ...........................7-41
Scan to Home Settings .............................................7-41
Scan/Fax Settings .......................................................6-6
Search by Operation .................................................4-15
Search Option Settings ...............................................6-7
Secure Print Only .......................................................7-52
Security Details ..........................................................7-51
Security Settings .......................................................7-49
Select Color ...............................................................5-31
Select Keyboard ..........................................................6-4
Select Time for Power Save ........................................7-7
Select Tray for Insert Sheet .............................. 6-8, 7-43
Send ..........................................................................5-62
Separate Scan ...........................................................5-13
Separate Scan Output Method ...................................6-8
Separation .................................................................5-33
Server Name ................................................................4-9
Service/Admin. Information .......................................4-15
Set Range ..................................................................5-35
Sharpness ..................................................................5-32
Sheet/Cover/ Chapter Insert .....................................5-21
Shift Output Each Job .................................................7-4
Shortcut Key 1 .............................................................6-6
Shortcut Key 2 .............................................................6-6
Single Color .................................................................5-4
Single Color > 2 Color Output Management .............7-41
Skip Job Operation Settings .....................................7-26
Sleep ............................................................................7-3
Sleep Mode Settings ...................................................7-3
Sort ............................................. 5-10, 5-23, 5-25, 5-26
Sound Setting ............................................................4-13
Specify Default Tray when APS Off .................. 6-8, 7-43
Stamp ........................................................................5-47
Stamp Repeat ............................................................5-51
Stamp Settings ............................................... 7-25, 7-57
Stamp Type/Preset Stamps ......................................5-47
Stamp/Composition ..................................................5-43
Staple ........................................................................5-11
Start .............................................................................4-4
Starting Chapter Number ..........................................5-45
Starting Page Number ...............................................5-45
Stop .............................................................................4-4
Store ............................................................................5-6
Synchronize User Authentication &
Account Track ...........................................................7-33
System Auto Reset ....................................................7-23
System Auto Reset Confirmation ..............................4-13
System Connection ...................................................7-47
System Settings ................................................. 6-3, 7-3
T
Text ............................................................................5-18
Text Color ....................................................... 5-47, 5-54
Text Details ..................................................... 5-44, 5-46
Text Enhancement .....................................................5-19bizhub C652/C652DS/C552/C552DS/C452 14-10
14.2 Index by button
14
Text Size ....................................................................5-47
Text/Photo .................................................................5-18
Ticket Hold Time Setting ...........................................7-33
Time Format ..............................................................5-44
Time Settings ..............................................................7-7
Time Zone ...................................................................7-5
Top ............................................................................5-41
Touch Panel Adjustment ...........................................4-12
Trail Edge Adjust .......................................................7-11
Transparency .............................................................5-21
Tray 1 ..........................................................................5-5
Tray 2 ..........................................................................5-5
Tray 3 ..........................................................................5-5
Tray 4 ..........................................................................5-5
Tri-Fold Position Adjustment .....................................7-15
Tri-Fold Print Side .............................................6-8, 7-43
U
User Authentication ...................................................7-32
User Authentication Settings .....................................7-34
User Authentication/Account Track ..........................7-31
User Box ............................................................4-5, 5-60
User Box Administrator Setting .................................7-49
User Box Settings .............................................6-6, 7-24
User Counter .............................................................7-36
User Name ........................................................4-9, 7-34
User Name List ..................................................4-9, 7-34
User Preset Zoom .......................................................5-7
User Registration .......................................................7-34
User Settings .......................................................4-6, 6-2
User/Account Common Setting ................................7-41
Utility/Counter .............................................................4-6
V
View Finishing ...........................................................4-20
View Pages ................................................................4-20
View Status ...............................................................4-20
W
Watermark .................................................................5-54
Watermark Type ........................................................5-54
Weekly Timer ON/OFF Settings ..................................7-7
Weekly Timer Setting ..................................................7-7
When # of Jobs Reach Maximum .............................7-33
When AMS Direction is Incorrect ................................6-8
Wide Paper ..................................................................5-6
With Margin ...............................................................5-34
Without Margin ..........................................................5-34
X
X/Y ...............................................................................5-6
Z
Z-Folded Original ......................................................5-15
Zoom .......................................................4-19, 5-7, 5-36http://konicaminolta.com
Copyright
A1DM-9585CO-00 2009 2009.11
Guide de l’utilisateur
IC-202 (Phase 2) Sommaire-1
Sommaire
1 Introduction
Déclaration OpenSSL..................................................................... 1-5
Copyright ....................................................................................... 1-7
1.1 Licence d'utilisation du logiciel....................................................... 1-8
1.2 A propos de ce Guide de l'utilisateur............................................ 1-10
Composition du Guide de l'utilisateur.......................................... 1-10
Notations...................................................................................... 1-10
Captures d'écran de ce manuel utilisateur .................................. 1-10
1.3 Explication des conventions.......................................................... 1-11
Recommandations de sécurité .................................................... 1-11
Séquence d'actions ..................................................................... 1-11
Astuces ........................................................................................ 1-12
Repères de texte spéciaux .......................................................... 1-12
2 Présentation
2.1 Configuration du CD-ROM du contrôleur ...................................... 2-3
2.2 Contrôleur d'impression .................................................................. 2-4
Rôle du contrôleur d'impression.................................................... 2-4
Fonctions disponibles du contrôleur d'impression........................ 2-4
Modes machine.............................................................................. 2-5
Flux d'impression........................................................................... 2-6
2.3 Environnement d'exploitation.......................................................... 2-8
Système d'exploitation compatible avec le pilote d'imprimante ... 2-8
Pilote PCL ...................................................................................... 2-8
Pilote PS (PostScript3)................................................................... 2-8
Pilote PPD PostScript (PostScript3) .............................................. 2-9
Interfaces compatibles................................................................... 2-9
2.4 Installation du système .................................................................. 2-11
Pour installer le système d'impression ........................................ 2-11
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3.1 Pilotes d'imprimante et systèmes d'exploitation compatibles .... 3-3
3.2 Utilisé avec Windows ....................................................................... 3-4
Installation du pilote d'imprimante à l'aide de l'Assistant Ajout
d'imprimante .................................................................................. 3-5
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64.............. 3-6
Sommaire-2 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour Windows 98SE/Me/NT 4.0/2000............................................ 3-8
Installation à l'aide du câble USB................................................. 3-10
Pour Windows 98SE/Me............................................................... 3-10
Pour Windows 2000...................................................................... 3-12
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64 ............ 3-13
Désinstaller le pilote d'imprimante................................................ 3-14
Désinstaller le pilote d'imprimante manuellement ........................ 3-14
3.3 Si vous utilisez Macintosh .............................................................. 3-15
Installation du pilote d'imprimante................................................ 3-15
Pour Mac OS X ............................................................................. 3-15
Sélectionner une imprimante ........................................................ 3-17
Pour Mac OS X ............................................................................. 3-17
Pour Mac OS 9 ............................................................................. 3-20
Désinstaller le pilote d'imprimante................................................ 3-22
Pour Mac OS X ............................................................................. 3-22
Pour Mac OS 9 ............................................................................. 3-23
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4.1 Aperçu des fonctions réseau ........................................................... 4-3
Fonctions réseau ............................................................................ 4-3
Caractéristiques des fonctions réseau ........................................... 4-4
Méthodes de connexion réseau que l'on peut sélectionner dans
chaque système d'exploitation Windows ....................................... 4-5
Impression réseau à partir d'un système d'exploitation Windows . 4-5
Impression réseau dans un environnement NetWare..................... 4-5
4.2 Réglage de l'adresse IP pour cet appareil ...................................... 4-6
Spécification de l'Adresse IP.......................................................... 4-6
4.3 Accéder à Web Connection.............................................................. 4-8
Pour accéder à Web Connection.................................................... 4-8
4.4 Impression SMB ................................................................................ 4-9
Opérations sur cet appareil ............................................................ 4-9
Paramètres du serveur d'imprimante ........................................... 4-11
Pour Windows 98SE/Me............................................................... 4-11
Pour Windows NT 4.0/2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/
Server 2003 x64............................................................................ 4-11
4.5 Impression Raw/LPR ...................................................................... 4-12
Opérations sur cet appareil .......................................................... 4-12
Paramètres du serveur d'imprimante ........................................... 4-12
Pour Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64 ... 4-12
Réglage de l'impression Raw ....................................................... 4-13
Réglage de l'impression LPR........................................................ 4-13
Pour Windows NT 4.0 (lors du réglage de l'impression LPR) ....... 4-13
IC-202 (Phase 2) Sommaire-3
4.6 Impression IPP (Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/
Server 2003 x64).............................................................................. 4-14
Opérations sur cet appareil.......................................................... 4-14
Installation du pilote d'imprimante............................................... 4-16
4.7 Imprimer avec NetWare ................................................................. 4-18
Impression réseau dans un environnement NetWare.................. 4-18
Pour le mode Imprimante distante avec l'émulation NetWare 4.x
Bindery ......................................................................................... 4-18
Pour le mode Serveur d'impression avec émulation NetWare 4.x
BIndery......................................................................................... 4-21
Pour le mode imprimante distante NetWare 4.x (NDS)................ 4-24
Pour le mode Serveur d'impression NetWare 4.x/5.x/6 (NDS) .... 4-27
Pour le service distribué d'impression NetWare 5.x/6 Novell
(NDPS).......................................................................................... 4-30
Configurer les paramètres d'un client (Windows) avec le serveur
NetWare ....................................................................................... 4-32
4.8 Imprimer avec Macintosh .............................................................. 4-33
Opérations sur cet appareil.......................................................... 4-33
Spécifier les paramètres AppleTalk ............................................. 4-33
Spécifier les paramètres Bonjour................................................. 4-35
Réglage de l'ordinateur Macintosh .............................................. 4-37
Pour Mac OS X ............................................................................ 4-37
Pour Mac OS 9............................................................................. 4-38
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5.1 Opérations d'impression.................................................................. 5-3
Pour Windows................................................................................ 5-3
Impression Test.............................................................................. 5-5
Pour Macintosh.............................................................................. 5-6
Pour Mac OS X .............................................................................. 5-6
Pour Mac OS 9............................................................................... 5-7
5.2 Réglage des fonctions d'impression .............................................. 5-8
Liste des fonctions......................................................................... 5-8
Présentation des fonctions .......................................................... 5-11
Orientation.................................................................................... 5-11
Format des originaux et format de sortie..................................... 5-12
Zoom (agrandissement et réduction) ........................................... 5-13
Magasin papier (Source papier) ................................................... 5-14
Type de papier (Support) ............................................................. 5-15
Type d'impression (Impression recto-verso/Impression Livret)... 5-16
Imprimer plusieurs pages sur une seule page ............................. 5-18
Marge ........................................................................................... 5-19
Agrafage et perforation ................................................................ 5-20
Type de sortie (gestion des travaux) ............................................ 5-21
Sommaire-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Tri (assemblage) et classement (décalage)................................... 5-22
Sauter pages vierges (Économiser papier) ................................... 5-23
Paramètres de page de couverture, de page de dos
et d'intercalaire ............................................................................ 5-24
Couverture avec bac d'insertion................................................... 5-25
Chapitre ........................................................................................ 5-26
Combinaison................................................................................. 5-27
Pliage ............................................................................................ 5-28
Décalage d'image ......................................................................... 5-29
Superposition................................................................................ 5-30
Filigrane ........................................................................................ 5-31
Réglage qualité ............................................................................. 5-32
Utiliser polices d'imprimante (Remplacer polices)........................ 5-33
Authentification/Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.) ..................................... 5-34
Envoyer téléfax ............................................................................. 5-35
Pour Windows............................................................................... 5-36
Pour Macintosh............................................................................. 5-39
Pour afficher la boîte de dialogue d'impression ........................... 5-39
Pour afficher la boîte de dialogue Format d'impression............... 5-39
Vérifiez le travail ............................................................................ 5-41
Affichage de la liste d'impression................................................. 5-41
Vérifier Réception/Boîte utilisateur ............................................... 5-42
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6.1 Paramètres......................................................................................... 6-3
Paramètres communs..................................................................... 6-3
Onglet Configuration....................................................................... 6-4
Onglet Paramétrage par page ........................................................ 6-5
Onglet Fonctions spéciales ............................................................ 6-5
Onglet Superposition ...................................................................... 6-5
Onglet Filigrane............................................................................... 6-5
Onglet Qualité ................................................................................. 6-6
Onglet Police................................................................................... 6-6
Onglet Fax....................................................................................... 6-6
Onglet Version ................................................................................ 6-6
Onglet Option.................................................................................. 6-6
6.2 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration ....................... 6-7
Adapter l'impression au format papier ........................................... 6-7
Enregistrer un format personnalisé................................................. 6-8
Configuration de la position d'impression ...................................... 6-9
Sélectionner la source papier ....................................................... 6-10
Spécifier la source du type de papier ........................................... 6-11
Spécifier l'impression recto-verso/livret ....................................... 6-13
Imprimer plusieurs pages sur une seule page (N en 1)................. 6-14
Régler la marge............................................................................. 6-15
IC-202 (Phase 2) Sommaire-5
Agrafage....................................................................................... 6-16
Perforer ........................................................................................ 6-16
Agrafage central et pliage ............................................................ 6-17
Sélectionner le type de sortie ...................................................... 6-18
Enregistrer dans boîte utilisateur ................................................. 6-20
Attente avec épreuve ................................................................... 6-20
Spécifier les paramètres d'authentification.................................. 6-21
Spécifier les paramètres de Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.) ................. 6-22
6.3 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage par page...... 6-23
Imprimer des documents avec page de couverture et de dos .... 6-23
Impression d'une couverture avec bac d'insertion...................... 6-24
Impression de chapitres............................................................... 6-25
Imprimer plusieurs pages............................................................. 6-26
Paramétrage par page ................................................................. 6-26
Utilisation de papier à onglet ....................................................... 6-28
6.4 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fonctions spéciales.......... 6-32
Une image étalée sur deux pages est imprimée sur une
feuille de papier de format double (combinaison)........................ 6-33
Définir le pliage............................................................................. 6-34
Réglage de la position d'impression (Décalage d'image) ............ 6-35
6.5 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Superposition .................... 6-36
Imprimer ensemble des documents originaux différents
(Superposition) ............................................................................. 6-36
Créer une superposition............................................................... 6-38
6.6 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Filigrane ............................. 6-40
Imprimer un filigrane .................................................................... 6-40
Modifier un filigrane...................................................................... 6-41
Imprimer le numéro du document................................................ 6-42
6.7 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Qualité................................ 6-43
Motif ............................................................................................. 6-43
Densité d'impression ................................................................... 6-43
Imprimer avec noir ....................................................................... 6-44
Lissage......................................................................................... 6-45
6.8 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Police ................................. 6-46
Spécifier les paramètres .............................................................. 6-46
6.9 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fax...................................... 6-47
Envoyer un fax ............................................................................. 6-47
Créer une page de garde ............................................................. 6-53
Enregistrer un destinataire dans le répertoire .............................. 6-57
Enregistrer les informations de destinataire................................. 6-57
Enregistrer un groupe .................................................................. 6-59
Sommaire-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
6.10 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Option ................................. 6-61
Spécifier les paramètres ............................................................... 6-62
6.11 Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote ............................................. 6-63
Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote............................................. 6-63
Rétablir les paramètres................................................................. 6-65
Supprimer les paramètres ............................................................ 6-66
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7.1 Paramètres......................................................................................... 7-3
Paramètres communs..................................................................... 7-3
Onglet Configuration....................................................................... 7-5
Onglet Paramétrage par page ........................................................ 7-6
Onglet Fonctions spéciales ............................................................ 7-6
Onglet PostScript............................................................................ 7-7
Onglet Superposition ...................................................................... 7-7
Onglet Qualité ................................................................................. 7-8
Onglet Filigrane............................................................................... 7-8
Onglet Option.................................................................................. 7-8
7.2 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration ....................... 7-9
Adapter l'impression au format papier ........................................... 7-9
Sélectionner une source papier .................................................... 7-10
Utiliser les transparents ................................................................ 7-12
Paramètres format personnalisé................................................... 7-15
Impression Recto-verso/Livret...................................................... 7-16
Agrafage........................................................................................ 7-17
Perforation .................................................................................... 7-18
Impression en mode Disposition .................................................. 7-19
Impression de livret....................................................................... 7-21
Impression en mode Zoom........................................................... 7-22
Imprimer une affiche ..................................................................... 7-23
Changer le papier ......................................................................... 7-24
Sélectionner le type de sortie ....................................................... 7-25
Impression sécurisée .................................................................... 7-26
Enregistrer dans boîte utilisateur .................................................. 7-27
Attente avec épreuve.................................................................... 7-28
Spécifier les paramètres d'authentification .................................. 7-29
Spécifier les paramètres de Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.) .................. 7-31
7.3 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage par page ...... 7-32
Imprimer des documents avec page de couverture et de dos..... 7-32
Impression d'une couverture avec bac d'insertion....................... 7-33
Impression de chapitres ............................................................... 7-34
Imprimer plusieurs pages ............................................................. 7-35
Paramétrage par page .................................................................. 7-35
Enregistrer/Charger la configuration............................................. 7-36
IC-202 (Phase 2) Sommaire-7
Enregistrer la configuration .......................................................... 7-36
Charger la configuration............................................................... 7-37
Utilisation de papier à onglet ....................................................... 7-38
7.4 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fonctions spéciales.......... 7-42
Imprimer le numéro du document................................................ 7-42
Imprimer 2 pages sur du papier deux fois plus grand ................. 7-43
Définir le pliage............................................................................. 7-44
Réglage de la position d'impression (Décalage d'image) ............ 7-45
7.5 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet PostScript .......................... 7-46
Impression d'un travail................................................................. 7-46
Compression d'un travail ............................................................. 7-47
Compression des bitmaps........................................................... 7-47
Utiliser le mode PS marqué ......................................................... 7-47
Définir le protocole de sortie ........................................................ 7-47
Régler la valeur gamma ............................................................... 7-48
Configurer les options.................................................................. 7-49
Effacer mémoire par page............................................................ 7-50
Compatibilité................................................................................ 7-50
Lissage bitmap............................................................................. 7-50
7.6 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Superposition .................... 7-51
Créer Superposition ..................................................................... 7-51
Ajouter Superposition .................................................................. 7-53
Effacer Superposition................................................................... 7-54
7.7 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Qualité................................ 7-55
Rotation de l'image...................................................................... 7-55
Imprimer les données en image miroir ou en image négative ..... 7-56
Ajuster la luminosité et le contraste des graphiques ................... 7-57
Lissage......................................................................................... 7-58
Conversion monochromatique..................................................... 7-59
Economie Toner, Brouillon........................................................... 7-60
7.8 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Filigrane ............................. 7-61
Imprimer un filigrane .................................................................... 7-61
Modifier un filigrane...................................................................... 7-62
7.9 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Police ................................. 7-64
Spécifier les paramètres .............................................................. 7-64
7.10 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Option ................................ 7-66
Configurer les options installées.................................................. 7-66
Collecte automatique des informations optionnelles................... 7-67
7.11 Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote ............................................ 7-68
Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote ............................................ 7-68
Rétablir les paramètres ................................................................ 7-69
Modifier les paramètres ............................................................... 7-69
Sommaire-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
8 Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows)
8.1 Paramètres......................................................................................... 8-3
Onglet Disposition .......................................................................... 8-3
Papier/qualité.................................................................................. 8-3
Avancé ............................................................................................ 8-4
Onglet Paramètres du périphérique................................................ 8-5
8.2 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Disposition ........................... 8-6
Spécifier les paramètres ................................................................. 8-6
8.3 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Papier/qualité....................... 8-7
Spécifier les paramètres ................................................................. 8-7
8.4 Avancé... ............................................................................................. 8-8
Spécifier les paramètres ................................................................. 8-8
8.5 Spécifier les périphériques............................................................. 8-10
Spécifier les paramètres ............................................................... 8-10
9 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9)
9.1 Paramètres......................................................................................... 9-3
Boîte de dialogue Format d'impression.......................................... 9-3
Boîte de dialogue Imprimer............................................................. 9-5
9.2 Disposition ......................................................................................... 9-8
Attributs de page (Paramètres de base) ......................................... 9-8
Format papier personnalisés .......................................................... 9-9
Options PostScript........................................................................ 9-10
9.3 Impression ....................................................................................... 9-11
Généralités (Paramètres de base)................................................. 9-11
Disposition (Imprimer plusieurs pages sur une seule page) ......... 9-12
Options de finition......................................................................... 9-13
9.4 Options de réglage.......................................................................... 9-15
Spécifier les paramètres ............................................................... 9-15
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10.1 Paramètres....................................................................................... 10-3
Boîte de dialogue Format d'impression........................................ 10-3
Boîte de dialogue Imprimer........................................................... 10-5
10.2 Disposition ....................................................................................... 10-8
Attributs de page (Paramètres de base) ....................................... 10-8
Format de papier personnalisé (en cas de
Mac OS 10.2x/10.3x) .................................................................. 10-10
Format de papier personnalisé (en cas de Mac OS 10.4x)......... 10-11
IC-202 (Phase 2) Sommaire-9
Format papier............................................................................. 10-11
Marges de l'imprimante ............................................................. 10-11
10.3 Impression..................................................................................... 10-12
Copies et pages (Paramètres de base)...................................... 10-12
Disposition (Imprimer plusieurs pages sur une seule page) ...... 10-13
Alimentation papier .................................................................... 10-14
Sécurité ...................................................................................... 10-15
Finition........................................................................................ 10-17
Image/Disposition ...................................................................... 10-18
Configuration.............................................................................. 10-19
10.4 Options de réglage ....................................................................... 10-20
Spécifier les paramètres ............................................................ 10-20
10.5 Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote .......................................... 10-21
Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote .......................................... 10-21
Rétablir les paramètres .............................................................. 10-22
Modifier les paramètres ............................................................. 10-22
11 Divers réglages
11.1 Paramètres d'impression en mode Utilitaires ............................. 11-3
Sélections par défaut ................................................................... 11-3
Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires............................. 11-3
Paramètre PDL............................................................................. 11-5
Nombre de jeux............................................................................ 11-6
Direction original .......................................................................... 11-7
Paramètre de désynchronisation ................................................. 11-8
Modifier format papier................................................................ 11-10
Réglage des bannières .............................................................. 11-11
Densité Texte Numérotation Jeux.............................................. 11-13
Bac papier.................................................................................. 11-15
Format de papier par défaut ...................................................... 11-16
Impression recto-verso .............................................................. 11-17
Type de reliure ........................................................................... 11-18
Agrafer........................................................................................ 11-19
Perforation.................................................................................. 11-20
Bac page bannière ..................................................................... 11-21
Numéro de police....................................................................... 11-22
Jeu de symboles ........................................................................ 11-24
Taille caractères ......................................................................... 11-25
Ligne/Page ................................................................................. 11-27
Mappage CR (Retour chariot)/LF (saut de ligne)........................ 11-28
Erreur impression PS ................................................................. 11-30
Imprimer les rapports................................................................. 11-31
11.2 Réglages de l'imprimante en mode administrateur .................. 11-32
Sommaire-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour afficher l'écran Réglage administrateur.............................. 11-32
Système prioritaire...................................................................... 11-34
Délai de connexion I/F ................................................................ 11-36
Capturer les données d'impression............................................ 11-37
11.3 Utiliser Web Connection ............................................................... 11-39
Configuration minimale requise .................................................. 11-39
Accéder à Web Connection........................................................ 11-39
Structure de page ....................................................................... 11-40
Fonction de cache des navigateurs Internet............................... 11-42
Dans Internet Explorer ................................................................ 11-42
Dans Netscape Navigator ........................................................... 11-42
Connexion et déconnexion......................................................... 11-43
Déconnexion............................................................................... 11-44
Se connecter en mode Utilisateur (utilisateur public) ................. 11-45
Se connecter en mode Utilisateur (utilisateur enregistré) ........... 11-47
Se connecter en mode Administrateur ....................................... 11-49
Mode Utilisateur.......................................................................... 11-52
Onglet Système .......................................................................... 11-53
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Consommables. 11-53
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Bac d'entrée...... 11-54
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Bac de sortie ..... 11-55
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Sommaire de
configuration ............................................................................... 11-56
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Disque dur......... 11-57
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique —
Information sur interface............................................................. 11-58
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique —
Information administrateur.......................................................... 11-59
Onglet Système — Compteur..................................................... 11-60
Onglet Système — Assistance en ligne...................................... 11-61
Onglet Système — Authentification d'utilisateur —
Modif. du mot de passe utilis. .................................................... 11-62
Onglet Système — Authentification d'utilisateur —
Information utilisateur ................................................................. 11-63
Onglet Système — Inform. compte département....................... 11-64
Onglet Tâche............................................................................... 11-65
Onglet Tâche — Tâches en cours .............................................. 11-65
Onglet Tâche — Historique tâches............................................. 11-67
Onglet Impression....................................................................... 11-68
Onglet Impression — Réglage général ....................................... 11-68
Onglet Impression — Sortie rapport........................................... 11-69
Mode Administrateur .................................................................. 11-70
Fonctionnement de base ............................................................ 11-70
Onglet Système .......................................................................... 11-71
Onglet Système — Importer/Exporter ........................................ 11-71
Onglet Système — Date/Heure — Réglage manuel ................... 11-73
IC-202 (Phase 2) Sommaire-11
Onglet Système — Date/Heure — Param. régl. heure .............. 11-74
Onglet Système — Paramètres Machine................................... 11-75
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique ............................... 11-76
Onglet Système — Version ROM............................................... 11-77
Onglet Système — Compteur.................................................... 11-78
Onglet Système — Assistance en ligne ..................................... 11-79
Onglet Système — Entretien — Effacer la config. réseau ......... 11-80
Onglet Système — Entretien — Réinitialisation......................... 11-81
Onglet Système — Entretien — Formater ttes destinations...... 11-82
Onglet Système — Paramètres notification statut..................... 11-83
Onglet Système – Configuration rapport compteur total........... 11-86
Onglet Système — Authentification d'utilisateur —
Enregist. utilis............................................................................. 11-88
Onglet Système — Authentification d'utilisateur —
Perm. par Défaut Fonctions ....................................................... 11-90
Onglet Système — Enregistrement Compte.............................. 11-91
Onglet Système — Mot de passe de l'administrateur ............... 11-93
Onglet Tâche — Historique tâches ............................................ 11-94
Onglet Impression...................................................................... 11-95
Onglet Impression — Interface .................................................. 11-95
Onglet Impression — Paramètre Port RAW............................... 11-96
Onglet Impression — Réglage par défaut — Réglage général .. 11-97
Onglet Impression — Réglage par défaut — Configuration PCL 11-99
Onglet Impression — Réglage par défaut — Configuration PS 11-100
Onglet Lecture ......................................................................... 11-101
Onglet Réseau.......................................................................... 11-102
Onglet Réseau — Paramètre TCP/IP— Paramètre TCP/IP ..... 11-102
11.4 Gestion des tâches d'impression.............................................. 11-104
Spécification des opérations d'impression.............................. 11-104
Spécification des réglages (pour Windows)............................. 11-104
Spécification des réglages (pour Mac OS X) ........................... 11-106
Stockage des tâches ............................................................... 11-107
Rappeler la tâche ..................................................................... 11-107
Impression sécurisée ............................................................... 11-108
Enregistrer dans boîte utilisateur ............................................. 11-109
Imprimer à l'aide du paramètre de suivi de volume................. 11-110
Spécification des réglages (pour Windows)............................. 11-111
Spécification des réglages (pour Mac OS X) ........................... 11-112
Fonctions de travaux dans Web Connection........................... 11-113
Sommaire-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
12 Dépannage
12.1 Impossible d'imprimer .................................................................... 12-3
12.2 Impossible de définir les paramètres voulus
ou impossible d'imprimer comme indiqué.................................... 12-5
13 Annexe
13.1 Spécifications .................................................................................. 13-3
13.2 Page de configuration..................................................................... 13-5
13.3 Liste des polices.............................................................................. 13-6
Liste des polices PCL ................................................................... 13-6
Liste des polices PS ..................................................................... 13-7
Page de test.................................................................................. 13-8
13.4 Polices d'écran ................................................................................ 13-9
Procédure d'installation des polices True type
(Windows 98SE/Me/NT4.0/2000) ................................................. 13-9
Procédure d'installation des polices True type
(Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64) ................. 13-11
13.5 Glossaire ........................................................................................ 13-14
13.6 Index ............................................................................................... 13-19
1 Introduction
Introduction 1
IC-202 (Phase 2) 1-3
1 Introduction
Merci d'avoir acheté le Develop ineo 750/600
Le ineo 750/600 est équipé d'un contrôleur d'impression intégré au copieur
vous permettant d'imprimer directement à partir d'ordinateurs compatibles
Windows ou d'ordinateurs Macintosh en installant le module IC-202 (puce
de contrôleur).
Ce manuel utilisateur décrit les fonctions d'impression, les opérations,
l'utilisation et les précautions de sécurité du contrôleur d'impression. Avant
d'utiliser cet appareil, lisez attentivement ce manuel pour garantir un
fonctionnement efficace de l'appareil. Afin de garantir une utilisation en toute
sécurité de cet appareil, lisez soigneusement les "Précautions d'installation
et d'utilisation" du manuel utilisateur 750/600 [Opérations de copie] avant
d'utiliser cet appareil.
Les illustrations utilisées dans ce manuel utilisateur peuvent varier par
rapport au modèle actuel.
Marques commerciales et Copyright
- Netscape Communications, le logo Netscape Communications,
Netscape Navigator, Netscape Communicator et Netscape sont des
marques de fabrique de Netscape Communications Corporation.
- Novell et NetWare sont des marques déposées de Novell, Inc.
- Microsoft, Windows et Windows NT sont des marques déposées de
Microsoft Corporation.
- IBM est une marque déposée de International Business Machines, Inc.
- Apple, Macintosh et Mac sont des marques déposées de Apple
Computer.Inc.
- Adobe, le logo Adobe, Acrobat, le logo Acrobat, PostScript et le logo
PostScript sont des marques déposées ou des marques commerciales
de Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
- Ethernet est une marque déposée de Xerox Corporation.
- PCL est une marque déposée de Hewlett-Packard Company Limited.
- Citrix, MetaFrame et MetaFrameXP sont des marques commerciales ou
des marques déposées de Citrix Systems, Inc. aux USA et dans d'autres
pays.
- Tous les autres produits ou noms de marque sont des marques de
fabrique ou des marques déposées de leurs propriétaires respectifs.
- En ce qui concerne le réseau partenaire d'accès Citrix Premier,
Develop GmbH est membre du réseau partenaire d'accès Citrix.
Le réseau partenaire d'accès Citrix est un programme qui, associé à une
solution de Citrix, promeut et développe des solutions meilleures pour les
clients.
1 Introduction
1-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
- Box Operator :
Ce logiciel est en partie basé sur le travail du Independent JPEG Group.
- Compact-VJE
Copyright 1986-2003 VACS Corp.
- RC4® est une marque déposée ou une marque de fabrique de RSA
Security Inc. aux Etats-Unis et/ou dans d'autres pays.
- RSA® est une marque déposée ou une marque de fabrique de RSA
Security Inc. aux Etats-Unis et/ou dans d'autres pays.
Introduction 1
IC-202 (Phase 2) 1-5
Déclaration OpenSSL
Licence OpenSSL
Copyright © 1998-2000 The OpenSSL Project. Tous droits réservés.
Toute redistribution et utilisation sous forme source ou binaire, avec ou sans
modification, est autorisée sous réserve de satisfaction des conditions
suivantes :
1. Les redistributions de code source doivent conserver l'avis de copyright
ci-dessus, cette liste de conditions et la décharge de responsabilité
suivante.
2. Les redistributions sous forme binaire doivent reproduire l'avis de
copyright ci-dessus, cette liste de conditions et la décharge de
responsabilité ci-dessous dans la documentation et/ou les autres
documents fournis avec la distribution.
3. Tous les documents publicitaires mentionnant des fonctions ou
l'utilisation de ce logiciel doivent contenir la déclaration suivante :
"Ce produit contient un logiciel développé par OpenSSL Project pour
utilisation dans le OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/)"
4. Les noms "OpenSSL Toolkit" et "OpenSSL Project" ne doivent pas être
utilisés pour exploiter ou promouvoir des produits dérivés de ce logiciel
dans accord écrit préalable. Pour l'accord écrit, veuillez contacter
openssl-core@openssl.org.
5. Les produits dérivés de ce logiciel ne peuvent pas s'appeler "OpenSSL"
et "OpenSSL" ne doit pas figurer dans leurs noms sans l'accord écrit
préalable de OpenSSL Project.
6. Toute redistribution sous quelque forme que ce soit doit faire mention de
la déclaration suivante :
"Ce produit contient un logiciel développé par OpenSSL Project pour
utilisation dans le OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)"
CE LOGICIEL EST FOURNI PAR LE OpenSSL PROJECT "TEL QUEL" ET
TOUTE GARANTIE IMPLICITE EXPRESSE ET IMPLICITE, Y COMPRIS,
SANS TOUTEFOIS S'Y LIMITER, LES GARANTIES IMPLICITES DE QUALITE
MARCHANDE ET D'APTITUDE POUR UNE APPLICATION SPECIFIQUE
SERA REJETEE. EN AUCUN CAS, LE OpenSSL PROJECT OU SES
COLLABORATEURS NE SAURONT ETRE TENUS POUR RESPONSABLES
DES MOINDRES DOMMAGES DIRECTS, INDIRECTS, ACCIDENTELS,
SPECIAUX, EXEMPLAIRES OU CONSECUTIFS (Y COMPRIS,
SANS TOUTEFOIS S'Y LIMITER, L'APPROVISIONNEMENT OU LE
REMPLACEMENT DE MARCHANDISES OU DES SERVICES ; LA PERTE
D'EXPLOITATION, DE DONNEES, DE BENEFICES OU L'INTERRUPTION
D'ACTIVITE) ENCOURUS ET EN MATIERE DE RESPONSABILITE, QU'IL
S'AGISSE D'UNE RESPONSABILITE CONTRACTUELLE, D'UNE
RESPONSABILITE CIVILE ABSOLUE OU DELICTUELLE (Y COMPRIS EN
CAS DE NEGLIGENCE OU AUTRE) EMANANT DE L'UTILISATION DE CE
1 Introduction
1-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
LOGICIEL, MEME SI VOUS ETES AVERTIS DE L'EVENTUALITE D'UN TEL
DOMMAGE.
Ce produit contient un logiciel cryptographique créé par Eric Young
(eay@crypt-Soft.com). Ce produit contient un logiciel créé par Tim Hudson
(tjh@cryptsoft.com).
Licence SSLeay d'origine
COPYRIGHT © 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) Tous droits
réservés.
Ce progiciel est une implémentation SSL écrite par Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com).
L'implémentation a été rédigée en conformité avec le protocole SSL de
Netscape.
Cette bibliothèque est libre pour un usage commercial et non commercial
si les conditions suivantes sont respectées. Les conditions suivantes
s'appliquent à tous les codes trouvé dans cette distribution, qu'il existe sous
forme de code RC4, RSA, Ihash, DES, etc., et pas seulement pour le code
SSL.
La documentation SSL fournie avec cette distribution est couverte par les
mêmes termes de copyright à la différence que le détenteur est Tim Hudson
(tjh@cryptsoft.com).
Le copyright est toujours celui d'Eric Young et an tant que tel, il est interdit
de supprimer tout avis de copyright du code. Si ce progiciel est utilisé au sein
d'un produit, Eric Young doit être cité comme étant l'auteur des parties de la
bibliothèque utilisée. Cela peut se faire sous la forme d'un texte affiché au
lancement du programme ou dans la documentation (en ligne ou sur papier)
fournie avec le progiciel.
Toute redistribution et utilisation sous forme source ou binaire,avec ou sans
modification, est autorisée sous réserve de satisfaction des conditions. Cela
peut se faire sous la forme d'un texte affiché au lancement du programme
ou dans la documentation (en ligne ou sur papier) fournie avec le progiciel.
ions suivantes :
1. Les redistributions de code source doivent conserver l'avis de copyright,
cette liste de conditions et la décharge de responsabilité suivante.
2. Les redistributions sous forme binaire doivent reproduire l'avis de
copyright ci-dessus, cette liste de conditions et la décharge de
responsabilité ci-dessous dans la documentation et/ou les autres
documents fournis avec la distribution.
3. Tous les documents publicitaires mentionnant les fonctions ou
l'utilisation de ce logiciel doivent contenir la déclaration suivante :
"Ce produit contient un logiciel cryptographique créé par Eric Young
(eay@crypt-soft.com)"
Le terme ‘cryptographique' peut être ignoré si les routines de la
bibliothèque utilisée ne sont pas cryptographiées.
Introduction 1
IC-202 (Phase 2) 1-7
4. Si vous incluez du code spécifique Windows (ou tout dérivé de ce
dernier) du dossier apps (code d'application), vous devez ajouter une
déclaration :
"Ce produit contient un logiciel créé par Tim Hudson
(tjh@cryptsoft.com)"
CE LOGICIEL EST FOURNI PAR ERIC YOUNG "TEL QUEL" ET TOUTE
GARANTIE IMPLICITE EXPRESSE ET IMPLICITE, Y COMPRIS, SANS
TOUTEFOIS S'Y LIMITER, LES GARANTIES IMPLICITES DE QUALITE
MARCHANDE ET D'APTITUDE POUR UNE APPLICATION SPECIFIQUE
SERA REJETEE. EN AUCUN CAS, L'AUTEUR OU SES COLLABORATEURS
NE SAURONT ETRE TENUS POUR RESPONSABLES DES MOINDRES
DOMMAGES DIRECTS, INDIRECTS, ACCIDENTELS, SPECIAUX,
EXEMPLAIRES OU CONSECUTIFS (Y COMPRIS, SANS TOUTEFOIS S'Y
LIMITER, L'APPROVISIONNEMENT OU LE REMPLACEMENT DE
MARCHANDISES OU DES SERVICES ; LA PERTE D'EXPLOITATION, DE
DONNEES, DE BENEFICES OU L'INTERRUPTION D'ACTIVITE) ENCOURUS
ET EN MATIERE DE RESPONSABILITE, QU'IL S'AGISSE D'UNE
RESPONSABILITE CONTRACTUELLE, D'UNE RESPONSABILITE CIVILE
ABSOLUE OU DELICTUELLE (Y COMPRIS EN CAS DE NEGLIGENCE OU
AUTRE) EMANANT DE L'UTILISATION DE CE LOGICIEL, MEME SI VOUS
ETES AVERTIS DE L'EVENTUALITE D'UN TEL DOMMAGE.
La licence et les termes de distribution de toute version publiquement
disponible ou dérivé de ce code ne peuvent pas être modifiés. C'est-à-dire
qu'il n'est pas possible de se contenter de copier ce code pour l'insérer dans
une autre licence de distribution [y compris la licence GNU Public Licence].
Tous les autres noms de produits mentionnés ici sont les marques
commerciales ou les marques déposées de leurs détenteurs respectifs.
Copyright
© 2006 Develop GmbH. Tous droits réservés.
Remarque
- Toute reproduction partielle ou totale de ce manuel utilisateur est
interdite sans autorisation.
- Develop GmbH ne saurait être tenu pour responsable en cas d'incidents
causés par l'utilisation de ce système d'impression ou de ce manuel
utilisateur.
- Les informations figurant dans ce manuel utilisateur sont susceptibles
d'être modifiées sans préavis.
- Develop GmbH détient le copyright des pilotes d'imprimante.
1 Introduction
1-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
1.1 Licence d'utilisation du logiciel
Ce progiciel contient les programmes suivants fournis par Develop GmbH :
logiciel inclus dans le système d'impression, données vectorielles lisibles par
machine à codage numérique au format spécial et sous forme cryptée
("Programmes polices"), logiciel supplémentaire installé dans le système
d'un ordinateur à utiliser en relation avec le logiciel d'impression ("logiciel
hôte") ainsi que les matériaux écrits explicatifs associés ("Documentation").
L'utilisation du terme "Logiciel" renvoie au logiciel d'impression, aux
programmes de polices et/ou au logiciel hôte et regroupe également
l'ensemble des mises à jour, des versions modifiées, des ajouts et des
copies du logiciel.
L'octroi de licence du Logiciel est soumis aux termes du présent contrat.
Develop GmbH vous accorde une sous-licence non exclusive d'utilisation du
Logiciel et de la Documentation, sous réserve de satisfaction des conditions
suivantes :
1. L'utilisation du logiciel d'impression ainsi que des programmes de
polices d'accompagnement pour la mise en image sur les périphériques
de sortie sous licence est strictement réservée à un usage professionnel
en interne.
2. Outre la licence relative aux programmes de polices prévue dans la
section 1 mentionnée ci-dessus ("Logiciel d'impression") l'utilisation des
programmes de polices de caractères romans est autorisée pour la
reproduction de graisse, de styles et de versions des lettres, chiffres,
caractères et symboles ("Caractères") à l'écran et ce, à l'usage
professionnel interne.
3. Vous êtes autorisé à réaliser une copie de sauvegarde du logiciel hôte
sous réserve de ne pas installer ni utiliser cette copie de sauvegarde sur
aucun ordinateur. Nonobstant les restrictions susmentionnées,
l'installation sur un nombre illimité d'ordinateurs est strictement réservée
à une utilisation associée à un ou plusieurs systèmes d'impression
exécutant le logiciel d'impression.
4. Vous pouvez concéder les droits inclus dans ce contrat à un cessionnaire
de tous les droits et intérêts du titulaire de licence dudit Logiciel et de
ladite Documentation ("Cessionnaire") sous réserve de transférer au
cessionnaire l'ensemble des copies dudit logiciel et de ladite
documentation pour lesquels le cessionnaire est lié par les termes et
modalités du présent contrat.
5. Vous vous engagez à ne pas modifier, adapter ni traduire le Logiciel et la
Documentation.
6. Vous êtes tenu de ne pas altérer, démanteler, décrypter, rétroconcevoir
ou décompiler le Logiciel.
7. Le titre et la propriété du Logiciel et de la Documentation restent ceux de
Develop GmbH et de son concédant de licence.
Introduction 1
IC-202 (Phase 2) 1-9
8. L'utilisation des marques commerciales doit être conforme aux pratiques
acceptées et inclure l'identification du nom du détenteur de la marque
commerciale. Les marques commerciales ne peuvent être utilisées que
pour identifier les impressions produites par le Logiciel. Une telle
utilisation de marque commerciale ne vous octroie aucun droit de
propriété de ladite marque commerciale.
9. Vous ne pouvez pas louer, louer à bail, sous-licencier, prêter ni transférer
des versions ou copies du Logiciel non utilisées, ou le Logiciel contenu
sur tout support non utilisé, sauf partie du transfert permanent de tout le
Logiciel et de toute la Documentation selon les modalités
susmentionnées.
10. EN AUCUN CAS, DEVELOP GmbH OU SON CONCÉDANT DE LICENCE
NE SAURAIT ÊTRE TENU RESPONSABLE DES MOINDRES
DOMMAGES CONSÉCUTIFS, ACCIDENTELS, INDIRECTS,
EXEMPLAIRES OU PARTICULIERS, Y COMPRIS LA PERTE DE
BÉNÉFICES OU DE REVENUS, MÊME SI DEVELOP GmbH EST AVERTI
DE L'ÉVENTUALITÉ DE TELS DOMMAGES, NI DE TOUT RECOURS DE
TIERS. DEVELOP GmbH OU SON CONCÉDANT DE LICENCE REJETTE
TOUTE GARANTIE CONCERNANT LE LOGICIEL, EXPRESSE OU
IMPLICITE, Y COMPRIS, ET SANS LIMITATION, LES GARANTIES
IMPLICITES CONCERNANT LA COMMERCIALISATION,
L'ADÉQUATION À UN USAGE PARTICULIER, LE TITRE ET LA NONVIOLATION
DES DROITS DE TIERS. CERTAINS ÉTATS OU
JURIDICTIONS N'AUTORISANT PAS L'EXCLUSION OU LA LIMITATION
DES DOMMAGES ACCIDENTELS, CONSÉCUTIFS OU SPÉCIAUX, LES
LIMITATIONS SUSMENTIONNÉES PEUVENT NE PAS S'APPLIQUER À
VOUS.
11. Avis aux utilisateurs finaux gouvernementaux : le Logiciel est un
"article commercial" tel que défini dans la disposition 48 C.F.R.2.101 et
comprend le "logiciel commercial" et la "documentation du logiciel
commercial" tels que définis dans la disposition 48 C.F.R. 12.212.
En avec les termes du 48 C.F.R. 12.212 et 48 C.F.R. 227.7202-1 à
227.7202-4, tous les utilisateurs finals du gouvernement américain
achètent le Logiciel uniquement avec les droits énoncés au présent.
12. Vous êtes tenu de ne pas exporter le Logiciel sous aucune forme
susceptible d'être en violation avec les lois et règlements en vigueur.
1 Introduction
1-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
1.2 A propos de ce Guide de l'utilisateur
Ce Guide de l'utilisateur contie d'utilisateur nt des informations sur
l'utilisation des fonctions d'impression du contrôleur d'impression Develop.
Pour des détails sur les fonctions de copie, de numérisation, de boîte et de
fax, veuillez-vous référer aux guides respectifs.
Ce Guide de l'utilisateur est destiné aux utilisateurs possédant déjà une
connaissance de base des opérations liées aux ordinateurs et aux copieurs.
Pour le système d'exploitation Windows ou Macintosh et les opérations liées
aux applications, veuillez-vous référer au manuel du produit correspondant.
Composition du Guide de l'utilisateur
Les guides d'utilisateur de cet appareil sont divisés par fonction et se
présentent comme suit :
Notations
Captures d'écran de ce manuel utilisateur
Sauf mention contraire, les fonctions du pilote d'imprimante sont décrites
pour le pilote d'imprimante pour Windows XP.
Guide de l'utilisateur Détails
Guide de l'utilisateur IC-202 Le présent guide. Lisez le présent manuel avant d'utiliser
cet appareil comme imprimante.
Opérations Fax Lisez le présent manuel avant d'utiliser cet appareil comme
télécopieur.
Opérations Scanner Réseau Lisez le présent manuel avant d'utiliser cet appareil comme
scanner.
Opérations Boîte Lisez le présent manuel avant d'utiliser les fonctions de
boîte de cet appareil.
Nom du produit Description dans ce guide
ineo 750/600
Copieur
Copieur ou imprimante
Contrôleur de réseau intégré Contrôleur de réseau
Contrôleur d'imprimante, y compris
cet appareil et ce système
d'impression
Système d'impression
Microsoft Windows Windows
Introduction 1
IC-202 (Phase 2) 1-11
1.3 Explication des conventions
Les repères et mises en forme utilisés dans le présent manuel sont décrits
ci-dessous.
Recommandations de sécurité
6 DANGER
Tout manquement au respect des instructions mises en évidence de
cette manière risquent de causer des blessures graves voire mortelles
dues à l'énergie électrique.
% Observer tous les dangers afin de prévenir toute blessure.
7 AVERTISSEMENT
Tout manquement au respect des instructions mises en valeur de cette
manière peut entraîner des blessures graves ou des dommages
matériels.
% Observer tous les avertissements afin de prévenir toute blessure et
garantir l'utilisation correcte de la machine.
7 ATTENTION
Tout manquement au respect des instructions mises en valeur de cette
manière peut entraîner des blessures légères ou des dommages
matériels.
% Observer toutes les mises en garde afin de prévenir toute blessure et
garantir l'utilisation correcte de la machine.
Séquence d'actions
1 Le chiffre 1 ainsi formaté indique la
première étape d'une séquence
d'actions.
2 Les nombres suivants ainsi formatés
indiquent les étapes successives
d'une série d'actions.
Une illustration insérée
ici montre les opérations
à effectuer.
1 Introduction
1-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
? Le texte formaté dans ce style offre une assistance supplémentaire.
% Le texte ainsi formaté décrit l'action permettant d'obtenir le résultat
escompté.
Astuces
2
Remarque
Le texte mis en évidence de cette manière contient des informations
utiles et des astuces pour garantir l'utilisation en toute sécurité de la
machine.
2
Rappel
Le texte mis en évidence de cette manière contient des informations
importantes (Rappel).
!
Détails
Le texte mis en évidence de cette manière contient des renvois à des
informations plus détaillées.
Repères de texte spéciaux
Touche [Stop]
Les noms des touches du panneau de contrôle sont illustrées comme
ci-dessus.
RÉGLAGE MACHINE
Les textes affichés se présentent sous la forme ci-dessus.
2 Présentation
Présentation 2
IC-202 (Phase 2) 2-3
2 Présentation
2.1 Configuration du CD-ROM du contrôleur
Les CD-ROM du contrôleur sont les suivants :
- CD-ROM du logiciel Utilisateur (Windows/Macintosh)
- CD des utilitaires
Chaque CD-ROM contient des contrôleurs d'imprimantes (pour Windows
et Macintosh), des utilitaires ainsi que des polices d'écran et de la
documentation, comme les manuels d'utilisateur et les notes de lancement.
2 Présentation
2-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2.2 Contrôleur d'impression
Le contrôleur d'impression est un périphérique chargé d'exécuter des
fonctions d'impression et d'impression réseau avec cet appareil.
Rôle du contrôleur d'impression
Le contrôleur d'impression a été intégré au copieur, ce qui vous permet
d'imprimer en installant le module IC-202.
Vous pouvez imprimer à partir des applications installées sur l'ordinateur
relié au système d'impression. Quand vous utilisez cet appareil comme
imprimante réseau, vous pouvez imprimer à partir des applications de
l'ordinateur.
Fonctions disponibles du contrôleur d'impression
Le contrôleur d'impression permet les fonctions suivantes.
- Impression à partir d'un ordinateur (avec le pilote d'imprimante PCL ou
PS)
- Support de protocoles réseau dont TCP/IP, NetBEUI, IPX/SPX,
AppleTalk et Bonjour/Rendez-vous
- Impression directe sur un réseau utilisant l'impression SMB (Windows),
LPR et IPP
- Accès aux paramètres de cet appareil et du contrôleur d'impression
à partir d'un ordinateur client sur le réseau (à l'aide d'un navigateur
Internet)
- Contrôle du nombre de pages imprimées (fonctions "Authentification
utilisateur" et "Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.)")
Système d'impression
Machine
Impression
d'impression
Ordinateur
Le kit d'interface parallèle (en option) est installé.
Présentation 2
IC-202 (Phase 2) 2-5
Modes machine
Les paramètres du pilote d'imprimante sont principalement définis à partir
d'un ordinateur, toutefois, vous pouvez imprimer la liste des polices et
les paramètres du contrôleur d'impression ainsi que les paramètres
d'impression par défaut peuvent se régler à partir du panneau de contrôle de
cet appareil. En outre, vous pouvez utiliser les opérations de numérisation en
changeant de mode.
Mode Copie
Cet appareil peut être utilisé comme copieur.
Mode Fax
Cet appareil peut être utilisé comme télécopieur.
Mode Numérisation
Cet appareil peut être utilisé comme scanner.
Mode Boîte
Cet appareil peut être utilisé pour archiver des travaux et comme dossier de
documents pour envoyer des données à un ordinateur sur le réseau.
2
Remarque
Vous pouvez utiliser cet appareil comme imprimante dans tous les
modes.
Modifiez les paramètres d'impression par défaut en mode Utilisateur.
2 Présentation
2-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Flux d'impression
Quand vous utilisez ce système d'impression comme imprimante, le flux du
processus principal est décrit ci-dessous.
Les commandes d'impression émises par l'application sont réceptionnés
par le pilote d'imprimante.
Les données sont transférées à cet appareil via une interface parallèle
(IEEE 1284) quand cet appareil est utilisé comme imprimante locale, via
une interface USB quand cet appareil est utilisé comme imprimante USB
ou via une interface Ethernet (TCP/IP, IPX/SPX NetBEUI, AppleTalk ou
Bonjour/Rendez-vous) quand cet appareil est utilisé comme imprimante
réseau. Les données sont ensuite envoyées au système d'impression qui se
charge de la rastérisation d'image (conversion des caractères et des images
de sortie en données bitmap). Et pour finir, ces données sont imprimées à
partir de cet appareil.
Présentation 2
IC-202 (Phase 2) 2-7
2
Remarque
Les interfaces Ethernet, USB et parallèle peuvent être utilisées
simultanément.
Pour utiliser les interfaces USB et parallèle, il faut installer le kit de
connexion locale (EK-701) en option.
Les fonctions de copie peuvent être utilisées pendant l'utilisation des
fonctions d'impression. Pour utiliser cet appareil comme copieur, appuyez
sur la touche [Copie] du panneau de contrôle.
Quand une tâche d'impression est réceptionnée pendant la copie, les
données sont stockées dans la mémoire de cet appareil. Une fois la copie
terminée, la tâche d'impression est automatiquement imprimée.
Ordinateur
Application Application Application
Pilote d'imprimante Pilote d'imprimante Pilote d'imprimante
USB
Système d'impression
Impression
Traitement d'image
Traitement PDL (rastérisation)
Utilisée comme
imprimante locale
Utilisée comme
imprimante USB
Utilisée comme
imprimante réseau
Interface parallèle
(IEEE 1284)
Ethernet (TCP/IP,
IPX/SPX ou
AppleTalk)
Disque dur
Impression sécurisée
Enregistrer dans boîte
utilisateur
2 Présentation
2-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2.3 Environnement d'exploitation
La configuration système nécessaire pour utiliser ce système d'impression
ainsi que les interfaces utilisées pour la connexion sont expliquées cidessous.
Système d'exploitation compatible avec le pilote d'imprimante
Ce système d'impression est équipé en fourniture standard du pilote
d'imprimante PCL ou PostScript3 (PS;PPD PostScript).
Pour utiliser ce système d'impression, vous devez installer le pilote
d'imprimante sur votre ordinateur.
Pilote PCL
Compatible Windows
- Windows 98 deuxième édition (identifié par Windows 98SE)
- Windows Millenium Edition (identifié par Windows Me)
- Windows NT 4.0 Service Pack6a ou supérieur (identifié par
Windows NT 4.0)
- Windows 2000 Service Pack4 ou supérieur (identifié par Windows 2000)
- Windows XP Home Edition/Professional Service Pack1 ou supérieur
(identifié par Windows XP)
- Windows Server 2003 (Service Pack1 ou supérieur)
Pilote PS (PostScript3)
Compatible Windows
- Windows NT 4.0 Service Pack6a ou supérieur
- Windows 2000 Service Pack4 ou supérieur
- Windows XP Home Edition/Professional Service Pack1 ou supérieur
- Windows Server 2003 (Service Pack1 ou supérieur)
- Windows XP Professional x64 Edition (identifié par Windows XP x64)
- Windows Serveur 2003 x64 Editions (identifié par
Windows Serveur 2003 x64)
– Pour l'acquisition du pilote PS pour Windows XP x64/ Server 2003 x64,
contactez le SAV.
Présentation 2
IC-202 (Phase 2) 2-9
Pilote PPD PostScript (PostScript3)
Compatible Windows
- Windows 98 deuxième édition
- Windows Millennium Edition
- Windows NT 4.0 Service Pack6a ou supérieur
- Windows 2000 Service Pack4 ou supérieur
- Windows XP Home Edition/Professional Service Pack1 ou supérieur
- Windows Server 2003 (Service Pack1 ou supérieur)
- Windows XP Professional x64 Edition
- Windows Server 2003 x64 Editions
Compatible Macintosh
- Mac OS 9.2.x (identifié par Mac OS 9)
- Mac OS X v10.2x/v10.3x/10.4x (identifié par Mac OS X)
(Inclut Intel Mac (v10.4x))
Interfaces compatibles
Les différentes interfaces pouvant être utilisées pour connecter ce système
d'impression à un ordinateur sont décrites ci-après.
Pour utiliser les interfaces USB et parallèle, il faut installer le kit de connexion
locale (EK-701) en option.
Interface Ethernet
Connecter lors de l'utilisation de ce système d'impression comme
imprimante réseau.
Pour la connexion, un câble Ethernet (RJ45) est nécessaire.
Supporte les normes 10Base-T et 100Base-TX. En outre, l'interface Ethernet
supporte les protocoles TCP/IP (LDP/LPR, Raw, IPP, SMB), NetBEUI (SMB),
IPX/SPX (NetWare), AppleTalk (EtherTalk) et Bonjour/Rendez-vous.
Interface parallèle (en option : EK-701)
Connecter lors de l'utilisation de ce système d'impression comme
imprimante locale.
Pour la connexion, il faut un ordinateur équipé de Windows et d'un câble
parallèle IEEE 1284. Utilisez un câble parallèle avec un embout équipé d'un
connecteur Amphenol mâle 36 broches.
L'interface parallèle supporte les modes compatibles, nibble et ECP.
2 Présentation
2-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Interface USB (en option : EK-701)
Connecter lors de l'utilisation de ce système d'impression comme
imprimante réseau.
L'interface USB peut se connecter à un ordinateur équipé de Windows ou à
un ordinateur Macintosh. La connexion requiert un câble USB. Utilisez un
câble USB type A (4 broches, mâle) ou type B (4 broches, mâle). Un câble
USB de 3 m ou moins est recommandé.
Les interfaces Ethernet, USB et parallèle peuvent être utilisées
simultanément.
Schéma de connexion
Les câbles d'imprimante peuvent se connecter sur chaque port sur le côté
de cet appareil.
Machine (vue latérale)
USB
Câble
Port
Câble
Port utilisateur
parallèle
parallèle
Présentation 2
IC-202 (Phase 2) 2-11
2.4 Installation du système
Afin de pouvoir utiliser ce système d'impression, il faut d'abord l'installer.
L'installation consiste à raccorder cet appareil à un ordinateur et à installer
le pilote d'imprimante sur l'ordinateur utilisé.
Pour installer le système d'impression
Installer le système d'impression comme décrit ci-après.
1 Connectez cet appareil à un ordinateur. (Voir "Interfaces compatibles"
à la page 2-9.)
2 Installez le pilote d'imprimante. (Voir "Installation du pilote
d'imprimante" à la page 3-3 ou "Si vous utilisez Macintosh" à la
page 3-15.)
3 Si vous utilisez une connexion réseau, configurez le réseau. (Voir
"Réglage de l'impression réseau" à la page 4-3.)
4 Vérifiez l'installation en imprimant une page test. (Voir "Impression
Test" à la page 5-5.)
5 Installez les polices d'écran.
– Le CD-ROM du logiciel utilisateur contient les polices Latin
TrueType comme polices d'écran.
– Voir "Polices d'écran" à la page 13-9 pour de plus amples
informations sur l'installation des polices d'écran.
L'installation du pilote d'imprimante peut varier en fonction de la méthode de
connexion utilisée avec cet appareil en plus du système d'exploitation de
l'ordinateur et du type de pilote d'imprimante utilisé.
!
Détails
Pour plus de détails sur la connexion de cet appareil à un ordinateur, voir
"Interfaces compatibles" à la page 2-9.
2
Remarque
Pour mettre à jour un pilote d'imprimante existant, commencez pas
supprimer le pilote d'imprimante existant. Pour plus de détails, voir
"Désinstaller le pilote d'imprimante" à la page 3-14 et page 3-22.
2 Présentation
2-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
3 Installation du pilote
d'imprimante
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-3
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3.1 Pilotes d'imprimante et systèmes d'exploitation
compatibles
Afin d'utiliser ce système d'impression, il faut d'abord installer le pilote
d'imprimante. Le pilote d'imprimante est un programme qui contrôle le
traitement des données pour la sortie. Installez le pilote d'imprimante sur
l'ordinateur à partir du CD-ROM fourni.
Les pilotes d'imprimante présents sur le CD et les systèmes informatiques
d'exploitation compatibles sont énumérés ci-après. Installez le pilote
d'imprimante requis.
Langage de description
de page
Pilote d'imprimante Systèmes d'exploitation compatibles
PCL PCL Windows 98SE, Windows Me,
Windows NT 4.0, Windows 2000,
Windows XP, Windows Server 2003
PostScript 3 PS Windows NT 4.0, Windows 2000,
Windows XP, Windows Server 2003
Windows XP x64, Windows Serveur 2003 x64
PPD PostScript Windows 98SE, Windows Me,
Windows NT 4.0, Windows 2000,
Windows XP, Windows Server 2003
Windows XP x64, Windows Server 2003 x64
Mac OS 9, Mac OS X
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
3.2 Utilisé avec Windows
La procédure d'installation pour le pilote d'imprimante Windows varie en
fonction de la manière dont cet appareil est raccordé à l'ordinateur et en
fonction du pilote d'imprimante utilisé.
2
Remarque
Pour obtenir des détails sur l'installation du pilote d'imprimante dans un
environnement réseau, voir "Réglage de l'impression réseau" à la
page 4-3. Comme il est nécessaire de spécifier à l'avance d'autres
paramètres de réseau lors de l'installation du pilote d'imprimante via une
connexion réseau, installez-le à ce moment avec une connexion locale.
Pour installer le pilote d'imprimante sous Windows NT 4.0,
Windows 2000, Windows XP ou Windows Server 2003/XP x64/
Server 2003 x64, connectez-vous avec un nom d'utilisateur autorisé
par l'administrateur.
Pour brancher cet appareil à un ordinateur par le biais d'une connexion
parallèle ou USB, vous avez besoin du kit d'interface locale
supplémentaire.
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
PCL
PS
"Installation du pilote d'imprimante à l'aide de l'Assistant
Ajout d'imprimante" à la page 3-5
"Installation du pilote d'imprimante à l'aide de l'Assistant
Ajout d'imprimante" à la page 3-5
"Pour Windows 98SE/Me/NT 4.0/2000" à la page 3-8
"Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64" à
la page 3-6
"Installation à l'aide du câble USB" à la page 3-10
"Pour Windows 98SE/Me" à la page 3-10
"Pour Windows 2000" à la page 3-12
"Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64" à
la page 3-13
PPD PostScript "Installation du pilote d'imprimante à l'aide de l'Assistant
Ajout d'imprimante" à la page 3-5
"Pour Windows 98SE/Me/NT 4.0/2000" à la page 3-8
"Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64" à
la page 3-6
"Installation à l'aide du câble USB" à la page 3-10
"Pour Windows 98SE/Me" à la page 3-10
"Pour Windows 2000" à la page 3-12
"Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64" à
la page 3-13
Le pilote PS peut s'utiliser sous Windows NT4.0/2000/XP/Server 2003/
XP x64/Server 2003 x64.
Pour l'acquisition du pilote PS pour Windows XP x64/Server 2003 x64, contactez le SAV.
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-5
Installation du pilote d'imprimante à l'aide de l'Assistant Ajout
d'imprimante
2
Remarque
Pour l'impression IPP, il n'est pas nécessaire d'installer le pilote
d'imprimante à ce moment car le paramétrage de l'impression IPP est
effectué lors de l'installation du pilote d'imprimante.
Pour de plus amples détails sur l'impression IPP, voir "Impression IPP
(Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64)" à la
page 4-14.
2
Remarque
Pour obtenir des détails sur l'installation du pilote d'imprimante dans un
environnement réseau, voir "Réglage de l'impression réseau" à la
page 4-3. Comme il est nécessaire de spécifier à l'avance d'autres
paramètres de réseau lors de l'installation du pilote d'imprimante via une
connexion réseau, installez-le à ce moment avec une connexion locale.
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64
1 Insérez le "CD-ROM du logiciel utilisateur" dans le lecteur de CD-ROM
de l'ordinateur.
2 Cliquez sur [Démarrer] et ensuite sur [Imprimantes et télécopieurs].
3 Pour Windows XP/XP x64, cliquez sur [Ajouter une imprimante] dans le
menu "Tâches d'impression".
– Pour Windows Server 2003/Server 2003 x64, faites un double clic
sur l'icône "Ajout d'imprimante".
L'Assistant Ajout d'imprimante démarre.
4 Cliquez sur [Suivant].
5 Sélectionnez "Imprimante locale connectée à cet ordinateur".
– Décochez la case "Détection et installation automatique de
l'imprimante Plug and Play" et cliquez sur [Suivant].
6 La boîte de dialogue Sélectionner le port d'imprimante apparaît.
Sélectionnez "LPT1" et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
– Le port LPT1 est généralement le port parallèle utilisé.
7 Cliquez sur [Disque fourni].
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-7
8 Cliquez sur [Parcourir].
9 En fonction de la langue, du système d'exploitation et du pilote
d'imprimante que vous utilisez, spécifiez le dossier du CD-ROM
contenant le pilote d'imprimante et cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
– Voir "Configuration du CD-ROM du contrôleur" à la page 2-3 pour
le dossier contenant le pilote d'imprimante.
– Si vous utilisez l'application Adobe PageMaker, copiez le fichier
PPD du dossier "PPD_PageMaker" dans un dossier approprié.
(Pour plus de détails, reportez-vous au manuel Adobe PageMaker.
10 Cliquez sur [OK].
– La liste "Imprimantes" apparaît.
11 Cliquez sur [Suivant].
12 Suivez les instructions à l'écran.
– Si vous utilisez une connexion réseau, effectuez un test
d'impression une fois que vous avez spécifié les paramètres
réseau.
13 Une fois l'installation terminée, assurez-vous que l'icône de
l'imprimante installée apparaît dans la fenêtre Imprimantes et
télécopieurs.
14 Sortez le CD-ROM du lecteur de CD-ROM.
L'installation du pilote d'imprimante est terminée.
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour Windows 98SE/Me/NT 4.0/2000
1 Insérez le "CD-ROM du logiciel utilisateur" dans le lecteur de CD-ROM
de l'ordinateur.
2 Cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez sur [Paramètres] et cliquez sur
[Imprimantes].
La fenêtre Imprimantes apparaît.
3 Double-cliquez sur l'icône "Ajouter une imprimante".
L'Assistant Ajout d'imprimante démarre.
4 Suivez les instructions à l'écran.
5 Sur l'écran de sélection de la connexion de l'imprimante, sélectionnez
"Imprimante locale".
Utilise les fenêtres de Windows 2000.
6 Cliquez sur [Suivant].
7 Cliquez sur [Disque fourni].
8 Cliquez sur [Parcourir].
9 En fonction de la langue, du système d'exploitation et du pilote
d'imprimante que vous utilisez, spécifiez le dossier du CD-ROM
contenant le pilote d'imprimante et cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
– Voir "Configuration du CD-ROM du contrôleur" à la page 2-3 pour
le dossier contenant le pilote d'imprimante.
– Si vous utilisez l'application Adobe PageMaker, copiez le fichier
PPD du dossier "PPD_PageMaker" dans un dossier approprié.
(Pour plus de détails, reportez-vous au manuel Adobe PageMaker.)
10 Cliquez sur [OK].
La liste "Imprimantes" apparaît.
11 Cliquez sur [Suivant].
12 Indiquez le port de connexion. Sélectionnez "LPT1".
13 Suivez les instructions à l'écran.
– Si vous utilisez une connexion réseau, effectuez un test
d'impression une fois que vous avez spécifié les paramètres
réseau.
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-9
14 Une fois l'installation terminée, assurez-vous que l'icône de
l'imprimante installée apparaît dans la fenêtre Imprimantes.
15 Sortez le CD-ROM du lecteur de CD-ROM.
L'installation du pilote d'imprimante est terminée.
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Installation à l'aide du câble USB
L'ordinateur personnel et le système d'impression peuvent être directement
connectés par un câble USB pour l'impression.
2
Remarque
Windows NT4.0 ne gère pas l'impression à l'aide d'un câble USB.
Les descriptions données ici concernent le pilote PCL .
Pour Windows 98SE/Me
Lorsque vous utilisez un câble USB pour la première fois, installez le
"support d'impression USB", puis le pilote d'imprimante.
1 Allumez le copieur.
2 Insérez le "CD-ROM du logiciel utilisateur" dans le lecteur de CD-ROM
de l'ordinateur.
– Lorsque vous introduisez le CD-ROM, le "programme
d'installation" est lancé automatiquement. Cliquez ensuite sur
[Terminer] pour terminer le "programme d'installation".
3 Reliez le copieur et l'ordinateur par un câble USB.
4 La fenêtre de dialogue de l'Assistant Ajout de nouveau matériel
apparaît. Cliquez sur [Suivant].
5 Sélectionnez "Chercher le pilote le mieux adapté à votre système.
(Recommandé" et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
– Les écrans Windows 98SE servent ici d'illustration.
6 Sélectionnez "Spécifier un emplacement" et cliquez ensuite sur
[Parcourir].
7 Spécifiez le dossier du CD-ROM qui contient le fichier de pilote du
"support d'impression USB" et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
– Pour spécifier le dossier qui contient le fichier du pilote (en cas de
pilote PCL:
À l'ouverture du lecteur de CD-ROM, sélectionnez "Drivers" –
"PCL" – "ineo750_600" – "EN" – "Win9X_Me". Vérifiez que
"Recherche du fichier de pilote Windows pour le système" est réglé
sur "Support d'impression USB" et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-11
8 L'installation démarre. Lorsque l'installation est terminée, cliquez sur
[Terminer].
L'installation du "support d'impression USB" est alors terminée.
Installez ensuite le pilote d'imprimante.
9 La fenêtre de dialogue de l'Assistant Ajout de nouveau matériel
apparaît. Cliquez sur [Suivant].
– Le nom à rechercher s'intitule "GENERIC 75/60 BW-1".
10 Sélectionnez "Chercher le pilote le mieux adapté à votre système.
(Recommandé" et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
11 Sélectionnez "Spécifier un emplacement" et cliquez ensuite sur
[Parcourir].
12 Spécifiez le dossier du CD-ROM qui contient le fichier du pilote
d'imprimante et cliquez sur [Suivant]. Le dossier est au même endroit
qu'à l'étape 7.
13 Une zone de message apparaît avec le message "Windows a décelé
un pilote mis à jour pour cet appareil...". Vérifiez que "le pilote mis à jour
(recommandé)" est réglé sur "GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 PCL",
sélectionnez-le et cliquez sur [Suivant].
14 Cliquez sur [Suivant].
15 Pour changer le nom d''imprimante, tapez le nom de l'imprimante
désirée. Pour la définir comme "Imprimante par défaut", sélectionnez
"Oui" et cliquez sur [Suivant].
– Lorsque vous installez une imprimante pour la première fois, aucun
écran de sélection n'apparaît. Elle automatiquement définie comme
"Imprimante par défaut".
16 Pour imprimer la "page de test", sélectionnez "Oui (recommandé)" et
cliquez sur [Terminer].
17 Si vous avez installé le pilote d'imprimante et sélectionné
"Oui (recommandé)" à l'étape 16, la page de test est imprimée. Si
la page de test s'imprime correctement, cliquez sur [Terminer].
L'installation du pilote d'imprimante est terminée.
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour Windows 2000
1 Mettez le copieur sous tension.
2 Insérez le "CD-ROM du logiciel utilisateur" dans le lecteur de CD-ROM
de l'ordinateur.
– Lorsque vous introduisez le CD-ROM, le "programme
d'installation" est lancé automatiquement. Cliquez ensuite sur
[Terminer] pour terminer le "programme d'installation".
3 Reliez le copieur et l'ordinateur par un câble USB.
4 La boîte de dialogue de l'Assistant Nouveau matériel détecté apparaît.
Cliquez sur [Suivant].
5 Sélectionnez "Chercher le pilote le mieux adapté à mon système
(recommandé)" et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
6 Cochez la case "lecteurs CD-ROM" et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
7 La recherche d'un pilote d'imprimante est lancée. Cliquez sur [Suivant].
– Si la recherche ne donne aucun pilote (en cas de pilote PCL):
Revenez à l'étape 6, cochez la case "Spécifier un emplacement"
ouvrez le lecteur CD-ROM, sélectionnez "Drivers" – "PCL" –
"ineo750_600" – "EN" – "Win2000_XP" et cliquez sur [Suivant].
8 Le pilote d'imprimante est installé. Cliquez sur [Terminer]. L'installation
du pilote d'imprimante est terminée.
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-13
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64
1 Mettez le copieur sous tension.
2 Insérez le "CD-ROM du logiciel utilisateur" dans le lecteur de CD-ROM
de l'ordinateur.
– Lorsque vous introduisez le CD-ROM, le "programme
d'installation" est lancé automatiquement. Cliquez ensuite sur
[Terminer] pour terminer le "programme d'installation".
3 Reliez le copieur et l'ordinateur par un câble USB.
4 La boîte de dialogue de l'Assistant Nouveau matériel détecté apparaît.
Sélectionnez "Installer à partir d'une liste ou d'un emplacement
spécifique (avancé)" et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
– Le nom à rechercher s'intitule "GENERIC 75/60 BW-1".
5 Sélectionnez "Chercher le meilleur pilote dans ces emplacements",
cochez l'option "Chercher les supports amovibles" et cliquez sur
[Suivant].
6 Un pilote d'imprimante est installé. Cliquez sur [Terminer]. L'installation
est terminée.
– Si aucun pilote n'est installé (en cas de pilote PCL) :
Revenez à l'étape 5, cochez la case "Inclure cet emplacement dans
la recherche", ", ouvrez le lecteur CD-ROM, sélectionnez "Drivers"
– "PCL" – "ineo750_600" – "EN" – "Win2000_XP" et cliquez ensuite
sur [Suivant].
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-14 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Désinstaller le pilote d'imprimante
S'il s'avère nécessaire de supprimer le pilote d'imprimante, par exemple,
quand vous voulez réinstaller le pilote d'imprimante, suivez la procédure
suivante pour supprimer le pilote.
Désinstaller le pilote d'imprimante manuellement
1 Pour Windows 98SE/Me/NT 4.0/2000, cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez
sur [Paramètres] et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes].
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, cliquez sur
[Démarrer], et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes et télécopieurs].
2 Dans la fenêtre Imprimantes (pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/
Server 2003 x64, fenêtre Imprimantes et télécopieurs), sélectionnez
l'icône de l'imprimante que vous voulez supprimer.
3 Appuyez sur la touche [Suppr] du clavier de votre ordinateur pour
supprimer le pilote d'imprimante.
4 Redémarrez votre ordinateur.
– Une fois que le pilote de l'imprimante a été supprimé, l'icône de
l'imprimante va disparaître de la fenêtre Imprimantes (pour
Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, fenêtre
Imprimantes et télécopieurs).
La désinstallation de Windows 98SE/Me est terminée. Si vous utilisez
Windows NT4.0/2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64,
exécutez les étapes 5 à 8 ci-dessous.
5 Sélectionnez "Propriétés du serveur" dans le menu "Fichier"
6 Cliquez sur l'onglet "Pilotes" et sélectionnez le pilote d'imprimante
supprimé à l'étape 3.
7 Appuyez sur la touche [Supprimer] pour supprimer le pilote
d'imprimante.
8 Redémarrez votre ordinateur.
– Une fois la suppression terminée, le nom du pilote d'imprimante
disparaît de l'onglet "Pilotes".
Maintenant la désinstallation est terminée.
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-15
3.3 Si vous utilisez Macintosh
La procédure d'installation du pilote d'imprimante Macintosh varie en
fonction de la version du système d'exploitation Mac et du pilote
d'imprimante utilisé. Veuillez-vous référer au tableau ci-dessous pour
trouver la procédure d'installation adéquate du pilote d'imprimante sur
votre ordinateur Macintosh.
Installation du pilote d'imprimante
Pour Mac OS X
1 Allumez l'ordinateur Macintosh.
2 Insérez le CD-ROM du logiciel utilisateur dans le lecteur de CD-ROM
de l'ordinateur Macintosh.
– Fermez toutes les applications en cours et susceptibles d'avoir
démarré lorsque vous avez allumé votre ordinateur Macintosh.
3 Ouvrez le dossier "Driver — OS10_2_X" ou "Drivers — OS10_3_X" sur
le CD-ROM.
4 Sélectionnez la version Mac utilisée et copiez le fichier pilote sur le
bureau.
Mac OS X 10.2 : GENERIC_75_BW-1_102.pkg
Mac OS X 10.3/10.4 : GENERIC_75_BW-1_103.pkg
5 Double-cliquez le fichier copié sur le bureau.
– Entrez le nom et le mot de passe requis de l'administrateur.
– Pour connaître le nom et le mot de passe administrateur, demandez
à votre administrateur réseau.
– Pour quitter l'installation, cliquez sur [Annuler].
6 Cliquez sur [Continuer] et suivez les instructions à l'écran jusqu'à ce
que la boîte de dialogue Installation apparaisse.
Syst. expl. Mac Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Mac OS X PPD PostScript "Installation du pilote d'imprimante" à la
page 3-15
Mac OS 9 PPD PostScript "Pour Mac OS 9" à la page 3-20
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-16 IC-202 (Phase 2)
7 Dans la boîte de dialogue Installation, cliquez sur [Installation].
– À partir de la deuxième installation du pilote d'imprimante, la
touche "Installation" peut s'appeler "MÁJ(Mise à jour)".
Le pilote d'imprimante est installé sur l'ordinateur Macintosh. Une fois
l'installation terminée, un message s'affiche.
8 Cliquez sur [Fermer].
L'installation du pilote d'imprimante est terminée.
Ensuite, sélectionnez l'imprimante.
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-17
Sélectionner une imprimante
2
Remarque
Si la connexion se fait par AppleTalk, il est nécessaire de spécifier sur
cette machine les paramètres AppleTalk. Pour plus de détails sur la
définition des paramètres AppleTalk, voir "Imprimer avec Macintosh" à la
page 4-33.
Si la connexion se fait par Bonjour sous Mac OS X 10.4, il est nécessaire
de spécifier sur cette machine les paramètres Bonjour. Pour plus de
détails sur la définition des paramètres Bonjour, voir "Imprimer avec
Macintosh" à la page 4-33.
Si la connexion se fait par Rendez-vous sous Mac OS X 10.3, il est
nécessaire de spécifier sur cette machine les paramètres Bonjour. Pour
plus de détails sur la définition des paramètres Bonjour, voir "Imprimer
avec Macintosh" à la page 4-33.
Pour Mac OS X
Après avoir branché cette machine à un ordinateur Macintosh, elle peut être
utilisée comme imprimante en la sélectionnant dans Centre d'impression ou
l'Utilitaire de configuration de l'imprimante comme imprimante à utiliser.
1 Ouvrez le Centre d'impression ou l'utilitaire Configuration de
l'imprimante, situé dans "Applications"—"Utilitaires" du "Disque dur".
2 Lorsque la boîte de dialogue Ajout d'imprimante apparaît, cliquez sur
[Ajouter]. Lorsque la liste d'imprimantes apparaît, cliquez sur [Ajouter].
– Pour Mac OS X 10.4, passez à l'étape 3.
– Pour Mac OS X 10.2 et Mac OS X 10.3, passez à l'étape 4.
– Si des imprimantes utilisables ont déjà été configurées, la boîte de
dialogue Ajouter imprimante n'apparaît pas.
3 Si cette machine apparaît comme imprimante avec une connexion
Bonjour, sélectionnez "GENERIC" dans la liste déroulante "Imprimer
avec", sélectionnez "GENERIC 75 BW-1 PS(P)" ou "GENERIC 60 BW-
1 PS(P)" dans la liste des modèles, et cliquez ensuite sur [Ajouter].
– Si l'imprimante sélectionnée est enregistrée dans la liste des
imprimantes, cela indique que la procédure d'installation est
terminée.
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-18 IC-202 (Phase 2)
– En cas de connexion AppleTalk, si cette machine n'apparaît pas
comme imprimante, cliquez sur [Autres imprimantes] et passez
ensuite à l'étape 4.
4 Sélectionnez la méthode de connexion et le nom de l'imprimante.
– Pour spécifier une zone AppleTalk pour une connexion AppleTalk,
sélectionnez "Zone locale AppleTalk".
– Si "IPP" est sélectionné comme protocole dans Imprimante IP, la
boîte de saisie du nom de la file apparaît.
Sous Mac OS 10.3, il convient de laisser cette boîte vide.
Sous Mac OS 10.4, entrez "ipp" dans la boîte texte du nom de la
file.
5 Sélectionnez "GENERIC" dans la zone de liste déroulante "Modèle de
l’imprimante".
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-19
6 Sélectionnez "GENERIC 75 BW-1 PS(P)" ou "GENERIC 60 BW-1
PS(P)" et cliquez ensuite sur [Ajouter].
– L'imprimante sélectionnée est enregistrée sur la liste des
imprimantes.
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-20 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour Mac OS 9
Après avoir branché cette machine, elle peut être utilisée comme imprimante
en sélectionnant "Imprimante PostScript" sous "Sélecteur" et en spécifiant
le fichier de description (PPD) de l'imprimante.
Commencez par copier le fichier de description (PPD) de l'imprimante sur
l'ordinateur Macintosh.
1 Insérez le CD-ROM du pilote d'imprimante Macintosh dans le lecteur
de CD-ROM de l'ordinateur Macintosh.
2 Ouvrez le dossier "Driver — OS9_x — en" sur le CD-ROM.
3 Sélectionnez le fichier PPD "GENERIC75BW-1UVxxx.ppd" et copiezle
dans le dossier "Printer descriptions" dans "System folder"—
"Extensions" du "Harddisk".
– Ensuite, sélectionnez une imprimante.
Le pilote d'imprimante peut utiliser une imprimante LaserWriter
Macintosh standard.
4 Dans le menu Apple, cliquez sur [Sélecteur]
5 Assurez-vous que "AppleTalk" est réglé sur "Activé" et cliquez ensuite
sur l'icône [LaserWriter]
6 Dans la liste "Sélectionner une imprimante PostScript", cliquez sur
l'imprimante compatible avec le système d'impression et cliquez
ensuite sur [Créer].
– Si un autre fichier PPD a déjà été sélectionné, cliquez sur
[Configurer] et cliquez ensuite sur [Sélectionner PPD] sur l'écran
déjà affiché.
L'écran de sélection du fichier de description (PPD) de l'imprimante
PostScript apparaît.
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-21
7 Sélectionnez le fichier PPD approprié et cliquez ensuite sur
[Sélectionner].
L'écran de réglage pour ajouter des options apparaît.
8 Sélectionnez les options installées sur cette machine.
9 Cliquez sur [OK].
La fenêtre du sélecteur réapparaît.
10 Fermez la fenêtre du sélecteur.
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-22 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Désinstaller le pilote d'imprimante
S'il s'avère nécessaire de désinstaller le pilote d'imprimante, suivez la
procédure ci-dessous pour supprimer le pilote.
2
Remarque
Fermez toutes les applications en cours et susceptibles d'avoir démarré
lorsque vous avez allumé votre ordinateur Macintosh.
Pour Mac OS X
1 Ouvrez le Centre d'impression ou l'utilitaire Configuration de
l'imprimante, situé dans "Applications"—"Utilities" du "Disque dur".
2 Sélectionnez le nom de l'imprimante à supprimer et cliquez ensuite sur
[Supprimer].
L'imprimante sélectionnée est supprimée.
3 Fermez la liste des imprimantes.
4 Faites glisser le fichier suivant, situé dans "Library"—"Pritners"—
"PPD"—"Contents"—"Resources" du "Disque dur" sur l'icône
"Corbeille".
– "GENERIC 75 BW-1.gz"
– "GENERIC 60 BW-1.gz"
5 Supprimez les fichiers inutiles dans "Library"—"Printers".
– Avec Mac OS 10.3/10.4
– Faites glisser les fichiers suivants dans "Library"—"Printers"—
"GENERIC"—"Filter" vers la "corbeille".
– pstokm750
– Faites glisser les fichiers suivants de "Library"—"Receipts" dans la
"corbeille".
– GENERIC_75_BW-1_103.pkg
– Faites glisser les fichiers suivants présents dans "Library"—
"Printers" — "GENERIC"— "PDE" dans la "corbeille".
– GENERIC75BW-1 Finishing.plugin
– GENERIC75BW-1 ImageLayout.plugin
– GENERIC75BW-1 Security.plugin
– GENERIC75BW-1 Setup.plugin
– Pour Mac OS 10.2
– Faites glisser les fichiers suivants dans "Library"—"Printers"—
"Plugins PPD" sur l'icône "Corbeille".
– GENERIC75BW-1 Finishing.plugin
Installation du pilote d'imprimante 3
IC-202 (Phase 2) 3-23
– GENERIC75BW-1 ImageLayout.plugin
– GENERIC75BW-1 Security.plugin
– GENERIC75BW-1 Setup.plugin
6 Relancez l'ordinateur Macintosh.
La procédure de désinstallation est terminée.
Pour Mac OS 9
1 Faites glisser le fichier PPD "GENERIC75BW-1UVxxx.ppd", situé dans
"System folder"—"Extensions"—"Printer descriptions" du "Disque
dur" sur l'icône "Corbeille".
Les fichiers associés au pilote d'imprimante sont supprimés.
2 Faites glisser l'"icône Imprimante du bureau" dans la "corbeille".
3 Relancez l'ordinateur Macintosh.
La procédure de désinstallation est terminée.
3 Installation du pilote d'imprimante
3-24 IC-202 (Phase 2)
4 Réglage de l'impression
réseau
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-3
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4.1 Aperçu des fonctions réseau
Fonctions réseau
En connectant cet appareil à un réseau par l'intermédiaire du port Ethernet,
ce système d'impression peut être utilisé comme imprimante réseau.
Ce système d'impression supporte les normes 10Base-T et 100Base-TX. En
outre, l'interface Ethernet supporte les protocoles TCP/IP (LDP/LPR, Raw,
IPP, SMB), NetBEUI (SMB), IPX/SPX (NetWare), AppleTalk (EtherTalk) et
Bonjour/Rendez-vous.
2
Remarque
Lors de la configuration du réseau, le mot de passe administrateur est
obligatoire pour accéder au mode Administrateur.
Demandez le mot de passe administrateur à l'administrateur de cet
appareil.
Vous pouvez également configurer le paramètre réseau sur le panneau
de contrôle du copieur.
Système d'impression
Cet appareil
Ethernet
Réseau
Hub
Le kit d'interface parallèle (en option) est installé.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Caractéristiques des fonctions réseau
Ce système d'impression est équipé des fonctions réseau suivantes pour
supporter de manière flexible divers environnements de réseau.
- Sélection automatique de 10Base-T ou 100Base-TX (Fast Ethernet)
- Supporte plusieurs protocoles réseau dont TCP/IP, NetBEUI, IPX/SPX et
AppleTalk (EtherTalk)
- Supporte l'impression SMB
L'impression SMB est une méthode d'impression qui ne requiert pas de
serveur d'impression spécifique.
- Supporte l'impression Raw (excepté sous Windows NT4.0)
- Supporte LPD/LPR sur TCP/IP dans Windows NT 4.0/2000/XP/
Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64
Vous pouvez imprimer avec LPD/LPR. Windows 98SE et Windows Me ne
sont pas compatibles.
– LPR (Line Printer Request) : ce système de requête d'impression peut
être utilisé sous Windows NT 4.0/2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/
Server 2003 x64.
- Supporte Novell NetWare ServeurP et RImprimante (NImprimante)
- Supporte les fonctions de serveur d'impression Novell NetWare et
supporte le mode Bindery et le mode Novell Directory Service (NDS)
- Acquisition automatique de l'adresse IP via DHCP
Avec NetWare
Les fonctions de serveur d'impression Novell NetWare 4.x-6 sont
supportées.
Vous pouvez connecter ce système d'impression à un réseau via Novell
NetWare 4.x-6 comme système d'exploitation du serveur et envoyer les
travaux d'impression du client au serveur d'impression (contrôleur réseau).
Les trois modes sont supportés comme suit :
- NImprimante
- ServeurP
- NDPS
2
Remarque
Pour plus de détails sur les fonctions NetWare, voir le manuel
d'exploitation NetWare.
Avec Macintosh
Vous pouvez imprimer à partir de votre ordinateur Macintosh en utilisant
AppleTalk ou Bonjour/Rendez-vous.
Vous pouvez connecter ce système d'impression au serveur d'impression
dans un environnement AppleTalk, Bonjour/Rendez-vous et envoyer des
tâches d'impression de l'ordinateur Macintosh vers cette machine.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-5
Méthodes de connexion réseau que l'on peut sélectionner dans chaque
système d'exploitation Windows
Ce chapitre décrit les paramètres à spécifier pour l'impression en réseau.
Les procédures de configuration varient selon la méthode d'impression
réseau utilisée (impression SMB, Raw, LPR ou IPP). Sélectionnez la meilleure
méthode d'impression réseau pour votre environnement Windows.
Impression réseau à partir d'un système d'exploitation Windows
*1 Pour exécuter l'impression Raw sous Windows 98SE/Me, l'application
désignée sous le terme "Peer to Peer Tool" peut s'avérer nécessaire. Pour
plus de détails, contactez le SAV.
2
Rappel
Avant de configurer l'impression réseau, installez le pilote d'imprimante.
Pour des détails sur l'installation du pilote d'imprimante, voir "Installation
du pilote d'imprimante" à la page 3-3.
Pour imprimer en réseau, changer de port d'imprimante du pilote
d'imprimante installé et optez pour une connexion réseau, puis modifiez
les paramètres sur cet appareil selon nécessité. Pour une connexion IPP,
il faut d'abord installer le pilote d'imprimante.
Impression réseau dans un environnement NetWare
Protocole
utilisé
98SE Me NT
4.0
2000 XP Serveur
2003
XP
x64
Server
2003
x64
Impression
SMB
TCP/IP,
NetBEUI
o o o o o o o o
Impression
Raw
TCP/IP *1 *1 o o o o o
Impression
LPR
TCP/IP o o o o o o
Impression
IPP
TCP/IP o o o o o
Version NetWare Protocole utilisé Emulation Mode Service
NetWare 4.x IPX NDS/Bindery ServeurP/Imprimante
NetWare 5.x/6 IPX NDS ServeurP
TCP/IP NDPS(lpr)
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
4.2 Réglage de l'adresse IP pour cet appareil
Servez-vous du panneau de contrôle de cet appareil pour assigner une
adresse IP à cet appareil.
2
Rappel
Quand vous spécifiez les paramètres réseau, suivez les instructions de
l'administrateur réseau.
Spécification de l'Adresse IP
1 Appuyez sur la touche [Utilities/Compteur] sur le panneau de contrôle
de cet appareil, appuyez sur [Réglage administrateur] et tapez le mot
de passe de l'administrateur.
– Le mot de passe administrateur est obligatoire pour accéder au
mode Administrateur. Demandez le mot de passe administrateur à
l'administrateur de cet appareil.
2 Appuyez sur [Paramètres Réseau] puis sur [Paramètre TCP/IP].
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Adresse IP : Définissez l'adresse IP de cet appareil.
Masque : Définissez le masque de sous-réseau pour le réseau auquel
vous vous connectez.
Passerelle par défaut : Définissez l'adresse de la passerelle par défaut
pour le réseau auquel vous vous connectez.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-7
4 Pour appliquer les paramètres, redémarrez cet appareil
(éteignez-le puis rallumez-le).
Après avoir éteint la machine, attendez au moins de 10 secondes avant
de la remettre en marche. La configuration de l'adresse IP devient
effective.
!
Détails
Bien que l'adresse IP soit saisie sans utiliser le serveur DHCP dans la
procédure décrite ici, il est également possible d'affecter
automatiquement l'adresse IP du serveur DHCP. Quand "Paramètre
DHCP" est réglé sur "ON", les paramètres d'adresse IP, de masque de
sous-réseau et d'adresse de passerelle sont automatiquement attribués
par le serveur DHCP sur le réseau, il n'est donc pas nécessaire de les
attribuer manuellement. Cependant, veuillez vous assurer des points
suivants si vous réglez "Paramètre DHCP" sur "ON".
Consultez l'administrateur réseau pour savoir si le serveur DHCP existe.
Si le serveur DHCP n'existe pas, assurez-vous de spécifier les
paramètres pour "Adresse IP", "Masque" et "Passerelle par défaut".
Si les paramètres de l'adresse IP et d'autres éléments ont été assignés
via le serveur DHCP, il se peut qu'ils aient été automatiquement modifiés.
Si les paramètres de l'adresse IP et d'autres éléments ont été modifiés,
si l'adresse IP a été utilisée pour définir une imprimante sur le réseau pour
impression, il se peut que l'impression ne puisse pas se faire parce que
cet appareil ne peut pas communiquer avec le réseau. Si "Paramètre
DHCP" est réglé sur "ON", il est recommandé de définir l'adresse
IP attribuée à cet appareil dans les paramètres de serveur DHCP.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
4.3 Accéder à Web Connection
La définition de l'adresse IP pour cet appareil vous permet d'accéder à Web
Connection.
Servez-vous de votre navigateur Internet pour accéder directement à Web
Connection.
Pour accéder à Web Connection
1 Lancez le navigateur Internet.
2 Dans la barre "Adresse", tapez l'adresse IP de cet appareil comme
illustré ci-dessous et appuyez sur la touche [Entrée].
– http:///
Exemple : si l'adresse IP de cet appareil est 192.168.1.20
http://192.168.1.20/
L'écran d'accueil de Web Connection apparaît.
Pour de plus amples détails sur Web Connection, voir "Utiliser Web
Connection" à la page 11-39.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-9
4.4 Impression SMB
Vous pouvez utiliser l'impression SMB (impression Windows) pour imprimer
directement sur le réseau Microsoft.
Opérations sur cet appareil
Définissez l'adresse IP pour cet appareil. Pour la procédure de configuration,
voir "Réglage de l'adresse IP pour cet appareil" à la page 4-6.
Spécifiez aussi les paramètres d'impression SMB dans Web Connection.
0 Vous pouvez également configurer l'impression SMB sur le panneau de
contrôle. Voir le "Guide de l'utilisateur [Scanner réseau]" pour plus de
détails.
1 Lancez Web Connection.
– Pour terminer une session lorsque la page de connexion n'apparaît
pas, cliquez sur [Déconnexion].
2 Dans la page de connexion, sélectionnez "Administrateur" et cliquez
sur [Connexion].
3 Tapez le mot de passe administrateur et connectez-vous en mode
Administrateur.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
4 Sous l'onglet Réseau, cliquez sur [Paramètre SMB] et ensuite sur
[Réglage Impression] dans le sous-menu qui s'affiche.
5 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Impression SMB : Définissez si vous voulez utiliser le service
d'impression SMB. Sélectionnez [Oui].
Nom NetBIOS spécifiez le nom NetBIOS (jusqu'à 15 caractères
alphanumériques).
Nom service d'impression : Spécifiez le nom du service d'impression
(jusqu'à 31 caractères alphanumériques).
Groupe de travail : Spécifiez le nom du groupe de travail (jusqu'à
15 caractères alphanumériques).
6 Pour appliquer les paramètres, redémarrez cet appareil
(éteignez-le puis rallumez-le).
Après avoir éteint la machine, attendez au moins 10 secondes avant de
la remettre en marche pour que le paramètre soit modifié.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-11
Paramètres du serveur d'imprimante
Pour Windows 98SE/Me
1 Cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez sur [Paramètres] et cliquez sur
[Imprimantes].
2 Effectuez un clic droit sur l'icône de l'imprimante installée et cliquez
ensuite sur [Propriétés]
3 Sous l'onglet Détails, cliquez sur [Ajouter un port].
4 Sélectionnez "Réseau" et cliquez ensuite sur [Parcourir]. Dans la
fenêtre de configuration réseau qui s'est ouverte, sélectionnez l'icône
d'imprimante appropriée.
Pour Windows NT 4.0/2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64
1 Pour Windows NT 4.0/2000, cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez sur
[Paramètres] et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes].
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, cliquez sur
[Démarrer] et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes et télécopieurs.].
2 Effectuez un clic droit sur l'icône de l'imprimante installée et cliquez
ensuite sur [Propriétés].
3 Cliquez sur [Ajouter un port] sous l'onglet Ports, double-cliquez sur
[Port local] ou sélectionnez [Port local] et cliquez sur [Nouveau port],
puis tapez "\\\".
– Tapez le même nom NetBIOS et le même nom de service
d'impression que vous aviez saisis dans Web Connection. Pour la
procédure de configuration, voir "Opérations sur cet appareil" à la
page 4-9.
4 Cliquez sur [Fermer] pour appliquer le réglage.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
4.5 Impression Raw/LPR
Ce modèle supporte les services d'impression Raw et LPR. Le service
d'impression Raw est disponible sous Windows 98SE/Me/2000/XP/
Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64 et le service d'impression LPR sous
Windows NT 4.0/2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64. TCP/IP sert
de protocole réseau.
2
Remarque
Pour exécuter l'impression Raw sous Windows 98SE/Me, l'application
désignée sous le terme "Peer to Peer Tool" peut s'avérer nécessaire.
Pour plus de détails, contactez le SAV.
Opérations sur cet appareil
% Définissez l'adresse IP pour cet appareil.
– Pour la procédure de configuration, voir "Réglage de l'adresse IP
pour cet appareil" à la page 4-6.
Paramètres du serveur d'imprimante
Pour Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64
1 Pour Windows 2000, cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez sur [Paramètres]
et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes].
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, cliquez sur
[Démarrer], puis sur [Imprimantes et télécopieurs].
2 Effectuez un clic droit sur l'icône de l'imprimante installée et cliquez
ensuite sur [Propriétés].
3 Sous l'onglet Ports, cliquez sur [Ajouter un port].
4 Dans la liste des "Ports d'imprimantes disponibles", sélectionnez
"Port standard TCP/IP" et cliquez sur [Nouveau port].
5 Quand l'Assistant Ajout de port d'imprimante TCP/IP standard s'ouvre
cliquez sur [Suivant].
6 Dans la zone "Nom de l'imprimante ou adresse IP", tapez l'adresse IP
de cet appareil et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
7 Sélectionnez "Personnalisé" et cliquez ensuite sur [Paramètres].
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-13
Réglage de l'impression Raw
1 Cochez la case "Raw", entrez le numéro de port défini dans la case
"Paramètres Raw" et cliquez sur [OK].
2 Cochez le paramètre de numéro de port dans "Numéro de port RAW"
si nécessaire. Voir le "Guide de l'utilisateur ineo 750/600 [Opérations
Scanner réseau]" pour de plus amples informations sur le "numéro de
port RAW".
3 Cliquez sur [Suivant] et [Terminer] pour terminer cette étape.
Réglage de l'impression LPR
1 Sélectionnez "LPR", tapez "Print" dans la case "Nom de file d'attente"
et cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
2 Cliquez sur [Suivant], puis sur [Terminer] pour appliquer le réglage.
Pour Windows NT 4.0 (lors du réglage de l'impression LPR)
1 Cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez sur [Paramètres] et cliquez sur
[Imprimantes].
2 Effectuez un clic droit sur l'icône de l'imprimante installée et cliquez
ensuite sur [Propriétés].
3 Sous l'onglet Ports, cliquez sur [Ajouter un port].
4 Dans la liste "Ports d'imprimantes disponibles", sélectionnez
"Port LPR" et cliquez ensuite sur [Nouveau port].
– Si "Port LPR" ne figure pas dans la liste, cliquez sur [Démarrer],
pointez sur [Panneau de configuration] et cliquez sur [Réseau].
Puis,sous l'onglet Service, cliquez sur [Ajouter] et installez le
service d'impression Microsoft TCP/IP.
5 Dans le champ "Nom ou adresse du serveur fournissant le lpd" de la
boîte de dialogue Ajouter imprimante compatible LPR, tapez l'adresse
IP de cet appareil.
6 Dans le champ "Nom de l'imprimante ou de la file d'attente
d'impression sur ce serveur", tapez "Print".
7 Cliquez sur [OK] pour appliquer le réglage.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-14 IC-202 (Phase 2)
4.6 Impression IPP (Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/XP
x64/Server 2003 x64)
Le service d'impression IPP (Internet Printing Protocol) est supporté par
défaut dans Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64.
TCP/IP sert de protocole réseau.
Opérations sur cet appareil
Définissez l'adresse IP pour cet appareil. Pour la procédure de configuration,
voir "Réglage de l'adresse IP pour cet appareil" à la page 4-6.
Spécifiez aussi les paramètres d'impression dans Web Connection.
(L'impression peut s'effectuer avec les paramètres par défaut.)
0 Vous pouvez également configurer l'impression IPP sur le panneau de
contrôle. Voir le "Guide de l'utilisateur [Opérations Scanner réseau]" pour
plus de détails.
1 Lancez Web Connection.
– Pour terminer une session lorsque la page de connexion n'apparaît
pas, cliquez sur [Déconnexion].
2 Dans la page de connexion, sélectionnez "Administrateur" et cliquez
sur [Connexion].
3 Tapez le mot de passe administrateur et connectez-vous en mode
administrateur.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-15
4 Sous l'onglet Réseau, cliquez sur [Paramètre IPP].
5 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Paramètre IPP : Définir s'il faut effectuer l'impression IPP. Sélectionnez
"Oui" ici.
Nom de l'imprimante : Spécifiez le nom de l'imprimante
(127 caractères alphanumériques max.).
Position imprimante : Spécifiez l'emplacement de l'imprimante
(127 caractères alphanumériques max.).
Informations sur l'imprimante : Spécifiez les coordonnées du fabricant
de l'imprimante (127 caractères alphanumériques max.).
URL imprimante : affichage de l'URL de l'imprimante qui peut être
utilisée pour l'impression IPP.
Opération soutenue : Spécifiez les opérations compatibles IPP.
Accepter IPP : Définir s'il faut utiliser la fonction de réception IPP.
Système d'Authentification IPP : Spécifiez la méthode
d'authentification, le nom de propriétaire, et le mot de passe pour la
connexion IPP.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-16 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Installation du pilote d'imprimante
Pour l'impression IPP, réinstallez le pilote d'imprimante.
1 Insérez le "CD-ROM du logiciel utilisateur" dans le lecteur de CD-ROM
de l'ordinateur.
2 Pour Windows 2000, cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez sur [Paramètres]
et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes].
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, cliquez sur
[Démarrer], puis sur [Imprimantes et télécopieurs].
3 Pour Windows 2000, double-cliquez sur l'icône "Ajouter une
imprimante".
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, cliquez sur
[Ajouter une imprimante] dans le menu [Tâches d'impression].
L' "Assistant Ajout d'imprimante" démarre.
4 Cliquez sur [Suivant].
5 Dans la boîte de dialogue Imprimante locale ou réseau, sélectionnez
"Imprimante réseau" et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
6 Dans la boîte de dialogue : Rechercher votre imprimante, sélectionnez
"Vous connecter à une imprimante sur Internet ou sur votre réseau
intranet".
7 Dans le champ "URL", tapez l'URL pour cet appareil au format suivant
et cliquez sur [Suivant].
– http:///ipp
Exemple : si l'adresse IP de cet appareil est 192.168.1.20
http://192.168.1.20/ipp
8 Quand la boîte de confirmation s'affiche, cliquez sur [OK].
9 Cliquez sur [Disque fourni].
10 Cliquez sur [Parcourir], spécifiez le dossier du CD-ROM qui contient le
pilote d'imprimante et cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
PCL driver :\User Software CD-ROM
"Driver\Drivers" folder
PostScript PPD Driver : User Software CD-ROM "Driver\Drivers" folder
11 Vérifiez que le nom de l'imprimante figure dans la liste "Imprimantes"
et cliquez ensuite sur [Suivant].
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-17
12 Sélectionnez s'il faut définir l'imprimante en tant qu'imprimante par
défaut et cliquez sur [Suivant].
13 Cliquez sur [Terminer] pour quitter l'Assistant Ajout d'imprimante.
Une fois les paramètres spécifiés pour l'imprimante, vous pouvez utiliser
l'imprimante de la même manière qu'une imprimante locale par défaut. De
même, si vous partagez l'imprimante dans Windows, elle peut être utilisée
comme imprimante réseau par d'autres ordinateurs Windows sur le réseau.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-18 IC-202 (Phase 2)
4.7 Imprimer avec NetWare
Le contrôleur d'impression supporte les environnements suivants.
Impression réseau dans un environnement NetWare
2
Remarque
Avant d'utiliser l'émulation bindery, vérifiez que l'émulation bindery est
compatible avec le serveur NetWare.
Pour le mode Imprimante distante avec l'émulation NetWare 4.x Bindery
1 À partir d'un ordinateur client, connectez-vous avec des autorisations
de Superviseur pour accéder au serveur NetWare sur lequel ServeurP
est installé.
2 Lancez Pconsole.
3 Dans la liste "Available Options", sélectionnez "Quick Setup" et cliquez
ensuite sur [Entrée].
4 Tapez les noms appropriés dans les champs "Print Server Name",
"Printer Name", "Print Queue Name" et "Print Queue Volume",
sélectionnez "Other/Unknown" à partir du champ "Printer Type" et
enregistrez les paramètres spécifiés.
5 Cliquez sur [Esc] pour quitter Pconsole.
6 Utilisez la console de serveur NetWare pour charger PSERVER.NLM.
– Pour les privilèges d'utilisation de la file d'attente, l'option de
notification d'imprimante, l'affectation de plusieurs files d'attente et
les mots de passe, veuillez-vous référer à la documentation
NetWare et spécifiez les paramètres selon vos besoins.
Version NetWare Protocole utilisé Emulation Mode Service
NetWare 4.x IPX NDS/Bindery ServeurP/
NImprimante
NetWare 5.x/6 IPX NDS ServeurP
TCP/IP NDPS(lpr)
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-19
7 En mode administrateur de Web Connection, sélectionnez "Paramètre
NetWare" sous l'onglet Réseau et spécifiez les paramètres suivants.
Activation IPX : Sélectionnez "Oui".
Type trame Ethernet : Sélectionnez "Détect. auto". (Sélectionne le type
de trame en fonction de l'environnement réseau).
Mode d'Impression NetWare : Sélectionnez
"NImprimante/RImprimante".
Nom de serveur d'impression : Spécifiez le nom du serveur
d'impression créé à l'étape 4.
Numéro d'imprimante : Spécifiez le numéro d'imprimante (0 à 255).
Si vous spécifiez 255, le paramètre est "Auto".
8 Redémarrez cet appareil (éteignez-le puis rallumez-le).
– Lorsque vous mettez l'appareil hors tension et sous tension à
nouveau, assurez-vous de commencer par actionner l'interrupteur
auxiliaire puis l'interrupteur général. De plus, attendez au moins
10 s avant de remettre l'appareil sous tension, sinon cette machine
risque de ne pas fonctionner correctement.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-20 IC-202 (Phase 2)
9 Utilisez la console de serveur NetWare pour afficher l'écran du serveur
d'impression et vérifie ensuite que l'imprimante créée s'affiche comme
étant "En attente de travail" pour l'imprimante connectée (0).
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-21
Pour le mode Serveur d'impression avec émulation NetWare 4.x BIndery
Avant d'utiliser l'émulation bindery, vérifiez que l'émulation bindery est
compatible avec le serveur NetWare.
1 À partir d'un ordinateur client, connectez-vous avec des autorisations
de Superviseur pour accéder au serveur NetWare sur lequel ServeurP
est installé.
2 Lancez Pconsole.
3 Dans la liste "Options disponibles", sélectionnez "Quick Setup" et
cliquez ensuite sur [Entrée].
4 Tapez les noms appropriés dans les champs "Print Server Name",
"Printer Name", "Print Queue Name" et "Print Queue Volume",
sélectionnez "Other/Unknown" à partir du champ "Printer Type" et
enregistrez les paramètres spécifiés.
5 Cliquez sur [Esc] pour quitter Pconsole.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-22 IC-202 (Phase 2)
6 En mode administrateur de Web Connection, sélectionnez "Paramètre
NetWare" sous l'onglet Réseau et spécifiez les paramètres suivants.
Activation IPX : Sélectionnez "Oui".
Type trame Ethernet : Sélectionnez "Détect. auto". (Sélectionnez le
type de trame en fonction de l'environnement réseau.)
Mode d'impression NetWare : Sélectionnez "ServeurP".
Nom de serveur d'impression : Spécifiez le nom du serveur
d'impression créé à l'étape 4.
Mot de passe serveur d'impression : Uniquement à indiquer si le
réglage s'effectue à partir du serveur NetWare. (affiché par "----".)
Intervalle appel : Spécifiez "1". (Changer selon nécessité.)
Paramètre Bindery/NDS : Sélectionnez "Param. NDS/Bindery".
Nom serveur de fichiers : Spécifiez le nom du serveur de fichiers qui se
connecte au serveurP.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-23
7 Redémarrez cet appareil (éteignez-le puis rallumez-le).
– Lorsque vous mettez l'appareil hors tension et sous tension à
nouveau, assurez-vous de commencer par actionner l'interrupteur
auxiliaire puis l'interrupteur général. De plus, attendez au moins
10 s avant de remettre l'appareil sous tension, sinon cette machine
risque de ne pas fonctionner correctement.
8 Utilisez la console de serveur NetWare pour charger MONITOR.NLM.
9 Sélectionnez les informations de connexion et vérifiez que le PServer
créé figure bien dans la colonne de connexion active.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-24 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour le mode imprimante distante NetWare 4.x (NDS)
1 Connectez-vous à NetWare en tant qu'administrateur à partir d'un
ordinateur client.
2 Lancez NWAdmin.
3 Sélectionnez l'organisation ou l'unité d'organisation du conteneur qui
propose le service d'impression et cliquez sur [Print Services Quick
Setup] dans le menu "Tools".
4 Tapez les noms appropriés dans les champs "Print Server Name",
"Printer Name", "Print Queue Name" et "Print Queue Volume",
sélectionnez "Other/Unknown" à partir du champ "Printer Type" et
enregistrez les paramètres spécifiés.
– Pour les privilèges d'utilisation de la file d'attente, l'option de
notification d'imprimante, l'affectation de plusieurs files d'attente et
les mots de passe, veuillez-vous référer à la documentation
NetWare et spécifiez les paramètres selon vos besoins.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-25
5 En mode administrateur de Web Connection, sélectionnez "Paramètre
NetWare" sous l'onglet Réseau et spécifiez les paramètres suivants.
Activation IPX : Sélectionnez "Oui".
Type trame Ethernet : Sélectionnez "Détect. auto". (Sélectionne le type
de trame en fonction de l'environnement réseau).
Mode d'Impression NetWare : Sélectionnez
"NImprimante/RImprimante".
Nom de serveur d'impression : Spécifiez le nom du serveur
d'impression créé à l'étape 4.
Numéro d'imprimante : Spécifiez le numéro d'imprimante (0 à 255).
Quand vous spécifiez 255, le réglage est "Détect. auto".
6 Redémarrez cet appareil (éteignez-le puis rallumez-le).
– Lorsque vous mettez l'appareil hors tension et sous tension à
nouveau, assurez-vous de commencer par actionner l'interrupteur
auxiliaire puis l'interrupteur général. De plus, attendez au moins
10 s avant de remettre l'appareil sous tension, sinon cette machine
risque de ne pas fonctionner correctement.
7 Utilisez la console de serveur NetWare pour charger PSERVER.NLM.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-26 IC-202 (Phase 2)
8 Utilisez la console de serveur NetWare pour afficher l'écran du serveur
d'impression et vérifiez que "ineo 750/600" (imprimante créée) apparaît
comme étant "En attente de travail" pour l'imprimante connectée (0).
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-27
Pour le mode Serveur d'impression NetWare 4.x/5.x/6 (NDS)
Pour utiliser le mode serveur d'impression, le protocole IPX doit être chargé
sur le serveur NetWare.
1 Connectez-vous à NetWare en tant qu'administrateur à partir d'un
ordinateur client.
2 Lancez NWAdmin.
3 Sélectionnez l'organisation ou l'unité d'organisation du conteneur qui
propose le service d'impression et cliquez sur [Print Services Quick
Setup (non-NDPS)] dans le menu "Tools".
4 Tapez les noms appropriés dans les champs "Print Server Name",
"Printer Name", "Print Queue Name" et "Print Queue Volume",
sélectionnez "Other/Unknown" à partir du champ "Printer Type" et
cliquez ensuite sur [Create].
– Pour les privilèges d'utilisation de la file d'attente, l'option de
notification d'imprimante, l'affectation de plusieurs files d'attente et
les mots de passe, veuillez-vous référer à la documentation
NetWare et spécifiez les paramètres selon vos besoins.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-28 IC-202 (Phase 2)
5 En mode administrateur de Web Connection, sélectionnez "Paramètre
NetWare" sous l'onglet Réseau et spécifiez les paramètres suivants.
Activation IPX : Sélectionnez "Oui".
Type trame Ethernet : Sélectionnez "Détect. auto". (Sélectionnez le
type de trame en fonction de l'environnement réseau.)
Mode d'impression NetWare : Sélectionnez "ServeurP".
Nom de serveur d'impression : Spécifiez le nom du serveur
d'impression créé à l'étape 4.
Mot de passe serveur d'impression : Uniquement à indiquer si le
réglage s'effectue à partir du serveur NetWare. (affiché par "----".)
Intervalle appel : Spécifiez "1". (Changer selon nécessité.)
Param Bindery/NDS : Sélectionnez "NDS".
Nom du contexte DNS : Spécifiez le nom du contexte se connectant
sur ServeurP.
Nom arborescence DNS : Spécifiez le nom de l'arborescence à
laquelle ServeurP se connecte.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-29
6 Redémarrez cet appareil (éteignez-le puis rallumez-le).
– Lorsque vous mettez l'appareil hors tension et sous tension à
nouveau, assurez-vous de commencer par actionner l'interrupteur
auxiliaire puis l'interrupteur général. De plus, attendez au moins
10 secondes avant de remettre l'appareil sous tension, sinon cette
machine risque de ne pas fonctionner correctement.
7 Utilisez la console de serveur NetWare pour charger MONITOR.NLM.
8 Sélectionnez les informations de connexion et vérifiez que le PServer
créé figure bien dans la colonne de connexion active.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-30 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour le service distribué d'impression NetWare 5.x/6 Novell (NDPS)
Avant de configurer NDPS, vérifiez que le courtier et le gestionnaire NDPS
ont bien été créés et chargés.
De même, avant de démarrer la procédure suivante, vérifiez que le protocole
TCP/IP a bien été défini dans le serveur NetWare, et vérifiez que l'adresse IP
a bien été définie pour cet appareil et que ce dernier est allumé.
1 Connectez-vous à NetWare en tant qu'administrateur à partir d'un
ordinateur client.
2 Lancez NWAdmin.
3 Effectuez un clic droit sur le conteneur de l'organisation ou de l'unité
d'organisation pour laquelle vous allez créer l'agent d'impression et
cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimante NDPS] dans le sous-menu "Créer".
4 Dans la case "NDPS Printer Name", tapez le nom de l'imprimante.
5 Dans la colonne "Printer Agent Source" sélectionnez "Create a New
Pritner Agent" " et cliquez ensuite sur [Create].
6 Vérifiez le nom de l'agent d'impression, puis dans la case "NDPS
Manager name", parcourez les noms de gestionnaires NDPS et
activez-en un.
7 Dans "Gateway Types", choisissez une "passerelle d'imprimante
Novell" et activez-la.
8 Dans la fenêtre Configure Novell PDS for Printer Agent, sélectionnez
"(None)" pour le type d'imprimante et "Novell Port Handler" pour le
type de gestionnaire de port, puis enregistrez les paramètres.
9 Dans "Connection Type", sélectionnez "Remote LPR (on IP)" et activez
le type voulu.
10 Entrez l'adresse IP définie pour cet appareil comme l'adresse d'hôte,
tapez "Print" comme nom d'imprimante et cliquez ensuite sur [Finish]
pour valider les paramètres.
11 L'écran d'enregistrement du pilote d'impression s'affiche.
Sélectionnez "None" pour chaque système d'exploitation afin de
conclure la procédure d'enregistrement.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-31
2
Remarque
Pour configurer les droits d'utilisateur pour les files d'attente, l'option de
notification d'imprimante, l'affectation de plusieurs files d'attente et les
mots de passe, veuillez-vous référer à la documentation NetWare, puis
définissez les paramètres selon vos besoins.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-32 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Configurer les paramètres d'un client (Windows) avec le serveur
NetWare
1 Pour Windows 98SE/Me/2000/NT 4.0, cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez
sur [Paramètres] et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes].
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003, cliquez sur [Démarrer] et cliquez
ensuite sur [Imprimantes et télécopieurs].
– Si "Imprimantes et télécopieurs" n'apparaît pas dans le menu
Démarrer, ouvrez le Panneau de configuration à partir du menu
Démarrer, sélectionnez "Imprimantes et autres périphériques" et
sélectionnez ensuite "Imprimantes et Fax".
2 Pour Windows 98SE/Me/2000/NT 4.0, double-cliquez sur l'icône
[Ajouter imprimante].
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003, cliquez sur [Ajouter une imprimante]
dans le menu "Tâches d'impression".
L'"Assistant Ajout d'imprimante" démarre.
3 Au paramètres de port, parcourez le réseau et définissez le nom de la
file d'attente créée (ou le nom d'imprimante NDPS).
4 Sur la liste "Modèles d'imprimante", spécifiez le dossier du CD-ROM
qui contient le pilote d'imprimante pour le système d'exploitation et le
pilote d'imprimante à utiliser.
– Pour Windows 98SE/Me
Pilote PCL : User Software CD-ROM
dossier "Driver\Drivers"
Pilote PostScript PPD : CD-ROM logiciel utilisateur dossier
"Driver\Drivers"
– Pour Windows NT4.0/2000/XP/Server 2003
Pilote PCL : CD-ROM logiciel utilisateur
dossier "Driver\Drivers"
Pilote PS : CD-ROM logiciel utilisateur dossier "Driver\Drivers"
Pilote PostScript PPD : CD-ROM logiciel utilisateur dossier
"Driver\Drivers"
5 Suivez les instructions à l'écran pour achever l'installation.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-33
4.8 Imprimer avec Macintosh
Cette section décrit les paramètres de cette machine ainsi que les
paramètres réseau pour Macintosh.
Spécifiez les paramètres du port réseau d'imprimante après avoir installé le
pilote d'imprimante et avoir sélectionné une imprimante. Pour sélectionner
une imprimante, voir "Sélectionner une imprimante" à la page 3-17.
Opérations sur cet appareil
Définissez l'adresse IP pour cet appareil. Pour la procédure de configuration,
voir "Réglage de l'adresse IP pour cet appareil" à la page 4-6.
Dans Web Connection, spécifiez les paramètres AppleTalk ou Bonjour.
Spécifier les paramètres AppleTalk
Lors de connexion de cet appareil à un ordinateur Macintosh utilisant
AppleTalk, il faut spécifier les paramètres AppleTalk.
1 Lancez Web Connection.
– Pour terminer une session lorsque la page de connexion n'apparaît
pas, cliquez sur [Déconnexion].
2 Dans la page de connexion, sélectionnez "Administrateur" et cliquez
sur [Connexion].
3 Tapez le mot de passe administrateur et connectez-vous en mode
administrateur.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-34 IC-202 (Phase 2)
4 Sous l'onglet Réseau, cliquez sur [Paramètre AppleTalk]
5 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
AppleTalk : Définir s'il faut utiliser AppleTalk. Sélectionnez "ON" ici.
Nom de l'imprimante : indiquez le nom de l'imprimante (31 caractères
alphanumériques max.).
Nom de zone : Spécifiez la zone connectée (31 caractères
alphanumériques).
6 Pour appliquer les paramètres, redémarrez cet appareil
(éteignez-le puis rallumez-le).
– Lorsque vous mettez l'appareil hors tension et sous tension à
nouveau, assurez-vous de commencer par actionner l'interrupteur
auxiliaire puis l'interrupteur général. De plus, attendez au moins
10 secondes avant de remettre l'appareil sous tension, sinon cette
machine risque de ne pas fonctionner correctement.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-35
Spécifier les paramètres Bonjour
Si vous connectez cette machine à une ordinateur Macintosh par
Bonjour/Rendez-vous, il faut spécifier les paramètres Bonjour.
1 Lancez Web Connection.
– Pour terminer une session lorsque la page de connexion n'apparaît
pas, cliquez sur [Déconnexion].
2 Dans la page de connexion, sélectionnez "Administrateur" et cliquez
sur [Connexion].
3 Tapez le mot de passe administrateur et connectez-vous en mode
Administrateur.
4 Sous l'onglet Réseau, cliquez sur [Paramètre Bonjour].
5 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Bonjour : Spécifiez s'il faut utiliser une connexion Bonjour/Rendezvous.
Sélectionnez "Oui" ici.
– Nom Bonjour : Spécifiez le nom Bonjour censé s'afficher comme
nom de périphérique connecté (63 caractères alphanumériques et
symboles max.).
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-36 IC-202 (Phase 2)
6 Pour appliquer les paramètres, redémarrez cet appareil
(éteignez-le puis rallumez-le).
2
Remarque
La connexion Bonjour est une fonction de Mac OS X 10.4, elle est
l'équivalent de la connexion Rendez-vous de Mac OS 10.3 ou des
versions antérieures.
Lorsque vous mettez l'appareil hors tension et sous tension à nouveau,
assurez-vous de commencer par actionner l'interrupteur auxiliaire puis
l'interrupteur général. De plus, attendez au moins 10 s avant de remettre
l'appareil sous tension, sinon cette machine risque de ne pas fonctionner
correctement.
Réglage de l'impression réseau 4
IC-202 (Phase 2) 4-37
Réglage de l'ordinateur Macintosh
Utilisez l'ordinateur Macintosh connecté pour spécifier les paramètres
TCP/IP et AppleTalk.
2
Rappel
Pour les paramètres réseau, consultez votre administrateur réseau.
Pour l'installation du pilote d'imprimante, voir "Installation du pilote
d'imprimante" à la page 3-3.
Comme Bonjour (une fonction Mac OS X 10.4) est toujours activé, il est
inutile de modifier les paramètres. Bonjour/Rendez-vous est une fonction
Mac OS X. Pour Mac OS 9.2, connectez-vous avec AppleTalk.
Pour Mac OS X
1 Dans le menu Apple, sélectionnez "Préférences système".
2 Cliquez sur l'icône "Réseau".
3 Dans "Afficher", sélectionnez "Ethernet intégré".
4 Cliquez sur l'onglet TCP/IP.
5 Sélectionnez les éléments dans "Configurer" qui correspond aux
paramètres réseau pour l'ordinateur Macintosh connecté au réseau et
réglez ensuite l'adresse IP et le masque de sous-réseau.
6 Si vous utilisez une connexion AppleTalk, cliquez sur l'onglet AppleTalk
et vérifiez ensuite que la case "Make AppleTalk Active" (Activer
AppleTalk) est cochée.
7 Cliquez sur la touche Fermer en haut à gauche de la boîte de dialogue.
Le message "Appliquer les changements de configuration ?" apparaît.
8 Cliquez sur [Appliquer].
Les paramètres modifiés sont enregistrés.
4 Réglage de l'impression réseau
4-38 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour Mac OS 9
1 Dans le menu Apple, pointez sur [Panneau de contrôle] et ensuite
cliquez sur [AppleTalk].
2 Dans la liste déroulante "Connect via", sélectionnez "Ethernet".
3 Dans le menu Apple, pointez sur [Panneau de contrôle] et ensuite
cliquez sur [TCP/IP].
4 Dans la liste déroulante "Connect via", sélectionnez "Ethernet".
5 Sélectionnez les éléments dans "Configurer" qui correspond aux
paramètres réseau pour l'ordinateur Macintosh connecté au réseau et
réglez ensuite l'adresse IP et le masque de sous-réseau.
6 Cliquez sur la touche Fermer en haut à gauche de la boîte de dialogue.
Le message "Enregistrer les changements dans la configuration
actuelle ?"apparaît.
7 Cliquez sur [Enregistrer].
5 Diverses méthodes
d'impression
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-3
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5.1 Opérations d'impression
Pour Windows
Les données peuvent être imprimées depuis une application.
Les travaux d'impression sont spécifiés depuis le logiciel d'application.
1 Ouvrez les données dans l'application, "Fichier" et cliquez ensuite sur
"Imprimer".
2 Vérifiez que le nom de l'imprimante est bien sélectionné dans
"Nom d'imprimante" ou "Sélection de l'imprimante".
– Si l'imprimante n'est pas sélectionnée, cliquez pour sélectionner
l'imprimante.
3 Spécifiez les pages à imprimer et le nombre d'exemplaires à imprimer.
– La boîte de dialogue Imprimer varie en fonction de l'application.
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
4 Cliquez sur [Préférences] ou sur [Propriétés] pour modifier les
paramètres du pilote d'imprimante selon vos besoins.
– En cliquant sur [Préférences] ou sur [Propriétés] dans la boîte de
dialogue Imprimer, vous pouvez spécifier les paramètres de
chaque modèle dans la boîte de dialogue de pilote d'impression qui
apparaît. Pour plus de détails, voir "Configuration du pilote PCL" à
la page 6-3"Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)" à la page 7-3 ou
"Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows)" à la page 8-3.
5 Cliquez sur [Imprimer].
L'indicateur de données de cet appareil se met à clignoter.
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-5
Impression Test
L'impression est possible quand le pilote d'imprimante est installé et que les
paramètres de réseau on été spécifiés. Pour vérifier si la connexion s'est
effectuée correctement, vous pouvez imprimer la page de test standard de
Windows.
Imprimer une page de test depuis la boîte de dialogue Propriétés du pilote
d'imprimante.
1 Pour Windows 98SE/Me/NT 4.0/2000, cliquez sur [Démarrer],
pointez sur [Paramètres] et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes].
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, cliquez sur
[Démarrer], et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes et télécopieurs].
2 Effectuez un clic droit sur l'icône de l'imprimante installée et cliquez
ensuite sur [Propriétés].
3 Sous l'onglet Général, cliquez sur [Imprimer une page de test] ou sur la
touche [Impression Test].
La page de test est imprimée et la boîte de confirmation apparaît.
4 Vérifiez la sortie imprimée, puis cliquez sur [OK] et sur [Oui].
2
Remarque
Si la page de test ne s'est pas imprimée correctement, vérifiez que le
pilote d'imprimante a bien été installé correctement et que les
paramètres de réseau sont complétés.
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour Macintosh
L'impression est possible quand le pilote d'imprimante est installé et que les
paramètres de réseau on été spécifiés. Les travaux d'impression sont
spécifiés depuis le logiciel d'application.
Pour Mac OS X
1 Ouvrez les données dans l'application, "Fichier" et cliquez ensuite sur
"Imprimer".
2 Vérifiez la sélection de l'imprimante.
3 Spécifiez les pages à imprimer et le nombre d'exemplaires à imprimer
et cliquez sur [Imprimer].
L'indicateur de données de cet appareil se met à clignoter.
2
Remarque
Si le nom de l'imprimante ne figure pas sur la liste, sélectionnez
l'imprimante dans Centre d'impression ou l'Utilitaire de réglage de
l'imprimante. Pour plus de détails, voir "Sélectionner une imprimante" à
la page 3-17.
La boîte de dialogue Imprimer varie en fonction de l'application.
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-7
Pour Mac OS 9
1 Ouvrez les données dans l'application, "Fichier" et cliquez ensuite sur
"Imprimer".
2 Vérifiez la sélection de l'imprimante.
3 Sélectionnez "Généralités".
4 Spécifiez les pages à imprimer et le nombre d'exemplaires à imprimer
et cliquez sur [Imprimer].
L'indicateur de données de cet appareil se met à clignoter.
2
Remarque
Si le nom de l'imprimante ne figure pas sur la liste, sélectionnez
l'imprimante dans la fenêtre de choix. Pour plus de détails, voir
"Sélectionner une imprimante" à la page 3-17.
La boîte de dialogue Imprimer varie en fonction de l'application.
Vous pouvez enregistrer les paramètres en cliquant sur [Enregistrer les
réglages].
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
5.2 Réglage des fonctions d'impression
Les fonctions de cet appareil comme le tri et le pliage peuvent être définies
lors de l'impression à partir d'un ordinateur. En fonction du système
d'exploitation installé sur l'ordinateur connecté, la procédure de réglage des
fonctions de cet appareil peuvent varier.
Liste des fonctions
La liste des fonctions contient un récapitulatif des principaux réglages
relatifs à l'impression et à la prise en charge par le pilote d'imprimante.
2
Remarque
Les noms de fonction sur cette liste se basent sur ceux affichés par le
pilote d'imprimante PCL sous Windows XP. En outre, les éléments et les
valeurs de réglage affichés peuvent varier selon que les options sont
installées ou que les paramètres sont disponibles.
Fonction Présentation Pilote d'imprimante
PCL PS PPD
Orientation Permet de spécifier l'orientation d'impression.
o o o
Format original Spécifie le format du document original. o o
Format de sortie Spécifie le format de papier de sortie. o o o
Agr./Réduction Imprime en format agrandi ou réduit. o o o
Source papier Sélectionne la source papier pour impression. o o o
Configuration du
type de papier
Spécifie le type de papier de la source papier. o o o
Position de reliure Permet de sélectionner la position de reliure. o o o
Type d'impression Sélectionne le type d'impression (recto,
recto-verso ou livret).
o o o
Combinaison Imprime plusieurs pages sur une seule page. o o o
Marge de fichier Définit des marges pour les trous de perforation
et les agrafes.
o
Agrafer Agrafe les documents.*1 o o o
Perforer Perfore les documents.*1 o o o
Pliage Exécute le pliage.*1 o o o
Agrafage
central et pliage
Exécute l'agrafage central et le pliage.*1 o o o
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-9
Type de sortie
(Gestion des
travaux)
Pour l'impression non-conventionnelle, sélectionne
le format de sortie spécial pour les
documents confidentiels ou les données enregistrées
dans une boîte.
o o (Mac
OS X
seulement)
Copies Spécifie le nombre de copies à imprimer. o o o
Bac de sortie Sélectionne le magasin de sortie des pages
imprimées.
o o o
Tri Spécifie s'il faut imprimer les copies multiples
par jeux.
o o o
Décalé Lors de l'impression de plusieurs copies, décale
la position de sortie de chaque jeu.
o o o
Sauter pages vierges
N'imprime pas les pages vierges des données.
o
Couverture avec
bac d'insertion
Une page de couverture est jointe au document
imprimé.
o o o
Authentification/
Suivi de Volume
(E.K.C.)
Effectue les opérations d'authentification utilisateur
et de Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.).
L'impression s'effectue après la saisie de l'ID
utilisateur enregistré et du mot de passe.
o o (Mac
OS X
seulement)
Paramétrage par
page
Vous pouvez insérer des feuilles de papier
dans le document imprimé ou changer de
magasin d'alimentation papier en cours d'impression.
o o
Couverture Ajoute une page de couverture. o o o
Dos Ajoute une page de dos. o o o
Chapitre Spécifie toujours la page que vous voulez utiliser
comme page de début de chapitre si
vous imprimez recto-verso ou en mode livret.
o o
Combinaison Imprime un document de 2 pages sur la feuille
de papier.
o o o
Décalage d'image Régler en cas de déplacement de l'image à
imprimer.
o o
Superposition Imprime le document original sur le haut des
données de forme créées séparément.
o o
Filigrane Imprime un filigrane (tampon de texte) sur la
page imprimée.
o o
Estampage numéro
de distribution
Imprime le numéro de la copie. o o
Motif Représente l'image à l'aide de points blancs
et noirs de densité différente.
o
Densité d'impression
Règle la densité d'impression. o o o
Imprimer avec noir Empêche les traits fins, les caractères en couleur,
les images d'être imprimées trop clairs.
o
Fonction Présentation Pilote d'imprimante
PCL PS PPD
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
*1 Réglage en option.
Lissage Impression lisse des parties curvilignes des
caractères et des images.
o o o
Utiliser les polices
de l'imprimante
Spécifie le remplacement des polices TrueType
par les polices de l'imprimante.
o o o
Sélection du mode
(FAX)
À définir pour transmettre un document par
fax. *1
o
Fonction Présentation Pilote d'imprimante
PCL PS PPD
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-11
Présentation des fonctions
Ce chapitre présente un récapitulatif de chaque fonction.
Orientation
Vous pouvez spécifier "Portrait" ou "Paysage" comme orientation de la page
à imprimer.
Portrait Paysage
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
PostScript PPD "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Disposition"
à la page 8-6
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Attributs de page (Paramètres de base)" à
la page 10-8
Mac OS 9 "Attributs de page (Paramètres de base)" à
la page 9-8
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Format des originaux et format de sortie
Vous pouvez spécifier la format d'un document original et le format du papier
de sortie. En spécifiant chaque format, vous pouvez spécifier le taux
d'agrandissement et de réduction.
2
Remarque
Le pilote PPD PostScript pour Windows ne permet de spécifier que les
formats de papier imprimé.
Format original
Format de sortie
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Attributs de page (Paramètres de base)" à
la page 10-8
Mac OS 9 "Attributs de page (Paramètres de base)" à
la page 9-8
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-13
Zoom (agrandissement et réduction)
Vous pouvez spécifier le taux d'agrandissement et de réduction à l'aide de
valeurs numériques.
Original
Réduction
Agrandissement
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Attributs de page (Paramètres de base)" à
la page 10-8
Mac OS 9 "Attributs de page (Paramètres de base)" à
la page 9-8
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-14 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Magasin papier (Source papier)
Vous pouvez sélectionner le magasin papier comme source papier pour
l'impression. Quand vous changez de type de papier, vous pouvez
sélectionner un magasin papier en fonction du type de papier.
Magasin
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
PostScript PPD "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Papier/
qualité" à la page 8-7
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Alimentation papier" à la page 10-14
Mac OS 9 "Généralités (Paramètres de base)" à la
page 9-11
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-15
Type de papier (Support)
Vous pouvez spécifier le type de papier pour l'impression.
2
Remarque
Avec le pilote PCL pour Windows, vous pouvez prédéfinir les paramètres
de type de papier en spécifiant le type de papier du bac d'alimentation
papier.
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
PostScript PPD "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Papier/
qualité" à la page 8-7
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-16 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Type d'impression (Impression recto-verso/Impression Livret)
Vous pouvez imprimer sur les deux côtés d'une page ou au format livret
(deux pages en vis-à-vis ou reliées au centre). Cela s'avère pratique quand
vous voulez relier des documents de plusieurs pages.
La zone de reliure peut être spécifiée en indiquant la position de reliure.
Impression recto verso
Impression de livret
Données Sortie sur Données
Reliure à gauche/Reliure à droite Reliure en haut
Sortie sur
d'impression imprimante d'impression imprimante
Données d'impression Sortie sur imprimante
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Finition" à la page 10-17
Mac OS 9 "Options de finition" à la page 9-13
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-17
2
Remarque
"Agrafage central et pliage" accessible en mode Livret peut uniquement
être utilisé si le module de finition FS-602 est installé.
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-18 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Imprimer plusieurs pages sur une seule page
Vous pouvez imprimer plusieurs pages de document sur une seule page.
Fonction bien pratique quand vous voulez réduire le nombre de pages
imprimées.
2en1 4en1 6en1
9en1 16en1
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
PostScript PPD "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Disposition"
à la page 8-6
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Disposition (Imprimer plusieurs pages sur
une seule page)" à la page 10-13
Mac OS 9 "Disposition (Imprimer plusieurs pages sur
une seule page)" à la page 9-12
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-19
Marge
Décale la position d'impression à l'écran pour laisser un espace.
Portrait Paysage
à gauche (Marge)
à droite (Marge)
en haut (Marge)
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-20 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Agrafage et perforation
Les documents peuvent être agrafés ensemble ou des trous peuvent être
perforés dans le document.
En spécifiant la marge, vous pouvez spécifier la marge d'agrafage ou de
perforation.
2
Remarque
La fonction d'agrafage est uniquement disponible quand le module de
finition en option (à l'exception du SF-601) est installé.
La fonction de perforation est uniquement disponible quand le module de
finition en option (à l'exception du SF-601) est installé. En outre, le kit de
perforation ou le module de perforation et de pliage en Z doit être installé.
Agrafage Perforation
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Finition" à la page 10-17
Mac OS 9 "Options de finition" à la page 9-13
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-21
Type de sortie (gestion des travaux)
Vous pouvez sélectionner "Impression sécurisée", qui exige un mot de passe
pour l'impression, ou "Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur", qui enregistre les
documents dans un dossier.
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X "Sécurité" à la page 10-15
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-22 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Tri (assemblage) et classement (décalage)
Vous pouvez imprimer l'ensemble des jeux du document le nombre de fois
spécifié ou chaque page le nombre de fois spécifié.
En spécifiant décalage, la position de sortie peut être décalée et sortie vers
l'avant et vers l'arrière pour chaque copie. (Plusieurs sources de papier sont
utilisées quand un module de finition de décalage est installé et quand aucun
module de finition n'est installé.)
Tri Décalé
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Copies et pages (Paramètres de base)" à
la page 10-12 et "Finition" à la page 10-17
Mac OS 9 "Options de finition" à la page 9-13
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-23
Sauter pages vierges (Économiser papier)
N'imprime pas les pages vierges des données.
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-24 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Paramètres de page de couverture, de page de dos et d'intercalaire
Une page de couverture et une page de dos peuvent être ajoutées ainsi que
des intercalaires entre les pages. (Le paramètre d'intercalaire est
uniquement disponible avec le pilote d'imprimante PCL et PS.)
Couverture Dos
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage
par page" à la page 6-23
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage
par page" à la page 7-32
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Configuration" à la page 10-19
Mac OS 9 "Options de finition" à la page 9-13
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-25
Couverture avec bac d'insertion
Une page de couverture est jointe au document imprimé. Vous pouvez
joindre du papier épais ou tout autre papier approprié à un document
imprimé en guise de page de couverture.
2
Remarque
Cette fonction en peut être utilisée que si le bac d'insertion en option
(PI-501) est installé.
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage
par page" à la page 6-23
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage
par page" à la page 7-32
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Configuration" à la page 10-19
Mac OS 9 "Options de finition" à la page 9-13
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-26 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Chapitre
En impression Recto-Verso/Livret, certaines pages peuvent toujours être
sorties face imprimée vers le haut.
Impression Recto-verso normale
Impression Recto-verso avec fonction Chapitre.
Si une page spécifiée comme page d'ouverture d'un
chapitre sort comme page de dos, insérez une page
vierge pour décaler l'emplacement de la page
spécifiée vers le recto de la feuille de papier suivante.
Une page précise
L'exemple est plié en long mais l'impression recto-verso peut
aussi s'appliquer aux documents pliés côté court.
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage
par page" à la page 6-23
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage
par page" à la page 7-32
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-27
Combinaison
Deux pages d'un document peuvent être imprimées sur une feuille de papier
(2 en 1) ou 1 page de document et sa copie peuvent être imprimées sur la
même page (Répétition 2 en 1).
Exemple : 2 pages A4 sont agglomérées sur un papier de format A3.
2 en 1
Répétition 2 en 1
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fonctions
spéciales" à la page 6-32
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fonctions
spéciales" à la page 7-42
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Configuration" à la page 10-19
Mac OS 9 "Options de finition" à la page 9-13
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-28 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pliage
Le papier est plié est sorti sous cette forme.
2
Remarque
Cette fonction peut uniquement être utilisée si le module de finition
FS-602 (Pliage en trois, pliage en deux) en option ou le module de
perforation et de pliage en Z (pliage en Z) est installé.
Pliage en trois
Original Pliage en Z
Pliage central
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fonctions
spéciales" à la page 6-32
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fonctions
spéciales" à la page 7-42
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Configuration" à la page 10-19
Mac OS 9 "Options de finition" à la page 9-13
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-29
Décalage d'image
La position d'impression est réglée.
Exemple : quand les paramètres sont décalés de 100 vers la droite et de
300 vers le bas. (unité : 0,1 mm)
Décalage vers la droite
de 10 mm
Décalage vers le bas
de 30 mm
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fonctions
spéciales" à la page 6-32
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fonctions
spéciales" à la page 7-42
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-30 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Superposition
Imprime le document original sur le haut des données de forme créées
séparément.
Données de forme Données créées
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Superposition"
à la page 6-36
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Superposition"
à la page 7-51
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-31
Filigrane
Imprime un filigrane (tampon de texte) sur la page imprimée.
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Filigrane"
à la page 6-40
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Filigrane"
à la page 7-61
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-32 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Réglage qualité
Ajuste la qualité de l'image.
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Qualité"
à la page 6-43
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Qualité"
à la page 7-55
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Image/Disposition" à la page 10-18
Mac OS 9 "Options de finition" à la page 9-13
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-33
Utiliser polices d'imprimante (Remplacer polices)
Spécifie le remplacement des polices TrueType par les polices de
l'imprimante.
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Police"
à la page 6-46
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Police"
à la page 7-64
PostScript PPD "Avancé..." à la page 8-8
Mac OS 9 PostScript PPD "Options PostScript" à la page 9-10
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-34 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Authentification/Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.)
Spécifie quand cette machine fonctionne en mode Authentification/Suivi de
volume.
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 6-7
PS "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration"
à la page 7-9
Mac OS X PostScript PPD "Sécurité" à la page 10-15
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-35
Envoyer téléfax
À définir pour transmettre un document par fax.
Système
d'exploitation
Pilote d'imprimante Voir
Windows PCL "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fax" à
la page 6-47
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-36 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour Windows
Les fonctions de cet appareil pouvant être utilisées lors de l'impression
peuvent être spécifiées dans la boîte de dialogue du pilote d'imprimante que
vous pouvez afficher depuis la fenêtre Imprimantes (pour Windows XP/
Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, fenêtre Imprimantes et télécopieurs).
Les paramètres spécifiés dans la boîte de dialogue de paramétrage du pilote
d'imprimante affichés selon la procédure décrite ci-dessous s'appliqueront
lors de l'impression à partir de n'importe quelle application.
1 Pour Windows 98SE/Me/NT 4.0/2000, cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez
sur [Paramètres] et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes].
Pour Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, cliquez sur
[Démarrer], et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes et télécopieurs].
2 Pour Windows 98SE/Me, faites un clic droit sur l'icône de l'imprimante
installée, puis cliquez sur [Propriétés].
Pour Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, faites
un clic droit sur l'icône de l'imprimante installée, puis cliquez sur
[Options d'impression].
Pour Windows NT4.0, faites un clic droit sur l'icône de l'imprimante
installée, puis cliquez sur [Document par défaut].
La boîte de dialogue de pilote d'imprimante apparaît.
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-37
Pour les paramètres pouvant être spécifiés avec chaque pilote d'imprimante,
voir les éléments suivants :
- Pilote PCL : "Configuration du pilote PCL" à la page 6-3
- Pilote PS : "Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)" à la page 7-3
- Pilote PPD PostScript PPD : "Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows)" à
la page 8-3
Pilote PCL
Pilote PS
Pilote PPD PostScript
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-38 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2
Remarque
Utilisez chaque onglet de la boîte de dialogue pour régler le pilote
d'imprimante.
Pour spécifier les paramètres personnalisés, cliquez Imprimer dans
l'application et cliquez ensuite sur [Préférences] de la boîte de dialogue
d'impression. Les paramètres spécifiés dans la boîte de dialogue
d'impression ne s'appliquent qu'au fichier actuel.
Lors du paramétrage des options installées dans Windows NT 4.0/
2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, faites un clic droit sur
l'icône de l'imprimante installée, puis cliquez sur [Propriétés].
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-39
Pour Macintosh
Les fonctions de cet appareil pouvant être utilisées pendant l'impression
peuvent être spécifiées dans la boîte de dialogue Imprimer ou dans la boîte
de dialogue Format d'impression.
Les paramètres ne peuvent s'appliquer que pendant l'utilisation de
l'application. Quand vous quittez l'application, les paramètres par défaut
sont réactivés.
Pour afficher la boîte de dialogue d'impression
% Ouvrez les données dans l'application "Fichier" et cliquez ensuite sur
[Imprimer].
Pour afficher la boîte de dialogue Format d'impression
% Ouvrez les données dans l'application "Fichier" et cliquez ensuite sur
[Format d'impression] ou sur [Réglage papier].
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-40 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour les paramètres pouvant être spécifiés avec chaque pilote d'imprimante,
voir les éléments suivants :
- OS X : "Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)" à la page 10-3
- OS 9 : "Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9)" à la page 9-3
2
Remarque
Le contenu de la boîte de dialogue Imprimer et de la boîte Format
d'impression peut varier.
Selon l'application, la boîte de dialogue Format d'impression peut être
affichée en sélectionnant "Réglage papier" – "Options" du menu
"Fichier".
Diverses méthodes d'impression 5
IC-202 (Phase 2) 5-41
Vérifiez le travail
Vous pouvez vérifier la liste, l'historique ou d'autres conditions d'impression.
Affichage de la liste d'impression
1 Appuyez sur [Liste Tâches] sur le panneau de contrôle.
L'écran Liste Tâches apparaît et affiche la liste des tâches d'impression
en cours.
2 Appuyez sur [Historique tâches].
La liste de l'historique d'impression est affichée en mode
"Tous travaux".
!
Détails
Lorsque vous appuyez sur [Historique tâches], l'écran "Tous travaux"
s'affiche en premier.
5 Diverses méthodes d'impression
5-42 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Vérifier Réception/Boîte utilisateur
L'historique est affiché si la BOÎTE est enregistrée depuis le pilote
d'imprimante.
1 Appuyez sur [Liste Tâches] du panneau de contrôle et sur [RX/Boîte
utilisat.].
La liste de tous les travaux s'affiche.
2 La touche [Historique tâches] affiche la liste des boîtes enregistrées et
des réceptions fax réalisées.
6 Configuration du pilote
PCL
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-3
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6.1 Paramètres
Paramètres communs
Ce chapitre décrit les paramètres communs et les boutons qui figurent sur
tous les onglets.
Bouton Fonction
OK Cliquez sur cette touche pour fermer la boîte de dialogue et appliquer
les paramètres modifiés.
Annuler Cliquez sur ce bouton pour annuler les paramètres modifiés et
fermer la boîte de dialogue.
Appliquer Cliquez sur cette touche pour appliquer les paramètres modifiés
sans fermer la boîte de dialogue.
Aide Cliquez sur ce bouton pour afficher l'aide relative à chaque élément
de la boîte de dialogue actuellement affichée.
Enregistrer/
Rétablir réglage
Cliquez sur ce bouton pour enregistrer les paramètres actuels
et les consulter ultérieurement.
Rétbl. par. déft. Cliquez sur cette touche pour restaurer les valeurs par défaut
des paramètres qui avaient été sélectionnés lors de l'installation
du pilote.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2
Remarque
Pour activer des options installées, vous devez spécifier les paramètres
Options. Pour plus de détails, voir "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet
Option" à la page 6-61.
Onglet Configuration
Afficher Quand "Papier" est sélectionné, un aperçu de la mise en page
tel que spécifié dans le réglage actuel est affiché et vous pouvez
consulter un aperçu de la tâche d'impression.
Quand "Imprimante" est sélectionné, une figure de l'imprimante
s'affiche avec toutes les options, comme les bacs d'alimentation
papier installés sur cet appareil.
Bouton Fonction
Papier Imprimante
Sous-menu Fonction
Papier Spécifie l'orientation, le format papier, la source papier et
le type de papier.
Reliure Spécifie le format de pliage comme la position de reliure,
l'impression recto-verso, l'impression livret, l'agrafage
central et pliage, l'impression de plusieurs pages sur une
seule page, la marge, l'agrafage ou la perforation.
Sortie Spécifie le format de sortie comme la méthode de sortie,
le nombre de copies, le plateau de sortie, le mode Tri ou
décalage.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-5
Onglet Paramétrage par page
Onglet Fonctions spéciales
Onglet Superposition
Onglet Filigrane
Sous-menu Fonction
Couverture Ajoute une page de couverture.
Dos Ajoute une page de dos.
Couverture avec
bac d'insertion
Régler si vous utilisez une couverture en papier épais.
Chapitre Régler pour l'impression Recto-verso/Livret pour que certaines
pages soient toujours sorties face imprimée vers le
haut.
Paramétrage par page Du papier vierge peut être inséré ou la source du papier
peut être configurée pour chaque page en plus de l'insertion
de feuilles de papier dans un document.
Sous-menu Fonction
Combinaison Vous pouvez imprimer plusieurs pages de document sur une seule
page. Vous pouvez spécifier les détails dans Détails de combinaison.
Pliage Plie les copies.
Décalage d'image Régler en cas de déplacement de l'image à imprimer.
Sous-menu Fonction
Superposition Spécifie l'impression superposée.
Sous-menu Fonction
Filigrane Imprime un filigrane (tampon de texte) sur le document en
cours d'impression.
Estampage numéro de distribution Imprime le numéro de la copie.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Qualité
Onglet Police
Onglet Fax
Onglet Version
Onglet Option
Sous-menu Fonction
Motif Représente l'image à l'aide de points blancs et noirs de
densité différente.
Densité d'impression Règle la densité d'impression.
Imprimer avec noir Empêche les traits fins en couleur, les caractères en couleur,
les images d'être imprimées trop clairs.
Lissage Impression lisse des parties curvilignes des caractères et
des images.
Sous-menu Fonction
Utiliser les polices de l'imprimante Sélectionne l'utilisation des polices TrueType ou des polices
de l'imprimante pour imprimer.
Format de police à télécharger Sélectionne si les polices sont téléchargées sur l'imprimante
en mode point ou vectoriel.
Sous-menu Fonction
Sélection du mode Choisissez l'impression ou l'envoi de fax.
Mode Fax Spécifie la définition du Fax et les conditions d'émission.
Page de garde Définit la page de garde du fax.
Saisie directe Tapez l'adresse d'émission.
Entrée au répertoire téléphonique Enregistrez l'adresse d'émission dans le répertoire téléphonique.
Liste des destinataires Indication du correspondant distant ou enregistré dans le
répertoire téléphonique.
Sous-menu Fonction
Version Affiche la version du pilote d'imprimante.
Sous-menu Fonction
Option Spécifie les options installées sur cet appareil.
Informations optionnelles Spécifie automatiquement les paramètres des options du
pilote d'imprimante.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-7
6.2 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration
Adapter l'impression au format papier
Vous pouvez agrandir ou réduire des documents créés lors de l'impression
pour les faire correspondre au format de sortie papier.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 A partir des zones de liste déroulante "Format original" et "Format de
sortie", sélectionnez les paramètres voulus.
– Vous pouvez aussi spécifier un taux d'agrandissement ou de
réduction dans la boîte "Zoom".
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Enregistrer un format personnalisé
Vous pouvez spécifier et enregistrer à l'avance un format personnalisé
suivant la procédure ci-après.
1 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Format de sortie", sélectionnez
"Config. format personnal.".
La boîte de dialogue Paramètres de format personnalisé apparaît.
2 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Liste des formats personnalisés : Sélectionnez le format pour le format
personnalisé en cours de création.
Nom du format personnalisé : Tapez le nom du format personnalisé en
cours d'enregistrement.
Format : Spécifiez la largeur et la longueur du format personnalisé en
fonction des unités de mesure choisies.
3 Cliquez sur [OK].
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-9
Configuration de la position d'impression
Vous pouvez régler la position d'impression pour le papier large ou le format
personnalisé de papier en sélectionnant "Config. position. impress.".
1 Cliquez sur [Config. position. impress.] dans "Format original" ou dans
"Format de sortie"
La boîte de dialogue Config. position. impress. apparaît.
2 Sélectionnez "En haut", "Au centre" ou "En bas".
3 Cliquez sur [OK].
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Sélectionner la source papier
Lors du changement de type de papier, vous pouvez l'enregistrer sur un
magasin papier et vous pourrez sélectionner le magasin papier en fonction
du type de papier désiré.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Source papier", sélectionnez le
bac d'alimentation papier contenant le papier à utiliser.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-11
Spécifier la source du type de papier
Suivez la procédure décrite ci-dessous pour attribuer un type de papier à un
bac d'alimentation papier.
1 Cliquez sur [Configuration du type de papier].
2 Sélectionnez la "source papier" à changer et cliquez ensuite sur
[Modifier].
3 Sélectionnez le paramètre voulu dans la liste déroulante "Type de
papier" et cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Si "Transparent" est sélectionné comme type de papier, vous pouvez
spécifier des intercalaires sur transparent.
Quand la case "Intercalaire sur transparent" est cochée, la boîte de
dialogue Config. Intercalaire sur transparent apparaît pour vous
permettre de spécifier les sources papier de l'intercalaire sur
transparent.
Vous pouvez aussi afficher la boîte de dialogue Config. Intercalaire sur
transparent en cliquant sur [Paramètres].
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-13
Spécifier l'impression recto-verso/livret
Vous pouvez imprimer un document sur les deux côtés d'une page ou au
format livret (deux pages en vis-à-vis). Cela s'avère pratique quand vous
voulez relier des documents de plusieurs pages.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Type d'impression",
sélectionnez "Recto/verso" ou "Livret".
2
Remarque
L'orientation de reliure peut se spécifier à partir de la zone de liste
déroulante "Position de reliure".
Quand le module de finition FS-602 en option est installé et que "Livret"
est spécifié, vous pouvez sélectionner "Agrafage central et pliage" pour
relier au centre d'une page.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-14 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Imprimer plusieurs pages sur une seule page (N en 1)
Vous pouvez imprimer des documents de plusieurs pages sur une seule
page. Fonction bien pratique quand vous voulez réduire le nombre de pages
imprimées.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Combinaison".
3 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Combinaison", sélectionnez le
nombre de pages à imprimer sur une page.
Pour modifier les paramètres de bordure et d'ordre d'impression,
sélectionnez "Détails" et modifiez les paramètres dans la boîte de
dialogue qui apparaît.
2
Remarque
Quand vous imprimez un travail comprenant plusieurs pages de
différents formats et orientées différemment, il se peut que des images
manquent ou se superposent lors de l'impression du document.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-15
Régler la marge
Des marges sont ajoutées au document avant son impression.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Marge de fichier".
3 Pour régler la largeur de la marge, cliquez sur [Détails] et spécifiez
ensuite les paramètres voulus dans la boîte de dialogue Détails de
marge de fichier qui apparaît.
Recto/Verso : Règle les valeurs de marge. En décochant la case à
cocher "Même valeur pour le recto et le verso", vous pouvez spécifier
des valeurs différentes pour les cotés recto et verso.
Mode de décalage : Sélectionne le processus d'impression pour le
document.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-16 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Agrafage
Vous pouvez agrafer des documents de plusieurs pages.
La fonction d'agrafage est uniquement disponible quand le module de
finition en option (à l'exception du SF-601) est installé.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Agrafer".
3 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante, spécifiez le nombre d'agrafes et
la position d'agrafage.
2
Remarque
En fonction du paramètre sélectionné de position de reliure, différentes
positions d'agrafage sont possibles.
Vous pouvez agrafer jusqu'à 100 feuilles de papier ordinaire au format A4
ou inférieur avec le module FS-505 et 50 feuilles avec le module FS-504
ou 602.
Perforer
Vous pouvez perforer les documents imprimés.
La fonction de perforation est uniquement disponible quand le module de
finition en option (à l'exception du SF-601) est installé. En outre, le kit de
perforation ou le module de perforation et de pliage en Z doit être installé.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Perforer".
3 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante, spécifiez le nombre de trous à
perforer.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-17
Agrafage central et pliage
Traitement du document imprimé avec la fonction Agrafage central et Pliage.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cochez la case "Agrafage central et pliage".
2
Remarque
La fonction de pliage et d'agrafage central est uniquement disponible si
le module de finition FS-602 est installé.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-18 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Sélectionner le type de sortie
Non seulement, vous pouvez imprimer directement, mais vous pouvez aussi
sélectionner "Impression sécurisée", qui nécessite un mot de passe pour
imprimer ou "Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur", qui enregistre les documents
dans le dossier des documents.
0 "Impression sécurisée" et "Enr. dns boîte utilis. (et imprim.)" doivent être
réglés au préalable sur "Disque dur imprimante" avec l'onglet Option.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Type de sortie", sélectionnez la
méthode de sortie.
Impression : imprime immédiatement.
Impression sécurisée : enregistre le document à imprimer dans la boîte
des documents classés de cette machine. Pour imprimer, il vous est
demandé de saisir l'ID utilisateur et le mot de passe sur le panneau de
contrôle de cet appareil. Sélectionnez quand vous imprimez des
documents très confidentiels. (jusqu'à 100 documents)
Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur : Enregistre le document à imprimer dans
une boîte de cet appareil.
Enr. dns boîte utilis, imprim. : Enregistre le document dans une boîte et
l'imprime simultanément.
Attente avec épreuve : après l'impression d'un exemplaire du
document, cet appareil s'arrête provisoirement d'imprimer.
Sélectionnez pour éviter de mal imprimer les travaux d'impression
volumineux.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-19
Impression sécurisée
Si "Impression sécurisée" était sélectionné, saisissez l'ID et le mot de passe
d'impression sécurisée dans la boîte de dialogue qui apparaît.
Pour imprimer le document, appuyez sur [Boîte ut. système] puis sur [Boîte
RX sécurisé] en mode Boîte de cette machine. Après avoir saisi l'ID et le mot
de passe utilisateur, le document est accessible et peut être imprimé.
2
Remarque
Pour de plus amples détails sur les fonctions de boîte de cet appareil,
consultez le manuel utilisateur 750/600 [Opérations de boîte].
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-20 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Enregistrer dans boîte utilisateur
% Quand "Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur" ou "Enr. dns boîte utilis, imprim."
est sélectionné, spécifiez le nom de fichier et le numéro de boîte dans
la boîte de dialogue qui apparaît pour saisir le nom de fichier et le
numéro de la boîte utilisateur.
2
Remarque
Pour de plus amples détails sur les fonctions de boîte de cet appareil,
consultez le manuel utilisateur 750/600 [Opérations de boîte].
Attente avec épreuve
% Lors de l'envoi d'une tâche d'impression, cet appareil s'arrête
provisoirement d'imprimer après avoir imprimé un exemplaire du
document. Le reste de la tâche d'impression est stocké dans l'appareil
en tant que tâche d'impression. Lors de l'impression de plusieurs
copies, vous pouvez imprimer la partie restante de la tâche
d'impression après avoir vérifié les résultats d 'impression.
Pour imprimer, affichez la liste des Tâches en attente de l'écran Liste
Tâches sur le panneau de contrôle de cet appareil et appuyez sur
[Libérer Tâch Att.].
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-21
Spécifier les paramètres d'authentification
Si des paramètres d'authentification ont été spécifiés sur cet appareil, il faut
saisir un nom d'utilisateur.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cliquez sur [Authentification/Suivi de Volume E.K.C.].
3 Cochez la case à cocher "Authentification" et sélectionnez "Utilisateur
destinataire" et saisissez le nom d'utilisateur et le mot de passe.
4 Cliquez sur [OK].
2
Remarque
Si cet appareil a été réglé pour autoriser les utilisateurs publics, l'appareil
peut être utilisé sans nom d'utilisateur ni mot de passe.
Pour les paramètres d'authentification, consultez l'administrateur de cet
appareil.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-22 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Spécifier les paramètres de Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.)
Si des paramètres de suivi de volume ont été spécifiés sur cet appareil, vous
devez saisir un mot de passe de service pour imprimer une travail.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cliquez sur [Authentification/Suivi de Volume E.K.C.].
3 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.)", puis
saisissez le nom et le mot de passe du service.
– Vous pouvez enregistrer un mot de passe par défaut plutôt que de
saisir un mot de passe pour chaque travail.
4 Cliquez sur [OK].
2
Remarque
Si une tâche d'impression est envoyée avec un nom de service ou un mot
de passe ne correspondant pas à un service enregistré sur cet appareil,
ou si un travail est envoyé sans cocher la case "Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.)",
une erreur va survenir. Vérifiez la liste des journaux à l'aide du panneau
de contrôle de cet appareil.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-23
6.3 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage par
page
Imprimer des documents avec page de couverture et de dos
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Sélectionnez les cases à cocher "Couverture" et "Dos".
3 Pour imprimer sur la page de couverture et de dos, sélectionnez
"Imprimé". Pour n'ajouter qu'une page vierge, sélectionnez "Vierge".
4 Sélectionnez la Source papier contenant le papier chargé pour la page
de couverture et la page de dos.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-24 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Impression d'une couverture avec bac d'insertion
Une page de couverture peut être jointe au document imprimé. Définissez le
papier épais ou tout autre type de papier pour le bac d'insertion. Le papier
chargé dans l'introducteur de papes de couverture est joint au document
imprimé comme page de couverture.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Cochez les cases à cocher "Couv. avc bac ins." et "Dos avc bac ins."
dans "Couvertures avec bac d'insertion".
3 Sélectionnez l'une des deux sources papier correspondant au papier
utilisé comme page de couverture ou page de dos.
2
Remarque
Une couverture avec bac d'insertion ne peut être jointe que si le bac
d'insertion (PI-501) est installé en option.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-25
Impression de chapitres
En mode d'impression Recto-verso/Livret, certaines pages peuvent toujours
sortir face imprimée vers le haut. Si une page spécifique devient le côté verso
en mode d'impression Recto-verso, cette page est décalée vers le recto de
la feuille suivante et imprimée.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Cochez la case à cocher "Chapitre".
3 Indiquez les pages à sortir face imprimée vers le haut dans la zone de
texte "Numéro de page".
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-26 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Imprimer plusieurs pages
La fonction "Paramétrage par page" s'avère bien pratique si vous voulez
changer le source papier pendant une tâche d'impression quand vous
imprimer plusieurs pages.
Paramétrage par page
Vous pouvez spécifier le type d'impression et la source papier pour chaque
page.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Paramétrage par page".
3 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Nom de liste", sélectionnez le
nom de la liste voulue.
– Quand vous changez de nom de liste, cliquez sur [Modifier nom de
liste...] après avoir sélectionné le nom de liste et appliquez les
paramètres dans la boîte de dialogue qui apparaît.
4 Cliquez sur [Ajouter] et spécifiez le numéro de page, le type
d'impression et la source papier dans la boîte de dialogue qui apparaît.
5 Cochez la case à cocher "Utilisation de papier à onglet" comme
demandé et choisissez d'utiliser le papier à onglet pour le papier
inséré.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-27
2
Remarque
Voir "Utilisation de papier à onglet" à la page 6-28 pour de plus amples
informations sur la configuration de l'Utilisation de papier à onglet.
Pour une liste existante, cliquez sur [Modifier] pour modifier les
paramètres de page sélectionnés ou cliquez sur [Effacer] pour les
supprimer.
Cliquez sur [+] ou [,] pour modifier le numéro de page.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-28 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Utilisation de papier à onglet
Le papier à onglet disponible dans le commerce peut être utilisé par la
fonction Paramétrage par page.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Paramétrage par page".
3 Cliquez sur [,] en regard du champ "Nom de liste" et sélectionnez un
nom de liste à utiliser sur la liste qui s'affiche
– La configuration de la liste sélectionnée s'affiche dans la zone de
liste.
– Dix types de nom de liste de "Liste 1" à "Liste 10" ont été préenregistrés.
– Vous pouvez enregistrer 10 types de liste fixes.
4 Cliquez sur [Config. papier à onglet].
La boîte de dialogue de configuration du papier à onglet apparaît.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-29
5 Cliquez sur [,] dans le champ "Format" de la boîte "Papier" et
sélectionnez un format à utiliser dans la liste affichée.
– La valeur par défaut est A4 à onglet.
6 Cliquez sur [,] dans le champ "Nombre d'onglets" de la boîte "Papier".
Une liste apparaît. Sélectionnez sur la liste un nombre d'onglets à
utiliser.
– Vous pouvez directement saisir le nombre dans la boîte "Nombre
d'onglets".
– La valeur par défaut est 5.
– Vous pouvez définir une valeur numérique comprise entre 2 et 15.
7 Définissez le "réglage position" nécessaire en spécifiant les champs
"Espace avant onglets", "Espace après onglet", "Espace entre
onglets" ou "Position du texte".
– La plage de valeur numériques définissables varie en fonction des
valeurs numériques dans "Nombre d'onglets".
8 Cliquez sur [OK] et fermez la boîte de dialogue Configuration du papier
à onglet.
Retournez à l'écran de "Paramétrage par page" de la fenêtre
Propriétés.
9 Cliquez sur [Ajouter].
La boîte de dialogue Paramétrage par page apparaît.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-30 IC-202 (Phase 2)
10 Sélectionnez "Numéro de page", "Type d'impression" ou "Source
papier" selon nécessité.
11 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Utilisation du papier à onglet".
12 Entrez votre texte dans la boîte "Texte sur onglet".
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 64 caractères.
13 Cliquez sur [Détails].
– La touche [Détails] ne peut pas être utilisée si vous ne saisissez rien
dans la boîte "Texte sur onglet".
La boîte de dialogue Détails du texte sur onglet apparaît.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-31
14 Définissez les paramètres "texte sur onglet"-"Orientation", "Position"
et "Paramétrage police"-"Nom de police", "Style" ou "Format" selon
nécessité.
15 Cliquez sur [OK] et fermez la boîte de dialogue Détails du texte sur
onglet.
La boîte de dialogue Paramétrage par page réapparaît.
16 Pour spécifier l'onglet pour lequel saisir le "Texte sur onglet", cliquez
sur [,] du champ "Position" et sélectionnez un onglet à spécifier.
– La valeur par défaut est Continuer page précédente.
17 Cliquez sur [OK] et fermez la boîte de dialogue Paramétrage par page.
L'onglet "Paramétrage par page" de la fenêtre "Propriétés" réapparaît.
Le paramètre figure dans la zone de liste.
18 Pour utiliser un autre papier à onglet, exécuter les étapes 9 à 16.
– Si vous utilisez du papier autre que le papier à onglet, voir "Spécifier
les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage par page" à la page 6-23.
19 Confirmez le contenu de la liste.
20 Cliquez sur [OK] et fermez la fenêtre "Propriété".
– Vous pouvez ajouter jusqu'à 30 paramètres à chaque liste.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-32 IC-202 (Phase 2)
6.4 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fonctions
spéciales
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-33
Une image étalée sur deux pages est imprimée sur une feuille de papier
de format double (combinaison)
Le contenu de deux feuilles au format de sortie peut être collecté et imprimé
sur une seule feuille de papier dont le format est le double de celui défini
dans "Format de sortie".
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Fonctions spéciales.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Combinaison".
3 Cliquez sur [,] pour cocher la case "Combinaison" et sélectionnez
"2 en 1" ou "Répétition 2 en 1" dans la liste qui s'affiche.
Si vous sélectionnez "2 en 1", l'image sur les 2 pages continues est collectée
et imprimée sur une seule feuille de papier.
Si vous sélectionnez "Répétition 2 en 1", deux exemplaires de la même page
sont imprimées sur une seule feuille de papier.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-34 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Définir le pliage
Le papier est plié et imprimé. Vous pouvez sélectionner Pliage en deux,
Pliage en Z ou Pliage en trois.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Fonctions spéciales.
2 Cochez la case à cocher "Pliage".
3 Cliquez sur [,] en regard de la case "Pliage". Sélectionnez "Pliage en
deux", "Pliage en Z" ou "Pliage en trois" sur la liste affichée.
2
Remarque
Certains des points peuvent ne pas apparaître en fonction du module de
finition installé.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-35
Réglage de la position d'impression (Décalage d'image)
Vous pouvez régler la position d'impression sur le document imprimé.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Fonctions spéciales.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Décalage d'image".
3 Cliquez sur [Paramètres].
4 Réglez le décalage vers le haut, vers le bas, vers la droite et vers la
gauche côtés recto et verso ou le décalage de gouttière par unités
de 0,1 mm.
2
Remarque
La fonction "Paramètres à utiliser" ne fonctionne pas. Seul un réglage
côté pilote d'imprimante est possible.
Cochez la case "Réglage verso auto" pour appliquer le même réglage
que pour le recto.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-36 IC-202 (Phase 2)
6.5 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Superposition
Imprimer ensemble des documents originaux différents (Superposition)
Un document original peut être imprimé sur des données de superposition
créées séparément. Cette fonction est bien pratique pour les pages de garde
de fax et les formulaires de lettre.
Vous devez pré-enregistrer les formulaires à imprimer. Pour plus de détails,
voir "Créer une superposition" à la page 6-38.
1 Créez les données d'impression à partir de n'importe quelle
application.
2 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
3 Sélectionnez l'imprimante PCL GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 et cliquez
ensuite sur [Préférences].
4 Cliquez sur l'onglet Superposition.
5 Sélectionnez "Imprimer superposition".
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-37
6 Sur la liste, sélectionnez la superposition que vous voulez imprimer.
– Lorsque seule la première page doit être imprimée en
superposition, cochez la case "1ère page seulement".
7 Sélectionnez le nom de fichier et cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
– La boîte de dialogue Imprimer apparaît de nouveau.
8 Cliquez sur [OK].
L'impression de la superposition est exécutée.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-38 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Créer une superposition
Pour utiliser Superposition, les données d'utilisation de la superposition
doivent être préenregistrées. Pour enregistrer une superposition,
sélectionnez la case à cocher "Créer superposition" et spécifiez le document
que vous voulez enregistrer.
1 Créez les données de superposition à partir de n'importe quelle
application.
2 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
3 Sélectionnez l'imprimante PCL GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 et cliquez
ensuite sur [Préférences].
4 Cliquez sur l'onglet Superposition.
5 Sélectionnez "Créer superposition".
6 Cliquez sur [Parcourir fichiers].
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-39
7 Spécifiez l'emplacement de stockage des données de superposition et
tapez le nom de fichier dans la case "Nom du fichier".
8 Cliquez sur [Enregistrer].
9 Sélectionnez le fichier et cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
– La boîte de dialogue Imprimer apparaît de nouveau.
10 Cliquez sur [OK].
Au lieu d'exécuter une tâche d'impression, les données de
superposition sont enregistrées. L'extension de fichier est ".kmf".
2
Remarque
Sous l'onglet Superposition, vous pouvez supprimer les données de
superposition sélectionnées en cliquant sur [Supprimer fichier de
superposition].
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-40 IC-202 (Phase 2)
6.6 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Filigrane
Imprimer un filigrane
Vous pouvez imprimer un texte donné en arrière-plan en tant que filigrane.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Filigrane.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Filigrane".
3 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante, sélectionnez le filigrane que vous
voulez imprimer.
4 Spécifiez les paramètres voulus pour "Saisir".
Ecraser : L'arrière-plan du filigrane est imprimé en blanc.
Transparent : L'arrière-plan du filigrane est transparent.
5 Cochez la case à cocher "1re page uniquement" si vous n'imprimez le
filigrane que sur la première page.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-41
Modifier un filigrane
Vous pouvez modifier les polices et la position du filigrane et vous pouvez en
enregistrer un nouveau.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Filigrane.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Filigrane".
3 Cliquez sur [Modifier].
4 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– [Ajouter]:
cliquez dessus pour saisir un nouveau filigrane dans la case de
texte filigrane.
– [Effacer] :
cliquez dessus pour effacer le filigrane sélectionné.
– Paramétrage police :
spécifie la police et la taille.
– Angle du texte :
spécifie l'angle d'impression du filigrane.
– Position:
spécifie la position du filigrane à l'aide des curseurs verticaux et
horizontaux.
– Densité du Texte :
spécifie la densité du texte avec le curseur.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-42 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Imprimer le numéro du document
Lors de l'impression de plusieurs copies, vous pouvez imprimer le numéro
de chaque document.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Filigrane.
2 Cochez la case "Estampage numéro de distribution".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Pages à imprimer : Spécifie les pages sur lesquelles la numérotation
doit être imprimée.
Numéro de départ : Spécifie le numéro de départ.
2
Remarque
La case à cocher "Estampage numéro de distribution" n'est pas
disponible si la case "Tri" n'est pas cochée sous l'onglet Configuration.
Définissez la position et le format des caractères sur le panneau de
contrôle du copieur.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-43
6.7 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Qualité
Motif
Représente l'image à l'aide de points blancs et noirs de densité différente.
En sélectionnant "Fin", vous augmentez la densité des points. "Grossier" est
le réglage par défaut.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Qualité.
2 Cliquez sur [Fin] dans "Motif".
Densité d'impression
La sélection de la case à cocher "Economie Toner" ou "Brouillon" permet de
réduire la consommation de toner ou imprime en plus clair.
0 Les cases "Economie Toner" et "Brouillon" dans "Densité d'impression"
ne peuvent pas être cochées simultanément.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Qualité.
2 Pour réduire la consommation de Toner, cochez la case "Economie
Toner".
3 Pour imprimer plus clair ou en mode Brouillon, cochez la case
"Brouillon".
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-44 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Imprimer avec noir
Empêche les traits fins en couleur, les caractères en couleur, les images
d'être imprimées en clair.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Qualité.
2 Cochez la case "Imprimer avec noir" et sélectionnez soit "Texte et
graphiques" ou "Tous".
Sous-menu Fonction
Texte et graphiques Les caractères et les images en couleur sont imprimés en noir.
Tous Tous les objets, y compris les données d'image comme les
images photographiques sont imprimées en noir à l'exception
des zones blanches.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-45
Lissage
Impression lisse des parties curvilignes des caractères et des images.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Qualité.
2 Appuyez sur [,] en regard de "Lissage" et sélectionnez le type voulu
dans la liste.
Sous-menu Fonction
Type 1 Processus convenant à l'impression des lignes diagonales des
caractères normaux et des graphiques.
Type 2 Processus convenant à l'impression des sections curvilignes
des caractères normaux.
Type 3 Processus convenant à l'impression des parties curvilignes des
écritures ornementales et des caractères fins.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-46 IC-202 (Phase 2)
6.8 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Police
Spécifier les paramètres
Vous pouvez remplacer les polices TrueType utilisées dans Windows par les
polices d'imprimante de cet appareil.
L'utilisation des polices d'imprimante va réduire le temps d'impression, mais
il risque d'y avoir une différence entre l'affichage à l'écran et les résultats d
'impression.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet "Police".
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Utiliser les polices de l'imprimante".
3 Sélectionnez la police TrueType que vous voulez remplacer.
4 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Police imprimante à utiliser",
sélectionnez la police d'imprimante pour remplacer la police TrueType.
5 Cliquez sur [OK].
2
Remarque
Quand vous utilisez les polices TrueType, sélectionnez le type de police
à télécharger sur l'imprimante à partir de la zone de liste déroulante
"Format de police à télécharger".
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-47
6.9 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fax
Envoyer un fax
Vous pouvez envoyer par fax les données que vous avez créées.
Pour utiliser la fonction de fax, vous devez installer le kit de fax en option sur
cet appareil. De plus, vous devez activer le kit de fax sur l'onglet d'option
correspondant après installation. Pour plus de détails, voir page 6-61.
1 Créez avec l'application de votre choix les données que vous voulez
envoyer.
2 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
3 Sélectionnez l'imprimante PCL GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 et cliquez
ensuite sur [Préférences].
4 Cliquez sur l'onglet "FAX".
5 Sous "Sélection du mode", sélectionnez "FAX".
– Quand vous sélectionnez "Format personnalisé" dans la liste
déroulante "Format papier" de l'onglet Configuration, la
configuration de la fonction fax est impossible.
– Pour plus de détails sur les fonctions de fax de la machine,
consultez le "Guide de l'utilisateur 750/600 [Opérations Fax]".
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-48 IC-202 (Phase 2)
6 Sélectionnez l'information et cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
7 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Résolution", sélectionnez le
paramètre voulu.
8 Cliquez sur [Détails].
La boîte de dialogue "Détail Mode Fax" apparaît.
9 Pour imprimer un fichier après l'envoi d'un fax, sélectionnez la case à
cocher "Imprimer fichier destinataire".
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-49
10 Pour régler l'heure à laquelle le fax doit être envoyé, sélectionnez la
case à cocher "Emission programmée" et spécifiez ensuite l'heure à
laquelle vous voulez envoyer le fax dans les cases "Heure d'émission".
– En cliquant sur [Retourner heure actuelle], l'heure actuelle réglée
sur l'ordinateur s'affiche dans les cases "Heure d'émission".
– Quand vous utilisez "Emission programmée", assurez-vous que
l'heure définie sur l'ordinateur est synchronisée avec l'heure de cet
appareil. Si l'heure d'émission est antérieure à l'heure actuelle de
l'appareil, le fax sera envoyé le lendemain.
11 Lors de l'émission d'un fax confidentiel, sélectionnez les cases "Sousadresse"
et "Envoyer ID" et tapez la sous-adresse et l'ID d'émission. Il
est possible d'envoyer des communications confidentielles à un autre
modèle de fax à l'aide de F codes.
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 20 caractères (chiffres de 0 à 9) dans la
case de texte "Sous-adresse".
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 20 caractères (chiffres de 0 à 9, # et *)
dans la case de texte "Envoyer ID".
12 Cliquez sur [OK].
La boîte de dialogue Options d'impression apparaît de nouveau.
13 Spécifier la destination du fax.
– Vous pouvez tapez le destinataire du fax directement ou le
sélectionner dans le répertoire téléphonique.
– Pour effectuer la saisie directe du destinataire du fax, passez à
l'étape 14. Pour sélectionner un destinataire dans le répertoire
téléphonique, passez à l'étape 15.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-50 IC-202 (Phase 2)
14 Sous "Saisie directe", tapez les informations pertinentes dans les
zones de texte "Nom" et "N° télécopie", puis cliquez sur [Ajouter
destinataire].
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 40 caractères dans la case de texte
"Nom".
– Vous pouvez saisir 38 caractères maximum (chiffres de 0 à 9,
tirets (-), #,*, P et T) dans la case "N° télécopie".
– Vous pouvez enregistrer 100 destinataires maximum dans la liste
"Destinataires". Après avoir saisi les informations relatives au
destinataire, sautez à l'étape 19.
15 Cliquez sur [Répertoire].
– Pour plus de détails sur l'enregistrement de destinataires dans le
répertoire, voir "Enregistrer un destinataire dans le répertoire" à la
page 6-57.
La boîte de dialogue Répertoire apparaît.
16 Sélectionnez le destinataire ou le groupe auquel vous voulez envoyer
le fax.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-51
17 Cliquez sur [Ajouter destinataire].
Le destinataire sélectionné s'affiche dans la liste "Destinataires".
18 Sélectionnez le destinataire et cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
– Si vous sélectionnez un groupe, tous les membres du groupe
s'affichent sur la liste "Destinataires".
La boîte de dialogue Options d'impression apparaît de nouveau.
19 Assurez-vous que le destinataire du fichier figure sur la liste
"Destinataires".
– Pour supprimer un destinataire, sélectionnez le destinataire à
supprimer dans la liste "Destinataires", et cliquez ensuite sur
[Supprimer].
– Ce n'est pas nécessaire de modifier les paramètres des cases à
cocher "ECM", "International" et "V.34". Pour plus de détails, voir
le guide de l'utilisateur "ineo 750/600 [Opérations Fax]".
20 Quand vous ajoutez une page de garde, sélectionnez la case à cocher
"Page de garde".
– Pour définir une page de garde de fax, voir "Créer une page de
garde" à la page 6-53.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-52 IC-202 (Phase 2)
21 Cliquez sur [OK].
La boîte de dialogue Imprimer apparaît de nouveau.
22 Cliquez sur [OK].
La boîte de dialogue Confirmation d'envoi de fax apparaît.
23 Cliquez sur [OK].
Le fax est envoyé au destinataire spécifié.
2
Remarque
Quand une erreur d'émission de fax survient, un rapport d’émission est
automatiquement imprimé. Si vous ne voulez pas que le rapport
d'émission soit automatiquement imprimé, réglez "Rapport Emission"
sur [OFF] sur l'écran Paramètres de rapport à partir du panneau de
contrôle de cet appareil.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-53
Créer une page de garde
Vous pouvez créer une page de garde de fax et la joindre à votre message
fax.
1 Dans la boîte de dialogue Options d'impression, sélectionnez la case à
cocher "Page de garde" sur l'onglet FAX.
2 Cliquez sur [Paramètres].
La boîte de dialogue des Paramètres page de garde FAX apparaît.
3 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Style", sélectionnez le format de
la page de garde.
Styles proposés : de 00 à 03.
4 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Objet" et tapez le sujet de document à
envoyer.
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 64 caractères dans la case de texte
"Objet".
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-54 IC-202 (Phase 2)
5 Sous "Coordonnées du destinataire", vous pouvez spécifier les
informations du destinataire, comme le nom, pour la page de garde à
ajouter. Les informations figurant sur la liste "Destinataires" de l'onglet
FAX sont saisies sur la page de garde.
– Standard:
sélectionne les informations de destinataire standard. Sélectionnez
"Standard" et, à partir de la zone de liste déroulante, le texte à saisir
sur la ligne des informations du destinataire. Vous pouvez aussi
saisir des caractères.
– Détails:
spécifiez séparément les informations de destinataire. Sélectionnez
"Détails" et ensuite, sélectionnez les cases à cocher "Entreprise",
"Service", "Nom" ou "N° télécopie" pour les informations à saisir
sur la ligne d'informations du destinataire. Cliquez sur [Paramètres],
pour sélectionner "Inclure coordonnées destinataires", "Changer
chaque destinataire" ou "Inclure informations choisies" dans la
boîte de dialogue des informations de destinataire.
– La première page de garde de destinataire s'affiche en échantillon
dans la boîte "Aperçu".
– Vous pouvez créer jusqu'à 10 pages de garde différentes si
"Changer chaque destinataire" est coché. Quand vous envoyez
11 fax ou plus avec "Inclure coordonnées destinataires" ou
"Changer chaque destinataire" coché, les informations spécifiées
pour "Standard" apparaissent sur la ligne d'informations
destinataire.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-55
– Si "Destination" n'est pas spécifié, "Inclure informations choisies"
ne peut pas être sélectionné.
– Selon le type de caractères saisis et les paramètres spécifiés avec
"Style", il se peut que tous les caractères saisis ne s'affichent pas
sur la page de garde. Après avoir saisi les informations, assurezvous
que les informations s'affichent correctement dans l'image de
la boîte "Aperçu".
6 Sélectionnez les cases "Entreprise", "Service", "Nom", "Téléphone",
"N° télécopie" ou "E-mail" sous "Coordonnées de l'expéditeur" pour
les informations que vous voulez indiquer sur la ligne des informations
d'expéditeur et cliquez ensuite sur [Paramètres] pour entrer les
principales informations à envoyer sur la page de garde.
– Selon le type de caractères saisis et les paramètres spécifiés avec
"Style", il se peut que tous les caractères saisis ne s'affichent pas
sur la page de garde. Après avoir saisi les informations, assurezvous
que les informations s'affichent correctement dans l'image de
la boîte "Aperçu".
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 40 caractères pour chaque élément.
Les informations d'expéditeur saisies apparaissent sur l'image de la
boîte "Aperçu".
7 Pour saisir la date actuelle sur la page de garde, sélectionnez la case à
cocher "Date".
8 Pour saisir le nombre de pages à envoyer, sélectionnez la case à
cocher "Pages" et spécifiez le nombre de pages.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-56 IC-202 (Phase 2)
9 Pour écrire un message sur la page de garde, tapez le message dans
la case de texte "Commentaire".
– Si vous tapez plus de 25 caractères par ligne, il se peut que les
caractères n'apparaissent pas correctement sur la page de garde.
Contrôlez le texte sur l'image de la boîte "Aperçu" et appuyez sur
la touche Retour pour ajuster le nombre de caractères par ligne.
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 640 caractères dans la case de texte
"Commentaire".
10 Pour insérer un logo d'entreprise des cartes ou d'autres images sur
une page de garde, cochez la case "Image", cliquez sur [Parcourir] et
spécifiez le fichier.
– Vous pouvez ajuster la position de l'image en spécifiant des valeurs
numériques dans les cases "X" et "Y" et vous pouvez ajuster la
taille de l'image entre 50% et 800% en indiquant un taux zoom
dans la boîte "Zoom".
11 Cliquez sur [Vérifier] pour contrôler les paramètres actuels.
La boîte de dialogue Page de garde Fax apparaît et la page de garde
est affichée dans une taille plus grande.
Vérifiez le contenu de la page de garde en y apportant les modifications
nécessaires.
12 Cliquez sur [OK].
La boîte de dialogue de paramétrage de la page de garde fax apparaît
de nouveau.
13 Sélectionnez le format de page de garde dans la zone de liste
déroulante "Form page garde".
14 Cliquez sur [OK].
La boîte de dialogue Options d'impression apparaît de nouveau.
2
Remarque
Pour effacer tous les paramètres modifiés, cliquez sur [Rétbl par déft]
dans la boîte de dialogue Paramètres page de garde FAX.
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-57
Enregistrer un destinataire dans le répertoire
Vous pouvez enregistrer le destinataire du message fax dans le Répertoire.
Enregistrer les informations de destinataire
1 Dans la boîte de dialogue Options d'impression, cliquez sur
[Répertoire] de l'onglet Fax.
La boîte de dialogue Répertoire apparaît.
2 Cliquez sur [Personnel].
La boîte de dialogue "Entrée du répertoire" apparaît.
3 Entrez les informations appropriées dans les zones de texte "Nom",
"N° télécopie", "Entreprise" et "Service". Vous pouvez saisir des titres
dans la zone de texte "Nom".
– Ce n'est pas nécessaire de modifier les paramètres des cases à
cocher "ECM", "International" et "V.34".
Pour plus de détails, voir le guide de l'utilisateur "ineo 750/600
[Opérations Fax]".
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 40 caractères dans les cases de texte
"Nom", "Entreprise" et "Service".
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-58 IC-202 (Phase 2)
– Vous pouvez saisir 38 caractères maximum (chiffres de 0 à 9,
tirets (-), #,*, P et T) dans la case "N° télécopie".
4 Cliquez sur [OK].
Le destinataire est enregistré et apparaît sur la liste "Destinataires".
5 Cliquez sur [OK].
2
Remarque
Lorsque son contenu est modifié, le répertoire téléphonique est réécrit.
Pour préparer un nouveau fichier à partir d'une partie du répertoire,
sélectionnez "Fichier" – "Ouvrir" ou "Fichier" – "Enregistrer sous" et
enregistrez le nouveau fichier séparément.
Pour ouvrir le répertoire téléphonique du nouveau fichier, sélectionnez
"Fichier" – "Ouvrir" et sélectionnez le fichier du répertoire.
L'extension des fichiers Répertoire est ".csv".
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-59
Enregistrer un groupe
Vous pouvez pré-enregistrer les destinataires auxquels vous voulez envoyer
le même fax. Cela s'appelle un "Groupe".
1 Dans la boîte de dialogue Répertoire, sélectionnez le destinataire à
enregistrer dans le groupe.
Le destinataire sélectionné est mis en évidence.
2 Effectuez un clic droit sur le destinataire sélectionné, puis, dans le
sous-menu "Ajouter au groupe", sélectionnez le groupe dans lequel
vous voulez enregistrer le destinataire.
Le destinataire est copié dans le groupe sélectionné.
2
Remarque
Dix groupes ont été créés. Vous ne pouvez ni ajouter ni supprimer de
groupe.
Vous pouvez enregistrer au total 100 destinataires dans l'ensemble des
10 groupes.
Pour modifier le nom de groupe, effectuez un clic droit sur le nom du
groupe dans l'arborescence des répertoires sur la gauche de la boîte de
dialogue et cliquez sur [Modifier].
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-60 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Pour supprimer un destinataire dans un groupe, cliquez sur le groupe
dont vous voulez supprimer un destinataire, effectuez un clic droit sur le
destinataire dans l'arborescence des répertoires sur la gauche de la boîte
de dialogue et cliquez ensuite sur [Retirer du groupe].
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-61
6.10 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Option
Vous pouvez spécifier les options installées sur cet appareil pour qu'elles
puissent être utilisées par le pilote d'imprimante.
2
Remarque
Si les options installées ne sont pas définies à partir de l'onglet Options,
la fonction Option ne peut pas être utilisée avec le pilote d'imprimante.
Lors de l'installation des options, assurez-vous d'effectuer les réglages
corrects.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-62 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Spécifier les paramètres
1 Pour Windows 98SE/Me/NT 4.0/2000, cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez
sur [Paramètres], et cliquez ensuite sur [Imprimantes]. Pour
Windows XP/Server 2003, cliquez sur [Démarrer], puis sur
[Imprimantes et télécopieurs].
2 Effectuez un clic droit sur l'icône "GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 PCL" et
cliquez ensuite sur [Propriétés].
3 Cliquez sur l'onglet Option.
4 Sélectionnez l'option installée à partir de la zone de liste déroulante.
2
Remarque
Pour configurer automatiquement les options installées pendant la
connexion au réseau, tapez le nom d'imprimante ou l'adresse IP de
cet appareil dans la case "Nom d'imprimante ou Adresse IP" sous
"Informations optionnelles" et cliquez ensuite sur [Collecter informations
optionnelles].
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-63
6.11 Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote
Pour les pilotes PCL, vous pouvez enregistrer les valeurs de paramètres du
pilote modifié et les rappeler si nécessaire.
Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote
1 Modifiez les paramètres du pilote à partir de l'onglet Configuration et
de l'onglet Paramètre par page.
2 Cliquez sur [Enregistrer/rétablir paramètres] et sélectionnez ensuite
"Enregistrer paramètres actuels".
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-64 IC-202 (Phase 2)
3 Tapez le nom de fichier dans la case de texte "Nom".
4 Tapez un message dans la case de texte "Commentaire" si nécessaire.
5 Spécifiez un dossier dans la case "Emplacement d'enregistrement" et
cliquez sur [OK].
Les paramètres sont enregistrés dans une bibliothèque.
2
Remarque
L'extension de fichier est ".ksf".
Vous pouvez enregistrer jusqu'à 25 éléments dans la bibliothèque.
Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 40 caractères dans la case de texte "Nom".
Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 512 caractères dans la case de texte
"Commentaire".
Configuration du pilote PCL 6
IC-202 (Phase 2) 6-65
Rétablir les paramètres
1 Cliquez sur [Enregistrer/rétablir paramètres] dans la boîte de dialogue
Options d'impression et sélectionnez ensuite "Paramètre détaillé de
restauration".
La boîte de dialogue "Paramètre détaillé de restauration" apparaît.
2 Cochez la case de l'élément à activer.
3 Cliquez sur [OK].
4 Sélectionnez "Rétablir paramètres enregistrés".
5 Sur la liste "Bibliothèque", sélectionnez le fichier de paramètres voulu.
6 Cliquez sur [OK].
Les valeurs de paramètres sont rappelées et la boîte de dialogue
Options d'impression réapparaît.
6 Configuration du pilote PCL
6-66 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Supprimer les paramètres
1 Cliquez sur [Enregistrer/rétablir paramètres] dans la boîte de dialogue
Options d'impression et sélectionnez ensuite "Modifier bibliothèque".
2 Sur la liste "Bibliothèque", sélectionnez le fichier de paramètres à
supprimer.
3 Cliquez sur [Supprimer].
2
Remarque
Même si le fichier de paramètres est supprimé de la liste "Bibliothèque",
il restera sur le disque dur de votre ordinateur. En spécifiant le nom de
fichier dans "Enregistrer fichier de paramètres dans bibliothèque", vous
le sauvegardez sur la liste "Bibliothèque".
7 Configuration du pilote
PS (Windows)
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-3
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7.1 Paramètres
Paramètres communs
Ce chapitre décrit les paramètres communs et les boutons qui figurent sur
tous les onglets.
2
Remarque
Le pilote PS peut s'utiliser uniquement sous
Windows NT4.0/2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64.
Il ne peut pas être utilisé sous Windows 98SE/Me ni avec Mac OS.
Bouton Fonction
OK Cliquez sur cette touche pour fermer la boîte de dialogue et appliquer
les paramètres modifiés.
Annuler Cliquez sur ce bouton pour annuler les paramètres modifiés et
fermer la boîte de dialogue.
Appliquer Cliquez sur cette touche pour appliquer les paramètres modifiés
sans fermer la boîte de dialogue.
Aide Cliquez sur ce bouton pour afficher l'aide relative à chaque élément
de la boîte de dialogue actuellement affichée.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2
Remarque
Pour activer des options installées, vous devez spécifier les paramètres
Options. Pour plus de détails, voir "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet
Option" à la page 7-66.
Enregistrer/
Rétablir réglage
Cliquez sur ce bouton pour enregistrer les paramètres actuels et
les consulter ultérieurement.
Rétbl. par Déft Cliquez sur cette touche pour restaurer les valeurs par défaut
des paramètres qui avaient été sélectionnés lors de l'installation
du pilote.
Afficher Quand vous cliquez sur "Papier", un aperçu de la mise en page
tel que spécifié dans le réglage actuel s'affiche et vous pouvez
consulter un aperçu du tâche d'impression.
Quand vous cliquez sur "Imprimante", une figure de l'imprimante
s'affiche avec toutes les options, comme les bacs d'alimentation
papier installés sur cet appareil.
Bouton Fonction
Papier Imprimante
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-5
Onglet Configuration
Sous-menu Fonction
Copies Spécifie le nombre de copies à imprimer.
Orientation Spécifie l'orientation de l'image imprimée sur le papier.
Format original Spécifie le format du document original.
Format de sortie Spécifie le format de papier de sortie. Agrandit ou réduit automatiquement
quand le paramètre Format original est modifié.
Source papier Sélectionne la source papier pour impression.
Configuration du type
de papier
Sélectionne le type de papier pour impression.
Position de reliure Spécifie la position de reliure.
Type d'impression Définir s'il faut imprimer uniquement sur une face (recto) du papier ou
recto et verso.
Agrafer Spécifie l'agrafage.
Perforer Spécifie la perforation.
Normal
Disposition Spécifie le nombre de pages à imprimer sur une page.
Livret L'impression est effectuée de manière à former un livret en pliant les
documents en deux.
Ajuster Une sélection est effectuée quand le Format original diffère du Format
de sortie avec l'échelle affichée.
Échelle Spécifie le taux d'agrandissement et de réduction.
Affiche L'impression est réalisée sur deux feuilles ou plus avec extension des
images.
Log/Phys L'impression est réalisée sans agrandissement ni réduction même si
le Format original diffère du Format de sortie.
Type de sortie Spécifie les méthodes de sortie, comme "Impression sécurisée" et
"Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur".
Bac de sortie Sélectionne le magasin de sortie des pages imprimées.
Ordre de sortie Définissez s'il faut orienter le papier à imprimer vers le haut ou vers le
bas.
Tri Spécifie s'il faut imprimer les copies multiples par jeux.
Décalé Lors de l'impression de plusieurs copies, décale la position de sortie
de chaque jeu.
Authentification/Suivi
de Volume (E.K.C.)
Spécifie l'ID utilisateur et le mot de passe pour "Authentification utilisateur"
et le mot de passe et le nom de boîte pour "Impression sécurisée"
et "Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur".
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Paramétrage par page
Onglet Fonctions spéciales
Sous-menu Fonction
Couverture Ajoute une page de couverture.
Dos Ajoute une page de dos.
Couverture avec
bac d'insertion
Une page de couverture est jointe aux documents imprimés.
Chapitre En mode d'impression Recto-verso/Livret, l'impression est réalisée
de manière à ce qu'une page précise soit assurée de sortir orientée
vers le haut, sans erreur.
Paramétrage par page Vous pouvez spécifier la page pour modifier le type d'impression et
la source du papier.
Sous-menu Fonction
Estampage numéro de
distribution
L'impression est réalisée avec un numéro de copie joint au document
imprimé.
Combinaison Vous pouvez imprimer plusieurs pages de document sur une seule
page. Vous pouvez spécifier les détails dans Détails de combinaison.
Pliage Plie les copies. (Pliage en Z, Pliage en 2, Pliage en 3 et Agrafage
central et pliage)
Décalage d'image Régler en cas de déplacement de l'image à imprimer.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-7
Onglet PostScript
Onglet Superposition
Sous-menu Fonction
Sortie Vous pouvez décider si l'impression est réalisée en tant que fichier
d'imprimante ou EPS.
Options filigrane En cas d'activation, un filigrane est imprimé sur l'original.
Compression des travaux En tant que méthode de compression du travail d'impression, vous
avez le choix entre "LZW" et "Flate".
Compression des bitmaps
En tant que méthode de compression de bitmap, vous avez le choix
entre "RLE", "JPEG" et "LZW".
PS marqué En cas d'activation, PS Marqué est activé.
Protocole de sortie Spécifie le protocole d'envoi à l'imprimante.
Niveau Gamma Réglage destiné à corriger la valeur gamma de l'imprimante.
Imprimer les informations
d'erreurs PostScript
En cas d'erreur d'impression des informations sur l'erreur sont imprimées.
Utiliser PostScript
Pass-through
Permet aux applications d'imprimer directement sans recourir à un
pilote d'imprimante.
Effacer mémoire par page Réglage destiné à effacer la mémoire de l'imprimante pour chaque
page.
Compatibilité Sélectionnez le type de sortie PostScript.
Activer Lissage bitmap Lisse les points du bitmap.
Sous-menu Fonction
Superposition Créer une superposition.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Qualité
Onglet Filigrane
Onglet Option
2
Remarque
Pour afficher l'onglet Option, sélectionnez "Démarrer" – "Imprimantes et
télécopieurs" (ou "Démarrer" – "Paramètres" – "Imprimantes"), faites un
clic droit sur l'icône de l'imprimante installée et cliquez ensuite sur
"Propriétés".
Sous-menu Fonction
Rotation de l'image Définit les données d'impression par unités de 90 degrés dans le
sens contraire des aiguilles d'une montre.
Effets En cas d'activation, les données d'impression sont imprimées sous
forme d'image miroir ou d'image en négatif.
Image Règle la luminosité et le contraste de l'image.
Lissage Impression lisse des parties curvilignes des caractères et des images.
Conversion monochromatique
La conversion monochrome d'une image, spécifiez la méthode de
conversion en cas de conversion par l'intermédiaire du pilote d'imprimante
ou par le copieur.
Economie Toner Réduisez la consommation de toner tout en maintenant la densité
d'impression basse.
Brouillon Une impression grossière est effectuée pour tous les éléments autre
que les caractères.
Sous-menu Fonction
Filigrane Imprime un filigrane (tampon de texte) sur la page imprimée.
Sous-menu Fonction
Option Spécifie les options installées sur cet appareil.
Informations
optionnelles
Entrez le nom de l'imprimante ou son adresse IP pour obtenir des
informations supplémentaires.
Mise à l'échelle pour les
applications
Le taux d'agrandissement/réduction défini au sein de l'application
est verrouillé de la même manière que pour le pilote d'imprimante.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-9
7.2 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Configuration
Adapter l'impression au format papier
Vous pouvez agrandir ou réduire des documents créés lors de l'impression
pour les faire correspondre au format de sortie papier.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 A partir des zones de liste déroulante "Format original" et "Format de
sortie", sélectionnez les paramètres voulus.
2
Remarque
Si "Format original" et "Format de sortie" diffèrent, la "Mise en page" est
automatiquement réglée sur "Ajuster" et Mise à l'échelle est affiché.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Sélectionner une source papier
Vous pouvez modifier la source du papier ou définir le type de papier comme
suit.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Sélectionnez une source de papier à utiliser avec "Source papier".
– Pour définir le type de papier pour la Source papier, procédez à
l'étape suivante.
3 Cliquez sur [Configuration du type de papier].
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-11
4 Sélectionnez une source de papier à modifier et cliquez sur [Modifier]
et définissez le type de papier.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Utiliser les transparents
Si vous imprimez sur du papier transparent, vous pouvez choisir d'insérer du
papier vierge pour l'impression.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Réglez la "Source papier" sur "Passe-copie".
– "Intercalaire sur transparent" ne peut pas être défini si "Source
papier" est réglé sur "Auto". Assurez-vous de bien régler sur
"Passe-copie".
3 Cliquez sur [Configuration du type de papier] et sélectionnez
"Passe-copie".
4 Cliquez sur [Modifier].
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-13
5 Sélectionnez "Transparent".
6 Cliquez sur [OK] pour réafficher "Configuration du type de papier".
Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Intercalaire sur transparent" et cliquez
sur [Paramètres].
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-14 IC-202 (Phase 2)
7 Sélectionnez un magasin contenant le papier à insérer.
8 Cliquez sur [OK] et fermez la boîte de dialogue "Configuration du type
de papier".
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-15
Paramètres format personnalisé
Vous pouvez spécifier et enregistrer à l'avance un format personnalisé
suivant la procédure ci-après.
1 Cliquez sur [Formats perso.].
La boîte de dialogue Paramètres de format personnalisé apparaît.
2 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Nom : Tapez le nom à enregistrer et cliquez ensuite sur [Enregistrer]
pour enregistrer le format irrégulier défini.
– Format : Spécifiez la largeur et la longueur du format personnalisé
en fonction des unités de mesure sélectionnées.
3 Cliquez sur [OK].
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-16 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Impression Recto-verso/Livret
Vous pouvez imprimer un document en mode Recto-verso ou Livret. Cette
fonction est pratique pour relier un document de plusieurs pages.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Sélectionnez "Recto/verso" ou "Livret" dans "Type d'impression".
2
Remarque
Vous pouvez sélectionner "Reliure à gauche", "Reliure en haut
(recto/verso uniquement)" ou "Reliure à droite" dans "Position de reliure".
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-17
Agrafage
Des documents de plusieurs pages sont agrafés.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Agrafer".
2
Remarque
Vous pouvez sélectionner "Reliure à gauche", "Reliure en haut
(recto/verso uniquement)" ou "Reliure à droite" dans "Position de reliure".
L'option "Agrafer" n'est disponible que si le module de finition
(excepté SF-601) est installé.
Vous pouvez agrafer jusqu'à 100 feuilles de papier ordinaire au format A4
ou inférieur avec le module FS-505 et 50 feuilles avec le module FS-504
ou 602.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-18 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Perforation
Perfore des trous sur le document imprimé.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Perforer".
2
Remarque
Vous pouvez sélectionner "Reliure à gauche", "Reliure en haut" ou
"Reliure à droite" dans "Position de reliure".
Pour utiliser la fonction "Perforer", le module de finition (à l'exception du
SF-601) et le kit de perforation ou de pliage en Z doivent être installés.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-19
Impression en mode Disposition
Un document de plusieurs pages peut être imprimé sur une feuille de papier.
Cette fonction est pratique pour économiser le nombre de feuilles à
imprimer.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cliquez sur [Disposition] dans "Mise en page".
3 Sélectionnez le nombre de pages à imprimer sur une feuille dans la liste
déroulante "Combinaison".
– Pour modifier ou ajouter la "Position" ou la "Bordure", sélectionnez
le paramètre voulu dans chacune des zones de liste déroulante.
4 Cliquez sur [Avancées] pour afficher la boîte de dialogue "Fonctions
avancées" et régler les différents points suivants de la boîte.
– Type de disposition
Spécifiez la disposition de la page.
– Echelle bordures (case à cocher)
Cochez cette case pour réduire aussi la ligne de bordure.
– Format/Orientation différent
Spécifie la méthode de sortie en cas de différences de format et
d'orientation du papier.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-20 IC-202 (Phase 2)
5 Une fois les réglages terminés, cliquez sur [OK].
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-21
Impression de livret
L'impression d'un livret est réalisée en pliant les pages imprimées en deux.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cliquez sur [Livret] dans "Mise en page".
– "Gouttière" vous permet de laisser une zone blanche uniforme dans
l'unité de points sur les 2 pages étalées après avoir été pliées. La
plage admissible va de 0 à 150.
– "Glissement" vous permet d'étaler ou de définir l'intervalle entre les
pages au centre du papier dans l'unité de points pour la feuille
intérieure quand elle est pliée. La plage de réglage oscille entre 0
et 20.
– "Grouper par" sert à sélectionner un nombre de pages d'une unité
formant un livret. Fonction pratique pour livrets comprenant un
grand nombre de feuilles.
3 Cliquez sur [Avancées] pour afficher la boîte de dialogue "Fonctions
avancées" et régler les points suivants dans la boîte.
– Remplir liasses
Si une autre valeur que "Standard" ou "4" est réglée pour "Grouper
par" et qu'il y a des pages partielles, de nombreuses pages vierges
peuvent être générées en fonction du nombre de pages sorties. En
gardant la case à cocher "Remplir liasses" sur Non, "Grouper par"
est réglée sur "4" uniquement pour les pages partielles de manière
à éviter les pages vierges inutiles.
– Format/Orientation différent
Spécifie la méthode de sortie en cas de différences de format et
d'orientation du papier.
4 Une fois le réglage terminé, cliquez sur [OK].
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-22 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Impression en mode Zoom
Vous pouvez imprimer avec des taux d'agrandissement variables sans
changer le format de sortie.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cliquez sur [%Échelle] dans "Mise en page".
3 Régler le "Taux" en chiffres dans "%". La plage admissible va de
25 à 400.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-23
Imprimer une affiche
L'image est agrandie et imprimée sur plusieurs feuilles.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cliquez sur [Affiche] dans "Mise en page".
3 Sélectionnez le "Style poster" voulu dans la zone de liste déroulante.
– Pour changer la "Position", choisissez une position dans la zone de
liste déroulante "Position".
4 Si vous sélectionnez "Personnalisé" dans "Style poster", réglez le
"taux" dans "Echelle (%)". La plage admissible va de 101 à 400.
5 Cliquez sur [Avancées] pour afficher la boîte de dialogue "Fonctions
avancées" et réglez les points suivants.
– Superposition
Réglez la quantité de recouvrement à la limite d'une page divisée.
La plage admissible va de 0 à 150.
6 Une fois les réglages terminés, cliquez sur [OK].
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-24 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Changer le papier
L'image est imprimée sans être agrandie ni réduite même si le format de
sortie est différent.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cliquez sur [Log/Phys] dans "Mise en page".
3 Sélectionnez un format de sortie dans "Format de sortie".
– Pour modifier ou ajouter une "Bordure" ou une "Position",
choisissez dans chaque zone de liste déroulante correspondante.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-25
Sélectionner le type de sortie
Non seulement, vous pouvez imprimer directement, mais vous pouvez aussi
sélectionner "Impression sécurisée", qui nécessite un mot de passe pour
imprimer ou "Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur", qui enregistre les documents
dans le dossier des documents.
0 "Impression sécurisée" et "Enr. dns boîte utilis. (et imprim.)" doivent être
réglés au préalable sur "Disque dur imprimante" avec l'onglet Option.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Type de sortie", sélectionnez la
méthode de sortie.
– Impression : Imprime immédiatement.
– Impression sécurisée : Enregistre le document à imprimer dans la
boîte des documents classés de cet appareil. Pour imprimer, il vous
est demandé de saisir l'ID utilisateur et le mot de passe sur le
panneau de contrôle de cet appareil. Sélectionnez quand vous
imprimez des documents très confidentiels. (jusqu'à
100 documents)
– Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur : Enregistre le document à imprimer
dans une boîte de cette machine.
– Enr. dns boîte utilis. imprim. : Enregistre simultanément le
document dans une boîte.
– Attente avec épreuve : après impression d'un exemplaire du
document, la machine s'arrête provisoirement d'imprimer.
Sélectionnez pour éviter de mal imprimer les travaux d'impression
volumineux.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-26 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Impression sécurisée
% Si "Impression sécurisée" était sélectionné, saisissez l'ID et le mot de
passe d'impression sécurisée dans la boîte de dialogue qui apparaît.
Pour imprimer le document, appuyez sur [Boîte ut. système] puis sur
[Boîte RX sécurisé] en mode Boîte de cette machine. Après avoir saisi
l'ID et le mot de passe utilisateur, le document est accessible et peut
être imprimé.
2
Remarque
Pour de plus amples détails sur les fonctions de boîte de cet appareil,
consultez le manuel utilisateur 750/600 [Opérations de boîte].
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-27
Enregistrer dans boîte utilisateur
% Quand "Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur" ou "Enr. dns boîte utilis, imprim."
est sélectionné, spécifiez le nom de fichier et le numéro de boîte dans
la boîte de dialogue qui apparaît pour saisir le nom de fichier et le
numéro de la boîte utilisateur.
2
Remarque
Pour de plus amples détails sur les fonctions de boîte de cet appareil,
consultez le manuel utilisateur 750/600 [Opérations de boîte].
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-28 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Attente avec épreuve
% Lors de l'envoi d'une tâche d'impression, cet appareil s'arrête
provisoirement d'imprimer après avoir imprimé un exemplaire du
document. Le reste de la tâche d'impression est stocké dans l'appareil
en tant que tâche d'impression. Lors de l'impression de plusieurs
copies, vous pouvez imprimer la partie restante de la tâche
d'impression après avoir vérifié les résultats d 'impression.
Pour imprimer, affichez la liste des Tâches en attente de l'écran Liste
Tâches sur le panneau de contrôle de cet appareil et appuyez sur
[Libérer Tâch Att.].
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-29
Spécifier les paramètres d'authentification
Si des paramètres d'authentification ont été spécifiés sur cet appareil, il faut
saisir un nom d'utilisateur.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cliquez sur [Authentification/Suivi de Volume E.K.C.].
3 Sélectionnez "Authentification" et sélectionnez ensuite "Utilisateur
destinataire".
4 Tapez le nom d'utilisateur et le mot de passe.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-30 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2
Remarque
Si cet appareil a été réglé pour autoriser les utilisateurs publics, l'appareil
peut être utilisé sans nom d'utilisateur ni mot de passe.
Pour les paramètres d'authentification, consultez l'administrateur de cet
appareil.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-31
Spécifier les paramètres de Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.)
Si des paramètres de suivi de volume ont été spécifiés sur cet appareil, vous
devez saisir un mot de passe de service pour imprimer une travail.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cliquez sur [Authentification/Suivi de Volume E.K.C.].
3 Sélectionnez "Suivi de Volume (E.K.C)" et tapez le nom et le mot de
passe du service.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-32 IC-202 (Phase 2)
7.3 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Paramétrage par
page
Imprimer des documents avec page de couverture et de dos
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Cochez les cases "Couverture" et "Dos".
Pour imprimer sur la page de couverture et de dos, sélectionnez
"Imprimé". Pour n'ajouter qu'une page vierge, sélectionnez "Vierge".
3 Sélectionnez une source de papier dont le papier est défini pour être
utilisé comme "Couverture" ou "Dos".
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-33
Impression d'une couverture avec bac d'insertion
Une page de couverture peut être jointe au document imprimé. Définissez le
papier épais ou tout autre type de papier pour le bac d'insertion. Le papier
chargé dans l'introducteur de papes de couverture est joint au document
imprimé comme page de couverture.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Cochez les cases à cocher "Couv. avc bac ins." et "Dos avc bac ins."
dans "Couvertures avec bac d'insertion". Sélectionnez une source de
papier correspondant au papier utilisé comme page de couverture ou
page de dos.
2
Remarque
Une couverture avec bac d'insertion ne peut être jointe que si le bac
d'insertion (PI-501) est installé en option.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-34 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Impression de chapitres
En mode d'impression Recto-verso/Livret, certaines pages peuvent toujours
sortir face imprimée vers le haut. Si une page spécifique devient le côté verso
en mode d'impression Recto-verso, cette page est décalée vers le recto de
la feuille suivante et imprimée.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Cochez la case "Chapitre".
3 Indiquez les pages à sortir face imprimée vers le haut dans la zone de
texte "Numéro de page".
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-35
Imprimer plusieurs pages
La fonction "Paramétrage par page" s'avère bien pratique si vous voulez
changer de magasin papier pendant une tâche d'impression quand vous
imprimer plusieurs pages.
Paramétrage par page
Vous pouvez spécifier le type d'impression et le magasin papier pour chaque
page.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Paramétrage par page".
3 Cliquez sur [Ajouter] et spécifiez le numéro de page, le type
d'impression et la source papier dans la boîte de dialogue qui apparaît.
4 Cochez la case à cocher "Utilisation de papier à onglet" comme
demandé et choisissez d'utiliser le papier à onglet pour le papier
inséré.
2
Remarque
Voir "Utilisation de papier à onglet" à la page 7-38 pour de plus amples
informations sur la configuration de l'Utilisation de papier à onglet.
Pour une liste existante, cliquez sur [Modifier] pour modifier les
paramètres de page sélectionnés ou cliquez sur [Effacer] pour les
supprimer.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-36 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Enregistrer/Charger la configuration
Vous pouvez enregistrer la configuration comme fichier de définition (xml) et
charger le fichier de définition.
Enregistrer la configuration
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Paramétrage par page".
3 Suivez la procédure de Paramétrage par page.
4 Cliquez sur [Enregistrer sous].
5 Tapez le nom du fichier et enregistrez le fichier.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-37
Charger la configuration
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Paramétrage par page".
3 Cliquez sur [Charger].
4 Le fichier de définition est chargé.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-38 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Utilisation de papier à onglet
Le papier à onglet disponible dans le commerce peut être utilisé par la
fonction Paramétrage par page.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Paramétrage par page.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Paramétrage par page".
3 Définissez le paramétrage par page ou chargez le fichier de définition.
– Voir "Charger la configuration" à la page 7-37 pour plus
d'informations sur le chargement du fichier de définition.
4 Cliquez sur [Config. papier à onglet].
La boîte de dialogue de configuration du papier à onglet apparaît.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-39
5 Cliquez sur [,] dans le champ "Format" de la boîte "Papier" et
sélectionnez un format à utiliser dans la liste affichée.
– La valeur par défaut est A4 à onglet.
6 Cliquez sur [,] dans le champ "Nombre d'onglets" de la boîte "Papier".
Une liste apparaît. Sélectionnez sur la liste un nombre d'onglets à
utiliser.
– Vous pouvez directement saisir le nombre dans la boîte "Nombre
d'onglets".
– La valeur par défaut est 5.
– Vous pouvez définir une valeur numérique comprise entre 2 et 15.
7 Définissez le "réglage position" nécessaire en spécifiant les champs
"Espace avant onglets", "Espace après onglet", "Espace entre
onglets" ou "Position du texte".
– La plage de valeur numériques définissables varie en fonction des
valeurs numériques dans "Nombre d'onglets".
8 Cliquez sur [OK] et fermez la boîte de dialogue Configuration du papier
à onglet.
Retournez à l'écran "Paramétrage par page".
9 Cliquez sur [Ajouter].
La boîte de dialogue Paramétrage par page apparaît.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-40 IC-202 (Phase 2)
10 Sélectionnez "Numéro de page", "Type d'impression" ou "Source
papier" selon nécessité.
11 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Utilisation du papier à onglet".
– Cette étape n'est pas nécessaire si le texte de l'onglet ne doit pas
être imprimé. Dans un cas pareil, passez à l'étape 17.
12 Entrez votre texte dans la boîte "Texte sur onglet".
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 64 caractères.
13 Cliquez sur [Détails].
– La touche "Détails" ne peut pas être utilisée si vous ne saisissez
rien dans la boîte "Texte sur onglet".
La boîte de dialogue Détails du texte sur onglet apparaît.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-41
14 Définissez les paramètres "texte sur onglet"-"Orientation", "Position"
et "Paramétrage police"-"Nom de police", "Style" ou "Format" selon
nécessité.
15 Cliquez sur [OK] et fermez la boîte de dialogue Détails du texte sur
onglet.
La boîte de dialogue Paramétrage par page réapparaît.
16 Pour spécifier l'onglet pour lequel saisir le "Texte sur onglet", cliquez
sur [,] du champ "Position" et sélectionnez un onglet à spécifier.
– La valeur par défaut est Continuer page précédente.
17 Cliquez sur [OK] et fermez la boîte de dialogue Paramétrage par page.
L'onglet "Paramétrage par page" de la fenêtre "Propriétés" réapparaît.
Le paramètre figure dans la zone de liste.
18 Pour utiliser un autre papier à onglet, exécuter les étapes 9 à 16.
– Si vous utilisez du papier autre que le papier à onglet, voir
Paramétrage par page.
19 Confirmez le contenu de la liste.
20 Cliquez sur [OK] et fermez la fenêtre "Propriété".
– Vous pouvez ajouter jusqu'à 30 paramètres à chaque liste.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-42 IC-202 (Phase 2)
7.4 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Fonctions
spéciales
Imprimer le numéro du document
Chaque document est numéroté lors de l'impression.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Fonctions spéciales.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Estampage numéro de distribution".
3 Réglez chaque point comme suit.
– Pages à imprimer
Sélectionnez soit "Toutes les pages" ou "1re page uniquement"
comme page à imprimer avec un numéro.
– Numéro de départ
Définissez le chiffre du numéro de départ.
2
Remarque
"Estampage numéro de distribution" ne peut s'utiliser que si "Tri" a été
réglé sur l'onglet "Configuration".
Le disque dur imprimante doit être installé au préalable avec l'onglet
Option pour l'"Estampage numéro de distribution".
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-43
Imprimer 2 pages sur du papier deux fois plus grand
Un document de 2 pages peut être imprimé sur une feuille de papier. Dans
ce cas, le format du papier de sortie est deux fois plus grand que le format
original. Par exemple, quand le "Papier de sortie" a été réglé sur A4, le format
du papier de sortie est A3.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Fonctions spéciales.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Combinaison (pas de réduction)".
3 Sélectionnez les points suivants.
– 2 en 1
2 pages sont imprimées sur une seule feuille de papier.
– Répétition 2 en 1
Une page et sa copie sont imprimées sur une feuille de papier.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-44 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Définir le pliage
Le papier est plié est sorti dans cet état.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Fonctions spéciales.
2 Cochez la case à cocher "Pliage".
3 Sélectionnez les points voulus.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-45
Réglage de la position d'impression (Décalage d'image)
La position d'impression sur le papier de sortie peut être réglée comme suit.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Fonctions spéciales.
2 Sélectionnez la case "Décalage d'image".
3 Cliquez sur [Paramètres].
4 Réglez le décalage vers le haut, vers le bas, vers la droite et vers la
gauche côtés recto et verso et réglez le décalage de gouttière par
unités de "0,1mmm".
2
Remarque
La fonction "Paramètres à utiliser" ne fonctionne pas. Seul un réglage
côté pilote d'imprimante est possible.
Sélectionnez la case "Réglage auto verso". Le verso peut être réglé de la
même manière que le côté recto de la feuille.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-46 IC-202 (Phase 2)
7.5 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet PostScript
Impression d'un travail
Définir s'il faut sortir ce travail vers l'imprimante ou sous forme de fichier
PostScript Encapsulé.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet PostScript.
2 Sélectionnez "Vers l'imprimante" ou "PostScript encapsul." dans
Sortie.
2
Remarque
Si vous sélectionnez "PostScript encapsul.", vous devez définir le nom
de fichier. Cliquez sur et définissez un nom de fichier. Si vous ne
définissez pas le nom de fichier ici, il vous sera demandé de saisir un nom
de fichier à chaque fois que vous imprimerez un document.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-47
Compression d'un travail
Définir s'il faut comprimer ou non le travail comme suit. Les données
d'impression sont comprimées afin d'améliorer la vitesse d'impression.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet PostScript.
2 Sélectionnez "LZW" ou "Flate" dans la zone de liste déroulante
"Compression des travaux" sous Paramètres.
– Si vous sélectionnez "Flate", vous pourrez sélectionner le type de
compression Flate dans la zone de liste déroulante "Compression
Flate".
Compression des bitmaps
Définir s'il faut ou non utiliser la compression des bitmaps. L'utilisation de
cette fonction pour l'impression de données d'image améliore la vitesse
d'impression.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet PostScript.
2 Sélectionnez "RLE", "LZW" ou "JPEG" dans la zone de liste déroulante
"Compression des bitmaps" sous Paramètres.
– Si vous sélectionnez "JPEG", vous pourrez sélectionner le type de
compression JPEG dans la zone de liste déroulante "JPEG".
Utiliser le mode PS marqué
Définir s'il faut utiliser ou non le mode PS marqué.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet PostScript.
2 Si vous utilisez le mode PS marqué, cochez la case "PS marqué" sous
Paramètres.
Définir le protocole de sortie
Définir le protocole de sortie comme suit.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet PostScript.
2 Sélectionnez "Binaire pur" ou "ASCII" dans la zone de liste déroulante
"Protocole de sortie" sous Paramètres.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-48 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Régler la valeur gamma
Définir la valeur de correction gamma comme suit.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet PostScript.
2 Définir la valeur de correction gamma à partir de la zone de liste
déroulante "Niveau Gamma" sous Paramètres.
– La plage admissible va de 0,000 à 2,000.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-49
Configurer les options
Définir les détails de PostScript comme suit.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet PostScript.
2 Cliquez sur [Options PostScript].
3 Définir chaque point comme souhaité.
– Imprimer les informations d'erreurs PostScript.
En cochant cette case, les informations d'erreur sont imprimées
dès qu'une erreur d'imprimante survient.
– Utiliser PostScript Pass-through
Lorsque cette case est cochée, une application gérant le PostScript
(applications Adobe, Quark Xpress, etc.) prépare les données
graphiques de façon à conserver la qualité des dessins d'origine.
Toutefois, il est impossible d'utiliser la fonction pour le traitement
d'images (Disposition, Livret, etc.).
Lorsque la case est décochée, les données graphiques sont
préparées côté pilote d'imprimante. Toutefois, si les données sont
imprimées avec une application gérant le PostScript, la qualité des
dessins risque d'en être altérée.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-50 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2
Remarque
Voir les pages suivantes pour de plus amples informations sur les
paramètres Superposition et Filigrane.
Effacer mémoire par page
Si vous cochez cette case, la mémoire d'imprimante de chaque page sera
effacée.
Compatibilité
Sélectionnez "Optimisation pour vitesse" et d'autres types de sortie
PostScript dans la zone de liste déroulante.
Lissage bitmap
Cochez cette case pour les lisser les points des bitmaps.
Sous-menu Description
Superposition "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Superposition" à la
page 7-51
Filigranes "Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Filigrane" à la
page 7-61
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-51
7.6 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Superposition
Créer Superposition
Pour utiliser Superposition, les données destinées à la superposition doivent
être enregistrées au préalable. Pour enregistrer la Superposition, préparez la
Superposition pour le document à enregistrer dans "Créer superposition".
1 Préparez les données de superposition avec le logiciel d'application
requis.
2 Sélectionnez "Imprimer" dans le menu "Fichier".
3 Sélectionnez "GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 PS(V)" dans "Sélectionner
imprimante" et cliquez sur [Préférences].
4 Cliquez sur l'onglet Superposition.
5 Cliquez sur [Créer superposition].
La boîte de dialogue "Créer superposition" apparaît.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-52 IC-202 (Phase 2)
6 Tapez le "Nom du fichier".
7 Cliquez sur [Enregistrer].
– Après avoir cliqué sur [Enregistrer], vous devez attendre que la
création de la superposition soit terminée. La touche
"Créer superposition" se transforme en "Annuler création de
superposition". Pour annuler la création de superposition, cliquez
sur [Annuler création de superposition].
8 Confirmez le nom du fichier et cliquez sur [OK].
La boîte de dialogue "Imprimer" réapparaît.
9 Cliquez sur [OK].
L'impression n'a pas lieu et la superposition est enregistrée.
L'extension devient "EPS".
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-53
Ajouter Superposition
Vous pouvez ajouter des fichiers de superposition à la liste selon la
procédure suivante :
1 Préparez les données de superposition avec le logiciel d'application
voulu.
2 Sélectionnez "Imprimer" dans le menu "Fichier".
3 Sélectionnez "GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 PS(V)" dans "Sélectionner
imprimante" et cliquez sur [Préférences].
4 Cliquez sur l'onglet Superposition.
5 Cliquez sur [Ajouter superposition].
La boîte de dialogue "Charger fichier pour superposition" apparaît.
6 Sélectionnez un fichier approprié et cliquez sur [Ouvrir].
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-54 IC-202 (Phase 2)
– Le nom de fichier sélectionné apparaît sur la liste dans
Superposition.
Effacer Superposition
Supprimez un fichier de la liste Superposition comme suit.
0 Si vous supprimez un fichier, il n'est pas seulement supprimé de la liste
mais le fichier lui-même sera supprimé.
1 Préparez les données pour la superposition avec le logiciel
d'application voulu.
2 Sélectionnez "Imprimer" dans le menu "Fichier".
3 Sélectionnez "GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 PS(V)" comme "Imprimante
sélectionné" et cliquez sur [Préférences].
4 Cliquez sur l'onglet Superposition.
5 Sélectionnez un nom de fichier à supprimer et cliquez sur [Supprimer
superposition].
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-55
7.7 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Qualité
Rotation de l'image
Faites pivoter l'image. Vous pouvez sélectionner 0°, 90°, 180° ou 270° (dans
le sens contraire des aiguilles d'une montre).
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Qualité.
2 Sélectionnez un angle en cochant un bouton radio dans "Rotation de
l'image".
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-56 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Imprimer les données en image miroir ou en image négative
Vous pouvez imprimer les données telles que les regardez dans un miroir ou
le noir et le blanc des données peuvent être inversés selon la procédure cidessous.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Qualité.
2 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Image miroir" ou "Image négative" dans
"Effets".
– Image miroir
L'image est imprimée comme une image réfléchie.
– Image négative
Le noir et le blanc de l'image sont inversés lors des impressions.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-57
Ajuster la luminosité et le contraste des graphiques
Vous pouvez ajuster la luminosité et le contraste des graphiques comme
suit.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Qualité.
2 Le curseur supérieur dans "Image" indique la luminosité et le curseur
inférieur le contraste.
– Luminosité
La luminosité augmente au fur et à mesure que le curseur approche
des 100% et diminue plus il s'approche de 0%.
– Contraste
Le contraste augmente au fur et à mesure que le curseur approche
des 100% et diminue plus il s'approche de 0%.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-58 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Lissage
Les sections curvilignes des caractères et des graphiques peuvent être
imprimées de manière lissée.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Qualité.
2 Sélectionnez un type dans la zone de liste déroulante à côté de "Type".
– Type 1
Convient à l'impression des lignes obliques des caractères et des
graphiques standard.
– Type 2
Convient à l'impression des sections curvilignes des caractères
standard.
– Type 3
Convient à l'impression des sections curvilignes des caractères
ornementaux et des lignes fines.
– Non
Aucune opération de lissage n'est effectuée.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-59
Conversion monochromatique
Définir s'il faut convertir l'image couleur en image monochrome sur le pilote
ou sur l'imprimante.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Qualité.
2 Sélectionnez soit "Par le pilote" ou "Par l'imprimante" sous
"Conversion monochromatique".
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-60 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Economie Toner, Brouillon
Réglez cette fonction pour économiser du toner ou imprimer plus clair.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Qualité.
2 Réglez en fonction de l'objet.
– Pour réduire la consommation de toner
Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Economie Toner".
– Pour imprimer plus clair
Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Brouillon".
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-61
7.8 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Filigrane
Imprimer un filigrane
Vous pouvez imprimer un texte donné en arrière-plan en tant que filigrane.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Filigrane.
2 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante, sélectionnez le filigrane que vous
voulez imprimer.
– Vous pouvez enregistrer des filigranes. Voir "Modifier un filigrane"
à la page 7-62 pour de plus amples informations.
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– 1re page uniquement :
cochez cette case pour n'imprimer que la première page.
– Texte transparent :
cochez cette case pour imprimer des filigranes transparents sur le
document.
– Texte contour:
cochez cette case pour n'imprimer que les contours des
caractères.
2
Remarque
Si "Livret" était sélectionné sur l'onglet "Configuration", le filigrane n'est
pas imprimé.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-62 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Modifier un filigrane
Vous pouvez modifier les polices et la position du filigrane et vous pouvez en
enregistrer un nouveau.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Filigrane.
2 Pour créer un filigrane, cliquez sur [Ajouter].
– En cas de nouvelle création
Réglez la zone de liste déroulante dans "Filigrane" sur "Aucun" et
tapez les caractères à imprimer dans le champ de "Texte de
filigrane" dans "Filigrane".
– En cas de modification
Sélectionnez les caractères à modifier dans la zone de liste
déroulante dans "Filigrane".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Texte:
affiche les caractères du filigrane
– Échelle de gris :
permet de régler les niveaux de gris des caractères à l'aide du
curseur.
– Taille:
permet de régler la taille à l'aide du curseur.
– Angle:
permet de régler l'angle de rotation des caractères à l'aide du
curseur.
– Polices :
Cliquez sur [Fonts] et réglez la police, le style de police et d'autres
éléments
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-63
– Position:
faites glisser la position d'impression des caractères directement
depuis l'écran d'aperçu ou définissez la position à l'aide des
curseurs.
– Centrer filigrane :
placez les caractères au centre de la feuille.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-64 IC-202 (Phase 2)
7.9 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Police
Spécifier les paramètres
Vous pouvez remplacer les polices TrueType utilisées dans Windows par les
polices d'imprimante de cet appareil.
0 L'utilisation des polices d'imprimante va réduire le temps d'impression,
mais il risque d'y avoir une différence entre l'affichage à l'écran et les
résultats d 'impression.
1 Sous Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, cliquez sur
[Démarrer], puis sur "Imprimantes et télécopieurs".
– Sous Windows NT 4.0/2000, cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez sur
"Paramètres" et cliquez ensuite sur "Imprimantes".
2 Effectuez un clic droit sur l'icône "GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 PS" et cliquez
ensuite sur "Propriétés".
3 Cliquez sur l'onglet Police.
4 Sélectionne TrueType(Type 42), Bitmap(Type 3) ou Adobe(Type 1)
comme méthode d'envoi des polices TrueType à l'imprimante dans
"Envoyer à l'imprimante en tant que".
5 Sélectionne des points, 1/100 de pouce ou des pixels dans "Unités de
seuil".
6 Réglez le "Seuil".
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-65
7 Sélectionnez la police TrueType que vous voulez remplacer.
8 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Police imprimante à utiliser",
sélectionnez la police d'imprimante pour remplacer la police TrueType.
– Quand "Utiliser l'imprimante pour toutes les polices True Type" est
coché, la police TrueType est automatiquement remplacée par le
police optimale de l'imprimante et le temps nécessaire à
l'impression est réduit. Mais dans ce cas, il peut y avoir une
différence entre l'affichage à l'écran et le résultat d'impression.
– Activez la case à cocher "Utiliser la table de substitution" pour
utiliser la table de remplacement des polices. Pour rétablir l'état
d'origine, cliquez sur [Substitution par défaut].
9 Cliquez sur [OK].
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-66 IC-202 (Phase 2)
7.10 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Option
Configurer les options installées
Configurez les modules en option installés sur la machine comme suit.
1 Sous Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, cliquez sur
[Démarrer], puis sur "Imprimantes et télécopieurs".
– Sous Windows NT 4.0/2000, cliquez sur [Démarrer], pointez sur
"Paramètres" et cliquez ensuite sur "Imprimantes".
2 Effectuez un clic droit sur l'icône "GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 PS" et cliquez
ensuite sur [Propriétés].
3 Cliquez sur l'onglet Option.
4 Sélectionnez l'option installée à partir de la zone de liste déroulante.
2
Remarque
Si vous cochez la case à cocher "Mise à l'échelle pour les applications",
les valeurs définies dans "Zoom" du menu d'impression et les valeurs
définies dans "Zoom" du menu d'impression sont liées.
Cliquez sur [A propos de] pour afficher la version du pilote d'imprimante.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-67
Collecte automatique des informations optionnelles
Si une option est utilisée dans le cadre de la connexion réseau à la machine,
les informations optionnelles sont automatiquement détectées.
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Option.
2 Entrez le nom de l'imprimante ou son adresse IP dans la zone de texte
"Nom d'imprimante ou adresse IP".
3 Cliquez sur [Collecter informations optionnelles] pour détecter
automatiquement les informations optionnelles.
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-68 IC-202 (Phase 2)
7.11 Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote
Vous pouvez enregistrer les valeurs de paramètres du pilote modifié et les
rappeler si nécessaire.
Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote
1 Changez les paramètres du pilote à partir de l'onglet Configuration.
2 Cliquez sur [Enregistrer].
3 Tapez le nom de fichier dans la case de texte "Nom".
4 Cliquez sur [OK].
Les paramètres sont enregistrés dans une bibliothèque.
Configuration du pilote PS (Windows) 7
IC-202 (Phase 2) 7-69
Rétablir les paramètres
% Cliquez sur [Enregistrer/Rétablir réglage] dans la fenêtre Options
d'impression et sélectionnez le nom d'un fichier de configuration
contenant le réglage enregistré.
Le réglage est rappelé et la boîte de dialogue Options d'impression
réapparaît.
Modifier les paramètres
1 Dans la boîte de dialogue Options d'impression, cliquez sur
[Enregistrer/Rétablir réglage].
2 Sur la liste, sélectionnez le fichier que vous voulez modifier et modifiez
le paramètre.
– Cliquez sur [Supprimer] si vous voulez supprimer le fichier.
La boîte de dialogue "Suppression d'une configuration" apparaît.
3 Cliquez sur [Enregistrer] et tapez dans la zone de texte Nom le même
nom que celui du paramètre que vous souhaitez modifier.
Le paramètre va être modifié.
4 Cliquez sur [OK].
7 Configuration du pilote PS (Windows)
7-70 IC-202 (Phase 2)
8 Configuration du pilote
PPD (Windows)
Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows) 8
IC-202 (Phase 2) 8-3
8 Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows)
8.1 Paramètres
Onglet Disposition
Papier/qualité
Sous-menu Fonction
Orientation Spécifie l'orientation.
Ordre des pages Réglez l'ordre dans lequel les feuilles de papier sont imprimées.
Pages par feuille Spécifie le nombre de pages à imprimer sur une page.
Sous-menu Fonction
Alimentation Permet de sélectionner le magasin papier.
Type de papier Sélectionne le type de papier pour impression.
8 Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows)
8-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Avancé
Sous-menu Fonction
Format papier Spécifie le format du papier.
Nombre de copies Spécifie le nombre de copies à imprimer.
Mise à l'échelle Spécifie le taux d'agrandissement et de réduction.
Police TrueType Remplace la police TrueType par la police de l'imprimante.
Fonctionnalités
d'impression avancées
Réglage destiné à décider si les fonctions d'impression détaillées
sont activées ou non.
Options PostScript Règle le type de sortie du fichier PostScript.
Option de téléchargement
de police TrueType
Lors de l'impression de la police TrueType font, sélectionnez le type
de police téléchargée sur l'imprimante.
Niveau de langage
PostScript
Règle le niveau de PostScript.
Envoyer une balise d'erreur
PostScript
Si une erreur PostScript survient, permet de décider si un rapport et
imprimé ou non.
Sortie en miroir L'impression est inversée (droite/gauche).
Sortie en négatif L'impression du noir et du blanc est inversée.
Décalé Spécifie le décalage.
Position d'impression Règle la position d'impression.
Bac de sortie Permet de sélectionner le bac de sortie.
Ordre de sortie Définissez s'il faut orienter le papier à imprimer vers le haut ou vers
le bas.
Position de reliure Permet de sélectionner la position de reliure.
Recto-verso Effectue l'impression recto-verso.
Combinaison Sélectionne l'impression Livret.
Agrafer Agrafe les copies.
Perforer Perfore les copies.
Pliage Plie les copies.
Couverture Ajoute une page de couverture.
Magasin papier (couverture)
Spécifie le magasin papier de la première page de couverture.
Dos Ajoute une page de dos.
Magasin papier (dos) Sélectionne le magasin papier pour la dernière page de couverture.
Couv. avc bac ins. Permet d'insérer une couverture à partir du bac d'insertion.
Dos avec bac ins. Permet d'insérer un dos à partir du bac d'insertion.
Intercalaire sur
transparent
Insère des intercalaires entre les transparents de rétroprojection.
Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows) 8
IC-202 (Phase 2) 8-5
Onglet Paramètres du périphérique
Magasin papier
(Intercalaire sur transparent)
Sélectionne le magasin papier pour les intercalaires entre transparents.
Mode attente Arrête provisoirement d'imprimer après qu'un exemplaire du document
a été imprimée afin de pouvoir vérifier l'épreuve.
Lissage Règle le processus de lissage.
Densité d'impression Activer en cas de réglage de la densité d'impression.
Sous-menu Fonction
Sous-menu Fonction
Affectation d'un modèle
à un bac
Règle le format de papier pour chaque magasin d'alimentation.
Table de substitution
des polices
Spécifie le remplacement des polices TrueType par les polices de
l'imprimante.
Mémoire PostScript disponible
Spécifie la taille de la mémoire PostScript utilisable.
Protocole de sortie Spécifie le protocole d'envoi à l'imprimante.
Envoyer CTRL-D avant
chaque tâche
Spécifie s'il faut initialiser l'imprimante avant d'imprimer.
Envoyer CTRL-D après
chaque tâche
Spécifie s'il faut initialiser l'imprimante après l'impression.
Convertir le texte gris en
PostScript gris
Spécifie s'il faut convertir le texte gris d'un document en gris
PostScript.
Convertir les graphiques
gris en PostScript gris
Spécifie s'il faut convertir les graphiques gris d'un document en gris
PostScript.
Ajouter le symbole monétaire
de l'Euro aux polices
PostScript
Spécifie s'il faut convertir le symbole de la monnaie Euro d'un document
en polices PostScript.
Délai d'attente de la tâche
L'imprimante s'arrête d'imprimer quand une tâche d'impression
n'est pas terminée dans le délai imparti.
Délai d'attente L'imprimante s'arrête d'imprimer quand l'imprimante ne reçoit pas
de données dans le délai imparti à partir du moment où la tâche avait
été envoyée. Taille minimale de la police téléchargée en vectoriel.
Taille minimale de police
à télécharger en tant que
police vectorielle
Spécifie le format minimum de police (pixels) lors du téléchargement
de polices TrueType en tant que polices vectorielles. Les polices
plus petites que le format minimum spécifié sont téléchargées comme
polices bitmap.
Taille maximale de police
à télécharger en tant que
bitmap
Spécifie le format maximum de police (pixels) lors du téléchargement
de polices TrueType en tant que polices bitmap. Les polices
plus grandes que le format minimum spécifié sont téléchargées
comme polices vectorielles.
Options d'installation Spécifie les options installées sur cet appareil.
8 Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows)
8-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
8.2 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Disposition
Vous pouvez régler l'orientation, la disposition et les autres réglages de mise
en page avec l'onglet Disposition.
Spécifier les paramètres
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Disposition.
2 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Orientation :
règle le sens du papier.
– Ordre des pages :
règle l'ordre d'impression des pages.
– Pages par feuille :
règle la disposition des feuilles (N en 1).
2
Remarque
Lors de l'affichage des éléments sur l'onglet "Disposition" dans
98SE/Me, affichez l'onglet Papier ou Images.
Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows) 8
IC-202 (Phase 2) 8-7
8.3 Spécifier les paramètres de l'onglet Papier/qualité
L'onglet Papier/qualité vous permet de configurer les types de papier ou le
magasin d'alimentation papier.
Spécifier les paramètres
1 Cliquez sur l'onglet Papier/qualité.
2 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Alimentation papier :
sélectionne une source papier.
– Média:
sélectionne un type de papier.
2
Remarque
Lors de l'affichage des éléments de l'onglet Papier/Qualité sous
Windows 98SE/Me, affichez l'onglet Papier.
8 Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows)
8-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
8.4 Avancé...
Vous pouvez régler les fonctions du module de finition, régler la densité
d'impression et d'autres fonctions avancées dans la fenêtre Options
avancées.
Spécifier les paramètres
0 Cette fonction ne peut être utilisée que si le module en option a été réglé
sur l'onglet Paramètres du périphérique ("Spécifier les périphériques" à
la page 8-10). N'oubliez pas de régler les options si elles sont installées.
0 Un point d'exclamation jaune ( ) apparaît à la sélection d'une fonction.
0 Les causes suivantes sont envisageables :
absence de définition d'une fonction en option nécessaire ou définition
d'une fonction incompatible avec les autres.
1 Cliquez sur [Avancé] sur l'onglet Disposition ou Papier/qualité.
2 Sélectionnez la fonction dans la zone de liste déroulante qui s'ouvre à
la droite de chaque élément.
Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows) 8
IC-202 (Phase 2) 8-9
2
Remarque
Voir "Paramètres" à la page 8-3 pour les éléments et fonctions
disponibles.
Pour afficher les éléments dans la fenêtre Options avancées sous
98SE/Me, affichez les onglets Papier, Options de périphérique,
PostScript, Images et Polices.
!
Détails
La fonction de pliage peut uniquement être utilisée si le module de finition
FS-602 (Pliage en trois, Pliage en deux) ou le module de perforation et de
pliage en Z (Pliage en Z) est installé en option.
La fonction d'agrafage peut uniquement être utilisée si le module de
finition en option est installé. Vous pouvez agrafer jusqu'à 100 feuilles
de papier ordinaire au format A4 ou inférieur avec le module FS-505 et
50 feuilles avec le module FS-504 ou 602.
La fonction de perforation peut uniquement être utilisée si le module de
finition en option est installé. En outre, le kit de perforation et le module
de perforation et de pliage en Z doivent être installé
Si le module SF-601 (magasin de décalage) est installé, les fonctions de
pliage, d'agrafage et de perforation ne sont pas disponibles.
8 Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows)
8-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
8.5 Spécifier les périphériques
L'option installée sur cette machine est configurée par le pilote d'imprimante
et devient utilisable
Spécifier les paramètres
1 En cas de Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64, cliquez
sur [Démarrer] et sur [Imprimantes et télécopieurs].
– Sous 98SE/Me/NT4.0/2000, cliquez sur [Démarrer] et ensuite sur
[Paramètres] – [Imprimantes].
2 Effectuez un clic droit sur l'icône de l'imprimante installée,
"GENERIC 75/60 BW-1 PS(P)" et cliquez ensuite sur [Propriétés].
3 Cliquez sur l'onglet paramètres de périphérique.
4 Sélectionnez une fonction dans la zone de liste déroulante qui s'ouvre
à la droite de chaque élément. Réglez les conditions d'installation du
périphérique optionnel dans "Options d'installation".
Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows) 8
IC-202 (Phase 2) 8-11
2
Remarque
Affichez l'onglet Options de périphérique, l'onglet PostScript, l'onglet
Graphiques et l'onglet Police pour afficher les éléments dans l'onglet
Paramètres de périphérique et ouvrez l'onglet options de périphérique
pour afficher les conditions d'installation du périphérique optionnel sous
Windows 98SE/Me.
8 Configuration du pilote PPD (Windows)
8-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
9 Configurer le pilote PPD
(Mac OS 9)
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9) 9
IC-202 (Phase 2) 9-3
9 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9)
9.1 Paramètres
Vous pouvez configurer les fonctions de cet appareil dans les boîtes de
dialogue Format d'impression et Imprimer affichées dans n'importe quelle
application.
Les paramètres ne peuvent s'appliquer que pendant l'utilisation de
l'application. Quand vous quittez l'application, les paramètres par défaut
sont réactivés.
Boîte de dialogue Format d'impression
9 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9)
9-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Eléments de Format d'impression
2
Remarque
Selon l'application, "Format d'impression" peut s'afficher sous forme de
"Réglage papier". De plus, vous devrez peut-être sélectionner "Réglage
papier" — "Options" à partir du menu "Fichier".
Les boîtes de dialogue varient en fonction de l'application.
Menu Sous-menu Fonction
Attributs de page Papier Spécifie le format du papier.
Orientation Spécifie l'orientation.
Échelle Spécifie le taux d'agrandissement et de réduction.
Options PostScript Retourner horizontalement
Imprime l'image tournée à l'horizontale.
Retourner verticalement
Imprime l'image tournée à la verticale.
Inverser l'image Imprime un négatif de l'image.
Substituer les
caractères
Remplace certaines polices par des polices d'imprimante.
Finition texte Lisse les données de texte.
Finition dessin Lisse les données graphiques.
Alignement précis
mode point
Corrige les images dentelées.
Polices téléchargeables
illimitées
Ne limite pas le téléchargement des polices
d'écran.
Formats de page
personnalisés
Unités Sélectionne l'unité spécifié.
Format papier Spécifie tous les formats papier.
Marges Spécifie les marges du papier.
Nom du format de
page
Entre le nom enregistré pour le format papier
spécifié et la marge après avoir cliqué sur [OK].
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9) 9
IC-202 (Phase 2) 9-5
Boîte de dialogue Imprimer
Elément d'impression
Menu Sous-menu Fonction
Généralités Copies Spécifie le nombre de copies à imprimer.
Triées Imprime les copies multiples par jeux.
Pages Spécifie les pages à imprimer.
Alimentation Permet de sélectionner le magasin papier.
Impression de fond Printing In Spécifie l'impression en arrière-plan.
Print Time Spécifie le niveau de priorité et l'heure d'impression.
Impression des couleurs
(Ce système d'impression
ne correspond
pas à cette
fonction.)
Print Color Spécifie la couleur pour l'impression.
Intent Sélectionne la méthode de correspondance.
Printer Profile Spécifie le profil de correction de couleur du périphérique
de sortie.
Page de garde Print Cover Page Joint une couverture.
Cover Page Paper
Source
Permet de sélectionner le magasin papier de la
couverture.
Réglages de police Font Documentation Ajoute des informations à la clé de police.
Font Downloading Spécifie les conditions de téléchargement de
polices.
Consignation des
tâches
If there is a
PostScriptTM error
Spécifie les conditions de rapport d'erreur
PostScript.
Job Documentation Spécifie les conditions du dossier d'opération à
enregistrer.
Job Documentation
Folder
Spécifie le dossier dans lequel le dossier d'opération
doit être enregistré.
9 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9)
9-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Disposition Pages par feuille Spécifie le nombre de pages à imprimer sur une
page.
Orientation Spécifie l'ordre des pages pour imprimer plusieurs
pages sur une seule page.
Bordure Spécifie les bordures autour des pages.
Enregistrement Format Spécifie le format de sortie du fichier PostScript.
PostScript Level Spécifie le niveau PostScript.
Data Format Spécifie le format pour enregistrer un document.
Font Inclusion Spécifie s'il faut inclure les données de police
dans un fichier.
Finishing Options 1 Décalage Spécifie le décalage.
Position d'impression Règle la position d'impression.
Bac de sortie Permet de sélectionner le bac de sortie.
Ordre de sortie Définissez s'il faut orienter le papier à imprimer
vers le haut ou vers le bas.
Position de reliure Permet de sélectionner la position de reliure.
Recto-verso Effectue l'impression recto-verso.
Combinaison Sélectionne l'impression Livret.
Finishing Options 2 Agrafer Agrafe les copies.
Perforer Perfore les copies.
Plier Plie les copies.
Couverture Ajoute une page de couverture.
Magasin papier
(couverture)
Spécifie le magasin papier de la première page
de couverture.
Dos Ajoute une page de dos.
Magasin papier (dos) Sélectionne le magasin papier pour la dernière
page de couverture.
Menu Sous-menu Fonction
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9) 9
IC-202 (Phase 2) 9-7
2
Remarque
Les boîtes de dialogue varient en fonction de l'application.
Finishing Options 3 Couv. avc bac ins. Permet d'insérer une couverture à partir du bac
d'insertion.
Dos avec bac ins. Permet d'insérer un dos à partir du bac d'insertion.
Intercalaire sur transparent
Insère des intercalaires entre les transparents de
rétroprojection.
Magasin papier
(intercalaire sur
transparent)
Sélectionne le magasin papier pour les intercalaires
entre transparents.
Mode attente Arrête provisoirement d'imprimer après qu'un
exemplaire du document a été imprimée afin de
pouvoir vérifier l'épreuve.
Résolution Spécifie la résolution d'impression.
Lissage Règle le processus de lissage.
Finishing Options 4 Densité d'impression Activer en cas de réglage de la densité d'impression.
Menu Sous-menu Fonction
9 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9)
9-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
9.2 Disposition
Attributs de page (Paramètres de base)
1 Sélectionnez "Réglage papier" ou "Format d'impression" dans le menu
"Fichier".
2 Sélectionnez "Attributs de page".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Papier:
spécifie le format du papier.
– Orientation :
spécifie l'orientation.
– Échelle:
spécifie le taux d'agrandissement et de réduction.
2
Remarque
La fonction de mise en page peut être sélectionnée à partir de l'écran qui
s'affiche quand "Mise en page" est coché dans la boîte de dialogue
Imprimer.
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9) 9
IC-202 (Phase 2) 9-9
Format papier personnalisés
1 Sélectionnez "Réglage papier" ou "Format d'impression" dans le menu
"Fichier".
2 Sélectionnez "Formats de page personnalisés".
3 Cliquez sur [Nouveau] ou [Modifier].
4 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Format de papier :
spécifie le format du papier.
– Marges:
spécifie les marges du papier.
– Nom du format de page :
Entrez le nom enregistré pour le format et la marge spécifiés et
cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
– Unités:
sélectionne l'unité spécifiée.
5 Cliquez sur [OK].
Enregistre les paramètres de format personnalisés et vous permet de
sélectionner le papier sur l'écran qui s'affiche quand "Attributs de
page" est sélectionné.
9 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9)
9-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Options PostScript
1 Sélectionnez "Réglage papier" ou "Format d'impression" dans le menu
"Fichier".
2 Sélectionnez "Options PostScript".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Effets visuels :
propose "Retourner horizontalement", "Retourner verticalement" et
"Inverser l'image" (image négative).
– Substituer les caractères :
remplace certaines polices par des polices de l'imprimante.
– Finition texte :
lisse les données de texte.
– Finition dessin :
lisse les données de dessin.
– Alignement précis mode point :
corrige les images dentelées.
– Polices téléchargeables illimitées :
ne limite pas le téléchargement des polices d'écran.
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9) 9
IC-202 (Phase 2) 9-11
9.3 Impression
Généralités (Paramètres de base)
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Généralités".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Copies:
spécifie le nombre de copies à imprimer.
– Triées:
imprime plusieurs copies par jeux.
– Pages:
spécifie le groupe de pages à imprimer.
– Alimentation :
sélectionne la magasin d'alimentation.
9 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9)
9-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Disposition (Imprimer plusieurs pages sur une seule page)
Vous pouvez spécifier l'impression de plusieurs pages sur une même page
ou l'impression recto-verso.
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Mise en page".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Pages par feuille :
spécifie le nombre de pages à imprimer sur une seule page.
– Orientation :
spécifie l'ordre des pages du document..
– Bordure:
spécifie les bordures autour des pages.
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9) 9
IC-202 (Phase 2) 9-13
Options de finition
Vous pouvez spécifier des options spécifiques à l'imprimante. Vous pouvez
spécifier cette option quand vous utilisez les fonctions Agrafer et Perforer de
cet appareil.
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Finishing Options 1 à 4".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Sous-menu Fonction
Décalé Spécifie le décalage.
Position d'impression Règle la position d'impression.
Bac de sortie Permet de sélectionner le bac de sortie.
Ordre de sortie Définissez s'il faut orienter le papier à imprimer vers
le haut ou vers le bas.
Position de reliure Permet de sélectionner la position de reliure.
Recto-verso Effectue l'impression recto-verso.
Combinaison Sélectionne l'impression Livret.
Agrafer Agrafe les copies.
Perforer Perfore les copies.
Pliage Plie les copies.
Couverture Ajoute une page de couverture.
Magasin papier (couverture) Spécifie le magasin papier de la première page de
couverture.
Dos Ajoute une page de dos.
Magasin papier (dos) Sélectionne le magasin papier pour la dernière page
de couverture.
9 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9)
9-14 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Couv. avc bac ins. Permet d'insérer une couverture à partir du bac d'insertion.
Dos avec bac ins. Permet d'insérer un dos à partir du bac d'insertion.
Intercalaire sur transparent Insère des intercalaires entre les transparents de rétroprojection.
Magasin papier (Intercalaire sur transparent)
Sélectionne le magasin papier pour les intercalaires
entre transparents.
Mode attente Arrête provisoirement d'imprimer après qu'un exemplaire
du document a été imprimée afin de pouvoir
vérifier l'épreuve.
Résolution Spécifie la résolution d'impression.
Lissage Règle le processus de lissage.
Densité d'impression Activer en cas de réglage de la densité d'impression.
Sous-menu Fonction
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9) 9
IC-202 (Phase 2) 9-15
9.4 Options de réglage
Vous pouvez spécifier les options installées sur cet appareil pour qu'elles
puissent être utilisées par le pilote d'imprimante.
2
Rappel
Si les options installées de cet appareil ne sont pas définies à partir de
l'écran Options Installables, la fonction Option ne peut pas être utilisée
avec le pilote d'imprimante. Lors de l'installation des options, assurezvous
d'effectuer les réglages corrects.
Spécifier les paramètres
1 Dans le menu Apple, cliquez sur [Sélecteur]
2 Sélectionnez le nom de l'imprimante.
3 Cliquez sur [Installation].
4 Cliquez sur [Configurer].
L'écran de réglage pour ajouter des options apparaît.
5 Sélectionnez l'option installée sur cet appareil.
6 Cliquez sur [OK].
La fenêtre du sélecteur réapparaît.
7 Fermez la fenêtre du sélecteur.
9 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS 9)
9-16 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2
Remarque
Les paramètres d'option s'affichent automatiquement la première fois
que vous sélectionnez le pilote d'imprimante. Pour plus de détails, voir
"Pour Mac OS 9" à la page 3-20.
10 Configurer le pilote PPD
(Mac OS X)
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X) 10
IC-202 (Phase 2) 10-3
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10.1 Paramètres
Vous pouvez configurer les fonctions de cet appareil dans les boîtes de
dialogue Mise en page et Imprimer affichées dans l'application.
Les paramètres ne peuvent s'appliquer que pendant l'utilisation de
l'application. Quand vous quittez l'application, les paramètres par défaut
sont réactivés.
Boîte de dialogue Format d'impression
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Eléments de Format d'impression
2
Remarque
Selon l'application, "Format d'impression" peut s'afficher sous forme de
"Réglage papier". De plus, vous devrez peut-être sélectionner "Réglage
papier" — "Options" à partir du menu "Fichier".
Les boîtes de dialogue varient en fonction de l'application.
Menu Sous-menu Fonction
Attributs de page Format papier Spécifie le format du papier.
Orientation Spécifie l'orientation.
Échelle Spécifie le taux d'agrandissement et de réduction.
Format de papier
personnalisé
Format papier Spécifie tous les formats papier.
Marges de l'imprimante
Spécifie les marges du papier.
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X) 10
IC-202 (Phase 2) 10-5
Boîte de dialogue Imprimer
Elément d'impression
Menu Sous-menu Fonction
Copies et pages Copies Spécifie le nombre de copies à imprimer.
Triées Imprime les copies multiples par jeux.
Pages Spécifie les pages à imprimer.
Disposition Pages par feuille Spécifie le nombre de pages à imprimer sur une
page.
Orientation Spécifies l'orientation des pages du document.
Bordure Spécifie les bordures autour des pages.
Options de sortie Format de sortie Spécifie le format de sortie du fichier à imprimer.
Programmateur*1 Print Document Spécifie l'heure d'impression.
Preferred Order Spécifie le niveau de priorité.
Gestion du papier*1 Reverse Page
Order
Imprime les pages dans l'ordre inverse.
Impression Sélectionne les pages pour impression.
Destination Paper
Size**2
Définit le format du papier en sortie
ColorSync*1
(Ce système d'impression
ne correspond
pas à cette
fonction.)
Color Conversion Spécifie la méthode de conversion des couleurs.
Quartz Filter Spécifie la couleur pour l'impression.
Page de garde*1 Print Cover Page Spécifie s'il faut ajouter une page de titre.
Cover Page Type Sélectionner pour imprimer "Confidentiel" ou
d'autres commentaires sur la page de titre.
Traitement d'erreur PostScript Error Spécifie s'il faut imprimer un rapport d'erreur en
cas d'erreur PostScript.
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Alimentation papier Toutes les pages Permet de sélectionner le magasin papier.
Première page Permet de sélectionner le magasin papier.
Pages restantes Permet de sélectionner le magasin papier.
Finition Tri Imprime les copies multiples par jeux.
Décalage Spécifie le décalage.
Recto-verso Effectue l'impression recto-verso.
Agrafer Agrafe les copies.
Perforation Perfore les copies.
Position de reliure Permet de spécifier la position de reliure.
Plier Plie les copies.
Bac de sortie Permet de sélectionner le bac de sortie.
Ordre de sortie Définissez s'il faut orienter le papier à imprimer
vers le haut ou vers le bas.
Image/Disposition Combinaison Spécifie le Livret, 2 en 1 or Répétition 2 en 1.
Position d'impression
Règle la position d'impression.
Résolution Affiche la résolution de l'imprimante. (600 dpi)
Lissage Spécifie le lissage dans un document.
Densité d'impression
Activer en cas de réglage de la densité d'impression.
Configuration Type de papier Sélectionne le type de papier.
Couverture Ajoute une page de couverture.
Magasin papier
(couverture)
Spécifie le magasin papier de la première page de
couverture.
Dos Ajoute une page de dos.
Magasin papier
(dos)
Sélectionne le magasin papier pour la dernière
page de couverture.
Couv. avc bac ins. Permet d'insérer une couverture à partir du bac
d'insertion.
Dos avec bac ins. Permet d'insérer un dos à partir du bac d'insertion.
Intercalaire sur
transparent
Insère des intercalaires entre les transparents de
rétroprojection.
Magasin papier
(Intercalaire sur
transparent)
Sélectionne le magasin papier pour les intercalaires
entre transparents.
Menu Sous-menu Fonction
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X) 10
IC-202 (Phase 2) 10-7
2
Remarque
Les boîtes de dialogue varient en fonction de l'application.
Les éléments repérés par "*1" ne s'affichent que sous Mac OS 10.3/10.4.
Les éléments repérés par "*2" ne s'affichent que sous Mac OS 10.4.
Sécurité Méthode de
sortie
Spécifie les méthodes de sortie, comme "Impression
sécurisée" et "Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur".
Paramètres d'impression
sécurisée
Spécifie l'ID et le mot de passe utilisateur pour
"Impression sécurisée".
Enr. dns Réglages
boîte util.
Spécifie le nom de fichier et le nom de boîte pour
"Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur".
Authentification Vérifie si les paramètres d'authentification ont été
appliqués et spécifie l'ID et le mot de passe utilisateur.
Suivi de Volume
(E.K.C.)
Vérifie si les paramètres de suivi de volume ont été
appliqués et spécifie le nom et le mot de passe du
service.
Menu Sous-menu Fonction
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
10.2 Disposition
Attributs de page (Paramètres de base)
1 Sélectionnez "Format d'impression" ou "Réglage papier" à partir du
menu "Fichier".
2 Sélectionnez "Attributs de page".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X) 10
IC-202 (Phase 2) 10-9
– Format de papier :
spécifie le format du papier.
– Orientation :
spécifie l'orientation.
– Échelle:
spécifie le taux d'agrandissement et de réduction.
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Format de papier personnalisé (en cas de Mac OS 10.2x/10.3x)
1 Sélectionnez "Format d'impression" ou "Réglage papier" à partir du
menu "Fichier".
2 Sélectionnez "Format de papier personnalisé".
3 Cliquez sur [Nouveau].
4 Tapez le nom du format papier.
5 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Taille du papier :
spécifie les dimensions du papier.
– Marges de l'imprimante :
spécifie les marges du papier.
6 Cliquez sur [Enregistrer].
7 Cliquez sur [OK].
Enregistre le format de papier personnalisé et vous permet de
sélectionner le format de papier sur l'écran qui s'affiche quand
"Attributs de page" est sélectionné.
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X) 10
IC-202 (Phase 2) 10-11
Format de papier personnalisé (en cas de Mac OS 10.4x)
Sélectionnez "Custom Page Sizes (Format de page personnalisé)" dans le
menu contextuel pour afficher "Format papier" de la fenêtre Format
d'impression.
Il est possible d'enregistrer un nouveau format de page personnalisé.
Le réglage du format de page personnalisé est supprimé.
Format papier
Définit la hauteur et la largeur du papier d'impression.
Marges de l'imprimante
Définit les marges du papier.
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
10.3 Impression
Copies et pages (Paramètres de base)
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Copies et pages".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Copies:
spécifie le nombre de copies à imprimer.
– Triées:
imprimer plusieurs copies par jeux.
– Pages:
spécifie le groupe de pages à imprimer.
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X) 10
IC-202 (Phase 2) 10-13
Disposition (Imprimer plusieurs pages sur une seule page)
Vous pouvez imprimer plusieurs pages de document sur une seule feuille.
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Mise en page".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Pages par feuille :
spécifie le nombre de pages à imprimer sur une seule page.
– Orientation :
spécifie l'ordre des pages du document..
– Bordure:
spécifie les bordures autour des pages.
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10-14 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Alimentation papier
Vous pouvez spécifier le magasin papier pour l'impression.
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Alimentation".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
– Toutes les pages :
sélectionne le magasin d'alimentation pour imprimer toutes les
pages.
– Première page :
sélectionne le magasin d'alimentation pour imprimer la première
page.
– Pages restantes :
sélectionne le magasin d'alimentation pour imprimer à partir de la
deuxième page.
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X) 10
IC-202 (Phase 2) 10-15
Sécurité
Non seulement vous pouvez imprimer directement, mais vous pouvez aussi
sélectionner "Impression sécurisée", qui nécessite un mot de passe pour
imprimer, "Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur", qui enregistre les documents
dans une boîte, "Attente avec épreuve", qui imprime le premier jeu de
plusieurs copies et s'arrête provisoirement d'imprimer, "Paramètres
d'authentification", qui nécessite une authentification et "Paramètres de
Suivi de volume", qui gère le nombre des pages imprimées.
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Sécurité".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10-16 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Sous-menu Fonction
Type de sortie Spécifie les conditions pour "Impression sécurisée" et "Enreg.
dans boîte utilisateur".
Paramètres d'impression sécurisée
Saisir l'ID et le mot de passe si "Impression sécurisée" est activé
dans la liste déroulante "Type de sortie". Tapez l'ID et le
mot de passe sur le panneau de contrôle de cet appareil
quand vous imprimez. (jusqu'à 100 documents)
Enr. dns Réglages boîte util. Entrez le nom de fichier et le numéro de boîte si "Enreg. dans
boîte utilisateur" ou "Enr. dns boîte utilis, imprim." est activé
dans la liste déroulante "Type de sortie".
Authentification Utilisateur Enregistre le nom d'utilisateur et le mot de passe si des paramètres
d'authentification ont été appliqués à cette machine et
si la case est cochée. Si cet appareil a été réglé pour autoriser
les utilisateurs publics, l'appareil peut être utilisé sans nom
d'utilisateur ni mot de passe.
Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.) Enregistre le nom d'accès et le mot de passe si des paramètres
de suivi de volume ont été appliqués à cette machine et
si la case est cochée.
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X) 10
IC-202 (Phase 2) 10-17
Finition
Vous pouvez spécifier ces options quand vous utilisez les fonctions de
finition Agrafage et Perforation de cet appareil.
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Finition".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Sous-menu Fonction
Tri Imprime les copies multiples par jeux.
Décalé Spécifie le décalage.
Recto-verso Effectue l'impression recto-verso.
Agrafer Agrafe les copies.
Perforer Perfore les copies.
Position de reliure Permet de spécifier la position de reliure.
Pliage Plie les copies.
Bac de sortie Permet de sélectionner le bac de sortie.
Ordre de sortie Définissez s'il faut orienter le papier à imprimer vers le haut ou
vers le bas.
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10-18 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Image/Disposition
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Image/Disposition".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Sous-menu Fonction
Combinaison Spécifie le Livret, 2 en 1 or Répétition 2 en 1.
Position d'impression Règle la position d'impression.
Résolution Spécifie la résolution.
Lissage Spécifie le lissage dans un document.
Densité d'impression Activer en cas de réglage de la densité d'impression.
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X) 10
IC-202 (Phase 2) 10-19
Configuration
Vous pouvez spécifier les paramètres NetWare.
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Configuration".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Sous-menu Fonction
Type de papier Sélectionne le type de papier.
Couverture Ajoute une page de couverture.
Magasin papier (couverture) Spécifie le magasin papier de la première page de couverture.
Dos Ajoute une page de dos.
Magasin papier (dos) Sélectionne le magasin papier pour la dernière page de
couverture.
Couv. avc bac ins. Permet d'insérer une couverture à partir du bac d'insertion.
Dos avec bac ins. Permet d'insérer un dos à partir du bac d'insertion.
Intercalaire sur transparent Insère des intercalaires entre les transparents de rétroprojection.
Magasin papier (Intercalaire sur
transparent)
Sélectionne le magasin papier pour les intercalaires entre
transparents.
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10-20 IC-202 (Phase 2)
10.4 Options de réglage
Vous pouvez spécifier les options installées sur cet appareil pour qu'elles
puissent être utilisées par le pilote d'imprimante.
2
Rappel
Si les options installées de cet appareil ne sont pas définies à partir de
l'écran Options Installables, la fonction Option ne peut pas être utilisée
avec le pilote d'imprimante. Lors de l'installation des options, assurezvous
d'effectuer les réglages corrects.
Spécifier les paramètres
1 Ouvrez le Centre d'impression ou l'utilitaire Configuration de
l'imprimante, situé dans "Applications" — "Utilities" de "Hard Disk" et
spécifiez le modèle d'imprimante.
2 A partir du menu "Imprimante (Imprimantes)", sélectionnez "Afficher
Infos".
La boîte de dialogue "Infos de l'imprimante" apparaît.
3 Sélectionnez "Options installables".
4 Sélectionnez l'option installée sur cet appareil.
5 Cliquez sur [Appliquer les changements] ou cliquez sur [e] pour fermer
la boîte de dialogue des Infos de l'imprimante.
Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X) 10
IC-202 (Phase 2) 10-21
10.5 Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote
Pour les pilotes Max OS X, vous pouvez enregistrer les valeurs de
paramètres du pilote modifié et les rappeler si nécessaire.
Enregistrer les paramètres de pilote
1 Modifiez les paramètres de pilote dans "Copies et pages" et
"Disposition".
2 Dans "Préréglages", cliquez sur [Enregistrer sous].
3 Entrez le "Enregistrer le préréglage sous".
4 Cliquez sur [OK].
Les paramètres sont enregistrés dans les paramètres prédéfinis.
10 Configurer le pilote PPD (Mac OS X)
10-22 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Rétablir les paramètres
% Sélectionnez "Préréglages" à partir de la boîte de dialogue "Imprimer"
pour rappeler les paramètres.
Les paramètres sont rappelés et la boîte de dialogue du pilote
d'imprimante apparaît.
Modifier les paramètres
1 Sélectionnez "Préréglages" à partir de la boîte de dialogue "Imprimer"
pour modifier les paramètres.
2 Modifiez les paramètres de pilote dans "Copies et pages" et
"Disposition".
3 Dans "Préréglages", cliquez sur [Enregistrer]
Pour supprimer, cliquez sur [Supprimer]. Pour changer de nom, cliquez
sur [Renommer].
Les paramètres prédéfinis sont modifiés.
11 Divers réglages
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-3
11 Divers réglages
11.1 Paramètres d'impression en mode Utilitaires
Vous pouvez modifier les différents paramètres d'impression sur le panneau
de contrôle de cet appareil.
Sélections par défaut
Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires
1 Appuyez sur la touche
[Utilitaire/Compteur].
2 Appuyez sur [2 Réglage Utilisateur].
11 Divers réglages
11-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
L'écran des Réglages utilisateur apparaît.
2
Remarque
En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez aussi sélectionner un élément en
appuyant sur une touche de clavier numérique pour taper le numéro à
côté de la touche voulu. Pour [2 Réglage Utilisateur], appuyez sur la
touche [2] du clavier.
Pour abandonner le réglage dans le mode Utilitaire, appuyez sur [Quitt.]
dans la zone d'affichage secondaire ou appuyez sur la touche
[Utilitaire/Compteur]. Autrement annulez le mode Utilitaire en appuyant
sur [Fermer] dans chaque écran successif jusqu'à ce que l'écran Copie,
ou Fax, ou Numérisation, ou Boîte réapparaisse.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-5
Paramètre PDL
Vous pouvez spécifier le paramètre PDL (Langage de description de page).
(Sélection par défaut : Auto)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [1 Fonctions de base].
3 Appuyez sur [Paramètre PDL].
4 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au réglage désiré.
– Auto : Bascule automatiquement entre PCL et PS.
– PCL : N'utilise que PCL.
– PS : N'utilise que PS.
11 Divers réglages
11-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Nombre de jeux
Vous pouvez spécifier le nombre de copies par défaut quand aucun réglage
n'a été spécifié à partir du pilote d'imprimante. (Sélection par défaut : 1 jeu)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [1 Fonctions de base].
3 Appuyez sur [Nombre de Jeux].
4 Appuyez sur la touche [C] (correction) pour effacer la valeur et servezvous
du clavier pour taper le nombre de copies par défaut
(entre 1 et 9999 jeux).
– Si vous spécifiez une valeur située hors de la plage autorisée, le
message "Erreur de saisie" apparaît. Tapez une valeur comprise
dans la plage autorisée.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
Le nombre de copies par défaut est défini.
Pour annuler toute modification des réglages, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-7
Direction original
Vous pouvez spécifier l'orientation d'image par défaut. (Sélection par
défaut : Portrait)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [1 Fonctions de base].
3 Appuyez sur [Direction Original].
4 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au réglage désiré.
– Portrait : L'image est imprimée verticalement sur la page.
Paysage : L'image est imprimée horizontalement sur la page.
11 Divers réglages
11-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Paramètre de désynchronisation
Vous choisissez d'utiliser un spoule ou non. (Sélection par défaut : ON)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [1 Fonctions de base].
3 Appuyez sur [Spool tâche dans HDD avant RIP].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-9
4 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au réglage désiré.
– ON : Quand la tâche suivante est reçue pendant le traitement d'une
tâche, les données d'impression sont stockées sur le disque dur.
OFF : Les données d'impression ne sont pas stockées sur le disque
dur.
2
Remarque
Assurez-vous de ne pas modifier le réglage sur [OFF]. L'impression
risque de ne pas être possible.
11 Divers réglages
11-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Modifier format papier
Vous pouvez spécifier si des formats de papier similaires 8-1/2 e 11 et A4 et
11 e 17 et A3 sont substitués les uns aux autres quand il n'y a plus de papier
au format spécifié avec le pilote d'imprimante. (Sélection par défaut : OFF)
0 L'image risque d'être faussée puisque l'impression est forcée.
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [1 Fonctions de base].
3 Appuyez sur [A4/A3 <-> LTR/LGR Auto Switch].
4 Appuyez sur le bouton correspondant au réglage désiré.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-11
Réglage des bannières
Vous pouvez choisir d'imprimer la page bannière (par défaut : OFF).
0 Voir "Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3 pour
la méthode d'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilisateur.
1 Appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante] sur l'écran Réglage Utilisateur.
2 Appuyez sur [1 Fonctions de base].
3 Appuyez sur la touche [ ].
4 Appuyez sur [Réglage Bannière].
11 Divers réglages
11-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
5 Appuyez sur le bouton correspondant au réglage désiré.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-13
Densité Texte Numérotation Jeux
Quand vous imprimez avec la fonction de numérotation, réglez la densité
d'impression. (Par défaut : Clair)
1 Appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante] sur l'écran Réglage Utilisateur.
2 Appuyez sur [1 Fonctions de base].
3 Appuyez sur la touche [ ].
4 Appuyez sur [Densité Texte Numérotation Jeux].
11 Divers réglages
11-14 IC-202 (Phase 2)
5 Appuyez sur le bouton correspondant au réglage désiré.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-15
Bac papier
Vous pouvez spécifier le magasin papier à utiliser quand aucun n'a été
spécifié avec le pilote d'imprimante. (Sélection par défaut : Auto)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [2 Paramètre Papier].
3 Appuyez sur [Magasin Papier].
4 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au magasin papier désiré.
– Pour sélectionner automatiquement le magasin papier, appuyez
sur [Auto].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler la modification des réglages, appuyez sur [Annul.].
11 Divers réglages
11-16 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Format de papier par défaut
Vous pouvez spécifier le format de papier par défaut quand aucun réglage
n'a été spécifié à partir du pilote d'imprimante. (Sélection par défaut :
8-1/2 e 11)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [2 Paramètre Papier].
3 Appuyez sur [Format Pap. Défaut].
4 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au réglage désiré.
– Pour annuler toute modification des paramètres, appuyez
sur [Annul.].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-17
Impression recto-verso
Vous pouvez spécifier le paramètre d'impression recto-verso par défaut.
(Sélection par défaut : OFF)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [2 Paramètre Papier].
3 Appuyez sur [Impr. recto verso].
4 Appuyez sur le bouton correspondant au réglage désiré.
11 Divers réglages
11-18 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Type de reliure
Vous pouvez spécifier la position de reliure par défaut pour l'impression
recto verso. (Sélection par défaut : Reliure gauche)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [2 Paramètre Papier].
3 Appuyez sur [Position Reliure].
4 Appuyez sur le bouton correspondant au réglage désiré.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-19
Agrafer
Vous pouvez spécifier les paramètres d'agrafage. (Sélection par défaut :
OFF)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [2 Paramètre Papier].
3 Appuyez sur [Agrafage].
4 Appuyez sur le bouton correspondant au réglage désiré.
11 Divers réglages
11-20 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Perforation
Vous pouvez spécifier les paramètres de perforation. (Sélection par défaut :
OFF)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [2 Paramètre Papier].
3 Appuyez sur [ ] ou [ ] et appuyez ensuite sur [Perforation].
4 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au réglage désiré.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-21
Bac page bannière
Vous pouvez configurer le magasin de la page bannière. (par défaut : Auto)
0 Voir "Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3 pour
la méthode d'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilisateur.
1 Appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante] sur l'écran Réglage Utilisateur.
2 Appuyez sur [2 Paramètre Papier].
3 Appuyez sur [ ] ou [ ] et appuyez ensuite sur [Magasin Bannière].
4 Appuyez sur la touche voulue.
11 Divers réglages
11-22 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Numéro de police
Vous pouvez spécifier la police à utiliser quand aucun réglage n'a été spécifié
à partir du pilote d'imprimante. (Sélection par défaut : Courier)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [3 Paramètre PCL].
3 Appuyez sur [1 Numéro de police].
4 Appuyez sur [Interne].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-23
5 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au réglage désiré.
– Appuyez sur [ ] ou [ ] et appuyez ensuite sur la touche du
paramètre désiré.
– Vous pouvez vérifier le numéro de police choisi ainsi que les unités
de format de police.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler la modification des réglages, appuyez sur [Annul.].
11 Divers réglages
11-24 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Jeu de symboles
Vous pouvez spécifier le jeu de symboles de police à utiliser quand aucun
réglage n'a été spécifié à partir du pilote d'imprimante. (Sélection par défaut :
PC-8, Code Page 437)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [3 Paramètre PCL].
3 Appuyez sur [2 Jeu de symboles].
4 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au réglage désiré.
– Appuyez sur [ ] ou [ ] et appuyez ensuite sur la touche du
paramètre désiré.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler la modification des réglages, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-25
Taille caractères
Vous pouvez spécifier le format de police à utiliser quand aucun réglage n'a
été spécifié à partir du pilote d'imprimante. (Sélection par défaut : Police
vectorielle – 12,00 points ; Police bitmap – 10,00 caract./pouce)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [3 Paramètre PCL].
3 Appuyez sur [3 Taille caractères].
11 Divers réglages
11-26 IC-202 (Phase 2)
4 Appuyez sur la touche [C] (correction) pour effacer la valeur et à l'aide
du clavier tapez la taille de caractères par défaut (Police vectorielle :
entre 4,00 et 999,75 points ; police bitmap : entre 0,44 et
99,00 caract./pouce).
– Police vectorielle : Spécifie le format de police en points.
Police bitmap : Spécifie la largeur de la largeur fixe de police en
caractères/pouces.
– Si vous spécifiez une valeur située hors de la plage autorisée, le
message "Erreur de saisie" apparaît. Tapez une valeur comprise
dans la plage autorisée.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
La taille des caractères est définie.
Pour annuler toute modification des paramètres, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-27
Ligne/Page
Vous pouvez spécifier le nombre de lignes par page lors du test
d'impression. (Sélection par défaut : 64 lignes)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [3 Paramètre PCL].
3 Appuyez sur [4 Ligne/Page].
4 Appuyez sur la touche [C] (correction) pour effacer la valeur et servezvous
du clavier pour taper le nombre de lignes par défaut
(entre 5 et 128 lignes).
– Si vous spécifiez une valeur située hors de la plage autorisée, le
message "Erreur de saisie" apparaît. Tapez une valeur comprise
dans la plage autorisée.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
Le nombre de lignes/page par défaut est défini.
Pour annuler toute modification des réglages, appuyez sur [Annul.].
11 Divers réglages
11-28 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Mappage CR (Retour chariot)/LF (saut de ligne)
Vous pouvez spécifier la méthode de substitution des données lors de
l'impression de données de texte. (Sélection par défaut : OFF)
Mode 1 : remplace les données reçues en CR par CR-LF.
Mode 2 : remplace les données reçues en LF par CR-LF.
Mode 3 : remplace toutes les données reçues par CR-LF.
OFF : n'effectue aucune substitution.
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [3 Paramètre PCL].
3 Appuyez sur [5 Mappage CR/LF].
– Appuyez sur le bouton correspondant au réglage désiré.
4 Appuyez sur le bouton correspondant au réglage désiré.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-29
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler la modification des réglages, appuyez sur [Annul.].
11 Divers réglages
11-30 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Erreur impression PS
Vous pouvez spécifier s'il faut imprimer le message d'erreur quand une
erreur survient pendant la rastérisation PS. (Sélection par défaut : OFF)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, voir
"Pour afficher l'écran de réglage des utilitaires" à la page 11-3.
2 Appuyez sur [4 Paramètre PS].
3 Appuyez sur [Impress. erreur PS].
4 Appuyez sur le bouton correspondant au réglage désiré.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-31
Imprimer les rapports
Vous pouvez imprimer les quatre types de rapports suivants.
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [6 Réglage Imprimante].
2 Appuyez sur [5 Sortie rapports].
3 Appuyez sur le bouton correspondant au réglage désiré.
– Liste info de réglage : imprime une liste des paramètres de
l'appareil.
Page de démo : Imprime une page test.
Liste polices PCL : Imprime la liste des polices PCL.
Liste polices PS : Imprime la liste des polices PS.
4 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au magasin papier désiré.
5 Pour imprimer un rapport, appuyez sur la touche [Départ].
11 Divers réglages
11-32 IC-202 (Phase 2)
11.2 Réglages de l'imprimante en mode administrateur
Pour afficher l'écran Réglage administrateur
1 Appuyez sur la touche
[Utilitaire/Compteur].
2 Appuyez sur [3 Réglage Administrateur].
3 Tapez le mot de passe et appuyez ensuite sur [OK].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-33
4 L'écran Réglage administrateur apparaît.
!
Détails
En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez aussi sélectionner un élément en
appuyant sur une touche de clavier numérique pour taper le numéro à
côté de la touche voulu. Pour [3 Réglage Administrateur], appuyez sur la
touche [3] du clavier.
Pour de plus amples détails sur la définition ou la modification du mot de
passe, consultez le manuel 750/600 [Opérations de copie].
!
Détails
Pour abandonner le réglage dans le mode Utilitaire, appuyez sur [Quitt.]
dans la zone d'affichage secondaire ou appuyez sur la touche
[Utilitaire/Compteur]. Autrement annulez le mode Utilitaire en appuyant
sur [Fermer] dans chaque écran successif jusqu'à ce que l'écran Copie,
ou Fax, ou Numérisation, ou Boîte réapparaisse.
11 Divers réglages
11-34 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Système prioritaire
Vous pouvez spécifier s'il faut imprimer les données après la réception ou s'il
faut les imprimer simultanément au fur et à mesure de la réception. (Sélection
par défaut : Impression par lots)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Administrateur, appuyez sur [1 Réglage Système].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Administrateur,
voir "Pour afficher l'écran Réglage administrateur" à la page 11-32.
2 Sur l'écran Réglage Système, appuyez sur [2 Réglage Sortie].
3 Sur l'écran de réglage Sortie, appuyez sur [1 Paramètres de sortie
Impression/Fax].
L'écran Système Prioritaire apparaît.
4 Appuyez sur [Imprimante].
Les touches des paramètres disponibles apparaissent.
5 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au réglage désiré.
Le timing d'impression est réglé.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-35
2
Remarque
Si [Impression par lots] est sélectionné, l'impression démarre quand
toutes les données sont reçues et la tâche d'impression est mise en file
d'attente. Si "Impression par page" est sélectionné, l'impression démarre
quand les données de la première page sont reçues et la tâche
d'impression est mise en file d'attente.
11 Divers réglages
11-36 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Délai de connexion I/F
Vous pouvez régler l'heure à laquelle survient un délai de connexion pour
l'interface parallèle, USB ou réseau. (Sélection par défaut : 60 secondes)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Utilitaires, appuyez sur [7 Réglage Imprimante].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Administrateur,
voir "Pour afficher l'écran Réglage administrateur" à la page 11-32.
2 Sur l'écran Paramètre imprimante, appuyez sur [1 Délai I/F].
L'écran Délai I/F apparaît.
3 Appuyez sur [Entrée] sous le paramètre que vous voulez spécifier.
4 Appuyez sur la touche [C] (correction) pour effacer la valeur,
puis servez-vous du clavier pour taper la durée par défaut
(entre 10 et 1000 secondes).
– Si vous spécifiez une valeur située hors de la plage autorisée, le
message "Erreur de saisie" apparaît. Tapez une valeur comprise
dans la plage de réglage disponible.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
Le délai avant que l'attente de connexion ne survienne est réglé.
Pour annuler toute modification des paramètres, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-37
Capturer les données d'impression
Vous pouvez spécifier d'autoriser ou d'interdire la capture des données
d'une tâche d'impression. (Sélection par défaut : Permis)
1 Sur l'écran Réglage Administrateur, appuyez sur [0 Paramètre
Sécurité].
– Pour des détails sur l'affichage de l'écran Réglage Administrateur,
voir "Pour afficher l'écran Réglage administrateur" à la page 11-32.
2 Sur l'écran Paramètre Sécurité, appuyez sur [4 Détails Sécurité].
3 Appuyez sur la touche [ ].
4 Sur l'écran Détails Sécurité, appuyez sur [Capture Données
d'Impression].
Les touches des paramètres disponibles apparaissent.
5 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au réglage désiré.
La capture d'une tâche d'impression est soit permise ou interdite.
11 Divers réglages
11-38 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2
Remarque
Pour plus de détails sur la capture d'une tâche d'impression, consultez
un technicien de maintenance.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-39
11.3 Utiliser Web Connection
Web Connection est un utilitaire de gestion supporté par le serveur HTTP
intégré dans le contrôleur d'impression.
Lancez votre navigateur Internet sur un ordinateur du réseau pour accéder à
Web Connection et modifier facilement les paramètres de cet appareil.
2
Remarque
Flash et HTML sont disponibles dans Mode vue de Web Connection.
Pour plus de détails, voir "Connexion et déconnexion" à la page 11-43.
Configuration minimale requise
Accéder à Web Connection
Vous pouvez accéder à Web Connection à partir d'un navigateur Internet.
1 Lancez le navigateur Internet.
2 Dans la barre Adresse, tapez l'adresse IP de cet appareil et appuyez
sur la touche [Entrée].
http:///
Exemple : si l'adresse IP de cet appareil est 192.168.1.20
http://192.168.1.20/
!
Détails
Si la fonction d'authentification utilisateur est activée, vous devez saisir
le nom utilisateur ou le mot de passe. Pour plus de détails, voir "Se
connecter en mode Utilisateur (utilisateur public)" à la page 11-45.
Pour la procédure de configuration de l'adresse IP de l'appareil, voir
"Réglage de l'adresse IP pour cet appareil" à la page 4-6.
Sous-menu Configuration minimale requise
Réseau EthernetTCP/IP
Application
informatique
Navigateur Internet :
Microsoft Internet Explorer 6 ou supérieur recommandé (JavaScript et
Cookies activés)
Microsoft XML Parser MSXML3.X doit être installé si vous utilisez
Internet Explorer 5.X.
Netscape Navigator 7.02 ou supérieur (JavaScript activé, Cookies activés)
Adobe® Flash® Player (Si "Flash" sélectionné en mode vue, le plugin version
7.0 ou supérieure est nécessaire).
11 Divers réglages
11-40 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Structure de page
La page qui s'affiche immédiatement après la connexion à Web Connection
est la page du mode Utilisateur et elle s'affiche quand vous êtes connecté en
tant qu'utilisateur public.
2
Remarque
En cliquant sur [Déconnexion], vous pouvez vous connecter comme
autre utilisateur ou comme administrateur. Pour plus de détails, voir
"Connexion et déconnexion" à la page 11-43.
La configuration d'une page Web Connection est présentée
ci-dessous.
3 4 5 6
1
2
9
10
7
8
Non. Sous-menu Description
1 Mode de connexion Affiche le mode de connexion actuel (public, utilisateur enregistré,
nom de compte, administrateur, administrateur de
boîte).
2 [Déconnexion] Cliquez dessus pour vous déconnecter du mode actuel.
3 Affichage des états Affiche l'état des sections imprimante et scanner de cet
appareil à l'aide d'icônes.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-41
4 Afficheur des messages Affiche l'état du problème/de l'erreur et d'autres informations
d'erreur si une erreur est survenue sur cet appareil.
5 Page de fonctionnement Affiche l'état de fonctionnement de cette machine.
6 Onglet Affiche les catégories que contrôle Web Connection. Les
onglets suivants s'affichent en mode Utilisateur.
• Système
• Tâche
• Boîte
• Impression
• Lecture
7 Aide La page spécifiée dans "URL Manuel en ligne" s'affiche.
Pour la procédure de configuration, voir "Onglet Système
— Assistance en ligne" à la page 11-79.
8 Rafraîchir Cliquez dessus pour mettre à jour la page affichée.
9 Menus Etablit une liste des informations et des paramètres pour
l'onglet sélectionné. les menus qui s'affichent diffèrent en
fonction de l'onglet sélectionné.
10 Affichage d'informations/
de paramètres
Affiche les détails de l'élément sélectionné dans le menu.
Non. Sous-menu Description
11 Divers réglages
11-42 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Fonction de cache des navigateurs Internet
Les informations les plus récentes risquent de ne pas s'afficher sur la page
de Web Connection à cause de la fonction de cache du navigateur Internet.
De plus, des problèmes peuvent survenir quand vous utilisez la fonction de
cache.
Quand vous utilisez Web Connection, désactivez la fonction de cache de
votre navigateur Internet.
!
Détails
Les menus et commandes peuvent varier d'un navigateur Internet à
l'autre. Pour plus de détails, voir l'aide du navigateur Internet.
Si la fonction de cache est activée dans le navigateur Internet et qu'une
déconnexion survient en mode administrateur, la page d'attente de
connexion peut s'afficher même quand vous accédez de nouveau à
Page-Scope Web Connection. Quand cela survient, le panneau de
contrôle de l'appareil reste bloqué et il faut mettre ce dernier hors tension
et le remettre sous tension. Pour éviter de tels problèmes, désactivez la
fonction de cache.
Lorsque vous mettez l'appareil hors tension et sous tension à nouveau,
assurez-vous de commencer par actionner l'interrupteur auxiliaire puis
l'interrupteur général. De plus, attendez au moins 10 s avant de remettre
l'appareil sous tension, sinon cette machine risque de ne pas fonctionner
correctement.
Dans Internet Explorer
1 Dans le menu "Outils", cliquez sur [Options Internet].
2 Sous l'onglet Général, cliquez sur [Paramètres] sous "Fichiers Internet
temporaires".
3 Sélectionnez "À chaque visite de la page" et cliquez ensuite sur [OK].
Dans Netscape Navigator
1 Dans le menu "Edition", cliquez sur [Préférences].
2 Dans la case "Catégorie", choisissez [Avancé], puis "Cache".
3 Sous "Comparer la page du cache à la page du réseau", sélectionnez
"A chaque fois que j'affiche la page".
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-43
Connexion et déconnexion
Lors de l'accès à Web Connection, c'est la page de connexion qui s'affiche
en cas d'authentification utilisateur et de suivi de volume sur cette machine
et la page de connexion en tant qu'utilisateur public en l'absence
d'authentification et de suivi de volume. Pour vous connecter en tant
qu'utilisateur différent et en tant qu'administrateur, vous devez vous
déconnecter puis vous reconnecter.
2
Remarque
Si aucune opération n'est effectuée pendant un laps de temps défini
alors que vous êtes connecté, une déconnexion survient
automatiquement et aucune opération ne peut être effectuée.
Vous pouvez régler le délai de déconnexion survenant en mode
Utilisateur et en mode Administrateur dans "Réseau" – "Authentification"
– "Déconnexion auto" du mode Administrateur.
11 Divers réglages
11-44 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Déconnexion
% Cliquez sur [Déconnexion] en haut à gauche de la page.
La page de connexion apparaît en cliquant sur [OK].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-45
Se connecter en mode Utilisateur (utilisateur public)
En l'absence d'authentification utilisateur, connectez-vous en tant
qu'utilisateur public.
1 Sur la page de connexion, sélectionnez "Utilisateur public".
– Au besoin, sélectionnez la langue et le format d'affichage.
– Si le format d'affichage "Flash" est sélectionné, les éléments
suivants sont affichés avec le masque Flash.
Icônes et images d'état
État "Onglet Système – Info sur le périphérique – Bac d'entrée"
État "Onglet Système"
– Flash Player est nécessaire au masque "Flash".
11 Divers réglages
11-46 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2 Cliquez sur [Connexion].
La page change et passe en mode Utilisateur.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-47
Se connecter en mode Utilisateur (utilisateur enregistré)
En cas d'authentification utilisateur sur cette machine, vous devez vous
connecter avec le nom d'utilisateur et le mot de passe qui sont enregistrés
sur cette machine ou sur un serveur d'authentification externe. Ce chapitre
décrit la procédure de connexion avec un nom d'utilisateur spécifié en cas
d'authentification de l'utilisateur.
1 Sur la page de connexion, entrez le nom d'utilisateur et le mot de
passe.
– En cas de suivi de volume, entrez le nom du compte et le mot de
passe.
– Au besoin, sélectionnez la langue et le format d'affichage.
– Si le format d'affichage "Flash" est sélectionné, les éléments
suivants sont affichés avec le masque Flash.
Icônes et images d'état
État "Onglet Système – Info sur le périphérique – Bac d'entrée"
État "Onglet Système"
– Flash Player est nécessaire au masque "Flash".
11 Divers réglages
11-48 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2 Cliquez sur [Connexion].
La page change et passe en mode Utilisateur.
2
Rappel
Lorsque les paramètres d'authentification d'utilisateur ou de compte
sont spécifiés sur cette machine, que la fonction de restriction des
opérations d'authentification est en Mode 2 et que les informations
d'authentification ne sont saisies correctement, l'utilisateur ou le compte
concerné est verrouillé et plus aucun accès n'est possible.
2
Remarque
Cliquez sur l'icône à droite de "Nom de propriétaire" pour sélectionner le
nom d'utilisateur sur une liste.
Si plusieurs domaines sont spécifiés en tant qu'authentification par
serveur externe sur cette machine, ajoutez "@" après le nom d'utilisateur
et indiquez le nom du domaine. (Exemple : si le nom d'utilisateur est
"utilisateur01" et que le nom de domaine est "domaine", entrez
"utilisateur01@domaine".)
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-49
Se connecter en mode Administrateur
La connexion en mode Administrateur vous permet de spécifier les
paramètres système et les paramètres réseau.
0 Pendant la connexion au mode Administrateur, le panneau de contrôle
de la machine est verrouillé et aucune opération n'est disponible. La
connexion au mode Administrateur n'est pas toujours disponible en
fonction de l'état de la machine.
1 Dans la page de connexion, sélectionnez "Administrateur" et cliquez
sur [Connexion].
– Au besoin, sélectionnez la langue et le format d'affichage.
– Si le format d'affichage "Flash" est sélectionné, les éléments
suivants sont affichés avec le masque Flash.
Icônes et images d'état
État "Onglet Système – Info sur le périphérique – Bac d'entrée"
État "Onglet Système"
– Flash Player est nécessaire au masque "Flash".
11 Divers réglages
11-50 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2 Entrez le mot de passe de l'administrateur de cette machine et cliquez
ensuite sur [OK].
La page change et passe en mode Administrateur.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-51
2
Remarque
Quand vous êtes connecté en mode administrateur, le panneau de
contrôle de la machine est verrouillé et ne peut pas être utilisé.
Selon l'état de l'appareil, il se peut que vous ne puissiez pas vous
connecter en mode Administrateur.
2
Remarque
Si le format d'affichage "Flash" est sélectionné, les éléments suivants
sont affichés avec le masque Flash.
Icônes et images d'état
État "Onglet Système – Info sur le périphérique – Bac d'entrée"
État "Onglet Tâche"
Flash Player est nécessaire au masque "Flash".
Si vous utilisez le logiciel de lecture d'écran, il est recommandé de
sélectionner HTML.
11 Divers réglages
11-52 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Mode Utilisateur
Le mode utilisateur offre des fonctions de contrôle et d'exploitation de
l'appareil à un niveau utilisateur. Vous avez le choix entre cinq onglets
(Système, Tâche, Boîte, Impression ou Lecture).
2
Remarque
Ce manuel décrit les fonctions liées à l'imprimante. Pour les fonctions de
boîte et de scanner de cet appareil, consulter le Guide de l'utilisateur
[Opérations Boîte] et le Guide de l'utilisateur [Opérations Scanner
Réseau].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-53
Onglet Système
L'onglet Système permet d'afficher des informations et des paramètres
relatifs à la configuration système de cet appareil.
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Consommables
Sous l'onglet Système, cliquez sur [Info sur le périphérique] et ensuite sur
[Consommables] dans le sous-menu qui s'affiche. Par ailleurs, c'est la
page d'accueil qui s'affiche quand vous accédez à
http:///avec votre navigateur Internet.
Cette page affiche les informations de consommable de cette machine.
2
Remarque
Les rubriques affichées peuvent varier en fonction des différentes
options installées.
Sous-menu Description
Toner Affiche les informations pour chaque élément.
Poussière de perforation
Agrafer
11 Divers réglages
11-54 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Bac d'entrée
Sous l'onglet Système, cliquez sur [Info sur le périphérique] et ensuite sur
[Bac d'entrée] dans le sous-menu qui s'affiche.
Vous pouvez contrôler l'état des bacs d'entrée de cet appareil.
2
Remarque
Si le format "HTML" est sélectionné en mode Vue lors de la connexion,
vous pouvez vérifier les détails en sélectionnant chaque magasin et en
cliquant sur [Détail].
Sous-menu Description
Magasin Affiche les informations pour chaque élément.
Format papier
Type de papier
Etat papier
Capacité de papier
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-55
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Bac de sortie
Sous l'onglet Système, cliquez sur [Info sur le périphérique] et ensuite sur
[Bac de sortie] dans le sous-menu qui s'affiche.
Vous pouvez contrôler l'état des bacs de sortie de cet appareil.
Sous-menu Description
Bac de sortie Affiche le nom du bas et l'état de chaque bac installé.
Option Affiche si une option est installée.
11 Divers réglages
11-56 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Sommaire de
configuration
Sous l'onglet Système, cliquez sur [Info sur le périphérique] et ensuite sur
[Sommaire de configuration] dans le sous-menu qui s'affiche. Cette page
affiche la configuration système actuelle ainsi que l'état de cet appareil.
Sous-menu Description
Sommaire de configuration
Affiche la configuration des options installées sur cette machine.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-57
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Disque dur
Sous l'onglet Système, cliquez sur [Info sur le périphérique] et ensuite sur
[Disque dur] dans le sous-menu qui s'affiche.
Vous pouvez contrôler l'état du disque dur de cet appareil.
Sous-menu Description
Nom Affiche le nom du disque dur.
Total Affiche la taille totale du disque dur installé.
Utilisé Affiche la quantité d'espace occupée par le système sur le disque
dur.
Reste Affiche la quantité d'espace libre sur le disque dur.
11 Divers réglages
11-58 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Information sur interface
Sous l'onglet Système, cliquez sur [Info sur le périphérique] et ensuite sur
[Information sur interface] dans le sous-menu qui s'affiche.
Vous pouvez contrôler les informations d'interface pour cet appareil.
Sous-menu Description
Information sur protocole Affiche l'état d'activité de chaque protocole.
Information sur réseau Affiche les informations de réseau.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-59
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique — Information
administrateur
Sous l'onglet Système, cliquez sur [Info sur le périphérique] et ensuite sur
[Information administrateur] dans le sous-menu qui s'affiche. Cette page
affiche les informations administrateur de cette machine.
2
Remarque
L'état risque de ne pas s'afficher correctement si les consommables ne
sont pas installés.
Sous-menu Description
Information administrateur Affiche les informations sur l'administrateur.
11 Divers réglages
11-60 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Compteur
Cliquez sur l'onglet Système puis, dans le menu, cliquez sur [Compteur].
Vous pouvez contrôler les compteurs que gère cet appareil.
Sous-menu Description
Compteur total Affiche le total du compteur de sortie (copies, impressions, numérisations
et fax).
Compteur de copies Affiche chaque compteur.
Compteur d'impressions
Compteur Numéris. (Apparaît comme Compteur Numéris./Fax si le kit Fax en option
est installé.)
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-61
Onglet Système — Assistance en ligne
Cliquez sur l'onglet Système puis, dans le menu, cliquez sur [Assistance en
ligne].
Vous pouvez contrôler les informations d'assistance à propos du produit.
Sous-menu Description
Nom de la personne de
contact
Affiche chaque rubrique spécifié sur la page Assistance en ligne à
partir de l'onglet Système en mode Administrateur.
Information sur la personne
de contact
URL aide produit
URL d'entreprise
Fournitures et accessoires
URL aide en ligne
11 Divers réglages
11-62 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Authentification d'utilisateur — Modif. du mot de
passe utilis.
Sous l'onglet Système, cliquez sur [Authentification d'utilisateur] et ensuite
sur [Modif. du mot de passe utilis.] dans le sous-menu qui s'affiche.
Vous pouvez modifier le mot de passe de l'utilisateur connecté.
2
Remarque
Il est impossible de modifier le mot de passe si vous n'êtes pas connecté
en tant qu'utilisateur.
Sous-menu Description
Mot de passe actuel Entrez le mot de passe actuel.
Nouveau mot de passe Entrez le nouveau mot de passe. (jusqu'à 64 caractères alphanumériques,
sauf " +)
Retaper nouveau mot de
passe
Confirmez le nouveau mot de passe en le retapant.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-63
Onglet Système — Authentification d'utilisateur — Information
utilisateur
Sous l'onglet Système, cliquez sur [Authentification d'utilisateur] et ensuite
sur [Information utilisateur] dans le sous-menu qui s'affiche.
Affiche les informations de l'utilisateur connecté.
2
Remarque
Les informations utilisateur ne s'affichent pas si vous n'êtes pas
connecté tant qu'utilisateur.
Sous-menu Description
Information utilisateur Affiche le nom de l'utilisateur.
Permission Fonction Affiche les fonctions utilisables sur cette machine.
Information compteur Affiche la valeur maximale et le compteur actuel.
11 Divers réglages
11-64 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Inform. compte département
Sous l'onglet Système cliquez sur [Inform. compte département].
Affiche les informations de suivi de volume de l'utilisateur connecté.
2
Remarque
Les informations de compte de département si la fonction de suivi de
volume n'est pas activée sur cette machine.
Sous-menu Description
Inform. compte
département
Affiche le nom du compte.
Information compteur Affiche la valeur maximale et le compteur actuel.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-65
Onglet Tâche
Sur l'onglet "Tâche", vous pouvez vérifier les tâches gérées par cet appareil.
Onglet Tâche — Tâches en cours
Sous l'onglet Tâches, cliquez sur [Tâches en cours] dans le menu et
sélectionnez ensuite chaque fonction (opération d'impression et de
numérisation) par type de tâche.
Vous pouvez contrôler des tâches en cours d'impression ou dans la file
d'attente d'impression.
Page échantillon
Sous-menu Description
Impression Affiche la liste et les détails des tâches d'impression.
Lecture Affiche la liste et les détails des tâches de numérisation.
Émission Fax Affiche la liste et les détails des tâches d'émission de fax.
Réception Fax Affiche la liste et les détails des tâches de réception de fax.
Mémoire HDD Affiche la liste et les détails des tâches de boîte.
11 Divers réglages
11-66 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2
Remarque
Le numéro de tâche affecté lors de la mise en file d'attente de cette tâche
dans l'appareil apparaît comme numéro de tâche.
Pour une sortie prioritaire (tâches d'impression), sélectionnez la tâche et
cliquez ensuite sur [Augmenter priorité].
Pour vérifier une adresse (des tâches d'émission), sélectionnez la tâche
et cliquez ensuite sur [Afficher la destination de diffusion].
Pour supprimer une tâche, sélectionnez-la et cliquez ensuite sur
[Supprimer].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-67
Onglet Tâche — Historique tâches
Sous l'onglet Tâches, cliquez sur [Historique tâches] dans le menu et
sélectionnez ensuite chaque fonction (opération d'impression et de
numérisation) par type de tâche.
Vous pouvez vérifier les tâches terminées.
Page échantillon
2
Remarque
Le numéro de tâche affecté lors de la mise en file d'attente de cette tâche
dans l'appareil apparaît comme numéro de tâche.
Si le format "HTML" est sélectionné en mode Vue lors de la connexion,
vous pouvez vérifier les détails en sélectionnant chaque magasin et en
cliquant sur [Détail].
Sous-menu Description
Impression Affiche la liste et les détails des tâches d'impression.
Lecture Affiche la liste et les détails des tâches de numérisation.
Émission Fax Affiche la liste et les détails des tâches d'émission de fax.
Réception Fax Affiche la liste et les détails des tâches de réception de fax.
Mémoire HDD Affiche la liste et les détails des tâches de boîte.
11 Divers réglages
11-68 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Impression
Vous pouvez vérifier les paramètres par défaut de l'imprimante et imprimer
différents rapports.
Onglet Impression — Réglage général
Sous l'onglet Tâche, cliquez sur [Réglage général] dans le menu et
sélectionnez ensuite chaque catégorie de paramètre (Générale et PCL).
En cas d'envoi d'une tâche d'impression dont les paramètres ne sont pas
spécifiés, ce sont les paramètres par défaut indiqués ici qui servent à
l'impression.
Page échantillon des réglages par défaut
Sous-menu Description
Réglage Général Affiche les informations pour chaque élément.
Param. PCL
Configuration PS
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-69
Onglet Impression — Sortie rapport
Sous l'onglet Impression, cliquez sur [Sortie rapport].
Vous pouvez imprimer diverses informations de configuration, les page de
démonstration et des informations sur les polices PCL. Sélectionnez le
rapport que vous voulez imprimer, sélectionnez le plateau papier dans la liste
déroulante "Bac papier" et cliquez ensuite sur [Impression].
2
Remarque
Quand cet appareil est en train de traiter une tâche, vous ne pouvez pas
imprimer de rapports.
Sous-menu Description
Liste des polices PS Imprime la liste des polices utilisées par PostScript.
Liste des polices PCL Imprime la liste des polices utilisées par PCL.
Page de démonstration Imprime une page de démonstration.
Page de configuration Imprime différentes pages de configuration de cet appareil.
Magasin papier Sélectionnez le bac papier pour imprimer les rapports.
11 Divers réglages
11-70 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Mode Administrateur
En mode Administrateur, vous pouvez spécifier les paramètres système pour
cet appareil. Vous avez le choix entre six onglets (Système, Tâche, Boîte,
Impression, Lecture ou Réseau).
Pour plus de détails sur la connexion en mode administrateur, voir "Se
connecter en mode Administrateur" à la page 11-49.
2
Remarque
Ce manuel décrit les fonctions liées à l'imprimante. Pour les fonctions de
boîte et de scanner et de réseau de cet appareil, consulter le Guide de
l'utilisateur [Opérations Boîte] et le Guide de l'utilisateur [Opérations
Scanner Réseau].
Fonctionnement de base
1 Cliquez sur un onglet et sélectionnez ensuite un élément du menu.
2 Spécifiez les paramètres pour les éléments affichés. Vous pouvez
entrer un paramètre directement ou le choisir dans une zone de liste
déroulante.
3 Cliquez sur [Appliquer] pour appliquer les réglages.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-71
Onglet Système
L'onglet Système permet d'afficher des informations et des paramètres
relatifs à la configuration système de cet appareil.
Onglet Système — Importer/Exporter
Vous pouvez enregistrer (exporter) les informations de réglage de cet
appareil comme fichier ou écrire (importer) les informations d'un fichier sur
cet appareil.
Spécifiez les informations à importer ou à exporter et cliquez ensuite sur
[Suivant].
Sous-menu Description
Réglage du périphérique Indiquez les valeurs de réglage pour les paramètres utilisateur et administrateur
de cette machine.
Journal de transmission Spécifiez le journal de transmission de cette machine.
Information utilisateur Spécifiez les informations d'enregistrement d'utilisateur.
11 Divers réglages
11-72 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Spécifiez le fichier à importer ou exporter.
2
Remarque
Il n'est pas possible de modifier les fichiers exportés.
2
Remarque
Le journal de transmission peut uniquement être exporté.
Sous-menu Description
Importer Pour importer un fichier, spécifiez le nom que vous voulez importer
et cliquez sur [Importer].
Exporter Pour télécharger un fichier, cliquez sur [Exporter].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-73
Onglet Système — Date/Heure — Réglage manuel
Tapez l'heure et la date pour cet appareil.
Sous-menu Description
Année Tapez l'année.
Mois Tapez le mois.
Jour Tapez le jour.
Heure Tapez l'heure.
Minute Tapez les minutes.
Zone d'heure Spécifiez le décalage horaire par rapport à GMT.
Heure d'été Spécifiez si l'heure est exprimée en heure d'économie de lumière
du jour (plage de saisie : 1 à 150, unité : minutes).
11 Divers réglages
11-74 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Date/Heure — Param. régl. heure
L'heure et la date de cet appareil peuvent être définis par acquisition passive
auprès du serveur NTP.
Cliquez sur [Ajuster] pour se connecter aux conditions spécifiées au serveur
NTP et régler l'heure.
Sous-menu Description
Réglage Date/Heure Spécifiez s'il faut activer l'acquisition automatique de l'heure par
NTP.
Adresse serveur NTP Tapez l'adresse du serveur NTP (jusqu'à 255 caractères, – . inclus
uniquement, format : "***.***.***.***" ou FQDN).
Numéro de port Entrez le port du serveur NTP (plage d'entrée : 1 à 65535).
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-75
Onglet Système — Paramètres Machine
Vous pouvez modifier les paramètres de la machine.
Sous-menu Description
Nom périphérique Spécifiez le nom du périphérique (jusqu'à 255 caractères).
Emplacement du
périphérique
Spécifiez l'emplacement du périphérique (jusqu'à 255 caractères).
Nom de l'administrateur Spécifiez le nom de l'administrateur (jusqu'à 255 caractères).
Numéro extension Définissez le numéro d'extension (jusqu'à huit caractères alphanumériques
et symboles).
11 Divers réglages
11-76 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Info sur le périphérique
Sous l'onglet Système, cliquez sur [Info sur le périphérique] et sélectionnez
ensuite chaque paramètre (Consommables, Bac d'entrée, etc.).
Cette page affiche la configuration et l'état de cet appareil.
2
Remarque
La rubrique affichée est la même que sur l'onglet Système dans "Info sur
le périphérique" en mode Utilisateur.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-77
Onglet Système — Version ROM
Affiche la version ROM.
11 Divers réglages
11-78 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Compteur
Sous l'onglet Système cliquez sur [Compteur] dans le menu.
Vous pouvez contrôler les compteurs que gère cet appareil.
Sous-menu Description
Compteur total Affiche le total du compteur de sortie (copies, impressions, numérisations
et fax).
Compteur de copies Affiche chaque compteur.
Compteur d'impressions
Compteur Numéris.
(Apparaît comme Compteur
Numéris./Fax si le
kit Fax en option est installé.)
Compteur format/type
papier
Affiche le compteur du format et du type de papier.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-79
Onglet Système — Assistance en ligne
Vous pouvez modifier les informations d'assistance en ligne. Pour afficher
ces informations, cliquez sur l'onglet Système en mode utilisateur et cliquez
ensuite sur [Assistance en ligne].
Onglet Système — Entretien — Effacer la config. réseau
Vous pouvez rétablir la configuration réseau départ usine de cet appareil.
Pour procéder au rétablissement, cliquez sur [Effacer].
Sous-menu Description
Nom de la personne de
contact
Spécifiez le nom du contact (jusqu'à 63 caractères).
Information sur la personne
de contact
Spécifiez les informations du contact (jusqu'à 127 caractères).
URL aide produit Spécifiez l'URL de la page Internet des informations produit (jusqu'à
127 caractères, sauf < >).
URL d'entreprise Spécifiez l'URL de la page Internet du fabricant (jusqu'à 127 caractères,
sauf < >).
Fournitures et accessoires Spécifiez les informations de contact pour les fournitures et les
accessoires (jusqu'à 127 caractères).
11 Divers réglages
11-80 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2
Remarque
Si vous effacez les paramètres après avoir terminé la configuration, vous
ne pourrez pas vous connecter à Web Connection avant que les réglages
ne soient réinitialisés.
Si le mode de sécurité avancé est activé, ce menu ne s'affichera pas.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-81
Onglet Système — Entretien — Réinitialisation
Réinitialise le contrôleur d'impression.
Pour procéder à la réinitialisation, cliquez sur [Réinitialisation].
11 Divers réglages
11-82 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Entretien — Formater ttes destinations
Toutes les destinations sont effacées.
Pour procéder au formatage, cliquez sur [Format], puis sur [OK].
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-83
Onglet Système — Paramètres notification statut
Quand une erreur survient sur cet appareil, la personne enregistrée est
avertie.
Entrez l'heure de notification et cliquez ensuite sur [Appliquer].
11 Divers réglages
11-84 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Cliquez sur l'icône [Editer] à la droite d'une adresse de notification pour
spécifier l'adresse de destination et les conditions de notification.
Sous-menu Description
Adresse de notification Tapez l'adresse e-mail de destination de notification (320 caractères
max.).
Remplir bac papier Avertit quand il n'y a plus de papier.
BOURRAGE Avertit en cas de bourrage papier.
Appel PM Avertit en cas d'entretien programmé.
Ajouter pile Avertit quand il n'y a plus d'agrafes.
Remettre toner Avertit quand il n'y a plus de toner.
Bac de finition plein Avertit quand le bac de finition est plein.
Appel service aprèsvente
Avertit en cas d'appel service après-vente.
Fin du travail Avertit quand une tâche est terminée (terminée normalement).
Collecteur de perforat.
plein
Avertit que la boîte de déchets de perforation doit être vidée.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-85
2
Remarque
L'emplacement de l'imprimante mentionnée dans l'e-mail envoyé par la
fonction de notification d'état se saisit dans "Position imprimante" sur
l'onglet Réseau — Paramètre IPP. Pour "Position imprimante", voir
"Impression IPP (Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003
x64)" à la page 4-14.
11 Divers réglages
11-86 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système – Configuration rapport compteur total
Vous pouvez enregistrer les paramètres de notification du compteur total par
e-mail ainsi que l'adresse e-mail de notification.
Entrez tous les éléments et cliquez sur [Appliquer] pour spécifier les
paramètres. Après spécification des paramètres, cliquez sur [Envoyer
maintenant] pour envoyer la notification par e-mail.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-87
Sous-menu Description
Config. rapport compteur
total (Pseudonyme
périphérique)
Entrez le nom du modèle à afficher dans la liste (jusqu'à 20 caractères
alphanumériques et symboles).
Configuration de calendrier
Spécifie les conditions du calendrier de notification. Vous pouvez enregistrer
des réglages différents pour le calendrier 1 et 2.
Adresse de notification Tapez l'adresse e-mail de destination de notification (320 caractères
max.). Il est possible de sélectionner un calendrier de notification pour
l'adresse entrée.
11 Divers réglages
11-88 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Authentification d'utilisateur — Enregist. utilis.
En cas d'authentification utilisateur sur cette machine, vous pouvez
enregistrer les utilisateurs pouvant se connecter.
Vous pouvez enregistrer un utilisateur dans "Nouvel enregistrement".
Cliquez sur l'icône [Editer] à la droite d'un nom d'utilisateur pour modifier
les conditions d'un utilisateur enregistré.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-89
Vous pouvez spécifier les conditions d'un utilisateur en saisissant chaque
rubrique et en cliquant sur [Appliquer].
Sous-menu Description
Enregist. utilis. Entrez le nom d'utilisateur et le mot de passe.
N° : numéro affecté pour le compteur d'utilisateur (jusqu'à 1000)
Nom d'utilisateur : 1 à 64 caractères
Adresse E-Mail : jusqu'à 320 caractères
Mot de passe : jusqu'à 64 caractères, sauf " +
Permission Fonction Spécifiez les fonctions utilisables sur cette machine.
Définir crédit Spécifiez la valeur maximale pouvant être utilisée.
11 Divers réglages
11-90 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Système — Authentification d'utilisateur — Perm. par Défaut
Fonctions
Vous pouvez spécifier les valeurs par défaut des fonctions limitées sur la
page d'enregistrement d'utilisateur.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-91
Onglet Système — Enregistrement Compte
En cas de suivi de volume sur cette machine ; vous pouvez enregistrer le
compte à gérer.
Vous pouvez enregistrer un compte dans "Nouvel enregistrement". Cliquez
sur l'icône [Editer] à la droite d'un nom de compte pour modifier les
conditions d'un compte enregistré.
11 Divers réglages
11-92 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Vous pouvez spécifier les données du compte en complétant tous les
champs, puis en cliquant sur [Appliquer].
Sous-menu Description
Enregistrement Compte Permet d'entrer le nom et le mot de passe du compte.
N° : numéro affecté pour le compteur de comptes (jusqu'à 1000)
Nom de compte : 1 à 8 caractères, sauf " +
Mot de passe : 1à 8 caractères, sauf " +
Définir crédit Spécifiez la valeur maximale pouvant être utilisée.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-93
Onglet Système — Mot de passe de l'administrateur
Le mot de passe administrateur peut être modifié.
2
Remarque
Le mot de passe ne peut être changé dans le mode sécurité.
11 Divers réglages
11-94 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Tâche — Historique tâches
Sous l'onglet Tâches, cliquez sur [Historique tâches] dans le menu.
Sélectionnez chaque fonction (opérations d'impression et de numérisation)
par type de tâche.
Vous pouvez vérifier les tâches terminées.
Exemple de page imprimée
2
Remarque
La rubrique affichée est la même que sur l'onglet Tâche dans "Historique
tâches" en mode Utilisateur.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-95
Onglet Impression
L'onglet Impression comporte des informations et des réglages relatifs à
l'interface de connexion et aux paramètres d'impression par défaut.
Onglet Impression — Interface
Vous pouvez modifier les paramètres de temporisation d'interface.
2
Remarque
Les rubriques affichées peuvent varier en fonction des différentes
options installées.
Sous-menu Description
Temporisation parallèle Entrez la temporisation de réception pour le port parallèle (plage
d'entrée : 10 à 1000).
Temporisation réseau Entrez la temporisation de réception pour le réseau (plage d'entrée :
10 à 1000).
Temporisation USB Entrez la temporisation USB (plage d'entrée : 10 à 1000).
11 Divers réglages
11-96 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Impression — Paramètre Port RAW
Vous pouvez vérifier l'efficacité du port RAW.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-97
Onglet Impression — Réglage par défaut — Réglage général
Vous pouvez spécifier les valeurs de réglage par défaut de l'imprimante.
Sous-menu Description
Paramètre PDL Sélectionnez la languie de description de l'imprimante.
Bac papier Permet de sélectionner le bac papier.
Bac de sortie Permet de sélectionner le bac de sortie.
Impression recto-verso Permet de désélectionner l'impression recto-verso.
Type de reliure Sélectionnez la position de la marge de reliure.
Agrafer Sélectionnez la fonction d'agrafage.
Perforation Sélectionnez la fonction de perforation.
Nombre de jeux Sélectionnez le nombre de copies à imprimer.
Format de papier par
défaut
Sélectionnez un format papier.
Orientation original Permet de sélectionner l'orientation d'impression.
Spool tâche dans HDD
avant RIP
Sélectionnez la fonction de spoule sur disque dur.
Réglage Bannière Indiquez s'il faut imprimer les bandeaux.
11 Divers réglages
11-98 IC-202 (Phase 2)
2
Remarque
Les rubriques affichées peuvent varier en fonction des différentes
options installées.
Bac pour bandeau Sélectionne le bac papier à utiliser pour l'impression des bandeaux.
Définition Papier inadéquat
magasin
Sélectionne l'opération lorsque le bac d'entrée ne contient pas le papier
approprié.
Changer bacs (Priorité bac) : alimente le papier à partir d'un autre
bac papier.
Stop impression (magasin fixe) : affiche un message d'avertissement
sans imprimer.
A4/A3 <-> LTR/LGR
Auto Switch
Décidez d'imprimer des documents 8-1/2 e 11 (A4)/11 e 17 (A3)
quand la source papier A4 (8-1/2 e 11)/A3 (11 e 17) est sélectionnée.
Sous-menu Description
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-99
Onglet Impression — Réglage par défaut — Configuration PCL
Vous pouvez spécifier les valeurs de réglage par défaut du mode PCL.
Sous-menu Description
Caractères Sélectionnez la police.
Jeu de symboles Sélectionnez le jeu de caractères.
Taille caractères Spécifiez l'espacement de la police (plage d'entrée : 0,44 à 99,00) ou
la taille du point de la police (plage d'entrée : 4,00 à 999,75) selon la
police sélectionnée.
Ligne/Page Entrez le nombre de lignes par page (plage d'entrée : 5 à 128).
Mappage CR/LF Sélectionnez le mode CR/LF.
11 Divers réglages
11-100 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Impression — Réglage par défaut — Configuration PS
Vous pouvez spécifier les valeurs de réglage par défaut du mode PS.
Sous-menu Description
Erreur impression PS Spécifiez s'il faut activer l'impression des erreurs.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-101
Onglet Lecture
L'onglet Lecture permet d'afficher les réglages lors de l'émission et les
informations et les réglages relatifs aux limitations de carnet d'adresses.
11 Divers réglages
11-102 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Onglet Réseau
L'onglet Réseau affiche des informations et des réglages relatifs à la
connexion réseau.
Onglet Réseau — Paramètre TCP/IP— Paramètre TCP/IP
Vous permet de spécifier les paramètres TCP/IP.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-103
2
Remarque
Pour une méthode détaillée de l'onglet Réseau, reportez-vous au
"Guide de l'utilisateur (Opérations Scanner réseau)".
11 Divers réglages
11-104 IC-202 (Phase 2)
11.4 Gestion des tâches d'impression
Spécification des opérations d'impression
% Vous pouvez spécifier le fonctionnement des tâches sur cet appareil en
configurant le pilote d'imprimante.
2
Remarque
Les trois pilotes d'imprimante utilisables sur cette machine sont les
suivants :
Pilote d'imprimante PCL pour Windows
Pilote d'imprimante PS pour Windows 2000/XP/
Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64
Pilote d'imprimante pour Mac OS X
Spécification des réglages (pour Windows)
1 Cliquez sur [Propriétés] dans la boîte de dialogue Imprimer pour ouvrir
la boîte de dialogue de configuration du pilote d'imprimante.
2 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration (pilote PCL ou PostScript).
3 A partir de la zone de liste déroulante "Type de sortie", sélectionnez la
méthode de sortie.
Impression : imprime immédiatement.
Impression sécurisée : insère l'ID et le mot de passe sur le panneau de
contrôle de cet appareil, avant d'imprimer. (jusqu'à 100 documents)
Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur : enregistre le document à imprimer dans
une boîte de cet appareil.
Enr. dns boîte utilis, imprim. : enregistre le document dans une boîte et
l'imprime simultanément.
Attente avec épreuve : après l'impression d'une partie du document,
cet appareil s'arrête provisoirement d'imprimer. Sélectionnez pour
éviter de mal imprimer un grand volume de tâches d'impression.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-105
!
Détails
Pour plus de détails, voir "Sélectionner le type de sortie" à la page 6-18
et page 7-25.
11 Divers réglages
11-106 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Spécification des réglages (pour Mac OS X)
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Sécurité".
3 Spécifiez les paramètres des éléments suivants :
Imprimer : Spécifie les conditions pour "Impression sécurisée" et
"Tâches en attente".
Impression sécurisée : insère ID et mot de passe quand "Impression
sécurisée" est sélectionné dans "Type de sortie". Tapez l'ID et le mot
de passe sur le panneau de contrôle de cet appareil quand vous
imprimez. (jusqu'à 100 documents)
Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur : insère le nom de fichier et le numéro de
boîte quand "Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur" ou "Enr. dns boîte utilis,
imprim." est sélectionné dans "Type de sortie".
Attente avec épreuve : après l'impression d'un exemplaire du
document, cet appareil s'arrête provisoirement d'imprimer.
Sélectionnez pour éviter de mal imprimer un grand volume de
tâches d'impression.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-107
Stockage des tâches
En fonction des réglages de "Type de sortie" du pilote d'imprimante, un
document d'impression peut être stocké dans cet appareil comme tâche
d'impression.
Pour imprimer une tâche stockée, vous devez rappeler la tâche à partir du
panneau de contrôle de cet appareil.
Rappeler la tâche
Vous pouvez rappeler une tâche enregistrée dans la machine depuis
"Impression sécurisée" ou "Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur".
11 Divers réglages
11-108 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Impression sécurisée
1 Appuyez sur [Boîte] sur le panneau
de contrôle.
2 Appuyez sur [Boîte Ut. système] et [Boîte RX sécurisé].
3 Tapez l'ID et mot de passe définis au moment de l'impression.
4 Sélectionnez une tâche à imprimer et appuyez sur [Imprimer].
5 Appuyez sur [Départ] pour commencer à imprimer.
2
Remarque
Vous pouvez modifier l'agrafage, le pliage et d'autres paramètres en
appuyant sur [Modifier]. (Certains paramètres ne peuvent pas être
modifiés.)
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-109
Enregistrer dans boîte utilisateur
1 Appuyez sur [Boîte] sur le panneau
de contrôle.
2 Appuyez sur [Boîte Ut. publique] et ensuite sur [Numéro de boîte] défini
au moment de l'impression.
3 Sélectionnez une tâche à imprimer et appuyez sur [Imprimer].
4 Appuyez sur [Départ] pour commencer à imprimer.
2
Remarque
Vous pouvez modifier l'agrafage, le pliage et d'autres paramètres en
appuyant sur [Modifier]. (Certains paramètres ne peuvent pas être
modifiés.)
11 Divers réglages
11-110 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Imprimer à l'aide du paramètre de suivi de volume
Si les paramètres de Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.) ont été spécifiés sur cet
appareil, vous devez saisir un mot de passe lors de l'impression d'une tâche.
2
Remarque
Si une tâche d'impression est envoyée avec un nom de service ou un mot
de passe ne correspondant pas à un service enregistré sur cet appareil,
ou si un travail est envoyé sans cocher la case "Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.)",
une erreur va survenir. Vérifiez le "Liste Impress." à l'aide du panneau de
contrôle de cet appareil.
Les trois pilotes d'imprimante utilisables sur cette machine sont les
suivants : pilote d'imprimante PCL pour Windows
Pilote d'imprimante PS pour Windows 2000/XP/
Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64
Pilote d'imprimante pour Mac OS X
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-111
Spécification des réglages (pour Windows)
1 Cliquez sur [Propriété] dans la boîte de dialogue Imprimer pour afficher
la boîte de dialogue Options d'impression.
2 Cliquez sur l'onglet Configuration (pilote PCL ou PostScript).
3 Cliquez sur [Authentification/Suivi de Volume E.K.C.].
4 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.)", puis
saisissez le nom du service et le mot de passe.
Vous pouvez enregistrer un nom de service par défaut et l'utiliser au
lieu de saisir un service pour chaque tâche.
5 Après avoir spécifié les paramètres, cliquez sur [OK] pour commencer
à imprimer.
Si le nom de service saisi est un nom enregistré sur cet appareil, la
tâche sera imprimée et comptée comme tâche du service concerné.
11 Divers réglages
11-112 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Spécification des réglages (pour Mac OS X)
1 Dans le menu "Fichier", sélectionnez "Imprimer".
2 Sélectionnez "Sécurité".
3 Sélectionnez la case à cocher "Suivi de Volume (E.K.C.)", puis
saisissez le nom du service et le mot de passe.
Divers réglages 11
IC-202 (Phase 2) 11-113
Fonctions de travaux dans Web Connection
Vous pouvez aussi contrôler l'état du travail en cours d'exécution par
l'appareil dans Web Connection.
Pour de plus amples détails, voir les pages suivantes.
- "Onglet Tâche — Tâches en cours" à la page 11-65
- "Onglet Tâche — Historique tâches" à la page 11-67
11 Divers réglages
11-114 IC-202 (Phase 2)
12 Dépannage
Dépannage 12
IC-202 (Phase 2) 12-3
12 Dépannage
12.1 Impossible d'imprimer
Ce chapitre décrit les procédures de dépannage permettant de remédier aux
dysfonctionnements.
Exécutez les procédures de dépannage décrites ci-dessous si cet appareil
n'imprime pas après que vous avez envoyé une tâche d'impression.
Symptôme Cause probable Dépannage
Le message "Aucune
imprimante n'est connectée."
ou "Erreur
impress." apparaît.
Le pilote d'imprimante sélectionné
pour l'impression n'est pas
compatible avec le contrôleur
d'impression.
Vérifier le nom de l'imprimante
sélectionnée.
Le câble réseau, le câble parallèle
ou le câble USB est débranché.
Vérifiez que le câble est correctement
branché.
Une erreur est survenue sur cet
appareil.
Vérifiez le panneau de contrôle de
cet appareil.
L'espace mémoire disponible est
insuffisant.
Effectuez un test d'impression
pour vérifier si l'impression est
possible.
Une erreur postscript
apparaît.
L'espace mémoire disponible de
l'ordinateur est insuffisant.
Effectuez un test d'impression
pour vérifier si l'impression est
possible.
Les paramètres logiciels de l'application
sont erronés.
Consultez le manuel du logiciel
d'application pour vérifier les paramètres.
Les paramètres d'impression du
fichier sont incorrects.
Modifiez les paramètres et essayez
d'imprimer une nouvelle
fois.
12 Dépannage
12-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Si le problème persiste après exécution de toutes ces procédures, reportezvous
au manuel utilisateur 750/600 [Opérations de Copie].
L'appareil ne commence
pas à imprimer
bien que la tâche
d'impression ait été
réalisée sur l'ordinateur.
Le pilote d'imprimante sélectionné
pour l'impression n'est pas
compatible avec le contrôleur
d'impression.
Vérifier le nom de l'imprimante
sélectionnée.
Une erreur est survenue sur cet
appareil.
Vérifiez le panneau de contrôle de
cet appareil.
Une tâche d'impression se trouve
dans la file d'attente de l'appareil,
ce qui retarde l'impression.
Vérifiez l'ordre de travail sur
l'écran Liste des tâches actives
du panneau de contrôle de l'appareil.
"Enreg. dans boîte utilisateur"
était sélectionné pour la tâche
d'impression.
Vérifiez si la tâche d'impression figure
sur l'écran Boîte du panneau
de contrôle de cet appareil.
"Impression sécurisée" était sélectionné
pour la tâche d'impression.
Vérifiez si la tâche d'impression
est retenu sur l'écran Boîte Impression
sécurisée du panneau
de contrôle de cet appareil.
Si des paramètres de suivi de volume
ont été appliqués, un nom
de service (ou mot de passe) non
enregistré peut avoir été saisi.
Tapez le nom de service (ou mot
de passe) correct.
L'espace mémoire disponible de
l'ordinateur est insuffisant.
Effectuez un test d'impression
pour vérifier si l'impression est
possible.
Symptôme Cause probable Dépannage
Dépannage 12
IC-202 (Phase 2) 12-5
12.2 Impossible de définir les paramètres voulus ou
impossible d'imprimer comme indiqué
Exécutez ces procédures de dépannage s'il vous est impossible de définir
les paramètres voulus du pilote d'imprimante ou si les résultats d'impression
ne correspondent pas aux paramètres définis.
2
Remarque
Certaines des fonctions du pilote d'imprimante ne peuvent pas être
combinées avec d'autres fonctions.
Symptôme Cause probable Dépannage
Impossible de sélectionner
un paramètre
de pilote d'imprimante.
Certaines fonctions ne peuvent
pas se combiner.
Ne pas essayer de sélectionner
les paramètres qui ne sont pas
disponibles.
Le message "Conflit"
apparaît avec "Impossible
de sélectionner"
ou "Fonction".
Vous avez indiqué une combinaison
incorrecte de fonctions.
Vérifiez les paramètres et spécifiez
les fonctions correctement.
L'impression ne s'exécute
pas comme indiqué.
Des paramètres incorrects ont été
spécifiés.
Vérifiez chaque paramètre du pilote
d'imprimante.
Une combinaison de fonctions,
autorisée par le pilote d'imprimante,
est impossible avec cet
appareil.
Le format du papier, son orientation
et d'autres paramètres indiqués
dans l'application sont plus
importants (priorité) que ceux
spécifiés dans le pilote d'imprimante.
Entrez les paramètres corrects
dans l'application.
Le filigrane ne peut
pas être imprimé.
Le filigrane n'est pas correctement
défini.
Contrôlez les paramètres de filigrane.
La densité du filigrane est réglée à
un niveau trop bas.
Contrôlez les paramètres de densité.
Les filigranes ne peuvent pas être
imprimés dans les applications
graphiques.
Aucun filigrane ne peut être imprimé
dans ce cas.
La fonction d'agrafage
ne peut pas être définie.
L'agrafage est impossible si
"Type de media" est réglé sur
"Epais" ou "Transparent".
Vérifiez chaque paramètre du pilote
d'imprimante.
La fonction d'agrafage nécessite
un module de finition en option
(pas le SF-601).
Installez le module de finition supplémentaire
requis et activez-le à
l'aide du pilote d'imprimante.
12 Dépannage
12-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Agrafage impossible. Vous pouvez agrafer jusqu'à
100 feuilles de papier ordinaire au
format A4 ou inférieur avec le module
FS-505 et 50 feuilles avec le
module FS-504 ou 602.
Modifiez le paramétrage Copies.
Nombre de pages pouvant être
agrafé au milieu (piqûre à cheval)
quand le module FS-602 est
installé : jusqu'à 20 pages de papier
ordinaire.
L'agrafage est impossible si le document
comporte des pages de
différents formats.
Vérifiez le document.
La position d'agrafage
n'est pas celle qui est
attendue.
Le paramètre d'orientation est incorrect.
Vérifiez la position d'agrafage
dans la boîte de dialogue d'installation
du pilote d'imprimante.
La fonction de perforation
ne peut pas être
définie.
Vous ne pouvez pas définir la
fonction de perforation si "Livret",
"Transparent" est sélectionné.
Vérifiez chaque paramètre du pilote
d'imprimante.
Si un module de finition (à l'exception
du SF-601) est installé en
option, en outre, le kit de perforation
ou de perforation et de pliage
en Z doit être installé.
Installez le module de finition supplémentaire
requis et activez-le à
l'aide du pilote d'imprimante.
Les pages ne sont pas
perforées.
Il se peut que les pages imprimées
soient introduites sans être
perforées si le papier chargé dans
la source papier n'a pas l'orientation
correcte.
Vérifiez le paramètre d'orientation.
La position de perforation
n'est pas celle qui
est attendue.
Le paramètre d'orientation est incorrect.
Vérifiez la position de perforation
sur l'onglet Disposition page de la
boîte de dialogue d'installation du
pilote d'imprimante.
Le formulaire ne s'imprime
pas correctement.
L'espace mémoire disponible de
l'ordinateur est insuffisant.
Simplifiez le formulaire pour réduire
la taille des données.
L'image ne s'imprime
pas correctement.
L'espace mémoire disponible de
l'ordinateur est insuffisant.
Simplifiez l'image pour réduire la
taille des données.
Le papier n'est pas
chargé à partir de la
source spécifiée.
Le papier peut ne pas provenir de
la source spécifiée si cette source
est chargée avec du papier de format
et d'orientation différents.
Chargez la source papier avec du
papier du format et de l'orientation
appropriée.
Symptôme Cause probable Dépannage
13 Annexe
Annexe 13
IC-202 (Phase 2) 13-3
13 Annexe
13.1 Spécifications
Sous-menu Spécifications
Modèle Contrôleur d'impression intégré
Alimentation Commune avec le corps principal
Processeur Commune avec le corps principal
ROM Commune avec le corps principal
RAM Commune avec le corps principal
Interface Identique à celle du corps principal.
Type de trames Ethernet 802.2
Ethernet 802.3
Ethernet II
Ethernet SNAP
Protocoles supportés TCP/IP
IPX/SPX
NetBEUI
AppleTalk (EtherTalk)
Bonjour
Vitesse d'impression ineo 750 : 75 pages/minute
ineo 600 : 60 pages/minute
(A4 600 x 600 dpi)
Temps de sortie première page Identique au temps de première impression du corps principal.
Langage de description de page PCL5e
PCL6
PostScript 3
Conditions ambiantes d'exploitation
Identique à celle du corps principal.
Résolution Définition des
données
600 e 600 dpi
Définition de
sortie
600 e 2400 dpi (équivalent)
Formats de papier supportés Identique à celle du corps principal.
Polices d'imprimante PCL Latin 80 polices Postscript 3 Emulation Latin
137 polices
Ordinateurs compatibles Compatible IBM PC
Macintosh
13 Annexe
13-4 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Systèmes
d'exploitation
compatibles
Serveur Windows NT 4.0/2000/Server 2003/Server 2003 x64
Client Windows 98SE/Me
Windows 2000/XP/XP x64
Windows NT 4.0
MacOS 9.x/MacOS X 10.2/10.3/10.4
Pilote d'imprimante PCL6 :
• Pilote d'imprimante Windows 98SE/Me
• Pilote d'imprimante Windows NT 4.0
• Pilote d'imprimante Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003
PS
• Pilote d'imprimante Windows NT 4.0/2000/XP/
Server 2003
• Pilote d'imprimante Windows XP x64/Server 2003 x64
PS3 (PPD PostScript) :
• FIchier PPD Windows 98SE/Me
• Fichier PPD Windows NT 4.0
• Fichier PPD Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003
• Fichier PPD Windows XP x64/Server 2003 x64
• Fichier PPD MacOS 9.x
• Fichier PPD MacOS X 10.2/10.3/10.4
Environnements d'exploitation
MetaFrame
Les opérations de ce pilote d'imprimante ne sont contrôlées
que dans les environnements suivants.
Système d'exploitation
du serveur :
Windows 2000 Serveur Avancé/
Windows 2003 Serveur
Entreprise
MetaFrame : Citrix® MetaFrame XP® Presentation
Server, Feature Release
3 Citrix® MetaFrame®
Presentation Server 3.0
Prévu pour être compatible
Citrix Presentation Server4.0
Système d'exploitation
du client :
Windows 2000/Windows XP
ICAClient : ICA32bit
Pour des opérations dans des configurations autres que
celles ci-dessus, contactez votre S.A.V.
Utilitaires Web Connection
Navigateurs Internet :
Microsoft Internet Explorer 6 ou supérieur recommandé
Microsoft XML Parser MSXML3.X doit être installé si vous
utilisez Internet Explorer 5.X.
Netscape Navigator 7.02 ou supérieur (JavaScript activé,
Cookies activés)
J2RE (Java 2 Runtime Environment) obligatoire
Sous-menu Spécifications
Annexe 13
IC-202 (Phase 2) 13-5
13.2 Page de configuration
13 Annexe
13-6 IC-202 (Phase 2)
13.3 Liste des polices
Liste des polices PCL
Annexe 13
IC-202 (Phase 2) 13-7
Liste des polices PS
13 Annexe
13-8 IC-202 (Phase 2)
Page de test
Annexe 13
IC-202 (Phase 2) 13-9
13.4 Polices d'écran
Le CD-ROM ci-joint contient dans le dossier Screenfont, une police
TrueType différente des polices standard de Windows.
L'installation de la police d'écran sur votre système permet d'instaurer
l'environnement WYSIWYG de la police d'imprimante et de la police
TrueType. Cela peut permettre d'améliorer également les résultats
d'impression.
Procédure d'installation des polices True type
(Windows 98SE/Me/NT4.0/2000)
1 Cliquez sur [Démarrer] dans la barre des tâches.
2 Sélectionnez "Paramètres".
3 Sélectionnez "Panneau de configuration".
La fenêtre "Panneau de configuration" apparaît.
4 Double-cliquez sur l'icône [Polices].
– L'écran Windows 98SE sert ici d'illustration.
La fenêtre "Polices" apparaît.
13 Annexe
13-10 IC-202 (Phase 2)
5 Sélectionnez le menu "Fichier".
– Sélectionnez "Installer une nouvelle police".
– La boîte de dialogue "Ajouter police" apparaît.
6 Sélectionnez la police à ajouter dans le dossier "\ScreenFont\PCL" ou
dans le dossier "\ScreenFont\PostScript\win" du CD-ROM logiciel
utilisateur.
– Cochez la case "Copier dans le dossier Polices".
7 Cliquez sur [OK].
Annexe 13
IC-202 (Phase 2) 13-11
Procédure d'installation des polices True type
(Windows XP/Server 2003/XP x64/Server 2003 x64)
1 Cliquez sur [Démarrer] dans la barre des tâches.
2 Sélectionnez "Paramètres". (En fonction de la configuration de votre
ordinateur, "Paramètres" peut être indisponible. Dans un cas pareil,
passez à l'étape 3).
3 Sélectionnez "Panneau de configuration". Si "Basculer vers l'affichage
classique" apparaît sous "Panneau de configuration", cliquez dessus.
La fenêtre "Panneau de configuration" apparaît.
4 Faites un double clic sur l'icône "Polices".
– La fenêtre "Polices" apparaît.
– L'écran Windows XP sert ici d'illustration.
13 Annexe
13-12 IC-202 (Phase 2)
5 Sélectionnez le menu "Fichier" et choisissez "Installer une nouvelle
police".
La boîte de dialogue "Ajouter polices" apparaît.
6 Sélectionnez la police à ajouter dans le dossier "\ScreenFont\PCL" ou
"\ScreenFont\PostScript\win" du "CD-ROM logiciel utilisateur". À ce
moment, cochez la case "Copier les polices dans le dossier
Annexe 13
IC-202 (Phase 2) 13-13
desPolices".
7 Cliquez sur [OK].
13 Annexe
13-14 IC-202 (Phase 2)
13.5 Glossaire
Terme Définition
10Base-T/100Base-
TX/1000Base-TX
Une norme Ethernet, comprenant un câble constitué de paires de fils
de cuivre torsadés. La vitesse d'émission est de 10 Mbps avec
10Base-T, de 100 Mbps avec 100Base-TX et de 1000 Mbps avec
1000Base-TX.
Adobe® Flash® Logiciel ou format de fichier permettant de créer les contenus combinés
animation/son des graphiques vectoriels développés par Adobe
Systems (antérieurement Macromedia). La saisie au clavier et à
l'aide de la souris permet la manipulation de contenus interactifs. La
taille des fichiers reste relativement faible et leur navigation est rendue
possible par l'introduction du plugin spécifique au navigateur
Internet.
Adresse IP Code (adresse) utilisé pour identifier des périphériques réseau distincts
sur Internet. Le numéro est formé de quatre groupes de chiffres
(au plus trois chiffres), comme dans 192.168.1.10. Les adresses
IP sont affectées à des périphériques comme les ordinateurs qui
sont connectés à Internet.
Adresse MAC Acronyme de Adresse Media Access Control (Adresse de contrôle
d'accès au support). Grâce à un numéro ID spécial pour chaque carte
Ethernet, il est possible d'envoyer et de recevoir les données entre
les cartes. Un nombre comporte 48 bits. Les 24 premiers bits sont
constitués d'un nombre spécial pour chaque fabricant contrôlant et
affectant IEEE. Les 24 derniers bits correspondent au numéro unique
attribuée à la carte par le fabricant.
Aperçu Fonction vous permettant de voir une image avant d'effectuer une
tâche d'impression ou de numérisation.
AppleTalk Nom générique de la suite de protocole développée par Apple
Computer pour la mise en réseau d'ordinateurs.
bit Abréviation de Binary Digit (chiffre binaire). La plus petite unité d'information
(quantité de données) sur un ordinateur ou une imprimante.
Affiche les données avec 0 ou 1.
BMP Acronyme de bitmap. Un format de fichier pour sauvegarder les données
d'image qui utilise l'extension .bmp. Généralement utilisé sur
les plates-formes Windows. Vous pouvez spécifier l'intensité de
couleur de monochrome (2 valeurs) à couleur (16 777 216 couleurs).
Généralement, les images ne sont pas comprimées lors de la sauvegarde.
Bonjour Technologie réseau de Macintosh (Mac OS X uniquement) qui détecte
automatiquement un périphérique connecté au réseau. Désignée
sous le terme "Rendez-vous" jusqu'à la version 10.3 modifié à
partir de la version 10.4.
BOOTP Acronyme de BOOTstrap Protocol. C'est un protocole permettant à
un ordinateur client sur un réseau TCP/IP de spécifier automatiquement
les paramètres réseau sur un serveur. Actuellement, on utilise
essentiellement DHCP, qui est un protocole de pointe basé sur
BOOTP.
Client Ordinateur qui utilise les services fournis par un serveur sur un
réseau.
Annexe 13
IC-202 (Phase 2) 13-15
CMYK Acronyme de Cyan, Magenta, Yellow et Black (Cyan, Magenta, Jaune
et Noir). Les couleurs du toner et de l'encre utilisées pour l'impression
couleur peuvent toutes être représentées en modifiant le
taux de mélange des quatre couleurs de CMYK.
Désinstaller Pour désinstaller des logiciels installés sur un ordinateur.
DHCP Abréviation de Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. C'est un protocole
permettant à un ordinateur client sur un réseau TCP/IP de
spécifier automatiquement les paramètres réseau sur un serveur.
Avec la gestion collective de l'adresse IP pour les clients DHCP sur
le serveur DHCP, vous pouvez éviter toute duplication d'adresse et
aisément construire un réseau.
Disque dur Périphérique de stockage grande capacité pour sauvegarder des
données. Les données peuvent être sauvegardées même en cas de
mise hors tension.
DNS Abréviation pour Domain Name System. Un système d'acquisition
des adresses IP à partir de noms d'hôte sur un environnement de réseau.
DNS permet à l'utilisateur d'accéder à d'autres ordinateurs sur
un réseau en indiquant des noms d'hôtes au lieu d'adresses IP difficiles
à comprendre et à mémoriser.
DPI (dpi) Abréviation pour Dots Per Inch (points par pouce). Une unité de définition
utilisée par les imprimantes et les scanners. Indique combien
de points par pouce sont représentés dans une image. Plus la valeur
est élevée, plus la définition est importante.
Ethernet Norme de ligne d'émission LAN.
File d'attente Logiciel qui met en attente sur les périphériques les tâches d'impression
générées.
FTP Abréviation de File Transfer Protocol. Protocole de transfert de fichiers
sur Internet ou un Intranet sur le réseau TCP/IP.
HTTP Abréviation pour HyperText Transfer Protocol. C'est un protocole
utilisé pour envoyer et recevoir des données entre un serveur Internet
et un client (navigateur Internet). Possibilité d'échanger des documents
contentant des images, des enregistrements et des clips
vidéo avec les informations de forme expressives.
IEEE 1284 Acronyme de Institute of Electrical et Electronic Engineers 1284.
Standard de port parallèle élaboré pour les imprimantes.
imprimante locale Imprimante connectée à un port parallèle ou USB d'un ordinateur.
Imprimante partagée Paramétrage d'imprimante qui permet à l'imprimante d'être utilisée
par plusieurs ordinateurs connectés sur un serveur ou via réseau.
installer Pour installer du matériel, des systèmes d'exploitation, des applications
et des pilotes d'imprimante sur un ordinateur.
Interface parallèle Méthode de transfert des données pour l'envoi et la réception des
données de plusieurs signaux simultanés. IEEE 1284 est généralement
utilisé comme connexion d'imprimante.
IPP Abréviation de Internet Printing Protocol. Protocole qui envoie et reçoit
des données d'impression et contrôle les imprimantes sur Internet
sur un réseau TCP/IP. Les données peuvent aussi être envoyées
à des imprimantes distantes pour impression sur Internet.
Terme Définition
13 Annexe
13-16 IC-202 (Phase 2)
IPX/SPX Acronyme de Internetwork Packet eXchange/Sequenced Packet
eXchange. Protocole mis au point par Novel, Inc. et généralement
utilisé dans un environnement NetWare.
LAN Abréviation pour Local Area Network. C'est un réseau qui connecte
des ordinateurs sur le même étage, dans le même bâtiment, dans les
bâtiments avoisinants.
LPR/LPD Acronyme de Line Imprimante Request/Line Imprimante Daemon
(Requête d'imprimante ligne par ligne/Démon d'imprimante ligne par
ligne). Méthode d'impression sur un réseau dans un système
Windows NT ou UNIX. Avec TCP/IP, vous pouvez imprimer des données
à partir de Windows ou Unix sur une imprimante via un réseau.
Luminosité Luminosité d'un écran d'affichage.
Masq s/réseau Unité utilisée pour diviser un réseau TCP/IP en plusieurs petits réseaux
(sous-réseaux). Utilisé pour identifier les bits d'une adresse
réseau qui sont supérieurs à l'adresse IP.
Mémoire Périphérique de stockage temporaire des données. Quand l'appareil
est mis hors tension, les données peuvent être effacées ou non.
Mémoire tampon
d'imprimante
Secteur mémoire utilisé temporairement pour le traitement des données
d'une tâche d'impression.
Navigateur Internet Logiciel comme Internet Explorer et Netscape Navigator utilisé pour
afficher des pages Internet.
NDPS Acronyme de Novell Distributed Print Services. Offre une solution
d'impression très efficace dans un environnement NDS. En utilisant
NDPS comme serveur d'impression, vous pouvez imprimer à partir
de l'imprimante désirée, télécharger automatiquement le pilote d'imprimante
d'une imprimante que vous venez d'installer, simplifier et
automatiser les environnements de gestion compliqués liés à l'utilisation
de l'imprimante et intégrer la gestion liée à l'imprimante réseau.
NDS Acronyme de Novell Directory Services. Les serveurs et les imprimantes
sur un réseau et les ressources partagées des informations
de l'utilisateur, ainsi que le niveau d'accès de l'utilisateur à ces éléments
peuvent être consolidés dans la structure hiérarchique.
NetBEUI Acronyme de NetBIOS Extended User Interface. Protocole réseau
développé par IBM. En indiquant tout simplement le nom de l'ordinateur,
vous pouvez construire un réseau à petite échelle.
NetBIOS Acronyme de Network Basic Input Output System. Interface de
communication développée par IBM.
NetWare Système d'exploitation réseau mis au point par Novell. NetWare
IPX/SPX est utilisé comme protocole de communication.
NImprimante/
RImprimante
Module de support d'imprimante distante pour utiliser une imprimante
réseau dans un environnement NetWare. Utilisez NetWare 3.x
avec RImprimante et NetWare 4.x avec NImprimante.
Niveau de gris Forme expressive d'image monochrome utilisant les informations de
dégradé du noir et du blanc.
File d'attente Logiciel qui met en attente sur les périphériques les tâches d'impression
générées.
Nom de la file d'attente Nom d'imprimante logique obligatoire pour l'impression réseau.
Terme Définition
Annexe 13
IC-202 (Phase 2) 13-17
Nom d'hôte Nom affiché d'un périphérique sur un réseau.
Octet Unité d'information (quantité de données) sur un ordinateur ou une
imprimante. Configurée comme suit : 1 octet équivaut à 8 bits.
OS Abréviation pour Operating System (système d'exploitation).
Logiciel de base contrôlant le système d'un ordinateur.
Passerelle Matériel et logiciel utilisé comme point de connexion d'un réseau au
réseau. Une passerelle change aussi les formats de données, les
adresses et les protocoles en fonction du réseau connecté.
Passerelle par défaut Périphérique (ordinateur ou routeur) utilisé comme "passerelle" pour
accéder à des ordinateurs ne se trouvant pas sur le même LAN.
PDF Abréviation de Portable Document Format. Un document formaté
électroniquement et utilisant l'extension .pdf. Basé sur le format
PostScript, vous pouvez utiliser le logiciel gratuit Adobe Acrobat
Reader pour visionner des documents.
PDL Acronyme de Page Description Language (Langage de description
de page). Langage utilisé pour spécifier l'image d'impression par
page pour une imprimante si vous imprimez avec une imprimante de
page.
Pilote Logiciel travaillant comme pont entre un ordinateur et un périphérique.
Plug and play Fonction permettant de trouver et d'utiliser automatiquement le pilote
approprié lors de la connexion d'un périphérique à un ordinateur.
Police d'écran Police d'affichage de texte et de symboles sur un écran CRT.
Police vectorielle Police utilisant des lignes et des courbes pour afficher le pourtour
d'un caractère. Permet d'afficher des caractères de grande taille sur
un écran ou d'imprimer sans bords dentelés.
PostScript Langage type de description de page mis au point par Adobe et généralement
utilisé pour l'impression de qualité supérieure.
PPD Acronyme de PostScript Printer Description (Description d'imprimante
PostScript). Fichier utilisé pour décrire la définition, le format
de papier utilisable et les informations spéciales relatives au modèle
d'imprimante PostScript.
Profil Fichier d'attribut couleur
Fichier dédié contenant la corrélation cumulée de l'entrée et la sortie
de chaque couleur primaire utilisée permettant aux périphériques
d'entrée et de sortie de couleur de reproduire la couleur.
Propriété Informations sur les attributs
Quand vous utilisez un pilote d'imprimante, plusieurs fonctions peuvent
être spécifiées dans les propriétés du fichier.
Les propriétés de fichier vous permettent de vérifier les informations
d'attribut du fichier.
Protocole Règles permettant à des ordinateurs de communiquer avec d'autres
ordinateurs ou périphériques.
PServer Module de serveur d'impression sous environnement NetWare qui
gère, change, suspend, relance ou annule une tâche d'impression.
Résolution Affiche la possibilité de reproduire correctement les détails des images
et des documents imprimés.
Terme Définition
13 Annexe
13-18 IC-202 (Phase 2)
RIP Acronyme de Raster Image Processor. Processeur qui rastérise les
images de données de texte décrites à l'aide du langage de description
de page PostScript. Le processeur est généralement intégré à
l'imprimante.
RVB Abréviation pour Rouge, Vert et Bleu. Représente toutes les couleurs
en changeant le taux de luminosité des 3 couleurs RVB à l'aide des
couleurs primaires utilisées pour la représentation couleur dans un
écran.
Serveur Proxy Serveur installé pour servir de connexion intermédiaire entre chaque
client et différents serveurs pour assurer la sécurité de manière efficace
sur tout le réseau pour les connexions Internet.
SLP Acronyme de Service Location Protocol. Protocole capable de trouver
des services sur un réseau TCP/IP et de spécifier automatiquement
un client.
SMB Abréviation de Server Message Block. Protocole qui partage des
fichiers et des imprimantes sur un réseau et principalement utilisé
par Microsoft Windows.
SMTP Abréviation de Simple Mail Transfer Protocol. Protocole d'envoi et
d'acheminement de courrier électronique.
SNMP Abréviation de Simple Network Management Protocol. Protocole de
gestion utilisant TCP/IP dans un environnement réseau.
Spoule En anglais Spool : Acronyme de Simultaneous Peripheral Operation
On-Line. Lors de l'impression, les données ne sont pas directement
envoyées à l'imprimante, elles sont stockées provisoirement dans
un autre emplacement, puis envoyées en bloc à l'imprimante.
Tâche d'impression Requête d'impression émise d'un ordinateur vers un périphérique
d'impression.
TCP/IP Abréviation de Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol. Le
protocole standard par défaut utilisé par Internet et utilisant des
adresses IP pour identifier chaque périphérique réseau.
Transparent Transparents de rétroprojection utilisés pour des présentations.
TrueType Police vectorielle mise au point par Apple Computer et Microsoft.
Norme utilisée par Macintosh et Microsoft Windows utilisable à la
fois pour l'affichage et l'impression.
Type de trames Type de format de communication utilisé dans un environnement
Netware.
La communication est impossible si les types de trames sont différents.
USB Acronyme de Universal Serial Bus. Interface standard générale de
connexion d'une souris, d'une imprimante et d'autres périphériques
à un ordinateur.
Terme Définition
Annexe 13
IC-202 (Phase 2) 13-19
13.6 Index
A
Agr./Réduction 5-13
Agrafage 5-20, 6-16, 9-6, 10-6,
11-19, 11-97
Agrafage central et pliage 6-17
Agrandissement et
réduction 5-13
Ajuster couleur 9-5
Assistant Ajout
d'imprimante 3-5
Attributs de
page 9-4, 9-8, 10-4, 10-8
Authentification 6-21, 10-7
Avancé... 8-4
B
Bac de sortie 9-6, 10-6, 11-97
Bac papier
5-14, 6-10, 11-15, 11-97
Bindery 4-18
Bordure 9-6, 10-5
C
Caractères 11-22
Combinaison 9-6, 10-6
Configuration PS 11-68
Connexion réseau 4-5
Conventions du manuel 1-11
Copies 9-5, 10-5, 11-6, 11-97
Copies & Pages 10-5
Couv. avc bac ins. 9-7
Couverture
5-24, 6-23, 7-32, 9-6, 10-6
Création de formulaires 6-38
D
Densité d'impression 9-7
Décalé 5-22, 9-6, 10-6
Dél. attent. paral 11-95
Dél. attent. rés. 11-95
Délai de connexion I/F 11-36
Désinstaller 3-22
Direction original 11-97
Disposition
9-6, 9-12, 10-3, 10-5, 10-13
Dos 5-24, 6-23, 7-32, 9-6, 10-6
Dos avec bac
d'insertion 9-7
E
Edition de formulaires 6-38
Enregistrer dans boîte
utilisateur 6-18, 10-7, 11-104
Epreuve et
impression 6-18, 11-104
Erreur d'impression PS 11-100
Erreur PS 11-30
É
Échelle 10-4
Émulation de bindery 4-18, 4-21
F
Filigrane 5-31, 5-35
Finition 9-6, 9-7, 10-17
Format de sortie 5-12
Format original 5-12
Format papier 10-4, 11-16, 11-97
Format papier
personnalisés 9-4, 10-4, 10-10
I
Impr. rapports 11-31
Impression 2-6, 9-5, 10-5
Impression de livret 5-16
Impression recto verso 5-16
Impression
recto-verso 11-17, 11-97
Opérations Fax
x Table des matières
C250 x-3
Table des matières
1 Introduction
1.1 Avis aux utilisateurs ......................................................................... 1-4
1.1.1 Canada ........................................................................................... 1-4
1.1.2 U.S.A. ............................................................................................. 1-4
1.1.3 Nouvelle-Zélande ........................................................................... 1-7
1.1.4 Europe ............................................................................................ 1-7
1.2 Mise en route (fax) ............................................................................ 1-8
1.3 Caractéristiques du télécopieur .................................................... 1-10
1.4 Conventions utilisées dans ce manuel ......................................... 1-22
1.5 Descriptions et symboles des documents et du papier ............. 1-24
1.5.1 “Largeur” et “Longueur” .............................................................. 1-24
1.5.2 Orientation du papier ................................................................... 1-24
1.6 Documentation ............................................................................... 1-25
2 Préliminaires
2.1 Restrictions ....................................................................................... 2-3
2.2 Tableau de commande ..................................................................... 2-4
2.2.1 Tableau de commande .................................................................. 2-4
2.3 Réglages de base ............................................................................. 2-7
2.3.1 Réglages indispensables ............................................................... 2-7
2.4 Fonctions utiles ................................................................................. 2-8
2.4.1 Carnet d'adresses .......................................................................... 2-8
2.4.2 Programme .................................................................................. 2-12
2.5 Écran Fax ......................................................................................... 2-15
2.6 Authentification utilisateur et compte de service ........................ 2-17
2.6.1 Si l'authentification utilisateur est paramétrée ............................. 2-17
2.6.2 Si le compte de service est paramétré ........................................ 2-17
2.7 Réception fax dans une boîte ........................................................ 2-18
2.7.1 Types de boîtes ............................................................................ 2-19
2.7.2 Fonctionnement de la Réception PC-fax ..................................... 2-21
x-4 C250
3 Émission
3.1 Émission simple de télécopie ...........................................................3-3
3.2 Positionnement de l'original sur la machine ...................................3-7
3.2.1 Utilisation du chargeur de document (ADF) ....................................3-7
3.2.2 Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition ..................3-8
3.2.3 Envoi de plusieurs originaux à partir de la vitre d'exposition .........3-9
3.2.4 Émission d'originaux avec le chargeur ADF et la vitre
d'exposition ..................................................................................3-10
3.3 Réglage des conditions d'émission ...............................................3-11
3.3.1 Type d'image original ....................................................................3-12
3.3.2 Densité ..........................................................................................3-13
3.3.3 Recto/Recto-verso ........................................................................3-14
3.3.4 Définition .......................................................................................3-15
3.3.5 Confirmation des réglages et des résultats de la communication 3-16
3.3.6 Enregistrement dans le carnet d'adresses à partir de l'écran
Vérifier détails de la tâche .............................................................3-19
3.4 Sélection de la destination .............................................................3-21
3.4.1 Sélection de la destination ............................................................3-21
3.4.2 Sélection de plusieurs destinations ..............................................3-28
3.4.3 Confirmation/Suppression d'une destination ...............................3-29
3.4.4 Rappel manuel ..............................................................................3-30
3.5 Numérisation ....................................................................................3-31
3.5.1 Lorsque la machine ne détecte pas le format d'origine ...............3-31
3.5.2 Lorsque la mémoire est saturée ...................................................3-31
3.5.3 Rotation automatique du document original ................................3-31
3.6 Lorsque l'émission ne s'effectue pas ............................................3-32
3.7 Réservation d'émission ...................................................................3-33
3.8 Émission manuelle ..........................................................................3-34
3.9 Annulation de l'émission .................................................................3-35
3.9.1 Annulation d'une communication en cours ..................................3-35
3.9.2 Annulation des tâches réservées ..................................................3-36
3.10 Confirmation de la liste de tâches .................................................3-37
3.11 Confirmation des résultats de la communication ........................3-38
C250 x-5
3.12 Émissions en mémoire et en mémoire rapide ............................. 3-41
3.12.1 Émission mémoire ........................................................................ 3-41
3.12.2 Émission en mémoire rapide ........................................................ 3-41
3.12.3 Pour émettre en mémoire rapide, procédez de la manière
suivante. ....................................................................................... 3-42
3.13 Nombre d'originaux ........................................................................ 3-44
3.14 Émission différée (TX) .................................................................... 3-47
3.15 Communications internationales .................................................. 3-50
3.16 Informations sur l'expéditeur ........................................................ 3-53
3.16.1 Réglage à l'intérieur du corps du texte ........................................ 3-53
3.16.2 Réglage à l'extérieur du corps du texte ....................................... 3-53
3.16.3 Réglage sur OFF .......................................................................... 3-54
4 Réception
4.1 Mode Réception ................................................................................ 4-3
4.1.1 Réception automatique (mode fax uniquement) ............................ 4-3
4.1.2 Réception manuelle (mode téléphone uniquement) ...................... 4-3
4.2 Réception automatique (mode fax uniquement) ........................... 4-4
4.3 Réception manuelle (mode téléphone uniquement) ..................... 4-5
4.4 Réception impossible ....................................................................... 4-6
4.5 Réception en mémoire de substitution .......................................... 4-7
4.6 Enregistrement de la réception ....................................................... 4-8
4.6.1 Enregistrement après réduction minimale ..................................... 4-8
4.6.2 Enregistrement après réduction pour convenir au papier
d'impression ................................................................................... 4-9
4.6.3 Enregistrement à l'échelle de 100 % ........................................... 4-16
4.7 Informations de réception ............................................................. 4-18
5 Dépannage
5.1 Impossible d'envoyer des messages .............................................. 5-3
5.2 Impossible de recevoir des messages ........................................... 5-4
5.3 Message d'erreur affiché ................................................................. 5-6
5.4 Appeler SAV ...................................................................................... 5-7
x-6 C250
6 Caractéristiques techniques
6.1 Caractéristiques techniques ............................................................6-3
7 Applications d'émission
7.1 Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et Réglage
communication ..................................................................................7-3
7.2 Présentation des fonctions d'application .......................................7-5
7.3 Originaux mixtes ................................................................................7-7
7.4 Position reliure ...................................................................................7-9
7.5 Émission avec effacement des bords ...........................................7-12
7.6 Ajustement fond ..............................................................................7-15
7.7 Netteté ..............................................................................................7-18
7.8 Format de numérisation ..................................................................7-21
7.9 Type de fichier .................................................................................7-24
7.10 Mot de passe émission (TX) ...........................................................7-26
7.11 Communication confidentielle (Émission F-code) .......................7-29
7.12 Requête d'émission en relais (Émission F-code) .........................7-32
7.13 ECM OFF ..........................................................................................7-35
7.14 V34 OFF ............................................................................................7-38
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8.1 Utilisation d'un document reçu en réception
confidentielle ......................................................................................8-3
8.1.1 Utilisation d'un document reçu en réception confidentielle ...........8-3
8.1.2 Impression du document reçu dans une boîte utilisateur
confidentielle ...................................................................................8-4
8.1.3 Suppression d'un document stocké dans une boîte utilisateur
confidentielle ...................................................................................8-5
8.2 Réception mémoire ...........................................................................8-6
8.2.1 Impression d'un document mémorisé ............................................8-6
8.2.2 Suppression d'un document mémorisé ..........................................8-8
8.3 Informations de réception ................................................................8-9
8.3.1 Informations sur la réception et l'impression recto-verso ..............8-9
C250 x-7
9 Relève
9.1 Émission en relève ............................................................................ 9-3
9.1.1 Émission en relève ......................................................................... 9-4
9.2 Réception en relève .......................................................................... 9-6
9.3 Bulletin ............................................................................................... 9-9
9.3.1 Écriture d'un document sur le bulletin board ............................... 9-10
9.3.2 Réception en relève d'un document placé sur le bulletin board
d'une destination (fax) .................................................................. 9-13
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10.1 Affichage de l'écran d'enregistrement du télécopieur ................ 10-3
10.2 Enregistrement du carnet d'adresses .......................................... 10-5
10.3 Enregistrement d'un groupe ........................................................ 10-19
10.4 Enregistrement d'un programme ................................................ 10-25
10.5 Enregistrement du sujet et du texte d'un e-mail ....................... 10-31
10.6 Réglage des boîtes confidentielles ............................................. 10-46
10.7 Réglage du bulletin (tableau électronique) ................................ 10-48
10.8 Réglage de la boîte utilisateur réception mémoire ................... 10-49
11 Mode Utilitaire
11.1 Écran mode Utilitaire ...................................................................... 11-3
11.1.1 Accès à l'écran Réglage Utilisateur ............................................. 11-3
11.1.2 Quitter l'écran Réglage Utilisateur ............................................... 11-4
11.1.3 Accès à l'écran Réglage Administrateur ...................................... 11-5
11.1.4 Quitter l'écran Réglage Administrateur ........................................ 11-6
11.2 Liste du mode Utilitaire fax ............................................................ 11-7
11.2.1 Écran FAX - réglage par défaut .................................................... 11-7
11.2.2 Écran Fax actif ............................................................................. 11-7
11.2.3 Réglage Initial ............................................................................... 11-7
11.2.4 Passage économie énergie (Fax) ................................................. 11-8
11.2.5 Système prioritaire (Réglages sortie Imprimante/Fax) ................. 11-8
11.2.6 Information en-tête ....................................................................... 11-8
11.2.7 Position en-tête / pied de page ................................................... 11-9
11.2.8 Réglage Paramètres ligne ............................................................ 11-9
11.2.9 Réglage Émission/Réception ..................................................... 11-10
x-8 C250
11.2.10 Réglage fonction .........................................................................11-11
11.2.11 Définir CN PBX ............................................................................11-12
11.2.12 Réglage Rapports .......................................................................11-13
11.2.13 Liste Paramètres tâche ...............................................................11-13
11.3 Écran Fax réglage par défaut .......................................................11-14
11.4 Réglage Initial ................................................................................11-17
11.5 Écran Fax actif ...............................................................................11-19
11.6 Passage économie énergie (Fax) .................................................11-22
11.7 Système prioritaire (Réglages sortie Imprimante/Fax) ..............11-25
11.8 Information en-tête .......................................................................11-28
11.9 Position en-tête/pied de page ......................................................11-31
11.10 Réglage Paramètres ligne ............................................................11-34
11.11 Réglage Émission/Réception .......................................................11-37
11.12 Réglage fonction ...........................................................................11-40
11.12.1 Réglage fonction ON/OFF ..........................................................11-40
11.12.2 Réception mémoire obligatoire ...................................................11-43
11.12.3 RX réseau fermé .........................................................................11-46
11.12.4 Réglage Transfert TX ..................................................................11-49
11.12.5 Vérification du mot de passe RX confidentiel .............................11-53
11.12.6 Réglage RX fax ...........................................................................11-56
11.12.7 Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI ...................................................11-61
11.13 Réglage CN PBX (Private Branch Exchange) .............................11-65
11.14 Réglage Rapports ..........................................................................11-67
12 Rapports et listes
12.1 Types de rapports et de listes ........................................................12-3
12.1.1 Rapports .......................................................................................12-3
12.1.2 Listes .............................................................................................12-4
12.2 Rapport d'activité ............................................................................12-5
12.2.1 Impression automatique ...............................................................12-5
12.2.2 Impression manuelle .....................................................................12-5
12.3 Rapport Émission ............................................................................12-9
12.3.1 Impression manuelle .....................................................................12-9
12.3.2 Impression automatique ...............................................................12-9
C250 x-9
12.4 Rapport d'émission (en relève) .................................................... 12-11
12.5 Rapport de relève ......................................................................... 12-13
12.6 Rapport de diffusion ..................................................................... 12-15
12.7 Rapport de relève séquentielle (réception) ................................ 12-17
12.8 Rapport de communication réservée ......................................... 12-19
12.9 Rapport d'émission réservée (relève) ......................................... 12-21
12.10 Rapport de diffusion réservée ..................................................... 12-23
12.11 Rapport de réception réservée (relève) ...................................... 12-25
12.12 Rapport de relève séquentielle réservée (réception) ................ 12-27
12.13 Rapport réception confidentielle ................................................ 12-29
12.14 Rapport Émission bulletin ............................................................ 12-31
12.15 Liste Carnet d'adresses ............................................................... 12-33
12.16 Liste d'adresses de groupe ......................................................... 12-36
12.17 Liste Programme .......................................................................... 12-39
12.18 Liste de Titres/Textes ................................................................... 12-42
12.19 Liste des réglages du fax ............................................................. 12-45
12.19.1 Liste confidentielle/bulletin ........................................................ 12-49
12.19.2 Boîte émetteur (TSI) ................................................................... 12-50
13 Annexe
13.1 Nombre de pages mémorisées ..................................................... 13-3
13.2 Saisie de texte ................................................................................. 13-4
13.3 Glossaire .......................................................................................... 13-7
13.4 Index .............................................................................................. 13-12
x-10 C250
1 Introduction
Introduction 1
C250 1-3
1 Introduction
Nous vous remercions d'avoir porté votre choix sur le photocopieur
électronique numérique Konica Minolta.
Ce manuel d'utilisation décrit les procédures d'utilisation des fonctions fax
de la machine, ainsi que les précautions à prendre. Veuillez lire ce manuel
avant de commencer à utiliser la machine.
Après avoir lu ce manuel, nous vous recommandons de le conserver à portée
de main pour pouvoir le consulter à tout moment, et assurer ainsi le
fonctionnement optimum des fonctions fax.
Pour garantir le fonctionnement correct de la machine, lisez également le
“Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie” avant de commencer.
Marques
KONICA MINOLTA, le logo KONICA MINOLTA et les unités d'image sont des
marques déposées ou commerciales de KONICA MINOLTA HOLDINGS,
INC.
PageScope et bizhub sont des marques déposées ou commerciales de
KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
Adobe, le logo Adobe, Acrobat, le logo Acrobat, PostScript et le logo
PostScript sont des marques déposées ou commerciales d'Adobe Systems,
Inc.
Les autres noms de sociétés ou de produits référencés dans ce manuel sont
les marques déposées ou commerciales de leurs détenteurs respectifs.
Copyright
© 2005 KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC. Tous droits
réservés.
Exemption
Avis relatif à la documentation
- Aucune partie de ce manuel d'utilisateur ne peut être utilisée ou copiée
sans autorisation
- Les informations contenues dans ce manuel peuvent être modifiées sans
avis préalable.
1 Introduction
1-4 C250
1.1 Avis aux utilisateurs
1.1.1 Canada
NOTICE:
This product meets the applicable Industry Canada technical specifications.
The ringer equivalence number (REN) is an indication of the maximum
number of devices allowed to be connected to a telephone interface. The
termination on an interface may consist of any combination of devices
subject only to the requirement that the sum of the RENs of all the devices
does not exceed five.
AVIS :
Ce produit est conforme aux normes définies par Industrie Canada.
L'indice d'équivalence de la sonnerie (IES) sert à indiquer le nombre
maximum de terminaux qui peuvent être raccordés à une interface
téléphonique. La terminaison d'une interface peut comporter une
combinaison quelconque de dispositifs, du moment que la somme des
indices d'équivalence de la sonnerie de tous les dispositifs n'excède pas 5.
1.1.2 U.S.A.
Réglementation 68 de la FCC
Cet équipement est conforme à l'article 68 de la réglementation FCC, et aux
exigences adoptées par l'ACTA. La certification est signalée par une
étiquette apposée sur l'équipement, indiquant entre autres, l'identification
du produit au format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. Cette identification peut être
fournie à l'opérateur téléphonique, sur demande.
Cet équipement utilise la certification de la fiche USOC RJ11C.
La prise téléphonique utilisée pour brancher cet équipement sur le réseau de
câblage téléphonique doit être conforme à l'article 68 de la réglementation
FCC applicable, et aux exigences adoptées par l'ACTA.
Un cordon de téléphone et une prise enfichable compatibles sont fournis
avec ce produit. Ils doivent être connectés au jack modulaire compatible
également conforme. Pour plus d'informations, voir les instructions
d'installation.
L'indice d'équivalence de la sonnerie (IES) détermine le nombre d'appareils
pouvant être connectés à la ligne téléphonique. Un nombre excessif d'IES
sur une ligne peut provoquer l'absence de sonnerie sur un appareil en
réponse à un appel entrant. Dans la plupart des régions, le nombre d'IES ne
doit pas être supérieur à 5.
Contactez votre opérateur téléphonique local pour connaître le nombre
d'appareils pouvant être connectés à la ligne. Sur les produits approuvés
Introduction 1
C250 1-5
après le 23 juillet 2001, l'IES est indiqué sur l'étiquette d'identification du
produit au format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX où ## représente l'IES, sans point
décimal (ex : 03 est l'IES de 0.3). Sur les produits antérieurs, l'IES est indiqué
séparément sur l'étiquette.
Si cet équipement FK-502 nuit au réseau téléphonique, l'opérateur de
téléphone vous préviendra de la possibilité d'interruption provisoire du
service. Si l'avis préalable n'est pas possible, l'opérateur avisera le client
dans les plus brefs délais. Vous serez également avisé de vos droits
d'enregistrement d'une plainte auprès de la FCC, s'il y a lieu.
Les modifications apportées par l'opérateur téléphonique à ses installations,
son équipement, ses opérations ou ses procédures peut avoir des
répercussions sur le fonctionnement de l'équipement. Dans ces
circonstances, l'opérateur vous préviendra à l'avance des modifications que
vous devez apporter pour garantir le service ininterrompu.
En cas de problème avec cet équipement FK-502, et pour connaître les
informations de garantie et de réparation, contactez votre revendeur local
Konica Minolta. Si l'équipement nuit au réseau téléphonique, l'opérateur de
téléphone peut vous demander de le débrancher jusqu'à ce que le problème
soit résolu.
La connexion à un service de ligne partagée est soumise aux tarifs en vigueur
dans l'état. Contactez la commission des services publics pour obtenir plus
d'informations. Si votre domicile est équipé d'un câblage d'alarme relié à la
ligne de téléphone, assurez-vous que l'installation du FK-502 ne désactive
pas l'équipement d'alarme. Pour plus d'informations à ce sujet, contactez
votre opérateur téléphonique ou un installateur qualifié.
La réglementation pour la protection des consommateurs de téléphone
(Telephone Consumer Protection Act) de 1991 stipule qu'il est contraire à la
loi d'utiliser un ordinateur ou tout autre appareil électronique, télécopieur
compris, pour envoyer des messages, à moins que ces messages
n'indiquent clairement en haut ou en bas de la première page transmise, la
date et l'heure de l'envoi, l'identification de l'entreprise, entité ou individu
expéditeur du message, ainsi que le numéro de téléphone de la machine
expéditrice ou de ladite entreprise, entité ou individu. (Le numéro de
téléphone fourni ne doit être ni un numéro 900 ni tout autre numéro pour
lequel les frais d'expédition dépassent les frais de communication locaux,
nationaux ou internationaux.)
Pour programmer ces informations sur votre télécopieur, vous devez
exécuter la procédure détaillée à la section “Information en-tête” à la
page 11-28.
1 Introduction
1-6 C250
Symboles d'avertissement et d'attention
7 AVERTISSEMENT
Un point d'exclamation dans un triangle, suivi du terme
“Avertissement”, avertit l'utilisateur que le non-respect de cet
avertissement peut provoquer des blessures graves, voire mortelles.
% Veillez à bien observer les avertissements énumérés dans ce manuel.
7 ATTENTION
Un point d'exclamation dans un triangle, suivi du terme “Attention”,
avertit l'utilisateur que le non-respect de cette précaution peut
provoquer des blessures ou des dommages matériels.
% Veillez à bien observer les précautions énumérées dans ce manuel.
Introduction 1
C250 1-7
1.1.3 Nouvelle-Zélande
Avis
- Cet appareil est équipé de la numérotation par impulsions alors que la
norme Telecom est la Double Tonalité Multi-Fréquence (DTMF). Il n'y a
aucune garantie que les lignes Telecom continueront à prendre en
charge la numérotation par impulsions.
- L'utilisation de la numérotation par impulsions lorsque cet équipement
est relié à la même ligne que d'autres équipements, peut entraîner un son
de cloche ou du bruit, ou encore une condition de réponse erronée. Dans
ce cas, l'utilisateur ne doit pas contacter le service de dépannage
Telecom (Telecom Fault Service).
- Il est possible que cet équipement ne puisse pas transférer un appel vers
un autre appareil raccordé à la même ligne.
- Cet équipement n'est pas entièrement conforme aux exigences
d'impédance de Telecom. La performance peut être réduite lorsqu'il est
utilisé conjointement avec d'autres parties du réseau. Telecom ne saurait
être responsable des problèmes pouvant subvenir dans de telles
conditions d'utilisation.
- L'octroi d'une autorisation de téléphonie pour tout élément d'un
équipement terminal indique uniquement l'acceptation par Telecom de la
conformité de l'élément avec les conditions minimales de connexion à
son réseau. Cela n'indique pas l'approbation du produit par Telecom, et
ne fournit aucune garantie. En particulier, cela n'offre aucune garantie de
fonctionnement correct d'un élément quelconque avec un autre élément
d'un équipement d'un autre fabricant ou modèle ayant reçu une
autorisation de téléphonie, de même que cela n'implique pas qu'un
produit est compatible avec tous les services de réseau Telecom.
- Les fonctions d'appel automatique de cet équipement ne doivent pas
être utilisées de façon à produire des nuisances pour le reste de la
clientèle.
- L'équipement faisant l'objet d'une autorisation de téléphonie ne peut être
raccordé qu'au port de téléphone auxiliaire. Ce port n'est pas
spécifiquement conçu pour une connexion à trois fils, et ce type de
connexion risque de ne pas répondre à une sonnerie entrante.
1.1.4 Europe
Ce télécopieur a reçu l'agrément, conformément à la décision 1999/5/ CE du
Conseil, concernant la connexion paneuropéenne de terminal unique aux
réseaux téléphoniques publics commutés (RTPC). Toutefois, en raison des
différences entre les RTPC d'un pays à un autre, l'agrément en soi ne
constitue pas une garantie absolue de fonctionnement optimal à chaque
point de terminaison du réseau RTPC.
En cas de problème, vous devez contacter en premier lieu le fournisseur de
l'appareil.
Le label CE doit être apposé sur le produit
ou sur son étiquette de données, sur l'emballage
du produit, s'il y a lieu, et sur les
documents qui l'accompagnent.
1 Introduction
1-8 C250
1.2 Mise en route (fax)
Émission
Procédez comme suit pour envoyer un fax.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande pour passer en mode
Fax.
2 Au besoin, définissez le réglage des fonctions.
Écran Fax
Écran Réglage
numérisation
Écran
Application
Écran Réglage
communication
Introduction 1
C250 1-9
3 Tapez le numéro de fax de la
destination sur le clavier.
– Si vous faites une faute de frappe,
appuyez sur [Eff.] pour effacer les
chiffres un par un.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour effacer
tout le numéro.
4 Placez l'original sur la machine.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Positionnement de l'original sur la
machine” à la page 3-7.
5 Appuyez sur [Départ] sur le tableau de
commande.
1 Introduction
1-10 C250
1.3 Caractéristiques du télécopieur
Impression du nombre total de pages sur le fax
En mode Mémoire rapide, vous pouvez placer le nombre total de pages sur
chaque page du fax. Cette possibilité est utile au destinataire, qui peut
vérifier s'il a bien reçu toutes les pages.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Nombre d'originaux” à la page 3-44.
Émission différée d'un fax
Vous pouvez préciser l'heure à laquelle le fax devra être envoyé : la nuit ou
tôt le matin, par exemple, pour profiter des heures creuses.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Émission différée (TX)” à la page 3-47.
De : 01234567890123456 2004 /12 /31 23:59 P.005 / 010
Introduction 1
C250 1-11
Émission dès qu'une page est lue. (Mémoire rapide)
Avec cette méthode, l'émission du fax commence dès qu'une page de
l'original a été numérisée.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Émissions en mémoire et en mémoire
rapide” à la page 3-41.
Envoi de fax à l'étranger
Vous pouvez sélectionner une vitesse de transmission moindre lorsque vous
envoyez un fax dans un pays où les conditions de communication ne sont
pas bonnes.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Communications internationales” à la
page 3-50.
1 Introduction
1-12 C250
Émission avec effacement des bords
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax après effacement des bandes noires
reproduites lors de la numérisation d'un document relié. Vous pouvez
également définir la largeur de la bordure à effacer.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Émission avec effacement des bords” à la
page 7-12.
Largeur à
effacer
Émission standard Émission avec effacement des bords
Introduction 1
C250 1-13
Émission d'un fax en mode format d'origine
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax en précisant le format de papier du document.
Cette fonction est utile pour n'envoyer qu'une partie de l'original.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Format de numérisation” à la page 7-21.
1 Introduction
1-14 C250
Envoi de pages de différents formats en une seule opération.
Vous pouvez envoyer des pages de différents formats parce que le
télécopieur reconnaît chacun des formats et les traite en conséquence
lorsque la fonction Originaux mixtes est activée.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Originaux mixtes” à la page 7-7.
Émission et reproduction dans
le même format que l'original à
la destination.
Vous placez les originaux
mixtes dans le chargeur RADF.
Introduction 1
C250 1-15
Spécification du style de reliure d'un document recto/verso
Vous pouvez préciser le style de reliure approprié (Gauche/Droite ou Haut/
Bas) lors l'émission d'un document recto/verso. Ainsi, les pages du
document sont lues dans le bon ordre.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Position reliure” à la page 7-9.
Envoi d'un fax à la réception d'une commande de relève du destinataire
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax, qui a été lu et stocké sur le disque dur du
télécopieur, lorsque le destinataire envoie une commande de relève.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réception en relève” à la page 9-6.
Reliure Gauche/Droite
Reliure Haut/Bas
Fax de destination
Émission
1 Introduction
1-16 C250
Envoi d'un fax avec la fonction ECM OFF
Vous pouvez désactiver la fonction de correction d'erreur (ECM) pour réduire
le temps d'émission.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “ECM OFF” à la page 7-35.
Document à relever
Vous pouvez placer les documents à relever sur le bulletin board (tableau
électronique) du disque dur pour l'émission ou la réception en relève.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Bulletin” à la page 9-9.
Émission d'un fax avec le mode Super G3 désactivé
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax après désactivation du mode Super G3 si le
protocole V.34 n'est pas disponible en raison de restrictions sur le PBX.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “V34 OFF” à la page 7-38.
Introduction 1
C250 1-17
Fax relayé
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax à une destination via une station de relais
intermédiaire.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Requête d'émission en relais (Émission Fcode)”
à la page 7-32.
Cette machine ne peut pas fonctionner en tant que relais.
Station d'origine Station relais intermédiaire
Station distante
Appel international Station distante Appel local
1 Introduction
1-18 C250
Utilisation d'une boîte confidentielle
Vous pouvez utiliser une boîte confidentielle (similaire à une boîte de
réception personnalisée) pour échanger des informations confidentielles
avec certaines personnes.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Communication confidentielle (Émission
F-code)” à la page 7-29.
Envoi d'un fax protégé par un mot de passe
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax protégé par un mot de passe si le récepteur
fonctionne en réseau fermé.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Mot de passe émission (TX)” à la
page 7-26.
Expéditeur Boîte de documents Récepteur
confidentiels
Introduction 1
C250 1-19
Ajustement de la densité de la couleur de fond
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax après ajustement de la couleur de fond de
l'original.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Ajustement fond” à la page 7-15.
Ajustement de la netteté du contour des caractères
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax après ajustement de la netteté du contour des
caractères pour améliorer la qualité de l'impression.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Netteté” à la page 7-18.
1 Introduction
1-20 C250
Envoi d'un e-mail à partir de l'écran Fax
Un original numérisé peut être envoyé en tant qu'e-mail de l'écran Fax à un
ordinateur.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Saisie directe” à la page 3-26.
Sauvegarde dans une boîte
Un original numérisé peut être sauvegardé dans une boîte créée sur le
disque dur interne.
Serveur de
messagerie
E-mail
Disque dur
Boîte
Introduction 1
C250 1-21
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réception fax dans une boîte” à la
page 2-18.
1 Introduction
1-22 C250
1.4 Conventions utilisées dans ce manuel
Cette section décrit les symboles et polices utilisés dans ce manuel.
Conseils de sécurité
6 DANGER
Le non-respect des instructions signalées de cette manière peut
entraîner des blessures graves, voire mortelles liées à la puissance
électrique.
% Observez ces instructions à la lettre pour éviter tout risque de
blessures.
7 AVERTISSEMENT
Le non-respect des instructions signalées de cette manière peut
entraîner des blessures graves ou endommager le matériel.
% Observez ces instructions à la lettre pour prévenir tout risque de
blessures et garantir le fonctionnement sécurisé de la machine.
7 ATTENTION
Le non-respect des instructions signalées de cette manière peut
entraîner des blessures légère ou endommager l'installation.
% Observez ces instructions à la lettre pour prévenir tout risque de
blessures et garantir le fonctionnement sécurisé de la machine.
Séquence d'une procédure
1 Le numéro 1, tel que formaté ici,
indique la première étape d'une
procédure.
2 Les numéros suivants, tels que
formatés ici, indiquent les étapes
suivantes d'une procédure.
? Le texte formaté dans ce style
fournit des informations
complémentaires.
% Le texte formaté dans ce style décrit les actions qui garantiront
l'obtention des résultats voulus.
Une illustration insérée
ici montre les opérations à
effectuer.
Introduction 1
C250 1-23
Conseils
2
Remarque
Les remarques fournissent des informations utiles et des conseils
d'utilisation sécurisée de la machine.
2
Rappel
Les rappels signalent des informations importantes qu'il convient de ne
pas oublier.
!
Détail
Les Détails réfèrent à des sections ou à des documents fournissant des
informations plus détaillées.
Conventions typographiques
Touche [Arrêt]
Le nom des touches du tableau de commande est indiqué dans cette police,
entre crochets.
REGLAGE MACHINE
Signale les termes affichés à l'écran.
1 Introduction
1-24 C250
1.5 Descriptions et symboles des documents et du papier
Les termes et symboles utilisés dans ce manuel sont expliqués ci-dessous.
1.5.1 “Largeur” et “Longueur”
Chaque fois que des dimensions de papier
sont mentionnées dans ce manuel, la
première valeur se réfère à la largeur du
papier (illustrée ci-contre par un “Y”) et la
seconde valeur à la longueur (illustrée cicontre
par un “X”).
1.5.2 Orientation du papier
Portrait (w)
Si la largeur (Y) du papier est plus courte que
la longueur (X) du papier, il a une orientation
verticale ou portrait, signalée par w.
Paysage (v)
Si la largeur (Y) du papier est plus longue que
la longueur (X) du papier, il a une orientation
horizontale ou paysage, signalée par v.
Introduction 1
C250 1-25
1.6 Documentation
Les manuels d'utilisation suivants ont été préparés pour cette machine.
Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie
Ce manuel décrit le fonctionnement de base de la machine, ainsi que les
procédures des fonctions de copie.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures détaillées des
fonctions de copie, notamment les précautions d'installation et
d'utilisation, la mise sous/hors tension de la machine, le chargement du
papier, et les opérations de dépannage, dans le cas d'un bourrage papier
par exemple.
Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Scanner réseau
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures de configuration du réseau
(équipement standard) et d'utilisation des fonctions de numérisation.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures détaillées des
fonctions de réseau, et d'utilisation de la numérisation vers un e-mail,
vers FTP et vers un PC (SMB).
Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures d'utilisation des boîtes.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures d'utilisation des
boîtes stockées sur le disque dur.
User utilities CD
Manuel d'utilisation - Opérations Impression
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures d'utilisation du contrôleur
d'impression standard intégré.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures d'utilisation des
fonctions d'impression.
Post Script CD
PageScope utility CD
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures d'impression.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures d'utilisation des
fonctions d'impression.
Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations fax (ce manuel)
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures d'utilisation du fax.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures d'utilisation des
fonctions fax si le kit de fax est installé.
1 Introduction
1-26 C250
Manuel d'utilisation – Zoom Écran
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures d'utilisation des fonctions de copie
en mode d'affichage étendu.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures d'utilisation du mode
d'affichage étendu.
2 Préliminaires
Préliminaires 2
C250 2-3
2 Préliminaires
2.1 Restrictions
2
Remarque
L'émission et la réception de fax couleur ne sont pas disponibles sur ce
télécopieur.
Ce télécopieur peut être raccordé aux lignes téléphoniques suivantes.
- Lignes locales (réseaux de communication fax compris)
- PBX (standard privé avec commutateur à 2 fils)
Tenir compte des points suivants en ce qui concerne la ligne téléphonique.
- Un poste téléphonique d'affaires ne peut pas être connecté en tant que
ligne extérieure.
- Si les liaisons privées numériques sont multiplexées sur le réseau
d'entreprise, les communications fax peuvent être soumises aux
restrictions suivantes.
– La vitesse de transmission est réduite.
– La communication via Super G3 n'est pas disponible.
Les réglages définis en usine peuvent parfois générer des erreurs de
communication dues au multiplexage qui limite au maximum la bande
disponible pour la ligne, sur l'hypothèse d'une utilisation vocale.
Ces restrictions dépendent toutefois du matériel de réseau. Pour plus
d'informations sur le réseau utilisé, contactez l'administrateur.
2
Rappel
L'appui répété sur l'interrupteur Marche/Arrêt peut entraîner un dysfonctionnement
de la machine.
Attendez au moins 5 secondes après avoir éteint la machine avant de la
rallumer.
2 Préliminaires
2-4 C250
2.2 Tableau de commande
2.2.1 Tableau de commande
1 2 3 5
8
9
11
12
24
10
21 2019 18 17 1514 13
22
23
16
4 6 7
No. Nom Description
1 [Eco énergie] Appuyez sur cette touche pour passer en mode Économie
d'énergie. Sous ce mode, le voyant de la touche [Eco
énergie] est vert et l'écran tactile s'éteint. Pour annuler ce
mode, réappuyez sur la touche [Eco énergie].
2 Écran tactile Affiche divers écrans et messages.
Réglez les fonctions en touchant l'écran.
3 [Code] Si l'authentification utilisateur ou le compte de service a été
activé, appuyez sur cette touche après avoir entré le nom
utilisateur et le mot de passe (pour l'authentification
utilisateur) ou le nom du compte et le mot de passe (pour le
compte de service), pour utiliser la machine.
4 [Boîte] Appuyez sur cette touche pour passer en mode Boîte. Sous
ce mode, le voyant de la touche [Boîte] est vert. Pour plus
d'informations, voir "Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte".
5 [Fax] Appuyez sur cette touche pour passer en mode Fax. Sous
ce mode, le voyant de la touche [Fax] est vert.
6 [Numérisation] Appuyez sur cette touche pour passer en mode Numérisation.
Sous ce mode, le voyant de la touche [Numérisation]
est vert. Pour plus d'informations, voir "Manuel d'utilisation
– Opérations Scanner réseau".
7 [Copie] Appuyez sur cette touche pour passer en mode Copie.
Sous ce mode, le voyant de la touche [Copie] est vert. Pour
plus d'informations, voir "Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations
Copie".
Préliminaires 2
C250 2-5
8 [Réinitialiser] Appuyez sur cette touche pour remettre à zéro tous les
réglages (à l'exception des réglages programmés) entrés
sur le tableau de commande et l'écran tactile.
9 [Interruption] L'écran Copie s'affiche après la numérisation de
documents originaux, puis la machine passe en mode
Interruption. Sous ce mode, le voyant de la touche
[Interruption] est vert et le message “Mode interruption en
cours” s'affiche sur l'écran tactile. Pour annuler le mode
Interruption, réappuyez sur la touche [Interruption].
10 [INTERRUPTEUR] Appuyez sur cet interrupteur Marche/Arrêt pour allumer/
éteindre la machine. Lorsque la machine est éteinte, elle
passe en veille (conservation d'énergie).
11 [Arrêt] Cette option n'est pas utilisée en mode Fax.
12 [Départ] Appuyez sur cette touche pour démarrer l'opération
sélectionnée en mode Boîte, Fax, Numérisation ou Copie.
En mode Fax, appuyez sur cette touche pour démarrer la
transmission.
Lorsque la machine est prête, le voyant de la touche [Départ]
est vert. Lorsque le voyant de la touche [Départ] est
orange, l'opération ne peut pas commencer.
Appuyez sur cette touche pour redémarrer une tâche
interrompue. Pour plus d'informations sur une tâche
interrompue, voir "Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie".
13 Voyant [Alimentation] Lorsque la machine est mise sous tension avec le bouton
[Alimentation], le voyant est vert.
14 Voyant [Données] Clignote en vert pendant la réception d'une tâche
d'impression. S'allume en vert pendant l'impression de
données.
15 [Epreuve] Cette touche n'est pas utilisée en mode Fax.
16 Clavier Utilisez ce clavier pour taper le numéro ou enregistrer le
numéro et les données d'un fax.
Utilisez ce clavier pour saisir le nombre de copies, le taux
d'agrandissement et d'autres réglages.
17 [C] ( de “clear” - effacer) Appuyez sur cette touche pour effacer une valeur (un
numéro de fax, un nombre de copies, un taux
d'agrandissement, un format, etc.) saisie au clavier.
18 [Contrôle] Appuyez sur cette touche pour vérifier les réglages.
19 [Utilitaire/Compteur] Appuyez sur cette touche pour afficher l'écran Utilitaire,
dans le cas d'une opération utilitaire ou pour confirmer le
nombre de copies, la communication fax ou la
numérisation, par exemple.
20 [Programmes] Cette touche n'est pas utilisée en mode Fax.
21 Contraste Utilisez cette touche pour ajuster le contraste sur l'écran
tactile.
22 [Zoom Ecran] Cette touche n'est pas utilisée en mode Fax.
23 [Accessibilité] Appuyez sur cette touche pour afficher l'écran de réglage
des fonctions d'accessibilité utilisateur.
No. Nom Description
2 Préliminaires
2-6 C250
2
Rappel
Ne pas appuyer trop fort sur l'écran tactile; cela risquerait de l'érafler ou
de l'endommager.
Ne jamais exercer de forte pression sur l'écran tactile, et ne jamais
sélectionner une option de cet écran avec un objet dur ou pointu.
Lorsque l'écran d'appel du service après-vente s'affiche et qu'il est
impossible de poursuivre les opérations de copie, un dysfonctionnement
s'est produit. Prendre note du code d'erreur, débrancher immédiatement
la machine, puis contacter le service après-vente.
24 [Aide] Appuyez sur cette touche pour afficher l'écran d'aide
principal et accéder aux descriptions des fonctions et du
fonctionnement. Pour plus d'informations, voir "Manuel
d'utilisation – Opérations Copie".
No. Nom Description
Préliminaires 2
C250 2-7
2.3 Réglages de base
2.3.1 Réglages indispensables
Une fois la machine installée, vous devez procéder aux réglages suivants
avant d'utiliser les fonctions de télécopie. La communication fax est bloquée
tant que ces réglages ne sont pas définis correctement.
- Information en-tête
– Enregistre le numéro et le nom du fax.
- Réglage Paramètres ligne
– Définit la ligne téléphonique et la méthode de réception utilisées.
Information en-tête
Réglez les options suivantes.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Information en-tête” à la page 11-28.
Réglage Paramètres ligne
Réglez les options suivantes.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage Paramètres ligne” à la
page 11-34.
Option Description
Nom expéditeur Définit le nom de cette machine. Ce nom de 30 caractères
maximum peut comporter tout caractère alphanumérique et tout
signe.
Nº de fax expéditeur Définit le numéro de fax de cette machine. Ce numéro de 20
caractères maximum peut comporter tout chiffre de 0 à 9, le signe
+, des espaces, le signe * et le signe #.
Option Description
Méthode de numérotation Sélectionnez le mode de numérotation à fréquences vocales
(DTMF) ou à impulsions (décimale).
Mode réception Choisissez entre la réception automatique ou manuelle.
Sélectionnez “Récept. auto” pour la réception automatique.
Sélectionnez “Réception manuelle” si vous recevez fréquemment
des appels sur un combiné externe connecté à la machine.
2 Préliminaires
2-8 C250
2.4 Fonctions utiles
Si le programme et le carnet d'adresses ont été enregistrés, il suffit
d'appuyer sur [Programme] ou [Carnet d'adresses] pour appeler un numéro
ou exécuter un programme enregistré.
2.4.1 Carnet d'adresses
En enregistrant dans le [Carnet d'adresses] une destination à laquelle vous
transmettez régulièrement , il suffit ensuite d'appuyer sur [Carnet d'adresses]
pour afficher et appeler cette destination.
!
Détail
Si le nom et son caractère de recherche sont enregistrés dans le carnet
d'adresses, vous pouvez spécifier une adresse par son caractère de
recherche.
Carnet d'adresses
Cette section décrit les procédures de réglage du numéro de fax, du nom de
la destination et du caractère de recherche d'une destination abrégée.
1 Appuyez sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de commande pour
ouvrir l'écran Utilitaire, si ce n'est pas déjà fait.
– Vous pouvez enregistrer jusqu'à 2 000 (001 à 2000) adresses dans
le carnet d'adresses, y compris dans les carnets d'adresses
d'autres fonctions de la machine.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les informations enregistrées dans la liste
de numéros abrégés.
2 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez sélectionner une fonction en tapant
son numéro au clavier.
Pour [Enregistrement 1-touche], tapez 1 au clavier.
Préliminaires 2
C250 2-9
3 Appuyez sur [Fax].
4 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
5 Appuyez sur la destination à enregistrer.
– Les éléments que vous pouvez enregistrer dans le carnet
d'adresses sont les suivants.
– [No. abrégé] :
Pour enregistrer un numéro de fax.
– [E-mail] :
Pour enregistrer une adresse e-mail. Cette machine peut spécifier
une adresse e-mail en tant que destination fax.
– Cette fonction est utile pour transmettre une image à une adresse
e-mail en même temps qu'une émission fax.
– [Boîte utilisateur] :
Pour enregistrer un nom de boîte. Cette machine peut spécifier une
boîte sur le disque dur interne en tant que destination fax.
– Cette fonction est utile pour sauvegarder une image dans une boîte
en même temps qu'une émission fax.
2 Préliminaires
2-10 C250
– Si le numéro abrégé est déjà enregistré, vous pouvez appuyer sur
[Modif.] sur cet écran pour modifier le contenu de la liste. Pour plus
d'informations, voir “Enregistrement d'une adresse e-mail dans le
carnet d'adresses” à la page 10-9.
6 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
7 Appuyez sur [Nom], saisissez le nom à enregistrer, puis appuyez sur
[OK].
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
8 Saisissez la destination.
– Si vous avez sélectionné [No. abrégé] à l'étape 5. Tapez sur le
clavier le numéro de fax de la destination.
– Si vous avez sélectionné [E-mail] à l'étape 5. Appuyez sur [Adresse
E-mail] et saisissez l'adresse e-mail.
– Si vous avez sélectionné [Boîte utilisateur] à l'étape 5. Appuyez sur
[Nom boîte ut.] et sélectionnez la boîte.
– Les numéros peuvent comporter 38 caractères maximum.
– Un numéro disponible est affiché par défaut dans le champ [No.].
– Pour corriger une faute de frappe, utilisez [Suppri.] ou [C] (clear).
– Pour pouvoir sélectionner une boîte, celle-ci doit avoir été
préalablement enregistrée.
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement des boîtes, voir
“Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte”.
9 Appuyez sur [Index] pour saisir les caractères de recherche, puis sur
[OK].
– Appuyez sur la touche à enregistrer comme caractère de recherche
parmi les touches [ABC] à [etc].
Préliminaires 2
C250 2-11
10 Appuyez sur [Réglage ligne], le cas échéant, pour sélectionner
[Communications internationales], [ECM OFF] ou [V34 OFF], puis
appuyez sur [OK].
– Si vous avez sélectionné [E-mail] ou [Boîte utilisateur] à l'étape 5,
[Réglage ligne] n'apparaît pas.
11 Appuyez sur [OK].
La destination est enregistrée et apparaît dans la liste.
Pour enregistrer une autre destination dans le carnet d'adresses,
passez à l'étape 6.
12 Appuyez sur [Quitt.].
2 Préliminaires
2-12 C250
2.4.2 Programme
En enregistrant dans un [Programme] la destination et les fonctions de
communication, il suffit d'appuyer sur [Programme] pour récupérer ces
informations.
!
Détail
Vous pouvez enregistrer le Réglage numérisation et le Réglage
communication. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Enregistrement d'un
programme” à la page 10-25.
Programme
Cette section décrit les procédures d'enregistrement d'un nom et d'une
destination dans un [Programme].
1 Appuyez sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de commande pour
ouvrir l'écran Utilitaire, si ce n'est pas déjà fait.
– Vous pouvez enregistrer 400 (001 à 400) programmes maximum.
2 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Enregistrement 1-
touche], tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Fax].
4 Appuyez sur [Programme].
Préliminaires 2
C250 2-13
5 Sélectionnez le numéro de programme à enregistrer et appuyez sur
[Modif.].
6 Appuyez sur [Nom], saisissez le nom du programme, puis appuyez sur
[OK].
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
2 Préliminaires
2-14 C250
7 Appuyez sur [Dest.] pour sélectionner la destination.
– Pour enregistrer une destination déjà enregistrée, sélectionnez
[Sélection dans Carnet d'adresses] pour la saisir dans [No. abrégé],
[Boîte utilisateur], [Groupe] ou [E-Mail], puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour saisir un numéro de fax, appuyez sur [Saisie directe], entrez
une destination en sélectionnant No. abrégé, Boîte utilisateur ou EMail,
puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour corriger une faute de frappe, utilisez [Suppri.] ou [C] (clear).
– Pour pouvoir sélectionner une boîte, celle-ci doit avoir été
préalablement enregistrée.
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement des boîtes, voir
“Manuel d’utilisation – Opérations Boîte”.
8 Appuyez sur [Fermer], puis sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement du programme, appuyez sur [Annul.].
La liste de programmes s'affiche.
Pour enregistrer un autre programme, passez à l'étape 5.
9 Appuyez sur [Quitt.].
Préliminaires 2
C250 2-15
2.5 Écran Fax
L'écran Fax s'affiche lorsque vous appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de
commande. Cet écran comprend [Programme], [Groupe], [Carnet
d'adresses] ou [Saisie directe].
1 2 3 4 5
678
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
No. Nom Description
1 Liste tâches Affiche la liste des tâches en file d'attente, l'historique
des tâches et les erreurs.
2 Programme Affiche l'écran de sélection d'un programme.
3 Groupe Affiche l'écran de sélection d'un groupe.
4 Carnet d'adresses Affiche l'écran de sélection d'un carnet d'adresses.
5 Saisie directe Affiche l'écran de numérotation à l'aide de symboles
spéciaux tels que Tonalité et Pause. Appuyez sur
[Numérisation vers E-Mail] pour afficher le clavier de
saisie de l'adresse e-mail.
6 No. de destinat. Le nombre de destinations de l'émission s'affiche.
7 Mémoire La mémoire disponible s'affiche.
8 Décrocher Appuyez sur cette touche pour émettre/recevoir un fax
manuellement. Vous entendez ainsi les signaux sur la
ligne.
9 Nom dest. Vous pouvez basculer entre l'affichage du nom ou du
numéro de téléphone de la destination.
10 Indicateur de page Affiche le numéro de page de la liste de destinations
programmées.
11 Liste pages Permet de préciser le numéro de page de la liste de
destinations programmées.
12 Réglage numéris. Affiche un menu dans lequel est réglée la méthode de
lecture de l'original, telle que type d'image originale,
définition ou application.
2 Préliminaires
2-16 C250
13 Réglage comm. Affiche un menu dans lequel est réglée la méthode de
communication, telle que Émission différée ou
Réception en relève.
14 Indicateur de destination Affiche la destination.
15 Zone secondaire Affiche la description des opérations réglées dans la
partie droite de l'écran. Dans le cas du fax, affiche
chaque fonction et les destinations de diffusion.
No. Nom Description
Préliminaires 2
C250 2-17
2.6 Authentification utilisateur et compte de service
L'utilisation de cette machine peut être liée à la saisie d'un nom d'utilisateur,
d'un nom de service et d'un mot de passe. Dans ce cas, vous devez entrer
ces informations pour accéder à l'écran d'utilisation. Pour connaître les
noms d'utilisateur et de service appropriés, contactez l'administrateur.
2.6.1 Si l'authentification utilisateur est paramétrée
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur l'authentification utilisateur et le compte de
service, voir “Manuel d'utilisation - Opérations Copie”.
2.6.2 Si le compte de service est paramétré
2 Préliminaires
2-18 C250
2.7 Réception fax dans une boîte
Si vous utilisez la fonction Réception PC-Fax et les fonctions Réception
mémoire de cette machine, vous pouvez sauvegarder le document reçu
dans une boîte du disque dur, en attendant une impression ultérieure.
D'autre part, un document confidentiel reçu est automatiquement
sauvegardé dans la boîte utilisateur confidentielle sur le disque dur.
Les documents sauvegardés dans une boîte peuvent être imprimés sur cette
machine ou exportés sur un ordinateur du réseau. Cette section présente les
principes de la réception d'un fax dans une boîte.
- Pour connaître la procédure de création d'une boîte et de téléchargement
des documents reçus dans cette boîte via la fonction Réception PC-Fax,
voir “Manuel d’utilisation – Opérations Boîte".
- Si une boîte de cette machine est spécifiée en tant que destination lors
de l'émission d'un fax, les documents lus peuvent y être sauvegardés.
Expéditeur Original
Disque dur
Préliminaires 2
C250 2-19
2.7.1 Types de boîtes
Une boîte publique et une boîte système sont fournies sur le disque dur de
cette machine.
- Dans la boîte publique, une boîte spécifiée (no. 1 à 999999999) est
fournie.
- Quatre types de boîtes sont disponibles dans la boîte système : boîte
bulletin board, boîte d'émission en relève, boîte de réception mémoire et
boîte d'impression sécurisée.
Sur cette machine, ces boîtes permettent d'utiliser les fonctions énumérées
dans le tableau suivant.
Nom de la boîte Fonction
Boîte publique
Boîte spécifiée (boîte
publique / boîte
personnelle : no. 1 à
99999999)
La boîte publique spécifiée équivaut à la boîte
confidentielle si la Réception confidentielle est
active (ON).
Si la boîte spécifiée est sélectionnée comme
emplacement de stockage des documents reçus
dans la fonction Réception PC-fax, et si la boîte
utilisateur TSI est sélectionnée, les documents
reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte
correspondante.
Avec la fonction Réception PC-fax :
Les documents sont sauvegardés dans la boîte
précisée dans l'adresse secondaire par
l'expéditeur.
Avec la fonction Réception TSI :
Les documents sont sauvegardés dans la boîte
dont le numéro correspond à celui de la boîte
utilisateur TSI.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Fonctionnement de la Réception PCfax”
à la page 2-21.
2 Préliminaires
2-20 C250
Boîte
système
Boîte bulletin board Boîte d'enregistrement des documents à consulter.
Les documents enregistrés dans la boîte bulletin
board peuvent être émis en relève conformément
aux instructions de relève du correspondant.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Bulletin” à
la page 9-9.
Boîte d'émission en
relève
Les originaux lus puis émis en relève sont
sauvegardés dans cette boîte.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Émission
en relève” à la page 9-4.
Boîte utilisateur
Réception mémoire
Lorsque la Réception mémoire est active (ON), les
documents reçus sont sauvegardés dans cette
boîte, sans impression.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réception
mémoire” à la page 8-6.
Si la boîte fixe est sélectionnée comme emplacement
de stockage des documents reçus dans la
fonction Réception PC-fax, les documents reçus
sont sauvegardés dans cette boîte.
!
Détails
Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Fonctionnement de la Réception PCfax”
à la page 2-21.
Boîte d'impression
sécurisée
Cette boîte est utilisée si l'impression confidentielle
est sélectionnée dans le contrôleur d'impression.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur la boîte
d'impression sécurisée, voir “Manuel
d’utilisation – Opérations d’impression".
Nom de la boîte Fonction
Préliminaires 2
C250 2-21
2.7.2 Fonctionnement de la Réception PC-fax
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage RX fax” à la page 11-56.
Si la Réception PC-fax ou le Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI est sélectionné,
les documents reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte fixe (0) ou la boîte
publique (1 à 999999999) sur le disque dur.
La boîte d'enregistrement des documents reçus est spécifiée dans [Réglage
RX fax] du mode Utilitaire. Le tableau suivant explique la relation entre le
[Réglage RX fax] et la méthode de réception.
[Réglage RX fax] du
mode Utilitaire
Méthode de réception
Réglage RX fax : OFF Les documents reçus sont imprimés immédiatement, sans
sauvegarde dans la boîte.
Dans les circonstances suivantes, les documents reçus sont
cependant sauvegardés dans la boîte.
• Avec la Réception confidentielle
(Si l'adresse secondaire dans la fonction F-code représente un
numéro de boîte utilisateur confidentielle) :
Les documents confidentiels reçus sont sauvegardés dans la
boîte confidentielle, quel que soit le réglage de la fonction
Réception PC-fax.
• Si le Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI est sélectionné, les documents
reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte définie par ce paramètre.
• Avec la Réception mémoire active (ON) :
S'ils ne correspondent pas au cas 1. ou 2. ci-dessus, les documents
reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte Réception mémoire.
Réglage RX fax : ON
Sortie RX : boîte fixe
Les documents reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte Réception
mémoire.
Dans les circonstances suivantes, les documents reçus sont
cependant sauvegardés dans une autre boîte.
• Avec la Réception confidentielle
(Si l'adresse secondaire dans la fonction F-code représente un
numéro de boîte utilisateur confidentielle) :
Les documents reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte
confidentielle, quel que soit le réglage de la fonction Réception
PC-fax. Si l'adresse secondaire ne correspond pas au numéro de
la boîte confidentielle, la machine génère une erreur de
communication.
2 Préliminaires
2-22 C250
Réglage RX fax : ON
Sortie RX : boîte
spécifiée
Les documents reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte spécifiée (1 à
999999999) dont le numéro est indiqué dans l'adresse secondaire.
Dans les circonstances suivantes, les documents reçus sont
cependant sauvegardés dans une autre boîte.
• Si l'adresse secondaire n'est pas précisée, les documents reçus
sont sauvegardés dans la boîte Réception mémoire.
• S'il n'existe pas de boîte spécifiée, voir le réglage de [Erreur saisie
no. boîte] en mode Utilitaire.
• Avec la Réception confidentielle (Si l'adresse secondaire dans la
fonction F-code représente un numéro de boîte utilisateur
confidentielle) :
Les documents confidentiels reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte
confidentielle, quel que soit le réglage de la fonction Réception
PC-fax. Si l'adresse secondaire ne correspond pas au numéro de
la boîte confidentielle, voir le réglage de [Erreur saisie no. boîte]
dans le mode Utilitaire.
[Réglage RX fax] du
mode Utilitaire
Méthode de réception
3 Émission
Émission 3
C250 3-3
3 Émission
3.1 Émission simple de télécopie
Émission simple de télécopie
La procédure d'émission de base d'une télécopie est décrite ci-dessous.
L'émission ou la réception d'un fax couleur n'est pas disponible. Pour
envoyer un e-mail en couleur, utilisez la fonction de numérisation. pour plus
d'informations sur cette fonction, voir “Manuel d’utilisation – Opérations
Scanner réseau”.
Cette procédure décrit l'émission d'un simple document recto, mais les
fonctions disponibles à chaque étape de la procédure sont également
présentées pour faciliter l'envoi de tous types de télécopies. Pour plus de
détails sur ces fonctions, voir “Applications d'émission” à la page 7-3.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande pour ouvrir l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.] pour régler la fonction de
numérisation, puis appuyez sur [OK].
3 Émission
3-4 C250
– L'écran Fax est réglé comme suit en usine.
– Type d'image original Texte
– Densité Standard
– Recto/Recto-Verso Recto
– Définition Standard
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission”
à la page 3-11.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Ouverture des écrans Réglage
numérisation et Réglage communication” à la page 7-3.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] pour paramétrer la fonction, puis
appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Applications d'émission” à la
page 7-3.
Émission 3
C250 3-5
4 Sélectionnez la destination.
– Le réglage de la destination s'effectue comme suit.
– Clavier
– Programme
– Groupe
– Carnet d'adresses
– Saisie directe
– L'enregistrement préalable du numéro du fax de destination avec
un numéro abrégé ou programmé simplifie la sélection de la
destination.
– Pour annuler une destination sélectionnée, sélectionnez-la à
nouveau.
– Appuyez sur [Reset] pour effacer l'ensemble de la saisie.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Enregistrement du carnet
d'adresses” à la page 10-5 et “Enregistrement d'un programme” à
la page 10-25.
– Lorsque [Saisie manuelle destination] dans [Réglage sécurité] du
mode Utilitaire est réglé sur [Interdit], [Saisie directe] n'apparaît pas.
Pour connaître le réglage de [Saisie manuelle destination],
contactez l'administrateur.
Le numéro de fax saisi s'affiche dans Destinations de diffusion.
5 Positionnez l'original sur la machine.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Positionnement de l'original sur la
machine” à la page 3-7.
3 Émission
3-6 C250
6 Appuyez sur [Départ].
– La machine procède à la numérisation de l'original et la
transmission commence.
– L'écran suivant apparaît si l'écran de vérification du rapport des
résultats émission (TX) a été programmé à cet effet. Pour imprimer
le rapport d'émission, appuyez sur [Oui].
– Pour interrompre l'émission, appuyez sur [Arrêt].
– Si l'émission ne s'effectue pas, voir page 5-3.
– En cas d'échec l'émission, le rapport d'émission est
automatiquement imprimé (s'il est paramétré à cet effet). Pour plus
d'informations sur le réglage du rapport, voir “Réglage Rapports” à
la page 11-67.
– Pour plus d'informations sur le rapport d'émission (TX), voir
“Rapport Émission” à la page 12-9.
Émission 3
C250 3-7
3.2 Positionnement de l'original sur la machine
Vous pouvez utiliser le chargeur de document (ADF) ou la vitre d'exposition
pour numériser les originaux. Lorsque vous placez un original dans le
chargeur, il est automatiquement acheminé et numérisé.
3.2.1 Utilisation du chargeur de document (ADF)
Outre la numérisation automatique de plusieurs originaux, le chargeur de
document permet d'envoyer des originaux recto/verso.
Utilisation du chargeur de document (ADF)
1 Rabattez le chargeur de document.
2 Alignez les originaux en commençant par la première page.
3 Placez les originaux dans le chargeur de document en orientant la face
à numériser vers le haut.
– Pour imprimer correctement les informations d'en-tête (nom/
numéro de fax de l'expéditeur), insérez le bord de l'original dans le
chargeur.
4 Réglez les guides du papier.
– En mode d'originaux mixtes,
ajustez les guides du papier sur le
format de la plus grande feuille, et
alignez le reste des originaux dans
le coin supérieur gauche du
chargeur.
3 Émission
3-8 C250
3.2.2 Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition
Utilisez la vitre d'exposition pour les originaux qui ne peuvent pas être placés
dans le chargeur de document, tel qu'un livre ou des originaux épais/fins.
Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition
1 Soulevez le chargeur de document.
2 Placez l'original recto vers le bas dans
le coin arrière gauche, en alignant son
bord sur la réglette gauche.
3 Rabattez soigneusement le chargeur
de document.
Émission 3
C250 3-9
3.2.3 Envoi de plusieurs originaux à partir de la vitre d'exposition
Les originaux qui ne peuvent pas être envoyés par le biais du chargeur ADF
peuvent être envoyés par le biais de la vitre d'exposition.
Envoi de plusieurs originaux à partir de la vitre d'exposition
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur la touche [Fax] du tableau de commande pour
ouvrir l'écran Fax.
2 Sélectionnez la destination.
3 Au besoin, définissez le réglage des fonctions.
4 Placez l'original sur la vitre d'exposition.
Appuyez sur [Réglage numér.] -
[Numérisation séparée] - [OK], puis
appuyez sur la touche [Départ].
5 Placez l'original suivant sur la vitre
d'exposition, puis appuyez sur la
touche [Départ].
– Répétez cette procédure pour
chacun des originaux à envoyer.
Les originaux numérisés sont
mémorisés.
6 Appuyez sur la touche [Fin].
Le mode de lecture du document est annulé.
7 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
3 Émission
3-10 C250
3.2.4 Émission d'originaux avec le chargeur ADF et la vitre
d'exposition
Vous pouvez numériser les originaux en utilisant le chargeur de document et
la vitre d'exposition, de même que vous pouvez numériser les originaux
volumineux en les plaçant en plusieurs lots sur le chargeur de document.
Émission d'originaux avec le chargeur ADF et la vitre d'exposition
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur la touche [Fax] du tableau de commande pour
ouvrir l'écran Fax.
2 Sélectionnez la destination.
3 Au besoin, définissez le réglage des fonctions.
4 Placez l'original sur la vitre d'exposition.
Appuyez sur [Réglage numér.] -
[Numérisation séparée] - [OK], puis
appuyez sur la touche [Départ].
– Un document placé dans le
chargeur a la priorité sur celui qui
est placé sur la vitre d'exposition.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Positionnement de l'original sur la
machine” à la page 3-7.
5 Placez l'original suivant dans le
chargeur ou sur la vitre d'exposition,
puis appuyez sur la touche [Départ].
– Répétez cette procédure pour
chacun des originaux à numériser
avant l'émission.
Les originaux numérisés sont
mémorisés.
6 Appuyez sur la touche [Fin].
Le mode de lecture du document est annulé.
7 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
Émission 3
C250 3-11
3.3 Réglage des conditions d'émission
Le réglage du type d'image original, de la densité, du recto/recto-verso et de
la définition s'affichent lorsque vous choisissez [Réglage numér.] dans
l'écran Fax. Ces options permettent de définir les conditions de l'émission
en fonction du type d'original à envoyer.
!
Détail
Les conditions de l'émission ne peuvent pas être réglées en unités de
page.
Réglage des conditions d'émission
1 Appuyez sur [Réglage numér.] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur la touche à régler.
3 Émission
3-12 C250
3.3.1 Type d'image original
Réglez la qualité en fonction du contenu de l'original. Vous avez le choix
entre 4 réglages de qualité, Texte étant le réglage par défaut.
Réglage de qualité Description
Texte S'applique si les originaux à numériser contiennent uniquement
du texte.
Lorsqu'une image est numérisée sous ce mode, les teintes
neutres des images ne sont pas reproduites.
Texte/Photo S'applique si les originaux à numériser contiennent du texte et
des photos (demi-teinte).
Sélectionnez ce mode si la page contient à la fois des caractères
et des images, ou si le document contient à la fois des pages de
texte et d'images.
Photo S'applique si les originaux à numériser contiennent uniquement
des photos (demi-teinte).
Trame S'applique si les originaux à numériser contiennent en majeure
partie du texte manuscrit clair.
Émission 3
C250 3-13
3.3.2 Densité
Réglez la densité en fonction de la clarté ou de l'obscurité de l'original.
Normal est le réglage par défaut. Vous réglez la densité en 9 étapes.
Option Densité Description
Clair Numérise les originaux avec une densité plus claire que la densité
normale.
Normal Numérise les originaux avec une densité située entre Clair et
Foncé. C'est le réglage par défaut.
Foncé Numérise les originaux avec une densité plus foncée que la
densité normale.
3 Émission
3-14 C250
3.3.3 Recto/Recto-verso
Cette option détermine la manière dont les originaux sont numérisés, en
fonction du type d'original. Vous avez le choix entre deux réglages, Recto
étant le réglage par défaut.
Option Recto/Rectoverso
Description
Recto Sélectionnez pour numériser des originaux recto.
Recto-verso Sélectionnez pour numériser des originaux recto-verso.
Émission 3
C250 3-15
3.3.4 Définition
Cette option définit la résolution de numérisation des originaux. Vous avez le
choix entre 4 réglages, Fin étant le réglage par défaut.
!
Détail
La quantité de données envoyées et la durée de l'émission dépendent du
degré de finesse de la définition.
Si vous sélectionnez Super fin ou Ultra fin et que la machine réceptrice
n'est pas dotée de cette définition, les originaux sont envoyés dans une
définition approchante sur la machine réceptrice.
Option Définition Description
Std. Sélectionnez pour accélérer le temps d'émission.
Fin Sélectionnez pour numériser des originaux standard.
Super fin Sélectionnez pour numériser des originaux contenant de petits
graphiques ou du texte.
Ultra fin Sélectionnez pour numériser des originaux contenant des
graphiques élaborés ou du texte.
3 Émission
3-16 C250
3.3.5 Confirmation des réglages et des résultats de la
communication
Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages et les résultats de la communication des
écrans Fax et Application par le biais de la touche [Contrôle] du tableau de
commande.
Confirmation des réglages et des résultats de la communication
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Contrôle] sur le tableau de commande.
3 Appuyez sur la touche de l'option dont vous voulez vérifier le réglage.
4 Confirmez les réglages.
– Les quatre types de réglages suivants peuvent être confirmés.
– Destination
Confirmation de la destination.
– Appuyez sur [Destination] dans l'écran qui s'affiche suite à l'appui
sur [Détails] pour changer la destination.
Émission 3
C250 3-17
– Réglage numérisation
Confirmation des réglages de numérisation. Appuyez sur chaque
touche de l'écran pour afficher l'écran de réglage correspondant, et
changer le réglage, s'il y a lieu.
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'écran Réglage numérisation, voir
“Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et Réglage
communication” à la page 7-3.
– Appuyez sur [Suiv. ] pour afficher l'écran suivant, et sur [ Préc.]
pour afficher l'écran précédent.
– Réglage communication
Confirmation des réglages de communication. Appuyez sur chaque
touche de l'écran pour afficher l'écran de réglage correspondant, et
changer le réglage, s'il y a lieu.
3 Émission
3-18 C250
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'écran Réglage communication, voir
“Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et Réglage
communication” à la page 7-3.
– Appuyez sur [Suiv. ] pour afficher l'écran suivant, et sur [ Préc.]
pour afficher l'écran précédent.
– Réglage E-mail
Lorsque vous transmettez par e-mail, vous pouvez confirmer ou
saisir le nom du fichier, le sujet, l'adresse e-mail de l’expéditeur et
le texte du message.
– Si la valeur de [De] n'est pas définie, c'est l'adresse e-mail qui a été
définie dans [Enregistrement administrateur] dans l'écran Mode
utilitaire, qui apparaît.
– Pour plus d'informations sur [Enregistrement administrateur], voir
“Manuel d'utilisateur - Opérations Copie”.
– Pour plus d'informations sur les valeurs par défaut de Sujet et
Texte, voir page 10-38, page 10-44.
5 Une fois que vous avez terminé la vérification, appuyez à deux reprises
sur [Fermer].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
!
Détail
En cas de modification des réglages de numérisation ou de
communication, l'écran de vérification ne réapparaît pas.
Émission 3
C250 3-19
3.3.6 Enregistrement dans le carnet d'adresses à partir de
l'écran Vérifier détails de la tâche
Une destination affichée sur l'écran Vérifier détails de la tâche peut être
enregistrée dans le [carnet d'adresses].
Enregistrement dans le carnet d'adresse à partir de l'écran Vérifier
détails de la tâche (Contrôle)
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Contrôle] sur le tableau de commande.
3 Appuyez sur [Destination].
4 Sélectionnez la destination à enregistrer dans le [carnet d'adresses],
puis appuyez sur [Détails].
3 Émission
3-20 C250
5 Appuyez sur [Enregistrer dans carnet d'adresses].
– Si la destination est déjà enregistrée, [Enregistrer dans carnet
d'adresses] n'apparaît pas.
– Si la destination est une boîte, [Régl. Dest.] s'affiche. Si une adresse
e-mail est saisie dans [Régl. Dest.], vous pouvez envoyer un e-mail
pour prévenir de la fin d'une tâche, une fois celle-ci accomplie.
6 Appuyez sur [Recherche nom] pour définir le caractères à rechercher,
puis appuyez sur [OK].
7 Appuyez sur [Nom] pour saisir le nom à enregistrer, puis appuyez sur
[OK].
8 Si les données à enregistrer sont correctes, appuyez sur [Oui].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Non].
9 Appuyez à trois reprises sur [Fermer] pour revenir à l'écran Fax.
La destination sélectionnée est enregistrée dans le [carnet d'adresses].
Émission 3
C250 3-21
3.4 Sélection de la destination
3.4.1 Sélection de la destination
Vous pouvez sélectionner une destination de quatre manières.
- Clavier
- Programme
- Carnet d'adresses
- Saisie directe
Clavier
1 Saisissez le numéro du fax auquel la
télécopie doit être transmise.
– Vous pouvez entrer un numéro de
38 chiffres maximum.
– Appuyez sur [Eff.] sur l'écran Fax
pour corriger un chiffre.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour effacer
tout le numéro.
Le numéro de fax saisi s'affiche dans
Destinations de diffusion.
2 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
3 Émission
3-22 C250
Programme
Toute destination enregistrée dans un programme peut être appelée en
appuyant sur Programme.
1 Appuyez sur [Programme] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Sélectionnez la destination programmée voulue.
– Les réglages de la fonction sont activés.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
La destination spécifiée s'affiche dans Destinations de diffusion.
3 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
2
Remarque
Si le réglage de la communication est défini dans le programme, il est
automatiquement activé.
Vous ne pouvez pas spécifier plus d'un programme.
Si la destination est une adresse e-mail, le sujet, le texte, le nom de fichier
et l'expéditeur peuvent être définis manuellement. Pour plus
d'informations, voir “Confirmation des réglages et des résultats de la
communication” à la page 3-16
Émission 3
C250 3-23
Carnet d'adresses
Vous pouvez appeler une destination en recherchant dans la liste de noms
enregistrés dans le carnet d'adresses.
1 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur le caractère à rechercher.
– Chaque fois que vous appuyez sur [Nom Dest.], l'affichage
bascule entre le numéro de fax et le nom enregistré.
– Vous ne pouvez pas spécifier plus d'une destination.
– La recherche est lancée lorsque les caractères sélectionnés
coïncident.
– Recherche dans [Recherche avancée]
– Appuyez sur [Recherche avancée].
– Appuyez sur [Nom], [N° Fax] ou [E-Mail], puis saisissez l'élément à
rechercher.
– Appuyez sur [OK].
Les résultats de la recherche s'affichent.
3 Émission
3-24 C250
– Recherche dans [Recherche LDAP]
– Appuyez sur [Recherche LDAP].
Émission 3
C250 3-25
– Authentifiez-la si l'authentification LDAP est requise.
– Appuyez sur [Recherche simple] ou [Recherche avancée], puis
saisissez les critères de recherche. Appuyez sur [OK].
– Les résultats de la recherche s'affichent.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la recherche LDAP, voir "Manuel
d'utilisation – Opérations Scanner réseau".
3 Appuyez sur le nom de la destination à laquelle vous voulez envoyer la
télécopie.
– Une lettre précédent la touche a la signification suivante.
A Appel
B Boîte
E E-mail
La destination spécifiée s'affiche dans Destinations de diffusion.
4 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
3 Émission
3-26 C250
Saisie directe
Vous pouvez saisir un préfixe de numérotation tel que [Tonalité], [Pause] et
[-]. Vous pouvez également numériser vers un e-mail ou enregistrer dans une
boîte utilisateur.
Si vous utilisez [Enregistrer ds boîte ut.], la boîte doit avoir été préalablement
enregistrée.
Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement de la boîte, voir “Manuel
d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte”.
0 Lorsque [Saisie manuelle destination] dans [Réglage sécurité] du mode
Utilitaire est réglé sur [Interdit], [Saisie directe] n'apparaît pas. Pour
connaître le réglage de [Saisie manuelle destination], contactez
l'administrateur.
1 Appuyez sur [Saisie directe] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Saisissez le préfixe voulu, tel que tonalité, pause ou “-”, puis saisissez
le numéro du fax de destination sur le clavier.
– Tonalité
Si vous utilisez la numérotation décimale (DC), appuyez sur [TonaÉmission
3
C250 3-27
lité] pour sélectionner le mode FV (fréquences vocales), qui est utilisé
avec les services de télécopie. La sélection de [Tonalité] est
indiquée par un “T” à l'écran.
– Si vous utilisez la numérotation décimale, vous pouvez commuter
provisoirement sur la numérotation à fréquences vocales par le
biais de la touche astérisque [1].
– Pause
Appuyez sur [Pause] pour insérer une pause entre deux chiffres du
numéro à composer. L'appui une fois sur [Pause] génère un intervalle
d'une seconde entre deux chiffres. Vous pouvez saisir plusieurs
intervalles, indiqués par un “P” à l'écran.
– Si la connexion PBX est active, lors d'un appel de la ligne intérieure
vers une ligne extérieure, appuyez sur [Pause] après le numéro de
la ligne extérieure (“0”, par exemple) pour sécuriser l'appel. “P”
s'affiche à l'écran.
– -
Le tiret est un signe de séparation uniquement. Il n'a aucune
incidence sur la numérotation. Il est indiqué à l'écran par un “-”.
– No. abrégé
Saisissez le numéro abrégé (de 0001 à 2000) sur le clavier et précisez
la destination enregistrée dans le carnet d'adresses.
À l'écran, un numéro abrégé et la destination sont indiqués comme
suit : “A0001: KMBT”.
– Numérisation vers E-mail
Appuyez sur cette touche pour envoyer un e-mail contenant une
image.
– Si la destination est une adresse e-mail, le sujet, le texte, le nom de
fichier de l'image et l'expéditeur peuvent être définis manuellement.
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission”
à la page 3-11
– L'émission ou la réception d'un fax couleur n'est pas disponible.
Pour envoyer un e-mail en couleur, utilisez la fonction de
numérisation. Pour plus d'informations sur cette fonction, voir
“Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Scanner réseau”.
– Appels récents #
Appuyez sur cette touche pour envoyer une télécopie à une destination
utilisée récemment.
– Pour plus d'informations sur Appels récents #, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30
– Enregistrer ds boîte ut.
Appuyez sur cette touche pour enregistrer une image sur le disque
dur interne.
3 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
3 Émission
3-28 C250
3.4.2 Sélection de plusieurs destinations
Vous pouvez envoyer une télécopie à plusieurs destinations en une seule
procédure. Vous effectuez ainsi une émission en série.
Vous pouvez sélectionner l'émission en série de quatre manières.
- Clavier
- Groupe
- Carnet d'adresses
- Saisie directe
Ces méthodes peuvent également être utilisées conjointement.
!
Détail
Vous pouvez préciser 605 adresses de destination maximum (500
numéros abrégés, 100 au clavier et 5 destinations e-mail par saisie
directe).
Sélection de plusieurs destinations
1 Indiquez toutes les destinations auxquelles vous voulez envoyer un
message. (Voir “Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.)
– Méthode au clavier ou par saisie directe
– Lors de la saisie directe ou au clavier, vous pouvez préciser la
destination suivant en appuyant sur [Dest. suivante], qui s'affiche
dès que vous avez précisé la première destination.
– Méthode de groupe
– Appuyez sur [Groupe] dans l'écran Fax.
– Appuyez sur Groupe dans l'écran Groupe.
– Appuyez sur la touche de la destination voulue dans le groupe.
Pour sélectionner tous les numéros du groupe, appuyez sur [Tout
sélectionner].
2 Appuyez sur [Départ].
!
Détail
Le numéro du groupe (01 à 99, 00) peut également être précisé en
appuyant sur [Groupe] dans l'écran de saisie directe.
Dans ce cas, la télécopie est transmise à toutes les destinations
enregistrées dans le groupe.
Émission 3
C250 3-29
3.4.3 Confirmation/Suppression d'une destination
Confirmation/Suppression d'une destination
Vous pouvez confirmer ou supprimer certaines destinations.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande, puis sur [Contrôle].
2 Appuyez sur [Destination].
3 Confirmez les destinations.
4 Pour supprimer une ou plusieurs destinations, sélectionnez-les dans la
liste et appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [Détails] pour afficher l'écran de détails.
– Appuyez sur ou sur pour afficher l'écran précédent ou
suivant.
L'écran de message apparaît.
5 Appuyez sur [Oui].
6 Appuyez deux fois sur [Fermer].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
3 Émission
3-30 C250
3.4.4 Rappel manuel
Le rappel consiste à renuméroter une destination.
Pour rappeler manuellement
1 Appuyez sur [Saisie directe], puis sur [Appels récents #].
– Les cinq (maximum) derniers numéros de fax s'affichent.
2 Sélectionnez la destination à rappeler.
Émission 3
C250 3-31
3.5 Numérisation
3.5.1 Lorsque la machine ne détecte pas le format d'origine
Lorsque la machine ne détecte pas le format d'origine
Si la machine ne parvient pas à détecter le format d'origine, l'écran suivant
s'affiche pour vous permettre de le sélectionner.
1 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au format d'origine.
2 Appuyez sur [OK].
3.5.2 Lorsque la mémoire est saturée
Lors de l'émission mémoire, si l'envoi est volumineux ou si les originaux
contiennent des images détaillées, sélectionnez Mémoire rapide (désactivez
Émission mémoire (TX) dans l'écran Réglage communication).
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Message d'erreur affiché” à la page 5-6.
3.5.3 Rotation automatique du document original
Un document original A4 (v) ou 8 1/2 × 11 (v) est automatiquement pivoté au
moment de la transmission et réglé sur A4 (w) ou 8 1/2 × 11(w).
!
Détails
Si cette rotation automatique n'est pas souhaitée, contactez le service
après-vente.
3 Émission
3-32 C250
3.6 Lorsque l'émission ne s'effectue pas
Lorsque l'émission ne s'effectue pas
Si vous ne parvenez pas à émettre une télécopie en raison de problème de
ligne ou autre, l'écran de vérification du rappel s'affiche.
1 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Le rappel s'effectue une fois le délai spécifié écoulé.
– Si l'émission ne s'effectue toujours pas après un rappel, un écran
indique que la tâche n'a pas abouti.
2 Appuyez sur [OK].
Pour supprimer une tâche d'émission qui a échoué, appuyez sur [Liste
des tâches] et supprimez cette tâche.
!
Détail
Si le rappel s'effectue normalement dans les réglages du mode Utilitaire,
aucun écran de rappel ne s'affiche.
Rappel
Le rappel se réfère à la renumérotation d'une destination.
Lorsque l'émission d'un fax n'aboutit pas parce que la machine réceptrice
est occupée ou pour une autre raison, la machine rappelle le numéro après
un laps de temps prédéterminé. Pendant ce laps de temps, le document à
émettre est traité en tant que document en attente.
!
Détail
La fonction de rappel est réglée en usine pour rappeler le numéro une fois
après un intervalle de trois minutes. Vous pouvez modifier ce réglage
dans l'écran Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage
Paramètres ligne” à la page 11-35.
Émission 3
C250 3-33
3.7 Réservation d'émission
Réservation d'émission
Vous pouvez paramétrer et lancer l'émission suivante pendant que la
machine exécute une communication ou une impression. C'est ce qu'on
appelle une réservation d'émission.
0 [Décrocher] ne peut pas être utilisé lors d'une réservation d'émission.
0 Si [Affichage émission] est réglé sur OFF, [Réservation tâche suivante]
n'apparaît pas.
0 Pour plus d'informations sur [Affichage émission], voir page 11-19.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande pour afficher l'écran
Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réservation tâche suivante].
3 Positionnez l'original.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur
la vitre d'exposition” à la page 3-8.
– Pour supprimer une émission
réservée, appuyez sur [Liste
tâches] - [Émission fax],
sélectionnez la tâche à supprimer
dans [Tâches en cours], puis
appuyez sur [Eff.].
– La touche Liste réservation de
l'écran Fax clignote en cas de
bourrage papier ou de manque de
papier pendant le traitement d'une
tâche, avant la réservation d'une
émission. Vous pouvez toutefois
réserver une ou des émissions.
4 Définissez le réglage des fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur le
réglage des fonctions de l'écran Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions
d'émission” à la page 3-11.
– Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et
Réglage communication” à la page 7-3.
5 Sélectionnez la destination.
6 Appuyez sur [Départ].
3 Émission
3-34 C250
3.8 Émission manuelle
Émission manuelle
L'émission manuelle permet d'envoyer des documents tout en confirmant
l'état de la machine réceptrice.
L'émission mémoire ne peut pas être utilisée avec l'émission manuelle.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande pour afficher l'écran
Fax.
2 Positionnez l'original.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Positionnement de l'original sur la
machine” à la page 3-7.
3 Appuyez sur [Décrocher].
– Si [Réception fax] est sélectionné, appuyez sur [Émission fax] pour
passer en mode d'émission.
4 Définissez les réglages de la numérisation, selon les besoins.
– Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11.
– Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
5 Saisissez la destination au clavier.
– Vous pouvez saisir 60 chiffres maximum.
– Appuyez sur [Raccrocher] pour revenir à l'écran Fax.
– Si un téléphone externe est branché, vous pouvez le décrocher
pour transmettre les documents.
6 Dès que vous entendez le signal, appuyez sur [Départ] sur l'écran
Décrocher.
– Si vous appuyez sur la touche [Départ] du tableau de commande,
l'écran de confirmation de la communication s'affiche. Appuyez sur
[Oui] pour lancer l'émission.
– Si un téléphone externe est branché, raccrochez-le une fois que
vous avez appuyé sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
Émission 3
C250 3-35
3.9 Annulation de l'émission
La procédure à suivre pour annuler l'émission dépend de l'état de l'émission
: la communication est en cours ou le document à émettre a été réservé. Sur
la machine FK-502, les instructions d'émission et les images mémorisées
constituent des tâches réservées. Les tâches de communication réservées
et les tâches en cours de traitement sont affichées sur l'écran Liste des
tâches.
3.9.1 Annulation d'une communication en cours
La procédure d'annulation d'une émission en cours est décrite ci-dessous.
Annulation d'une communication en cours
1 Appuyez sur [Liste tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Émission fax].
3 Vérifiez si les tâches ont été sélectionnées dans [Tâches en cours].
4 Sélectionnez la tâche à supprimer, puis appuyez sur [Suppri.].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui].
L'émission est annulée.
6 Appuyez sur [Quitt.].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
3 Émission
3-36 C250
3.9.2 Annulation des tâches réservées
La suppression d'une tâche réservée annule son émission.
Annulation des tâches réservées
1 Appuyez sur [Liste tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Émission fax].
3 Appuyez sur [Tâches en cours].
4 Appuyez sur [Tâches différées].
5 Sélectionnez le document réservé à annuler, puis appuyez sur
[Suppri.].
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
L'écran de confirmation apparaît.
6 Appuyez sur [Oui].
Le document réservé est supprimé.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
Émission 3
C250 3-37
3.10 Confirmation de la liste de tâches
Confirmation des documents réservés
Vous pouvez vérifier les réservations d'émissions stockées en mémoire sur
la liste des tâches affichée à l'écran.
1 Appuyez sur [Liste tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Émission fax].
3 Appuyez sur [Tâches en cours].
4 Appuyez sur [Tâches différées] ou [Tâches actives].
5 Confirmez la tâche, puis appuyez sur [Quitt.].
– Appuyez sur ou sur pour afficher l'écran précédent ou
suivant.
– Pour confirmer les détails d'une tâche, sélectionnez la tâche et
appuyez sur [Vérifier tâches] ou sur [Détail].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
3 Émission
3-38 C250
3.11 Confirmation des résultats de la communication
Confirmation des résultats de la communication
Pour vérifier les résultats de l'émission, vous pouvez appuyer sur [Liste
tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
1 Appuyez sur [Liste tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Impre.], [Émission fax] ou [Réc. fax/Boîte ut.].
3 Appuyez sur [Historique tâches].
Émission 3
C250 3-39
4 Confirmez les résultats de la communication.
– Émission fax
– Type :
Fax, e-mail ou boîte.
– Dest :
Numéro du fax, adresse e-mail ou nom de boîte de la destination.
– Début enreg. :
Date et heure de l'émission.
– # de pges :
Nombre de documents émis.
– Résultat :
“Tâche finie”, “Supprimée par utilisateur”, “Supprimée cause
erreur”, “Annulée” (agrafe ou perforation) ou “Tâche annulée”.
– Réc. fax/Boîte ut.
– Nom utilis :
Nom de l'utilisateur en mode autorisation utilisateur et nom du
compte en mode suivi du compte. Dans les autres cas, le type de
la copie, de l'impression ou de la réception fax est affiché.
– Nom du document :
Nom du document reçu ou enregistré.
– Début enreg. :
Date et heure de réception du document.
– # de pges :
Nombre de documents reçus.
3 Émission
3-40 C250
– Résultat :
“Tâche finie”, “Supprimée par utilisateur”, “Supprimée cause
erreur”, “Annulée” (agrafe ou perforation), “Impr. page séparation”,
“Enreg. fini” “Échec de l'enreg.” ou “Tâche annulée”.
– Vous pouvez appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] pour vérifier les
résultats de la communication dans un rapport d'émission ou dans
un rapport de réception. Ces rapports peuvent être imprimés.
– Appuyez sur [Détails] pour afficher l'écran de détails.
5 Une fois que vous avez terminé la confirmation, appuyez à deux
reprises sur [Quitt.].
L'écran précédent [Liste tâches] s'affiche à nouveau.
Émission 3
C250 3-41
3.12 Émissions en mémoire et en mémoire rapide
Cette machine offre deux méthodes d'émission des documents.
3.12.1 Émission mémoire
Avec cette méthode, toutes les pages sont numérisées, puis mémorisées
avant l'émission. Le document est automatiquement paginé et les images de
la première page apparaissent dans le rapport de communication.
Cependant, si le document à envoyer est volumineux ou si les images de
l’original sont envoyées en haute définition, la mémoire peut saturer.
La machine est automatiquement configurée sur Émission mémoire quand
l'une des procédures suivantes est réalisée.
- [Mémoire rapide] est défini sur l'écran Réglage communication.
3.12.2 Émission en mémoire rapide
Avec cette méthode, l'émission du fax s'effectue immédiatement après la
numérisation de chaque page. C'est la méthode recommandée pour ne pas
saturer la mémoire lors de l'émission d'un document volumineux.
3 Émission
3-42 C250
3.12.3 Pour émettre en mémoire rapide, procédez de la manière
suivante.
Émission en mémoire rapide
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] dans l'écran Fax.
3 Appuyez sur [Mémoire rapide].
4 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Mémoire rapide est configuré de façon à revenir à l'écran Fax.
5 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et
Réglage communication” à la page 7-3.
6 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Sélection de la destination” à la
page 3-21.
7 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Positionnement de l'original sur la
machine” à la page 3-7.
8 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
Émission 3
C250 3-43
!
Détail
Si la ligne est occupée, les données sont enregistrées en mémoire, puis
transmises lorsque la ligne est disponible.
Pour annuler la transmission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la
page 3-35.
Si la machine réceptrice n'est pas en état de recevoir, la destination sera
rappelée. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel manuel” à
la page 3-30.
Si la transmission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à
la page 5-3.
3 Émission
3-44 C250
3.13 Nombre d'originaux
Nombre d'originaux
En mode Mémoire rapide, le nombre total de pages émises suit le numéro de
la page sur la ligne d'informations sur l'expéditeur.
En émission mémoire, le nombre total de pages est imprimé
automatiquement. Vous n'avez pas besoin de définir cette fonction.
0 Spécifications
Le nombre total de pages est imprimé sous le format “P.numéro de la
page/nombre total de pages”.
La machine imprime le nombre total de pages que vous spécifiez, même
si ce nombre ne correspond pas au nombre total de pages lues.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
*Émission mémoire (TX), Effacer bord, Format d'origine, Originaux
mixtes, Émission en relève TX (normale), Émission en relève TX (bulletin).
* : La définition du nombre d'originaux est automatiquement annulée.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] dans l'écran Fax.
3 Appuyez sur [Mémoire rapide].
De : 01234567890123456 2005 /20 /31 01:23:00 P.005 / 010
Émission 3
C250 3-45
4 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
5 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.] - [Application] - [Nombre d'originaux].
6 Saisissez sur le clavier le nombre de pages du document.
– 999 pages maximum.
7 Appuyez à deux reprises sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage du nombre total de pages, appuyez sur
[Annul.].
Le nombre total de pages est enregistré, et vous revenez à l'écran Fax.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Réglage numérisation ou Réglage communication, voir “Ouverture
des écrans Réglage numérisation et Réglage communication” à la
page 7-3.
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Sélection de la destination” à la
page 3-21.
10 Positionnez le document original.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 lit le document et procède à l'émission de chaque page
numérisée.
3 Émission
3-46 C250
!
Détail
Pour annuler la transmission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la
page 3-35.
Si la machine réceptrice n'est pas en état de recevoir, la destination sera
rappelée. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel manuel” à
la page 3-30.
Si la transmission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à
la page 5-3.
Émission 3
C250 3-47
3.14 Émission différée (TX)
Émission différée (TX)
Cette fonction permet de préciser l'heure à laquelle la communication devra
commencer. L'envoi de fax la nuit ou tôt le matin permet de tirer parti de
tarifs réduits.
0 Spécifications
Avec Émission différée (TX), l'émission mémoire est automatiquement
sélectionnée.
Vous pouvez différer l'émission de 24 heures maximum, en précisant un
nombre de minutes et d'heures.
Vous ne pouvez pas préciser de date.
0 Vous pouvez préciser un nombre total de 21 transmissions différées TX
(20 émissions normales et 1 réception en relève RX).
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Nombre d'originaux, Émission en relève TX (normale), Émission en relève
TX (bulletin), Réception en relève RX (bulletin), Émission en mémoire
rapide.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] dans l'écran Fax.
3 Appuyez sur [Émission différée (TX)].
3 Émission
3-48 C250
4 Indiquez, à l'aide du clavier, l'heure à laquelle doit débuter l'émission.
– Saisissez l'heure et les minutes avec deux chiffres au format d'une
horloge de 24 heures.
– Exemple : pour démarrer la communication à 21:07, tapez “21” et
“07”.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
Vous revenez à l'écran Fax.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et
Réglage communication” à la page 7-3.
8 Indiquez la ou les destinations.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Sélection de la destination” à la
page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Positionnement des originaux sur la
vitre d'exposition” à la page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 lit le document et le place en mémoire jusqu'à son heure de
transmission.
Émission 3
C250 3-49
!
Détail
Pour annuler la transmission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la
page 3-35.
Si la machine réceptrice n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si la transmission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à
la page 5-3.
3 Émission
3-50 C250
3.15 Communications internationales
Communications internationales
La vitesse de transmission des communications internationales est réduite.
La procédure ci-dessous décrit les émissions à l'étranger.
Les numéros de téléphone internationaux, code du pays compris, peuvent
être enregistrés à l'aide des fonctions Programme et du Carnet d'adresses.
Pour plus d'informations à ce sujet, voir “Enregistrement du carnet
d'adresses” à la page 10-5.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Émission en relève TX (normale), Réception en relève RX (normale),
Émission en relève TX (Bulletin), Réception en relève RX (bulletin)
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] dans l'écran Fax.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage ligne].
Émission 3
C250 3-51
4 Appuyez sur [Communications internationales].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.] ou réappuyez sur
[Communications internationales].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
Les communications internationales sont sélectionnées et vous
revenez à l'écran Fax.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et
Réglage communication” à la page 7-3.
8 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Positionnement des originaux sur la
vitre d'exposition” à la page 3-8.
3 Émission
3-52 C250
9 Composez “001-010”, le code du pays
et le code régional de la destination,
puis le numéro de fax de la destination.
– Nous supposons ici que le préfixe
d'un appel à l'étranger est le 001,
mais ce préfixe varie d'un opérateur
téléphonique à un autre. Au besoin,
contactez votre opérateur pour
connaître le préfixe à utiliser pour
les appels à l'étranger.
– Les numéros de téléphone internationaux peuvent être enregistrés
dans le carnet d'adresse. Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Enregistrement du carnet d'adresses” à la page 10-5.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 démarre la transmission.
!
Détail
Pour annuler la transmission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la
page 3-35.
Si la machine réceptrice n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si la transmission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à
la page 5-3.
Émission 3
C250 3-53
3.16 Informations sur l'expéditeur
Les originaux émis sont enregistrés de la manière suivante par la machine
réceptrice.
3.16.1 Réglage à l'intérieur du corps du texte
!
Détail
Le nom de l'expéditeur et l'ID du fax sont définis en mode Utilitaire dans
les Informations en-tête. Les réglages par défaut de l'écran de base du
fax sont affichés dans le champ DE des informations sur l'expéditeur.
3.16.2 Réglage à l'extérieur du corps du texte
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur ce réglage, voir “Position en-tête/pied de
page” à la page 11-31.
De : 01234567890 01/20/2005 01:23#012 p.5/10
De : 01234567890 01/20/2005 01:23#012 p.5/10
3 Émission
3-54 C250
3.16.3 Réglage sur OFF
!
Détails
OFF ne peut pas être sélectionné dans certains pays.
Pour plus d'informations sur ce réglage, voir “Position en-tête/pied de
page” à la page 11-31.
4 Réception
Réception 4
C250 4-3
4 Réception
Ce chapitre explique le principe et les procédures de réception de fax.
4.1 Mode Réception
Cette machine gère deux modes de réception.
La ligne de téléphone doit être connectée selon le type d'utilisation.
Les deux modes de réception sont les suivants.
4.1.1 Réception automatique (mode fax uniquement)
Ce mode est utilisé si la ligne de téléphone est dédiée à un fax.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réception automatique (mode fax
uniquement)” à la page 4-3.
4.1.2 Réception manuelle (mode téléphone uniquement)
Le FK-502 doit être paramétré sur ce mode si un téléphone externe (ou un
répondeur) est connecté et si la majorité des appels entrants sont
téléphoniques.
Appel entrant
Document
reçu
Réception automatique du message
Appel entrant
Le téléphone externe sonne
Soulevez le combiné et parlez
Pour recevoir un fax, appuyez sur
4 Réception
4-4 C250
4.2 Réception automatique (mode fax uniquement)
Sélectionnez ce mode si la ligne téléphonique est dédiée à la communication
de fax. La machine reçoit automatiquement les fax dès que le nombre de
sonneries réglé est atteint. Pendant la réception, “Réception” s'affiche dans
la zone de message de l'écran.
!
Détail
Si l'option Affichage réception est réglée sur OFF, le message n'apparaît
pas.
Ce mode est actif si le mode de réception est réglé sur Réception auto dans
Réglage ligne du mode Utilitaire.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage de ce mode, voir “Réglage
Paramètres ligne” à la page 11-34.
Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage du nombre de sonneries avant
réception, voir “Réglage Paramètres ligne” à la page 11-34.
Appel entrant
Document
reçu
Réception automatique du message
Réception 4
C250 4-5
4.3 Réception manuelle (mode téléphone uniquement)
Réception manuelle (mode téléphone uniquement)
Si le mode de réception est réglé sur Réception manuelle dans Réglage ligne
du mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez recevoir les fax manuellement. Un téléphone
externe doit être connecté.
Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage de la réception manuelle, voir
“Réglage Paramètres ligne” à la page 11-34.
La procédure de réception manuelle est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Lorsque le téléphone externe sonne, appuyez sur [Décrocher].
2 Assurez-vous que [Réception (RX)] est en surbrillance.
– Si un document se trouve dans le chargeur ADF ou sur la vitre
d'exposition, Réception (RX) n'apparaît pas en surbrillance, même
en cas d'appel entrant. Dans ce cas, appuyez sur Réception (RX).
3 Appuyez sur [Départ] dans le menu Décrocher.
– Si vous appuyez sur la touche [Départ] du tableau de commande,
l'écran Décrocher s'affiche. Appuyez sur [Oui] pour lancer la
réception.
La réception commence.
Appel entrant
Le téléphone externe sonne
Soulevez le combiné et parlez
Pour recevoir un fax, appuyez sur [Départ]
4 Réception
4-6 C250
4.4 Réception impossible
En cas de problème de réception, un message d'erreur s'affiche. Référezvous
à “Message d'erreur affiché” à la page 5-6 pour connaître la manière
d'y remédier. Appuyez sur [Arrêt] pour supprimer le message affiché.
!
Détail
Si le téléphone externe continue de sonner, le mode de réception
(automatique/manuel) est peut-être réglé sur RX manuelle dans Réglages
initiaux du mode Utilitaire.
Cette option doit être réglée sur Réception auto pour pouvoir les
documents automatiquement. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage
Paramètres ligne” à la page 11-34.
La réception ne s'effectue pas si la mémoire est saturée. Vérifiez
également que le magasin de papier est chargé.
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Impossible de recevoir des messages” à
la page 5-4.
Réception 4
C250 4-7
4.5 Réception en mémoire de substitution
Lorsque le fax ne peut pas recevoir un document, celui-ci est mémorisé
jusqu'à ce qu'il puisse être imprimé. C'est ce qu'on appelle la réception en
mémoire de substitution.
- Le document mémorisé est imprimé dès que le problème est résolu
(bourrage papier, par exemple).
- Cette fonction n'est pas disponible si la mémoire est saturée.
4 Réception
4-8 C250
4.6 Enregistrement de la réception
À réception d'un document à enregistrer, son format de papier et le format
de papier du magasin défini sont comparés. Le document est ensuite réduit
au taux de réduction défini ou au meilleur taux de réduction pour convenir au
papier avant son enregistrement. Si vous définissez un taux de réduction
équimultiple, le document est enregistré à ce taux quel que soit le format de
papier du document reçu.
4.6.1 Enregistrement après réduction minimale
À réception d'un document formaté, celui-ci est enregistré après réduction
au taux défini pour ce format de papier (la valeur par défaut est de 96 %).
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur le taux de réduction minimum, voir “Réglage
Émission/Réception” à la page 11-37.
Original Document reçu
Réduit au
taux de
réduction
minimum
Réception 4
C250 4-9
4.6.2 Enregistrement après réduction pour convenir au papier
d'impression
Si le document reçu est plus long que le format de papier standard, le format
de papier approprié est déterminé en fonction de la longueur et de la largeur
de ce document, et celui-ci est imprimé sur du papier correspondant à ce
format. Par contre, si ce format conforme n'est pas chargé dans le magasin
de papier, le document est imprimé au format le plus proche après réduction.
Original Document reçu
Réduit pour
convenir au
format de
papier
4 Réception
4-10 C250
La machine applique les règles suivantes pour déterminer le meilleur format
de papier :
- Étape 1
Sélection du format de papier approprié
– La machine détermine le format de papier approprié en prenant en
compte la largeur et la longueur du document, tel qu'indiqué dans le
tableau suivant.
Largeur du
document reçu
Position d'enregistrement
des informations
de réception
Longueur du document reçu
A4 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 - 154 155 - 314 315 - 386 387 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 146 147 - 306 307 - 378 379 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné A5 v A4 w B4 w A3 w
B4 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 -195 196 - 395 396 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 186 187 - 386 387 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné B5 v B4 w A3 w
A3 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 - 226 227 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 217 218 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné A4 v A3 w
Réception 4
C250 4-11
Si “5,5 × 8,5 w” convient, “5,5 × 8,5 v” est sélectionné parce que c'est la
seule longueur réglable sur la machine.
- Étape 2
Sélection du papier d'impression du document
– La machine vérifie si le format de papier approprié déterminé à l'étape 1
est présent dans le magasin.
Le format de papier est présent :
La machine procède à l'enregistrement.
Le format de papier n'est pas présent dans le magasin ou la fonction
de sélection automatique du magasin est désactivée :
La machine recherche le second choix de format de papier approprié, tel
qu'indiqué dans le tableau. Si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est
réglée sur [ON] en mode Utilitaire, la machine recherche les formats de
papier appropriés pour enregistrer le document sur plusieurs formats.
Largeur du
document reçu
Position d'enregistrement
des informations
de réception
Longueur du document reçu
A4 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 - 150 151 - 305 306 - 309 391 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 141 142 - 296 297 - 381 382 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné 5.5 × 8.5 v
*1
8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 14 w 11 × 17 w
B4 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 - 232 233 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 223 224 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné 8.5 × 11 v 11 × 17 w
A3 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 - 232 233 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 223 224 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné 8.5 × 11 v 11 × 17 w
4 Réception
4-12 C250
Si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est réglé sur OFF :
Le papier est sélectionné en ordre décroissant.
!
Détail
Même si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est réglée sur OFF, la
machine imprime sur des pages distinctes les documents volumineux ou
en haute définition.
Format de
papier approprié
A5 v A4 w B5 v B4 w A4 v A3 w
Ordre de
placement
du papier
(de haut en
bas)
A5 v A4 w B5 v B4 w A4 v A3 w
A5 w A4 v B5 w A3 w A4 w B4 w
A4 w F4 w B4 w A4 w F4 w A4 w
A4 v B4 w A4 w A4 v B4 w F4 w
B5 v A3 w A4 v F4 w A3 w
B5 w F4 w
F4 w A3 w
B4 w
A3 w
Format de papier approprié
5.5 × 8.5 v 8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 11 v 8.5 × 14 w 11 × 17 w
Ordre de placement du
papier
(de haut en bas)
5.5 × 8.5 v 8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 11 v 8.5 × 14 w 11 × 17 w
5.5 × 8.5 w 8.5 × 11 v 8.5 × 11 w 11 × 17 w A3 w
A5 v A4 w A4 v B4 w B4 w
A5 w A4 v A4 w A3 w 8.5 × 14 w
8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 14 w 8.5 × 14 w 8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 11 w
8.5 × 11 v 11 × 17 w 11 × 17 w 8.5 × 11 v A4 w
A4 w B4 w B4 w A4 w
A4 v A3 w A3 w A4 v
B5 v
B5 w
8.5 × 14 w
11 × 17 w
B4 w
A3 w
Réception 4
C250 4-13
Si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est réglé sur ON :
Le papier est sélectionné en ordre décroissant.
!
Détail
Même si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est réglée sur ON, le
document est réduit pour tenir dans la largeur du papier sélectionné si
celui-ci est inférieur à la largeur de l'image du document reçu.
Si le papier d'impression des rapports d’activité de format B5 w, B5 v, A4
w ou A4 v est sélectionné, l'image de cette page peut être imprimée sur
plusieurs pages.
Format de
papier approprié
A5 v A4 w B5 v B4 w A4 v A3 w
Ordre de
placement
du papier
(de haut en
bas)
A5 v A4 w B5 v B4 w A4 v A3 w
A5 w F4 v B5 w B5 v A4 w A4 v
A4 w B4 w B4 w B5 w F4 w A4 w
A4 v A3 w A4 w A3 w B4 w
B5 w A4 v A4 v A3 w
F4 w F4 w A4 w
B5 v A3 w F4 w
B4 w
A3 w
4 Réception
4-14 C250
!
Détail
Si le format du papier d'impression du fax est inférieur au format de
papier sélectionné à l'étape 1, le document est réduit.
Si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est réglée sur [OFF] et que
l'orientation du papier d'impression est différente de celle du papier
sélectionné à l'étape 1, la sortie imprimée est automatiquement pivotée
de 90 degrés.
Si vous imprimez des originaux mixtes, ce processus est exécuté sur
chaque page.
Si les formats de papier sélectionnés aux étapes 1 et 2 se trouvent dans
plusieurs magasins, le magasin utilisé est sélectionné en fonction du
réglage de la fonction automatique du format de papier. Pour plus
d'informations, voir “Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie”.
Si le format de papier requis se trouve uniquement dans le magasin
d'insertion manuelle, le document est imprimé sur le papier chargé dans
ce magasin. Toutefois, si la fonction de sélection automatique du format
de papier est désactivée ou si la fonction de sélection automatique du
Format de papier approprié
5.5 × 8.5 v 8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 11 v 8.5 × 14 w 11 × 17 w
Ordre de placement du
papier
(de haut en bas)
5.5 × 8.5 v 8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 11 v 8.5 × 14 w 11 × 17 w
5.5 × 8.5 w A4 w 8.5 × 11 w 11 × 17 w A3 w
A5 v 8.5 × 14 w A4 v B4 w 8.5 × 11 v
A5 w 11 × 17 w A4 w A3 w 8.5 × 11 w
8.5 × 11 w B4 w 8.5 × 14 w 8.5 × 11 v A4 v
8.5 × 11 v A3 w 11 × 17 w 8.5 × 11 w A4 w
A4 w B4 w A4 v
A4 v A3 w A4 w
B5 v
B5 w
8.5 × 14 w
11 × 17 w
B4 w
A3 w
Réception 4
C250 4-15
magasin est désactivée pour ce magasin, ce magasin n'est pas
sélectionné.
Même si l'option de division de la page est réglée sur ON, la page n'est
pas divisée si [Réglage TX/RX] est réglée comme suit.
[Sélection magasin impression réception] est réglé
[Réduction min. pour impression réception] est réglé sur [x 1.0]
Sélection papier d'impression] est réglée sur [Format fixe] ou [Format
prioritaire]
[Impression R/V pour réception] est réglée sur [ON]
Si aucune option de sélection du papier d'impression n'est définie, un
message vous demande de le faire.
Si [Sélection papier d'impression] est réglé sur [Format prioritaire ]:
Le format de papier approprié est sélectionné parmi A4, B4 et A3 (8,5 ×
11, 8,5 × 14 et 11 × 17). Si ce format de papier n'est pas disponible, le
papier est sélectionné selon la procédure standard, puis le document est
enregistré.
Si [Sélection papier d'impression] est réglé sur [Format fixe ]:
Le format de papier approprié est sélectionné parmi A4, B4 et A3 (8,5 ×
11, 8,5 × 14 et 11 × 17). Si ce format de papier n'est pas disponible, le
message demeure jusqu'à ce que le papier soit chargé.
Si [Sélection magasin impression réception] est réglé sur une valeur autre
que [Auto ]:
Le document est enregistré de façon à convenir au format de papier
chargé dans le magasin (à l'exception du magasin d'insertion manuelle)
défini pour [Sélection magasin impression réception].
Si [Sélection papier d'impression] est réglé sur une valeur autre que
[Sélection auto] et si [Sélection magasin impression réception] est réglé
sur une valeur autre que [Auto ]:
Le réglage défini pour [Sélection magasin impression réception] a la
priorité.
4 Réception
4-16 C250
4.6.3 Enregistrement à l'échelle de 100 %
Un document reçu est enregistré pour tenir sur le même format de papier à
l'échelle de 100 % si [Réduction mini impres. réception] est réglé sur [× 1.0]
en mode Utilitaire. Si le même format de papier n'est pas disponible, le document
est enregistré pour tenir sur le format de papier supérieur suivant.
!
Détails
L'option Imprimer page de séparation n'est pas disponible.
Vous ne pouvez pas enregistrer d'image supérieure à 11 x 17 pouces
(280 mm x 431 mm).
Si le papier approprié n'est pas disponible, un message s'affiche jusqu'au
chargement du papier.
Méthode d'enregistrement à la réception
Le tableau suivant indique la relation entre le format de papier du document
reçu et l'enregistrement de facto du document sur la machine.
Original Document reçu
Réduit à
l'échelle de
100 %
Réception 4
C250 4-17
!
Détail
Si [Impression R/V pour réception] est réglé sur ON, l'écran peut indiquer
le papier.
Pour plus d'informations, voir page 11-34.
Format de papier du
document reçu
Réglage de [Réduction min.
pour impression réception]
Sélection dans [Sélection
magasin impression
réception]
96 - 87%
Format standard (A3 à A5) Enregistré après réduction
pour tenir sur le même format
de papier
Enregistré après réduction
pour tenir sur le format de
papier spécifié
Original long
(plus long que le
format
standard)
L'enregistrement
avec division
de la
page est
OFF
Enregistré après réduction
pour tenir sur le format de
papier approprié
Enregistré après réduction
pour tenir sur le format de
papier spécifié
L'enregistrement
avec division
de la
page est
ON
Enregistré après division de la
page en fonction du papier
utilisé
Enregistré après réduction
pour tenir sur le format de
papier spécifié
A
B
C A
B
C
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
A
B
CD
A
B
C
D
4 Réception
4-18 C250
4.7 Informations de réception
Lorsque les informations de réception (date, heure, numéros de réception et
de page) sont réglées sur l'intérieur ou l'extérieur du corps du texte avec
l'option [Position en-tête/pied de page], elles sont enregistrées dans le
document reçu.
Réglage à l'intérieur du corps du texte
Réglage à l'extérieur du corps du texte
Réglage sur OFF
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur ce réglage, voir “Position en-tête/pied de
page” à la page 11-31.
Original
Date RX : 01/20/2005 R001 P.001/003
Original
Date RX : 01/20/2005 R001 P.001/003
Original
5 Dépannage
Dépannage 5
C250 5-3
5 Dépannage
5.1 Impossible d'envoyer des messages
Si vous ne parvenez pas à envoyer un document, consultez le tableau cidessous
pour tenter de remédier au problème. Si vous ne pouvez résoudre
le problème en suivant les solutions proposées, contactez le service aprèsvente.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur les messages d'erreur, voir “Message
d'erreur affiché” à la page 5-6.
En cas de problème de bourrage des originaux ou du papier des
magasins, de mauvaise qualité de l'image ou de manque de toner,
consultez le “Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie” fourni avec le
FK-502.
Points à vérifier Actions correctives
La procédure d'émission a-t-elle
été effectuée correctement ?
Vérifiez la procédure d'émission et réessayez.
Le numéro de fax de la destination
est-il correct ? Les numéros
d'appel programmés ou abrégés
sont-ils enregistrés
correctement ?
Si vous utilisez un numéro programmé ou abrégé, il est
possible qu'il ait été enregistré incorrectement. Essayez
d'imprimer la liste des numéros abrégés et vérifiez si le
numéro est enregistré correctement. Si ce n'est pas le cas,
corrigez l'enregistrement.
Le réglage de la ligne est-il
correct ?
Vérifiez si la [Méthode de numérotation] de [Réglage
Paramètres ligne] dans le mode Utilitaire correspond à la
ligne téléphonique utilisée. Corrigez ce réglage si ce n'est
pas le cas.
La ligne téléphonique est-elle
connectée correctement ?
Vérifiez si la prise de téléphone est bien branchée. Si ce
n'est pas le cas, branchez-la.
Le problème se situe-t-il au niveau
le la machine réceptrice ?
Téléphonez à la destination et vérifiez si le fax récepteur
est hors tension, s'il manque de papier ou s'il existe un
autre problème.
5 Dépannage
5-4 C250
5.2 Impossible de recevoir des messages
Si vous ne parvenez pas à recevoir un document, consultez le tableau cidessous
pour tenter de remédier au problème. Si vous ne parvenez pas à
résoudre le problème en suivant les solutions proposées, contactez le
service après-vente.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur les messages d'erreur, voir “Message
d'erreur affiché” à la page 5-6.
En cas de problème de bourrage des originaux ou du papier des
magasins, de mauvaise qualité de l'image ou de manque d'encre,
consultez le “Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie” fourni avec le
FK-502.
Dépannage 5
C250 5-5
Description du
problème
Points à vérifier Actions correctives
Impossible de
recevoir
Y-a-t-il du papier
dans la machine ?
Si l'icône d'ajout de papier est allumée, la machine
manque de papier et les documents reçus sont
mémorisés. Ajoutez du papier. Pour connaître la
procédure, consultez le “Manuel d'utilisation –
Opérations Copie”.
Y-a-t-il un bourrage
papier dans la
machine ?
En cas de bourrage papier, les documents reçus sont
mémorisés. Dégagez le bourrage papier. Pour
connaître la procédure, consultez le “Manuel
d'utilisation – Opérations Copie”.
Le flacon de toner
est-il vide ?
La réception de message ne s'effectue pas si le flacon
de toner est vide. Remplacez immédiatement le flacon
de toner. Pour connaître la procédure, consultez le
“Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie”.
Le FK-502 est-il en
mode de réception
manuelle ?
Si l'option [Mode réception] de [Réglage Paramètres
ligne] dans le mode Utilitaire est réglée sur [Réception
manuelle], vous devez réaliser la procédure de
réception manuelle. Pour connaître cette procédure,
voir “Réception manuelle (mode téléphone
uniquement)” à la page 4-5.
La ligne
téléphonique estelle
connectée
correctement ?
Vérifiez si la prise de téléphone est bien branchée. Si
ce n'est pas le cas, branchez-la.
Le FK-502 est-il en
mode de
communication en
réseau fermé ?
Si la fonction de communication en réseau fermé (pour
empêcher la réception de documents non sollicités)
est active (ON), vous ne pouvez recevoir que les
documents provenant de fax déterminés.
L'expéditeur a-t-il
envoyé une adresse
secondaire erronée
en fonction
F-code ?
Une erreur de communication peut survenir en cas de
réception d'une adresse secondaire erronée alors que
la boîte utilisateur confidentielle est active. Dans ces
circonstances, la réception est impossible. Vérifiez
auprès de l'expéditeur si l'adresse secondaire a été
définie correctement.
Pas de sortie La réception fax
a-t-elle été activée ?
Identifiez la boîte de sauvegarde du fichier dans les
fonctions de réception PC-fax.
Le Paramètre boîte
utilisateur TSI est-il
réglé sur ON ?
Vérifiez la boîte définie dans le Paramètre boîte utilisateur
TSI.
La réception
mémoire a-t-elle été
activée ?
Une fois la réception mémoire activée, imprimez le
document reçu comme suit :
• Appuyez sur [Boîte] sur le tableau de commande.
• Appuyez sur [Boîte utilisateur système].
• Appuyez sur [Boîte utilisateur réception mémoire].
• Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
• Sélectionnez le document à imprimer et appuyez
sur Imprimer.
• Une fois le document imprimé, appuyez sur
[Fermer].
5 Dépannage
5-6 C250
5.3 Message d'erreur affiché
Les messages d'erreur énumérés dans le tableau ci-dessous s'affichent en
cas de problème. Référez-vous aux explications pour remédier à la situation.
Si vous ne pouvez toujours pas émettre correctement après avoir corriger le
problème, contactez le service après-vente.
Message d'erreur Actions correctives
Occupé Bien que le nombre de rappels déterminé ait été tenté, la machine
réceptrice est toujours occupée. Confirmez l'état de la machine
réceptrice et renvoyez.
Pas de réponse La machine n'est pas en état de répondre. Contactez la
destination par téléphone, confirmez l'état de la machine et
réessayez.
Mémoire saturée • Si la mémoire devient saturée pendant la lecture du
document :
Pour émettre la partie du document lue, appuyez sur [Départ].
Appuyez sur [Arrêt] pour annuler l'émission.
Dépannage 5
C250 5-7
5.4 Appeler SAV
Ce message apparaît lorsque vous devez appeler le service après-vente. Les
numéros de téléphone et de fax du service après-vente sont également
indiqués. La procédure de signalisation d'un problème par téléphone au
service après-vente est présentée ci-dessous.
7 ATTENTION
Risque d'accident grave
% Pour prévenir tout risque d'accident grave, procédez de la manière
suivante lorsque le message d'appel du SAV s'affiche et que le fax ne
fonctionne plus.
Procédure à suivre lorsque le message d'appel du SAV s'affiche
1 Notez le numéro du code d'erreur.
2 Mettez hors tension le commutateur Marche/Arrêt principal et
secondaire.
3 Débranchez le cordon d'alimentation.
4 Contactez le service après-vente et indiquez à votre correspondant le
numéro du code d'erreur.
5 Dépannage
5-8 C250
6 Caractéristiques
techniques
Caractéristiques techniques 6
C250 6-3
6 Caractéristiques techniques
6.1 Caractéristiques techniques
Les caractéristiques techniques des fonctions de télécopie sont énumérées
ci-dessous.
Ces caractéristiques peuvent être modifiées sans préavis.
Fonction Caractéristiques techniques
Capacité de mémoire
image
27 Go* (27 des 40 Go du disque dur sont utilisés en tant que
mémoire.)
Nombre max. de pages
enregistrées
Environ 9 000 pages*
(pages enregistrées au format KONICA MINOLTA standard A4
contenant environ 700 caractères en définition “fine”)
Lignes téléphoniques Lignes d'abonnés (réseaux de communication fax compris)
Réseau privé (PBX)
Résolution de numérisation G3
Ultra fine : 600 ppp × 600 ppp
Super fine : 16 points/mm × 15,4 lignes/mm,
8 points/mm × 15,4 lignes/mm,
400 ppp × 400 ppp
Fine : 8 points/mm × 7,7 lignes/mm,
200 ppp × 200 ppp
Normale : 8 points/mm × 3,85 lignes/mm,
200 ppp × 100 ppp
Les résolutions de numérisation ci-dessus dépendent des
capacités de la machine de destination.
Vitesse de transmission 2400, 4800, 7200, 9600, 12000, 14400, 16800, 19200, 21600,
24000, 26400, 28800, 31200, 33600 bps
Temps d'émission 2 secondes
Temps d'émission de pages au format KONICA MINOLTA
standard A4 contenant environ 700 caractères en résolution
normale. Il s'agit du temps d'émission de l'image uniquement
(non compris le temps d'établissement de la communication). Le
temps de communication varie selon le contenu des originaux et
le type de ligne téléphonique à la destination.
Codage MH, MR, MMR, JBIG
* Le disque dur interne est utilisé pour chacune des fonctions des écrans Copie, Numérisation,
Fax et Boîte.
Format max. de
numérisation
280 mm × 431 mm (11 pouces × 17 pouces) ou A3
(420 mm × 297 mm)
Largeur : 297 mm
Longueur : 432 mm max.
Format max.
d'enregistrement
280 mm × 431 mm (11 pouces × 17 pouces) ou A3
(420 mm × 297 mm)
Les originaux supérieurs à 600 mm ne peuvent pas être reçus.
Lors de la réception d'originaux plus longs que le format de papier
chargé dans les magasins, ils sont imprimés selon le réglage de
l'option [Imprimer page de séparation].
Fonction Caractéristiques techniques
7 Applications d'émission
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-3
7 Applications d'émission
7.1 Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et
Réglage communication
!
Détail
Appuyez sur la touche de la fonction à définir pour ouvrir l'écran de
réglage correspondant (les touches [Mémoire rapide], [V34 OFF], [ECM
OFF] et [Communications internationales] n'affichent pas d'écran car ce
sont des touches à bascule qui activent/désactivent la fonction).
Vous pouvez sélectionner plusieurs fonctions, du moment que celles-ci
ne sont pas incompatibles entre elles. En cas d'incompatibilité, la
fonction est grisée sur le tableau de commande.
Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et Réglage communication
Pour envoyer un fax par le biais d'une fonction Application, ouvrez l'écran
Réglage numérisation ou Réglage communication et paramétrez les
fonctions voulues.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande pour ouvrir l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.] ou sur [Réglage comm.] dans l'écran
Fax.
7 Applications d'émission
7-4 C250
3 Appuyez sur la touche de la fonction voulue. Pour afficher l'écran de
réglage d'une application, appuyez sur la touche [Application] dans
l'écran Réglage numérisation.
4 Effectuez l'une des opérations suivantes.
– Sur l'écran voulu affiché :
Réglez la fonction dans l'écran affiché, puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Une fois l'option sélectionnée :
Appuyez sur [OK].
– Appuyez sur [Annul.] pour annuler le réglage et revenir au réglage
de communication d'origine.
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-5
7.2 Présentation des fonctions d'application
Les fonctions suivantes apparaissent dans l'écran Réglage numérisation et
l'écran Réglage communication.
[Annul.]
Annule le réglage et revient aux conditions de communication d'origine.
[OK]
Affiche à nouveau l'écran Fax.
[OFF]
Désactive l'option et vous ramène à l'écran précédent.
[Reset]
Réinitialise toutes les options de l'écran.
Écran Réglage numérisation
Écran Application
Écran Réglage communication
Fonction Description
Originaux mixtes : Vous pouvez envoyer des pages de différents formats en une
seule procédure. (page 7-7)
Position reliure : Spécifie la position de l'agrafage d'un original recto-verso placé
sur le chargeur de document (ADF) et place à la verticale le
verso de l'original. (page 7-9)
7 Applications d'émission
7-6 C250
!
Détail
La touche associée à la fonction sélectionnée apparaît inversée.
Appuyez sur [Annul.] pour revenir à l'écran Fax.
Le mode de communication V34 est utilisé par le fax Super G3.
Effacement bords : Lors de l'émission des pages d'un livre, cette fonction efface les
bandes noires qui apparaîtraient en marge. (page 7-12)
Ajustement fond : Règle la densité de la couleur de fond de l'original. (page 7-15)
Netteté : Rend plus net le contour des caractères. (page 7-18)
Nombre originaux : En mode Mémoire rapide, inclut le nombre total de pages dans
les informations sur le nombre de pages. (page 3-44)
Format de numérisat. : Permet de préciser la taille du document à émettre. Cette
fonction est utile lors de l'émission d'une partie d'une ou de
plusieurs pages. (page 7-21)
Type de fichier : Précise le format d'un fichier joint à un message e-mail.
(page 7-24)
Mémoire rapide : Émet un message immédiatement après la lecture d'une page
d'un document. (page 3-42)
Mot de passe émission (TX)*1
:
Joint un mot de passe à l'émission. Cette fonction est requise
si le poste récepteur fonctionne en réseau fermé. (page 7-26)
Émission en relève (TX) : Permet de numériser un document et de le mémoriser jusqu'à
ce que la destination initie la transmission en adressant une
requête de relève. (page 9-3)
Réception en relève (RX) : Permet d'initier la réception en adressant à la destination une
requête de relève de document. (page 9-6)
Émission différée (TX) : Permet de préciser l'heure de l'émission. (page 3-47)
Émission F-code (TX)*2 : Permet de préciser l'adresse secondaire et le mot de passe
requis pour la communication confidentielle et l'émission en
relais. (page 7-26, page 7-29, page 7-32, page 9-9)
Réglage ligne Communications
internationales
Spécifie un débit de transmission moins rapide. (page 3-50)
ECM OFF Le mode de correction d'erreur (ECM) peut être désactivé.
(page 7-35)
V34 OFF Si l’équipement du central ne permet pas d'utiliser le protocole
V.34, le mode V34 est désactivé. (page 7-38)
Fonction Description
*1 : Cette fonction permet d'émettre ou de recevoir avec des postes fonctionnant en réseau
fermé.
Dans ce cas, la fonction F-code doit être active sur les deux machines.
*2 : F-code est utilisé.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-7
7.3 Originaux mixtes
Fonction Originaux mixtes
Cette fonction permet d'envoyer des pages de différents formats en une seule
séquence d'opérations.
0 Spécifications
L'Émission mémoire est automatiquement sélectionnée.
Si les options Format d'origine et Originaux mixtes sont toutes deux sélectionnées,
le Format d'origine a la priorité.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Nombre originaux, Position reliure, Réception en relève
RX (normal), Réception en relève RX (bulletin)
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour afficher
l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
3 Appuyez sur [Originaux mixtes].
Émission et reproduction dans
le même format que l'original à
la destination.
Vous placez les originaux mixtes
dans le chargeur RADF.
7 Applications d'émission
7-8 C250
4 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Réglage numérisation ou Réglage communication, voir
“Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la page 7-5.
7 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
8 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
9 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-9
7.4 Position reliure
Fonction Position reliure
La fonction d'inversion Haut/Bas et la fonction Gauche/Droite précisent le
type de reliure lors de l'émission d'un document recto-verso. En
sélectionnant le type de reliure, vous vous assurez que le document sera
relié, et donc lu, correctement.
0 Spécifications
Le chargeur de document (ADF) doit être utilisé. La vitre d'exposition ne
peut pas être utilisée pour l'émission en mode reliure.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Originaux mixtes, Réception en relève RX (normal), Réception en relève
RX (bulletin)
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
Reliure Haut/Bas
Reliure Gauche/Droite
Fax de destination
Émission
7 Applications d'émission
7-10 C250
3 Appuyez sur [Position reliure].
4 Appuyez sur [Reliure G/D] ou [Reliure H/B] pour préciser le type de
reliure du document original imprimé recto-verso.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Application s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-11
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
10 Placez le document avec la page imprimée vers le haut.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
7 Applications d'émission
7-12 C250
7.5 Émission avec effacement des bords
2
Remarque
Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
Fonction d'émission avec effacement des bords
Lors de l'émission d'un document relié, cette fonction supprime les bandes
noires qui risqueraient d'apparaître en marge des pages transmises. Ces
bandes noires apparaissent lorsque la machine lit les données d'un livre ou
lorsque le chargeur de document n'est pas rabattu.
0 Spécifications
L'Émission mémoire rapide est automatiquement sélectionnée.
Vous pouvez utiliser le chargeur ADF ou la vitre d'exposition.
La largeur à effacer peut être définie par incréments de 0,1 mm
(1/16 pouce) dans une plage de 0,1 à 50 mm (1/16 à 2 pouces).
Réglage initial de la largeur à effacer : 50 mm (3/16 pouce).
Si vous combinez plusieurs effacements de bords, ils s'appliquent au
format de page original non encore effacé.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Nombre originaux, Réception en relève RX (normal),
Réception en relève RX (bulletin)
Largeur à
effacer
Émission standard Émission avec effacement des bords
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-13
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
3 Appuyez sur [Effacement bords].
4 Sélectionnez [Haut], [Gauc], [Droi] ou [Bas] et tapez au clavier la largeur
à effacer, [+] ou [-].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Application s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Applications d'émission
7-14 C250
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
10 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si la machine réceptrice n'est pas en état de recevoir, la destination sera
rappelée. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel manuel” à
la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-15
7.6 Ajustement fond
Fonction Ajustement fond
Cette fonction permet d'ajuster la densité de la couleur d'arrière-plan de
l'original. Si le fond de l'original est en couleur, il risque d'être reproduit en
noir. Dans ce cas, vous pouvez envoyer un message après avoir ajusté la
densité de la couleur de fond de l'original.
0 Spécifications
Vous pouvez utiliser le chargeur de document (ADF) et la vitre
d'exposition.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
3 Appuyez sur [Ajustement fond].
7 Applications d'émission
7-16 C250
4 Appuyez sur [+ Foncé] pour assombrir la densité de la couleur de fond
de l'original, et sur [+ Clair] pour l'éclaircir. Appuyez sur [Auto] pour
activer le réglage automatique.
– Si vous sélectionnez [Auto], les étapes permettant de déterminer
l'ajustement approprié du fond sont effectuées page par page, ce
qui peut ralentir l'opération de numérisation.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Application s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
10 Positionnez le document original.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-17
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler la transmission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la
page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
7 Applications d'émission
7-18 C250
7.7 Netteté
Fonction Netteté
Cette fonction permet d'ajuster la netteté des bords des caractères. Si les
caractères d'un document ne sont pas nets, augmentez la netteté ([+]) pour
définir plus précisément leurs contours ou diminuez-la ([-]), le cas échéant.
0 Spécifications
Vous pouvez utiliser le chargeur de document (ADF) et la vitre
d'exposition.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
3 Appuyez sur [Netteté].
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-19
4 Selon que vous voulez rendre les contours des caractères plus ou
moins nets, appuyez sur [ ] ou [ ] vers la droite [+] ou vers la gauche
[-].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Application s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
10 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
7 Applications d'émission
7-20 C250
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-21
7.8 Format de numérisation
Fonction Format de numérisation
Cette fonction permet de préciser que le format de papier du document émis
doit être identique au format du papier chargé à l'autre extrémité. Cela
permet d'imprimer les images sans réduction sur le poste récepteur. En
général, si le format du papier chargé à la destination ne peut contenir
l'image transmise, cette image est réduite. Cette fonction permet aussi
d'imprimer une partie de l'image, sans réduction.
0 Spécifications
L'Émission mémoire est automatiquement sélectionnée.
L'emplacement de lecture des originaux varie selon que l'original est
placé sur le chargeur ADF ou sur la vitre d'exposition.
Si Format d'origine et Originaux mixtes sont toutes deux sélectionnées,
le Format d'origine a la priorité.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Nombre originaux, Réception en relève RX (normal),
Réception en relève RX (bulletin)
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
7 Applications d'émission
7-22 C250
3 Appuyez sur [Format de numérisat.].
4 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au format du document à
émettre.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Application s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-23
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
10 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
7 Applications d'émission
7-24 C250
7.9 Type de fichier
Définition du type de fichier
Cette fonction permet de préciser le type de fichier image à lire si la
destination est une adresse e-mail ou une boîte utilisateur.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.].
3 Appuyez sur [Type de fichier].
4 Sélectionnez le type de fichier.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-25
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
7 Applications d'émission
7-26 C250
7.10 Mot de passe émission (TX)
Mot de passe émission (TX)
L'émission avec ID exige un mot de passe. Si le poste récepteur fonctionne
en réseau fermé, l'expéditeur doit envoyer le même mot de passe que celui
du réseau fermé en réception.
0 Spécification
Cette fonction n'est disponible que si la machine du correspondant est
dotée de la fonction Réseau fermé en réception (Transmission de mot de
passe).
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Émission en relève TX (normal), Réception en relève RX (normal),
Émission F-code.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Mot de passe émission (TX)].
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-27
4 Tapez le mot de passe au clavier (20 caractères maximum).
– Les caractères et signes autorisés sont les suivants : 0 à 9, # et *
– Pour effacer un caractère, appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour effacer tout le mot de passe.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
7 Applications d'émission
7-28 C250
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-29
7.11 Communication confidentielle (Émission F-code)
Fonction Communication confidentielle
Cette fonction permet d'utiliser des boîtes confidentielles (similaires à des
comptes de messagerie) pour échanger des informations avec certaines
personnes. Outre l'envoi d'un document vers une boîte confidentielle de
destination (émission confidentielle), la réception d'un document dans une
boîte confidentielle sur votre poste (réception confidentielle) est possible.
Les sections suivantes décrivent les procédures d'émission confidentielle.
0 Spécifications
L'émission confidentielle suppose que le fax récepteur soit doté d'une
boîte confidentielle et d'un mot de passe spécifique (ce dernier n'est pas
toujours requis par le fax récepteur). L'émission confidentielle suppose
en outre que le fax de destination soit doté de la fonction F-code.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Émission en relève TX (normal), Réception en relève RX (normal), Mot de
passe émission (TX)>
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
Expéditeur Boîte de documents Récepteur
confidentiels
7 Applications d'émission
7-30 C250
3 Appuyez sur [Émission F-code (TX)].
4 Saisissez le numéro de la boîte sur le poste récepteur dans le champ
Adresse secondaire. Appuyez sur [Mot Passe] et tapez le mot de passe
au clavier, s'il y a lieu.
– L'adresse secondaire et le mot de passe peuvent comporter 20
caractères maximum.
– Pour la communication avec le FK-502, saisissez 9 caractères
maximum pour le numéro de la boîte et 8 caractères maximum pour
le mot de passe. Les caractères autorisés dépendent de la
machine.
– Les caractères et signes autorisés dans le mot de passe sont les
suivants : 0 à 9, # et *.
– Pour effacer un caractère, appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour effacer l'intégralité de l'entrée.
Si le mot de passe est requis, appuyez sur [Oui] et saisissez-le.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-31
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour interrompre la séquence d'opérations, appuyez sur [Arrêt].
7 Applications d'émission
7-32 C250
7.12 Requête d'émission en relais (Émission F-code)
Requête d'émission en relais
La requête d'émission en relais consiste à faire transiter les transmissions
vers plusieurs destinations sur une station relais (intermédiaire). Cette
fonction permet de réduire les coûts de communication des destinations
éloignées. Vous pouvez définir plusieurs stations, chacune d'entre elles étant
composée d'une station de relais et de plusieurs destinations.
0 Spécifications
La requête d'émission en relais n'est disponible que si cette fonction a
été activée en mode Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage
fonction” à la page 11-40.
La station d'origine émet la demande de relais, la station de relais relaye
les transmissions et les stations d'arrivée sont celles qui reçoivent et
terminent les communications.
Cette fonction suppose le paramétrage sur la station de relais d'un
numéro de boîte de relais, d'un mot de passe de relais et d'un numéro de
groupe de destination.
Elle suppose en outre que la station de relais soit dotée de la fonction
F-code.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Émission en relève TX (normal), Réception en relève RX (normal), Mot de
passe émission (TX)
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
Station d'origine Station relais intermédiaire
Station distante
Appel international Station distante Appel local
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-33
3 Appuyez sur [Émission F-code (TX)].
4 Saisissez dans le champ Adresse secondaire le numéro de la boîte de
relais sur la station de relais, et le mot de passe dans le champ Mot
Passe, à l'aide du clavier.
– Les champs [Adresse secondaire] et [Mot Passe] acceptent 20
caractères maximum.
– Les caractères et signes autorisés dans le champ [Mot Passe] sont
les suivants : 0 à 9, # et *
– Pour effacer un caractère, appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour effacer l'intégralité de l'entrée.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Applications d'émission
7-34 C250
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Désignez la station relais.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour interrompre la séquence d'opérations, appuyez sur [Arrêt].
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-35
7.13 ECM OFF
Fonction ECM OFF
Les communications peuvent être effectuées avec le mode de correction
d'erreur (ECM) désactivé. Ce mode, établi par l'ITU-T (International
Telecommunications Union), permet aux télécopieurs qui en sont équipés de
communiquer les uns avec les autres et de confirmer que les données
émises sont exemptes d'erreur. Les perturbations dues aux bruits sur la ligne
ou autres sont ainsi éliminées. Le FK-502 utilise par défaut le mode ECM lors
des émissions.
0 Spécifications
En cas de perturbation sur la ligne, le temps de communication peut être
légèrement plus long lorsque le mode ECM est activé.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Émission en relève TX (normal), Réception en relève RX (normal), V34
OFF, Émission en relève (bulletin) et Réception en relève RX (bulletin).
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage ligne].
7 Applications d'émission
7-36 C250
4 Appuyez sur [ECM OFF].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.] ou rappuyez sur [ECM
OFF].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 démarre la transmission.
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-37
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
7 Applications d'émission
7-38 C250
7.14 V34 OFF
Mode V34 OFF
Le fax Super G3 utilise le protocole V.34. Si la destination ou le FK-502 est
connecté à la ligne via un équipement d’extension de central, et selon les
conditions de la ligne, la communication avec le Super G3 peut ne pas
aboutir.
Dans ces circonstances, nous vous recommandons d'émettre en
désactivant le mode V34 (OFF). Ce mode sera automatiquement réactivé à
la fin de l'émission.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Réception en relève RX (normal), ECM OFF
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage ligne].
Applications d'émission 7
C250 7-39
4 Appuyez sur [V34 OFF].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.] ou rappuyez sur [V34
OFF].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
7 Applications d'émission
7-40 C250
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
8 Fonctions utiles pour la
réception
Fonctions utiles pour la réception 8
C250 8-3
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8.1 Utilisation d'un document reçu en réception
confidentielle
8.1.1 Utilisation d'un document reçu en réception confidentielle
La communication confidentielle permet d'utiliser des boîtes confidentielles
(similaires à des comptes de messagerie) pour échanger des informations
avec certaines personnes. Outre l'envoi d'un document vers une boîte confidentielle
de destination (émission confidentielle), la réception d'un document
dans une boîte confidentielle sur votre poste (réception confidentielle)
est possible. Les sections suivantes décrivent les procédures d'impression
d'un document reçu dans une boîte utilisateur confidentielle, et la suppression
d'un tel document.
Spécifications
Si vous comptez utiliser la réception confidentielle, définissez la boîte utilisateur
confidentielle (voir “Réglage des boîtes confidentielles” à la page 10-46)
et le mot de passe d'accès au FK-502, puis fournissez ces données au poste
à l'autre extrémité. L'émission suppose que le fax de destination soit doté de
la fonction F-code.
Expéditeur Boîte de documents Récepteur
confidentiels
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8-4 C250
8.1.2 Impression du document reçu dans une boîte utilisateur
confidentielle
Impression du document reçu dans une boîte utilisateur confidentielle
Lorsque le FK-502 reçoit un document confidentiel, il imprime automatiquement
un rapport de réception confidentielle. Procédez comme suit pour imprimer
un document reçu dans une boîte utilisateur confidentielle.
1 Appuyez sur [Boîte] dans le tableau de commande.
2 Sélectionnez l'onglet [Boîte utilisateur publique], puis une [Boîte utilisateur
confidentielle].
3 Si un mot de passe d'accès a été défini, saisissez-le dans le champ affiché,
puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe peut comporter 8 caractères maximum.
4 Sélectionnez le No. boîte confidentielle à l'aide de ou , puis
appuyez sur [Imprimer].
5 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le document stocké dans la boîte utilisateur confidentielle désignée
est imprimé.
!
Détails
Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Fermer].
Une fois imprimé, le document est automatiquement supprimé.
Fonctions utiles pour la réception 8
C250 8-5
8.1.3 Suppression d'un document stocké dans une boîte utilisateur
confidentielle
Procédez comme suit pour supprimer les documents placés dans une boîte
utilisateur confidentielle.
Suppression d'un document stocké dans une boîte utilisateur confidentielle
Vous pouvez supprimer tous les documents d'une boîte utilisateur confidentielle
en mode Utilitaire.
1 Appuyez sur [Boîte] dans le tableau de commande.
2 Sélectionnez l'onglet [Boîte utilisateur publique], puis une [Boîte utilisateur
confidentielle].
3 Si un mot de passe d'accès a été défini, saisissez-le dans le champ affiché,
puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe peut comporter 8 caractères maximum.
4 Sélectionnez le No. boîte confidentielle à l'aide de ou , puis
appuyez sur [Suppri.].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui] dans l'écran de confirmation de la suppression.
Le ou les documents placés dans cette boîte sont supprimés.
!
Détails
Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Fermer].
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8-6 C250
8.2 Réception mémoire
Dans l'écran Utilitaire, vous pouvez activer le mode de réception mémoire
sur FK-502, qui permet de recevoir les documents, de les mémoriser et de
les imprimer selon les besoins. Les sections qui suivent décrivent les
procédures d'impression et de suppression d'un document reçu mémorisé.
Il est supposé que la réception mémoire est active.
!
Détail
Pour activer et régler la réception mémoire, voir “Réception mémoire
obligatoire” à la page 11-43.
8.2.1 Impression d'un document mémorisé
Impression d'un document mémorisé
La procédure suivante décrit l'impression d'un document reçu, stocké en
mémoire.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Boîte] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran de sélection d'une boîte.
2 Sélectionnez l'onglet [Boîte ut. système] et [Boîte réception mémoire
RX].
– Si la fonction d'authentification utilisateur est réglée sur [ON],
l'onglet [Boîte ut. personnelle] apparaît.
Fonctions utiles pour la réception 8
C250 8-7
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Annul.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
4 Sélectionnez le document reçu à l'aide de ou et appuyez sur
[Imprimer].
5 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le document sélectionné est imprimé.
!
Détails
Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou précédent.
Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Fermer] avant d'appuyer sur
[Imprimer].
Pour afficher la première page du ficher sélectionné afin d'en vérifier le
contenu, appuyez sur [Epreuve].
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8-8 C250
8.2.2 Suppression d'un document mémorisé
Suppression d'un document mémorisé
La procédure suivante décrit la suppression d'un document reçu, stocké en
mémoire.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Boîte] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran de sélection d'une boîte.
2 Sélectionnez l'onglet [Boîte ut. système] et [Boîte réception mémoire
RX].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Annul.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
4 Sélectionnez le document reçu à l'aide de ou et appuyez sur
[Suppri.].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui] dans l'écran de confirmation de la suppression.
Le document sélectionné est imprimé.
!
Détails
Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Fermer] avant d'appuyer sur
[Imprimer].
Pour afficher la première page du ficher sélectionné afin d'en vérifier le
contenu, appuyez sur [Epreuve].
Fonctions utiles pour la réception 8
C250 8-9
8.3 Informations de réception
8.3.1 Informations sur la réception et l'impression recto-verso
Lorsque [Impression R/V pour réception] est réglée sur [ON]
Lorsque [Impression R/V pour réception] est réglée sur [ON] dans le réglage
émission/réception du mode Utilitaire, les documents sont imprimés rectoverso.
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage Émission/Réception” à la
page 11-37.
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8-10 C250
9 Relève
Relève 9
C250 9-3
9 Relève
9.1 Émission en relève
L'émission en relève permet de numériser un document à l'aide du FK-502
et de l'enregistrer sur le disque dur jusqu'à ce qu'une destination transmette
une commande de relève.
Le document est sauvegardé dans la boîte relève émission de la boîte
utilisateur système, et l'émission commence à réception d'une commande
de relève de la destination. L'émission en relève stocke les documents dans
la boîte relève émission et les bulletins dans la boîte bulletin board.
La description qui suit suppose l'utilisation de l'émission en relève et de la
boîte relève émission.
!
Détail
Si vous utilisez l'option bulletin board, reportez-vous à “Bulletin” à la
page 9-9.
Pour connaître la procédure d'impression et de suppression des
documents émis en relève, voir “Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte”.
9 Relève
9-4 C250
9.1.1 Émission en relève
Émission en relève
Cette section décrit la procédure d'émission en relève (normale).
0 Spécifications
L'émission en relève porte sur un seul document.
L'émission mémoire est automatiquement sélectionnée.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Nombre d'originaux, Réception en relève TX (normal),
Émission différée TX, Communications internationales, ECM OFF, Mot
de passe émission TX, Émission F-code, V34 OFF
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour afficher
l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Émission en relève (TX)].
4 Appuyez sur [Normal].
Relève 9
C250 9-5
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement de l'original sur la machine” à la page 3-7.
9 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 numérise le document et le mémorise jusqu'à ce que la
destination envoie une commande de relève, qui entraîne l'émission du
document.
!
Détail
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
9 Relève
9-6 C250
9.2 Réception en relève
La réception en relève permet au FK-502 d'envoyer une commande à une
destin ation pour recevoir le document qui est soit prêt à l'émission sur la
machine distante, soit réservé pour l'émission en relève. Cette fonction est
utile si vous préférez assumer les frais de la communication.
La réception en relève séquentielle permet de désigner plusieurs
destinations de réception en relève.
Un rapport de relève réception séquentielle est imprimé en fin de réception,
de même qu'un rapport de relève séquentielle réservée si vous utilisez
également l'émission différée.
!
Détail
Cette fonction ne fonctionne pas si la machine distante n'est pas dotée
de cette caractéristique.
Pour plus d'informations sur le rapport de relève séquentielle réservée,
voir “Rapport de relève séquentielle réservée (réception)” à la page 12-27
et sur le rapport de relève réception séquentielle, voir “Rapport de relève
séquentielle (réception)” à la page 12-17.
Relève 9
C250 9-7
Réception en relève
La réception en relève comporte deux options : normale et bulletin board.
Avec l'option bulletin board, le document à recevoir est réservé dans le
tableau électronique de la destination. Pour plus d'informations sur cette
option, voir “Réception en relève d'un document placé sur le bulletin board
d'une destination (fax)” à la page 9-13. La description s'applique à la
réception en relève normale.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Effacement bords, Format de numérisation, Nombre
d'originaux, Originaux mixtes, Position relieure, Émission confidentielle,
Émission en relais, ECM OFF, Communications internationales, Émission
en relève (normal), Mot de passe émission TX
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour afficher
l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Réception en relève (RX)].
4 Appuyez sur [Normal].
9 Relève
9-8 C250
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Indiquez la ou les destinations.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
Vous pouvez spécifier plusieurs destinations.
8 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 commence à recevoir le ou les documents prêts à
l'émission ou réservés pour émission en relève sur la ou les
destinations.
!
Détail
Pour suspendre la réception en relève, appuyez sur [Arrêt] sur le tableau
de commande avant d'appuyer sur [Départ].
Si la réception échoue, voir “Réception impossible” à la page 4-6.
Relève 9
C250 9-9
9.3 Bulletin
Le FK-502 vous permet de parcourir le bulletin board (tableau électronique)
d'une destination pour y rechercher les documents en attente de relève ou
pour y placer des documents à relever. Cette section décrit les procédures
de gestion des documents affichés sur le bulletin board d'une destination,
notamment l'écriture d'un document sur le tableau et la réception en relève
d'un document posté sur le tableau.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur l'impression et la suppression d'un
document affiché sur le tableau électronique, consultez le “Manuel
d'utilisation - Opérations Scanner réseau”.
Relève
Écriture
Parcourir
Bulletin boards
(tableaux électroniques)
9 Relève
9-10 C250
9.3.1 Écriture d'un document sur le bulletin board
La procédure d'écriture d'un document sur le bulletin board est décrite cidessous.
Écriture d'un document sur le bulletin board
0 Spécifications
Les tableaux électroniques (bulletin board) doivent être préalablement
définis. Voir “Réglage du bulletin (tableau électronique)” à la page 10-48.
Les tableaux électroniques ne peuvent être utilisés que si la destination
est dotée de la fonction F-code.
Vous ne pouvez placer sur un tableau électronique qu'un document à la
fois.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Nombre d'originaux, Réception en relève TX (normal),
Émission différée TX, Communications internationales, ECM OFF, Mot
de passe émission TX, Émission F-code, V34 OFF
0 Si le bulletin board comporte déjà un document et que vous en placez un
nouveau, celui-ci écrase le document existant.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Émission en relève (TX)].
Relève 9
C250 9-11
4 Appuyez sur [Bulletin].
5 Saisissez le numéro du bulletin dans le champ [No. bulletin].
– Vous pouvez saisir un numéro compris entre 1 et 999999999 (9
chiffres).
– Pour effacer un caractère, appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour supprimer tous les numéros de bulletin
board.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
9 Relève
9-12 C250
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
– Si vous voulez interrompre la lecture du document après avoir
appuyé sur [Départ], appuyez sur [Arrêt], puis sur [Oui] dans l'écran
de confirmation.
Le FK-502 lit le document et le place sur le bulletin board.
Relève 9
C250 9-13
9.3.2 Réception en relève d'un document placé sur le bulletin
board d'une destination (fax)
Réception en relève d'un document placé sur le bulletin board d'une
destination (fax)
Vous pouvez recevoir par relève le document placé sur le bulletin board
d'une destination. Procédez de la manière suivante.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Réception en relève (RX)].
4 Appuyez sur [Bulletin].
9 Relève
9-14 C250
5 Saisissez le numéro du bulletin dans le champ [No. bulletin].
– Vous pouvez saisir un numéro de bulletin de 20 chiffres maximum.
– Pour effacer un caractère, appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour supprimer tous les numéros de bulletin
board.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Sélectionnez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Sélection de la destination” à la
page 3-21.
9 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine distante lance l'opération de relève sur son bulletin board.
10 Enregistrement/
Réglages
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-3
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10.1 Affichage de l'écran d'enregistrement du télécopieur
La procédure d'affichage de l'écran d'enregistrement du télécopieur est
décrite ci-dessous.
Affichage de l'écran d'enregistrement du télécopieur
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] et sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande pour afficher l'écran du mode Utilitaire.
2 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Enregistrement
1-touche], tapez “1” sur le clavier.
– Si [Enregistrement et changement d'adresse] de l'option [Interdire
accès Paramètres tâche] dans l'écran Utilitaires est réglé sur
[Interdire], vous ne pouvez pas changer ou enregistrer la touche
correspondant à [Enregistrement 1-touche]. Pour plus
d'informations à ce sujet, contactez l'administrateur.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-4 C250
3 Appuyez sur Fax.
L'écran Enregistrement fax s'affiche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-5
10.2 Enregistrement du carnet d'adresses
Vous pouvez enregistrer dans le [Carnet d'adresses] le numéro du fax et
l'adresse e-mail d'une destination fréquente. Vous pouvez ensuite accéder
au [Carnet d'adresses] enregistré par le biais de [Carnet d'adresses] ou
[Saisie directe] dans l'écran Fax.
- Vous pouvez enregistrer 2 000 adresses maximum (0001 à 2000), y
compris le [Carnet d'adresses] d'autres fonctions de la machine, telle que
la numérisation.
- L'enregistrement du nom de la destination et du caractère de recherche
dans le [Carnet d'adresses] permet ensuite de spécifier la destination en
sélectionnant le caractère de recherche.
- Vous pouvez enregistrer le numéro de fax ([No. abrégé]), l'adresse e-mail
ou la boîte.
Cette section décrit la procédure d'enregistrement, de modification et de
suppression du carnet d'adresses.
Tenez compte du point suivant :
- L'enregistrement n'est pas disponible tant que le nom, la destination,
l'adresse e-mail ou la boîte n'a pas été défini.
!
Détail
Vous pouvez confirmer les informations enregistrées dans la liste de
numéros abrégés.
Pour plus d'informations sur la liste de numéros abrégés, voir “Liste
Carnet d'adresses” à la page 12-33
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-6 C250
Enregistrement d'un numéro de fax dans un carnet d'adresses
La procédure d'enregistrement d'un numéro de fax dans un carnet
d'adresses est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Carnet d'adresses],
tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [No. abrégé].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-7
4 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
5 Appuyez sur [Nom] et saisissez le nom du carnet d'adresses.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
– Un numéro inutilisé apparaît par défaut dans le champ [No.].
6 Tapez sur le clavier le numéro de fax de la destination.
– Les touches suivantes sont disponibles.
– [Tonalité] :
Si vous utilisez la numérotation décimale (DC), appuyez sur
[Tonalité] pour sélectionner le mode FV (fréquences vocales), qui
est utilisé avec les services de télécopie. La sélection de cette
option est indiquée par un “T” à l'écran.
– [Pause] :
Appuyez sur [Pause] pour insérer une pause entre deux chiffres du
numéro à composer. L'appui une fois sur [Pause] génère un
intervalle d'une seconde entre deux chiffres. Vous pouvez saisir
plusieurs intervalles, indiqués par un “P” à l'écran.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-8 C250
– [-] :
Le tiret est un signe de séparation uniquement. Il n'a aucune
incidence sur la numérotation. Il est indiqué à l'écran par un “-”.
– :
Déplace le curseur vers la gauche.
– :
Déplace le curseur vers la droite.
– [Suppri.] :
Les caractères sont supprimés un par un à partir de la position du
curseur. Si celui-ci se trouve à l'extrême droite de l'entrée, les
caractères précédent le curseur sont supprimés.
– [Ligne extérieure]:
S'affiche si [Définir CN PBX] est réglé sur [ON]. Est indiqué à l'écran
par un [E-].
– Vous pouvez saisir un numéro de 38 chiffres maximum.
– Si vous faites une faute de frappe, appuyez sur [Suppri.] pour
effacer les caractères un par un, sur [C] (clear) pour tout effacer.
– Si la connexion PBX est [ON] lors d'un appel de la ligne intérieure
vers une ligne extérieure, appuyez sur [Pause] après le numéro de
la ligne extérieure (“0”, par exemple) pour sécuriser l'appel. “P”
s'affiche à l'écran.
7 Pour changer le caractère de recherche, appuyez sur [Index], puis
réenregistrez ce caractère.
– Appuyez sur la touche à enregistrer comme caractère de recherche
parmi les touches [ABC] à [etc].
– Si la destination est fréquemment utilisée, précisez le caractère de
recherche et sélectionnez en même temps [Comm]. Ce caractère
de recherche s'affichera en premier lieu dans le carnet d'adresses.
– Le caractère affiché en préfixe du Nom est défini par défaut comme
caractère de recherche.
8 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Le numéro de fax est enregistré dans le carnet d'adresses et la
destination enregistrée apparaît dans la liste.
9 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à un autre enregistrement de numéro de fax dans le
carnet d'adresses, reprenez à l'étape 4.
10 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-9
Enregistrement d'une adresse e-mail dans le carnet d'adresses
L'enregistrement d'une adresse e-mail dans le carnet d'adresses permet
d'envoyer un original numérisé en pièce jointe d'un message. Le fichier est
au format TIFF ou PDF.
La procédure d'enregistrement d'une adresse e-mail dans le carnet
d'adresses est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour le [Carnet d'adresses],
tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [E-Mail].
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-10 C250
4 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
5 Appuyez sur [Nom] et saisissez le nom du carnet d'adresses.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
– Un numéro inutilisé apparaît par défaut dans le champ [No.].
6 Appuyez sur [Adresse E-Mail].
7 Saisissez l'adresse e-mail dans l'écran qui s'affiche, puis appuyez sur
[OK].
– :
Déplace le curseur vers la gauche.
– :
Déplace le curseur vers la droite.
– [Suppri.] :
Les caractères sont supprimés un par un à partir de la position du
curseur. Si celui-ci se trouve à l'extrême droite de l'entrée, les
caractères précédent le curseur sont supprimés.
– L'adresse e-mail peut comporter 320 caractères maximum.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-11
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour supprimer toutes les entrées saisies.
8 Pour changer le caractère de recherche, appuyez sur [Index], puis
réenregistrez ce caractère.
– Appuyez sur la touche à enregistrer comme caractère de recherche
parmi les touches [ABC] à [etc].
– Si la destination est fréquemment utilisée, précisez le caractère de
recherche et sélectionnez en même temps [Comm]. Ce caractère
de recherche s'affichera en premier lieu dans la sélection du carnet
d'adresses.
– Le caractère affiché en préfixe du Nom est automatiquement défini
comme caractère de recherche.
9 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'adresse e-mail est enregistrée dans le carnet d'adresses et la
destination enregistrée apparaît dans la liste.
10 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à un autre enregistrement dans le carnet d'adresses,
reprenez à l'étape 4.
11 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-12 C250
Enregistrement d'une boîte dans le carnet d'adresses
L'enregistrement d'une boîte dans le carnet d'adresses permet de placer
dans cette boîte l'original numérisé. Le fichier est enregistré au format TIFF.
La procédure d'enregistrement d'une boîte dans le carnet d'adresses est
décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour le [Carnet d'adresses],
tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Boîte utilisateur].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-13
4 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
5 Appuyez sur [Nom] et saisissez le nom du carnet d'adresses.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
– Un numéro inutilisé apparaît par défaut dans le champ [No.].
6 Appuyez sur [Nom boîte utilisateur].
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-14 C250
7 Sélectionnez la boîte à enregistrer et appuyez sur [OK].
– Cette opération suppose l'enregistrement préalable de la boîte.
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement de la boîte, voir
“Manuel d'utilisation - Opérations Boîte”.
8 Pour changer le caractère de recherche, appuyez sur [Index], puis
réenregistrez ce caractère.
– Appuyez sur la touche à enregistrer comme caractère de recherche
parmi les touches [ABC] à [etc].
– Si la destination est fréquemment utilisée, précisez le caractère de
recherche et sélectionnez en même temps [Comm]. Ce caractère
de recherche s'affichera en premier lieu dans la sélection du carnet
d'adresses.
– Le caractère affiché en préfixe du Nom est défini par défaut comme
caractère de recherche.
9 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
La boîte est enregistrée dans le carnet d'adresses et la destination
enregistrée apparaît dans la liste.
10 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à un autre enregistrement dans le carnet d'adresses,
reprenez à l'étape 4.
11 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-15
Modification du contenu du carnet d'adresses
La procédure de modification du contenu du carnet d'adresses est décrite
ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour le [Carnet d'adresses],
tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [No. abrégé], [E-Mail] ou [Boîte utilisateur].
4 Appuyez sur le carnet d'adresses à modifier, puis sur [Modif.].
5 Appuyez sur l'élément à modifier, apportez-y les modifications
voulues, puis appuyez sur [OK].
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-16 C250
6 Confirmez les modifications et appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler la modification, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Pour apporter d'autres modifications, reprenez la procédure à
l'étape 5.
7 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
8 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-17
Suppression du carnet d'adresses
La procédure de suppression du carnet d'adresses est décrite ci-dessous.
0 Si vous supprimez une destination du carnet d'adresses, celle-ci est
également supprimée du groupe et du programme auxquels elle
appartient.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour le [Carnet d'adresses],
tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [No. abrégé], [E-Mail] ou [Boîte utilisateur].
4 Appuyez sur le carnet d'adresses à supprimer, puis sur [Supprimer].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui] pour confirmer la suppression.
– Pour annuler la suppression, appuyez sur [Non].
Pour procéder à une autre suppression, reprenez à l'étape 4.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-18 C250
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-19
10.3 Enregistrement d'un groupe
Plusieurs carnet d'adresses peuvent être affectés à un groupe. Cette
fonction est utile si vous envoyez régulièrement des informations à plusieurs
destinations en même temps, ou si vous avez choisi la réception en relève
de ces émetteurs.
- Vous pouvez enregistrer jusqu'à 100 groupes (01 à 99, 00), y compris les
groupes utilisés pour la fonction de numérisation.
- Chaque groupe peut comporter jusqu'à 500 carnets d'adresses.
- Un carnet d'adresses peut être enregistré pour le groupe. Veillez
seulement à enregistrer la destination dans ce carnet d'adresses avant
de procéder à l'enregistrement du groupe.
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement d'un carnet d'adresses,
voir “Enregistrement du carnet d'adresses” à la page 10-5.
- Chaque groupe peut porter un nom.
Les procédures qui suivent décrivent l'enregistrement d'un carnet
d'adresses et d'un groupe, ainsi que la modification et la suppression d'un
groupe enregistré.
Tenez compte du point suivant :
- L'enregistrement n'est pas disponible tant que le nom, la destination,
l'adresse e-mail ou la boîte n'a pas été défini.
!
Détail
Vous pouvez confirmer les informations enregistrées dans la liste des
groupes.
Pour plus d'informations sur la liste des groupes, voir “Liste d'adresses
de groupe” à la page 12-36
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-20 C250
Enregistrement d'un groupe
La procédure d'enregistrement d'un groupe est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Groupe].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour un [Groupe], tapez “2”
sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
– Si le groupe a déjà été enregistré, vous pouvez modifier les entrées
à ce stade en appuyant sur [Modifier]. Pour plus d'informations, voir
page 10-23.
– Seuls les groupes enregistrés dans [Fax] sont affichés.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-21
4 Appuyez sur [Nom] et saisissez le nom du groupe.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
– Un numéro disponible est affiché par défaut dans le champ [No.].
5 Appuyez sur [Destination].
– Chaque groupe peut comporter jusqu'à 500 carnets d'adresses.
6 Sélectionnez la catégorie à enregistrer dans le groupe parmi [No.
abrégé], [Boîte utilisateur] et [E-Mail].
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-22 C250
7 Sélectionnez la destination à enregistrer dans le groupe.
– Recherche par nom :
Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au caractère de recherche,
puis sélectionnez la destination dans le carnet d'adresses.
– Recherche par numéro :
Affiche les destinations numérotées dans l'ordre d'enregistrement
(écran de 100). Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au numéro du
carnet d'adresses à afficher.
Appuyez sur ou pour faire défiler les numéros.
8 Appuyez sur [OK].
9 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
10 Appuyez sur [OK].
Pour procéder à l'enregistrement d'un autre groupe, reprenez à
l'étape 5.
11 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-23
Modification d'un groupe
La procédure de modification d'un groupe est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Groupe].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour un [Groupe], tapez “2”
sur le clavier.
3 Sélectionnez le groupe à modifier et appuyez sur [Modifier].
– Appuyez sur ou pour faire défiler les pages.
4 Sélectionnez l'élément à modifier, apportez les modifications voulues,
puis appuyez sur [OK] ou sur [Fermer].
5 Confirmez les modifications et appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler les modifications, appuyez sur [Annul.].
6 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-24 C250
Suppression d'un groupe
La procédure de suppression d'un groupe est décrite ci-dessous.
0 La suppression d'un groupe le supprime également du programme
auquel il appartient.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Groupe].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour un [Groupe], tapez “2”
sur le clavier.
3 Sélectionnez le groupe à supprimer et appuyez sur [Supprimer].
– Appuyez sur ou pour faire défiler les pages.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages en sélectionnant le groupe,
puis en appuyant sur [Détails].
4 Appuyez sur [Oui] pour confirmer la suppression.
– Pour annuler la suppression, appuyez sur [Non].
Pour procéder à une autre suppression, reprenez à l'étape 3.
5 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
6 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-25
10.4 Enregistrement d'un programme
Avant d'être enregistrée dans un programme, une destination (numéro de
fax, boîte utilisateur ou e-mail) appelée fréquemment peut être associée au
[Réglage numérisa.] ou au [Réglage communic.] qui sera utilisé. Cela fait, il
suffit d'appuyer sur la touche correspondant au [Programme], de définir les
fonctions de la destination enregistrée ainsi que le [Réglage numérisa.] ou le
[Réglage commnic.], puis d'émettre.
- Vous pouvez enregistrer jusqu'à 400 (001 à 400) programmes, y compris
ceux d'autres fonctions de la machine.
- Chaque programme peut porter un nom.
Les procédures ci-dessous décrivent l'enregistrement d'un programme,
ainsi que la modification et la suppression d'un programme.
Tenez compte du point suivant :
- L'enregistrement n'est pas disponible si le [Nom], l'un quelconque des
[Réglage numérisa.] ou [Réglage communic.], ou la destination ne sont
pas définis.
Enregistrement d'un programme
La procédure d'enregistrement d'un programme est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Programme].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour un [Programme], tapez
“3” sur le clavier.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-26 C250
3 Sélectionnez le programme à enregistrer et appuyez sur [Modifier].
– Affichage de [Réglage numéri.] et [Réglage communic.]
Réglage : ON OFF Non enregistré
Affichage : * - (Espace)
– Appuyez sur ou à gauche de [Liste page] pour afficher
une autre page. Chaque page affiche 15 destinations.
– Appuyez sur [Liste page] pour paramétrer l'affichage d'une liste de
programmes par page.
– Appuyez sur [Changer nom page] dans l'écran Liste page pour le
nom de la page affichée.
– Appuyez sur ou à droite de la liste pour afficher le
programme suivant.
– Si la destination est un scanner, "Destination scanner" est affiché.
4 Appuyez sur [Nom] et tapez le nom du programme.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-27
5 Appuyez sur [Dest.].
6 Appuyez sur [Sélection dans carnet d'adresses] ou [Saisie directe] pour
préciser la destination.
– Si vous choisissez [Sélection dans carnet d'adresses] :
Sélectionnez une destination dans les carnets d'adresses et les
groupes enregistrés.
– Sélectionnez la destination à enregistrer parmi [No. abrégé], [Boîte
utilisateur], [Groupe] ou [E-Mail].
– Appuyez sur [Recherche par nom] ou [Recherche par numéro], puis
sélectionnez la destination.
– [Recherche par nom] :
Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au caractère de recherche,
puis sélectionnez la destination dans le carnet d'adresses.
– [Recherche par numéro] :
Affiche les destinations numérotées dans l'ordre d'enregistrement
(écran de 100). Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au numéro du
carnet d'adresses à afficher.
Appuyez sur ou pour faire défiler les numéros.
– Appuyez sur [OK].
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-28 C250
– Si vous choisissez la [Saisie directe] :
Définissez la destination de la manière suivante.
– Appuyez sur [No. abrégé], [Boîte utilisateur] ou [E-Mail].
– Saisissez ou sélectionnez la destination, puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des numéros à composer, voir
“Enregistrement d'un numéro de fax dans un carnet d'adresses” à
la page 10-6.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des boîtes, voir
“Enregistrement d'une adresse e-mail dans le carnet d'adresses” à
la page 10-9.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des adresses e-mail, voir
“Enregistrement d'une boîte dans le carnet d'adresses” à la
page 10-12.
7 Pour paramétrer le [Réglage numérisation] ou le [Réglage
communication], appuyez sur [ON], puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Dans l'écran [Réglage communications], vous pouvez paramétrer
[Réglage E-Mail] et [Notification E-Mail].
– Si [Notification E-Mail] est réglé sur [ON], la fin d'une tâche peut être
confirmée par e-mail à la destination précisée dans le champ
[Notification E-Mail].
– Pour plus d'informations sur [Réglage numérisation] et [Réglage
communication], voir “Applications d'émission” à la page 7-3.
8 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Pour procéder à l'enregistrement d'un autre programme, reprenez à
l'étape 3.
9 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-29
Suppression d'un programme
La procédure de suppression d'un programme est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Programme].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour un [Programme], tapez
“3” sur le clavier.
3 Sélectionnez le programme à supprimer et appuyez sur [Supprimer].
– Appuyez sur ou à gauche de [Liste page] pour afficher
une autre page. Chaque page affiche 15 destinations.
– Appuyez sur [Liste page] pour paramétrer l'affichage d'une liste de
programmes par page.
– Appuyez sur une touche dans l'écran Liste page pour modifier le
nom de la page affichée.
– Appuyez sur ou à droite de la liste pour afficher le
programme suivant.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-30 C250
– Si la destination est un scanner, "Destination scanner" est affiché.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages en sélectionnant le
programme, puis en appuyant sur [Vérifier réglage].
4 Appuyez sur [Oui] pour confirmer la suppression.
– Pour annuler la suppression, appuyez sur [Non].
Pour procéder à une autre suppression, reprenez à l'étape 3.
5 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-31
10.5 Enregistrement du sujet et du texte d'un e-mail
Les procédures d'enregistrement du sujet et du texte d'un e-mail, de
modification et de suppression de ceux-ci sont décrites ci-dessous, de
même que la définition des valeurs par défaut.
!
Détail
Vous pouvez enregistrer jusqu'à 10 sujets d'e-mail et jusqu'à 10 textes
d'e-mail.
Enregistrement du sujet d'un e-mail
La procédure d'enregistrement du sujet d'un e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour
E-mail)], tapez “4” sur le clavier.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-32 C250
3 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
4 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
5 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
– Vous pouvez saisir 64 caractères maximum dans le champ [Sujet]
de l'écran [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– Un numéro inutilisé apparaît par défaut dans le champ [No.].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-33
6 Saisissez le sujet dans l'écran qui s'affiche, puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Le sujet est enregistré et la destination enregistrée apparaît dans la
liste.
8 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à l'enregistrement d'un autre sujet, reprenez à l'étape 4.
9 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-34 C250
Modification du sujet d'un e-mail
La procédure de modification du sujet d'un e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour Email)],
tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-35
4 Sélectionnez le sujet à modifier et appuyez sur [Modifier].
– Appuyez sur ou pour faire défiler les pages.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages en sélectionnant le sujet, puis
en appuyant sur [Détails].
5 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
6 Modifiez le sujet dans l'écran qui s'affiche, puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Le sujet est modifié.
8 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à la modification d'un autre sujet, reprenez à l'étape 4.
9 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-36 C250
Suppression du sujet d'un e-mail
La procédure de suppression du sujet d'un e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour
E-mail)], tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-37
4 Sélectionnez le sujet à supprimer et appuyez sur [Supprimer].
– Appuyez sur ou pour passer à la page précédente ou
suivante.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages en sélectionnant le sujet, puis
en appuyant sur [Détails].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui] pour confirmer la suppression.
– Pour annuler la suppression, appuyez sur [Non].
Le sujet est supprimé.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à la suppression d'un autre sujet, reprenez à l'étape 4.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-38 C250
Réglage par défaut du sujet d'un e-mail
Lors de la transmission de l'e-mail à partir de l'écran Fax, le sujet paramétré
ici en tant que sujet par défaut est adressé à l'ordinateur. La procédure de
réglage du sujet par défaut de l'e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour
E-mail)], tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-39
4 Sélectionnez le sujet voulu et appuyez sur [Régler par défaut].
5 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
6 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-40 C250
Enregistrement du texte d'un e-mail
La procédure d'enregistrement du texte d'un e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
0 Le texte d'un e-mail enregistré ne peut pas être modifié. Vous devez
commencer par supprimer le texte à modifier, puis le réenregistrer.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour
E-mail)], tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Texte].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-41
4 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
5 Appuyez sur [Texte].
– Vous pouvez saisir 256 caractères maximum dans le champ [Texte]
de l'écran [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– Un numéro inutilisé apparaît par défaut dans le champ [No.].
6 Saisissez le texte dans l'écran qui s'affiche, puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Le texte est enregistré et la destination enregistrée apparaît dans la
liste.
8 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à l'enregistrement d'un autre texte, reprenez à
l'étape 4.
9 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-42 C250
Suppression du texte d'un e-mail
La procédure de suppression du texte d'un e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour Email)],
tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Texte].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-43
4 Sélectionnez le texte à supprimer et appuyez sur [Supprimer].
– Appuyez sur ou pour passer à la page précédente ou
suivante.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages en sélectionnant le texte, puis
en appuyant sur [Détails].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui] pour confirmer la suppression.
– Pour annuler la suppression, appuyez sur [Non].
Le texte est supprimé.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à la suppression d'un autre texte, reprenez à l'étape 4.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-44 C250
Réglage par défaut du texte d'un e-mail
Lors de la transmission de l'e-mail à partir de l'écran Fax, le texte paramétré
ici en tant que texte par défaut est adressé à l'ordinateur. La procédure de
réglage du texte par défaut de l'e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour
E-mail)], tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Texte].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-45
4 Sélectionnez le texte voulu et appuyez sur [Régler par défaut].
5 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
6 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-46 C250
10.6 Réglage des boîtes confidentielles
La boîte confidentielle est la boîte publique / personnelle attachée à l'aide de
la fonction avancée de boîte.
Cette machine gère la communication confidentielle (F-code).
Pour paramétrer la réception confidentielle, vous devez définir le numéro de
boîte utilisateur, le nom, mot de passe de communication, Mot de passe de
boîte, index et type.
- Vous pouvez confirmer le mot de passe des boîtes confidentielles. Pour
plus d'informations, voir page 11-53.
- Pour plus d'informations sur la communication confidentielle, voir
page 7-29.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement des boîtes, voir “Manuel
d'utilisation - Opérations Boîte”.
Vous devez fournir le mot de passe de la boîte utilisateur confidentielle.
La communication confidentielle peut être utilisée sans mot de passe.
No. boîte utilisateur
De 1 à 999999999.
- Ce numéro doit être fourni au télécopieur central qui transmettra les
informations en mode de communication confidentielle.
Nom
Le nom peut comporter 20 caractères maximum.
Mot de passe de communication
Il s'agit du mot de passe au moment de la réception confidentielle.
Les caractères autorisés sont les chiffres 0 à 9, * ou un numéro de 8 chiffres
maximum.
- Ce mot de passe doit être fourni au télécopieur central qui transmettra
les informations en mode de communication confidentielle.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-47
Mot de passe de boîte
Mot de passe permettant de consulter un document stocké dans la boîte
confidentielle.
!
Détails
Pour plus d'informations sur le mot de passe de boîte, voir "Manuel d'utilisation
- Opérations Boîte".
Principe de la communication confidentielle
En mode de communication confidentielle, chaque fax à un rôle spécifique à
remplir.
Station expéditrice
Spécifie une boîte utilisateur confidentielle
et émet.
Station réceptrice
Ouvre la boîte utilisateur confidentielle pour
recevoir le document.
Un numéro de boîte et un mot de passe de
communication initient la transmission d'un
document fax.
Le document fax reçu contient la boîte
utilisateur confidentielle spécifiée.
Imprime ou supprime le document contenu
dans la boîte utilisateur confidentielle.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-48 C250
10.7 Réglage du bulletin (tableau électronique)
Cette machine gère l'émission / réception en relève d'un bulletin (tableau
électronique) utilisant la fonction F-code. Ces opérations supposent le
réglage de la boîte utilisateur bulletin.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement des boîtes bulletin, voir
“Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte”.
No. boîte utilisateur
De 1 à 999999999.
Nom de la boîte
Le nom peut comporter 20 caractères maximum.
Mot de passe (d'accès)
Mot de passe alphanumérique de 8 caractères maximum.
!
Détails
Les documents enregistrés dans la boîte peuvent être imprimés à l'aide
du mot de passe défini au moment de l'enregistrement des boîtes bulletin.
Principe de l'émission/réception en relève d'un bulletin
!
Détail
Ces informations doivent être fournies au télécopieur central qui recevra
les informations par relève du bulletin.
Pour plus d'informations sur le bulletin (tableau électronique), voir
page 9-9.
Station expéditrice
Envoie les informations en relevant un
bulletin.
Station réceptrice
Reçoit le document en relevant le bulletin
(tableau électronique).
Le document à transmettre en relève doit se
trouver dans le tableau électronique.
Le numéro de la boîte doit être fourni au
récepteur en relève.
Enregistre un bulletin
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C250 10-49
10.8 Réglage de la boîte utilisateur réception mémoire
Si [Réception mémoire] est réglé sur [ON] dans l'écran Utilitaires, tout
document reçu est enregistré dans la boîte réception mémoire.
!
Détail
Pour connaître la méthode d'impression de la boîte utilisateur réception
mémoire, voir “Réception mémoire” à la page 8-6
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-50 C250
11 Mode Utilitaire
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-3
11 Mode Utilitaire
11.1 Écran mode Utilitaire
Un responsable du mode Utilitaire doit être désigné. Cette personne, qui doit
de préférence être unique, sera responsable de la gestion de la machine.
La section suivante décrit les procédures d'accès au mode Utilitaire et de
sortie de celui-ci, ainsi que le réglage des fonctions de fax.
11.1.1 Accès à l'écran Réglage Utilisateur
Accès à l'écran Réglage Utilisateur
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Utilisateur].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-4 C250
11.1.2 Quitter l'écran Réglage Utilisateur
Quitter l'écran Réglage Utilisateur
% Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-5
11.1.3 Accès à l'écran Réglage Administrateur
Accès à l'écran Réglage Administrateur
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
!
Détail
Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans [Réglage
Sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la gestion du mot de
passe.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-6 C250
11.1.4 Quitter l'écran Réglage Administrateur
Quitter l'écran Réglage Administrateur
% Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-7
11.2 Liste du mode Utilitaire fax
Le mode Utilitaire fax inclut les options présentées ci-dessous.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
11.2.1 Écran FAX - réglage par défaut
Réglage Utilisateur >> Réglage Affichage >> Écran FAX Réglage par défaut
Règle les conditions initiales de l'écran Fax. (page 11-14)
11.2.2 Écran Fax actif
Réglage Utilisateur >> Réglage Affichage >> Écran Fax actif
Règle l'affichage ou non du message en cours de transmission. (page 11-19)
11.2.3 Réglage Initial
Réglage Utilisateur >> Réglage Initial
Définit les valeurs par défaut de la fonction Fax. (page 11-17)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Onglet par défaut Définit la valeur par défaut de la
colonne destination dans l'écran Fax.
Programme* / Groupe / Carnet
d'adresses / Saisie directe
Programme par
défaut
Définit le programme par défaut. Temporaire 1-touche / PAGE1*
- PAGE27
Carnet d'adresses
Index par défaut
Définit le carnet d'adresses par défaut. Comm* / ABC - etc
Affichage symbole
type d'adresse
Règle l'affichage ou non du symbole
du type d'adresse.
ON* / OFF
Nombre caractères
par nom d'adresse
Définit le nombre de caractères du
nom de l'adresse à afficher.
14 caract.* / 24 caract.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Affichage émission Règle l'affichage ou non du message
en [Émission].
ON / OFF*
Affichage réception Règle l'affichage ou non du message
en [Réception].
ON / OFF*
Option Description Valeur disponible
Fax [Réglage actuel] :
Avant le passage au mode Utilitaire, toutes les
options définies sur le tableau de commande
sont enregistrées en tant que valeurs par
défaut de la fonction fax.
[Réglage usine] :
Les valeurs définies en usine sont enregistrées
en tant que valeurs par défaut de la fonction
fax.
Réglage actuel* / Réglage
usine
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-8 C250
11.2.4 Passage économie énergie (Fax)
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Système >> Économie d'énergie >>
Passage économie énergie (Fax)
Règle le mode économie d'énergie (Fax). (page 11-22)
11.2.5 Système prioritaire (Réglages sortie Imprimante/Fax)
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Système >> Réglage Sortie >> Système
prioritaire
Définit la méthode d'impression du document reçu. (page 11-25)
11.2.6 Information en-tête
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Information en-tête
Enregistre le nom de l'expéditeur et l'ID du fax. (page 11-28)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Passage
économie
énergie (Fax)
Si [Immédiatement] est sélectionné et que la
machine est en mode économie d'énergie au
moment de l'arrivée d'un signal entrant, la
machine repasse sous ce mode à la fin de la
réception.
Normal* / Immédiatement
Option Description Valeur disponible
Fax Définit la méthode d'impression du document
reçu.
Impression par lots* /
Impression par page
Option Description Valeur disponible
Nom expéditeur Le nom enregistré est imprimé en en-tête sur le
document reçu par le correspondant.
30 caractères et signes
maximum.
No Fax Le numéro (identification) du fax enregistré est
imprimé en en-tête sur le document reçu par le
correspondant.
Le numéro de fax de la machine est entré dans
ce champ.
20 caractères maximum (0
à 9, +, espace, *, #).
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-9
11.2.7 Position en-tête / pied de page
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Position en-tête/pied de page
Définit la méthode de spécification des informations de l'expéditeur et du
récepteur. (page 11-31)
11.2.8 Réglage Paramètres ligne
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Réglage Paramètres ligne
Définit les options d'émission et de réception. (page 11-34)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Position en-tête
*1
Définit la position d'impression des
informations expéditeur.
Intérieur corps texte / Hors
corps du texte* / OFF
Position pied de
page
Définit la position d'impression de l'heure et du
numéro de réception sur le document reçu.
Intérieur corps texte / Hors
corps du texte / OFF*
*1: Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Méthode de
numérotation
*1
Définit la méthode de numérotation. PB* / 10 ips
Mode réception [Récept. auto] définit la réception automatique.
[Réception manuelle] définit la réception dans
le cas d'un lot d'appels réalisés avec un
téléphone externe raccordé ou de l'utilisation
de la fonction de réception distante.
Réception auto* /
Réception manuelle
Nbre de
sonneries sur
appel entrant
Règle le nombre de sonnerie en réception.
Règle le nombre de tonalités de retour d'appel
entre l'arrivée d'un message et le début de la
réception.
0 à 15 (2 fois*)
Nbre de rappels
*2
Définit le nombre de rappels lorsque la ligne du
correspondant est occupée.
0 à 15 (3 fois*)
Délai entre
rappels
Règle l'intervalle de temps entre deux rappels. 1 à 15 (3 min.*)
Suivi audio ligne Définir sur ON pour entendre le son sur la ligne
via le haut-parleur pendant l'émission.
ON / OFF*
Contrôle volume
sonore
Règle le volume sonore du haut-parleur. 0-31 (16*)
*1 : Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
*2 : Les options de ligne diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-10 C250
11.2.9 Réglage Émission/Réception
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Réglage Émis/Récep
Définit la méthode d'impression en mode émission/réception. (page 11-37)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Impression R/V
pour réception
Réglé sur ON (actif), l'original reçu est imprimé
recto verso.
OFF* / ON
Papier prioritaire
(pouces) sur A4 *1
Réglé sur ON (actif) la priorité est donnée au
papier au format en pouces.
OFF* / ON
Sélection papier
d'impression
Si la priorité du format est réglée :
L'impression est effectuée sur le format
prioritaire. Dans le cas contraire, l'impression
est effectuée dans le format de papier le plus
proche.
Si le format est fixe :
L'impression est effectuée uniquement dans
ce format.
Sélec auto* / Format fixe /
Format prioritaire
Format papier
d'impression *1 *2
Définit le format de papier d'impression du
document reçu.
La valeur par défaut dépend du réglage de
[Papier prioritaire (pouces) sur A4].
A3 / B4 / A4* / 8 1/2 × 11
/ 8 1/2 × 14 / 11 × 17
Erreur saisie no.
boîte
Définit l'action en cas de saisie d'un numéro de
boîte non enregistré. La sélection de [Création
auto boîte] crée la boîte dont le numéro est
saisi.
Impre.* / Afficher
message d'erreur /
Création auto boîte
Sélection
magasin
impression
réception *2
Définit le magasin de papier à utiliser pour
imprimer le document reçu.
Auto* / Mag 1 / Mag 2 /
Mag 3 / Mag 4
Réduction mini
impres.
réception*4
Règle la réduction de l'original reçu. 87-96* / × 1.0
Imprimer page de
séparation
Définit le mode d'émission par défaut. OFF* / ON
Archiver après
appel en relève
Définit la suppression ou non du document
après l'émission en relève.
Supprimer* / Sauvegarder
*1 Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
*2 : Pour activer le réglage de [Format papier d'impression], réglez [Sélection magasin impression
réception] sur [Auto].
*3 : Selon l'option installée, le type de magasin peut être différent.
*4 : Si [Réduction mini impres. réception] est réglé sur [x1.0], [Sélection papier d'impression] et
[Sélection magasin impression réception] sont réglés sur [Auto]. [Imprimer page de
séparation] est réglé sur [OFF].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-11
11.2.10Réglage fonction
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Réglage fonction
Active/Désactive (ON/OFF) les fonctions d'émission/réception. (page 11-40)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Régl. fonct ON/OFF
Fonction
d’émission
F-code
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Activer/
Désactiver (ON/OFF) les fonctions
d'émission/réception.” à la page 11-40.
ON* / OFF
Réception
mémoire
Cette fonction permet de recevoir les
documents et de les mémoriser en vue
d'une impression ultérieure.
ON / OFF*
RX réseau fermé La réception en réseau fermé permet de
ne recevoir les données entrantes que si
le mot de passe de l'expéditeur est
valide.
ON / OFF*
Définir un mot de passe de 4
chiffres.
Régl. transfert TX Cette fonction permet de transférer les
données reçues vers une station
déterminée à l'avance.
OFF* / Transfert et Impres. /
Transf. + Imp. si erreur
Dest. de transfert
Vérif. mot de
passe RX
confidentiel
Vous pouvez confirmer les numéros
d'accès confidentiels définis.
-
Réglage RX fax La fonction RX PC-fax permet
d'enregistrer les fichiers de fax reçus
dans des boîtes sur le disque dur.
OFF* / ON
Boîte fixe / Boîte spécifiée
Paramètre boîte
utilisateur TSI
Cette fonction permet d'allouer les
originaux reçus selon leurs informations
TSI.
ON / OFF*
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-12 C250
11.2.11Définir CN PBX
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Définir CN PBX
Définit la méthode de connexion de la ligne PBX. (page 11-65)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Définir CN PBX Sélectionner ON si le FK-502 est raccordé à
une ligne PBX.
Si le mode CN PBX est réglé sur ON, ce
paramètre détermine le code d'accès à la ligne
extérieure, c'est à dire le préfixe lié au numéro
de téléphone et composé avec celui-ci si
l'option de ligne extérieure est sélectionnée
avec un numéro abrégé ou un programme.
ON / OFF*
Si réglé sur ON, numéro
d'accès à la ligne
extérieure.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-13
11.2.12Réglage Rapports
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Réglage Rapports
Définit la méthode d'impression d'un rapport. (page 11-67)
11.2.13Liste Paramètres tâche
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Liste Paramètres tâche
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir page 12-45.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Rapport
d'activité
Détermine l'impression ou non du rapport et
l'intervalle/la plage de cette impression.
OFF / Quotidien / Toutes
les 100 com.* / 100/jour
Rapport
émission
ON / Sur erreur seulement*
/ OFF
Rapport
émission
séquentiel
ON* / OFF
Rapport
émission
programmée
ON* / OFF
Rapport
réception
confidentielle
ON* / OFF
Rapport
émission bulletin
ON* / OFF
Magasin papier
pour rapport *1
Spécifie le magasin utilisé pour l'impression
d'un rapport.
Magasin 1 / Magasin 2* /
Magasin 3 / Magasin 4 /
Introduct. manuelle
Vérif. rapport
résultat émission
Détermine l'affichage ou non de l'écran de
sélection du rapport de résultat de l'émission.
Si vous sélectionnez ON, cet écran s'affiche
après chaque émission.
OFF* / ON
*1 : Selon l'option installée, le type de magasin peut être différent.
* : Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-14 C250
11.3 Écran Fax réglage par défaut
Définit les conditions initiales de l'écran Fax.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Onglet par
défaut
Définit la valeur par défaut de la colonne
destination dans l'écran Fax.
Programme* / Groupe /
Carnet d'adresses / Saisie
directe
Programme par
défaut
Définit le programme par défaut. Temporaire 1-touche /
PAGE1* - PAGE27
Carnet
d'adresses Index
par défaut
Définit le carnet d'adresses par défaut. Comm* / ABC - etc
Affichage
symbole type
d'adresse
Définit l'affichage ou non du symbole du type
d'adresse.
ON* / OFF
Nombre
caractères par
nom d'adresse
Définit le nombre de caractères du nom de
l'adresse à afficher.
14 caract.* / 24 caract.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-15
Écran Fax réglage par défaut
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Utilisateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Utilisateur” à la page 11-3).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Affichage].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Affichage], tapez “2” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Écran fax - Réglage par défaut].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-16 C250
4 Sélectionnez l'option à régler.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-17
11.4 Réglage Initial
Définit la valeur par défaut de la fonction Fax.
Vous pouvez régler la fonction fax sélectionnée lorsque la machine est sous
tension ou en appuyant sur [Réinitialiser].
Affichez l'écran Fax et appuyez sur [Utilitaire/Compteur].
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Réglage Initial
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Utilisateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Utilisateur” à la page 11-3).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Initial].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Initial], tapez “3” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Fax [Réglage actuel]:
Avant le passage au mode Utilitaire, toutes les
options définies sur le tableau de commande
sont enregistrées en tant que valeurs par
défaut de la fonction fax.
[Réglage usine]:
Les valeurs définies en usine sont enregistrées
en tant que valeurs par défaut de la fonction
fax.
Réglage actuel* / Réglage
usine
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-18 C250
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage usine], puis sur [OK].
– Si vous voulez annuler un réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.]
4 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
5 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-19
11.5 Écran Fax actif
Définit l'affichage ou non du message en cours de transmission.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Écran Fax actif
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Utilisateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Utilisateur” à la page 11-3).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Affichage].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Affichage], tapez “2” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Affichage
émission
Définit l'affichage ou non du message en
[Émission].
ON / OFF*
Affichage
réception
Définit l'affichage ou non du message en
[Réception].
ON / OFF*
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-20 C250
3 Appuyez sur [Écran Fax actif].
4 Sélectionnez [Affichage émission] ou [Affichage réception].
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-21
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-22 C250
11.6 Passage économie énergie (Fax)
Passage économie énergie (Fax)
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Passage économie énergie (Fax)
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Système].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Système], tapez “1” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Passage
économie
énergie (Fax)
Si [Immédiatement] est sélectionné et que la
machine est en mode économie d'énergie au
moment de l'arrivée d'un signal entrant, la
machine repasse sous ce mode à la fin de la
réception.
Normal* / Immédiatement
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-23
3 Appuyez sur [Économie d'énergie].
4 Appuyez sur [Passage économie énergie (Fax)].
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-24 C250
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-25
11.7 Système prioritaire (Réglages sortie Imprimante/Fax)
Définit la méthode d'impression du document reçu.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Système prioritaire (Réglages sortie Imprimante/Fax)
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Système].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Système], tapez “1” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Fax Définit la méthode d'impression du document
reçu.
Impression par lots* /
Impression par page
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-26 C250
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage sortie].
4 Appuyez sur [Système prioritaire].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-27
5 Sélectionnez la méthode d'impression.
– Impression par lots :
L'impression commence une fois que tous les documents ont été
reçus.
– Impression par page :
L'impression est réalisée dès la réception d'une page de
document.
– Si l'option [Impression R/V pour réception] est réglée sur [ON],
l'impression commence dès que les données des deux pages ont
été reçues.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-28 C250
11.8 Information en-tête
Enregistre le nom de l'expéditeur et l'ID du fax.
Information en-tête
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Nom expéditeur Le nom enregistré est imprimé en en-tête sur le
document reçu par le correspondant.
30 caractères et signes
maximum.
No Fax Le numéro (identification) du fax enregistré est
imprimé en en-tête sur le document reçu par le
correspondant.
Le numéro de fax de la machine est entré dans
ce champ.
20 caractères maximum (0
à 9, +, espace, *, #).
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-29
3 Appuyez sur [Information en-tête].
4 Appuyez sur [Nom expéditeur].
L'écran de saisie du nom s'affiche.
5 Saisissez le nom de l'expéditeur et appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Saisie de texte” à la page 13-4.
6 Tapez le numéro de fax de l'expéditeur à l’aide du clavier et des
touches +, espace, ou .
– + :
Représente le signe “+”.
– Espace :
Représente un espace.
–
Déplace le curseur vers la gauche.
–
Déplace le curseur vers la droite.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-30 C250
– Suppri. :
Les caractères sont supprimés un par un à partir de la position du
curseur. Si celui-ci se trouve à l'extrême droite de l'entrée, les
caractères précédent le curseur sont supprimés.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.]
– Pour corriger une entrée, appuyez sur [C] (clear) sur le tableau de
commande.
7 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
Le nom et le numéro de fax de l'expéditeur saisis sont enregistrés.
8 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-31
11.9 Position en-tête/pied de page
Vous pouvez activer/désactiver (ON/OFF) cette fonction d'impression, qui
identifie la station d'origine et l'heure de la réception. Si vous sélectionnez
ON, vous pouvez également choisir d'imprimer ces informations.
!
Détail
Les informations identifiant la station d'origine, qui peuvent être
imprimées sur la station réceptrice, sont l'ID et le nom du fax. Pour plus
d'informations, voir “Informations sur l'expéditeur” à la page 3-53.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Position en-tête
*1
Définit la position d'impression des
informations expéditeur.
Intérieur corps texte :
Les informations expéditeurs seront
imprimées dans la zone
correspondant au document.
Hors corps du texte :
Les informations expéditeurs seront
imprimées en dehors de la zone
correspondant au document.
OFF :
Les informations expéditeur ne seront
pas imprimées.
Position pied
de page
Définit la position d'impression de
l'heure et du numéro de réception
sur le document reçu.
Intérieur corps texte :
Les informations d'heure/numéro
seront imprimées dans la zone
correspondant au document.
Hors corps du texte :
Les informations d'heure/numéro
seront imprimées au bas des pages
reproduites.
OFF* :
Les informations d'heure/numéro ne
seront pas imprimées.
* : Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
*1 : Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-32 C250
Position en-tête/pied de page
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Position en-tête / pied de page].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-33
4 Sélectionnez l'option à régler.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-34 C250
11.10 Réglage Paramètres ligne
Les options de ligne disponibles sont les suivantes.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Méthode de
numérotation *1
Définit la méthode de numérotation. PB* / 10 ips
Mode réception [Récept. auto] définit la réception automatique.
[Réception manuelle] définit la réception dans
le cas d'un lot d'appels réalisés avec un
téléphone externe connecté ou de l'utilisation
de la fonction de réception distante.
Réception auto* /
Réception manuelle
Nbre de sonneries
sur appel entrant
Définit le nombre de sonnerie en réception.
Définit le nombre de tonalités de retour d'appel
entre l'arrivée d'un message et le début de la
réception.
0 à 15 (2 fois*)
Nbre de rappels *2 Définit le nombre de rappels lorsque la ligne du
correspondant est occupée.
0 à 15 (3 fois*)
Délai entre
rappels
Définit l'intervalle de temps entre deux rappels. 1 à 15 (3 min.*)
Suivi audio ligne Définir sur ON pour entendre le son sur la ligne
via le haut-parleur pendant l'émission.
ON / OFF*
Contrôle volume
sonore
Règle le volume sonore du haut-parleur. 0-31 (16*)
*1 : Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
*2 : Les options de ligne diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
* : Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-35
Réglage Paramètres ligne
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage paramètres ligne].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-36 C250
4 Sélectionnez l'option à régler.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
– Pour modifier [Contrôle volume sonore], appuyez sur [Contrôle
volume sonore], puis sur [Plus faible] ou [Plus fort] pour définir le
niveau. Appuyez ensuite sur [OK].
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-37
11.11 Réglage Émission/Réception
Les options d'émission et de réception sont présentées ci-dessous.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Impression R/V
pour réception
Réglé sur ON (actif), l'original reçu est imprimé
recto verso.
Non indiqué si [Imprimer page de séparation]
est réglé sur ON.
OFF* / ON
Papier prioritaire
(pouces) sur A4 *1
Réglé sur ON (actif) la priorité est donnée au
papier au format en pouces.
OFF* / ON
Sélection papier
d'impression
Si la priorité du format est réglée :
L'impression est effectuée sur le format
prioritaire. Dans le cas contraire, l'impression
est effectuée sur le format de papier le plus
proche.
Si le format est fixe :
L'impression est effectuée uniquement dans
ce format.
Sélec auto* / Format fixe /
Format prioritaire
Format papier
d'impression *1 *2
Définit le format de papier d'impression du
document reçu.
La valeur par défaut dépend du réglage de
[Papier prioritaire (pouces) sur A4].
A3 / B4 / A4* / 8 1/2 × 11
/ 8 1/2 × 14 / 11 × 17
Erreur saisie no.
boîte
Définit l'action en cas de saisie d'un numéro de
boîte non enregistré. La sélection de [Création
auto boîte] crée la boîte dont le numéro est
saisi.
Impre.* / Afficher
message d'erreur /
Création auto boîte
Sélection magasin
impression
réception *3
Définit le magasin de papier à utiliser pour
imprimer le document reçu.
Auto* / Mag 1 / Mag 2 /
Mag 3 / Mag 4
Réduction min.
pour impression
réception*4
Règle l'agrandissement de l'original reçu. 87-96* / × 1.0
Imprimer page de
séparation
Définit le mode d'émission par défaut.
Non indiqué si Impression R/V pour réception
est réglée sur ON.
OFF* / ON
Archiver après
appel en relève
Définit la suppression ou non du document
après l'émission en relève.
Supprimer* /
Sauvegarder
* : Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
*1 Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
*2 Pour activer le réglage de [Format papier d'impression], réglez [Sélection magasin
impression réception] sur [Auto].
*3 : Selon l'option installée, le type de magasin peut être différent.
*4 Si [Réduction mini impres. réception] est réglé sur [x1.0], [Sélection papier d'impression] et
[Sélection magasin impression réception] sont réglés sur [Auto]. [Imprimer page de séparation]
est réglé sur [OFF].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-38 C250
Réglage Émission/Réception
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Émis/Récep].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-39
4 Sélectionnez l'option à régler.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-40 C250
11.12 Réglage fonction
Vous pouvez activer/désactiver chacune des fonctions d'émission et de
réception individuellement.
11.12.1Réglage fonction ON/OFF
Sélectionnez ON ou OFF pour chaque fonction.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Activer/Désactiver (ON/OFF) les fonctions d'émission/réception.
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Quitter l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-6).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Régl. fonct ON/OFF
Fonction
d’émission
F-code
La sélection de “OFF” désactive à la fois la
demande d'émission en relais et l'émission
via plusieurs stations de relais.
Pour plus d'informations sur les
communications en relais, voir “Requête
d'émission en relais (Émission F-code)” à la
page 7-32.
ON* / OFF
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-41
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
4 Appuyez sur [Régl. fonct ON/OFF].
– Si [Réception mémoire], [Réglage transfert TX], [Réglage RX fax] ou
[Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI] est réglé sur ON, les autres éléments
ne sont pas affichés.
5 Sélectionnez l'option à régler.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-42 C250
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
6 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
7 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
8 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-43
11.12.2Réception mémoire obligatoire
Vous pouvez activer ou désactiver la réception mémoire inconditionnelle,
c'est-à-dire la mémorisation des documents reçus en vue de leur impression
ultérieure.
Si vous sélectionnez ON, définissez le mot de passe d'impression de 8
caractères maximum.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
!
Détail
Si la Réception mémoire est réglée sur ON, le Réglage RX fax, le
Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI et le Réglage transfert TX ne sont pas
disponibles.
Pour imprimer un document reçu en mode de réception mémoire, voir
“Réception mémoire” à la page 8-6.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Réception
mémoire
obligatoire
Cette fonction permet de recevoir les
documents et de les mémoriser en vue
d'une impression ultérieure.
ON / OFF*
Définissez un mot de passe de
8 caractères maximum.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-44 C250
Réglage de la réception mémoire
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Quitter l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-6).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-45
4 Appuyez sur [Réception mémoire obligatoire].
5 Appuyez sur [ON] et saisissez dans le champ [Mot passe] le mot de
passe (8 caractères) requis pour imprimer le document reçu.
– Le mot de passe peut contenir jusqu'à 8 caractères.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.]
6 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-46 C250
11.12.3RX réseau fermé
Vous pouvez activer ou désactiver la fonction de réception en réseau fermé.
Si vous activez cette fonction (ON), vous devez préciser le mot de passe de
clôture du réseau, composé de 4 caractères.
Avec la réception en réseau fermé, le FK-502 ne reçoit les données entrantes
que si le mot de passe de l'expéditeur est valide. Le FK-502 vérifie si le mot
de passe de l'expéditeur correspond à celui qui est défini sur la machine. Si
les deux mots de passe diffèrent ou si l'expéditeur ne fournit pas de mot de
passe, la machine génère une erreur de communication.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Option Description Valeur disponible
RX réseau fermé La réception en réseau fermé permet de
ne recevoir les données entrantes que si
le mot de passe de l'expéditeur est valide.
ON / OFF*
Le mot de passe peut contenir
jusqu'à 4 caractères.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-47
Réglage de la réception en réseau fermé
0 Conditions requises de la réception en réseau fermé
Cette fonction n'est disponible que si la machine du correspondant est
dotée de la fonction Transmission de mot de passe.
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-48 C250
4 Appuyez sur [RX Réseau fermé].
5 Appuyez sur [ON] et saisissez dans le champ [Mot passe] le mot de
passe requis pour imprimer le document reçu.
– Le mot de passe peut contenir jusqu'à 4 caractères.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
6 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-49
11.12.4Réglage Transfert TX
Vous pouvez activer ou désactiver la fonction de transfert de fax. Si cette
fonction est active, les données reçues sont transférées à une station
déterminée à l'avance.
!
Détail
Si Régl. transfert TX est réglé sur [Transfert et Impres.] ou [Transf. + Imp.
si erreur], les options Réception mémoire, Réglage RX Fax et Paramètre
boîte utilisateur TSI ne sont pas disponibles.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Régl. transfert TX Cette fonction permet de transférer les
données reçues vers une station
déterminée à l'avance.
OFF* / Transfert et Impres. /
Transf. + Imp. si erreur
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-50 C250
Réglage du transfert de fax (Réglage transfert TX)
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-51
4 Appuyez sur [Régl. transfert TX].
5 Sélectionnez [Transfert et Impress.] ou [Transf. + Imp. si Erreur].
– OFF
Le document reçu n'est pas transféré.
– Transfert et Impression
Le document reçu est transféré après impression sur cette
machine.
– Transfert + Impression si Erreur
Le document reçu est transféré.
En cas d'échec du transfert, le document est imprimé sur cette
machine.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-52 C250
6 Saisissez dans le champ [Adresse transf.] le numéro de fax du
destinataire du transfert.
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 38 caractères dans le champ [Adresse
transf.].
– Vous pouvez utiliser les préfixes [Tonalité], [Pause] et [-]. Voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
– Vous pouvez appuyer sur [Carnet d'adresses] pour sélectionner
l'[Adresse transf.] dans un [carnet d'adresses] enregistré.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.]
7 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée et vous revenez à l'écran Utilitaire.
8 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-53
11.12.5Vérification du mot de passe RX confidentiel
Vous pouvez confirmer les numéros d'accès confidentiels définis.
!
Détail
Pour enregistrer les numéros d'accès confidentiels, voir “Réglage des
boîtes confidentielles” à la page 10-46.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Vérif. mot de passe
RX confidentiel
Vous pouvez confirmer les numéros
d'accès confidentiels définis.
-
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-54 C250
Confirmation du mot de passe d'une boîte confidentielle
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-55
4 Appuyez sur [Vérif. mot de passe RX confidentiel].
5 Sélectionnez la boîte confidentielle dont vous voulez confirmer le mot
de passe.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-56 C250
11.12.6Réglage RX fax
Vous pouvez activer ou désactiver la fonction RX PC-Fax.
Si cette fonction est réglée sur ON, indiquez la boîte d'enregistrement de la
sortie.
La fonction RX PC-fax permet d'enregistrer dans des boîtes sur le disque dur
les fichiers contenant les fax reçus. Vous pouvez ensuite lire le contenu des
boîtes sur les ordinateurs du réseau.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Expéditeur Original
Disque dur
Option Description Valeur disponible
Réglage RX fax La fonction RX PC-fax permet d'enregistrer les
fichiers de fax reçus dans des boîtes sur le
disque dur.
ON / OFF*
Sortie RX Le fichier de fax reçu est enregistré dans la Boîte
utilisateur réception mémoire si Sortie RX est
réglé sur Boîte fixe, et dans la boîte spécifiée par
la fonction F-code (adresse secondaire) si Sortie
RX est réglé sur Boîte spécifiée.
Boîte fixe* / Boîte
spécifiée
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-57
!
Détail
Si Réglage RX fax est réglé sur ON, la Réception mémoire, le Paramètre
boîte utilisateur TSI et le Réglage transfert TX ne sont pas disponibles.
Les documents fax reçus sont sauvegardés au format TIFF dans la boîte
fixe, la boîte spécifiée ou la boîte de réception (TSI).
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-58 C250
Réglage RX fax
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-59
4 Appuyez sur [Réglage RX Fax].
5 Sélectionnez [ON] pour [Réglage RX Fax].
– Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
– OFF :
La fonction RX PC-fax n'est pas disponible.
– ON :
La fonction RX PC-fax est exécutée à réception d'un numéro de fax
ou de PC-fax, et le document reçu est sauvegardé dans la boîte
spécifiée.
6 Pour [Sortie RX], sélectionnez la boîte dans laquelle sera sauvegardé
un document reçu via la fonction RX PC-fax.
– Boîte fixe :
un fichier reçu est stocké dans la boîte réception mémoire.
– Boîte spécifiée :
un fichier reçu est stocké dans la boîte stipulée par la fonction F-code
(adresse secondaire).
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-60 C250
– Pour plus d'informations sur le fonctionnement de la réception
PC-fax, voir “Fonctionnement de la Réception PC-fax” à la
page 2-21.
7 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée et vous revenez à l'écran Utilitaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-61
11.12.7Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI
Cette fonction permet d'allouer les documents reçus par le fax. Les fichiers
d'originaux reçus sont sauvegardés dans les boîtes correspondant à l'ID fax
(TSI) des expéditeurs.
!
Détails
L'original reçu avec une ID de fax non enregistrée est stocké dans la Réception
mémoire.
!
Détail
Si Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI est ON, la Réception mémoire, le
Réglage transfert TX et le Réglage RX Fax ne sont pas disponibles.
Expéditeur Original
Disque dur
Option Description Valeur disponible
Paramètre boîte
utilisateur TSI
Cette fonction permet d'allouer les
originaux reçus selon leurs informations
TSI.
ON / OFF*
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-62 C250
Allocation des originaux reçus à l'expéditeur du fax
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-63
4 Appuyez sur [Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI].
5 Appuyez sur [ON].
6 Sélectionnez le numéro à enregistrer et appuyez sur [Modif.].
– Si vous voulez supprimer une distribution, sélectionnez-la et
appuyez sur [Suppri.].
– Vous pouvez enregistrer 128 boîtes maximum.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-64 C250
7 Utilisez le clavier numérique, [+], [ESPACE] ou pour saisir l'ID
du fax dans le champ [Expéditeur (TSI)].
– +
Insère le signe +.
– Espace
Insère un espace.
–
Déplace le curseur vers la gauche.
–
Déplace le curseur vers la droite.
– Suppri.
Les caractères sont supprimés un par un à partir de la position du
curseur. Si celui-ci se trouve à l'extrême droite de l'entrée, les
caractères précédent le curseur sont supprimés.
– Lors de la transmission, [+] et [ESPACE] sont ignorés.
8 Appuyez sur [No. boîte ut] et tapez le numéro de la boîte
d'enregistrement du document reçu.
– Plage de numéros disponibles : 1 à 999999999.
9 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
Le Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI est défini.
10 Appuyez sur [Quitt.].
L'écran de distribution des fax reçus s'affiche à nouveau.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-65
11.13 Réglage CN PBX (Private Branch Exchange)
Les options PBX disponibles sont décrites ci-dessous.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Options du mode de connexion PBX (Private Branch Exchange)
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Définir mode
PBX CN
Sélectionner ON si le FK-502 est raccordé à
une ligne PBX.
ON / OFF*
Ligne extérieure Si le mode PBX CN est réglé sur ON, ce
paramètre détermine le code d'accès à la ligne
extérieure, c'est à dire le préfixe lié au numéro
de téléphone et composé avec celui-ci si
l'option de ligne extérieure est sélectionnée
avec un numéro abrégé ou un programme.
0-9999
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-66 C250
3 Appuyez sur [Définir CN PBX].
4 Sélectionnez [ON] pour Définir mode PBX CN.
5 Saisissez au clavier le code de la ligne extérieure.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.]
6 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-67
11.14 Réglage Rapports
Vous pouvez activer ou désactiver (ON/OFF) le Réglage rapports. Cette
fonction imprime les rapports de communication à la direction, les rapports
de résultats et spécifie les magasins d'entrée/sortie des rapports. Si cette
fonction est activée (ON), la méthode d'impression peut également être
sélectionnée.
!
Détail
Si “Vérif. rapport résultat émission” est actif (ON), le rapport d'émission
est imprimé si OUI est sélectionné. Il n'est pas imprimé dans le cas
contraire (NON).
Option Description Valeur disponible
Rapport d'activité Détermine l'impression ou non du rapport et
l'intervalle/la plage de cette impression.
OFF / Quotidien / Toutes
les 100 com.* / 100/jour
Rapport Émission ON / Sur erreur seulement*
/ OFF
Rapport émission
séquentiel
ON* / OFF
Rapport émission
programmée
ON* / OFF
Rapport réception
confidentielle
ON* / OFF
Rapport émission
bulletin
ON* / OFF
Magasin papier
pour rapport *1 *2
Spécifie le magasin utilisé pour l'impression
d'un rapport.
Magasin 1 / Magasin 2* /
Magasin 3 / Magasin 4 /
Introduct. manuelle
Vérif. rapport
résultat émission
Détermine l'affichage ou non de l'écran de
sélection du rapport de résultat de
l'émission. Si vous sélectionnez ON, cet
écran s'affiche après chaque émission.
OFF* / ON
* : Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
*1 : Selon l'option installée, le type de magasin peut être différent.
*2 : Le Magasin 1 est le magasin par défaut, si aucune option de magasins n'est installée.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-68 C250
Réglage des rapports
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Rapports].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C250 11-69
4 Sélectionnez le rapport à régler.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez l'option voulue.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-70 C250
12 Rapports et listes
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-3
12 Rapports et listes
12.1 Types de rapports et de listes
Vous pouvez imprimer sur cette machine les types de rapports et de listes
suivants :
12.1.1 Rapports
Les rapports sont de trois types : impression automatique, méthode
d'impression paramétrable, impression selon les besoins.
Nom du rapport Description
Rapport d'activité Ce rapport liste les 100 (maximum) dernières émissions et
réceptions sur des pages distinctes (une pour les émissions,
l'autre pour les réceptions). Selon les besoins, la liste des
émissions, celle des réceptions, ou ces deux listes peuvent être
imprimées.
• L'impression du rapport d'activité est réglée dans le mode
Utilitaire sur OFF*, Quotidien, Toutes les 100 com. ou 100/jour*.
• Les rapports suivants peuvent être sélectionnés et imprimés
via l'écran Fax. ([Liste tâches] - [onglet Émission fax] -
[Historique tâches] - [Réglage comm.])
• Rapport d'activité, Rapport Émission, Rapport Réception
Rapport Émission Le Rapport Émission est imprimé automatiquement. Le mode
Utilitaire définit l'impression des rapports Émission sur Toujours
si l'impression est active (ON) / Sur erreur seulement / OFF.
Rapport d'émission (relève) Si le Rapport Émission est réglé sur ON ou Sur erreur seulement
dans les réglages administrateur du mode Utilitaire, le résultat de
l'émission en relève sont automatiquement imprimés.
Rapport de relève Si le Rapport Émission est réglé sur ON ou Sur erreur seulement
dans les réglages Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, le résultat de
la réception en relève est automatiquement imprimé.
Rapport de diffusion Si Rapport émission séquentielle est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est imprimé
automatiquement à la fin de l'émission diffusée séquentielle.
Rapport de relève
séquentielle (réception)
Si Rapport émission séquentielle est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, le résultat de la réception en
relève de plusieurs destinations est automatiquement imprimé.
Rapport de communication
réservée
Si Rapport Émission programmée est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est
automatiquement imprimé lorsqu'une émission est réservée.
Rapport d'émission
réservée (relève)
Si Rapport émission programmée est réglée sur ON dans
Réglage Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est
automatiquement imprimé lorsqu'une émission en relève est
réservée.
12 Rapports et listes
12-4 C250
12.1.2 Listes
Les listes sont imprimées selon les besoins.
Rapport de diffusion
réservée
Si Rapport émission programmée est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est
automatiquement imprimé lorsqu'une émission multiposte
séquentielle est réservée.
Rapport de réception réservée
(relève)
Si Rapport émission programmée est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est automatiquement
imprimé lorsqu'une relève programmée vers une destination
est réservée.
Rapport de relève
séquentielle réservée
(réception)
Si Rapport émission programmée est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est
automatiquement imprimé lorsqu'une relève programmée vers
plusieurs destinations est réservée.
Rapport réception
confidentielle
Si Rapport réception confidentielle est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est
automatiquement imprimé à la réception d'un document
confidentiel.
Rapport Émission bulletin Si Rapport émission bulletin est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, le résultat de l'émission en
relève au bulletin board (tableau électronique) est
automatiquement imprimé.
Nom du rapport Description
Nom de la liste Description
Liste Carnet d'adresses Les numéros enregistrés dans le carnet d'adresses peuvent être
imprimés.
Liste Programme Les numéros enregistrés dans un programme peuvent être
imprimés.
Liste d'adresses de groupe Les numéros enregistrés dans un groupe peuvent être imprimés.
Liste de Titres/Textes La liste de sujets et de textes (e-mail) peut être imprimée.
Liste des réglages du fax Les réglages du mode Utilitaire peuvent être imprimés.
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-5
12.2 Rapport d'activité
Le rapport d'activité liste les 100 (maximum) dernières émissions et
réceptions sur des pages distinctes (une pour les émissions, l'autre pour les
réceptions). Ce rapport peut être imprimé automatiquement, ou imprimé
selon les besoins, en totalité (rapport d'activité), pour les émissions
uniquement (rapport d'émission, ou pour les réceptions uniquement (rapport
de réception).
12.2.1 Impression automatique
L'intervalle d'impression du rapport d'activité peut être défini dans Réglage
Rapports.
12.2.2 Impression manuelle
Le rapport d'activité peut être imprimé manuellement comme suit.
Impression manuelle
1 Appuyez sur [Liste tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur l'onglet [Émission fax].
3 Appuyez sur [Historique tâches].
12 Rapports et listes
12-6 C250
4 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
5 Appuyez sur [Rapport d'activité], [Rapport émission] ou [Rapport
réception].
6 Appuyez sur [Imprimer].
Le rapport est imprimé.
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-7
!
Détail
Un message s'affiche si le papier requis ne se trouve pas dans le magasin
destiné aux rapports et aux listes. Chargez le papier requis.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Un numéro de série est attribué à chaque émission et à chaque
réception.
Destination Contient les informations suivantes (cet espace est vide en l'absence de
ces informations).
• Nom si celui-ci a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros abrégés
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de début Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication
Impressions Nombre de pages émises ou reçues. En cas d'émission mémoire, le
nombre de pages émises et le nombre total de pages sont indiqués.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-8 C250
!
Détail
Les éléments indiqués dépendent des réglages optionnels.
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-9
12.3 Rapport Émission
12.3.1 Impression manuelle
Les informations suivantes apparaissent si l'émission est réglée sur [ON]
dans [Réglage Rapports]-[Rapport Émission] du mode Utilitaire.
Appuyez sur [Oui] pour imprimer le Rapport Émission ; sur [Non] pour ne pas
imprimer ce rapport. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à
la page 11-68.
12.3.2 Impression automatique
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON], [Sur erreur seulement]
ou [OFF] dans [Rapport Émission] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le
mode Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
12 Rapports et listes
12-10 C250
Élément Description
No. Un numéro de série est attribué à chaque émission et à chaque
réception.
Destination Indique :
• Nom si celui-ci a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros abrégés ou
la liste d'entrée
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure début
émission
Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication
Impressions Nombre de pages émises. En cas d'émission mémoire, le nombre de
pages émises et le nombre total de pages sont indiqués.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas aboutie parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-11
12.4 Rapport d'émission (en relève)
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement à la suite de l'émission en relève
d'un document enregistré dans la boîte relève émission.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
Émission] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode Utilitaire. Pour
plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Le nom de la destination s'il est enregistré dans la liste Carnet
d'adresses.
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de création Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication
Impressions Nombre de pages émises.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-12 C250
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-13
12.5 Rapport de relève
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement à réception de la relève.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
Émission] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode Utilitaire. Pour
plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Un nom de destination s'il est enregistré dans la liste Carnet
d'adresses.
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de début Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication
Impressions Nombre de pages émises.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-14 C250
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-15
12.6 Rapport de diffusion
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement à la suite d'une émission
multiposte séquentielle.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission séquentielle] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Un nom de destination s'il est enregistré dans la liste Carnet
d'adresses.
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de début Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication.
Impressions Nombre de pages émises. Le nombre de pages émises et le nombre
total de pages sont indiqués.
12 Rapports et listes
12-16 C250
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-17
12.7 Rapport de relève séquentielle (réception)
Le rapport de relève séquentielle vers plusieurs destinations est imprimé
automatiquement.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission séquentielle] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Nom de la destination s'il a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros
abrégés, et
• Numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de début Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication.
Impressions Nombre de pages transmises.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-18 C250
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-19
12.8 Rapport de communication réservée
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement en cas d'émission programmée.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission programmée] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Nom si celui-ci a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros abrégés
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de création Heure d'émission programmée.
Heure de début Heure spécifiée en cas d'émission programmée.
Impressions Nombre de pages numérisées.
12 Rapports et listes
12-20 C250
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-21
12.9 Rapport d'émission réservée (relève)
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement lorsqu'une émission en relève est
réservée.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission programmée] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Non indiquée.
Heure de création Heure d'émission programmée.
Heure de début Non indiquée.
Impressions Nombre de pages numérisées.
12 Rapports et listes
12-22 C250
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-23
12.10 Rapport de diffusion réservée
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement à la suite de la réservation d'une
émission multiposte séquentielle.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission programmée] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Nom de la destination s'il a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros
abrégés, et
• Numéro de téléphone de la destination s'il a été sélectionné au clavier.
Heure de création Heure à laquelle l'émission a été réservée.
Heure de début Heure spécifiée en cas d'émission programmée.
Impressions Nombre de pages numérisées.
12 Rapports et listes
12-24 C250
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-25
12.11 Rapport de réception réservée (relève)
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement lors de la réservation de la relève
d'une destination.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission programmée] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Numéro de téléphone de la destination.
Heure de création Heure de réception de la relève.
Heure de début Heure spécifiée en cas d'émission programmée (réservée).
Impressions Nombre de pages transmises.
12 Rapports et listes
12-26 C250
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-27
12.12 Rapport de relève séquentielle réservée (réception)
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement lors de la réservation de la relève
de plusieurs destinations.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission programmée] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Numéro de téléphone de la destination.
Heure de création Heure de réception de la relève.
Heure de début Heure spécifiée en cas d'émission programmée (réservée).
Impressions Nombre de pages transmises.
12 Rapports et listes
12-28 C250
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-29
12.13 Rapport réception confidentielle
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement suite à la réception d'un document
confidentiel.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
réception confidentielle] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Nom de la destination s'il a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros
abrégés
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de création Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication.
Impressions Nombre de pages transmises.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-30 C250
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-31
12.14 Rapport Émission bulletin
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement à la suite de l'émission en relève
d'un document enregistré dans la boîte utilisateur Bulletin.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission bulletin] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode Utilitaire.
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la page 11-68.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Nom de la destination s'il a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros
abrégés
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de création Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication.
Impressions Nombre de pages transmises.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-32 C250
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-33
12.15 Liste Carnet d'adresses
Liste Carnet d'adresses
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans
[Paramètre sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la
gestion du mot de passe.
4 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option
[Enregistrement 1-touche], tapez “3” sur le clavier.
5 Appuyez sur [Liste enregistre. 1-touche].
6 Appuyez sur [Liste Carnet d'adresses].
12 Rapports et listes
12-34 C250
7 Tapez au clavier la plage de numéros d'enregistrements à imprimer
dans le champ [No. enregistrement] et sélectionnez [E-Mail], [Boîte
utilisat.] ou [Fax] pour le champ [Type de destination].
– Vous pouvez indiquer 100 numéros d'enregistrements maximum.
– Appuyez sur pour déplacer le curseur vers la gauche, sur
pour le déplacer vers la droite.
– Pour corriger une entrée, appuyez sur [C] (clear) sur le tableau de
commande.
8 Appuyez sur [Impr.].
9 Sélectionnez le magasin de papier.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La liste Carnet d'adresses est imprimée.
!
Détail
Si le papier requis n'est pas chargé dans le magasin indiqué, la touche
[Départ] clignote en rouge. Dans ce cas, vous ne pouvez pas appuyer sur
[Départ].
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-35
Description de la liste Carnet d'adresses
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Numéro abrégé.
Nom Nom enregistré
Numéro tél. Numéro de fax enregistré dans le carnet d'adresses
Réglage ligne * indiqué s'il a été paramétré.
12 Rapports et listes
12-36 C250
12.16 Liste d'adresses de groupe
Liste d'adresses de groupe
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans
[Paramètre sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la
gestion du mot de passe.
4 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option
[Enregistrement 1-touche], tapez “3” sur le clavier.
5 Appuyez sur [Liste enregistre. 1-touche].
6 Appuyez sur [Liste groupe].
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-37
7 Tapez au clavier la plage de numéros d'enregistrements à imprimés
dans le champ [No. enregistrement].
– Vous pouvez indiquer 20 numéros d'enregistrements maximum.
– Appuyez sur pour déplacer le curseur vers la gauche, sur
pour le déplacer vers la droite.
– Pour corriger une entrée, appuyez sur [C] (clear) sur le tableau de
commande.
8 Appuyez sur [Impr.].
9 Sélectionnez le magasin de papier.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La liste d'adresses de groupe est imprimée.
!
Détail
Si le papier requis n'est pas chargé dans le magasin indiqué, la touche
[Départ] clignote en rouge. Dans ce cas, vous ne pouvez pas appuyer sur
[Départ].
12 Rapports et listes
12-38 C250
Description de la liste d'adresses de groupe
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Numéro du groupe
Nom Nom du groupe
Adr. No. Numéros abrégés enregistrés dans le groupe
Nombre enregist. Nombre de numéros abrégés enregistrés dans le groupe
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-39
12.17 Liste Programme
Liste Programme
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans
[Paramètre sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la
gestion du mot de passe.
4 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option
[Enregistrement 1-touche], tapez “3” sur le clavier.
5 Appuyez sur [Liste enregistre. 1-touche].
6 Appuyez sur [Liste Programme].
12 Rapports et listes
12-40 C250
7 Tapez au clavier la plage de numéros d'enregistrements à imprimer
dans le champ [No. enregistrement] et sélectionnez [E-Mail], [Boîte
utilisat.], [Fax], [Numéro abrégé] ou [No. groupe] pour le champ [Type
de destination].
– Vous pouvez indiquer 50 numéros d'enregistrements maximum.
– Appuyez sur pour déplacer le curseur vers la gauche, sur
pour le déplacer vers la droite.
– Pour corriger une entrée, appuyez sur [C] (clear) sur le tableau de
commande.
8 Appuyez sur [Impr.].
9 Sélectionnez le magasin de papier.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La liste Programme est imprimée.
!
Détail
Si le papier requis n'est pas chargé dans le magasin indiqué, la touche
[Départ] clignote en rouge. Dans ce cas, vous ne pouvez pas appuyer sur
[Départ].
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-41
Description de la Liste Programme
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Numéro d'enregistrement du programme
Nom Nom de l'enregistrement
Numéro abrégé Numéro abrégé de l'enregistrement
No. boîte utilisateur Numéro d'enregistrement de la boîte utilisateur
Adresse E-Mail Adresse e-mail enregistrée
Élément Fonctions du FK-502.
Setting Valeur de réglage sélectionnée
12 Rapports et listes
12-42 C250
12.18 Liste de Titres/Textes
La liste de sujets et de textes (e-mail) enregistrés peut être imprimée.
Liste de Titres/Textes
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans
[Paramètre sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la
gestion du mot de passe.
4 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option
[Enregistrement 1-touche], tapez “3” sur le clavier.
5 Appuyez sur [Liste enregistre. 1-touche].
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-43
6 Appuyez sur [Liste Sujet/Texte E-Mail].
7 Sélectionnez le magasin de papier.
8 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La liste Titres/Textes est imprimée.
!
Détail
Si le papier requis n'est pas chargé dans le magasin indiqué, la touche
[Départ] clignote en rouge. Dans ce cas, vous ne pouvez pas appuyer sur
[Départ].
12 Rapports et listes
12-44 C250
Description de la liste de Titres/Textes
Nom de la liste Élément Description
Liste Sujet No. Numéro de l'enregistrement.
Sujet Sujet enregistré en tant que sujet/texte (pour un
e-mail).
Liste de textes No. Numéro de l'enregistrement.
Texte Texte enregistré en tant que sujet/texte (pour un
e-mail).
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-45
12.19 Liste des réglages du fax
La liste des réglages du fax peut être imprimée.
Liste des réglages du fax
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans
[Paramètre sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la
gestion du mot de passe.
4 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
12 Rapports et listes
12-46 C250
5 Appuyez sur [Réglage Multi lignes].
6 Sélectionnez le magasin de papier.
7 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La liste des réglages du fax est imprimée.
!
Détail
Si le papier requis n'est pas chargé dans le magasin indiqué, la touche
[Départ] clignote en rouge. Dans ce cas, vous ne pouvez pas appuyer sur
[Départ].
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-47
Description de la liste des réglages du fax
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Élément Fonction du mode Utilitaire.
Réglages Valeur de réglage sélectionnée
12 Rapports et listes
12-48 C250
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Rapports et listes 12
C250 12-49
12.19.1Liste confidentielle/bulletin
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Numéro de boîte enregistré avec le réglage confidentiel / bulletin board.
Nom Nom enregistré.
Mot de passe Mot de passe confidentiel.
Type Confidentiel ou Bulletin board.
12 Rapports et listes
12-50 C250
12.19.2Boîte émetteur (TSI)
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Numéro d'enregistrement de l'expéditeur (TSI) RX
Expédit. (TSI) Informations sur l'expéditeur enregistré.
No. boîte Numéro d'enregistrement de la boîte
13 Annexe
Annexe 13
C250 13-3
13 Annexe
13.1 Nombre de pages mémorisées
Cette machine est équipée en standard d'un disque dur de 40 Go. Les
images de fax sont sauvegardées dans la zone 27 Go du disque dur.
Ce disque dur a une capacité de stockage et de réception dans chacun des
modes (copie, imprimante, numérisation, boîte et fax) d'environ 9 000
originaux Konica Minolta standard au format A4 contenant chacun 700 mots
(en définition “fine”).
La taille, l'état et la définition des originaux a toutefois une incidence sur le
nombre de pages sauvegardées sur le disque dur.
!
Détail
La mémoire peut saturer pendant la lecture de l'original. Dans ce cas,
vous pouvez soit émettre la partie lue de l'original, soit recommencer la
procédure.
13 Annexe
13-4 C250
13.2 Saisie de texte
La section suivante explique comment utiliser le clavier affiché sur l'écran
tactile pour saisir les noms des comptes enregistrés et les formats de papier
personnalisés. Vous pouvez également y taper les numéros.
Les différents claviers pouvant apparaître sont illustrés ci-dessous.
Exemple
Écran de saisie du mot de passe
Écran de saisie d'une adresse e-mail
Écran de saisie d'un e-mail
Annexe 13
C250 13-5
La procédure suivante explique comment se servir du clavier tactile affiché
sur l'écran de saisie d'une adresse e-mail.
13 Annexe
13-6 C250
Pour taper du texte
% Touchez la touche du caractère voulu sur le clavier affiché.
– Pour saisir une lettre en majuscule ou un symbole exigeant le
clavier en majuscule, touchez [Maj.].
– Vous pouvez également taper des chiffres sur ce clavier.
Les caractères saisis s'affichent dans la zone de texte.
2
Remarque
Pour annuler le texte saisi, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Pour effacer tout le texte saisi, appuyez sur la touche [C] (clear).
!
Détail
Pour modifier un caractère dans le texte saisi, touchez et/ou
pour placer le curseur devant ce caractère, touchez [Suppri.], puis
retapez la lettre ou le chiffre voulu.
Liste des caractères disponibles
Type Caractères disponibles
Caractères
alphanumériques /
symboles
Annexe 13
C250 13-7
13.3 Glossaire
Cette section décrit les termes de communication fax employés.
Certaines définitions s'appliquent à des fonctions non employées sur cette
machine.
Termes Description
Caractères
numériques
2 en 1 TX Fonction de réunion de deux pages en une seule et
d'émission de la page au format large ainsi composée.
B bps Abréviation de “bit par seconde”, unité de transmission de
données représentant la quantité de données envoyée par
seconde.
Bulletin board (tableau électronique) Fonction permettant de poster les
documents à lire ou à émettre en relève.
C Carnet
d'adresses
Carnet permettant d'appeler la destination en recherchant
son nom dans la liste de numéros abrégés enregistrés.
Communication
confidentielle
Fonction d'échange d'informations confidentielles avec
certaines personnes déterminées. L'original émis avec cette
fonction est enregistré dans la boîte confidentielle du
destinataire, sans impression. L'impression d'une
communication confidentielle exige un mot de passe.
Communications
internationales
Cette fonction permet d'émettre à une vitesse de
transmission moins rapide. Elle est particulièrement utile lors
de l'émission d'un fax dans une région (nationale comprise)
où les conditions de communication sont moins fiables.
D Débordement
mémoire
État de saturation de la mémoire de cette machine pendant
la mémorisation d'un document transmis.
Définition Plus la définition est fine, plus le temps de transmission est
long. Il convient de sélectionner la définition appropriée.
Diffusion Émission d'un fax vers plusieurs postes, en une seule
opération.
13 Annexe
13-8 C250
E ECM (Error
Correction Mode)
(code de correction d'erreur) Ce mode est utilisé avec la
communication G3. La transmission exacte des données et
leur bonne réception sont vérifiées. En cas d'erreur, les
données sont émises à nouveau. Si la destination gère ce
mode de vérification des erreurs, les données sont
transmises sous ce mode, à moins que la fonction ECM OFF
n'ait été activée.
Effacement bords Fonction permettant d'effacer les bandes noires reproduites
lorsque l'original est un livre ou qu'il est lu avec le chargeur
de document ouvert.
Émission de
substitution
Fonction de transfert/émission des documents reçus en
attente d'impression, par le biais du tableau de commande.
Cette fonction peut être réglée sur l'écran Fax lorsque
l'opération a été interrompue en raison d'un manque de
papier ou d'un bourrage papier dans la machine.
Émission différée
(TX)
Fonction permettant de spécifier l'heure de début de la
communication. L'exécution de l'émission la nuit ou tôt le
matin permet de tirer parti de tarifs plus intéressants.
Émission en relais Fonction d'envoi d'un fax à plusieurs stations via une station
de relais. En cas d'émission vers des stations distantes, la
configuration de l'une des stations en tant que station relais
permet de réduire les coûts de communication.
Émission groupée Fonction de transmission simultanée du dernier document
réservé avec le document réservé précédent si la destination
et les conditions de transmission (émission mémoire,
définition, etc.) sont les mêmes. Cette fonction peut émettre
jusqu'à cinq documents.
Émission livre Fonction qui génère deux pages distinctes à partir de deux
pages en vis à vis d'un livre ou d'un catalogue ouvert.
Émission
manuelle
Fonction d'émission de documents tout en confirmant l'état
de la machine réceptrice.
Émission
mémoire
Avec cette méthode, toutes les pages sont numérisées, puis
mémorisées avant l'émission. Le document est
automatiquement paginé et les images de la première page
apparaissent dans le rapport de communication.
Lors de l'émission d'un grand nombre de pages ou si les
images des originaux sont hautement définies, la capacité de
la mémoire peut toutefois être dépassée.
Émission par lot Fonction d'émission automatique d'un document à une
heure donnée si la destination, l'heure d'émission, l'émission
mémoire et la définition ne changent pas.
Termes Description
Annexe 13
C250 13-9
F F-code Stipule l'utilisation de l'adresse secondaire du protocole
T.30* normalisé par l'ITU-T. Plusieurs fonctions F-code
peuvent être utilisées sur les télécopieurs gérant ce code,
quels que soient leurs fabricants. Sur cette machine, la
fonction F-code s’utilise dans le bulletin board, pour les
requêtes de transmission en relais, les communications
confidentielles et les émissions d'ID. (* il s’agit d’une des
normes de communication.)
Format original Fonction de désignation du format du document à envoyer.
En principe, si le format de papier chargé à la destination est
trop petit pour recevoir l'image transmise, cette image est
réduite pour tenir dans la feuille. Cette fonction permet
d'imprimer une partie de l'image sans réduction.
G G3 L'un des modes de communication fax normalisés par l'ITUT.
C'est le mode le plus utilisé.
Groupe Regroupement de plusieurs numéros abrégés. Cette
fonction est utile si vous utilisez fréquemment l'émission
séquentielle multiposte ou la réception en relève. Un groupe
peut contenir jusqu'à 500 numéros abrégés.
H Haut/Bas Fonction de précision du type de reliure lors de l'émission
d'un document recto-verso. Le type de reliure sélectionné
permet de le lire correctement de droite à gauche ou de haut
en bas.
I ID Fax Code permettant d'identifier le fax émetteur et récepteur. Le
numéro de fax est généralement enregistré en tant qu'ID du
fax.
Informations de
l'expéditeur
Informations telles que la date d'émission, le nom et le
numéro de téléphone de l'expéditeur, ainsi que le nombre de
pages, imprimées en haut du document reçu par la
destination.
L Lecture Numérisation optique d'un original et capture de cet original
en tant que données d'image.
M Mémoire Emplacement de stockage des données. La mémoire peut
contenir les réglages de la communication et le document à
émettre/reçu.
Mémoire rapide Avec cette méthode, l'émission du fax s'effectue
immédiatement après la numérisation de chaque page. C'est
la méthode recommandée pour ne pas saturer la mémoire
dans le cas de l'émission d'un document volumineux.
Méthode de
numérotation
Il existe deux méthodes de numérotation : à impulsions
(décimale) et à fréquences vocales (DTME).
Mot de passe
émission (TX)
Fonction de transmission de fax avec un mot de passe.
L'expéditeur doit utiliser le même mot de passe que celui qui
est paramétré sur la machine réceptrice fonctionnant en
réseau fermé, si cette machine est la destination.
Termes Description
13 Annexe
13-10 C250
N Nom expéditeur Nom de la machine, représenté par des caractères
alphanumériques et des signes. Ce nom est imprimé en haut
du document reçu par le destinataire.
Nombre total de
pages
Fonction plaçant automatiquement le nombre total de pages
sur chaque page du fax en mode Mémoire rapide. Cette
fonction permet au destinataire de vérifier la bonne réception
de toutes les pages du document.
Numérisation
horizontale
L'original est numérisé à l'horizontale.
Numérisation
verticale
L'original est numérisé à la verticale.
Numéro abrégé L'une des fonctions d'enregistrement des numéros de fax
fréquemment composés. L'enregistrement du nom de la
destination et du caractère de recherche avec le numéro
abrégé permet ensuite de désigner la destination dans le
carnet d'adresses. 500 numéros abrégés (000 à 499)
peuvent être enregistrés.
O Original long Fonction permettant d'émettre des pages plus longues que
le format 11 × 17 (420 mm/16,5 pouces). Cette fonction doit
être choisie avant l'émission d'un document long, faute de
quoi la machine génère un message d'erreur
d'acheminement du papier. Les pages de 800 mm maximum
peuvent être émises sous ce mode.
Original plié Fonction déterminant le format de l'original avant sa lecture
et son émission. Certains télécopieurs ne détectent pas le
format d'un document plié. Cette fonction n'est disponible
que si le document est placé dans le chargeur de document.
Originaux mixtes Fonction permettant de régler et d'envoyer des pages de
différents formats en une seule procédure.
P Pause Cette fonction inclut une pause dans la numérotation.
L'appui une fois sur la touche Pause crée un intervalle d'une
seconde.
Programme Fonction d'enregistrement des numéros de fax fréquemment
utilisés et des modèles de procédures dans un programme.
Cela fait, la destination ou la procédure voulue est
sélectionnée en appuyant sur la touche Programme (dans la
liste de numéros abrégés).
Termes Description
Annexe 13
C250 13-11
R Rappel Renuméroter la même destination. Le rappel peut s'effectuer
automatiquement ou manuellement.
Réception en
mémoire
Fonction de mémorisation automatique du document reçu
s'il ne peut être imprimé en raison de manque de papier.
Réception
mémoire
Fonction d'enregistrement, et d'impression le cas échéant,
du document reçu.
Ré-émission Fonction de sélection des documents dont l'émission a
échoué. Les documents sont mémorisés, puis émis à
nouveau à la même destination ou à une autre.
Réglage usine Valeur par défaut définie en usine. Ces valeurs peuvent être
modifiées en mode Utilitaire. La définition d'une valeur
utilisée fréquemment en tant que valeur par défaut accélère
les procédures.
Relève Fonction d'envoi d'un fax, qui a été lu et enregistré sur le
disque dur du télécopieur, au moment où le destinataire
envoie une commande de relève.
Réservation
d'émission
Fonction de réservation de l'émission suivante pendant une
communication ou une impression.
S Station d'origine Le télécopieur fournissant les instructions d'émission d'un
document vers plusieurs stations.
Station relais Le télécopieur émettant le document vers plusieurs stations
à la demande de la station d'origine.
Super G3 (SG3) Mode de communication G3 conforme au protocole V.34 de
l'ITU-T, plus rapide (jusqu'à 33 400 bps) que la
communication G3 standard.
T Temps de
transmission
La durée d'émission d'un fax. Plus la définition est fine, plus
le temps de transmission est long.
V V.34 Protocole de communication en super G3. Ce mode est
disponible si le récepteur et l'expéditeur sont connectés à la
ligne via une extension de matériel de central.
Vitesse de
transmission
Débit de transmission du modem sur le télécopieur. Il peut
être réglé sur le haut débit de 33 600 bps. En mode de
communication internationale, ce débit peut être réduit lors
de l'émission d'un fax dans une région où les conditions de
communication sont moins fiables. Le débit peut alors être
réglé sur 7 200 ou 4 800 bps.
Termes Description
13 Annexe
13-12 C250
13.4 Index
A
Accessibilité, tableau de commande
.................................................. 2-5
Aide, tableau de commande .... 2-6
Ajustement fond .............7-6, 7-15
Alimentation, tableau de commande
.................................................. 2-5
Annul. ....................................... 7-5
Annuler, tableau de commande 2-5
Appels récents # .................... 3-27
Arrêt, tableau de commande ... 2-5
Authentification utilisateur ..... 2-17
B
Boîte ....................................... 2-18
Boîte bulletin board ............... 2-20
Boîte d'émission en relève ..... 2-20
Boîte d'impression sécurisée . 2-20
Boîte émetteur (TSI) ............. 12-50
Boîte spécifiée ....................... 2-19
Boîte système ........................ 2-20
Boîte utilisateur ........................ 2-9
Boîte utilisateur réception
mémoire .....................2-20, 10-49
Boîte, tableau de commande .. 2-4
Boîtes confidentielles ........... 10-46
Bulletin (tableau électronique)
............................................. 10-48
Bulletin board (tableau électronique)
................................................ 9-10
C
C, tableau de commande ........ 2-5
Carnet d'adresses 2-8, 2-15, 3-19,
...................................... 3-23, 10-5
chargeur ADF .................3-7, 3-10
Clavier .................................... 3-21
Clavier, tableau de commande 2-5
Code, tableau de commande ...2-4
Communication confidentielle 7-29
Communications internationales
.......................................3-50, 7-6
Compte de service .................2-17
Contraste, tableau de commande
.................................................2-5
Contrôle, tableau de commande
.................................................2-5
Copie, tableau de commande ..2-4
D
Décrocher ...............................2-15
Définir mode PBX CN ...........11-65
Définition ................................3-15
Densité ...................................3-13
Départ, tableau de commande 2-5
Données, tableau de commande
.................................................2-5
E
ECM OFF ........................7-6, 7-35
Écran Fax actif ...........11-7, 11-19
Écran Fax
réglage par défaut ......11-7, 11-15
Écran tactile .............................2-4
Effacement bords ...........7-6, 7-12
E-mail .......................................2-9
Émission différée (TX) .....3-47, 7-6
Émission en relève ...................9-4
Émission en relève (TX) ............7-6
Émission F-code (TX) ...............7-6
Enregistrer ds boîte ut. ...........3-27
Epreuve, tableau de commande
.................................................2-5
F
Fax, tableau de commande .....2-4
Format de numérisat. ...............7-6
Format de numérisation .........7-21
Annexe 13
C250 13-13
G
Groupe .......................2-15, 10-19
I
Imprimer page de séparation .4-12
Imprimer page de séparation
...............................................4-13
Indicateur de destination .......2-16
Indicateur de page .................2-15
Information en-tête
...........................2-7, 11-8, 11-28
INTERRUPTEUR, tableau de
commande ...............................2-5
Interruption, tableau de commande
.................................................2-5
L
Ligne extérieure ...................11-65
Liste Carnet d'adresses .......12-33
Liste confidentielle/bulletin ..12-49
Liste d'adresses de groupe .12-36
Liste de Titres/Textes ...........12-42
Liste des caractères
disponibles .............................13-6
Liste des réglages du fax .....12-45
Liste pages .............................2-15
Liste Paramètres tâche ........11-13
Liste Programme ..................12-39
Liste tâches ..................2-15, 3-37
M
Mémoire .................................2-15
Mémoire rapide ..............3-42, 7-6
Mémoire saturée ......................5-6
Méthode de numérotation .......2-7
Mode réception ........................2-7
Mot de passe
émission (TX) ..................7-6, 7-26
N
Netteté ........................... 7-6, 7-18
Nº de fax expéditeur ................ 2-7
No. abrégé ..................... 2-9, 3-27
No. de destinat. ..................... 2-15
Nom dest. ............................. 2-15
Nom expéditeur ....................... 2-7
Nombre d'originaux ............... 3-45
Nombre originaux .................... 7-6
Numérisation vers E-mail ...... 3-27
Numérisation, tableau de
commande .............................. 2-4
O
Occupé .................................... 5-6
OFF .......................................... 7-5
OK ........................................... 7-5
Originaux mixtes .............. 7-5, 7-7
P
Paramètre boîte
utilisateur TSI ....................... 11-61
Pas de réponse ....................... 5-6
Passage économie
énergie (Fax) .............. 11-8, 11-22
Pause ..................................... 3-27
Paysage ................................. 1-24
Portrait ................................... 1-24
Position en-tête/
pied de page ............. 11-9, 11-32
Position reliure ................. 7-5, 7-9
Programme .................. 2-12, 2-15
.................................... 3-22, 10-25
R
Rappel ................................... 3-32
Rapport d'activité .................. 12-5
Rapport d’émission
(en relève) ............................ 12-11
13 Annexe
13-14 C250
Rapport d’émission
réservée (relève) ................... 12-21
Rapport de communication
réservée ............................... 12-19
Rapport de diffusion ............ 12-15
Rapport de diffusion
réservée ............................... 12-23
Rapport de réception réservée
(relève) .................................12-25
Rapport de relève
(réception) ............................ 12-13
Rapport de relève
séquentielle (réception) ........ 12-17
Rapport de relève séquentielle
réservée (réception) ............. 12-27
Rapport Émission .................. 12-9
Rapport émission bulletin .... 12-31
Rapport réception
confidentielle ........................ 12-29
Réception en relève ................. 9-7
Réception en relève (RX) .......... 7-6
Réception mémoire
obligatoire ............................ 11-43
Réception PC-fax .................. 2-21
Recherche avancée ............... 3-23
Recherche LDAP ................... 3-24
Recto/Recto-verso ................ 3-14
Réglage comm. ...................... 2-16
Réglage communication ........ 3-17
Réglage E-mail ....................... 3-18
Réglage Émission/
Réception .................11-10, 11-38
Réglage fonction .................. 11-11
Réglage Initial ............11-7, 11-17
Réglage ligne ........................... 7-6
Réglage numérisation .. 2-15, 3-17
Réglage
Paramètres ligne .................... 11-9
Réglage
paramètres ligne .......... 2-7, 11-35
Réglage Rapports ....11-13, 11-68
Réglage RX fax ...........2-21, 11-56
Réglage Transfert TX ............11-49
Réinitialiser, tableau de commande
.................................................2-5
Requête d'émission en relais .7-32
Reset ........................................7-5
RX réseau fermé ...................11-46
S
Saisie de texte ........................13-6
Saisie directe ................2-15, 3-26
Sortie RX ..............................11-56
Sujet .....................................10-31
Système prioritaire (Réglages
sortie Imprimante/Fax)
...................................11-8, 11-25
T
Tableau de commande ............2-4
Texte ....................................10-31
Tonalité ...................................3-26
Type d'image original .............3-12
Type de fichier ................7-6, 7-24
U
Utilitaire/Compteur, tableau de
commande ...............................2-5
V
V34 OFF .........................7-6, 7-38
Vérif. mot de passe
RX confidentiel .....................11-53
Vérifier détails de la tâche
(Contrôle) ................................3-19
Vitre d'exposition .. 3-8, 3-9, 3-10
Z
Zone secondaire ....................2-16
Annexe 13
C250 13-15
13 Annexe
13-16 C250
Opérations Fax
x Table des matières
C351 x-3
Table des matières
1 Introduction
1.1 Avis aux utilisateurs ......................................................................... 1-4
1.1.1 Canada ........................................................................................... 1-4
1.1.2 U.S.A. ............................................................................................. 1-4
1.1.3 Nouvelle-Zélande ........................................................................... 1-7
1.1.4 Europe ............................................................................................ 1-7
1.2 Mise en route (fax) ............................................................................ 1-8
1.3 Caractéristiques du télécopieur .................................................... 1-10
1.4 Conventions utilisées dans ce manuel ......................................... 1-22
1.5 Descriptions et symboles des documents et du papier ............. 1-24
1.5.1 “Largeur” et “Longueur” .............................................................. 1-24
1.5.2 Orientation du papier ................................................................... 1-24
1.6 Documentation ............................................................................... 1-25
2 Préliminaires
2.1 Restrictions ....................................................................................... 2-3
2.2 Tableau de commande ..................................................................... 2-4
2.2.1 Tableau de commande .................................................................. 2-4
2.3 Réglages de base ............................................................................. 2-7
2.3.1 Réglages indispensables ............................................................... 2-7
2.4 Fonctions utiles ................................................................................. 2-8
2.4.1 Carnet d'adresses .......................................................................... 2-8
2.4.2 Programme .................................................................................. 2-12
2.5 Écran Fax ......................................................................................... 2-15
2.6 Authentification utilisateur et compte de service ........................ 2-17
2.6.1 Si l'authentification utilisateur est paramétrée ............................. 2-17
2.6.2 Si le compte de service est paramétré ........................................ 2-17
2.7 Réception fax dans une boîte ........................................................ 2-18
2.7.1 Types de boîtes ............................................................................ 2-19
2.7.2 Fonctionnement de la Réception PC-fax ..................................... 2-21
x-4 C351
3 Émission
3.1 Émission simple de télécopie ...........................................................3-3
3.2 Positionnement de l'original sur la machine ...................................3-7
3.2.1 Utilisation du chargeur de document (ADF) ....................................3-7
3.2.2 Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition ..................3-8
3.2.3 Envoi de plusieurs originaux à partir de la vitre d'exposition .........3-9
3.2.4 Émission d'originaux avec le chargeur ADF et la vitre
d'exposition ..................................................................................3-10
3.3 Réglage des conditions d'émission ...............................................3-11
3.3.1 Type d'image original ....................................................................3-12
3.3.2 Densité ..........................................................................................3-13
3.3.3 Recto/Recto-verso ........................................................................3-14
3.3.4 Définition .......................................................................................3-15
3.3.5 Confirmation des réglages et des résultats de la communication 3-16
3.3.6 Enregistrement dans le carnet d'adresses à partir de
l'écran Vérifier détails de la tâche .................................................3-19
3.4 Sélection de la destination .............................................................3-21
3.4.1 Sélection de la destination ............................................................3-21
3.4.2 Sélection de plusieurs destinations ..............................................3-28
3.4.3 Confirmation/Suppression d'une destination ...............................3-29
3.4.4 Rappel manuel ..............................................................................3-30
3.5 Numérisation ....................................................................................3-31
3.5.1 Lorsque la machine ne détecte pas le format d'origine ...............3-31
3.5.2 Lorsque la mémoire est saturée ...................................................3-31
3.5.3 Rotation automatique du document original ................................3-31
3.6 Lorsque l'émission ne s'effectue pas ............................................3-32
3.7 Réservation d'émission ...................................................................3-33
3.8 Émission manuelle ..........................................................................3-34
3.9 Annulation de l'émission .................................................................3-35
3.9.1 Annulation d'une communication en cours ..................................3-35
3.9.2 Annulation des tâches réservées ..................................................3-36
3.10 Confirmation de la liste de tâches .................................................3-37
3.11 Confirmation des résultats de la communication ........................3-38
C351 x-5
3.12 Émissions en mémoire et en mémoire rapide ............................. 3-41
3.12.1 Émission mémoire ........................................................................ 3-41
3.12.2 Émission en mémoire rapide ........................................................ 3-41
3.12.3 Pour émettre en mémoire rapide, procédez de la manière
suivante. ....................................................................................... 3-42
3.13 Nombre d'originaux ........................................................................ 3-44
3.14 Émission différée (TX) .................................................................... 3-47
3.15 Communications internationales .................................................. 3-50
3.16 Informations sur l'expéditeur ........................................................ 3-53
3.16.1 Réglage à l'intérieur du corps du texte ........................................ 3-53
3.16.2 Réglage à l'extérieur du corps du texte ....................................... 3-53
3.16.3 Réglage sur OFF .......................................................................... 3-54
4 Réception
4.1 Mode Réception ................................................................................ 4-3
4.1.1 Réception automatique (mode fax uniquement) ............................ 4-3
4.1.2 Réception manuelle (mode téléphone uniquement) ...................... 4-3
4.2 Réception automatique (mode fax uniquement) ........................... 4-4
4.3 Réception manuelle (mode téléphone uniquement) ..................... 4-5
4.4 Réception impossible ....................................................................... 4-6
4.5 Réception en mémoire de substitution .......................................... 4-7
4.6 Enregistrement de la réception ....................................................... 4-8
4.6.1 Enregistrement après réduction minimale ..................................... 4-8
4.6.2 Enregistrement après réduction pour convenir au papier
d'impression ................................................................................... 4-9
4.7 Informations de réception ............................................................. 4-17
5 Dépannage
5.1 Impossible d'envoyer des messages .............................................. 5-3
5.2 Impossible de recevoir des messages ........................................... 5-4
5.3 Message d'erreur affiché ................................................................. 5-6
5.4 Appeler SAV ...................................................................................... 5-7
x-6 C351
6 Caractéristiques techniques
6.1 Caractéristiques techniques ............................................................6-3
7 Applications d'émission
7.1 Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et Réglage
communication ..................................................................................7-3
7.2 Présentation des fonctions d'application .......................................7-5
7.3 Originaux mixtes ................................................................................7-7
7.4 Position reliure ...................................................................................7-9
7.5 Émission avec effacement des bords ...........................................7-12
7.6 Ajustement fond ..............................................................................7-15
7.7 Netteté ..............................................................................................7-18
7.8 Format de numérisation ..................................................................7-21
7.9 Type de fichier .................................................................................7-24
7.10 Mot de passe émission (TX) ...........................................................7-26
7.11 Communication confidentielle (Émission F-code) .......................7-29
7.12 Requête d'émission en relais (Émission F-code) .........................7-32
7.13 ECM OFF ..........................................................................................7-35
7.14 V34 OFF ............................................................................................7-38
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8.1 Utilisation d'un document reçu en réception confidentielle .........8-3
8.1.1 Utilisation d'un document reçu en réception confidentielle ...........8-3
8.1.2 Impression du document reçu dans une boîte utilisateur
confidentielle ...................................................................................8-4
8.1.3 Suppression d'un document stocké dans une boîte
utilisateur confidentielle ..................................................................8-5
8.2 Réception mémoire ...........................................................................8-6
8.2.1 Impression d'un document mémorisé ............................................8-6
8.2.2 Suppression d'un document mémorisé ..........................................8-8
8.3 Informations de réception ................................................................8-9
8.3.1 Informations sur la réception et l'impression recto-verso ..............8-9
C351 x-7
9 Relève
9.1 Émission en relève ............................................................................ 9-3
9.1.1 Émission en relève ......................................................................... 9-4
9.2 Réception en relève .......................................................................... 9-6
9.3 Bulletin ............................................................................................... 9-9
9.3.1 Écriture d'un document sur le bulletin board ............................... 9-10
9.3.2 Réception en relève d'un document placé sur le bulletin
board d'une destination (fax) ....................................................... 9-13
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10.1 Affichage de l'écran d'enregistrement du télécopieur ................ 10-3
10.2 Enregistrement du carnet d'adresses .......................................... 10-5
10.3 Enregistrement d'un groupe ........................................................ 10-19
10.4 Enregistrement d'un programme ................................................ 10-25
10.5 Enregistrement du sujet et du texte d'un e-mail ....................... 10-31
10.6 Réglage des boîtes confidentielles ............................................. 10-46
10.7 Réglage du bulletin (tableau électronique) ................................ 10-48
10.8 Réglage de la boîte utilisateur réception mémoire ................... 10-49
11 Mode Utilitaire
11.1 Écran mode Utilitaire ...................................................................... 11-3
11.1.1 Accès à l'écran Réglage Utilisateur ............................................. 11-3
11.1.2 Quitter l'écran Réglage Utilisateur ............................................... 11-4
11.1.3 Accès à l'écran Réglage Administrateur ...................................... 11-5
11.1.4 Quitter l'écran Réglage Administrateur ........................................ 11-6
11.2 Liste du mode Utilitaire fax ............................................................ 11-7
11.2.1 Écran FAX - réglage par défaut .................................................... 11-7
11.2.2 Écran Fax actif ............................................................................. 11-7
11.2.3 Réglage Initial ............................................................................... 11-7
11.2.4 Passage économie énergie (Fax) ................................................. 11-8
11.2.5 Système prioritaire (Réglages sortie Imprimante/Fax) ................. 11-8
11.2.6 Information en-tête ....................................................................... 11-8
11.2.7 Position en-tête / pied de page ................................................... 11-9
11.2.8 Réglage Paramètres ligne ............................................................ 11-9
11.2.9 Réglage Émission/Réception ..................................................... 11-10
x-8 C351
11.2.10 Réglage fonction .........................................................................11-11
11.2.11 Définir CN PBX ............................................................................11-12
11.2.12 Réglage Rapports .......................................................................11-13
11.2.13 Liste Paramètres tâche ...............................................................11-13
11.3 Écran Fax réglage par défaut .......................................................11-14
11.4 Réglage Initial ................................................................................11-17
11.5 Écran Fax actif ...............................................................................11-19
11.6 Passage économie énergie (Fax) .................................................11-22
11.7 Système prioritaire (Réglages sortie Imprimante/Fax) ..............11-25
11.8 Information en-tête .......................................................................11-28
11.9 Position en-tête/pied de page ......................................................11-31
11.10 Réglage Paramètres ligne ............................................................11-34
11.11 Réglage Émission/Réception .......................................................11-37
11.12 Réglage fonction ...........................................................................11-40
11.12.1 Réglage fonction ON/OFF ..........................................................11-40
11.12.2 Réception mémoire obligatoire ...................................................11-43
11.12.3 RX réseau fermé .........................................................................11-46
11.12.4 Réglage Transfert TX ..................................................................11-49
11.12.5 Vérification du mot de passe RX confidentiel .............................11-53
11.12.6 Réglage RX fax ...........................................................................11-56
11.12.7 Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI ...................................................11-60
11.13 Réglage CN PBX (Private Branch Exchange) .............................11-64
11.14 Réglage Rapports ..........................................................................11-66
12 Rapports et listes
12.1 Types de rapports et de listes ........................................................12-3
12.1.1 Rapports .......................................................................................12-3
12.1.2 Listes .............................................................................................12-4
12.2 Rapport d'activité ............................................................................12-5
12.2.1 Impression automatique ...............................................................12-5
12.2.2 Impression manuelle .....................................................................12-5
12.3 Rapport Émission ............................................................................12-9
12.3.1 Impression manuelle .....................................................................12-9
12.3.2 Impression automatique ...............................................................12-9
C351 x-9
12.4 Rapport d'émission (en relève) .................................................... 12-11
12.5 Rapport de relève ......................................................................... 12-13
12.6 Rapport de diffusion ..................................................................... 12-15
12.7 Rapport de relève séquentielle (réception) ................................ 12-17
12.8 Rapport de communication réservée ......................................... 12-19
12.9 Rapport d'émission réservée (relève) ......................................... 12-21
12.10 Rapport de diffusion réservée ..................................................... 12-23
12.11 Rapport de réception réservée (relève) ...................................... 12-25
12.12 Rapport de relève séquentielle réservée (réception) ................ 12-27
12.13 Rapport réception confidentielle ................................................ 12-29
12.14 Rapport Émission bulletin ............................................................ 12-31
12.15 Liste Carnet d'adresses ............................................................... 12-33
12.16 Liste d'adresses de groupe ......................................................... 12-36
12.17 Liste Programme .......................................................................... 12-39
12.18 Liste de Titres/Textes ................................................................... 12-42
12.19 Liste des réglages du fax ............................................................. 12-45
12.19.1 Liste confidentielle/bulletin ........................................................ 12-49
12.19.2 Boîte émetteur (TSI) ................................................................... 12-50
13 Annexe
13.1 Nombre de pages mémorisées ..................................................... 13-3
13.2 Saisie de texte ................................................................................. 13-4
13.3 Glossaire .......................................................................................... 13-7
13.4 Index .............................................................................................. 13-12
x-10 C351
1 Introduction
Introduction 1
C351 1-3
1 Introduction
Nous vous remercions d'avoir porté votre choix sur le photocopieur
électronique numérique Konica Minolta.
Ce manuel d'utilisation décrit les procédures d'utilisation des fonctions fax
de la machine, ainsi que les précautions à prendre. Veuillez lire ce manuel
avant de commencer à utiliser la machine.
Après avoir lu ce manuel, nous vous recommandons de le conserver à portée
de main pour pouvoir le consulter à tout moment, et assurer ainsi le
fonctionnement optimum des fonctions fax.
Pour garantir le fonctionnement correct de la machine, lisez également le
“Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie” avant de commencer.
Marques
KONICA MINOLTA, le logo KONICA MINOLTA et les unités d'image sont des
marques déposées ou commerciales de KONICA MINOLTA HOLDINGS,
INC.
PageScope et bizhub sont des marques déposées ou commerciales de
KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
Adobe, le logo Adobe, Acrobat, le logo Acrobat, PostScript et le logo
PostScript sont des marques déposées ou commerciales d'Adobe Systems,
Inc.
Les autres noms de sociétés ou de produits référencés dans ce manuel sont
les marques déposées ou commerciales de leurs détenteurs respectifs.
Copyright
© 2005 KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC. Tous droits
réservés.
Exemption
Avis relatif à la documentation
- Tout ou partie de ce manuel d'utilisateur peut être utilisé ou copié sans
autorisation.
- Les informations contenues dans ce manuel peuvent être modifiées sans
avis préalable.
1 Introduction
1-4 C351
1.1 Avis aux utilisateurs
1.1.1 Canada
NOTICE:
This product meets the applicable Industry Canada technical specifications.
The ringer equivalence number (REN) is an indication of the maximum
number of devices allowed to be connected to a telephone interface. The
termination on an interface may consist of any combination of devices
subject only to the requirement that the sum of the RENs of all the devices
does not exceed five.
AVIS :
Ce produit est conforme aux normes définies par Industrie Canada.
L'indice d'équivalence de la sonnerie (IES) sert à indiquer le nombre
maximum de terminaux qui peuvent être raccordés à une interface
téléphonique. La terminaison d'une interface peut comporter une
combinaison quelconque de dispositifs, du moment que la somme des
indices d'équivalence de la sonnerie de tous les dispositifs n'excède pas 5.
1.1.2 U.S.A.
Réglementation 68 de la FCC
Cet équipement est conforme à l'article 68 de la réglementation FCC, et aux
exigences adoptées par l'ACTA. La certification est signalée par une
étiquette apposée sur l'équipement, indiquant entre autres, l'identification
du produit au format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. Cette identification peut être
fournie à l'opérateur téléphonique, sur demande.
Cet équipement utilise la certification de la fiche USOC RJ11C.
La prise téléphonique utilisée pour brancher cet équipement sur le réseau de
câblage téléphonique doit être conforme à l'article 68 de la réglementation
FCC applicable, et aux exigences adoptées par l'ACTA.
Un cordon de téléphone et une prise enfichable compatibles sont fournis
avec ce produit. Ils doivent être connectés au jack modulaire compatible
également conforme. Pour plus d'informations, voir les instructions
d'installation.
L'indice d'équivalence de la sonnerie (IES) détermine le nombre d'appareils
pouvant être connectés à la ligne téléphonique. Un nombre excessif d'IES
sur une ligne peut provoquer l'absence de sonnerie sur un appareil en
réponse à un appel entrant. Dans la plupart des régions, le nombre d'IES ne
doit pas être supérieur à 5.
Contactez votre opérateur téléphonique local pour connaître le nombre
d'appareils pouvant être connectés à la ligne. Sur les produits approuvés
Introduction 1
C351 1-5
après le 23 juillet 2001, l'IES est indiqué sur l'étiquette d'identification du
produit au format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX où ## représente l'IES, sans point
décimal (ex : 03 est l'IES de 0.3). Sur les produits antérieurs, l'IES est indiqué
séparément sur l'étiquette.
Si cet équipement FK-502 nuit au réseau téléphonique, l'opérateur de
téléphone vous préviendra de la possibilité d'interruption provisoire du
service. Si l'avis préalable n'est pas possible, l'opérateur avisera le client
dans les plus brefs délais. Vous serez également avisé de vos droits
d'enregistrement d'une plainte auprès de la FCC, s'il y a lieu.
Les modifications apportées par l'opérateur téléphonique à ses installations,
son équipement, ses opérations ou ses procédures peut avoir des
répercussions sur le fonctionnement de l'équipement. Dans ces
circonstances, l'opérateur vous préviendra à l'avance des modifications que
vous devez apporter pour garantir le service ininterrompu.
En cas de problème avec cet équipement FK-502, et pour connaître les
informations de garantie et de réparation, contactez votre revendeur local
Konica Minolta. Si l'équipement nuit au réseau téléphonique, l'opérateur de
téléphone peut vous demander de le débrancher jusqu'à ce que le problème
soit résolu.
La connexion à un service de ligne partagée est soumise aux tarifs en vigueur
dans l'état. Contactez la commission des services publics pour obtenir plus
d'informations. Si votre domicile est équipé d'un câblage d'alarme relié à la
ligne de téléphone, assurez-vous que l'installation du FK-502 ne désactive
pas l'équipement d'alarme. Pour plus d'informations à ce sujet, contactez
votre opérateur téléphonique ou un installateur qualifié.
La réglementation pour la protection des consommateurs de téléphone
(Telephone Consumer Protection Act) de 1991 stipule qu'il est contraire à la
loi d'utiliser un ordinateur ou tout autre appareil électronique, télécopieur
compris, pour envoyer des messages, à moins que ces messages
n'indiquent clairement en haut ou en bas de la première page transmise, la
date et l'heure de l'envoi, l'identification de l'entreprise, entité ou individu
expéditeur du message, ainsi que le numéro de téléphone de la machine
expéditrice ou de ladite entreprise, entité ou individu. (Le numéro de
téléphone fourni ne doit être ni un numéro 900 ni tout autre numéro pour
lequel les frais d'expédition dépassent les frais de communication locaux,
nationaux ou internationaux.)
Pour programmer ces informations sur votre télécopieur, vous devez
exécuter la procédure détaillée à la section “Information en-tête” à la
page 11-28.
1 Introduction
1-6 C351
Symboles d'avertissement et d'attention
7 AVERTISSEMENT
Un point d'exclamation dans un triangle, suivi du terme
“Avertissement”, avertit l'utilisateur que le non-respect de cet
avertissement peut provoquer des blessures graves, voire mortelles.
% Veillez à bien observer les avertissements énumérés dans ce manuel.
7 ATTENTION
Un point d'exclamation dans un triangle, suivi du terme “Attention”,
avertit l'utilisateur que le non-respect de cette précaution peut
provoquer des blessures ou des dommages matériels.
% Veillez à bien observer les précautions énumérées dans ce manuel.
Introduction 1
C351 1-7
1.1.3 Nouvelle-Zélande
Avis
- Cet appareil est équipé de la numérotation par impulsions alors que la
norme Telecom est la Double Tonalité Multi-Fréquence (DTMF). Il n'y a
aucune garantie que les lignes Telecom continueront à prendre en
charge la numérotation par impulsions.
- L'utilisation de la numérotation par impulsions lorsque cet équipement
est relié à la même ligne que d'autres équipements, peut entraîner un son
de cloche ou du bruit, ou encore une condition de réponse erronée. Dans
ce cas, l'utilisateur ne doit pas contacter le service de dépannage
Telecom (Telecom Fault Service).
- Il est possible que cet équipement ne puisse pas transférer un appel vers
un autre appareil raccordé à la même ligne.
- Cet équipement n'est pas entièrement conforme aux exigences
d'impédance de Telecom. La performance peut être réduite lorsqu'il est
utilisé conjointement avec d'autres parties du réseau. Telecom ne saurait
être responsable des problèmes pouvant subvenir dans de telles
conditions d'utilisation.
- L'octroi d'une autorisation de téléphonie pour tout élément d'un
équipement terminal indique uniquement l'acceptation par Telecom de la
conformité de l'élément avec les conditions minimales de connexion à
son réseau. Cela n'indique pas l'approbation du produit par Telecom, et
ne fournit aucune garantie. En particulier, cela n'offre aucune garantie de
fonctionnement correct d'un élément quelconque avec un autre élément
d'un équipement d'un autre fabricant ou modèle ayant reçu une
autorisation de téléphonie, de même que cela n'implique pas qu'un
produit est compatible avec tous les services de réseau Telecom.
- Les fonctions d'appel automatique de cet équipement ne doivent pas
être utilisées de façon à produire des nuisances pour le reste de la
clientèle.
- L'équipement faisant l'objet d'une autorisation de téléphonie ne peut être
raccordé qu'au port de téléphone auxiliaire. Ce port n'est pas
spécifiquement conçu pour une connexion à trois fils, et ce type de
connexion risque de ne pas répondre à une sonnerie entrante.
1.1.4 Europe
Ce télécopieur a reçu l'agrément, conformément à la décision 1999/5/ CE du
Conseil, concernant la connexion paneuropéenne de terminal unique aux
réseaux téléphoniques publics commutés (RTPC). Toutefois, en raison des
différences entre les RTPC d'un pays à un autre, l'agrément en soi ne
constitue pas une garantie absolue de fonctionnement optimal à chaque
point de terminaison du réseau RTPC.
En cas de problème, vous devez contacter en premier lieu le fournisseur de
l'appareil.
Le label CE doit être apposé sur le produit
ou sur son étiquette de données, sur l'emballage
du produit, s'il y a lieu, et sur les
documents qui l'accompagnent.
1 Introduction
1-8 C351
1.2 Mise en route (fax)
Émission
Procédez comme suit pour envoyer un fax.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande pour passer en mode
Fax.
2 Au besoin, définissez le réglage des fonctions.
Écran Fax
Écran Réglage
numérisation
Écran
Application
Écran Réglage
communication
Introduction 1
C351 1-9
3 Tapez le numéro de fax de la
destination sur le clavier.
– Si vous faites une faute de frappe,
appuyez sur [Eff.] pour effacer les
chiffres un par un.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour effacer
tout le numéro.
4 Placez l'original sur la machine.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Positionnement de l'original sur la
machine” à la page 3-7.
5 Appuyez sur [Départ] sur le tableau de
commande.
1 Introduction
1-10 C351
1.3 Caractéristiques du télécopieur
Impression du nombre total de pages sur le fax
En mode Mémoire rapide, vous pouvez placer le nombre total de pages sur
chaque page du fax. Cette possibilité est utile au destinataire, qui peut
vérifier s'il a bien reçu toutes les pages.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Nombre d'originaux” à la page 3-44.
Émission différée d'un fax
Vous pouvez préciser l'heure à laquelle le fax devra être envoyé : la nuit ou
tôt le matin, par exemple, pour profiter des heures creuses.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Émission différée (TX)” à la page 3-47.
De : 01234567890123456 2004 /12 /31 23:59 P.005 / 010
Introduction 1
C351 1-11
Émission dès qu'une page est lue. (Mémoire rapide)
Avec cette méthode, l'émission du fax commence dès qu'une page de
l'original a été numérisée.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Émissions en mémoire et en mémoire
rapide” à la page 3-41.
Envoi de fax à l'étranger
Vous pouvez sélectionner une vitesse de transmission moindre lorsque vous
envoyez un fax dans un pays où les conditions de communication ne sont
pas bonnes.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Communications internationales” à la
page 3-50.
1 Introduction
1-12 C351
Émission avec effacement des bords
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax après effacement des bandes noires
reproduites lors de la numérisation d'un document relié. Vous pouvez
également définir la largeur de la bordure à effacer.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Émission avec effacement des bords” à la
page 7-12.
Largeur à
effacer
Émission standard Émission avec effacement des bords
Introduction 1
C351 1-13
Émission d'un fax en mode format d'origine
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax en précisant le format de papier du document.
Cette fonction est utile pour n'envoyer qu'une partie de l'original.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Format de numérisation” à la page 7-21.
1 Introduction
1-14 C351
Envoi de pages de différents formats en une seule opération.
Vous pouvez envoyer des pages de différents formats parce que le
télécopieur reconnaît chacun des formats et les traite en conséquence
lorsque la fonction Originaux mixtes est activée.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Originaux mixtes” à la page 7-7.
Émission et reproduction dans
le même format que l'original à
la destination.
Vous placez les originaux
mixtes dans le chargeur RADF.
Introduction 1
C351 1-15
Spécification du style de reliure d'un document recto/verso
Vous pouvez préciser le style de reliure approprié (Gauche/Droite ou Haut/
Bas) lors l'émission d'un document recto/verso. Ainsi, les pages du
document sont lues dans le bon ordre.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Position reliure” à la page 7-9.
Envoi d'un fax à la réception d'une commande de relève du destinataire
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax, qui a été lu et stocké sur le disque dur du
télécopieur, lorsque le destinataire envoie une commande de relève.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réception en relève” à la page 9-6.
Reliure Gauche/Droite
Reliure Haut/Bas
Fax de destination
Émission
1 Introduction
1-16 C351
Envoi d'un fax avec la fonction ECM OFF
Vous pouvez désactiver la fonction de correction d'erreur (ECM) pour réduire
le temps d'émission.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “ECM OFF” à la page 7-35.
Document à relever
Vous pouvez placer les documents à relever sur le bulletin board (tableau
électronique) du disque dur pour l'émission ou la réception en relève.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Bulletin” à la page 9-9.
Émission d'un fax avec le mode Super G3 désactivé
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax après désactivation du mode Super G3 si le
protocole V.34 n'est pas disponible en raison de restrictions sur le PBX.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “V34 OFF” à la page 7-38.
Introduction 1
C351 1-17
Fax relayé
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax à une destination via une station de relais
intermédiaire.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Requête d'émission en relais (Émission Fcode)”
à la page 7-32.
Cette machine ne peut pas fonctionner en tant que relais.
Station d'origine Station relais intermédiaire
Station distante
Appel international Station distante Appel local
1 Introduction
1-18 C351
Utilisation d'une boîte confidentielle
Vous pouvez utiliser une boîte confidentielle (similaire à une boîte de
réception personnalisée) pour échanger des informations confidentielles
avec certaines personnes.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Communication confidentielle (Émission
F-code)” à la page 7-29.
Envoi d'un fax protégé par un mot de passe
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax protégé par un mot de passe si le récepteur
fonctionne en réseau fermé.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Mot de passe émission (TX)” à la
page 7-26.
Expéditeur Boîte de documents Récepteur
confidentiels
Introduction 1
C351 1-19
Ajustement de la densité de la couleur de fond
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax après ajustement de la couleur de fond de
l'original.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Ajustement fond” à la page 7-15.
Ajustement de la netteté du contour des caractères
Vous pouvez envoyer un fax après ajustement de la netteté du contour des
caractères pour améliorer la qualité de l'impression.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Netteté” à la page 7-18.
1 Introduction
1-20 C351
Envoi d'un e-mail à partir de l'écran Fax
Un original numérisé peut être envoyé en tant qu'e-mail de l'écran Fax à un
ordinateur.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Saisie directe” à la page 3-26.
Sauvegarde dans une boîte
Un original numérisé peut être sauvegardé dans une boîte créée sur le
disque dur interne.
Serveur de
messagerie
E-mail
Disque dur
Boîte
Introduction 1
C351 1-21
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réception fax dans une boîte” à la
page 2-18.
1 Introduction
1-22 C351
1.4 Conventions utilisées dans ce manuel
Cette section décrit les symboles et polices utilisés dans ce manuel.
Conseils de sécurité
6 DANGER
Le non-respect des instructions signalées de cette manière peut
entraîner des blessures graves, voire mortelles liées à la puissance
électrique.
% Observez ces instructions à la lettre pour éviter tout risque de
blessures.
7 AVERTISSEMENT
Le non-respect des instructions signalées de cette manière peut
entraîner des blessures graves ou endommager le matériel.
% Observez ces instructions à la lettre pour prévenir tout risque de
blessures et garantir le fonctionnement sécurisé de la machine.
7 ATTENTION
Le non-respect des instructions signalées de cette manière peut
entraîner des blessures légère ou endommager l'installation.
% Observez ces instructions à la lettre pour prévenir tout risque de
blessures et garantir le fonctionnement sécurisé de la machine.
Séquence d'une procédure
1 Le numéro 1, tel que formaté ici,
indique la première étape d'une
procédure.
2 Les numéros suivants, tels que
formatés ici, indiquent les étapes
suivantes d'une procédure.
? Le texte formaté dans ce style
fournit des informations
complémentaires.
% Le texte formaté dans ce style décrit les actions qui garantiront
l'obtention des résultats voulus.
Une illustration insérée
ici montre les opérations à
effectuer.
Introduction 1
C351 1-23
Conseils
2
Remarque
Les remarques fournissent des informations utiles et des conseils
d'utilisation sécurisée de la machine.
2
Rappel
Les rappels signalent des informations importantes qu'il convient de ne
pas oublier.
!
Détail
Les Détails réfèrent à des sections ou à des documents fournissant des
informations plus détaillées.
Conventions typographiques
Touche [Arrêt]
Le nom des touches du tableau de commande est indiqué dans cette police,
entre crochets.
REGLAGE MACHINE
Signale les termes affichés à l'écran.
1 Introduction
1-24 C351
1.5 Descriptions et symboles des documents et du papier
Les termes et symboles utilisés dans ce manuel sont expliqués ci-dessous.
1.5.1 “Largeur” et “Longueur”
Chaque fois que des dimensions de papier
sont mentionnées dans ce manuel, la
première valeur se réfère à la largeur du
papier (illustrée ci-contre par un “Y”) et la
seconde valeur à la longueur (illustrée cicontre
par un “X”).
1.5.2 Orientation du papier
Portrait (w)
Si la largeur (Y) du papier est plus courte que
la longueur (X) du papier, il a une orientation
verticale ou portrait, signalée par w.
Paysage (v)
Si la largeur (Y) du papier est plus longue que
la longueur (X) du papier, il a une orientation
horizontale ou paysage, signalée par v.
Introduction 1
C351 1-25
1.6 Documentation
Les manuels d'utilisation suivants ont été préparés pour cette machine.
Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie
Ce manuel décrit le fonctionnement de base de la machine, ainsi que les
procédures des fonctions de copie.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures détaillées des
fonctions de copie, notamment les précautions d'installation et
d'utilisation, la mise sous/hors tension de la machine, le chargement du
papier, et les opérations de dépannage, dans le cas d'un bourrage papier
par exemple.
Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Scanner réseau
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures de configuration du réseau
(équipement standard) et d'utilisation des fonctions de numérisation.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures détaillées des
fonctions de réseau, et d'utilisation de la numérisation vers un e-mail,
vers FTP et vers un PC (SMB).
Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures d'utilisation des boîtes.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures d'utilisation des
boîtes stockées sur le disque dur.
User utilities CD
Manuel d'utilisation - Opérations Impression
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures d'utilisation du contrôleur
d'impression standard intégré.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures d'utilisation des
fonctions d'impression.
Post Script CD
PageScope utility CD
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures d'impression.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures d'utilisation des
fonctions d'impression.
Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations fax (ce manuel)
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures d'utilisation du fax.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures d'utilisation des
fonctions fax si le kit de fax est installé.
1 Introduction
1-26 C351
Manuel d'utilisation – Zoom Écran
Ce manuel décrit en détail les procédures d'utilisation des fonctions de copie
en mode d'affichage étendu.
- Consultez ce manuel pour connaître les procédures d'utilisation du mode
d'affichage étendu.
2 Préliminaires
Préliminaires 2
C351 2-3
2 Préliminaires
2.1 Restrictions
2
Remarque
L'émission et la réception de fax couleur ne sont pas disponibles sur ce
télécopieur.
Ce télécopieur peut être raccordé aux lignes téléphoniques suivantes.
- Lignes locales (réseaux de communication fax compris)
- PBX (standard privé avec commutateur à 2 fils)
Tenir compte des points suivants en ce qui concerne la ligne téléphonique.
- Un poste téléphonique d'affaires ne peut pas être connecté en tant que
ligne extérieure.
- Si les liaisons privées numériques sont multiplexées sur le réseau
d'entreprise, les communications fax peuvent être soumises aux
restrictions suivantes.
– La vitesse de transmission est réduite.
– La communication via Super G3 n'est pas disponible.
Les réglages définis en usine peuvent parfois générer des erreurs de
communication dues au multiplexage qui limite au maximum la bande
disponible pour la ligne, sur l'hypothèse d'une utilisation vocale.
Ces restrictions dépendent toutefois du matériel de réseau. Pour plus
d'informations sur le réseau utilisé, contactez l'administrateur.
2
Rappel
L'appui répété sur l'interrupteur Marche/Arrêt peut entraîner un dysfonctionnement
de la machine.
Attendez au moins 5 secondes après avoir éteint la machine avant de la
rallumer.
2 Préliminaires
2-4 C351
2.2 Tableau de commande
2.2.1 Tableau de commande
1 2 3 5
8
9
11
12
24
10
21 2019 18 17 1514 13
22
23
16
4 6 7
No. Nom Description
1 [Eco énergie] Appuyez sur cette touche pour passer en mode Économie
d'énergie. Sous ce mode, le voyant de la touche [Eco
énergie] est vert et l'écran tactile s'éteint. Pour annuler ce
mode, réappuyez sur la touche [Eco énergie].
2 Écran tactile Affiche divers écrans et messages.
Réglez les fonctions en touchant l'écran.
3 [Code] Si l'authentification utilisateur ou le compte de service a été
activé, appuyez sur cette touche après avoir entré le nom
utilisateur et le mot de passe (pour l'authentification
utilisateur) ou le nom du compte et le mot de passe (pour le
compte de service), pour utiliser la machine.
4 [Boîte] Appuyez sur cette touche pour passer en mode Boîte. Sous
ce mode, le voyant de la touche [Boîte] est vert. Pour plus
d'informations, voir "Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte".
5 [Fax] Appuyez sur cette touche pour passer en mode Fax. Sous
ce mode, le voyant de la touche [Fax] est vert.
6 [Numérisation] Appuyez sur cette touche pour passer en mode Numérisation.
Sous ce mode, le voyant de la touche [Numérisation]
est vert. Pour plus d'informations, voir "Manuel d'utilisation
– Opérations Scanner réseau".
7 [Copie] Appuyez sur cette touche pour passer en mode Copie.
Sous ce mode, le voyant de la touche [Copie] est vert. Pour
plus d'informations, voir "Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations
Copie".
Préliminaires 2
C351 2-5
8 [Réinitialiser] Appuyez sur cette touche pour remettre à zéro tous les
réglages (à l'exception des réglages programmés) entrés
sur le tableau de commande et l'écran tactile.
9 [Interruption] L'écran Copie s'affiche après la numérisation de
documents originaux, puis la machine passe en mode
Interruption. Sous ce mode, le voyant de la touche
[Interruption] est vert et le message “Mode interruption en
cours” s'affiche sur l'écran tactile. Pour annuler le mode
Interruption, réappuyez sur la touche [Interruption].
10 [INTERRUPTEUR] Appuyez sur cet interrupteur Marche/Arrêt pour allumer/
éteindre la machine. Lorsque la machine est éteinte, elle
passe en veille (conservation d'énergie).
11 [Arrêt] Cette option n'est pas utilisée en mode Fax.
12 [Départ] Appuyez sur cette touche pour démarrer l'opération
sélectionnée en mode Boîte, Fax, Numérisation ou Copie.
En mode Fax, appuyez sur cette touche pour démarrer la
transmission.
Lorsque la machine est prête, le voyant de la touche [Départ]
est vert. Lorsque le voyant de la touche [Départ] est
orange, l'opération ne peut pas commencer.
Appuyez sur cette touche pour redémarrer une tâche
interrompue. Pour plus d'informations sur une tâche
interrompue, voir "Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie".
13 Voyant [Alimentation] Lorsque la machine est mise sous tension avec le bouton
[Alimentation], le voyant est vert.
14 Voyant [Données] Clignote en vert pendant la réception d'une tâche
d'impression. S'allume en vert pendant l'impression de
données.
15 [Epreuve] Cette touche n'est pas utilisée en mode Fax.
16 Clavier Utilisez ce clavier pour taper le numéro ou enregistrer le
numéro et les données d'un fax.
Utilisez ce clavier pour saisir le nombre de copies, le taux
d'agrandissement et d'autres réglages.
17 [C] ( de “clear” - effacer) Appuyez sur cette touche pour effacer une valeur (un
numéro de fax, un nombre de copies, un taux
d'agrandissement, un format, etc.) saisie au clavier.
18 [Contrôle] Appuyez sur cette touche pour vérifier les réglages.
19 [Utilitaire/Compteur] Appuyez sur cette touche pour afficher l'écran Utilitaire,
dans le cas d'une opération utilitaire ou pour confirmer le
nombre de copies, la communication fax ou la
numérisation, par exemple.
20 [Programmes] Cette touche n'est pas utilisée en mode Fax.
21 Contraste Utilisez cette touche pour ajuster le contraste sur l'écran
tactile.
22 [Zoom Ecran] Cette touche n'est pas utilisée en mode Fax.
23 [Accessibilité] Appuyez sur cette touche pour afficher l'écran de réglage
des fonctions d'accessibilité utilisateur.
No. Nom Description
2 Préliminaires
2-6 C351
2
Rappel
Ne pas appuyer trop fort sur l'écran tactile; cela risquerait de l'érafler ou
de l'endommager.
Ne jamais exercer de forte pression sur l'écran tactile, et ne jamais
sélectionner une option de cet écran avec un objet dur ou pointu.
Lorsque l'écran d'appel du service après-vente s'affiche et qu'il est
impossible de poursuivre les opérations de copie, un dysfonctionnement
s'est produit. Prendre note du code d'erreur, débrancher immédiatement
la machine, puis contacter le service après-vente.
24 [Aide] Appuyez sur cette touche pour afficher l'écran d'aide
principal et accéder aux descriptions des fonctions et du
fonctionnement. Pour plus d'informations, voir "Manuel
d'utilisation – Opérations Copie".
No. Nom Description
Préliminaires 2
C351 2-7
2.3 Réglages de base
2.3.1 Réglages indispensables
Une fois la machine installée, vous devez procéder aux réglages suivants
avant d'utiliser les fonctions de télécopie. La communication fax est bloquée
tant que ces réglages ne sont pas définis correctement.
- Information en-tête
– Enregistre le numéro et le nom du fax.
- Réglage Paramètres ligne
– Définit la ligne téléphonique et la méthode de réception utilisées.
Information en-tête
Réglez les options suivantes.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Information en-tête” à la page 11-28.
Réglage Paramètres ligne
Réglez les options suivantes.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage Paramètres ligne” à la
page 11-34.
Option Description
Nom expéditeur Définit le nom de cette machine. Ce nom de 30 caractères
maximum peut comporter tout caractère alphanumérique et tout
signe.
Nº de fax expéditeur Définit le numéro de fax de cette machine. Ce numéro de 20
caractères maximum peut comporter tout chiffre de 0 à 9, le signe
+, des espaces, le signe * et le signe #.
Option Description
Méthode de numérotation Sélectionnez le mode de numérotation à fréquences vocales
(DTMF) ou à impulsions (décimale).
Mode réception Choisissez entre la réception automatique ou manuelle.
Sélectionnez “Récept. auto” pour la réception automatique.
Sélectionnez “Réception manuelle” si vous recevez fréquemment
des appels sur un combiné externe connecté à la machine.
2 Préliminaires
2-8 C351
2.4 Fonctions utiles
Si le programme et le carnet d'adresses ont été enregistrés, il suffit
d'appuyer sur [Programme] ou [Carnet d'adresses] pour appeler un numéro
ou exécuter un programme enregistré.
2.4.1 Carnet d'adresses
En enregistrant dans le [Carnet d'adresses] une destination à laquelle vous
transmettez régulièrement , il suffit ensuite d'appuyer sur [Carnet d'adresses]
pour afficher et appeler cette destination.
!
Détail
Si le nom et son caractère de recherche sont enregistrés dans le carnet
d'adresses, vous pouvez spécifier une adresse par son caractère de
recherche.
Carnet d'adresses
Cette section décrit les procédures de réglage du numéro de fax, du nom de
la destination et du caractère de recherche d'une destination abrégée.
1 Appuyez sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de commande pour
ouvrir l'écran Utilitaire, si ce n'est pas déjà fait.
– Vous pouvez enregistrer jusqu'à 2 000 (001 à 2000) adresses dans
le carnet d'adresses, y compris dans les carnets d'adresses
d'autres fonctions de la machine.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les informations enregistrées dans la liste
de numéros abrégés.
2 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez sélectionner une fonction en tapant
son numéro au clavier.
Pour [Enregistrement 1-touche], tapez 1 au clavier.
Préliminaires 2
C351 2-9
3 Appuyez sur [Fax].
4 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
5 Appuyez sur la destination à enregistrer.
– Les éléments que vous pouvez enregistrer dans le carnet
d'adresses sont les suivants.
– [No. abrégé] :
Pour enregistrer un numéro de fax.
– [E-mail] :
Pour enregistrer une adresse e-mail. Cette machine peut spécifier
une adresse e-mail en tant que destination fax.
– Cette fonction est utile pour transmettre une image à une adresse
e-mail en même temps qu'une émission fax.
– [Boîte utilisateur] :
Pour enregistrer un nom de boîte. Cette machine peut spécifier une
boîte sur le disque dur interne en tant que destination fax.
– Cette fonction est utile pour sauvegarder une image dans une boîte
en même temps qu'une émission fax.
2 Préliminaires
2-10 C351
– Si le numéro abrégé est déjà enregistré, vous pouvez appuyer sur
[Modif.] sur cet écran pour modifier le contenu de la liste. Pour plus
d'informations, voir “Enregistrement d'une adresse e-mail dans le
carnet d'adresses” à la page 10-9.
6 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
7 Appuyez sur [Nom], saisissez le nom à enregistrer, puis appuyez sur
[OK].
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
8 Saisissez la destination.
– Si vous avez sélectionné [No. abrégé] à l'étape 5. Tapez sur le
clavier le numéro de fax de la destination.
– Si vous avez sélectionné [E-mail] à l'étape 5. Appuyez sur [Adresse
E-mail] et saisissez l'adresse e-mail.
– Si vous avez sélectionné [Boîte utilisateur] à l'étape 5. Appuyez sur
[Nom boîte ut.] et sélectionnez la boîte.
– Les numéros peuvent comporter 38 caractères maximum.
– Un numéro disponible est affiché par défaut dans le champ [No.].
– Pour corriger une faute de frappe, utilisez [Suppri.] ou [C] (clear).
– Pour pouvoir sélectionner une boîte, celle-ci doit avoir été
préalablement enregistrée.
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement des boîtes, voir
“Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte”.
9 Appuyez sur [Index] pour saisir les caractères de recherche, puis sur
[OK].
– Appuyez sur la touche à enregistrer comme caractère de recherche
parmi les touches [ABC] à [etc].
Préliminaires 2
C351 2-11
10 Appuyez sur [Réglage ligne], le cas échéant, pour sélectionner
[Communications internationales], [ECM OFF] ou [V34 OFF], puis
appuyez sur [OK].
– Si vous avez sélectionné [E-mail] ou [Boîte utilisateur] à l'étape 5,
[Réglage ligne] n'apparaît pas.
11 Appuyez sur [OK].
La destination est enregistrée et apparaît dans la liste.
Pour enregistrer une autre destination dans le carnet d'adresses,
passez à l'étape 6.
12 Appuyez sur [Quitt.].
2 Préliminaires
2-12 C351
2.4.2 Programme
En enregistrant dans un [Programme] la destination et les fonctions de
communication, il suffit d'appuyer sur [Programme] pour récupérer ces
informations.
!
Détail
Vous pouvez enregistrer le Réglage numérisation et le Réglage
communication. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Enregistrement d'un
programme” à la page 10-25.
Programme
Cette section décrit les procédures d'enregistrement d'un nom et d'une
destination dans un [Programme].
1 Appuyez sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de commande pour
ouvrir l'écran Utilitaire, si ce n'est pas déjà fait.
– Vous pouvez enregistrer 400 (001 à 400) programmes maximum.
2 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Enregistrement 1-
touche], tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Fax].
4 Appuyez sur [Programme].
Préliminaires 2
C351 2-13
5 Sélectionnez le numéro de programme à enregistrer et appuyez sur
[Modif.].
6 Appuyez sur [Nom], saisissez le nom du programme, puis appuyez sur
[OK].
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
2 Préliminaires
2-14 C351
7 Appuyez sur [Dest.] pour sélectionner la destination.
– Pour enregistrer une destination déjà enregistrée, sélectionnez
[Sélection dans Carnet d'adresses] pour la saisir dans [No. abrégé],
[Boîte utilisateur], [Groupe] ou [E-Mail], puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour saisir un numéro de fax, appuyez sur [Saisie directe], entrez
une destination en sélectionnant No. abrégé, Boîte utilisateur ou EMail,
puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour corriger une faute de frappe, utilisez [Suppri.] ou [C] (clear).
– Pour pouvoir sélectionner une boîte, celle-ci doit avoir été
préalablement enregistrée.
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement des boîtes, voir
“Manuel d’utilisation – Opérations Boîte”.
8 Appuyez sur [Fermer], puis sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement du programme, appuyez sur [Annul.].
La liste de programmes s'affiche.
Pour enregistrer un autre programme, passez à l'étape 5.
9 Appuyez sur [Quitt.].
Préliminaires 2
C351 2-15
2.5 Écran Fax
L'écran Fax s'affiche lorsque vous appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de
commande. Cet écran comprend [Programme], [Groupe], [Carnet
d'adresses] ou [Saisie directe].
1 2 3 4 5
678
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
No. Nom Description
1 Liste tâches Affiche la liste des tâches en file d'attente, l'historique
des tâches et les erreurs.
2 Programme Affiche l'écran de sélection d'un programme.
3 Groupe Affiche l'écran de sélection d'un groupe.
4 Carnet d'adresses Affiche l'écran de sélection d'un carnet d'adresses.
5 Saisie directe Affiche l'écran de numérotation à l'aide de symboles
spéciaux tels que Tonalité et Pause. Appuyez sur
[Numérisation vers E-Mail] pour afficher le clavier de
saisie de l'adresse e-mail.
6 No. de destinat. Le nombre de destinations de l'émission s'affiche.
7 Mémoire La mémoire disponible s'affiche.
8 Décrocher Appuyez sur cette touche pour émettre/recevoir un fax
manuellement. Vous entendez ainsi les signaux sur la
ligne.
9 Nom dest. Vous pouvez basculer entre l'affichage du nom ou du
numéro de téléphone de la destination.
10 Indicateur de page Affiche le numéro de page de la liste de destinations
programmées.
11 Liste pages Permet de préciser le numéro de page de la liste de
destinations programmées.
12 Réglage numéris. Affiche un menu dans lequel est réglée la méthode de
lecture de l'original, telle que type d'image originale,
définition ou application.
2 Préliminaires
2-16 C351
13 Réglage comm. Affiche un menu dans lequel est réglée la méthode de
communication, telle que Émission différée ou
Réception en relève.
14 Indicateur de destination Affiche la destination.
15 Zone secondaire Affiche la description des opérations réglées dans la
partie droite de l'écran. Dans le cas du fax, affiche
chaque fonction et les destinations de diffusion.
No. Nom Description
Préliminaires 2
C351 2-17
2.6 Authentification utilisateur et compte de service
L'utilisation de cette machine peut être liée à la saisie d'un nom d'utilisateur,
d'un nom de service et d'un mot de passe. Dans ce cas, vous devez entrer
ces informations pour accéder à l'écran d'utilisation. Pour connaître les
noms d'utilisateur et de service appropriés, contactez l'administrateur.
2.6.1 Si l'authentification utilisateur est paramétrée
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur l'authentification utilisateur et le compte de
service, voir “Manuel d'utilisation - Opérations Copie”.
2.6.2 Si le compte de service est paramétré
2 Préliminaires
2-18 C351
2.7 Réception fax dans une boîte
Si vous utilisez la fonction Réception PC-Fax et les fonctions Réception
mémoire de cette machine, vous pouvez sauvegarder le document reçu
dans une boîte du disque dur, en attendant une impression ultérieure.
D'autre part, un document confidentiel reçu est automatiquement
sauvegardé dans la boîte utilisateur confidentielle sur le disque dur.
Les documents sauvegardés dans une boîte peuvent être imprimés sur cette
machine ou exportés sur un ordinateur du réseau. Cette section présente les
principes de la réception d'un fax dans une boîte.
- Pour connaître la procédure de création d'une boîte et de téléchargement
des documents reçus dans cette boîte via la fonction Réception PC-Fax,
voir “Manuel d’utilisation – Opérations Boîte".
- Si une boîte de cette machine est spécifiée en tant que destination lors
de l'émission d'un fax, les documents lus peuvent y être sauvegardés.
Expéditeur Original
Disque dur
Préliminaires 2
C351 2-19
2.7.1 Types de boîtes
Une boîte publique et une boîte système sont fournies sur le disque dur de
cette machine.
- Dans la boîte publique, une boîte spécifiée (no. 1 à 999999999) est
fournie.
- Quatre types de boîtes sont disponibles dans la boîte système : boîte
bulletin board, boîte d'émission en relève, boîte de réception mémoire et
boîte d'impression sécurisée.
Sur cette machine, ces boîtes permettent d'utiliser les fonctions énumérées
dans le tableau suivant.
Nom de la boîte Fonction
Boîte publique
Boîte spécifiée (boîte
publique / boîte
personnelle : no. 1 à
99999999)
La boîte publique spécifiée équivaut à la boîte
confidentielle si la Réception confidentielle est
active (ON).
Si la boîte spécifiée est sélectionnée comme
emplacement de stockage des documents reçus
dans la fonction Réception PC-fax, et si la boîte
utilisateur TSI est sélectionnée, les documents
reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte
correspondante.
Avec la fonction Réception PC-fax :
Les documents sont sauvegardés dans la boîte
précisée dans l'adresse secondaire par
l'expéditeur.
Avec la fonction Réception TSI :
Les documents sont sauvegardés dans la boîte
dont le numéro correspond à celui de la boîte
utilisateur TSI.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Fonctionnement de la Réception PCfax”
à la page 2-21.
2 Préliminaires
2-20 C351
Boîte
système
Boîte bulletin board Boîte d'enregistrement des documents à consulter.
Les documents enregistrés dans la boîte bulletin
board peuvent être émis en relève conformément
aux instructions de relève du correspondant.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Bulletin” à
la page 9-9.
Boîte d'émission en
relève
Les originaux lus puis émis en relève sont
sauvegardés dans cette boîte.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Émission
en relève” à la page 9-4.
Boîte utilisateur
Réception mémoire
Lorsque la Réception mémoire est active (ON), les
documents reçus sont sauvegardés dans cette
boîte, sans impression.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réception
mémoire” à la page 8-6.
Si la boîte fixe est sélectionnée comme emplacement
de stockage des documents reçus dans la
fonction Réception PC-fax, les documents reçus
sont sauvegardés dans cette boîte.
!
Détails
Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Fonctionnement de la Réception PCfax”
à la page 2-21.
Boîte d'impression
sécurisée
Cette boîte est utilisée si l'impression confidentielle
est sélectionnée dans le contrôleur d'impression.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur la boîte
d'impression sécurisée, voir “Manuel
d’utilisation – Opérations d’impression".
Nom de la boîte Fonction
Préliminaires 2
C351 2-21
2.7.2 Fonctionnement de la Réception PC-fax
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage RX fax” à la page 11-56.
Si la Réception PC-fax ou le Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI est sélectionné,
les documents reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte fixe (0) ou la boîte
publique (1 à 999999999) sur le disque dur.
La boîte d'enregistrement des documents reçus est spécifiée dans [Réglage
RX fax] du mode Utilitaire. Le tableau suivant explique la relation entre le
[Réglage RX fax] et la méthode de réception.
[Réglage RX fax] du
mode Utilitaire
Méthode de réception
Réglage RX fax : OFF Les documents reçus sont imprimés immédiatement, sans
sauvegarde dans la boîte.
Dans les circonstances suivantes, les documents reçus sont
cependant sauvegardés dans la boîte.
• Avec la Réception confidentielle
(Si l'adresse secondaire dans la fonction F-code représente un
numéro de boîte utilisateur confidentielle) :
Les documents confidentiels reçus sont sauvegardés dans la
boîte confidentielle, quel que soit le réglage de la fonction
Réception PC-fax.
• Si le Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI est sélectionné, les documents
reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte définie par ce paramètre.
• Avec la Réception mémoire active (ON) :
S'ils ne correspondent pas au cas 1. ou 2. ci-dessus, les documents
reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte Réception mémoire.
Réglage RX fax : ON
Sortie RX : boîte fixe
Les documents reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte Réception
mémoire.
Dans les circonstances suivantes, les documents reçus sont
cependant sauvegardés dans une autre boîte.
• Avec la Réception confidentielle
(Si l'adresse secondaire dans la fonction F-code représente un
numéro de boîte utilisateur confidentielle) :
Les documents reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte
confidentielle, quel que soit le réglage de la fonction Réception
PC-fax. Si l'adresse secondaire ne correspond pas au numéro de
la boîte confidentielle, la machine génère une erreur de
communication.
2 Préliminaires
2-22 C351
Réglage RX fax : ON
Sortie RX : boîte
spécifiée
Les documents reçus sont sauvegardés dans la boîte spécifiée (1 à
999999999) dont le numéro est indiqué dans l'adresse secondaire.
Dans les circonstances suivantes, les documents reçus sont
cependant sauvegardés dans une autre boîte.
• Si l'adresse secondaire n'est pas précisée, les documents reçus
sont sauvegardés dans la boîte Réception mémoire.
• S'il n'existe pas de boîte spécifiée, voir le réglage de [Erreur saisie
no. boîte] en mode Utilitaire.
• Avec la Réception confidentielle (Si l'adresse secondaire dans la
fonction F-code représente un numéro de boîte utilisateur
confidentielle) :
Les documents confidentiels reçus sont sauvegardés dans la
boîte confidentielle, quel que soit le réglage de la fonction
Réception PC-fax. Si l'adresse secondaire ne correspond pas au
numéro de la boîte confidentielle, voir le réglage de [Erreur saisie
no. boîte] dans le mode Utilitaire.
[Réglage RX fax] du
mode Utilitaire
Méthode de réception
3 Émission
Émission 3
C351 3-3
3 Émission
3.1 Émission simple de télécopie
Émission simple de télécopie
La procédure d'émission de base d'une télécopie est décrite ci-dessous.
L'émission ou la réception d'un fax couleur n'est pas disponible. Pour
envoyer un e-mail en couleur, utilisez la fonction de numérisation. pour plus
d'informations sur cette fonction, voir “Manuel d’utilisation – Opérations
Scanner réseau”.
Cette procédure décrit l'émission d'un simple document recto, mais les
fonctions disponibles à chaque étape de la procédure sont également
présentées pour faciliter l'envoi de tous types de télécopies. Pour plus de
détails sur ces fonctions, voir “Applications d'émission” à la page 7-3.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande pour ouvrir l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.] pour régler la fonction de
numérisation, puis appuyez sur [OK].
3 Émission
3-4 C351
– L'écran Fax est réglé comme suit en usine.
– Type d'image original Texte
– Densité Standard
– Recto/Recto-Verso Recto
– Définition Standard
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission”
à la page 3-11.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Ouverture des écrans Réglage
numérisation et Réglage communication” à la page 7-3.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] pour paramétrer la fonction, puis
appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Applications d'émission” à la
page 7-3.
Émission 3
C351 3-5
4 Sélectionnez la destination.
– Le réglage de la destination s'effectue comme suit.
– Clavier
– Programme
– Groupe
– Carnet d'adresses
– Saisie directe
– L'enregistrement préalable du numéro du fax de destination avec
un numéro abrégé ou programmé simplifie la sélection de la
destination.
– Pour annuler une destination sélectionnée, sélectionnez-la à
nouveau.
– Appuyez sur [Reset] pour effacer l'ensemble de la saisie.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Enregistrement du carnet
d'adresses” à la page 10-5 et “Enregistrement d'un programme” à
la page 10-25.
– Lorsque [Saisie manuelle destination] dans [Réglage sécurité] du
mode Utilitaire est réglé sur [Interdit], [Saisie directe] n'apparaît pas.
Pour connaître le réglage de [Saisie manuelle destination],
contactez l'administrateur.
Le numéro de fax saisi s'affiche dans Destinations de diffusion.
5 Positionnez l'original sur la machine.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Positionnement de l'original sur la
machine” à la page 3-7.
3 Émission
3-6 C351
6 Appuyez sur [Départ].
– La machine procède à la numérisation de l'original et la
transmission commence.
– L'écran suivant apparaît si l'écran de vérification du rapport des
résultats émission (TX) a été programmé à cet effet. Pour imprimer
le rapport d'émission, appuyez sur [Oui].
– Pour interrompre l'émission, appuyez sur [Arrêt].
– Si l'émission ne s'effectue pas, voir page 5-3.
– En cas d'échec l'émission, le rapport d'émission est
automatiquement imprimé (s'il est paramétré à cet effet). Pour plus
d'informations sur le réglage du rapport, voir “Réglage Rapports” à
la page 11-66.
– Pour plus d'informations sur le rapport d'émission (TX), voir
“Rapport Émission” à la page 12-9.
Émission 3
C351 3-7
3.2 Positionnement de l'original sur la machine
Vous pouvez utiliser le chargeur de document (ADF) ou la vitre d'exposition
pour numériser les originaux. Lorsque vous placez un original dans le
chargeur, il est automatiquement acheminé et numérisé.
3.2.1 Utilisation du chargeur de document (ADF)
Outre la numérisation automatique de plusieurs originaux, le chargeur de
document permet d'envoyer des originaux recto/verso.
Utilisation du chargeur de document (ADF)
1 Rabattez le chargeur de document.
2 Alignez les originaux en commençant par la première page.
3 Placez les originaux dans le chargeur de document en orientant la face
à numériser vers le haut.
– Pour imprimer correctement les informations d'en-tête (nom/
numéro de fax de l'expéditeur), insérez le bord de l'original dans le
chargeur.
4 Réglez les guides du papier.
– En mode d'originaux mixtes,
ajustez les guides du papier sur le
format de la plus grande feuille, et
alignez le reste des originaux dans
le coin supérieur gauche du
chargeur.
3 Émission
3-8 C351
3.2.2 Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition
Utilisez la vitre d'exposition pour les originaux qui ne peuvent pas être placés
dans le chargeur de document, tel qu'un livre ou des originaux épais/fins.
Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition
1 Soulevez le chargeur de document.
2 Placez l'original recto vers le bas dans
le coin arrière gauche, en alignant son
bord sur la réglette gauche.
3 Rabattez soigneusement le chargeur
de document.
Émission 3
C351 3-9
3.2.3 Envoi de plusieurs originaux à partir de la vitre d'exposition
Les originaux qui ne peuvent pas être envoyés par le biais du chargeur ADF
peuvent être envoyés par le biais de la vitre d'exposition.
Envoi de plusieurs originaux à partir de la vitre d'exposition
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur la touche [Fax] du tableau de commande pour
ouvrir l'écran Fax.
2 Sélectionnez la destination.
3 Au besoin, définissez le réglage des fonctions.
4 Placez l'original sur la vitre d'exposition.
Appuyez sur [Réglage numér.] -
[Numérisation séparée] - [OK], puis
appuyez sur la touche [Départ].
5 Placez l'original suivant sur la vitre
d'exposition, puis appuyez sur la
touche [Départ].
– Répétez cette procédure pour
chacun des originaux à envoyer.
Les originaux numérisés sont
mémorisés.
6 Appuyez sur la touche [Fin].
Le mode de lecture du document est annulé.
7 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
3 Émission
3-10 C351
3.2.4 Émission d'originaux avec le chargeur ADF et la vitre
d'exposition
Vous pouvez numériser les originaux en utilisant le chargeur de document et
la vitre d'exposition, de même que vous pouvez numériser les originaux
volumineux en les plaçant en plusieurs lots sur le chargeur de document.
Émission d'originaux avec le chargeur ADF et la vitre d'exposition
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur la touche [Fax] du tableau de commande pour
ouvrir l'écran Fax.
2 Sélectionnez la destination.
3 Au besoin, définissez le réglage des fonctions.
4 Placez l'original sur la vitre d'exposition.
Appuyez sur [Réglage numér.] -
[Numérisation séparée] - [OK], puis
appuyez sur la touche [Départ].
– Un document placé dans le
chargeur a la priorité sur celui qui
est placé sur la vitre d'exposition.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Positionnement de l'original sur la
machine” à la page 3-7.
5 Placez l'original suivant dans le
chargeur ou sur la vitre d'exposition,
puis appuyez sur la touche [Départ].
– Répétez cette procédure pour
chacun des originaux à numériser
avant l'émission.
Les originaux numérisés sont
mémorisés.
6 Appuyez sur la touche [Fin].
Le mode de lecture du document est annulé.
7 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
Émission 3
C351 3-11
3.3 Réglage des conditions d'émission
Le réglage du type d'image original, de la densité, du recto/recto-verso et de
la définition s'affichent lorsque vous choisissez [Réglage numér.] dans
l'écran Fax. Ces options permettent de définir les conditions de l'émission
en fonction du type d'original à envoyer.
!
Détail
Les conditions de l'émission ne peuvent pas être réglées en unités de
page.
Réglage des conditions d'émission
1 Appuyez sur [Réglage numér.] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur la touche à régler.
3 Émission
3-12 C351
3.3.1 Type d'image original
Réglez la qualité en fonction du contenu de l'original. Vous avez le choix
entre 4 réglages de qualité, Texte étant le réglage par défaut.
Réglage de qualité Description
Texte S'applique si les originaux à numériser contiennent uniquement
du texte.
Lorsqu'une image est numérisée sous ce mode, les teintes
neutres des images ne sont pas reproduites.
Texte/Photo S'applique si les originaux à numériser contiennent du texte et
des photos (demi-teinte).
Sélectionnez ce mode si la page contient à la fois des caractères
et des images, ou si le document contient à la fois des pages de
texte et d'images.
Photo S'applique si les originaux à numériser contiennent uniquement
des photos (demi-teinte).
Trame S'applique si les originaux à numériser contiennent en majeure
partie du texte manuscrit clair.
Émission 3
C351 3-13
3.3.2 Densité
Réglez la densité en fonction de la clarté ou de l'obscurité de l'original.
Normal est le réglage par défaut. Vous réglez la densité en 9 étapes.
Option Densité Description
Clair Numérise les originaux avec une densité plus claire que la densité
normale.
Normal Numérise les originaux avec une densité située entre Clair et
Foncé. C'est le réglage par défaut.
Foncé Numérise les originaux avec une densité plus foncée que la
densité normale.
3 Émission
3-14 C351
3.3.3 Recto/Recto-verso
Cette option détermine la manière dont les originaux sont numérisés, en
fonction du type d'original. Vous avez le choix entre deux réglages, Recto
étant le réglage par défaut.
Option Recto/Rectoverso
Description
Recto Sélectionnez pour numériser des originaux recto.
Recto-verso Sélectionnez pour numériser des originaux recto-verso.
Émission 3
C351 3-15
3.3.4 Définition
Cette option définit la résolution de numérisation des originaux. Vous avez le
choix entre 4 réglages, Fin étant le réglage par défaut.
!
Détail
La quantité de données envoyées et la durée de l'émission dépendent du
degré de finesse de la définition.
Si vous sélectionnez Super fin ou Ultra fin et que la machine réceptrice
n'est pas dotée de cette définition, les originaux sont envoyés dans une
définition approchante sur la machine réceptrice.
Option Définition Description
Std. Sélectionnez pour accélérer le temps d'émission.
Fin Sélectionnez pour numériser des originaux standard.
Super fin Sélectionnez pour numériser des originaux contenant de petits
graphiques ou du texte.
Ultra fin Sélectionnez pour numériser des originaux contenant des
graphiques élaborés ou du texte.
3 Émission
3-16 C351
3.3.5 Confirmation des réglages et des résultats de la
communication
Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages et les résultats de la communication des
écrans Fax et Application par le biais de la touche [Contrôle] du tableau de
commande.
Confirmation des réglages et des résultats de la communication
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Contrôle] sur le tableau de commande.
3 Appuyez sur la touche de l'option dont vous voulez vérifier le réglage.
4 Confirmez les réglages.
– Les quatre types de réglages suivants peuvent être confirmés.
– Destination
Confirmation de la destination.
– Appuyez sur [Destination] dans l'écran qui s'affiche suite à l'appui
sur [Détails] pour changer la destination.
Émission 3
C351 3-17
– Réglage numérisation
Confirmation des réglages de numérisation. Appuyez sur chaque
touche de l'écran pour afficher l'écran de réglage correspondant, et
changer le réglage, s'il y a lieu.
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'écran Réglage numérisation, voir
“Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et Réglage
communication” à la page 7-3.
– Appuyez sur [Suiv. ] pour afficher l'écran suivant, et sur [ Préc.]
pour afficher l'écran précédent.
– Réglage communication
Confirmation des réglages de communication. Appuyez sur chaque
touche de l'écran pour afficher l'écran de réglage correspondant, et
changer le réglage, s'il y a lieu.
3 Émission
3-18 C351
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'écran Réglage communication, voir
“Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et Réglage
communication” à la page 7-3.
– Appuyez sur [Suiv. ] pour afficher l'écran suivant, et sur [ Préc.]
pour afficher l'écran précédent.
– Réglage E-mail
Lorsque vous transmettez par e-mail, vous pouvez confirmer ou
saisir le nom du fichier, le sujet, l'adresse e-mail de l’expéditeur et
le texte du message.
– Si la valeur de [De] n'est pas définie, c'est l'adresse e-mail qui a été
définie dans [Enregistrement administrateur] dans l'écran Mode
utilitaire, qui apparaît.
– Pour plus d'informations sur [Enregistrement administrateur], voir
“Manuel d'utilisateur - Opérations Copie”.
– Pour plus d'informations sur les valeurs par défaut de Sujet et
Texte, voir page 10-38, page 10-44.
5 Une fois que vous avez terminé la vérification, appuyez à deux reprises
sur [Fermer].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
!
Détail
En cas de modification des réglages de numérisation ou de
communication, l'écran de vérification ne réapparaît pas.
Émission 3
C351 3-19
3.3.6 Enregistrement dans le carnet d'adresses à partir de
l'écran Vérifier détails de la tâche
Une destination affichée sur l'écran Vérifier détails de la tâche peut être
enregistrée dans le [carnet d'adresses].
Enregistrement dans le carnet d'adresse à partir de l'écran Vérifier
détails de la tâche (Contrôle)
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Contrôle] sur le tableau de commande.
3 Appuyez sur [Destination].
4 Sélectionnez la destination à enregistrer dans le [carnet d'adresses],
puis appuyez sur [Détails].
3 Émission
3-20 C351
5 Appuyez sur [Enregistrer dans carnet d'adresses].
– Si la destination est déjà enregistrée, [Enregistrer dans carnet
d'adresses] n'apparaît pas.
– Si la destination est une boîte, [Régl. Dest.] s'affiche. Si une adresse
e-mail est saisie dans [Régl. Dest.], vous pouvez envoyer un e-mail
pour prévenir de la fin d'une tâche, une fois celle-ci accomplie.
6 Appuyez sur [Recherche nom] pour définir le caractères à rechercher,
puis appuyez sur [OK].
7 Appuyez sur [Nom] pour saisir le nom à enregistrer, puis appuyez sur
[OK].
8 Si les données à enregistrer sont correctes, appuyez sur [Oui].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Non].
9 Appuyez à trois reprises sur [Fermer] pour revenir à l'écran Fax.
La destination sélectionnée est enregistrée dans le [carnet d'adresses].
Émission 3
C351 3-21
3.4 Sélection de la destination
3.4.1 Sélection de la destination
Vous pouvez sélectionner une destination de quatre manières.
- Clavier
- Programme
- Carnet d'adresses
- Saisie directe
Clavier
1 Saisissez le numéro du fax auquel la
télécopie doit être transmise.
– Vous pouvez entrer un numéro de
38 chiffres maximum.
– Appuyez sur [Eff.] sur l'écran Fax
pour corriger un chiffre.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour effacer
tout le numéro.
Le numéro de fax saisi s'affiche dans
Destinations de diffusion.
2 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
3 Émission
3-22 C351
Programme
Toute destination enregistrée dans un programme peut être appelée en
appuyant sur Programme.
1 Appuyez sur [Programme] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Sélectionnez la destination programmée voulue.
– Les réglages de la fonction sont activés.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
La destination spécifiée s'affiche dans Destinations de diffusion.
3 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
2
Remarque
Si le réglage de la communication est défini dans le programme, il est
automatiquement activé.
Vous ne pouvez pas spécifier plus d'un programme.
Si la destination est une adresse e-mail, le sujet, le texte, le nom de fichier
et l'expéditeur peuvent être définis manuellement. Pour plus
d'informations, voir “Confirmation des réglages et des résultats de la
communication” à la page 3-16
Émission 3
C351 3-23
Carnet d'adresses
Vous pouvez appeler une destination en recherchant dans la liste de noms
enregistrés dans le carnet d'adresses.
1 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur le caractère à rechercher.
– Chaque fois que vous appuyez sur [Nom Dest.], l'affichage
bascule entre le numéro de fax et le nom enregistré.
– Vous ne pouvez pas spécifier plus d'une destination.
– La recherche est lancée lorsque les caractères sélectionnés
coïncident.
– Recherche dans [Recherche avancée]
– Appuyez sur [Recherche avancée].
– Appuyez sur [Nom], [N° Fax] ou [E-Mail], puis saisissez l'élément à
rechercher.
– Appuyez sur [OK].
Les résultats de la recherche s'affichent.
3 Émission
3-24 C351
– Recherche dans [Recherche LDAP]
– Appuyez sur [Recherche LDAP].
Émission 3
C351 3-25
– Authentifiez-la si l'authentification LDAP est requise.
– Appuyez sur [Recherche simple] ou [Recherche avancée], puis
saisissez les critères de recherche. Appuyez sur [OK].
– Les résultats de la recherche s'affichent.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la recherche LDAP, voir "Manuel
d'utilisation – Opérations Scanner réseau".
3 Appuyez sur le nom de la destination à laquelle vous voulez envoyer la
télécopie.
– Une lettre précédent la touche a la signification suivante.
A Appel
B Boîte
E E-mail
La destination spécifiée s'affiche dans Destinations de diffusion.
4 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
3 Émission
3-26 C351
Saisie directe
Vous pouvez saisir un préfixe de numérotation tel que [Tonalité], [Pause] et
[-]. Vous pouvez également numériser vers un e-mail ou enregistrer dans une
boîte utilisateur.
Si vous utilisez [Enregistrer ds boîte ut.], la boîte doit avoir été préalablement
enregistrée.
Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement de la boîte, voir “Manuel
d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte”.
0 Lorsque [Saisie manuelle destination] dans [Réglage sécurité] du mode
Utilitaire est réglé sur [Interdit], [Saisie directe] n'apparaît pas. Pour
connaître le réglage de [Saisie manuelle destination], contactez
l'administrateur.
1 Appuyez sur [Saisie directe] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Saisissez le préfixe voulu, tel que tonalité, pause ou “-”, puis saisissez
le numéro du fax de destination sur le clavier.
– Tonalité
Si vous utilisez la numérotation décimale (DC), appuyez sur [TonaÉmission
3
C351 3-27
lité] pour sélectionner le mode FV (fréquences vocales), qui est utilisé
avec les services de télécopie. La sélection de [Tonalité] est
indiquée par un “T” à l'écran.
– Si vous utilisez la numérotation décimale, vous pouvez commuter
provisoirement sur la numérotation à fréquences vocales par le
biais de la touche astérisque [1].
– Pause
Appuyez sur [Pause] pour insérer une pause entre deux chiffres du
numéro à composer. L'appui une fois sur [Pause] génère un intervalle
d'une seconde entre deux chiffres. Vous pouvez saisir plusieurs
intervalles, indiqués par un “P” à l'écran.
– Si la connexion PBX est active, lors d'un appel de la ligne intérieure
vers une ligne extérieure, appuyez sur [Pause] après le numéro de
la ligne extérieure (“0”, par exemple) pour sécuriser l'appel. “P”
s'affiche à l'écran.
– -
Le tiret est un signe de séparation uniquement. Il n'a aucune
incidence sur la numérotation. Il est indiqué à l'écran par un “-”.
– No. abrégé
Saisissez le numéro abrégé (de 0001 à 2000) sur le clavier et précisez
la destination enregistrée dans le carnet d'adresses.
À l'écran, un numéro abrégé et la destination sont indiqués comme
suit : “A0001: KMBT”.
– Numérisation vers E-mail
Appuyez sur cette touche pour envoyer un e-mail contenant une
image.
– Si la destination est une adresse e-mail, le sujet, le texte, le nom de
fichier de l'image et l'expéditeur peuvent être définis manuellement.
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission”
à la page 3-11
– L'émission ou la réception d'un fax couleur n'est pas disponible.
Pour envoyer un e-mail en couleur, utilisez la fonction de
numérisation. Pour plus d'informations sur cette fonction, voir
“Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Scanner réseau”.
– Appels récents #
Appuyez sur cette touche pour envoyer une télécopie à une destination
utilisée récemment.
– Pour plus d'informations sur Appels récents #, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30
– Enregistrer ds boîte ut.
Appuyez sur cette touche pour enregistrer une image sur le disque
dur interne.
3 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
3 Émission
3-28 C351
3.4.2 Sélection de plusieurs destinations
Vous pouvez envoyer une télécopie à plusieurs destinations en une seule
procédure. Vous effectuez ainsi une émission en série.
Vous pouvez sélectionner l'émission en série de quatre manières.
- Clavier
- Groupe
- Carnet d'adresses
- Saisie directe
Ces méthodes peuvent également être utilisées conjointement.
!
Détail
Vous pouvez préciser 605 adresses de destination maximum (500
numéros abrégés, 100 au clavier et 5 destinations e-mail par saisie
directe).
Sélection de plusieurs destinations
1 Indiquez toutes les destinations auxquelles vous voulez envoyer un
message. (Voir “Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.)
– Méthode au clavier ou par saisie directe
– Lors de la saisie directe ou au clavier, vous pouvez préciser la
destination suivant en appuyant sur [Dest. suivante], qui s'affiche
dès que vous avez précisé la première destination.
– Méthode de groupe
– Appuyez sur [Groupe] dans l'écran Fax.
– Appuyez sur Groupe dans l'écran Groupe.
– Appuyez sur la touche de la destination voulue dans le groupe.
Pour sélectionner tous les numéros du groupe, appuyez sur [Tout
sélectionner].
2 Appuyez sur [Départ].
!
Détail
Le numéro du groupe (01 à 99, 00) peut également être précisé en
appuyant sur [Groupe] dans l'écran de saisie directe.
Dans ce cas, la télécopie est transmise à toutes les destinations
enregistrées dans le groupe.
Émission 3
C351 3-29
3.4.3 Confirmation/Suppression d'une destination
Confirmation/Suppression d'une destination
Vous pouvez confirmer ou supprimer certaines destinations.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande, puis sur [Contrôle].
2 Appuyez sur [Destination].
3 Confirmez les destinations.
4 Pour supprimer une ou plusieurs destinations, sélectionnez-les dans la
liste et appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [Détails] pour afficher l'écran de détails.
– Appuyez sur ou sur pour afficher l'écran précédent ou
suivant.
L'écran de message apparaît.
5 Appuyez sur [Oui].
6 Appuyez deux fois sur [Fermer].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
3 Émission
3-30 C351
3.4.4 Rappel manuel
Le rappel consiste à renuméroter une destination.
Pour rappeler manuellement
1 Appuyez sur [Saisie directe], puis sur [Appels récents #].
– Les cinq (maximum) derniers numéros de fax s'affichent.
2 Sélectionnez la destination à rappeler.
Émission 3
C351 3-31
3.5 Numérisation
3.5.1 Lorsque la machine ne détecte pas le format d'origine
Lorsque la machine ne détecte pas le format d'origine
Si la machine ne parvient pas à détecter le format d'origine, l'écran suivant
s'affiche pour vous permettre de le sélectionner.
1 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au format d'origine.
2 Appuyez sur [OK].
3.5.2 Lorsque la mémoire est saturée
Lors de l'émission mémoire, si l'envoi est volumineux ou si les originaux
contiennent des images détaillées, sélectionnez Mémoire rapide (désactivez
Émission mémoire (TX) dans l'écran Réglage communication).
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Message d'erreur affiché” à la page 5-6.
3.5.3 Rotation automatique du document original
Un document original A4(v) ou 8 1/2 × 11 (v) est automatiquement pivoté au
moment de la transmission et réglé sur A4(w) ou 8 1/2 × 11(w).
!
Détails
Si cette rotation automatique n'est pas souhaitée, contactez le service
après-vente.
3 Émission
3-32 C351
3.6 Lorsque l'émission ne s'effectue pas
Lorsque l'émission ne s'effectue pas
Si vous ne parvenez pas à émettre une télécopie en raison de problème de
ligne ou autre, l'écran de vérification du rappel s'affiche.
1 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Le rappel s'effectue une fois le délai spécifié écoulé.
– Si l'émission ne s'effectue toujours pas après un rappel, un écran
indique que la tâche n'a pas abouti.
2 Appuyez sur [OK].
Pour supprimer une tâche d'émission qui a échoué, appuyez sur [Liste
des tâches] et supprimez cette tâche.
!
Détail
Si le rappel s'effectue normalement dans les réglages du mode Utilitaire,
aucun écran de rappel ne s'affiche.
Rappel
Le rappel se réfère à la renumérotation d'une destination.
Lorsque l'émission d'un fax n'aboutit pas parce que la machine réceptrice
est occupée ou pour une autre raison, la machine rappelle le numéro après
un laps de temps prédéterminé. Pendant ce laps de temps, le document à
émettre est traité en tant que document en attente.
!
Détail
La fonction de rappel est réglée en usine pour rappeler le numéro une fois
après un intervalle de trois minutes. Vous pouvez modifier ce réglage
dans l'écran Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage
Paramètres ligne” à la page 11-35.
Émission 3
C351 3-33
3.7 Réservation d'émission
Réservation d'émission
Vous pouvez paramétrer et lancer l'émission suivante pendant que la
machine exécute une communication ou une impression. C'est ce qu'on
appelle une réservation d'émission.
0 [Décrocher] ne peut pas être utilisé lors d'une réservation d'émission.
0 Si [Affichage émission] est réglé sur OFF, [Réservation tâche suivante]
n'apparaît pas.
0 Pour plus d'informations sur [Affichage émission], voir page 11-19.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande pour afficher l'écran
Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réservation tâche suivante].
3 Positionnez l'original.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur
la vitre d'exposition” à la page 3-8.
– Pour supprimer une émission
réservée, appuyez sur [Liste
tâches] - [Émission fax],
sélectionnez la tâche à supprimer
dans [Tâches en cours], puis
appuyez sur [Eff.].
– La touche Liste réservation de
l'écran Fax clignote en cas de
bourrage papier ou de manque de
papier pendant le traitement d'une
tâche, avant la réservation d'une
émission. Vous pouvez toutefois
réserver une ou des émissions.
4 Définissez le réglage des fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur le
réglage des fonctions de l'écran Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions
d'émission” à la page 3-11.
– Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et
Réglage communication” à la page 7-3.
5 Sélectionnez la destination.
6 Appuyez sur [Départ].
3 Émission
3-34 C351
3.8 Émission manuelle
Émission manuelle
L'émission manuelle permet d'envoyer des documents tout en confirmant
l'état de la machine réceptrice.
L'émission mémoire ne peut pas être utilisée avec l'émission manuelle.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande pour afficher l'écran
Fax.
2 Positionnez l'original.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Positionnement de l'original sur la
machine” à la page 3-7.
3 Appuyez sur [Décrocher].
– Si [Réception fax] est sélectionné, appuyez sur [Émission fax] pour
passer en mode d'émission.
4 Définissez les réglages de la numérisation, selon les besoins.
– Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11.
– Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
5 Saisissez la destination au clavier.
– Vous pouvez saisir 60 chiffres maximum.
– Appuyez sur [Raccrocher] pour revenir à l'écran Fax.
– Si un téléphone externe est branché, vous pouvez le décrocher
pour transmettre les documents.
6 Dès que vous entendez le signal, appuyez sur [Départ] sur l'écran
Décrocher.
– Si vous appuyez sur la touche [Départ] du tableau de commande,
l'écran de confirmation de la communication s'affiche. Appuyez sur
[Oui] pour lancer l'émission.
– Si un téléphone externe est branché, raccrochez-le une fois que
vous avez appuyé sur [Départ].
La transmission commence.
Émission 3
C351 3-35
3.9 Annulation de l'émission
La procédure à suivre pour annuler l'émission dépend de l'état de l'émission
: la communication est en cours ou le document à émettre a été réservé. Sur
la machine FK-502, les instructions d'émission et les images mémorisées
constituent des tâches réservées. Les tâches de communication réservées
et les tâches en cours de traitement sont affichées sur l'écran Liste des
tâches.
3.9.1 Annulation d'une communication en cours
La procédure d'annulation d'une émission en cours est décrite ci-dessous.
Annulation d'une communication en cours
1 Appuyez sur [Liste tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Émission fax].
3 Vérifiez si les tâches ont été sélectionnées dans [Tâches en cours].
4 Sélectionnez la tâche à supprimer, puis appuyez sur [Suppri.].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui].
L'émission est annulée.
6 Appuyez sur [Quitt.].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
3 Émission
3-36 C351
3.9.2 Annulation des tâches réservées
La suppression d'une tâche réservée annule son émission.
Annulation des tâches réservées
1 Appuyez sur [Liste tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Émission fax].
3 Appuyez sur [Tâches en cours].
4 Appuyez sur [Tâches différées].
5 Sélectionnez le document réservé à annuler, puis appuyez sur
[Suppri.].
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
L'écran de confirmation apparaît.
6 Appuyez sur [Oui].
Le document réservé est supprimé.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
Émission 3
C351 3-37
3.10 Confirmation de la liste de tâches
Confirmation des documents réservés
Vous pouvez vérifier les réservations d'émissions stockées en mémoire sur
la liste des tâches affichée à l'écran.
1 Appuyez sur [Liste tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Émission fax].
3 Appuyez sur [Tâches en cours].
4 Appuyez sur [Tâches différées] ou [Tâches actives].
5 Confirmez la tâche, puis appuyez sur [Quitt.].
– Appuyez sur ou sur pour afficher l'écran précédent ou
suivant.
– Pour confirmer les détails d'une tâche, sélectionnez la tâche et
appuyez sur [Vérifier tâches] ou sur [Détail].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
3 Émission
3-38 C351
3.11 Confirmation des résultats de la communication
Confirmation des résultats de la communication
Pour vérifier les résultats de l'émission, vous pouvez appuyer sur [Liste
tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
1 Appuyez sur [Liste tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Impre.], [Émission fax] ou [Réc. fax/Boîte ut.].
3 Appuyez sur [Historique tâches].
Émission 3
C351 3-39
4 Confirmez les résultats de la communication.
– Émission fax
– Type :
Fax, e-mail ou boîte.
– Dest :
Numéro du fax, adresse e-mail ou nom de boîte de la destination.
– Début enreg. :
Date et heure de l'émission.
– # de pges :
Nombre de documents émis.
– Résultat :
“Tâche finie”, “Supprimée par utilisateur”, “Supprimée cause
erreur”, “Annulée” (agrafe ou perforation) ou “Tâche annulée”.
– Réc. fax/Boîte ut.
– Nom utilis :
Nom de l'utilisateur en mode autorisation utilisateur et nom du
compte en mode suivi du compte. Dans les autres cas, le type de
la copie, de l'impression ou de la réception fax est affiché.
– Nom du document :
Nom du document reçu ou enregistré.
– Début enreg. :
Date et heure de réception du document.
– # de pges :
Nombre de documents reçus.
3 Émission
3-40 C351
– Résultat :
“Tâche finie”, “Supprimée par utilisateur”, “Supprimée cause
erreur”, “Annulée” (agrafe ou perforation), “Impr. page séparation”,
“Enreg. fini” “Échec de l'enreg.” ou “Tâche annulée”.
– Vous pouvez appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] pour vérifier les
résultats de la communication dans un rapport d'émission ou dans
un rapport de réception. Ces rapports peuvent être imprimés.
– Appuyez sur [Détails] pour afficher l'écran de détails.
5 Une fois que vous avez terminé la confirmation, appuyez à deux
reprises sur [Quitt.].
L'écran précédent [Liste tâches] s'affiche à nouveau.
Émission 3
C351 3-41
3.12 Émissions en mémoire et en mémoire rapide
Cette machine offre deux méthodes d'émission des documents.
3.12.1 Émission mémoire
Avec cette méthode, toutes les pages sont numérisées, puis mémorisées
avant l'émission. Le document est automatiquement paginé et les images de
la première page apparaissent dans le rapport de communication.
Cependant, si le document à envoyer est volumineux ou si les images de
l’original sont envoyées en haute définition, la mémoire peut saturer.
La machine est automatiquement configurée sur Émission mémoire quand
l'une des procédures suivantes est réalisée.
- [Mémoire rapide] est défini sur l'écran Réglage communication.
3.12.2 Émission en mémoire rapide
Avec cette méthode, l'émission du fax s'effectue immédiatement après la
numérisation de chaque page. C'est la méthode recommandée pour ne pas
saturer la mémoire lors de l'émission d'un document volumineux.
3 Émission
3-42 C351
3.12.3 Pour émettre en mémoire rapide, procédez de la manière
suivante.
Émission en mémoire rapide
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] dans l'écran Fax.
3 Appuyez sur [Mémoire rapide].
4 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Mémoire rapide est configuré de façon à revenir à l'écran Fax.
5 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et
Réglage communication” à la page 7-3.
6 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Sélection de la destination” à la
page 3-21.
7 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Positionnement de l'original sur la
machine” à la page 3-7.
8 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
Émission 3
C351 3-43
!
Détail
Si la ligne est occupée, les données sont enregistrées en mémoire, puis
transmises lorsque la ligne est disponible.
Pour annuler la transmission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la
page 3-35.
Si la machine réceptrice n'est pas en état de recevoir, la destination sera
rappelée. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel manuel” à
la page 3-30.
Si la transmission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à
la page 5-3.
3 Émission
3-44 C351
3.13 Nombre d'originaux
Nombre d'originaux
En mode Mémoire rapide, le nombre total de pages émises suit le numéro de
la page sur la ligne d'informations sur l'expéditeur.
En émission mémoire, le nombre total de pages est imprimé
automatiquement. Vous n'avez pas besoin de définir cette fonction.
0 Spécifications
Le nombre total de pages est imprimé sous le format “P.numéro de la
page/nombre total de pages”.
La machine imprime le nombre total de pages que vous spécifiez, même
si ce nombre ne correspond pas au nombre total de pages lues.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
*Émission mémoire (TX), Effacer bord, Format d'origine, Originaux
mixtes, Émission en relève TX (normale), Émission en relève TX (bulletin).
* : La définition du nombre d'originaux est automatiquement annulée.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] dans l'écran Fax.
3 Appuyez sur [Mémoire rapide].
De : 01234567890123456 2005 /20 /31 01:23:00 P.005 / 010
Émission 3
C351 3-45
4 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
5 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.] - [Application] - [Nombre d'originaux].
6 Saisissez sur le clavier le nombre de pages du document.
– 999 pages maximum.
7 Appuyez à deux reprises sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage du nombre total de pages, appuyez sur
[Annul.].
Le nombre total de pages est enregistré, et vous revenez à l'écran Fax.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Réglage numérisation ou Réglage communication, voir “Ouverture
des écrans Réglage numérisation et Réglage communication” à la
page 7-3.
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Sélection de la destination” à la
page 3-21.
10 Positionnez le document original.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 lit le document et procède à l'émission de chaque page
numérisée.
3 Émission
3-46 C351
!
Détail
Pour annuler la transmission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la
page 3-35.
Si la machine réceptrice n'est pas en état de recevoir, la destination sera
rappelée. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel manuel” à
la page 3-30.
Si la transmission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à
la page 5-3.
Émission 3
C351 3-47
3.14 Émission différée (TX)
Émission différée (TX)
Cette fonction permet de préciser l'heure à laquelle la communication devra
commencer. L'envoi de fax la nuit ou tôt le matin permet de tirer parti de
tarifs réduits.
0 Spécifications
Avec Émission différée (TX), l'émission mémoire est automatiquement
sélectionnée.
Vous pouvez différer l'émission de 24 heures maximum, en précisant un
nombre de minutes et d'heures.
Vous ne pouvez pas préciser de date.
0 Vous pouvez préciser un nombre total de 21 transmissions différées TX
(20 émissions normales et 1 réception en relève RX).
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Nombre d'originaux, Émission en relève TX (normale), Émission en relève
TX (bulletin), Réception en relève RX (bulletin), Émission en mémoire
rapide.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] dans l'écran Fax.
3 Appuyez sur [Émission différée (TX)].
3 Émission
3-48 C351
4 Indiquez, à l'aide du clavier, l'heure à laquelle doit débuter l'émission.
– Saisissez l'heure et les minutes avec deux chiffres au format d'une
horloge de 24 heures.
– Exemple : pour démarrer la communication à 21:07, tapez “21” et
“07”.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
Vous revenez à l'écran Fax.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et
Réglage communication” à la page 7-3.
8 Indiquez la ou les destinations.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Sélection de la destination” à la
page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Positionnement des originaux sur la
vitre d'exposition” à la page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 lit le document et le place en mémoire jusqu'à son heure de
transmission.
Émission 3
C351 3-49
!
Détail
Pour annuler la transmission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la
page 3-35.
Si la machine réceptrice n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si la transmission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à
la page 5-3.
3 Émission
3-50 C351
3.15 Communications internationales
Communications internationales
La vitesse de transmission des communications internationales est réduite.
La procédure ci-dessous décrit les émissions à l'étranger.
Les numéros de téléphone internationaux, code du pays compris, peuvent
être enregistrés à l'aide des fonctions Programme et du Carnet d'adresses.
Pour plus d'informations à ce sujet, voir “Enregistrement du carnet
d'adresses” à la page 10-5.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Émission en relève TX (normale), Réception en relève RX (normale),
Émission en relève TX (Bulletin), Réception en relève RX (bulletin)
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.] dans l'écran Fax.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage ligne].
Émission 3
C351 3-51
4 Appuyez sur [Communications internationales].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.] ou réappuyez sur
[Communications internationales].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
Les communications internationales sont sélectionnées et vous
revenez à l'écran Fax.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et
Réglage communication” à la page 7-3.
8 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Positionnement des originaux sur la
vitre d'exposition” à la page 3-8.
3 Émission
3-52 C351
9 Composez “001-010”, le code du pays
et le code régional de la destination,
puis le numéro de fax de la destination.
– Nous supposons ici que le préfixe
d'un appel à l'étranger est le 001,
mais ce préfixe varie d'un opérateur
téléphonique à un autre. Au besoin,
contactez votre opérateur pour
connaître le préfixe à utiliser pour
les appels à l'étranger.
– Les numéros de téléphone internationaux peuvent être enregistrés
dans le carnet d'adresse. Pour plus d'informations, voir
“Enregistrement du carnet d'adresses” à la page 10-5.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 démarre la transmission.
!
Détail
Pour annuler la transmission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la
page 3-35.
Si la machine réceptrice n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si la transmission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à
la page 5-3.
Émission 3
C351 3-53
3.16 Informations sur l'expéditeur
Les originaux émis sont enregistrés de la manière suivante par la machine
réceptrice.
3.16.1 Réglage à l'intérieur du corps du texte
!
Détail
Le nom de l'expéditeur et l'ID du fax sont définis en mode Utilitaire dans
les Informations en-tête. Les réglages par défaut de l'écran de base du
fax sont affichés dans le champ DE des informations sur l'expéditeur.
3.16.2 Réglage à l'extérieur du corps du texte
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur ce réglage, voir “Position en-tête/pied de
page” à la page 11-31.
De : 01234567890 01/20/2005 01:23#012 p.5/10
De : 01234567890 01/20/2005 01:23#012 p.5/10
3 Émission
3-54 C351
3.16.3 Réglage sur OFF
!
Détails
OFF ne peut pas être sélectionné dans certains pays.
Pour plus d'informations sur ce réglage, voir “Position en-tête/pied de
page” à la page 11-31.
4 Réception
Réception 4
C351 4-3
4 Réception
Ce chapitre explique le principe et les procédures de réception de fax.
4.1 Mode Réception
Cette machine gère deux modes de réception.
La ligne de téléphone doit être connectée selon le type d'utilisation.
Les deux modes de réception sont les suivants.
4.1.1 Réception automatique (mode fax uniquement)
Ce mode est utilisé si la ligne de téléphone est dédiée à un fax.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réception automatique (mode fax
uniquement)” à la page 4-3.
4.1.2 Réception manuelle (mode téléphone uniquement)
Le FK-502 doit être paramétré sur ce mode si un téléphone externe (ou un
répondeur) est connecté et si la majorité des appels entrants sont
téléphoniques.
Appel entrant
Document
reçu
Réception automatique du message
Appel entrant
Le téléphone externe sonne
Soulevez le combiné et parlez
Pour recevoir un fax, appuyez sur
4 Réception
4-4 C351
4.2 Réception automatique (mode fax uniquement)
Sélectionnez ce mode si la ligne téléphonique est dédiée à la communication
de fax. La machine reçoit automatiquement les fax dès que le nombre de
sonneries réglé est atteint. Pendant la réception, “Réception” s'affiche dans
la zone de message de l'écran.
!
Détail
Si l'option Affichage réception est réglée sur OFF, le message n'apparaît
pas.
Ce mode est actif si le mode de réception est réglé sur Réception auto dans
Réglage ligne du mode Utilitaire.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage de ce mode, voir “Réglage
Paramètres ligne” à la page 11-34.
Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage du nombre de sonneries avant
réception, voir “Réglage Paramètres ligne” à la page 11-34.
Appel entrant
Document
reçu
Réception automatique du message
Réception 4
C351 4-5
4.3 Réception manuelle (mode téléphone uniquement)
Réception manuelle (mode téléphone uniquement)
Si le mode de réception est réglé sur Réception manuelle dans Réglage ligne
du mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez recevoir les fax manuellement. Un téléphone
externe doit être connecté.
Pour plus d'informations sur le réglage de la réception manuelle, voir
“Réglage Paramètres ligne” à la page 11-34.
La procédure de réception manuelle est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Lorsque le téléphone externe sonne, appuyez sur [Décrocher].
2 Assurez-vous que [Réception (RX)] est en surbrillance.
– Si un document se trouve dans le chargeur ADF ou sur la vitre
d'exposition, Réception (RX) n'apparaît pas en surbrillance, même
en cas d'appel entrant. Dans ce cas, appuyez sur Réception (RX).
3 Appuyez sur [Départ] dans le menu Décrocher.
– Si vous appuyez sur la touche [Départ] du tableau de commande,
l'écran Décrocher s'affiche. Appuyez sur [Oui] pour lancer la
réception.
La réception commence.
Appel entrant
Le téléphone externe sonne
Soulevez le combiné et parlez
Pour recevoir un fax, appuyez sur [Départ]
4 Réception
4-6 C351
4.4 Réception impossible
En cas de problème de réception, un message d'erreur s'affiche. Référezvous
à “Message d'erreur affiché” à la page 5-6 pour connaître la manière
d'y remédier. Appuyez sur [Arrêt] pour supprimer le message affiché.
!
Détail
Si le téléphone externe continue de sonner, le mode de réception
(automatique/manuel) est peut-être réglé sur RX manuelle dans Réglages
initiaux du mode Utilitaire.
Cette option doit être réglée sur Réception auto pour pouvoir les
documents automatiquement. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage
Paramètres ligne” à la page 11-34.
La réception ne s'effectue pas si la mémoire est saturée. Vérifiez
également que le magasin de papier est chargé.
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Impossible de recevoir des messages” à
la page 5-4.
Réception 4
C351 4-7
4.5 Réception en mémoire de substitution
Lorsque le fax ne peut pas recevoir un document, celui-ci est mémorisé
jusqu'à ce qu'il puisse être imprimé. C'est ce qu'on appelle la réception en
mémoire de substitution.
- Le document mémorisé est imprimé dès que le problème est résolu
(bourrage papier, par exemple).
- Cette fonction n'est pas disponible si la mémoire est saturée.
4 Réception
4-8 C351
4.6 Enregistrement de la réception
À réception d'un document à enregistrer, son format de papier et le format
de papier du magasin défini sont comparés. Le document est ensuite réduit
au taux de réduction défini ou au meilleur taux de réduction pour convenir au
papier avant son enregistrement. Si vous définissez un taux de réduction
équimultiple, le document est enregistré à ce taux quel que soit le format de
papier du document reçu.
4.6.1 Enregistrement après réduction minimale
À réception d'un document formaté, celui-ci est enregistré après réduction
au taux défini pour ce format de papier (la valeur par défaut est de 96 %).
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur le taux de réduction minimum, voir “Réglage
Émission/Réception” à la page 11-37.
Original Document reçu
Réduit au
taux de
réduction
minimum
Réception 4
C351 4-9
4.6.2 Enregistrement après réduction pour convenir au papier
d'impression
Si le document reçu est plus long que le format de papier standard, le format
de papier approprié est déterminé en fonction de la longueur et de la largeur
de ce document, et celui-ci est imprimé sur du papier correspondant à ce
format. Par contre, si ce format conforme n'est pas chargé dans le magasin
de papier, le document est imprimé au format le plus proche après réduction.
Original Document reçu
Réduit pour
convenir au
format de
papier
4 Réception
4-10 C351
La machine applique les règles suivantes pour déterminer le meilleur format
de papier :
- Étape 1
Sélection du format de papier approprié
– La machine détermine le format de papier approprié en prenant en
compte la largeur et la longueur du document, tel qu'indiqué dans le
tableau suivant.
Largeur du
document reçu
Position d'enregistrement
des informations
de réception
Longueur du document reçu
A4 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 - 154 155 - 314 315 - 386 387 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 146 147 - 306 307 - 378 379 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné A5 v A4 w B4 w A3 w
B4 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 -195 196 - 395 396 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 186 187 - 386 387 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné B5 v B4 w A3 w
A3 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 - 226 227 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 217 218 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné A4 v A3 w
Réception 4
C351 4-11
Si “5,5 × 8,5 w” convient, “5,5 × 8,5 v” est sélectionné parce que c'est la
seule longueur réglable sur la machine.
- Étape 2
Sélection du papier d'impression du document
– La machine vérifie si le format de papier approprié déterminé à l'étape 1
est présent dans le magasin.
Le format de papier est présent :
La machine procède à l'enregistrement.
Le format de papier n'est pas présent dans le magasin ou la fonction
de sélection automatique du magasin est désactivée :
La machine recherche le second choix de format de papier approprié, tel
qu'indiqué dans le tableau. Si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est
réglée sur [ON] en mode Utilitaire, la machine recherche les formats de
papier appropriés pour enregistrer le document sur plusieurs formats.
Largeur du
document reçu
Position d'enregistrement
des informations
de réception
Longueur du document reçu
A4 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 - 150 151 - 305 306 - 309 391 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 141 142 - 296 297 - 381 382 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné 5.5 × 8.5 v
*1
8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 14 w 11 × 17 w
B4 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 - 232 233 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 223 224 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné 8.5 × 11 v 11 × 17 w
A3 [OFF] ou [Intérieur
du corps
du texte]
0 - 232 233 ou plus
[Extérieur du
corps du texte]
0 - 223 224 ou plus
Format de papier sélectionné 8.5 × 11 v 11 × 17 w
4 Réception
4-12 C351
Si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est réglé sur OFF :
Le papier est sélectionné en ordre décroissant.
!
Détail
Même si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est réglée sur OFF, la
machine imprime sur des pages distinctes les documents volumineux ou
en haute définition.
Format de
papier approprié
A5 v A4 w B5 v B4 w A4 v A3 w
Ordre de
placement
du papier
(de haut en
bas)
A5 v A4 w B5 v B4 w A4 v A3 w
A5 w A4 v B5 w A3 w A4 w B4 w
A4 w F4 w B4 w A4 w F4 w A4 w
A4 v B4 w A4 w A4 v B4 w F4 w
B5 v A3 w A4 v F4 w A3 w
B5 w F4 w
F4 w A3 w
B4 w
A3 w
Format de papier approprié
5.5 × 8.5 v 8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 11 v 8.5 × 14 w 11 × 17 w
Ordre de placement du
papier
(de haut en bas)
5.5 × 8.5 v 8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 11 v 8.5 × 14 w 11 × 17 w
5.5 × 8.5 w 8.5 × 11 v 8.5 × 11 w 11 × 17 w A3 w
A5 v A4 w A4 v B4 w B4 w
A5 w A4 v A4 w A3 w 8.5 × 14 w
8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 14 w 8.5 × 14 w 8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 11 w
8.5 × 11 v 11 × 17 w 11 × 17 w 8.5 × 11 v A4 w
A4 w B4 w B4 w A4 w
A4 v A3 w A3 w A4 v
B5 v
B5 w
8.5 × 14 w
11 × 17 w
B4 w
A3 w
Réception 4
C351 4-13
Si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est réglé sur ON :
Le papier est sélectionné en ordre décroissant.
!
Détail
Même si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est réglée sur ON, le
document est réduit pour tenir dans la largeur du papier sélectionné si
celui-ci est inférieur à la largeur de l'image du document reçu.
Format de
papier approprié
A5 v A4 w B5 v B4 w A4 v A3 w
Ordre de
placement
du papier
(de haut en
bas)
A5 v A4 w B5 v B4 w A4 v A3 w
A5 w F4 v B5 w B5 v A4 w A4 v
A4 w B4 w B4 w B5 w F4 w A4 w
A4 v A3 w A4 w A3 w B4 w
B5 w A4 v A4 v A3 w
F4 w F4 w A4 w
B5 v A3 w F4 w
B4 w
A3 w
Format de papier approprié
5.5 × 8.5 v 8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 11 v 8.5 × 14 w 11 × 17 w
Ordre de placement du
papier
(de haut en bas)
5.5 × 8.5 v 8.5 × 11 w 8.5 × 11 v 8.5 × 14 w 11 × 17 w
5.5 × 8.5 w A4 w 8.5 × 11 w 11 × 17 w A3 w
A5 v 8.5 × 14 w A4 v B4 w 8.5 × 11 v
A5 w 11 × 17 w A4 w A3 w 8.5 × 11 w
8.5 × 11 w B4 w 8.5 × 14 w 8.5 × 11 v A4 v
8.5 × 11 v A3 w 11 × 17 w 8.5 × 11 w A4 w
A4 w B4 w A4 v
A4 v A3 w A4 w
B5 v
B5 w
8.5 × 14 w
11 × 17 w
B4 w
A3 w
4 Réception
4-14 C351
Si le papier d'impression des rapports d’activité de format B5 w, B5 v, A4
w ou A4 v est sélectionné, l'image de cette page peut être imprimée sur
plusieurs pages.
!
Détail
Si le format du papier d'impression du fax est inférieur au format de
papier sélectionné à l'étape 1, le document est réduit.
Si l'option [Imprimer page de séparation] est réglée sur [OFF] et que
l'orientation du papier d'impression est différente de celle du papier
sélectionné à l'étape 1, la sortie imprimée est automatiquement pivotée
de 90 degrés.
Si vous imprimez des originaux mixtes, ce processus est exécuté sur
chaque page.
Si les formats de papier sélectionnés aux étapes 1 et 2 se trouvent dans
plusieurs magasins, le magasin utilisé est sélectionné en fonction du
réglage de la fonction automatique du format de papier. Pour plus
d'informations, voir “Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie”.
Si le format de papier requis se trouve uniquement dans le magasin
d'insertion manuelle, le document est imprimé sur le papier chargé dans
ce magasin. Toutefois, si la fonction de sélection automatique du format
de papier est désactivée ou si la fonction de sélection automatique du
magasin est désactivée pour ce magasin, ce magasin n'est pas
sélectionné.
Même si l'option de division de la page est réglée sur ON, la page n'est
pas divisée si [Réglage TX/RX] est réglée comme suit.
[Sélection magasin impression réception] est réglé
Sélection papier d'impression] est réglée sur [Format fixe] ou [Format
prioritaire]
[Impression R/V pour réception] est réglée sur [ON]
Si aucune option de sélection du papier d'impression n'est définie, un
message vous demande de le faire.
Si [Sélection papier d'impression] est réglé sur [Format prioritaire ]:
Le format de papier approprié est sélectionné parmi A4, B4 et A3 (8,5 ×
11, 8,5 × 14 et 11 × 17). Si ce format de papier n'est pas disponible, le
papier est sélectionné selon la procédure standard, puis le document est
enregistré.
Réception 4
C351 4-15
Si [Sélection papier d'impression] est réglé sur [Format fixe ]:
Le format de papier approprié est sélectionné parmi A4, B4 et A3 (8,5 ×
11, 8,5 × 14 et 11 × 17). Si ce format de papier n'est pas disponible, le
message demeure jusqu'à ce que le papier soit chargé.
Si [Sélection magasin impression réception] est réglé sur une valeur autre
que [Auto ]:
Le document est enregistré de façon à convenir au format de papier
chargé dans le magasin (à l'exception du magasin d'insertion manuelle)
défini pour [Sélection magasin impression réception].
Si [Sélection papier d'impression] est réglé sur une valeur autre que
[Sélection auto] et si [Sélection magasin impression réception] est réglé
sur une valeur autre que [Auto ]:
Le réglage défini pour [Sélection magasin impression réception] a la
priorité.
4 Réception
4-16 C351
Méthode d'enregistrement à la réception
Le tableau suivant indique la relation entre le format de papier du document
reçu et l'enregistrement de facto du document sur la machine.
!
Détail
Si [Impression R/V pour réception] est réglé sur ON, l'écran peut indiquer
le papier.
Pour plus d'informations, voir page 11-34.
Format de papier du
document reçu
Réglage de [Réduction min.
pour impression réception]
Sélection dans [Sélection
magasin impression
réception]
96 - 87%
Format standard (A3 à A5) Enregistré après réduction
pour tenir sur le même format
de papier
Enregistré après réduction
pour tenir sur le format de
papier spécifié
Original long
(plus long que le
format
standard)
L'enregistrement
avec division
de la
page est
OFF
Enregistré après réduction
pour tenir sur le format de
papier approprié
Enregistré après réduction
pour tenir sur le format de
papier spécifié
L'enregistrement
avec division
de la
page est
ON
Enregistré après division de la
page en fonction du papier
utilisé
Enregistré après réduction
pour tenir sur le format de
papier spécifié
A
B
C A
B
C
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
A
B
CD
A
B
C
D
Réception 4
C351 4-17
4.7 Informations de réception
Lorsque les informations de réception (date, heure, numéros de réception et
de page) sont réglées sur l'intérieur ou l'extérieur du corps du texte avec
l'option [Position en-tête/pied de page], elles sont enregistrées dans le
document reçu.
Réglage à l'intérieur du corps du texte
Réglage à l'extérieur du corps du texte
Réglage sur OFF
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur ce réglage, voir “Position en-tête/pied de
page” à la page 11-31.
Original
Date RX : 01/20/2005 R001 P.001/003
Original
Date RX : 01/20/2005 R001 P.001/003
Original
4 Réception
4-18 C351
5 Dépannage
Dépannage 5
C351 5-3
5 Dépannage
5.1 Impossible d'envoyer des messages
Si vous ne parvenez pas à envoyer un document, consultez le tableau cidessous
pour tenter de remédier au problème. Si vous ne pouvez résoudre
le problème en suivant les solutions proposées, contactez le service aprèsvente.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur les messages d'erreur, voir “Message
d'erreur affiché” à la page 5-6.
En cas de problème de bourrage des originaux ou du papier des
magasins, de mauvaise qualité de l'image ou de manque de toner,
consultez le “Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie” fourni avec le
FK-502.
Points à vérifier Actions correctives
La procédure d'émission a-t-elle
été effectuée correctement ?
Vérifiez la procédure d'émission et réessayez.
Le numéro de fax de la destination
est-il correct ? Les numéros
d'appel programmés ou abrégés
sont-ils enregistrés
correctement ?
Si vous utilisez un numéro programmé ou abrégé, il est
possible qu'il ait été enregistré incorrectement. Essayez
d'imprimer la liste des numéros abrégés et vérifiez si le
numéro est enregistré correctement. Si ce n'est pas le cas,
corrigez l'enregistrement.
Le réglage de la ligne est-il
correct ?
Vérifiez si la [Méthode de numérotation] de [Réglage
Paramètres ligne] dans le mode Utilitaire correspond à la
ligne téléphonique utilisée. Corrigez ce réglage si ce n'est
pas le cas.
La ligne téléphonique est-elle
connectée correctement ?
Vérifiez si la prise de téléphone est bien branchée. Si ce
n'est pas le cas, branchez-la.
Le problème se situe-t-il au niveau
le la machine réceptrice ?
Téléphonez à la destination et vérifiez si le fax récepteur
est hors tension, s'il manque de papier ou s'il existe un
autre problème.
5 Dépannage
5-4 C351
5.2 Impossible de recevoir des messages
Si vous ne parvenez pas à recevoir un document, consultez le tableau cidessous
pour tenter de remédier au problème. Si vous ne parvenez pas à
résoudre le problème en suivant les solutions proposées, contactez le
service après-vente.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur les messages d'erreur, voir “Message
d'erreur affiché” à la page 5-6.
En cas de problème de bourrage des originaux ou du papier des
magasins, de mauvaise qualité de l'image ou de manque d'encre,
consultez le “Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie” fourni avec le
FK-502.
Dépannage 5
C351 5-5
Description du
problème
Points à vérifier Actions correctives
Impossible de
recevoir
Y-a-t-il du papier
dans la machine ?
Si l'icône d'ajout de papier est allumée, la machine
manque de papier et les documents reçus sont
mémorisés. Ajoutez du papier. Pour connaître la
procédure, consultez le “Manuel d'utilisation –
Opérations Copie”.
Y-a-t-il un bourrage
papier dans la
machine ?
En cas de bourrage papier, les documents reçus sont
mémorisés. Dégagez le bourrage papier. Pour
connaître la procédure, consultez le “Manuel
d'utilisation – Opérations Copie”.
Le flacon de toner
est-il vide ?
La réception de message ne s'effectue pas si le flacon
de toner est vide. Remplacez immédiatement le flacon
de toner. Pour connaître la procédure, consultez le
“Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Copie”.
Le FK-502 est-il en
mode de réception
manuelle ?
Si l'option [Mode réception] de [Réglage Paramètres
ligne] dans le mode Utilitaire est réglée sur [Réception
manuelle], vous devez réaliser la procédure de
réception manuelle. Pour connaître cette procédure,
voir “Réception manuelle (mode téléphone
uniquement)” à la page 4-5.
La ligne
téléphonique estelle
connectée
correctement ?
Vérifiez si la prise de téléphone est bien branchée. Si
ce n'est pas le cas, branchez-la.
Le FK-502 est-il en
mode de
communication en
réseau fermé ?
Si la fonction de communication en réseau fermé (pour
empêcher la réception de documents non sollicités)
est active (ON), vous ne pouvez recevoir que les
documents provenant de fax déterminés.
L'expéditeur a-t-il
envoyé une adresse
secondaire erronée
en fonction
F-code ?
Une erreur de communication peut survenir en cas de
réception d'une adresse secondaire erronée alors que
la boîte utilisateur confidentielle est active. Dans ces
circonstances, la réception est impossible. Vérifiez
auprès de l'expéditeur si l'adresse secondaire a été
définie correctement.
Pas de sortie La réception fax
a-t-elle été activée ?
Identifiez la boîte de sauvegarde du fichier dans les
fonctions de réception PC-fax.
Le Paramètre boîte
utilisateur TSI est-il
réglé sur ON ?
Vérifiez la boîte définie dans le Paramètre boîte utilisateur
TSI.
La réception
mémoire a-t-elle été
activée ?
Une fois la réception mémoire activée, imprimez le
document reçu comme suit :
• Appuyez sur [Boîte] sur le tableau de commande.
• Appuyez sur [Boîte utilisateur système].
• Appuyez sur [Boîte utilisateur réception mémoire].
• Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
• Sélectionnez le document à imprimer et appuyez
sur Imprimer.
• Une fois le document imprimé, appuyez sur
[Fermer].
5 Dépannage
5-6 C351
5.3 Message d'erreur affiché
Les messages d'erreur énumérés dans le tableau ci-dessous s'affichent en
cas de problème. Référez-vous aux explications pour remédier à la situation.
Si vous ne pouvez toujours pas émettre correctement après avoir corriger le
problème, contactez le service après-vente.
Message d'erreur Actions correctives
Occupé Bien que le nombre de rappels déterminé ait été tenté, la machine
réceptrice est toujours occupée. Confirmez l'état de la machine
réceptrice et renvoyez.
Pas de réponse La machine n'est pas en état de répondre. Contactez la
destination par téléphone, confirmez l'état de la machine et
réessayez.
Mémoire saturée • Si la mémoire devient saturée pendant la lecture du
document :
Pour émettre la partie du document lue, appuyez sur [Départ].
Appuyez sur [Arrêt] pour annuler l'émission.
Dépannage 5
C351 5-7
5.4 Appeler SAV
Ce message apparaît lorsque vous devez appeler le service après-vente. Les
numéros de téléphone et de fax du service après-vente sont également
indiqués. La procédure de signalisation d'un problème par téléphone au
service après-vente est présentée ci-dessous.
7 ATTENTION
Risque d'accident grave
% Pour prévenir tout risque d'accident grave, procédez de la manière
suivante lorsque le message d'appel du SAV s'affiche et que le fax ne
fonctionne plus.
Procédure à suivre lorsque le message d'appel du SAV s'affiche
1 Notez le numéro du code d'erreur.
2 Mettez hors tension le commutateur Marche/Arrêt principal et
secondaire.
3 Débranchez le cordon d'alimentation.
4 Contactez le service après-vente et indiquez à votre correspondant le
numéro du code d'erreur.
6 Caractéristiques
techniques
Caractéristiques techniques 6
C351 6-3
6 Caractéristiques techniques
6.1 Caractéristiques techniques
Les caractéristiques techniques des fonctions de télécopie sont énumérées
ci-dessous.
Ces caractéristiques peuvent être modifiées sans préavis.
Fonction Caractéristiques techniques
Capacité de mémoire
image
27 Go* (27 des 40 Go du disque dur sont utilisés en tant que
mémoire.)
Nombre max. de pages
enregistrées
Environ 9 000 pages*
(pages enregistrées au format KONICA MINOLTA standard A4
contenant environ 700 caractères en définition “fine”)
Lignes téléphoniques Lignes d'abonnés (réseaux de communication fax compris)
Réseau privé (PBX)
Résolution de numérisation G3
Ultra fine : 600 ppp × 600 ppp
Super fine : 16 points/mm × 15,4 lignes/mm,
8 points/mm × 15,4 lignes/mm,
400 ppp × 400 ppp
Fine : 8 points/mm × 7,7 lignes/mm,
200 ppp × 200 ppp
Normale : 8 points/mm × 3,85 lignes/mm,
200 ppp × 100 ppp
Les résolutions de numérisation ci-dessus dépendent des
capacités de la machine de destination.
Vitesse de transmission 2400, 4800, 7200, 9600, 12000, 14400, 16800, 19200, 21600,
24000, 26400, 28800, 31200, 33600 bps
Temps d'émission 2 secondes
Temps d'émission de pages au format KONICA MINOLTA
standard A4 contenant environ 700 caractères en résolution
normale. Il s'agit du temps d'émission de l'image uniquement
(non compris le temps d'établissement de la communication). Le
temps de communication varie selon le contenu des originaux et
le type de ligne téléphonique à la destination.
Codage MH, MR, MMR, JBIG
* Le disque dur interne est utilisé pour chacune des fonctions des écrans Copie, Numérisation,
Fax et Boîte.
Format max. de
numérisation
280 mm × 431 mm (11 pouces × 17 pouces) ou A3
(420 mm × 297 mm)
Largeur : 297 mm
Longueur : 432 mm max.
Format max.
d'enregistrement
280 mm × 431 mm (11 pouces × 17 pouces) ou A3
(420 mm × 297 mm)
Les originaux supérieurs à 600 mm ne peuvent pas être reçus.
Lors de la réception d'originaux plus longs que le format de papier
chargé dans les magasins, ils sont imprimés selon le réglage de
l'option [Imprimer page de séparation].
Fonction Caractéristiques techniques
7 Applications d'émission
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-3
7 Applications d'émission
7.1 Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et
Réglage communication
!
Détail
Appuyez sur la touche de la fonction à définir pour ouvrir l'écran de
réglage correspondant (les touches [Mémoire rapide], [V34 OFF], [ECM
OFF] et [Communications internationales] n'affichent pas d'écran car ce
sont des touches à bascule qui activent/désactivent la fonction).
Vous pouvez sélectionner plusieurs fonctions, du moment que celles-ci
ne sont pas incompatibles entre elles. En cas d'incompatibilité, la
fonction est grisée sur le tableau de commande.
Ouverture des écrans Réglage numérisation et Réglage communication
Pour envoyer un fax par le biais d'une fonction Application, ouvrez l'écran
Réglage numérisation ou Réglage communication et paramétrez les
fonctions voulues.
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] sur le tableau de commande pour ouvrir l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.] ou sur [Réglage comm.] dans l'écran
Fax.
7 Applications d'émission
7-4 C351
3 Appuyez sur la touche de la fonction voulue. Pour afficher l'écran de
réglage d'une application, appuyez sur la touche [Application] dans
l'écran Réglage numérisation.
4 Effectuez l'une des opérations suivantes.
– Sur l'écran voulu affiché :
Réglez la fonction dans l'écran affiché, puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Une fois l'option sélectionnée :
Appuyez sur [OK].
– Appuyez sur [Annul.] pour annuler le réglage et revenir au réglage
de communication d'origine.
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-5
7.2 Présentation des fonctions d'application
Les fonctions suivantes apparaissent dans l'écran Réglage numérisation et
l'écran Réglage communication.
[Annul.]
Annule le réglage et revient aux conditions de communication d'origine.
[OK]
Affiche à nouveau l'écran Fax.
[OFF]
Désactive l'option et vous ramène à l'écran précédent.
[Reset]
Réinitialise toutes les options de l'écran.
Écran Réglage numérisation
Écran Application
Écran Réglage communication
Fonction Description
Originaux mixtes : Vous pouvez envoyer des pages de différents formats en une
seule procédure. (page 7-7)
Position reliure : Spécifie la position de l'agrafage d'un original recto-verso placé
sur le chargeur de document (ADF) et place à la verticale le
verso de l'original. (page 7-9)
7 Applications d'émission
7-6 C351
!
Détail
La touche associée à la fonction sélectionnée apparaît inversée.
Appuyez sur [Annul.] pour revenir à l'écran Fax.
Le mode de communication V34 est utilisé par le fax Super G3.
Effacement bords : Lors de l'émission des pages d'un livre, cette fonction efface les
bandes noires qui apparaîtraient en marge. (page 7-12)
Ajustement fond : Règle la densité de la couleur de fond de l'original. (page 7-15)
Netteté : Rend plus net le contour des caractères. (page 7-18)
Nombre originaux : En mode Mémoire rapide, inclut le nombre total de pages dans
les informations sur le nombre de pages. (page 3-44)
Format de numérisat. : Permet de préciser la taille du document à émettre. Cette
fonction est utile lors de l'émission d'une partie d'une ou de
plusieurs pages. (page 7-21)
Type de fichier : Précise le format d'un fichier joint à un message e-mail.
(page 7-24)
Mémoire rapide : Émet un message immédiatement après la lecture d'une page
d'un document. (page 3-42)
Mot de passe émission (TX)*1
:
Joint un mot de passe à l'émission. Cette fonction est requise
si le poste récepteur fonctionne en réseau fermé. (page 7-26)
Émission en relève (TX) : Permet de numériser un document et de le mémoriser jusqu'à
ce que la destination initie la transmission en adressant une
requête de relève. (page 9-3)
Réception en relève (RX) : Permet d'initier la réception en adressant à la destination une
requête de relève de document. (page 9-6)
Émission différée (TX) : Permet de préciser l'heure de l'émission. (page 3-47)
Émission F-code (TX)*2 : Permet de préciser l'adresse secondaire et le mot de passe
requis pour la communication confidentielle et l'émission en
relais. (page 7-26, page 7-29, page 7-32, page 9-9)
Réglage ligne Communications
internationales
Spécifie un débit de transmission moins rapide. (page 3-50)
ECM OFF Le mode de correction d'erreur (ECM) peut être désactivé.
(page 7-35)
V34 OFF Si l’équipement du central ne permet pas d'utiliser le protocole
V.34, le mode V34 est désactivé. (page 7-38)
Fonction Description
*1 : Cette fonction permet d'émettre ou de recevoir avec des postes fonctionnant en réseau
fermé.
Dans ce cas, la fonction F-code doit être active sur les deux machines.
*2 : F-code est utilisé.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-7
7.3 Originaux mixtes
Fonction Originaux mixtes
Cette fonction permet d'envoyer des pages de différents formats en une seule
séquence d'opérations.
0 Spécifications
L'Émission mémoire est automatiquement sélectionnée.
Si les options Format d'origine et Originaux mixtes sont toutes deux sélectionnées,
le Format d'origine a la priorité.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Nombre originaux, Position reliure, Réception en relève
RX (normal), Réception en relève RX (bulletin)
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour afficher
l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
3 Appuyez sur [Originaux mixtes].
Émission et reproduction dans
le même format que l'original à
la destination.
Vous placez les originaux mixtes
dans le chargeur RADF.
7 Applications d'émission
7-8 C351
4 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Réglage numérisation ou Réglage communication, voir
“Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la page 7-5.
7 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
8 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
9 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-9
7.4 Position reliure
Fonction Position reliure
La fonction d'inversion Haut/Bas et la fonction Gauche/Droite précisent le
type de reliure lors de l'émission d'un document recto-verso. En
sélectionnant le type de reliure, vous vous assurez que le document sera
relié, et donc lu, correctement.
0 Spécifications
Le chargeur de document (ADF) doit être utilisé. La vitre d'exposition ne
peut pas être utilisée pour l'émission en mode reliure.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Originaux mixtes, Réception en relève RX (normal), Réception en relève
RX (bulletin)
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
Reliure Haut/Bas
Reliure Gauche/Droite
Fax de destination
Émission
7 Applications d'émission
7-10 C351
3 Appuyez sur [Position reliure].
4 Appuyez sur [Reliure G/D] ou [Reliure H/B] pour préciser le type de
reliure du document original imprimé recto-verso.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Application s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-11
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
10 Placez le document avec la page imprimée vers le haut.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
7 Applications d'émission
7-12 C351
7.5 Émission avec effacement des bords
2
Remarque
Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
Fonction d'émission avec effacement des bords
Lors de l'émission d'un document relié, cette fonction supprime les bandes
noires qui risqueraient d'apparaître en marge des pages transmises. Ces
bandes noires apparaissent lorsque la machine lit les données d'un livre ou
lorsque le chargeur de document n'est pas rabattu.
0 Spécifications
L'Émission mémoire rapide est automatiquement sélectionnée.
Vous pouvez utiliser le chargeur ADF ou la vitre d'exposition.
La largeur à effacer peut être définie par incréments de 0,1 mm
(1/16 pouce) dans une plage de 0,1 à 50 mm (1/16 à 2 pouces).
Réglage initial de la largeur à effacer : 5,0 mm (3/16 pouce).
Si vous combinez plusieurs effacements de bords, ils s'appliquent au
format de page original non encore effacé.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Nombre originaux, Réception en relève RX (normal),
Réception en relève RX (bulletin)
Largeur à
effacer
Émission standard Émission avec effacement des bords
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-13
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
3 Appuyez sur [Effacement bords].
4 Sélectionnez [Haut], [Gauc], [Droi] ou [Bas] et tapez au clavier la largeur
à effacer, [+] ou [-].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Application s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Applications d'émission
7-14 C351
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
10 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si la machine réceptrice n'est pas en état de recevoir, la destination sera
rappelée. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel manuel” à
la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-15
7.6 Ajustement fond
Fonction Ajustement fond
Cette fonction permet d'ajuster la densité de la couleur d'arrière-plan de
l'original. Si le fond de l'original est en couleur, il risque d'être reproduit en
noir. Dans ce cas, vous pouvez envoyer un message après avoir ajusté la
densité de la couleur de fond de l'original.
0 Spécifications
Vous pouvez utiliser le chargeur de document (ADF) et la vitre
d'exposition.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
3 Appuyez sur [Ajustement fond].
7 Applications d'émission
7-16 C351
4 Appuyez sur [+ Foncé] pour assombrir la densité de la couleur de fond
de l'original, et sur [+ Clair] pour l'éclaircir. Appuyez sur [Auto] pour
activer le réglage automatique.
– Si vous sélectionnez [Auto], les étapes permettant de déterminer
l'ajustement approprié du fond sont effectuées page par page, ce
qui peut ralentir l'opération de numérisation.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Application s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
10 Positionnez le document original.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-17
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler la transmission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la
page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
7 Applications d'émission
7-18 C351
7.7 Netteté
Fonction Netteté
Cette fonction permet d'ajuster la netteté des bords des caractères. Si les
caractères d'un document ne sont pas nets, augmentez la netteté ([+]) pour
définir plus précisément leurs contours ou diminuez-la ([-]), le cas échéant.
0 Spécifications
Vous pouvez utiliser le chargeur de document (ADF) et la vitre
d'exposition.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
3 Appuyez sur [Netteté].
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-19
4 Selon que vous voulez rendre les contours des caractères plus ou
moins nets, appuyez sur [ ] ou [ ] vers la droite [+] ou vers la gauche
[-].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Application s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
10 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
7 Applications d'émission
7-20 C351
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-21
7.8 Format de numérisation
Fonction Format de numérisation
Cette fonction permet de préciser que le format de papier du document émis
doit être identique au format du papier chargé à l'autre extrémité. Cela
permet d'imprimer les images sans réduction sur le poste récepteur. En
général, si le format du papier chargé à la destination ne peut contenir
l'image transmise, cette image est réduite. Cette fonction permet aussi
d'imprimer une partie de l'image, sans réduction.
0 Spécifications
L'Émission mémoire est automatiquement sélectionnée.
L'emplacement de lecture des originaux varie selon que l'original est
placé sur le chargeur ADF ou sur la vitre d'exposition.
Si Format d'origine et Originaux mixtes sont toutes deux sélectionnées,
le Format d'origine a la priorité.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Nombre originaux, Réception en relève RX (normal),
Réception en relève RX (bulletin)
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.], puis sur [Application].
7 Applications d'émission
7-22 C351
3 Appuyez sur [Format de numérisat.].
4 Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au format du document à
émettre.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Application s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-23
9 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
10 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
11 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
7 Applications d'émission
7-24 C351
7.9 Type de fichier
Définition du type de fichier
Cette fonction permet de préciser le type de fichier image à lire si la
destination est une adresse e-mail ou une boîte utilisateur.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage numéris.].
3 Appuyez sur [Type de fichier].
4 Sélectionnez le type de fichier.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage numérisation s'affiche à nouveau.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-25
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine lit le document et l'enregistre en mémoire en tant que
document réservé avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
7 Applications d'émission
7-26 C351
7.10 Mot de passe émission (TX)
Mot de passe émission (TX)
L'émission avec ID exige un mot de passe. Si le poste récepteur fonctionne
en réseau fermé, l'expéditeur doit envoyer le même mot de passe que celui
du réseau fermé en réception.
0 Spécification
Cette fonction n'est disponible que si la machine du correspondant est
dotée de la fonction Réseau fermé en réception (Transmission de mot de
passe).
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Émission en relève TX (normal), Réception en relève RX (normal),
Émission F-code.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Mot de passe émission (TX)].
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-27
4 Tapez le mot de passe au clavier (20 caractères maximum).
– Les caractères et signes autorisés sont les suivants : 0 à 9, # et *
– Pour effacer un caractère, appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour effacer tout le mot de passe.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
7 Applications d'émission
7-28 C351
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-29
7.11 Communication confidentielle (Émission F-code)
Fonction Communication confidentielle
Cette fonction permet d'utiliser des boîtes confidentielles (similaires à des
comptes de messagerie) pour échanger des informations avec certaines
personnes. Outre l'envoi d'un document vers une boîte confidentielle de
destination (émission confidentielle), la réception d'un document dans une
boîte confidentielle sur votre poste (réception confidentielle) est possible.
Les sections suivantes décrivent les procédures d'émission confidentielle.
0 Spécifications
L'émission confidentielle suppose que le fax récepteur soit doté d'une
boîte confidentielle et d'un mot de passe spécifique (ce dernier n'est pas
toujours requis par le fax récepteur). L'émission confidentielle suppose
en outre que le fax de destination soit doté de la fonction F-code.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Émission en relève TX (normal), Réception en relève RX (normal), Mot de
passe émission (TX)>
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
Expéditeur Boîte de documents Récepteur
confidentiels
7 Applications d'émission
7-30 C351
3 Appuyez sur [Émission F-code (TX)].
4 Saisissez le numéro de la boîte sur le poste récepteur dans le champ
Adresse secondaire. Appuyez sur [Mot Passe] et tapez le mot de passe
au clavier, s'il y a lieu.
– L'adresse secondaire et le mot de passe peuvent comporter 20
caractères maximum.
– Pour la communication avec le FK-502, saisissez 9 caractères
maximum pour le numéro de la boîte et 8 caractères maximum pour
le mot de passe. Les caractères autorisés dépendent de la
machine.
– Les caractères et signes autorisés dans le mot de passe sont les
suivants : 0 à 9, # et *.
– Pour effacer un caractère, appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour effacer l'intégralité de l'entrée.
Si le mot de passe est requis, appuyez sur [Oui] et saisissez-le.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-31
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour interrompre la séquence d'opérations, appuyez sur [Arrêt].
7 Applications d'émission
7-32 C351
7.12 Requête d'émission en relais (Émission F-code)
Requête d'émission en relais
La requête d'émission en relais consiste à faire transiter les transmissions
vers plusieurs destinations sur une station relais (intermédiaire). Cette
fonction permet de réduire les coûts de communication des destinations
éloignées. Vous pouvez définir plusieurs stations, chacune d'entre elles étant
composée d'une station de relais et de plusieurs destinations.
0 Spécifications
La requête d'émission en relais n'est disponible que si cette fonction a
été activée en mode Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage
fonction” à la page 11-40.
La station d'origine émet la demande de relais, la station de relais relaye
les transmissions et les stations d'arrivée sont celles qui reçoivent et
terminent les communications.
Cette fonction suppose le paramétrage sur la station de relais d'un
numéro de boîte de relais, d'un mot de passe de relais et d'un numéro de
groupe de destination.
Elle suppose en outre que la station de relais soit dotée de la fonction
F-code.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Émission en relève TX (normal), Réception en relève RX (normal), Mot de
passe émission (TX)
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
Station d'origine Station relais intermédiaire
Station distante
Appel international Station distante Appel local
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-33
3 Appuyez sur [Émission F-code (TX)].
4 Saisissez dans le champ Adresse secondaire le numéro de la boîte de
relais sur la station de relais, et le mot de passe dans le champ Mot
Passe, à l'aide du clavier.
– Les champs [Adresse secondaire] et [Mot Passe] acceptent 20
caractères maximum.
– Les caractères et signes autorisés dans le champ [Mot Passe] sont
les suivants : 0 à 9, # et *
– Pour effacer un caractère, appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour effacer l'intégralité de l'entrée.
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Applications d'émission
7-34 C351
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Désignez la station relais.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
!
Détail
Pour interrompre la séquence d'opérations, appuyez sur [Arrêt].
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-35
7.13 ECM OFF
Fonction ECM OFF
Les communications peuvent être effectuées avec le mode de correction
d'erreur (ECM) désactivé. Ce mode, établi par l'ITU-T (International
Telecommunications Union), permet aux télécopieurs qui en sont équipés de
communiquer les uns avec les autres et de confirmer que les données
émises sont exemptes d'erreur. Les perturbations dues aux bruits sur la ligne
ou autres sont ainsi éliminées. Le FK-502 utilise par défaut le mode ECM lors
des émissions.
0 Spécifications
En cas de perturbation sur la ligne, le temps de communication peut être
légèrement plus long lorsque le mode ECM est activé.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Émission en relève TX (normal), Réception en relève RX (normal), V34
OFF, Émission en relève (bulletin) et Réception en relève RX (bulletin).
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage ligne].
7 Applications d'émission
7-36 C351
4 Appuyez sur [ECM OFF].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.] ou rappuyez sur [ECM
OFF].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 démarre la transmission.
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-37
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
7 Applications d'émission
7-38 C351
7.14 V34 OFF
Mode V34 OFF
Le fax Super G3 utilise le protocole V.34. Si la destination ou le FK-502 est
connecté à la ligne via un équipement d’extension de central, et selon les
conditions de la ligne, la communication avec le Super G3 peut ne pas
aboutir.
Dans ces circonstances, nous vous recommandons d'émettre en
désactivant le mode V34 (OFF). Ce mode sera automatiquement réactivé à
la fin de l'émission.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Réception en relève RX (normal) ECM OFF
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage ligne].
Applications d'émission 7
C351 7-39
4 Appuyez sur [V34 OFF].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.] ou rappuyez sur [V34
OFF].
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Indiquez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 mémorise le document avant de l'émettre.
7 Applications d'émission
7-40 C351
!
Détail
Pour annuler l'émission, voir “Annulation de l'émission” à la page 3-35.
Si le poste récepteur n'est pas en état de recevoir, son numéro fera
l'objet d'un rappel. Pour plus d'informations sur le rappel, voir “Rappel
manuel” à la page 3-30.
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
8 Fonctions utiles pour la
réception
Fonctions utiles pour la réception 8
C351 8-3
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8.1 Utilisation d'un document reçu en réception
confidentielle
8.1.1 Utilisation d'un document reçu en réception confidentielle
La communication confidentielle permet d'utiliser des boîtes confidentielles
(similaires à des comptes de messagerie) pour échanger des informations
avec certaines personnes. Outre l'envoi d'un document vers une boîte confidentielle
de destination (émission confidentielle), la réception d'un document
dans une boîte confidentielle sur votre poste (réception confidentielle)
est possible. Les sections suivantes décrivent les procédures d'impression
d'un document reçu dans une boîte utilisateur confidentielle, et la suppression
d'un tel document.
Spécifications
Si vous comptez utiliser la réception confidentielle, définissez la boîte utilisateur
confidentielle (voir “Réglage des boîtes confidentielles” à la page 10-46)
et le mot de passe d'accès au FK-502, puis fournissez ces données au poste
à l'autre extrémité. L'émission suppose que le fax de destination soit doté de
la fonction F-code.
Expéditeur Boîte de documents Récepteur
confidentiels
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8-4 C351
8.1.2 Impression du document reçu dans une boîte utilisateur
confidentielle
Impression du document reçu dans une boîte utilisateur confidentielle
Lorsque le FK-502 reçoit un document confidentiel, il imprime automatiquement
un rapport de réception confidentielle. Procédez comme suit pour imprimer
un document reçu dans une boîte utilisateur confidentielle.
1 Appuyez sur [Boîte] dans le tableau de commande.
2 Sélectionnez l'onglet [Boîte utilisateur publique], puis une [Boîte utilisateur
confidentielle].
3 Si un mot de passe d'accès a été défini, saisissez-le dans le champ affiché,
puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe peut comporter 8 caractères maximum.
4 Sélectionnez le No. boîte confidentielle à l'aide de ou , puis
appuyez sur [Imprimer].
5 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le document stocké dans la boîte utilisateur confidentielle désignée
est imprimé.
!
Détails
Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Fermer].
Une fois imprimé, le document est automatiquement supprimé.
Fonctions utiles pour la réception 8
C351 8-5
8.1.3 Suppression d'un document stocké dans une boîte utilisateur
confidentielle
Procédez comme suit pour supprimer les documents placés dans une boîte
utilisateur confidentielle.
Suppression d'un document stocké dans une boîte utilisateur confidentielle
Vous pouvez supprimer tous les documents d'une boîte utilisateur confidentielle
en mode Utilitaire.
1 Appuyez sur [Boîte] dans le tableau de commande.
2 Sélectionnez l'onglet [Boîte utilisateur publique], puis une [Boîte utilisateur
confidentielle].
3 Si un mot de passe d'accès a été défini, saisissez-le dans le champ affiché,
puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe peut comporter 8 caractères maximum.
4 Sélectionnez le No. boîte confidentielle à l'aide de ou , puis
appuyez sur [Suppri.].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui] dans l'écran de confirmation de la suppression.
Le ou les documents placés dans cette boîte sont supprimés.
!
Détails
Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Fermer].
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8-6 C351
8.2 Réception mémoire
Dans l'écran Utilitaire, vous pouvez activer le mode de réception mémoire
sur FK-502, qui permet de recevoir les documents, de les mémoriser et de
les imprimer selon les besoins. Les sections qui suivent décrivent les
procédures d'impression et de suppression d'un document reçu mémorisé.
Il est supposé que la réception mémoire est active.
!
Détail
Pour activer et régler la réception mémoire, voir “Réception mémoire
obligatoire” à la page 11-43.
8.2.1 Impression d'un document mémorisé
Impression d'un document mémorisé
La procédure suivante décrit l'impression d'un document reçu, stocké en
mémoire.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Boîte] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran de sélection d'une boîte.
2 Sélectionnez l'onglet [Boîte ut. système] et [Boîte réception mémoire
RX].
– Si la fonction d'authentification utilisateur est réglée sur [ON],
l'onglet [Boîte ut. personnelle] apparaît.
Fonctions utiles pour la réception 8
C351 8-7
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Annul.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
4 Sélectionnez le document reçu à l'aide de ou et appuyez sur
[Imprimer].
5 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le document sélectionné est imprimé.
!
Détails
Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou précédent.
Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Fermer] avant d'appuyer sur
[Imprimer].
Pour afficher la première page du ficher sélectionné afin d'en vérifier le
contenu, appuyez sur [Epreuve].
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8-8 C351
8.2.2 Suppression d'un document mémorisé
Suppression d'un document mémorisé
La procédure suivante décrit la suppression d'un document reçu, stocké en
mémoire.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Boîte] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran de sélection d'une boîte.
2 Sélectionnez l'onglet [Boîte ut. système] et [Boîte réception mémoire
RX].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Annul.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
4 Sélectionnez le document reçu à l'aide de ou et appuyez sur
[Suppri.].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui] dans l'écran de confirmation de la suppression.
Le document sélectionné est imprimé.
!
Détails
Pour interrompre l'opération, appuyez sur [Fermer] avant d'appuyer sur
[Imprimer].
Pour afficher la première page du ficher sélectionné afin d'en vérifier le
contenu, appuyez sur [Epreuve].
Fonctions utiles pour la réception 8
C351 8-9
8.3 Informations de réception
8.3.1 Informations sur la réception et l'impression recto-verso
Lorsque [Impression R/V pour réception] est réglée sur [ON]
Lorsque [Impression R/V pour réception] est réglée sur [ON] dans le réglage
émission/réception du mode Utilitaire, les documents sont imprimés rectoverso.
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage Émission/Réception” à la
page 11-37.
8 Fonctions utiles pour la réception
8-10 C351
9 Relève
Relève 9
C351 9-3
9 Relève
9.1 Émission en relève
L'émission en relève permet de numériser un document à l'aide du FK-502
et de l'enregistrer sur le disque dur jusqu'à ce qu'une destination transmette
une commande de relève.
Le document est sauvegardé dans la boîte relève émission de la boîte
utilisateur système, et l'émission commence à réception d'une commande
de relève de la destination. L'émission en relève stocke les documents dans
la boîte relève émission et les bulletins dans la boîte bulletin board.
La description qui suit suppose l'utilisation de l'émission en relève et de la
boîte relève émission.
!
Détail
Si vous utilisez l'option bulletin board, reportez-vous à “Bulletin” à la
page 9-9.
Pour connaître la procédure d'impression et de suppression des
documents émis en relève, voir “Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte”.
9 Relève
9-4 C351
9.1.1 Émission en relève
Émission en relève
Cette section décrit la procédure d'émission en relève (normale).
0 Spécifications
L'émission en relève porte sur un seul document.
L'émission mémoire est automatiquement sélectionnée.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Nombre d'originaux, Réception en relève TX (normal),
Émission différée TX, Communications internationales, ECM OFF, Mot
de passe émission TX, Émission F-code, V34 OFF
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour afficher
l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Émission en relève (TX)].
4 Appuyez sur [Normal].
Relève 9
C351 9-5
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF] ou sur [Annul.].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
8 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement de l'original sur la machine” à la page 3-7.
9 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 numérise le document et le mémorise jusqu'à ce que la
destination envoie une commande de relève, qui entraîne l'émission du
document.
!
Détail
Si l'émission échoue, voir “Impossible d'envoyer des messages” à la
page 5-3.
9 Relève
9-6 C351
9.2 Réception en relève
La réception en relève permet au FK-502 d'envoyer une commande à une
destin ation pour recevoir le document qui est soit prêt à l'émission sur la
machine distante, soit réservé pour l'émission en relève. Cette fonction est
utile si vous préférez assumer les frais de la communication.
La réception en relève séquentielle permet de désigner plusieurs
destinations de réception en relève.
Un rapport de relève réception séquentielle est imprimé en fin de réception,
de même qu'un rapport de relève séquentielle réservée si vous utilisez
également l'émission différée.
!
Détail
Cette fonction ne fonctionne pas si la machine distante n'est pas dotée
de cette caractéristique.
Pour plus d'informations sur le rapport de relève séquentielle réservée,
voir “Rapport de relève séquentielle réservée (réception)” à la page 12-27
et sur le rapport de relève réception séquentielle, voir “Rapport de relève
séquentielle (réception)” à la page 12-17.
Relève 9
C351 9-7
Réception en relève
La réception en relève comporte deux options : normale et bulletin board.
Avec l'option bulletin board, le document à recevoir est réservé dans le
tableau électronique de la destination. Pour plus d'informations sur cette
option, voir “Réception en relève d'un document placé sur le bulletin board
d'une destination (fax)” à la page 9-13. La description s'applique à la
réception en relève normale.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Effacement bords, Format de numérisation, Nombre
d'originaux, Originaux mixtes, Position relieure, Émission confidentielle,
Émission en relais, ECM OFF, Communications internationales, Émission
en relève (normal), Mot de passe émission TX
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour afficher
l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Réception en relève (RX)].
4 Appuyez sur [Normal].
9 Relève
9-8 C351
5 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Indiquez la ou les destinations.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la désignation de la destination, voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
Vous pouvez spécifier plusieurs destinations.
8 Appuyez sur [Départ].
Le FK-502 commence à recevoir le ou les documents prêts à
l'émission ou réservés pour émission en relève sur la ou les
destinations.
!
Détail
Pour suspendre la réception en relève, appuyez sur [Arrêt] sur le tableau
de commande avant d'appuyer sur [Départ].
Si la réception échoue, voir “Réception impossible” à la page 4-6.
Relève 9
C351 9-9
9.3 Bulletin
Le FK-502 vous permet de parcourir le bulletin board (tableau électronique)
d'une destination pour y rechercher les documents en attente de relève ou
pour y placer des documents à relever. Cette section décrit les procédures
de gestion des documents affichés sur le bulletin board d'une destination,
notamment l'écriture d'un document sur le tableau et la réception en relève
d'un document posté sur le tableau.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur l'impression et la suppression d'un
document affiché sur le tableau électronique, consultez le “Manuel
d'utilisation - Opérations Scanner réseau”.
Relève
Écriture
Parcourir
Bulletin boards
(tableaux électroniques)
9 Relève
9-10 C351
9.3.1 Écriture d'un document sur le bulletin board
La procédure d'écriture d'un document sur le bulletin board est décrite cidessous.
Écriture d'un document sur le bulletin board
0 Spécifications
Les tableaux électroniques (bulletin board) doivent être préalablement
définis. Voir “Réglage du bulletin (tableau électronique)” à la page 10-48.
Les tableaux électroniques ne peuvent être utilisés que si la destination
est dotée de la fonction F-code.
Vous ne pouvez placer sur un tableau électronique qu'un document à la
fois.
0 Fonctions incompatibles
Mémoire rapide, Nombre d'originaux, Réception en relève TX (normal),
Émission différée TX, Communications internationales, ECM OFF, Mot
de passe émission TX, Émission F-code, V34 OFF
0 Si le bulletin board comporte déjà un document et que vous en placez un
nouveau, celui-ci écrase le document existant.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Émission en relève (TX)].
Relève 9
C351 9-11
4 Appuyez sur [Bulletin].
5 Saisissez le numéro du bulletin dans le champ [No. bulletin].
– Vous pouvez saisir un numéro compris entre 1 et 999999999 (9
chiffres).
– Pour effacer un caractère, appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour supprimer tous les numéros de bulletin
board.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Le cas échéant, définissez les autres fonctions.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Fax, voir “Réglage des conditions d'émission” à la page 3-11. Pour
plus d'informations sur la définition des fonctions de l'écran
Application, voir “Présentation des fonctions d'application” à la
page 7-5.
9 Relève
9-12 C351
9 Positionnez le document original.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la mise en place du document, voir
“Positionnement des originaux sur la vitre d'exposition” à la
page 3-8.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
– Si vous voulez interrompre la lecture du document après avoir
appuyé sur [Départ], appuyez sur [Arrêt], puis sur [Oui] dans l'écran
de confirmation.
Le FK-502 lit le document et le place sur le bulletin board.
Relève 9
C351 9-13
9.3.2 Réception en relève d'un document placé sur le bulletin
board d'une destination (fax)
Réception en relève d'un document placé sur le bulletin board d'une
destination (fax)
Vous pouvez recevoir par relève le document placé sur le bulletin board
d'une destination. Procédez de la manière suivante.
1 Au besoin, appuyez sur [Fax] dans le tableau de commande pour
afficher l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
3 Appuyez sur [Réception en relève (RX)].
4 Appuyez sur [Bulletin].
9 Relève
9-14 C351
5 Saisissez le numéro du bulletin dans le champ [No. bulletin].
– Vous pouvez saisir un numéro de bulletin de 20 chiffres maximum.
– Pour effacer un caractère, appuyez sur [Eff.].
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour supprimer tous les numéros de bulletin
board.
6 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [OFF].
L'écran Réglage communication s'affiche à nouveau.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
L'écran Fax s'affiche à nouveau.
8 Sélectionnez la destination.
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Sélection de la destination” à la
page 3-21.
9 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La machine distante lance l'opération de relève sur son bulletin board.
10 Enregistrement/
Réglages
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-3
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10.1 Affichage de l'écran d'enregistrement du télécopieur
La procédure d'affichage de l'écran d'enregistrement du télécopieur est
décrite ci-dessous.
Affichage de l'écran d'enregistrement du télécopieur
1 Appuyez sur [Fax] et sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande pour afficher l'écran du mode Utilitaire.
2 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Enregistrement
1-touche], tapez “1” sur le clavier.
– Si [Enregistrement et changement d'adresse] de l'option [Interdire
accès Paramètres tâche] dans l'écran Utilitaires est réglé sur
[Interdire], vous ne pouvez pas changer ou enregistrer la touche
correspondant à [Enregistrement 1-touche]. Pour plus
d'informations à ce sujet, contactez l'administrateur.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-4 C351
3 Appuyez sur Fax.
L'écran Enregistrement fax s'affiche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-5
10.2 Enregistrement du carnet d'adresses
Vous pouvez enregistrer dans le [Carnet d'adresses] le numéro du fax et
l'adresse e-mail d'une destination fréquente. Vous pouvez ensuite accéder
au [Carnet d'adresses] enregistré par le biais de [Carnet d'adresses] ou
[Saisie directe] dans l'écran Fax.
- Vous pouvez enregistrer 2 000 adresses maximum (0001 à 2000), y
compris le [Carnet d'adresses] d'autres fonctions de la machine, telle que
la numérisation.
- L'enregistrement du nom de la destination et du caractère de recherche
dans le [Carnet d'adresses] permet ensuite de spécifier la destination en
sélectionnant le caractère de recherche.
- Vous pouvez enregistrer le numéro de fax ([No. abrégé]), l'adresse e-mail
ou la boîte.
Cette section décrit la procédure d'enregistrement, de modification et de
suppression du carnet d'adresses.
Tenez compte du point suivant :
- L'enregistrement n'est pas disponible tant que le nom, la destination,
l'adresse e-mail ou la boîte n'a pas été défini.
!
Détail
Vous pouvez confirmer les informations enregistrées dans la liste de
numéros abrégés.
Pour plus d'informations sur la liste de numéros abrégés, voir “Liste
Carnet d'adresses” à la page 12-33
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-6 C351
Enregistrement d'un numéro de fax dans un carnet d'adresses
La procédure d'enregistrement d'un numéro de fax dans un carnet
d'adresses est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Carnet d'adresses],
tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [No. abrégé].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-7
4 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
5 Appuyez sur [Nom] et saisissez le nom du carnet d'adresses.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
– Un numéro inutilisé apparaît par défaut dans le champ [No.].
6 Tapez sur le clavier le numéro de fax de la destination.
– Les touches suivantes sont disponibles.
– [Tonalité] :
Si vous utilisez la numérotation décimale (DC), appuyez sur
[Tonalité] pour sélectionner le mode FV (fréquences vocales), qui
est utilisé avec les services de télécopie. La sélection de cette
option est indiquée par un “T” à l'écran.
– [Pause] :
Appuyez sur [Pause] pour insérer une pause entre deux chiffres du
numéro à composer. L'appui une fois sur [Pause] génère un
intervalle d'une seconde entre deux chiffres. Vous pouvez saisir
plusieurs intervalles, indiqués par un “P” à l'écran.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-8 C351
– [-] :
Le tiret est un signe de séparation uniquement. Il n'a aucune
incidence sur la numérotation. Il est indiqué à l'écran par un “-”.
– :
Déplace le curseur vers la gauche.
– :
Déplace le curseur vers la droite.
– [Suppri.] :
Les caractères sont supprimés un par un à partir de la position du
curseur. Si celui-ci se trouve à l'extrême droite de l'entrée, les
caractères précédent le curseur sont supprimés.
– [Ligne extérieure]:
S'affiche si [Définir CN PBX] est réglé sur [ON]. Est indiqué à l'écran
par un [E-].
– Vous pouvez saisir un numéro de 38 chiffres maximum.
– Si vous faites une faute de frappe, appuyez sur [Suppri.] pour
effacer les caractères un par un, sur [C] (clear) pour tout effacer.
– Si la connexion PBX est [ON] lors d'un appel de la ligne intérieure
vers une ligne extérieure, appuyez sur [Pause] après le numéro de
la ligne extérieure (“0”, par exemple) pour sécuriser l'appel. “P”
s'affiche à l'écran.
7 Pour changer le caractère de recherche, appuyez sur [Index], puis
réenregistrez ce caractère.
– Appuyez sur la touche à enregistrer comme caractère de recherche
parmi les touches [ABC] à [etc].
– Si la destination est fréquemment utilisée, précisez le caractère de
recherche et sélectionnez en même temps [Comm]. Ce caractère
de recherche s'affichera en premier lieu dans le carnet d'adresses.
– Le caractère affiché en préfixe du Nom est défini par défaut comme
caractère de recherche.
8 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Le numéro de fax est enregistré dans le carnet d'adresses et la
destination enregistrée apparaît dans la liste.
9 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à un autre enregistrement de numéro de fax dans le
carnet d'adresses, reprenez à l'étape 4.
10 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-9
Enregistrement d'une adresse e-mail dans le carnet d'adresses
L'enregistrement d'une adresse e-mail dans le carnet d'adresses permet
d'envoyer un original numérisé en pièce jointe d'un message. Le fichier est
au format TIFF ou PDF.
La procédure d'enregistrement d'une adresse e-mail dans le carnet
d'adresses est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour le [Carnet d'adresses],
tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [E-Mail].
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-10 C351
4 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
5 Appuyez sur [Nom] et saisissez le nom du carnet d'adresses.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
– Un numéro inutilisé apparaît par défaut dans le champ [No.].
6 Appuyez sur [Adresse E-Mail].
7 Saisissez l'adresse e-mail dans l'écran qui s'affiche, puis appuyez sur
[OK].
– :
Déplace le curseur vers la gauche.
– :
Déplace le curseur vers la droite.
– [Suppri.] :
Les caractères sont supprimés un par un à partir de la position du
curseur. Si celui-ci se trouve à l'extrême droite de l'entrée, les
caractères précédent le curseur sont supprimés.
– L'adresse e-mail peut comporter 320 caractères maximum.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-11
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) pour supprimer toutes les entrées saisies.
8 Pour changer le caractère de recherche, appuyez sur [Index], puis
réenregistrez ce caractère.
– Appuyez sur la touche à enregistrer comme caractère de recherche
parmi les touches [ABC] à [etc].
– Si la destination est fréquemment utilisée, précisez le caractère de
recherche et sélectionnez en même temps [Comm]. Ce caractère
de recherche s'affichera en premier lieu dans la sélection du carnet
d'adresses.
– Le caractère affiché en préfixe du Nom est automatiquement défini
comme caractère de recherche.
9 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
L'adresse e-mail est enregistrée dans le carnet d'adresses et la
destination enregistrée apparaît dans la liste.
10 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à un autre enregistrement dans le carnet d'adresses,
reprenez à l'étape 4.
11 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-12 C351
Enregistrement d'une boîte dans le carnet d'adresses
L'enregistrement d'une boîte dans le carnet d'adresses permet de placer
dans cette boîte l'original numérisé. Le fichier est enregistré au format TIFF.
La procédure d'enregistrement d'une boîte dans le carnet d'adresses est
décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour le [Carnet d'adresses],
tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Boîte utilisateur].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-13
4 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
5 Appuyez sur [Nom] et saisissez le nom du carnet d'adresses.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
– Un numéro inutilisé apparaît par défaut dans le champ [No.].
6 Appuyez sur [Nom boîte utilisateur].
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-14 C351
7 Sélectionnez la boîte à enregistrer et appuyez sur [OK].
– Cette opération suppose l'enregistrement préalable de la boîte.
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement de la boîte, voir
“Manuel d'utilisation - Opérations Boîte”.
8 Pour changer le caractère de recherche, appuyez sur [Index], puis
réenregistrez ce caractère.
– Appuyez sur la touche à enregistrer comme caractère de recherche
parmi les touches [ABC] à [etc].
– Si la destination est fréquemment utilisée, précisez le caractère de
recherche et sélectionnez en même temps [Comm]. Ce caractère
de recherche s'affichera en premier lieu dans la sélection du carnet
d'adresses.
– Le caractère affiché en préfixe du Nom est défini par défaut comme
caractère de recherche.
9 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
La boîte est enregistrée dans le carnet d'adresses et la destination
enregistrée apparaît dans la liste.
10 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à un autre enregistrement dans le carnet d'adresses,
reprenez à l'étape 4.
11 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-15
Modification du contenu du carnet d'adresses
La procédure de modification du contenu du carnet d'adresses est décrite
ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour le [Carnet d'adresses],
tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [No. abrégé], [E-Mail] ou [Boîte utilisateur].
4 Appuyez sur le carnet d'adresses à modifier, puis sur [Modif.].
5 Appuyez sur l'élément à modifier, apportez-y les modifications
voulues, puis appuyez sur [OK].
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-16 C351
6 Confirmez les modifications et appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler la modification, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Pour apporter d'autres modifications, reprenez la procédure à
l'étape 5.
7 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
8 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-17
Suppression du carnet d'adresses
La procédure de suppression du carnet d'adresses est décrite ci-dessous.
0 Si vous supprimez une destination du carnet d'adresses, celle-ci est
également supprimée du groupe et du programme auxquels elle
appartient.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Carnet d'adresses].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour le [Carnet d'adresses],
tapez “1” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [No. abrégé], [E-Mail] ou [Boîte utilisateur].
4 Appuyez sur le carnet d'adresses à supprimer, puis sur [Supprimer].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui] pour confirmer la suppression.
– Pour annuler la suppression, appuyez sur [Non].
Pour procéder à une autre suppression, reprenez à l'étape 4.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-18 C351
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-19
10.3 Enregistrement d'un groupe
Plusieurs carnet d'adresses peuvent être affectés à un groupe. Cette
fonction est utile si vous envoyez régulièrement des informations à plusieurs
destinations en même temps, ou si vous avez choisi la réception en relève
de ces émetteurs.
- Vous pouvez enregistrer jusqu'à 100 groupes (01 à 99, 00), y compris les
groupes utilisés pour la fonction de numérisation.
- Chaque groupe peut comporter jusqu'à 500 carnets d'adresses.
- Un carnet d'adresses peut être enregistré pour le groupe. Veillez
seulement à enregistrer la destination dans ce carnet d'adresses avant
de procéder à l'enregistrement du groupe.
– Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement d'un carnet d'adresses,
voir “Enregistrement du carnet d'adresses” à la page 10-5.
- Chaque groupe peut porter un nom.
Les procédures qui suivent décrivent l'enregistrement d'un carnet
d'adresses et d'un groupe, ainsi que la modification et la suppression d'un
groupe enregistré.
Tenez compte du point suivant :
- L'enregistrement n'est pas disponible tant que le nom, la destination,
l'adresse e-mail ou la boîte n'a pas été défini.
!
Détail
Vous pouvez confirmer les informations enregistrées dans la liste des
groupes.
Pour plus d'informations sur la liste des groupes, voir “Liste d'adresses
de groupe” à la page 12-36
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-20 C351
Enregistrement d'un groupe
La procédure d'enregistrement d'un groupe est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Groupe].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour un [Groupe], tapez “2”
sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
– Si le groupe a déjà été enregistré, vous pouvez modifier les entrées
à ce stade en appuyant sur [Modifier]. Pour plus d'informations, voir
page 10-23.
– Seuls les groupes enregistrés dans [Fax] sont affichés.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-21
4 Appuyez sur [Nom] et saisissez le nom du groupe.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
– Un numéro disponible est affiché par défaut dans le champ [No.].
5 Appuyez sur [Destination].
– Chaque groupe peut comporter jusqu'à 500 carnets d'adresses.
6 Sélectionnez la catégorie à enregistrer dans le groupe parmi [No.
abrégé], [Boîte utilisateur] et [E-Mail].
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-22 C351
7 Sélectionnez la destination à enregistrer dans le groupe.
– Recherche par nom :
Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au caractère de recherche,
puis sélectionnez la destination dans le carnet d'adresses.
– Recherche par numéro :
Affiche les destinations numérotées dans l'ordre d'enregistrement
(écran de 100). Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au numéro du
carnet d'adresses à afficher.
Appuyez sur ou pour faire défiler les numéros.
8 Appuyez sur [OK].
9 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
10 Appuyez sur [OK].
Pour procéder à l'enregistrement d'un autre groupe, reprenez à
l'étape 5.
11 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-23
Modification d'un groupe
La procédure de modification d'un groupe est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Groupe].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour un [Groupe], tapez “2”
sur le clavier.
3 Sélectionnez le groupe à modifier et appuyez sur [Modifier].
– Appuyez sur ou pour faire défiler les pages.
4 Sélectionnez l'élément à modifier, apportez les modifications voulues,
puis appuyez sur [OK] ou sur [Fermer].
5 Confirmez les modifications et appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler les modifications, appuyez sur [Annul.].
6 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-24 C351
Suppression d'un groupe
La procédure de suppression d'un groupe est décrite ci-dessous.
0 La suppression d'un groupe le supprime également du programme
auquel il appartient.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Groupe].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour un [Groupe], tapez “2”
sur le clavier.
3 Sélectionnez le groupe à supprimer et appuyez sur [Supprimer].
– Appuyez sur ou pour faire défiler les pages.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages en sélectionnant le groupe,
puis en appuyant sur [Détails].
4 Appuyez sur [Oui] pour confirmer la suppression.
– Pour annuler la suppression, appuyez sur [Non].
Pour procéder à une autre suppression, reprenez à l'étape 3.
5 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
6 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-25
10.4 Enregistrement d'un programme
Avant d'être enregistrée dans un programme, une destination (numéro de
fax, boîte utilisateur ou e-mail) appelée fréquemment peut être associée au
[Réglage numérisa.] ou au [Réglage communic.] qui sera utilisé. Cela fait, il
suffit d'appuyer sur la touche correspondant au [Programme], de définir les
fonctions de la destination enregistrée ainsi que le [Réglage numérisa.] ou le
[Réglage commnic.], puis d'émettre.
- Vous pouvez enregistrer jusqu'à 400 (001 à 400) programmes, y compris
ceux d'autres fonctions de la machine.
- Chaque programme peut porter un nom.
Les procédures ci-dessous décrivent l'enregistrement d'un programme,
ainsi que la modification et la suppression d'un programme.
Tenez compte du point suivant :
- L'enregistrement n'est pas disponible si le [Nom], l'un quelconque des
[Réglage numérisa.] ou [Réglage communic.], ou la destination ne sont
pas définis.
Enregistrement d'un programme
La procédure d'enregistrement d'un programme est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Programme].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour un [Programme], tapez
“3” sur le clavier.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-26 C351
3 Sélectionnez le programme à enregistrer et appuyez sur [Modifier].
– Affichage de [Réglage numéri.] et [Réglage communic.]
Réglage : ON OFF Non enregistré
Affichage : * - (Espace)
– Appuyez sur ou à gauche de [Liste page] pour afficher
une autre page. Chaque page affiche 15 destinations.
– Appuyez sur [Liste page] pour paramétrer l'affichage d'une liste de
programmes par page.
– Appuyez sur [Changer nom page] dans l'écran Liste page pour le
nom de la page affichée.
– Appuyez sur ou à droite de la liste pour afficher le
programme suivant.
– Si la destination est un scanner, "Destination scanner" est affiché.
4 Appuyez sur [Nom] et tapez le nom du programme.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
– Le nom peut comporter 24 caractères maximum.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-27
5 Appuyez sur [Dest.].
6 Appuyez sur [Sélection dans carnet d'adresses] ou [Saisie directe] pour
préciser la destination.
– Si vous choisissez [Sélection dans carnet d'adresses] :
Sélectionnez une destination dans les carnets d'adresses et les
groupes enregistrés.
– Sélectionnez la destination à enregistrer parmi [No. abrégé], [Boîte
utilisateur], [Groupe] ou [E-Mail].
– Appuyez sur [Recherche par nom] ou [Recherche par numéro], puis
sélectionnez la destination.
– [Recherche par nom] :
Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au caractère de recherche,
puis sélectionnez la destination dans le carnet d'adresses.
– [Recherche par numéro] :
Affiche les destinations numérotées dans l'ordre d'enregistrement
(écran de 100). Appuyez sur la touche correspondant au numéro du
carnet d'adresses à afficher.
Appuyez sur ou pour faire défiler les numéros.
– Appuyez sur [OK].
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-28 C351
– Si vous choisissez la [Saisie directe] :
Définissez la destination de la manière suivante.
– Appuyez sur [No. abrégé], [Boîte utilisateur] ou [E-Mail].
– Saisissez ou sélectionnez la destination, puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des numéros à composer, voir
“Enregistrement d'un numéro de fax dans un carnet d'adresses” à
la page 10-6.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des boîtes, voir
“Enregistrement d'une adresse e-mail dans le carnet d'adresses” à
la page 10-9.
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des adresses e-mail, voir
“Enregistrement d'une boîte dans le carnet d'adresses” à la
page 10-12.
7 Pour paramétrer le [Réglage numérisation] ou le [Réglage
communication], appuyez sur [ON], puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Dans l'écran [Réglage communications], vous pouvez paramétrer
[Réglage E-Mail] et [Notification E-Mail].
– Si [Notification E-Mail] est réglé sur [ON], la fin d'une tâche peut être
confirmée par e-mail à la destination précisée dans le champ
[Notification E-Mail].
– Pour plus d'informations sur [Réglage numérisation] et [Réglage
communication], voir “Applications d'émission” à la page 7-3.
8 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Pour procéder à l'enregistrement d'un autre programme, reprenez à
l'étape 3.
9 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-29
Suppression d'un programme
La procédure de suppression d'un programme est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Programme].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour un [Programme], tapez
“3” sur le clavier.
3 Sélectionnez le programme à supprimer et appuyez sur [Supprimer].
– Appuyez sur ou à gauche de [Liste page] pour afficher
une autre page. Chaque page affiche 15 destinations.
– Appuyez sur [Liste page] pour paramétrer l'affichage d'une liste de
programmes par page.
– Appuyez sur une touche dans l'écran Liste page pour modifier le
nom de la page affichée.
– Appuyez sur ou à droite de la liste pour afficher le
programme suivant.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-30 C351
– Si la destination est un scanner, "Destination scanner" est affiché.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages en sélectionnant le
programme, puis en appuyant sur [Vérifier réglage].
4 Appuyez sur [Oui] pour confirmer la suppression.
– Pour annuler la suppression, appuyez sur [Non].
Pour procéder à une autre suppression, reprenez à l'étape 3.
5 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-31
10.5 Enregistrement du sujet et du texte d'un e-mail
Les procédures d'enregistrement du sujet et du texte d'un e-mail, de
modification et de suppression de ceux-ci sont décrites ci-dessous, de
même que la définition des valeurs par défaut.
!
Détail
Vous pouvez enregistrer jusqu'à 10 sujets d'e-mail et jusqu'à 10 textes
d'e-mail.
Enregistrement du sujet d'un e-mail
La procédure d'enregistrement du sujet d'un e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour
E-mail)], tapez “4” sur le clavier.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-32 C351
3 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
4 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
5 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
– Vous pouvez saisir 64 caractères maximum dans le champ [Sujet]
de l'écran [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– Un numéro inutilisé apparaît par défaut dans le champ [No.].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-33
6 Saisissez le sujet dans l'écran qui s'affiche, puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Le sujet est enregistré et la destination enregistrée apparaît dans la
liste.
8 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à l'enregistrement d'un autre sujet, reprenez à l'étape 4.
9 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-34 C351
Modification du sujet d'un e-mail
La procédure de modification du sujet d'un e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour Email)],
tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-35
4 Sélectionnez le sujet à modifier et appuyez sur [Modifier].
– Appuyez sur ou pour faire défiler les pages.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages en sélectionnant le sujet, puis
en appuyant sur [Détails].
5 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
6 Modifiez le sujet dans l'écran qui s'affiche, puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Le sujet est modifié.
8 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à la modification d'un autre sujet, reprenez à l'étape 4.
9 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-36 C351
Suppression du sujet d'un e-mail
La procédure de suppression du sujet d'un e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour
E-mail)], tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-37
4 Sélectionnez le sujet à supprimer et appuyez sur [Supprimer].
– Appuyez sur ou pour passer à la page précédente ou
suivante.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages en sélectionnant le sujet, puis
en appuyant sur [Détails].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui] pour confirmer la suppression.
– Pour annuler la suppression, appuyez sur [Non].
Le sujet est supprimé.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à la suppression d'un autre sujet, reprenez à l'étape 4.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-38 C351
Réglage par défaut du sujet d'un e-mail
Lors de la transmission de l'e-mail à partir de l'écran Fax, le sujet paramétré
ici en tant que sujet par défaut est adressé à l'ordinateur. La procédure de
réglage du sujet par défaut de l'e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour
E-mail)], tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Sujet].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-39
4 Sélectionnez le sujet voulu et appuyez sur [Régler par défaut].
5 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
6 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-40 C351
Enregistrement du texte d'un e-mail
La procédure d'enregistrement du texte d'un e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
0 Le texte d'un e-mail enregistré ne peut pas être modifié. Vous devez
commencer par supprimer le texte à modifier, puis le réenregistrer.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour
E-mail)], tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Texte].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-41
4 Appuyez sur [Nouveau].
5 Appuyez sur [Texte].
– Vous pouvez saisir 256 caractères maximum dans le champ [Texte]
de l'écran [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– Un numéro inutilisé apparaît par défaut dans le champ [No.].
6 Saisissez le texte dans l'écran qui s'affiche, puis appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations sur la saisie des caractères, voir
page 13-4.
7 Appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour annuler l'enregistrement, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Le texte est enregistré et la destination enregistrée apparaît dans la
liste.
8 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à l'enregistrement d'un autre texte, reprenez à
l'étape 4.
9 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-42 C351
Suppression du texte d'un e-mail
La procédure de suppression du texte d'un e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour Email)],
tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Texte].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-43
4 Sélectionnez le texte à supprimer et appuyez sur [Supprimer].
– Appuyez sur ou pour passer à la page précédente ou
suivante.
– Vous pouvez confirmer les réglages en sélectionnant le texte, puis
en appuyant sur [Détails].
5 Appuyez sur [Oui] pour confirmer la suppression.
– Pour annuler la suppression, appuyez sur [Non].
Le texte est supprimé.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
Pour procéder à la suppression d'un autre texte, reprenez à l'étape 4.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-44 C351
Réglage par défaut du texte d'un e-mail
Lors de la transmission de l'e-mail à partir de l'écran Fax, le texte paramétré
ici en tant que texte par défaut est adressé à l'ordinateur. La procédure de
réglage du texte par défaut de l'e-mail est décrite ci-dessous.
1 Pour afficher l'écran Enregistrement fax, voir “Affichage de l'écran
d'enregistrement du télécopieur” à la page 10-3.
2 Appuyez sur [Sujet / Texte (pour E-mail)].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier un
numéro d'option pour la sélectionner. Pour [Sujet / Texte (pour
E-mail)], tapez “4” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Texte].
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-45
4 Sélectionnez le texte voulu et appuyez sur [Régler par défaut].
5 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
6 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] en bas à gauche.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-46 C351
10.6 Réglage des boîtes confidentielles
La boîte confidentielle est la boîte publique / personnelle attachée à l'aide de
la fonction avancée de boîte.
Cette machine gère la communication confidentielle (F-code).
Pour paramétrer la réception confidentielle, vous devez définir le numéro de
boîte utilisateur, le nom, mot de passe de communication, boîte, index et
type.
- Vous pouvez confirmer le mot de passe des boîtes confidentielles. Pour
plus d'informations, voir page 11-53.
- Pour plus d'informations sur la communication confidentielle, voir
page 7-29.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement des boîtes, voir “Manuel
d'utilisation - Opérations Boîte”.
Vous devez fournir le mot de passe de la boîte utilisateur confidentielle.
La communication confidentielle peut être utilisée sans mot de passe.
No. boîte utilisateur
De 1 à 999999999.
- Ce numéro doit être fourni au télécopieur central qui transmettra les
informations en mode de communication confidentielle.
Nom
Le nom peut comporter 20 caractères maximum.
Mot de passe de communication
Il s'agit du mot de passe au moment de la réception confidentielle.
Les caractères autorisés sont les chiffres 0 à 9, * ou un numéro de 8 chiffres
maximum.
- Ce mot de passe doit être fourni au télécopieur central qui transmettra
les informations en mode de communication confidentielle.
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-47
Mot de passe de boîte
Mot de passe permettant de consulter un document stocké dans la boîte
confidentielle.
!
Détails
Pour plus d'informations sur le mot de passe de boîte, voir "Manuel d'utilisation
- Opérations Boîte".
Principe de la communication confidentielle
En mode de communication confidentielle, chaque fax à un rôle spécifique à
remplir.
Station expéditrice
Spécifie une boîte utilisateur confidentielle
et émet.
Station réceptrice
Ouvre la boîte utilisateur confidentielle pour
recevoir le document.
Un numéro de boîte et un mot de passe de
communication initient la transmission d'un
document fax.
Le document fax reçu contient la boîte
utilisateur confidentielle spécifiée.
Imprime ou supprime le document contenu
dans la boîte utilisateur confidentielle.
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-48 C351
10.7 Réglage du bulletin (tableau électronique)
Cette machine gère l'émission / réception en relève d'un bulletin (tableau
électronique) utilisant la fonction F-code. Ces opérations supposent le
réglage de la boîte utilisateur bulletin.
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations sur l'enregistrement des boîtes bulletin, voir
“Manuel d'utilisation – Opérations Boîte”.
No. boîte utilisateur
De 1 à 999999999.
Nom de la boîte
Le nom peut comporter 20 caractères maximum.
Mot de passe (d'accès)
Mot de passe alphanumérique de 8 caractères maximum.
!
Détails
Les documents enregistrés dans la boîte peuvent être imprimés à l'aide
du mot de passe défini au moment de l'enregistrement des boîtes bulletin.
Principe de l'émission/réception en relève d'un bulletin
!
Détail
Ces informations doivent être fournies au télécopieur central qui recevra
les informations par relève du bulletin.
Pour plus d'informations sur le bulletin (tableau électronique), voir
page 9-9.
Station expéditrice
Envoie les informations en relevant un
bulletin.
Station réceptrice
Reçoit le document en relevant le bulletin
(tableau électronique).
Le document à transmettre en relève doit se
trouver dans le tableau électronique.
Le numéro de la boîte doit être fourni au
récepteur en relève.
Enregistre un bulletin
Enregistrement/Réglages 10
C351 10-49
10.8 Réglage de la boîte utilisateur réception mémoire
Si [Réception mémoire] est réglé sur [ON] dans l'écran Utilitaires, tout
document reçu est enregistré dans la boîte réception mémoire.
!
Détail
Pour connaître la méthode d'impression de la boîte utilisateur réception
mémoire, voir “Réception mémoire” à la page 8-6
10 Enregistrement/Réglages
10-50 C351
11 Mode Utilitaire
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-3
11 Mode Utilitaire
11.1 Écran mode Utilitaire
Un responsable du mode Utilitaire doit être désigné. Cette personne, qui doit
de préférence être unique, sera responsable de la gestion de la machine.
La section suivante décrit les procédures d'accès au mode Utilitaire et de
sortie de celui-ci, ainsi que le réglage des fonctions de fax.
11.1.1 Accès à l'écran Réglage Utilisateur
Accès à l'écran Réglage Utilisateur
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Utilisateur].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-4 C351
11.1.2 Quitter l'écran Réglage Utilisateur
Quitter l'écran Réglage Utilisateur
% Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-5
11.1.3 Accès à l'écran Réglage Administrateur
Accès à l'écran Réglage Administrateur
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
!
Détail
Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans [Réglage
Sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la gestion du mot de
passe.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-6 C351
11.1.4 Quitter l'écran Réglage Administrateur
Quitter l'écran Réglage Administrateur
% Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-7
11.2 Liste du mode Utilitaire fax
Le mode Utilitaire fax inclut les options présentées ci-dessous.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
11.2.1 Écran FAX - réglage par défaut
Réglage Utilisateur >> Réglage Affichage >> Écran FAX Réglage par défaut
Règle les conditions initiales de l'écran Fax. (page 11-14)
11.2.2 Écran Fax actif
Réglage Utilisateur >> Réglage Affichage >> Écran Fax actif
Règle l'affichage ou non du message en cours de transmission. (page 11-19)
11.2.3 Réglage Initial
Réglage Utilisateur >> Réglage Initial
Définit les valeurs par défaut de la fonction Fax. (page 11-17)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Onglet par défaut Définit la valeur par défaut de la
colonne destination dans l'écran Fax.
Programme* / Groupe / Carnet
d'adresses / Saisie directe
Programme par
défaut
Définit le programme par défaut. Temporaire 1-touche / PAGE1*
- PAGE27
Carnet d'adresses
Index par défaut
Définit le carnet d'adresses par défaut. Comm* / ABC - etc
Affichage symbole
type d'adresse
Règle l'affichage ou non du symbole
du type d'adresse.
ON* / OFF
Nombre caractères
par nom d'adresse
Définit le nombre de caractères du
nom de l'adresse à afficher.
14 caract.* / 24 caract.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Affichage émission Règle l'affichage ou non du message
en [Émission].
ON / OFF*
Affichage réception Règle l'affichage ou non du message
en [Réception].
ON / OFF*
Option Description Valeur disponible
Fax [Réglage actuel] :
Avant le passage au mode Utilitaire, toutes les
options définies sur le tableau de commande
sont enregistrées en tant que valeurs par
défaut de la fonction fax.
[Réglage usine] :
Les valeurs définies en usine sont enregistrées
en tant que valeurs par défaut de la fonction
fax.
Réglage actuel* / Réglage
usine
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-8 C351
11.2.4 Passage économie énergie (Fax)
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Système >> Économie d'énergie >>
Passage économie énergie (Fax)
Règle le mode économie d'énergie (Fax). (page 11-22)
11.2.5 Système prioritaire (Réglages sortie Imprimante/Fax)
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Système >> Réglage Sortie >> Système
prioritaire
Définit la méthode d'impression du document reçu. (page 11-25)
11.2.6 Information en-tête
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Information en-tête
Enregistre le nom de l'expéditeur et l'ID du fax. (page 11-28)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Passage
économie
énergie (Fax)
Si [Immédiatement] est sélectionné et que la
machine est en mode économie d'énergie au
moment de l'arrivée d'un signal entrant, la
machine repasse sous ce mode à la fin de la
réception.
Normal* / Immédiatement
Option Description Valeur disponible
Fax Définit la méthode d'impression du document
reçu.
Impression par lots* /
Impression par page
Option Description Valeur disponible
Nom expéditeur Le nom enregistré est imprimé en en-tête sur le
document reçu par le correspondant.
30 caractères et signes
maximum.
No Fax Le numéro (identification) du fax enregistré est
imprimé en en-tête sur le document reçu par le
correspondant.
Le numéro de fax de la machine est entré dans
ce champ.
20 caractères maximum (0
à 9, +, espace, *, #).
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-9
11.2.7 Position en-tête / pied de page
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Position en-tête/pied de page
Définit la méthode de spécification des informations de l'expéditeur et du
récepteur. (page 11-31)
11.2.8 Réglage Paramètres ligne
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Réglage Paramètres ligne
Définit les options d'émission et de réception. (page 11-34)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Position en-tête
*1
Définit la position d'impression des
informations expéditeur.
Intérieur corps texte / Hors
corps du texte* / OFF
Position pied de
page
Définit la position d'impression de l'heure et du
numéro de réception sur le document reçu.
Intérieur corps texte / Hors
corps du texte / OFF*
*1: Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Méthode de
numérotation
*1
Définit la méthode de numérotation. PB* / 10 ips
Mode réception [Récept. auto] définit la réception automatique.
[Réception manuelle] définit la réception dans
le cas d'un lot d'appels réalisés avec un
téléphone externe raccordé ou de l'utilisation
de la fonction de réception distante.
Réception auto* /
Réception manuelle
Nbre de
sonneries sur
appel entrant
Règle le nombre de sonnerie en réception.
Règle le nombre de tonalités de retour d'appel
entre l'arrivée d'un message et le début de la
réception.
0 à 15 (2 fois*)
Nbre de rappels
*2
Définit le nombre de rappels lorsque la ligne du
correspondant est occupée.
0 à 15 (3 fois*)
Délai entre
rappels
Règle l'intervalle de temps entre deux rappels. 1 à 15 (3 min.*)
Suivi audio ligne Définir sur ON pour entendre le son sur la ligne
via le haut-parleur pendant l'émission.
ON / OFF*
Contrôle volume
sonore
Règle le volume sonore du haut-parleur. 0-31 (16*)
*1 : Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
*2 : Les options de ligne diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-10 C351
11.2.9 Réglage Émission/Réception
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Réglage Émis/Récep
Définit la méthode d'impression en mode émission/réception. (page 11-37)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Impression R/V
pour réception
Réglé sur ON (actif), l'original reçu est imprimé
recto verso.
OFF* / ON
Sélection papier
d'impression
Si la priorité du format est réglée :
L'impression est effectuée sur le format
prioritaire. Dans le cas contraire, l'impression
est effectuée dans le format de papier le plus
proche.
Si le format est fixe :
L'impression est effectuée uniquement dans
ce format.
Sélec auto* / Format fixe /
Format prioritaire
Format papier
d'impression *1 *2
Définit le format de papier d'impression du
document reçu.
La valeur par défaut dépend du réglage de
[Papier prioritaire (pouces) sur A4].
A3 / B4 / A4*
Erreur saisie no.
boîte
Définit l'action en cas de saisie d'un numéro de
boîte non enregistré. La sélection de [Création
auto boîte] crée la boîte dont le numéro est
saisi.
Impre.* / Afficher
message d'erreur /
Création auto boîte
Sélection
magasin
impression
réception *2
Définit le magasin de papier à utiliser pour
imprimer le document reçu.
Auto* / Mag 1 / Mag 2 /
Mag 3 / Mag 4
Réduction mini
impres. réception
Règle la réduction de l'original reçu. 87-96*
Imprimer page de
séparation
Définit le mode d'émission par défaut. OFF* / ON
Archiver après
appel en relève
Définit la suppression ou non du document
après l'émission en relève.
Supprimer* / Sauvegarder
*1 : Pour activer le réglage de [Format papier d'impression], réglez [Sélection magasin
impression réception] sur [Auto].
*2 : Selon l'option installée, le type de magasin peut être différent.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-11
11.2.10Réglage fonction
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Réglage fonction
Active/Désactive (ON/OFF) les fonctions d'émission/réception. (page 11-40)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Régl. fonct ON/OFF
Fonction
d’émission
F-code
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Activer/
Désactiver (ON/OFF) les fonctions
d'émission/réception.” à la page 11-40.
ON* / OFF
Réception
mémoire
Cette fonction permet de recevoir les
documents et de les mémoriser en vue
d'une impression ultérieure.
ON / OFF*
RX réseau fermé La réception en réseau fermé permet de
ne recevoir les données entrantes que si
le mot de passe de l'expéditeur est
valide.
ON / OFF*
Définir un mot de passe de 4
chiffres.
Régl. transfert TX Cette fonction permet de transférer les
données reçues vers une station
déterminée à l'avance.
OFF* / Transfert et Impres. /
Transf. + Imp. si erreur
Dest. de transfert
Vérif. mot de
passe RX
confidentiel
Vous pouvez confirmer les numéros
d'accès confidentiels définis.
-
Réglage RX fax La fonction RX PC-fax permet
d'enregistrer les fichiers de fax reçus
dans des boîtes sur le disque dur.
OFF* / ON
Boîte fixe / Boîte spécifiée
Paramètre boîte
utilisateur TSI
Cette fonction permet d'allouer les
originaux reçus selon leurs informations
TSI.
ON / OFF*
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-12 C351
11.2.11Définir CN PBX
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Définir CN PBX
Définit la méthode de connexion de la ligne PBX. (page 11-64)
Option Description Valeur disponible
Définir CN PBX Sélectionner ON si le FK-502 est raccordé à
une ligne PBX.
Si le mode CN PBX est réglé sur ON, ce
paramètre détermine le code d'accès à la ligne
extérieure, c'est à dire le préfixe lié au numéro
de téléphone et composé avec celui-ci si
l'option de ligne extérieure est sélectionnée
avec un numéro abrégé ou un programme.
ON / OFF*
Si réglé sur ON, numéro
d'accès à la ligne
extérieure.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-13
11.2.12Réglage Rapports
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Réglage Rapports
Définit la méthode d'impression d'un rapport. (page 11-66)
11.2.13Liste Paramètres tâche
Réglage Administrateur >> Réglage Fax >> Liste Paramètres tâche
!
Détail
Pour plus d'informations, voir page 12-45.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Rapport
d'activité
Détermine l'impression ou non du rapport et
l'intervalle/la plage de cette impression.
OFF / Quotidien / Toutes
les 100 com.* / 100/jour
Rapport
émission
ON / Sur erreur seulement*
/ OFF
Rapport
émission
séquentiel
ON* / OFF
Rapport
émission
programmée
ON* / OFF
Rapport
réception
confidentielle
ON* / OFF
Rapport
émission bulletin
ON* / OFF
Magasin papier
pour rapport *1
Spécifie le magasin utilisé pour l'impression
d'un rapport.
Magasin 1 / Magasin 2* /
Magasin 3 / Magasin 4 /
Introduct. manuelle
Vérif. rapport
résultat émission
Détermine l'affichage ou non de l'écran de
sélection du rapport de résultat de l'émission.
Si vous sélectionnez ON, cet écran s'affiche
après chaque émission.
OFF* / ON
*1 : Selon l'option installée, le type de magasin peut être différent.
* : Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-14 C351
11.3 Écran Fax réglage par défaut
Définit les conditions initiales de l'écran Fax.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Onglet par
défaut
Définit la valeur par défaut de la colonne
destination dans l'écran Fax.
Programme* / Groupe /
Carnet d'adresses / Saisie
directe
Programme par
défaut
Définit le programme par défaut. Temporaire 1-touche /
PAGE1* - PAGE27
Carnet
d'adresses Index
par défaut
Définit le carnet d'adresses par défaut. Comm* / ABC - etc
Affichage
symbole type
d'adresse
Définit l'affichage ou non du symbole du type
d'adresse.
ON* / OFF
Nombre
caractères par
nom d'adresse
Définit le nombre de caractères du nom de
l'adresse à afficher.
14 caract.* / 24 caract.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-15
Écran Fax réglage par défaut
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Utilisateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Utilisateur” à la page 11-3).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Affichage].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Affichage], tapez “2” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Écran fax - Réglage par défaut].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-16 C351
4 Sélectionnez l'option à régler.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-17
11.4 Réglage Initial
Définit la valeur par défaut de la fonction Fax.
Vous pouvez régler la fonction fax sélectionnée lorsque la machine est sous
tension ou en appuyant sur [Réinitialiser].
Affichez l'écran Fax et appuyez sur [Utilitaire/Compteur].
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Réglage Initial
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Utilisateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Utilisateur” à la page 11-3).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Initial].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Initial], tapez “3” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Fax [Réglage actuel]:
Avant le passage au mode Utilitaire, toutes les
options définies sur le tableau de commande
sont enregistrées en tant que valeurs par
défaut de la fonction fax.
[Réglage usine]:
Les valeurs définies en usine sont enregistrées
en tant que valeurs par défaut de la fonction
fax.
Réglage actuel* / Réglage
usine
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-18 C351
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage usine], puis sur [OK].
– Si vous voulez annuler un réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.]
4 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
5 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-19
11.5 Écran Fax actif
Définit l'affichage ou non du message en cours de transmission.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Écran Fax actif
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Utilisateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Utilisateur” à la page 11-3).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Affichage].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Affichage], tapez “2” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Affichage
émission
Définit l'affichage ou non du message en
[Émission].
ON / OFF*
Affichage
réception
Définit l'affichage ou non du message en
[Réception].
ON / OFF*
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-20 C351
3 Appuyez sur [Écran Fax actif].
4 Sélectionnez [Affichage émission] ou [Affichage réception].
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-21
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-22 C351
11.6 Passage économie énergie (Fax)
Passage économie énergie (Fax)
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Passage économie énergie (Fax)
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Système].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Système], tapez “1” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Passage
économie
énergie (Fax)
Si [Immédiatement] est sélectionné et que la
machine est en mode économie d'énergie au
moment de l'arrivée d'un signal entrant, la
machine repasse sous ce mode à la fin de la
réception.
Normal* / Immédiatement
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-23
3 Appuyez sur [Économie d'énergie].
4 Appuyez sur [Passage économie énergie (Fax)].
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-24 C351
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-25
11.7 Système prioritaire (Réglages sortie Imprimante/Fax)
Définit la méthode d'impression du document reçu.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Système prioritaire (Réglages sortie Imprimante/Fax)
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Système].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Système], tapez “1” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Fax Définit la méthode d'impression du document
reçu.
Impression par lots* /
Impression par page
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-26 C351
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage sortie].
4 Appuyez sur [Système prioritaire].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-27
5 Sélectionnez la méthode d'impression.
– Impression par lots :
L'impression commence une fois que tous les documents ont été
reçus.
– Impression par page :
L'impression est réalisée dès la réception d'une page de
document.
– Si l'option [Impression R/V pour réception] est réglée sur [ON],
l'impression commence dès que les données des deux pages ont
été reçues.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-28 C351
11.8 Information en-tête
Enregistre le nom de l'expéditeur et l'ID du fax.
Information en-tête
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Nom expéditeur Le nom enregistré est imprimé en en-tête sur le
document reçu par le correspondant.
30 caractères et signes
maximum.
No Fax Le numéro (identification) du fax enregistré est
imprimé en en-tête sur le document reçu par le
correspondant.
Le numéro de fax de la machine est entré dans
ce champ.
20 caractères maximum (0
à 9, +, espace, *, #).
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-29
3 Appuyez sur [Information en-tête].
4 Appuyez sur [Nom expéditeur].
L'écran de saisie du nom s'affiche.
5 Saisissez le nom de l'expéditeur et appuyez sur [OK].
– Pour plus d'informations, voir “Saisie de texte” à la page 13-4.
6 Tapez le numéro de fax de l'expéditeur à l’aide du clavier et des
touches +, espace, ou .
– + :
Représente le signe “+”.
– Espace :
Représente un espace.
–
Déplace le curseur vers la gauche.
–
Déplace le curseur vers la droite.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-30 C351
– Suppri. :
Les caractères sont supprimés un par un à partir de la position du
curseur. Si celui-ci se trouve à l'extrême droite de l'entrée, les
caractères précédent le curseur sont supprimés.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.]
– Pour corriger une entrée, appuyez sur [C] (clear) sur le tableau de
commande.
7 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
Le nom et le numéro de fax de l'expéditeur saisis sont enregistrés.
8 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-31
11.9 Position en-tête/pied de page
Vous pouvez activer/désactiver (ON/OFF) cette fonction d'impression, qui
identifie la station d'origine et l'heure de la réception. Si vous sélectionnez
ON, vous pouvez également choisir d'imprimer ces informations.
!
Détail
Les informations identifiant la station d'origine, qui peuvent être
imprimées sur la station réceptrice, sont l'ID et le nom du fax. Pour plus
d'informations, voir “Informations sur l'expéditeur” à la page 3-53.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Position en-tête
*1
Définit la position d'impression des
informations expéditeur.
Intérieur corps texte :
Les informations expéditeurs seront
imprimées dans la zone
correspondant au document.
Hors corps du texte :
Les informations expéditeurs seront
imprimées en dehors de la zone
correspondant au document.
OFF :
Les informations expéditeur ne seront
pas imprimées.
Position pied
de page
Définit la position d'impression de
l'heure et du numéro de réception
sur le document reçu.
Intérieur corps texte :
Les informations d'heure/numéro
seront imprimées dans la zone
correspondant au document.
Hors corps du texte :
Les informations d'heure/numéro
seront imprimées au bas des pages
reproduites.
OFF* :
Les informations d'heure/numéro ne
seront pas imprimées.
* : Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
*1 : Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-32 C351
Position en-tête/pied de page
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Position en-tête / pied de page].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-33
4 Sélectionnez l'option à régler.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-34 C351
11.10 Réglage Paramètres ligne
Les options de ligne disponibles sont les suivantes.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Méthode de
numérotation *1
Définit la méthode de numérotation. PB* / 10 ips
Mode réception [Récept. auto] définit la réception automatique.
[Réception manuelle] définit la réception dans
le cas d'un lot d'appels réalisés avec un
téléphone externe connecté ou de l'utilisation
de la fonction de réception distante.
Réception auto* /
Réception manuelle
Nbre de sonneries
sur appel entrant
Définit le nombre de sonnerie en réception.
Définit le nombre de tonalités de retour d'appel
entre l'arrivée d'un message et le début de la
réception.
0 à 15 (2 fois*)
Nbre de rappels *2 Définit le nombre de rappels lorsque la ligne du
correspondant est occupée.
0 à 15 (3 fois*)
Délai entre
rappels
Définit l'intervalle de temps entre deux rappels. 1 à 15 (3 min.*)
Suivi audio ligne Définir sur ON pour entendre le son sur la ligne
via le haut-parleur pendant l'émission.
ON / OFF*
Contrôle volume
sonore
Règle le volume sonore du haut-parleur. 0-31 (16*)
*1 : Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
*2 : Les options de ligne diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
* : Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-35
Réglage Paramètres ligne
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage paramètres ligne].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-36 C351
4 Sélectionnez l'option à régler.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
– Pour modifier [Contrôle volume sonore], appuyez sur [Contrôle
volume sonore], puis sur [Plus faible] ou [Plus fort] pour définir le
niveau. Appuyez ensuite sur [OK].
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-37
11.11 Réglage Émission/Réception
Les options d'émission et de réception sont présentées ci-dessous.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Impression R/V
pour réception
Réglé sur ON (actif), l'original reçu est imprimé
recto verso.
Non indiqué si [Imprimer page de séparation]
est réglé sur ON.
OFF* / ON
Sélection papier
d'impression
Si la priorité du format est réglée :
L'impression est effectuée sur le format
prioritaire. Dans le cas contraire, l'impression
est effectuée sur le format de papier le plus
proche.
Si le format est fixe :
L'impression est effectuée uniquement dans
ce format.
Sélec auto* / Format fixe /
Format prioritaire
Format papier
d'impression *1 *2
Définit le format de papier d'impression du
document reçu.
La valeur par défaut dépend du réglage de
[Papier prioritaire (pouces) sur A4].
A3 / B4 / A4*
Erreur saisie no.
boîte
Définit l'action en cas de saisie d'un numéro de
boîte non enregistré. La sélection de [Création
auto boîte] crée la boîte dont le numéro est
saisi.
Impre.* / Afficher
message d'erreur /
Création auto boîte
Sélection magasin
impression
réception *2
Définit le magasin de papier à utiliser pour
imprimer le document reçu.
Auto* / Mag 1 / Mag 2 /
Mag 3 / Mag 4
Réduction min.
pour impression
réception
Règle l'agrandissement de l'original reçu. 87-96*
Imprimer page de
séparation
Définit le mode d'émission par défaut.
Non indiqué si Impression R/V pour réception
est réglée sur ON.
OFF* / ON
Archiver après
appel en relève
Définit la suppression ou non du document
après l'émission en relève.
Supprimer* /
Sauvegarder
* : Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
*1 : Pour activer le réglage de [Format papier d'impression], réglez [Sélection magasin
impression réception] sur [Auto].
*2 : Selon l'option installée, le type de magasin peut être différent.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-38 C351
Réglage Émission/Réception
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Émis/Récep].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-39
4 Sélectionnez l'option à régler.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-40 C351
11.12 Réglage fonction
Vous pouvez activer/désactiver chacune des fonctions d'émission et de
réception individuellement.
11.12.1Réglage fonction ON/OFF
Sélectionnez ON ou OFF pour chaque fonction.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Activer/Désactiver (ON/OFF) les fonctions d'émission/réception.
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Quitter l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-6).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Régl. fonct ON/OFF
Fonction
d’émission
F-code
La sélection de “OFF” désactive à la fois la
demande d'émission en relais et l'émission
via plusieurs stations de relais.
Pour plus d'informations sur les
communications en relais, voir “Requête
d'émission en relais (Émission F-code)” à la
page 7-32.
ON* / OFF
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-41
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
4 Appuyez sur [Régl. fonct ON/OFF].
– Si [Réception mémoire], [Réglage transfert TX], [Réglage RX fax] ou
[Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI] est réglé sur ON, les autres éléments
ne sont pas affichés.
5 Sélectionnez l'option à régler.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-42 C351
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
6 Sélectionnez la valeur voulue de l'option.
7 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
– La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
8 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-43
11.12.2Réception mémoire obligatoire
Vous pouvez activer ou désactiver la réception mémoire inconditionnelle,
c'est-à-dire la mémorisation des documents reçus en vue de leur impression
ultérieure.
Si vous sélectionnez ON, définissez le mot de passe d'impression de 8
caractères maximum.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
!
Détail
Si la Réception mémoire est réglée sur ON, le Réglage RX fax, le
Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI et le Réglage transfert TX ne sont pas
disponibles.
Pour imprimer un document reçu en mode de réception mémoire, voir
“Réception mémoire” à la page 8-6.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Réception
mémoire
obligatoire
Cette fonction permet de recevoir les
documents et de les mémoriser en vue
d'une impression ultérieure.
ON / OFF*
Définissez un mot de passe de
8 caractères maximum.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-44 C351
Réglage de la réception mémoire
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Quitter l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-6).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-45
4 Appuyez sur [Réception mémoire obligatoire].
5 Appuyez sur [ON] et saisissez dans le champ [Mot passe] le mot de
passe (8 caractères) requis pour imprimer le document reçu.
– Le mot de passe peut contenir jusqu'à 8 caractères.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.]
6 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-46 C351
11.12.3RX réseau fermé
Vous pouvez activer ou désactiver la fonction de réception en réseau fermé.
Si vous activez cette fonction (ON), vous devez préciser le mot de passe de
clôture du réseau, composé de 4 caractères.
Avec la réception en réseau fermé, le FK-502 ne reçoit les données entrantes
que si le mot de passe de l'expéditeur est valide. Le FK-502 vérifie si le mot
de passe de l'expéditeur correspond à celui qui est défini sur la machine. Si
les deux mots de passe diffèrent ou si l'expéditeur ne fournit pas de mot de
passe, la machine génère une erreur de communication.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Option Description Valeur disponible
RX réseau fermé La réception en réseau fermé permet de
ne recevoir les données entrantes que si
le mot de passe de l'expéditeur est valide.
ON / OFF*
Le mot de passe peut contenir
jusqu'à 4 caractères.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-47
Réglage de la réception en réseau fermé
0 Conditions requises de la réception en réseau fermé
Cette fonction n'est disponible que si la machine du correspondant est
dotée de la fonction Transmission de mot de passe.
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-48 C351
4 Appuyez sur [RX Réseau fermé].
5 Appuyez sur [ON] et saisissez dans le champ [Mot passe] le mot de
passe requis pour imprimer le document reçu.
– Le mot de passe peut contenir jusqu'à 4 caractères.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
– Pour annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
6 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-49
11.12.4Réglage Transfert TX
Vous pouvez activer ou désactiver la fonction de transfert de fax. Si cette
fonction est active, les données reçues sont transférées à une station
déterminée à l'avance.
!
Détail
Si Régl. transfert TX est réglé sur [Transfert et Impres.] ou [Transf. + Imp.
si erreur], les options Réception mémoire, Réglage RX Fax et Paramètre
boîte utilisateur TSI ne sont pas disponibles.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Régl. transfert TX Cette fonction permet de transférer les
données reçues vers une station
déterminée à l'avance.
OFF* / Transfert et Impres. /
Transf. + Imp. si erreur
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-50 C351
Réglage du transfert de fax (Réglage transfert TX)
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-51
4 Appuyez sur [Régl. transfert TX].
5 Sélectionnez [Transfert et Impress.] ou [Transf. + Imp. si Erreur].
– OFF
Le document reçu n'est pas transféré.
– Transfert et Impression
Le document reçu est transféré après impression sur cette
machine.
– Transfert + Impression si Erreur
Le document reçu est transféré.
En cas d'échec du transfert, le document est imprimé sur cette
machine.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-52 C351
6 Saisissez dans le champ [Adresse transf.] le numéro de fax du
destinataire du transfert.
– Vous pouvez saisir jusqu'à 38 caractères dans le champ [Adresse
transf.].
– Vous pouvez utiliser les préfixes [Tonalité], [Pause] et [-]. Voir
“Sélection de la destination” à la page 3-21.
– Vous pouvez appuyer sur [Carnet d'adresses] pour sélectionner
l'[Adresse transf.] dans un [carnet d'adresses] enregistré.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.]
7 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée et vous revenez à l'écran Utilitaire.
8 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-53
11.12.5Vérification du mot de passe RX confidentiel
Vous pouvez confirmer les numéros d'accès confidentiels définis.
!
Détail
Pour enregistrer les numéros d'accès confidentiels, voir “Réglage des
boîtes confidentielles” à la page 10-46.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Vérif. mot de passe
RX confidentiel
Vous pouvez confirmer les numéros
d'accès confidentiels définis.
-
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-54 C351
Confirmation du mot de passe d'une boîte confidentielle
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-55
4 Appuyez sur [Vérif. mot de passe RX confidentiel].
5 Sélectionnez la boîte confidentielle dont vous voulez confirmer le mot
de passe.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-56 C351
11.12.6Réglage RX fax
Vous pouvez activer ou désactiver la fonction RX PC-Fax.
Si cette fonction est réglée sur ON, indiquez la boîte d'enregistrement de la
sortie.
La fonction RX PC-fax permet d'enregistrer dans des boîtes sur le disque dur
les fichiers contenant les fax reçus. Vous pouvez ensuite lire le contenu des
boîtes sur les ordinateurs du réseau.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
!
Détail
Si Réglage RX fax est ON, la Réception mémoire, le Paramètre boîte
utilisateur TSI et Régl. transfert TX ne sont pas disponibles.
Les documents fax reçus sont sauvegardés au format TIFF dans la boîte
fixe, la boîte spécifiée ou la boîte de réception (TSI).
Expéditeur Original
Disque dur
Option Description Valeur disponible
Réglage RX fax La fonction RX PC-fax permet d'enregistrer les
fichiers de fax reçus dans des boîtes sur le
disque dur.
ON / OFF*
Sortie RX Le fichier de fax reçu est enregistré dans la Boîte
utilisateur réception mémoire si Sortie RX est
réglé sur Boîte fixe, et dans la boîte spécifiée par
la fonction F-code (adresse secondaire) si Sortie
RX est réglé sur Boîte spécifiée.
Boîte fixe* / Boîte
spécifiée
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-57
Réglage RX fax
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-58 C351
4 Appuyez sur [Réglage RX Fax].
5 Sélectionnez [ON] pour [Réglage RX Fax].
– Les affichages diffèrent d'un pays à un autre.
– OFF :
La fonction RX PC-fax n'est pas disponible.
– ON :
La fonction RX PC-fax est exécutée à réception d'un numéro de fax
ou de PC-fax, et le document reçu est sauvegardé dans la boîte
spécifiée.
6 Pour [Sortie RX], sélectionnez la boîte dans laquelle sera sauvegardé
un document reçu via la fonction RX PC-fax.
– Boîte fixe :
un fichier reçu est stocké dans la boîte réception mémoire.
– Boîte spécifiée :
un fichier reçu est stocké dans la boîte stipulée par la fonction F-code
(adresse secondaire).
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-59
– Pour plus d'informations sur le fonctionnement de la réception
PC-fax, voir “Fonctionnement de la Réception PC-fax” à la
page 2-21.
7 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée et vous revenez à l'écran Utilitaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-60 C351
11.12.7Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI
Cette fonction permet d'allouer les documents reçus par le fax. Les fichiers
d'originaux reçus sont sauvegardés dans les boîtes correspondant à l'ID fax
(TSI) des expéditeurs.
!
Détail
Si Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI est ON, la Réception mémoire, le
Réglage transfert TX et le Réglage RX Fax ne sont pas disponibles.
Expéditeur Original
Disque dur
Option Description Valeur disponible
Paramètre boîte
utilisateur TSI
Cette fonction permet d'allouer les
originaux reçus selon leurs informations
TSI.
ON / OFF*
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-61
Allocation des originaux reçus à l'expéditeur du fax
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fonction].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-62 C351
4 Appuyez sur [Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI].
5 Appuyez sur [ON].
6 Sélectionnez le numéro à enregistrer et appuyez sur [Modif.].
– Si vous voulez supprimer une distribution, sélectionnez-la et
appuyez sur [Suppri.].
– Vous pouvez enregistrer 128 boîtes maximum.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-63
7 Utilisez le clavier numérique, [+], [ESPACE] ou pour saisir l'ID
du fax dans le champ [Expéditeur (TSI)].
– +
Insère le signe +.
– Espace
Insère un espace.
–
Déplace le curseur vers la gauche.
–
Déplace le curseur vers la droite.
– Suppri.
Les caractères sont supprimés un par un à partir de la position du
curseur. Si celui-ci se trouve à l'extrême droite de l'entrée, les
caractères précédent le curseur sont supprimés.
– Lors de la transmission, [+] et [ESPACE] sont ignorés.
8 Appuyez sur [No. boîte ut] et tapez le numéro de la boîte
d'enregistrement du document reçu.
– Plage de numéros disponibles : 1 à 999999999.
9 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
Le Paramètre boîte utilisateur TSI est défini.
10 Appuyez sur [Quitt.].
L'écran de distribution des fax reçus s'affiche à nouveau.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-64 C351
11.13 Réglage CN PBX (Private Branch Exchange)
Les options PBX disponibles sont décrites ci-dessous.
* Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
Options du mode de connexion PBX (Private Branch Exchange)
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
Option Description Valeur disponible
Définir mode
PBX CN
Sélectionner ON si le FK-502 est raccordé à
une ligne PBX.
ON / OFF*
Ligne extérieure Si le mode PBX CN est réglé sur ON, ce
paramètre détermine le code d'accès à la ligne
extérieure, c'est à dire le préfixe lié au numéro
de téléphone et composé avec celui-ci si
l'option de ligne extérieure est sélectionnée
avec un numéro abrégé ou un programme.
0-9999
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-65
3 Appuyez sur [Définir CN PBX].
4 Sélectionnez [ON] pour Définir mode PBX CN.
5 Saisissez au clavier le code de la ligne extérieure.
– Appuyez sur [C] (clear) si vous voulez supprimer les données
saisies.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Annul.]
6 Appuyez sur [OK], puis sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-66 C351
11.14 Réglage Rapports
Vous pouvez activer ou désactiver (ON/OFF) le Réglage rapports. Cette
fonction imprime les rapports de communication à la direction, les rapports
de résultats et spécifie les magasins d'entrée/sortie des rapports. Si cette
fonction est activée (ON), la méthode d'impression peut également être
sélectionnée.
!
Détail
Si “Vérif. rapport résultat émission” est actif (ON), le rapport d'émission
est imprimé si OUI est sélectionné. Il n'est pas imprimé dans le cas
contraire (NON).
Option Description Valeur disponible
Rapport d'activité Détermine l'impression ou non du rapport et
l'intervalle/la plage de cette impression.
OFF / Quotidien / Toutes
les 100 com.* / 100/jour
Rapport Émission ON / Sur erreur seulement*
/ OFF
Rapport émission
séquentiel
ON* / OFF
Rapport émission
programmée
ON* / OFF
Rapport réception
confidentielle
ON* / OFF
Rapport émission
bulletin
ON* / OFF
Magasin papier
pour rapport *1 *2
Spécifie le magasin utilisé pour l'impression
d'un rapport.
Magasin 1 / Magasin 2* /
Magasin 3 / Magasin 4 /
Introduct. manuelle
Vérif. rapport
résultat émission
Détermine l'affichage ou non de l'écran de
sélection du rapport de résultat de
l'émission. Si vous sélectionnez ON, cet
écran s'affiche après chaque émission.
OFF* / ON
* : Indique le réglage par défaut défini en usine.
*1 : Selon l'option installée, le type de magasin peut être différent.
*2 : Le Magasin 1 est le magasin par défaut, si aucune option de magasins n'est installée.
Mode Utilitaire 11
C351 11-67
Réglage des rapports
1 Ouvrez l'écran Réglage Administrateur (voir “Accès à l'écran Réglage
Administrateur” à la page 11-5).
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
3 Appuyez sur [Réglage Rapports].
11 Mode Utilitaire
11-68 C351
4 Sélectionnez le rapport à régler.
– Appuyez sur ou pour afficher l'écran suivant ou
précédent.
– Si vous voulez annuler le réglage, appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone
secondaire.
5 Sélectionnez l'option voulue.
6 Appuyez sur [Fermer].
La valeur de l'option est modifiée.
7 Appuyez sur [Quitt.] dans la zone secondaire.
12 Rapports et listes
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-3
12 Rapports et listes
12.1 Types de rapports et de listes
Vous pouvez imprimer sur cette machine les types de rapports et de listes
suivants :
12.1.1 Rapports
Les rapports sont de trois types : impression automatique, méthode
d'impression paramétrable, impression selon les besoins.
Nom du rapport Description
Rapport d'activité Ce rapport liste les 100 (maximum) dernières émissions et
réceptions sur des pages distinctes (une pour les émissions,
l'autre pour les réceptions). Selon les besoins, la liste des
émissions, celle des réceptions, ou ces deux listes peuvent être
imprimées.
• L'impression du rapport d'activité est réglée dans le mode
Utilitaire sur OFF*, Quotidien, Toutes les 100 com. ou 100/jour*.
• Les rapports suivants peuvent être sélectionnés et imprimés
via l'écran Fax. ([Liste tâches] - [onglet Émission fax] -
[Historique tâches] - [Réglage comm.])
• Rapport d'activité, Rapport Émission, Rapport Réception
Rapport Émission Le Rapport Émission est imprimé automatiquement. Le mode
Utilitaire définit l'impression des rapports Émission sur Toujours
si l'impression est active (ON) / Sur erreur seulement / OFF.
Rapport d'émission (relève) Si le Rapport Émission est réglé sur ON ou Sur erreur seulement
dans les réglages administrateur du mode Utilitaire, le résultat de
l'émission en relève sont automatiquement imprimés.
Rapport de relève Si le Rapport Émission est réglé sur ON ou Sur erreur seulement
dans les réglages Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, le résultat de
la réception en relève est automatiquement imprimé.
Rapport de diffusion Si Rapport émission séquentielle est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est imprimé
automatiquement à la fin de l'émission diffusée séquentielle.
Rapport de relève
séquentielle (réception)
Si Rapport émission séquentielle est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, le résultat de la réception en
relève de plusieurs destinations est automatiquement imprimé.
Rapport de communication
réservée
Si Rapport Émission programmée est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est
automatiquement imprimé lorsqu'une émission est réservée.
Rapport d'émission
réservée (relève)
Si Rapport émission programmée est réglée sur ON dans
Réglage Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est
automatiquement imprimé lorsqu'une émission en relève est
réservée.
12 Rapports et listes
12-4 C351
12.1.2 Listes
Les listes sont imprimées selon les besoins.
Rapport de diffusion
réservée
Si Rapport émission programmée est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est
automatiquement imprimé lorsqu'une émission multiposte
séquentielle est réservée.
Rapport de réception réservée
(relève)
Si Rapport émission programmée est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est automatiquement
imprimé lorsqu'une relève programmée vers une destination
est réservée.
Rapport de relève
séquentielle réservée
(réception)
Si Rapport émission programmée est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est
automatiquement imprimé lorsqu'une relève programmée vers
plusieurs destinations est réservée.
Rapport réception
confidentielle
Si Rapport réception confidentielle est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, ce rapport est
automatiquement imprimé à la réception d'un document
confidentiel.
Rapport Émission bulletin Si Rapport émission bulletin est réglé sur ON dans Réglage
Administrateur du mode Utilitaire, le résultat de l'émission en
relève au bulletin board (tableau électronique) est
automatiquement imprimé.
Nom du rapport Description
Nom de la liste Description
Liste Carnet d'adresses Les numéros enregistrés dans le carnet d'adresses peuvent être
imprimés.
Liste Programme Les numéros enregistrés dans un programme peuvent être
imprimés.
Liste d'adresses de groupe Les numéros enregistrés dans un groupe peuvent être imprimés.
Liste de Titres/Textes La liste de sujets et de textes (e-mail) peut être imprimée.
Liste des réglages du fax Les réglages du mode Utilitaire peuvent être imprimés.
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-5
12.2 Rapport d'activité
Le rapport d'activité liste les 100 (maximum) dernières émissions et
réceptions sur des pages distinctes (une pour les émissions, l'autre pour les
réceptions). Ce rapport peut être imprimé automatiquement, ou imprimé
selon les besoins, en totalité (rapport d'activité), pour les émissions
uniquement (rapport d'émission, ou pour les réceptions uniquement (rapport
de réception).
12.2.1 Impression automatique
L'intervalle d'impression du rapport d'activité peut être défini dans Réglage
Rapports.
12.2.2 Impression manuelle
Le rapport d'activité peut être imprimé manuellement comme suit.
Impression manuelle
1 Appuyez sur [Liste tâches] dans l'écran Fax.
2 Appuyez sur l'onglet [Émission fax].
3 Appuyez sur [Historique tâches].
12 Rapports et listes
12-6 C351
4 Appuyez sur [Réglage comm.].
5 Appuyez sur [Rapport d'activité], [Rapport émission] ou [Rapport
réception].
6 Appuyez sur [Imprimer].
Le rapport est imprimé.
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-7
!
Détail
Un message s'affiche si le papier requis ne se trouve pas dans le magasin
destiné aux rapports et aux listes. Chargez le papier requis.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Un numéro de série est attribué à chaque émission et à chaque
réception.
Destination Contient les informations suivantes (cet espace est vide en l'absence de
ces informations).
• Nom si celui-ci a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros abrégés
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de début Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication
Impressions Nombre de pages émises ou reçues. En cas d'émission mémoire, le
nombre de pages émises et le nombre total de pages sont indiqués.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-8 C351
!
Détail
Les éléments indiqués dépendent des réglages optionnels.
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-9
12.3 Rapport Émission
12.3.1 Impression manuelle
Les informations suivantes apparaissent si l'émission est réglée sur [ON]
dans [Réglage Rapports]-[Rapport Émission] du mode Utilitaire.
Appuyez sur [Oui] pour imprimer le Rapport Émission ; sur [Non] pour ne pas
imprimer ce rapport. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à
la page 11-67.
12.3.2 Impression automatique
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON], [Sur erreur seulement]
ou [OFF] dans [Rapport Émission] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le
mode Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
12 Rapports et listes
12-10 C351
Élément Description
No. Un numéro de série est attribué à chaque émission et à chaque
réception.
Destination Indique :
• Nom si celui-ci a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros abrégés ou
la liste d'entrée
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure début
émission
Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication
Impressions Nombre de pages émises. En cas d'émission mémoire, le nombre de
pages émises et le nombre total de pages sont indiqués.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas aboutie parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-11
12.4 Rapport d'émission (en relève)
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement à la suite de l'émission en relève
d'un document enregistré dans la boîte relève émission.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
Émission] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode Utilitaire. Pour
plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Le nom de la destination s'il est enregistré dans la liste Carnet
d'adresses.
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de création Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication
Impressions Nombre de pages émises.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-12 C351
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-13
12.5 Rapport de relève
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement à réception de la relève.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
Émission] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode Utilitaire. Pour
plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Un nom de destination s'il est enregistré dans la liste Carnet
d'adresses.
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de début Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication
Impressions Nombre de pages émises.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-14 C351
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-15
12.6 Rapport de diffusion
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement à la suite d'une émission
multiposte séquentielle.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission séquentielle] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Un nom de destination s'il est enregistré dans la liste Carnet
d'adresses.
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de début Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication.
Impressions Nombre de pages émises. Le nombre de pages émises et le nombre
total de pages sont indiqués.
12 Rapports et listes
12-16 C351
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-17
12.7 Rapport de relève séquentielle (réception)
Le rapport de relève séquentielle vers plusieurs destinations est imprimé
automatiquement.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission séquentielle] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Nom de la destination s'il a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros
abrégés, et
• Numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de début Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication.
Impressions Nombre de pages transmises.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-18 C351
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-19
12.8 Rapport de communication réservée
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement en cas d'émission programmée.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission programmée] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Nom si celui-ci a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros abrégés
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de création Heure d'émission programmée.
Heure de début Heure spécifiée en cas d'émission programmée.
Impressions Nombre de pages numérisées.
12 Rapports et listes
12-20 C351
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-21
12.9 Rapport d'émission réservée (relève)
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement lorsqu'une émission en relève est
réservée.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission programmée] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Non indiquée.
Heure de création Heure d'émission programmée.
Heure de début Non indiquée.
Impressions Nombre de pages numérisées.
12 Rapports et listes
12-22 C351
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-23
12.10 Rapport de diffusion réservée
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement à la suite de la réservation d'une
émission multiposte séquentielle.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission programmée] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Nom de la destination s'il a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros
abrégés, et
• Numéro de téléphone de la destination s'il a été sélectionné au clavier.
Heure de création Heure à laquelle l'émission a été réservée.
Heure de début Heure spécifiée en cas d'émission programmée.
Impressions Nombre de pages numérisées.
12 Rapports et listes
12-24 C351
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-25
12.11 Rapport de réception réservée (relève)
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement lors de la réservation de la relève
d'une destination.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission programmée] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Numéro de téléphone de la destination.
Heure de création Heure de réception de la relève.
Heure de début Heure spécifiée en cas d'émission programmée (réservée).
Impressions Nombre de pages transmises.
12 Rapports et listes
12-26 C351
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-27
12.12 Rapport de relève séquentielle réservée (réception)
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement lors de la réservation de la relève
de plusieurs destinations.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission programmée] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Numéro de téléphone de la destination.
Heure de création Heure de réception de la relève.
Heure de début Heure spécifiée en cas d'émission programmée (réservée).
Impressions Nombre de pages transmises.
12 Rapports et listes
12-28 C351
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-29
12.13 Rapport réception confidentielle
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement suite à la réception d'un document
confidentiel.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
réception confidentielle] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode
Utilitaire. Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la
page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Nom de la destination s'il a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros
abrégés
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de création Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication.
Impressions Nombre de pages transmises.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-30 C351
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-31
12.14 Rapport Émission bulletin
Ce rapport est imprimé automatiquement à la suite de l'émission en relève
d'un document enregistré dans la boîte utilisateur Bulletin.
L'impression automatique peut être réglée sur [ON] ou [OFF] dans [Rapport
émission bulletin] de la fonction [Réglage Rapports] dans le mode Utilitaire.
Pour plus d'informations, voir “Réglage des rapports” à la page 11-67.
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Destination Indique :
• Nom de la destination s'il a été enregistré dans la liste de numéros
abrégés
• Le numéro de téléphone de la destination
Heure de création Heure à laquelle la communication a commencé.
Heure Durée de la communication.
Impressions Nombre de pages transmises.
Résultat OK La communication s'est terminée normalement.
ARRET La communication a été interrompue.
ETEIND L'interrupteur est hors tension.
TEL Appel téléphonique entrant.
ECHEC Une erreur de communication s'est produite.
Erreur Une erreur s'est produite et le FK-502 est passé
en rappel de la page d'erreur.
Pas ré La destination appelée n'a pas répondu.
Occupé La communication n'a pas abouti parce que la
ligne est occupée.
M-plei La mémoire fax disponible a été dépassée
pendant la réception, et celle-ci a échoué.
12 Rapports et listes
12-32 C351
Note Indique la ou les remarques suivantes.
DIF: Communication différée
D/R: Relève
ORG: Format original
BOR: Effacement bords
ODI: Original de format différent (mixte)
MAN: Téléphone
CSRC: CS remote care (appel distant)
TR: Retransmission
PC: PC-fax
REL: Position reliure
OS: Original spécial
CODEF: Fonction F-Code
MBX: Confidentiel
BLTN: Bulletin board
Élément Description
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-33
12.15 Liste Carnet d'adresses
Liste Carnet d'adresses
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans
[Paramètre sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la
gestion du mot de passe.
4 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option
[Enregistrement 1-touche], tapez “3” sur le clavier.
5 Appuyez sur [Liste enregistre. 1-touche].
6 Appuyez sur [Liste Carnet d'adresses].
12 Rapports et listes
12-34 C351
7 Tapez au clavier la plage de numéros d'enregistrements à imprimer
dans le champ [No. enregistrement] et sélectionnez [E-Mail], [Boîte
utilisat.] ou [Fax] pour le champ [Type de destination].
– Vous pouvez indiquer 100 numéros d'enregistrements maximum.
– Appuyez sur pour déplacer le curseur vers la gauche, sur
pour le déplacer vers la droite.
– Pour corriger une entrée, appuyez sur [C] (clear) sur le tableau de
commande.
8 Appuyez sur [Impr.].
9 Sélectionnez le magasin de papier.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La liste Carnet d'adresses est imprimée.
!
Détail
Si le papier requis n'est pas chargé dans le magasin indiqué, la touche
[Départ] clignote en rouge. Dans ce cas, vous ne pouvez pas appuyer sur
[Départ].
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-35
Description de la liste Carnet d'adresses
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Numéro abrégé.
Nom Nom enregistré
Numéro tél. Numéro de fax enregistré dans le carnet d'adresses
Réglage ligne * indiqué s'il a été paramétré.
12 Rapports et listes
12-36 C351
12.16 Liste d'adresses de groupe
Liste d'adresses de groupe
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans
[Paramètre sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la
gestion du mot de passe.
4 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option
[Enregistrement 1-touche], tapez “3” sur le clavier.
5 Appuyez sur [Liste enregistre. 1-touche].
6 Appuyez sur [Liste groupe].
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-37
7 Tapez au clavier la plage de numéros d'enregistrements à imprimés
dans le champ [No. enregistrement].
– Vous pouvez indiquer 20 numéros d'enregistrements maximum.
– Appuyez sur pour déplacer le curseur vers la gauche, sur
pour le déplacer vers la droite.
– Pour corriger une entrée, appuyez sur [C] (clear) sur le tableau de
commande.
8 Appuyez sur [Impr.].
9 Sélectionnez le magasin de papier.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La liste d'adresses de groupe est imprimée.
!
Détail
Si le papier requis n'est pas chargé dans le magasin indiqué, la touche
[Départ] clignote en rouge. Dans ce cas, vous ne pouvez pas appuyer sur
[Départ].
12 Rapports et listes
12-38 C351
Description de la liste d'adresses de groupe
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Numéro du groupe
Nom Nom du groupe
Adr. No. Numéros abrégés enregistrés dans le groupe
Nombre enregist. Nombre de numéros abrégés enregistrés dans le groupe
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-39
12.17 Liste Programme
Liste Programme
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans
[Paramètre sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la
gestion du mot de passe.
4 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option
[Enregistrement 1-touche], tapez “3” sur le clavier.
5 Appuyez sur [Liste enregistre. 1-touche].
6 Appuyez sur [Liste Programme].
12 Rapports et listes
12-40 C351
7 Tapez au clavier la plage de numéros d'enregistrements à imprimer
dans le champ [No. enregistrement] et sélectionnez [E-Mail], [Boîte
utilisat.], [Fax], [Numéro abrégé] ou [No. groupe] pour le champ [Type
de destination].
– Vous pouvez indiquer 50 numéros d'enregistrements maximum.
– Appuyez sur pour déplacer le curseur vers la gauche, sur
pour le déplacer vers la droite.
– Pour corriger une entrée, appuyez sur [C] (clear) sur le tableau de
commande.
8 Appuyez sur [Impr.].
9 Sélectionnez le magasin de papier.
10 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La liste Programme est imprimée.
!
Détail
Si le papier requis n'est pas chargé dans le magasin indiqué, la touche
[Départ] clignote en rouge. Dans ce cas, vous ne pouvez pas appuyer sur
[Départ].
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-41
Description de la Liste Programme
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Numéro d'enregistrement du programme
Nom Nom de l'enregistrement
Numéro abrégé Numéro abrégé de l'enregistrement
No. boîte utilisateur Numéro d'enregistrement de la boîte utilisateur
Adresse E-Mail Adresse e-mail enregistrée
Élément Fonctions du FK-502.
Setting Valeur de réglage sélectionnée
12 Rapports et listes
12-42 C351
12.18 Liste de Titres/Textes
La liste de sujets et de textes (e-mail) enregistrés peut être imprimée.
Liste de Titres/Textes
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans
[Paramètre sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la
gestion du mot de passe.
4 Appuyez sur [Enregistrement 1-touche].
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option
[Enregistrement 1-touche], tapez “3” sur le clavier.
5 Appuyez sur [Liste enregistre. 1-touche].
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-43
6 Appuyez sur [Liste Sujet/Texte E-Mail].
7 Sélectionnez le magasin de papier.
8 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La liste Titres/Textes est imprimée.
!
Détail
Si le papier requis n'est pas chargé dans le magasin indiqué, la touche
[Départ] clignote en rouge. Dans ce cas, vous ne pouvez pas appuyer sur
[Départ].
12 Rapports et listes
12-44 C351
Description de la liste de Titres/Textes
Nom de la liste Élément Description
Liste Sujet No. Numéro de l'enregistrement.
Sujet Sujet enregistré en tant que sujet/texte (pour un
e-mail).
Liste de textes No. Numéro de l'enregistrement.
Texte Texte enregistré en tant que sujet/texte (pour un
e-mail).
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-45
12.19 Liste des réglages du fax
La liste des réglages du fax peut être imprimée.
Liste des réglages du fax
1 Appuyez sur [Fax], puis sur [Utilitaire/Compteur] sur le tableau de
commande.
2 Appuyez sur [Réglage Administrateur].
3 Saisissez le mot de passe et appuyez sur [OK].
– Le mot de passe de l'administrateur peut être modifié dans
[Paramètre sécurité]. L'administrateur a la responsabilité de la
gestion du mot de passe.
4 Appuyez sur [Réglage Fax].
– Certaines options de réglages optionnels peuvent ne pas être
indiquées.
– En mode Utilitaire, vous pouvez également taper sur le clavier le
numéro de l'option pour la sélectionner. Pour l'option [Réglage
Fax], tapez “8” sur le clavier.
12 Rapports et listes
12-46 C351
5 Appuyez sur [Réglage Multi lignes].
6 Sélectionnez le magasin de papier.
7 Appuyez sur [Départ].
La liste des réglages du fax est imprimée.
!
Détail
Si le papier requis n'est pas chargé dans le magasin indiqué, la touche
[Départ] clignote en rouge. Dans ce cas, vous ne pouvez pas appuyer sur
[Départ].
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-47
Description de la liste des réglages du fax
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
Élément Fonction du mode Utilitaire.
Réglages Valeur de réglage sélectionnée
12 Rapports et listes
12-48 C351
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Rapports et listes 12
C351 12-49
12.19.1Liste confidentielle/bulletin
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Numéro de boîte enregistré avec le réglage confidentiel / bulletin board.
Nom Nom enregistré.
Mot de passe Mot de passe confidentiel.
Type Confidentiel ou Bulletin board.
12 Rapports et listes
12-50 C351
12.19.2Boîte émetteur (TSI)
* Les rapports que vous imprimez peuvent être différents de ceux qui
sont illustrés dans ce manuel.
Élément Description
No. Numéro d'enregistrement de l'expéditeur (TSI) RX
Expédit. (TSI) Informations sur l'expéditeur enregistré.
No. boîte Numéro d'enregistrement de la boîte
13 Annexe
Annexe 13
C351 13-3
13 Annexe
13.1 Nombre de pages mémorisées
Cette machine est équipée en standard d'un disque dur de 40 Go. Les
images de fax sont sauvegardées dans la zone 27 Go du disque dur.
Ce disque dur a une capacité de stockage et de réception dans chacun des
modes (copie, imprimante, numérisation, boîte et fax) d'environ 9 000
originaux Konica standard au format A4 contenant chacun 700 mots (en
définition “fine”).
La taille, l'état et la définition des originaux a toutefois une incidence sur le
nombre de pages sauvegardées sur le disque dur.
!
Détail
La mémoire peut saturer pendant la lecture de l'original. Dans ce cas,
vous pouvez soit émettre la partie lue de l'original, soit recommencer la
procédure.
13 Annexe
13-4 C351
13.2 Saisie de texte
La section suivante explique comment utiliser le clavier affiché sur l'écran
tactile pour saisir les noms des comptes enregistrés et les formats de papier
personnalisés. Vous pouvez également y taper les numéros.
Les différents claviers pouvant apparaître sont illustrés ci-dessous.
Exemple
Écran de saisie du mot de passe
Écran de saisie d'une adresse e-mail
Écran de saisie d'un e-mail
Annexe 13
C351 13-5
La procédure suivante explique comment se servir du clavier tactile affiché
sur l'écran de saisie d'une adresse e-mail.
13 Annexe
13-6 C351
Pour taper du texte
% Touchez la touche du caractère voulu sur le clavier affiché.
– Pour saisir une lettre en majuscule ou un symbole exigeant le
clavier en majuscule, touchez [Maj.].
– Vous pouvez également taper des chiffres sur ce clavier.
Les caractères saisis s'affichent dans la zone de texte.
2
Remarque
Pour annuler le texte saisi, appuyez sur [Annul.].
Pour effacer tout le texte saisi, appuyez sur la touche [C] (clear).
!
Détail
Pour modifier un caractère dans le texte saisi, touchez et/ou
pour placer le curseur devant ce caractère, touchez [Suppri.], puis
retapez la lettre ou le chiffre voulu.
Liste des caractères disponibles
Type Caractères disponibles
Caractères
alphanumériques /
symboles
Annexe 13
C351 13-7
13.3 Glossaire
Cette section décrit les termes de communication fax employés.
Certaines définitions s'appliquent à des fonctions non employées sur cette
machine.
Termes Description
Caractères
numériques
2 en 1 TX Fonction de réunion de deux pages en une seule et
d'émission de la page au format large ainsi composée.
B bps Abréviation de “bit par seconde”, unité de transmission de
données représentant la quantité de données envoyée par
seconde.
Bulletin board (tableau électronique) Fonction permettant de poster les
documents à lire ou à émettre en relève.
C Carnet
d'adresses
Carnet permettant d'appeler la destination en recherchant
son nom dans la liste de numéros abrégés enregistrés.
Communication
confidentielle
Fonction d'échange d'informations confidentielles avec
certaines personnes déterminées. L'original émis avec cette
fonction est enregistré dans la boîte confidentielle du
destinataire, sans impression. L'impression d'une
communication confidentielle exige un mot de passe.
Communications
internationales
Cette fonction permet d'émettre à une vitesse de
transmission moins rapide. Elle est particulièrement utile lors
de l'émission d'un fax dans une région (nationale comprise)
où les conditions de communication sont moins fiables.
D Débordement
mémoire
État de saturation de la mémoire de cette machine pendant
la mémorisation d'un document transmis.
Définition Plus la définition est fine, plus le temps de transmission est
long. Il convient de sélectionner la définition appropriée.
Diffusion Émission d'un fax vers plusieurs postes, en une seule
opération.
13 Annexe
13-8 C351
E ECM (Error
Correction Mode)
(code de correction d'erreur) Ce mode est utilisé avec la
communication G3. La transmission exacte des données et
leur bonne réception sont vérifiées. En cas d'erreur, les
données sont émises à nouveau. Si la destination gère ce
mode de vérification des erreurs, les données sont
transmises sous ce mode, à moins que la fonction ECM OFF
n'ait été activée.
Effacement bords Fonction permettant d'effacer les bandes noires reproduites
lorsque l'original est un livre ou qu'il est lu avec le chargeur
de document ouvert.
Émission de
substitution
Fonction de transfert/émission des documents reçus en
attente d'impression, par le biais du tableau de commande.
Cette fonction peut être réglée sur l'écran Fax lorsque
l'opération a été interrompue en raison d'un manque de
papier ou d'un bourrage papier dans la machine.
Émission différée
(TX)
Fonction permettant de spécifier l'heure de début de la
communication. L'exécution de l'émission la nuit ou tôt le
matin permet de tirer parti de tarifs plus intéressants.
Émission en relais Fonction d'envoi d'un fax à plusieurs stations via une station
de relais. En cas d'émission vers des stations distantes, la
configuration de l'une des stations en tant que station relais
permet de réduire les coûts de communication.
Émission groupée Fonction de transmission simultanée du dernier document
réservé avec le document réservé précédent si la destination
et les conditions de transmission (émission mémoire,
définition, etc.) sont les mêmes. Cette fonction peut émettre
jusqu'à cinq documents.
Émission livre Fonction qui génère deux pages distinctes à partir de deux
pages en vis à vis d'un livre ou d'un catalogue ouvert.
Émission
manuelle
Fonction d'émission de documents tout en confirmant l'état
de la machine réceptrice.
Émission
mémoire
Avec cette méthode, toutes les pages sont numérisées, puis
mémorisées avant l'émission. Le document est
automatiquement paginé et les images de la première page
apparaissent dans le rapport de communication.
Lors de l'émission d'un grand nombre de pages ou si les
images des originaux sont hautement définies, la capacité de
la mémoire peut toutefois être dépassée.
Émission par lot Fonction d'émission automatique d'un document à une
heure donnée si la destination, l'heure d'émission, l'émission
mémoire et la définition ne changent pas.
Termes Description
Annexe 13
C351 13-9
F F-code Stipule l'utilisation de l'adresse secondaire du protocole
T.30* normalisé par l'ITU-T. Plusieurs fonctions F-code
peuvent être utilisées sur les télécopieurs gérant ce code,
quels que soient leurs fabricants. Sur cette machine, la
fonction F-code s’utilise dans le bulletin board, pour les
requêtes de transmission en relais, les communications
confidentielles et les émissions d'ID. (* il s’agit d’une des
normes de communication.)
Format original Fonction de désignation du format du document à envoyer.
En principe, si le format de papier chargé à la destination est
trop petit pour recevoir l'image transmise, cette image est
réduite pour tenir dans la feuille. Cette fonction permet
d'imprimer une partie de l'image sans réduction.
G G3 L'un des modes de communication fax normalisés par l'ITUT.
C'est le mode le plus utilisé.
Groupe Regroupement de plusieurs numéros abrégés. Cette
fonction est utile si vous utilisez fréquemment l'émission
séquentielle multiposte ou la réception en relève. Un groupe
peut contenir jusqu'à 500 numéros abrégés.
H Haut/Bas Fonction de précision du type de reliure lors de l'émission
d'un document recto-verso. Le type de reliure sélectionné
permet de le lire correctement de droite à gauche ou de haut
en bas.
I ID Fax Code permettant d'identifier le fax émetteur et récepteur. Le
numéro de fax est généralement enregistré en tant qu'ID du
fax.
Informations de
l'expéditeur
Informations telles que la date d'émission, le nom et le
numéro de téléphone de l'expéditeur, ainsi que le nombre de
pages, imprimées en haut du document reçu par la
destination.
L Lecture Numérisation optique d'un original et capture de cet original
en tant que données d'image.
M Mémoire Emplacement de stockage des données. La mémoire peut
contenir les réglages de la communication et le document à
émettre/reçu.
Mémoire rapide Avec cette méthode, l'émission du fax s'effectue
immédiatement après la numérisation de chaque page. C'est
la méthode recommandée pour ne pas saturer la mémoire
dans le cas de l'émission d'un document volumineux.
Méthode de
numérotation
Il existe deux méthodes de numérotation : à impulsions
(décimale) et à fréquences vocales (DTME).
Mot de passe
émission (TX)
Fonction de transmission de fax avec un mot de passe.
L'expéditeur doit utiliser le même mot de passe que celui qui
est paramétré sur la machine réceptrice fonctionnant en
réseau fermé, si cette machine est la destination.
Termes Description
13 Annexe
13-10 C351
N Nom expéditeur Nom de la machine, représenté par des caractères
alphanumériques et des signes. Ce nom est imprimé en haut
du document reçu par le destinataire.
Nombre total de
pages
Fonction plaçant automatiquement le nombre total de pages
sur chaque page du fax en mode Mémoire rapide. Cette
fonction permet au destinataire de vérifier la bonne réception
de toutes les pages du document.
Numérisation
horizontale
L'original est numérisé à l'horizontale.
Numérisation
verticale
L'original est numérisé à la verticale.
Numéro abrégé L'une des fonctions d'enregistrement des numéros de fax
fréquemment composés. L'enregistrement du nom de la
destination et du caractère de recherche avec le numéro
abrégé permet ensuite de désigner la destination dans le
carnet d'adresses. 500 numéros abrégés (000 à 499)
peuvent être enregistrés.
O Original long Fonction permettant d'émettre des pages plus longues que
le format 11 × 17 (420 mm/16,5 pouces). Cette fonction doit
être choisie avant l'émission d'un document long, faute de
quoi la machine génère un message d'erreur
d'acheminement du papier. Les pages de 800 mm maximum
peuvent être émises sous ce mode.
Original plié Fonction déterminant le format de l'original avant sa lecture
et son émission. Certains télécopieurs ne détectent pas le
format d'un document plié. Cette fonction n'est disponible
que si le document est placé dans le chargeur de document.
Originaux mixtes Fonction permettant de régler et d'envoyer des pages de
différents formats en une seule procédure.
P Pause Cette fonction inclut une pause dans la numérotation.
L'appui une fois sur la touche Pause crée un intervalle d'une
seconde.
Programme Fonction d'enregistrement des numéros de fax fréquemment
utilisés et des modèles de procédures dans un programme.
Cela fait, la destination ou la procédure voulue est
sélectionnée en appuyant sur la touche Programme (dans la
liste de numéros abrégés).
Termes Description
Annexe 13
C351 13-11
R Rappel Renuméroter la même destination. Le rappel peut s'effectuer
automatiquement ou manuellement.
Réception en
mémoire
Fonction de mémorisation automatique du document reçu
s'il ne peut être imprimé en raison de manque de papier.
Réception
mémoire
Fonction d'enregistrement, et d'impression le cas échéant,
du document reçu.
Ré-émission Fonction de sélection des documents dont l'émission a
échoué. Les documents sont mémorisés, puis émis à
nouveau à la même destination ou à une autre.
Réglage usine Valeur par défaut définie en usine. Ces valeurs peuvent être
modifiées en mode Utilitaire. La définition d'une valeur
utilisée fréquemment en tant que valeur par défaut accélère
les procédures.
Relève Fonction d'envoi d'un fax, qui a été lu et enregistré sur le
disque dur du télécopieur, au moment où le destinataire
envoie une commande de relève.
Réservation
d'émission
Fonction de réservation de l'émission suivante pendant une
communication ou une impression.
S Station d'origine Le télécopieur fournissant les instructions d'émission d'un
document vers plusieurs stations.
Station relais Le télécopieur émettant le document vers plusieurs stations
à la demande de la station d'origine.
Super G3 (SG3) Mode de communication G3 conforme au protocole V.34 de
l'ITU-T, plus rapide (jusqu'à 33 400 bps) que la
communication G3 standard.
T Temps de
transmission
La durée d'émission d'un fax. Plus la définition est fine, plus
le temps de transmission est long.
V V.34 Protocole de communication en super G3. Ce mode est
disponible si le récepteur et l'expéditeur sont connectés à la
ligne via une extension de matériel de central.
Vitesse de
transmission
Débit de transmission du modem sur le télécopieur. Il peut
être réglé sur le haut débit de 33 600 bps. En mode de
communication internationale, ce débit peut être réduit lors
de l'émission d'un fax dans une région où les conditions de
communication sont moins fiables. Le débit peut alors être
réglé sur 7 200 ou 4 800 bps.
Termes Description
13 Annexe
13-12 C351
13.4 Index
A
Accessibilité, tableau de commande
.................................................. 2-5
Aide, tableau de commande .... 2-6
Ajustement fond .............7-6, 7-15
Alimentation, tableau de commande
.................................................. 2-5
Annul. ....................................... 7-5
Annuler, tableau de commande 2-5
Appels récents # .................... 3-27
Arrêt, tableau de commande ... 2-5
Authentification utilisateur ..... 2-17
B
Boîte ....................................... 2-18
Boîte bulletin board ............... 2-20
Boîte d'émission en relève ..... 2-20
Boîte d'impression sécurisée . 2-20
Boîte émetteur (TSI) ............. 12-50
Boîte spécifiée ....................... 2-19
Boîte système ........................ 2-20
Boîte utilisateur ........................ 2-9
Boîte utilisateur réception
mémoire .....................2-20, 10-49
Boîte, tableau de commande .. 2-4
Boîtes confidentielles ........... 10-46
Bulletin (tableau électronique)
............................................. 10-48
Bulletin board (tableau électronique)
................................................ 9-10
C
C, tableau de commande ........ 2-5
Carnet d'adresses .........2-8, 2-15
............................3-19, 3-23, 10-5
chargeur ADF .................3-7, 3-10
Clavier .................................... 3-21
Clavier, tableau de commande 2-5
Code, tableau de commande ...2-4
Communication confidentielle 7-29
Communications internationales
.......................................3-50, 7-6
Compte de service .................2-17
Contraste, tableau de commande
...................................................2-5
Contrôle, tableau de commande....
...................................................2-5
Copie, tableau de commande ..2-4
D
Décrocher ...............................2-15
Définir mode PBX CN ...........11-64
Définition ................................3-15
Densité ...................................3-13
Départ, tableau de commande 2-5
Données, tableau de commande
...................................................2-5
E
ECM OFF ........................7-6, 7-35
Écran Fax actif ...........11-7, 11-19
Écran Fax
réglage par défaut ......11-7, 11-15
Écran tactile .............................2-4
Effacement bords ...........7-6, 7-12
E-mail .......................................2-9
Émission différée (TX) .....3-47, 7-6
Émission en relève ...................9-4
Émission en relève (TX) ............7-6
Émission F-code (TX) ...............7-6
Enregistrer ds boîte ut. ...........3-27
Epreuve, tableau de commande
...................................................2-5
F
Fax, tableau de commande .....2-4
Format de numérisat. ...............7-6
Format de numérisation .........7-21
Annexe 13
C351 13-13
G
Groupe .......................2-15, 10-19
I
Imprimer page de séparation .4-12
Imprimer page de séparation
...............................................4-13
Indicateur de destination .......2-16
Indicateur de page .................2-15
Information en-tête
...........................2-7, 11-8, 11-28
INTERRUPTEUR, tableau de
commande ...............................2-5
Interruption, tableau de commande
..................................................2-5
L
Ligne extérieure ...................11-64
Liste Carnet d'adresses .......12-33
Liste confidentielle/bulletin ..12-49
Liste d'adresses de groupe .12-36
Liste de Titres/Textes ...........12-42
Liste des caractères
disponibles .............................13-6
Liste des réglages du fax .....12-45
Liste pages .............................2-15
Liste Paramètres tâche ........11-13
Liste Programme ..................12-39
Liste tâches ..................2-15, 3-37
M
Mémoire .................................2-15
Mémoire rapide ..............3-42, 7-6
Mémoire saturée ......................5-6
Méthode de numérotation .......2-7
Mode réception ........................2-7
Mot de passe
émission (TX) ..................7-6, 7-26
N
Netteté ........................... 7-6, 7-18
Nº de fax expéditeur ................ 2-7
No. abrégé ..................... 2-9, 3-27
No. de destinat. ..................... 2-15
Nom dest. ............................. 2-15
Nom expéditeur ....................... 2-7
Nombre d'originaux ............... 3-45
Nombre originaux .................... 7-6
Numérisation vers E-mail ...... 3-27
Numérisation, tableau de
commande .............................. 2-4
O
Occupé .................................... 5-6
OFF .......................................... 7-5
OK ........................................... 7-5
Originaux mixtes .............. 7-5, 7-7
P
Paramètre boîte
utilisateur TSI ....................... 11-60
Pas de réponse ....................... 5-6
Passage économie
énergie (Fax) .............. 11-8, 11-22
Pause ..................................... 3-27
Paysage ................................. 1-24
Portrait ................................... 1-24
Position en-tête/
pied de page ............. 11-9, 11-32
Position reliure ................. 7-5, 7-9
Programme .................. 2-12, 2-15
.................................... 3-22, 10-25
R
Rappel ................................... 3-32
Rapport d'activité .................. 12-5
Rapport d’émission
(en relève) ............................ 12-11
Rapport d’émission
réservée (relève) .................. 12-21
13 Annexe
13-14 C351
Rapport de communication
réservée ............................... 12-19
Rapport de diffusion ............ 12-15
Rapport de diffusion
réservée ............................... 12-23
Rapport de réception réservée
(relève) .................................12-25
Rapport de relève
(réception) ............................ 12-13
Rapport de relève
séquentielle (réception) ........ 12-17
Rapport de relève séquentielle
réservée (réception) ............. 12-27
Rapport Émission .................. 12-9
Rapport émission bulletin .... 12-31
Rapport réception
confidentielle ........................ 12-29
Réception en relève ................. 9-7
Réception en relève (RX) .......... 7-6
Réception mémoire
obligatoire ............................ 11-43
Réception PC-fax .................. 2-21
Recherche avancée ............... 3-23
Recherche LDAP ................... 3-24
Recto/Recto-verso ................ 3-14
Réglage comm. ...................... 2-16
Réglage communication ........ 3-17
Réglage E-mail ....................... 3-18
Réglage Émission/
Réception .................11-10, 11-38
Réglage fonction .................. 11-11
Réglage Initial ............11-7, 11-17
Réglage ligne ........................... 7-6
Réglage numérisation .. 2-15, 3-17
Réglage
Paramètres ligne .................... 11-9
Réglage
paramètres ligne .......... 2-7, 11-35
Réglage Rapports ....11-13, 11-67
Réglage RX fax ..........2-21, 11-56
Réglage Transfert TX ........... 11-49
Réinitialiser, tableau de commande
...................................................2-5
Requête d'émission en relais .7-32
Reset ........................................7-5
RX réseau fermé ...................11-46
S
Saisie de texte ........................13-6
Saisie directe ................2-15, 3-26
Sortie RX ..............................11-56
Sujet .....................................10-31
Système prioritaire (Réglages
sortie Imprimante/Fax)
.....................................11-8, 11-25
T
Tableau de commande ............2-4
Texte ....................................10-31
Tonalité ...................................3-26
Type d'image original .............3-12
Type de fichier ................7-6, 7-24
U
Utilitaire/Compteur, tableau de
commande ...............................2-5
V
V34 OFF .........................7-6, 7-38
Vérif. mot de passe
RX confidentiel .....................11-53
Vérifier détails de la tâche
(Contrôle) ................................3-19
Vitre d'exposition .. 3-8, 3-9, 3-10
Annexe 13
C351 13-15
Z
Zone secondaire ....................2-16
Notes d'installation à l'intention des utilisateurs de Windows 7 et de Windows Server 2008 R2 Page 1/15
IMPORTANT: Notes d'installation à l'intention des utilisateurs de Windows 7 et de Windows Server 2008 R2
Les programmes d'installation automatisée contenus sur le CD ou le DVD-ROM fourni avec la machine ont été initialement conçus pour les systèmes d'exploitation Microsoft jusqu'à Windows Vista seulement.
Pour procéder à une installation sous le nouveau système d'exploitation Microsoft Windows 7 ou Microsoft Windows Server 2008 R2, veuillez suivre les étapes décrites dans ce document.
A - Sommaire :
Cette procédure s'applique aux modèles d'imprimante suivants dont la version figure sur le CD ou DVD-ROM Utilitaires et Documentation :
-
bizhub C20P 1.00EU, 1.01EU, 1.30EU
-
bizhub C31P 1.00EU, 1.30EU
-
bizhub 40P 1.00EU, 1.01EU, 1.30EU
-
magicolor 1650 1.00EU, 1.30EU
-
magicolor 4650 1.00EU, 1.30EU
-
magicolor 5650 1.00EU, 1.01EU, 1.30EU
-
magicolor 5670 1.00EU, 1.01EU, 1.30EU
-
magicolor 7450II 1.00EU, 1.10EU, 1.20EU
-
magicolor 8650 1.00EU, 1.10EU
-
pagepro 4650 1.00EU, 1.30EU
-
pagepro 5650 1.00EU, 1.30EU
Si le CD/DVD-ROM fourni avec votre machine indique une version supérieure, vous n'avez pas besoin d'appliquer cette procédure; vous pouvez simplement utiliser le programme d'installation intégré qui démarrera automatiquement une fois que le CD/DVD-ROM aura été inséré dans le lecteur.
Cette procédure s'applique aux systèmes d'exploitation suivants :
-
Windows 7 (Toutes éditions)
-
Windows Server 2008 R2 (Toutes éditions)
Si vous utilisez un précédent système d'exploitation, comme Microsoft Windows XP ou Microsoft Windows Vista, vous n'avez pas besoin de suivre cette procédure; vous pouvez simplement utiliser le programme d'installation intégré qui démarrera automatiquement une fois que le CD/DVD-ROM aura été inséré dans le lecteur.
Fiery X3eTY2 65C-KM Color Server
Drucken in Farbe
© 2006 Electronics for Imaging, Inc. Die in dieser Veröffentlichung enthaltenen Informationen
werden durch den Inhalt des Dokuments
Rechtliche Hinweise
für dieses Produkt abgedeckt.
45057655
03. November 2006
INHALT 3
I
NHALT
E
INFÜHRUNG
7
Terminologie und Konventionen
7
Aufbau dieses Dokuments
8
Schlüsselfunktionen von ColorWise
8
C
OLOR
W
ISE
P
RO
T
OOLS
10
Aufbau dieses Abschnitts
10
Einrichten der ColorWise Pro Tools unter Windows
11
Installieren der ColorWise Pro Tools 11
Installieren von ICC-Profilen 11
Konfigurieren der Verbindung 13
Bearbeiten der Konfiguration 15
Einrichten der ColorWise Pro Tools unter Mac OS
15
Installieren der ColorWise Pro Tools unter Mac OS 15
Installieren von ColorSync Profilen 16
Konfigurieren der Verbindung 18
Bearbeiten der Konfiguration 20
ColorWise Pro Tools
21
Calibrator 21
Color Editor 21
Profile Manager 25
Spot-On 31
Color Setup 32
INHALT 4
K
ALIBRIERUNG
34
Aufbau dieses Abschnitts
34
Kalibrieren mit Komponente Calibrator der ColorWise Pro Tools
35
Starten von Calibrator 35
Profi-Modus 36
Anwenden von Messwerten auf mehrere Kalibrierungssets 37
Wiederherstellen der Standardmesswerte für die Kalibrierung 38
Kalibrieren mit ColorCal 39
Kalibrieren mit DTP32 oder DTP32 Series II 42
Kalibrieren mit DTP41 44
Kalibrieren mit ED-100 47
Kalibrieren mit ES-1000 51
Kalibrieren über Kopiererdisplay
54
Kalibrieren mit ColorCal 54
Zweck der Kalibrierung
56
Übersicht 56
Funktionsweise der Kalibrierung 56
Zeitplanung für die Kalibrierung 58
Ermitteln des Kalibrierungsstatus 59
S
POT
-O
N
60
Spot-On
60
Starten von Spot-On 61
Hauptfenster von Spot-On 62
Arbeiten mit vorhandenen Farben 63
Erstellen eigener Farben 64
Herunterladen eigener Farbgruppen 65
Hochladen eigener Farbgruppen 66
Bearbeiten von Farbwerten 67
Anpassen von Zielfarben mittels Messinstrument 71
Zurücksetzen von Standardfarben auf Werkseinstellungen 72
Speichern von Änderungen und Beenden von Spot-On 73
INHALT 5
Spot-On und Ersatzfarben
74
Erstellen von Ersatzfarbgruppen und Ersatzfarben 74
Definieren der Farbwerte für eine Ersatzfarbe 76
Drucken eines Auftrags mit Ersatzfarben 78
Dialogfenster „Ersatzfarbe hinzufügen/umbenennen“ 79
Richtlinien für Ersatzfarben 80
Hoch- und Herunterladen einer Ersatzfarbgruppe 83
C
OLOR
W
ISE
D
RUCKOPTIONEN
84
Aufbau dieses Abschnitts
84
Farbmanagement des Fiery X3eTY2
85
ColorWise Druckoptionen
86
Autom. Überfüllung 86
Schwarzerkennung 87
Schwarz überdrucken 87
Schwarze Texte/Grafiken 88
CMYK-Simulationsprofil 90
CMYK-Simulationsverfahren 91
Separationen überdrucken 92
Composite-Ausgabe überdrucken 92
Ausgabeprofil 93
Nur Schwarz für Grautöne 93
Farbwiedergabe 94
RGB-Separation 95
RGB-Quellprofil 96
Spot-Farbabstimmung 97
Farbsubstitution 98
Druckertreiber und Druckoptionen
99
Festlegen von Druckoptionen unter Windows 99
Festlegen von Druckoptionen für das Farbmanagement unter Mac OS 101
Aktivieren von Device Link-Profilen im Fenster „Profi-Farbeinstellungen“ 103
INHALT 6
I
MPORTIEREN
VON
D
ENSITOMETERMESSWERTEN
105
Simple ASCII Import File Format (SAIFF)
105
Beispiel: 1D Status T-Dichte für EFI 21 106
Beispiel: 1D Status T-Dichte für EFI 34 106
Beispiel: 1D Status T-Dichte für andere Seite 107
I
NDEX
109
EINFÜHRUNG 7
E
INFÜHRUNG
In diesem Dokument wird die Steuerung der Farbausgabe auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 65C-KM
Color Server beschrieben. Außerdem werden Informationen über die Kalibrierung und
über Farbprofile bereitgestellt.
Dieses Dokument ist Teil eines Dokumentationssatzes, der Dokumente für Anwender und
Systemadministratoren umfasst. Eine ausführliche Beschreibung des Fiery X3eTY2 65C-KM
Color Server finden Sie in den anderen Dokumenten der Anwenderdokumentation.
Weitere Informationen über unterstützte Betriebssysteme und die Systemanforderungen
finden Sie im Dokument
Einführung und erste Schritte
.
Terminologie und Konventionen
In diesem Dokument werden die folgenden Begriffe und Konventionen verwendet:
Begriff oder Konventionen Beschreibung
Aero Fiery X3eTY2 (in Abbildungen und Beispielen)
Anwendung Command
WorkStation
Anwendung Command WorkStation, Windows Edition und
Anwendung Command WorkStation, Macintosh Edition
Kopierer Kopierer 65C-KM
Fiery X3eTY2 Fiery X3eTY2 65C-KM Color Server
Mac OS Apple Mac OS X
Titel in
Kursivschrift
Verweis auf andere Dokumente der Anwenderdokumentation
Windows Microsoft Windows 2000, Windows XP, Windows Server 2003
Verweis auf weitere Informationen in der Online-Hilfe der Software
Tipps und Anmerkungen
Wichtige Informationen
Wichtige Informationen über mögliche Gefahrensituationen
EINFÜHRUNG 8
Aufbau dieses Dokuments
In diesem Dokument finden Sie alle Informationen, die Sie benötigen, um die Farbausgabe
auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 in optimaler Weise zu steuern.
In diesem Dokument werden die folgenden Themen behandelt:
• Installieren und Konfigurieren der ColorWise Pro Tools
• Verwenden der Komponenten Color Editor, Profile Manager und Color Setup
• Übersicht über die Kalibrierung und Beschreibung der von der Komponente Calibrator
der ColorWise Pro Tools unterstützten Verfahren zum Kalibrieren des Fiery X3eTY2
• Verwalten von Spot- und Sonderfarben mithilfe von Spot-On
• Einstellen der ColorWise Druckoptionen unter Windows und Mac OS
• Beschreibung des Dateiformats „Simple ASCII File Format“ (SAIFF), das den Import von
Dichtemesswerten von verschiedenen Messinstrumenten unterstützt
H
INWEIS
:
Im
Glossar
werden Fachbegriffe wie „Farbraum“, „Spot-Farben“, „Gamut“ oder
„Quellprofil“ erläutert. Die Fachbegriffe werden in diesem Dokument in Fettdruck dargestellt.
Lesen Sie die Beschreibungen dieser Begriffe im
Glossar
, falls Sie mit der Terminologie
der Farbtechnologie nicht vertraut sind.
Schlüsselfunktionen von ColorWise
ColorWise
ist das
Farbmanagementsystem
(
CMS
), das in den Fiery X3eTY2 integriert ist
und Neueinsteiger und Farbexperten gleichermaßen dabei unterstützt, für jeden Zweck die
bestmögliche Farbausgabe zu erzielen. Mit den ColorWise Standardeinstellungen lassen sich
aus vielen Windows- und Mac OS Anwendungen auf Anhieb perfekte Farbausgaben erzielen.
Auch als weniger versierter Anwender erhalten Sie auf diese Weise Farbausgaben in optimaler
Qualität, ohne dass Sie sich im Detail mit den Farbeinstellungen auf dem Fiery X3eTY2
befassen müssen.
Zur Erhaltung der Farbkonsistenz sollten Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 regelmäßig kalibrieren.
Die ColorWise Pro Tools stellen hierfür die Komponente Calibrator zur Verfügung, mit der
Sie mit dem in den Kopierer integrierten Scanner oder mithilfe eines optional erhältlichen
Spektralfotometers
oder
Densitometers
die Kalibrierung vornehmen können (siehe
Kalibrierung auf Seite 34).
EINFÜHRUNG 9
Mit den Funktionen von ColorWise können Sie die Druckausgabe beeinflussen. Sie haben
folgende Möglichkeiten:
• Sie können das Verhalten der
CMYK
-Druckfunktionalität so beeinflussen, dass die
Offsetdruckstandards
DIC
,
Euroscale
und
SWOP
sowie andere Offsetdruckstandards
emuliert werden.
• Sie können PANTONE- und andere
Spot-Farben
mit den bestmöglichen CMYKÄquivalenten
für Ausgaben im Vierfarboffsetdruck oder für Ausgaben mit zusätzlichen
speziellen Druckplatten abstimmen.
• Durch die Auswahl eines bestimmten
Color Rendering Dictionary
(CRD) – einer
bestimmten Farbwiedergabe – können Sie die
RGB
-Farbausgabe steuern. Mit CRDs
erzielen Sie die ideale Farbwiedergabe, ganz gleich für welchen Zweck: brillante,
gesättigte Farben für
Präsentationsgrafiken
oder die akkurate Wiedergabe von Fotos
oder die Farbwiedergabe mit relativer oder absoluter Farbmetrik für spezielle Druckaufträge
oder Anwendungsgebiete.
• Sie können den Quellfarbraum von RGB-Farbdaten definieren und die Farbkonvertierung
für RGB-Daten optimieren, deren Quellfarbraum nicht bekannt ist.
• Sie können festlegen, ob RGB-Daten in den vollen Gamut des Kopierermodells oder
zunächst in den Gamut eines anderen Ausgabegeräts (z.B. einer Offsetdruckmaschine)
konvertiert werden sollen. Mit dieser Funktion können Sie mit einem Ausgabegerät
das Farbverhalten eines anderen Ausgabegeräts in Bezug auf RGB-Daten simulieren.
Außerdem können Sie das Aussehen einer RGB-Datei unter verschiedenen Druckbedingungen
überprüfen, ohne dass Sie die RGB-Daten dafür nach CMYK konvertieren
müssen.
Das
ColorWise Farbmanagement
(
ColorWise
) bietet eine offene Architektur, so dass der
Fiery X3eTY2 gezielt für die jeweiligen Erfordernisse angepasst werden kann. Außerdem
unterstützt ColorWise
ICC-Profile
; hierbei handelt es sich um Farbprofile nach Industriestandard,
die das Farbverhalten von Ausgabegeräten exakt beschreiben. Es werden sowohl
Profile der ICC-Spezifikation Version 4.0 (Profilversion 4.2.0.0) als auch der ICC-Spezifikation
Version 2.0 unterstützt. Indem Sie ICC-Profile auf den Fiery X3eTY2 laden, können
Sie mit dem Fiery X3eTY2 das Farbverhalten einer bestimmten Offsetdruckmaschine (oder
eines anderen Kopierermodells) simulieren und die Farben eines bestimmten Monitors oder
eines bestimmten Scanners akkurat wiedergeben. Schließlich haben Sie noch die Möglichkeit,
eigene ICC-Profile für den Kopierer zu erstellen und zu verwenden.
ColorWise unterstützt darüber hinaus die Kalibrierung mit einem beliebigen
Status T
-
Densitometer, da Messwerte in einem Standarddateiformat importiert werden können
(siehe Importieren von Densitometermesswerten auf Seite 105). Sie sollten in diesem Fall
jedoch beachten, dass sich die Präzision des Messinstruments unmittelbar auf die Qualität
der
Kalibrierung
auswirkt.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 10
C
OLOR
W
ISE
P
RO
T
OOLS
Mit den ColorWise Standardeinstellungen lassen sich aus vielen Windows- und Mac OS
Anwendungen auf Anhieb perfekte Farbausgaben erzielen. Auch als weniger versierter
Anwender erhalten Sie auf diese Weise Farbausgaben in optimaler Qualität, ohne dass Sie sich
im Detail mit den Farbeinstellungen auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 befassen müssen. Erfahrene
Anwender können mit dem ColorWise Farbmanagementsystem (CMS) die Farbausgabe
weiter optimieren, da mit den ColorWise Pro Tools eine individuelle Anpassung der
Einstellungen möglich ist.
Zu den ColorWise Pro Tools gehören die folgenden Anwendungen für das Farbmanagement,
mit denen Sie die Farbdruckfunktionalität auf flexible Weise steuern können:
• Calibrator (unterschiedliche Verfahren zur Kalibrierung des Fiery X3eTY2)
• Color Editor (auch „Farbeditor“; Anpassung von Simulations- und Ausgabeprofilen)
• Profile Manager (auch „Profilmanager“; Verwaltung von Profilen)
• Spot-On (Definition der CMYK-Äquivalente für Spot-Farben)
• Color Setup (Festlegung der Standardwerte für die ColorWise Druckoptionen)
Aufbau dieses Abschnitts
In diesem Abschnitt werden die Installation, Konfiguration und Verwendung der ColorWise
Pro Tools unter Windows und Mac OS beschrieben.
Plattform Aufgabe Siehe
Windows ColorWise Pro Tools installieren Seite 11
ICC-Profile installieren Seite 11
Verbindung konfigurieren Seite 13
Konfiguration ändern Seite 15
Mac OS ColorWise Pro Tools installieren Seite 15
ColorSync Profile installieren Seite 16
Verbindung konfigurieren Seite 18
Konfiguration ändern Seite 20
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 11
Einrichten der ColorWise Pro Tools unter Windows
Im Folgenden wird die Installation der ColorWise Pro Tools und weiterer Dateien sowie die
Konfiguration der Druckverbindung auf einem Windows-Computer beschrieben.
Installieren der ColorWise Pro Tools
Unter Windows erfolgt die Installation der gesamten Fiery Anwendersoftware durch das
Master-Installationsprogramm. Die Anleitungen im Dokument
Dienstprogramme
beschreiben
die Installation von der DVD mit der Anwendersoftware bzw. über das Netzwerk.
Damit Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools auf einem Computer unter Windows verwenden können,
muss Sun Java 5 auf diesem Computer installiert sein. Falls bei der Installation der ColorWise
Pro Tools das Fehlen dieser Datei festgestellt wird, wird ihre Installation automatisch gestartet.
Folgen Sie den Anleitungen auf dem Bildschirm.
Installieren von ICC-Profilen
Sie können zusätzliche ICC-Profile, die Sie verwenden wollen, vom Fiery X3eTY2 auf Ihren
Computer kopieren. Verwenden Sie die ICC-Profile in Verbindung mit Anwendungen, die
ICC-Standards unterstützen (z. B. Adobe Photoshop). Für die meisten ICC-kompatiblen
Anwendungen müssen die Dateien im Ordner „Color“ installiert werden. Für die ColorWise
Pro Tools können Sie die Dateien in einen Ordner Ihrer Wahl kopieren.
ICC-PROFILE FÜR WINDOWS INSTALLIEREN
1 Navigieren Sie über das Netzwerk zum Fiery X3eTY2; verwenden Sie dazu entweder die
IP-Adresse oder den DNS-Namen des Servers.
2 Geben Sie Ihren Anwendernamen und das zugehörige Kennwort ein, wenn Sie dazu
aufgefordert werden.
Ihr Netzwerkadministrator kann Ihnen sagen, ob diese Angaben erforderlich sind.
Windows und Mac OS Calibrator verwenden Seite 21
Farbeditor verwenden Seite 21
Profilmanager verwenden Seite 25
Spot-On verwenden Seite 31
Color Setup verwenden Seite 32
Plattform Aufgabe Siehe
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 12
3 Doppelklicken Sie auf den Ordner „PC_User_SW“.
4 Öffnen Sie den Ordner „ICC“.
5 Klicken Sie mit der rechten Maustaste auf das gewünschte Profil und wählen Sie
„Profil installieren“.
Die Profile werden auf Ihrem Computer automatisch im Ordner „System32\spool\drivers\
color“ innerhalb des Ordners „Windows“ (Windows XP) bzw. „WINNT“ (Windows 2000)
installiert.
Farbdateien
Sie können zusätzliche Farbdateien, die Sie verwenden wollen, vom Fiery X3eTY2 kopieren.
Viele dieser Dateien sind PostScript-Dateien, die Sie mit der Anwendung Command
WorkStation auf den Druckserver herunterladen und drucken können.
Ordner „Windows
Color Files“
CMYK Color Reference.ps: PostScript-Datei mit 11 Seiten im
Format „Letter“ („US Brief“), die als Referenz bei der Festlegung
von CMYK-Farben in einer Anwendung verwendet werden
kann.
PANTONE Book.ps: PostScript-Datei mit 20 Seiten im Format
„Letter“ („US Brief“), die die Äquivalente für die optimalen
PANTONE-Farben für gestrichenes Papier definiert, die mit
dem Fiery X3eTY2 und dem jeweiligen Kopierer erzeugt
werden können. Die Methode zum Drucken der Datei
„PANTONE Book.ps“ hängt von der Einstellung der Option
„Spot-Farbabstimmung“ ab. Weitere Informationen finden
Sie im Abschnitt ColorWise Druckoptionen auf Seite 84.
RGB page 01.doc: Datei für MS Word 97 (oder höher), die die in
der Anwendung verfügbaren RGB-Farben darstellt.
RGB page 02.ppt: Datei für PowerPoint 6.0 (oder höher), die die
in der Anwendung verfügbaren RGB-Farben darstellt.
Ordner „Color Bars“
(im Ordner
„Windows Color
Files“)
FieryColorBar.eps: Diese Datei kann als Kontrollstreifen auf
Auftragsseiten gedruckt werden.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 13
Konfigurieren der Verbindung
Wenn Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools zum ersten Mal starten, müssen Sie die Verbindung zum
Fiery X3eTY2 konfigurieren.
VORBEREITUNG
• Drucken Sie die Konfigurationsseite des Fiery X3eTY2 über das Kopiererdisplay und notieren
Sie sich die IP-Adresse des Fiery X3eTY2.
oder
Drucken Sie die Konfigurationsseite über die Anwendung Command WorkStation und notieren
Sie sich die IP-Adresse des Fiery X3eTY2.
Auf dieser Seite finden Sie alle Informationen, die Sie für die Konfiguration benötigen (z. B.
die IP-Adresse). Bei TCP/IP-Installationen können Sie den DNS-Namen des Fiery X3eTY2
anstelle der IP-Adresse verwenden. Stellen Sie sicher, dass der Fiery X3eTY2 auf einem von
Ihrem Netzwerk verwendeten DNS-Server registriert ist. Weitere Hinweise finden Sie in Ihrer
Windows-Dokumentation.
VERBINDUNG FÜR COLORWISE PRO TOOLS KONFIGURIEREN
1 Starten Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools.
2 Klicken Sie auf „Hinzufügen“, wenn das Auswahlfenster angezeigt wird.
Ordner „PS Files“
(im Ordner
„Windows Color
Files > Calibration
Files“)
Custom21.ps, Custom34.ps, Standard21.ps und Standard34.ps:
PostScript-Dateien mit Farbfeldern für Messungen.
Die Zahl im Dateinamen gibt die Anzahl der Farbfelder pro Seite
wieder. Die „Custom“-Dateien ermöglichen das Laden von
Messwertefeldern, die das aktuelle Kalibrierungsset des Kopierers
berücksichtigen. Die „Standard“-Dateien ermöglichen das Laden
von Messwertefeldern, die das aktuelle Kalibrierungsset des
Kopierermodells ignorieren.
HINWEIS: Die Dateien sind für erfahrene Anwender gedacht
und nicht für die routinemäßige Kalibrierung geeignet.
Ordner „Halftone
Calibration Files“
(im Ordner
„Windows Color
Files > Calibration
Files“)
Dies sind für verschiedene Kalibrierinstrumente und
Seitengrößen ausgelegte Messwerteseiten zum Kalibrieren
des Fiery X3eTY2 im Hinblick auf verschiedene Halftone-
Raster. Die Dateien werden für Adobe Photoshop und andere
Anwendungen bereitgestellt.
HINWEIS: Verwenden Sie für das Densitometer X-Rite
DTP32 Series II die Kalibrierungsdatei für das Densitometer
X-Rite DTP32.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 14
3 Geben Sie die Informationen für den Fiery X3eTY2 ein.
Kurzname: Geben Sie einen Namen für den Fiery X3eTY2 ein. Der Name muss nicht mit
dem tatsächlichen Servernamen des Fiery X3eTY2 übereinstimmen.
HINWEIS: Der Kurzname darf die folgenden Zeichen nicht enthalten:
[ ] _ " '
Servername oder IP-Adresse des Servers: Geben Sie die IP-Adresse (oder den DNS-Namen)
des Fiery X3eTY2 ein.
Neues Gerät: Geben Sie den Namen des mit dem Fiery X3eTY2 verbundenen Ausgabegeräts
ein: 65C-KM.
4 Klicken Sie auf „Hinzufügen“, nachdem Sie alle Informationen eingegeben haben.
5 Markieren Sie den Gerätenamen (65C-KM) in der Geräteliste und klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Der Fiery X3eTY2 wird nun in der Liste der verfügbaren Server angezeigt. In der ersten Zeile
des Eintrags sehen Sie den Kurznamen, den Sie dem Fiery X3eTY2 zugeordnet haben, und in
Klammern das gewählte Protokoll. In der zweiten Zeile des Eintrags ist der Gerätename zu
sehen.
6 Markieren Sie den Gerätenamen in der Liste „Verfügbare Server“ und klicken Sie auf
„Auswählen“.
Daraufhin erscheint das Hauptfenster der ColorWise Pro Tools.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 15
Bearbeiten der Konfiguration
Sie müssen die Konfiguration bearbeiten, wenn sich die Angaben für den Fiery X3eTY2
oder das Netzwerk ändern (z. B. der Servername oder die IP-Adresse). Ändern Sie zuerst
die spezifischen Setup-Informationen des Fiery X3eTY2 und konfigurieren Sie danach die
Verbindung neu.
KONFIGURATION BEARBEITEN
1 Wenn Sie der Serverliste einen neuen Fiery X3eTY2 hinzufügen wollen, klicken Sie auf
„Hinzufügen“ und konfigurieren Sie die neue Verbindung (siehe Schritte 3 bis 5 der
Anleitung oben).
2 Wenn Sie einen Fiery X3eTY2 aus der Serverliste entfernen wollen, aktivieren Sie den
Kurznamen des Fiery X3eTY2 und klicken Sie auf „Entfernen“.
3 Wenn Sie die Konfigurationsinformationen für einen Fiery X3eTY2 ändern wollen,
markieren Sie den zugehörigen Kurznamen und klicken Sie auf „Ändern“. Bearbeiten
Sie die Informationen im nachfolgenden Fenster und klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Die Serverliste wird entsprechend den vorgenommenen Änderungen aktualisiert.
Einrichten der ColorWise Pro Tools unter Mac OS
Im Folgenden wird die Installation der ColorWise Pro Tools und weiterer Dateien sowie die
Konfiguration der Druckverbindung auf einem Mac OS Computer beschrieben.
Installieren der ColorWise Pro Tools unter Mac OS
Überlegen Sie sich vor Beginn der Installation, wo Sie die jeweilige Komponente installieren
wollen. Standardmäßig wird die Software im Ordner „Fiery“ installiert.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS UNTER MAC OS VON DVD MIT DER ANWENDERSOFTWARE INSTALLIEREN
1 Legen Sie die DVD mit der Anwendersoftware in das DVD-Laufwerk ein.
2 Navigieren Sie zum Ordner mit der Software für das von Ihnen verwendete Betriebssystem.
3 Doppelklicken Sie auf das Symbol für das Installationsprogramm der ColorWise Pro Tools.
4 Folgen Sie den Anleitungen auf dem Bildschirm.
5 Schließen Sie das Installationsprogramm durch Klicken auf „Beenden“.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 16
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS UNTER MAC OS ÜBER DAS NETZWERK INSTALLIEREN
1 Wählen Sie „Mit Server verbinden“ im Menü „Gehe zu“.
2 Geben Sie „smb://“ gefolgt von der IP-Adresse des Fiery X3eTY2 ein und klicken Sie auf
„Verbinden“.
Wenden Sie sich an Ihren Netzwerkadministrator, wenn der Fiery X3eTY2 nicht gefunden
wird.
3 Geben Sie ggf. Ihren Anwendernamen und das zugehörige Kennwort ein.
Ihr Netzwerkadministrator kann Ihnen sagen, ob diese Angaben erforderlich sind.
4 Öffnen Sie das Verzeichnis „Mac_User_SW“.
5 Öffnen Sie den Ordner „OSX“.
6 Doppelklicken Sie auf das Symbol für das Installationsprogramm der ColorWise Pro Tools.
7 Folgen Sie den Anleitungen auf dem Bildschirm.
8 Schließen Sie das Installationsprogramm durch Klicken auf „Beenden“.
Installieren von ColorSync Profilen
Sie können ggf. zusätzliche ICC-Profile vom Fiery X3eTY2 auf Ihren Computer kopieren.
Verwenden Sie die ICC-Profile in Verbindung mit Anwendungen, die ICC-Standards unterstützen
(z. B. Adobe Photoshop). Für die meisten ICC-kompatiblen Anwendungen müssen
die Dateien im Ordner „Startfestplatte > Library > ColorSync > Profiles“ installiert werden.
Für die ColorWise Pro Tools können Sie die Dateien in einen Ordner Ihrer Wahl kopieren.
COLORSYNC PROFILE FÜR MAC OS INSTALLIEREN
1 Wählen Sie „Mit Server verbinden“ im Menü „Gehe zu“.
2 Geben Sie „smb://“ gefolgt von der IP-Adresse des Fiery X3eTY2 ein und klicken Sie auf
„Verbinden“.
Wenden Sie sich an Ihren Netzwerkadministrator, wenn der Fiery X3eTY2 nicht gefunden
wird.
3 Geben Sie ggf. Ihren Anwendernamen und das zugehörige Kennwort ein.
Ihr Netzwerkadministrator kann Ihnen sagen, ob diese Angaben erforderlich sind.
4 Doppelklicken Sie auf das Verzeichnis „Mac_User_SW“.
5 Öffnen Sie den Ordner „ColorSync“.
6 Installieren Sie die Profile im Ordner „Library > ColorSync > Profiles“.
Informationen zum Festlegen von ColorSync Profilen wie EFIRGB finden Sie in der
Dokumentation zu ColorSync.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 17
Farbdateien
Sie können zusätzliche Farbdateien, die Sie verwenden wollen, von der DVD mit der
Anwendersoftware kopieren. Viele dieser Dateien sind PostScript-Dateien, die Sie mit der
Anwendung Command WorkStation auf den Druckserver herunterladen und drucken
können.
Ordner „Mac Color
Files“
CMYK Color Reference.ps: PostScript-Datei mit 11 Seiten im Format
„Letter“ („US Brief“), die als Referenz bei der Festlegung von
CMYK-Farben in einer Anwendung verwendet werden kann.
PANTONE Book.ps: PostScript-Datei mit 19 Seiten im Format
„Letter“ („US Brief“), die die Äquivalente für die optimalen
PANTONE-Farben für gestrichenes Papier definiert, die mit
dem Fiery X3eTY2 und dem jeweiligen Kopierermodell erzeugt
werden können. Die Methode zum Drucken der Datei
„PANTONE Book.ps“ hängt von der Einstellung der Option
„Spot-Farbabstimmung“ ab. Weitere Informationen finden
Sie im Abschnitt ColorWise Druckoptionen auf Seite 86.
RGB page 01.doc: Datei für MS Word 97 (oder höher), die die in der
Anwendung verfügbaren RGB-Farben darstellt.
RGB page 02.ppt: Datei für PowerPoint 6.0 (oder höher), die die in
der Anwendung verfügbaren RGB-Farben darstellt.
Ordner „Color Bars“
(im Ordner „Mac
Color Files“)
FieryColorBar.eps: Diese Datei kann als Kontrollstreifen auf
Auftragsseiten gedruckt werden.
Ordner „PS Files“
(im Ordner „Mac
Color Files >
Calibration Files“)
Custom21.ps, Custom34.ps, Standard21.ps und Standard34.ps:
PostScript-Dateien mit Farbfeldern für Messungen.
Die Zahl im Dateinamen gibt die Anzahl der Farbfelder pro Seite
wieder. Die „Custom“-Dateien ermöglichen das Laden von Messwertefeldern,
die das aktuell installierte Kalibrierungsset berücksichtigen.
Die „Standard“-Dateien ermöglichen das Laden von
Messwertefeldern, die das aktuell installierte Kalibrierungsset
ignorieren.
HINWEIS: Die Dateien sind für erfahrene Anwender gedacht und
nicht für die routinemäßige Kalibrierung geeignet.
Ordner „Halftone
Calibration Files“
(im Ordner „Mac
Color Files“ >
Calibration Files“)
Dies sind für verschiedene Kalibrierinstrumente und Seitengrößen
ausgelegte Messwerteseiten zum Kalibrieren des Fiery X3eTY2 im
Hinblick auf verschiedene Halftone-Raster. Die Dateien werden für
Adobe Photoshop und andere Anwendungen bereitgestellt.
HINWEIS: Verwenden Sie für das Densitometer X-Rite DTP32
Series II die Kalibrierungsdatei für das Densitometer X-Rite DTP32.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 18
Konfigurieren der Verbindung
Wenn Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools zum ersten Mal starten, müssen Sie die Verbindung
zum Fiery X3eTY2 konfigurieren.
HINWEIS: Die ColorWise Pro Tools werden nur in TCP/IP-Netzwerken unterstützt.
VORBEREITUNG
• Drucken Sie die Konfigurationsseite des Fiery X3eTY2 über das Kopiererdisplay und notieren
Sie sich die IP-Adresse des Fiery X3eTY2.
oder
• Drucken Sie die Konfigurationsseite über die Anwendung Command WorkStation und notieren
Sie sich die IP-Adresse des Fiery X3eTY2.
Diese Seite enthält Informationen, die Sie für die Verbindungskonfiguration benötigen.
Bei TCP/IP-Installationen können Sie den DNS-Namen des Fiery X3eTY2 anstelle der
IP-Adresse verwenden. Stellen Sie sicher, dass der Fiery X3eTY2 auf einem von Ihrem
Netzwerk verwendeten DNS-Server registriert ist. Weitere Hinweise finden Sie in Ihrer
Mac OS Dokumentation.
VERBINDUNG FÜR COLORWISE PRO TOOLS KONFIGURIEREN
1 Doppelklicken Sie auf das Symbol für die ColorWise Pro Tools.
Daraufhin wird das Auswahlfenster angezeigt.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 19
2 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, wenn das Fenster „Keine Server konfiguriert“ angezeigt wird. Klicken
Sie auf „Hinzufügen“, wenn das Auswahlfenster angezeigt wird.
3 Geben Sie die Informationen für den Fiery X3eTY2 ein.
Kurzname: Geben Sie einen Namen für den Fiery X3eTY2 ein. Der Name muss nicht mit
dem tatsächlichen Servernamen des Fiery X3eTY2 übereinstimmen.
HINWEIS: Der Kurzname darf die folgenden Zeichen nicht enthalten:
[ ] _ " '
Servername oder IP-Adresse des Servers: Geben Sie die IP-Adresse (oder den DNS- bzw.
Host-Namen) des Fiery X3eTY2 ein.
Neues Gerät: Geben Sie den Namen des mit dem Fiery X3eTY2 verbundenen Ausgabegeräts
ein: 65C-KM. Den Gerätenamen finden Sie auf der Konfigurationsseite im Bereich mit den
Druckereinstellungen.
4 Klicken Sie auf „Hinzufügen“, nachdem Sie alle Informationen eingegeben haben.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 20
5 Markieren Sie den Gerätenamen in der Geräteliste und klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Der Fiery X3eTY2 wird nun in der Liste der verfügbaren Server angezeigt. In der ersten Zeile
des Eintrags sehen Sie den Kurznamen, den Sie dem Fiery X3eTY2 zugeordnet haben, und in
Klammern das gewählte Protokoll. In der zweiten Zeile des Eintrags ist der Gerätename zu
sehen.
6 Markieren Sie den Gerätenamen in der Liste „Verfügbare Server“ und klicken Sie auf
„Auswählen“.
Daraufhin erscheint das Hauptfenster der ColorWise Pro Tools.
Bearbeiten der Konfiguration
Sie müssen die Konfiguration ändern, wenn sich die Angaben für den Fiery X3eTY2 oder
das Netzwerk ändern (z. B. der Servername oder die IP-Adresse). Ändern Sie zuerst die
spezifischen Setup-Informationen des Fiery X3eTY2 und konfigurieren Sie danach die
Verbindung neu.
KONFIGURATION BEARBEITEN
1 Wenn Sie der Serverliste einen neuen Fiery X3eTY2 hinzufügen wollen, klicken Sie auf
„Hinzufügen“ und konfigurieren Sie die neue Verbindung (siehe Schritte 3 bis 5 der
Anleitung oben).
2 Wenn Sie einen Fiery X3eTY2 aus der Serverliste entfernen wollen, aktivieren Sie den
Kurznamen des Fiery X3eTY2 und klicken Sie auf „Entfernen“.
3 Wenn Sie die Konfigurationsinformationen für einen Fiery X3eTY2 ändern wollen,
markieren Sie den zugehörigen Kurznamen und klicken Sie auf „Ändern“. Bearbeiten
Sie die Informationen im nachfolgenden Fenster und klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Die Serverliste wird entsprechend den vorgenommenen Änderungen aktualisiert.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 21
ColorWise Pro Tools
Die ColorWise Pro Tools ermöglichen Ihnen eine umfassende und flexible Steuerung der
Farbausgabe, da Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 kalibrieren, die Simulations- und Ausgabeprofile
individuell anpassen, die Profile auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 verwalten, Spot-Farben verwalten
und Standardwerte für die ColorWise Druckoptionen festlegen können.
Calibrator
Mit der Komponente Calibrator der ColorWise Pro Tools stehen für die Kalibrierung des
Fiery X3eTY2 mehrere Messverfahren zur Auswahl. Informationen über die Kalibrierung
des Fiery X3eTY2 finden Sie auf Seite 34.
Color Editor
Mit der Komponente Color Editor (Farbeditor) der ColorWise Pro Tools können Sie eigene
(anwenderdefinierte) Profile erstellen, indem Sie ein vorhandenes Simulations- oder Ausgabeprofil
bearbeiten und die neuen Einstellungen als neues Profil speichern. Mit dem Farbeditor
können Sie ein Profil auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 gezielt für Ihre Umgebung anpassen. Sie können
den Farbeditor direkt aufrufen, indem Sie im Hauptfenster der ColorWise Pro Tools auf das
entsprechende Symbol klicken. Darüber hinaus haben Sie die Möglichkeit, ihn indirekt über
den Profilmanager aufzurufen.
HINWEIS: Quellprofile können nicht bearbeitet werden. Sie können nur Simulations- und
Ausgabeprofile anpassen.
FARBEDITOR VERWENDEN
1 Starten Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools und stellen Sie die Verbindung zum Fiery X3eTY2 her.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 22
2 Klicken Sie auf „Color Editor“.
Bei Auswahl von „Simulation” werden die auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 residenten Simulationsprofile
aufgeführt. Bei Auswahl von „Ausgabe“ werden die Ausgabeprofile auf dem
Fiery X3eTY2 aufgeführt.
3 Wählen Sie das gewünschte Profil und klicken Sie auf „Auswählen“.
Weitere Informationen über die Komponente Color Editor finden Sie in der Online-Hilfe der
ColorWise Pro Tools.
Anpassen der Graubalance
Mit der Funktion AutoGray lässt sich der in den Kopierer integrierte Scanner als Messgerät
zur Anpassung der Graubalance von Ausgabeprofilen verwenden. Die Graubalance bezieht
sich auf die Qualität der neutralen Grautöne eines Profils. Grautöne haben vielfach einen
bläulichen oder rötlichen Schimmer. Mit AutoGray werden diese Verfärbungen in neutralere
Grautöne umgewandelt. Wenn Sie mit der Graubalance des Kopierers zufrieden sind, ist es
nicht notwendig, AutoGray zu verwenden.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 23
GRAUBALANCE EINES AUSGABEPROFILS KORRIGIEREN
1 Starten Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools und klicken Sie auf „Color Editor“.
2 Wählen Sie „Ausgabe“ im Menü „Anzeigen“
3 Wählen Sie das zu bearbeitende Profil und klicken Sie auf „Auswählen“.
Sie können alternativ auch die Komponente Profile Manager starten, darin das gewünschte
Profil auswählen und auf „Bearbeiten“ klicken.
Daraufhin wird die Komponente Color Editor gestartet.
4 Wählen Sie „Eigen“ im Menü „Editiermodus“.
5 Klicken Sie auf „AutoGray“.
6 Wenn das Ausgabeprofil keine Editierpunkte enthält, fahren Sie mit Schritt 8 fort. Wenn das
Ausgabeprofil bereits Editierpunkte aus einer früheren AutoGray Sitzung enthält, wählen Sie
„Optimieren“ oder „Neu“.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 24
Optimieren: Mit dieser Aktion werden die Editierpunkte früherer Sitzungen wiederverwendet
und weiter präzisiert. Diese Aktion ist optional und sollte nur verwendet werden, wenn die
Graubalance in Ihrem Testdokument nach der ersten Bearbeitung mit AutoGray weiterer
Verbesserungen bedarf. Sollten die Verbesserungen nach zweimaliger Anwendung der Option
„Optimieren“ nicht eintreten, liegt dies wahrscheinlich daran, dass Ihr Testdokument das
Ausgabeprofil nicht richtig berücksichtigt oder dass das von Ihnen bearbeitete Ausgabeprofil
die tatsächlichen Kopierer- und Druckbedingungen nicht angemessen beschreibt. Es wird
nicht empfohlen, die Option „Optimieren“ mehr als zweimal durchzuführen.
Neu: Mit dieser Option wird eine neue AutoGray Sitzung gestartet; dabei werden sämtliche
Editierpunkte früherer Sitzungen gelöscht. Die Aktion „Neu“ wird empfohlen, wenn Sie
„Optimieren“ bereits mehr als zweimal angewendet haben.
7 Enthält das Ausgabeprofil anwenderdefinierte Editierpunkte, wählen Sie „Fortsetzen“,
um diese zu löschen und mit der Anpassung von AutoGray fortzufahren.
Mit der Aktion „Fortsetzen“ wird eine neue AutoGray Sitzung gestartet und sämtliche
anwenderdefinierte Editierpunkte werden gelöscht. Dies ist nötig, da AutoGray anwenderdefinierte
Editierpunkte nicht ändern kann.
8 Wählen Sie im Dialogfenster „Druckoptionen“ das Zufuhrfach für die Messwerteseite und
klicken Sie auf „Drucken“.
Für den Seitentyp wird automatisch die Einstellung „AutoGray Messwerteseite“ gewählt.
Für die Papiergröße wird automatisch die Einstellung „LTR/A4“ gewählt.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 25
9 Bestätigen Sie mit „OK“, dass die Messwerteseite gedruckt werden soll.
10 Nehmen Sie die gedruckte Seite aus dem Kopierer.
11 Legen Sie den Kodak Graustufenstreifen und die AutoGray Messwerteseite entsprechend den
Anleitungen im Dialogfenster auf dem Vorlagenglas des Kopierers ab und klicken Sie auf
„Weiter“.
Eingeblendete Meldungen zeigen den Fortschritt der Graubalanceanpassung an.
12 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, wenn die Anpassung abgeschlossen ist.
Die angepasste Kurve des Ausgabeprofils wird im Farbeditor angezeigt. Um eine Veränderung
der Graubalance zu erreichen, werden durch AutoGray neue Editierpunkte so eingefügt, wie
ein Profi-Anwender sie manuell eingeben würde.
13 Klicken Sie erneut auf „AutoGray“, um die Kurve des Ausgabeprofils zu verändern.
14 Wählen Sie „Optimieren“, um die Feinabstimmung für die vorhandene Kurve vorzunehmen,
oder „Neu“, um eine neue Kurve zur Bearbeitung zu erstellen.
Weitere Informationen zu diesen Schritten finden Sie auf Seite 24.
Profile Manager
Mit der Komponente Profile Manager (Profilmanager) der ColorWise Pro Tools können Sie
ICC-Profile verwalten und bearbeiten.
PROFILMANAGER VERWENDEN
1 Starten Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools und stellen Sie die Verbindung zum Fiery X3eTY2 her.
2 Klicken Sie auf „Profile Manager“.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 26
Das Fenster „Profile Manager“ wird angezeigt.
3 Klicken Sie auf das gewünschte Profil, um es zu markieren.
Im unteren Bereich des Fensters werden Informationen über das markierte Profil wie das
Erstellungsdatum und die Version der ICC-Spezifikation angezeigt. Es werden sowohl Profile
der ICC-Spezifikation Version 4.0 (Profilversion 4.2.0.0) als auch der ICC-Spezifikation
Version 2.0 unterstützt.
Weitere Informationen über die Komponente Profile Manager finden Sie in der Online-Hilfe
der ColorWise Pro Tools.
Informationen über die Option „Mediumabhängiges Profil“ finden Sie im folgenden
Abschnitt.
Weitere Informationen über Device Link-Profile finden Sie auf Seite 27.
Festlegen der Standardprofile
Mit dem Profilmanager können Sie Standardprofile für die Kategorien RGB-Quelle,
Simulation und Ausgabe festlegen. Die standardmäßigen RGB-Quell- und Simulationsprofile
werden auf alle Aufträge angewendet, die an den Fiery X3eTY2 gesendet werden,
sofern kein spezifisches anderes Profil für einen Auftrag gewählt wird. Analog gilt dies
auch für das standardmäßige Ausgabeprofil, es sei denn, die Option „Mediumabhängiges
Profil“ wird gewählt.
Mit der Option „Mediumabhängiges Profil“ wird veranlasst, dass für jedes in einem Auftrag
verwendete Medium automatisch das dem Medium zugeordnete Ausgabeprofil verwendet
wird. Weitere Informationen finden Sie im folgenden Abschnitt.
1 Ausgabeprofile
1
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 27
Verwenden mediumabhängiger Ausgabeprofile
Anstatt den Profilmanager anzuweisen, ein Standardausgabeprofil auf alle Ihre Druckaufträge
anzuwenden, haben Sie die Möglichkeit, die Option „Mediumabhängiges Profil“ zu aktivieren.
Mit dieser Option wird automatisch das Ausgabeprofil des Mediums verwendet, das für einen
Auftrag gewählt wird. Wenn ein Auftrag gemischte Medien enthält, werden mithilfe dieser
Option verschiedene vordefinierte Ausgabeprofile für die verschiedenen Medien verwendet.
Im Fenster des Profilmanagers ist die Option „Mediumabhängiges Profil“ standardmäßig
aktiviert. Sie wird auf alle an den Fiery X3eTY2 gesendeten Aufträge angewendet, für die im
Druckertreiber keine gegenteilige Festlegung getroffen wird.
MEDIUMABHÄNGIGE AUSGABEPROFILE VERWENDEN
1 Starten Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools und klicken Sie auf „Profile Manager“.
2 Aktivieren Sie die Option „Mediumabhängiges Profil“ in der Leiste „Ausgabe“ des
Profilmanagers.
Wenn Sie die Einstellung der Option „Mediumabhängiges Profil“ im Profilmanager ändern,
wird diese Einstellung automatisch auch in der Komponente Color Setup geändert. Weitere
Informationen finden Sie im Abschnitt Color Setup auf Seite 32.
Device Link-Profile
Der Fiery X3eTY2 unterstützt Device Link-Profile. Ein Device Link-Profil beschreibt die
Konvertierung von Farbdaten aus einem Farbraum in einen anderen. Device Link-Profile
sind restriktiv, da sie die Konvertierung aus dem Quell- in den Zielfarbraum in umfassender
Weise definieren. Da ein Device Link-Profil die Spezifikation sowohl des Quell- als auch des
Ausgabeprofils umfasst, brauchen beim Drucken eines Auftrags mithilfe eines Device Link-
Profils diese beiden Profile nicht festgelegt werden. ColorWise unterstützt zwei Arten von
Device Link-Profilen: Profile für die Konvertierung aus einem RGB-Quellfarbraum in einen
CMYK-Zielfarbraum und Profile für die Konvertierung aus einem CYMK-Quellfarbraum in
einen CMYK-Zielfarbraum.
Wenn Sie ein Device Link-Profil verwenden, werden wesentliche Elemente des ColorWise
Farbmanagements ignoriert, da alle Informationen, die für die Konvertierung aus dem Quellin
den Zielfarbraum benötigt werden, bereits im Device Link-Profil enthalten sind.
HINWEIS: Ob ein Device Link-Profil erforderlich ist oder nicht, hängt vom spezifischen
Workflow eines Auftrags ab.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 28
Installieren von Device Link-Profilen
Als Administrator können Sie Device Link-Profile mithilfe des Profilmanagers auf den
Fiery X3eTY2 herunterladen. Für ein Device Link-Profil müssen Sie die folgenden
Einstellungen festlegen:
• Ein RGB-Quellprofil oder ein CMYK-Simulationsprofil und
• Ein Ausgabeprofil
Ein Device Link-Profil wird nur aktiviert, wenn diese beiden Einstellungen vorgenommen
wurden.
Sie können ein Device Link-Profil an drei Orten aktivieren:
• In der Komponente Color Setup der ColorWise Pro Tools: Hier legen Sie die Standardeinstellungen
für die Optionen „RGB-Quellprofil“, „CMYK-Simulationsprofil“ und
„Ausgabeprofil“ fest. Diese Einstellungen werden standardmäßig auf alle Aufträge
angewendet, für die keine abweichenden Einstellungen festgelegt werden.
• Im Fenster „Profi-Farbeinstellungen“ des Druckertreibers für den Fiery X3eTY2:
Hier legen Sie die Einstellungen für die Optionen „RGB-Quellprofil“, „CMYKSimulationsprofil“
und „Ausgabeprofil“ für einen einzelnen zu druckenden Auftrag fest.
• Im Fenster „Auftragseigenschaften“ der Anwendung Command WorkStation:
Hier können Sie die vom Anwender gewählten Einstellungen der Optionen „RGBQuellprofil“,
„CMYK-Simulationsprofil“ und „Ausgabeprofil“ für einen einzelnen
Auftrag überschreiben.
Weitere Informationen über das Aktivieren von Device Link-Profilen mit der Komponente
Color Setup finden Sie auf Seite 33. Weitere Informationen über das Aktivieren von Device
Link-Profilen über die Profi-Farbeinstellungen des Fiery X3eTY2 Druckertreibers finden Sie
auf Seite 103.
DEVICE LINK-PROFILE MIT PROFILMANAGER HERUNTERLADEN
1 Klicken Sie im Fenster des Profilmanagers auf „Durchsuchen“ links oben, wenn in der Liste
„Beschreibung“ links das gewünschte Device Link-Profil nicht angezeigt wird, und navigieren
Sie zu dem Ordner mit dem gewünschten Profil.
2 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um den Ordner in die Liste „Beschreibung“ aufzunehmen.
Das Device Link-Profil wird daraufhin in der Liste „Beschreibung“ angezeigt.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 29
3 Markieren Sie das Device Link-Profil in der Liste „Beschreibung“ links und klicken Sie auf
den grünen Rechtspfeil, der auf die Kategorie Device Link im rechten Teil des Fensters zeigt.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster „Device Link-Profileinstellungen“ angezeigt. Die
Festlegung der Einstellungen wird im nächsten Abschnitt beschrieben.
Zuordnen der Device Link-Profileinstellungen
In der nachfolgenden Beispielabbildung des Dialogfensters „Device Link-Profileinstellungen“
sind die Angaben für ein RGB-Quellprofil zu sehen. Im Falle eines CMYK-Simulationsprofils
werden in diesem Dialogfenster die Angaben für ein CMYK-Simulationsprofil anstelle der
Angaben für ein RGB-Quellprofil angezeigt.
1 Kategorie Device Link
1
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 30
DEVICE LINK-PROFILEINSTELLUNGEN ZUORDNEN
1 Nachdem Sie mit dem Profilmanager das Device Link-Profil für die Kategorie Device Link
auf den Server heruntergeladen haben, müssen Sie im Dialogfenster „Device Link-Profileinstellungen“
das Quell- und das Ausgabeprofil für das heruntergeladene Device Link-Profil
zuordnen.
Wenn ein heruntergeladenes Device Link-Profil bereits Referenzen auf eine Quelle und eine
Ausgabe (Ziel) beinhaltet, werden das betreffende Quell- und das betreffende Ausgabeprofil
automatisch im jeweiligen Feld angezeigt.
Wenn ein Quell- oder ein Ausgabeprofil, das als Referenz in einem heruntergeladenen Device
Link-Profil enthalten ist, auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 nicht gefunden wird, wird für das Quellbzw.
das Ausgabeprofil der Eintrag „Nicht zugeordnet“ angezeigt; zugleich wird eine Infozeile
mit dem Hinweis eingeblendet, dass das Quell- bzw. das Ausgabeprofil nicht gefunden wurde.
Durch Klicken auf „Informationen“ können Sie weitere Angaben zum fehlenden Profil
einblenden.
Wenn Sie ein Quell- bzw. ein Ausgabeprofil auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 installieren, das
dem fehlenden, im Device Link-Profil angesprochenen Profil entspricht, wird der Eintrag
„Nicht zugeordnet“ automatisch durch den Namen des Quell- bzw. Ausgabeprofils ersetzt.
HINWEIS: Solange das Quell- oder das Ausgabeprofil nicht zugeordnet wurde, kann
das Device Link-Profil nicht verwendet werden. Die Zuordnung dieser Einstellungen ist
unbedingt erforderlich.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 31
2 Geben Sie für ein Device Link-Profil, dem noch keine Quelle und keine Ausgabe zugeordnet
wurde, eine Profilbeschreibung ein. Ordnen Sie anschließend das für das Device Link-Profil
gewünschte Quell- und das gewünschte Ausgabeprofil zu.
3 Klicken Sie im Dialogfenster „Device Link-Profileinstellungen“ auf „OK“, nachdem Sie die
erforderlichen Zuordnungen vorgenommen haben.
Ändern von Device Link-Profilen
Sie können die Einstellungen eines Device Link-Profils mit den folgenden Schritten ändern.
DEVICE LINK-PROFILEINSTELLUNGEN ÄNDERN
1 Doppelklicken Sie in der Liste der Kategorie Device Link auf das zu ändernde Device Link-
Profil.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster „Device Link-Profileinstellungen“ angezeigt.
2 Legen Sie ein neues Quell- oder ein neues Ausgabeprofil fest.
3 Klicken Sie auf „Anwenden“ und danach auf „OK“.
HINWEIS: Es ist nicht möglich, ein Device Link-Profil mithilfe der ColorWise Pro Tools zu
bearbeiten. Zum Bearbeiten müssen Sie die Anwendung verwenden, mit der das Device Link-
Profil erstellt wurde.
Spot-On
Spot-On bietet Ihnen die Möglichkeit, Listen von Spot-Farben und deren CMYK-Äquivalente
anzupassen und zu verwalten. Die Abgleichungslisten von Spot-Farben und CMYKWerten
werden als „Spot-Farbbibliotheken“ bezeichnet. Mit Spot-On können Sie für jedes
Ausgabeprofil auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 mehrere Spot-Farbbibliotheken pflegen und verwalten.
Weitere Informationen über Spot-On finden Sie auf Seite 60.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 32
Color Setup
Mit der Komponente Color Setup der ColorWise Pro Tools können Sie die Standardwerte für
die ColorWise Druckoptionen des Fiery X3eTY2 festlegen.
Diese Einstellungen gelten für alle Druckaufträge, die von Anwendern an den Fiery X3eTY2
gesendet werden und für die im Druckertreiber keine anders lautenden Einstellungen gewählt
werden. Die Standardeinstellungen können auch in der Anwendung Command WorkStation
überschrieben werden. Darüber hinaus werden die Standardeinstellungen, die Sie mit der
Komponente Color Setup festlegen, automatisch auch in andere Fiery X3eTY2 Tools übernommen,
in denen Standardwerte angezeigt werden.
Die Art und Weise, in der die Optionen in der Komponente Color Setup angeordnet sind,
reflektiert den Ablauf der Farbverarbeitung auf dem Fiery X3eTY2. Klicken Sie im Fenster
„Color Setup“ links unten auf „Werksstandards“, wenn Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 auf die
Standardwerte zurücksetzen wollen, die werkseitig festgelegt wurden.
COLOR SETUP VERWENDEN
1 Starten Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools und stellen Sie die Verbindung zum Fiery X3eTY2 her.
2 Klicken Sie auf „Color Setup“.
COLORWISE PRO TOOLS 33
Aktivieren von Device Link-Profilen mit Color Setup
Sie können mit der Komponente Color Setup auch Device Link-Profile aktivieren.
Weitere Informationen über das Installieren und Zuordnen von Device Link-Profilen finden
Sie auf Seite 28.
DEVICE LINK-PROFILE MIT KOMPONENTE COLOR SETUP AKTIVIEREN
1 Starten Sie die Komponente Color Setup der ColorWise Pro Tools.
2 Wählen Sie ein RGB-Quellprofil bzw. ein CMYK-Simulationsprofil sowie ein Ausgabeprofil.
Wenn Sie dabei eine Kombination von Quellprofil und Ausgabeprofil wählen, die der in
einem Device Link-Profil festgelegten Kombination entspricht, wird automatisch das
betreffende Device Link-Profil aktiviert und verwendet.
Wird ein Device Link-Profil aktiviert, wird der Inhalt des Fensters „Profi-Farbeinstellungen“
automatisch aktualisiert; dabei werden u. U. bestimmte Fiery Druckoptionen ausgeblendet.
Unter der Option „RGB-Quellprofil“ bzw. „CMYK-Simulationsprofil“ erscheint die
Meldung „Benutztes Device Link-Profil“ zusammen mit dem Namen des verwendeten Profils.
3 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um die Komponente Color Setup zu beenden.
1 Benutztes Device Link-Profil
1
KALIBRIERUNG 34
KALIBRIERUNG
Das regelmäßige Kalibrieren des Fiery X3eTY2 ist die Voraussetzung für konsistente und
exakt prognostizierbare Farbausgaben. Sie können den Fiery X3eTY2 mit der Komponente
Calibrator der ColorWise Pro Tools unter Verwendung des in den Kopierer integrierten
Scanners oder mithilfe eines Densitometers oder Spektralfotometers kalibrieren.
In diesem Dokument wird für Farbmessinstrumente die folgende Terminologie verwendet:
Aufbau dieses Abschnitts
In diesem Abschnitt wird die Kalibrierung des Fiery X3eTY2 mit der Komponente Calibrator
der ColorWise Pro Tools unter Verwendung verschiedener Farbmessinstrumente sowie über
das Kopiererdisplay beschrieben. Die folgende Tabelle erleichtert das Auffinden der einzelnen
Kalibrierungsverfahren.
Begriff Beschreibung
ColorCal plus Calibrator Kalibrierungsverfahren, bei dem die Werte für die Tonerdichte mit
dem in den Kopierer integrierten Scanner gemessen werden. Sie
können die Komponente Calibrator der ColorWise Pro Tools
verwenden, um die ColorCal Kalibrierung durchzuführen.
DTP32 oder
DTP32 Series II
Automatisches Densitometer X-Rite DTP32 II oder
DTP32 Series II
DTP41 Automatisches Spektralfotometer X-Rite DTP41
ED-100 Densitometer ED-100
ES-1000 Spektralfotometer ES-1000
ColorCal über
Kopiererdisplay
Kalibrierungsverfahren, bei dem die Werte für die Tonerdichte mit
dem in den Kopierer integrierten Scanner gemessen werden. Die
ColorCal Kalibrierung kann über das Kopiererdisplay erfolgen.
Kalibrierungsverfahren Siehe
ColorCal plus Calibrator Seite 39
DTP32 oder DTP32 Series II plus Calibrator Seite 42
DTP41 plus Calibrator Seite 44
ED-100 plus Calibrator Seite 47
ES-1000 plus Calibrator Seite 51
ColorCal über Kopiererdisplay Seite 54
KALIBRIERUNG 35
Dieser Abschnitt enthält auch wichtige Hintergrundinformationen und Empfehlungen für
die Kalibrierung. Die folgende Tabelle erleichtert das Auffinden der behandelten Themen.
HINWEIS: Die in diesem Kapitel beschriebenen Verfahren sind für Windows und Mac OS
im Wesentlichen identisch. Alle Abbildungen in diesem Abschnitt stammen von einem
Windows-Computer.
Kalibrieren mit Komponente Calibrator der ColorWise Pro Tools
Mit der Komponente Calibrator der ColorWise Pro Tools stehen für die Kalibrierung des
Fiery X3eTY2 mehrere Messverfahren zur Auswahl.
Das Ändern der Kalibrierung hat Auswirkungen auf alle Aufträge aller Anwender; zur Farbkalibrierung
sollte daher nur eine begrenzte Anzahl von Personen berechtigt werden. Sie
können ein Administratorkennwort festlegen, um den Zugriff auf die Kalibrierungsfunktion
zu steuern (siehe Konfiguration und Setup).
HINWEIS: Über die ColorWise Pro Tools können mehrere Anwender gleichzeitig mit einem
Fiery X3eTY2 verbunden sein. Die Komponente Calibrator kann aber stets nur von einem
Anwender ausgeführt werden. Wenn Sie versuchen, eine Kalibrierung vorzunehmen, solange
ein anderer Anwender die ColorWise Pro Tools für die Kalibrierung einsetzt, wird eine Fehlermeldung
angezeigt.
Starten von Calibrator
Die Komponente Calibrator wird im Hauptfenster der ColorWise Pro Tools gestartet.
FIERY X3ETY2 MIT KOMPONENTE CALIBRATOR KALIBRIEREN
1 Starten Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools und stellen Sie die Verbindung zum Fiery X3eTY2 her.
Die Anleitung für die Konfiguration der Verbindung finden Sie auf den Seiten 13 und 18.
Thema Siehe
Übersicht Seite 56
Funktionsweise der Kalibrierung Seite 56
Zeitplanung für die Kalibrierung Seite 58
Ermitteln des Kalibrierungsstatus Seite 59
KALIBRIERUNG 36
2 Klicken Sie auf „Calibrator“.
3 Wählen Sie im Menü „Messverfahren auswählen“ das gewünschte Messverfahren.
Die konkreten Schritte für die jeweiligen Kalibrierungsverfahren werden im weiteren Verlauf
dieses Abschnitts beschrieben.
Profi-Modus
Die Komponente Calibrator unterstützt zwei Modi: den Standardmodus und den Expertoder
Profi-Modus. Sie können alle für die Kalibrierung wesentlichen Aufgaben im Standardmodus
ausführen. Im Profi- oder Expert-Modus sind zwei weitere Optionen verfügbar:
„Seiten drucken“ und „Messwerte anzeigen“.
1 Kalibrierungsverfahren
1
1 Kalibrierungsverfahren
1
KALIBRIERUNG 37
Mit der Option „Seiten drucken“ können Sie eine Vergleichsseite drucken, die das Ergebnis
der neuen Messwerte in Verbindung mit einem Profil zeigt, das mit dem aktuellen Kalibrierungsset
verknüpft ist. Sie können eine eigene Vergleichsseite erstellen und sie im Format
PostScript oder EPS (Encapsulated PostScript) unter dem Namen „CALIB.PS“ speichern.
Senden Sie diese Datei aus Ihrer Anwendung an die Warteschlange „Halten“ des Fiery X3eTY2.
Sie können die Datei „CALIB.PS” auch erstellen, indem Sie einen beliebigen Auftrag in
der Warteschlange „Halten“ in der Anwendung Command WorkStation umbenennen
(siehe Dienstprogramme).
Mit der Option „Messwerte anzeigen“ können Sie die aktuellen Messwerte in tabellarischer
oder grafischer Form anzeigen; in der Grafik werden die Mess- und die Sollwertekurven
darstellt.
Wenn mehrere Profile dieselben Sollwerte verwenden, wird rechts oben das Menü „Zeichnen
relativ zu“ angezeigt. In diesem Menü werden alle Ausgabeprofile aufgelistet, die dasselbe
Kalibrierungsset verwenden. Wenn Sie in diesem Menü ein Ausgabeprofil wählen, werden
die Sollwertekurven für dieses Profil angezeigt. Wenn jedes Ausgabeprofil eindeutige
Kalibrierungssollwerte verwendet, ändern sich bei einem Profilwechsel die angezeigten
Kurven.
Anwenden von Messwerten auf mehrere Kalibrierungssets
Die Komponente Calibrator stellt eine Option bereit („Auf alle Sets anwenden“), die es Ihnen
ermöglicht, die bei der aktuellen Kalibrierung ermittelten Messwerte für alle Kalibrierungssets
auf dem Server zu übernehmen. Diese Option ist nur verfügbar, wenn der Fiery X3eTY2 über
mehr als ein Kalibrierungsset verfügt. Sie ist standardmäßig aktiviert.
1 Name des Ausgabeprofils
1
KALIBRIERUNG 38
Wenn Sie die Option „Auf alle Sets anwenden“ deaktivieren, können Sie festlegen, dass die
aktuelle Kalibrierung nur auf bestimmte Kalibrierungssets auf dem Server angewendet wird.
Sie können die gewünschten Sets wählen, indem Sie neben der Option „Auf alle Sets
anwenden“ auf „Anpassen“ klicken; daraufhin wird das Fenster „Anwenden“ angezeigt.
Aktivieren bzw. deaktivieren Sie die Optionen der angezeigten Kalibrierungssets; klicken Sie
danach auf „OK“.
Wenn eines der gewählten Kalibrierungssets keinem Ausgabeprofil zugeordnet ist, wird eine
entsprechende Warnmeldung angezeigt. Sie können die ermittelten Kalibrierungsmesswerte
jedoch trotzdem auf dieses Set anwenden.
Die Kalibrierungsmesswerte werden am Ende des Kalibrierungsprozesses in das angegebene
Kalibrierungsset übernommen, wenn Sie auf „Anwenden“ klicken.
Wiederherstellen der Standardmesswerte für die Kalibrierung
Mit den folgenden Schritten können Sie die im Werk voreingestellten Standardmesswerte für
die Kalibrierung wiederherstellen.
STANDARDMESSWERTE FÜR KALIBRIERUNG WIEDERHERSTELLEN
1 Klicken Sie im Fenster „Calibrator“ auf „Standard aktivieren“.
2 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um die Werksstandards für das Kalibrierungsset wiederherzustellen.
HINWEIS: Wenn die Option „Auf alle Sets anwenden“ aktiviert ist, werden alle Kalibrierungssets
auf dem Server wiederhergestellt. Ist die Option „Auf alle Sets anwenden“ deaktiviert,
gilt die Option „Standard aktivieren“ nur für die über die Option „Anpassen“ gewählten
Kalibrierungssets.
KALIBRIERUNG 39
Kalibrieren mit ColorCal
Mit ColorCal können Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 ohne Spektralfotometer oder Densitometer
kalibrieren. Bei der Kalibrierung mit ColorCal werden die Werte für die Tonerdichte statt
dessen mit dem in den Kopierer integrierten Scanner gemessen.
ColorCal hat die folgenden Funktionen:
• Scannerkalibrierung: Bei ColorCal können Sie den Scanner (Einzugsvorrichtung) des
Kopierers mit den Kodak Farb- und Graustufenstreifen kalibrieren.
• Messwerteseite: Bei ColorCal wird eine ColorCal Messwerteseite verwendet, auf der
rechteckige Schwarzweiß- und Farbfelder in zufälliger Reihenfolge angeordnet sind.
Dadurch wird ColorCal weniger durch die Umgebungsbedingungen des Kopierers
beeinflusst, wodurch eine größere Präzision bei der Farbreproduktion und -kalibrierung
erreicht wird.
HINWEIS: Für die Kalibrierung mit ColorCal benötigen Sie den Kodak Graustufenstreifen,
der im Medienpaket des Fiery X3eTY2 enthalten ist. Um den Scanner des Kopierermodells
für ColorCal zu kalibrieren, benötigen Sie außer dem Kodak Graustufenstreifen auch den
Kodak Farbkontrollstreifen.
Wenn Sie ColorCal über die ColorWise Pro Tools ausführen, können Sie den Scanner im
Kopierer vor dem Fiery X3eTY2 selbst kalibrieren. Es empfiehlt sich, den Scanner für
ColorCal zu kalibrieren, wenn das Ausgabeverhalten des Kopierers verändert wurde. Dies
ist z.B. nach Wartungsarbeiten der Fall.
DRUCKSERVER MIT COLORWISE PRO TOOLS UND COLORCAL KALIBRIEREN
1 Starten Sie die Komponente Calibrator.
Die Anleitung zum Starten der Komponente Calibrator finden Sie auf Seite 35.
2 Wählen Sie im Bereich „Messverfahren auswählen“ die Einstellung „ColorCal“.
3 Aktivieren Sie im Bereich „Druckeinstellungen prüfen“ ein geeignetes Kalibrierungsset.
Wählen Sie, wenn mehrere Sets zur Auswahl stehen, das Kalibrierungsset für das Medium,
das Sie am häufigsten verwenden.
HINWEIS: Damit diese Kalibrierung wirksam wird, müssen Sie das Kalibrierungsset mit
einem oder mehreren Ausgabeprofilen verknüpfen. Das Standardkalibrierungsset ist bereits
mit dem Standardausgabeprofil verknüpft, so dass sich eine weitere Zuordnung erübrigt.
4 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Messwerteseite generieren“ auf „Drucken“.
KALIBRIERUNG 40
5 Wählen Sie den gewünschten Seitentyp.
• Bei der Einstellung „ColorCal Seite“ wird eines von 256 ColorCal Mustern nach dem
Zufallsprinzip gewählt und gedruckt.
• Bei der Einstellung „Bestimmtes Muster“ wird ein bestimmtes ColorCal Muster gedruckt.
Die Nummer des Musters können Sie in das Feld „Farbfeldseite #“ eingeben.
Für die Papiergröße wird automatisch die Einstellung „LTR/A4“ gewählt.
6 Wählen Sie das Zufuhrfach für die Messwerteseite und klicken Sie auf „Drucken“.
In einer Meldung werden Sie über den Status Ihres Druckauftrags informiert.
7 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um den Vorgang fortzusetzen.
8 Nehmen Sie die gedruckte Messwerteseite aus dem Ablagefach des Kopierermodells.
9 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Messwerte ermitteln“ auf „Messen“.
Sie werden gefragt, ob Sie den in den Kopierer integrierten Scanner kalibrieren wollen.
10 Wählen Sie „Ja“, wenn Sie den Scanner kalibrieren wollen. Wählen Sie „Nein“, wenn Sie die
Scannerkalibrierung auslassen wollen; fahren Sie in diesem Fall mit Schritt 18 fort.
KALIBRIERUNG 41
11 Wählen Sie das Zufuhrfach für die Messwerteseite und klicken Sie auf „Drucken“.
Als Seitentyp wird automatisch die Einstellung „Scanner-Messwerteseite“ angezeigt. Für die
Papiergröße wird automatisch die Einstellung „LTR/A4“ gewählt.
In einer Meldung werden Sie über den Status Ihres Druckauftrags informiert.
12 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um den Vorgang fortzusetzen.
13 Nehmen Sie die gedruckte Messwerteseite aus dem Kopierer.
14 Legen Sie die Graustufenskala, die Farbskala und die Messwerteseite für die Scannerkalibrierung
auf dem Vorlagenglas des Kopierers ab. Die genauen Anleitungen dafür
enthält das Dialogfenster „Setup für Scannerkalibrierung“.
15 Klicken Sie auf „Fortfahren“.
16 Am Ende des Messvorgangs wird das Dialogfenster „Informationen“ angezeigt.
17 Klicken Sie auf „Fortfahren“, um die Scannerkalibrierung fortzusetzen.
KALIBRIERUNG 42
18 Legen Sie den Graustufenstreifen und die ColorCal Messwerteseite auf das Vorlagenglase
des Kopierers ab; die genauen Anleitungen dafür enthält das Dialogfenster „Farbfeldseite
auflegen“.
19 Klicken Sie auf „Fortfahren“.
20 Am Ende des Messvorgangs wird das Dialogfenster „Messung“ angezeigt.
21 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um die Kalibrierung abzuschließen.
22 Klicken Sie auf „Anwenden“, um die ColorCal Kalibrierungswerte anzuwenden.
Kalibrieren mit DTP32 oder DTP32 Series II
Mit dem Densitometer DTP32 oder DTP 32 Series II können Sie die Farbfelder der vom
Kopierer generierten Messwerteseite messen und die Messwerte automatisch auf den
Fiery X3eTY2 laden.
HINWEIS: Bevor Sie mit den ColorWise Pro Tools den Fiery X3eTY2 kalibrieren, müssen Sie
das Densitometer DTP32 oder DTP 32 Series II einrichten und kalibrieren. Die Anleitung
hierzu finden Sie in der im Lieferumfang des Messinstruments enthaltenen Dokumentation.
FIERY X3ETY2 MIT DTP32 ODER DTP32 SERIES II KALIBRIEREN
1 Starten Sie die Komponente Calibrator.
Die Anleitung dazu finden Sie auf Seite 35.
2 Wählen Sie „X-Rite DTP32“ oder „X-Rite DTP32 Series II“ als Messverfahren.
3 Aktivieren Sie im Bereich „Druckeinstellungen prüfen“ das gewünschte Kalibrierungsset.
KALIBRIERUNG 43
Wählen Sie, wenn mehrere Sets zur Auswahl stehen, das Kalibrierungsset für das Medium, das
Sie am häufigsten verwenden.
HINWEIS: Damit diese Kalibrierung wirksam wird, müssen Sie das Kalibrierungsset mit
einem oder mehreren Ausgabeprofilen verknüpfen. Das Standardkalibrierungsset ist bereits
dem Standardausgabeprofil zugeordnet. Für das Standardkalibrierungsset brauchen Sie keine
erneute Zuordnung vornehmen.
4 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Messwerteseite generieren“ auf „Drucken“.
Das Dialogfenster „Druckoptionen“ wird angezeigt.
5 Wählen Sie die gewünschten Optionen und klicken Sie auf „Drucken“.
Seitentyp: Sie können zwischen 21 und 34 sortierten Farbfeldern wählen.
Papiergröße: Hier wird automatisch die Einstellung „LTR/A4“ für 21 sortierte Farbfelder festgelegt.
Wählen Sie die Einstellung „11x17/A3“ oder „12x18/SRA3“, wenn Sie 34 sortierte
Farbfelder generieren wollen.
Papierzufuhr: Wählen Sie das Fach oder Magazin, aus dem das Medium für die
Messwerteseite zugeführt werden soll.
Halftone-Raster: Wählen Sie, um optimale Ergebnisse zu erzielen, das Halftone-Raster,
das Sie beim Drucken mithilfe dieses Kalibrierungssets verwenden werden.
6 Nehmen Sie die gedruckte Messwerteseite aus dem Kopierer.
7 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Messwerte ermitteln“ auf „Messen“.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster mit den Messoptionen geöffnet, in dem der angegebene
Seitentyp und die gewählte Papiergröße angezeigt werden.
8 Klicken Sie auf „Messen“.
Führen Sie die Messwerteseite entsprechend den Anweisungen auf dem Bildschirm in das
DTP32 ein.
HINWEIS: Das DTP32 Series II besitzt keine solche Führungsschiene. Legen Sie bei diesem
Instrument die Seite so an, dass der zu messende Farbstreifen unter der Justiermarke ausgerichtet
ist.
KALIBRIERUNG 44
Im Feld „Status“ werden Anweisungen für die Auswahl des Anschlusses und für das Zuführen
der Messwerteseite angezeigt; die Messwerteseite muss einmal für jeden Farbstreifen zugeführt
werden (insgesamt also viermal).
9 Klicken Sie auf „Übernehmen“, wenn im Feld „Status“ die Meldung erscheint, dass die
Messungen erfolgreich waren.
10 Klicken Sie im Dialogfenster „Messen“ auf „OK“.
11 Klicken Sie im Fenster „Calibrator“ auf „Anwenden“, um das neue Kalibrierungsset zu
implementieren.
12 Klicken Sie im Fenster „Information“ auf „OK“.
Damit ist die Kalibrierung beendet.
Kalibrieren mit DTP41
Mit dem Spektralfotometer DTP41 können Sie die Farbfelder der vom Kopierer generierten
Messwerteseite messen und die Messwerte automatisch auf den Fiery X3eTY2 laden.
HINWEIS: Bevor Sie mit den ColorWise Pro Tools den Fiery X3eTY2 kalibrieren, müssen Sie
das Densitometer DTP41 einrichten und kalibrieren. Die Anleitung hierzu finden Sie in der
im Lieferumfang des Messinstruments enthaltenen Dokumentation.
DTP32
DTP32 Series II
KALIBRIERUNG 45
FIERY X3ETY2 MIT DTP41 KALIBRIEREN
1 Starten Sie die Komponente Calibrator.
Die Anleitung dazu finden Sie auf Seite 35.
2 Wählen Sie „X-Rite DTP41“ als Messverfahren.
3 Aktivieren Sie im Bereich „Druckeinstellungen prüfen“ das gewünschte Kalibrierungsset.
Wählen Sie, wenn mehrere Sets zur Auswahl stehen, das Kalibrierungsset für das Medium, das
Sie am häufigsten verwenden.
HINWEIS: Damit diese Kalibrierung wirksam wird, müssen Sie das Kalibrierungsset mit
einem oder mehreren Ausgabeprofilen verknüpfen. Das Standardkalibrierungsset ist bereits
dem Standardausgabeprofil zugeordnet. Für das Standardkalibrierungsset brauchen Sie keine
erneute Zuordnung vornehmen.
4 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Messwerteseite generieren“ auf „Drucken“.
Das Dialogfenster „Druckoptionen“ wird angezeigt.
5 Wählen Sie die gewünschten Optionen und klicken Sie auf „Drucken“.
Seitentyp: Sie können zwischen 21 und 34 sortierten Farbfeldern wählen.
Papiergröße: Hier wird automatisch die Einstellung „LTR/A4“ für 21 sortierte Farbfelder
festgelegt. Wählen Sie die Einstellung „11x17/A3“ oder „12x18/SRA3“, wenn Sie
34 sortierte Farbfelder generieren wollen.
Papierzufuhr: Wählen Sie das Fach oder Magazin, aus dem das Medium für die
Messwerteseite zugeführt werden soll.
Halftone-Raster: Wählen Sie, um optimale Ergebnisse zu erzielen, das Halftone-Raster,
das Sie beim Drucken mithilfe dieses Kalibrierungssets verwenden werden.
6 Nehmen Sie die gedruckte Messwerteseite aus dem Kopierer.
KALIBRIERUNG 46
7 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Messwerte ermitteln“ auf „Messen“.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster mit den Messoptionen geöffnet, in dem der angegebene
Seitentyp und die gewählte Papiergröße angezeigt werden.
8 Klicken Sie auf „Messen“.
9 Wählen Sie in der Liste „Verfügbare Anschlüsse“ ggf. den COM-Anschluss für das DTP41 und
klicken Sie anschließend auf „Messung starten“.
10 Führen Sie die Messwerteseite in das DTP41 ein; messen Sie zuerst den Cyan-Farbstreifen.
Richten Sie die Messwerteseite so im Führungsschlitz aus, dass der jeweils zu messende
Farbstreifen unter der Justiermarke zentriert ist. Führen Sie die Messwerteseite über die
vorderen Walzen in das Instrument ein, bis sie an die hinteren Antriebswalzen stößt
(etwa 7 cm) und Sie einen Widerstand spüren.
11 Klicken Sie auf „Streifen lesen“.
Die Messwerteseite wird nun automatisch durch das DTP41 gezogen.
Nachdem die Messwerteseite gelesen wurde, werden Sie von der Komponente Calibrator
aufgefordert, die Messwerteseite für den nächsten zu messenden Farbstreifen auszurichten
und zuzuführen.
KALIBRIERUNG 47
12 Wiederholen Sie die oben beschriebenen Schritte für die Farbstreifen Magenta, Gelb und
Schwarz.
Das runde Kontrollelement des zuletzt gemessenen Farbstreifens wird mit einem Häkchen
versehen; zugleich erscheint im Feld „Status“ eine Bestätigungsmeldung, dass die Messung
erfolgreich war.
Klicken Sie auf „Zurück“ oder „Weiter“ um den letzten bzw. den nächsten Schritt des
Messverfahrens anzusteuern.
13 Klicken Sie auf „Messwerte übernehmen“, wenn im Feld „Status“ angezeigt wird, dass alle
vier Farbstreifen erfolgreich eingelesen wurden.
14 Klicken Sie im Dialogfenster „Messen“ auf „OK“.
15 Klicken Sie im Fenster „Calibrator“ auf „Anwenden“, um das neue Kalibrierungsset zu
implementieren.
16 Klicken Sie im Fenster „Information“ auf „OK“.
Damit ist die Kalibrierung des Fiery X3eTY2 beendet.
Kalibrieren mit ED-100
Sie können den Fiery X3eTY2 mit den ColorWise Pro Tools in Verbindung mit dem ED-100
kalibrieren.
HINWEIS: Sie müssen den Kopierer stets kalibrieren, wenn Sie das ED-100 verwenden.
FIERY X3ETY2 MIT ED-100 KALIBRIEREN
1 Starten Sie die Komponente Calibrator.
Die Anleitung zum Starten der Komponente Calibrator finden Sie auf Seite 35.
2 Wählen Sie „EFI Densitometer ED-100“ als Messverfahren.
KALIBRIERUNG 48
3 Aktivieren Sie im Bereich „Druckeinstellungen prüfen“ das gewünschte Kalibrierungsset.
Wählen Sie, wenn mehrere Sets zur Auswahl stehen, das Kalibrierungsset für das Medium, das
Sie am häufigsten verwenden.
HINWEIS: Damit diese Kalibrierung wirksam wird, müssen Sie das Kalibrierungsset mit
einem oder mehreren Ausgabeprofilen verknüpfen. Das Standardkalibrierungsset ist bereits
mit dem Standardausgabeprofil verknüpft, so dass sich eine weitere Zuordnung erübrigt.
4 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Messwerteseite generieren“ auf „Drucken“.
Das Dialogfenster „Druckoptionen“ wird angezeigt.
5 Wählen Sie die gewünschten Optionen und klicken Sie auf „Drucken“.
Seitentyp: Sie können zwischen der Messwerteseite mit 21 Farbfeldern und der Seite mit
34 Farbfeldern (jeweils sortiert bzw. in Zufallsfolge) wählen. Sortierte Felder werden auf der
Seite abgestuft nach Farbton und Sättigung gedruckt. Felder in Zufallsfolge werden auf der
Seite ohne eine bestimmte Reihenfolge gedruckt, um unterschiedliche Dichten in unterschiedlichen
Seitenbereichen auszugleichen.
Papiergröße: Hier wird automatisch die Einstellung „LTR/A4“ für 21 Farbfelder festgelegt.
Wählen Sie statt dessen die Einstellung „11x17/A3“ oder „12x18/SRA3“, wenn Sie
34 Farbfelder generieren wollen.
Papierzufuhr: Wählen Sie das Fach oder Magazin, aus dem das Medium für die
Messwerteseite zugeführt werden soll.
Halftone-Raster: Wählen Sie, um optimale Ergebnisse zu erzielen, das Halftone-Raster,
das Sie beim Drucken mithilfe dieses Kalibrierungssets verwenden werden.
6 Nehmen Sie die gedruckte Messwerteseite aus dem Kopierer.
7 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Messwerte ermitteln“ auf „Messen“.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster mit den Messoptionen angezeigt.
KALIBRIERUNG 49
8 Wählen Sie die gewünschten Optionen und klicken Sie auf „Start“.
Als Seitentyp wird automatisch der Typ der Messwerteseite angezeigt, für den Sie sich in
Schritt 5 entschieden haben.
Geben Sie mit den Pfeiltasten neben dem Feld „Klickvorgänge pro Farbfeld“ an, wie oft die
einzelnen Farbfelder auf der Seite gemessen werden sollen. Wenn Sie sich für die Mehrfachmessung
entscheiden, wird für jedes Feld der Durchschnittswert ermittelt und an den
Fiery X3eTY2 gesendet. Mehrfachmessungen bringen exaktere Ergebnisse, dauern aber
länger.
Aktivieren Sie die Option „Akustische Rückmeldung“, wenn jede Einzelmessung durch einen
Signalton bestätigt werden soll. Dabei zeigt ein einzelner Ton eine erfolgreiche Messung an,
zwei Töne dagegen einen Messfehler. Bei aktivierter Mehrfachmessung ertönt das Signal nach
dem letzten Messvorgang.
Wählen Sie im Menü „Anschluss“ ggf. den COM-Anschluss für das ED-100.
Wenn Sie auf „Starten“ klicken, wird das Fenster mit den Messwerten angezeigt.
Im Bereich „Status“ werden Anleitungen zur Messung der Farbfelder eingeblendet.
KALIBRIERUNG 50
9 Positionieren Sie das ED-100 über dem angegebenen Farbfeld auf der Messwerteseite. Dabei
muss sich die Messöffnung zentriert über dem Feld befinden. Drücken Sie die Taste Messen,
um die Messung auszulösen.
HINWEIS: Legen Sie mehrere leere Blätter unter die Messwerteseite, um ein exaktes Ergebnis
zu erzielen. Dadurch verhindern Sie, dass unter der Seite befindliche farbige Flächen vom
Messinstrument gelesen werden und das Messergebnis verfälschen.
Wenn Sie die Mehrfachmessung aktiviert haben, halten Sie die Taste Messen gedrückt, damit
die erforderliche Anzahl der Messungen vorgenommen wird. Es empfiehlt sich, das ED-100
nach jeder Messung leicht zu bewegen, allerdings stets innerhalb des jeweiligen Farbfelds.
Nach einer erfolgreichen Messung wird das Farbfeld im Fenster mit den Messwerten mit
einem Häkchen versehen. Danach wird das nächste zu messende Feld gekennzeichnet.
10 Wiederholen Sie Schritt 9 so oft, bis alle Felder auf der Messwerteseite gemessen wurden.
Beginnen Sie bei A1, und gehen Sie in Spalte A nach unten. Fahren Sie nach dem Messen aller
Felder in Spalte A in gleicher Weise mit Spalte B fort, bis Sie alle Spalten gemessen haben.
Wenn Sie eine bestimmte Messung wiederholen wollen, wählen Sie das gewünschte Farbfeld
im Fenster „Messwerte“ aus und messen Sie das Farbfeld auf der Messwerteseite erneut mit
dem ED-100.
HINWEIS: Sie müssen die Messungen in der Reihenfolge vornehmen, die im Fenster
„Messwerte“ und auf der Seite mit den Messwerten vorgegeben ist.
11 Klicken Sie auf „Übernehmen“, wenn alle Farbfelder erfolgreich gemessen wurden.
12 Klicken Sie im Fenster „Calibrator“ auf „Anwenden“.
Die neuen Kalibrierungsmesswerte werden implementiert.
13 Klicken Sie im Fenster „Information“ auf „OK“.
Damit ist die Kalibrierung des Fiery X3eTY2 beendet.
KALIBRIERUNG 51
Kalibrieren mit ES-1000
Sie können den Fiery X3eTY2 mit den ColorWise Pro Tools in Verbindung mit dem
Spektralfotometer ES-1000 kalibrieren.
HINWEIS: Sie müssen das ES-1000 einrichten und kalibrieren, bevor Sie den Fiery X3eTY2
mithilfe der ColorWise Pro Tools kalibrieren. Die Anleitung finden Sie in der Dokumentation
zu Ihrem Messinstrument.
FIERY X3ETY2 MIT ES-1000 KALIBRIEREN
1 Starten Sie die Komponente Calibrator.
Die Anleitung dazu finden Sie auf Seite 35.
2 Wählen Sie „EFI Spectrometer ES-1000“ als Messverfahren.
3 Aktivieren Sie im Bereich „Druckeinstellungen prüfen“ das gewünschte Kalibrierungsset.
Wählen Sie, wenn mehrere Sets zur Auswahl stehen, das Kalibrierungsset für das Medium,
das Sie am häufigsten verwenden.
HINWEIS: Damit diese Kalibrierung wirksam wird, müssen Sie das Kalibrierungsset mit
einem oder mehreren Ausgabeprofilen verknüpfen. Das Standardkalibrierungsset ist bereits
dem Standardausgabeprofil zugeordnet. Für das Standardkalibrierungsset brauchen Sie keine
erneute Zuordnung vornehmen.
4 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Messwerteseite generieren“ auf „Drucken“.
Das Dialogfenster „Druckoptionen“ wird angezeigt.
5 Wählen Sie die gewünschten Optionen und klicken Sie auf „Drucken“.
KALIBRIERUNG 52
Seitentyp: Wählen Sie zwischen der Messwerteseite mit 21 oder 34 Farbfeldern (jeweils
sortiert oder in Zufallsfolge). Sortierte Felder werden auf der Seite abgestuft nach Farbton
und Sättigung gedruckt. Felder in Zufallsfolge werden auf der Seite ohne eine bestimmte
Reihenfolge gedruckt, um unterschiedliche Dichten in unterschiedlichen Seitenbereichen
auszugleichen.
Papiergröße: Hier wird automatisch die Einstellung „LTR/A4“ für 21 Farbfelder festgelegt.
Wählen Sie die Einstellung „11x17/A3“ oder „12x18/SRA3“, wenn Sie 34 Farbfelder generieren
wollen.
Papierzufuhr: Hier wird automatisch die Einstellung „Automatisch auswählen“ eingestellt.
Halftone-Raster: Wählen Sie, um optimale Ergebnisse zu erzielen, das Halftone-Raster,
das Sie beim Drucken mithilfe dieses Kalibrierungssets verwenden werden.
6 Nehmen Sie die gedruckte Messwerteseite aus dem Kopierer.
7 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Messwerte ermitteln“ auf „Messen“.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster mit den Messoptionen angezeigt.
Als Seitentyp wird automatisch der Typ angezeigt, für den Sie sich in Schritt 5 entschieden
haben.
8 Überprüfen Sie die Einstellungen und klicken Sie auf „Messen“.
Das Dialogfenster „Information“ wird angezeigt.
9 Legen Sie das ES-1000 in der Basisstation ab.
Wenn Sie das Spektralfotometer ES-1000 in der Basisstation ablegen, wird eine Weißpunktkalibrierung
durchgeführt, die graduelle Abweichungen des Messinstruments kompensiert.
Stellen Sie sicher, dass die Messöffnung des Instruments exakt auf dem weißen Keramikfeld
der Basisstation aufliegt. Wird das Spektralfotometer nicht richtig in die Basisstation eingesetzt,
werden keine präzisen Messwerte generiert.
KALIBRIERUNG 53
10 Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster „Messwerte“ angezeigt. Im Bereich „Status“ werden
Anleitungen zur Messung der Farbstreifen und Farbfelder eingeblendet.
11 Legen Sie mehrere leere weiße Blätter unter die Messwerteseite, um ein exakteres
Messergebnis zu erzielen.
Die zusätzlichen Blätter verhindern, dass Farbflächen unter der Messwerteseite vom
Messinstrument gelesen werden und das Messergebnis verfälschen.
12 Richten Sie die Messwerteseite so aus, dass die Streifen horizontal verlaufen und das
Scannen von links nach rechts erfolgt (die Pfeile am Beginn jedes Streifen geben die
Scanrichtung an).
13 Halten Sie das ES-1000 so, dass sich seine Längsseite im rechten Winkel zur Scanrichtung
befindet und richten Sie die Messöffnung mit dem weißen Bereich am Beginn der jeweiligen
Farbe aus.
14 Halten Sie die Messtaste gedrückt, bis Sie einen Signalton hören, oder warten Sie, bis die
Hintergrundfarbe des Dialogfensters von Grün nach Weiß wechselt.
HINWEIS: Damit auf einem Windows-Computer der Signalton ausgegeben werden kann,
muss der Computer mit einer Soundkarte und mit Lautsprechern ausgerüstet sein. Unter
Umständen müssen Sie an Ihrem Computer die Lautstärke erhöhen, um den Signalton hören
zu können.
15 Ziehen Sie, wenn Sie den Signalton hören bzw. die Hintergrundfarbe des Dialogfensters
wechselt, das ES-1000 langsam und gleichmäßig über den Farbstreifen.
Es dauert etwa fünf Sekunden, bis der gesamte Streifen gemessen wurde.
16 Lassen Sie die Messtaste erst los, nachdem alle Farbfelder des aktuellen Farbstreifens
gemessen wurden und Sie den weißen Bereich am Ende des Farbstreifens erreicht haben.
Nachdem ein Farbstreifen erfolgreich gemessen wurde, wechselt die Hintergrundfarbe des
Dialogfensters wieder nach Grün und das Fadenkreuz markiert die nächste Farbe. Konnte
der Farbstreifen nicht erfolgreich gemessen werden, wechselt die Hintergrundfarbe des
Dialogfensters nach Rot und Sie werden in einer Meldung aufgefordert, die Messung zu
wiederholen.
KALIBRIERUNG 54
17 Wiederholen Sie die Schritte 13 bis 16, bis alle Farbstreifen gemessen wurden.
HINWEIS: Sie müssen die Messungen in der Reihenfolge vornehmen, die im Bereich „Status“
vorgegeben wird.
18 Klicken Sie auf „Übernehmen“, wenn alle Farbfelder erfolgreich gemessen wurden.
19 Klicken Sie im Fenster „Calibrator“ auf „Anwenden“.
Die neuen Kalibrierungsmesswerte werden angewendet.
20 Klicken Sie im Fenster „Information“ auf „OK“.
Damit ist die Kalibrierung des Fiery X3eTY2 beendet.
Kalibrieren über Kopiererdisplay
Der Fiery X3eTY2 kann mit der Funktion ColorCal über das Kopiererdisplay kalibriert
werden. Für diese Art der Kalibrierung ist die Komponente Calibrator der ColorWise Pro
Tools nicht erforderlich.
Kalibrieren mit ColorCal
Falls das Administratorkennwort eingerichtet wurde, müssen Sie sich damit für die
Kalibrierung über das Kopiererdisplay autorisieren. Weitere Hinweise zum Kopiererdisplay
finden Sie im Dokument Konfiguration und Setup.
COLORCAL ÜBER KOPIERERDISPLAY AUSFÜHREN
1 Drücken Sie auf „Controller“, wenn sich der Kopierer im Status „Bereit“ befindet,
um auf die Schnittstelle des Fiery X3eTY2 zuzugreifen.
2 Wählen Sie „Kalibrierung“.
3 Wählen Sie das gewünschte Kalibrierungsset als Druckmodus.
4 Wählen Sie das Fach oder Magazin, aus dem das Medium für die Messwerteseite zugeführt
werden soll.
Vergewissern Sie sich, dass das in das Fach/Magazin eingelegte Papier die Größe aufweist,
die auf dem Display angezeigt wird.
Die Messwerteseite enthält standardisierte Farbfelder, die mithilfe des in den Kopierer
integrierten Scanners gemessen werden; danach werden die gemessenen Werte mit den
Sollfarbwerten verglichen.
HINWEIS: Wenn Sie das Medium für die Messwerteseite über die Stapelanlage zuführen
wollen, müssen Sie das entsprechende Medium zuvor einlegen.
5 Drücken Sie auf „Scanner anpassen“ und danach auf „Drucken“, wenn Sie zunächst den
Scanner kalibrieren wollen. Fahren Sie ansonsten mit Schritt 9 fort.
Die Messwerteseite für die Scannerkalibrierung wird gedruckt. Nachdem diese Seite gedruckt
wurde, wird auf dem Display wieder die Schnittstelle der Druckmaschine angezeigt.
KALIBRIERUNG 55
6 Nehmen Sie die gedruckte Messwerteseite für die Scannerkalibrierung aus dem Kopierer;
drücken Sie danach auf „Controller“, um die Scannerkalibrierung fortzusetzen.
7 Legen Sie die Messwerteseite für die Scannerkalibrierung entsprechend der Anleitung auf der
Glasfläche des Kopierers; drücken Sie danach auf „Scannen“.
8 Drücken Sie auf „OK“, wenn die Meldung erscheint, dass die Scanneranpassung beendet wurde.
9 Drücken Sie auf „Drucken“.
Die Messwerteseite für die Farbkalibrierung wird gedruckt. Nachdem diese Seite gedruckt
wurde, wird auf dem Display wieder die Schnittstelle der Druckmaschine angezeigt.
10 Nehmen Sie die gedruckte Messwerteseite für die Farbkalibrierung aus dem Kopierer;
drücken Sie danach auf „Controller“, um die Kalibrierung fortzusetzen.
11 Legen Sie, wenn Sie dazu aufgefordert werden, den Kodak Graustufenstreifen mit der
bedruckten Seite nach unten auf das Vorlagenglas des Kopierers ab.
Zentrieren Sie den Streifen am oberen Rand des Vorlagenglases zwischen den entsprechenden
Papiergrößenangaben am Kopierer.
12 Legen Sie die Messwerteseite mit dem Druckbild nach unten über den Graustufenstreifen.
Achten Sie darauf, dass der Graustufenstreifen keine Farbfelder auf der Messwerteseite
verdeckt.
Schließen Sie die Klappe am Vorlagenglas; achten Sie darauf, dass der Graustufenstreifen und
die Messwerteseite nicht verrutschen.
13 Drücken Sie auf dem Kopiererdisplay auf „Scannen“.
14 Warten Sie, bis auf dem Display die Meldung erscheint, dass die Kalibrierung beendet wurde.
15 Drücken Sie auf „Vergleichen“, um eine Seite mit einem Vergleich der aktuellen Kalibrierung
mit der Standardkalibrierung zu drucken.
Anhand dieser Vergleichsseite können Sie das Resultat der Kalibrierung prüfen.
16 Drücken Sie auf „Anwenden“, um die Messwerte zu speichern und gegebenenfalls im
Kalibrierungsset vorhandene Kalibrierungsdaten zu überschreiben.
1 Legen Sie den Graustufenstreifen
mit dem Druckbild
nach unten ab
2 Legen Sie die Messwerteseite
mit dem Druckbild nach
unten über den Graustufenstreifen
1 2
KALIBRIERUNG 56
Zweck der Kalibrierung
In den folgenden Abschnitten werden wichtige Grundlagen der Kalibrierung behandelt.
Übersicht
Bei der Kalibrierung werden Kurven erstellt, die die Unterschiede zwischen den tatsächlichen
Tonerdichten (Messwerten) und dem laut Ausgabeprofil erwarteten Ergebnis oder Verhalten
ausgleichen.
• Die Messwerte reflektieren das tatsächliche Farbverhalten des Kopierermodells.
• Kalibrierungssets sind Gruppen oder Sätze von Messwerten, die die Einstellungen für
Medium für die Komponente Calibrator kombinieren.
• Jedes Ausgabeprofil enthält Kalibrierungssollwerte, die das erwartete Verhalten des
Kopierermodells beschreiben.
Nachdem Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 kalibriert haben, wird ein Kalibrierungsset gespeichert.
Dieses Kalibrierungsset wird verwendet, wenn Sie es mit einem Ausgabeprofil verknüpfen.
Jedem Ausgabeprofil ist ein Kalibrierungsset zugeordnet. Wenn Sie kein Ausgabeprofil
wählen, wird das Set verwendet, das mit dem Standardausgabeprofil verknüpft ist.
Wenn Sie die Kalibrierungseinstellungen nach der Verarbeitung eines Druckauftrags ändern,
müssen Sie den Auftrag nicht noch einmal verarbeiten. Die neuen Kalibrierungseinstellungen
wirken sich auf den Auftrag aus, ohne dass dieser nochmals verarbeitet werden muss.
HINWEIS: Das Ändern der Kalibrierung hat Auswirkungen auf alle Aufträge aller Anwender;
zur Farbkalibrierung sollte daher nur eine begrenzte Anzahl von Personen berechtigt werden.
Im Setup-Programm des Fiery X3eTY2 können Sie das Administratorkennwort festlegen, um
den Zugriff auf die Kalibrierungsfunktion zu steuern (siehe Konfiguration und Setup).
Funktionsweise der Kalibrierung
Das Standardkalibrierungsset eignet sich für die meisten Anwendungszwecke. Der
Fiery X3eTY2 bietet aber die Möglichkeit, ein Set zu wählen, mit dem die Kalibrierung
spezifisch angepasst wird.
Durch Kalibrieren können Sie:
• die Farbreproduktion des Fiery X3eTY2 optimieren
• die Farbkonsistenz über längere Zeiträume sichern
• konsistente Ausgaben auf verschiedenen Fiery X3eTY2 Servern sicherstellen
• die Reproduktion von Spot- oder Sonderfarben (z.B. PANTONE-Farben und
benannte Farben anderer Farbsysteme) entscheidend verbessern
• den Fiery X3eTY2 für die Verwendung von ColorWise Farbwiedergabearten (CRDs),
CMYK-Simulationen und ICC-Profilen optimieren
KALIBRIERUNG 57
Das Erzielen zufrieden stellender Druckergebnisse mit dem Fiery X3eTY2 hängt von
mehreren Faktoren ab. Zu den wichtigsten zählen das Bestimmen und Einhalten der
optimalen Tonerdichten. Die Dichte ist das Maß dafür, wie viel Licht eine Oberfläche
absorbiert. Durch das sorgsame Regulieren der Tonerdichten können Sie konsistente
Farbausgaben sicherstellen.
Doch selbst bei kalibrierten Systemen werden die Tonerdichten durch die Einstellungen
des Kopierermodells sowie durch die Luftfeuchtigkeit und die Umgebungstemperatur
beeinflusst. Nach einer gewissen Zeit kann es auch zu Schwankungen in der Dichte kommen.
Auch ungleichmäßige Tonerdichten auf dem Papier können die Kalibrierungsergebnisse
beeinflussen. Außerdem ist zu beobachten, dass die Dichte, die Gradation und die Farbreproduktion
mit der Zeit von den Idealwerten abweichen. Diese Veränderungen können
Sie durch regelmäßiges Kalibrieren kompensieren.
Die Kalibrierung basiert auf Kalibrierungskurven, die auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 erstellt werden
und die Unterschiede zwischen den tatsächlichen (gemessenen) Dichten und den gewünschten
Solldichten ausgleichen. Kalibrierungskurven sind grafische Pendants zu Transferfunktionen,
die ihrerseits die Änderungen, die an den Originaldaten vorgenommen werden, mit mathematischen
Mitteln beschreiben. Transferfunktionen werden häufig als Eingangs- oder
Ausgangskurven dargestellt.
Der Fiery X3eTY2 generiert Kalibrierungskurven, nachdem für jede der vier Tonerfarben die
Mess- mit den endgültigen Sollwerten verglichen wurden. Die Sollwerte basieren auf dem
gewählten Ausgabeprofil.
Messwerte
Messwertedateien enthalten numerische Werte, die die mit dem Kopierer erzielte Tonerdichte
prozentual für jede der vier Farben Cyan, Magenta, Gelb und Schwarz angeben.
Um eine Messwertedatei zu erstellen, müssen Sie eine Messwerteseite mit standardisierten
Farbfeldern drucken. Die Farbfelder dieser Messwerteseite werden danach mit einem
Farbmessinstrument, das an einen Computer im Netzwerk angeschlossen ist, oder (falls
vorhanden) mit der Scannereinheit des Ausgabegeräts gemessen. Die neuen Messwerte
werden automatisch auf den Fiery X3eTY2 geladen.
Ausgabeprofile und Kalibrierungssets
Ausgabeprofile und Kalibrierungssets definieren die Ergebniswerte, die durch die Kalibrierung
erzielt werden sollen. Für den Fiery X3eTY2 sind mindestens ein Ausgabeprofil und ein Kalibrierungsset
verfügbar. Wenn Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 kalibrieren, können Sie das Set wählen,
das einem für Ihre Druckumgebung typischen Auftrag in optimaler Weise entspricht. Dieses
Kalibrierungsset kann mit einem oder mehreren Ausgabeprofilen verknüpft werden. Weitere
Informationen über Ausgabeprofile finden Sie auf Seite 93.
KALIBRIERUNG 58
Zeitplanung für die Kalibrierung
Sie sollten den Fiery X3eTY2 abhängig vom Druckvolumen, jedoch mindestens einmal pro
Tag kalibrieren. Wenn die Konsistenz der Farben absolut vorrangig ist oder sich der Kopierer
in einer Umgebung mit hohen Schwankungen bei der Temperatur und der Luftfeuchtigkeit
befindet, sollten Sie die Kalibrierung alle paar Stunden vornehmen. Um dauerhaft eine optimale
Leistung sicherzustellen, sollten Sie die Kalibrierung wiederholen, sobald Sie sichtbare
Qualitätseinbußen in der Farbausgabe bemerken oder nicht die erwarteten Ergebnisse
erzielen.
Wenn Sie einen Auftrag auf zwei oder mehr Stapel aufteilen müssen, ist es unerlässlich,
die Kalibrierung vor dem Drucken der einzelnen Stapel zu wiederholen. Auch nach
Wartungsarbeiten am Kopierer sollten Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 neu kalibrieren. Die Ausgabe
des Kopierermodells kann direkt nach der Wartung aber instabil sein. Daher sollten Sie
vor der Kalibrierung etwa 50 Seiten drucken.
HINWEIS: Da die Farbausgabe des Kopierermodells empfindlich auf Veränderungen der
Temperatur oder der Luftfeuchtigkeit reagiert, sollten Sie den Kopierer nicht direkt vor oder
neben einem Fenster, einem Heizkörper oder einer Klimaanlage aufstellen und keinem
direkten Sonnenlicht aussetzen. Auch Papier reagiert sehr empfindlich auf Änderungen
der Umgebungsbedingungen. Sie sollten Papier daher in einem kühlen Raum mit stabiler
Luftfeuchtigkeit und Temperatur aufbewahren und die Verpackung erst unmittelbar vor
Gebrauch öffnen.
Drucken Sie die folgenden Farbseiten zum Überwachen der Druckqualität:
• Farbtabellen (über Anwendung Command WorkStation oder Kopiererdisplay)
• Farbreferenzseiten auf der DVD mit der Anwendersoftware (siehe Seiten 12 und 17)
Alle diese Seiten enthalten Farbkeile für Cyan, Magenta, Gelb und Schwarz, von der
gesättigten Farbe bis hin zu einem sehr schwachen Farbton. Fotos mit Hautfarben eignen
sich ebenfalls sehr gut als Referenz. Speichern Sie die gedruckten Seiten und vergleichen
Sie die Seiten in regelmäßigen Abständen. Kalibrieren Sie den Fiery X3eTY2, sobald Sie
Veränderungen in der Druckausgabe bemerken.
Beachten Sie beim Prüfen der Testseite, dass alle Farbfelder erkennbar sein müssen, auch wenn
sie im Bereich zwischen 2% und 5% u. U. sehr blass erscheinen. Die Felder sollten innerhalb
einer Farbe beim Aufhellen von 100% bis 0% einen gleichmäßigen Farbverlauf aufweisen.
Wenn bei den stark gesättigten Farbfeldern (100% Cyan, Magenta, Gelb bzw. Schwarz) die
Sättigung mit der Zeit nachlässt, zeigen Sie die gedruckten Seiten dem Servicetechniker,
der für den Kopierer zuständig ist. Er kann Ihnen sagen, ob sich durch eine Justierung des
Kopierermodells die Ausgabequalität verbessern lässt.
KALIBRIERUNG 59
Ermitteln des Kalibrierungsstatus
Sie können wie nachfolgend beschrieben jederzeit prüfen, ob der Fiery X3eTY2 kalibriert ist,
welches Kalibrierungsset und welches Ausgabeprofil dafür verwendet wurden und wann der
Kopierer zuletzt kalibriert wurde:
• Drucken Sie über das Kopiererdisplay oder die Anwendung Command WorkStation eine
Konfigurations- oder Testseite.
• Wählen Sie in der Komponente Calibrator ein Kalibrierungsset. Der Zeitpunkt der letzten
Kalibrierung und der Name des Anwenders, der sie durchgeführt hat, werden angezeigt.
SPOT-ON 60
SPOT-ON
Mit der Druckoption „Spot-Farbabstimmung“ wird die Abstimmung von Spot-Farben mit
den jeweils besten CMYK-Äquivalenten automatisch vorgenommen; diese Abstimmung ist
die Voraussetzung dafür, dass Spot-Farben mit den CMYK-Tonern des Kopierers simuliert
werden können. Es kann aber erforderlich werden, die standardmäßigen CMYK-Äquivalente
anzupassen, um für bestimmte Druckbedingungen eine noch präzisere Übereinstimmung zu
erzielen. Diese Modifikation der Spot-Farben können Sie mit Spot-On vornehmen.
Neben der Verwaltung ‚benannter’ Farben bietet Ihnen die Komponente Spot-On die
Möglichkeit, eine Liste sogenannter ‚Ersatzfarben’ zu erstellen. Auf dieser Basis können
Farben, die in einem Dokument als RGB- oder CMYK-Werte spezifiziert werden, durch
andere Farben ersetzt werden, deren CYMK-Farbwerte aus einer Spot-On Farbbibliothek
abgerufen werden. Diese Funktion ermöglicht die exakte Farbsteuerung und das individuelle
Überschreiben einzelner RBG- und CMYK-Farben.
Spot-On
Spot-On bietet Ihnen die Möglichkeit, Listen von Spot-Farben und deren CMYK-Äquivalente
anzupassen und zu verwalten. Die Abgleichungslisten von Spot-Farben und CMYK-Werten
werden als „Spot-Farbbibliotheken“ bezeichnet. Mit Spot-On können Sie für jedes Ausgabeprofil
auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 mehrere Spot-Farbbibliotheken pflegen und verwalten.
HINWEIS: Wenn Sie die Spot-On Funktionen für benannte Farben nutzen wollen, müssen
Sie die Druckoption „Spot-Farbabstimmung“ aktivieren. Weitere Informationen über diese
Option finden Sie auf Seite 97.
HINWEIS: Spot-Farben, die anhand ihrer Namen oder Benennung identifiziert werden,
werden mit den für sie definierten CMYK-Werten gedruckt. Änderungen, die Sie mit der
Komponente Color Editor (dem Farbeditor) an einem Ausgabeprofil vornehmen, haben keine
Auswirkungen darauf, wie Spot-Farben gedruckt werden.
Für bestimmte Funktionen von Spot-On wird vorausgesetzt, dass ein Auftrag mit der richtigen
Farbgebung auf dem Monitor angezeigt wird. Damit die Darstellung der richtigen Farben auf
dem Monitor sichergestellt ist, müssen Sie den Monitor gemäß den Anleitungen des Monitorherstellers
einrichten und das richtige Monitorprofil für Ihren Monitor angeben.
Legen Sie für die Monitoranzeige die folgenden Einstellungen fest:
• Am Monitor: Helligkeit, Kontrast und Temperatur
• Über die Systemsteuerung des Betriebssystems: Auflösung, Frequenz und Anzahl der
Farben
SPOT-ON 61
Weitere Informationen über das Einrichten des Monitors und des Monitorprofils finden Sie
in der Begleitdokumentation zu Ihrem Monitor.
Starten von Spot-On
Für die Arbeit mit Spot-On müssen Sie das Ausgabeprofil angeben, das mit der Spot-
Farbbibliothek verknüpft ist, die Sie bearbeiten wollen.
Wenn Sie z.B. das Ausgabeprofil „X“ wählen und in Spot-On den Wert „30%M“ für die
Spot-Farbe „PANTONE 123“ in „50%M“ ändern, erfolgt die Ausgabe mit „50%M“, wenn
Sie den Auftrag mithilfe des Ausgabeprofils „X“ drucken. Wenn Sie ihn dagegen mit dem
Ausgabeprofil „Y“ drucken, erfolgt die Ausgabe mit dem Originalwert „30%M“. Wenn Sie
das Ausgabeprofil „X“ wählen und eine eigene Farbe mit der Benennung „Mein Purpur“
erstellen und als „80C 40M“ definieren, berechnet ColorWise die Lab-Werte automatisch
mithilfe des Ausgabeprofils „X“ und erstellt neue CMYK-Werte für die Verwendung
zusammen mit dem Ausgabeprofil „Y“.
HINWEIS: Es kann immer nur ein (1) Anwender über Spot-On mit dem Fiery X3eTY2
verbunden sein.
SPOT-ON STARTEN
1 Starten Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools und stellen Sie die Verbindung zum Fiery X3eTY2 her.
2 Klicken Sie auf „Spot-On“.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster „Ausgabeprofil wählen“ angezeigt.
3 Wählen Sie ein Ausgabeprofil und klicken Sie auf „OK“.
1 Aktuelles Ausgabeprofil
2 Für Verknüpfung verfügbare
Ausgabeprofile
1
2
SPOT-ON 62
Das Hauptfenster der Komponente Spot-On wird angezeigt. Die CMYK-Werte, die in
diesem Fenster angezeigt werden, werden bezogen auf das gewählte Profil berechnet.
HINWEIS: Wenn Sie einen Auftrag drucken, müssen Sie dasselbe Ausgabeprofil wählen,
für das Sie sich im Dialogfenster „Ausgabeprofil wählen“ entschieden haben. Wenn Sie beim
Drucken ein anderes Ausgabeprofil wählen, werden die Farbanpassungen, die Sie in Spot-On
vorgenommen haben, nicht angewendet.
Hauptfenster von Spot-On
Das Hauptfenster der Komponente Spot-On enthält eine Liste von Farbgruppen, die die
auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 vorhandenen Spot-Farbbibliotheken darstellen. Im oberen Fensterbereich
werden Symbole für die Arbeit mit Farben eingeblendet.
Standardmäßig befinden sich auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 neben einer Systembibliothek mehrere
PANTONE-Bibliotheken. Diese werkseitigen Standardbibliotheken sind mit dem Symbol für
Standardgruppen ( ) gekennzeichnet.
Sie können im Spot-On Hauptfenster eigene Farbgruppen und Farben hinzufügen (siehe
Seite 64). Hinzugefügte Gruppen sind mit dem Symbol für eigene Gruppen ( ) gekennzeichnet.
Sie können Standardgruppen ebenso wie eigene Gruppen öffnen und die darin
enthaltenen Farben anzeigen.
1 Ausgabeprofil
2 Speichern
3 Hochladen
4 Herunterladen
5 Ausschneiden
6 Kopieren
7 Einfügen
8 Alles schließen
9 Drucken
10 Nach oben
11 Nach unten
12 Eigene Farbgruppe
13 Standardfarbgruppe
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
12
13
SPOT-ON 63
FARBGRUPPE ÖFFNEN UND SCHLIESSEN
1 Klicken Sie zum Öffnen einer Farbgruppe auf das Symbol links vom Gruppennamen.
Beim Öffnen einer Gruppe werden alle darin enthaltenen Farben angezeigt; gleichzeitig
ändert sich die Gestalt des Gruppensymbols.
2 Klicken Sie zum Schließen einer Farbgruppe auf das Symbol links vom Gruppennamen.
3 Wählen Sie „Alles schließen“ im Menü „Bearbeiten“, um alle Farbgruppen in der Liste zu
schließen.
Arbeiten mit vorhandenen Farben
Mit Spot-On können Sie Farbgruppen, die auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 vorhanden sind, anzeigen
und verwalten und nach einer bestimmten Farbe in der Spot-On Liste suchen.
Die Farbgruppen im Spot-On Hauptfenster sind nach Priorität sortiert. Die Farbgruppen
mit der höchsten Priorität stehen am Anfang der Liste. Wenn z.B. zwei Farben in zwei
verschiedenen Farbgruppen denselben Namen haben, verwendet der Fiery X3eTY2 die
Farbe aus der weiter oben stehenden Gruppe und lässt die andere Farbe unbeachtet. Diese
Art, Farbprioritäten zu verwalten, macht es möglich, für eine bestimmte Spot-Farbe mehrere
CMYK-Äquivalente zu speichern.
PRIORITÄTEN VON FARBEN NEU ORDNEN
1 Aktivieren Sie eine Farbgruppe, wenn Sie die Priorität der ganzen Gruppe neu festlegen
wollen. Aktivieren Sie eine einzelne Farbe, wenn Sie nur deren Priorität neu festlegen wollen.
Die einzelnen Spot-Farben werden durch farbige Kreise symbolisiert.
2 Klicken Sie auf der Symbolleiste auf das Symbol „Nach oben“ bzw. „Nach unten“, um Ihre
Auswahl innerhalb der Liste zu verschieben.
SPOT-ON 64
3 Klicken Sie auf der Symbolleiste auf das Symbol „Ausschneiden“ bzw. „Kopieren“, wenn Sie
Ihre Auswahl an einer anderen Position innerhalb der Liste einfügen wollen.
HINWEIS: Die Option „Ausschneiden“ wird nur für eigene Farben angeboten.
4 Markieren Sie in der Liste die Position, an der Sie die ausgeschnittene bzw. kopierte Auswahl
einfügen wollen, und klicken Sie auf der Symbolleiste auf das Symbol „Einfügen“.
Wenn Sie eine PANTONE Standardfarbe oder Standardgruppe einfügen, erscheint eine
Warnmeldung mit der Aufforderung, wegen der unterschiedlichen Präfixe und Suffixe für
PANTONE Farben und Farbgruppen Ihre Auswahl umzubenennen. Wählen Sie mithilfe der
Menüs das gewünschte Präfix und Suffix für den neuen Namen und klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Die eingefügte Auswahl wird mit dem angegebenen Namen zu einer neuen eigenen Farbe
bzw. Farbgruppe.
BESTIMMTE FARBE SUCHEN
1 Wählen Sie „Suchen“ im Menü „Bearbeiten“.
Das Dialogfenster „Suchen“ wird angezeigt.
2 Geben Sie den Namen der gesuchten Farbe ein und klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Spot-On durchsucht die Farbliste von oben nach unten nach der gesuchten Farbe. Wird die
Farbe gefunden, wird sie in der Farbliste hervorgehoben.
3 Wenn Sie weitere Farben unter Verwendung derselben Kriterien suchen wollen, können Sie
„Weitersuchen“ im Menü „Bearbeiten“ wählen.
Erstellen eigener Farben
Die Farbliste von Spot-On umfasst eine Reihe von Standardfarbgruppen. Sie können diese
Liste durch eigene Spot-Farben und eigene Farbgruppen erweitern.
SPOT-ON 65
NEUE FARBE ODER NEUE FARBGRUPPE HINZUFÜGEN
1 Markieren Sie in der Farbliste die Position, an der die neue Farbe bzw. die neue Farbgruppe
eingefügt werden soll.
2 Wählen Sie „Neue Gruppe“ bzw. „Neue Farbe“ im Menü „Bearbeiten“, um eine neue
Farbgruppe bzw. eine neue Farbe einzufügen.
Daraufhin wird ein Eintrag für die neue Farbe bzw. Farbgruppe mit der Bezeichnung
„Ohne Titel“ angezeigt.
EIGENE FARBE ODER FARBGRUPPE UMBENENNEN
1 Markieren Sie die einzelne Farbe bzw. die Farbgruppe, die Sie umbenennen wollen.
2 Doppelklicken Sie auf den Namen der Farbe bzw. Farbgruppe.
3 Geben Sie den neuen Namen genau in der Schreibweise ein, wie er im Druckauftrag enthalten
ist. Beachten Sie Leerzeichen sowie Groß- und Kleinschreibung.
Dieser neue Name wird von der Quellanwendung (z.B. Adobe Illustrator oder QuarkXPress)
auf Ihren PostScript-Auftrag angewendet.
HINWEIS: Standardfarben oder -farbgruppen wie PANTONE können nicht umbenannt
werden.
Herunterladen eigener Farbgruppen
Sie können eigene Farbgruppen von Ihrem Computer auf den Fiery X3eTY2 herunterladen.
Heruntergeladene Gruppen werden der Spot-On Farbliste als eigene Gruppen hinzugefügt
und auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 sofort für die Verwendung aktiviert.
EIGENE FARBGRUPPEN HERUNTERLADEN
1 Markieren Sie in der Farbliste die Position, an der die Gruppe eingefügt werden soll.
2 Wählen Sie „Herunterladen“ im Menü „Datei“.
Das Dialogfenster „Datei wählen“ wird angezeigt.
SPOT-ON 66
HINWEIS: Für das Herunterladen wird das Dateiformat „icc/icm-Dateien“ unterstützt;
bei Dateien dieses Formats handelt es sich um benannte ICC-Farbprofile.
3 Markieren Sie die gewünschte Farbgruppe und klicken Sie auf „Öffnen“.
Die heruntergeladene Gruppe wird an der angegebenen Position in die Spot-On Farbliste
eingefügt. Wenn Sie keine Position angeben, wird die Gruppe am Anfang der Farbliste
eingefügt.
Wenn eine heruntergeladene Gruppe denselben Namen hat wie eine bereits in der Farbliste
vorhandene Gruppe, werden Sie aufgefordert, die heruntergeladene Gruppe umzubenennen.
Hochladen eigener Farbgruppen
Sie können eigene Farbgruppen vom Fiery X3eTY2 als ICC-Dateien auf Ihren Computer
laden. Diese Funktion ermöglicht Ihnen die gemeinsame Verwendung einer Gruppe durch die
Erstellung einer lokalen Kopie, die Sie ihrerseits auf einen anderen Fiery X3eTY2 herunterladen
können.
Damit Sie eine Farbgruppe auf Ihren Computer hochladen können, müssen Sie sie auf dem
Fiery X3eTY2 speichern. Damit Sie eine werkseitige Standardgruppe hochladen können,
müssen Sie sie kopieren und als neue eigene Gruppe in die Farbliste einfügen.
EIGENE FARBGRUPPEN HOCHLADEN
1 Aktivieren Sie den Namen der Farbgruppe, die Sie hochladen wollen.
2 Wählen Sie „Hochladen“ im Menü „Datei“.
Das Dialogfenster „Speichern unter“ angezeigt.
3 Navigieren Sie zu dem Ordner, in dem Sie die Datei speichern wollen, geben Sie einen
Dateinamen ein und klicken Sie auf „Speichern“.
SPOT-ON 67
Bearbeiten von Farbwerten
Wenn eine vorhandene Spot-Farbe nicht in der erwarteten Weise gedruckt wird, können
Sie durch Ändern der Farbwerte das gewünschte Ergebnis erzielen. Sie können Farbwerte
bearbeiten, indem Sie die gewünschten CMYK-Werte direkt im Hauptfenster von Spot-On
oder im Dialogfenster „Farbe für Feld im Zentrum festlegen“ eingeben oder indem Sie die
Suchfunktion von Spot-On verwenden.
Gehen Sie in der nachfolgend beschriebenen Weise, wenn Sie eine benannte Farbe bearbeiten
wollen, indem Sie die gewünschten CMYK-Werte eingeben. Informationen über die sukzessive
Annäherung an eine Zielfarbe mithilfe der Suchfunktion von Spot-On finden Sie auf Seite 68.
FARBE IM HAUPTFENSTER VON SPOT-ON BEARBEITEN
1 Markieren Sie die Farbe, die Sie bearbeiten wollen.
2 Doppelklicken Sie auf den Wert in der Spalte „C“, „M“, „Y“ und/oder „K“ und geben Sie den
gewünschten Wert für den jeweiligen Farbkanal ein.
Die bearbeitete Farbe wird in der Farbliste angezeigt.
HINWEIS: Die bearbeitete Farbe wird erst gespeichert, wenn Sie „Speichern“ im Menü „Datei“
wählen.
FARBE IM FENSTER „FARBE FÜR FELD IM ZENTRUM FESTLEGEN“ BEARBEITEN
1 Markieren Sie die Farbe, die Sie bearbeiten wollen.
2 Doppelklicken Sie auf das Symbol der Farbe.
Das Dialogfenster „Spot-On Farbe suchen“ wird angezeigt; die gewählte Farbe erscheint im
Farbfeld im Zentrum.
3 Klicken Sie auf das mittlere Farbfeld.
SPOT-ON 68
Das Dialogfenster „Farbe für Feld im Zentrum festlegen“ wird angezeigt.
4 Geben Sie an, ob Sie die CMYK-Werte als Prozentwerte oder als Gerätecodes eingeben wollen.
Bei der Option „Prozentwerte“ können Sie Farbwerte von 0% bis 100% eingeben
(in Abstufungen von 0,5%). Werte mit abweichenden Abstufungen werden auf den
nächsten vollen bzw. halben Prozentpunkt gerundet.
Bei der Option „Gerätecodes“ können Sie Farbwerte im Bereich von „0“ bis „255“ eingeben.
Diese Option berücksichtigt in vollem Umfang die auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 reproduzierbaren
Farbwerte und ermöglicht daher eine feinere Farbabstufung als die Prozentwerte.
5 Geben Sie die Werte für „C“, „M“, „Y“ und „K“ Ihrer spezifischen Farbe in die Felder ein.
Mit der Tabulatortaste können Sie den Cursor von Feld zu Feld bewegen. Wenn Sie einen
neuen Wert eingeben, wird die Vorschau des Farbfelds aktualisiert und der Unterschied
zwischen der alten und der neuen Farbe dargestellt.
6 Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Die neue Farbe wird im Fenster „Spot-On Farbe suchen“ im mittleren Feld angezeigt.
7 Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Die bearbeitete Farbe wird nun in der Farbliste des Spot-On Hauptfensters angezeigt.
Mit der in der nächsten Anleitung beschriebenen Suchfunktion von Spot-On können Sie
eine Farbe sukzessive eingrenzen. Wählen Sie dazu anfangs eine ähnliche Farbe und ändern
Sie nach und nach die Werte für Farbton, Sättigung und Helligkeit, bis die Übereinstimmung
erzielt ist.
FARBE MIT SPOT-ON SUCHFUNKTION SUKZESSIVE EINGRENZEN
1 Markieren Sie die Farbe, die Sie bearbeiten wollen.
2 Doppelklicken Sie auf das Symbol der Farbe.
SPOT-ON 69
Das Dialogfenster „Spot-On Farbe suchen“ wird angezeigt; die gewählte (aktuelle) Farbe
erscheint im mittleren Farbfeld.
3 Wenn Sie das mittlere Feld mit einer benachbarten Farbe aktualisieren wollen, die Ihrem Ziel
näher kommt, klicken Sie auf das entsprechende Nachbarfeld.
Nachbarfelder sind Variationen des mittleren Feldes, die Sie wählen können, um Ihrer Zielfarbe
näher zu kommen. Wenn Sie auf ein Nachbarfeld klicken, wird dessen Farbe in das mittlere
Feld übernommen; danach werden die Nachbarfelder automatisch neu angepasst. Abhängig
von der Option, für die Sie sich im nächsten Schritt entscheiden, sind diese Felder Nachbarn
im Hinblick auf die Luminanz oder auf die Sättigung.
HINWEIS: Wenn Sie bestimmte Farben wählen, kann es geschehen, dass ein Ausrufezeichen
rechts oben im Fenster eingeblendet wird. Dieses Symbol zeigt an, dass eine oder mehrere
Farben ihre jeweiligen Maximalwerte erreicht haben.
4 Gehen Sie wie folgt vor, um die Generierung der Nachbarfelder zu steuern:
Wählen Sie „Luminanz“ oder „Sättigung“ im Bereich „Legende für Farbrichtungen“.
Bei der Einstellung „Luminanz“ werden in den Nachbarfeldern hellere bis dunklere Schattierungen
der Farbe im mittleren Feld generiert. Diese Variationen werden von links nach rechts
angezeigt, wobei die Ausgangsfarbe im mittleren Feld der mittleren Farbfeldgruppe (Feld
im Zentrum) verbleibt.
Bei der Einstellung „Sättigung“ werden in den Nachbarfeldern weniger bis stärker gesättigte
Variationen der Ausgangsfarbe generiert. Diese Variationen werden von links nach rechts
angezeigt, wobei die Ausgangsfarbe im mittleren Feld der mittleren Farbfeldgruppe (Feld
im Zentrum) verbleibt.
Wählen Sie im Menü „Farbraum“ einen Wert für den Farbabstand der Nachbarfelder.
Je höher dieser Wert ist, desto stärker weichen die generierten Nachbarfelder von der Farbe
im Zentrum ab. Je näher sie Ihrer Zielfarbe kommen, desto kleiner sollte der Wert für den
Farbabstand ausfallen.
SPOT-ON 70
Aktivieren Sie die Option „Monitorkompensierung“, wenn Sie die Darstellung aller Farbfelder
auf dem Monitor in der auf Papier gedruckten Ausgabe simulieren wollen.
Diese Simulation hängt von dem Monitorprofil ab, das Sie für Ihren Monitor konfiguriert
haben. Wählen Sie „Voreinstellungen“ im Menü „Bearbeiten“ des Spot-On Hauptfensters,
um dieses Monitorprofil festzulegen.
Vergewissern Sie sich, dass Ihr Monitor entsprechend den Empfehlungen des Monitorherstellers
eingerichtet und das richtige Profil für Ihren Monitor gewählt wurde.
5 Setzen Sie die Anpassung mithilfe der Farbsteuerelemente und die Auswahl der Nachbarfelder
fort, bis im mittleren Feld die gewünschte Zielfarbe angezeigt wird.
6 Klicken Sie auf „Muster drucken“.
HINWEIS: Die präzise Abstimmung mit Spot-Farben auf dem Monitor ist äußerst schwierig.
Sie sollten daher stets ein Muster drucken, um sicher zu sein, dass die Farbabstimmung das
gewünschte Ergebnis erbringt.
7 Wählen Sie in den Menüs „Ausgabestil“, „Papiergröße“ und „Papierfach“ die gewünschten
Einstellungen.
Für die Option „Ausgabestil“ werden die Einstellungen „Muster für Farbsuche“ und „Muster
für Farbnachbar“ angeboten. Mit der Einstellung „Muster für Farbsuche“ werden die Felder
in dem Muster gedruckt, das im Fenster „Farbe suchen“ zu sehen ist. Bei der Auswahl von
„Muster für Farbnachbar“ werden die Felder in drei Spalten mit je acht Zeilen gedruckt.
Wählen Sie im Menü „Papiergröße“ die Größe des Papiers, auf dem das Muster gedruckt
werden soll.
Wählen Sie im Menü „Papierfach“ das Fach, aus dem das gewünschte Papier zugeführt
werden soll.
SPOT-ON 71
8 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um das Muster zu drucken.
Die Seite mit dem Testmuster enthält die folgenden Angaben:
• CMYK-Wert des mittleren Farbfelds
• Farbabstand zwischen den Nachbarfeldern
• Angabe, ob die Generierung der Nachbarfelder in Bezug auf die Luminanz oder die
Sättigung erfolgt
• Gewähltes Ausgabeprofil
Ziel einer Farbsuche in Spot-On ist es, die Farbwerte zu finden, die zur Übereinstimmung
zwischen der Zielfarbe und einem gedruckten Farbfeld führen, nicht zur Übereinstimmung
mit der Darstellung des betreffenden Farbfelds auf dem Monitor. Das gedruckte Muster der
benachbarten Farbfelder gibt Ihnen die Möglichkeit, die gedruckten Farbfelder mit der Zielfarbe
zu vergleichen. Wenn Sie in der Druckausgabe das Farbfeld identifiziert haben, das der
Zielfarbe am nächsten kommt, können Sie dieses Farbfeld auf dem Monitor wählen.
9 Markieren Sie im Dialogfenster „Spot-On Farbe suchen“ die gewünschte Zielfarbe und klicken
Sie auf „OK“.
Die bearbeitete Farbe wird nun in der Farbliste des Spot-On Hauptfensters angezeigt.
Anpassen von Zielfarben mittels Messinstrument
Vom Densitometer ED-100 und vom Spektralfotometer ES-1000 können gemessene
Farbwerte direkt in Spot-On importiert werden. Sie können auf diese Weise die Farbanpassung
auf der Basis der echten Farben vornehmen, z.B. von einem roten Logo oder einer gelben
Verpackung.
Um optimale Ergebnisse zu erzielen, sollten Sie alle Messdaten, die Sie mit dem ED-100
offline gesammelt haben, herunterladen und speichern. Spot-On löscht beim Aufbau der
Verbindung zum Messinstrument automatisch alle gespeicherten Daten. Anleitungen zum
Herunterladen gespeicherter Daten vom ED-100 finden Sie in der zum Messinstrument
gehörenden Dokumentation.
FARBMESSWERTE IN SPOT-ON IMPORTIEREN
1 Installieren Sie das ED-100 bzw. das ES-1000 und konfigurieren Sie es im Hinblick auf
Ihren Computer.
Die Installations- und Konfigurationsanleitungen finden Sie in der Begleitdokumentation
Ihres Messinstruments.
2 Wählen Sie „Starten“ im Menü „Instrument“.
Das Dialogfenster „Instrument wählen“ wird angezeigt.
SPOT-ON 72
3 Wählen Sie im Menü „Instrument“ das Instrument aus, mit dem Sie die Messungen
vornehmen wollen. Wählen Sie im Menü „Anschluss“ den seriellen Anschluss für das
Messinstrument. Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Beim ED-100 blinkt die Betriebsanzeige einige Male, während die Verbindung mit Spot-On
hergestellt wird. Wenn das Blinken aufhört, ist das Instrument für die Messung bereit.
4 Positionieren Sie das Messinstrument ED-100 bzw. ES-1000 über der Zielfarbe. Dabei muss
sich die Messöffnung mittig über dem Farbfeld befinden. Drücken Sie die Taste Messen, um
die Messung auszulösen.
Die gemessenen CMYK-Werte werden wie folgt in Spot-On importiert:
• Wurde eine einzelne Farbe in der Farbliste markiert, wird diese Farbe mit den Messwerten
aktualisiert.
• Wurde eine Farbgruppe in der Farbliste markiert, wird eine neue Farbe in der Gruppe
erstellt, der die Messwerte zugeordnet werden.
• Wenn das Fenster „Spot-On Farbe suchen“ geöffnet ist, wird die Farbe im mittleren Farbfeld
mit den Messwerten aktualisiert; anschließend werden die Nachbarfelder automatisch
angepasst.
• Wenn das Dialogfenster „Farbe für Feld im Zentrum festlegen“ geöffnet ist, werden die
Messwerte in die Eingabefelder „C“, „M“, „Y“ und „K“ importiert.
5 Klicken Sie im Menü „Instrument“ auf „Stoppen“, wenn Sie die Farbmessungen abgeschlossen
haben.
Spot-On trennt die Verbindung zum Messinstrument.
Zurücksetzen von Standardfarben auf Werkseinstellungen
Sie können die Standardfarben auf die werkseitigen Standardeinstellungen zurücksetzen. Sie
können dabei alle Farben innerhalb einer Standardfarbgruppe zurücksetzen lassen oder eine
oder mehrere Farben in einer Standardfarbgruppe wählen, die zurückgesetzt werden sollen.
ALLE FARBEN EINER STANDARDFARBGRUPPE AUF WERKSEINSTELLUNGEN ZURÜCKSETZEN
1 Klicken Sie auf das Symbol vor dem Namen der Gruppe, die Sie zurücksetzen wollen.
2 Wählen Sie „Gruppe zurücksetzen“ im Menü „Datei“.
Daraufhin erscheint ein Warnhinweis.
3 Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
SPOT-ON 73
BESTIMMTE FARBEN EINER STANDARDFARBGRUPPE AUF WERKSEINSTELLUNGEN ZURÜCKSETZEN
1 Klicken Sie auf das Symbol vor dem Namen der Gruppe, die die Farben enthält, die Sie
zurücksetzen wollen.
2 Markieren Sie durch Klicken die Farben, die Sie auf die Werkseinstellungen zurücksetzen
wollen.
Halten Sie beim Klicken die Umschalttaste gedrückt, wenn Sie mehrere Farben markieren
wollen, die unmittelbar aufeinander folgen. Halten Sie beim Klicken die Taste Strg bzw. Ctrl
gedrückt, wenn Sie mehrere Farben markieren wollen, die nicht unmittelbar aufeinander
folgen.
3 Wählen Sie „Zurück zu Farbeinstellung ab Werk“ im Menü „Datei“.
Daraufhin erscheint ein Warnhinweis.
4 Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Speichern von Änderungen und Beenden von Spot-On
Damit Sie die von Ihnen vorgenommenen Spot-Farbabstimmungen und -anpassungen für
den Fiery X3eTY2 verwenden können, müssen Sie Ihre Änderungen vor dem Beenden von
Spot-On speichern. Damit stellen Sie sicher, dass alle Änderungen, die Sie an den Spot-On
Farbdefinitionen vorgenommen haben, auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 gespeichert werden und für
die nachfolgende Druckausgabe von Dokumenten mit Spot-Farben verfügbar sind.
Die folgenden Bearbeitungsschritte werden wirksam, auch ohne dass Sie Ihre Änderungen
explizit speichern:
• Neufestlegung der Prioritätsebene einer Farbgruppe
• Herunterladen einer Farbgruppe
• Leeren oder Löschen einer Farbgruppe
SPOT-ON FARBLISTE SPEICHERN
1 Wählen Sie „Speichern“ im Menü „Datei“.
2 Klicken Sie auf das Schließfeld rechts oben im Spot-On Hauptfenster, um das
Dienstprogramm zu beenden.
SPOT-ON 74
Spot-On und Ersatzfarben
Der Workflow für Ersatzfarben besteht im Wesentlichen daraus, in Spot-On die Werte für die
Ersatzfarbe zu definieren und danach für ein zu druckendes Dokument im Druckertreiber die
Druckoption „Farbsubstitution“ zu aktivieren. Sie können die entsprechende Druckoption
auch in der Anwendung Command WorkStation einstellen.
HINWEIS: Farbsubstitutionen wirken sich nur auf Text, Vektorgrafiken und Strichzeichnungen
aus. Sie haben keine Auswirkung auf Rasterbilder.
HINWEIS: Wird eine Farbe als Ersatzfarbe definiert, haben die Einstellungen für eine RGBFarbe
(„RGB-Quellprofil“, „Farbwiedergabe“ und „RGB-Separation“) bzw. für eine CMYKFarbe
(„CMYK-Simulationsprofil“ und „CMYK-Simulationsverfahren“) keine Relevanz für
die Druckausgabe. Die Farbe wird mit einem Verfahren konvertiert, das dem Konvertierungsverfahren
für Spot-Farben ähnelt.
Erstellen von Ersatzfarbgruppen und Ersatzfarben
Führen Sie die nachfolgend beschriebenen Schritte aus, um einer Ersatzfarbgruppe eine neue
Ersatzfarbe hinzuzufügen und die Wert-Name-Kombination für die Farbsubstitution festzulegen.
HINWEIS: Sie können eine neue Ersatzfarbe nur einer Ersatzfarbgruppe hinzufügen.
NEUE ERSATZFARBE HINZUFÜGEN UND WERT-NAME-KOMBINATION FÜR SUBSTITUTION ANGEBEN
1 Starten Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools und stellen Sie die Verbindung zum Fiery X3eTY2 her.
Sie können auf Ihrem Computer oder über die erweiterte Controllerschnittstelle des
Fiery X3eTY2 die ColorWise Pro Tools als eigenständige Anwendung oder als Komponente
der Anwendung Command WorkStation starten.
2 Klicken Sie auf „Spot-On“.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster „Ausgabeprofil wählen“ angezeigt.
3 Wählen Sie ein Ausgabeprofil und klicken Sie auf „OK“.
SPOT-ON 75
Daraufhin wird das Hauptfenster der Komponente Spot-On angezeigt.
4 Wählen Sie „Neue Ersatzfarbgruppe“ im Menü „Bearbeiten“.
Für die neue Ersatzfarbgruppe wird ein Eintrag mit der Bezeichnung „Ohne Titel“ angezeigt.
5 Doppelklicken Sie auf „Ohne Titel“ und geben Sie den Namen für die neue Ersatzfarbgruppe
ein.
6 Markieren Sie die Ersatzfarbgruppe und wählen Sie „Neue Ersatzfarbe“ im Menü „Bearbeiten“.
HINWEIS: Wenn eine Ersatzfarbgruppe bereits Ersatzfarbeinträge enthält, müssen Sie die
vorhandene Farbe markieren, vor der die neue Ersatzfarbe eingefügt werden soll.
Das Dialogfenster „Ersatzfarbe hinzufügen“ wird angezeigt.
7 Wählen Sie den Farbmodus für die Ersatzfarbe.
8 Wählen Sie die Toleranz für die Ersatzfarbe.
Weitere Informationen über die Option „Toleranz“ finden Sie auf Seite 80.
9 Geben Sie die Werte der Originalfarbe ein, die ersetzt werden soll.
10 Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Die Ersatzfarbe wird an der zuvor markierten Position angezeigt.
1 Ausgabeprofil
2 Speichern
3 Hochladen
4 Herunterladen
5 Ausschneiden
6 Kopieren
7 Einfügen
8 Alles schließen
9 Drucken
10 Nach oben
11 Nach unten
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
SPOT-ON 76
Definieren der Farbwerte für eine Ersatzfarbe
Nachdem Sie die zu ersetzende Originalfarbe angegeben haben, müssen Sie die CMYK-Werte
für die Ersatzfarbe definieren. Sie können diese CMYK-Werte direkt im Hauptfenster von
Spot-On oder im Fenster „Farbe für Feld im Zentrum festlegen“ eingeben oder dafür die
Suchfunktion von Spot-On verwenden.
Die Anleitungen dafür, wie Sie eine Ersatzfarbe durch Eingabe der gewünschten CMYKWerte
definieren, finden Sie in den nachfolgenden Abschnitten. Wie Sie eine Ersatzfarbe
mithilfe der Suchfunktion von Spot-On definieren, wird auf Seite 78 beschrieben.
ERSATZFARBE IM HAUPTFENSTER VON SPOT-ON DEFINIEREN
1 Starten Sie die ColorWise Pro Tools und stellen Sie die Verbindung zum Fiery X3eTY2 her.
2 Klicken Sie auf „Spot-On“.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster „Ausgabeprofil wählen“ angezeigt.
3 Wählen Sie ein Ausgabeprofil und klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Das Hauptfenster der Komponente Spot-On wird angezeigt.
4 Markieren Sie die Farbe, die Sie ersetzen wollen.
5 Doppelklicken Sie auf den Wert in der Spalte „C“, „M“, „Y“ und/oder „K“ und geben Sie
den gewünschten Wert für den jeweiligen Farbkanal ein.
Die neuen Werte für die Ersatzfarbe werden in der Farbliste angezeigt.
HINWEIS: Die bearbeitete Farbe wird erst gespeichert, wenn Sie „Speichern“ im Menü „Datei“
wählen.
1 Ausgabeprofil
1
SPOT-ON 77
ERSATZFARBE IM FENSTER „FARBE FÜR FELD IM ZENTRUM FESTLEGEN“ DEFINIEREN
1 Markieren Sie die Farbe, die Sie ersetzen wollen.
2 Doppelklicken Sie auf das Symbol der Farbe.
Das Dialogfenster „Spot-On Farbe suchen“ wird angezeigt; die gewählte Farbe erscheint im
Farbfeld im Zentrum.
3 Klicken Sie auf das mittlere Farbfeld.
Das Dialogfenster „Farbe für Feld im Zentrum festlegen“ wird angezeigt.
4 Geben Sie die Werte für die Farbkanäle „C“, „M“, „Y“ und „K“ ein.
Weitere Informationen über das Dialogfenster „Farbe für Feld im Zentrum festlegen“ finden
Sie auf Seite 67.
5 Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Die neue Farbe wird im Fenster „Spot-On Farbe suchen“ im mittleren Feld angezeigt.
6 Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Die neue Farbe wird nun in der Farbliste im Spot-On Hauptfenster angezeigt.
HINWEIS: Die bearbeitete Farbe wird erst gespeichert, wenn Sie „Speichern“ im Menü „Datei“
wählen.
1 Farbfeld im Zentrum
1
SPOT-ON 78
Mit der in der nächsten Anleitung beschriebenen Suchfunktion von Spot-On können Sie eine
Ersatzfarbe sukzessive eingrenzen.
ERSATZFARBE MIT SPOT-ON SUCHFUNKTION DEFINIEREN
1 Markieren Sie die Farbe, die Sie ersetzen wollen.
2 Doppelklicken Sie auf das Symbol der Farbe.
Das Dialogfenster „Spot-On Farbe suchen“ wird angezeigt; die gewählte (aktuelle) Farbe
erscheint im Farbfeld im Zentrum.
3 Klicken Sie auf benachbarte Farbfelder, bis Sie die Farbe gefunden haben, die Sie für die
Substitution verwenden wollen.
Informationen über die Suchfunktion von Spot-On finden Sie auf Seite 68.
4 Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Die neue Ersatzfarbe wird nun in der Farbliste im Spot-On Hauptfenster angezeigt.
HINWEIS: Die bearbeitete Farbe wird erst gespeichert, wenn Sie „Speichern“ im Menü „Datei“
wählen.
Drucken eines Auftrags mit Ersatzfarben
Nachdem Sie in Spot-On die CYMK-Werte für die Farbsubstitution definiert haben, können
Sie im Druckertreiber veranlassen, dass ein Dokument unter Verwendung einer Ersatzfarbe
gedruckt werden soll. Sie können die entsprechende Druckoption auch in der Anwendung
Command WorkStation einstellen.
HINWEIS: Wenn Sie einen Auftrag drucken, müssen Sie dasselbe Ausgabeprofil wählen, für
das Sie sich im Dialogfenster „Ausgabeprofil wählen“ entschieden haben. Anderenfalls haben
mit Spot-On definierte Farbsubstitutionen keine Auswirkung.
HINWEIS: Die Vorgehensweisen zum Drucken eines Auftrags unter Mac OS und Windows
sind ähnlich.
1 Nachbarfeld
1
SPOT-ON 79
AUFTRAG MIT EINER ERSATZFARBE DRUCKEN
1 Öffnen Sie ein Dokument in Ihrer Anwendung.
2 Wählen Sie „Drucken“.
3 Wählen Sie „ColorWise“ im Menü mit der Anfangsauswahl „Kopien & Seiten“.
Die Seite „ColorWise“ wird angezeigt.
4 Aktivieren Sie die Option „Farbsubstitution“.
5 Klicken Sie auf „Drucken“.
Der Auftrag wird mit der Ersatzfarbe gedruckt, die Sie in Spot-On definiert haben.
Dialogfenster „Ersatzfarbe hinzufügen/umbenennen“
Im Dialogfenster „Ersatzfarbe hinzufügen/umbenennen“ können Sie den Farbmodus und
den Toleranzbereich für eine Ersatzfarbe festlegen.
SPOT-ON 80
HINWEIS: Das Dialogfenster „Ersatzfarbe hinzufügen“ wird angezeigt, wenn Sie eine
Ersatzfarbgruppe in der Liste markieren und „Bearbeiten > Neue Ersatzfarbe“ wählen. Das
Dialogfenster „Ersatzfarbe umbenennen“ erscheint, wenn Sie auf die zwischen Klammern
befindliche Bezeichnung doppelklicken.
HINWEIS: Die Dialogfenster „Ersatzfarbe hinzufügen“ und „Ersatzfarbe umbenennen“
beinhalten dieselben Steuerungselemente für die Ersatzfarbdefinition.
• Ersatzfarbe: Wählen Sie einen der folgenden Farbmodi für die Ersatzfarbe.
– CMYK (0-100%)
– RGB (Gerätecode 0-255)
– RGB (0-100%)
• Toleranz: Wählen Sie einen der folgenden Toleranzbereiche für die Ersatzfarbe.
– Klein (dargestellt durch Kleinbuchstaben)
– Groß (dargestellt durch Großbuchstaben)
Zur Vermeidung von Eingabefehlern werden in den Dialogfenstern „Ersatzfarbe hinzufügen“
und „Ersatzfarbe umbenennen“ die Werte in dem unten beschriebenen vordefinierten Format
angezeigt. Abhängig von den Einstellungen, für die Sie sich entschieden haben, werden in den
Dialogfenstern außerdem Groß- oder Kleinbuchstaben sowie das Symbol „%“ angezeigt.
• CMYK (0-100%)
– Klein: <„0“%c, „0“%m, „0“%y, „0“%k>
– Groß: <„0“%C, „0“%M, „0“%Y, „0“%K>
• RGB (Gerätecode 0-255)
– Klein: <„0“r, „0“g, „0“b>
– Groß: <„0“R, „0“G, „0“B>
• RGB (0-100%)
– Klein: <„0“%r, „0“%g, „0“%b>
– Groß: <„0“%R, „0“%G, „0“%B>
Richtlinien für Ersatzfarben
Beachten Sie beim Festlegen der Werte für Ersatzfarben die folgenden Richtlinien.
Toleranzbereich
Die Genauigkeit der Ersatzfarbe wird durch verschiedene Faktoren beeinflusst, z.B. durch
die Anwendung, das Betriebsystem, den Druckertreiber und das Distiller-Verfahren. Die
Einstellungen „Klein“ und „Groß“ für den Toleranzbereich der Farbsubstitution werden im
Hinblick auf die ‚Fehler’ angeboten, die durch Rundungsverluste zwischen den vom Anwender
eingegebenen Werten und den vom Fiery X3eTY2 empfangenen Werte entstehen.
SPOT-ON 81
Die folgende Tabelle gibt einen Überblick über die Toleranzbereiche, die mit den
Einstellungen „Klein“ und „Groß“ bei den verschiedenen Farbmodi angewendet werden.
HINWEIS: Bei den Werten für die Toleranzbereiche handelt es sich um Näherungswerte.
• CMYK (0-100%)
– Klein: Jede Farbe, die im Bereich von +/-0,25% um den eingegebenen Farbwert liegt,
wird durch eine Ersatzfarbe ersetzt.
– Groß: Jede Farbe, die im Bereich von +/-0,5% um den eingegebenen Farbwert liegt,
wird durch eine Ersatzfarbe ersetzt.
• RGB (Gerätecode 0-255)
– Klein: Jede Farbe, die im Bereich von +/-0,25 um den eingegebenen Farbwert liegt,
wird durch eine Ersatzfarbe ersetzt.
– Groß: Jede Farbe, die im Bereich von +/-1 um den eingegebenen Farbwert liegt,
wird durch eine Ersatzfarbe ersetzt.
• RGB (0-100%)
– Klein: Jede Farbe, die nach dem Skalieren im Bereich von +/-0,25% um den Farbwert
liegt, wird durch eine Ersatzfarbe ersetzt.
– Groß: Jede Farbe, die nach dem Skalieren im Bereich von +/-0,5% um den Farbwert
liegt, wird durch eine Ersatzfarbe ersetzt.
Farbsubstitution
Die Farbsubstitution erfolgt, wenn eine Ersatzfarbe mit einem anderen Set von CMYKWerten
für dieselbe Wert-Name-Kombination definiert wird wie die Originalfarbe.
Das folgende Beispiel veranschaulicht die Funktionsweise der Farbsubstitution.
• Originalfarbe: <100, 0, 0, 0> als CMYK-Werte (Cyan)
• Ersatzfarbe 1: <0, 100, 100, 0> (Rot)
• Ersatzfarbe 2: <100, 0, 100, 0> (Grün)
HINWEIS: In diesem Beispiel werden die Extremwerte und Begriffe „Rot“ und „Grün“
ausschließlich zu Demonstrationszwecken verwendet. In der Praxis wird die Farbsubstitution
nicht für extreme Farbverschiebungen verwendet.
Farbmodus Toleranz - Klein Toleranz - Groß
CMYK (0-100%) +/- 0,25% +/- 0,5%
RGB (Gerätecode 0-255) +/- 0,25 +/- 1
RGB (0-100%) +/- 0,25% +/- 0,5%
SPOT-ON 82
Die folgende Tabelle zeigt die Farbsubstitution bei unterschiedlichen Sets von CMYKWerten,
die derselben Originalfarbe zugewiesen sind.
Prioritätsschema
Wenn zwei Ersatzfarben mit denselben Wert-Name-Kombinationen mit unterschiedlichen
Sets von CMYK-Werten und mit unterschiedlichen Toleranzbereichen definiert werden,
bewertet Spot-On die Priorität der Farbsubstitution entsprechend der Reihenfolge der Farben
innerhalb der Gruppe.
Bei Spot-On basiert die Prozessfarbsubstitution auf der Reihenfolge der Farben innerhalb der
Farbgruppe. Die Einträge am Anfang der Liste haben eine höhere Priorität als die Einträge am
Ende der Liste. Spot-On analysiert die Liste von oben nach unten und verarbeitet die Farbsubstitution
in linearer Folge. Eine Farbe, die bereits ersetzt wurde, wird bei nachfolgenden
Substitutionsanforderungen übergangen.
Die folgenden Beispiele veranschaulichen die Funktionsweise des Prioritätsschemas.
• Originalfarbe: <100, 0, 0, 0> als CMYK-Werte (Cyan)
• Ersatzfarbe 3: <0, 100, 100, 0> (Rot) mit „Toleranz = Klein“
• Ersatzfarbe 4: <100, 0, 100, 0> (Grün) mit „Toleranz = Groß“
HINWEIS: In diesem Beispiel werden die Extremwerte und Begriffe „Rot“ und „Grün“
ausschließlich zu Demonstrationszwecken verwendet.
Reihenfolge der Farben
• Fall 1: Die Ersatzfarbe 3 (Rot) hat eine höhere Priorität als die Ersatzfarbe 4 (Grün).
• Fall 2: Die Ersatzfarbe 4 (Grün) hat eine höhere Priorität als die Ersatzfarbe 3 (Rot).
Wert-Name-Kombination
für Substitution
CMYK-Werte Vor Substitution Nach Substitution
Originalfarbe — <100, 0, 0, 0> — —
Ersatzfarbe 1 <100,0c, 0,0m, 0,0y, 0,0k> <0, 100, 100, 0> Cyan Rot
Ersatzfarbe 2 <100,0c, 0,0m, 0,0y, 0,0k> <100, 0, 100, 0> Cyan Grün
SPOT-ON 83
Die folgende Tabelle verdeutlicht das Prioritätsschema in dem Fall, dass der Originalfarbe
dieselben Wert-Name-Kombinationen, jedoch mit unterschiedlichen Sets von CMYKWerten
und unterschiedlichen Toleranzbereichen zugewiesen sind.
Die Ersatzfarbe 3 und die Ersatzfarbe 4 haben dieselben Wert-Name-Kombinationen, führen
aber abhängig von der Reihenfolge, in der sie in der Spot-On Farbliste enthalten sind, zu
unterschiedlichen Ergebnissen.
• In Fall 1 hat die Ersatzfarbe 3 (Rot) die höhere Priorität, da sie weiter oben in der Liste
steht. Alle Vorkommen der Originalfarbe Cyan innerhalb des Toleranzbereichs „Klein“
werden durch die Farbe Rot ersetzt. Vorkommen der Farbe Cyan, die sich innerhalb des
Toleranzbereichs „Groß“, aber außerhalb des Toleranzbereichs „Klein“ befinden, werden
durch die Ersatzfarbe 4 (Grün) ersetzt.
• In Fall 2 hat die Ersatzfarbe 4 (Grün) die höhere Priorität, da sie weiter oben in der Liste
steht. Die Ersatzfarbe 3 (Rot) kann nur Vorkommen der Originalfarbe Cyan ersetzen, die
sich innerhalb des Toleranzbereichs „Klein“ befinden. Diese Vorkommen wurden jedoch
bereits durch die Farbe Grün ersetzt. Daher erfolgt keine Substitution durch die Farbe Rot.
Hoch- und Herunterladen einer Ersatzfarbgruppe
Ähnlich wie Gruppen benannter Farben kann auch eine Gruppe mit Ersatzfarben in Form
eines ICC-Profils hoch- und heruntergeladen werden. Die Ersatzfarbdefinitionen werden mit
persönlichen Kennungen als Teil eines ICC-Profils gespeichert, sodass die Definitionen der
Ersatzfarbgruppen exportiert und auf mehrere Druckserver verteilt und gemeinsam genutzt
werden können.
Reihenfolge
der
Farben
Wert-Name-Kombination
für Substitution
CMYK-Werte Vor Substitution Nach Substitution
Originalfarbe <100, 0, 0, 0>
Fall 1 Ersatzfarbe 3
Ersatzfarbe 4
<100,0c, 0,0m, 0,0y, 0,0k>
<100,0C, 0,0M, 0,0Y, 0,0K>
<0, 100, 100, 0>
<100, 0, 100, 0>
Cyan Rot
(siehe unten)
Fall 2 Ersatzfarbe 4
Ersatzfarbe 3
<100,0C, 0,0M, 0,0Y, 0,0K>
<100,0c, 0,0m, 0,0y, 0,0k>
<100, 0, 100, 0>
<0, 100, 100, 0>
Cyan Grün
(siehe unten)
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 84
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN
Das ColorWise Farbmanagementsystem verwendet Druckoptionen, mit denen die Druckausgabe
von Objekten in den unterschiedlichen Farbräumen beeinflusst werden kann.
Durch die Festlegung der geeigneten Einstellung für jede dieser Druckoptionen können
beim Drucken Ihrer Aufträge die gewünschten Ergebnisse erzielt werden.
Aufbau dieses Abschnitts
Dieser Abschnitt enthält eine Übersicht über das ColorWise Farbmanagementsystem, mit
dem die Farben auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 gesteuert werden (siehe Seite 85), und ausführliche
Beschreibungen der einzelnen Druckoptionen. Die folgende Tabelle erleichtert das Auffinden
der einzelnen Druckoptionen.
Darüber hinaus enthält dieser Abschnitt Informationen über PostScript-Druckertreiber sowie
Anleitungen zum Einstellen der ColorWise Druckoptionen unter Windows und Mac OS.
Die Informationen über Druckertreiber finden Sie auf Seite 99.
ColorWise Druckoption Siehe
Ausgabeprofil Seite 93
Autom. Überfüllung Seite 86
CMYK-Simulationsprofil Seite 90
CMYK-Simulationsverfahren Seite 91
Composite-Ausgabe überdrucken Seite 92
Farbsubstitution Seite 98
Farbwiedergabe Seite 94
Nur Schwarz für Grautöne Seite 93
RGB-Quellprofil Seite 96
RGB-Separation Seite 95
Schwarz überdrucken Seite 87
Schwarze Texte/Grafiken Seite 88
Schwarzerkennung Seite 87
Separationen überdrucken Seite 92
Spot-Farbabstimmung Seite 97
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 85
Farbmanagement des Fiery X3eTY2
Sie können das Druckverhalten des Fiery X3eTY2 auf eine der folgenden Weisen ändern:
• Sie können die ColorWise Optionen individuell für einen Auftrag einstellen, indem Sie
in den Menüs des Druckertreibers die gewünschten Einstellungen wählen.
• Sie können die meisten ColorWise Optionen mit der Komponente Color Setup der
ColorWise Pro Tools als Serverstandardeinstellungen festlegen (siehe Seite 32).
Bestimmte Standardwerte können Sie auch im Setup-Programm des Fiery X3eTY2
festlegen. Eine ausführliche Beschreibung finden Sie im Dokument Konfiguration
und Setup. Die Standardeinstellungen gelten für alle nachfolgenden Aufträge, sofern
Sie keine abweichenden Einstellungen für einen Auftrag wählen.
• Bestimmte ColorWise Optionen, insbesondere das ICC-Standardprofil und die
Kalibrierungsoptionen, können Sie mit den ColorWise Pro Tools festlegen. Zu diesen
Optionen gehören das CMYK-Simulationsprofil (siehe Seite 90), das Simulationsverfahren
(siehe Seite 91), das Standardquellprofil (siehe Seite 96), die RGB-Separation
(siehe Seite 95) sowie das zugehörige Kalibrierungsset (siehe Seite 35).
Anwendungsprogramme können die Farbdaten für den Fiery X3eTY2 in mehr als einem
Farbraum liefern. Office- oder Büroanwendungen verwenden in der Regel den RGBFarbraum,
während Prepress-Anwendungen normalerweise CMYK-Daten generieren.
Desktop-Anwendungen können zusätzlich auch Spot-Farben (z. B. PANTONE-Farben)
generieren. Eine besondere Schwierigkeit stellen dabei Seiten dar, auf denen RGB-, CMYKund
Spot-Farben gemischt sind. Sie können aber auch die Druckausgabe dieser komplexen
Dokumente mit gemischten Farbräumen präzise steuern, da der Fiery X3eTY2 spezifische
Funktionen für jeden Farbraum (RGB, CMYK und Spot-Farben) bereitstellt.
In der Abbildung unten sind die Optionen des Fiery X3eTY2 Farbmanagementsystems
zusammengefasst, die die Konvertierung von Farbdaten beeinflussen. Diese Optionen stehen
Ihnen zur Verfügung, wenn Sie einen Auftrag zum Drucken an den Fiery X3eTY2 senden.
Die meisten dieser Optionen und Einstellungen werden in diesem Kapitel ausführlich
beschrieben.
RGB-Quellprofil
Nur Schwarz für Grautöne (RGB)
Farbwiedergabe (CRD)
Helligkeit
Schwarze Texte/Grafiken
RGB-Separation
Ausgabeprofil
An Kopierer
gesendete
Farbdaten
Fiery X3eTY2
Farbprozessor
RGB-Daten
CMYK-Daten
Spot-Farbdaten Spot-Farbabstimmung
CMYK-Simulationsprofil
CMYK-Simulationsverfahren
Nur Schwarz für Grautöne (CMYK)
Helligkeit
Schwarze Texte/Grafiken
Separationen überdrucken
Ausgabeprofil
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 86
„RGB-Quellprofil“ ist die einzige Farboption, die ausschließlich für RGB-Daten gilt. Alle
anderen Optionen, die RGB-Farben beeinflussen, wirken sich auch auf seltener verwendete
Farbräume wie Lab, XYZ und andere kalibrierte Farbräume aus.
HINWEIS: Beim PostScript 3 Farbmanagement beeinflusst das RGB-Quellprofil auch den
Farbraum „CIEBasedABC“ (sofern RGB der Quellfarbraum ist). Wenn beispielsweise
CMYK-Daten im Format „CIEBasedDEFG“ an den Fiery X3eTY2 gesendet werden (indem
Sie in Photoshop das PostScript-Farbmanagement aktivieren), beeinflusst die Einstellung
für die Option „Farbwiedergabe“, die sich normalerweise nur auf RGB-Daten auswirkt,
auch die CMYK-Daten.
ColorWise Druckoptionen
Die folgenden Abschnitte enthalten ausführliche Beschreibungen der ColorWise
Druckoptionen und deren Auswirkungen auf Druckaufträge.
Autom. Überfüllung
Das Überfüllen ist eine Technik, bei der Objekte minimal vergrößert werden, damit aneinander
stoßende Farben geringfügig überlappen und keine weißen Bereiche zwischen den
Farben entstehen. Diese sogenannten „Blitzer“ können auf Ungenauigkeiten in der Farbregistrierung,
auf die physischen Eigenschaften der verwendeten Toner oder auf die Steifigkeit
des verwendeten Mediums zurückgehen. Die folgende Abbildung zeigt dasselbe Bild mit und
ohne Überfüllen.
Durch das Aktivieren der Option „Autom. Überfüllung“ wird erreicht, dass die Technik des
Überfüllens auf alle Objekte in einem Druckauftrag angewendet wird.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 87
Schwarzerkennung
Mit der Option „Schwarzerkennung“ kann festgelegt werden, ob vor dem Drucken eines
Auftrags Schwarzweißseiten erkannt werden sollen. Wenn Sie diese Option verwenden
möchten, müssen Sie für die Option „Farbmodus“ bzw. „Druckmodus“ die Einstellung
„Standardfarben“ oder „Profi-Farben“ wählen.
• Aus: Wählen Sie „Aus“ für einen Auftrag mit reinschwarzen Seiten und einer
beträchtlichen Anzahl von Farbseiten.
• Ein: Wählen Sie „Ein“ für einen Auftrag, der vorwiegend aus S/W-Seiten besteht. Für die
reinen S/W-Seiten werden bei dieser Einstellung die korrekten Fakturierungsdaten erhoben.
Schwarz überdrucken
Mit der Option „Schwarz überdrucken“ können Sie festlegen, ob schwarzer Text (definiert
als RGB = 0, 0, 0 oder als CMYK = 0%, 0%, 0%, 100%) als zusätzliche Schicht über den
Farbhintergrund gedruckt werden soll.
• Text: Schwarzer Text wird als zusätzliche Schicht über den Farbhintergrund gedruckt,
wodurch weiße Zwischenräume vermieden und Lichthofeffekte sowie die Auswirkungen
einer fehlerhaften Farbregistrierung reduziert werden. Mit dieser Einstellung wird für die
Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“ automatisch die Einstellung „Reines Schwarz - Ein“
festgelegt.
• Text/Grafik: Schwarzer Text und schwarze Grafiken werden als zusätzliche Schicht über
den Farbhintergrund gedruckt, wodurch weiße Zwischenräume vermieden und Lichthofeffekte
sowie die Auswirkungen einer fehlerhaften Farbregistrierung reduziert werden.
Mit dieser Einstellung wird für die Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“ automatisch die
Einstellung „Reines Schwarz - Ein“ festgelegt.
• Aus: Schwarzer Text bzw. schwarzer Text und schwarze Grafiken werden in einer Schicht
mit dem Farbhintergrund gedruckt.
HINWEIS: Bestimmte PostScript-Anwendungen führen eigene Konvertierungen für das
Überdrucken von Schwarz aus, bevor sie den Auftrag an den Kopierer senden.
Die Funktionsweise dieser Option soll am Beispiel einer Seite mit schwarzem Text auf
hellblauem Hintergrund verdeutlicht werden. Das Blau des Hintergrunds hat die Werte
CMYK=40%, 30%, 0%, 0%. Der schwarze Text hat die Werte CMYK=0%, 0%, 0%, 100%.
• Wenn Sie die Option „Schwarz überdrucken“ aktivieren („Text“ bzw. „Text/Grafik“),
werden die Textabschnitte bzw. Text- und Grafikabschnitte der Seite überdruckt, d. h.
mit den Farben darunter kombiniert. Das in Anwendungen generierte Schwarz (z. B.
„RGB=0, 0, 0“ oder „CMYK=0%, 0%, 0%,100%“) wird nur mit schwarzem Toner
reproduziert. Dadurch werden unerwünschte Rastereffekte bei schwarzen Text- und
Grafikelementen vermieden, vorausgesetzt der Kopierer ist korrekt kalibriert. Es gibt auf
diese Weise keinen Übergang bei den Tonerfarben Cyan und Magenta. Die Qualität der
Ausgabe wird gesteigert, da an den Kanten von Text, der im RGB-Farbraum definiert
wurde (RGB=0, 0, 0), keine Artefakte entstehen.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 88
• Wenn Sie die Option „Schwarz überdrucken“ deaktivieren („Aus“), bilden sich Stoßkanten
an den Text- und Grafikrändern, an denen die Tonerfarben Cyan und Magenta
(außerhalb des Textes) und die Tonerfarbe Schwarz (des Textes) aneinander grenzen.
Diese Übergänge können zu Artefakten führen, da die technischen Möglichkeiten des
Kopierermodells hier an ihre Grenzen stoßen.
HINWEIS: Wenn Sie für die Option „Schwarz überdrucken“ die Einstellung „Text/Grafik“
festlegen, können schwarze Text- und Grafikelemente über einen farbigen Hintergrund
gedruckt werden (siehe CMYK-Simulationsverfahren auf Seite 91).
HINWEIS: Bei anderen CMYK-Werten als CMYK=0%, 0%, 0%, 0% ist die Reproduktion
der CMYK-Komponenten abhängig von der Einstellung für die CMYK-Simulation und von
der Kalibrierungskurve.
Schwarze Texte/Grafiken
Die Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“ wird auf schwarze Textelemente und Vektorgrafiken
angewendet. Im Normalfall können Sie die Einstellung „Reines Schwarz - Ein“ für diese
Option beibehalten. Wenn Sie für die Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“ die Einstellung
„Reines Schwarz – Ein“ wählen, wird das in einer Anwendung generierte Schwarz (z.B.
„RGB=0, 0, 0“ oder „CMYK=0%, 0%, 0%, 100%“) nur mit schwarzem Toner reproduziert.
Dies verhindert unerwünschte Artefakte bei Halftone-Rastern (sofern der Kopierer richtig
kalibriert wurde) sowie Fehler durch eine falsche Registrierung bei schwarzen Text- und
Grafikelementen, da nur mit einem Toner gedruckt wird. Außerdem wird dadurch die
Übersteuerung vermieden. Für diese Option wird automatisch die Einstellung „Reines
Schwarz = Ein“ festgelegt, wenn Sie die Option „Schwarz überdrucken“ durch Auswahl
einer entsprechenden Einstellung aktivieren.
Für bestimmte Aufträge ist es ratsam, diese Option zu deaktivieren, z. B. für Aufträge mit
Farbverläufen/Gradienten, für die Schwarz verwendet wird. In der folgenden Tabelle werden
die Auswirkungen der Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“ auf schwarze Daten in verschiedenen
Farbräumen beschrieben.
HINWEIS: Die Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“ kann nur für unseparierte Farbdrucke
(Composite), nicht für Separationen verwendet werden.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 89
Farbe Schwarze Texte/Grafiken = Normal Schwarze Texte/Grafiken =
Reines Schwarz - Ein oder
CMYK-Schwarz - Ein
RGB=0,0,0
(für alle anderen RGB-Werte ist
die Einstellung der Option
„Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“
nicht relevant)
RGB=0,0,0 wird unter Berücksichtigung der
Definition für RGB=0,0,0 im Ausgabeprofil
gedruckt. Dies kann zu einem mit allen Tonern
erzeugten satten CMYK-Schwarz führen, wenn
im Ausgabeprofil sattes Schwarz für diesen Fall
vorgegeben ist. Sieht das Ausgabeprofil dagegen
für RGB=0,0,0 die ausschließliche Verwendung
von schwarzem Toner vor, so wird ein reines
Schwarz (100% K) erzeugt. Die Ausgabe wird
durch die Kalibrierungskurve beeinflusst.
RGB=0,0,0 wird als 100% K unter Verwendung
von schwarzem Toner (Reines Schwarz - EIN)
oder als 100% K plus 50% Cyan (CMYKSchwarz
- EIN) unter Verwendung von Toner
in den Farben Schwarz und Cyan gedruckt.
Für alle anderen RGB-Werte ist die Einstellung
der Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“ nicht
relevant.
CMYK=0%,0%,0%,100%
(für alle anderen CMYK-Werte
ist die Einstellung der Option
„Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“
nicht relevant)
Die Ausgabe von CMYK=0%,0%,0%,100%
erfolgt – abhängig von den Einstellungen der
Optionen „CMYK-Simulationsprofil“ und
„CMYK-Simulationsverfahren“ – entweder als
reines Schwarz (100% K) oder als ein mit allen
Tonern erzeugtes sattes Schwarz.
Bei den Verfahren „Schnell“ und „Komplett
(Quell-GCR)“ wird CMYK=0%,0%,0%,100%
als reines Schwarz (100% K) ausgegeben; in
diesem Fall wird die Menge an schwarzem Toner
durch das Simulationsprofil und die Kalibrierungskurve
beschränkt.
Beim Verfahren „Komplett (Ausgabe-GCR)“
wird CMYK=0%,0%,0%,100% als reines
Schwarz (100% K) ausgegeben; in diesem Fall
wird die Menge an schwarzem Toner durch das
Simulationsprofil und die Kalibrierungskurve
beschränkt.
Wird für die Option „CMYK-Simulationsprofil“
die Einstellung „ColorWise Aus“ verwendet,
werden das Simulationsprofil und die Kalibrierungskurve
deaktiviert. In diesem Fall wird der
schwarze Toner nicht durch die Kalibrierungskurve
beschränkt.
CMYK=0%,0%,0%,100% wird unabhängig
von den Einstellungen der Optionen „CMYKSimulationsprofil“
und „CMYK-Simulationsverfahren“
als 100% K unter Verwendung von
schwarzem Toner (Reines Schwarz - EIN) oder
als 100% K plus 50% Cyan (CMYK-Schwarz -
EIN) unter Verwendung von Toner in den
Farben Schwarz und Cyan gedruckt. Für alle
anderen CMYK-Werte ist die Einstellung der
Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“ nicht
relevant.
Wird für die Option „CMYK-Simulationsprofil“
die Einstellung „ColorWise Aus“ verwendet,
werden das Simulationsprofil und die Kalibrierungskurve
deaktiviert. In diesem Fall wird der
schwarze Toner nicht durch die Kalibrierungskurve
beschränkt.
Spot-Farben
(für Spot-Farben ist die
Einstellung der Option
„Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“
nicht relevant)
Spot-Farben werden in der gewohnten Weise
verarbeitet
Spot-Farben werden in der gewohnten Weise
verarbeitet
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 90
HINWEIS: Bestimmte PostScript-Anwendungen (z. B. QuarkXPress) konvertieren Elemente,
die als RGB = 0, 0, 0 definiert sind, in ein Vierfarbschwarz (CMYK), bevor Sie den Auftrag
an den Fiery X3eTY2 senden. Für diese Elemente ist die Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“
nicht relevant. Weitere Informationen finden Sie im Dokument Fiery Farbreferenz. Schwarze
Text- und Grafikelemente, die in Büroanwendungen wie Microsoft Word als RGB = 0,0,0
definiert sind, werden vom Microsoft PostScript 3 Druckertreiber für Windows 2000/XP/
Server 2003 in ein Einfarbschwarz (CMYK = 0%,0%,0%,100%) konvertiert. Damit dieses
mit nur einer Druckfarbe produzierte Schwarz mit der maximalen Tonerdichte des Kopierermodells
gedruckt wird, muss für die Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“ die Einstellung
„Reines Schwarz - Ein“ gewählt werden.
CMYK-Simulationsprofil
Die Option „CMYK-Simulationsprofil“ ermöglicht es Ihnen, Prepress-Proofs (kurz Proofs)
oder Simulationen zu drucken. Mit dieser Option legen Sie den Offsetdruckstandard bzw.
das Farbausgabegerät fest, den/das Sie simulieren wollen. Diese Option wirkt sich nur auf
CMYK-Daten aus.
In den Druckertreibern für Windows kann auch eine unbegrenzte Anzahl von eigenen
kompletten Simulationen angezeigt werden, die mit den ColorWise Pro Tools erstellt wurden.
Unter Mac OS können bis zu zehn eigene komplette Simulationen angezeigt werden. Die
Anzahl eigener Simulationen, die Sie auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 speichern können, ist nur durch
den verfügbaren Festplattenbereich beschränkt.
Wenn Sie mit dem PostScript-Treiber drucken und die bidirektionale Kommunikation
aktiviert ist, werden die Namen der geladenen und eigenen Profile im Menü „CMYKSimulationsprofil“
angezeigt. Wenn die bidirektionale Kommunikation nicht aktiviert
wurde, werden für die geladenen bzw. die eigenen Profile die generischen Bezeichnungen
„Simulation-1“ bis „Simulation-10“ angezeigt. Weitere Informationen über die bidirektionale
Kommunikation finden Sie in den Dokumenten Drucken unter Windows und Drucken unter
Mac OS.
Mit der Einstellung „Nein“ werden Ihre CMYK-Originaldaten an den Kopierer in kalibriertem
Zustand gesendet, ohne dass sie zur Simulation eines anderen Ausgabegeräts konvertiert
werden. Bei der Einstellung „ColorWise Aus“ werden die CMYK-Originaldaten an den
Kopierer in unkalibriertem Zustand gesendet, ohne dass sie zur Simulation eines anderen
Ausgabegeräts konvertiert werden.
Für welches CMYK-Simulationsprofil Sie sich entscheiden sollten, hängt von dem Offsetdruckstandard
ab, für den die CMYK-Daten separiert wurden.
• Wählen Sie für Bilder, die mit einer eigenen Separation separiert wurden (z. B. für eine
mit einem ICC-Profil erzeugte Separation) das Profil auf dem Fiery X3eTY2, das der
Einstellung der Option „CMYK-Simulationsprofil“ entspricht.
• Wählen Sie für Bilder, die z. B. für den Offsetdruckstandard SWOP separiert wurden,
die Einstellung „SWOP“ für die Option „CMYK-Simulationsprofil“.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 91
Damit ein Bild, das mithilfe eines ICC-Profils separiert wurde, korrekt simuliert wird, muss
das betreffende Profil auch auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 verfügbar sein. Weitere Hinweise zum
Laden von ICC-Profilen auf den Fiery X3eTY2 finden Sie auf Seite 11.
CMYK-Simulationsverfahren
Mit der Option „CMYK-Simulationsverfahren“ können Sie das gewünschte CMYK>CMYKKonvertierungsverfahren
festlegen.
• Schnell: Mit dieser Einstellung werden eindimensionale Transferkurven angewendet, die
nur die Ausgabedichte der Farbkanäle Cyan, Magenta, Gelb und Schwarz beeinflussen.
Mit diesem Verfahren erreichen Sie mit dem Kopierer eine zufriedenstellende Farbausgabe,
da die Primärfarben nicht durch weitere Farbstoffe ‚verunreinigt’ werden. Obwohl dieses
das schnellste Simulationsverfahren ist und sich besonders für Entwürfe eignet, sollten
Sie es nicht für endbearbeitete Dokumente verwenden, die als Prepress-Proofs benutzt
werden. Es gibt andere Verfahren, mit denen die für die Erstellung von Proofs erforderliche
höhere CMYK-Simulationspräzision erzielt werden kann.
• Komplett (Quell-GCR): Mit dieser Einstellung wird durch kolorimetrische Transformationen
eine komplette und präzise Simulation erreicht. Die Farbtöne werden beibehalten,
auch bei Primärfarben. Die im Originaldokument (Quelle) festgelegte Einstellung für
den Unbuntaufbau (GCR) wird auch für reinschwarze Texte und Grafiken beibehalten.
Verarbeitetes und als CMY definiertes Schwarz wird mit CMY-Tonern reproduziert. Die
Einstellung „Komplett (Quell-GCR)“ wird für Anwendungen empfohlen, mit denen
hochqualitative Proofs erstellt werden können.
• Komplett (Ausgabe-GCR): Mit dieser Einstellung wird durch kolorimetrische Transformationen
eine komplette und präzise Simulation erreicht. Die Farbtöne werden beibehalten,
auch bei Primärfarben. Die im Originaldokument festgelegte Einstellung für den Unbuntaufbau
(GCR) wird jedoch nicht beibehalten. Stattdessen werden sämtliche CMYK-Daten
unter Verwendung der im Ausgabeprofil festgelegten GCR-Einstellung nochmals separiert.
Dieses Simulationsverfahren ähnelt den traditionellen ICC-Farbabstimmungsverfahren
und ist für den Vollfarbdruck von Dokumenten, die für den Offsetdruck konzipiert sind,
aber auf dem Kopierer ausgegeben werden, besser geeignet als die Einstellung „Komplett
(Quell-GCR)“.
HINWEIS: Wenn Sie die Einstellung „Reines Schwarz - Ein“ für die Option „Schwarze Texte/
Grafiken“ festlegen und „Komplett (Ausgabe-GCR)“ als CYMK-Simulationsverfahren
angeben, werden schwarze Textelemente und Grafiken in Ihrem Dokument ausschließlich
mit schwarzem Toner (100%K) gedruckt.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 92
Separationen überdrucken
Mit der Option „Separationen überdrucken“ bestimmen Sie, wie separierte CMYK-Daten
ausgegeben werden.
• Aus: Mit dieser Einstellung wird jede Separation einzeln gedruckt.
• Ein: Mit dieser Einstellung werden die Separationen übereinander gelegt und als nicht
separierter Farbdruck (Composite) ausgegeben. Außerdem werden die Einstellungen der
folgenden Optionen automatisch wie folgt festgelegt: Farbmodus (CMYK), Schwarze
Texte/Grafiken (Normal), Schwarz überdrucken (Aus) und Spot-Farbabstimmung (Aus).
Informationen über die Verwendung der Option „Separationen überdrucken“ in
Anwendungen wie Adobe Photoshop finden Sie im Dokument Fiery Farbreferenz.
Composite-Ausgabe überdrucken
Beim Drucken zweier einander überlappender Objekte gibt es die Möglichkeit, die Farbe des
überlappten Objekts (im Hintergrund) auszusparen oder aber sie zu drucken und mit der
Farbe des überlappenden Objekts (im Vordergrund) zu überdrucken. Im zweiten Fall – beim
Überdrucken – scheint die Farbe des Hintergrundobjekts an den Stellen, an denen sich die
Objekte überlappen, durch die Farbe des Vordergrundobjekts hindurch. Dies führt dazu, dass
die resultierende Farbe an den Überlappungsstellen einer Kombination der Farben der beiden
Objekte entspricht. Beim Aussparen deckt das Vordergrundobjekt die Farbe des Hintergrundobjekts
vollkommen ab.
Mit der Option „Composite-Ausgabe überdrucken“ können Sie veranlassen, dass überdruckte
Objekte in der Weise ausgegeben werden, in der sie in der Quelldatei definiert sind.
Standardmäßig ist die Option „Composite-Ausgabe überdrucken“ deaktiviert; in diesem Fall
werden die Farben überlappter Objekte ausgespart.
Die Option „Composite-Ausgabe überdrucken“ wird für PostScript- und PDF-Aufträge
unterstützt, die mit einem der folgenden Anwendungsprogramme erstellt wurden:
• Adobe Acrobat
• Adobe Illustrator
• Adobe InDesign
• Macromedia FreeHand
• QuarkXPress
• CorelDRAW
Wird die Option „Composite-Ausgabe überdrucken“ für einen Auftrag aktiviert, in dem
Spot-Farben verwendet werden, muss die optionale Erweiterung Spot-On auf dem
Fiery X3eTY2 aktiviert werden.
Zu beachten ist, dass ein Auftrag mit mehr als 32 Spot-Farben u. U. nicht in der erwarteten
Weise gedruckt wird.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 93
Ausgabeprofil
Da das definierte Ausgabeprofil auf alle Daten eines Auftrags angewendet wird, sollten Sie sich
vor dem Drucken vergewissern, dass das gewählte Ausgabeprofil für Ihren Auftrag geeignet ist.
Das Standardausgabeprofil umfasst ein Profil für Ihren Kopierer, das dessen Farbeigenschaften
beschreibt, und Sollwerte für die Kalibrierung, die das erwartete Verhalten des Kopierermodells
beschreiben.
Mit der Komponente Profile Manager der ColorWise Pro Tools können Sie ein eigenes
(anwenderdefiniertes) Ausgabeprofil auf den Fiery X3eTY2 laden (siehe Abschnitt Profile
Manager auf Seite 25). Die geladenen Ausgabeprofile werden zunächst mit den Kalibrierungssollwerten
verknüpft, die mit dem standardmäßigen Ausgabeprofil verbunden sind. Wie
erwähnt, können die D-Max-Werte der Kalibrierungssollwerte separat bearbeitet werden.
Wenn Sie mit dem PostScript-Treiber drucken und die bidirektionale Kommunikation
aktiviert ist, werden die Namen der geladenen und eigenen Profile im Menü „Ausgabeprofil“
angezeigt. Wenn die bidirektionale Kommunikation nicht aktiviert wurde, werden für die
geladenen bzw. die eigenen Profile die generischen Bezeichnungen „Ausgabe-1“ bis
„Ausgabe-10“ angezeigt. Weitere Informationen über die bidirektionale Kommunikation
finden Sie in den Dokumenten Drucken unter Windows und Drucken unter Mac OS.
Aktivieren Sie die Option „Mediumabhängiges Profil“, wenn (anstelle der Einstellungen eines
bestimmten einzelnen Ausgabeprofils) für jedes Medium, das in einem Auftrag verwendet
wird, automatisch das dem Medium zugeordnete Ausgabeprofil verwendet werden soll.
Weitere Informationen finden Sie im Abschnitt Verwenden mediumabhängiger Ausgabeprofile
auf Seite 27.
Wählen Sie die Einstellung „Serverstandard“, wenn das mit der Komponente Color Setup als
Standard festgelegte Ausgabeprofil verwendet werden soll. Weitere Informationen über die
Komponente Color Setup finden Sie im Abschnitt Color Setup auf Seite 32.
Nur Schwarz für Grautöne
Wenn Sie die Option „Nur Schwarz für Grautöne“ aktivieren, wird jeder Grauton (d. h. jede
Farbe mit gleich großen Anteilen von Rot, Grün und Blau [R=G=B] bzw. Cyan, Gelb und
Magenta [C=Y=M] und jeder nur mit Schwarz definierte Grauton [nur K]) in einem Auftrag
ausschließlich mit schwarzen Toner (nicht mit CMYK-Schwarz) gedruckt.
Zusätzlich können Sie angeben, ob die Option „Nur Schwarz für Grautöne“ auf Text- und
Grafikobjekte beschränkt oder auf Text-, Grafik- und Bildobjekte angewendet werden soll.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 94
Im Hinblick auf diese Druckoption sind die folgenden Einschränkungen zu beachten:
• Die Option „Nur Schwarz für Grautöne“ wirkt sich auf vorseparierte Aufträge nur
insofern aus, als bei ihrer Deaktivierung (Einstellung „Aus“) jede Separation als CMYKGrau
gedruckt wird, da die Separationen als Graustufenbilder behandelt werden.
• Wird für die Option „CMYK-Simulationsverfahren“ die Einstellung „Komplett
(Quell-GCR)“ oder „Schnell“ festgelegt, hat die Einstellung der Option „Nur Schwarz
für Grautöne (CMYK)“ keinen Einfluss auf die Ausgabe.
• Wird für die Option „RGB-Separation“ die Einstellung „Simulation“ verwendet, wird
die Option „Nur Schwarz für Grautöne (RGB)“ deaktiviert. Umgekehrt steht, wenn die
Option „Nur Schwarz für Grautöne (RGB)“ aktiviert wird, die Einstellung „Simulation“
der Option „RGB-Separation“ nicht zur Verfügung.
• Wird für die Option „Schwarze Texte/Grafiken“ die Einstellung „Reines Schwarz – Ein“
oder „CMYK-Schwarz – Ein“ verwendet, so hat im Falle von reinschwarzen Text- und
Grafikobjekten (100%K) diese Festlegung Vorrang vor der Option „Nur Schwarz für
Grautöne“.
• Ein Grauton, der im Auftrag als Spot-Farbe definiert ist, ist von der Festlegung der
Druckoption „Nur Schwarz für Grautöne“ nicht betroffen.
Farbwiedergabe
Mit der Option „Farbwiedergabe“ aktivieren Sie ein CRD für die Konvertierung der Farbdaten.
Sie können mit dieser Option die Farbausgabe von Druckbildern beeinflussen, z. B.
von Dokumenten aus Büroanwendungen oder von RGB-Fotos aus Photoshop. Der
Fiery X3eTY2 unterstützt vier Farbwiedergabearten, die auf ICC-Profilen nach Industriestandard
basieren.
Fiery X3eTY2
Farbwiedergabeart
Optimal für Äquivalente ICCFarbwiedergabe
Foto: Bei der fotorealistischen
Wiedergabe erscheinen RGB-Farben
außerhalb des Gamuts des Ausgabegeräts
weniger gesättigt als bei der
Einstellung „Präsentation“. Die
Relationen zwischen den Farben
werden in der Ausgabe beibehalten.
Fotos, Scans und Bilder von
Foto-CDs bzw. von digitalen
Kameras.
Bild, Kontrast und
Wahrnehmung
Präsentation: Diese Farbwiedergabe
eignet sich für leuchtende, gesättigte
Farben; die gedruckten Farben
werden aber nicht präzise mit den
Monitorfarben abgestimmt. Farben
im Gamut (z. B. Hautfarben) werden
sehr gut wiedergegeben. Diese
Wiedergabeart ähnelt der Wiedergabeart
„Foto“.
Illustrationen und Grafiken für
Präsentationen. Diese Art der
Wiedergabe eignet sich für
Auftragsseiten, die sowohl
Präsentationsgrafiken als auch
Fotos enthalten.
Sättigung, Grafiken
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 95
RGB-Separation
Die Option „RGB-Separation“ bestimmt, wie RGB- (und Lab- und XYZ-) Farben in den
CMYK-Farbraum konvertiert werden. Diese Option hat eine beschreibende Bezeichnung.
Sie soll zum Ausdruck bringen, dass die Option die Farbräume festlegt, die auf dem
Fiery X3eTY2 verwendet werden, um RGB-Daten in CMYK-Werte zu ‚separieren‘.
Mit den beiden Einstellungen für diese Option können Sie bestimmen, ob RGB-Daten in
den vollen Gamut des Kopierermodells (Ausgabe) oder zuvor in den Gamut eines anderen
digitalen Ausgabegeräts oder eines Offsetdruckstandards (Simulation) konvertiert werden.
Mithilfe dieser Funktion können Sie für RGB-Daten mit Ihrem Ausgabegerät das Farbverhalten
eines anderen Geräts simulieren. Wenn Ihnen z. B. ein qualitativ gutes ICCProfil
eines anderen Ausgabegeräts zur Verfügung steht, können Sie mit Ihrem Kopierer
das Verhalten dieses anderen Geräts simulieren.
Die RGB-Separation ist darüber hinaus für Prepress-Anwendungen von Vorteil. Mit ihr
können Sie z. B. das Aussehen eines RGB-Scans unter verschiedenen Offsetdruckbedingungen
testen, ohne dass Sie die RGB-Daten für jede dieser Bedingungen erneut in CMYKDaten
konvertieren müssen. Wenn die gewünschte Druckbedingung gefunden wurde,
können Sie Ihre Datei unter Verwendung des CMYK-Simulationsprofils, das für den Test
eingesetzt wurde, in den CMYK-Farbraum konvertieren.
Relative Farbmetrik: Diese Farbwiedergabe
unterstützt die Weißpunkttransformation
zwischen den
Weißpunktwerten von Quelle und
Ziel. Damit wird z. B. das bläuliche
Weiß (Grau) eines Monitors durch
Papierweiß ersetzt. Mit dieser
Wiedergabeart können sichtbare
Ränder zwischen leeren Bereichen
und weißen Objekten vermieden
werden.
Diese Einstellung sollte benutzt
werden, wenn die Farbabstimmung
wichtig ist, weiße Farben im
Dokument aber als Papierweiß
gedruckt werden sollen.
Zusammen mit dem PostScript-
Farbmanagement kann diese
Wiedergabeart benutzt werden,
um CMYK-Daten zu Simulationszwecken
zu manipulieren.
Farbmetrisch
relativ
Absolute Farbmetrik: Diese Farbwiedergabe
unterstützt die Weißpunkttransformation
zwischen den
Weißpunktwerten von Quelle und
Ziel nicht. Damit wird z. B. das bläuliche
Weiß (Grau) eines Monitors
nicht durch Papierweiß ersetzt.
Diese Einstellung sollte verwendet
werden, wenn akkurate Farben
erzielt werden sollen und sichtbare
Ränder als weniger störend
empfunden werden. Zusammen
mit dem PostScript-Farbmanagement
kann diese Wiedergabeart
benutzt werden, um CMYKDaten
zu Simulationszwecken
zu manipulieren.
Farbmetrisch
absolut
Fiery X3eTY2
Farbwiedergabeart
Optimal für Äquivalente ICCFarbwiedergabe
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 96
HINWEIS: Verwenden Sie die Druckoption „RGB-Separation“ in Verbindung mit der Option
„Ausgabeprofil“ oder der Option „CMYK-Simulationsprofil“.
• Ausgabe: Mit dieser Einstellung werden alle RGB-Farben in den CMYK-Farbraum Ihres
Kopierermodells konvertiert (wenn Sie für die Option „Ausgabeprofil“ den „Druckerstandard“
wählen) oder in einen spezifischen CMYK-Farbraum für Ihren Kopierer (wenn
Sie für die Option „Ausgabeprofil“ eine der Einstellungen „Ausgabe-1“ bis „Ausgabe-10“
wählen).
• Simulation: Mit dieser Einstellung werden alle RGB-Farben in den CMYK-Farbraum
für die ausgewählte Simulation konvertiert (wählen Sie daher mit der Option „CMYKSimulationsprofil“
die gewünschte Simulation).
RGB-Quellprofil
Mit der Option „RGB-Quellprofil“ können Sie die Merkmale von RGB-Daten in einem
Dokument so definieren, dass auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 die korrekte Farbkonvertierung erfolgt.
Häufig verwendete Monitorfarbräume sind über die entsprechenden Einstellungen des
Druckertreibers bzw. des Fiery X3eTY2 verfügbar. Für andere Farbräume können Sie mit der
Komponente Profile Manager der ColorWise Pro Tools eigene Monitor- und Scannerprofile
auf den Druckserver laden.
Bei allen Einstellungen außer „Nein“ werden auf dem Fiery X3eTY2 die Angaben und Profile
für den Quellfarbraum anderer Farbmanagementsysteme überschrieben. Wenn Sie z. B. auf
Ihrem Mac OS Computer ein ColorSync Systemprofil gewählt haben, wird dieses Profil
durch die Einstellung der Option „RGB-Quellprofil“ überschrieben. Wenn Sie nicht wollen,
dass der zuvor gewählte Quellfarbraum überschrieben wird, müssen Sie die Einstellung
„Nein“ für die Option „RGB-Quellprofil“ wählen.
Mit allen Einstellungen außer „Nein“ erzielen Sie auch plattformübergreifend konsistente
Ausgaben auf dem Fiery X3eTY2, da die Farbraumdefinitionen bei allen Einstellungen
außer „Nein“ überschrieben werden. Nachfolgend werden die Einstellungen für die Option
„RGB-Quellprofil“ des Fiery X3eTY2 aufgeführt.
• EFIRGB: Mit dieser Einstellung wählen Sie einen von EFI definierten Quellfarbraum; diese
Einstellung wird empfohlen, wenn keine detaillierten Informationen über die RGB-Daten
vorhanden sind.
• sRGB (PC): Mit dieser Einstellung wird das Profil eines standardmäßigen Monitors für
einen Windows-Computer festgelegt.
• Apple Standard: Mit dieser Einstellung wird das Profil eines standardmäßigen Monitors
für einen Mac OS Computer festgelegt.
• Adobe RGB (1998): Diese Einstellung steht für einen von Adobe definierten Farbraum,
der in der Druckvorstufe als Standardarbeitsfarbraum in Photoshop 5 verwendet wird.
• ECI-RGB: Dies ist der Farbraum, der von der European Color Initiative (ECI) als RGBArbeitsfarbraum
und für den Austausch von Farbdaten zwischen Werbeagenturen,
Verlagen, Reprobetrieben und Druckereien empfohlen wird.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 97
• Fiery RGB: Dieser von EFI definierte Farbraum wird für Office-Anwendungen empfohlen.
Dieser Farbraum ähnelt dem Farbraum „EFIRGB“, ist aber größer und kann Ausgaben
mit intensiveren Blautönen erzeugen.
• Quelle 1-10: Mit diesen Einstellungen wählen Sie Definitionen, die Sie als RGBQuellprofile
geladen haben.
Wenn Sie mit dem PostScript-Treiber drucken und die bidirektionale Kommunikation
aktiviert ist, werden die tatsächlichen Namen der geladenen Profile im Menü „RGB-Quellprofil“
angezeigt. Wenn die bidirektionale Kommunikation nicht aktiviert wurde, werden
für die geladenen bzw. die eigenen Profile die generischen Bezeichnungen „Quelle-1“ bis
„Quelle-10“ angezeigt. Weitere Informationen über die bidirektionale Kommunikation
finden Sie in den Dokumenten Drucken unter Windows und Drucken unter Mac OS.
• Nein: Mit dieser Einstellung weisen Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 an, die RGB-Quelle zu
verwenden, die Sie an anderer Stelle (z. B. innerhalb Ihrer Anwendung) definiert haben.
Bei der Einstellung „Nein“ ist das Aussehen der Farben nicht unabhängig vom Dateityp.
RGB-Dateien im TIFF-Format werden z. B. in anderer Weise ausgegeben als RGBDateien
im EPS-Format.
Bei der Einstellung „Nein“ werden PostScript-RGB-Daten, für die ein Quellfarbraum
definiert ist, mit dem CRD konvertiert, das mit der Option „Farbwiedergabe“ festgelegt
wurde (siehe Farbwiedergabe auf Seite 94). RGB-Daten, die nicht im PostScript-Format
vorliegen, und RGB-Daten ohne eine Definition des Quellfarbraums, werden mit einem
allgemeinen Verfahren für die Unterfarbenbeseitigung konvertiert.
Spot-Farbabstimmung
Die Option „Spot-Farbabstimmung“ sorgt für die automatische Abstimmung von Spot-
Farben mit den bestmöglichen CMYK-Äquivalenten.
• Ein: Bei dieser Einstellung verwendet der Fiery X3eTY2 die interne Referenztabelle, um
Spot-Farben mit den bestmöglichen CMYK-Äquivalenten zu drucken, die der verwendete
Kopierer erzeugen kann. (Beim Hinzufügen neuer Ausgabeprofile werden neue Tabellen
generiert.)
Der Fiery X3eTY2 verwendet gegebenenfalls die CMYK-Äquivalente, die mit Spot-On
definiert wurden (siehe Seite 60).
• Aus: Der Fiery X3eTY2 verarbeitet die Spot-Farben als CMYK-Daten und verwendet
die CMYK-Werte, die vom Hersteller der Spot-Farben (z. B. PANTONE) vorgegeben
werden. Es handelt sich dabei um die CMYK-Werte, die auch von Anwendungen mit
Spot-Farbbibliotheken verwendet werden.
HINWEIS: Spot-Farben, die nicht in der internen Referenztabelle enthalten sind, werden
als CMYK-Farben behandelt.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 98
Für Aufträge mit Spot-Farben muss die Option „Spot-Farbabstimmung“ aktiviert werden,
es sei denn, Sie drucken Offsetsimulationen. Zum Drucken von Simulationen müssen Sie
diese Option deaktivieren („Aus“) und eine geeignete Einstellung für die Option „CMYKSimulationsprofil“
wählen (siehe Seite 90).
Bei Aufträgen im PDF-Format, die Spot-Farben beinhalten, die nicht in der internen
Referenztabelle enthalten sind, können die ursprünglichen Spot-Farben durch das Aktivieren
der Option „Spot-Farbabstimmung“ beibehalten werden. Der Fiery X3eTY2 verwendet
die interne Referenztabelle, um bestmögliche CMYK-Äquivalente der ursprünglichen Spot-
Farben zu erstellen.
HINWEIS: Die Option „Spot-Farbabstimmung“ kann nur für unseparierte Farbdrucke
(Composite) verwendet werden; für Separationen ist die Option ohne Belang.
Spot-Farbabstimmung und PANTONE-Farbreferenz für gestrichenes Papier
Die PANTONE-Farbreferenz für gestrichenes Papier wird abhängig von der Einstellung der
Option „Spot-Farbabstimmung“ unterschiedlich gedruckt (siehe Fiery Farbreferenz).
• Ein: Bei dieser Einstellung verwendet der Fiery X3eTY2 die interne Referenztabelle bzw.
die Spot-On Farbbibliotheken (sofern Spot-on verfügbar ist), um PANTONE-Farben mit
den bestmöglichen CMYK-Äquivalenten für den Kopierer zu drucken. Dabei erscheint die
PANTONE-Farbnummer unter jedem Farbfeld.
Weitere Informationen über Spot-On finden Sie auf Seite 60.
• Aus: Bei dieser Einstellung verwendet der Fiery X3eTY2 zum Drucken der Farbfelder
die von Pantone, Inc. empfohlenen CMYK-Werte (die in den Anwendungen verwendet
werden, die die PANTONE-Bibliotheken bereitstellen). In diesem Fall werden die verwendeten
CMYK-Werte und die PANTONE-Farbnummer unter jedes Farbfeld gedruckt.
Diese CMYK-Werte werden unter Verwendung der Einstellungen für die Optionen
„CMYK-Simulationsprofil“ und „Ausgabeprofil“ gedruckt.
Farbsubstitution
Mit Spot-On können Sie eine Liste von Ersatzfarben erstellen. Auf dieser Basis können Farben,
die in einem Dokument als RGB- oder CMYK-Werte spezifiziert werden, durch andere Farben
ersetzt werden, deren CYMK-Farbwerte aus einer Spot-On Farbbibliothek abgerufen werden.
Diese Funktion ermöglicht die exakte Farbsteuerung und das individuelle Überschreiben
einzelner RBG- und CMYK-Farben.
Damit in einem Auftrag spezifizierte Farben durch Ersatzfarben ersetzt werden können,
müssen Sie für den betreffenden Auftrag die Option „Farbsubstitution“ aktivieren.
Weitere Informationen über das Erstellen und Verwenden von Ersatzfarben finden Sie im
Abschnitt Spot-On und Ersatzfarben auf Seite 74.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 99
Druckertreiber und Druckoptionen
Der Druckertreiber erstellt eine PostScript-Datei, die die von der Anwendung erzeugten
Instruktionen und die gewählten Einstellungen der ColorWise Druckoptionen enthält.
Diese PostScript-Datei wird vom Druckertreiber an den Fiery X3eTY2 gesendet. Der
Fiery X3eTY2 führt die PostScript-Verarbeitung und die Farbkonvertierung aus und leitet
die gerasterten Farbdaten an den Kopierer.
Festlegen von Druckoptionen unter Windows
Im Folgenden wird beschrieben, wie Sie die Druckoptionen für das Farbmanagement mit den
Adobe und Microsoft PostScript-Druckertreibern für Windows einstellen können. Diese
PostScript 3 Druckertreiber erlauben es Ihnen, die Farbfunktionen des Fiery X3eTY2 in
vollem Umfang zu nutzen.
Führen Sie die folgenden Schritte aus, bevor Sie fortfahren:
• Installieren Sie den Druckertreiber und die PPD-Datei für den Fiery X3eTY2 (siehe
Drucken unter Windows).
• Konfigurieren Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 zum Drucken (siehe Drucken unter Windows).
HINWEIS: Die folgenden Abbildungen und Erläuterungen gelten nicht für alle Anwendungen.
Viele Anwendungen (z. B. Adobe PageMaker, Adobe Photoshop, Adobe Illustrator,
QuarkXPress und CorelDRAW) haben zusätzlich zu den im Druckertreiber angebotenen
Optionen eigene Farbmanagementoptionen. Spezifische Informationen für bestimmte
Anwendungen finden Sie im Dokument Fiery Farbreferenz.
Anhand der folgenden Schritte können Sie die Farboptionen auf Windows-Computern
einstellen.
DRUCKOPTIONEN UNTER WINDOWS EINSTELLEN
1 Wählen Sie „Drucken“ in Ihrer Anwendung.
2 Wählen Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 als Drucker und klicken Sie auf „Eigenschaften“.
Im Dialogfenster mit den Eigenschaften wird die Registerkarte „Fiery Druckfunktionalität“
angezeigt.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 100
3 Klicken Sie auf das Symbol „Farbe“.
4 Legen Sie die Einstellungen für die Druckoptionen fest.
Informationen über die einzelnen ColorWise Druckoptionen finden Sie auf Seite 86.
5 Klicken Sie auf „Profi-Einstellungen“.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster „Profi-Farbeinstellungen“ angezeigt.
In diesem Dialogfenster finden Sie die Mehrzahl der ColorWise Druckoptionen für den
Fiery X3eTY2.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 101
6 Klicken Sie auf „Aktualisieren“, um die aktuellen Einstellungen des Fiery X3eTY2
anzuzeigen.
Wenn die Schaltfläche „Aktualisieren“ nicht angezeigt wird, müssen Sie die bidirektionale
Kommunikation aktivieren. Anleitungen für das Aktivieren der bidirektionalen Kommunikation
finden Sie im Dokument Drucken unter Windows.
7 Legen Sie die Einstellungen für die angebotenen ColorWise Druckoptionen fest.
Für die meisten Anwendungsgebiete bieten die Standardeinstellungen eine ausreichende
Farbsteuerung. Informationen über die einzelnen Optionen finden Sie auf Seite 86.
8 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um das Fenster „Profi-Farbeinstellungen“ zu schließen.
9 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um das Fenster mit den Eigenschaften zuschließen, und nochmals auf
„OK“, um Ihren Auftrag zu senden.
Festlegen von Druckoptionen für das Farbmanagement unter Mac OS
Im Folgenden wird beschrieben, wie Sie die Druckoptionen für das Farbmanagement mit den
Druckertreibern für Mac OS einstellen können.
Führen Sie die folgenden Schritte aus, bevor Sie fortfahren:
• Installieren Sie die PPD-Datei für den Fiery X3eTY2 (siehe Drucken unter Mac OS).
• Konfigurieren Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 für den Druckbetrieb (siehe Drucken unter Mac OS).
DRUCKOPTIONEN UNTER MAC OS X EINSTELLEN
1 Wählen Sie „Drucken“ in Ihrer Anwendung.
Das Dialogfenster „Drucken“ wird angezeigt.
2 Wählen Sie unter Mac OS X v10.3.x und neueren Versionen „ColorSync“ im Menü mit der
aktuellen Einstellung „Kopien & Seiten“.
Die Seite „ColorSync“ wird angezeigt.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 102
3 Wählen Sie „Druckerspezifisch” im Menü „Farbkonvertierung“.
4 Wählen Sie „ColorWise“ im Menü mit der aktuellen Einstellung „ColorSync“.
Die Seite „ColorWise“ wird angezeigt.
5 Aktivieren Sie die Option „Bidirektionale Kommunikation verwenden“.
Anleitungen für das Aktivieren der bidirektionalen Kommunikation finden Sie im Dokument
Drucken unter Mac OS.
6 Legen Sie die Einstellungen für die Druckoptionen fest.
Informationen über die einzelnen ColorWise Druckoptionen finden Sie auf Seite 86.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 103
7 Klicken Sie im Bereich „Druckmodus“ auf „Einstellungen“.
Daraufhin wird das Dialogfenster mit den ColorWise Profi-Farbeinstellungen angezeigt.
8 Wählen Sie die Einstellungen für die angebotenen ColorWise Druckoptionen.
Informationen über die einzelnen ColorWise Druckoptionen finden Sie auf Seite 86.
9 Klicken Sie auf „OK“.
Die Seite „ColorWise” wird wieder angezeigt.
10 Klicken Sie auf „Drucken“.
Aktivieren von Device Link-Profilen im Fenster
„Profi-Farbeinstellungen“
Sie können für einen einzelnen Auftrag die Verwendung eines Device Link-Profils im
Fiery X3eTY2 Druckertreiber veranlassen, sofern im Treiber die bidirektionale Kommunikation
aktiviert wurde. Wenn Sie ein Device Link-Profil aktivieren, wird im Fenster „Profi-
Farbeinstellungen“ dessen Name nach der Meldung „Benutztes Device Link-Profil“ angezeigt.
HINWEIS: Wenn die bidirektionale Kommunikation nicht aktiviert wurde und Sie eine
Kombination aus RGB-Quellprofil und Ausgabeprofil wählen, die der Festlegung in einem
Device Link-Profil entspricht, wird das betreffende Device Link-Profil ebenfalls aktiviert;
in diesem Fall wird allerdings der Name des betreffenden Profils nicht im Fenster „Profi-
Farbeinstellungen“ angezeigt.
Weitere Informationen über das Installieren und Zuordnen von Device Link-Profilen finden
Sie auf Seite 27.
COLORWISE DRUCKOPTIONEN 104
HINWEIS: Die Vorgehensweise zum Aktivieren eines Device Link-Profils im Fenster „Profi-
Farbeinstellungen“ sind unter Windows und Mac OS X sehr ähnlich. Im Folgenden werden
die entsprechenden Windows-Abbildungen verwendet. Auf Unterschiede werden Sie ggf.
hingewiesen.
DEVICE LINK-PROFILE IM FIERY X3ETY2 DRUCKERTREIBER AKTIVIEREN
1 Aktivieren Sie die bidirektionale Kommunikation.
Anleitungen für das Aktivieren der bidirektionalen Kommunikation finden Sie im Dokument
Drucken unter Windows bzw. Drucken unter Mac OS.
2 Wählen Sie „Drucken“ in Ihrer Anwendung.
3 Wählen Sie den Fiery X3eTY2 als Drucker und klicken Sie auf „Eigenschaften“.
4 Klicken Sie auf das Symbol „Farbe“.
5 Klicken Sie auf „Profi-Einstellungen“.
6 Wählen Sie ein Quellprofil und ein Ausgabeprofil.
Wenn Sie dabei eine Kombination von Quellprofil und Ausgabeprofil wählen, die einer
in einem Device Link-Profil festgelegten Kombination entspricht, wird automatisch das
betreffende Device Link-Profil verwendet.
Wird ein Device Link-Profil aktiviert, wird der Inhalt des Fensters „Profi-Farbeinstellungen“
automatisch aktualisiert; dabei werden u. U. bestimmte Optionen ausgeblendet. Im Bereich
der Option „RGB-Quellprofil“ bzw. „CMYK-Simulationsprofil“ erscheint die Meldung
„Benutztes Device Link-Profil“ zusammen mit dem Namen des verwendeten Profils.
7 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um das Fenster „Profi-Farbeinstellungen“ zu schließen.
8 Klicken Sie auf „OK“, um das Fenster mit den Eigenschaften zuschließen, und nochmals
auf „OK“, um Ihren Auftrag zu senden.
1 Benutztes Device Link-Profil
1
IMPORTIEREN VON DENSITOMETERMESSWERTEN 105
IMPORTIEREN VON DENSITOMETERMESSWERTEN
Im Folgenden wird das Dateiformat „Simple ASCII File Format“ (SAIFF) beschrieben, mit
dem Sie Dichtemesswerte von unterschiedlichen Messinstrumenten importieren können.
Wenn Sie eigene Messwerte verwenden wollen, die Sie mit einem alternativen Messinstrument
ermittelt haben, müssen Sie die gemessenen Werte in einer Textdatei erfassen, deren
Struktur unten beschrieben wird.
Simple ASCII Import File Format (SAIFF)
Dieses Format beschreibt Status T-Messwerte; es wird für den Import in die Komponente
Calibrator der ColorWise Pro Tools verwendet. Es gibt drei unterstützte Dateiformate:
• 1D Status T-Dichte für EFI Messwerteseiten mit 21 Farbfeldern
• 1D Status T-Dichte für EFI Messwerteseiten mit 34 Farbfeldern
• 1D Status T-Dichte für andere Seiten (mit maximal 256 Farbfeldern pro Druckfarbe)
Das Dateiformat ist ASCII, und es werden keine Tabulatoren verwendet. Als Begrenzungszeichen
sind ein oder mehrere Leerzeichen zulässig. Leerzeilen sind nicht zulässig. Jede
Zeile in der Datei repräsentiert vier Farbfelder (C, M, Y, K) des jeweiligen Druckfarbwerts.
Kommentarzeilen können an jeder Stelle in die Datei eingefügt werden. Sie müssen mit
dem Zeichen # beginnen, auf das ein Leerzeichen folgt. (Eine Zeile, in der auf das Anfangszeichen
# ein anderes Zeichen als das Leerzeichen folgt, ist reserviert.) Jeder Kommentar
muss innerhalb einer Zeile abgeschlossen sein.
Jede Datenzeile enthält fünf Werte. Die erste Zahl ist die fortlaufende Farbfeldnummer (bei
EFI 21 und EFI 34 Seiten) oder der prozentuale Druckfarbwert (bei anderen Seiten). Die
nachfolgenden vier Werte sind die Dichten für C, M, Y und K im jeweiligen Farbfeld. Die
Zeilen können aufsteigend entweder nach den fortlaufenden Farbfeldnummern oder nach
den prozentualen Farbwerten angeordnet werden.
Unter Windows muss die Textdatei die Dateinamenerweiterung „.cm1“ erhalten.
Für Mac OS muss die Datei den Dateityp „TEXT“ haben.
Bei EFI 21 und EFI 34 sind die Messwerte papierabhängig. Korrespondiert bei anderen
Seiten die erste Zeile der Textdatei mit dem Druckfarbwert 0 (Null), geht die Komponente
Calibrator von absoluten Messwerten aus und passt sie so an, dass auch sie papierabhängig
werden; dazu werden die Dichtewerte in der ersten Zeile von den Dichtewerten der nachfolgenden
Farbfelder subtrahiert.
IMPORTIEREN VON DENSITOMETERMESSWERTEN 106
Beispiel: 1D Status T-Dichte für EFI 21
Mit diesem Dateiformat werden die Status T-Dichtemesswerte für die EFI Messwerteseite
mit 21 Farbfeldern (EFI 21) beschrieben. Der Wert in der ersten Spalte ist die Nummer
des jeweiligen Farbfelds. Das erste Farbfeld muss die Nummer 1, das letzte Farbfeld die
Nummer 21 haben.
#!EFI 3
# EFI ColorWise 2.0 Data
type: 1DST21
# Cyan Magent Yellow Black
1 0.0300 0.0400 0.0200 0.0400
2 0.0600 0.0700 0.0800 0.0700
3 0.1000 0.1000 0.1000 0.1000
(…weitere Daten…)
20 1.6700 1.3400 0.8900 1.6700
21 1.7200 1.4300 0.9300 1.7500
Beispiel: 1D Status T-Dichte für EFI 34
Mit diesem Dateiformat werden die Status T-Dichtemesswerte für die EFI Messwerteseite
mit 34 Farbfeldern (EFI 34) beschrieben. Der Wert in der ersten Spalte ist die Nummer
des jeweiligen Farbfelds. Das erste Farbfeld muss die Nummer 1, das letzte Farbfeld die
Nummer 34 haben.
#!EFI 3
# EFI ColorWise 2.0 Data
type: 1DST34
# Cyan Magent Yellow Black
1 0.0300 0.0400 0.0200 0.0400
2 0.0600 0.0700 0.0800 0.0700
3 0.1000 0.1000 0.1000 0.1000
(…weitere Daten…)
33 1.6700 1.3400 0.8900 1.6700
34 1.7200 1.4300 0.9300 1.7500
IMPORTIEREN VON DENSITOMETERMESSWERTEN 107
Beispiel: 1D Status T-Dichte für andere Seite
Mit diesem Dateiformat werden die Status T-Dichtemesswerte für eine anwenderdefinierte
Farbfeldseite beschrieben. Der Wert in der ersten Spalte ist der prozentuale Tinte/Toner-
Anteil am jeweiligen Farbfeld. Der erste Prozentwert muss 0 (Null), der letzte Prozentwert
100 lauten. Die Prozentwerte dazwischen müssen ansteigen.
#!EFI 3
# EFI ColorWise 2.0 Data
type: 1DST
# percnt Cyan Magent Yellow Black
0.0000 0.0300 0.0400 0.0200 0.0400
0.3922 0.0600 0.0700 0.0800 0.0700
1.1765 0.1000 0.1000 0.1000 0.1000
(…weitere Daten…)
98.0000 1.6700 1.3400 0.8900 1.6700
100.0000 1.7200 1.4300 0.9300 1.7500
INDEX 109
A Absolute Farbmetrik, Farbwiedergabe 95
Apple Standard, Einstellung für RGBQuellprofil
96
Ausgabeprofil 93
Spot-On 31, 60, 61, 62, 71, 74, 76, 78
Ausgabeprofile 57
AutoGray 23
Autom. Überfüllung 86
B Bidirektionale Kommunikation 90, 93, 97
Bild, ICC-Farbwiedergabe 94
C
Calibration Files, Ordner 13, 17
Calibrator
Drucken der Vergleichsseite 37
Ermitteln von Messwerten 37
Profi-Modus 36
Verwenden 21, 35
Wiederherstellen der Standardwerte 38
CMYK Color Reference.ps 12, 17
CMYK-Simulationsprofil 90
CMYK-Simulationsverfahren 91
Color Bars, Ordner 12, 17
Color Editor 21
AutoGray 23
Color Rendering Dictionary (CRD) 9, 94
Color Setup 32
ColorWise
Druckoptionen 32
Schlüsselfunktionen 8
Workflow-Diagramm 85
ColorWise Pro Tools
Calibrator 21, 35
Kalibrierungsstatus 59
Composite-Ausgabe überdrucken 92
CRD 9, 94
Custom21.ps 13, 17
Custom34.ps 13, 17
D
Densitometer
DTP32 42
ED-100 47
Device Link-Profile
Aktivieren im Fenster „Profi-
Farbeinstellungen“ 103
Aktivieren mit Color Setup 33
Info über 27
Installieren 28
Zuordnen der Einstellungen 29
Dichte 57, 58
Importieren 105
DNS-Name 13, 18
Domain Name Server (DNS) 18
Drucken von Farben 88, 92, 98
Druckertreiber
Bidirektionale Kommunikation 90, 93, 97
Mac OS 101
Windows 99
Druckoptionen
Festlegen der Standardwerte 32
Mac OS 101
Windows 99
DTP32
Kalibrieren mit 42
DTP41
Kalibrieren mit 45
E
ED-100
Importieren von Messwerten 71, 72
Kalibrieren mit 47
EFIRGB, Einstellung für RGB-Quellprofil 96
Eigene Simulationen 90
ES-1000
Importieren von Messwerten 71, 72
Kalibrieren mit 51
INDEX
INDEX 110
F
Farbfelder, Seite 57
Farbmanagementsystem (CMS) 8
Farbprofile 10
Farbraum 85
Farbreferenzdateien für Windows 12
Farbreferenzseiten 58
Farbsubstitution 98
CMYK (0-100%) 80
Definieren 76
Farbe für Feld im Zentrum festlegen 77
Spot-On Hauptfenster 76
Spot-On Suchfunktion 78
Drucken 78
Farbsubstitution 81
Genauigkeit 80
Herunterladen von Ersatzfarbgruppen 83
Hinzufügen 74
Hinzufügen von Ersatzfarben 75, 79
Hochladen von Ersatzfarbgruppen 83
Neue Ersatzfarbgruppe 75
Prioritätsschema 82
RGB (0-100%) 80
RGB (Gerätecode 0-255) 80
Richtlinien 80
Toleranz 80
Toleranzbereich 80
Umbennenen von Ersatzfarben 79
Workflow 74
Farbtabelle 58
Farbwiedergabe 94
Farbwiedergabearten 9, 86
Fiery Dienstprogramme, Konfigurieren der
Verbindung 15, 20
Foto, Farbwiedergabeart 94
G
Gerätename 14, 20
Grafiken, ICC-Farbwiedergabe 94
I
ICC-Profile 10
Bearbeiten 21
Definition 9
Farbwiedergabearten 94
Herunterladen 27
Korrigieren der Graubalance 23
K
Kalibrieren
ColorCal 54 to 55
Kalibrierung
ColorCal 54 to 55
Display des Kopierers 54
DTP32 42
DTP41 45
ED-100 47
Ermitteln des Status 59
Ermitteln von Messwerten 37
ES-1000 51
Farbfelder 57
Importieren von Dichtemesswerten 105
Kurven 37, 57
Messwerte 56
Messwerteseite 57
Sollwerte 56, 57
Übersicht 56
Vergleichsseite 37
Wiederherstellen der Standardwerte 38
Zeitplanung 58
Kennwörter, für Kalibrierung 35, 56
Komplett (Ausgabe-GCR), Einstellung für
CMYK-Simulationsverfahren 91
Komplett (Quell-GCR), Einstellung für CMYKSimulationsverfahren
91
Konfigurationsseite 13, 18, 59
Kontrast, ICC-Farbwiedergabe 94
Kopiererdisplay
Kalibrierung mit 54
Korrigieren der Graubalance 23
L
Luminanz, Spot-On 69
M Mac OS Farbmanagementoptionen 101
Messwerteseite 57
Monitorkompensierung
Spot-On 70
N
Nein, Einstellung für RGB-Quellprofil 97
HDD TWAIN driver
HDD TWAIN driver i
Contents
1 Introduction
1.1 What Is an HDD TWAIN Driver? ........................................................1-1
1.2 How You Can Use an HDD TWAIN Driver........................................1-2
1.3 Operating Environment .....................................................................1-3
1.3.1 Software .........................................................................................1-3
1.3.2 System Requirements ....................................................................1-3
2 Installing the HDD TWAIN Driver
2.1 Installation ..........................................................................................2-1
2.2 Uninstallation......................................................................................2-3
2.2.1 Uninstalling the Driver from the Control Panel ...............................2-3
2.2.2 Uninstalling the Driver Using the CD-ROM ....................................2-4
3 Workflow
4 Loading
5 Changing the Settings
5.1 Black And White Inversion ................................................................5-1
5.2 Deleting a Loaded Document ...........................................................5-2
5.3 Adjusting the Image Quality..............................................................5-3
5.4 Changing the Color Mode .................................................................5-5
5.5 Changing the Image Resolution .......................................................5-6
6 Selecting the Device to Load From
6.1 Selecting a Network Device..............................................................6-1
6.2 Selecting from the List of Registered Devices................................6-3
6.3 Editing the List of Registered Devices.............................................6-5
6.3.1 Adding a Device .............................................................................6-6
6.3.2 Changing the Device Information ...................................................6-7
6.3.3 Copying the Device Information .....................................................6-8
6.3.4 Deleting the Device Information .....................................................6-9
HDD TWAIN driver ii
7 Loading with a Device Whose Authentication Settings
Have Been Configured
7.1 Devices with User Authentication ....................................................7-1
7.2 Devices with Account Track Authentication ...................................7-3
7.3 Devices That Use a Middle Authentication Server..........................7-4
8 Troubleshooting
HDD TWAIN driver iii
About This Product
This HDD TWAIN driver enables you to load the document data on an MFP
(multifunction printer) connected to a LAN into an image processing
application on a PC.
Trademarks and Registered Trademarks
Trademark Acknowledgements
Microsoft® and Windows® are either registered trademarks or trademarks of
Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.
RSA® BSAFETM
RSA is a registered trademark of RSA Security Inc. BSAFE is a registered
trademark of RSA Security Inc. in the United States and other countries.
Licensing Information
This product contains RSA® BSAFETM of RSA Security
Inc.
All other company and product names are either trademarks or registered
trademarks of their respective companies.
Dialog Boxes
The dialog boxes shown in this manual are those that appear in Windows 7.
!
Detail
The dialog boxes that appear in this document may differ from those that
appear on your PC, depending on the installed devices and specified
settings.
Note
Unauthorized reproduction, translation or duplication of this document,
whether in its entirety or in part, is strictly prohibited.
The contents of this document are subject to change without notice.
Copyright © 2005 KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC. All
rights reserved.
HDD TWAIN driver iv
LICENSE ISSUES
The OpenSSL toolkit stays under a dual license, i.e. both the conditions of
the OpenSSL License and the original SSLeay license apply to the toolkit.
See below for the actual license texts. Actually both licenses are BSD-style
Open Source licenses. In case of any license issues related to OpenSSL
please contact opensslcore@openssl.org.
OpenSSL License
Copyright © 1998-2001 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must
display the following acknowledgment:
"This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for
use in the OpenSSL Toolkit.
(http://www.openssl.org/)"
4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used
to endorse or promote products derived from this software without prior
written permission. For written permission, please contact
opensslcore@openssl.org.
5. Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL" nor
may "OpenSSL" appear in their names without prior written permission
of the OpenSSL Project.
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
acknowledgment:"This product includes software developed by the
OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit
(http://www.openssl.org/)"
HDD TWAIN driver v
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT "AS IS" AND
ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF
THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com). This product includes software written by Tim Hudson
(tjh@cryptsoft.com).
Original SSLeay License
Copyright © 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) All rights reserved.
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com).
The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL.
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the
following conditions are aheared to. The following conditions apply to all
code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code;
not just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with this distribution
is covered by the same copyright terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson
(tjh@cryptsoft.com).
Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright notices in the
code are not to be removed.
If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be given attribution
as the author of the parts of the library used.
This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in
documentation (online or textual) provided with the package.
HDD TWAIN driver vi
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list
of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must
display the following acknowledgement:
"This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young
(eay@cryptsoft.com)" The word 'cryptographic' can be left out if the
routines from the library being used are not cryptographic related.
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from
the apps directory (application code) you must include an
acknowledgement:"This product includes software written by Tim
Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com)"
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG "AS IS" AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or
derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be
copied and put under another distribution licence [including the GNU Public
Licence.]
Introduction 1
HDD TWAIN driver 1-1
1 Introduction
1.1 What Is an HDD TWAIN Driver?
An HDD TWAIN driver loads document data that is stored on an MFP
(multifunction printer) connected to a LAN.
You can operate an HDD TWAIN driver from an image processing application
on your PC.
You can edit loaded documents using the image processing application.
You can also adjust images using the HDD TWAIN driver.
Introduction 1
HDD TWAIN driver 1-2
1.2 How You Can Use an HDD TWAIN Driver
You can use an HDD TWAIN driver to do the following.
Store documents in the MFP (multifunction
printer) and load them later into a PC. Load the contents of received
faxes into a PC and send the
contents by email.
Load the data of unsatisfactory copies into
a PC, edit the data, and print it.
Introduction 1
HDD TWAIN driver 1-3
1.3 Operating Environment
1.3.1 Software
To use this software, you must install the following software on your PC
beforehand.
- TWAIN compatible image processing application
1.3.2 System Requirements
Refer to the Readme file for the latest information about service packs and
so on.
Operating system Windows XP Home Edition (SP3 or later)
Windows XP Professional (SP3 or later)
Windows XP Professional x64 Edition (SP2 or later)
Windows Vista Home Basic (SP2 or later)*
Windows Vista Home Premium (SP2 or later)*
Windows Vista Business (SP2 or later)*
Windows Vista Enterprise (SP2 or later)*
Windows Vista Ultimate (SP2 or later)*
Windows 7 Home Basic (SP1 or later)*
Windows 7 Home Premium (SP1 or later)*
Windows 7 Professional (SP1 or later)*
Windows 7 Enterprise (SP1 or later)*
Windows 7 Ultimate (SP1 or later)*
*Compatible with 32-bit (x86) and 64-bit (x64) environments
PC Depends on the specifications of the OS
Memory Depends on the specifications of the OS
Network A PC whose TCP/IP protocol settings have been configured correctly
Hard disk 20 MB or more of free disk space is necessary
Installing the HDD TWAIN Driver 2
HDD TWAIN driver 2-1
2 Installing the HDD TWAIN Driver
This chapter explains how to install and uninstall the HDD TWAIN driver.
The examples in this section will use Windows 7 as the OS.
2.1 Installation
To install the HDD TWAIN driver, follow the procedure below.
Procedure
1 Insert the User Software CD-ROM into your PC's CD-ROM drive.
The CD's menu will appear.
2 Under "Install Scanner", select "HDD TWAIN driver".
The "User Account Control" window will appear.
3 Click [Yes].
4 Afterward, follow the directions that appear on the window.
The installation will start, and the necessary files will be copied.
After all the files have been copied, the installation completed window
opens.
5 Click [Finish].
The HDD TWAIN driver installation window will close.
2
Note
To use the HDD TWAIN driver with the 32-bit version of Photoshop CS5,
you need to download the TWAIN plugin from the Adobe website and
install it.
The TWAIN driver is not compatible with the 64-bit version of Photoshop
CS5.
Installing the HDD TWAIN Driver 2
HDD TWAIN driver 2-2
!
Detail
Separate MSI-based installers have been prepared for this software.
When an MSI-based installer is used, the software can be automatically
distributed, and can be installed automatically in the Active Directory
environment.
For details, contact your service representative.
Installing the HDD TWAIN Driver 2
HDD TWAIN driver 2-3
2.2 Uninstallation
You can use one of the following two methods to uninstall the HDD TWAIN
driver.
2.2.1 Uninstalling the Driver from the Control Panel
Follow the procedure below to uninstall the HDD TWAIN driver from the
control panel.
Procedure
1 On the taskbar, click Start, "Control Panel", "Programs", and then
"Programs and Features".
– In Windows XP, click "Control Panel" and then "Add or Remove
Programs".
2 Select the application that you want to uninstall from the list, and then
click [Uninstall].
– In Windows XP, select the application that you want to uninstall
from the list, and then click [Change/Remove].
A confirmation window opens.
3 Click [Yes].
4 Afterward, follow the directions that appear on the window.
– In the "Program Maintenance" window, click [Remove].
The uninstallation of the TWAIN driver will start. When the uninstallation
is finished, the InstallShield Wizard Completed window will appear.
5 Click [Finish].
The HDD TWAIN driver uninstallation window will close.
Installing the HDD TWAIN Driver 2
HDD TWAIN driver 2-4
2.2.2 Uninstalling the Driver Using the CD-ROM
Follow the procedure below to uninstall the HDD TWAIN driver using the CDROM.
Procedure
1 Insert the User Software CD-ROM into your PC's CD-ROM drive.
The CD's menu will appear.
2 Under "Install Scanner", select "HDD TWAIN driver".
The "User Account Control" window will appear.
3 Click [Yes].
4 Afterward, follow the directions that appear on the window.
– In the "Program Maintenance" window, click [Remove].
The uninstallation of the TWAIN driver will start. When the uninstallation
is finished, the InstallShield Wizard Completed window will appear.
5 Click [Finish].
The HDD TWAIN driver uninstallation window will close.
Workflow 3
HDD TWAIN driver 3-1
3 Workflow
The following flowchart illustrates the operations that you can perform.
Start the image processing application.
Select the HDD TWAIN driver.
Select the MFP (multifunction printer) that you want to connect to.
Select a box.
Changing the Settings
Select a document.
Click [Acquire].
(p. 5-1)
Loading 4
HDD TWAIN driver 4-1
4 Loading
This chapter explains how to load a document.
2
Note
You cannot load documents that have been saved to a box in copy mode
or print mode or documents that are in a system box.
2
Note
You cannot load documents when operations on documents
accumulated in boxes have been disabled on the MFP (multifunction
printer) side.
Procedure
1 Start the image processing application.
2 In the image processing application, select the HDD TWAIN driver.
– Some applications will display a "Select Devices" command.
If this is the case, before you load a document, use Select Devices
to select the HDD TWAIN driver that you want to use.
The "Select Devices" window appears.
Loading 4
HDD TWAIN driver 4-2
3 Select the device you want to connect to, and then click [Connect].
– You can also select the device that you want to connect to from the
list of registered devices. For details, see "Selecting from the List of
Registered Devices" on page 6-3.
– For details about the "Select Devices" dialog box, see "Selecting
the Device to Load From" on page 6-1.
– When user authentication and account track authentication are
configured on the MFP (multifunction printer) side, various
authentication windows appear. For details, see "Loading with a
Device Whose Authentication Settings Have Been Configured" on
page 7-1.
– When the MFP (multifunction printer) is configured to disable
operations by the logged in user on documents accumulated in
boxes, the user will be unable to load documents.
– If you select the [Use this device for future session] check box, the
selected device will be used again the next time you connect. The
next time you select the HDD TWAIN driver, the "Select Devices"
dialog box will not open, and the Select Box dialog box will open
instead.
The Select Box dialog box opens.
Loading 4
HDD TWAIN driver 4-3
4 Select a box.
– Click [Select from Box List], and then select a box. After you select
a box, click [OK].
If you know the box number, enter it in the [Box No.] box.
Loading 4
HDD TWAIN driver 4-4
5 If a password is set on the box, enter the password in the [Box
Password] box.
6 Click [OK].
The main window opens.
7 Click the document you want to load.
Loading 4
HDD TWAIN driver 4-5
– If you select [Thumbnail] from the "Views" list, the thumbnail of the
first page of the document will be displayed. You may not be able
to select [Thumbnail] depending on the device.
– To delete the selected document, click [Delete].
– To refresh the list, click [Refresh].
– When you want to adjust an image or delete a loaded document,
click [Settings]. For details, see "Changing the Settings" on
page 5-1.
– When you want to change the box, click [Select].
– When you want to change the device to load from, click [Select].
For details, see "Selecting the Device to Load From" on page 6-1.
Click [Acquire].
The document will be loaded, and an image of it will appear in the
image processing application.
Changing the Settings 5
HDD TWAIN driver 5-1
5 Changing the Settings
In the "Settings" dialog box, you can adjust images and delete loaded
documents.
Click [OK] after you are finished.
5.1 Black And White Inversion
You can invert the black and white parts of a document when you load it.
In the "Settings" dialog box, select the "Scan" tab, and then select the
[Negative Image] check box.
2
Reminder
You can select this check box for black and white monochrome data.
Changing the Settings 5
HDD TWAIN driver 5-2
5.2 Deleting a Loaded Document
This section will explain how to delete a loaded document.
In the "Settings" dialog box, select the "Scan" tab, and then select the
[Delete after scanning] check box.
Changing the Settings 5
HDD TWAIN driver 5-3
5.3 Adjusting the Image Quality
This section will explain how to adjust the image quality of a loaded
document.
You can set the image quality in the "Image Enhancement" tab of the
"Settings" dialog box.
Item Description
Full Enhancement Select this check box to adjust the contrast, undercolor removal,
background removal, and halftone removal all at
once. You can select Off, Low, Standard, or High.
2
Reminder
This setting is invalid for grayscale data and
black and white monochrome data.
Adjust Contrast Adjust the contrast. You can select Off, Low, Standard, or
High.
2
Reminder
This setting is invalid for black and white monochrome
data.
Changing the Settings 5
HDD TWAIN driver 5-4
Remove Undercolor Removes unnecessary undercolors, such as a light background
color or the discoloration of an original document
due to aging or exposure to sunlight. You can select Off,
Low, Standard, or High.
2
Reminder
This setting is invalid for grayscale data and
black and white monochrome data.
Remove Background When there are characters and figures in the background,
you can use this setting to remove them without affecting
the characters and figures in the foreground. You can select
Off, Low, Standard, or High.
2
Reminder
This setting is invalid for grayscale data and
black and white monochrome data.
Remove Halftone Reduces the formation of moiré patterns (striped patterns
that appear on scanned printed materials). You can select
Off, Low, Standard, or High.
2
Reminder
This setting is invalid for black and white monochrome
data.
Deskew Automatically corrects the scan of a skewed original document.
2
Note
This feature may not work properly with small
image sizes.
Item Description
Changing the Settings 5
HDD TWAIN driver 5-5
5.4 Changing the Color Mode
This section will explain how to change a document's color mode.
In the "Settings" dialog box, you can select the color mode from the "Color"
list in the "Image Adjustment" tab.
You can select Off, Full Color, Gray Scale, or Black.
2
Reminder
This setting is not valid for some devices.
2
Reminder
You cannot change grayscale to full color or change black and white
monochrome to grayscale or full color.
Changing the Settings 5
HDD TWAIN driver 5-6
5.5 Changing the Image Resolution
This section will explain how to change the image resolution of the
document.
In the "Settings" dialog box, you can select the resolution from the
"Resolution" list in the "Image Adjustment" tab.
You can select Off, 200 e 100 dpi, 200 e 200 dpi, 300 e 300 dpi, 400 e 400
dpi, or 600 e 600 dpi.
2
Reminder
This setting is not valid for some devices.
Selecting the Device to Load From 6
HDD TWAIN driver 6-1
6 Selecting the Device to Load From
Select a device on the network that you can load from. Select the device in
the [Select Devices] dialog box that appears when you first open the HDD
TWAIN driver and when you click [Select] in the main window.
6.1 Selecting a Network Device
Select one of the devices that have been automatically detected on the
network.
Procedure
1 Open the HDD TWAIN driver, or in the main window, click [Select].
– The Select Device window opens.
– A list appears that shows the devices that have been automatically
detected on the network.
– If you want to search for devices again, click [from Search Result].
2 Select the device you want to connect to, and then click [Connect].
– To add a device to the list of registered devices when you connect
to it, select the [Add this to the registered device list] check box. For
more information about the list of registered devices, see "Editing
the List of Registered Devices" on page 6-5.
– If you're loading from a device whose authentication settings have
been configured, enter the necessary information in the various
windows that appear. For details, see "Loading with a Device
Whose Authentication Settings Have Been Configured" on
page 7-1.
Selecting the Device to Load From 6
HDD TWAIN driver 6-2
– If you select the [Use this device for future session] check box, the
"Select Devices" dialog box will not appear the next time you select
the HDD TWAIN driver, and the main window will be displayed
instead.
The main window opens.
Selecting the Device to Load From 6
HDD TWAIN driver 6-3
6.2 Selecting from the List of Registered Devices
This section explains how to select a device from the list of registered
devices.
Procedure
1 Open the HDD TWAIN driver, or in the main window, click [Select].
The Select Device window opens.
2 Click [from Registered Devices].
Selecting the Device to Load From 6
HDD TWAIN driver 6-4
3 Select the device you want to connect to, and then click [Connect].
– If you're loading from a device whose authentication settings have
been configured, enter the necessary information in the various
windows that appear. For details, see "Loading with a Device
Whose Authentication Settings Have Been Configured" on
page 7-1.
– For information about how to add, edit, copy, and delete the
devices in the list of registered devices see "Editing the List of
Registered Devices" on page 6-5.
– If you select the [Use this device for future session] check box, the
"Select Devices" dialog box will not appear the next time you select
the HDD TWAIN driver, and the main window will be displayed
instead.
The main window opens.
Selecting the Device to Load From 6
HDD TWAIN driver 6-5
6.3 Editing the List of Registered Devices
This section explains how to add, edit, copy, and delete the devices in the
list of registered devices.
The list of registered devices appears in the "Select Devices" window when
you click [from Registered Devices].
Selecting the Device to Load From 6
HDD TWAIN driver 6-6
6.3.1 Adding a Device
This section explains how to add a device to the list of registered devices.
Procedure
1 Click [Add].
The "Destination Settings" window appears.
2 Enter the device information, and then click [OK].
– Name: Enter the device's name.
– IP Address (Host Name): Enter the device's IP address or host
name.
– Box No.: Enter the box number that you want to load from.
– Box Password: If a password has been set for the box, select the
"Save Box Password " check box, and enter the password.
Selecting the Device to Load From 6
HDD TWAIN driver 6-7
6.3.2 Changing the Device Information
This section explains how to change the information about a device that is
registered in the list of registered devices.
Procedure
1 From the list, select the item that you want to change, and click [Edit].
The "Destination Settings" window appears.
2 Enter the device information.
– Name: Enter the device's name.
– IP Address (Host Name): Enter the device's IP address or host
name.
– Box No.: Enter the box number that you want to load from.
– Box Password: If a password has been set for the box, select the
"Save Box Password " check box, and enter the password.
Selecting the Device to Load From 6
HDD TWAIN driver 6-8
– Login Information: This button is available when authentication
information was saved the last time the device was connected to.
Click this button to display authentication information. To clear the
login information, click [Clear Login Information]. Click [OK] to
display the "Destination Settings" dialog box.
6.3.3 Copying the Device Information
This section explains how to copy the information about a device that is
registered in the list of registered devices.
Procedure
1 In the list of registered devices, select the information of the device you
want to copy, and click [Copy].
2 The device's information is copied to the list of registered devices.
Selecting the Device to Load From 6
HDD TWAIN driver 6-9
6.3.4 Deleting the Device Information
This section explains how to delete the information about a device that is
registered in the list of registered devices.
Procedure
1 In the list of registered devices, select the information of the device you
want to delete, and click [Delete].
A confirmation message appears.
2 Click [Yes].
The information about the device that you selected is deleted.
Loading with a Device Whose Authentication Settings Have Been Configured 7
HDD TWAIN driver 7-1
7 Loading with a Device Whose
Authentication Settings Have Been
Configured
7.1 Devices with User Authentication
When you connect to a device with user authentication, the "User
Authentication" window appears before the main window.
Enter the predetermined user name and password.
For details, consult your system administrator.
Procedure
1 Click [Login as Public User] or [Login as the Registered User].
– If the device's user authentication settings have been configured to
allow public users, click [Login as Public User]. Otherwise, click
[Login as the Registered User].
Loading with a Device Whose Authentication Settings Have Been Configured 7
HDD TWAIN driver 7-2
2 Enter the user name and password, and then click [OK].
– If you click [Login as Public User], you do not need to enter a user
name or password.
– If you select the [Save these settings] check box, the user name and
password will already be entered the next time you select the same
device.
– If external server authentication has been selected in the MFP's
(multifunction printer's) user authentication settings and multiple
domains have been registered, after the user name, enter "@"
followed by the domain name. For example, if the user name is
"user@1" and the domain name is "domain" enter
"user@1@domain".
Loading with a Device Whose Authentication Settings Have Been Configured 7
HDD TWAIN driver 7-3
7.2 Devices with Account Track Authentication
When you connect to a device with account track authentication, the
"Account Track Authentication" window appears before the main window.
Enter the predetermined account name and password.
For details, consult your system administrator.
Procedure
% Enter the account name and password, and then click [OK].
– If you select the [Save these settings] check box, the account name
and password will already be entered the next time you select the
same device.
Loading with a Device Whose Authentication Settings Have Been Configured 7
HDD TWAIN driver 7-4
7.3 Devices That Use a Middle Authentication Server
When you connect to a device that uses a middle authentication server, the
"Custom Login" window appears before the main window.
Enter the predetermined user name and password.
For details, consult your system administrator.
% The dialog box shown is an example. The actual dialog box for middle
authentication may vary depending on the authentication application.
Troubleshooting 8
HDD TWAIN driver 8-1
8 Troubleshooting
This section explains the error messages, their causes, and how to respond
to them.
Error Message Cause Corrective Action
Can not connect to server (IP addres).
The specified IP address
is wrong.
Check the IP address of the device
that you're trying to connect
to.
Destination device is not supported.
The device at the IP
address that you
specified does not
support this HDD
TWAIN driver.
Specify a destination device that
is compatible with this HDD
TWAIN driver.
Other users have access to the
specified User Box.
The box that you
specified is being
used by another user.
Please wait a moment, and then
try connecting again.
Access to specified User Box is
denied.
A password has been
set for the box you
specified, or the password
that you specified
is incorrect.
Make sure that the password is
correct.
The specified User Box does not
exist.
The box number that
you specified is incorrect.
Enter the correct box number.
HDD not installed. User Box is not
available.
Because the device
that you're connecting
to does not have a
hard drive, you cannot
use boxes.
Contact a service technician to install
a hard drive.
User Box is not accessible. Try
again in a few minutes, or check
with your administrator.
The box is locked. Try connecting again after a few
minutes, or contact the administrator.
User Authentication failed. Make
sure your USER NAME is correct,
then enter your password again.
The user name or
password is incorrect.
Make sure that the user name and
password are correct.
Your authentication account is
locked. Try again in a few minutes,
or check with your administrator.
Your authentication
account is locked.
Try connecting again after a few
minutes, or contact your administrator.
Login is failed because of external
authentication server error.
The external authentication
server cannot
be connected to.
Check to make sure that the external
authentication server is operating
normally.
The server could not accept an
authentication request. Please
wait a moment, and then login
again.
The server could not
accept an authentication
request.
Try connecting again after a few
minutes.
Troubleshooting 8
HDD TWAIN driver 8-2
Account Track Authentication
failed. Make sure your Account
Name is correct, then enter your
password again (if required).
Account track authentication
failed.
Make sure that the account name
and password are correct.
No response from scanner device. The PC was unable to
communicate with the
device.
Check the network and device
conditions.
Unable to delete the specified
document.
The specified document
could not be deleted.
Check whether the document has
already been deleted on the device
side.
Access to the document is denied.
You have been denied
access to the specified
document.
Enter the correct password for the
box number.
The specified document does not
exist.
The document that
you specified does
not exist.
Check whether the document has
already been deleted on the device
side.
Can not retrieve User Box information
from the device.
The box that you
specified does not exist.
Check whether the box has already
been deleted on the device
side.
Can not retrieve thumbnail images.
Thumbnail images
cannot be displayed.
Check whether the document has
already been deleted on the device
side.
Please check the page range. The page that you
specified does not exist.
Please check the page range.
Device Memory Error occurred. An error occurred in
the device's memory.
Check with the administrator of
the device.
Can not scan due to device error
that has occurred.
A device error has occurred.
Check the device conditions.
Can not start scanning because
you have reached the maximum
number of registered jobs.
The number of registered
jobs has
reached the maximum
value.
Please wait a moment, and then
try connecting again.
Device busy. Can not begin scan. The device is currently
being used or is in a
state in which it cannot
be used.
Please wait a moment, and then
try connecting again.
If the same message still appears
after you wait awhile, check with
the administrator of the device.
Scanning has been cancelled. The scan has been
canceled by the device.
Check the device conditions.
A scanning error has occurred. A scanning error has
occurred.
Check the device conditions.
An error occurred during communication
with the device.
An error occurred during
communication
with the device.
Check the network and device
conditions.
Error Message Cause Corrective Action
2011. 7
Copyright
All rights reserved.
Opérations Boîte
www.develop.eu
ineo 223/283/363/423 Table des matières-1
Table des matières
1 Introduction
1.1 Bienvenue ........................................................................................................................................ 1-3
1.1.1 Guides de l'utilisateur ........................................................................................................................ 1-3
1.1.2 Guide de l'utilisateur .......................................................................................................................... 1-4
1.2 Conventions utilisées dans ce manuel ......................................................................................... 1-5
1.2.1 Symboles utilisés dans ce manuel..................................................................................................... 1-5
Pour utiliser cette machine en toute sécurité .................................................................................... 1-5
Instruction de procédure.................................................................................................................... 1-5
Symboles clés.................................................................................................................................... 1-6
1.2.2 Indications concernant l'original et le papier ..................................................................................... 1-6
Formats original et papier .................................................................................................................. 1-6
Indications concernant l'original et le papier ..................................................................................... 1-6
1.3 Vérifier la fonction à utiliser ........................................................................................................... 1-7
Comprendre le Flux d'opérations ...................................................................................................... 1-7
Utilisation de la structure des menus................................................................................................. 1-7
2 Présentation de la fonction boîte
2.1 Fonctions Boîte ............................................................................................................................... 2-3
2.1.1 Fonctions de boîte disponibles.......................................................................................................... 2-4
Enregistrer des documents................................................................................................................ 2-4
Utilisation des documents ................................................................................................................. 2-5
Organisation des documents............................................................................................................. 2-7
2.1.2 Configurer les paramètres d'utilisation des fonctions Boîte .............................................................. 2-8
Enregistrement d'une boîte................................................................................................................ 2-8
Si cette machine est utilisée comme appareil relais .......................................................................... 2-8
Boîte de stockage des données pour réception Mémoire obligatoire............................................... 2-8
2.2 Information ...................................................................................................................................... 2-9
2.2.1 Authentification Utilisateur ................................................................................................................. 2-9
Authentification MFP.......................................................................................................................... 2-9
Authentification par un serveur externe ............................................................................................. 2-9
Authentification Compte Département ............................................................................................ 2-10
2.2.2 Restrictions applicables à l'enregistrement des boîtes ................................................................... 2-10
Boîtes Public, Privé ou Groupe........................................................................................................ 2-10
Boîte Bulletin.................................................................................................................................... 2-10
Boîte Émission en relève.................................................................................................................. 2-10
Boîte Réception mémoire ................................................................................................................ 2-11
Boîte Relais ...................................................................................................................................... 2-11
Boîte Document sécurisé................................................................................................................. 2-11
2.2.3 Restrictions concernant le nom de fichier ....................................................................................... 2-11
2.3 Authentification et boîtes utilisateur accessibles...................................................................... 2-12
2.3.1 Lorsque Authentification utilisateur ou Compte Département est désactivé .................................. 2-12
2.3.2 Lorsque seule l'Authentification utilisateur est activée .................................................................... 2-12
2.3.3 Lorsque seul Compte Département est activé ................................................................................ 2-13
2.3.4 Lorsque Authentification utilisateur et Compte Département sont activés et synchronisés ........... 2-13
2.3.5 Lorsque Authentification utilisateur et Compte Département sont activés mais pas synchronisés 2-14
Table des matières-2 ineo 223/283/363/423
3 Panneau de contrôle/Ecran à cristaux liquides
3.1 Panneau de contrôle....................................................................................................................... 3-3
3.2 Écran tactile..................................................................................................................................... 3-6
3.2.1 Éléments de l'écran ........................................................................................................................... 3-6
Icônes qui apparaissent sur le l'écran tactile..................................................................................... 3-6
3.2.2 Affichage et utilisation du volet de gauche........................................................................................ 3-7
Liste Tâches....................................................................................................................................... 3-8
Liste Tâches - Supprimer................................................................................................................... 3-8
Liste Tâches - Détails Tâche.............................................................................................................. 3-9
Infos Boîte ........................................................................................................................................ 3-16
Utilis/Archiv - Détail ......................................................................................................................... 3-16
Utilis/Archiv - Vérif.Régl. Tâche ....................................................................................................... 3-16
Utilis/Archiv - Vérif.Régl. Tâche - Vérifier Adresse........................................................................... 3-17
Utilis/Archiv - Vérif.Régl. Tâche - Réglages Document ................................................................... 3-17
Utilis/Archiv - Vérif.Régl. Tâche - Réglage communication ............................................................. 3-18
Utilis/Archiv - Vérif.Régl. Tâche - Réglages E-mail.......................................................................... 3-18
Aperçu.............................................................................................................................................. 3-18
Aperçu avant impression ................................................................................................................. 3-19
Aperçu (Impression/Combinaison)................................................................................................... 3-19
Aperçu - (Env./Lier EMI) ................................................................................................................... 3-20
4 Flux d'opérations Boîte
4.1 Enregistrer des documents dans des boîtes................................................................................ 4-3
4.2 Impression de documents depuis une boîte ................................................................................ 4-5
4.3 Envoi de documents depuis une boîte.......................................................................................... 4-8
4.4 Enregistrer un document dans une mémoire externe............................................................... 4-11
4.5 Enregistrer un document de la mémoire externe vers une Boîte............................................. 4-13
4.6 Impression d'un document depuis une mémoire externe ........................................................ 4-15
4.7 Archiver des documents dans une boîte .................................................................................... 4-17
4.8 Impression d'un document enregistré dans un téléphone cellulaire ou un
agenda électronique..................................................................................................................... 4-19
4.9 Enregistrement dans une Boîte utilisateur d'un document archivé dans un
téléphone cellulaire ou un agenda électronique........................................................................ 4-21
4.10 Structure des menus du mode Boîte .......................................................................................... 4-23
4.10.1 Enregistrer document ...................................................................................................................... 4-23
Boîte Public, Privé ou Groupe.......................................................................................................... 4-23
Système ........................................................................................................................................... 4-24
4.10.2 Utilis/Archiv ...................................................................................................................................... 4-26
Impression (pour les boîtes Public, Privé ou Groupe)...................................................................... 4-26
Envoyer (pour les boîtes Public, Privé ou Groupe) .......................................................................... 4-29
Réglages Archivage (pour les boîtes Public, Privé ou Groupe) ....................................................... 4-33
Application (pour les boîtes Public, Privé ou Groupe) ..................................................................... 4-34
Système ........................................................................................................................................... 4-35
5 Pour accéder au mode Boîte
5.1 Pour accéder au mode Boîte ......................................................................................................... 5-3
5.2 Menu Opération Boîte..................................................................................................................... 5-4
5.2.1 Enregistrer document ........................................................................................................................ 5-4
5.2.2 Utilis/Archiv ........................................................................................................................................ 5-4
6 Enregistrer document
6.1 Enreg. doc. - Présentation ............................................................................................................. 6-3
6.1.1 Fonctions ........................................................................................................................................... 6-3
Boîtes Public, Privé ou Groupe.......................................................................................................... 6-3
Boîte Annotation ................................................................................................................................ 6-3
Mémoire externe ................................................................................................................................ 6-3
6.1.2 Fenêtre initiale de la fonction Enregistrer document ......................................................................... 6-4
ineo 223/283/363/423 Table des matières-3
Boîtes Public, Privé ou Groupe.......................................................................................................... 6-4
Système ............................................................................................................................................. 6-4
6.1.3 Fenêtre Enregistrer document ........................................................................................................... 6-5
6.2 Param. Numéris............................................................................................................................... 6-6
6.2.1 De base - Type original ...................................................................................................................... 6-6
6.2.2 De base - Recto/Recto-Verso............................................................................................................ 6-7
6.2.3 De base - Définition ........................................................................................................................... 6-7
6.2.4 De base - Type Fichier....................................................................................................................... 6-8
Type de fichier ................................................................................................................................... 6-8
Cryptage ............................................................................................................................................ 6-9
Cryptage - Paramètres Détaillés........................................................................................................ 6-9
PDF Contours .................................................................................................................................. 6-11
Réglage Numérisation...................................................................................................................... 6-11
6.2.5 De base - Densité ............................................................................................................................ 6-12
6.2.6 De base - Couleur ............................................................................................................................ 6-12
6.2.7 Format Numérisation ....................................................................................................................... 6-13
Format standard .............................................................................................................................. 6-13
Formats perso.................................................................................................................................. 6-13
Format Photo ................................................................................................................................... 6-13
6.2.8 Réglage image ................................................................................................................................. 6-14
Suppression Fond............................................................................................................................ 6-14
Netteté ............................................................................................................................................. 6-15
6.2.9 Applications - Effacement cadre...................................................................................................... 6-15
6.2.10 Applications - Copie Livre................................................................................................................ 6-16
Méthode Copie Livre........................................................................................................................ 6-16
Effacem. livre - Effacement Bords ................................................................................................... 6-16
Effacem. Livre - Effacem. Centre..................................................................................................... 6-17
Position Reliure ................................................................................................................................ 6-17
6.2.11 Numér. Séparée ............................................................................................................................... 6-18
6.3 Réglages Original.......................................................................................................................... 6-19
6.3.1 Original spécial................................................................................................................................. 6-19
6.3.2 Spécifier direction - Orientation Original.......................................................................................... 6-19
6.3.3 Spécifier direction - Position Reliure................................................................................................ 6-20
6.3.4 Dépoussiérer.................................................................................................................................... 6-20
7 Utilis/Archiv
7.1 Présentation des opérations Utilis/Archiv.................................................................................... 7-3
7.1.1 Fonctions Utilis/Archiv ....................................................................................................................... 7-3
Imprimer un document....................................................................................................................... 7-3
Envoi .................................................................................................................................................. 7-3
Archivage ........................................................................................................................................... 7-3
Réglages Application ......................................................................................................................... 7-3
7.1.2 Détail de l'écran Utiliser document.................................................................................................... 7-4
7.1.3 Si un code d'accès est spécifié pour une boîte................................................................................. 7-5
7.2 Impression ....................................................................................................................................... 7-6
7.2.1 Présentation de l'onglet Impression .................................................................................................. 7-6
Description de l'onglet Impression .................................................................................................... 7-6
Imprimer............................................................................................................................................. 7-7
Combinaison...................................................................................................................................... 7-7
7.2.2 Imprimer............................................................................................................................................. 7-8
7.2.3 Combinaison...................................................................................................................................... 7-8
Ordre Document ................................................................................................................................ 7-8
Éléments configurables pour combiner et imprimer des documents................................................ 7-9
7.3 Impression - De base (Boîte Public, Privé ou Groupe) .............................................................. 7-10
7.3.1 Copies.............................................................................................................................................. 7-10
7.3.2 Recto/Recto-Verso .......................................................................................................................... 7-10
7.3.3 Finition.............................................................................................................................................. 7-11
Tri/Groupe........................................................................................................................................ 7-11
Table des matières-4 ineo 223/283/363/423
Décalé .............................................................................................................................................. 7-11
Agraf................................................................................................................................................. 7-11
Agraf. - Réglage Position ................................................................................................................. 7-12
Perfo................................................................................................................................................. 7-12
Réglage Position - Perforation......................................................................................................... 7-12
Pli/Reliure ......................................................................................................................................... 7-13
7.3.4 Combinaison.................................................................................................................................... 7-14
7.3.5 Zoom................................................................................................................................................ 7-14
7.3.6 Impression continue......................................................................................................................... 7-15
7.4 Impression - Application (Boîte Public, Privé ou Groupe)......................................................... 7-16
7.4.1 Marge page...................................................................................................................................... 7-16
Marge de page................................................................................................................................. 7-16
Décalage Image ............................................................................................................................... 7-16
Décalage Image - Changer Décalage verso .................................................................................... 7-17
7.4.2 Insér. Feuil/Couv/Chapitre ............................................................................................................... 7-17
7.4.3 Insér. Feuil/Couv/Chapitre - Couverture.......................................................................................... 7-18
7.4.4 Insér. Feuil/Couv/Chapitre - Insertion Feuille................................................................................... 7-19
7.4.5 Insér. Feuil/Couv/Chapitre - Chapitres ............................................................................................ 7-20
7.4.6 Tampon/Surimpression.................................................................................................................... 7-21
7.4.7 Tampon/Surimpression - Date/Heure.............................................................................................. 7-21
7.4.8 Tampon/Surimpression - Numéro Page .......................................................................................... 7-22
Réglages .......................................................................................................................................... 7-22
Param. Insert. Feuille ....................................................................................................................... 7-23
7.4.9 Tampon/Surimpression - Tampon................................................................................................... 7-23
7.4.10 Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Protection Copie............................................................. 7-24
Type Protection Copie ..................................................................................................................... 7-25
Paramètres Détaillés ........................................................................................................................ 7-25
Position ............................................................................................................................................ 7-25
7.4.11 Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Pare-copie ...................................................................... 7-26
Type Pare-copie............................................................................................................................... 7-26
Paramètres Détaillés ........................................................................................................................ 7-27
7.4.12 Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Copie Prot. MdP............................................................. 7-27
Type Tampon................................................................................................................................... 7-28
Paramètres Détaillés ........................................................................................................................ 7-28
7.4.13 Tampon/Surimpression - Tampon répétitif...................................................................................... 7-28
Type Tampon répétitif...................................................................................................................... 7-29
Paramètres Détaillés ........................................................................................................................ 7-29
Position ............................................................................................................................................ 7-29
7.4.14 Tampon/Surimpression - En-tête/Pied de page.............................................................................. 7-30
Contrôle/Modif. temp....................................................................................................................... 7-30
7.4.15 Tampon/Surimpression - Surimpression enregistrée ...................................................................... 7-32
Réglages .......................................................................................................................................... 7-32
Réglage Surimpression.................................................................................................................... 7-33
7.5 Envoyer .......................................................................................................................................... 7-34
7.5.1 Présentation des réglages Transmission......................................................................................... 7-34
Description de l'onglet Env. ............................................................................................................. 7-34
Envoyer ............................................................................................................................................ 7-35
Lier EMI ............................................................................................................................................ 7-35
7.5.2 Réglages Transmission.................................................................................................................... 7-36
7.5.3 Combinaison.................................................................................................................................... 7-37
Ordre Document .............................................................................................................................. 7-37
7.6 Envoyer (Boîte Public, Privé ou Groupe)..................................................................................... 7-38
7.6.1 Carnet Adresses - Recherche simple .............................................................................................. 7-38
Type d'adresse ................................................................................................................................ 7-38
Index ................................................................................................................................................ 7-39
Recherche détaillée ......................................................................................................................... 7-39
Recherche détaillée - Options recherche ........................................................................................ 7-40
7.6.2 Saisie dir. ......................................................................................................................................... 7-40
7.6.3 Saisie directe - Fax .......................................................................................................................... 7-41
Prochaine Destination...................................................................................................................... 7-41
ineo 223/283/363/423 Table des matières-5
Quand la fonction Confirm. Adresse (Émiss) est spécifiée : ............................................................ 7-41
7.6.4 Saisie dir. - E-mail ............................................................................................................................ 7-41
Prochaine Destination...................................................................................................................... 7-41
7.6.5 Saisie directe - FAX Internet ............................................................................................................ 7-42
Prochaine Destination...................................................................................................................... 7-42
Capacité Réception Récepteur........................................................................................................ 7-42
7.6.6 Saisie directe - Fax Adresse IP........................................................................................................ 7-42
7.6.7 Saisie Directe - PC (SMB) ................................................................................................................ 7-43
Nom Serveur .................................................................................................................................... 7-43
Chemin Fichier ................................................................................................................................. 7-43
Nom utilisat. ..................................................................................................................................... 7-43
Code d'accès................................................................................................................................... 7-43
Référence......................................................................................................................................... 7-43
Prochaine Dest................................................................................................................................. 7-43
7.6.8 Saisie directe - FTP.......................................................................................................................... 7-44
Nom Serveur .................................................................................................................................... 7-44
Chemin Fichier ................................................................................................................................. 7-44
Nom utilisat. ..................................................................................................................................... 7-44
Code d'accès................................................................................................................................... 7-44
Réglages détaillés ............................................................................................................................ 7-44
Prochaine Dest................................................................................................................................. 7-44
7.6.9 Saisie directe - WebDAV.................................................................................................................. 7-45
Nom Serveur .................................................................................................................................... 7-45
Chemin Fichier ................................................................................................................................. 7-45
Nom utilisat. ..................................................................................................................................... 7-45
Code d'accès................................................................................................................................... 7-45
Réglages détaillés ............................................................................................................................ 7-45
Prochaine Dest................................................................................................................................. 7-45
7.6.10 Vérif. histor. (Historique tâches) ....................................................................................................... 7-46
7.6.11 Rech. Adresse.................................................................................................................................. 7-46
7.6.12 Recherche LDAP - Recherche simple ............................................................................................. 7-47
7.6.13 Recherche LDAP - Recherche Avancée .......................................................................................... 7-47
Nom ................................................................................................................................................. 7-47
Adr. E-Mail ....................................................................................................................................... 7-47
Numéro Fax ..................................................................................................................................... 7-47
Nom ................................................................................................................................................. 7-47
Prénom............................................................................................................................................. 7-47
Ville................................................................................................................................................... 7-47
Nom société..................................................................................................................................... 7-48
Département .................................................................................................................................... 7-48
OU/ET/DÉBUT/FINIT PAR ............................................................................................................... 7-48
7.6.14 Présentation des réglages document .............................................................................................. 7-48
7.6.15 Réglages Document - Définition ...................................................................................................... 7-48
7.6.16 Réglages Document - Type Fichier ................................................................................................. 7-49
Type Fichier...................................................................................................................................... 7-49
Cryptage .......................................................................................................................................... 7-50
Cryptage - Paramètres détaillés ...................................................................................................... 7-50
Tampon/Surimpression.................................................................................................................... 7-52
PDF Contours .................................................................................................................................. 7-52
Réglage Numérisation...................................................................................................................... 7-53
7.6.17 Réglages Document - Couleur......................................................................................................... 7-53
7.6.18 Présentation des Réglages de Communication............................................................................... 7-54
7.6.19 Réglages de Communication - Réglages Ligne .............................................................................. 7-54
Description des réglages Ligne ....................................................................................................... 7-54
EMI Outremer................................................................................................................................... 7-54
ECM OFF ......................................................................................................................................... 7-55
V.34 OFF .......................................................................................................................................... 7-55
Vérif. Dest. & envoyer....................................................................................................................... 7-55
Sélect. ligne...................................................................................................................................... 7-55
7.6.20 Réglages de Communication - Réglages E-Mail ............................................................................. 7-56
Paramètres E-Mail ........................................................................................................................... 7-56
Nom Document................................................................................................................................ 7-56
Table des matières-6 ineo 223/283/363/423
Sujet ................................................................................................................................................. 7-56
De..................................................................................................................................................... 7-57
Corps txte ........................................................................................................................................ 7-57
7.6.21 Réglages de Communication - Vérif. régl URL Dest........................................................................ 7-58
URL Destination ............................................................................................................................... 7-58
Recherche détaillée ......................................................................................................................... 7-58
Saisie dir. ......................................................................................................................................... 7-58
7.6.22 Réglages de Communication - Réglage Méthod Comm................................................................. 7-59
Émission différée.............................................................................................................................. 7-59
Transmission par code d'accès (EMI Mode de passe).................................................................... 7-60
Émission Code F (Fonction TX code F)............................................................................................ 7-60
7.6.23 Réglages de Communication - Cryptage E-Mail ............................................................................. 7-61
7.6.24 Réglages de Communication - Signature numérique...................................................................... 7-61
7.6.25 Réglages de Communication - Réglages En-tête Fax..................................................................... 7-61
7.6.26 Présentation des réglages Applications .......................................................................................... 7-62
7.6.27 Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - Date/Heure....................................................................... 7-62
7.6.28 Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - Numéro Page................................................................... 7-62
7.6.29 Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - Tampon............................................................................ 7-62
7.6.30 Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - En-tête/Pied de page....................................................... 7-63
7.6.31 Applications - Impress. par page..................................................................................................... 7-63
7.7 Réglages Archivage (boîtes Public, Privé ou Groupe)............................................................... 7-64
7.7.1 Présentation des réglages Archivage .............................................................................................. 7-64
Description de l'onglet Réglages Archivage .................................................................................... 7-64
7.7.2 Suppression de documents............................................................................................................. 7-65
7.7.3 Modif. nom....................................................................................................................................... 7-65
7.7.4 Déplacer les documents .................................................................................................................. 7-65
7.7.5 Copie................................................................................................................................................ 7-66
7.7.6 Enregistrer dans mémoire externe................................................................................................... 7-66
Réglages Document......................................................................................................................... 7-67
Réglages Document - Définition ...................................................................................................... 7-67
Réglages Document - Type Fichier ................................................................................................. 7-68
Réglages Document - Couleur......................................................................................................... 7-68
7.7.7 Détails Document............................................................................................................................. 7-69
Affichage des Informations détaillées.............................................................................................. 7-69
Aperçu.............................................................................................................................................. 7-69
7.8 Applications................................................................................................................................... 7-70
7.8.1 Présentation des réglages Applications .......................................................................................... 7-70
Description de l'onglet Applications ................................................................................................ 7-70
7.8.2 Modifier document........................................................................................................................... 7-71
Modifier document - Suppr. page.................................................................................................... 7-71
Modifier document - Pivoter Page................................................................................................... 7-72
Modifier document - Déplacer Page................................................................................................ 7-74
Aperçu/Déf. Plage............................................................................................................................ 7-76
Aperçu/Spécification par saisie ....................................................................................................... 7-77
7.8.3 Enregistrer la surimpression ............................................................................................................ 7-78
Enregistrer la surimpression - Nouveau........................................................................................... 7-79
Enregistrer la surimpression - Écraser............................................................................................. 7-80
Paramètres Détaillés ........................................................................................................................ 7-81
7.9 Boîte Utilisateur Bulletin Bord (Système) ................................................................................... 7-82
7.9.1 Présentation des Boîtes Utilisateur Bulletin Bord............................................................................ 7-82
7.9.2 Écran Bte Util. Bulletin Bord ............................................................................................................ 7-82
7.9.3 Impression d'un document dans une boîte Bulletin ........................................................................ 7-82
7.9.4 Suppression d'un document d'une boîte Bulletin............................................................................ 7-82
7.10 Boîte Émis. en relève (Système) .................................................................................................. 7-83
7.10.1 Présentation boîtes Émission en relève ........................................................................................... 7-83
7.10.2 Impression d'un document dans la boîte Émission en relève ......................................................... 7-83
7.10.3 Suppression d'un document dans la boîte Émission en relève....................................................... 7-83
7.11 Boîte Utilisateur Document Sécurisé (Système) ........................................................................ 7-84
7.11.1 Présentation de la boîte Document sécurisé ................................................................................... 7-84
ineo 223/283/363/423 Table des matières-7
7.11.2 Procédure d'authentification 1......................................................................................................... 7-84
7.11.3 Procédure d'authentification 2......................................................................................................... 7-84
7.11.4 Impression - Impression .................................................................................................................. 7-85
Copies.............................................................................................................................................. 7-85
Impression ....................................................................................................................................... 7-85
Finition.............................................................................................................................................. 7-85
Combinaison.................................................................................................................................... 7-85
Zoom................................................................................................................................................ 7-85
Marge de page................................................................................................................................. 7-85
Insertion Feuille/Couverture/Chapitre .............................................................................................. 7-85
Tampon/Surimpression.................................................................................................................... 7-85
7.11.5 Réglages Archivage ......................................................................................................................... 7-86
7.12 Boîte Réception Mémoire Oblig. (Système)................................................................................ 7-87
7.12.1 Présentation de la Boîte Réception Mémoire Oblig......................................................................... 7-87
7.12.2 Impression ....................................................................................................................................... 7-87
7.12.3 Réglages Archivage ......................................................................................................................... 7-88
7.13 Boîte Annotation (Système) ......................................................................................................... 7-89
7.13.1 Présentation des fonctions Boîte Annotation .................................................................................. 7-89
7.13.2 Impression - Fonction de base ........................................................................................................ 7-89
7.13.3 Impression - Marge page................................................................................................................. 7-89
7.13.4 Impression - Insér. Feuil/Couv/Chapitre - Couverture..................................................................... 7-90
7.13.5 Impression - Insér. Feuil/Couv/Chapitre - Insertion Feuille ............................................................. 7-90
7.13.6 Impression - Insér. Feuil/Couv/Chapitre - Chapitres ....................................................................... 7-90
7.13.7 Impression - Tampon/Surimpression - Date/Heure......................................................................... 7-90
7.13.8 Impression - Tampon/Surimpression - Numéro Page..................................................................... 7-90
7.13.9 Impression - Tampon/Surimpression - Tampon.............................................................................. 7-90
7.13.10 Préférences d'impression - Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Protection Copie ................ 7-90
7.13.11 Préférences d'impression - Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Pare-copie.......................... 7-90
7.13.12 Impression - Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Copie Prot. MdP........................................ 7-90
7.13.13 Impression - Tampon/Surimpression - Tampon répétitif................................................................. 7-90
7.13.14 Impression - Tampon/Surimpression - Surimpression enregistrée ................................................. 7-90
7.13.15 Description de l'onglet Env. ............................................................................................................. 7-90
7.13.16 Env. - Saisie dir. - E-mail ................................................................................................................. 7-90
7.13.17 Env. - Saisie dir. - PC (SMB) ............................................................................................................ 7-90
7.13.18 Env. - Saisie dir. - FTP ..................................................................................................................... 7-91
7.13.19 Env. - Saisie dir. - WebDAV ............................................................................................................. 7-91
7.13.20 Env. - Vérif. histor............................................................................................................................. 7-91
7.13.21 Env. - Recherche LDAP - Recher simple......................................................................................... 7-91
7.13.22 Env. - Recherche LDAP - Recherche Avancée................................................................................ 7-91
7.13.23 Env. - Réglages Document - Définition............................................................................................ 7-91
7.13.24 Env. - Réglages Document - Type Fichier ....................................................................................... 7-91
7.13.25 Env. - Réglages Document - Couleur .............................................................................................. 7-91
7.13.26 Env. - Réglages de communication - Réglages E-Mail ................................................................... 7-91
7.13.27 Env. - Réglages de communication - Paramètres URL Dest........................................................... 7-91
7.13.28 Env. - Réglages de communication - Cryptage E-Mail ................................................................... 7-91
7.13.29 Env. - Réglages de communication - Signature numérique ............................................................ 7-91
7.13.30 Env. - Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - Date/Heure ............................................................ 7-91
7.13.31 Env. - Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - Numéro Page ........................................................ 7-91
7.13.32 Env. - Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - Tampon ................................................................. 7-92
7.13.33 Env. - Applications - Impress. par page .......................................................................................... 7-92
7.13.34 Env. - Applications - Changer Texte................................................................................................ 7-92
Texte numérotat............................................................................................................................... 7-92
Date/Heure....................................................................................................................................... 7-92
Densité ............................................................................................................................................. 7-93
Type Numéro ................................................................................................................................... 7-93
Position Impression ......................................................................................................................... 7-93
7.13.35 Réglages Archivage ......................................................................................................................... 7-94
Table des matières-8 ineo 223/283/363/423
7.13.36 Applications - Enregistrer la surimpression ..................................................................................... 7-94
7.14 Boîte Ré-émission Fax (Système)................................................................................................ 7-95
7.14.1 Présentation de la Boîte Ré-émission Fax....................................................................................... 7-95
7.14.2 Impression - Épreuve....................................................................................................................... 7-95
7.14.3 Env. - Fax......................................................................................................................................... 7-96
7.14.4 Réglages Archivage - Supprimer ..................................................................................................... 7-96
7.15 Boîte PDF Cryptés Mot de Passe (Système) .............................................................................. 7-97
7.15.1 Présentation de la Boîte PDF Crypté Mot de Passe........................................................................ 7-97
7.15.2 Impr/Enreg - Impr/Enreg .................................................................................................................. 7-97
7.15.3 Réglages Archivage - Supprimer ..................................................................................................... 7-97
7.16 Boîte Utilis. ID & Imprimer (Système).......................................................................................... 7-98
7.16.1 Présentation de la Boîte ID & Imprimer............................................................................................ 7-98
Voir documents................................................................................................................................ 7-98
7.16.2 Impression - Impression .................................................................................................................. 7-99
7.16.3 Réglages Archivage - Supprimer ..................................................................................................... 7-99
7.17 Mémoire externe (Système) ....................................................................................................... 7-100
7.17.1 Dispositif de mémoire externe ....................................................................................................... 7-100
Dispositifs de mémoire externe pris en charge ............................................................................. 7-100
Connexion du dispositif de mémoire externe ................................................................................ 7-100
7.17.2 Écran Mémoire externe.................................................................................................................. 7-101
Entrer un chemin de fichier ............................................................................................................ 7-101
Sélectionner un fichier ................................................................................................................... 7-101
Imprimer des données PDF cryptées ............................................................................................ 7-101
Déplacement vers le dossier parent .............................................................................................. 7-101
Ouvrir un dossier............................................................................................................................ 7-102
Imprimer......................................................................................................................................... 7-102
Détails Document........................................................................................................................... 7-102
7.17.3 Impression - Fonction de base ...................................................................................................... 7-102
Copies............................................................................................................................................ 7-102
Impression ..................................................................................................................................... 7-102
Position Reliure .............................................................................................................................. 7-102
Finition............................................................................................................................................ 7-103
Papier............................................................................................................................................. 7-103
7.17.4 Impression - Applications .............................................................................................................. 7-103
Tampon/Surimpression - Date/Heure............................................................................................ 7-103
Tampon/Surimpression - Numéro Page ........................................................................................ 7-103
Tampon/Surimpression - Tampon................................................................................................. 7-103
Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Protection Copie........................................................... 7-103
Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Pare-copie .................................................................... 7-103
Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Copie Prot. MdP........................................................... 7-103
Tampon/Surimpression - Tampon répétitif.................................................................................... 7-103
7.17.5 Réglages Fichier - Enreg. dans Boîte utilisateur ............................................................................ 7-104
7.18 Mobile/PDA (Système)................................................................................................................ 7-105
7.18.1 Environnement d'exploitation ........................................................................................................ 7-105
7.18.2 Mobile/PDA - Imprimer .................................................................................................................. 7-106
Saisie du code PIN......................................................................................................................... 7-106
Vérifier les préférences d'impression............................................................................................. 7-106
7.18.3 Mobile/PDA - Enregistrer ............................................................................................................... 7-107
Saisie du code PIN......................................................................................................................... 7-107
7.19 Boîte Document sécurisé (Système)......................................................................................... 7-108
7.19.1 Présentation de la boîte Document sécurisé ................................................................................. 7-108
7.19.2 Impression ..................................................................................................................................... 7-108
7.19.3 Réglages Archivage ....................................................................................................................... 7-109
8 Réglages Boîte
8.1 Structure des menus Réglages Boîte ........................................................................................... 8-3
8.1.1 Mode Utilisateur................................................................................................................................. 8-3
8.1.2 Réglage Administrateur...................................................................................................................... 8-4
ineo 223/283/363/423 Table des matières-9
8.2 Réglage Mode Utilisateur............................................................................................................... 8-6
8.2.1 Création d'une boîte .......................................................................................................................... 8-6
Boîte Public, Privé ou Groupe............................................................................................................ 8-6
Supprimer Boîte Vide (Réglages Administrateur)............................................................................... 8-7
Boîte Bulletin...................................................................................................................................... 8-8
Boîte Relais ........................................................................................................................................ 8-9
Boîte Document sécurisé................................................................................................................. 8-10
8.2.2 Paramètres Affichage Perso - Configurer la boîte ........................................................................... 8-11
Onglet par Défaut............................................................................................................................. 8-11
Touche de Raccourci ....................................................................................................................... 8-12
8.2.3 Réglage Mobile/PDA - Notif. Erreur Lien Fichier ............................................................................. 8-12
8.2.4 Réglage Mobile/PDA - Utilisation Serveur Proxy............................................................................. 8-13
8.2.5 Réglage Mobile/PDA - Réglages Impression................................................................................... 8-13
De base - Impression....................................................................................................................... 8-13
De base - Papier .............................................................................................................................. 8-14
De base - Finition............................................................................................................................. 8-14
Applications - Marge........................................................................................................................ 8-14
Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - Date/Heure....................................................................... 8-15
Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - Numéro Page................................................................... 8-15
Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - Tampon............................................................................ 8-15
Applications - Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Protection Copie ..................................... 8-15
Applications - Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Pare-copie............................................... 8-15
Applications - Tampon/Composition - Sécurité Copie - Copie Prot. MdP...................................... 8-15
Applications - Tampon/Surimpression - Tampon répétitif............................................................... 8-15
8.3 Réglage Administrateur................................................................................................................ 8-16
8.3.1 Autorisations de boîte ...................................................................................................................... 8-16
Types d'utilisateurs .......................................................................................................................... 8-16
Boîte Public et boîte Privé ou Groupe ............................................................................................. 8-16
8.3.2 Création d'une boîte ........................................................................................................................ 8-17
8.3.3 Créer une boîte Public, Privé ou Groupe ......................................................................................... 8-17
8.3.4 Créer une boîte Bulletin ................................................................................................................... 8-17
8.3.5 Créer un boîte Relais........................................................................................................................ 8-18
8.3.6 Créer une boîte Annotation.............................................................................................................. 8-18
8.3.7 Créer une boîte Document sécurisé ................................................................................................ 8-20
8.3.8 Réglage Maxi. Boîtes ....................................................................................................................... 8-20
Boîte Public, Privé ou Groupe.......................................................................................................... 8-20
Gestion Boîte maximum................................................................................................................... 8-20
Réglage Maxi. Boîtes ....................................................................................................................... 8-20
8.3.9 Configurer la boîte ........................................................................................................................... 8-21
Supprimer Bte Util. inutilisée............................................................................................................ 8-21
Suppr. Docs Impr. Sécurisée........................................................................................................... 8-21
Délai suppress Impress. sécuris. ..................................................................................................... 8-22
Délai suppress PDF cryptés............................................................................................................. 8-22
Délai Suppress. ID & Impr................................................................................................................ 8-23
Réglage attente doc......................................................................................................................... 8-23
Réglages Fonction Mémoire Externe............................................................................................... 8-24
Boîte Util. Autor./Interd. ................................................................................................................... 8-24
Réglage ID & Imprimer Supprimer après impression....................................................................... 8-25
Réglage Délai suppression Document............................................................................................. 8-25
Paramètres ID & Imprimer................................................................................................................ 8-26
8.3.10 Réglage Mobile/PDA........................................................................................................................ 8-26
8.3.11 Réglage administrateur Boîte Utilisateur ......................................................................................... 8-27
Réglage Administrateur de boîtes.................................................................................................... 8-27
Connexion à cette machine comme Administrateur de boîtes........................................................ 8-27
Fonctions Administrateur disponibles ............................................................................................. 8-27
8.3.12 Détails Sécurité ................................................................................................................................ 8-28
Impression sécurisée seulement...................................................................................................... 8-28
8.3.13 Paramétrage DD/Réglages SSD...................................................................................................... 8-28
Vérifier Capac. Disque Dur............................................................................................................... 8-28
Vérifier capacité SSD ....................................................................................................................... 8-29
Écraser données Disque Dur ........................................................................................................... 8-29
Écraser données .............................................................................................................................. 8-30
Table des matières-10 ineo 223/283/363/423
Mot de passe Accès DD .................................................................................................................. 8-31
Formater disque dur ........................................................................................................................ 8-32
Formater SSD .................................................................................................................................. 8-33
Réglage cryptage DD....................................................................................................................... 8-33
8.3.14 Réglages Tampon............................................................................................................................ 8-34
Régl. Horodatage............................................................................................................................. 8-34
9 Web Connexion
9.1 Utiliser Web Connection................................................................................................................. 9-3
9.1.1 Environnement d'exploitation ............................................................................................................ 9-3
9.1.2 Accéder à Web Connection ............................................................................................................... 9-3
9.1.3 Cache du navigateur Internet............................................................................................................. 9-4
Pour Internet Explorer ........................................................................................................................ 9-4
Pour Netscape Navigator................................................................................................................... 9-4
Pour Mozilla Firefox ........................................................................................................................... 9-4
9.1.4 Fonction Aide en ligne ....................................................................................................................... 9-4
9.2 Connexion et déconnexion ............................................................................................................ 9-5
9.2.1 Opérations de connexion et de déconnexion.................................................................................... 9-5
Lorsque Authentification utilisateur ou Compte Département est désactivé .................................... 9-5
Quand Authentification utilisateur ou Compte Département est activé............................................. 9-7
9.2.2 Déconnexion ...................................................................................................................................... 9-8
9.2.3 Connexion.......................................................................................................................................... 9-9
Options de Connexion ....................................................................................................................... 9-9
Connexion en tant qu'utilisateur public ........................................................................................... 9-10
Connexion en tant qu'utilisateur enregistré ..................................................................................... 9-11
Se connecter en mode Administrateur ............................................................................................ 9-12
Mode d'affichage en mode Administrateur ..................................................................................... 9-13
Connexion en tant qu'Administrateur de boîte ................................................................................ 9-14
9.3 Configuration de la page.............................................................................................................. 9-15
9.4 Présentation du mode Utilisateur................................................................................................ 9-17
9.4.1 Information ....................................................................................................................................... 9-17
9.4.2 Tâche ............................................................................................................................................... 9-18
9.4.3 Boîtes ............................................................................................................................................... 9-18
9.4.4 Impression directe ........................................................................................................................... 9-19
9.4.5 Enregistrement Destination.............................................................................................................. 9-20
9.4.6 Personnaliser ................................................................................................................................... 9-21
9.5 Gérer un document dans une boîte............................................................................................. 9-22
9.5.1 Afficher sous forme de liste des documents enregistrés dans une boîte........................................ 9-22
Connexion de boîte.......................................................................................................................... 9-22
Liste de fichiers ................................................................................................................................ 9-23
9.5.2 Imprimer un document..................................................................................................................... 9-24
9.5.3 Envoyer un document à une autre machine .................................................................................... 9-27
9.5.4 Téléchargement des données d'un document sur votre ordinateur................................................ 9-29
9.5.5 Déplacer ou copier un document vers une autre boîte utilisateur ................................................... 9-32
9.5.6 Supprimer un document .................................................................................................................. 9-33
9.6 Présentation du mode Administrateur........................................................................................ 9-35
9.6.1 Entretien........................................................................................................................................... 9-35
9.6.2 Réglage Système ............................................................................................................................. 9-36
9.6.3 Sécurité ............................................................................................................................................ 9-37
9.6.4 Authentification utilisateur/Compte département............................................................................ 9-38
9.6.5 Réseau ............................................................................................................................................. 9-39
9.6.6 Boîtes ............................................................................................................................................... 9-40
9.6.7 Réglages imprimante ....................................................................................................................... 9-41
9.6.8 Enregistrement Destination.............................................................................................................. 9-42
9.6.9 Réglage fax ...................................................................................................................................... 9-43
9.6.10 Multiréglage ..................................................................................................................................... 9-44
ineo 223/283/363/423 Table des matières-11
10 Annexe
10.1 Liste des messages d'erreur........................................................................................................ 10-3
10.2 Glossaire ........................................................................................................................................ 10-4
11 Index
11.1 Index des éléments....................................................................................................................... 11-3
11.2 Index des touches......................................................................................................................... 11-6
Table des matières-12 ineo 223/283/363/423
1 Introduction
ineo 223/283/363/423 1-3
1.1 Bienvenue 1
1 Introduction
1.1 Bienvenue
Nous vous remercions d'avoir acheté cet appareil.
Ce guide de l'utilisateur décrit les fonctions, les instructions, les précautions d'utilisation et les procédures
de dépannage élémentaires relatives à cette machine. Pour tirer le maximum de ce produit et l